# The Baha'i World: Volume 17 (1976-1979)

*Exported from [Holy-Writings.com](https://www.holy-writings.com/) on 2026-06-19 — 1 clipping.*

---

> Source: Bahá'í Library Online (bahai-library.com), curated by Jonah Winters. Used by permission of the curator. Original citation: Universal House of Justice, The Baha'i World: Volume 17 (1976-1979), Haifa: Bahá’í World Centre, 1981, bahai-library.com.
> ──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
> 
> THE BAHA'I WORLD
> VOLUME XVII
> 133, 134 and 135
> OF THE BAHA'I ERA
> 1976- 1979
> Da wn over th e Uppe r Chamber of th e Ho use of th e Bab in Shlraz where He
> declared His mission.
> THE BAHA'I WORLD
> AN INTERNATIONAL RECORD
> 
> Prepared under the supervision of
> The Universal House of Justice
> 
> VOLUME XVII
> 
> 133, 134 and 135
> OF THE BAHA'I ERA
> 1976-1979
> 
> BAHA'I WORLD CENTRE
> HAIFA
> 1981
> © 1981 The Universal House of Justice
> 
> World Rights Reserved
> 
> NOTE: The spelling of the Oriental words and proper names used
> in this volume of The Baha'i World is according to the system of
> transliteration established at one of the International Oriental
> Congresses .
> 
> ISBN 0-85398-130-2
> 
> Printed in Great Britain
> by Mackays of Chatham Ltd
> PREFACE
> THE successive volumes of The Baha'i World have come to be anticipated hy Baha'ls
> as the record of their own collective endeavours on behalf of their Faith, of the
> establishment and development of its administrative order throughout the world and as
> the source of data, both historical and statistical, relating to the rise of that Faith during
> its formative age.
> By librarians and students The Baha'i World is becoming ever more widely known as a
> source of authentic information about the aims, tenets, history, activities, organization
> and growth of the Baha'i Faith. The editors therefore have always in mind the preservation of an even balance between the presentation of material of supreme interest to
> believers and of a fair and objective picture to enquirers. In this they are guided by the
> policy of Shoghi Effendi, Guardian of the Baha'i Faith, who directed the compilation of
> the successive volumes from I to XII covering the years 1925 to 1954. The first volume,
> known as Baha'i Year Book , was in fact a one-year survey; the next seven volumes were
> biennial, terminating in 1940; volume IX recorded the four years from 1940 to 1944;
> volume X was again biennial and volumes XI and XII presented the periods 1946 to
> 1950 and 1950 to 1954 respectively. All these volumes were published in the United
> States under the aegis of the National Spiritual Assembly, volume I being compiled by
> an editorial committee of American Baha'ls, and the remainder by an international
> board of editors, all under the supervision of the Guardian of the Faith. Volume XIII,
> which recorded the passing of the Guardian and the course and completion of his Ten
> Year Crusade, covered the entire period from 1954 to 1963 and was produced under the
> supervision of the Universal House of Justice , which thenceforth assumed responsibility
> for publication. Volumes XIV, XV and XVI covered the years 1963 to 1968, 1968 to
> 1973 and 1973 to 1976 respectively.
> This volume, XVII, relating to the years 1976 to 1979, records the centenary
> observation in the Holy Land in June 1977 of the termination of Baha'u'llah's
> confinement in the prison-city of 'Akka; progress made towards restoration of the
> House of 'Abdu'llah Pasha and towards construction of the permanent Seat of the
> Universal House of Justice; the holding in the Holy Land in May 1978 of the fourth
> International Convention; the laying of the cornerstones for Baha'i Houses of Worship
> in India and Samoa; the holding of eight International Teaching Conferences; the
> initiation in December 1977 of the first Baha'i full-time radio station in the world at
> Otavalo, Ecuador; the successful completion of the Five Year Plan launched at Ri<;lvan
> 1974; the announcement in December 1978 of the inauguration at Ri<;lvan 1979 of a
> Seven Year global teaching plan constituting yet another stage in the unfoldment of
> 'Abdu'l-Baha's Divine Plan, and the resumption in Iran on a scale unprecedented in
> recent history of persecutions and hardships directed against the Persian Baha'i community and the holy places of the Faith.
> CONTENTS
> 
> *
> Introduction
> Page
> AIMS AND PURPOSES OF THE BAHA'I FAITH, by David Hofman . .                                                                            1
> 
> PART ONE
> 
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION
> 
> I. EXCERPTS FROM THE BAHA'I SACRED WRITINGS
> 1. Baha'u'llah . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       9
> 2. The Bab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    22
> 3. 'Abdu'l-Baha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       28
> 
> II. EXCERPTS FROM THE WRITINGS OF SHOGHI EFFENDI
> 1. A Wider Loyalty-Excerpts from Call to the Nations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                        43
> 
> PART TWO
> THE COMMEMORATION OF HISTORIC ANNIVERSARIES
> 
> I. THE CENTENARY OF THE TERMINATION OF BAHA'U'LLAH'S
> CONFINEMENT IN' AKKA
> 1. The Significance of Baha'u'llah's Incarceration in 'Akka-Excerpts from God
> Passes By, by Shoghi Effendi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                   51
> 2. Excerpt from the Message of the Universal House of Justice to the Annual
> Conventions of all National Spiritual Assemblies-24 March 1977 . . . . . . . .                                                   63
> 3. The Commemoration at the World Centre of the Centenary of the
> Termination of Baha'u'llah's Confinement in 'Akka . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                      64
> 
> PART THREE
> 
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I
> ACTIVITIES
> 
> I. THE FIRST VISIT BY A BAHA'f REIGNING MONARCH TO THE
> RESTING PLACE OF SHOGHI EFFENDI                                                                                                      69
> 
> II. THE FIVE YEAR INTERNATIONAL TEACHING PLAN 1974-1979
> 1. The Completion of the Five Year International Teaching Plan . . . . . . . . . . . .                                              71
> Vlll                                                            CONTENTS
> 
> Page
> 2. The World Centre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            71
> 3. Summary of National Goals and Accomplishments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                       85
> 4. Summary of Other Accomplishments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            98
> 5. Expansion and Consolidation of the Baha'i Faith including the period of the
> Five Year Plan- Information Statistical and Comparative . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                        106
> A. Africa . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   106
> B. The Americas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           107
> c. Asia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   107
> o. Australasia and the Pacific Islands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        108
> E . Europe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    108
> 
> III. EIGHT INTERNATIONAL TEACHING CONFERENCES
> 1. Arise!-A Pictorial Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    109
> 2. Messages of the Universal House of Justice to the Eight International
> Teaching Conferences ...... : . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      129
> A. To the International Teaching Conference in He lsinki, Finland 5-8
> July 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          129
> B. To the International Teaching Conference in Anchorage, Alaska
> 23 - 25 July 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                130
> c. To the International Teaching Conference in Paris 3-6 August 1976 .                                                          131
> o. To the International Teaching Conference in Nairobi, Kenya 15-17
> October 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               133
> E. To the International Teaching Conference in Hong Kong27-30
> November 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  135
> F. To the International Teaching Conference in Auckland, New Zealand
> 19-22 January 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     136
> G. To the International Teaching Conference in Bahia, Brazil 27-30
> January 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               137
> H. To the International Teaching Conference in Merida, Mexico 4-6
> February 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                139
> 3. Message of Mr. Kurt Waldheim , Secretary-General of the United Nations,
> to the International Baha'i Conference, Paris, 3-6 August 1976 . . . . . . . . . . .                                               140
> 
> IV. INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES
> 1976-1979
> 1. Survey by Continents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        141
> A. Africa . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
> B. The Americas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        157
> c. Asia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
> o. Australasia and the Pacific Islands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      186
> E. Europe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  190
> 2. The Challenge and Promise of Baha'i Scholarship . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                195
> 3. The Canadian Association for Studies on the Baha'i Faith 1975-1979 . . . . .                                                197
> Appendix I . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    199
> Appendix II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     200
> Appendix III . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    200
> 4. Survey of Activities of Baha'i Women in the Five Year Plan by R. Collins . .                                                 202
> 5. Survey of the expanded use of Radio and Television in the Five Year Plan . .                                                215
> 6. The New Era Baha'i School . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               225
> 7. Rural Development in India . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              227
> V. THE BAHA'I FAITH AND THE UNITED NATIONS
> 1. SummaryoftheYears1947-1976 .......... . ...... . ... . . ........ .. ...                                                            229
> CONTENTS                                                                      ~
> 
> Page
> 2. The Baha'i International Community and the United Nations 1976-1979                                                              233
> Annex I . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      243
> Annex II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       243
> Annex III . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        244
> 
> VI. RECOGNITION OF THE BAHA'I FAITH
> 1. Incorporation of National Spiritual Assemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                      247
> 2. Incorporation of Local Spiritual Assemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                   258
> 3. A Selection of other Documents Recording Official recognition
> of the Baha'i Faith . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               269
> 
> PART FOUR
> 
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA 'U'LLAH
> 
> I. THE UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE
> 1. The Constitution of the Universal House of Justice                                                                                  285
> 2. The Fourth International Convention for the Election of the Universal
> House of Justice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            293
> 3. The Historic Significance of the Erection of the Seat of the Universal House
> of Justice, by Paul Haney . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                   301
> 4. The Construction of the Building for the Seat of the Universal House of
> Justice-A Pictorial Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      303
> 5. A Tribute by Chiampo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    314
> 
> II. THE HANDS OF THE CAUSE OF GOD
> 1. The Hands of the Cause of God and the Extension of their Functions into the
> F uture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   317
> A. The Rulers and the Learned                          ....................................                                      317
> B. The Hands of the Cause of God . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                               318
> c. The Continental Boards of Counsellors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                   319
> o . The International Teaching Centre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                              322
> 2. The Work and Travels of the Hands of the Cause . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                        326
> 3. Hands of the Cause who Represented the Universal House of Justice at
> Inaugural Conventions for the election of National Spiritual Assemb lies
> 1976- 1979 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          333
> 
> III. THE NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY
> 1. Introduction, by Horace Holley . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        334
> 2. A Model Declaration of Trust and By-Laws for a National Spiritual
> Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        337
> 3. A Procedure for the Conduct of the Annual Baha'i Convention . . . . . . . . . . .                                                   346
> 
> IV. THE LOCAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY
> 1. The Institution and its Significance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          349
> 2. By-Laws of a Local Spiritual Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                 361
> 
> V. THE INSTITUTION OF THE MASHRIQU ' L - ADHKAR
> 1. Foreword, by Horace Holley . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                         365
> 2. The Spiritual Significance of the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                        366
> 3. The Laying of the Foundation Stone of the Mother Temple of the Indian
> Subcontinent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           368
> x                                                                CONTENTS
> 
> Page
> 4. The Laying of the Foundation Stone of the First Mashriqu'l-Adhkar of the
> Pacific Islands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   371
> A. Text of Address delivered by His Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II . . .                                                  372
> B. Excerpts from the Address of the Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha
> Rul)iyyih Khanum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             373
> 5. The Designation of the Mother Temple of the West as a National Historic
> Place by the United States Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                         375
> VI. THE NON-POLITICAL CHARACTER OF THE BAHA'I FAITH
> 1. The Non-Political Character of the Baha'i Faith-Excerpts from the
> Writings of Shoghi Effendi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                 377
> VII. RELATIONSHIP TO GOVERNMENT
> 1. Loyalty to Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  383
> 2. The Baha'i View of Pacifism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      384
> 3. Summary of the Guardian's Instructions on the Obligations of Baha'is in
> Connection with Military Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       384
> VIII. BAHA'I CALENDAR, FESTIVALS AND DATES OF HISTORICAL
> SIGNIFICANCE
> 1. Foreword . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       386
> 2. Baha'i Feasts, Anniversaries and Days of Fasting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                   386
> 3. Baha'i Holy Days on which work should be suspended . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                           387
> 4. Additional material gleaned from Nabil's Narrative regarding the Baha'i
> Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       387
> 5. Historical Data gleaned from Nabil's Narrative regarding Baha'u'llah . . . . . .                                                   390
> 6. Dates of Historical Significance in the Rise of the Baha'i Faith . . . . . . . . . . . .                                           394
> 
> PART FIVE
> 
> IN MEMORIAM
> Page                                                                      Page
> 
> Anderson, Angela Annette . . .                          417                 Gupta, Nathulal . . . . . . . . . . . . .             444
> 'Azzavi, Siyyid Mu9ammad . . .                          425                 Gutos, Javan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          455
> Battrick, Jeannette Hilda . . . . .                     4 70                Hafner, Otto .. .. .. .. .. .. .. ..                  473
> Blackwell, Ellsworth . . . . . . . . .                  452                 Hornell (Kathleen, Lady
> Blundell, Hugh K. . . . . . . . . . . .                 421                   Hornell) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      443
> Boon, Choo Yeok . . . . . . . . . . .                   404                 Huffman, Evelyn and Vern . . .                        466
> Bowman, Amelia . . . . . . . . . . . .                  409                 'Ilmi, Siyyid Ma9f~u'l-l:laq . . . .                  446
> Brown, Ramona Allen Bray . . .                          399                 Irizarry, Maria T. . . . . . . . . . . . .            437
> Busey, Garreta Helen . . . . . . . .                    422                 Iverson, Clarence John . . . . . . .                  47 4
> Derozhinsky, Pamela . . . . . . . . .                   465                 JOrgensen, Else . . . . . . . . .. . . . . .          428
> Ebo, Antonio Francisco . . . . . .                      432                 el Khemiri, 'Abdu'l-I:Iamid . . .                     427
> Enongene Joseph . . . . . . . . . . . .                 412                 Kurlawala, Ghulam-'Ali . . . . . .                    460
> Fananapadhir, 'Inayatu'llah . . .                       453                 Laite, Gordon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           456
> Fat9-'A~am, Ru9angiz . . . . . . .                      467                 Laws, Elizabeth S. . . . . . . . . . . .              459
> Franchino, Leticia . . . . . . . . . . .                413                 Linfoot, Charlotte M. . . . . . . . .                 423
> Fujita, Saichiro . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            406                 Maxwell, Marion Lord . . . . . . .                    429
> Gomez, Luisa Mapa . . . . . . . . .                     441                 Meymoun, Ismail Hiwari . . . . .                      4 72
> Gregory, Ernest . . . . . . . . . . . . .               454                 Miessler, Edmund . . . . . . . . . . .                430
> Grossmann, Elsa Maria . . . . . . .                    440                 Moffett, Ruth J. . . . . . . . . . . . . .            463
> Giiney, Muzaffer . . . . . . . . . . . .               445                 Mohapi, Chadwick and Mary . .                         449
> CONTENTS                                                               xi
> Page                                                                  Page
> Richardson, Doris . . . . . . . . . . .            410                Tijssen-Hartmann, Emma
> Safrang, Gulbanu . . . . . . . . . . . .           416                 Margaret . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      4 74
> Salazar, Anguel Maria . . . . . . . .              420                Tobey, Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        401
> ~amimi, AJ:tmad . . . . . . . . . . . . .          411                Trigg, Martha 'Nakiya'
> Senne, Dorothy Kedibone . . . .                    434                 Noyakuk..... . . . . . . . . . . . . .            447
> Sharp, Adelaide . . . . . . . . . . . . .          418                VanSombeek, Georgette . . . . .                    475
> Steffes, Marian . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        458                Wayenece, Emma . . . . . . . . . . .               414
> Taymuri-Muqadam, RuJ:t'u'llah                      433                Yazdani, AJ:tmad . . . . . . . . . . . .           438
> Thomas, Wilma . . . . . . . . . . . . .            436
> 
> PART SIX
> DIRECTORY, BIBLIOGRAPHY, GLOSSARY
> I. BAHA'I DIRECTORY
> 1. The Universal House of Justice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           481
> 2. The Hands of the Cause . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     481
> 3. The International Teaching Centre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            481
> 4. Continental Boards of Counsellors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            482
> 5. Baha'i International Community . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           482
> 6. National Spiritual Assemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        482
> 7. Baha'i Publishing Trusts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   482
> 
> II. BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY
> 1. Baha'u' llah's Best-Known Works                                                                                       484
> 2. The Bab's Best-Known Works ..................................... .. .                                                 485
> 3. 'Abdu' l-Baha's Best-Known Works ...................... . . . ... .... . . .                                          486
> 4. Some Compilations from the Writings of Baha'u'llah, the Bab and' Abdu'l-Baha                                          487
> 5. Shoghi Effendi's Best-Known Works . .. . . ... ... ....... .. ............ . .                                        487
> 6. Language and Literature Achievements of the Five Year Plan- Ric:Ivan
> 1974-1979 ................... .. .. . .......... . .. . ................. .                                           489
> A. Africa ....................... . . .. . . ....... ......... . . . .. ... . . .                                   489
> B. The Americas ......... . ..... . ................... . ..... . . . . . .. .                                     491
> c. Asia ............ . ... .. . . ... . ...... . . . . ..... ... . .. . ... . .... . . .                            493
> D. Australasia ...... . ............ . .. . .................... . ...... .                                         494
> E. Europe .. . ............ . ..... . ............... . ..... . ... . .. .... .                                     494
> F. Invented Languages ............................ . ....... . ...... .                                            495
> G. Total by Continents ................ . ..... . .................... .                                            495
> 7. The Short Obligatory Prayer in 391 Languages, Dialects or Scripts ... . ... .                                         496
> A. Africa ....................................................... .                                                 497
> B. The Americas . . .... .. ......... . .......... . ................... .                                          510
> c. Asia .. . ........................... . .................... . .... .                                            519
> D. Australasia and the Pacific Islands ................ . ............. .                                           533
> E. Europe .................... . ....... . ..... . . . ................. .                                          536
> F. Invented Languages .. .... ......... ....... ... ................ . . .                                         540
> 8. Major Works and Partial List of Languages in which they are available ... . .                                         542
> A. Works of Baha'u'llah . . .............. . ......................... .                                            542
> B. Works of the Bab ............ . .. . ..................... . .... . .. .                                        542
> c. Works of 'Abdu'l-B aha . ........... ..... ... . ................... .                                           542
> o. Works Compiled from the Writings of Baha'u'llah, The Bab and
> 'Abd u'l-Baha ....... . .............. ............. ....... . ..... .                                          542
> E. Works of Shoghi Effendi ..... . ..... . ........... . .............. .                                           542
> XU                                                            CONTENTS
> 
> Page
> 9. A Selection of Introductory and Expository Works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                 543
> A. General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     543
> B. For Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        544
> c. Periodicals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     544
> D. International Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              545
> 10. The Publication and Disseminatio n of Baha'f Literature in English, by
> William P. Collins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       546
> 11. Bibliographies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   554
> A . A Bibliography of Baha'f Books and Booklets in the English
> Language, by Robert E. Cadwalader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          554
> (i) The Writings of Baha' u' llah . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    554
> (ii) The Writings of the Bab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    555
> (iii) The Writings of 'Abdu'l-Baha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                         555
> (iv) Works compiled from the Writings of Baha'u'llah and
> 'Abdu'l-B a ha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           558
> (v) The writings of Shoghi Effendi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          560
> (vi) Messages and compilations of the Universal House of Justice . .                                                 562
> (vii) Writings on the Baha'f Faith . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        562
> B. An Alphabetical Listing of Authors, Compilers and Translators of
> Baha'f Books and Booklets in the English Language, by Robert E.
> Cadwalader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       572
> c. A Bibliography of Baha'f Children's Literature in the English
> Language, 1917-1979, by Robert E. Cadwalader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                       575
> D. A Partial Bibliography of English-language Books by non-Baha'fs in
> which Mention is Made of the Baha'f Faith, by Maureen Thur . . . . . . .                                               577
> E. A Partial Bibliography of English-language items by Baha'fs in
> which Mention is Made of the Baha'f Faith . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                              593
> F. A Partial Bibliography of Theses Relating to the Baha'f Faith                                                          593
> 
> III. ORIENTAL TERMS
> 1. Transliteration of Oriental Words Frequently used in Baha'f Literature                                                         595
> 2. Guide to Transliteration and Pronunciation of the Persian Alphabet . . . . . . .                                               597
> 3. Notes on the Pronunciation of Persian Words . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                              597
> 4 . Definitions of Some of the Oriental Terms Used in Baha'f Literature . . . . . .                                               599
> 
> PART SEVEN
> LITERARY AND MUSICAL WORKS
> 
> I. ESSAYS AND REVIEWS
> 1. The Unity of Re ligion and Science, by William S. Hatcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                     607
> 2. Can There Be a Baha'f Poetry?, by Geoffrey P. Nash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                    620
> 3. Highlights in the Life of Mfrza Abu'l-Fa<;ll, by R. Mehrabkhani . . . . . . . . . . .                                         625
> 4. A Portion of Radiance: A Reminiscence, by Berthalin Allien . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                          630
> 5. Fragments from a Diary, by Jonathan Rishworth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                 632
> 6. Reginald Turvey: An Appreciation of the Man and His Art, by
> Lowell Johnson . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      634
> 
> II. VERSE                                                                                                                              639
> 
> III. MUSIC                                                                                                                              653
> LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
> 
> Frontispiece:           Dawn over the Upper Chamber of the House of the Bab in Shiraz where He
> declared His mission (photo courtesy of Mihdi ~amfmi)
> 
> Part One: The Baha'i Revelation
> Page
> The Mansion of Bahji . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              18
> Entrance from an adjoining dwelling which gives access to the courtyard of the House of
> the Bab in Shiraz . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          23
> Courtyard of the House of the Bab in Shiraz . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                              23
> View of the garden in the courtyard of the House of the Bab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                          24
> Upper chamber of the House of the Bab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            24
> 'Abdu'l-Baha-photograph taken in 1912 during His visit to the United States . . . . . .                                                          34
> 'Abdu'l-Baha-photograph taken in Philadelphia; 1912 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                          36
> A glimpse of 'Abdu'l-Baha in the Holy Land . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                               38
> 'Abdu'l-Baha-photograph taken in Paris; 1911 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                   40
> A selection of the Writings of' Abdu'l-Baha translated into English . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                            41
> The resting place of Shoghi Effendi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      42
> Entrance of the Baha'i International Archives building on Mount Carmel . . . . . . . . . . .                                                     45
> 
> Part Two: The Commemoration of Historic Anniversaries
> 
> Two views of 'Akka . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           53
> View of 'Akka looking north-west . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       55
> Partial view of sea wall and fortifications, 'Akka . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                             56
> Two views of Baha'u'llah's room in the prison of 'Akka . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                     57
> Inn of the Pillars (Khan-i-'Avamfd), 'Akka . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                           59
> The Mansion of Bahji . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             60
> The Shrine of the Bab, Mount Carmel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          61
> Aerial view of Mazra'ih . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              63
> Hands of the Cause, members of the Universal House of Justice and Counsellor members
> of the International Teaching Centre gathered at the House of 'Abbud . . . . . . . . . . .                                                      64
> Mount Carmel: view of the Shrine of the Bab and the Baha'i International Archives
> building . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   65
> The Shrine of Baha'u'llah . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              66
> 
> Part Three: International Survey of Current
> Baha'i Activities
> 
> His Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II of Western Samoa and others visiting the resting
> place of Shoghi Effendi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              69
> Graph illustrating growth of the Baha'i Faith 1953-1 979 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                       70
> Three volumes of Sacred Text produced during the Five Year Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                72
> Three volumes of The Baha'( World produced during the Five Year Plan . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                     72
> First shipment of marble for Permanent Seat of the Universal House of Justice . . . . . .                                                        73
> Aerial view of the Shrine of Baha'u'llah showing newly-developed gardens . . . . . . . . . .                                                     74
> View of the gardens at Mazra'ih . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    75
> United Nations Seminar on Participation of Women in Development, Kathmandu,
> Nepal; 15- 22 February 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    77
> XIV                                                      LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
> 
> Page
> A Baha'i worker preparing to read microfilmed documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                               83
> The House of 'Abdu'l-Baha in ' Akka, known as the house of 'Abdu'llah Pasha . . . . . .                                                               84
> Asian Baha'i Women's Conference, New Delhi , India; 13-16 October 1977 . . . . . . . . .                                                              91
> Third annual Baha'i Children's Conference, Guyana; March 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                     93
> The Hand of the Cause Amatu' l-Baha Rul:llyyih Khanum with Maori and Polynesian
> Baha'is of New Zealand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     95
> Some students of the Ideal Baha'i Primary School, Dharmanager, North Tripura , India .                                                                96
> Some students of the Baha'i Primary School, Tadung, Gangtok, Sikkim . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                         97
> 'Erena Roe', a catamaran used for teaching in Kiribati and Tuvalu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                100
> Xhosa translation of Baha' u'llah 's Kitab-i-lqan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                101
> His Majesty Sobhuza II, King of Swaziland, accepting an illuminated Baha'i prayer for
> unity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   102
> Mrs. Dorothy Francis, recipient of the Order of Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                           103
> Mr. and Mrs. Eric Bowes at dedication of a library named in honour of Mr. Bowes . . .                                                                104
> Mr. Viiino Rissanen, the first Baha'i of Finland . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                 129
> The first Baha'i group of Paris, circa 1902 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            132
> Mr. Robert Turner, 'disciple of 'Abdu'l-B aha' . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                 133
> The Hands of the Cause John Henry Hyde Dunn and Clara Dunn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                       137
> Mrs . Leonora Holsapple Armstrong . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            138
> ' Abdu'l-Baha in Paris; 1912 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                   140
> Conference of Counsellors and Auxiliary Board members for Central and East Africa                                                                    142
> First Baha'i Summer School of Rhodesia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                               145
> Baha'i Booth, Trade Fair, Gaborone, Botswana ; July 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                             146
> Conference of Counsellors, Auxiliary Board members and assistants for Western African
> zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    148
> Baha'i Women's Conference , Niger; January 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                        151
> First Baha'i Summer School of Sierra Leone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                   151
> Baha'is and guests, Rosso, Mauritania . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            151
> Baha'is of Kumba , Cameroon Republic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                               152
> The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone at dedication of a Regional Baha'i Centre,
> Ghana . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       152
> Baha'is and guests, Illie-Etche, River State, Nigeria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                    152
> Baha'i Children's Class, Chad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      155
> Site of the future Mashriqu' l-Adhkar, Lome, Togo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                      155
> Baha'i Children's Class, Ikot Uba Village, Cross River State, Nigeria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                  155
> Teaching Conference, Martinique, French Antilles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                       159
> Guaymi and Cuna Indian Baha'is who participated in satellite teaching conference,
> Magisterio Panameno Unidas, Panama . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                  160
> International Baha'i Youth Conference , San Jose, Costa Rica . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                               160
> National f:Ia:(':fratu'l-Quds, Nassau, Bahamas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                             161
> First Canadian Baha'i Native Council, Tyendinaga, Ontario . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                              162
> Baha'i exhibit 'Symposium of Philosophies and Religions'-Montreal, Quebec . . . . . . .                                                              163
> Public information advertisement placed in Canadian publications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                 163
> Baha'i Children's Class, San Jose, California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                164
> Facsimile of bronze plaque marking entry of the Baha'i House of Worship, Wilmette in
> U .S. Government National Register of Historic Places . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                         165
> Baha'i Centre, San Francisco, California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                             167
> 'Baha'i Week' proclamation materials, Los Angeles, California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                167
> Baha'i exhibit, Dulles International Airport, Washington, D .C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                              167
> Some participants in third All-Quechua Conference, Otavalo, Ecuador . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                        171
> Street poster, Brazil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            171
> Students of the Baha'i School of La Cisterna, Chile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                      171
> LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS                                                                        XV
> 
> Page
> Mr. Victor Raul Haya de la Torre of Peru with delegation of Baha'is . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                   173
> Baha'i Children's Class, Ecuador . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        174
> National Teaching Conference, Ponape, Caroline Islands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                            177
> The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone and other Baha'is at the first National
> Convention of the Baha'is of the Marshall Islands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                    177
> Hawaiian Baha'i float entered in 'Aloha Week' parade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                          177
> Some participants in Baha'i Summer School, Taiwan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                         181
> Baha'is of the Lama tribe, Winter School, Bangladesh . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                        181
> Participants in third Western Asian Youth Conference, Lucknow, India . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                      181
> Participants in a nine-day Spiritual Institute, Malaysia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                    183
> Participants in World Religon Day meeting, Hong Kong . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                            183
> Students and faculty of the Rabbani Baha'i School, Gwalior, India . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                 183
> Siyyid Shah Mul)ammad, pioneer (Luristan, Iran) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                     184
> Baha'i Children's Class, Daglanlu Village, Adhirbayjan, fran . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                            185
> Conference of Auxiliary Board members and assistants, Tonga . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                 187
> Baha'i Children's Conference, Samoa . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                             187
> Baha'i singing group of New Ireland, Papua New Guinea . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                             189
> Baha'i Youth Conference, Port Vila, New Hebrides . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                        189
> Participants in programme commemorating the International Year of the Child, Sydney,
> Australia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      189
> Baha'i exhibition and tent, Jokkmokk Winter Market, Sweden . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                191
> Exhibit on 'Six World Religions', Cambridge, England . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                        191
> Baha'i information counter, Orebro, Sweden . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                  191
> First Baha'i Winter School of Malta . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                         192
> First Baha'i Winter School of Cyprus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          193
> Participants in the annual meeting of the Canadian Association for Studies on the Baha'i
> Faith; January 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               199
> Five publications produced by the Canadian Association for Studies on the Baha'i Faith                                                              200
> Amatu'l-Baha Rujtiyyih Khanum at the formal welcome to the Maori Meeting House,
> New Zealand; January 1979 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                         204
> Mrs. Mehrangiz Munsiff with Girl Guides, New Hebrides; 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                   206
> Dr. Jane Faily with participants in a Teacher Training Institute, Nigeria; 1979 . . . . . . .                                                       206
> His Excellency James R. Mancham, President of Seychelles, in interview with Mrs. Lea
> Nys ; November 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  206
> Participants in National Baha'i Women's Conference, El Salvador; March 1977 . . . . . .                                                             208
> Participants in National Baha'i Women's Conference, Senegal; April 1978 . . . . . . . . . .                                                         208
> Participants in first National Baha'i Women's Conference, Bangladesh; January 1977 .                                                                208
> Four participants in the National Teaching Conference, Umgababa, South Africa;
> October 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            211
> Participants in the first International Conference of Baha'i Women of South America-
> Peru ; December 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  211
> Some participants in the first National Baha'i Children's Conference of Samoa; April
> 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   211
> Some participants in the Asian Baha'i Women's Conference, India; October 1977 . . . .                                                               212
> Marion Jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         213
> Site of a new short-wave broadcasting facility for Radio Baha'i, O tavalo, Ecuador . . . .                                                          216
> Radio personnel preparing a tape for broadcasting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                     216
> Silhouette of the antenna and broadcasting studio, Cajas, Ecuador . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                 216
> Participants in National Teaching Conference, Cajas, Ecuador; August 1978 . . . . . . . .                                                           218
> Representative sampling of references to the Baha'i Faith from newspapers and journals .                                                            218
> Participants in the international television and radio workshop, Otavalo, Ecuador;
> December 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               223
> xvi                                                    LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
> 
> Page
> Inauguration of the New Era Rural Development Project, Chikli, India; October 1975 .                                                            228
> United Nations Day observance, Porto Alegre, Brazil; October 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                 235
> United Nations Day observance, San Salvador, El Salvador; October 1976 . . . . . . . . . .                                                      237
> International Year of the Child observance, Karachi, Pakistan; December 1979 . . . . . .                                                        241
> United Nations Day display, Moen, Truk Islands; December 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                 245
> Mrs. Nancy B. Mondschein and Mrs. T. Memet Tanumidjaja . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                              245
> Governor George R. Ariyoshi of Hawaii signing the document proclaiming 18 September
> 1977 as World Peace Day . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  246
> Baha'fs who participated in the dedication of the local J:Ia~fratu' l-Qud s , Annandale ,
> Demerara, Guyana; 27 June 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          246
> Certificate of Incorporation in American Samoa of the National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Baha'fs of Samoa; 23 April 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       248
> Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of South
> and West Africa; 13 August 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       249
> Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Singapore; 4 October 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              250
> Act of Parliament incorporating the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of
> Guyana, passed on 9 December 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            251
> Receipt for Declaration of Association of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs
> of Gabon; 8 April 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                252
> Letter from the Ministry of Justice and Ecclesiastical Affairs confirming registration of the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Iceland as a religious society of Iceland,
> 29 April 1977, with translation into English . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            253
> Certificate of Registration of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Suriname
> and French Guiana; 16 January 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            254
> Extract from the Official Journal of New Caledonia for 3 November 1978, relating to the
> Declaration of Association of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of the
> New Hebrides; receipt dated 19 October 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                   255
> Extract from the Official Journal of the French Republic relating to the registration of the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the French Antilles; 5 January 1979 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                255
> Certificate oflncorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Caroline Islands; 29
> January 1979 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        256
> Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Mariana Islands; 2
> April 1979 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   257
> Certificates of Incorporation of the Local Spiritua l Assemblies of the Baha'fs of
> Ufwenuka and Mwiika Villages, Zambia, both dated 3 May 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                  259
> Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Perseverance Village (Couva), Trinidad and Tobago; 9 July 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                       260
> Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Tauranga
> City , New Zealand; 12 July 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     261
> Extracts from articles of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of
> Willemstad, Curac;ao, signed 6 December 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                 262
> Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Portland
> Cottage, Jamaica; 29 September 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          263
> Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Lipan,
> Papua New Guinea; 11 January 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            264
> Presidential Decree approving By-Laws and conferring Juridical Personality on the Local
> Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Palomita, Paraguay; 3 July 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                               265
> Extract from the Official Journal of French Polynesia of 15 July 1978, rela ting to the
> registration of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Tahiti; receipt dated 22
> June 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    266
> Extract from the Official Journal of New Caledonia for 1 December 1978, relating to the
> LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS                                                                       XVll
> 
> Page
> Declaration of Association of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of Fila Island,
> New Hebrides; receipt dated 23 November 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                           267
> Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of Galway,
> Ireland; 20 February 1979 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      268
> Document signed by primary school authorities in Wetzikon, Switzerland, permitting
> Baha'i students to be absent from school on Baha'i Holy Days ; 19 April 1977 . . . . .                                                             270
> Letter dated 15 October 1977 from Ministry of Lands and Settlements, exempting the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of Kenya from payment of rates . . . . . . .                                                            271
> Letter dated 28 October 1977 from the office of the Minister of Home Affairs and Health ,
> approving the appointment of Mr. Eric Wilson as Marriage Officer of Belize for the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of Belize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                       272
> Letter dated 16 June 1978 from the National Register Coordinator, Division of Historic
> Sites, Illinois Department of Conservation , giving notice that the Baha'i House of
> Worship in Wilmette, Illinois was on 23 May 1978 entered in the National Register of
> Historic Places . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            273
> Certificate of Registration of the Baha'i Faith as a religious body in Tuvalu ; 8 August
> 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     274
> Certificates of Registration of Baha'i symbols with the African Office of Industrial
> Property on behalf of the National Spiritual Assemblies of the Central African Empire,
> the Cameroon Republic, and the Ivory Coast; 18 August 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                     275
> Extract from the Gazette of India for 9 September 1978, relating to exemption from
> income tax of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of India, with translation
> into English . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         276
> Letter dated 8 November 1978 from Ministry of Churches, legalizing Baha'i marriage in
> Denmark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          277
> Certificates of Approval of Religious Organization authorizing establishment of the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of the Cook Islands; 20 December 1978,
> with cover letter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            278
> Letter dated 3 February 1979 addressed to Court of Personal Status for Non-Muslims by
> the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of the Sudan, designating representative
> to appear before the Court in matters of Baha'i personal status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                279
> Letter dated 9 March 1979 from the Procurer General of the Republic, confirming that
> the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of Zaire obtained civil personality by
> ordinance on 9 June 1972 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       280
> Resolution adopted 15 March 1979 by the House of Representatives of the Eighty-First
> General Assembly, State of Illinois, calling upon the President of the United States to
> urge the Government of Iran to recognize the religious character of the Baha'i Faith,
> and to assure the rights of all religious minorities including the Baha'ls . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                 281
> Letter dated 28 March 1979 signed by 22 members of the United States Senate, addressed
> to the Prime Minister of Iran, expressing concern for the rights of religous minorities,
> including the Baha'ls, under the new Provisional Revolutionary Islamic Government of
> Iran . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   282
> 
> Part Four: The World Order of Baha'u'llah
> 
> Facsimile of signatures on the Constitution of the Universal House of Justice; 26
> November 1972 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                287
> The Hands of the Cause Amatu' l-Baha RuJ:ilyyih Khan um and Paul Haney with members
> of the Universal House of Justice elected at Ric;lvan 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                           292
> Counsellor Thelma Khelgati with delegates from Niger who participated in the fourth
> International Convention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     294
> xviii                                                    LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
> 
> Page
> Mr. Anthony Providence addressing the delegates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                      295
> Partial view of the exhibit on display during the fourth International Convention . . . . .                                                          295
> Delegates from Japan who participated in the fourth International Convention . . . . . . .                                                           295
> Delegates from Ghana who participated in the fourth International Convention . . . . . .                                                             297
> Mr. Kawku Negble Attigah of Togo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                             297
> Mr. Adrien Zanou Gnambode of Benin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                   297
> Silver box holding containers of Dust from the Shrines of Baha'u'llah and the Bab . . .                                                              298
> The Hands of the Cause and Counsellors, Mazra'ih; May 1978 · ....................                                                                    299
> Amatu'l-Baha RuQ.iyyih Khanum in conversation with Mr. Alibe Mimba of Surinam . .                                                                    300
> The construction of the building for the Seat of the Universal House of Justice: a
> photographic report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                303
> Booklet published by the town of Chiampo, Italy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                      316
> The Continental Board of Counsellors for Australasia; January 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                     320
> The Continental Board of Counsell ors for Central America; March 1977 . . . . . . . . . . .                                                          320
> The Continental Board of Counse llors for North America; October 1976 . . . . . . . . . . .                                                          320
> The Hand of the Cause Abu'l-Qasim Faizi during his visit to Fiji; March 1977 . . . . . . .                                                           325
> The Hand of the Cause' Ali-Akbar Furutan paying a courtesy call on Mr. Krishan Chand,
> Lieutenant Governor of India; November 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                        327
> The Hand of the Cause' Ali-Mul)ammad Varga during his visit to French Guiana; Spring
> 1979 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    329
> The Hand of the Cause John Robarts visiting the Irish Baha'i Summer School; August
> 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    330
> The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone visiting the Baha'is of Sagafau, Savai'i,
> Western Samoa; 12 April 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          331
> The Hands of the Cause who participated in the International Teaching Conference in
> Paris . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   332
> The Hand of the Cause Ral)matu' llah Muhajir and Mr. Mazco Kucel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                       332
> The Hand of the Cause Ugo Giachery and some participants in the Teaching Conference
> held in San Zano, Italy; May 1976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                           332
> 
> Some newly-formed National Spiritual Assemblies
> 1977-1978
> Page                                                                             Page
> Greece(1977) ..... . ............                                  336              Burundi (re-established 1978)                                    347
> The French Antilles (1977) . . . . . . .                           336              The Bahamas (1978) . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     348
> The Marshall Islands ( 1977) . . . . . .                           336              Cyprus (1978) Inaugural Convention                               348
> The New Hebrides (1977) . . . . . . . .                            341              The Mariana Islands (1978) . . . . . . .                         348
> Surinam and French Guiana (1977)                                   341              Mauritania (1978) Inaugural
> Upper Volta (1977) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     341              Convention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             348
> The Spiritual Assembly of Ocean Island (Banaba); Ric;lvfo 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                 354
> 
> Some newly-formed Local Spiritual Assemblies
> 1976-1979
> Page                                                                              Page
> Nuuk , Greenland . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                   354              Emmen, the Netherlands . . . . . . . . .                         360
> Imphal, Manipur, India . . . . . . . . . . .                       360
> The first incorporated Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Hamilton Township, New
> Jersey, U.S.A.; October 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                         364
> The Mother Temple of the West, Wilmette, Illinois, U.S.A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                              367
> Model of the Mother Temple of the Indian Sub-continent, New Delhi, India . . . . . . . . .                                                           368
> LIST OF ILL UST RA TIO NS                                                                   XlX
> 
> Page
> Amatu'l-Baha Rulµyyih Khanum at the ceremony for laying the foundation stone of the
> House of Worship of India . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     369
> Amatu'l-Baha Rulµyyih Khan um laying the foundation stone of the House of Worship of
> India . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   370
> Architect's impression of the first Mashriqu'l-Adhkar of the Pacific Islands . . . . . . . . . .                                                    371
> His Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II addressing those gathered to witness the laying of
> the foundation stone of the first Mashriqu'l-Adhkar of the Pacific Islands . . . . . . . . . .                                                    372
> Amatu'l-Baha Rulµyyih Khanum at the ceremony for laying the foundation stone of the
> first Mashriqu'l-Adhkar of the Pacific Islands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                373
> His Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II laying the foundation stone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                               374
> Amatu'l-Baha Rulµyyih Khanum laying the foundation stone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                374
> Casket containing Dust from the Shrines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                             374
> Two views of 'Abdu'l-Baha taken on 1 May 1912 at the dedication of the site of the
> Baha'i House of Worship, Wilmette, Illinois, U.S.A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                         376
> Partial view of the Baha'i cemetery, Mount Carmel, Haifa, Israel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                396
> 
> Part Five: In Memorian
> Page                                                                            Page
> Brown, Ramona Allen Bray . . . . . . .                             400             Yazdani, AJ:imad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     438
> Tobey, Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                401             Grossmann, Elsa Maria . . . . . . . . . . .          440
> Boon, Choo Yeok . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      405             Gomez, Luisa Mapa . . . . . . . . . . . . .          442
> Fujita, Saichiro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               407             Hornell (Kathleen, Lady Hornell) .                   443
> Bowman, Amelia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     409             Gupta, Nathulal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    444
> Richardson, Doris . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    411             Giiney, Muzaffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     445
> $amfmf, AJ:imad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  412             'Ilmf, Siyyid MaJ:iflizu'l-I:Iaq . . . . . . .       447
> Enongene, Joseph . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     413             Trigg, Martha 'Nakiya' Noyakuk . . .                 448
> Franchino, Leticia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                   414              Mohapi, Chadwick and Mary ... . 449, 451
> Wayenece, Emma . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       415             Blackwell, Ellsworth . . . . . . . . . . . . .       452
> Safrang, Gulbanu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                   416             Fananapadhfr, 'Inayatu'llah . . . . . . .            453
> Anderson, Angela Annette . . . . . . .                             41 7            Gregory, Ernest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    455
> Sharp, Adelaide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  419             Gutos, Javan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 456
> Salazar, Anguel Marfa . . . . . . . . . . . .                      421             Laite, Gordon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  457
> Blundell, Hugh K. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    422             Steffes, Marian . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  458
> Busey, Garreta H. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    423             Laws, Elizabeth S. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     459
> Linfoot, Charlotte M. . . . . . . . . . . . .                      424             Kurlawala, Ghulam-'Ali . . . . . . . . . .           461
> 'Azzavf, Siyyid MuJ:iammad . . . . . . .                           425             Moffett, Ruth J. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   463
> el Khemfrf, 'Abdu' l-I:Iamfd . . . . . . .                         427             Derozhinsky, Pamela . . . . . . . . . . . . .        465
> Ji:irgensen, Else . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              428             Huffman, Evelyn and Vern . . . . . . .               467
> Maxwell, Marion Lord . . . . . . . . . . .                         430             FatJ:i-A''.?am, RuJ:iangfz . . . . . . . . . . .     469
> Miessler, Edmund . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     431             Battrick, Jeannette Hilda . . . . . . . . .          471
> Ebo, Antonio Francisco . . . . . . . . . .                         432             Meymoun, Ismail Hiwari . . . . . . . . .             472
> Taymlirf- Muqadam, RuJ:i'u'llah . . . .                            434             Hafner, Otto . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
> Senne, Dorothy Kedibone . . . . . . . .                            435             Tijssen-Hartmann, Emma Margaret                      474
> Thomas, Wilma . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    436             VanSombeek, Georgette . . . . . . . . .              475
> Irizarry, Maria T. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                 437
> One of the ornamental urns which grace the gardens surrounding the Shrine of the Bab                                                                4 78
> 
> Part Six: Directory, Bibliography, Glossary
> 
> Facsimile of the Short Obligatory Prayer in Braille (English) Grade II . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                  541
> Baha'i literature display sponsored by the Baha'i Publishing Trust of Taiwan . . . . . . . .                                                        541
> xx                                                   LIST OF ILLUSTRATIO NS
> 
> Page
> Some current Baha'i periodicals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               545
> Examp les of Baha'i literature in English . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                   551
> Baha'i literature display , Belo Horizonte, Brazil; October 1977 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                    552
> Baha 'i literat ure display sponsored by the Baha'i Publishing Trust of Italy, Milan Trade
> Fair, April 1978 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    571
> Ca ll igraphic arrangement of part of the opening sentence of the Will and Testament of
> 'Abdu' l-Baha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   598
> Calligra phic arrangement by Mishkin-Qalam of the invocation: 'Praise be to God, the
> Exalted, the Beloved!' . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        604
> 
> Part Seven: Literary and Musical Works
> 
> Mirza Ab u'l-Fa<;ll (1844-1914) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             626
> Reginald Turvey (1882- 1968) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                636
> Untitled painting by Reginald Turvey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    637
> INTRODUCTION
> 
> AIMS AND PURPOSES OF THE
> BAHA'I FAITH
> DAVID HOFMAN
> 
> RELIGION has two objectives, the regen-                human relationships, and establish once for all
> eration of men and the advancement of man-              the machinery that can best incarnate this funkind. All men have been created to carry for-           damental principle of its life.' 1
> ward an ever advancing civilization proclaims              Religion sees the course of history as an
> Baha'u'llah, and The purpose of the one true            organic process, moving towards the full real-
> God, exalted be His glory, in revealing Himself         ization of all the potentialities implanted in
> unto men is to lay bare those gems that lie hid-        man . The vicissitudes, the great advances, the
> den within the mine of their true and inmost            hiatuses it regards as the natural unfoldment of
> selves.                                                 that process just as the succession of bud, leaf,
> These aims of religion, universal and eternal,       flower and fruit is the natural unfoldment in the
> nevertheless have been conditioned to the               life of a tree; or infancy, childhood, youth and
> capacities of each age or dispensation and the          maturity in that of a man. Indeed, Baha'i scripgreat religions of the past have developed their        ture explains, the process is the same. The sun
> social orders within generally definable times          is the effective agent in the organic life of the
> and areas . Judaism, for instance, attained its         earth; religion in that of humanity. The Sun of
> peak under Solomon and was confined, before             Truth is the Word of God upon which depends
> the dispersion, to the Near East; Zoroastrian-          the education ofthose who are endowed with the
> ism remained Persian until the Arab conquest            power of understanding and of utterance. 2 The
> and the settlement of a remnant in Western              creative Word, revealed in each stage of
> India; Christianity became the religion of              human progress by a Manifestation of God,
> European civilization; the building of the              and conditioned to the requirements of the
> nation state undertaken by Islam remained a             time, is the effective agent in the long, single
> Muslim experiment until feudal Europe                   process of humanity's development from
> learned the lesson and its city states gave way         infancy to World Order. This truth is enshrined
> to and adopted the more advanced order. It has          in all revealed religion although it needs the
> remained for the Baha'i religion to declare and         illumination of Baha'u'llah's revelation to
> promote the cause of world order-the sine               enable men to perceive it. 'The first picture
> qua non of its existence-and to disclose the            presented in the Bible is that of human unity in
> concomitant unities of religion, of mankind             its simplest form; that of a single family. The
> and of historical purpose. 'Unity of family, of         last picture is that of a unity manifold and
> tribe, of city-state, and nation have been suc-         universal in which all kindreds and tongues and
> cessively attempted and fully established.              peoples and nations are gathered into one and
> World unity is the goal towards which a har-            unified in the enjoyment of a common worship,
> assed humanity is striving. Nation-building has         a common happiness, a common glory.
> come to an end. The anarchy inherent in state              'The great problem which, according to the
> sovereignty is moving towards a climax. A               1
> Shoghi Effendi, Guardian of the Baha'i Faith, The
> world, growing to maturity, must abandon this               Unfoldment of World Civilization.
> fetish, recognize the oneness and wholeness of          2
> BaM'u'llah, Daryay-i-Danim.
> 2                                            THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Bible, confronts the human race in its progress         tion of mankind which must turn again to God
> is that of advancing from the barest, baldest           and recognize His purpose . The two aims of
> unity through a long experience of multiplying          religion are, therefore, interacting and
> diversities till ultimately a balance between the       interdependent.
> two principles is struck, poise is gained and the          Such a world-shaking transformation cannot
> two forces of variety and unity are blended in a        be brought about by any movement of reform,
> multiple, highly developed world fellowship,            however disinterested, nor by any unaided
> the perfection of whose union was hardly sug-           human effort. Modern man has turned away
> gested in the primitive simplicity of early             from God, and bereft of his traditional sancman.''                                                  tions, has inevitably wrecked his old order
> This spiritual view of evolution is the con-        which, in truth, is lamentably inadequate to
> stant theme of religion. Each revelation refers         modern conditions and is not susceptible of
> to the past, looks forward to the future and            repair. Soon, is Baha' u'llah's prophetic view of
> concentrates upon the immediate need for                our day, will the present-day order be rolled up,
> spiritual regeneration and enlightenment. The           and a new one spread out in its stead. Likewise,
> Prophet evokes in human hearts a sacrificial            The signs of impending convulsions and chaos
> love which transcends self-interest and causes          can now be discerned, inasmuch as the prevailthe early believers to dedicate themselves              ing order appears to be lamentably defective.
> entirely to the practice and diffusion of the new          The current aim of religion, embodied in the
> message . As it spreads it works like leaven in         aims and purposes of the Baha'i Faith, is the
> society, reforming its morals, uplifting its vi-        promotion of the next stage in the organic prosion and promoting a greater diffusion of love          cess of human evolution-the coming of age of
> in social action .                                      the human race . The achievement of this
> 'World history at its core and in its essence is    maturity will be attested by the unification of
> the story of the spiritual evolution of mankind.        mankind and the federation of the world in a
> From this all other activities of man proceed           single, all-embracing world society of human
> and round it all other activities revolve.' 2           brotherhood. But great objectives are reached
> Unlike the revelations of the past, the Baha'i      by dedicated pursuit of the preliminary and
> revelation releases not only the creative Word          intermediate stages of the task, without ever
> necessary to the renewal of spiritual vitality in       losing sight of the ultimate goal, and this has
> the human spirit, but embodies that divine              been and is now the occupation of the Baha'i
> energy in an administrative order capable of            world community-the completion within
> bringing within its shade all the diversified           specified times of specified goals. These teachethnic groups and myriad types of the human             ing plans to which the Baha'is eagerly devote
> race, who may find within its wide embrace a            their lives do far more than simply increase the
> full, happy and purposeful life. Baha'i activity        size and consolidation of that world commutherefore is directed not only, as in the past, to     nity. They are devised and launched by the
> the spreading of the Word, but to the estab-           head of the Faith- the Guardian and now the
> lishment of the fabric of that Order which,            Universal House of Justice-and are therefore
> enshrined within the creative Word itself,             conceived from a global view, directed to the
> becomes the chief instrument for the further           immediate needs of the great objective, condiffusion and social application of the Divine         servative of the community's resources,
> Message. This World Order, which the Baha'i            world-wide in scale permitting the organic
> Faith exists to establish, is none other than that     development of each part according to its stage
> long-promised Kingdom in which peace, jus-              of growth but with due regard for the needs of
> tice and brotherhood shall prevail universally         the whole, fostering intensively the unity, the
> and 'the earth shall be filled with the knowl-          international co-operation, the diversification
> edge of the glory of the Lord, as the waters            of the ethnic, religious and social backgrounds
> cover the sea.' 3 The establishment of this             of its increasing membership and developing
> World Order is dependent upon the regenera-             new resources for the next step forward .
> It should be noted that none of these plans is
> George Townshend, The Heart of the Gospel , 1939.
> ibid.                                               isolated in aim or conception but all are
> Habakkuk 2: 14.                                     directed towards the implementation of three
> INTRODUCTION                                                   3
> 
> great charters, enshrined in Baha'i sacred Writ-           implementing these three charters and it is
> ings, which authorize and guide the expansion              incontrovertibly apparent that never in any
> of the Faith and the development of its institu-           preceding Dispensation has the command to
> tions. In past Dispensations the command to                spread the Word of God been given, in the
> 'spread the Gospel' has been general and                   sacred text, such explicit guidance and detailed
> unspecified. It was the inspired guidance of the           objectives.
> beloved Guardian of the Baha'i Faith which                     As the Faith of Baha'u'llah increases in size
> disclosed to a spiritually delighted and grateful          and influence other aims and objectives
> community yet another of the unique features               become apparent and possible of pursuit. The
> of this Dispensation in the specific guidance              relationship with agencies, institutions and
> given in these three charters for the implemen-            authorities of the non-Baha'i world becomes
> tation of this eternal command.                            an important consideration once the commu-
> Baha'u'llah's Tablet of Carmel is the charter           nity emerges from obscurity, and has led to
> for the development of the Baha'i World                    public relations programmes and the develop-
> Centre in the twin cities of 'Akka and Haifa,              ment of closer association with the United
> the site of its most sacred Shrines-the tombs              Nations. The Baha'i International Community
> of the twin Prophets and of' Abdu'l-Baha, the              is accredited as a non-governmental agency
> Centre of the Covenant-its monuments and                   with consultative status to the United Nations
> gardens, and of its 'world-shaking, world-                 Economic and Social Council (ECOSOC) and
> embracing, world-directing administrative                  in various ways to other agencies of the United
> institutions'. 1                                           Nations. The fostering of this relationship has
> The Will and Testament of 'Abdu'l-Baha is               been the goal of all international plans so far,
> the charter for the development of the adminis-            and is visualized as a continuing process. There
> trative order of the Faith. In this majestic               are other objectives related to the special
> document, the child of 'that mystic intercourse            characteristics of Baha'i life which become
> between Him Who communicated the generat-                  more and more important as the Faith grows
> ing influence of His divine Purpose and the                and engages greater and greater public atten-
> One Who was its vehicle and chosen recip-                  tion. They affect Baha'i individuals, comient,'2 are delineated the structure of the                munities and institutions alike. These objecadministrative order, its modus operandi, its              tives fall into two groups-those concerned
> main institutions, the chain of authority, the             specifically with standards of conduct and
> source of guidance and the position of every               those which relate to special Baha'i practices.
> believer vis-a-vis the Covenant. It has been                   The standards of conduct enjoined by the
> well called the 'Charter of the New World                  Prophet are invariably different from and
> Order of Baha'u'llah'.                                     sometimes diametrically opposed to the gener-
> The Tablets of the Divine Plan, a series of             ally accepted ones of His day. High standards
> fourteen letters written by' Abdu'l-Baha to the            of conduct are, throughout Baha'i scripture,
> believers of the United States and Canada,                 constantly upheld and urged upon the believsome addressed to the entire company of                    ers, but the Guardian of the Faith in an essay
> believers in the North American continent and              written in 1938 addressed to the believers in
> others to those in named geographical areas of             the United States and Canada laid great stress
> that continent, constitute the charter for teach-          upon the 'spiritual prerequisites ... which coning the Faith throughout the world. 'Abdu'l-               stitute the bedrock on which ... all teaching
> Baha names the places, the people to whom                  plans ... must ultimately rest ... ' 3 He writes of
> teachers must go, the conditions under which               ' . . . a high sense of moral rectitude in their
> they must travel and settle and He reveals sev-            social and administrative activities, absolute
> eral prayers for those who undertake this all-             chastity in their individual lives, and complete
> important task.                                            freedom from prejudice in their dealings with
> All the international plans of the Faith                peoples of a different race, class, creed or collaunched so far have set specific goals aimed at           our.'4 In his expansion of this theme he
> Shoghi Effendi, The Spiritual Potencies of That Consedeclared that 'This rectitude of conduct, with
> crated Spot .                                              Shoghi Effendi, The Advent of Divine Justice .
> Shoghi Effendi, The Dispensation of Baha'u'l/ah.         'ibid.
> 4                                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> its implications of justice, equity, truthfulness,          intensely dynamic and highly responsible body
> honesty, fairmindedness, reliability, and trust-            of the elected national representatives of every
> worthiness, must distinguish every phase of the             Baha'f community, which constitutes the suslife of the Baha'i community.'' ' A chaste and              taining pillar, and the sole instrument for the
> holy life must be made the controlling principle            election in every community, of that Universal
> in the behaviour and conduct of all Baha'is,                House whose very name and title, as ordained
> both in their social relationships with the                 by Baha'u'llah, symbolizes that rectitude of
> members of their own community, and in their                conduct which is its highest mission to
> contacts with the world at large.' 2 'It requires           safeguard and enforce.' 6
> total abstinence from all alcoholic drinks, from               The attitudes deriving from such standards,
> opium, and from similar habit-forming drugs.                and from all the varied teachings of Baha'-
> It condemns the prostitution of art and of liter-           u'llah, must pervade all Baha'i communities
> ature, the practices of nudism and of com-                  and imbue them with distinctive characteristics
> panionate marriage, infidelity in marital rel a-            which can be recognized, amid the welter of
> tionships, and all manner of promiscuity, of                opposing or mutually uninterested groups and
> easy familiarity , and of sexual vices.' 3 'As to           factions into which modern society is disinteracial prejudice, the corrosion of which, for               grating, as easily as the features of an indiwell nigh a century, has bitten into the fibre ,            vidual in a crowd.
> and attacked the whole social structure of                     Those special Baha'f practices which will
> American society, it should be regarded as                  inevitably characterize the Baha'i community,
> constituting the most vital and challenging                 are the regular observances of its Holy Days
> issue confronting the Baha'i community [of                  and Festivals, the abstention from work on
> that country] at the present stage of its evolu-            nine such days during the year, the observances
> tion.'4                                                     by all members of the community of the annual
> The regeneration of men-the first objective              fast , of the laws governing marriage and
> of religion mentioned in this essay-is there-               divorce, of daily prayer, of the invariable pracfore seen as the prime objective of the Bah a'i             tice of consultation in all affairs of life, and
> Faith. Membership in the Faith is drawn from                particularly by the regular observance of the
> that society which permits and indulges itself in           Nineteen Day Feast. The habitual practice of
> all those corrupt, immoral and prejudiced                   such laws and ordinances is an objective puractivities which Baha'is are required to                    sued by all Baha'fs and Baha'i families.
> renounce, and since the Faith is steadily but                  It is seen that the aims and purposes of the
> persistently growing in numbers there is reason             Baha'i Faith may be stated as the raising up of a
> to hope that slowly but surely a regeneration               world-wide community recruited from every
> will take place.                                            race , nation , colour, religious and social back-
> Further, these Baha'f standards of conduct               ground known on the planet, inspired, united
> are not for individuals alone. They must be the             and regenerated by the spiritual teachings and
> hallmark of Baha'i institutions and com-                    love of Baha'u'llah, dedicated to the building
> munities. 'Such a rectitude of conduct,' wrote              of that New World Order which 'may well be
> the Guardian, 'must manifest itself, with ever-              regarded a~ the brightest emanation' 7 of His
> increasing potency , in every verdict which the              mind and is none other than the long hoped for,
> elected representatives of the Baha'i commu-                 Christ-promised Kingdom of God on earth. To
> nity, in whatever capacity they may find them-               prepare men for the gifts of that Kingselves, may be called upon to pronounce. It                  dom-peace , brotherhood , spirituality-and
> must be constantly reflected in the business                 to raise its very fabric in the world , are the
> dealings of all its members, in their domestic               immediate and long-time objectives of the
> lives, in all manner of employment, and in any               Baha'i Faith.
> service they may , in the future , render their                The energies of the Baha'is therefore, in
> government or people.' 5 'It must be made the                pursuance of these aims, flow in three major
> hallmark of that numerically small , yet                    channels: individual spiritual development,
> Shoghi Effendi , Th e Advent of Divine Justice.
> l   ibid.                                                       ibid.
> 3   ibi d.                 ' ibid.               , ibid.        Shoghi Effendi , God Passes By , p. 213 .
> INTRODUCTION                                               5
> conveying the message of Baha'u'llah to               conserved to the service of human welfare by
> others, and developing the pattern of world           the agencies of Baha'u'llah's World Order will
> society embodied in the Baha'i administrative         result in the proliferation of new arts and sciorder. All these activities derive from the sac-      ences, new social and economic relationships,
> red text and it is the unique feature of the          new educational methods and a general acces-
> Baha'i revelation that whereas the first two are      sion of well-being and felicity. The vision of the
> common to all revealed religions it is only           Baha'i Faith, though glorious, is a practical
> Baha'u'llah Who creates the institutions and          one, and the number of its dedicated promotreveals the laws, delineates the social order and     ers grows with increasing speed. It is summaestablishes the principles of the civilization to     rized in the following words by the Guardian of
> which His revelation will give rise. Neither          the Baha'i Faith in his essay The Unfoldment of
> Moses nor Christ, MuJ:iammad, Buddha,                 World Civilization:
> Zoroaster or Krishna did this, although They             'The unity of the human race, as envisaged
> all foretold that it would be done by Him Who         by Baha'u'Ilah, implies the establishment of a
> would take the government upon His shoul-             world commonwealth in which all nations,
> ders and establish the Kingdom in peace and           races, creeds and classes are closely and perrighteousness.                                        manently united, and in which the autonomy of
> None of the traditional motives operates to        its state members and the personal freedom
> create the Baha'i community, neither former           and initiative of the individuals that compose
> associations, political or economic identity of       them are definitely and completely safeinterest, racial or patriotic grouping. Only the      guarded. This commonwealth must, as far as
> recognition and love of Baha'u'llah brings into       we can visualize it, consist of a world legislaclose relatedness and co-operative action peo-        ture, whose members will, as the trustees of the
> ple from every human background, of all types         whole of mankind, ultimately control the
> of character and personality, divergent and           entire resources of all the component nations,
> diversified interest. Through their brother-          and will enact such laws as shall be required to
> hood in Baha'u'llah the old crystallized forms        regulate the life, satisfy the needs and adjust
> of human divisiveness to which they formerly          the relationships of all races and peoples. A
> belonged, whether of class, race, religion,           world executive, backed by an intern ational
> occupation, temperament or degree of civiliza-        Force, will carry out the decisions arrived at,
> tion lose their rigidity and eventually disinte-      and apply the laws enacted by, this world legisgrate. The growing Baha'i community on the            lature, and will safeguard the organic unity of
> other hand is essentially based on love, is a         the whole commonwealth. A world tribunal
> brotherhood, a family, each member delight-           will adjudicate and deliver its compu lsory and
> ing in the diversity of its membership, welcom-       final verdict in all and any disputes that may
> ing the former pariah or outcast as a new flower      arise between the various elements constitutin the garden, each as proud of his humanity as       ing this universal system. A mechanism of
> was ever the former chauvinist of his country.        world inter-communication will be devised,
> Within such a community the sun of Baha'-          embracing the whole planet, freed from
> u'llah's revelation can evoke new morals, new         national hindrances and restrictions, and funcattitudes, new conventions, new hopes and vi-         tioning with marvellous swiftness and perfect
> sions, all enshrined within the text of the revela-   regularity . A world metropolis will act as the
> tion itself and which provide the spiritual           nerve centre of a world civilization, the focus
> atmosphere and distinctive culture of the new         towards which the unifying forces of life will
> day. Such a community, as it grows, becomes           converge and from which its energizing
> more and more a true social order, providing a        influences will radiate. A world language will
> soil to human life, a climate for its best            either be invented or chosen frbm among the
> development , an arena for the practice of its        existing languages and will be taught in the
> highest aspirations, and a beacon light to            schools of all the federated nations as an auxilattract and guide the disillusioned, spiritually      iary to their mother tongue. A world script, a
> impoverished, frenetic and frustrated peoples         world literature, a uniform and universal sysof the earth.                                         tem of currency, of weights and measures, will
> The energies of this new culture, guided and       simplify and facilitate intercourse and under-
> 6                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> standing among the nations and races of man-         economic or political. will be consecrated to
> kind. In such a world society, science and relig-    such ends as will extend the range of human
> ion, the two most potent forces in human life,       inventions and technical development, to the
> will be reconciled, will co-operate , and will       increase of the productivity of mankind, to the
> harmoniously develop. The press will, under          extermination of disease, to the extension of
> such a system, while giving full scope to the        scientific research, to the raising of the stanexpression of the diversified views and convic-      dard of physical health, to the sharpening and
> tions of mankind, cease to be mischievously          refinement of the human brain, to the exploitamanipulated by vested interests, whether pri-        tion of the unused and unsuspected resources
> vate or public, and will be liberated from the       of the planet, to the prolongation of human
> influence of contending governments and peo-         life, and to the furtherance of any other agency
> ples. The economic resources of the world will       that can stimulate the intellectual, the moral ,
> be organized, its sources of raw materials will      and spiritual life of the entire human race.
> be tapped and fully utilized, its markets will be       'A world federal system, ruling the whole
> co-ordinated and developed, and the distribu-        earth and exercising unchallengeable authority
> tion of its products will be equitably regulated.    over its unimaginably vast resources, blending
> 'National rivalries, hatred, and intrigues will   and embodying the ideals of both the East and
> cease , and racial animosity and prejudice will      the West, liberated from the curse of war and
> be replaced by racial amity, understanding and       its miseries, and bent on the exploitation of all
> co-operation. The causes of religious strife will    the available sources of energy on the surface
> be permanently removed, economic barriers            of the planet, a system in which Force is made
> and restrictions will be completely abolished,       the servant of Justice, whose life is sustained by
> and the inordinate distinction between classes       its universal recognition of one God and by its
> will be obliterated. Destitution on the one          allegiance to one common Revelation -such
> hand, and gross accumulation of ownership on         is the goal towards which humanity, impelled
> the other, will disappear. The enormous              by the unifying forces of life, is moving .'
> energy dissipated and wasted on war, whether
> PART ONE
> 
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION
> I
> EXCERPTS FROM
> THE BAHA'I SACRED WRITINGS
> 
> 1. BAHA'U'LLAH
> 
> Excerpts from Tablets of Baha'u'llah revealed after the Kitab-i-Aqdas 1
> 
> ALL glory be to this Day , the Day in which             exalted Spot than We made reply: 'Render
> the fragrances of mercy have been wafted over           thanks unto Thy Lord , 0 Carmel. The fire of
> all created things, a Day so blest that past ages       thy separation from Me was fast consuming
> and centuries can never hope to rival it, a Day         thee , when the ocean of My presence surged
> in which the countenance of the Ancient of              before thy face, cheering thine eyes and those
> Days hath turned towards His holy seat.                 of all creation, and filling with delight all things
> Thereupon the voices of all created things, and         visible and invisible . Rejoice, for God hath in
> beyond them those of the Concourse on High ,            this Day established upon thee His throne,
> were heard calling aloud: 'Haste thee, 0 Car-           hath made thee the dawning-place of His signs
> mel, for lo, the light of the countenance of God,       and the dayspring of the evidences of His Revethe Ruler of the Kingdom of Names and                   lation. Well is it with him that circleth around
> Fashioner of the heavens, hath been lifted              thee , that proclaimeth the revelation of thy
> upon thee.'                                             glory, and recounteth that which the bounty of
> Seized with transports of joy, and raising           the Lord thy God hath showered upon thee.
> high her voice, she thus exclaimed: 'May my             Seize thou the Chalice of Immortality in the
> life be a sacrifice to Thee, inasmuch as Thou           name of thy Lord, the All-Glorious, and give
> hast fixed Thy gaze upon me, hast bestowed              thanks unto Him, inasmuch as He, in token of
> upon me Thy bounty, and hast directed                   His mercy unto thee, hath turned thy sorrow
> towards me Thy steps. Separation from Thee ,            into gladness, and transmuted thy grief into
> 0 Thou Source of everlasting life, hath well            blissful joy. He, verily, loveth the spot which
> nigh consumed me, and my remoteness from                had been made the seat of His throne, which
> Thy presence hath burned away my soul. All              His footsteps have trodden, which hath been
> praise be to Thee for having enabled me to              honoured by His presence, from which He
> hearken to Thy call, for having honoured me             raised His call, and upon which He shed His
> with Thy footsteps, and for having quickened            tears.
> my soul through the vitalizing fragrance of Thy            'Call out to Zion, 0 Carmel, and announce
> Day and the shrilling voice of Thy Pen, a voice         the joyful tidings: He that was hidden from
> Thou didst ordain as Thy trumpet-call amidst            mortal eyes is come! His all-conquering
> Thy people. And when the hour at which Thy              sovereignty is manifest; His all-encompassing
> resistless Faith was to be made manifest did            splendour is revealed. Beware lest thou hesistrike, Thou didst breathe a breath of Thy spirit       tate or halt. Hasten forth and circumambulate
> into Thy Pen, and lo, the entire creation shook         the City of God that hath descended from
> to its very foundations, unveiling to mankind           heaven, the celestial Kaaba round which have
> such mysteries as lay hidden within the                 circled in adoration the favoured of God, the
> treasuries of Him Who is the Possessor of all           pure in heart, and the company of the most
> created things.'                                        exalted angels. Oh, how I long to announce
> No sooner had her voice reached that most            unto every spot on the surface of the earth, and
> Baha'i World Centre, Haifa, 1978.                   to carry to each one of its cities, the glad-tidings
> 10                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> of this Revelation-a Revelation to which the         are the exponents of power and the daysprings
> heart of Sinai hath been attracted, and in           of glory, to enforce His laws and ordinances.
> whose name the Burning Bush is calling:              He is in truth the Omnipotent, the All-
> "Unto God, the Lord of Lords, belong the             Powerful, He Who is wont to answer the call of
> kingdoms of earth and heaven." Verily this is        me n.
> the Day in which both land and sea rejoice at
> this announcement, the Day for which have
> been laid up those things which God, through a
> bounty beyond the ken of mortal mind or                 Praise and glory beseem the Lord of Names
> heart, hath destined for revelation. Ere long        and the Creator of the heavens, He, the waves
> will God sail His Ark upon thee , and will man-      of Whose ocean of Revelation surge before the
> ifest the people of Baha who have been men-          eyes of the peoples of the world. The Day-Star
> tioned in the Book of Names.'                        of His Cause shineth through every veil and
> Sanctified be the Lord of all mankind, at the     His Word of affirmation standeth beyond the
> mention of Whose name all the atoms of the           reach of negation. Neither the ascendancy of
> earth have been made to vibrate, and the             the oppressor nor the tyranny of the wicked
> Tongue of Grandeur hath been moved to dis-           hath been able to thwart His Purpose. How
> close that which had been wrapt in His knowl-        glorified is His sovereignty, how exalted His
> edge and lay concealed within the treasury of        dominion!
> His might. He, verily, through the potency of           Great God! Although His signs have
> His name , the Mighty, the All-Powerful, the         encompassed the world and His proofs and
> Most High, is the ruler of all that is in the        testimonies are shining forth and manifest as
> heavens and all that is on earth.                    the light, yet the ignorant appear heedless, nay
> rather, rebellious. Would that they had been
> content with opposition. But at all times they
> are plotting to cut down the sacred Lote-Tree.
> Since the dawn of this Revelation the embodi-
> In former religions such ordinances as holy       ments of selfishness have, by resorting to
> war, destruction of books, the ban on associa-       cruelty and oppression, striven to extinguish
> tion and companionship with other peoples or         the Light of divine manifestation. But God,
> on reading certain books had been laid down          having stayed their hands, revealed this Light
> and affirmed according to the exigencies of the      through His sovereign authority and protected
> time; however, in this mighty Revelation, in         it through the power of His might until earth
> this momentous Announcement, the manifold            and heaven were illumined by its radiance and
> bestowals and favours of God have over-              brightness. Praise be unto Him under all condishadowed all men, and from the horizon of the        tions.
> Will of the Ever-Abiding Lord, His infallible           Glory be unto Thee , 0 Lord of the world and
> decree hath prescribed that which We have set        Desire of the nations, 0 Thou Who hast
> forth ...                                            become manifest in the Greatest Name
> We yield praise unto God-hallowed and             whereby the pearls of wisdom and utterance
> glorified be He-for whatsoever He hath               have appeared from the shells of the great sea
> graciously revealed in this blessed, this glorious   of Thy knowledge, and the heavens of divine
> and incomparable Day. Indeed if everyone on          revelation have been adorned with the light of
> earth were endowed with a myriad tongues and         the appearance of the Sun of Thy countenance.
> were to continually praise God and magnify              I beg of Thee, by that Word through which
> His Name to the end that knoweth no end,             Thy proof was perfected among Thy creatures
> their thanksgiving would not prove adequate           and Thy testimony was fulfilled among Thy
> for even one of the gracious favours We have         servants to strengthen Thy people in that
> mentioned in this Tablet. Unto this beareth          whereby the face of the Cause will radiate in
> witness every man of wisdom and discernment,         Thy dominion, the standards of Thy power will
> of understanding and knowledge.                       be planted among Thy servants, and the ban-
> We earnestly beseech God-exalted be His            ners of Thy guidance will be raised throughout
> glory-to aid the rulers and sovereigns , who         Thy dominions.
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION                                           11
> 0 my Lord! Thou beholdest them clinging to         It beseemeth you to fix your gaze under all
> the rope of Thy grace and holding fast unto the    conditions upon justice and fairness. In the
> hem of the mantle of Thy beneficence. Ordain       Hidden Words this exalted utterance hath
> for them that which may draw them nearer           been revealed from Our Most August Pen: 'O
> unto Thee , and withhold them from all else        Son of Spirit! The best beloved of all things in
> save Thee. I beg of Thee, 0 Thou King of           My sight is Justice; turn not away therefrom if
> existence and Protector of the seen and the        thou desirest Me, and neglect it not that I may
> unseen, to make whosoever ariseth to serve         confide in thee. By its aid thou shalt see with
> Thy Cause as a sea moving by Thy desire, as        thine own eyes and not through the eyes of
> one ablaze with the fire of Thy Sacred Tree,       others, and shalt know of thine own knowledge
> shining from the horizon of the heaven of Thy      and not through the knowledge of thy neighwill. Verily Thou art the mighty One Whom          bour. Ponder this in thy heart; how it behoveth
> neither the power of all the world nor the         thee to tie. Verily justice is My gift to thee and
> strength of nations can weaken. There is no        the sign of My loving kindness. Set it then
> God but Thee, the One, the Incomparable, the       before thine eyes.'
> Protector, the Self-Subsistent.                      They that are just and fair-minded in their
> judgement occupy a sublime station and hold
> an exalted rank. The light of piety and uprightness shineth resplendent from these souls. We
> earnestly hope that the peoples and countries
> They that are endued with sincerity and
> of the world may not be deprived of the splenfaithfulness should associate with all the peodours of these two luminaries .
> ples and kindreds of the earth with joy and
> radiance, inasmuch as consorting with people
> hath promoted and will continue to promote
> unity and concord, which in turn are conducive
> to the maintenance of order in the world and to
> God testifieth that there is none other God
> the regeneration of nations. Blessed are such as
> but Him and that He Who hath appeared is the
> hold fast to the cord of kindliness and tender
> Hidden Mystery, the Treasured Symbol, the
> mercy and are free from animosity and hatred.
> Most Great Book for all peoples, and the
> This Wronged One exhorteth the peoples of
> Heaven of bounty for the whole world. He is
> the world to observe tolerance and righteousthe Most Mighty Sign amongst men and the
> ness, which are two lights amidst the darkness
> Dayspring of the most august attributes in the
> of the world and two educators for the
> realm of creation. Through Him hath appeared
> edification of mankind. Happy are they who
> that which had been hidden from time
> have attained thereto and woe betide the heedimmemorial and been veiled from the eyes of
> less.
> men. He is the One Whose Manifestation was
> announced by the heavenly Scriptures, in
> former times and more recently. Whoso acknowledgeth belief in Him and in His signs and
> A good character is, verily, the best mantle     testimonies hath in truth acknowledged that
> for men from God. With it He adorneth the          which the Tongue of Grandeur uttered ere the
> temples of His loved ones. By My life! The light   creation of earth and heaven and the revelation
> of a good character surpasseth the light of the    of the Kingdom of Names. Through Him the
> sun and the radiance thereof. Whoso attaineth      ocean of knowledge hath surged amidst manunto it is accounted as a jewel among men. The     kind and the river of divine wisdom hath
> glory and the upliftment of the world must         gushed out at the behest of God, the Lord of
> needs depend upon it. A goodly character is a      Days.
> means whereby men are guided to the Straight         Well is it with the man of discernment who
> Path and are led to the Great Announcement.        hath recognized and perceived the Truth, and
> Well is it with him who is adorned with the        the one possessed of a hearing ear who hath
> saintly attributes and character of the Con-       hearkened unto His sweet Voice, and the hand
> course on High.                                    that hath received His Book with such resolve
> 12                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> as is born of God, the Lord of this world and of      twin principles. Exalted is the Lord of Wisdom,
> the next, and the earnest wayfarer who hath           the Possessor of Great Bounty.
> hastened unto His glorious Horizon, and the
> one endued with strength whom neither the
> overpowering might of the rulers, nor the
> tumult raised by the leaders of religion hath
> The light of men is justice. Quench it not
> been able to shake. And woe betide him who
> with the contrary winds of oppression and
> hath rejected the grace of God and His bounty,
> tyranny. The purpose of justice is the appearand hath denied His tender mercy and authorance of unity among men. The ocean of divine
> ity; such a man is indeed reckoned with those
> wisdom surgeth within this exalted word, while
> who have throughout eternity repudiated the
> the books of the world cannot contain its inner
> testimony of God and His proof.
> significance. Were mankind to be adorned with
> Great is the blessedness of him who hath in
> this raiment, they would behold the day-star of
> this Day cast away the things current amongst
> the utterance, 'On that day God will satisfy
> men and hath clung unto that which is ordained
> everyone out of His abundance,' 1 shining resby God, the Lord of Names and the Fashioner
> plendent above the horizon of the world.
> of all created things, He Who is come from the
> Appreciate ye the value of this utterance; it is a
> heaven of eternity through the power of the
> noble fruit that the Tree of the Pen of Glory
> Most Great Name, invested with so invincible
> hath yielded. Happy is the man that giveth ear
> an authority that all the powers of the earth are
> unto it and observeth its precepts. Verily I say,
> unable to withstand Him. Unto this beareth
> whatever is sent down from the heaven of the
> witness the Mother Book, calling from the
> Will of God is the means for the establishment
> Most Sublime Station.
> of order in the world and the instrument for
> promoting unity and fellowship among its peoples. Thus hath the Tongue of this Wronged
> One spoken from His Most Great Prison.
> Above all else , the grea test gift and the most
> wondrous blessing hath ever been and will continue to be wisdom. It is man's unfailing protec-        0 ye men of wisdom among nations! Shut
> tor. It aideth him and strengtheneth him. Wis-        your eyes to estrangement, then fix your gaze
> dom is God's emissary and the revealer of His         upon unity. Cleave tenaciously unto that which
> Name the Omniscient. Through it the loftiness         will lead to the wellbeing and tranquillity of all
> of man's station is made manifest and evident.        mankind. This span of earth is but one home-
> It is all-knowi ng and the foremost teacher in        land and one habitation. It behoveth you to
> the schoo l of existence. It is the guide and is      abandon vainglory which causeth alienation
> invested with high distinction. Thanks to its         and to set your hearts on whatever will ensure
> educating influence earthly beings have               harmony. In the estimation of the people of
> become imbued with a gem-like spirit which            Baha man's glory lieth in his knowledge, his
> outshineth the heavens. In the city of justice it     upright conduct, his praiseworthy character,
> is the unrivalled Speaker Who, in the year nine,      his wisdom , and not in his nationality or rank.
> illumined the world with the joyful tidings of        0 people of the earth! Appreciate the value of
> this Revelation. And it was this peerless Source      this heavenly word. Indeed it may be likened
> of wisdom that at the beginning of the founda-        unto a sh ip for the ocean of knowledge and a
> tion of the world ascended the stair of inner         shining luminary for the realm of perception.
> meaning and when enthroned upon the pulpit
> of utterance, through the operation of the
> divine Will , proclaimed two words. The first
> heralded the promise of reward, while the second voiced the ominous warning of punish-                In all matters moderation is desirable. If a
> ment. The promise gave rise to hope and the          thing is carried to excess, it will prove a source
> warning begat fear. Thus th e basis of world          of evil. Consider the civilization of the West,
> order hath been firmly established upon these         1
> cf. Qur' an 4: 129.
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION                                            13
> how it hath agitated and alarmed the peoples of    Being. God grant that all men may turn unto
> the world. An infernal engine hath been            the treasuries latent within their own beings.
> devised, and hath proved so cruel a weapon of
> destruction that its like none hath ever witnessed or heard. The purging of such deeplyrooted and overwhelming corruptions cannot
> be effected unless the peoples of the world           Justice is in this day bewailing its plight, and
> unite in pursuit of one common aim and             Equity groaneth beneath the yoke of oppresembrace one universal faith . Incline your ears    sion. The thick clouds of tyranny have darkunto the Call of this Wronged One and adhere       ened the face of the earth , and enveloped its
> firmly to the Lesser Peace.                        peoples. Through the movement of Our Pen of
> Strange and astonishing things exist in the     glory We have , at the bidding of the omnipoearth but they are hidden from the minds and       tent Ordainer, breathed a new life into every
> the understanding of men. These things are         human frame , and instilled into every word a
> capable of changing the whole atmosphere of        fresh potency. All created things proclaim the
> the earth and their contamination would prove      evidences of this world-wide regeneration.
> lethal. Great God! We have observed an amaz-       This is the most great, the most joyful tidings
> ing thing. Lightning or a force similar to it is   imparted by the Pen of this Wronged One to
> controlled by an operator and moveth at his        mankind. Wherefore fear ye, 0 My wellcommand. Immeasurably exalted is the Lord          beloved ones? Who is it that can dismay you?
> of Power Who hath laid bare that which He          A touch of moisture sufficeth to dissolve the
> purposed through the potency of His weighty        hardened clay out of which this perverse genand invincible command .                           eration is moulded . The mere act of your
> gathering together is enough to scatter the
> forces of these vain and worthless people.
> Strife and conflict befit the beasts of the wild.
> It was through the grace of God and with the
> We enjoin upon them that are the emblems        aid of seemly words and praiseworthy deeds
> of His names and attributes to firmly adhere       that the unsheathed swords of the Babi comhenceforth unto that which hath been set forth     munity were returned to their scabbards.
> in this Most Great Revelation , not to allow       Indeed through the power of good words, the
> themselves to become the cause of strife , and,    righteous have always succeeded in winning
> until the end that knoweth no end , to keep        command over the meads of the hearts of men.
> their eyes directed towards the dayspring of       Say , 0 ye loved ones! Do not forsake pruthese resplendent words which have been            dence . Incline your hearts to the counsels given
> recorded in this Tablet. Strife leads to           by the Most Exalted Pen and beware lest your
> bloodshed and provokes commotion amongst           hands or tongues cause harm unto anyone
> people. Hearken ye unto the Voice of this          among mankind.
> Wronged One and deviate not therefrom.
> Were anyone to ponder in his heart that
> which hath, in this Revelation, streamed forth
> from the Pen of Glory, he would be assured
> that whatever this Wronged One hath affirmed          It is incumbent upon every man , in this Day ,
> He hath had no intention of establishing any       to hold fast unto whatsoever will promote the
> position or distinction for Himself. The pur-      interests, and exalt the station , of all nations
> pose hath rather been to attract the souls ,       and just governments. Through each and every
> through the sublimity of His words, unto the       one of the verses which the Pen of the Most
> summit of transcendent glory and to endow          High hath revealed, the doors of love and unity
> them with the capacity of perceiving that which    have been unlocked and flung open to the face
> will purge and purify the peoples of the world     of men. We have erewhile declared-and Our
> from the strife and dissension which religious     Word is the truth-: 'Consort with the followdifferences provoke. Unto this bear witness        ers of all religions in a spirit of friendliness and
> My heart, My Pen, My inner and My outer            fellowship.' Whatsoever hath led the children
> 14                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> of men to shun one another, and hath caused           fire that blazed in the Burning Bush. The
> dissensions and divisions amongst them, hath,         brightness of the fire of your love will no doubt
> through the revelation of these words, been           fuse and unify the contending peoples and kinnullified and abolished. From the heaven of           dreds of the earth, whilst the fierceness of the
> God's Will, and for the purpose of ennobling          flame of enmity and hatred cannot but result in
> the world of being and of elevating the minds         strife and ruin. We beseech God that He may
> and souls of men, hath been sent down that            shield His creatures from the evil designs of His
> which is the most effective instrument for the        enemies. He verily hath power over a ll things.
> education of the whole human race. The high-             All praise be to the one true God-exalted
> est essence and most perfect expression of            be His glory-inasmuch as He hath , through
> whatsoever the peoples of old have either said        the Pen of the Most High , unlocked the doors
> or written hath , through this most potent Reve-      of men's hearts. Every verse which this Pen
> lation, been sent down from the heaven of the         hath revealed is a bright and shining portal that
> Will of the All-Possessing, the Ever-Abiding          discloseth the glories of a saintly and pious life ,
> God . Of old it hath been revealed: ' Love of         of pure and stainless deeds. The summons and
> one's country is an element of the Faith of           the message which We gave were never
> God.' The Tongue of Grandeur hath, however,           intended to reach one land or one people only .
> in the day of His manifestation proclaimed: 'It       Mankind in its entirety must firmly adhere to
> is not his to boast who loveth his country, but it    whatsoever hath been revealed and vouchis his who loveth the world.' Through the             safed unto it. Then and only then will it attain
> power released by these exalted words He hath         unto true liberty. The whole earth is illumilent a fresh impulse and set a new direction to       nated with the resplendent glory of God's
> the birds of men's hearts, and hath obliterated       Revelation. In the year sixty He Who heralded
> every trace of restriction and limitation from        the light of Divine Guidance-may all creation
> God's holy Book.                                      be sacrificed unto Him-arose to announce a
> This Wronged One hath forbidden the peo-           fresh revelation of the Divine Spirit and was
> ple of God to engage in contention or conflict        followed, twenty years later, by Him through
> and hath ex horted them to righteous deeds and        Whose coming the world was made the recippraiseworthy character. In this day the hosts         ient of this promised glory, this wondrous
> that can ensure the victory of the Cause are          favour. Behold how the generality of mankind
> those of goodly conduct and saintly character.        hath been endued with the capacity to hearken
> Blessed are they who firmly adhere unto them          unto God's most exalted Word-the Word
> and woe betide such as turn away therefrom.           upon which must depend the gathering
> together and spiritual resurrection of all men.
> 
> 0 people of God! I admon ish you to observe
> courtesy . For above all else it is the prince of        Incline your hearts, 0 people of God , unto
> virtues. Well is it with him who is illumined         the counse ls of your true, your incomparable
> with the light of courtesy and is attired with the    Friend. The Word of God may be likened unto
> vesture of uprightness . Whoso is endued with         a sap lin g, whose roots have been impl anted in
> courtesy hath indeed attained a sublime sta-          the hearts of men. It is in cumbent upon you to
> tion. It is hoped that this Wronged One and           foster its growth through the living waters of
> everyone e lse may be enabled to acquire it,          wisdom , of sanctified and holy words, so that its
> hold fast unto it, observe it, and fix our gaze       root may become firmly fixed and its branches
> upon it. This is a binding command which hath         may spread out as high as the heavens and
> streamed forth from the Pen of the Most Great         beyond .
> Name.                                                    0 ye that dwell on earth! The distinguishing
> This is the day when the gems of constancy         feature that marketh the pre-eminent characthat lie hid in the mine of men's inner selves        ter of this Supreme Revelation consisteth in
> should be made manifest. 0 people of Justice!         that We have , on the one hand , blotted out
> Be as brilliant as the light and as splendid as the   from the pages of God's holy Book whatsoever
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION                                           15
> hath been the cause of strife, of malice and         under His rule, and He is the supreme Ruler,
> mischief amongst the children of men, and            the Ordainer, the All-Knowing, the Allhave, on the other, laid down the essential          Informed.
> prerequisites of concord, of understanding, of
> complete and enduring unity. Well is it with
> them that keep My statutes.
> Time and again We have admonished Our                 We have enjoined upon all mankind to
> beloved ones to avoid, nay to flee from, any-        establish the Lesser Peace-the surest of all
> thing whatsoever from which the odour of mis-        means for the protection of humanity. The
> chief can be detected. The world is in great         sovereigns of the world should, with one
> turmoil, and the minds of its people are in a        accord, hold fast thereunto, for this is the
> state of utter confusion. We entreat the             supreme instrument that can ensure the se-
> Almighty that He may graciously illuminate           curity and welfare of all peoples and nations.
> them with the glory of His justice, and enable       They, verily, are the manifestations of the
> them to discover that which will be profitable       power of God and the daysprings of His
> unto them at all times and under all conditions.     authority. We beseech the Almighty that He
> He, verily is the All-Possessing, the Most High.     may graciously assist them in that which is conducive to the well-being of their subjects. A full
> explanation regarding this matter hath been
> previously set forth by the Pen of Glory; well is
> it with them that act accordingly.
> 0 thou who hast fixed thy gaze upon the
> Dawning-Place of the Cause of God! Know
> thou for a certainty that the Will of God is not
> limited by the standards of the people, and
> God doth not tread in their ways. Rather is it         It is incumbent upon everyone to observe
> incumbent upon everyone to firmly adhere to          God's holy commandments, inasmuch as they
> God's straight Path. Were He to pronounce the        are the wellspring of life unto the world. The
> right to be the left or the south to be the north,   heaven of divine wisdom is illumined with the
> He speaketh the truth and there is no doubt of       two luminaries of consultation and compassion
> it. Verily He is to be praised in His acts and to    and the canopy of world order is upraised upon
> be obeyed in His behests. He hath no associate       the two pillars of reward and punishment.
> in His judgement nor any helper in His
> sovereignty. He doeth whatsoever He willeth
> and ordaineth whatsoever He pleaseth. Know
> thou moreover that all else besides Him have
> been created through the potency of a word              In this Revelation the hosts that can render it
> from His presence , while of themselves they         victorious are the hosts of praiseworthy deeds
> have no motion nor stillness, except at His          and upright character. The leader and combidding and by His leave .                           mander of these hosts hath ever been the fear
> 0 thou who soarest in the atmosphere of           of God, a fear that encompasseth all things and
> love and fellowship and hast fixed thy gaze          reigneth over all things.
> upon the light of the countenance of thy Lord,
> the King of creation! Render thanks unto God,
> inasmuch as He hath unravelled for thee that
> which was hidden and enshrined in His knowledge so that everyone may become aware that             0 peoples of the world! Forsake all evil , hold
> within His realm of supreme infallibility He         fast that which is good. Strive to be shining
> hath not taken a partner nor a counsellor unto       examples unto all mankind, and true reminders
> Himself. He is in truth the Dayspring of divine      of the virtues of God amidst men. He that
> precepts and commandments and the Foun-              riseth to serve My Cause should manifest My
> tainhead of knowledge and wisdom , while all         wisdom , and bend every effort to banish ignorelse besides Him are but His subjects and            ance from the earth. Be united in counsel , be
> 16                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> one in thought . Let each morn be better than       heart to the Beloved One , and sever himself
> its eve and each morrow richer than its yester-     from all else but Him , and desire naught save
> day. Man 's merit lieth in service and virtue and   that which is the desire of his Lord.
> not in the pageantry of wealth and riches. Take        True remembrance is to make mention of
> heed that your words be purged from idle fan -      the Lord , the All-Praised , and forget aught else
> cies and worldly desires and your deeds be          beside Him .
> cleansed from craftiness and suspicion. Dissi-         True reliance is for the servant to pursue his
> pate not the wealth of your precious lives in the   profession and calling in this world, to hold fast
> pursuit of evil and corrupt affection, nor let      unto the Lord, to seek naught but His grace ,
> your endeavours be spent in promoting your          inasmuch as in His Hands is the destiny of all
> personal interest. Be generous in your days of      His servants.
> plenty, and be patient in the hour of loss.            The essence of detachment is for man to turn
> Adversity is followed by success and rejoicings     his face towards the courts of the Lord, to enter
> follow woe . Guard against idleness and sloth,      His Presence, behold His Countenance, and
> and cling unto that which profiteth mankind,        stand as witness before Him.
> whether young or old, whether high or low.             The essence of understanding is to testify to
> Beware lest ye sow tares of dissension among        one's poverty, and submit to the Will of the
> men or plant thorns of doubt in pure and            Lord, the Sovereign, the Gracious, the Allradiant hearts.                                     Powerful.
> 0 ye beloved of the Lord! Commit not that           The source of courage and power is the
> which defileth the limpid steam of love or de-      promotion of the Word of God , and steadfaststroyeth the sweet fragrance of friendship. By      ness in His love.
> the righteousness of the Lord! Ye were created         The essence of charity is for the servant to
> to show love one to another and not perversity      recount the blessings of His Lord , and to renand rancour. Take pride not in love for your-       der thanks unto Him at all times and under all
> selves but in love for your fellow-creatures.       conditions.
> Glory not in love for your country but in love         The essence of faith is fewness of words and
> for all mankind. Let your eye be chaste, your       abundance of deeds; he whose words exceed
> hand faithful, your tongue truthful and your        his deeds, know verily his death is better than
> heart enlightened. Abase not the station of the     his life.
> learned in Baha and belittle not the rank of           The essence of true safety is to observe sisuch rulers as administer justice amidst you.       lence, to look at the end of things and to
> Set your reliance on the army of justice, put on    renounce the world.
> the armour of wisdom, let your adorning be             The beginning of magnanimity is when man
> forgiveness and mercy and that which cheereth       expendeth his wealth on himself, on his family
> the hearts of the well-favoured of God.             and on the poor among his brethren in his
> Faith.
> The essence of wealth is love for Me; whoso
> loveth Me is the possessor of all things, and he
> that loveth Me not is indeed of the poor and
> The source of all good is trust in God , sub-     needy. This is that which the Finger of Glory
> mission unto His command, and contentment           and Splendour hath revealed.
> with His holy will and pleasure.                       The source of all evil is for man to turn away
> The essence of wisdom is the fear of God, the     from his Lord and set his heart on things
> dread of His scourge and punishment, and the        ungodly.
> apprehension of His justice and decree.                The most burning fire is to question the signs
> The essence of religion is to testify unto that   of God, to dispute idly that which He hath
> which the Lord hath revealed, and follow that       revealed, to deny Him and carry one's self
> which He hath ordained in His mighty Book.          proudly before Him .
> The source of all glory is acceptance of what-       The source of all learning is the knowledge
> soever the Lord hath bestowed, and content-         of God, exalted be His Glory , and this cannot
> ment with that which God hath ordained.              be attained save through the knowledge of His
> The essence of love is for man to turn his         Divine Manifestation.
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION                                            17
> 
> The essence of abasement is to pass out from       posure. Were the earth to attain this station
> under the shadow of the Merciful and seek the         and be illumined with its light it could then be
> shelter of the Evil One.                              truly said of it: 'Thou shall see in it no hollows
> The source of error is to disbelieve in the        or rising hills .' '
> One true God , rely upon aught else but Him,
> a nd flee from His Decree.
> True loss is for him whose days have been
> spent in utter ignorance of his self.
> The essence of all that We have revealed for          The Great Being, wishing to reveal the prethee is Justice, is for man to free himself from      requisites of the peace and tranquillity of the
> idle fancy and imitation , discern with the eye of    world and the advancement of its peoples , hath
> oneness His glorious handiwork, a nd look into        written: The time must come when the imperaall things with a searching eye.                      tive necessity for the holding of a vast, an all-
> Thus have We instructed thee , manifested          embracing assemblage of men will be univerunto thee Words of Wisdom , that thou mayest          sally realized . The rulers and kings of the earth
> be thankful unto the Lord , thy God , and glory       must needs attend it, and, participating in its
> the rein amidst all peoples.                          deliberations , must consider such ways and
> means as will lay the foundations of the world's
> Great Peace amongst men. Such a peace
> demandeth that the Great Powers should
> resolve, for the sake of the tranquillity of the
> Man is the supre me Ta lisma n. Lack of a          peoples of the earth, to be fully reconciled
> proper education hath , howeve r, deprived him        among themselves. Should any king take up
> of that which he do th inhere ntl y possess.          arms against another, all should unitedly arise
> Through a word proceeding o ut of the mouth           and prevent him. If this be done, the nations of
> of God he was ca ll ed into bein g; by one word       the world will no longer require any armamore he was guided to recognize the Source of         ments, except for the purpose of preserving the
> his ed ucatio n; by ye t a nother wo rd his station   security of their realms and of maintaining
> and destiny were safeguarded. The Great               internal order within their territories. This will
> Being saith: Regard man as a mine rich in gems        ensure the peace and composure of every
> of inestimable value . Education ca n, alone,         people, government and nation. We fain would
> cause it to reveal its treasures, a nd enable         hope that the kings and rulers of the earth, the
> mankind to benefit therefrom. If any man were         mirrors of the gracious and almighty name of
> to meditate on that which the Scriptures, sent        God, may attain unto this station , and shield
> down from the heaven of God's holy Will , have        mankind from the onslaught of tyranny.
> revealed , he would readily recognize that their
> purpose is that all men shall be regarded as one
> soul, so that the seal bearing the words 'The
> Kingdom shall be God's' may be stamped on
> every heart, and the light of Divine bounty, of         The Great Being saith: The man of congrace, and mercy may envelop all mankind.             summate learning and the sage endowed with
> The One true God , exalted be His glory, hath         penetrating wisdom are the two eyes to the
> wished nothing for Himself. The allegiance of         body of mankind. God willing, the earth shall
> mankind profiteth Him not, neither doth its           never be deprived of these two greatest gifts.
> perversity harm Him. The Bird of the Realm of         That which hath been set forth and will be
> Utterance voiceth continually this call: 'All         revealed in the future is but a token of this
> things have I willed for thee, and thee, too, for     Servant's ardent desire to dedicate Himself to
> thine own sake.' If the learned and worldly-          the service of all the kindreds of the earth .
> wise men of this age were to allow mankind to            0 my friend! In all circumstances one should
> inhale the fragrance of fellowship and love,          seize upon every means which will promote
> every understanding heart would apprehend             security and tranquillity among the peoples of
> the meaning of true liberty, and discover the
> secret of undisturbed peace and absolute com-         1
> Qur'an 20: 106.
> 18                                     THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> The Mansion of Bahjf where Baha'u'llah spent the last twelve years of His life. Here the
> distinguished orientalist, Prof £. G. Browne of Cambridge, was granted his four successive
> interviews with Baha'u'lldh, during the five days he was His guest; 15-20 April 1890.
> 
> the world . The Great Being sai th: In this glori-   convulsions and chaos can now be discerned,
> ous Day whatever will purge yo u from corrup-        inasmuch as the prevailing order appea reth to
> tion and will lead yo u towards peace and com-       be lamentably defective. I beseech God,
> posure , is indeed the Straight Path.                exa lted be His glory, that He may graciously
> Please God, the peoples of the world may be       awaken the peoples of the earth , may grant
> led , as the result of the high e ndeavours          that the end of their conduct may be profitable
> exerted by their rulers and the wise and learned     unto them, and aid them to accomplish that
> a mongst me n, to recognize their best interests.    which beseemeth their station.
> How long will humanity persist in its wayward-          Were man to appreciate the greatness of his
> ness? How long will injustice continue? How          station and the loftiness of his destiny he would
> long is chaos and confusion to reign amongst         manifest naught save goodly character, pure
> men? How long will discord agitate the face of       deeds, and a seemly and praiseworthy conduct.
> society?                                             If the learned and wise men of goodwill were to
> This humble servant is filled with wonder,        impart guidance unto the people, the whole
> inas much as all men are endowed with the            earth would be regarded as one country. Verily
> capacity to see and hear, yet we find them           this is the undoubted truth. This servant
> deprived of the privilege of usi ng these facul -    appealeth to every diligent and enterprising
> ties . This servant hath been prompted to pen        soul to exert his utmost endeavour and arise to
> these lines by virtue of the tender love he          rehabi li tate the conditions in all regions and to
> cherisheth for thee. The winds of despair are ,      quicken the dead with the living waters of wisalas, blowing from every direction, and the          dom and utterance, by virtue of the love he
> strife that divideth and afflicteth the human        cherisheth for God, the One, the Peerless, the
> race is daily increasing. The signs of impending     Almighty, the Beneficent.
> THE BAHA'f REVELATION                                         19
> No man of wisdom can demonstrate his            effulgent splendour shone forth upon the mirknowledge save by means of words. This             ror of love than the blessed word 'I am the
> showeth the significance of the Word as is         Best-Beloved' was reflected therein. It is an
> affirmed in al l the Scriptures, whether of        ocean inexhaustible in riches, comprehending
> former times or more recently. For it is through   all things. Every thing which can be perceived
> its potency and animating spirit that the people   is but an emanation therefrom. High,
> of the world have attained so eminent a posi-      immeasurably high is this sublime station, in
> tion. Moreover words and utterances should be      whose shadow moveth the essence of loftiness
> both impressive and penetrating. However, no       and splendour, wrapt in praise and adoration .
> word will be infused with these two qualities         Methinks people's sense of taste hath, alas
> unless it be uttered wholly for the sake of God    been sorely affected by the fever of negligence
> and with due regard unto the exigencies of the     and folly, for they are found to be wholly
> occasion and the people.                           unconscious and deprived of the sweetness of
> The Great Being saith: Human utterance is       His utterance. How regrettable indeed. that
> an essence which aspireth to exert its influence   man should debar himself from the fruits of the
> and needeth moderation. As to its influence,       tree of wisdom while his days and hours pass
> this is conditional upon refinement which in       swiftly away . Please God, the hand of divine
> turn is dependent upon hearts which are            power may safeguard all mankind and direct
> detached and pure. As to its moderation, this      their steps towards the horizon of true underhath to be combined with tact and wisdom as        standing.
> prescribed in the Holy Scriptures and Tablets.        Verily our Lord of Mercy is the Helper, the
> Every word is endowed with a spirit, there-     Knowing, the Wise.
> fore the speaker or expounder should carefully
> deliver his words at the appropriate time and
> place, for the impression which each word
> maketh is clearly evident and perceptible. The        Although the Realm of Glory hath none of
> Great Being saith: One word may be likened         the vanities of the world, yet within the treasunto fire, another unto light, and the influence   ury of trust and resignation We have
> which both exert is manifest in the world.         bequeathed to Our heirs an excellent and
> Therefore an enlightened man of wisdom             priceless heritage. Earthly treasures We have
> should primarily speak with words as mild as       not bequeathed, nor have We added such cares
> milk, that the children of men may be nurtured     as they entail. By God! In earthly riches fear is
> and edified thereby and may attain the ultimate    hidden and peril is concealed. Consider ye and
> goal of human existence which is the station of    call to mind that which the All-Merciful hath
> true understanding and nobility. And likewise      revealed in the Qur'an: 'Woe betide every
> He saith: One word is like unto springtime         slanderer and defamer, him that layeth up
> causing the tender saplings of the rose-garden     riches and counteth them.' 1 Fleeting are the
> of knowledge to become verdant and flourish-       riches of the world; all that perisheth and
> ing, while another word is even as a deadly        changeth is not, and hath never been, worthy of
> poison. It behoveth a prudent man of wisdom        attention, except to a recognized measure.
> to speak with utmost leniency and forbearance         The aim of this Wronged One in sustaining
> so that the sweetness of his words may induce      woes and tribulations, in revealing the Holy
> everyone to attain that which befitteth man's      Verses and in demonstrating proofs hath been
> station.                                           naught but to quench the flame of hate and
> 0 friend of mine! The Word of God is the        enmity, that the horizon of the hearts of men
> king of words and its pervasive influence is       may be illumined with the light of concord and
> incalculable. It hath ever dominated and will      attain real peace and tranquillity. From the
> continue to dominate the realm of being. The       dawning-place of the divine Tablet the day-star
> Great Being saith: The Word is the master key      of this utterance shineth resplendent, and it
> for the whole world, inasmuch as through its       behoveth everyone to fix his gaze upon it: We
> potency the doors of the hearts of men, which      exhort you, 0 peoples of the world, to observe
> in reality are the doors of heaven, are
> unlocked. No sooner had but a glimmer of its       1
> Qur'an 104:1-2.
> 20                                     THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> that which will elevate your station. Hold fast      Him with the splendour of His confirmation.
> to the fear of God and firmly adhere to what is      Verily He is the All-Knowing, the All-Wise.
> right. Verily I say, the tongue is for mentioning
> what is good, defile it not with unseemly talk.
> God hath forgiven what is past. Henceforward
> everyone should utter that which is meet and
> Blessed is the wayfarer who hath recognized
> seemly, and should refrain from slander, abuse
> the Desired One, and the seeker who hath
> and whatever causeth sadness in men. Lofty is
> heeded the Call of Him Who is the intended
> the station of man! Not long ago this exalted
> Aim of all mankind, and the learned one who
> Word streamed forth from the treasury of Our
> hath believed in God, the Help in Peril , the
> Pen of Glory: Great and blessed is this
> Self-Subsisting.
> Day-the Day in which all that lay latent in
> How vast the number of the learned who
> man hath been and will be made manifest.
> have turned aside from the way of God and
> Lofty is the station of man, were he to hold fast
> how numerous the men devoid of learning who
> to righteousness and truth and to remain firm
> have apprehended the truth and hastened unto
> and steadfast in the Cause . In the eyes of the
> Him , saying, 'Praised be Thou, 0 Lord of all
> All-Mercifu l a true man appeareth even as a
> things, vis ible and invisible.'
> firmament; its sun and moon are his sight and
> By the righteousness of God! The world's
> hearing, and his shining and resplendent
> horizon is resplendent with the light of the
> character its stars. His is the loftiest station,
> Most Great Luminary , yet the genera lity of
> and his influence educateth the world of being .
> mankind perceive it not. Verily He Who is the
> Every receptive soul who hath in this Day
> Sovereign Truth moveth before the eyes of all
> inhaled the fragrance of His garment and hath,
> men . Unto this beareth witness the One Who is
> with a pure heart, set his face towards the allproclaiming in the midmost heart of the world ,
> glorious Horizon is reckoned among the peo-
> 'In truth no God is there but Me, Omnipotent
> ple of Baha in the Crimson Book. Grasp ye, in
> over all things, whether of the past or the
> My Name, the chalice of My loving-kindness,
> future.'
> drink then your fill in My glorious and won-
> Great is the blessedness of the believer who
> drous remembrance.
> hath directed himself towards Him and hath
> 0 ye that dwell on earth! The religion of God
> gained admittance into His presence, and woe
> is for love and unity; make it not the cause of
> betide every disbeliever who hath turned away
> enmity or dissension. In the eyes of men of
> from God and followed the wayward and the
> insight and the beholders of the Most Sublime
> outcast.
> Vision , whatsoever are the effective means for
> safeguarding and promoting the happiness and
> welfare of the children of men hath already
> been revealed by the Pen of Glory. But the
> foolish ones of the earth , being nurtured in evil      Man is like unto a tree. If he be adorned with
> passions and desires, have remained heedless         fruit, he hath been and will ever be worthy of
> of the consummate wisdom of Him Who is, in           praise and commendation. Otherwise a fruittruth , the All- Wise, while their words and         less tree is but fit for fire . The fru its of the
> deeds are prompted by idle fancies and vain          human tree are exquisite, highly desired and
> imaginings.                                          dearly cherished. Among them are upright
> 0 ye the loved ones and the trustees of God!      character, virtuous deeds and a goodly utter-
> Kings are the manifestations of the power, and       ance. The springtime for earthly trees occurthe daysprings of the might and riches, of God.      reth once every year, while the one for human
> Pray ye on their behalf. He hath invested them       trees appeareth in the D ays of God-exalted
> with the rulership of the earth and hath singled     be His glory. Were the trees of men 's lives to be
> out the hearts of men as His Own domain.             adorned in this divine Springtime with the
> Conflict and contention are categorically         fruits that have been mentioned, the efful gence
> forbidden in His Book. This is a decree of God       of the light of Justice wou ld, of a certainty,
> in this Most Great Revelation. It is divinely        illumine all the dwellers of the earth a nd
> preserved from annulment and is invested by          everyone would abide in tranquill ity and con-
> THE BAHA ' I REVELATION                                        21
> tentment beneath the sheltering shadow of          carry them away to the place ordained for
> Him Who is the Objeci of all mankind. The          them. Ignorant did they arrive, ignorant did
> Water for these trees is the living water of the   they linger and ignorant did they retire to their
> sacred Words uttered by the Beloved of the         abodes.
> world. In one instant are such trees planted and     The world is continually proclaiming these
> in the next their branches shall, through the      words: Beware, I am evanescent, and so are all
> outpourings of the showers of divine mercy,        my outward appearances and colours. Take ye
> have reached the skies. A dried-up tree, how-      heed of the changes and chances contrived
> ever, hath never been nor will be worthy of any    within me and be ye roused from your slumber.
> mention.                                           Nevertheless there is no discerning eye to see,
> Happy is the faithful one who is attired with   nor is there a hearing ear to hearken.
> the vesture of high endeavour and hath arisen        In this Day the inner ear exclaimeth and
> to serve this Cause. Such a soul hath truly        saith: Indeed well is it with me, today is my day,
> attained the desired Goal and hath                 inasmuch as the Voice of God is calling aloud.
> apprehended the Object for which it hath been      And the essence of vision crieth out: Blessed
> created . But a myriad times alas for the way-     am I, this is my day, for the Ancient Beauty is
> ward who are like unto dried-up leaves fallen      shining resplendent from the most exalted
> upon the dust. Ere long mortal blasts shall        Horizon.
> 22                                        THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> 2. THE BAB
> 
> Excerp1s from Selections from the Writings of the Bab'
> 
> SAY, verily God hath caused all created                  0 concourse of light! By the righteousness of
> things to enter beneath the shade of the tree of      God, We speak not according to selfish desire,
> affirmation, except those who are endowed             nor hath a single letter of this Book been
> with the facu lty of und erstanding. Theirs is the    revealed save by the leave of God, the
> choice either to believe in God their Lord, and       Sovereign Truth. Fear ye God and entertain no
> put their whole trust in Him, or to shut them-        doubts regarding His Cause, for verily, the
> selves out from Him and refuse to believe with        Mystery of this Gate is shrouded in the mystic
> certitude in His sign s. These two groups sail        utterances of His Writ and hath been written
> upon two seas: the sea of affirmation and the         beyond the impenetrable veil of concealment
> sea of negation .                                     by the hand of God, the Lord of the visible and
> They that truly believe in God and in His          the invisible.
> signs, and who in every Dispensation faithfully          Indeed God hath created everywhere
> obey that which hath been revealed in the             around this Gate oceans of divine e lixir, tinged
> Book-such are indeed the ones whom God                crimson with the essence of existence and vitalhath created from the fruits of the Paradise of       ized through the animating power of the
> His good-pleasure, and who are of the blissful.       desired fruit; and for them God hath provided
> But they who turn away from God and His               Arks of ruby, tender, crimson -coloured,
> sign s in each Dispensation, those are the ones       wherein none shall sail but the people of Bahii,
> who sai l upon the sea of negation.                   by the leave of God , the Most Exalted; and
> God hath, through the potency of His               verily He is the All-Glorious, the All-Wise.
> behest, ordained for Himself the task of ensuring the asce ndancy of the sea of affirmation and
> of bringing to naught the sea of negation
> through the power of His might. He is in truth
> potent over all things.
> Verily it is incumbent upon you to recognize          Rid thou thyself of all attachments to aught
> your Lord at the time of His manifestation, that      except God , enrich thyself in God by dispenshaply ye may not enter into negation, and that,       ing with all e lse besides Him, and recite this
> ere a prophet is raised by God, ye may find           prayer:
> yourselves secure ly establ ished upon the sea of           Say: God sufficeth all things above all
> affirmation. For if a prophet cometh to you              things, and nothing in the heavens or in
> from God and ye fail to walk in His Way, God             the earth or in whatever lieth between
> will, thereupon, transform yo ur light into fire.        them but God, thy Lord, sufficeth. Verily,
> Take heed then that perchance ye may,                    He is in Himself the Knower, the Susthrough the grace of God and His signs, be               tainer, the Omnipotent.
> e nabled to redeem your souls.                           Regard not the all-sufficing power of God as
> an idle fancy. It is that genuine faith which thou
> cherishest for the Manifestation of God in
> every Dispensation. It is such faith which
> By My glory! I will make the infidels to taste,     sufficeth above all the things that exist on the
> with the hands of My power, retributions              earth, whereas no created thing on earth
> unknown of any one except Me, and will waft           besides faith would suffice thee. If thou art not
> over the faithful those musk-scented breaths          a believer, the Tree of divine Truth would conwhich I have nursed in the midmost heart of           demn thee to extinction. If thou art a believer,
> My throne; and verily the knowledge of God            thy faith sha ll be sufficient for thee above all
> embraceth all things.                                 things that exist on earth, even though thou
> ' Baha'i World Centre , Haifa , I 976.                possess nothing.
> THE BAHA'f REVELATION                                        23
> 
> Entrance from an adjoining dwelling which gives access to the courtyard of the House of the
> Bab in Shira z.
> 
> Courtyard of the House of the Bab in Shiraz, showing the orange tree and reflecting pool and,
> on the left, a well.
> 24                                   THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> View of the garden in the courtyard of the House of the Bab in Sh{raz. On 1he righl is seen 1he
> entrance from an adjoining dwelling.
> 
> Upperchamberof1he House ofthe Bab where He announced His Mission lo Mulla f:lusayn in
> 1844.
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION                                         25
> 0 people of the Qur'an! Ye are as nothing           I am aware, 0 Lord, that my trespasses
> unless ye submit unto the Remembrance of            have covered my face with shame in Thy pres-
> God and unto this Book. Ifye follow the Cause       ence , and have burdened my back before Thee,
> of God, We will forgive you your sins, and if ye    have intervened between me and Thy beauturn aside from Our command, We will, in            teous countenance, have compassed me from
> truth, condemn your souls in Our Book, unto         every direction and have hindered me on all
> the Most Great Fire . We, verily , do not deal      sides from gaining access unto the revelations
> unjustly with men, even to the extent ofa speck     of T hy celestial power.
> on a date-stone.                                       0 Lord! If Thou forgivest me not, who is
> there then to grant pardon , and if Thou hast no
> mercy upon me, who is capable of showing
> compassion? Glory be unto Thee, Thou didst
> create me when I was non-existent and Thou
> didst nourish me while I was devoid of any
> 0 my God! There is no one but Thee to allay      understanding. Praise be unto Thee , every evithe anguish of my soul, and Thou art my high-       dence of bounty proceedeth from Thee and
> est asp irat ion, 0 my God . My heart is wedded     every token of grace emanateth from the
> to none save Th'e e and such as Thou dost love. I   treasuries of Thy decree.
> solemnly declare that my life and death are
> both for Thee. Verily Thou art incomparable
> and hast no partner.
> 0 my Lord! I beg Thee to forgive me for             I beg Thee to forgive me , 0 my Lord, for
> shutting myself out from Thee. By Thy glory         every mention but the mention of Thee, and
> and majesty, I have failed to befittingly recog-    for every praise but the praise of Thee, and for
> nize Thee and to worship Thee, while Thou           every delight but delight in Thy nearness, and
> dost make Thyself known unto me and callest         for every pleasure but the pleasure of communme to remembrance as beseemeth Thy station.         ion with Thee, and for every joy but the joy of
> Grievous woe would betide me, 0 my Lord,            Thy love and of Thy good-pleasure, and for all
> wert Thou to take hold of me by reason of my        things pertaining unto me which bear no relamisdeeds and trespasses. No helper do I know        tionship unto Thee, 0 Thou Who art the Lord
> of other than Thee. No refuge do I have to flee     of lords, He Who provideth the means and
> to save Thee. None among Thy creatures can          unlocketh the doors.
> dare to intercede with Thyself without Thy
> leave. I hold fast to Thy love before Thy court,
> and, according to Thy bidding, I earnestly pray
> unto Thee as befitteth Thy glory. I beg Thee to        0 God our Lord! Protect us through Thy
> heed my call as Thou hast promised me. Verily       grace from whatsoever may be repugnant unto
> Thou art God; no God is there but Thee. Alone       Thee and vouchsafe unto us that which well
> and unaided, Thou art independent of all cre-       beseemeth Thee. Give us more out of Thy
> ated things. Neither can the devotion of Thy        bounty and bless us. Pardon us for the things
> lovers profit Thee, nor the evil doings of the      we have done and wash away our sins and
> faithless harm Thee. Verily Thou art my God,        forgive us with Thy gracious forgiveness. Ver-
> He Who will never fail in His promise.              ily Thou art the Most Exalted, the Self-
> 0 my God! I beseech Thee by the evidences        Subsisting.
> of Thy favour , to let me draw nigh to the sub-        Thy loving providence hath encompassed all
> lime heights of Thy holy presence, and protect      created things in the heavens and on the earth,
> me from inclining myself toward the subtle          and Thy forgiveness hath surpassed the whole
> allusions of aught else but Thee. Guide my          creation. Thine is sovereignty; in Thy hand are
> steps, 0 my God, unto that which is acceptable      the Kingdoms of Creation and Revelation; in
> and pleasing to Thee. Shield me, through Thy        Thy right hand Thou holdest all created things
> might, from the fury of Thy wrath and chas-         and within Thy grasp are the assigned meastisement, and hold me back from entering            ures of forgiveness. Thou forgivest whomhabitations not desired by Thee.                    soever among Thy servants Thou pleasest.
> 26                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Verily Thou art the Ever-Forgiving, the All-          It is seemly that the servant· should, after
> Loving. Nothing whatsoever escapeth Thy             each prayer, supplicate God to bestow mercy
> knowledge, and naught is there which is hidden      and forgiveness upon his parents. Thereupon
> from Thee.                                          God's call will be raised: 'Thousand upon
> 0 God our Lord! Protect us through the           thousand of what thou hast asked for thy parpotency of Thy might, enable us to enter Thy        ents shall be thy recompense!' Blessed is he
> wondrous surging ocean, and grant us that           who remembereth his parents when communwhich well befitteth Thee .                         ing with God. There is, verily, no God but Him,
> Thou art the Sovereign Ruler, the Mighty         the Mighty, the Well-Beloved.
> Doer, the Exalted, the All-loving.
> 
> Glory be unto Thee, 0 God . How can I
> Vouchsafe unto me, 0 my God, the full            make mention of Thee while Thou art
> measure of Thy love and Thy good-pleasure,          sanctified from the praise of all mankind.
> and through the attractions of Thy resplendent      Magnified be Thy Name, 0 God, Thou art the
> light enrapture our hearts, 0 Thou Who art the      King, the Etenial Truth; Thou knowest what is
> Supreme Evidence and the All-Glorified. Send        in the heavens and on the earth , and unto Thee
> down upon me, as a token of Thy grace, Thy          must all return. Thou hast sent down Thy
> vitalizing breezes, throughout the day-time         divinely-ordained Revelation according to a
> and in the night season, 0 Lord of bounty.          clear measure. Praised art Thou , 0 Lord! At
> No deed have I done, 0 my God, to merit          Thy behest Thou dost render victorious whombeholding Thy face, and I know of a certainty       soever Thou wiliest, through the hosts of
> that were I to live as long as the world lasts I    heaven and earth and whatsoever existeth
> would fa il to accomplish any deed such as to       between them. Thou art the Sovereign, the
> deserve this favour , inasmuch as the station of    Eternal Truth, the Lord of invincible might.
> a servant shall ever fall short of access to Thy       Glorified art Thou, 0 Lord, Thou forgivest
> holy precincts, unless Thy bounty should reach      at all times the sins of such among Thy servants
> me and Thy tender mercy pervade me and Thy          as implore Thy pardon. Wash away my sins and
> loving-kindness encompass me.                       the sins of those who seek Thy forgiveness at
> dawn, who pray to Thee in the day-time and in
> the night season, who yearn after naught save
> God, who offer up whatsoever God hath graciously bestowed upon them, who celebrate Thy
> I beg Thy forgiveness, 0 my God, and              praise at morn and eventide, and who are not
> implore pardon after the manner Thou wishest        remiss in their duties.
> Thy servants to direct themselves to Thee. I
> beg of Thee to wash away our sins as befitteth
> Thy Lordship, and to forgive me, my parents,
> and those who in Thy estimation have entered
> the abode of Thy love in a manner which is             Verily I am Thy servant, 0 my God, and Thy
> worthy of Thy transcendent sovereignty and          poor one and Thy suppliant and Thy wretched
> well beseemeth the glory of Thy celestial           creature. I have arrived at Thy gate, seeking
> power.                                              Thy shelter. I have found no contentment save
> 0 my God! Thou hast inspired my soul to          in Thy love, no exultation except in Thy
> offer its supplication to Thee, and but for Thee,   remembrance, no eagerness but in obedience
> I would not call upon Thee. Lauded and              to Thee, no joy save in Thy nearness, and no
> glorified art Thou; I yield Thee praise inas-       tranquillity except in reunion with Thee, notmuch as Thou didst reveal Thyself unto me,          withstanding that I am conscious that all creand I beg Thee to forgive me, since I have          ated things are debarred from Thy sublime
> fallen short in my duty to know Thee and have       Essence and the entire creation is denied
> failed to walk in the path of Thy love.             access to Thine inmost Being. Whenever I
> THE BAHA'i REVELATION                                          27
> attempt to approach Thee, I perceive nothing           Glory be to Thee, 0 God! Thou art the God
> in myself but the tokens of Thy grace and           Who hath existed before all things, Who will
> behold naught in my being but the revelations       exist after all things and will last beyond all
> of Thy loving-kindness. How can one who is          things. Thou art the God Who knoweth all
> but Thy creature seek reunion with Thee and         things, and is supreme over all things . Thou art
> attain unto Thy presence, whereas no created        the God Who dealeth mercifully with all things,
> thing can ever be associated with Thee, nor can     Who judgeth between all things and Whose
> aught comprehend Thee? How is it possible for       vision embraceth all things. Thou art God my
> a lowly se rvant to recognize Thee and to extol     Lord, Thou art aware of my position, Thou
> Thy praise , notwithstanding that Thou hast         dost witness my inner and outer being.
> destined for him the revelations of Thy domin-         Grant Thy forgiveness unto me and unto the
> ion and the wondrous testimonies of Thy             believers who responded to T hy Call. Be Thou
> sovereignty? Thus every created thing beareth       my sufficing helper against the mischief of
> witness that it is debarred from the sanctuary of   whosoever may desire to inflict sorrow upon
> Thy presence by reason of the limitations           me or wish me ill. Verily Tho u art the Lord of
> imposed upon its inner reality. It is undisputed,   all created things. Thou dost suffice everyone,
> however, that the influence of Thine attraction     while no one can be self-sufficient without
> hath everlastingly been inherent in the realities   Thee.
> of Thy handiwork, although that which
> beseemeth the hallowed court of Thy providence is exalted beyond the attainment of the
> entire creation. This indicateth, 0 my God, my
> utter powerlessness to praise Thee and                0 Lord! Thou art the Remover of every
> revealeth my utmost impotence in yielding           anguish and the Dispeller of every affl iction.
> thanks unto Thee; and how much more to              Thou art He Who banisheth every sorrow and
> attain the recognition of Thy divine unity or to    setteth free every slave , the Redeemer of every
> succeed in reaching the clear tokens of Thy         soul. 0 Lord! Grant deliverance through Thy
> praise, Thy sanctity and Thy glory . Nay, by Thy    mercy and reckon me among such servants of
> might, I yearn for naught but Thine Own Self        Thine as have gained salvation .
> and seek no one other than Thee.
> 
> 0 Lord! Unto Thee I repair for refuge and
> toward all Thy signs I set my heart.
> 0 Lord! Whether travelling or at home, and
> in my occupation or in my work, I place my
> whole trust in Thee.
> Grant me then Thy sufficing help so as to
> 0 my God, 0 my Lord, 0 my Master! I beg             make me independent of all things, 0 Thou
> Thee to forg ive me for seeking any pleasure        Who art unsurpassed in Thy mercy!
> save Thy love, or any comfort except Thy               Bestow upon me my portion, 0 Lord, as
> nearness, or any delight besides Thy good-          Thou pleasest, and cause me to be satisfied
> pleasure, or any existence other than commun-       with whatsoever Thou hast ordained for me .
> ion with Thee.                                        Thine is the absolute authority to command.
> 28                                            THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 3. 'ABDU'L-BAHA
> Excerpts from Selections from the Writings of 'Abdu'l-Baha 1
> 
> 0      peo ples of the world! The Sun of Truth                 0 ye dear friends! T he world is at war and
> hath rise n to illumine the whole earth, a nd to            the huma n race is in travail and mortal combat.
> spiritualize the community of ma n. Laudable                T he dark night of hate hat h taken over, and th e
> are the res ults and the fruits thereof, abunda nt          light of good faith is blotted out. The peoples
> the hol y evidences deriving from this grace.               and kindreds of the ea rth have sharpened th eir
> This is mercy unalloyed and purest bounty; it is            claws, and are hu rling themselves one again st
> light for the world and all its peoples; it is              the other. It is the very fo undatio n of the
> harmony and fellowship, and love and solidar-               human race that is being destro yed . It is
> ity ; indee d it is compassion and unit y, and the          thousands of ho useho lds that are vagrant and
> end of fo re ignness; it is the being at one , in           dispossessed , and every year seeth thousands
> complete dignity and freedom , with all on                  upon th ousa nds of hum an beings weltering in
> earth.                                                      their life-blood on dusty battlefields. The te nts
> The B lessed Beauty saith: 'Ye are all the               of life and joy are down. The generals practi se
> fruits of one tree , the leaves of one branch. '            their ge nera lship , boasting of the blood they
> Thus hath He likened this world of be ing to a              shed, competing one with the next in inciting to
> single tree, and all its peopl es to the leaves             violence . ' With this sword ,' saith one of them,
> thereof, and the blossoms and fruits. It is need-           'I beheaded a people!' A nd another: ' I toppled
> ful for the bough to blossom, a nd leaf a nd fruit          a nation to the gro und! ' And ye t anot her: 'I
> to fl o urish, and upon the interco nn ection of all        brought a government down!' On such thin gs
> parts of the world-tree , dependeth the flourish-           do men pride themselves, in such do they glory!
> ing of leaf and blossom , and the sweetness of              Love-righteousness-these are everywhere
> the fruit.                                                  censured , while despised are ha rmony , and
> For this reaso n must a ll huma n beings pow-           devotion to the truth.
> e rfully sustai n one another and seek for ever-               The Faith of the Blessed Beauty is summonlasting life; and for this reason must the lovers           in g mankind to safety and love, to amity and
> of God in this contingent world become the                  peace; it hath raised up its tabernacle on the
> me rcies a nd the blessings se nt fo rth by that           heights of the earth , and directeth its call to all
> clement King of the see n and unseen realms.                nations. Wherefore , 0 ye who are God's lov-
> Let them purify the ir sight a nd behold all               ers, know ye the value of thi s precious Faith ,
> hum ankind as leaves and blosso ms and fruits of           obey its teachings, walk in this road that is
> the tree of being. Let the m at a ll times concern          drawn straig ht, and show ye this way to the
> themselves with doing a kindly thing for one of            people. Lift up yo ur vo ices and sing o ut the
> their fe ll ows. offering to someone love, consid-         song of the Kingdom. Spread far a nd wide the
> era tion , tho ughtful help. Let th e m see no o ne         precepts a nd counsels of th e loving Lord, so
> as the ir e ne my , or as wishing the m ill , but think    that this world will change into another world,
> of all hum a nkind as their friend s; regarding the        and this darksome earth will be fl ooded with
> alie n as a n intimate, the stran ger as a compan-         light, and the dead body of mankind will arise
> ion, stayin g free of prejudice, drawing no lin es .       and li ve; so th at eve ry soul will ask fo r imm o r-
> In this day, the one favo ured at the                   tality , through the ho ly breaths of God.
> Threshold of the Lord is he who ha ndeth ro un d              Soon will yo ur swiftly-passing days be over,
> the cup of fa ithfulness; who bestoweth, even              and the fame and riches , the comforts, the joys
> upon his e nemies, the jewe l of bounty, and               provided by this rubbish-heap, the world, will
> lendeth, eve n to his fa lle n oppressor, a he lping       be gone without a trace. Summo n ye, the~, the
> hand ; it is he who will , eve n to th e fiercest of his   people to God, and invite hum a nity to follow
> foes , be a loving friend. These a re th e Teach-          the exa mple of the Co mpany o n high. Be ye
> ings of the Blessed Beauty , these the co un sels          loving fathers to the orph an, and a refuge to the
> of the Most Great Na me .                                  helpless, and a treasury for the poor, and a cure
> Baha'i Wo rld Ce ntre , Haifa, 197 8.                    for the ailin g. Be ye the he lpers of eve ry victim
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION                                             29
> of oppression, the patrons of the disadvan-             Service to the friends is service to the Kingtaged. Think ye at all times of rendering some        dom of God , and consideration shown to the
> service to every member of the human race.            poor is one of the greatest teachings of God.
> Pay ye no heed to aversion and rejection, to
> disdain, hostility , injustice: act ye in the opposite way. Be ye sincerely kind, not in appearance only. Let each one of God's loved ones               O ye illumined loved ones and ye handmaids
> centre his attention on this: to be the Lord's        of the Merciful! At a time when the sombre
> mercy to man; to be the Lord's grace . Let him        night of ignorance , of neglect of the divine
> do some good to every person whose path he            world, of being veiled from God , had overcrosseth, and be of some benefit to him. Let          spread the earth , a bright morning dawned and
> him improve the character of each and all , and       a rising light lit up the eastern sky. Then rose
> reorient the minds of men. In this way, the light     the Sun of Truth and the splendours of the
> of divine guidance wi ll shine forth , and the        Kingdom were shed over east and west. Those
> blessings of God will cradle all mankind: for         who had eyes to see rejoiced at the glad tidings
> love is light, no matter in what abode it dwell-      and cried out: 'O blessed, blessed are we! ', and
> eth; and hate is darkness, no matter where it         they witnessed the inner reality of all things,
> may make its nest. 0 friends of God! That the         and uncovered the mysteries of the Kingdom.
> hidden Mystery may stand revealed, and the            Delivered then from their fancies and their
> secret essence of all things may be disc losed ,      doubts, they beheld the light of truth, and so
> strive ye to banish that darkness for ever and        exhilarated did they become from draining the
> ever.                                                 cha lice of God's love, that they utterly forgot
> the world and their own selves. Dancing for joy
> they hastened to the place of their own martyrdom and there, where men die for love, they
> Aung away their heads and hearts.
> But those with unseeing eyes were
> astonished at this tumult, and they cried ,
> 0 ye peoples of the Kingdom! How many a            'Where is the light?' and again, 'We see no
> soul expended all its span of life in worship,        light! We see no rising sun! Here is no truth.
> endured the mortification of the Aesh , longed        This is but fantasy and nothing more. ' Bat-like
> to gain an entry into the Kingdom, and yet            they Aed into the underground dark , and there,
> failed, while ye, with neither toil nor pain nor      to their way of thinking, they found a measure
> self-denial, have won the prize and entered in.       of security and peace.
> It is even as in the time of the Messiah , when        This, however, is but the beginning of the
> the Pharisees and the pious were left without a       dawn , and the heat of the rising Orb of Truth is
> portion , while Peter, John and Andrew, given         not yet at the fullness of its power. Once the
> neither to pious worship nor ascetic practice ,       sun hath mounted to high noon, its fires will
> won the day. Wherefore , thank ye God for             burn so hot as to stir even the creeping things
> setting upon your heads the crown of glory            beneath the earth; and although it is not for
> everlasting, for granting unto you this               them to behold the light, yet will they all be set
> immeasurable grace.                                   in frenzied motion by the impact of the heat.
> The time hath come when as a thank-                    Wherefore , 0 ye beloved of God , offer up
> offering for this bestowa l, ye should grow in        thanks that ye have, in the day of the dawning,
> fa ith and constancy as day followeth day , and       turned your faces unto the Light of the World
> should draw ever nearer to the Lord , your            and beheld its splendours. Ye have received a
> God, becom ing magnetized to such a degree,           share of the light of truth , ye have enjoyed a
> and so aAame, that your holy melodies in praise       portion of those blessings that endure forever;
> of the Beloved will reach upward to the Com-          and therefore, as a returning of thanks for this
> pany on high; and that each one of you , even as      bounty , rest ye not for a moment , sit ye not
> a nightingale in this rose garden of God, will        si lent , carry to men's ears the glad tidings of the
> glorify the Lord of Hosts, and become the             Kingdom, spread far and wide the Word of
> teacher of all who dwell on earth.                    God.
> 30                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Act in accordance with the counsels of the        come out of Nazareth? The second sign is that
> Lord: that is, rise up in such wise, and with such   He shall rule with a rod of iron, that is, He must
> qualities, as to endow the body of this world        act with the sword, but this Messiah has not
> with a living soul, and to bring this young child,   even a wooden staff. Another of the conditions
> humanity , to the stage of adulthood. So far as      and signs is this: He must sit upon the throne of
> ye are able , ignite a candle of love in every       David and establish David's sovereignty. Now,
> meeting, and with tenderness rejoice and cheer       far from being enthroned, this man has not
> ye every heart. Care for the stranger as for one     even a mat to sit on. Another of the conditions
> of your own; show to alien souls the same            is this: the promulgation of all the laws of the
> loving kindness ye bestow upon your faithful         Torah; yet this man has abrogated these laws,
> friends. Should any come to blows with you,          and has even broken the sabbath day, although
> seek to be friends with him; should any stab         it is the clear text of the Torah that whosoever
> you to the heart, be ye a healing salve unto his     layeth claim to prophethood and revealeth
> sores; should any taunt and mock at you , meet       miracles and breaketh the sabbath day, must
> him with love. Should any heap his blame upon        be put to death. Another of the signs is this,
> you , praise ye him; should he offer you a           that in His reign justice will be so advanced that
> dead ly poison, give him the choicest honey in       righteousness and well-doing will extend from
> exchange; and should he threaten your life ,         the human even to the animal world-the
> grant him a remedy that will heal him ever-          snake and the mouse will share one hole, and
> more. Should he be pain itself, be ye his            the eagle and the partridge one nest, the lion
> medicine; should he be thorns, be ye his roses       and the gazelle shall dwell in one pasture, and
> and sweet herbs. Perchance such ways and             the wolf and the kid shall drink from one founwords from you will make this darksome world         tain. Yet now, injustice and tyranny have
> turn bright at last; will make this dusty earth      waxed so great in his time that they have
> turn heavenly, this devilish prison place            crucified him! Another of the conditions is this,
> become a royal palace of the Lord-so that war        that in the days of the Messiah the Jews will
> and strife will pass and be no more , and love       prosper and triumph over all the peoples of the
> and trust will pitch their tents on the summits of   world , but now they are living in the utmost
> the world. Such is the essence of God's admo-        abasement and servitude in the empire of the
> nitions; such in sum are the teachings for the       Romans. Then how can this be the Messiah
> Dispensation of Baba.                                promised in the Torah?'
> In this wise did they object to that Sun of
> Truth , although that Spirit of God was indeed
> the One promised in the Torah. But as they did
> not understand the meaning of these signs,
> When Christ appeared, twenty centuries            they crucified the Word of God. Now the
> ago, although the Jews were eagerly awaiting         Baha'fs hold that the recorded signs did come
> His Coming, and prayed every day, with tears,        to pass in the Manifestation of Christ, although
> saying: 'O God, hasten the Revelation of the          not in the sense which the Jews understood, the
> Messiah ,' yet when the Sun of Truth dawned,         description in the Torah being allegorical. For
> they denied Him and rose against Him with the         instance, among the signs is that of sovereignty.
> greatest enmity, and eventually crucified that        For Baha'fs say that the sovereignty of Christ
> divine Spirit, the Word of God, and named             was a heavenly, divine, everlasting sover-
> Him Beelzebub, the evil one, as is recorded in        eignty, not a Napoleonic sovereignty that vanthe Gospel. The reason for this was that they         isheth in a short time. For well nigh two
> said: 'The Revelation of Christ, according to         thousand years this sovereignty of Christ hath
> the clear text of the Torah, will be attested by      been established, and until now it endureth,
> certain signs, and so long as these signs have        and to all eternity that Holy Being will be
> not appeared, whoso layeth claim to be a Mes-         exalted upon an everlasting throne.
> siah is an impostor. Among these signs is this,          In like manner all the other signs have been
> that the Messiah should come from an                  made manifest, but the Jews did not underunknown place , yet we all know this man's            stand . Although nearly twenty centuries have
> house in Nazareth, and can any good thing             elapsed since Christ appeared with divine
> THE BAHA ' I REVELATION                                         31
> splendour, yet the Jews are still awaiting the       proved superior to the men, and surpassed the
> coming of the Messiah and regard themselves          famous of the earth.
> as true and Christ as false.                            The House of Justice, however, according to
> the explicit text of the Law of God, is confined
> to men; this for a wisdom of the Lord God's,
> which will ere long be made manifest as clearly
> 0 leaf upon the Tree of Life! The Tree of         as the sun at high noon.
> Life, of which mention is made in the Bible, is         As to you, 0 ye other handmaids who are
> Baha'u'llah, and the daughters of the Kingdom        enamoured of the heavenly fragrances,
> are the leaves upon that blessed Tree. Then          arrange ye holy gatherings, and found ye
> thank thou God that thou hast become related         Spiritual Assemblies, for these are the basis for
> to that Tree, and that thou art flourishing, ten-    spreading the sweet savours of God, exalting
> der and fresh.                                       His Word, uplifting the lamp of His grace,
> The gates of the Kingdom are opened wide,          promulgating His religion and promoting His
> and every favoured soul is seated at the ban-        Teachings, and what bounty is there greater
> quet table of the Lord, receiving his portion of     than this? These Spiritual Assemblies are
> that heavenly feast. Praised be God, thou too        aided by the Spirit of God. Their defender is
> art present at this table, taking thy share of the   ' Abdu'l-Baha'. Over them He spreadeth His
> bountiful food of heaven. Thou art serving the       wings. What bounty is there greater than this?
> Kingdom, and art well acquainted with the            These Spiritual Assemblies are shining lamps
> sweet savours of the Abha Paradise.                  and heavenly gardens, from which the fra-
> Then strive thou with all thy might to guide      grances of holiness are diffused over all regthe people , and eat thou of the bread that hath     ions, and the lights of knowledge are shed
> come down from heaven. For this is the mean-         abroad over all created things. From them the
> ing of Christ's words: 'I am the living bread        spirit of life streameth in every direction. They ,
> which came down from heaven ... he that              indeed, are the potent sources of the progress
> eateth of this bread shall live forever."            of man, at all times and under all conditions .
> What bounty is there greater than this?
> 
> 0 handmaid of God, who tremblest even as a
> fresh and tender branch in the winds of the love        The prime requisites for them that take
> of God! I have read thy letter, which telleth of     counsel together are purity of motive, radiance
> thine abundant love, thine intense devotion,         of spirit, detachment from all else save God,
> and of thy being occupied with the remem-            attraction to His Divine Fragrances, humility
> brance of thy Lord.                                  and lowliness amongst His loved ones, pa-
> Depend thou upon God. Forsake thine own           tience and long-suffering in difficulties and serwill and cling to His, set aside thine own desires   vitude to His exalted Threshold . Should they
> and lay hold of His, that thou mayest become         be graciously aided to acquire these attributes,
> an example, holy, spiritual, and of the King-        victory from the unseen Kingdom of Baha
> dom, unto His handmaids.                             shall be vouchsafed to them.
> Know thou, 0 handmaid, that in the sight of
> Baha, women are accounted the same as men,
> and God hath created all humankind in His
> own image , and after His own likeness. That is,        The members thereof must take counsel
> men and women alike are the revealers of His         together in such wise that no occasion for illnames and attributes , and from the spiritual        feeling or discord may arise. This can be
> viewpoint there is no difference between them.       attained when every member expresseth with
> Whosoever draweth nearer to God, that one is         absolute freedom his own opinion and setteth
> the most favoured, whether man or woman.             forth his argument. Should anyone oppose, he
> How many a handmaid, ardent and devoted,             must on no account feel hurt for not until mathath, within the sheltering shade of Baha,           ters are fully discussed can the right way be
> 'John 6:51, 58.                                      ' Of a Spiritual A ssembly .
> 32                                              THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> revealed. The shining spark of truth cometh                      Baha'i world wherein distinction of colour
> forth only after the clash of differing opinions .               findeth no place , but where hearts only are
> If after discussion, a decision be carried                       considered. Praise be to God , the hearts of the
> unanimously well and good; but if, the Lord                      friends are united and linked together, whether
> forbid , differences of opinion should arise, a                  they be from the east or the west, from north or
> majority of voices must prevail.                                 from south, whether they be German, French,
> Japanese , American, and whether they pertain
> to the white , the black , the red , the yellow or
> Yo u have asked as to the feast in every                      the brown race. Variations of colour, of land
> Bah[1'i month. This feast is held to foster com-                 and of race are of no importance in the Baha'i
> rad eship a nd love , to call God to mind and                    Faith; on the contrary, Baha'i unity oversupplicate Him with contrite hearts, and to                      cometh them all and doeth away with all these
> encourage benevolent pursuits.                                   fancies and imaginations.
> That is, the friends should there dwell upon
> God and glorify Him , read the prayers and holy
> ve rse s, and treat one another with the utmost
> affection and love.                                                 0 thou who hast an illumined heart! Thou
> art even as the pupil of the eye, the very
> wellspring of the light , for God's love hath cast
> As to the Nineteen Day Feast, it rejoiceth                     its rays upon thine inmost being and thou hast
> mind and heart. lf this feast be held in the                     turned thy face toward the Kingdom of thy
> prope r fashion, the friends will , once in nine-                Lord.
> teen da ys, find themselves spiritually restored ,                  Intense is the hatred , in America, between
> and endued with a power that is not of this                      black and white, but my hope is that the power
> wo rld.                                                          of the Kingdom will bind these two in friendship , and serve them as a healing balm.
> Let them look not upon a man's colour but
> 0 bird that singeth sweetly of the Abha                       upon his heart. If the heart be filled with light,
> Beauty! In this new and wondrous dispensa-                       that man is nigh unto the threshold of his
> tion the veils of superstition have been torn                    Lord; but if not, that man is careless of his
> asunder a nd the prejudices of eastern peoples                   Lord, be he white or be he black.
> sta nd conde mned. Among certain nations of
> the E ast, music was considered reprehensible,
> but in this new age the Manifest Light hath , in
> His ho ly Tablets, specifically proclaimed that                     0 thou dear handmaid of God! Thy letter
> music, sung or played , is spiritual food for soul               hath been received , and its contents were
> and heart.                                                       noted.
> The musician's art is among those arts                           Marriage, among the mass of the people, is a
> worthy of the highest praise, and it moveth the                  physical bond , and this union can on ly be temhearts of all who grieve . Wherefore, 0 thou                     porary, since it is foredoomed to a physical
> Sh ahnaz, 1 play and sing out the holy words of                  separation at the close.
> Go d with wondrous tones in the gatherings of                       Among the people of Baha , however, marthe friends , that the listener may be freed from                riage must be a union of the body and of the
> chains of care and sorrow , and his soul may                     spirit as well , for here both husband and wife
> leap for joy and humble itself in prayer to the                  are aglow with the same wine, both are
> rea lm of Glory.                                                 enamoured of the same matchless Face, both
> live and move through the same spirit, both are
> illumined by the same glory. This connection
> Strive with heart and soul in order to bring                   between them is a spiritual one, hence it is a
> about union and harmony among the white and                      bond that will abide forever. Likewise do they
> the black and prove thereby the unity of the                     enjoy strong and lasting ties in the physical
> ' Sh ahnaz, the name given to the recipient of this Tablet, is
> world as well, for if the marriage is based both
> also the name of a musical mode.                               on the spirit and the body, that union is a true
> THE BAHA'i REVELATION                                               33
> one, hence it will endure . If, however, the bond           0 handm a ids of the Lord! The spiritual
> is physical and nothing more, it is sure to be           asse mblage that ye established in that
> only temporary, and must inexorably end in               illumined city is most propitious . Ye have
> separation.                                              made great strides ; ye have surpassed the
> When, therefore, the people of Baha under-            others, have arise n to serve the Holy
> take to marry, the union must be a true rela-            Threshold, and have won heavenly bestowals.
> tionship, a spiritua l coming together as well as        Now with all spiritual zeal must ye gather in
> a physical one, so that throughout every phase           that enlightened assemblage and recite the
> of life, and in all the worlds of God, their union       Holy Writings and engage in remembering the
> will endure; for this real oneness is a gleaming         Lord . Set ye forth His arguments and proofs.
> out of the love of God.                                  Work ye for the guidance of the women in that
> In the same way, when any souls grow to be            land, teach the young girls and the children, so
> true believers, they will attain a spiritual relation-   that the mothers may educate their little ones
> ship with one another, and show forth a ten-             from their earliest days, thoroughly train them,
> derness which is not of this world. They will, all       rear them to have a goodly character and good
> of them, become elated from a draught of                 morals, guide them to all the virt ues of humandivine love, and that union of theirs, that con-         kind, prevent the development of any
> nection, will also abide forever. Souls, that is,        behaviour that would be worthy of blame , and
> who will consign their own selves to oblivion,           foster them in the embrace of Baha'i educastrip from .themselves the defects of human-             tion. Thus shall these tender infants be nurkind, and unchain themselves from human                  tured at the breast of the knowledge of God
> bondage, will beyond any doubt be illumined              and His love. Thus shall they grow and flourish,
> with the heavenly splendours of oneness, and             and be taught righteousness and the dignity of
> will all attain unto real union in the world that        humankind, resolution and the will to strive
> dieth not.                                               and to endure. Thus shall they learn perseverance in all things, the will to advance, high mindedness and high resolve, chastity and purity of life .
> Thus shall they be enabled to carry to a successful
> As for the question regarding marriage                conclusion whatsoever they undertake.
> under the Law of God: first thou must choose
> one who is pleasing to thee , and then the matter is subject to the consent of father and                 Let the mothers consider that whatever conmother. Before thou makest thy choice , they             cerneth the education of children is of the first
> have no right to interfere.                              importance. Let them put forth every effort in
> this regard, for when the bough is green and
> tender it will grow in whatever way ye train it.
> Therefore is it incumbent upon the mothers to
> Baha'i marriage is the commitment of the              rear their little ones even as a gardener tendeth
> two parties one to the other, and their mutual           his young plants. Let them strive by day and by
> attachment of mind and heart. Each must,                 night to establish within their children faith and
> however, exercise the utmost care to become              certitude, the fear of God, the love of the
> thoroughly acquainted with the character of              Beloved of the worlds, and all good qualities
> the other, that the binding covenant between             and traits. Whensoever a mother seeth that her
> them may be a tie that will endure forever.              child hath done well, let her praise and applaud
> Their purpose must be this: to become loving             him and cheer his heart; and if the slightest
> companions and comrades and at one with                  undesirable trait should manifest itself, let her
> each other for time and eternity ... .                   counsel the child and punish him, and use
> The true marriage of Baha'is is this, that             means based on reason, even a slight verbal
> husband and wife should be united both physi-            chastisement should this be necessary. It is not,
> cally and spiritually, that they may ever                however, permissible to strike a child, or vilify
> improve the spiritual life of each other, and            him, for the child's character will be totally
> may enjoy everlasting unity throughout all the           perverted if he be subjected to blows or verbal
> worlds of God. This is Baha'i marriage.                  abuse.
> 34                             THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 'Abdu'l-Baha
> Photograph taken in 1912 during 'Abdu'l-Bahti's visit to the United States.
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION                                               35
> As to the difference between that material         Baha'i young people, each and all, are known
> civilization now prevailing, and the divine civil-    throughout the world for their intellectual
> ization which will be one of the benefits to          attainments . There is no question but that they
> derive from the House of Justice, it is this:         will exert all their efforts, their energies, their
> material civi lization, through the power of          sense of pride, to acquire the sciences and arts.
> punitive and retaliatory laws, restraineth the
> people from criminal acts; and notwithstanding this, while laws to retaliate against and
> punish a man are continually proliferating, as           0 Friends of the Pure and Omnipotent God!
> ye can see, no laws exist to reward him . In all      To be pure and holy in all things is an attribute
> the cities of Europe and America, vast build-         of the consecrated soul and a necessary characings have been erected to serve as jails for the      teristic of the unenslaved mind. The best of
> criminals .                                           perfections is immaculacy and the freeing of
> Divine civilization, however, so traineth          oneself from every defect . Once the individual
> every member of society that no one, with the         is, in every respect, cleansed and purified, then
> exception of a negligible few, will undertake to      will he become a focal centre reflecting the
> commit a crime. There is thus a great differ-         Manifest Light.
> ence between the prevention of crime through             First in a human being's way of life must be
> measures that are violent and retaliatory, and        purity, then freshness , cleanliness, and indeso training the people, and enlightening them,        pendence of spirit. First must the stream bed be
> and spiritualizing them, that without any fear        cleansed, then may the sweet river waters be
> of punishment or vengeance to come, they will         led into it. Chaste eyes enjoy the beatific vision
> shun all criminal acts. They will, indeed, look       of the Lord and know what this encounter
> upon the very commission of a crime as a great        meaneth; a pure sense inhaleth the fragrances
> disgrace and in itself the harshest of punish-        that blow from the rose gardens of His grace; a
> ments. They will become enamoured of human           burnished heart will mirror forth the comely
> perfections, and will consecrate their lives to       face of truth.
> whatever will bring light to the world and will          This is why, in Holy Scriptures, the counsels
> further those qualities which are acceptable at       of heaven are likened to water, even as the
> the Holy Threshold of God.                            Qur'an saith: 'And pure water send We down
> See then how wide is the difference between        from Heaven,' 1 and the Gospel: 'Except a man
> material civilization and divine. With force and     be baptized of water and of the spirit, he cannot
> punishments, material civilization seeketh to         enter into the Kingdom of God.' 2 Thus is it
> restrain the people from mischief, from inflict-     clear that the Teachings which come from God
> ing harm on society and committing crimes.            are heavenly outpourings of grace; they are
> But in a divine civilization, the individual is so   rain-showers of divine mercy, and they cleanse
> conditioned that with no fear of punishment,          the human heart.
> he shunneth the perpetration of crimes, seeth            My meaning is this, that in every aspect of
> the crime itself as the severest of torments, and    life, purity and holiness, cleanliness and
> with alacrity and joy, setteth himself to acquir-     refinement, exalt the human condition and
> ing the virtues of humankind, to furthering          further the development of man's inner reality.
> human progress, and to spreading light across        Even in the physical realm, cleanliness will
> the world.                                           conduce to spirituality, as the Holy Writings
> clearly state. And although bodily cleanliness
> is a physical thing, it hath, nevertheless, a powerful influence on the life of the spirit. It is ·e ven
> It is incumbent upon Baha'i children to sur-        as a voice wondrously sweet, or a melody
> pass other children in the acquisition of sci-        played: although sounds are but vibrations in
> ences and arts, for they have been cradled in         the air which affect the ear's auditory nerve,
> the grace of God.                                     and these vibrations are but chance
> Whatever other children learn in a year, let        phenomena carried along through the air, even
> Baha'i children learn in a month . The heart of       1
> Qur'an 25: 50.
> 'Abdu'l-Bahli longeth, in its love, to find that      2
> cf. John 3:5.
> 36                                      THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 'Abdu'l-Baha
> Photograph of'Abdu'/-Bahd taken during His visit to Philadelphia, Pennsylvania; 1912.
> 
> so, see how they move the heart. A wondrous           Text, but their avoidance is necessary to purity ,
> melody is wings for the spirit, and maketh the        cleanliness , the preservation of health, and
> soul to tremble for joy. The purport is that          freedom from addiction.
> physical cleanliness doth also exert its effect          Among these latter is smoking tobacco,
> upon the human soul.                                  which is dirty , smelly , offensive-an evil habit,
> Observe how pleasing is cleanliness in the        and one the harmfulness of which gradually
> sight of God, and how specifically it is empha-       becometh apparent to all . Every qualified
> sized in the Holy Books of the Prophets; for the      physician hath ruled-and this hath also been
> Scriptures forbid the eating or the use of any        proven by tests-that one of the components
> unclean thing. Some of these prohibitions were        of tobacco is a deadly poison, and that the
> absolute, and binding upon a ll , and whoso           smoker is vulnerable to many and various distransgressed the give n law was abhorred of           eases. This is why smok ing hath been plainly
> God and anathematized by the believers. Such ,        set forth as repugnant from the standpo int of
> for example, were things categorically forbid -       hygiene.
> den , the perpetration of which was accounted a          The Bab , at the outset of His mission ,
> most grievous sin, among them actions so              explicitly prohibited tobacco , and the friends
> loathsome that it is shameful even to speak           one and all abandoned its use. But since those
> their name.                                           were times when dissimulation was permitted ,
> But there are other forbidden things which        and every individual who abstained from
> do not cause immediate harm , and the injuri-        smoking was exposed to harassment, abuse
> ous effects of which are only gradually pro-         and even death-the friends , in order not to
> duced: such acts are also repugnant to the           advertise their beliefs, would smoke . Later on ,
> Lord , and blameworthy in His sight, and repel-      the Book of Aqdas was revealed, and since
> le nt. The abso lute un lawfu lness of these, how-   smoking tobacco was not specifically forbidden
> ever, hath not been expressly set forth in the        there, the believers did not give it up. The
> THE BA H A'I R EVE L ATION                                            37
> B lessed B eauty, however, always expressed                O Divin e Providence ! Bestow Tho u in all
> re pugnance fo r it, and altho ugh, in the earl y       thin gs puri ty and cleanl iness upon th e peop le
> days, the re were reasons why He wo uld smo ke          of B aha. Gra nt that they be freed fro m all
> a little tobacco, in time He complete ly                defi le me nt, and re leased from a ll addictions.
> re no unced it, and those sanctifi e d souls who        Save the m fro m commi tting any re pugnant act,
> fo llowed H im in all things also aba ndoned its        un bind th em fro m th e chain s of eve ry evil
> use.                                                    habit, that th ey may live pure and fr ee, who le-
> My mea ni ng is that in the sigh t of God ,        so me and cleanly, wo rth y to serve at T hy Sasmo kin g tobacco is de precate d , abho rre nt,        cred Thres hold and fit to be related to th eir
> fi lthy in the extreme; and, albeit by degrees,         Lo rd. D eliver the m fro m intox icating drin ks
> highl y injurious to health. It is a lso a waste of     and tobacco , save them , rescue the m, fro m thi s
> money and time, and make th the user a prey to          opium that bringet h o n mad ness, suffe r the m
> a noxio us addi ctio n. To th ose who stand firm in     to enj oy the sweet savo urs of ho liness, that
> the Cove nant, this habit is therefo re censured        they may drink deep of the mystic cup of
> both by reason and experience, and re no unc-           heavenl y love and know the ra pture of be ing
> in g it will b ring relief a nd peace of mind to all    draw n eve r closer un to the Rea lm of the A llme n. Furthermore , this will make it possible to       G lo ri ous. Fo r it is even as T ho u has t said: 'A ll
> have a fresh mo uth and unstaine d fin ge rs, and       that tho u hast in thy ce ll a r will not appease th e
> hair th at is free of a fo ul and repell ent sme ll.    thirst of my love-bring me, 0 cup-bea re r, of
> O n receipt of this missive , the friends will          the wine of the spirit a cup full as the sea !'
> sure ly, by whatever mea ns and even over a                0 ye, God's loved ones! Experie nce hat h
> period of time, fo rsake th is pe rn icious hab it.     show n how greatl y the re no un cing of smokin g,
> Such is my hope .                                       of intoxicatin g drink , and of opium , co ndu ce th
> As to opium , it is fo ul and accursed . God       to health a nd vigo ur, to the ex pansio n and
> protect us fro m the punishme nt He inflicteth          kee nn ess of the mi nd and to bodil y strengt h.
> on the use r. Acco rd ing to the explicit Text of       There is today a peop le 2 who strictly avo id
> the Most Ho ly Boo k, it is for bi dd en, and its use   tobacco, in tox icating liquor and opium . T his
> is utterl y co nde mne d. Reaso n showeth th at         peo ple is fa r and away supe ri or to the others ,
> smo kin g o pium is a kind of insa nity, and            fo r stre ngth and physica l courage, fo r hea lth,
> ex pe rience attesteth that the user is complete ly     beauty a nd co meliness. A single o ne of their
> cut off fro m the huma n kingdo m. May God              men ca n sta nd up to ten me n of anothe r tri be.
> protect all against the perpetrati on of an act so      T hi s hath proved true of th e entire peo ple : th at
> hideo us as this, an act which laye th in ruins th e    is, membe r fo r member, each ind ivid ua l of thi s
> ve ry fo undatio n of what it is to be hum an, and      community is in every respect superior to the
> whi ch ca useth the user to be di spossessed fo r       in dividuals of other communities .
> ever and eve r. Fo r opium fas teneth o n the soul ,       Make ye the n a might y effo rt, tha t the purity
> so that the user's conscience die th , his mind is      and sa ncti ty which , above all e lse, a re
> blo tted away, his perceptio ns are eroded . It         cherished by ' Abd u'l- Baha, shall disti nguish
> turneth the livi ng into the dead. It quencheth         the peo ple of Ba ha; that in eve ry kin d of exce lthe na tu ra l heat. No greater harm can be co n-       le nce the peo pl e of God sha ll surpass a ll o th er
> ce ived th a n that which o pium inflicte th. Fortu-    human be ings; th at bo th outwardl y and
> nate are they who never even speak the name             in wa rdl y they shall prove supe ri o r to the res t;
> of it; the n thin k how wretched is t he user.          that fo r purity, immaculacy, refi ne men t, and
> 0 ye lovers of God! I n this, the cycle of          the preservation of health, they shall be leaders
> A lmighty God, vio le nce and fo rce , constra int      in the va nguard of those who know . A nd that
> a nd oppressio n, are o ne and a ll co nde mned. It     by their freedom fro m e nslave ment, th e ir
> is, howeve r, mandato ry that the use of opium          knowledge, the ir self-co ntro l, they sha ll be fi rst
> be preve nted by any means whatsoever, that             a mong the pure, the free and the wise .
> percha nce th e hu man race may be de li ve red
> fro m thi s most powerful of pl ag ues . A nd
> o therwise, woe and misery to whoso fall eth               T here are two ways of healing sickness, masho rt of his duty to hi s Lord . 1                     te rial means and spiritual means. The first is by
> cf. Qur'an 39:57.                                   ' The Sik hs.
> 38                                    THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> A glimpse of'Abdu'l-Bahti in the Holy Land.
> the treatment of physicians; the second consis-     answer to a previous letter, that feelings of
> teth in prayers offered by the spiritual o nes to   affection were being established between thy-
> God and in turning to Him . Both means shou ld      self and the friends.
> be used and practised.                                 One must see in every hum an being on ly that
> Illnesses which occur by reason of physical     which is worthy of praise. When this is done,
> causes should be treated by doctors with medi-      one can be a friend to the whole human race. If,
> cal remedies ; those which are due to spiritu al    however, we look at people from the standcauses disappear through spiritual means.           point of their faults, then being a friend to them
> Thus an illness caused by affliction, fear, nerv-   is a formidable task.
> ous impressions, will be healed more effec-            It happened one day in the time of
> tive ly by spiritual rather than by physical        Christ-may the life of the world be a sacrifice
> treatment. Hence, both kinds of treatment           unto Him-that He passed by the dead body of
> shou ld be followed; they are not contradictory .   a dog, a carcass reeking, hideous, the limbs
> Therefore thou shouldst also accept physical        rotting away. One of those present said: 'How
> remedies inasmuch as these too have come            foul its stench!' And another said: 'How sickfrom the mercy and favour of God, Who hath          ening! How loathsome!' To be brief, each one
> revealed and made manifest med ical science so      of them had something to add to the list.
> that His servants may profit from this kind of        But then Christ Himself spoke, and He told
> treatment a lso. Thou shouldst give equal atten-    them: 'Look at that dog's teeth! How gleami ng
> tion to spiritu al treatments, for they produce    white!'
> marvellous effects .                                  The Messiah' s sin-coverin g gaze did not for a
> Now, if thou wishest to know the true           moment dwell upon the repulsiveness of that
> remedy which will heal man from all sickness        carrion. The one element of that dead dog's
> and will give him the hea lth of the divine king-   carcass which was not abomination was the
> dom, know that it is the precepts and teachings     teeth: and Jesus looked upon their brightness.
> of God. Focus thine attention upon them .              Thus is it incumbent upon us, when we direct
> our gaze toward other people , to see where
> they excel, not where they fail.
> Praise be to God , thy goal is to promote the
> 0 lover of humankind! Thy letter hath been        well-being of humankind and to help the souls
> received, and it telleth, God be praised, of thy    to overcome their fau lts. This good intention
> health and well-being. It appea reth , from thine   will produce laudable results.
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION                                           39
> As to thy question, doth every soul without       and hardships, then his nature will recoil and
> exception achieve life everlasting? Know thou        he will desire the eternal realm-a realm which
> that immortality belongeth to those souls in         is sanctified from all afflictions and calamities.
> whom hath been breathed the spirit of life from      Such is the case with the man who is wise. He
> God. All save these are lifeless-they are the        shall never drink from a cup which is at the end
> dead, even as Christ hath explained in the           distasteful, but, on the contrary, he will seek
> Gospel text. He whose eyes the Lord hath             the cup of pure and limpid water. He will not
> opened will see the souls of men in the stations     taste of the honey that is mixed with poison.
> they will occupy after their release from the           Praise thou God, that thou hast been tried
> body. He will find the living ones thriving          and hast experienced such a test. Be patient
> within the precincts of their Lord , and the dead    and grateful. Turn thy face to the divine Kingsunk down in the lowest abyss of perdition.          dom and strive that thou mayest acquire merci-
> Know thou that every soul is fashioned after      ful characteristics, mayest become illumined
> the nature of God , each being pure and holy at      and acquire the attributes of the Kingdom and
> his birth. Afterwards, however, the individuals      of the Lord. Endeavour to become indifferent
> will vary according to what they acquire of          to the pleasures of this world and to its comfort,
> virtues or vices in this world. Although all exis-   to remain firm and steadfast in the Covenant
> tent beings are in their very nature created in      and to promulgate the Cause of God .
> ranks or degrees, for capacities are various,           This is the cause of the exaltation of man, the
> nevertheless every individual is born holy and      cause of his glory and of his salvation.
> pure, and only thereafter may he become
> defiled.
> And further, although the degrees of being           Follow thou the way of thy Lord, and say not
> are various, yet all are good. Observe the           that which the ears cannot bear to hear, for
> human body, its limbs, its members, the eye ,        such speech is like luscious food given to small
> the ear, the organs of smell, of taste, the hands,   children. However palatable , rare and rich the
> the fingernails. Notwithstanding the differ-         food may be, it cannot be assimilated by the
> ences among all these parts, each one within         digestive organs of a suckling child. Therefore
> the limitations of its own being participateth in    unto every one who hath a right, let his settled
> a coherent whole. If one of them faileth it must     measure be given.
> be healed, and should no remedy avail, that             'Not everything that a man knoweth can be
> part must be removed.                                disclosed, nor can everything that he can disclose be regarded as timely, nor can every
> timely utterance be considered as suited to the
> capacity of those who hear it.' Such is the con-
> Those souls that, in this day, enter the divine   summate wisdom to be observed in thy purkingdom and attain everlasting life, although        suits. Be not oblivious thereof, if thou wishest
> materially dwelling on earth, yet in reality soar    to be a man of action under all conditions. First
> in the realm of heaven . Their bodies may linger     diagnose the disease and identify the malady,
> on earth but their spirits travel in the immen-      then prescribe the remedy, for such is the persity of space. For as thoughts widen and             fect method of the skilful physician.
> become illumined, they acquire the power of
> flight and transport man to the kingdom of
> God.
> The teacher, when teaching, must be himself
> fully enkindled, so that his utterance, like unto
> a flame of fire, may exert influence and con-
> 0 thou servant of God! Do not grieve at the       sume the veil of self and passion. He must also
> afflictions and calamities that have befallen        be utterly humble and lowly so that others may
> thee. All calamities and afflictions have been       be edified, and be totally self-effaced and evacreated for man so that he may spurn this mor-       nescent so that he may teach with the melody
> tal world-a world to which he is much                of the Concourse on high-otherwise his
> attached. When he experienceth severe trials         teaching will have no effect.
> 40                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 'Abdu'l-Baha
> Phowgraph taken in Paris; 19 I I .
> 
> Whoso reciteth this prayer with lowlin ess and fervour will bring gladness
> and joy to the heart ofthis Servant; it will be even as meeting Him face to face.
> He is the All-Glorious!
> 
> 0 God, my God! Lowly and tearful , I raise       me to be selfless at the heavenly entrance of
> my suppliant hands to Thee and cover my face        Thy ga te , and aid me to be detached from all
> in the dust of that Threshold of Thine, exalted     things within Thy holy precincts. Lord! Give
> above the knowledge of the learned , and the        me to drink from the chalice of selflessness;
> praise of all th at glorify Thee. Graciously look   with its robe clothe me, a nd in its ocean
> upon Thy servant, humble and lowly at Thy           immerse me. Make me as dust in the pathway
> door, with the glances of the eye of Thy mercy,     of Thy loved ones, and grant that I may offer up
> and immerse him in the Ocean of Thine eternal       rny soul for the earth ennobled by the footsteps
> grace.                                              of Thy chosen ones in Thy path, 0 Lord of
> Lord! He is a poor and lowly se rvant of         Glory in the Highest.
> Thine, enthralled and imploring Thee, captive          With this prayer doth Thy servant call Thee,
> in Thy hand, praying fervently to Thee, trust-      at dawntide and in the night-season . Fulfil his
> ing in Thee, in tears before Thy face, calling to   heart's desire, 0 Lord! Illumine his heart,
> Thee and beseeching Thee, saying:                   gladden his bosom, kindle his light, that he may
> 0 Lord, my God! Give me Thy grace to             serve Thy Cause and Thy serva nts .
> serve Thy loved ones, strengthen me in my              Thou art the Bestower, the Pitiful, the Most
> servitude to Thee, illumine my brow with the        Bountiful, the Gracious, the Merciful, the
> light of adoration in Thy court of holiness, and    Compassionate.
> of prayer to Thy Kingdom of grandeur. Help
> THE BAHA'i REVELATION   41
> 42   THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> ~
> ~
> 0-0
> -s::s
> v:i
> ;<
> :<::"'
> h
> ~
> "'
> ~
> E
> "'
> \..)
> >::
> "i::!
> >::
> ....J
> ....>::
> .s::"'
> t'.
> :<::
> ~
> "'....
> (.)
> 
> -s"'
> .s
> -s·
> ~
> ~-
> '<:::
> .s::
> <::s
> ~
> 
> -s"-.,"'
> >::
> <::s
> ' 'ij
> ....
> <::s
> ::s
> (.)
> 'ij-
> ' ~>::
> kl
> ~
> 0-0
> .s::
> v:i
> "-.,
> 
> "'
> ~
> <.J
> 
> c:..
> 0-0
> .so:;
> "'....
> ~"'
> II
> EXCERPTS FROM THE WRITINGS OF
> SHOGHI EFFENDI
> A WIDER LOY AL TY
> Excerpts concerning the oneness of mankind from Call to the Nations 1
> 
> MYSTERIOUSLY, slowly, a nd resist-                         ephemeral manifestations of returning proslessly God accompli shes His design, though the            perity which at times appear to be capable of
> sight that meets our eyes in this day be the               checking the disruptive influence of the chronic
> spectacle of a world hopelessly entangled in its           ills affl icting the institutions of a decaying age .
> own meshes, utterly careless of the Voice                  T he sign s of the times are too numerous and
> which, for a century, has been callin g it to God,         compelling to all ow him to mistake their
> and miserably subservient to the siren voices              character or to belittle their significance. He
> which are atte mpting to lure it into the vast             can, if he be fair in his judgement, recognize in
> abyss.                                                     the chain of events which proclaim on the one
> God's purpose is none other than to usher in ,          hand the irresistible march of the institutions
> in ways He alone can bring abo ut, and the full            directly associated with the Revelation ofBaha'-
> significance of which He alone can fat hom, the            u'llah and foreshadow on the other the down-
> Great, the Golden Age of a long-divided, a                 fa ll of those powers and principalities that ha ve
> long-afflicted humanity. Its present state,                either ignored or opposed it-he can recognize
> indeed even its immediate future, is dark, dis-            in them a ll evidences of the operation of God's
> tressingly dark. Its distant future, however, is           a ll-pervasive Will, the shaping of His perfectly
> rad iant, gloriously radiant-so radiant that no            ordered and world-e mb racing Plan .. . .
> eye can visualize it.
> 
> The Revelation of Baha' u' llah , whose sup-
> T he contrast between the accumulating evi-             reme mission is none other but the achievedences of steady consolidation that accompany              ment of this organic and spiritua l unity of the
> the rise of the Admi nistrative Order of the               whole body of nations, should, if we be fa ithful
> Faith of God, and the forces of disintegration             to its implications, be regarded as signa lizing
> which batter at the fabric of a travailing society,        through its advent the coming of age of the
> is as clear as it is arresting. Both within and            entire human race. It should be viewed not
> outside the Baha'i world the signs and tokens              merely as ye t another spiritual revival in the
> which , in a mysterious manner, are heralding              everchanging fortunes of mankind , not only as
> the birth of that World Order, the establish-              a further stage in a chain of progressive Revelament of which must signalize the Golden Age                tions, no r even as the culmination of one of a
> of the Cause of God, are growing and multiply-             series of recurrent prophetic cycles, but rather
> ing day by day. No fair-mi nded observer can               as marking the last a nd highest stage in the
> any longer fail to discern them. He can not be             stupendous evolution of man's collective life
> misled by the painful slowness characterizing              on this pla net. The emergence of a world comthe unfoldment of the civilization which the               munity, the consciousness of world citizenship,
> followers of Baha' u'llah are labouring to                 the founding of a world civilization and culestablish. Nor can he be deluded by the                    ture- all of which must synchronize with the
> 'Baha'i World Centre, Haifa, 1977.                         initial stages in the unfoldment of the Golden
> 44                                           THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Age of the Baha'i Era-should, by their very                 ve nture to asse rt, would the ve ry act of devising
> nature, be rega rded, as far as this pla ne tary life       the mach inery required for the political and
> is co ncerned, as the furthermo st limits in th e           eco nomic unificatio n of th e world- a principle
> organ ization of huma n society, though ma n, as            that has been increasingly advoca ted in rece nt
> an individual, will, nay must indeed as a result            times-provide in itself the antidote against
> of such a consummation , continue indefinite ly             the poison that is steadily und e rminin g the vigto progress a nd develop .                                  our of organ ized peo ples and nation s.
> T ha t mystic, all-pervasive, ye t in definab le           What e lse, mi ght we not confide ntl y affirm ,
> change, which we associate with th e stage of               but the unrese rved acce ptance of the Divine
> mat urity inevita ble in the life of the individual         Programme e nunci a ted, with such simplicity
> a nd the deve lopment of the fruit mu st, if we             and force as fa r back as sixty years ago, 1 by
> wou ld correctly apprehend th e utte rances of              Baha' u' ll a h , e mbodyi ng in its esse ntia ls God's
> Baha' u' ll a h, have its co unterpart in the evo lu-       divine ly appo inted sche me fo r the unifica ti o n
> tio n of th e orga nization of huma n society. A            of mankin d in this age, co upled with a n
> simi la r stage must sooner or later be a tt ain ed in      in domitab le co nvi cti o n in th e unfailin g effic acy
> the co ll ective life of ma nkind , producing a n           of each and all of its provisio ns, is eventua ll y
> eve n more striking phenomenon in world re la-              capab le of wit hstandin g the forces of intern al
> ti ons, a nd e nd owing th e whole hum a n race             disintegrat ion which , if unch ecked, must nee ds
> with such potentialit ies of well-being as shall            continue to eat into th e vitals of a despairing
> provide, throughout th e succeeding ages, the               society. It is tow a rds this goa l-the goa l of a
> ch ief incentive required for th e eve ntual                new Wor ld Orde r, D ivine in origin , a llfu lfilme nt of its high destiny ....                       e mbracin g in scope, equita ble in principle,
> challenging in its fe a tures- that a harassed
> humanity mu st stri ve.
> To claim to have grasped a ll the implicat ions
> Hum a nity, whether viewed in th e light of             of Ba ha' u' ll a h's prodigious scheme for
> ma n's ind ivid ual cond uct o r in th e ex istin g rela-   world-wide human solida rity, or to have
> tionships betwee n orga ni zed communities a nd             fatho med its import , wo ul d be presumptuous
> natio ns, has, alas, strayed too far a nd suffe red         on the pa rt of eve n th e declared supporters of
> to o grea t a decline to be redeem ed throu gh the          His Faith. To a ttempt to visualize it in all its
> un aided efforts of the best among its recognized           possibiliti es, to estima te its future be nefits, to
> rul e rs a nd states men-howeve r disinte rested            picture its glory, wou ld be pre mature a t eve n so
> th e ir motives, howeve r conce rted their act io n,        adva nced a stage in the evo lution of mankind.
> howeve r un sparing in their zea l a nd devotion               All we can reasonably venture to attempt is
> to its ca use. No scheme whi ch th e calcu la tion s        to strive to obtain a glim pse of the first streaks
> of th e hi ghest statesma nship ma y ye t devise ; no       of the promised D awn that must, in the fullness
> doctrine wh ich the most distin g uished expo-              of time, chase away the gloom that has encirne nts of eco nomic th eo ry may ho pe to                   cled hum a nity. A ll we ca n do is to point out, in
> adv a nce; no princip le which th e most a rde nt of        their broadest o utlines, what appear to us to be
> mora li sts may strive to in cul cate, ca n provide,        the guiding principles underlying the World
> in th e last reso rt, adeq ua te fo und a tion s upo n      Order of Ba ha' u' ll a h ....
> whi ch the fut ure of a distracted world can be
> built.
> No a ppea l for mutu a l to lera nce wh ich th e
> worldly-wise might ra ise , however compe lling                .. . Is it not a fac t-and this is the centra l
> and insiste nt, can calm its passio ns o r he lp            idea I des ire to e mphas ize- th a t th e fundarestore its vigo ur. Nor would a ny ge ne ral               me ntal cause of this world unrest is attrib utsche me of me re orga ni zed inte rn ation a l co-          a ble, not so much to the conseq uences of what
> ope ra ti o n, in whatever sphere of hum a n activ-         must sooner or late r come to be regarded as a
> it y, howeve r in ge nious in conceptio n , or exten-       transitory dis location in the affairs of a consive in scope , succeed in re movi ng th e root             tinually cha nging world , but rather to th e fa ilcause of the ev il th a t has so rud e ly upset th e        ure of th ose into whose ha nds the immedi ate
> equilibrium o f p resent-day society. Not eve n , I         1
> Written in 1931.
> THE BAHA'f REVELATION                                         45
> 
> Entrance of the Bahli'( International Archives building on Mount Carmel. The columns
> chosen by Shoghi Effendi are a copy of the noblest ever erected in the Ionic order, those ofthe
> temple of Athena Nike. The exterior of the building was completed in 1957.
> 46                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> destinies of peoples and nations have been
> •       impose taxation and all rights to maintain
> committed, to adjust their systems of economic         armaments, except for purposes of maintaining
> and political institutions to the imperative           internal order within their respective dominneeds of a rapidly evolving age? Are not these         ions. Such a state will have to include within its
> intermittent crises that convulse present-day          orbit an International Executive adequate to
> society due primarily to the lamentable inabil-        enforce supreme and unchallengeable authority of the world's recognized leaders to read          ity on every recalcitrant member of the comaright the signs of the times, to rid themselves       monwealth; a World Parliament whose memonce for all of their preconceived ideas and           bers shall be elected by the people in their
> fettering creeds, and to reshape the machinery         respective countries and whose election shall
> of their respective governments according to           be confirmed by their respective governments;
> those standards that are implicit in Baha'-            and a Supreme Tribunal whose judgement will
> u'llah's supreme declaration of the Oneness of         have a binding effect even in such cases where
> Mankind-the chief and distinguishing feature           the parties concerned did not voluntarily agree
> of the Faith He proclaimed? For the principle          to submit their case to its consideration. A
> of the Oneness of Mankind, the corner-stone            world community in which all economic barof Baha'u'llah 's world-embracing dominion,            riers will have been permanently demolished
> implies nothing more nor less than the                 and the interdependence of Capital and
> enforcement of His scheme for the unification          Labour definitely recognized; in which the
> of the world-the scheme to which we have               clamour of religious fanaticism and strife will
> already referred. 'In every Dispensation,'             have been forever stilled; in which the flame of
> writes 'Abdu'l-Baha, 'the light of Divine Gui-         racial animosity will have been finally extindance has been focussed upon one central               guished; in which a single code of international
> theme . ... In this wondrous Revelation, this          law- the product of the considered judgement
> glorious century, the foundation of the Faith of       of the world's federated representatives-shall
> God and the distinguishing feature of His Law          have as its sanction the instant and coercive
> is the consciousness of the Oneness of Man-            intervention of the combined forces of the fedkind.'                                                 erated units; and finally a world community in
> How pathetic indeed are the efforts of those        which the fury of a capricious and militant
> leaders of human institutions who, in utter dis-       nationalism will have been transmuted into an
> regard of the spirit of the age, are striving to       abiding consciousness of world c1t1zenadjust national processes, suited to the ancient       ship-such indeed appears, in its broadest outdays of self-contained nations, to an age which        line, the Order anticipated by Baha'u'llah, an
> must either achieve the unity of the world, as         Order that shall come to be regarded as the
> adumbrated by Baha'u'llah, or perish. At so            fairest fruit of a slowly maturing age.
> critical an hour in the history of civilization it         'The Tabernacle of Unity,' Baha'u'llah probehoves the leaders of all the nations of the         claims in His message to all mankind, 'has been
> world, great and small, whether in the East or        raised; regard ye not one another as stranin the West, whether victors or vanquished, to         gers . .. . Of one tree are all ye the fruit and of
> give heed to the clarion call of Baha'u'llah and,      one bough the leaves . ... The world is but one
> thoroughly imbued with a sense of world sol-          country and mankind its citizens . ... Let not a
> idarity, the sine qua non of loyalty to His           man glory in that he loves his country; let him
> Cause, arise manfully to carry out in its entirety    rather glory in this, that he loves his kind.'
> the one remedial scheme He, the Divine Physi-             Let there be no misgivings as to the animatcian , has prescribed for an ail ing humanity . ...    ing purpose of the world-wide Law of Baha'-
> u'llah. Far from aiming at the subversion of the
> existing foundations of society, it seeks to
> broaden its basis, to remould its institutions in
> a matter consonant with the needs of an ever-
> . . . Some form of a world super-state must           changing world. It can conflict with no legitineeds be evolved, in whose favour all the               mate allegiances, nor can it undermine essennations of the world will have willingly ceded          tial loyalties. Its purpose is neither to stifle the
> every claim to make war, certain rights to              flame of a sane and intelligent patriotism in
> THE BAHA'I REVELATION                                            47
> men's hearts, nor to abolish the system of           nature of those essential relationships that
> national autonomy so essential if the evils of       must bind all the states and nations as members
> excessive centralization are to be avoided. It       of one human family. It does not constitute
> does not ignore, nor does it attempt to sup-         merely the enunciation of an ideal, but stands
> press, the diversity of ethnical origins, of cli-    inseparably associated with an institution ademate, of history, of language and tradition, of      quate to embody its truth, demonstrate its vathought and habit , that differentiate the peo-      lidity, and perpetuate its influence. It implies
> ples and nations of the world. It calls for a        an organic change in the structure of presentwider loyalty , for a larger aspiration than any     day society, a change such as the world has not
> that has animated the human race. It insists         yet experienced. It constitutes a challenge, at
> upon the subordination of natio nal impulses         once bold and universal , to outworn shiband interests to the imperative claims of a          boleths of national creeds-creeds that have
> unified world. It repudiates excessive central-      had their day and which must, in the ordinary
> ization on one hand, and disclaims all attempts      course of events as shaped and controlled by
> at uniformity on the other. Its watchword is         Providence, give way to a new gospel, fundaunity in diversity ....                              mentally different from, and infinitely superior
> to, what the world has already conceived. It
> calls for no less than the reconstruction and the
> demilitarization of the whole civilized
> world-a world organically unified in all the
> The call of Baha' u'llah is primarily directed    essential aspects of its life, its political machinagain st all forms of provincialism , all            ery, its spiritual aspiration, its trade and
> ins ul arities and prejudices . If long-cherished    finance, its script and language, and yet infinite
> ideals and time-honoured institutions, if cer-       in the diversity of the national characteristics of
> tain socia l assumptions and religious formulae      its federated units .
> have ceased to promote the welfare of the gen-           It represents the consummation of hum an
> erality of mankind, if they no longer minister to    evolution-an evolution that has had its earthe needs of a continually evolving humanity,        liest beginnings in the birth of family life, its
> let them be swept away and relegated to the          subsequent development in the achievement of
> limbo of obsolescent and forgotten doctrines.        tribal solidarity, leading in turn to the constitu-
> Why should these, in a world subject to the          tion of the city-state, and expanding later into
> immutable law of change and decay , be exempt        the institution of independent and sovereign
> from the deterioration that must needs over-         nations.
> take every human institution? For legal stan -          The principle of the Oneness of Mankind, as
> dards, political and economic theories are sole-     proclaimed by Baha'u'llah, carries with it no
> ly designed to safeguard the interests of            more and no less than a solemn assertion that
> humanity as a whole, and not humanity to be          attainment to this final stage in this stupendous
> crucified for the preservation of the integrity of   evolution is not only necessary but inevitable ,
> any particular law or doctrine.                      that its realization is fast approaching, and that
> Let there be no mistake. The principle of the     nothing short of a power that is born of God
> Oneness of Mankin d-the pivot round which            can succeed in establishing it. .. .
> all the teachings of Baha'u'll a h revolve-is no         Who knows that for so exalted a conception
> mere outburst of ignorant emotionalism or an         to take shape a suffering more intense than any
> expression of vague and pious hope. Its appeal       it has yet experienced will have to be inflicted
> is not to be merely identified with a reawaken-      upon hum anity? Co uld anything less than the
> ing of the spirit of brotherhood and good-will       fire of a civil war with all its violence and vicisamong men, nor does it aim solely at the foster-     situdes-a war that nearly rent the great
> ing of harmonious co-operation among indi-           American Republic-have welded the states,
> vidual peoples and nations. Its implications are     not only into a Union of independent units , but
> deeper, its claims greater than any which the        into a Nation, in spite of all the ethnic differ-
> Prophets of old were allowed to advance. Its         ences that characterized its component parts?
> message is applicable not only to the indi-          That so fundamental a revolution, involving
> vidual, but concerns itself primarily with the       such far-reaching changes in the structure of
> 48                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> society, can be achieved through the ordinary       compared with such expressions of pious hope
> processes of diplomacy and education seems          as have been uttered in the past. His is not
> highly improbable. We have but to turn our          merely a call which He raised, alone and
> gaze to humanity's blood-stai ned history to        unaided, in the face of the relentless and comrealize that nothing short of intense mental as     bined opposition of two of the most powerful
> well as physical agony has been able to precipi-    Oriental potentates of His day-while Himself
> tate those epoch-making changes that consti-        an exile and prisoner in their hands. It implies
> tute the greatest landmarks in the history of       at o nce a warning and a promise- a warning
> human civilization.                                 that in it lies the sole means for the salvation of
> Great and far-reaching as have been those        a greatly suffering world, a promise that its
> changes in the past, they cannot appear, when       realization is at hand.
> viewed in their proper pe rspecti ve, except as        Uttered at a time when its possibility had not
> subsidiary adjustments preluding that trans-        yet been seriously envisaged in any part of the
> formation of unparalleled majesty and scope         world, it has, by virtue of that celestial potency
> which humanity is in this age bound to              which the Spirit of Baha'u'llah has breathed
> undergo. That the forces of a world catas-          into it, come at last to be regarded, by an
> trophe can alone precipitate such a new phase       increasing number of thoughtful men, not only
> of human thought is, alas, becoming increas-        as an approaching possibility, but as the necesingly apparent. That nothing short of the fire of   sary outcome of the forces now operating in the
> a severe ordeal, unparalleled in its intensity,     world.
> can fuse a nd weld the discordant entities that        Surely the world, contracted and transconstitute the elements of present-day civiliza-    formed into a single highly complex organism
> tion, into the integral components of the world     by the marvellous progress achieved in the
> commonwealth of the future, is a truth which        realm of physical science, by the world-wide
> future events will increasingly demonstrate.        expansion of commerce and industry, and
> The prophetic voice of Baha'u'llah warning,      struggling, under the pressure of world
> in the concluding passages of The Hidden            economic forces, amidst the pitfalls of a
> Words, the peoples of the world that an             materialistic civilization, stands in dire need of
> unforeseen calamity is following them and that      a restatement of the Truth underlying all the
> grievous retribution awaiteth them throws           Revelations of the past in a language suited to
> indeed a lurid light upon the immediate for-        its essential requirements. And what voice
> tunes of sorrowing humanity. Nothing but a          other than that of Baha' u'llah-the Mouthfiery ordeal, out of which humanity will            piece of God for this age- is capable of effectemerge, chastened and prepared, can succeed         ing a transformation of society as radical as that
> in implanting that sense of responsibility which    which He has already accomplished in the
> the leaders of a new-born age must arise to         hearts of those men and women, so diversified
> shoulder.                                           and seemingly irreconcilable, who constitute
> I would again direct yo ur atte ntion to those   the body of His declared followers throughout
> ominous words of Baha'u'llah which I have           the world?
> already quoted: 'A nd when the appointed hour          That such a mighty conception is fast budis come, there shall suddenly appea r that which    ding out in the minds of men, that voices are
> shall cause the limbs of mankind to quake.' . ..    being raised in its support, that its salient features must fast crystallize in the consciousness
> of those who are in authority, few indeed can
> doubt. That its modest beginnings have already
> taken shape in the world-wide Administration
> One word more in conclusion. The procla-          with which the adherents of the Faith of Ba ha' -
> mation of the Oneness of Mankind-the head           u'llah stand associated only those whose hearts
> corner-stone of Baha'u'llah's all-embracing         are tainted by prejudice can fail to perdominion- can under no circumstances be             ceive . ...
> PART TWO
> 
> THE COMMEMORATION OF
> HISTORIC ANNIVERSARIES
> I
> THE CENTENARY OF THE
> TERMINATION OF BAHA'U'LLAH'S
> CONFINEMENT IN 'AKKA
> 1. THE SIGNIFICANCE OF BAHA'U'LLAH'S INCARCERATION IN 'AKKA
> Excerpts from God Passes By, by Shoghi Effendi
> 
> THE arrival of Baha' u'llah in 'A kka marks               had been actually prophesied 'through the
> the opening of the last phase of His forty-year           tongue of the Prophets two or three thousand
> long ministry, the final stage , and indeed the           years before. ' God, 'faithful to His promise,'
> climax, of the banishment in which the whole              had, 'to some of the Prophets' 'revealed and
> of that ministry was spent. A banishment that             given the good news that the "Lord of Hosts
> had, at first, brought Him to the immediate               should be manifested in the Holy Land."'
> vicinity of the strongholds of Shi' ah orthodoxy          Isaiah had, in this connection, announced in his
> and into contact with its outstanding expo-               Book: 'Get thee up into the high mountain, 0
> nents, and which, at a later period, had carried          Zion that bringest good tidings; lift up thy voice
> Him to the capital of the Ottoman empire, and             with strength, 0 Jerusalem, that bringest good
> led Him to address His epoch-making pro-                  tidings. Lift it up, be not afraid; say unto the
> nouncements to the Sultan, to his ministers and           cities of Judah: " Behold your God! Behold the
> to the ecclesiastical leaders of Sunnf Islam, had         Lord God will come with strong hand, and His
> now been instrumental in landing Him upon                 arm shall rule for Him."' David, in his Psalms,
> the shores of the Holy Land-the Land prom-                 had predicted: 'Lift up your heads, 0 ye gates;
> ised by God to Abraham, sanctified by the                 even lift them up, ye everlasting doors; and the
> Revelation of Moses, honored by the lives and             King of Glory shall come in. Who is this King of
> labors of the Hebrew patriarchs, judges, kings            Glory? The Lord of Hosts, He is the King of
> and prophets, revered as the cradie of Chris-             Glory.' 'Out of Zion, the perfection of beauty,
> tianity, and as the place where Zoroaster,                God hath shined. Our God shall come, and
> according to 'Abdu'l-Baha's testimony, had                shall not keep silence.' Amos had, likewise,
> 'held converse with some of the Prophets of               foretold His coming: 'The Lord will roar from
> Israel,' and associated by Islam with the Apos-           Zion , and utter His voice from Jerusalem; and
> tle's night-journey, through the seven heavens,           the habitations of the shepherds shall mourn,
> to the throne of the Almighty. Within the                 and the top of Carmel shall wither.'
> confines of this holy and enviable country, 'the             'Akka, itself, flanked by the 'glory of Lebanest of all the Prophets of God,' 'the Va le of           non,' and lying in full view of the 'sp lendor of
> God's unsearchable Decree, the snow-white                 Carmel,' at the foot of the hills which enclose
> Spot, the Land of unfading splendor' was the              the home of Jesus Christ Himself, had been
> Exile of Bag!!dad, of Constantinople and                  described by David as 'the Strong City,' desig-
> Adrianople condemned to spend no less than a              nated by Hosea as 'a door ofhope,' and alluded
> third of the allotted span of His life, and over          to by Ezekiel as 'the gate that looketh towards
> half of the total period of His Mission. 'It is           the East,' whereunto 'the glory of the God of
> difficult,' declares 'Abdu'l-Baha, 'to under-             Israel came from the way of the East,' His voice
> stand how Bahti'u'lltih could have been obliged           'like a noise of many waters.' To it the Arabian
> to leave Persia, and to pitch His tent in this Holy       Prophet had referred as 'a city in Syria to which
> Land, but for the persecution of His enemies,             God hath shown His special mercy,' situated
> His banishment and exile.'                                'betwixt two mountains ... in the middle of a
> Indeed such a consummation, He assures us,             meadow,' 'by the shore of the sea . .. suspended
> 52                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> beneath the Throne,' 'white, whose whiteness is       of water within its gates; was flea-infested,
> pleasing unto God.' 'Blessed the man,' He,            damp and honey-combed with gloomy, filthy
> moreover, as confirmed by Baha'u'llah, had            and tortuous lanes. 'According to what they
> declared, 'that hath visited 'Akkd, and blessed       say,' the Supreme Pen has recorded in the
> he that hath visited the visitor of 'Akkd.' Fur-      LawJ:i-i-Sultan, 'it is the most desolate of the
> thermore, 'He that raiseth therein the call to        cities of the world, the most unsightly of them in
> prayer, his voice will be lifted up unto Paradise.'   appearance, the most detestable in climate, and
> And again: 'The poor of 'Akkd are the kings of        the foulest in water. It is as though it were the
> Paradise and the princes thereof A month in           metropolis ofthe owl.' So putrid was its air that,
> 'Akkd is better than a thousand years else-           according to a proverb, a bird when flying over
> where.' Moreover, in a remarkable tradition,          it would drop dead.
> ... which is recognized as an authentic utter-            Explicit orders had been issued by the Sultan
> ance of MuJ:iammad, .. . this significant predic-     and his ministers to subject the exiles, who
> tion has been made: 'All of them (the compan-          were accused of having grievously erred and
> ions of the Qa'im) shall be slain except One          led others far astray, to the strictest
> Who shall reach the plain of 'Akkd, the               confinement. Hopes were confidently expres-
> Banquet-Hall of God.'                                 sed that the sentence of life-long imprisonment
> Baha'u'llah Himself, as attested by Nabfl in        pronounced against them would lead to their
> his narrative, had, as far back as the first years    eventual extermination. The farman of Sultan
> of His banishment to Adrianople, alluded to           'Abdu'l-' Aziz, dated the fifth of Rabf'u'ththat same city in His LawJ:i-i-SayyaJ:i, designat-    Thanf 1285 A.H. (July 26, 1868), not only
> ing it as the 'Vale of Nabfl,' the word Nabfl         condemned them to perpetual banishment, but
> being equal in numerical value to that of             stipulated their strict incarceration , and for-
> 'Akka. 'Upon Our arrival,' that Tablet had             bade them to associate either with each other
> predicted, 'We were welcomed with banners of          or with the local inhabitants. The text of the
> light, whereupon the Voice ofthe Spirit cried out     farman itself was read publicly, soon after the
> saying: "Soon will all that dwell on earth be         arrival of the exiles, in the principal mosque of
> enlisted under these banners."'                        the city as a warning to the population . .. .
> The banishment, lasting no less than                   Having, after a miserable voyage, disemtwenty-four years, to which two Oriental               barked at 'Akka, all the exiles, men, women
> despots had, in their implacable enmity and           and children, were, under the eyes of a curious
> short-sightedness, combined to condemn                and callous population that had assembled at
> Baha'u'llah, will go down in history as a period       the port to behold the 'God of the Persians,'
> which witnessed a miraculous and truly                conducted to the army barracks, where they
> revolutionizing change in the circumstances            were locked in, and sentinels detailed to guard
> attending the life and activities of the Exile         them. 'The first night,' Baha'u'llah testifies in
> Himself, will be chiefly remembered for the            the LawJ:i-i-Ra'is, 'all were deprived of either
> widespread recrudescence of persecution,              food or drink ... They even begged for water,
> intermittent but singularly cruel, throughout         and were refused.' So filthy and brackish was
> His native country and the simultaneous                the water in the pool of the courtyard that no
> increase in the number of His followers, and,          one could drink it. Three loaves of black and
> lastly, for an enormous extension in the range         salty bread were assigned to each, which they
> and volume of His writings ....                        were later permitted to exchange, when
> 'Akka, the ancient Ptolemais, the St. Jean          escorted by guards to the market, for two of
> d' Acre of the Crusaders, that had successfully        better quality . Subsequently they were allowed
> defied the siege of Napoleon, had sunk, under          a mere pittance as substitute for the allotted
> the Turks, to the level of a penal colony to           dole of bread. All fell sick, except two, shortly
> which murderers, highway robbers and politi-           after their arrival. Malaria, dysentery, comcal agitators were consigned from all parts            bined with the sultry heat, added to their misof the Turkish empire. It was girt about by a          eries. Three succumbed, among them two
> double system of ramparts; was inhabited by a         brothers, who died the same night, 'locked,' as
> people whom Baha'u'ullah stigmatized as 'the          testified by Baha'u'Uah, 'in each other's arms.'
> generation of vipers'; was devoid of any source        The carpet used by Him He gave to be sold in
> THE COMMEMORATION OF HISTORIC ANNIVERSARIES                                  53
> 
> Two views of'Akka, described by David as 'the Strong City,' designated by Hosea as 'a door of
> hope,' alluded co by Ezekiel as the place whereunto 'the glory of the God of Israel came from
> the way of the East,' and referred to by Muf:iammad as being 'by the shore of the sea ...
> suspended beneath the Throne,' 'whose whiteness is pleasing unto God.'
> 54                                     THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> order to provide for their winding-sheets and           Nor was this the full measure of the
> burial. The paltry sum obtained after it had         afflictions endured by the Prisoner of 'Akka
> been auctioned was delivered to the guards,          and His fellow-exiles. Four months after this
> who had refused to bury them without first           tragic event a mobilization of Turkish troops
> being paid the necessary expenses. Later, it         necessitated the removal of Baha'u'llah and all
> was learned that, unwashed and unshrouded,           who bore Him company from the barracks. He
> they had buried them, without coffins, in the        and His family were accordingly assigned the
> clothes they wore, though, as affirmed by            house of Malik, in the western quarter of the
> Baha'u'llah, they were given twice the amount        city, whence, after a brief stay of three months,
> required for their burial. 'None,' He Himself        they were moved by the authorities to the
> has written, 'knoweth what befell Us, except         house of Khavvam which faced it , and from
> God, the Almighty, the All-Knowing . .. From         which, after a few months, they were again
> the foundation of the world until the present day    obliged to take up new quarters in the house of
> a cruelty such as this hath neither been seen nor    Rabi'ih, being finally transferred, four months
> heard of' 'He hath, during the greater part of       later, to the house of 'Udf Khammar, which
> His life,' He, referring to Himself, has,            was so insufficient to their needs that in one of
> moreover, recorded, 'been sore-tried in the          its rooms no less than thirteen persons of both
> clutches of His enemies. His sufferings have         sexes had to accommodate themselves. Some
> now reached their culmination in this afflictive     of the companions had to take up their resi-
> Prison, into which His oppressors have so            dence in other houses, while the remainder
> unjustly thrown Him.'                                were consigned to a caravanserai named the
> The few pilgrims who, despite the ban that       Khiin-i-' Aviimfd .
> had been so rigidly imposed, managed to reach           Their strict confinement had hardly been
> the gates of the Prison-some of whom had             mitigated, and the guards who had kept watch
> journeyed the entire distance from Persi a on        over them been dismissed, when an internal
> foot-had to content themselves with a fleeting       crisis , which had been brewing in the midst of
> glimpse of the face of the Prisoner, as they         the community, was brought to a sudden and
> stood, beyond the second moat, facing the            catastrophic climax .... Though [Baha' u'lliih]
> window of His Prison. The very few who suc-          Himself had stringently forbidden His followceeded in penetrating into the city had, to their    ers . . . any retaliatory acts against their
> great distress, to retrace their steps without       tormentors . . . seven of the companions
> even beholding His countenance ....                  clandestinely sought out and slew three of
> To the galling weight of these tribulations      their persecutors ...
> was now added the bitter grief of a sudden              The consternation that seized an already
> tragedy-the premature loss of the noble, the         oppressed community was indescribable.
> pious Mirza Mihdf, the Purest Branch ,              Baha'u'llah's indignation knew no bounds.
> 'Abdu'l-Baha's twenty-two year old brother,          'Were We,' He thus voices His emotions, in a
> an amanuensis of Baha'u'llah and a companion         Tablet revealed shortly after this act had been
> of His exile from the days when, as a child, he      committed, 'to make mention of what befell Us,
> was brought from Tihriin to Ba_gbdad to join         the heavens would be rent asunder and the
> his Father after His return from Sulay-             mountains would crumble.' 'My captivity,' He
> maniyyih. He was pacing the roof of the bar-         wrote on another occasion, 'cannot harm Me.
> racks in the twilight, one evening, wrapped in        That which can harm Me is the conduct of those
> his customary devotions, when he fell through        who love Me, who claim to be related to Me, and
> the unguarded skylight onto a wooden crate,          yet perpetrate what causeth My heart and My
> standing on the floor beneath , which pierced        pen to groan.' And again: 'My captivity can
> his ribs, and caused, twenty-two hours later, his   bring on Me no shame. Nay, by My life, it
> death, on the 23rd of Rabf'u'l-Avval 1287            conferreth on Me glory. That which can make
> A.H. (June 23, 1870). His dying supplication         Me ashamed is the conduct of such of My folto a grieving Father was that his life might be     lowers as profess to love Me, yet in fact follow
> accepted as a ransom for those who were pre-        the Evil One.'
> vented from attaining the presence of their             He was dictating His Tablets to His
> Beloved . .. .                                       amanuensis when the governor, at the head of
> THE COMMEMORATION OF HISTORIC ANNIVERSARIES                                    55
> 
> Bahti'u'lltih's banishment to 'Akkti extended over a period of twenty-four years, from 31
> August 1868 to 29May1892. This view, looking north-west, shows the Most Great Prison on
> the right and the citadel on the left. Jn June 1877 Bahti'u'lltih took up residence in Mazra 'ih
> ending His confinement within the walls of the prison city.
> 
> his troops, with drawn swords, surrounded His       place?' When interrogated, He was asked to
> house . The entire populace, as well as the         state His name and that of the country from
> military authorities, were in a state of great      which He came. 'It is more manifest than the
> agitation. The shouts and clamor of the people       sun,' He answered. The same question was put
> could be heard on all sides. Baha'u'llah was         to Him again, to which He gave the following
> peremptorily summoned to the Governorate,           reply: '/deem it not proper to mention it. Refer
> interrogated, kept in custody the first night,      lo thefarmtin ofthe government which is in your
> with one of His sons, in a chamber in the           possession.' Once agai n they, with marked
> Khan-i-Shavirdf, transferred for the following      deference , reiterated their request, whereupon
> two nights to better quarters in that neighbor-     Baha'u'llah spoke with majesty and power
> hood , and allowed only after the lapse of          these words: 'My name is Bahti'u'lltih (Light of
> seventy hours to regain His home. ' Abdu'l-          God), and My country is Nur (Light). Be ye
> Baha was thrown into prison and chained             apprized of it.' Turning then, to the Mufti, He
> during the first night, after which He was          addressed him words of veiled rebuke, after
> permitted to join His Father. Twenty-five           which He spoke to the entire gathering, in such
> of the companions were cast into another            vehement and exalted language that none
> prison and shackled, all of whom, except those      made bold to answer Him. Having quoted
> responsible for that odious deed , whose            verses from the Suriy-i-Muluk, He , afterwards,
> imprisonment lasted several years, were, afte r     arose and left the gathering. The Governor,
> six days, moved to the Khan-i-Shavirdf,              soon after, sent word that He was at liberty to
> and there placed, for six months, under             return to His home , and apologized for what
> confinement.                                        had occurred.
> 'Is it proper,' the Commandant of the city,         A population, already ill-disposed towards
> turning to Baha'u'llah , after He had arrived at     the exiles, was, after such an incident, fired
> the Governorate, boldly inquired , ' that some       with uncontrollahle animosity for all those who
> of your followers should act in such a manner?'      bore the name of the Faith which those exiles
> 'If one ofyour soldiers,' was the swift rejoinder,   professed. The charges of impiety, atheism,
> 'were to commit a reprehensible act, would you       terrorism and heresy were openly and without
> be held responsible, and be punished in his          restraint flung into their faces. 'Abbud, who
> 56                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> A partial view of the sea wall and fortifications of'Akka.
> lived next door to Baha'u'llah, reinforced the      was now setting in, a reaction with which the
> partition that separated his house from the         period of Baha'u'llah's banishment to 'Akka
> dwelling of his now much-feared and suspected       will ever remain indissolubly associated.
> Neighbor. Even the children of the imprisoned          Such was the devotion gradually kindled in
> exiles, whenever they ventured to show them-        the heart of that governor, through his associaselves in the streets during those days, would      tion with 'Abdu'l-Baha, and later through his
> be pursued, vilified and pelted with stones.        perusal of the literature of the Faith, which
> The cup of Baha'u'llah's tribulations was        mischief-makers, in the hope of angering him,
> now filled to overflowing. A situation, greatly     had submitted for his consideration, that he
> humiliating, full of anxieties and even perilous,   invariably refused to enter His presence withcontinued to face the exiles, until the time, set   out first removing his shoes, as a token of his
> by an inscrutable Will, at which the tide of        respect for Him. It was even bruited about that
> misery and abasement began to ebb, signaliz-        his favoured counselors were those very exiles
> ing a transformation in the fortunes of the         who were the followers of the Prisoner in his
> Faith even more conspicuous than the                custody. His own son he was wont to send to
> revolutionary change effected during the latter     'Abdu'l-Baha for instruction and enlightenyears of Baha'u'llah's sojourn in Baghdad.          ment. It was on the occasion of a long-sought
> The gradual recognition by all elements of       audience with Baha'u'llah that, in response to a
> the population of Baha' u'llah 's complete inno-    request for permission to render Him some
> cence; the slow penetration of the true spirit of   service, the suggestion was made to him to
> His teachings through the hard crust of their       restore the aqueduct which for thirty years had
> indifference and bigotry; the substitution of       been allowed to fall into disuse-a suggestion
> the sagacious and humane governor, AJ:imad          which he immediately arose to carry out. To
> Big Tawfiq, for one whose mind had been             the inflow of pilgrims, ... he offered scarcely
> hopelessly poisoned against the Faith and its       any opposition, though the text of the imperial
> followers; the unremitting labors of 'Abdu'l-       farman forbade their admission into the city.
> Baha, now in the full flower of His manhood,        Mu~tafa .Qiya Pasha, who became governor a
> Who, through His contacts with the rank and         few years later, had even gone so far as to
> file of the population, was increasingly demon-     intimate that his Prisoner was free to pass
> strating His capacity to act as the shield of His   through its gates whenever He pleased, a sug-
> Father; the providential dismissal of the offi-     gestion which Baha'u'llah declined. Even the
> cials who had been instrumental in prolonging       Mufti of 'Akka, Shaykh MaJ:imud, a man
> the confinement of the innocent compan-             notorious for his bigotry, had been converted
> ions-all paved the way for the reaction that        to the Faith, and, fired by his newborn
> THE COMMEMORATION OF HISTORIC ANNIVERSARIES                                    57
> 
> Baha'u'llah's incarceration in the prison of'Akka, Nab{[ attests, extended from 31 August
> 1868to13 October 1870, a period oftwo years, two months and five days. After nine years He
> was permitted to move beyond the walls of the city. On the left, above, is seen the entrance to
> Baha'u' /!ah' s room in the prison; below is a view of its interior.
> 58                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> enthusiasm, made a compilation of the                mar, on the construction of which so much
> MuJ:iammadan traditions related to' Akka. Nor       wealth had been lavished , while Bahii'u'llah
> were the occasionally unsympathetic gover-          lay imprisoned in the barracks, and which its
> nors, despatched to that city, able, despite the    owner had precipitately abandoned with his
> arbitrary power they wielded, to check the          family owing to the outbreak of an epidemic
> forces which were carrying the Author of            disease , was rented and later purchased for
> the Faith towards His virtual emancipation          Him-a dwelling-place which He characterand the ultimate accomplishment of His pur-         ized as the 'lofty mansion,' the spot which 'God
> pose. Men of letters, and even ' ulamas residing    hath ordained as the most sublime vision of
> in Syria, were moved, as the years rolled by, to    mankind.' ...
> voice their recognition of Baha'u ' llah's rising      The drastic farman of Sultan 'Abdu' l-'Aziz,
> greatness and power. 'Aziz Pasha, who, in           though officially unrepealed, had by now
> Adrianople, had evinced a profound attach-          become a dead letter. Though Baha'u'llah was
> ment to 'Abdu'l-Baha, and had in the mean-          still nominally a prisoner, 'the doors of majesty
> time been promoted to the rank of Vali, twice       and true sovereignty were,' in the words of
> visited' Akka for the express purpose of paying     'Abdu'l-Baha' 'flung wide open.' 'The rulers of
> his respects to Baha'u'llah, and to renew his       Palestine,' He moreover has written, 'envied
> friendship with One Whom he had learned to          His influence and power. Governors and
> admire and revere.                                  muti~arrifs, generals and local officials, would
> Though Baha'u'llah Himself practically           humbly request the honor of attaining His presnever granted personal interviews, as He had        ence-a request to which He seldom acceded.'
> been used to do in Ba~dad , yet such was the           It was in that same mansion that the distininfluence He now wielded that the inhabitants       guished Orientalist, Prof. E . G. Browne of
> openly asserted that the noticeable improve-        Cambridge, was granted his four successive
> ment in the climate and water of their city was     interviews with Baha'u'llah, during the five
> directly attributable to His continued presence     days he was His guest at Bahji (April 15-20,
> in their midst. The very designations by which      1890), interviews immortalized by the Exile's
> they chose to refer to him, such as the 'august     historic declaration that 'these fruitless strifes,
> leader,' and 'his highness' bespoke the rever-      these ruinous wars shall pass away and the
> ence with which He inspired them. On one            "Most Great Peace" shall come.' ...
> occasion, a European general who, together             In that same year Baha'u'llah's tent, the
> with the governor, was granted an audience by       'Tabernacle of Glory,' was raised on Mt. Car-
> Him, was so impressed that he ' remained            mel, 'the Hill of God and His Vineyard,' the
> kneeling on the ground near the door.' Shaykh       home of Elijah, extolled by Isaiah as the
> 'Aliy-i-Miri, the Mufti of' Akka, had even, at      'mountain of the Lord,' to which 'all nations
> the suggestion of' Abdu'l-Baha, to plead insis-     shall flow.' Four times He visited Haifa, His
> tently that He might permit the termination of      last visit being no less than three months long .
> His nine-year confinement within the walls of       In the course of one of these visits, when His
> the prison-city, before He would consent to         tent was pitched in the vicinity of the Carmelite
> leave its gates. The garden ofNa'mayn, a small      Monastery, He, the 'Lord of the Vineyard,'
> island, situated in the middle of a river to the    revealed the Tablet of Carmel, remarkable for
> east of the city, honored with the appellation of   its allusions and prophecies. On another occa-
> Ric;lviin, and designated by Him the 'New           sion He pointed out Himself to 'Abdu'l-Baha,
> Jerusalem' and 'Our Verdant Isle,' had,             as He stood on the slopes of that mountain, the
> together with the residence of 'Abdu'llah           site which was to serve as the permanent
> Pasha,-rented and prepared for Him by               resting-place of the Bab, and on which a
> 'Abdu'l-Baha, and situated a few miles north        befitting mausoleum was later to be erected .
> of 'Akka- become by now the favorite                   ... 'Su/fan 'Abdu'l-'A z fz,' Baha'u'llah is
> retreats of One Who, for almost a decade, had       reported by one of His fellow-exiles to have
> not set foot beyond the city walls, and Whose       stated, 'banished Us to this country in the greatsole exercise had been to pace, in monotonous       est abasement, and since his object was to derepetition, the floor of His bed-chamber.           stroy Us and humble Us, whenever the means of
> Two years later the palace of '0di Kham-         glory and ease presented themselves, We did not
> THE COMMEMORATION OF HISTORIC ANNIVERSARIES                                         59
> 
> Many of Baha'u'llah's companions were, for a time, consigned to a caravansarai in 'Akka
> named the Khan-i- 'A vam(d (Inn of the Pillars), a structure built in 1785. The Baha'(s lived
> mostly in the western and southern wings on the top floor. One of the rooms was occupied by
> 'Abdu'l-Baha. The caravansarai became the first Bahri'( pilgrim house of the Holy Land.
> 
> reject them .' 'Now, praise be to God,' He,            embrace, seem to fall into three distinct
> moreover, as reported by Nabfl in his narra-           categories. The first comprises those writings
> tive, once remarked, 'it has reached the point         which constitute the sequel to the proclamawhen all the people of these regions are mani-         tion of His mission in Adrianople. The second
> festing their submissiveness unto Us.' ...             includes the laws and ordinances of His Dis-
> 'His enemies,' 'Abdu' l-Baha, referring to          pensation, which, for the most part, have been
> this same theme, has written, 'intended that His       recorded in the Kitab-i-Aqdas, His Most Holy
> imprisonment should completely destroy and             Book. To the third must be assigned those
> annihilate the blessed Cause, but this prison          Tablets which partly enunciate and partly
> was, in reality, of the greatest assistance, and       reaffirm the fundamental tenets and principles
> became the means of its development. ' '. .. This      underlying that Dispensation.
> illustrious Being,' He, moreover has affirmed,            The Proclamation of His Mission had been,
> 'uplifted His Cause in the Most Great Prison.          as already observed, directed particularly to
> From this Prison His light was shed abroad; His        the kings of the earth, who, by virtue of the
> fame conquered the world, and the proclama-            power and authority they wielded, were intion of His glory reached the East and the West.'      vested with a peculiar and inescapable respon-
> 'His light at first had been a star; now it became a   sibility for the destinies of their subjects. It was
> mighty sun. ' 'Until our time,' He, morever has        to these kings, as well as to the world's religious
> affirmed, 'no such thing has ever occurred.'           leaders, who exercised a no less pervasive
> Little wonder that, in view of so remarkable        influence on the mass of their followers, that
> a reversal in the circumstances attending the          the Prisoner of 'Akka directed His appeals,
> twenty-four years of His banishment to 'Akka,          warnings, and exhortations during the first
> Baha'u'llah Himself should have penned these           years of His incarceration in that city. ' Upon
> weighty words: 'The Almighty . .. hath trans-          Our arrival at this Prison, ' He Himself affirms,
> formed this Prison-House into the Most Exalted         'We purposed to transmit to the kings the mes-
> Paradise, the Heaven of Heavens.' ...                  sages of their Lord, the Mighty, the All-Praised.
> The writings of Baha'u'llah during this             Though We have transmitted to them, in several
> period, as we survey the vast field which they         Tablets, that which We were commanded, yet
> 60                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> We do it once again, as a token of God's grace.'   the prison-fortress of 'Akka. Kings and
> To the kings of the earth, both in the East      emperors, severally and collectively; the chief
> and in the West, both Christian and Muslim,        magistrates of the Republics of the American
> who had already been collectively admonished       continent; ministers and ambassadors; the
> and warned in the Suriy-i-Muluk revealed in        Sovereign Pontiff himself; the Vicar of the
> Adrianople, and had been so vehemently             Prophet of Islam; the royal Trustee of the
> summoned by the Bab, in the opening chapter        Kingdom of the Hidden Imam; the monarchs
> of the Qayyumu'l-Asma', on the very night of       of Christendom, its patriarchs, archbishops,
> the Declaration of His Mission, Baha' u'llah,      bishops, priests and monks; the recognized
> during the darkest days of His confinement in      leaders of both the Sunni and Shi' ah sacerdotal
> 'Akka, addressed some of the noblest passages      orders; the high priests of the Zoroastrian
> of His Most Holy Book . In these passages He       religion; the philosophers, the ecclesiastical
> called upon them to take fast hold of the' Most    leaders, the wise men and the inhabitants of
> Great Law'; proclaimed Himself to be 'the          Constantinople-that proud seat of both the
> King of Kings' and 'the Desire of all Nations';    Sultanate and the Caliphate; the entire comdeclared them to be His 'vassals' and 'emblems     pany of the professed adherents of the Zoroasof His sovereignty'; disclaimed any intention of   trian, the Jewish, the Christian and Muslim
> laying hands on their kingdoms; bade them          Faiths; the people of the Bayan; the wise men
> forsake their palaces, and hasten to gain admit-   of the world, its men of letters, its poets, its
> tance into His Kingdom; extolled the king who      mystics, its tradesmen, the elected representawould arise to aid His Cause as 'the very eye of   tives of its peoples; His own countrymen-all
> mankind'; and finally arraigned them for the       have , at one time or another, in books, Episthings which had befallen Him at their             tles, and Tablets, been brought directly within
> hands ....                                         the purview of the exhortations, the warnings,
> Such in sum are the salient features of the     the appeals, the declarations and the
> concluding utterances of that historic Procla-     prophecies which constitute the theme of His
> mation, the opening notes of which were            momentous summons to the leaders of mansounded during the latter part of Baha' u'llah's   kind-a summons which stands unparalleled in
> banishment to Adrianople, and which closed         the annals of any previous religion, and to
> during the early years of His incarceration in     which the messages directed by the Prophet of
> 
> The Mansion of Bahj(, construcred by 'Ud( Khammar circa 1870, was characterized by
> Bah<i'u'//lih as the 'lofty mansion,' the spot which 'God hath ordained as the most sublime
> vision of mankind.' Bahj( literally means 'Delight.'
> THE COMMEMORATION OF HISTORIC ANNIVERSARIES                                     61
> 
> The Shrine of the Bab on Mount Carmel, the site of which Bahti'u'lltih pointed out to
> 'Abdu'l-Bahti during the course of one of His visits to Haifa.
> 
> Islam to some of the rulers among His contem-      will embrace the entire planet, may well be
> poraries alone offer a faint resemblance.          regarded as the brightest emanation of the
> 'Never since the beginning of the world,'       mind of Baha ' u'llah, as the Mother Book of
> Baha'u'llah Himself affirms, 'hath the Message     His Dispensation, and the Charter of His New
> been so openly proclaimed.' ...                    World Order.
> Unique and stupendous as was this Procla-          Revealed soon after Baha'u'llah had been
> mation, it proved to be but a prelude to a still   transferred to the house of 'Udf Khammar
> mightier revelation of the creative power of its   (circa 1873) , at a time when He was still
> Author, and to what may well rank as the most      encompassed by the tribulations that had
> signal act of His ministry-the promulgation of     afflicted Him, through the acts committed by
> the Kitab-i-Aqdas. Alluded to in the Kitab-i-      His enemies and the professed adherents of
> iqan; the principal repository of that Law         His Faith, this Book, this treasury enshrining
> which the Prophet Isaiah had anticipated, and      the priceless gems of His Revelation, stands
> which the writer of the Apocalypse had             out, by virtue of the principles it inculcates, the
> described as the 'new heaven' and the 'new         administrative institutions it ordains and the
> earth,' as 'the Tabernacle of Cod,' as the 'Holy   function with which it invests the appointed
> City,' as the 'Bride,' the ' New Jerusalem com-    Successor of its Author, unique and incompaing down from Cod,' this 'Most Holy Book,'         rable among the world's sacred Scriptures ....
> whose provisions must remain inviolate for no         In this Charter of the future world civilizaless than a thousand years, and whose system       tion its Author-at once the Judge, the Law-
> 62                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> giver, the Unifier and Redeemer of man-              ishment of subsidiary ordinances designed to
> kind-announces to the kings of the earth the         supplement the provisions of His Most Holy
> promulgation of the 'Most Great Law'; pro-           Book. These were recorded in unnumbered
> nounces them to be His vassals; proclaims            Tablets, which He continued to reveal until the
> Himself the ' King of Kings'; disclaims any          last days of His earthly life, among which the
> intention of laying hands on their kingdoms ;        'Ishraqat' (Splendors), the 'Bisharat' (Glad
> reserves for Himself the right to 'seize and pos-    Tidings), the 'Tarazat' (Ornaments), the
> sess the hearts of men'; warns the world's           'Tajalliyat' (Effulgences) , the 'Kalimat-iecclesiastical leaders not to weigh the 'Book of     Firdawsfyyih' (Words of Paradise) , the
> God' with such standards as are current              'Law!)-i-Aqdas' (Most Holy Tablet), the
> a mongst them; and affirms that the Book itself      'Law!)-i-Dunya' (Tablet of the World), the
> is the 'Unerring Balance' established amongst        ' Law!)-i-Maqsud' (Tablet of Maqsud), are the
> men . In it He formally ordains the institution of   most noteworthy. These Tablets-mighty and
> the 'House of Justice, ' defines its functions,      final effusions of His indefatigable pen-must
> fixes its revenues, and designates its members       rank among the choicest fruits which His mind
> as the 'Men of Justice,' the 'Deputies of God,'      has yielded, and mark the consummation of
> the 'Trustees of the All-Merciful,' alludes to the   His forty -year-long ministry . ..
> future Center of His Covenant, and invests              Nor should a review of the outstanding fea -
> Him with the right of interpreti ng His holy         tures of Baha' u'llah 's writings during the latter
> Writ; anticipates by implication the institution     part of His banishment to ' Akka fail to include
> of Guardianship; bears witness to the                a reference to the Law!)-i-J:Iikmat (Tablet of
> revolutionizing effect of His World Order;           Wisdom), in which He sets forth the fundaenunci ates the doctrine of the 'Most Great          mentals of true philosophy, or to the Tablet of
> infallibility' of the Manifestation of God;          Visitation revealed in honor of the Imam
> asserts th is infallibility to be the inherent and   J:Iusayn, whose praises He celebrates in glowexclusive right of the Prophet; and rules out the    ing language; or to the 'Questions and Anpossibi lity of the appearance of another Man-       swers' which elucidates the laws and ordiifes tation ere the lapse of at least one thousand   nances of the Kitab-i-Aqdas; or to the 'Law!)-
> years . ...                                          i-Burhan' (Tablet of the Proof) in which the
> The laws and ordinances that constitute the      acts perpetrated by Shaykh Mu!)ammadmajor theme of this Book, Baha'u'llah,              Baqir, surnamed 'Dhi'b' (Wolf), and Mfr
> moreover , has specifically characterized as 'the   Mu!)ammad-l;lusayn, the Imam-Jum' ih of
> breath of life unto all created things,' as 'the     I~fahan, surnamed' Raqsha' (She-Serpent) , are
> mightiest stronghold,' as the 'fruits' of H is       severely condemned; or to the Law!)-i-Karmil
> ' Tree,' as 'the highest means for the main-         (Tablet of Carmel) in which the Author
> tenance of order in the world and the security of    significantly makes mention of 'the City of God
> its peoples,' as 'the lamps of His wisdom and        that hath descended from heaven,' and
> loving-providence,' as 'the sweet smelling savor     prophesies that 'erelong will God sail His Ark'
> of His garment,' as the 'keys' of His 'm ercy' to    upon that mountain , and 'will manifest the peo-
> His creatures. 'This Book,' He Himself              ple of Ba ha.' Finally, mention must be made of
> testifies, 'is a heaven which We have adorned       His Epistle to Shaykh Mu!)ammad-Taqf, surwith the stars of Our commandments and pro-          named 'Ibn-i-Dhi' b' (Son of the Wolf) , the last
> hibitions.' . ..                                     outstanding Tablet revealed by the pen of
> The formulation by Baha'u ' llah , in His        Baha'u'llah, in which He calls upon that
> Kitab- i- Aqdas, of the fundam ental laws of His    rapacious priest to repent of his acts, quotes
> Dispensation was fo llowed, as His Mission          some of the most characteristic and celebrated
> drew to a close, by the enunciation of certain      passages of His own writings, and adduces
> precepts and principles which lie at the very       proofs establishing the validity of His Cause .
> core of His Faith, by the reaffirmation of truths      With this book , revealed about one year
> He had previously procl aimed, by the elabora-       prior to His ascension, the prodigious
> tion and elucid ation of some of the laws He had    achievement as author of a hundred volumes,
> a lready laid dow n, by the revelation of further    repositories of the priceless pearls of His Reveprophecies and warni ngs, and by the establ-        lation, may be said to have practically termi-
> THE COMMEMORATION OF HISTORIC ANNIVERSARIES                                      63
> nated- volumes replete with unnumbered              and humanitarian spheres of human activity.
> exhortations,      revolutionizing    principles,      ' We, verily,' wrote Baha'u'llah, surveying, in
> world-shaping laws and ordinances, dire warn-       the evening of His life, from His Most Great
> ings and portentous prophecies, with soul-          Prison, the entire range of this vast and weighty
> uplifting prayers and meditations, illuminating     Revelation , 'have not fallen short of Our duty to
> commentaries and interpretations, impas-            exhort men, and to deliver that whereunto I was
> sioned discourses and homilies, all inter-          bidden by God, the Almighty, the All-Praised.'
> spersed with either addresses or references to      'Is there any excuse,' He further has stated, 'left
> kings, to emperors and to ministers, of both the    for any one in this Revelation? No, by God, the
> East and the West, to ecclesiastics of divers       Lord of th e Mighty Throne! My signs have
> denominations, and to leaders in the intellec-      encompassed the earth, and my power
> tual, political, literary, mystical, commercial     enveloped all mankind.'
> 
> 2. EXCERPT FROM THE MESSAGE OF THE UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE TO THE
> ANNUAL CONVENTIONS OF ALL NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLIES
> 
> IN EARLY DAYS OF JUNE 1877 BAHA'U 'LLAH LEFT CITY ' AKKA AND TOOK UP RESIDENCE IN
> MAZRA'IH. TO MARK CENTENARY THIS TERMINATION CONFINEMENT ANCIENT BEAUTY
> WITHIN WALLS PRISON CITY WE CALL UPON HIS FOLLOWERS ALL LANDS DEVOTE NINE-
> TEEN DAY FEAST OF NOR COMMEMORATION HISTORIC EVENT, REDEDICATING THEM-
> SELVES URGENT TASKS BEFORE THEM, SO THAT PENT-UP ENERGIES HIS PRECIOUS FAITH
> MAY BE RELEASED TO REACH EVER GREATER NUMBER SEEKING SOULS IN EVER WIDER
> CIRCLE THEIR FELLOW MEN.
> 
> (24 March 1977)
> 
> Aerial view of Mazra 'ih where Bahd'u'llah lived for two years, from June 1877 to September
> 1879. In the foreground may be seen recently developed gardens and plantings of citrus and
> ornamental trees; April 1979.
> 64                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 3. THE COMMEMORATION AT THE WORLD CENTRE OF THE CENTENARY OF THE
> TERMINATION OF BAHA'U'LLAH'S CONFINEMENT IN 'AKKA
> 
> 'The remembrance of God and His praise, and the glory of God and His splendour, rest
> upon Thee, 0 Thou who art His Beauty! I bear witness that the eye of creation hath never
> gazed upon one wronged like Thee. Thou wast immersed all the days of Thy life beneath
> an ocean oftribulations. At one time Thou wast in chains and fetters; at another Thou wast
> threatened by the sword of Thine enemies. Yet, despite all this, Thou didst enjoin upon all
> men to observe what had been prescribed unto Thee by Him Who is the All-Knowing, the
> All-Wise.'                                                                  BAHA'u'LLAH
> 
> In the early afternoon of Saturday, 11 June 1977 the pilgrims and the friends serving at the
> World Centre made their way to Mazra'ih to visit the Mansion which' Abdu'l-Baha had rented a
> century ago for the use of Baha'u'llah, His first residence after leaving the prison-city of' Akka.
> While there, each was privileged to visit and offer prayers in the very room occupied by the
> Blessed Beauty; later they repaired to the gardens at Bahjf.
> Meanwhile the Hands of the Cause present in the Holy Land, the members of the Universal
> House of Justice and the Counsellor members of the International Teaching Centre were paying
> their respects to the memory of Baha'u'llah at the House of' Ab bud in' Akka and at the Garden of
> Ric;lvan. The rooms Baha'u'llah had occupied were visited and prayers of thanksgiving for His
> release from confinement were offered in these Holy Places. They then journeyed north to
> Mazra'ih for prayers at that Holy Spot, and afterwards joined the other friends in the J:Iaram-i-
> Aqdas at Bahjf for the formal programme of the commemoration of this great event in the history
> of the Heroic Age of the Cause.
> Prayers were recited; 'Abdu'l-Baha's account of the end of Baha'u'llah's confinement and
> Shoghi Effendi's narrative from God Passes By were read; and finally, just as the sun was casting
> its last light over the Mediterranean, the friends made their way in the utmost reverence to the
> Most Holy Shrine for the chanting of the Tablet of Visitation.
> 
> Hands of the Cause, the members of the Universal House ofJustice and Counsellor members
> of the International Teaching Centre, photographed at the House of'Abbud in 'Akka where
> they gathered on 1 I June 1977 to commemorate the centenary of the termination of
> Baha'u' llah' s confinement in the prison city. Amatu' I-Bahri Rul]fyyih Khdnum is seen seated
> in the centre of the first row.
> THE COMMEMORATION OF HISTORIC ANNIVERSARIES   65
> 66   THE BAHA, ' i WORLD
> PART THREE
> 
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF
> CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES
> 1976-1979
> I
> THE FIRST VISIT BY A BAHA'I
> REIGNING MONARCH TO THE RESTING
> PLACE OF SHOGHI EFFENDI
> 
> Cablegram of the Universal House of Justice to all National Spiritual Assemblies,
> dated 10 October 1976
> 
> WITH FEELINGS IMMENSE ELATION ANNOUNCE BAHAI COMMUNITIES ALL CONTINENTS
> JOYFUL NEWS FIRST VISIT BY BAHAI REIGNING MONARCH TO RESTING PLACE BELOVED
> SHOGHI EFFENDI WELL NIGH NINETEEN YEARS FOLLOWING HIS PASSING STOP HIS
> HIGHNESS MALIETOA TANUMAFILI II OF WESTERN SAMOA COURSE HIS RECENT VISIT
> LONDON ATTAINED THIS INESTIMABLE BOUNTY STOP HIS HIGHNESS ACCOMPANIED BY
> SMALL DELEGATION FRIENDS HEADED BY HANDCAUSE GIACHERY INCLUDING HANDS
> CAUSE KHADEM VARQA AND FIVE' MEMBERS NATIONAL ASSEMBLY UNITED KINGDOM
> PROCEEDED CEMETERY PARTICIPATED DEEPLY MOVING HIGHLY DIGNIFIED VISITA-
> TION RESTING PLACE SIGN GOD ON EARTH WHOSE LIFELONG HEROIC LABOURS
> ACHIEVED WORLDWIDE SPREAD GLORIOUS CAUSE BAHAULLAH STOP FOLLOWING
> PRAYERS DEVOTIONS AND EXPRESSIONS APPRECIATION GRATITUDE BY HIS HIGHNESS
> HE MET WITH RADIANT SPIRIT LARGE GATHERING BELIEVERS ASSEMBLED PRECINCTS
> GRAVE TO WELCOME HIM AND TO WHOM HE CONVEYED GREETINGS HIS FELLOW
> SAMOAN BAHAIS AND HIS HOPE GROWTH FAITH FROM STRENGTH TO STRENGTH ALL
> OVER WORLD STOP IN HOLY LAND SYNCHRONIZING WITH THESE EVENTS HANDS CAUSE
> OTHER MEMBERS INTERN A TJONAL TEACHING CENTRE JOINED MEMBERS HOUSE JUS-
> TICE SPECIAL VISIT BAHJI WHERE FERVENT PRAYERS WERE OFFERED SACRED
> THRESHOLD MOST HOLY SHRINE JN THANKSGIVING HIGHLY SIGNIFICANT DEVELOP-
> MENT WHICH REPRESENTS PRELUDE TO FULFILMENT LONG CHERISHED DESIRE ABDUL-
> BAHA AND SHOGHI EFFENDI WITNESS PILGRIM KINGS PAY THEIR HUMBLE TRIBUTE AT
> HOLY SHRINES FOUNDERS OUR FAITH IN SPIRITUAL HEART PLANET STOP FERVENTLY
> PRAYING THIS JOYOUS NEWS WILL STRENGTHEN RESOLVE SUPPORTERS MOST GREAT
> NAME EVERY LAND REDOUBLE THEIR EFFORTS TO FORGE AHEAD HOWEVER ARDUOUS
> THE TASKS HOWEVER SEEMINGLY INSURMOUNTABLE THE OBSTACLES UNTIL EVERY
> GOAL WORLDWIDE PLAN IS SPEEDILY AND FULLY CONSUMMATED.
> 
> UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE
> 
> His Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II of Western Samoa; the Hands of the Cause Ugo
> Giachery, Dhikrul!ah Khadem and 'Alf Muf:tammad Varqa; representatives of the National
> Sp iritual Assembly of the United Kingdom and others of the delegation who visited the resting
> place of Shoghi Effendi on 12 September 1976.
> Later information confirms that there were six. The visit took place on 12 September 1976.
> 70                                                  THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> THE GROWTH OF THE BAHA'i FAITH
> 1953-1979
> 
> 11 0.000~----------------------~-----------------
> 
> 103,323
> 100.0001----------------+-+-------+--------+---ll--------·
> 
> 80,000         NATION AL SPIRITU AL
> ASSEMBLIES
> 
> 1953 . .............. ... ..     12
> 1963.                            56
> 1973 ..                         113
> 70,000
> 1979                       .. . 130
> 
> 60,0001-----------------+-+--------------<--+---I----------<
> 
> so . 0001----------------+-+------+---~J----+----i----------j
> 
> A0,0001-----------------+--+------+-~L_-----+---+-------~
> 
> 30,00 0 1 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - + - - + - - - --             -   -i-- - - - - - - + - - - + - - - - - - - - - j
> 
> 25,5 11
> 
> '63   ' 64              ' 68                '73   '74                   '79
> TEN-Y EA R CR USADE                                     NI N E-YEAR PLAN                  FIVE-YEAR PLA N
> 1 953- 1 963                                             1964-1973                       19 74- 197 9
> II
> THE FIVE YEAR INTERNATIONAL
> TEACHING PLAN 1974-1979
> 
> 1. THE COMPLETION OF THE FIVE YEAR
> INTERNATIONAL TEACHING PLAN
> 
> IN    its Naw-Ruz message to the Baha'fs of the world the Universal Ho use of Justice
> stated: 'The teaching victories in that Plan have been truly prodigious; the points of
> li ght, those localities where the Promised One is recognized, have increased from
> sixty-nine thousand five hundred to over ninety-six thousand; 1 the number of Local
> Spiritual Assemb lies has grown from seventee n thousand to over twenty-five thousand; 1
> e ighteen new National Spiritua l Assemblies have been formed.
> 'Beyond the expansion of the community, vi tal as it is, the Five Year Plan wit nessed
> great progress in the spiritual development of the friends, the growing maturity and
> wisdom of Local and National Asse mblies, and in the degree to which Baha'i communities e mbody the distinguishing characteristics of Baha'i life and att ract, by their
> unity , their steadfast ness, their radiance and good reputation, the interest and eventual
> wholehearted support of their fe llow citizens. This is the magnet which will attract the
> masses to the Cause of God, and the leaven that will transform human society.'
> In that sa me message the House of Justice pointed out that during the first two yea rs
> of the newly-launched Seven Year Plan efforts should be exerted by Natio nal Spiritual
> Asse mblies ' to attai n, where circumstances permit, any goals that may have had to
> remain un accomplished at the e nd of the Five Year Plan.'
> This rep ort of the achieveme nts of the Five Year Plan, both at the World Ce ntre and
> throughout the Baha'i world , has been compiled by the Department of Statistics at the
> World Centre.
> 
> 2. THE WORLD CENTRE
> 
> I. Continued Collation and Classification of the Sacred Texts
> 
> The original Tablets of Baha' u' ll ah a nd                     of ' Abd u'l-B aha, and 12,076 letters of Shoghi
> 'Abdu'l-B a ha, to gethe r with the o ri gin al let-               Effendi, to talling some 48 ,727 documents.
> ters of Shoghi Effe ndi, now at the World                            These documents ha ve bee n studied and
> Centre number so me 13 ,629 , of which nearly                      important passages from them have been
> 3,335 are Tablets of Baha'u 'llah, 7,198 Tablets                   extracted and classified .
> of 'Abd u'l-B aha , and 3,096 lette rs of Shoghi                     During the period under review, nine major
> Effendi. Moreover, authenticated copies                            compilations from the Writings of th e Faith
> availab le at the World Ce ntre, for which no                      have been prepared an d circulated to Nation al
> o riginals have yet been received, numbe r                         Sp iritua l Asse mblies .
> 6,390 Tablets of Baha' u' ll ah, 16,632 Ta blets
> At 20 April 1979, the total number of localities is 103,323 and the number of Loca l Spiritual Assembl ies is 25,5 11.
> 72                                     THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> 2. The Preparation and Publication of Author-        passages translated by Shoghi Effendi and
> ized Translations of Three Compilations of        quoted in his various works a re included in the
> Scripture:                                        compilation which was published in December
> 1976.
> (a) Tablets of B a ha' u' llah revealed after
> Selections from the Writings of 'A bdu'lthe Kitab-i-Aqdas
> Baha, published in D ece mber 1978 in both
> (b) Prayers and extracts fr o m the Writings
> cased a nd paper editions, contains passages
> of the Bab
> translated by the G uardian and translations or
> ( c) Selections from the works of
> retranslations made by Marzieh Gail or a
> 'Abd u' l-Ba ha
> committee at the World Centre appointed by
> Tab lets of Baha'u'llcih revealed after the       the House of Justice.
> Kitcib-i-Aqdas was publi shed in June 1978.             In 1977 the Universal House of Justice felt
> The Universa l House of Justice appo inted its       moved to call for the production of a compila-
> Research Department to prepare the compila-          tion of the writings of Shoghi Effendi. Pubtio n, and Mr. Habib Taherzadeh , with the           lished under the title Ca ll to the Nations, the
> assistance of a committee at the World Centre ,      compilat ion was avai lab le for distribution in
> was res ponsible for the translation of those        August of th at yea r, in cased and paper ed i-
> Tablets and passages from Tablets not trans-         tions.
> lated by Shoghi Effendi.                                Three volumes of the international record,
> Selections from the Writings of the Bab, the      The Baha'i World, published under the supermost comprehensive selection of His Writings         vision of the Universal House of Justice , were
> yet produced in English, was also compiled by        produced in the period under review, vol. XIV
> th e R esearch Department and translated by          (1963-1968) in February 1975 , vol. XV
> Mr. Habib Taherzadeh with the ass istance of a       (1968-1973) in August 1976 and vol. XVI
> co mmittee at th e World Centre . A number of        (1973-1976) in February 1979.
> 
> Three volumes of Sacred Text produced                Three volumes of The Baha'i World (XIV,
> under the supervision of the Universal               XV and XVI) produced under the supervi-
> House of Justice during the Five Year Plan.          sion ofthe Universal House ofJustice during
> A selection of the writings of Shoghi Effendi                    the Five Year Plan.
> was also published under the title Call to the
> Nations.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                                73
> 
> Arrival offirst shipment of marble at the site of the Permanent Seat of the Universal House of
> Justice; 28 December 1976. Commencement of the excavation was announced on 17 June
> 1975.
> 
> 3. Initiation of the Construction of the Building   January 1977, and he entered into a contract to
> on Mount Carmel to Serve as the Seat of the      be responsible for the reinforced concrete con-
> Universal House of Justice                       struction as well as to do the general supervision and coordination of the sub-contractors
> T his project, which ranks as the greatest       for the mechanical, e lectrica l and finishing
> single undertaking of the Five Year Plan , was      works. Excavations for the foundations cominitiated in February 197 4 with the acceptance     menced immediately thereafter.
> of the design conceived by I:Iusayn Amfoat,             At March 1978 construction had reached
> who was named as architect for the building. A      the level of the floor immediately above the
> site office was established in the old Archives     council chamber, with related mechanical,
> Building, and a Baha'i resident engineer was        e lectrical and finishing work well under way.
> chosen by the architect to supervise on his         Over 2,200 tons of fin ished carved marble had
> behalf the construction of the building. Exca-      already been delivered to the site. A contract
> vation of earth and stone amounting to over         had been signed with a French firm to install
> 65,000 cubic metres began in June 1975. In          the marble on the building after the completion
> April 1976 a contract was signed with a firm in     of the concrete shell.
> Italy, for the supply of over 3.000 tons of Pen-        Participants in the International Convention
> telicon marble from Greece, to be carved and        at Ric;lvan 1978 assembled at the construction
> dressed in Italy at a cost of approximately six     site for a ceremony in which a casket containmillion dollars. This includes fac ing materia l    ing Dust from the Shrines of the Bab and Baha'-
> for the exterior of the building and fifty-eight    u'llah was placed by Amatu'l-Baha Rul:if yyi h
> flut ed columns with Corinthian capitals.           Khanum in a small niche which had been pre-
> In December 1976 the first shipment of           pared in the building, high above the main
> finished marble was delivered to the building       entrance.
> site. The major plans of the building were sup-         At April 1979 exterior concrete construcplied by the architect in October 1976, and         tion had been completed except for the enwere submitted with specifications to a number      tablature, main staircase, and the annex to the
> of local contractin g firms for bids. A general     lower basement. The placing of all marble
> contractor residing in Haifa was chosen in          cladding on the main structure and erection of
> 74                                    THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> all columns and capitals has been completed         4. Further Extension and Beautification of the
> and the placing of the entablature marble has          Gardens and Lands Surrounding the Holy
> commenced. Interior finishing work has begun           Places
> and fabrication of doors and windows in Italian
> walnut as well as the plaster elements for cor-        The extension and beautification of the garnices, mouldings and domed ceilings is pro-         dens surrounding the Holy Places has been one
> ceeding at suppliers' factories in Italy.           of the World Centre goals in both the Nine and
> Retaining walls for the terraces behind the      Five Year Plans, and it has been constantly
> main building have been designed and drilling       pursued.
> for , and placing, rock anchors to retain the          Two new gardens outside the J:laram-iupper terraces has begun. It is foreseen that       Aqdas and north of the Collins gate are in the
> these terraces will be landscaped as a fitting      initial stages of development: one immediately
> background for the Seat of the Universal            adjacent to the little house of the beloved
> House of Justice. Plans for a separate building     Guardian which he used when planning and
> which will house the air-conditioning and heat-     creating the gardens of the J:Iaram-i-Aqdas,
> ing equipment, the electrical transformers and      and the other on the opposite side of the path
> main control panels, as well as a parking garage    leading to the northern gate of the property.
> for 44 cars, both to be built into the slope of        In Haifa, the informal gardens on the upper
> Mount Carmel, earth-covered and landscaped,         slopes of the mountain facing the Shrine of the
> have now been finalized and work on these           Bab have been further extended and
> auxiliary buildings should commence shortly.        beautified.
> It is intended that the utilities building men-        The pastoral setting of Mazra'ih has been
> tioned above will also service the other build-     beautified through the planting of a flower garings to be built on the Arc.                        den on the eastern side of the Mansion and the
> It is hoped that the interior finishing of the   creation of an extensive orchard of various
> Seat, the terrace walls and the auxiliary build-    kinds of citrus trees, an avocado grove and
> ings will all be completed by Ric;lvan 1980.        other decorative fruit trees. A pathway divid-
> 
> 'I•    I     1
> , '
> ' ,'
> 
> :.
> 
> Aerial view of the Shrine of Bahti'u'llah at Bahji illustrating the development of the gardens
> surrounding it. In the foreground may be seen the new plantings in the areas on either side of
> the long drive from the northern entrance to the Collins gate; April 1979.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES   75
> 76                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> ing the orchard has been bordered with              ticipated in thirty-four United Nations conferaraucaria trees, and the fences defining the        ences, congresses, and seminars, in seventyland blaze with plantings of colourful bougain-     two regular sessions of the Economic and
> villaea.                                            Social Council or its commissions , committees
> and other associated or related bodies, and in
> the special session of the United Nations Gen-
> 5. Continued Strengthening of the Relationship
> eral Assembly devoted to disarmament. About
> between the Baha'i International Communfifty statements, pamphlets, or reports were
> ity and the United Nations
> prepared and presented to the United Nations
> The Baha'i International Community has           between 197 4 and 1979. The following are
> continued to furnish pertinent information on       some of the conferences and other meetings
> the Baha'i Faith to various permanent delega-       sponsored by the United Nations in which the
> tions to the United Nations, particularly to        Baha'i International Community participated:
> those of countries in which official recognition
> of the Faith was being sought, and found many          -Regional Consultation for Asia and the
> opportunities to explain to the delegates, as       Far East on the Integration of Women in
> well as to members of the United Nations Sec-       Development with Special Reference to Popuretariat, how its interest in the goals of the      lation Factors; Bangkok, Thailand; 13-17
> United Nations Charter was rooted in the            May 1974.
> Baha'i teachings, principles and laws , and how        - Regional Seminar for Africa on the Intethese present a lasting solution of the world's     gration of Women in Development with Speproblems. In fact, through a series of public       cial Reference to Population Factors; Addis
> meetings and mailings of key statements, in         Ababa, Ethiopia; 3-7 June 1974.
> addition to a widely circulated article on the         -Seminar on the Promotion and Protection
> Baha'i Faith and its activities at the United       of the Human Rights of National, Ethnic and
> Nations appearing in the United Nations Sec-        Other Minorities; Ohrid, Yugoslavia; 25
> retariat News, some 10,000 members of the           June-8 July 1974.
> United Nations Secretariat, the United                 - World Population Conference; Buchar-
> Nations Missions, and non-governmental              est, Rumania; 19-30 August 1974.
> organizations associated with the United               -Interregional Seminar on National
> Nations heard directly about the Faith.             Machinery to Accelerate the Integration of
> Increasingly the Baha'i International Com-          Women in Development and to Eliminate Dismunity was able to point to the way of life         crimination on Grounds of Sex; Ottawa,
> evolving in Baha'i communities aro und the          Canada; 4-17 September 1974.
> world as an embodiment of the Baha'i teach-            - World Food Conference; Rome, Italy;
> ings .                                              6-16 November 1974.
> Since 1974 the Baha'i International Com-           -Regional Seminar for Latin America on
> munity added to its existing consultative status   the Integration of Women in Development
> with the United Nations Economic and Social        with Special Reference to Population Factors;
> Council (ECOSOC), and its association with         Caracas, Venezuela; 28 April-2 May 1975.
> the United Nations Department of Public               -Regional Conference of Non-Govern-
> Information , two new relationships-an             mental Organizations organized by the Office
> association with the United Nations Environ-       of Public Information of the United Nations in
> ment Programme (UNEP) , with headquarters          Cooperation with the Economic and Social
> in Nairobi, begun in 1974 which resulted in the    Commission for Asia and the Pacific; Bangappointment of al'! accredited representative in   kok, Thailand; 27-29 May 1975.
> Nairobi to serve as liaison with UNEP; and, on        -Regional Preparatory Conference on
> 8 March 1976, consultative status with the         Human Settlements for Asia, the Pacific, and
> United Nations Children's Fund (UNICEF),            Western Asia; Tihran, fran; 14-19 June 1975.
> an affiliation which promises to offer many           - World Conference of the International
> opportunities for closer ties between the Baha'i    Women's Year; Mexico City, Mexico; 19
> world community and the United Nations.            June-2 July 1975 .
> The Baha'i International Community par-            - Regional Preparatory Conference on
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                              77
> 
> United Nations Seminar on Participation of Women in Development, Kathmandu, Nepal;
> 15-22 February 1977. Counsellor Zena Sorabjee (centre), and Dr. Penelope Walker (right),
> represented the Bah{/{ International Community.
> 
> Human Settlements for Africa; Cairo , Egypt;      - United      Nations     Conference    on
> 21-26 June 1975.                               Desertification; Nairobi , Kenya; 29 August-9
> -Latin American Regional Preparatory         September 1977.
> Conference for Habitat: the United Nations        -Regional Conference on the Implementa-
> Conference on Human Settlements; Caracas,      tion of National, Regional, and World Plans of
> Venezuela; 30 June-4 July 1975.                Action for the Integration of Women in
> -Fifth United Nations Congress on the        Development; Nouakchott, Mauritania; 27
> Prevention of Crime and Treatment of           September- 2 October 1977.
> Offenders; Geneva, Switzerland; 1-15 Sep-         - World Conference to Combat Racism and
> tember 1975 .                                  Racial Discrimination; Geneva, Switzerland;
> -Seminar on the Participation of Women in    14-25 August 1978.
> Econom ic, Social and Political Development:      - United Nations Conference on Technical
> Obstacles that Hinder their Integration;       Cooperation among Developing Countries;
> Buenos Aires, Argentina; 22-30 March 1976.     Buenos Aires, Argentina; 30 August-1 2 Sep-
> - Th ird Conference of the Econom ic Com-    tember 1978.
> mission for Europe on Urban and Regional          -International Conference on Primary
> Research; Warsaw , Poland; 5-13 May 1976.      Health Care; Alma Ata, U.S.S.R.; 6-1 2 Sep-
> -Habitat: United Nations Conference on       tember 1978.
> Human Settlements; Vancouver, Canada; 31          -Seminar on National and Local Institu-
> May-11June1976.                                tions for the Promotion and Protection of
> -Regional Seminar on Participation of        Human Rights; Geneva, Switzerland; 18-29
> Women in Political, Economic, and Socia l      September 1978.
> Development with Specia l Emphasis on
> Machinery to Accelerate the Integration of
> Women in Development; Kathmandu, Nepa l;          A detailed report of the act1v1t1es of the
> 15-22 February 1977.                           Baha'i International Commun ity appears in
> - United Nations Water Conference; Mar       Part Three, section V, subsections 1 and 2 of
> del Plata, Argentin a; 14-25 March 1977.       this volume.
> 78                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 6. Constant Efforts to Protect the Faith from        upon Baha'i actlVltles. The Baha'is became
> Persecution and to Free It from the Re-           free in principle to resume their activities, but
> straints Imposed by Religious Orthodoxy           provincial and local officials had discretionary
> Arab Boycott                                         powers which required the Baha'is to obtain
> Early in February 1975, through a mis-            from the Ministry of the Interior specifi c
> understanding as to the true nature and pur-         confirmation of the lifting of the ban before
> pose of the Faith of Baha'u'llah, the Arab           permitting the resumption of Baha'i activities.
> Boycott Office at its meeting in Cairo               In provinces where the local authorities did not
> announced that the Baha'i Faith had been             object, Local Spiritual Assemblies were replaced on its black list. The decision of the        established and Baha'i work was quietly pur-
> Arab Boycott Office was subsequently mod-            sued. In other areas, however, which included
> ified to state that only the businesses of indi-     Bujumbura itself, the activities of the friends
> vidual Baha'is and companies owned by them           continued to be restr icted. When approached,
> would be boycotted.                                  the Minister of the Interior promised that the
> A statement was immediately released dur-         requested permission would soon be issued.
> ing the same month, through the Baha'i Inter-        We are glad to report that this was done, and
> national Community in New York, explaining           normal Baha'i activities have been resumed in
> the position of the Faith on politics and the        that country.
> historical reasons why the World Centre of the       Congo
> Faith is in the Holy Land. It is hoped that these       With the exception offive religious organizaexplanations have been helpful, and that the         tions, all other religious minorities, including
> authorities in all Arab lands will increasingly      the Baha'i Faith, were banned in this country
> appreciate the Teachings of our Faith which lay      during February 1978. Dr. 'Aziz Navidi is cursuch stress on non-involvement in subversive         rently in Brazzaville endeavouring to have the
> activities and on loyalty and obedience to gov-      ban removed from the Baha'is, whose activities
> ernment.                                             can in no way constitute a threat to the security
> of the State.
> Algeria
> The Faith remains banned in Algeria , and no       Egypt
> Baha'i institu tions exist there.                       Ever since the Decree of the former President of the United Arab Republic in 1960
> Burundi                                              banning all Baha'i activities, the friends in
> The Faith was recognized in Burundi in the        Egypt have been subjected to a series of interconclud ing months of the Nine Year Plan. In         rogations, arrests, imprisonments and fines, as
> 1974 a reversal was experienced in the for-          well as abuse in the mass media of the country.
> tunes of the Faith in that country when the             During the period under review , evidences
> Egyptian charge d'affaires made inaccurate           of adverse as well as favourab le developments
> statements about the Faith to the newly-             have been witnessed . On the one hand, after
> appointed Minister of Justice of Burundi,            the Arab Boycott Office, at its meeting in Cairo
> recommending that he seek authority from the         during February 197 5, resolved to blacklist the
> President to repeal the former decree. This was      Baha'is in Arab lands, the Supreme Constituobtained, and the new decision was announced         tional Court of Egypt was summarily convened
> on the radio and released as a news item in a        and announced its dec ision that the 1960
> semi-official bulletin . The same bulletin also      Decree of President Nasser banning all Baha'i
> published a harshly abusive article vilifying the    activities in Egypt was entirely constitutional,
> Faith as a dangerous political movement, the         and therefore the application of the Baha'is for
> text of the article being provided by the staff of   annulment of the Decree was dismissed. On
> the Egyptian Embassy in Burundi.                     the other hand, four other cases, long pending
> At the request of the Universal House of          before the local courts, either have been drop-
> Justice and through the able intervention of         ped or are being allowed to reach their statu-
> Dr. 'Aziz Na vi di, several representations were     tory period of limitation and thus set aside ,
> made to the Government. In 1975 the Presi-           although the major court case against the
> dent withdrew the ban that had been placed           Baha'is, which was opened in Tanta, is still
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                  79
> unresolved. Efforts have repeatedly been             preparation for the implementation of a town
> made, so far through appeals to President            planning scheme. Steps were taken immedi-
> Sadat and to several Ministers of State, to          ately to register with the authorities the indigexplain the position of the Baha'is and to           nation of the Baha'is that two of their most
> request that the 1960 Decree be repealed , or at     holy places in Shiraz had been unjustly and
> least that its effect on the Baha'is be lessened ,   peremptorily demolished, despite prior subso that the the civil rights of the believers, as    mission to the authorities for protection of
> law-abiding citizens of the country , may be         these properties. It is hoped that it will be
> restored and protected. It is hoped that the         possible in the future to rebuild these struca uthorities will soon realize the true aims and     tures on the same sites and with much of the
> purposes ofthe Faith and be sympathetic to the       original material , including exquisite fittings
> appeals of the friends .                             and ornamentation which fortunately have
> been salvaged through the devoted efforts of
> Indonesia
> the local believers.
> Although the ban imposed upon Baha' i
> In June 1977, ne ar Gurgan, one of the
> activity in Indonesia remains in force, it prodevoted friends, Mr. Ruhu'llah Taymurfhibits only the operation of administrative
> Muqaddam , was cruelly martyred, and his sisinstitutions; teaching has continued quietly on
> ter seriously injured. A court case was opened
> an indiv idual basis and Baha'i publications in
> aga inst the perpetrators, and the National
> Indonesian languages have steadily increased .
> Assembly hoped that the sense of justice of the
> A number of enthusiastic and zealous new
> authorities would not allow such an odious act
> believers of Muslim background , knowledgeto remain unpunished.
> able in the Qur'an and in Arabic literature ,
> On 15 December 1978 , a cabled message
> have entered the Faith; several are members of
> was sent to ninety-three National Spiritual
> prominent fam ilies. Fanatical elements reacted
> Assemblies advising that the friends in Iran
> unfavourably and, at their instigation , ten of
> and most of the Holy Places in Tihran and
> the new be lievers were condemned to five
> Shiraz were in great peril, that homes were
> years' imprisonment. While confined, they
> being burned and looted, and that some of the
> became much loved by other prisoners as well
> Baha'fs were threatened with death and /or
> as by their jailers. Some were sent to distant
> forcibly made to recant their Faith. The
> islands and were pleased that, by this forced
> National Assemblies were requested to cable
> move, the Message of God was carried to new
> appeals to the Prime Minister of Iran expresplaces. Most of them have now been released,
> sing their concern and asking him to take
> having completed their prison terms.
> measures to safeguard the lives of the Baha'fs
> Three believers from Indonesia embarked
> and protect the Baha 'i Holy Places . Subseupon an interna tional travel-teaching trip to
> quent reports indicated that the persecutions
> New Caledonia, where a large number of
> were increasing ; that a total of 200 houses in
> Indonesians reside , and this project was highly
> Shiraz were burned; that famil ies were driven
> successful.
> from their homes and threats made to their
> At the present time the friends are hoping
> lives. Some of the Baha'fs were beaten , and,
> that the authorities will recognize the position
> tragically, so me lost their lives. At one time
> of the Baha'fs and will remove the restrictions
> 700 Baha'fs were homeless and their means of
> imposed upon the operation of Baha'i adminislivelihood destroyed , and therefore a special
> trative activities.
> fund was established to aid our stricken breth-
> Iran                                                 ren in Iran.
> The Faith is still unrecognized in the land of       The wave of persecutions continues, and the
> its birth , and fanatical elements continue to       beloved friends and Holy Places in the Cradle
> instigate severe attacks against Baha'fs and         of the Faith are still in great danger. Armed
> their properties. In November 1975, the house        men of the revolutionary committees have
> of the maternal uncle of the Bab and the adja-       confiscated documents, and seized and
> cent house where the Bab was born were de-           occupied the House of the Bab in Shiraz, the
> stroyed on the pretext that the sites and the        Sfyah-Chal , the Houses of Baha' u'llah in
> adjoining area had to be cleared of buildings in     Tihran and Takur, the Houses of Quddus and
> 80                                     THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> Hujjat, as well as many Local I:Ia'.?iratu'l-Quds.   to ten years, and Baha'i properties, as well as
> The Nawnahalan Company, which has been in            properties of individual believers, were
> operation for about sixty years, is likewise         confiscated.
> occupied , its accounts fro zen and its operations       In July 197 5, a parti al amnesty reducing the
> stopped. The National Spiritual Assembly of          terms of imprisonment by fifteen per cent was
> Iran has frequently appealed to the new              granted on the occasion of one of 'Iraq 's
> authorities after the change of government, but      national events, to all those in 'Iraqi prisons,
> the results are still unknown.                       including the Baha'is. The friends incarcerated
> are still in custody, although some improve-
> 'Iraq                                                ment is reported in the conditions under which
> In May 1970, the 'Iraqi Government issued         they are being held.
> a Decree disbanding all Baha'i institutions and         In December 1977, all properties belonging
> banning all Baha'i activities. The attempts of       to individual believers were returned to them ,
> the local friends to explain the Baha'i position     but Baha'i properties and funds were turned
> to the authorities were of no avail. For nearly      over to the Ministry of the Interior for disposal.
> three years, although the authorities carefully         During the period under review, several
> watched the conduct of the Baha'is, nothing          attempts have been made and are still under
> apparently gave cause for interference in their      way to clear away any misunderstanding the
> personal lives and the imposition of fresh re-       authorities may have acquired abo ut the Faith.
> strictions.                                          It is hoped that the Government of 'Iraq will be
> In mid-December 1973, an incident occur-          assured of the innocence of the Baha'is, and
> red which sparked a fire of persecution and          will appreciate the true position of the Faith in
> adversity in whose flames many of the dedi-          its recognition of the divine origin of Islam and
> cated Baha'is of 'Iraq were engulfed, and            its injunction upon the believers to be loyal to
> whose future course seems unpredictable. A           government and to avoid any involvement in
> teenage Shi'ih Muslim girl learned of the Faith      political or subversive activity.
> from one of her Baha'i classmates and, with her
> older sister, became seriously interested in the     Jordan
> teachings. When the Baha'i Faith was referred          The National Spiritual Assembly here , in
> to during a discussion of religion in class in one   protracted negotiations with the authorities
> of the Government schools in Ba~dad, the girl        has clearly set forth the independent character
> rose to her feet in defence of the Cause. When       of the laws and ordinances of the Faith and the
> questioned by the teacher, she announced her         need for the believers to register themselves
> belief in Baha'u'llah, an assertion which cre-       and their children as Baha'is, and for their
> ated a stir in the class. The students spoke of      institutions to conduct the Baha'i marriage
> the incident the same day to their parents,          ceremony.
> among whom was the Minister of Education,
> Kampuchea (Cambodia)
> who, the following day, ordered an investiga-
> Owing to the political situation here, all
> tion to be made, himself went to the school,
> Baha'i activities had to be suspended, and
> dismissed the headm as ter, and, following the
> there is no contact with the friends.
> intervention of the Minister of the Interior,
> ordered the arrest of the girl and three Baha'i      Laos
> girls studying at that school. A chain of arrests,      The uncertain political situation in Laos has
> totalling almost fifty , followed in the course of   brought pressure upon the friends, and upon
> the next few months. The trial began on 4            the pioneers in particular, who as foreigners
> March 197 4 and, although the hearings of the        are conspicuous; all but two have been forced
> court were postponed several times, its verdict      to leave the country. Activities of the urban
> exonerated the Baha'is. Dissatisfied with the        Baha'is do not seem to be restricted, and the
> verdict, the Revolutionary Council ordered the       borders remain open to travellers, but comcase of the Baha'is reopened in a military           munications between the Baha'is in rural areas
> court. Twenty-nine Baha'is, both men and             and those in the city are restricted. In Vienwomen, were eventually sentenced by this             tiane, the Baha'is have sustained their
> court to terms varying from life imprisonment        activities, and are conducting children's classes
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                 81
> on a regular basis. A local J::Ia?iratu'l-Quds is    which had been banned, the Baha'is evinced
> presently being constructed adjoining the            exemplary steadfastness and constancy.
> Temple site.                                            Upon the request of the authorities, a list of
> It is hoped that the authorities, who are now      all Baha'i properties in the country was made
> reviewing the application of the Baha'is to be       and subm itted to them.
> regarded as a religious community , will give a         The recent change in the Ugandan governfavourable response.                                 ment bids fair to allow the Baha'is to resume
> Mali                                                 their activities in the heart of Africa.
> Although recognition of the Faith had been        Vietnam
> granted in Mali, the authorities decided in May         After the change of government, the
> 1976 to impose restrictions on Baha'i activities     National Spiritual Assembly was functioning
> and suspended the decree of recognition. Dr.         for some time, though in a very limited way.
> 'Aziz Navidi is in contact with the authorities to   However, this situation was short-lived. The
> dispel the misgivings of high government offi-       authorities soon detained two members of the
> cials about the Faith, and it is anticipated that,   National Spiritual Assembly, confiscated the
> once again, the Faith will be recognized.            National J::Ia?iratu'l-Quds and changed it into
> Uganda                                               an orphanage, and prevented the functioning
> In September 1977 , twenty-seven religious        of the Baha'i Administration. Appeals have
> been made to the authorities through the
> organizations were banned in this country.
> Baha'i International Community and other
> Among them was the Baha'i Faith . The
> National Spiritual Assembly and all the Local        channels. It is hoped that these appeals will
> bring forth favourable results and that the
> Assemblies had to suspend all their activities,
> beloved friends in Vietnam will again obtain
> while in the capital the resident Hand of the
> their freedom of worship, a freedom which is
> Ca use and other representatives of the Faith
> met with government officials to determine the       guaranteed in the Vietnamese Constitution.
> extent of the implications of this ban .             There are other countries where the Faith is
> Although abused in many localities by their       restricted , but about which it is unwise to
> fellow-countrymen for belonging to a Faith           report.
> 
> 7. The Holding of Eight International Teaching Conferences-From July 1976 to February
> 1977
> These eight International Teaching Conferences were attended by a total of approximately
> 15,000 believers from all parts of the world.
> The Hand of the Cause of God                      Number
> Place and Date                 representing the Universal House of Justice            Attending
> 
> Helsinki, Finland                 Ugo Giachery                                          950
> 5- 8 July 1976
> Anchorage, Alaska                 H. Collis Featherstone                              1,005
> 23-25 July 1976
> Paris, France                    Amatu'l-Baha Ruf:i.[yyih Khdnum                      5,700
> 3 - 6 August 1976
> Nairobi, Kenya                    William Sears                                       1,363
> 15-17 Oct. 1976
> Hong Kong                        'Alf-Akbar Furutan                                     506
> 27-30 Nov. 1976
> Auckland, N. Z.                  Abu'l-Qasim Faiz(                                    1,195
> 19-22 Jan. 1977
> Bahia, Brazil                    Enoch Olinga                                         1,300
> 27-30 Jan . 1977
> Merida, Mexico                   Paul Haney                                           2,000 plus
> 4 - 6 Feb. 1977
> 82                                  THE BAH A' f WORLD
> 
> During the Helsinki Conference Dr.             Justice by the National Spiritual Assembly of
> Giachery paid a courtesy call on Mr. T. Aura,     the Baha'is of the United Kingdom.
> the Mayor of Helsinki .
> The Governor of Alaska sent a message of       House of'Abdu'llah Pasha
> greeting to the Anchorage Conference which           The announcement by the Universal House
> was read on his behalf by Lieutenant-             of Justice of the acquisition of the House of
> Governor Lowell Thomas, Jr.                       ' Abdu'llah Pasha , in which 'Abdu'l-Baha lived
> Mr. Kurt Waldheim, Secretary-General of        for twelve years, was made on 14 January
> the United Nations, sent a message to the Paris   1975. The purchase of this House, which
> Conference which was read on his behalf by        derives its name from the Governor of 'Akka
> Mr. Luc Van Bellinghen , Director of the          who completed the House during the early
> United Nations Information Centre in Paris;       decades of the last century, is a supplementary
> this was the first occasion on which the United   achievement of the Five Year Plan.
> Nations through a high-ranking officer sent a        In September 1977 , the Universal House of
> message of goodwill to an international Baha'i    Justice approved the plans for restoration preconference.                                       pared by Mr. Ric;lvanu'llah Ashraf, a young
> The Hon. N. W. Munoko, the Minister for        Persian Baha'i architect, and the actual work
> Works, addressed the Nairobi Conference.          was started in December 1977 by a team of
> The Auckland Conference was opened by          Persian Baha'is with experience of reconstruct-
> His Excellency the Right Hon. Robert D. Mul-      ing certain of the Holy Places in friin. Certain
> doon, Prime Minister of New Zealand , and Sir     aspects of the project have been contracted
> Dove-Myer Robinson , the Mayor of Auck-           and the work is progressing.
> land.
> His Excellency Roberto Santos, Gove rnor       Preservation and Microfilming of Documents
> of the State of Bahia, opened that Conference.       Preservation of the Sacred Texts involves
> The Hon . Dr. Francisco Luna Kan, Gover-       protecting them from acids from within as well
> nor of Yucatan, himself a Mayan , opened the      as without the paper, and from the more usual
> Merida Conference.                                deterioration factors . Accordingly, extensive
> As the Baha'i world entered the second half    tests of the acidity of the Tablets and of their
> of the Five Year Plan, these Conferences pro-     surroundings were made and the decision
> vided an opportunity for examination of its       taken to remove them from the translucent and
> achievements and appraisal of its unaccom-        transparent folders and albums, which had
> plished tasks.                                    developed dangerous acidity, and to place
> A pictorial report of these Conferences        them in acid-free folders within acid-free storappears elsewhere in this volume.                 age boxes in which air could circulate freely.
> All available Tablets have been transferred,
> after microfilming, and are being stored in
> 8. Supplementary Achievements                     dehumidified rooms. In all, some 10,500
> Protection of the Resting-Place of Shoghi         documents from the Central Figures are now in
> Effendi                                           acid-free storage. Additional Tablets still being
> A further supplementary accomplishment          received are placed in acid-free storage even
> during the first half of the Five Year Plan was   before microfilming.
> announced by the Universal House of Justice          More than 2,000 of the Guardian's original
> in its cablegram of 5 February 197 5 to all       letters having postscripts in his own hand have
> National Spiritual Assemblies:                    been similarly preserved, as well as his cables
> and draft manuscripts of his general letters and
> ANNOUNCE PURCHASE STRIP LAND GREAT
> NORTHERN LONDON CEMETERY FACING
> books.
> BELOVED    GUARDIAN'S  RESTING-PLACE            Other historical documents similarly treated
> ENSURING PROTECTION   SACRED PLOT.           include handwritten manuscripts of several of
> PRAYERS GRATITUDE OFFERED DIVINE             Baha'u'llah's books, Nabfl's original notes,
> THRESHOLD.
> receipts written by 'Abdu'l-Baha, autographed
> The negotiations for this purchase were con-    photographs, notes by early amanuenses,
> ducted on behalf of the Universal House of        copies of Tablets, and examples of calligraphy.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                  83
> At present, the letters received by the Guar-     these letters have been indexed for Universal
> dian and already microfilmed are being trans-        House of Justice retrieval on microfilm. The
> ferred to acid-free storage. Other material will     Master Subject Index and its related Names
> be treated when adequate storage space               Index used for this purpose have been designed
> becomes available.                                   to provide a unified indexing system for use
> Microfilming of all available originals or ver-   throughout the World Centre when all materified copies of the Tablets of the Central Fig-      ial is on microfilm .
> ures of the Faith has been completed.                   Letters and papers received by ' Abdu'l-
> Great progress has been made with                 Baha are in process of being filmed.
> microfilming of the letters of the beloved              Filming of letters received by the Guardian
> Guardian. As all such items arrive at the World      is proceeding.
> Centre they will be microfilmed. Available              All original film rolls are stored in a
> documents associated with the history of the         maximum-security depository and a copy of
> Faith are also on film.                              each roll has been stored in a depository in
> Microfilming of the permanent letters and         each of five different countries of the world for
> statements of the Universal House of Justice is      safekeeping.
> up to date, and more than fourteen years of
> 
> A Baha'i worker prepares to read microfilmed documents. The preservation and microfilming
> of historical material is a continuing concern of the Baha'i World Centre.
> 
> """
> 
> ...,
> ::r:
> tT1
> Ill
> ;:...
> ::r:
> >
> ...;_
> :i::
> :;<l
> r
> a
> 
> The House of'Abdu'l-Bahli in 'A kka, which was His official residence from 1897 to 1908, was acquired in 1975. The building, known locally as
> the house of'Abdu'llah Pasha, was the birthplace of Shoghi Effendi. Restoration of the house began in December 1977.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                                85
> 
> 3. SUMMARY OF NATIONAL GOALS AND
> ACCOMPLISHMENTS
> 
> 1. National Spiritual Assemblies which were to     approved a design prepared by Farfburz
> make Plans to Accommodate the Interna-          ~ahba , who has been retained as architect for
> tional Conferences of 1976/1977                 this Temple . Working drawings are being prepared by Mr. ~ahba and the structural
> Each of the National Spiritual Assemblies
> engineers in England.
> which served as host had a major and decisive
> On 27 February 1979 a cable was received
> role in making these Conferences successful. A
> stating that the necessary permit for the condetailed summary appears in section 7 under
> struction of the House of Worship had been
> 'World Centre Goals'. See also the pictorial
> issued by the authorities and that excavation of
> report, 'Arise!', elsewhere in this volume.
> the area had begun.
> In addition , many countries held 'Satellite'
> A fuller report appears in Part Four, section
> teaching conferences or summer or winter
> V of this volume.
> schools before or after the International Conferences, which were attended by many of
> Samoa
> those travelling to attend the latter. These
> In November 1975 , the National Spiritual
> 'Satellite' events included two summer schools,
> Assembly of Samoa purchased a twelve-acre
> an International Youth Conference, twentylot at an elevation of 1,800 feet, overlooking
> three National Teaching Conferences and one
> the city of Apia and not far from Vailima, the
> Regional Teaching Conference in Africa; four
> official residence of His Highness Malietoa
> summer schools, one Native Council, and six-
> Tanumafili II. His Highness visited the land
> teen National Teaching Conferences in the
> and was delighted with its location . Most of the
> Americas; one winter school and ten National
> city of Apia can be seen from the site, and when
> Teaching Conferences in Asia and the Pacific;
> the Temple has been erected it should be
> one summer school and seven National Teachclearly visible from a wide area below.
> ing Conferences in Australasia; and ten sum-
> Mr. I:Iusayn Amanat was appointed as
> mer schools, two winter schools, and fifteen
> architect for the Temple at Ri<;ivan 1978. His
> National Teaching Conferences in Europe.
> design was submitted to the Universal House
> of Justice in September of that year and to His
> 2. Countries where the Construction          of
> Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II shortly there-
> Mashriqu'l-Adhkars is to be Initiated
> after. When the design had been approved,
> India                                              plans were made for the laying of the founda-
> During the Ten Year Crusade, twenty-two         tion stone. This ceremony took place on the
> acres of land in New Delhi were acquired for       Temple site on 27 January 1979 with His
> the Mashriqu'I-Adhkar, but this property was       Highness laying the stone. Amatu'l-Baha
> requisitioned by the Government for a green        RuJ:ifyyih Khanum , the representative of the
> belt area. After several years of constant         Universal House of Justice, participated by
> negotiation by the National Assembly, and          placing in a niche in the stone a small casket of
> upon viewing the beautiful design for the Tem-     dust from the Most Holy Shrine. More than
> ple, the Government agreed to release the          500 Baha'fs attended the ceremony and the
> entire twenty-two acres, as reported on 1 Feb-     Conference which was held concurrently. Sixruary 1978.                                        teen national communities from all parts of the
> On the occasion of the All-Asia Baha'f          Pacific area were represented.
> Women's Conference in New Delhi , and at a            In February 1979 an additional one acre of
> special ceremony on 17 October 1977 at the         land was acquired adjacent to the Temple site
> Temple site , the Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-       to the east to provide an approach to the Tem-
> Baha RuJ:ifyyih Khanum laid the foundation         ple from the main road.
> stone for this important edifice.                     A fuller report appears in Part Four, section
> The Universal House of Justice has               V of this volume.
> 86                                        THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> iran                                                     blies of Equatorial Guinea, Indonesia, and
> Preliminary steps were to be adopted to pave          Nepal had to be disbanded; and those of Mali
> the way for the eventual construction of the             and Somalia, which were goals of the Plan,
> Mawriqu'l-Adhkar in Tihran, circumstances                could not be formed. However, it has been
> permitting.                                              possible to form in 1977 and 1978 the National
> Although difficulties have prevented the              Spiritual Assemblies of the Marshall Islands
> Baha'is in that country from actively engaging           and the Mariana Islands, respectively, and in
> in this important project, a special committee           the latter year two new National Spiritual
> has completed all drawings and details for the           Assemblies in the zone of Western Asia, makconstruction. The plans have been checked and            ing a total of eighteen National Spiritual
> made ready by an engineering firm in the                 Assemblies.
> United Kingdom, thus enabling immediate                         4. National Spiritual Assemblies to be Incorpoinitiation of construction when circumstances                   rated
> permit.                                                         FIVE YEAR PLAN INCORPORATION
> 3. National Spiritual Assemblies to be Estab-                   GOALS
> Central and East Africa
> lished
> Ethiopia             In Process
> In 1974 the number of National Spiritual                        Southern Africa
> Assemblies was                                           115    Reunion              Goal Achieved
> The Five Year Plan goal was to form                        16 South and West
> 
> Thus calling for a total of                               131      Africa            Goal Achieved
> Western Africa
> Total National Spiritual Assemblies ,                           The Gambia           Goal Achieved
> Ric;lvan 1979                                             130
> Mali                 Circumstances Permitting
> GOALS ACHIEVED                                                  Mauritania           Circumstances Permitting
> Central and East Africa                                    Senegal              Goal Achieved
> 1. Burundi 1                                          1978 Sierra Leone            In Process
> Western Africa                                            Upper Volta          Goal Achieved
> 2. Mauritania                                         1978    Central America
> 3. Niger                                              1975 French Antilles         Goal Achieved
> 4 . Senegal                                           1975 South America
> 5. Sierra Leone                                       1975 Surinam and
> 6. Togo                                               1975       French Guiana Goal Achieved
> 7. Upper Volta                                       1977 North-eastern Asia
> Central America                                           Mariana Islands      Goal Achieved
> 8. French Antilles                                   1977    South-eastern Asia
> Nonh America                                              Hong Kong            Goal Achieved
> 9. The Bahamas                                       1978    Nepa!2               Circumstances   Permitting
> South America                                             Singapore            Goal Achieved
> 10. Surinam and French Guiana                          1977 Western Asia
> Western Asia                                              Turkey               Circumstances Permitting
> 11. Jordan                                             1975 Auslralasia
> Australasia                                               New Hebrides         Goal Achieved
> 12. The New Hebrides                                   1977    Europe
> Europe                                                    Austria              Circumstances Permitting
> 13. Cyprus                                             1978 Cyprus                  In Process
> 14. Greece                                             1977    Portugal             Goal  Achieved
> SUPPLEMENTARY ACHIEVEMENTS
> SUPPLEMENTARY ACHIEVEMENTS                                      American Samoa Guyana
> In the course of the Plan , because of local Caroline Islands                        Nicaragua
> circumstances, the National Spiritual Assem- Central African
> 1 First established in 1969, dissolved in 1972; re-established    Empire            Tuvalu
> 1978.                                                     Goal achieved but recognition withdrawn in 1975.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                  87
> 5. Baha'i Publishing Trusts to be Formed           when they are taken into account approximately fifty of the language achievements rep-
> In 1974 the number of Baha'i Publishing
> resent supplemental language achievements of
> Trusts was                                  16
> The Five Year Plan goal was to form an             the Plan not covered by any goal. Ten additional languages were reported 'in process' and
> additional                                   6
> no reports have yet reached the World Centre
> Thus calling for a total of                   22
> concerning progress in respect of eight of the
> Present number of Baha'i Publishing                named language goals.
> Trusts                                      23      Because the purpose of these language goals
> TRUSTS ESTABLISHED PRIOR TO THE                    was to increase the availability of Baha'i litera-
> FIVE YEAR PLAN                                     ture to friends and seekers, we have counted as
> Argentina       Netherlands                        'Publication ' circulation through newsletters
> Belgium         Pakistan                           or mimeographed sheets, as well as publication
> Brazil          Spain                              in book form. We have also listed languages
> Germany         Sweden                             reported available on tape , as the specific goal
> India          Taiwan                              was assigned to many countries of supplying
> Iran            Uganda                             prayers and short excerpts from the Holy Texts
> Italy           United Kingdom                     on tape for the friends to memorize in their
> Near East       United States                      own languages.
> A detailed list of language and literature
> TO BE FORMED DURING THE FIVE                       achievements of the Five Year Plan appears in
> YEAR PLAN                                          the bibliographic section of this volume, Part
> Australia          Achieved October 197 5          Six, section II , subsections 6 to 9.
> Fiji Islands       Achieved March 1975
> Japan              Achieved June 1975              7. Properties to be Acquired
> Korea              Achieved February 1976            A. National lja;iratu'l-Quds
> Malaysia           Achieved February 1976          FIVE YEAR PLAN GOALS ASSIGNED
> Philippine Islands Achieved April 1979
> Central and East Africa
> SUPPLEMENTARY ACHIEVEMENT                          Burundi                       In Process
> Norway              Achieved February 1976         Somalia                       Circumstances
> Permitting
> Western Africa
> 6. Languages into which Baha'i Literature is to
> Equatorial Guinea             Circumstances
> be Translated and Published and Those in
> which Additional Publications are to be                                       Permitting
> Mali                          Achieved
> made
> Mauritania                    Achieved
> (See also ' Publication & Dissemination of
> Niger                         Achieved
> Baha'i Literature,' section 4 of 'S ummary of
> Senegal                       Achieved
> Accomplishments in Other Areas'.)
> Sierra Leone                  Achieved
> Named Goal s    Achieved
> Togo                          Achieved
> Africa                  42           137           Upper Volta                   Achieved
> Americas                15            76           Central America
> Asia                    38            62           Barbados                      Achieved
> Australasia              4            42           French Antilles               Achieved
> Europe                  30            40           North America
> Invented                                           Bahamas                       Achieved
> Languages                            1           South America
> 129           358           Surinam                       Achieved
> In addition to the languages named as goals,    North-eastern Asia
> many countries were assigned to translate and      Eastern Carolina Is.
> publish or record on tape Baha'i literature in       (Ponape)                    In Process
> unspecified local languages used in their coun-    Mariana Is.
> tries. These are not shown in the table above;     (Guam)                        Achieved
> 88                                   THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> Marshall ls.                                  North-eastern Asia
> (Majuro)                   Achieved         Eastern Caroline ls.
> Western Caro line Is.                           (Ponape)                  Achieved
> (Yap)                        In Process       Mariana Is.
> South-eastern Asia                              (Guam)                    Achieved
> Hong Kong                    Achieved         Marshall ls .
> Western Asia                                    (Majuro)                  Achieved
> Jordan                       Achieved         Western Caroline Is.
> Australasia                                     (Yap)                     In Process
> New Hebrides                 Achieved         South Central Asia
> New Zealand                                   Bangladesh                  Achieved
> Cook Is.                   In Process       South-eastern Asia
> Europe                                        Hong Kong                   Achieved
> Cyprus                       Achieved         Australasia
> Greece                       Achieved         New Hebrides
> (Efate)                   Achieved
> SUPPLEMENTARY ACHIEVEMENTS                    New Zealand
> French Guiana                Puerto Rico        Cook Is.                  Achieved
> The Gambia                                    Tonga                       In Process
> Europe
> B. National Temple Sites                    Cyprus                      Achieved
> Greece                      Achieved
> FIVE YEAR PLAN GOALS ASSIGNED
> Central and East Africa                        SUPPLEMENTARY ACHIEVEMENTS
> Burundi                      In Process        Burma
> Soma lia                     Circumstances
> Permitting
> Zaire                        Achieved            C. National Endowments
> Southern Africa
> Seychelles                   Achieved          FIVE YEAR PLAN GOALS ASSIGNED
> Western Africa                                Central and East Africa
> Chad                         In Process       Burundi                     In Process
> Equatorial Guinea            Circumstances    Somalia                     Achieved
> Permitting       Zaire                       Achieved
> Gambia, The                  Achieved         Southern Africa
> Mali                         Achieved         Seychelles                  Achieved
> Mauritania                   Achieved         Western Africa
> Niger                        Circumstances    Equatorial Guinea           Circumstances
> Permitting                                   Permitting
> Nigeria                      Achieved          Gambia, The                Achieved
> Senegal                      Achieved          Mali                       Achieved
> Sierra Leone                 Achieved          Mauritania                 Achieved
> Togo                         Achieved          Niger                      Achieved
> Upper Volta                  Achieved          Senegal                    Achieved
> Central America                                Sierra Leone               Achieved
> Barbados                     Achieved          Togo                       Achieved
> French                                         Upper Volta                In Process
> Antilles                   In Process        Central America
> Puerto Rico                  Achieved          Barbados                   In Process
> North America                                  French Antilles            In Process
> Bahamas                      Achieved          Puerto Rico                Achieved
> South America                                  North America
> Surinam                      Achieved          Bahamas                    Achieved
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                                         89
> South America                                       F. Local lfa'{.iratu'l-Quds
> Surinam                        Achieved                                      Goal              Achieved
> 
> Nonh-eastern Asia                                 Africa                      799                 998
> Eastern Caroline ls.                              Americas                    294                 258
> (Truk)                       Achieved           Asia                        140                 152
> Mariana ls.                                       Australasia                  52                  58
> (Guam)                       Achieved           Europe                        6                  11
> Marshall Is.                                                                1,291               1,477
> (Majuro)                     Achieved             G. Local Endowments
> Western Caroline Is.                                                         Goal              Achieved
> (Yap)                        In Process         Africa                    1,195               1,211
> South Central Asia                                Americas                    354                 370
> Bangladesh                     Achieved           Asia                         47                 110
> South-eastern Asia                                Australasia                   0                   1
> Singapore                      Achieved           Europe                        2                   3
> Western Asia                                                                1,598               1,695
> Jordan                         Achieved              H. Specific Property Goals
> A ustra/asia                                      At least one local I:Ia~fratu'l-Quds in each
> New Hebrides                                      Province:
> (Efate)                     Achieved              Costa Rica         Achieved in 4 of 7
> New Zealand                                                             Provinces
> Cook Is.                    Achieved              Korea              Goal postponed
> Papua New Guinea               Achieved           At least one local I:Ia~fratu ' l-Quds on each of 5
> Tonga                          In Process         named islands:
> Europe                                               Hawaiian Is.       Achieved on 2 of 5
> Cyprus                         Achieved                                 named islands
> Greece                         Achieved           At least one local I:Ia~fratu ' l-Quds on each of 3
> SUPPLEMENTARY ACHIEVEMENTS                        named and 2 other major islands:
> Philippine Is.     Achieved on 3 named
> Nigeria                                                                 islands;
> 4 completed and in
> D. Summer Schools                                                     use.
> FIVE YEAR PLAN GOALS ASSIGNED                     At least one local I:Ia~fratu'l-Quds in each of 4
> named regions:
> Central and East Africa                              United Kingdom Achieved in 3 of 4
> Ethiopia                       Achieved                                 regions; 1 region has 2
> North-eastern Asia                                At least one local Endowment in each Prov-
> Hawaiian Islands               In Process         ince:
> South-eastern Asia                                   Costa Rica         Achieved in 4 of 7
> Burma                          Achieved                                 Provinces
> SUPPLEMENTARY ACHIEVEMENTS                        8. Local Incorporations to be Achieved
> Guatemala Zambia                                                             Goal              Achieved
> Malaysia                                          Africa                                           78
> Americas                    892                 906
> E. District lfa'{.iratu'l-Quds and Institutes   Asia                        874                 733
> Australasia                 139                 130
> Goal           Achieved
> Europe                      183                 252
> Africa                  73                51                                2,088               2,099
> Americas                14                13      • While no Local Spiritual Assembly incorporation goals
> Asia                    73               69         were assigned to Africa as Five Year Plan goals, the
> Australasia              0                0         following African countries were asked to continue
> efforts towards completion of unfulfilled local incorpora-
> Europe                   1                1         tion goals of the Nine Year Plan. (The achievements
> 161              134         shown have been included in the total shown above.)
> 90                                               THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Goal                 Achieved     as pioneers. A special assignment to iran was
> Central African
> Empire                    3                      1
> to send thirty-four pioneers "with special ca-
> Ghana                      10                      4     pacity and training in the establishment and
> Kenya                      50                      1     conducting of classes for Baha'i children to
> Malawi                      5
> Nigeria                    IO                            twenty-one countries in Africa; by 1975,
> Swaziland                   5                      5     twenty-nine such pioneers were reported to
> Zambia                     11                    11      have reached their posts.
> 95                    23
> 
> 9. Inter-Assembly Collaboration Projects                 INTERNATIONAL TRAVELLING
> TEACHERS
> At the outset of the Plan in 1974, ninety-                                          Number Sent
> eight National Spiritual Assemblies were                 AFRICA           More than                       200
> assigned to receive assistance through 444 pro-          THE AMERICAS     More than                     3,200
> ASIA             More than                       800
> jects assigned to eighty-one National Spiritual
> AUSTRALASIA      More than                       300
> Assemblies; and, as new National Spiritual               EUROPE           More than                       500
> Assemblies were formed during the course of                               More than                     5,000
> the Plan, additional projects were assigned.                                          Number Received
> These projects included such efforts as acquisi-         AFRICA           More than                       700
> tion of properties; provision of literature;             THE AMERICAS     More than                     1,700
> teaching and consolidation projects , including          ASIA             More than                       900
> AUSTRALASIA      More than                       400
> teaching of minorities ; supplying pioneers              EUROPE           More than                     1,300
> and travelling teachers, including pioneers                               More than                     5,000
> specializing in training of children's teachers;
> teaching conferences; opening of new ter-                 10. Miscellaneous Untabulated Goals
> ritories; establishment of first Local Spiritual
> A. National Spiritual Assemblies to Select One
> Assemblies, and re-establishing lost Assembor More Believers from Local Comlies in goal countries.
> munities, and to Train Them to Help in
> In a few instances, due to local circum-
> Deepening Their Fellow Believers and in
> stances , only token assistance was possible; in
> Consolidating Their Local Communities
> most cases the collaboration extended was substantial and effective. For example , inter-                 This goal was assigned to fifty-two National
> Assembly collaboration made possible the                  Spiritual Assemblies; 102 National Spiritual
> purchase of twenty-two National f:la~fratu ' l­           Assemblies report various approaches to
> Quds and twenty-six Temple sites during the               fulfilling it. Some have interpreted the goal
> Plan, and 2,605 pioneers and more than 5,000              broadly , reporting deepening sessions for both
> travelling teachers left their homes during the           old and new believers, members of new Local
> course of the Five Year Plan to serve the Faith           Spiritual Assemblies, women or youth; sumin other countries. These latter achievements             mer school programs; youth and women's conare detailed below.                                       ferences; and, especially, teacher-training
> PIONEERS Number                  Sent From
> institutes. One National Spiritual Assembly in
> AFRICA          57               17 countries of          particular chose to focus on this goal, consider-
> THE AMERICAS 1,050               22 countries of          ing it the key to fulfillment of all other goals,
> ASIA         1.189               18 countries of          and developed an extensive program which
> AUSTRALASIA     78                7 countries of          included visiting localities, training teachers,
> EUROPE       --11.!.             !l countries of
> 2,605               81 countries             training a deepening cadre, and the establishment of twenty-seven five-week courses in var-
> Number         Received By              ious subjects, after which participants were
> AFRICA              521          41 countries
> expected to return to their homes to share what
> THE AMERICAS        728          37 countries
> ASIA                729          34 countries             they had learned before being permitted to
> AUSTRALASIA         163          10 countries             enroll for further courses. This program has
> EUROPE              464         _l!! countries            had great success, resulting not only in
> 2,605         140 countries             increased expansion, but also in deepening,
> Of special interest among the pioneer goals               consolidation, and strengthening of Baha'i
> were several requiring native believers to arise          family and community life .
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA ' I ACTIVITIES                               91
> In addition , Continental Boards of Counsel-      localities in Guatemala, and from Panama
> lors, by training Auxiliary Board members and        embarked on a three-nation travel-teaching
> by encouraging the appointment and training          trip. The National Spiritual Assemblies of
> of assistants to the Auxiliary Boards, have          Benin, the Solomon Islands, and the South
> assisted hundreds of believers on each conti-        West Pacific Ocean have reported the first
> nent to play a major role in strengthening the       native women elected to their National
> administrative institutions of the Faith and in      Spiritual Assemblies.
> stimulating the friends to greater achievements         More than 1,000 Baha'i women from all
> in all fields of Baha'i activity.                    over Asia, with observers and speakers from
> Europe and America , gathered in New Delhi ,
> B. National Spiritual Assemblies which are to
> India, 13-16 October 1977, for the Asian
> Organize Baha'i Activities for Women            Baha'i Women's Conference. The presence of
> Although this goal was originally assigned to     the Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha Ru~iyyih
> only eighty National Spiritual Assemblies,           Khanum as the most distinguished guest and
> activities toward its achievement have been          principal speaker was a source of great joy and
> reported by 115 National Assemblies in many          happiness for the believers. Before the Conparts of the world. Baha'i activities by and for     ference opened and while it was in progress,
> women have included greater participation in a       Ru~fyyih Khanum met five ministers of the
> wide range of endeavours to further the prog-         Government of India, which served to strengthress of the Cause: women's conferences; fam-         en cordial and personal relationships with
> ily life conferences; classes in child care, read-   these high dignitaries. The Conference
> ing, nutrition and hygiene, arts and crafts; and     received wide coverage in the news media in
> many others. Particularly significant has been a     India, and many of the participants also travelgreat increase in regular children's classes,        led to other parts of the country in a postmany of them taught by women's groups, and           conference teaching plan.
> the formation of women's teaching teams.                Another significant international women 's
> Some of these latter have visited islands in the     conference was the West African Baha'i
> New Hebrides following a women's conference          Women's Conference held in Monrovia 28-31
> there, spent four months opening new                 December 1978, on the theme of 'Spiritual
> 
> a           ASIAN
> BAHAl
> WOMEN·s
> ' , CONFERENCE
> 
> Asian Baha'i Women's Conference, New Delhi, India; 13-16 October 1977. The photograph
> shows a few of the more than 1,000 representatives who attended. The Hand of the Cause
> Amatu'l-Baha Ruf:iiyyih Khanum is seen seated in the centre.
> 92                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Education of Women: Foundation for a New           in western Europe and Australasia, many
> Human Society'. It was attended by 150             opportunities to gain radio and TV time have
> women from fourteen different countries, and       been seized upon. In the United States the Jeff
> opened by the Liberian Minister of Informa-        Reynolds' Show, Fireside Playhouse, and Divine
> tion and a woman Senator. Again, extensive         Art of Living (Spanish) radio series have been
> radio, television and press coverage brought       widely used, as well as radio specials and series
> the Faith to the attention of thousands of         of public service announcements. In India the
> Liberians from every stratum of society.           government has authorized announcements of
> Many smaller local, regional, national and      Baha'i events and festivals. Radio Sri Lanka
> international conferences took place, and it       has repeatedly broadcast a series of programs
> was especially significant that in many of the     prepared in India, and mini-dramas from
> developing countries, where such behavior on       Japan have been widely utilized. In total, some
> the part of men is almost unknown, the Baha'i      thirty-five countries have reported radio promen would prepare the food and care for the        gramming for varied lengths of time, not
> children in order to enable their wives to par-    including the scattered reports from every
> ticipate in the conference sessions.               corner of the world of radio and television
> interviews of Baha'i travelling teachers, of spot
> See 'Survey of Activities of Baha'i Women
> announcements of Baha'i activities, etc. In St.
> in the Five Year Plan ,' Part Three, section IV,
> Martin, French Antilles, TV programs have
> subsection 4 of this volume.
> almost continuously been on the air since 197 5.
> C. National Spiritual Assemblies which are         The first Baha'i radio station, Radio Baha'i,
> Specifically Called upon to Expand the use   of Cajas and Otavalo, Ecuador, began regular
> of Radio and/or Television                   broadcasting in December 1977, and it is
> Thirty-nine National Spiritual Assemblies       hoped a shortwave unit will be added shortly at
> were assigned the specific task of expanding       Lake Cuicocha.
> the use of radio and television for proclamation      In Canada a weekly cablevision telecast entiand teaching of the Faith. Developments have       tled Baha'f News was under way for many
> been impressive , notably in Latin America.         months in the Toronto area, the videotapes
> Audio recording studios have been estab-        being used in other Canadian cities. In the
> lished in some twenty-one countries. A centre      United States videotapes were produced and
> for distribution of radio scripts, tapes and        used for a highly successful training program
> information-Centro          para     lntercambio   for Local Assembly members . The National
> Radiof6nico Baha'i de America Latina (CIR-         Spiritual Assembly of Hawaii , collaborating
> BAL)-was established in E l Salvador and is        with the Hand of the Cause William Sears, in
> now based in Trinidad; it publishes a periodic      1975 completed thirteen color TV programs
> news bulletin entitled Ondas Baha'fs. Three        entitled The New World; the series was telecast
> international radio and television conferences     several times in Hawaii, in Alaska and the
> have been held, and radio-television work-         United States, and individual videotapes have
> shops and seminars have been conducted in          had wide usage. The Green Light Expedition
> many countries in Latin America, from which        film has been extensively shown on TV chanderived the booklet Transmit Thy Knowledge         nels in many parts of the world. The crisis in
> on Baha'i radio methods. Extensive radio           Persia has brought extraordinary opportunities
> programs have been in use in Ecuador, Peru,        for proclamation of the Faith by television and
> Paraguay, Bolivia and the French Antill es, and    radio in the western countries.
> there are intermittent but continuing radio           A fuller report appears in the survey appearprograms in Puerto Rico, Jamaica, Belize,          ing in Part Three, section IV, subsection 5 of
> Trinidad and Tobago , Guyana , the Leeward         this volume.
> and Virgin Islands, Colombia , Liberia and
> other countries. In Africa the Central African      D. National Spiritual Assemblies which are
> Empire holds the record with its more than             Specifically Called upon to hold National
> three years of twice-weekly radio broadcasts;          Teaching Conferences
> earlier it was able to produce many TV pro-         The holding of annual National Teaching
> grams. In Samoa, Hawaii, A laska and Canada,       Conferences was a goal assigned to eighty
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                               93
> 
> The third annual Baha'( Children's Conference of Guyana, Georgetown, Guyana; March
> 1977. More than 1, 100 national and regional teaching conferences were held throughout the
> Baha'( world during the Five Year Plan in addition to numerous children's conferences.
> 
> National Spiritual Assemblies. Reports ~y 117      correspondence courses in four languages;
> National Assemblies indicate that more than        India reports about 1,000 new believers en-
> 1,100 National and Regional Teaching Con-          rolled annually through correspondence courses
> ferences were held during the course of the        in nine languages.
> Five Year Plan.
> F. National Spiritual Assemblies Called upon
> The spiritual stimulus imparted at such conto Increasingly Teach and Enrol People
> ferences has impelled the believers to greater
> from Specific Minorities and Other Groups
> efforts to achieve the goals of the Plan. Many
> countries have held conferences twice each            Enrolment of minorities has been extensive
> year, or added a series of regional conferences    in many parts of the world, whether or not
> and deepening institutes for further enrich-       specifically assigned as a goal. Examples
> ment and development of the distinctive            include Pygmies in Zaire , African refugees in
> character of Baha'i life.                          Portugal, Poles in Switzerland, and Cypriots in
> the United Kingdom, Koreans in Samoa ,
> E. National Spiritual Assemblies which are to    Chinese and ' Bush Pagans' in the Solomons, as
> Develop and Conduct Correspondence
> well as native tribes in many countries. Espe-
> Courses                                       cially successful in reaching many different
> Development of correspondence courses for       minorities in their countries have been
> teaching and deepening was a goal assigned to      Australia, Benin, Chad, the Cameroon
> fifteen National Spiritual Assemblies; they are    Republic, Guyana, Surinam and French
> also in use in a number of other countries, some   Guiana, and Venezuela . Members of several
> of which have been using them for many years.      minorities have been enrolled in Afghanistan.
> During the Five Year Plan thirty-seven          Chile has enrolled nine members of the vanish-
> National Spiritual Assemblies have reported        ing Alacaluf tribe at the southernmost tip of
> on the use of correspondence courses for teach-    South America; Fiji reports mass e nrolm ents
> ing and/or deepening, for children , youth ,       in areas of large populations from India, of
> adults and families. Seven countries in Latin      both Sikh and Hindu backgrounds. Several
> America are making good use of a variety of        Latin American countries are reaching remote
> courses, including some for literacy training.     areas through extensive use of radio program-
> Pakistan is using a correspondence course for      ming in Quechua and Guajira.
> youth; Italy has courses for parents and chil-        An example of the great value of such minordren. Malaysia and the Philippines each report     ity enrolments to the future of the Faith is the
> 94                                        THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> report received that Yugoslavs of A lbanian                The practice has been stimulated in Samoa
> background, who enrolled in th e Faith in Lux-           by the early morning devotional radio broadembourg, have returned to Yugoslavia, so me              casts sponsored by the Faith. Early morning
> for holidays and some to live. Their homes in            prayers are also broadcast by Radio Baha'i
> Yugoslavia lie near the border with Albania,             Ecuador and some other nationa l comwhich is still a virgin territory for the Faith.         munities.
> Also among the fundamentally importa nt
> H. Miscellaneous
> achievements of the Five Year Plan has been
> the increasing participation in all as pects of the      a. Transfer of the remains of members of the
> work of the Cause by native believers around                Holy Family of the Bab (assigned to iran)
> th e world . Increasingly they are being elected            Special circumstances prevailing in the counto adm inistrative bodies; arising as travel-            tries of the Middle East have held up the purte achers a nd pioneers, both internationall y           suit of this goa l.
> a nd on the homefront; represen ting the Faith           b. Acquire Ho ly Sites in !ran and 'Iraq (iran)
> in proclam ation efforts; contributing in cash,             Altho ugh the fo rtress Chihrfq came into the
> kind and effort to the Funds of the Faith and to         possession of the National Spiritual Assembly
> the achieve ment of property goals; and                  of Iran in 1972, the necessary legal procedures
> fulfilling unsung but necessary committee                and documents were completed during the
> work, translation work, organization of con-             Five Year Plan.
> ferences, and the like . Their efforts and                  The title deed fo r that portion of the fort ress
> accomplishments have brought great joy to the            of Mah-Ku which served as the Bab's prison
> Universal House of Justice, and give great               has been obtain ed, and this Ho ly Place is now
> promise for the futur e of the Faith in their            owned by the Baha'i Faith.
> countries.
> c. Establish an Institute of Higher Studies ofthe
> In all , 168 minorities are listed as enro ll ed in
> Fa ith (iran)
> Africa during the Plan, seventy-seven in the
> Americas, sixty-two in Asia , sixty-seven in                Th is project was inaugurated at Ric;lvan
> 1975. Its purpose is to prepare a number of
> Australasia, and fifteen in E urope, for a total of
> selected believers to pursue adva nced and
> 389 .
> detailed studies about the history , teachings
> G. Encourage the Friends to Gather for Early           and principles of the Faith and its relationship
> Morning Prayers in Their Local Com-                 with other religions and va rious schoo ls of
> munities in Localities Where Such Gather-           philosophy and thought. It is intended to be a n
> ings Would Fit into the Pattern of the              Institute for both study and research. Accord-
> Friends' Lives                                      ing to a previous report, the Writings in Persian, Arabic and E ngli sh are being studied in
> This goa l was assigned to seventy-two
> Nationa l Spiritual Assemblies: thirty-six in            this Institute, and there are five instructors and
> twenty stude nts. It is hoped that this nucleus
> Africa, thirtee n in the A mericas, eight in
> will grow in to a very useful Institute which will
> Australasia and the Pacific, and fifteen in Asia .
> meet the needs of th e Faith in the years to
> In all , eighty-eight National Spiritu al
> come .
> Asse mblies have reported community ga therings for early morning prayers. Reports                  d. With a view to attracting great numbers to the
> received indicate increasing frequency of this              Cause, develop intensive teaching and conin spiring and unifying practice in increasing              solidation plans in at least three of the States
> numbers of local communities, including some                visited by 'Abdu'l-Bahd (United States)
> in Europe and in other countries which had not              In response to the call to develop intensive
> been assigned this goa l. Some gatherings are            teaching and consol idation pl a ns in at least
> sporadic, but the most usual frequency seems             three of the States visited by' Abdu' l-Baha durto be weekly, although some communities                  ing His stay in the United States, the National
> re port daily gatherings. In additio n to loca l         Spiritual Assembly of that country selected
> meetings, some co untries report regular meet-           California , praised by the Master for its natural
> ings at the National I;Ia~fratu'l-Quds or Tem-           splendours and about which He expressed the
> ple sites.                                               hope that it would 'earn an ideal similarity with
> z
> ...,
> tTl
> :<l
> z
> ...,>
> z
> >
> r
> "'c::
> :<l
> <
> tTl
> -<:
> .,,
> (')
> c::
> :<l
> :<l
> tTl
> ...,z
> tD
> >
> :r:
> »
> >
> (')
> ...,
> -
> <
> j
> tTl
> "'
> 
> Maori and Polynesian Baha'(s of New Zealand ga 1hered at the Orakei Marae Meeting House; January, 1979. The Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-
> Baha Ruf:ifyyih Khdnum is seen in the centre holding an infant.                                      '°
> Ul
> 96                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> the Holy Land'; Illinois, the first place in          development of this School at Panchgani, as
> America where the Name of Baha' u'llah was            follows:
> publicly mentioned , and where 'Abdu'l-Baha              1. A multi-purpose building was inauguplaced the foundation stone on the lakefront                rated at Naw-ruz 1978.
> site where today stands the holiest House of             2. Land has been acquired and approval
> Worship in the Baha'i world; and New York,                  given by the House of Justice on 2 Februon whose great metropolis the Master be-                    ary 1979 to establish a diploma course for
> stowed the title 'City of the Covenant', for it was         training teachers at the pre-primary level
> there that He explained for the first time in the           in the near future.
> West the implications of His unique office as            3. A Rural Development Project, financed
> Centre of the Covenant of Baha'u'llah.                      by an individual and designed to improve
> To the friends in these three States, the                the standard of living of the people in
> National Spiritual Assembly gave a high por-                villages near the New Era School, was
> tion of the numerical goals assigned to the                 established, and plans are being made in
> American Baha'i community-twenty-one per                    consultation with the donor to further
> cent of the 7,000 localities to be raised, thirty           expand this project into the appropriate
> per cent of the 1,400 Local Spiritual Assem-               technology and cottage industries area of
> blies to be formed, and forty per cent of the              rural development.
> Assembly incorporations to be achieved.                  4. Children of pioneers from other areas,
> e. Assume a major role in promoting the spread              particularly the Arabian countries, were
> of the Faith in the Far East (Japan)                     provided with the opportunity to attend
> Nine travelling teachers from Japan visited              this School.
> several areas in Korea during the months of              A fuller report appears in Part Three, sec-
> December 1975 and January 1976.                       tion IV, subsections 6 and 7 of this volume.
> f Greatly intensify the teaching work along the
> Black Sea coast (Turkey)                              Rabbani School
> There are now at least five Local Spiritual           This School was re-established in July 1977,
> Assemblies and five groups along the Black            and is designed to be vocational in atmosphere
> Sea coast and the route ofBaha'u'llah's travels .     with emphasis placed on agricultural sciences
> useful to village development. An academic
> g. Develop the New Era and Rabbani Schools
> and Baha'i curriculum has been developed ,
> and increase the number of village tutorial
> poultry and fishery operations have begun, and
> schools (India)
> extensive landscaping and construction of new
> New Era School                                   facilities are planned so that an eventual
> Great strides have been made in the              enrolment of 300 students will be realized.
> 
> Some students of the Ideal Baha'i Primary School, Dharmanager, North Tripura, India, with
> the rickshaw which transports them to their classes.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                      97
> 
> Some students of the Bahti'( Primary School, Tadung, Gangtock, Sikkim. Counsellor Shirin
> Boman is seen in the centre, back row, with two members of the staff
> 
> Tutorial Schools                                    Commission published World Religions: A
> The development of tutorial schools has             Handbook for Teachers, a work compiled by
> played a great role in the teaching and consoli-      the SHAP Working Party on World Religions
> dation activities of the Baha'i communities in        in Education. This book, in large format, con-
> India. At present there are forty-nine such           tains six full pages under 'The Baha'i Faith',
> schools in operation in that country.                 comprising an excellent statement prepared by
> h. Develop the Baha'i Education Trust recently        the National Spiritual Assembly and a list of
> established (Iran)                                Baha'i literature categorized as Primary
> This Trust was established in 197 4. Its pur-     Sources-the Sacred Writings and works of
> pose is to provide earmarked capital, the inter-     the Guardian; Secondary Sources-histories,
> est of which is to be used in providing scholar-     lives of the Founders, exegesis; and Periodicals
> ships to deserving students, enabling them to        and Leaflets. It is available to all teachers in the
> pursue their studies in goal countries. The          United Kingdom and at present some 500
> amount of capital in this Trust has been gradu-      copies have been taken up. The Baha'i friends
> ally increasing, and it is hoped that in the near    are calling it to the attention of teachers in their
> future there will be sufficient funds to satisfac-   localities.
> torily carry out the purpose for which the Trust     k. Cultivate opportunities for courses on the
> was created.                                            Faith in Canadian institutions ofhigher learni. Develop the existing Baha'i schools (Sikkim)          ing (Canada)
> There are two tutorial schools operating in          The National Spiritual Assembly of Canada
> different parts of the country, both of which        formed the Canadian Association for Studies
> have brought prestige to the Faith in that land.     on the Baha'i Faith as the principal instrumen-
> There is also a school located in the capital city   tality for meeting this goal. Four national
> of Gangtok, which has become very popular            annual meetings of the Association have been
> and is considered one of the best schools in         held, six bilingual Bulletins have been circu-
> Sikkim. At present, this school has around 300       lated, and five popular volumes of Baha'i
> students.                                            Studies have been issued. The Association has
> j. Study and implement as far as possible the use     announced the forthcoming publication of a
> in schools and colleges of specially prepared     new work, under the auspices of the Universite
> textbooks on the Faith (United Kingdom)           de Montreal , designed to provide an authorita-
> This goal, although a continuing one with no      tive textbook for studies on the Baha'i Faith in
> finality, has got away to a good start and may       universities and colleges; the book will appear
> certainly be counted as accomplished for the         in both French and English. Significant pro-
> Five Year Plan . The National Spiritual Assem-       gress has been made in introducing formal prebly is represented on a number of government         sentations of the Faith in Canadian instituand other agencies dealing with the problem of       tions of higher learning.
> religious education in schools, and in                  See also the report appearing in Part Three,
> December 1976 the Community Relations                section IV, subsection 3 of this volume .
> 98                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 4. SUMMARY OF OTHER ACCOMPLISHMENTS
> 1. Increase the Number of Believers, Local Spiritual Assemblies and Localities where Bahli'is
> Reside
> A major objective of the Five Year Plan was to achieve a 'vast and widespread expansion of the
> Baha'i community'. The following tables show the extent to which this goal was achieved.
> The number of believers increased by 43 per cent worldwide from June 1974, at the beginning of
> the Plan, to April 1979.
> Increase                                               In crease
> Africa                                    53% Australasi a                                   117%
> The Americas                              27 % Europe                                         25%
> Asia                                      44%
> Local Spiritual Assemblies increased during the same period by 79 per cent, from a total of 14,228
> to 25 ,511.
> June 1974        April 1979                 ln crease
> Africa                               4,113          5,376                   31%
> The Americas                         3,193          5,752                   80%
> Asia                                 6,265         13,163                  110%
> Australasia                            278            583                  110%
> Europe                                 379            637                   68%
> The number of localities increased during the same period by 67 per cent, from 61,815 to
> 103,323.
> June 1974        April 1979                 Increase
> Africa                                   13,363            26,111                     95%
> The Americas                             15 ,835           22,577                     43%
> Asia                                     29 ,198           49,794                     71%
> Australasia                               1,445             2,376                     64%
> Europe                                    1,974             2,465                     25%
> Many National Spiritual Assemblies were           Spiritual Assemblies in Europe have at least
> specifically called upon to 'grea tly increase the   doubled the number of Local Spiritual
> number of believers' from all strata of society.     Assemblies. In addition, thirty-six National
> A comparison of the figures shown in the tables      Assemblies have achieved increases of double
> of thi.s report with the first reports received at   or more in the number of localities, several by
> the beginning of the Five Year Plan show that        as much as five-fold. Twenty-seven National
> sixty-three National Spiritual Assemblies have       Spiritual Assemblies have increased the
> at least doubled the number of Local Spiritual       number of believers under their jurisdiction by
> Assemblies in the territories under their juris-     double or more. Nineteen National Spiritual
> diction and many of these have achieved much         Assemblies have at least doubled their numlarger increases: one National Spiritual             bers in all three sets of statistics: eleven in
> Assembly has achieved a nine-fold increase,          Africa, three in the Americas, two in Asia, two
> one a seven-fold increase, one a six-fold            in Australasia, and one in Europe (Cyprus).
> increase, five have quintupled, six quadrupled,         The greatest growth of all has been in Upper
> eight tripled, seventeen achieved a two-and-         Volta, which has multiplied the number of its
> a-half-fold increase, and twenty-four have           Local Spiritual Assemblies by nine times, the
> doubled the numbers of Local Spiritual               number of its localities by twelve times, and the
> Assemblies under their jurisdiction. Of these,       number of believers by more than eighteen
> all but three of the National Spiritual Assem-       times. The National Spiritual Assembly of the
> blies in Africa, half of the National Spiritual      Hawaiian Islands entered the Plan with Local
> Assemblies in the Americas and more than             Spiritual Assemblies in every possible locality;
> one-third of the National Assemblies of Asia,        during the Plan Singapore also reached the
> all but two of the National Spiritual Assemblies     maximum number of Local Spiritual Assemin Australasia, and two of the National              blies possible within its area of jurisdiction.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                                 99
> BAHA'fS IN THE GENERAL                                 Partially Achieved: Austria, 8 of 9 Prov-
> POPULATION                                             inces; Guatemala, 19 of 22 Departments;
> Netherlands, 10 of 11 Provinces; Philippine
> The following percentages have been calcu-
> Islands , 49 of 74 Provinces; Sweden, 21 of
> lated using the number of believers reported to
> 24 Lan
> the World Centre as of 20 April 1979 in each
> country's final Five Year Plan report, and the       -Establish a Local Spiritual Assembly in the
> most recent population statistics avai lable to      capital city of each Province:
> the Statistics Department. Where no report of          Partially Achieved: Costa Rica, 6 of 7 Provnumber of believers was sent, the last availab le      inces
> figure has been used. Ten countries or ter-          -Establish at least 4 Local Spiritual Assemritories, as listed below, have a Baha'i popula-     blies in Cantons previously without any:
> tion exceeding one per cent of the genera l             Achieved: Switzerland
> population. In addition, Alaska shows more           -Establish Local Spiritual Assemblies in
> than 0.99 per cent and Bolivia 0.95 per cent.        tribal areas:
> Gi lbert Islands & Tuvalu                            Nationa l Assembly Specific Goal     Achieved
> 8.77%
> Sikkim                                    2.98%      Australia      3 in aboriginal areas 7
> Marshall Is.                              2.58%      Botswana       3 in Bushman areas 8 +
> Solomon Is.                               2.05 o/o   U nited States 25 on Indian
> Belize                                    2.03%                     Reservations          31
> Tonga                                     1.86%      Zaire          5 amo ng Pygmies     21+
> Falkland Is.                              1.37%      -Establish Local Spiritual Assemblies in
> Caroline Is.                              1.37%      specified places:
> Samoa                                     1.20%      National Assembly Specific Goal      Achieved
> Swaziland                                 1.03 o/o   Denmark         1 in Bornholm         1 group
> Ecuador         1 in Galapagos
> 2. Strive to have the Baha'i Community repre-                        Islands               2
> sented broadly across the geographical areas      Finland         1 in Lappland         1
> of national jurisdiction                          France          6 in named areas      2
> SPECIFIC TEACHING GOALS                              Spain           1 each in 5 named
> areas                 4
> -Establish at least 10 Local Spiritual Assem-        Venezuela       4 on Isla Margarita   4
> blies in each Province:                                              1 each on Aruba &
> Achieved: Zaire                                                    Bona ire              1
> Partially Achieved: Kenya, 6 of 7 Provinces       -Establish groups in towns and major villages
> -Establish at least 4 Local Spiritual Assem-         visited by Baha'u'llah (Turkey):
> blies in each State:                                   Partially Achieved: 5 Local Spiritual
> Partially Achieved: Germany, 9 of 11 States          Assemblies and 5 groups established among
> 18 towns and villages
> - Establish at least 2 Local Spiritual Assem-        -Open all localities:
> blies in each major ad ministrative unit of the        Achieved: United Kingdom
> country:                                                Partially Achieved: Mauritius, 175 of 237
> Achieved: Belize and Jamaica                          localities
> Partially Achieved: Colombia, 31 of 32
> -Establish from one to three localities in each
> administrative units
> Province, Department, County or other
> -Establish at least one Local Spiritual              national administrative unit:
> Assembly in each major administrative unit of          Achieved:     Argentina, Bolivia, Chile,
> the country:                                            Rwanda. Uganda reported achievement in
> Achieved: Argentina, Belgium, Central                 1977 before disruption of local conditions.
> African Empire, Chile, Ecuador, Fiji, Mex-            No recent report has been received.
> ico, Nicaragua, Nigeria, Paraguay, Peru,             Partially Achieved: Denmark, 10 of 14
> Singapore, United Kingdom, Uruguay,                  Counties; France, 53 of 96 Departments;
> Venezuela, Rwanda                                    Norway, 18of19 Counties
> 100                                 THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 'Erena Roe', a 40-foot catamaran built in Kiribati and Tuvalu for use in teaching the Bahd'{
> Faith throughout the islands. The vessel, launched in April 1977, was named for Elena and
> Roy Fernie, Knights of Bahd'u'llah for the Gilbert Islands. Jn the foreground are seen John
> Thurston (left) and Terimwi Tonga (right) who operate the vessel.
> 
> -Open all populated islands to the Faith:           report that the number of believers in
> Achieved: Mariana Islands; Tonga; Marshall        Tuvalu is more than doubled.
> Islands                                              Switzerland opened four specified Can-
> Partially Achieved: Caroline Islands, 35 of       tons, two of which now have more than
> 43 islands; Solomon Islands reports efforts,      fifteen localities.
> but no specific report has been received;
> Samoa has not reported.                         3. Provide for the efficient and rapid dissemination of news and messages
> -Raise number of major islands opened to the
> Faith to 9:                                         During the course of the Five Year Plan,
> Achieved: Fiji Islands, with 11 reported        publication of various kinds of newsletters and
> opened                                          bulletins increased from 149 published by
> -Many National Spiritual Assemblies were          ninety-three National Spiritual Assemblies in
> requested to open or increase the number of       1974 to 176 published by 101 National
> localities in a variety of tribal, minority, or   Spiritual Assemblies in 1979. These include
> other specified areas. Among achievements         special bulletins for women, children and
> reported are these:                               youth, as well as multiple editions in more than
> Chad established several new localities in   one language of the country. Some National
> northern and desert region tribal areas.        Spiritual Assemblies also report publication of
> Kenya established the Faith on at least      Nineteen Day Feast letters or newsletters,
> two islands in Lake Victoria.                   sometimes including readings prepared for the
> Norway established a Local Assembly in       Feast, in four or five languages.
> the Lofoten Islands and increased their           In addition, some National Spiritual
> localities to 40 , including Spitzbergen.       Assemblies have been able to disseminate
> India reports the establishment of many      news of meetings, elections, special visitors,
> new localities and increased teaching           and the like through the use of spot announceactivities in 11 specified areas.               ments on local or national radio stations. A full
> Papua New Guinea increased the level of      report of the use of radio and television during
> teaching activity in the Highlands of New       the Five Year Plan is included elsewhere in this
> Guinea. There are now 22 Assemblies and         report.
> 135 localities in the area.                       See also Part Three, section IV, subsection 5
> The Gilbert Islands (Kiribati) and Tuvalu     of this volume.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                101
> 4. Increase the Publication and Dissemination       Some National Spiritual Assemblies are also
> of Baha'i Literature                             beginning to prepare materials for literacy
> training, in such languages as Guajiro
> During the course of the Five Year Plan,
> (Ecuador) and Sidamigna (Ethiopia).
> literature has been published in more than 185
> A detailed listing of language accomplishlanguages, approximately thirty of them for the
> ments will be found in the bibliographic section
> first time, including the production of such
> of this volume.
> materials as pamphlets and books for use in
> Where necessary, National Spiritual
> teaching activities, in deepening and in chil-
> Assemblies were assisted from the Literature
> dren's classes; selected prayers and short selec-
> Subvention Fund for the purchase or publications for memorization, and scholarly works
> tion of essential literature and its distribuand compilations of the Sacred Texts. The
> tion-often at prices below cost-to reinforce
> World Centre library reports that it has a total
> their teaching, consolidation, and deepening
> inventory of 1,380 titles in 279 languages other
> objectives.
> than English, of which 937 titles in 135 languages were received at the World Centre dur-
> 5. Baha'i Communities at present dependent
> ing the Five Year Plan.
> on outside help to aim at becoming financi-
> In addition, translations have been made but
> ally self-supporting
> not yet published in more than 150 languages,
> of which at least sixty are first translations in      In 197 4, 64 per cent of all National Spiritual
> that language . Translations into nearly sixty      Assemblies received all or part of their
> languages have been recorded on tape in pre-        national budgets from international Baha'i
> paration for dissemination in areas where           funds (74 of 115 National Spiritual Assemmany of the friends cannot read, or in lan-         blies). By the 1978-9 budget year, this figure
> guages which as yet have no writing system.         was reduced to 52 per cent of all National
> 
> I K l ' i -AB- 1 - i Q_.\N
> 
> l l , l ,  '  · 1 . 1 __, , ,
> 
> A handsome edition of Baha'u'llah's Kitab-i-fqan, translated from Shoghi Effendi's English
> into Xhosa by Robert Mazibuko, was produced by the National Spiritual Assembly of South
> and West Africa in the closing months of the Five Year Plan. More than 900 titles, in 135
> languages, were received at the World Centre during the Plan.
> 102                                      THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> In Africa, twenty-eight National Spiritual
> Assemblies report extension teaching by Local
> Spiritual Assemblies, including over 200 Local
> Assemblies in Kenya, and fifty or more in
> South and West Africa.
> In the Americas, twenty-one National
> Spiritual Assemblies report such extension
> teaching, including more than thirty Local
> Spiritual Assemblies in Brazil, twenty-seven in
> Ecuador, and twenty-five in Honduras.
> In Asia, such extension teaching is reported
> by sixteen National Spiritual Assemblies,
> including 139 Local Spiritual Assemblies in
> Korea .
> In Australasia, nine of ten National Spiritual
> Assemblies report extension teaching goals
> adopted, including all Local Spiritual Assemblies in Australia and fifteen in the Solomon
> Islands.
> In Europe, ten National Spiritual Assemblies report extension teaching by Local
> His Majesty Sobhuza II, King of Swaziland,             Assemblies under their jurisdiction, including
> accepts from Dr. M. Ahmadi of lnin an                  twelve Local Spiritual Assemblies in Switzerilluminated Baha'f prayer for unity. Dr.               land .
> Ahmadi was a principal speaker at the dedication on 15 April 1979 of a new interdenominational church at Lobamba, Swazi-               7. Foster cordial relations with people of promland. More than 10,000 people attended the                inence and those in authority.
> event, sponsored by His Majesty as one                       Seize opportunites to increase the recognimeans of encouraging unity among the                      tion of the Faith through the incorporation of
> people in his country.                         Spiritual Assemblies and the recognition of
> Baha'i Marriage Certificates and of Baha'i
> Spiritual Assemblies (66 of 126 National
> Holy Days
> Spiritual Assemblies).
> To assist National Spiritual Assemblies                 The boundary between these two types of
> whose goals required funds exceeding their              activity is not clear-cut, and many activities
> resources, the Universal House of Justice allo-         reported from around the world involve both
> cated special amounts to facilitate construction        'fostering cordial relations' and various kinds
> of J:la'.?iratu' l- Quds, to finance special teaching   of recognition, both legal and otherwise, some
> projects, and for use in subvention of literature       of which result directly from these efforts.
> and audio-visual materials. In addition,                Meetings of various kinds with the authorities,
> through inter-Assembly collaboration assign-            and with prominent persons in other fields,
> ments, eighty-one National Spiritual Assem-             which have been reported to the World Centre,
> blies provided financial assistance to their sister     range from meetings with village chiefs, some-
> Assemblies throughout the world for major               times to obtain permission for teaching in their
> achievements of the Plan .                              localities, to meetings by travelling international dignitaries of the Faith with ruling
> sovereigns, other heads of government, and
> 6. Extension teaching goals to be adopted by or
> members of their immediate families. Innumassigned to an increasing number of Local
> erable interviews are reported from almost
> Spiritual Assemblies
> every national community, and they are
> Reports received indicate increasing under-          increasing rapidly as the Faith comes more and
> standing throughout the Baha'i world of the             more to public notice. Only the highlights can
> importance of such extension teaching goals.            be reported here.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                               103
> Of particular interest in this regard is the
> systematic five-phase program organized in
> Australia, in each phase of which groups contact certain types of authorities, the press, and
> other influential persons at national, regional
> and local levels. The response to these interviews has generally been very favourable, with
> such remarks reported as 'Our country needs
> these principles', and invitations to share them
> as widely as possible.
> Legal incorporations, both national and
> local, have been reported elsewhere in this
> report. Tax exemption has been granted to the
> Faith during the Plan in Kenya, India, Fiji,
> New Zealand, Madagascar, Argentina, Costa
> Rica, and Malaysia, and an import licence was
> granted to the Faith in Ghana. In the Sudan,
> permission has been granted to the National
> Spiritual Assembly to appoint a representative
> for dealing with the courts in matters of Baha'i
> inheritance. Recognition of the Baha'i marriage ceremony as fulfilling legal marriage
> requirements has been achieved in Belize,
> Denmark, Italy, Scotland, and New Hebrides.          Mrs . Dorothy Francis, a Salteaux Indian
> In Canada the Baha'i Shrine in Montreal has          Bahd'{, was awarded the Order of Canada in
> received official government designation as a        April 1978 for her services to Canadian
> Sanctuaire, and in the United States the Baha'i      Indians and her efforts to preserve their
> culture.
> House of Worship has been entered in the
> official Register of Historic Sites. In Pakistan,
> Turkey, and the Solomon Islands the Faith has       Association); Leo Reano Memorial Award
> been recognized as a separate minority relig-       (National Education Association)
> ion; in Turkey, Baha'ls may have their Faith        Canada
> listed in their identity cards; and in the Sol-        Mrs. Dorothy Francis: Order of Canada (for
> omons, the Faith was listed as a separate entry     services to Canadian Indians)
> in the 1977 national census. Baha'i Holy Days       El Salvador
> have been gazetted in Malaysia, and in Tonga           Baha'i Community of El Salvador: United
> the National Spiritual Assembly has been            Nations Peace Medal
> certified as a permanent member of the Hospi-       Papua New Guinea
> tal Board of Visitors-a certification limited to       Mrs. El ti Kunak: British Empire Medal (for
> the heads of various faiths. Baha'i symbols         work with women's clubs)
> have been registered as official trademarks in      United Kingdom
> the Cameroons , the Central African Empire,            Mr. Bernard Leach: Companion of Honour
> and in Iceland.                                        Mr. Norman Bailey: Commander of the
> An increasing number of individual Baha'is       Order of the British Empire
> around the world are receiving official honours        Dr. Richard St. Barbe Baker: Order of the
> from national and local governments and pro-        British Empire (for lifelong service to the cause
> fessional organizations, in recognition of their    of conservation)
> outstanding contributions in many fields.           United States
> Among those which have been reported to the            Mr. Robert Hayden: Appointed Consultant
> World Centre are included the following:            in Poetry to the Library of Congress
> Alaska                                                 Dr. Dorothy Nelson: Pax Orbis Ex Jure
> Mr. Raymond Hudson: Willard Bowman               Medallion Award (Centre Associates , World
> Award for Human Rights (Alaska Education            Peace Through Law Centre)
> 104                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> In a few instances, authorities are beginning   ous countries, and the Faith has figured in symto turn to the institutions of the Faith-for       posia at universities in Canada and Sweden.
> example, in Zaire the National Spiritual              Germany: Dr. Udo Schaefer's The Light
> Assembly, among other bodies, was invited to       Shineth in Darkness (George Ronald, Pubcomment on proposed changes in the educa-          lisher) was enthusiastically reviewed in Choice,
> tional system.                                     a publication of the Association of College and
> Especially interesting is the number of edu-    Research Libraries (a division of the American
> cational institutions which have granted per-      Library Association) as an 'exceptionally
> mission and even invited the Baha'is to offer      informative ... well expressed, scholarly preregular classes on the Baha'i Faith, at elemen-    sentation' of the Baha'i Faith and recomtary, high school, and university levels.          mended as 'a valuable holding for a wide range
> Reports have been received from Jamaica,           of libraries.'
> where the official curriculum calls upon stu-         United States: Mr. John Huddleston's This
> dents in government high schools and teacher-      Earth is But One Country (Baha'i Publishing
> training colleges to investigate the Faith; from   Trust of the United Kingdom) was selected by
> Nigeria, where the Faith has been added to the     Choice magazine as one of the outstanding
> curriculum of the Department for Religious         academic books of 1979. The reviewer found it
> Studies at the University of Ife; and from the     to be 'an unsurpassed ... presentation of the
> United States, where credit courses on the         Faith for general adult reading ... a superbly
> Faith have been offered at prestigious Prince-     written account.' Choice is published monthly
> ton University. Similar reports have also been     and reaches 'virtually every two-year, fourreceived from the Gilbert Islands, New Zea-        year and university academic library in the
> land, the Seychelles, Swaziland, Tanzania, and     United States and Canada, as well as many
> Tonga. Special studies and theses on the Faith     foreign subscribers and non-academic lihave been accepted by six universities in vari-    braries.'
> 
> Mr. Eric Bowes (centre), while Mrs. Bowes lo9ks on, receives congratulations from the Hon.
> David Tonkin, Opposition Leader of Australia's Parliament, on the dedication of a library
> named in honour of Mr. Bowes, at Urrbrae Agricultural High School near Adelaide. Mr.
> Bowes, for years a member of the National Spiritual Assembly of Australia, and now an
> Auxiliary Board member, served the school for over 30 years. He was cited for his energy,
> devotion and humility.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                105
> 8. Special Achievements                             travel teachers from Sweden.
> LIECHTENSTEIN: 'We joyfully announce                                          Reported July 1977
> the declaration of the first native Liechtenstein   (The opening of Lithuania to the Faith was a
> Baha'i, Miss Edith Sprenger .. .'                   goal assigned to Sweden.)
> Reported by the National Spiritual       FIJI: ' ... the village elders visited the Confer-
> Assembly of Switzerland, 4 July 1974        ence and, during a formal Fijian ceremony,
> CHILE: 'We are very happy to announce that          announced that, following a village meeting,
> in June, one of our pioneers ... travelled to       the Baha'i Faith was to be included as one of
> Port Eden . . . in the extreme south of             the official permitted religions on the island.
> Chile .... This is the only place where there       The elders were aware of the Baha'i teachings
> are Alacalufe Indians, a tribe that has been        and were very happy with the tremendous
> driven into isolation and near extinction, and      interest being shown in the Faith by the villaout of the 25 persons of this race who are left,    gers. A momentous event.'
> nine became Baha'is .. .'                                                     Reported August 1977
> Reported September 1974        ECUADOR: 'During a travel-teaching trip
> (Enrolment ofthis tribe and translation oflitera-   last fall, two believers from Ecuador estabture into their language were goals assigned to     lished the first two Local Spiritual Assemblies
> Chile.)                                             in the Galapagos Islands, a small archipelago
> off the western coast of South America and a
> ALASKA: 'Happy report Local Spiritual               possession of Ecuador. Several other localities
> Assembly formed in Barro~, northernmost vil-        were also opened to the Faith during their
> lage in Alaska.'                                    stay.'
> Reported 13January1976                                   Reported 25 March 1978
> MALAYSIA: 'Grateful Blessed Beauty com-             INDIA: 'Happy inform all villages Dang tnbal
> pleted goals Assemblies total 404 localities        district have Local Assemblies, numbering
> 1,600 I:Ia'.?fratu'l-Quds East Malaysia ex-         312.'
> ceeded, few West, two finalized three in                                  Reported 16 May 1978
> process, new believers during six months 4,000,     'Happy inform progress since Ric;lvan over
> consultation Hands Counsellors launching new        65,000 believers, over 2,500 localities includfive months plan , submitting international         ing 161 Assemblies ... .'
> travel-teaching      possibilities, beseeching                        Reported 6 December 1978
> prayers. Deepest love.'                             ZAIRE: 'A total of 1,528 Baha'is from 206
> Reported 18 November 1976
> different Local Assembly areas attended a
> (This National Spiritual Assembly was the first
> Regional Teaching Conference held 23-25
> to report completion of all Five Year Plan
> December in Kivu Province ... One delegagoals.)                                             tion of over a dozen Baha'fs walked to the
> SWEDEN: Sweden reports the opening of               Conference from their home village, a journey
> Lithuania to the Faith by the declaration of a      of 14 days in each direction.'
> Lithuanian believer through the efforts of                             Reported 28 January 1979
> 106                                               THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 5. EXP ANSI ON AND CONSOLIDATION OF THE
> BAHA'I FAITH INCLUDING THE PERIOD OF
> THE FIVE YEAR PLAN
> INFORMATION STATISTICAL AND COMPARATIVE
> Ri{lvtin 1973             Ri(ivtin 1979
> Countries, significant territories and islands where the
> Ba ha'i Faith is established ................. . ... .                                     335                        360
> National Spiritual Assemblies .. .. . ............... .                                      113                        130
> Incorporated National Spiritual Assemb lies ... .. .. . .                                     90                        106
> Nationa l I:J a'.?iratu' l- Quds (headquarters of national
> Baha'i administrative activity) ........ . .... ..... .                                   112                        129
> National Endowments ....................... . .. .                                           104                        156
> Baha'i Temples (Mafil}riqu ' l- Adhkar) ......... . ... .                                      5                          5
> Sites for fut ure Ba ha'i Temples ... . ...... . .. . ... . . .                               98                        123
> Baha'i P ublishing Trusts ... ....... ....... ..... . .. .                                    15                         23
> Languages into which Baha'i li terature has been translated . .. .... .. ............. .. .. ..... ......... .                                   530                        640
> Indigenous tribes, races, and e thnic groups represented
> in the Baha'i Faith (estimated) ................. .                                     1,607                    1,8 20
> Countries recognizing Baha'i Holy Days ... . .... . . . .                                    64                        64 1
> Countries recognizing Baha'i marriage ... . . .. . .. .. .                                   40                        40 1
> Locali ties where Baha'is reside ........ ... .... .... .                                69,541                  103 ,323
> Isolate d centres or groups . . . . .. . ... ..... . . . . . . .. .                      52,133                   77,812
> Local Spiritua l Assembl ies ......... . . .... . . . . . . .. .                         17,037                   25,511
> Incorporated Local Spiritual Assemblies .. ... . ..... .                                  1,556                    2,099
> A.     AFRICA
> Ri(ivtin 1973             Ri(ivtin 1979
> Countries, significant territories and islands where the
> Baha'i Faith is established . . ... ..... ...... ..... .                                     66                        70
> National Spiritual Assemblies . . . .. . .. . ... ... .. ... .                                 30                        37
> Incorporated National Spiritual Assemblies .. . . .... .                                       25                        31
> National I:Ja'.?iratu'l-Quds (headquarters of national
> Baha'i admin istrative activity) . .. .. . .... . ... . .. . .                               31                        35
> Nationa l Endowments ..... . ...... . .. . .. ... ... .. .                                     29                        40
> Baha'i Temples (Mafil}riqu'l-Adhkar) .. . . . . . .. .. .. .                                    1                         1
> Sites for future Baha'i Temples . . ..... .... ....... . .                                     26                        32
> Baha'i Publishing Trusts . . ............ . . .. ....... .                                      1                         1
> Lang uages into wh ich Baha'i literature has been translated ..... . . .. ...... . .......... . .... .. . . ..... .                               160                      212
> Indigeno us tribes, races and ethnic gro ups represented
> in the Baha'i Faith ...... . .... . ....... .... . . ... .                             1,012                     1,120
> Countries recognizing Baha'i Holy Days .......... . .                                         11                       11 1
> Countries recogni zing Baha'i marriage . . ......... . .                                       7                        71
> Localities where Baha'is reside . . ..... . .. ... .. . . .. .                           15 ,245                   26,111
> Isolated centres or groups ... .. .... . .. . ...... ·. . .. .                           10,047                    20,735
> Local Spiritual Assemblies ............ . .. .. .. . ... .                                4,990                     5,376
> Incorporated Local Spiritual Assemblies . . .. . . . . .. . .                                142
> C urrentl y under review.
> ' In view of the events in a few countries in Africa during the period under review, such as Uganda and the Congo Rep ublic,
> a nd the uncertainty created by these difficulties for the followers of the Faith, exact figure s for this entry are not avai lable.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                              107
> B. THE AMERICAS
> 
> Rit;lvan 1973   Rit;ivan 1979
> Countries, significant territories and islands where the
> Baha'i Faith is established . . . . . . .... . . ......... .               97            100
> National Spiritual Assemblies .. . . . .. ... . . . ...... . .               30             33
> Incorporated National Spiritual Assemblies ..... ... .                       29             30
> National I:Ia?iratu' l-Quds (headquarters of national
> Baha'i administrative activity) ... . .. .. . . . ..... . . .             29              34
> National Endowments .... . . .. . . .... . .. . ....... . .                  28              31
> Baha'i Temples (Mashriqu'l-Adhkar) ...... . ...... .                          2               2
> Sites for future Baha'i Temples ........ . ... . .. . ... .                  26              30
> Baha'i Publishing Trusts . . . . .. . . ...... . .......... .                 3               3
> Languages into which Baha'i literature has been translated .. .... ....... . . . .. . . ... .. . . .. . .. ........ .          91            123
> Indigenous tribes, races and ethnic groups represented
> in the Baha'i Faith ....... . . ................... .                    234            275
> Countries recognizing Baha'f Holy Days .......... . .                        23              23 1
> Countries recognizing Baha'i marriage ..... .. .... . .                      10              10 1
> Localities where Baha'is reside ........ . ... . ..... . .               15,860         22,577
> Isolated centres or groups . . . . . . ................. .               12,548         16,8 25
> Local Spiritu al Assemblies . . . ... .. .. . . . . ... .. . ... .        3,234          5,752
> Incorporated Local Spiritual Assembli es ........... .                      522            906
> 
> c. ASIA
> Rit;ivan 1973   Rit;lvan 1979
> Countries, significant territories and islands where the
> Baha'i Faith is established .................. . .. .                      70              75
> National Spiritual Assemblies ......... ... .. . ..... .                     25              27
> Incorporated National Spiritual Assemblies .. . ..... .                      13              15
> National I:Ia?fratu'l-Quds (headquarters of national
> Baha'i administrative activity) ..... . ........ . ... .                  25              26
> National Endowments ........... .. .... ......... .                          22              53
> Baha'i Temples (Mashriqu'l-Adhkar) ............. .
> Sites for future Baha'i Temples .......... . .. .. ... . .                   21              26
> Baha'i Publishing Trusts ... . ..................... .                        5               9
> Languages into wh ich Baha'i literature has been translated . .. .... .... ..................... .. · · · · · · ·              160             171
> Indigenous tribes, races and ethnic groups represented
> in the Baha'i Faith ............ .... .. .. . ....... .                   261            300
> Countries recognizing Baha'i Holy Days .... . ...... .                        10             10 1
> Countries recognizing Baha'i marriage ........ .. . . .                        9              91
> Localities where Baha'is reside ................... .                    34 ,892        49 ,597
> Isolated centres or groups .... . ......... ... . . .... .               28,816         36,511
> Local Spiritual Assemblies ................. . .. . .. .                  8,029         13,086
> Incorporated Local Spiritual Assemblies ........ . . . .                     689            712
> 
> Currently under review.
> 108                                         THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> D. AUSTRALASIA AND THE PACIFIC ISLANDS
> Rit;lvan 1973   Rifivan 1979
> Countries, significant territories and islands where the
> Baha'i Faith is established ..... . . .. .. ....... .. . .                  33             40
> National Spiritual Assemblies ........ .. .. .. ...... .                      11             14
> Incorporated National Spiritual Assemblies . ... ... . .                       9             14
> National I:Ia~ratu'l-Quds (headquarters of national
> Baha'i administrative activity) . .. .. . . ... . .. ... . . .              10             15
> National Endowments .... .. . . .. . .. . . .... ....... .                     8             13
> Baha'i Temples (Mashriqu'l-Adhkar) . . . . . . . ... . . . .                   1              1
> Sites for future Baha'i Temples . ..... . . . ..... . . . .. .                 9             12
> Baha'i Publishing Trusts .. . . .. . . .. .. . . ... ..... . .. .                             2
> Languages into which Baha'i literature has been translated .. . ... . .. .. .. ........... . .... .. .. .. ..... .               66             77
> Indigenous tribes, races and ethnic groups represented
> in the Baha'i Faith .... . ........ . .... . . . ... .. .. .              78             108
> Countries recognizing Baha'i Holy Days . . . . ... .... .                    10              10 1
> Countries recognizing Baha'i marriage . .. ...... . .. .                     10              10 1
> Localities where Baha'is reside . ... . .......... . ... .                1,456           2,573
> Isolated centres or groups ... . . .. .. ..... . . . .. ... . .           1,049           1,913
> Local Spiritual Assemblies .... . . .. ...... . . . . . . . . . .           379             660
> Incorporated Local Spiritual Assemblies . ........ . . .                     76             151
> 
> E. EUROPE
> 
> Riff van 1973   Riff van 1979
> Countries, significant territories and islands where the
> Baha'i Faith is established ... . ......... . ... . ... .                   69             75
> National Spiritual Assemblies .. .. . .. ... . ... . . . . . . .              17             19
> Incorporated National Spiritual Assemblies . .. ... . . .                     15             16
> National I:Ia~fratu'l-Quds (headquarters of national
> Baha'i administrative activity) . . . . . .... . . .. .... . .              17             19
> National Endowments ... . . . . ... . . . ... . . .. . ..... .                17             19
> Baha'i Temples (Mashriqu'l-Adhkar) .... . . . ... . . . .                      1              1
> Sites for future Baha'i Temples .. . ...... ... .. . . .. . .                 16             18
> Baha'i Publishing Trusts .. . . . ... . ...... ....... . . . .                 6              8
> Languages into which Baha'i literature has been translated ........ . ..... . . . ...... .. . . .. .. .. .. . . .. . .          53             57
> Indigenous tribes, races and ethnic groups represented
> in the Baha'i Faith ... . ... . . . . ... . . ... ......... .              22             22
> Countries recognizing Baha'i Holy Days . . . . . ...... .                     10             10 1
> Countries recognizing Baha'i marriage ... .. .. . . . . . .                    4              41
> Localities where Baha'is reside . ... . .. .. .......... .                 2,088          2,465
> Isolated centres or groups ........ . . ... .......... .                   1,673          1,828
> Local Spiritual Assemblies .. .. . .. . . .. .. .. . .. . .. . . .           405            637
> Incorporated Local Spiritual Assemblies . .. . . . ... . . .                 127            252
> 
> Currently under re view.
> III
> EIGHT INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCES
> 1. ARISE!-A PICTORIAL REPORT 1
> 
> The urgent need for Baha'(s to arise to teach
> the Cause of Bahd'u'llah was th e theme of the
> eight international teaching conferences called
> by the Universal House of Justice. The
> acrostic 'A rise-Reach-lndividual-Souls-
> Everywhere' provides the title of this report.
> More than 14,500 Bahd'fs from all parts of
> the world attended the conferences.
> 
> The purposes of the conferences, as stated by
> the Universal House of Justice, were to
> familiarize the Baha'[s with the general
> progress of the Five Year Plan, to bring to
> their attention what remained to be achieved
> and to present the Baha'i world community
> with opportunities for proclamation and
> teaching which would lend impetus to the
> progress of the Plan.
> 
> Eight Hands of the Cause were chosen to
> represent the Universal House of Justice at
> these conferences. In view of the association of
> her distinguished mother, May Maxwell, with
> the very early history of the Faith in Paris, it
> was particularly fitting that Amatu'l-Bahd
> Rufifyyih Khanum was the representative at
> the conference in that city.
> 
> Dr. Ugo Giachery was the representative in
> Helsinki.
> 
> Adapted from a programme for slides and filmstrip
> prepared under the direction of the Audio-Vis ual
> Department of the Baha'i World Centre and released
> through the International Bahii'f Audio-Visual Centre,
> Victor, New York . Copyright © 1977 National Spiritual
> Assembly of the Bahii'fs of the United States.
> 110                                   THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> At Hong Kong the representative was
> 'AU-Akbar Furutan.
> 
> Paul Haney and Enoch Olinga attended the
> Bahia and Merida conferences. Mr. Haney
> was the representative at Merida and Mr.
> Olinga at Bahia.
> 
> William Sears represented the Universal
> House of Justice at the conference held in
> Nairobi.
> 
> Collis Featherstone was the representative at
> Anchorage ...
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                             111
> 
> ... and at Auckland, Abu'l-Qasim Faizi,
> seen here with some of the youth, was the
> representative of the Universal House of
> Justice.
> 
> Most members of the Continental Boards of
> Counsellors attended one or more of the
> conferences. Seen here is Yan Kee Leong, a
> member of the Continental Board of
> Counsellors in South-east Asia, who was
> present at the Hong Kong conference.
> 
> There were many long-time pioneers at the
> various conferences, including Zylpha Mapp
> and Claire Cung, shown here at Nairobi.
> 
> There were also young pioneers including
> Hakan and Mas Britt Cullsberg, who
> pioneered from Sweden to Chad.
> 112                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> There were distinguished Bahti'{s who have
> achieved world recognition in their chosen
> fields, including 'the man of the trees', Dr.
> Richard St. Barbe Baker, seen here in
> attendance at the Nairobi conference . ..
> 
> . . . and the renowned artisl John Birks
> 'Dizzy' Gillespie who performed at the
> Helsinki conference and made a video tape
> which was played later on Finnish television.
> 
> Representatives of many races and tribes
> came from all over the world to attend these
> great assemblages. Seen here are Navajo and
> Oneida Indians from North America who
> attended the Helsinki conference.
> 
> To the various conferences were drawn Maya
> Indians from the Yucatan . ..
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                          113
> 
> .. . Indians from the Altiplano of Bolivia . ..
> 
> . .. tribesmen from Swaziland ...
> 
> . . . Chinese believers from South-east Asia.
> 
> . .. and Eskimo Baha'[s from Alaska.
> 114                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Large numbers of those attending the
> conferences came from iriin, the cradle of the
> Baha'[ Faith. The Paris conference held
> during the first week of August 1976
> attracted an attendance of 6,230 Baha'fs and
> was the largest international conference since
> the World Congress held in 1963 in London
> to commemorate the formal assumption by
> Baha'u'llah of His Prophetic Office one
> hundred years earlier and the victorious
> consummation of the Ten Year Crusade.
> 
> During the first week of July 1976 Baha'fs
> from many nations gathered in Finlandia
> Hall in Helsinki for the first of two Arctic
> conferences.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Dr. Ugo Giachery
> presented Mayor Teuvo Aura of Helsinki
> with an inscribed copy of The Baha'i World.
> Mayor Aura cordially welcomed the Baha'fs
> to Helsinki.
> 
> Dr. Giachery was interviewed by a radio
> reporter and the programme was aired
> throughout Finland. The conference was
> reported and publicized, as well, in the press
> and national magazines. Shown here are
> some of the Bahti'[s who were present at the
> conference.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                              115
> 
> On the morning of 6 July the conference was
> formally opened and Dr. Giachery read the
> message of the Universal House of Justice in
> which the Baha'fs were reminded that the
> northern regions of the world had been
> alluded to by Bahti'u'lldh in the
> Kitab-i-Aqdas, the 'mother book' of the
> Baha'i revelation ...
> 
> . .. and their names recorded in the Tablets
> of the Divine Plan by 'Abdu'l-Baha, Who, in
> one of His other Tablets, supplicated God to
> raise up sanctified, pure and spiritual souls
> in the countries of the West and the
> territories of the North, and make them
> signs of (Divine) guidance ...
> 
> The first of many speakers was Adib
> Taherzadeh of the Continental Board of
> Counsellors in Europe who spoke about the
> devotion and self-sacrifice of some of the
> early teachers of the Faith. The faith that
> animated these heroes animates the
> present-day followers of Bahti'u'lltih who
> truly love Him, he said.
> 
> Dr. and Mrs. Giachery paid a visit to the
> children's classes during the conference. The
> visit was a source of immense mutual
> happiness. A concert was provided by
> Rouhanieh Golmohammadi, a soprano of
> exquisite voice, who presented prayers of
> Bahti'u'llah set to music by her gifted
> accompanist, Mr. Lasse Thoresen . On
> another occasion the North Star singing
> group performed.
> 116                                   THE BAHA't WORLD
> 
> Three weeks later more than 1,000 Bahti'{s
> assembled in the second Arctic conference
> which was held in Anchorage, Alaska situated
> almost directly across the North Pole from
> Helsinki.
> 
> The symbol adopted for the conference,
> consisting of the words 'Alaska Bahti'('
> superimposed on a map of Alaska backed by
> a nine-pointed star, served as the backdrop
> and also appeared on programmes, posters,
> folios and flight bags. The theme of the
> conference was 'From Strength to Strength'.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone
> read the message of the Universal House of
> Justice which reminded the assembled Bahti'(s
> that sixty years earlier 'Abdu'l-Bahti had
> summoned the North American believers to
> open the remote and inhospitable regions
> which form the climatic frontiers of the Arctic
> and the sub-Arctic.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause William Sears made it
> clear that divine bounties and bestowals are
> the reward of those who arise to serve. Other
> speakers included the Hand of the Cause John
> Robarts; Edna True and Velma Sherrill of the
> Continental Board of Counsellors in North
> America; and Hideya Suzuki of Japan, a
> member of the Continental Board of
> Counsellors in North-east Asia.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                              117
> 
> On the lighter side there was an abundance of
> good entertainment including native Indian
> and Eskimo dancing and songs by the
> Windflower group and the Jin-ai singers.
> 
> England Dan and John Ford Coley,
> internationally known popular entertainers,
> also performed and lovely songs were
> presented by the Shfraz group.
> 
> Afterwards, native believers, filled with the
> happy spirit generated by the conference,
> convened as the Bahti'( Native Council and
> expressed their wish to assume responsibility
> for teaching their own peoples, the Indians
> and Eskimos.
> 
> Paris, a city thrice visited by 'Abdu'l-Bahti,
> and one rich in memories of the early days of
> the Faith in the West, was the venue for the
> third conference.
> 118                                 THE BAHA 'f WORLD
> 
> Early in August 1976 Bahti'{s from all o'ver
> the world gathered at the official headquarters
> across the street from the Palais de Congres
> where the conference sessions were held.
> 
> The main auditorium proved not large enough
> to accommodate the Baha'fs who attended the
> conference. Arrangements had been made,
> however, for the believers who could not find
> seating in the main hall to watch the
> proceedings over closed-circuit television in
> adjacent rooms.
> 
> Amatu'l-Baha Ruf:ityyih Khtinum held a press
> conference at Hotel Meridien. Representatives
> of several newspapers and news services were
> present.
> 
> The conference officially opened on 4 August
> with the reading, by Amatu'l-Bahti Ruf:iiyyih
> Khanum, of the message of the Universal
> House of Justice. The message recalled the
> visits of'Abdu'l-Baha which 'alone outshine
> in historical importance anything in the long
> history of France'. The Secretary-General of
> the United Nations, Mr. Kurt Waldheim, sent
> a special message of greeting to the Bahti'ts
> assembled in Paris. 1
> 
> ' See p. 140 for text .
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                             119
> 
> At one session members of the National
> Spiritual Assemblies represented at the
> conference were asked to come to the
> platform. A total offifty-five National
> Spiritual Assemblies-almost half the world
> total-were represented.
> 
> Classes were held each morning for children
> between the ages of six and twelve and a
> nursery was provided for younger children.
> 
> The Kenyatta Centre in Nairobi was the site of
> the fourth of the eight conferences; it was held
> in October 1976.
> 
> As the friends assembled they were informed
> by the Hand of the Cause William Sears that
> at that very moment the Universal House of
> Justice was linked with them in prayer at the
> Holy Shrines.
> 120                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Mr. Sears then read the message of the
> Universal House of Justice which reminded
> the friends that the privileged continent of
> Africa, 'rich in cherished associations, has
> reached its present stage of growth through
> countless feats of heroism and dedication'.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause John Robarts, who
> returned to African soil to travel and teach
> after many years of service in the western
> hemisphere, spoke of the need to develop
> Baha'{ characteristics in our lives and to
> demonstrate unity in our communities.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Enoch Oligna and
> Mrs. Olinga are seen talking with Mrs . Valerie
> Allen and Miss Loava Carter during an
> intermission.
> 
> As in all conferences, entertainment was
> provided in abundance. A singing group from
> Swaziland is seen here.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                121
> 
> There are many different colours in
> Bahci'u'llcih's human flower garden as this
> view of the friends illustrates.
> 
> The fifth conference was held in October 1976
> in Hong Kong. Present were Bahci'is from
> thirty-nine countries. Among those in
> attendance were three Hands of the Cause and
> representatives of twenty-one National
> Spiritual Assemblies.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause 'A li-Akbar Furutan
> read the message of the Universal House of
> Justice: ' What an imperishable glory has been
> bestowed upon the people of Asia, the first to
> be illumined by the rays of God's Faith, the
> first recipients of His Call and the first
> promoters of His Cause ...
> 
> . .. This great continent contains within its
> boundaries the heart of the Faith and its
> Cradle, the lands wherein its Founders toiled
> and suffered, and not only the great majority
> of the human race, but the great majority of
> the followers of Bahci'u' llcih .. . '
> 122                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Raf:zmatu'llah Muhtijir
> pointed out that it was especially fitting that
> this meeting be held in Hong Kong;
> approximately a century ago Mirza
> Muf:zammad 'A[{ Afnan, a cousin of the
> blessed Bab, arrived in Hong Kong, the first
> Baha'i to reside in China.
> 
> Children's classes were held each day and the
> children presented a programme at one of the
> conference sessions.
> 
> Although it was a relatively small conference it
> was truly, as one delegate described it, 'a
> spiritual banquet'.
> 
> Prior to the opening of the conference in
> Auckland in January 1977 the Baha'fs were
> given a tradional Maori welcome at the
> Orakei Marae. The Maoris paid homage to
> God and expressed the belief that the rain
> which commenced half-way through the
> ceremony was a good omen, assuring all of
> God's presence.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                            123
> 
> The conference was held in the Auckland
> Town Hall. Between four and five hundred
> guests attended the public meeting at which the
> guest speaker was Dr. Peter Khan of the
> Continental Board of Counsellors in
> Australasia.
> 
> The Prime Minister of New Zealand, the Hon.
> Robert D. Muldoon (left), welcomed the
> Bahd'is to his country and expressed his
> appreciation and respect for the principles of
> the Faith.
> 
> A choir, sixty-strong, charmed the audience
> with a presentation of excerpts from The
> Seven Valleys which had been set to music by
> Mr. Russ Garcia.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Abu'l-Qtisim Faizi, as
> the representative of the Universal House of
> Justice, read its message which was addressed
> to the 'spiritual heirs' of the Hands of the
> Cause Hyde and Clara Dunn 'who in direct
> response to the Tablets of the Divine Plan
> forsook their home and went to pioneer in
> Australia .. .'
> 124                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone
> made a stirring call for pioneers. By the end of
> the conference forty-nine pioneers and fifty -six
> travelling teachers had arisen.
> 
> Teatro Castro Alves was the scene of the
> seventh conference; it was held in Salvador,
> Bahia, Brazil during the last week of January
> 1977. In attendance were 1,300 Bahd'fs
> representing five continents, thirty-seven
> countries and seventeen indigenous tribes.
> 
> The first session was opened by the Governor
> of the State of Bahia, Professor Roberto
> Santos (right), shown here with a delegation
> of Bahd'(s: Mrs. Margot Worley, Counsellor
> Mas'ud Khams{, the Hand of the Cause
> Enoch Olinga, Mrs. Olinga and Mr.
> Enayatollah Vahdat.
> 
> Mr. Olinga read the message of the Universal
> House of Justice: 'How truly fitting ... that
> this auspicious conference have its venue in
> the city of Bahia, singled out for special
> mention by 'Abdu'l-Bahd in His Tablets of the
> Divine Plan . . .'
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                             125
> 
> The assembled friends were reminded that
> Leonora Holsapple Armstrong of the
> Continental Board of Counsellors in South
> America had settled in Bahia just two years
> after the indomitable Martha Root visited
> many important centres in South America in
> 1919.
> 
> One of the highlights of the conference was
> the address by the Hand of the Cause Paul
> Haney who spoke about the spiritual meaning
> of the erection of the Seat of the Universal
> House of Justice. Mr. Habib Taherzadeh
> described the progress made toward its
> construction.
> 
> Mr. Haney and Mr. Olinga participated in the
> news conference together with Dr. Victor de
> Araujo, representative of the Bahd'{
> International Community at the United
> Nations. Excellent publicity was obtained,
> with coverage by nine television and seven
> radio programmes in addition to articles in the
> press.
> 
> The Bahia conference which brought together
> in unity people of many nations and races will
> surely exert a beneficial effect upon the
> Bahd'is of the great continent of South
> America.
> 126                                 THE BAHA't WORLD
> 
> The conference held in February 1977" in
> Merida, Yucatan, Mexico was held in an
> outdoor setting under a canopy in Carta Clara
> gardens. It was the second largest conference
> of the series with more than 2,000 in
> attendance.
> 
> Bahd'(s from forty-four countries assembled
> under the canopy for the opening of the
> programme.
> 
> Among those in attendance were
> representatives of thirty-two indigenous tribes
> of North, South and Central America and the
> Caribbean.
> 
> The Hon. Dr. Francisco Luna Kan, Governor
> of Yucatan, was introduced to the conference
> by the Hand of the Cause Paul Haney . Dr.
> Kan, a Mayan, welcomed the Bahti'fs to
> Merida.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                              127
> 
> Mr. Haney then read the message of the
> Universal House of Justice. It said, in part:
> 'The convening of this conference ... in the
> capital city of a state that was once an
> important part of a great Indian empire,
> provides a unique opportunity to initiate what
> may well become the widespread reawakening
> of a people whose ancestors more than 1,200
> years ago developed one of the most brilliant
> pre-Columbian civilizations known to modern
> man ...
> 
> The Hands of the Cause Enoch Olinga and
> Raf:zmatu'lltih Muhtijir addressed the
> conference as did Mrs. Florence V. Mayberry,
> a member of the International Teaching
> Centre.
> 
> Close by, in a thatched pavilion, a book and
> audio-visual display was maintained
> throughout the conference.
> 
> More than two hundred Bahti'[s arose to
> pioneer and to travel and to teach.
> 128                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Helsinki, Anchorage, Paris, Nairobi, Hong
> Kong, Auckland, Bahia, Merida-names,
> places and associations to be cherished in the
> memories of the thousands who attended these
> conferences.
> 
> How vast is the tabernacle of the Cause of
> God! Bahti'u'llah has revealed. It hath
> overshadowed all the peoples and kindreds of
> the earth, and will, erelong, gather together
> the whole of mankind beneath its shelter . ..
> 
> . . . Thy day of service is now come.
> Countless Tablets bear the testimony of the
> bounties vouchsafed unto thee ...
> 
> . .. Arise for the triumph of My Cause, and,
> through the power of thine utterance, subdue
> the hearts of men.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                               129
> 
> 2. MESSAGES OF THE UNIVERSAL
> HOUSE OF JUSTICE TO THE EIGHT
> INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCES
> 
> A . TO THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCE IN HELSINKI, FINLAND
> 5-8 July 1976
> 
> WITH eager hearts we hail the convocation            growth was reached with the Nine Year Plan
> of this first of the twin Arctic conferences inau-   and the convocation of the North Atlantic congurating the series of eight international Baha'i    ference in Reykjavik, which marked the openconferences to be held during the middle part        ing of a new phase in the collaboration between
> of the Five Year Plan. The northern regions of       the northern communities on both sides of that
> the world were alluded to by Baha'u'llah in the      ocean.
> Kitab-i-Aqdas, the Mother Book of this Reve-            Only thirty-eight years have passed since
> lation. Their names were recorded in the Tab-        Viiino Rissanen , the first Baha'i in Finland,
> lets of the Divine Plan by the pen of 'Abdu'l-       accepted with radiant heart the life-giving mes-
> Baha, Who, in one of His other Tablets, suppli-      sage brought to him by Josephine Kruka , the
> cated God to 'raise up sanctified, pure and          'Mother of Finland' , in July 1938, and now the
> spiritual souls in the countries of the West and     city of Helsinki, the seat of the National
> the territories of the North, and make them signs    Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Finland, is
> of His guidance, ensigns of the Concourse on         the scene of an international Baha'i conference
> High and angels of the Abhli Kingdom.' These         whose deliberations are focused on the diffulands received the constant attention of Shoghi      sion of the light of God's Faith throughout the
> Effendi, who repeatedly urged the friends to         entire Arctic and sub-Arctic regions of the
> carry the Faith to their uttermost inhabited         world.
> areas, and who joyfully announced every
> advance of the Baha'fs that established a centre
> closer to the North Pole.
> Already touched by the morning light of
> God's Cause by the nineteen-twenties, the
> lands of the North were blessed by visits from
> the indomitable Martha Root, whose love
> warmed and encouraged the hearts of the
> handful of believers then labouring in a few
> scattered centres in Scandinavia and illumined
> the soul of H6lmfrfour Arnad6ttir, Iceland's
> first Baha'i. Bursting into blossom under the
> impact of the rays of the second Seven Year
> Plan, these communities received a major
> impetus from the Ten Year Crusade, of which
> the European campaign was launched at the
> never-to-be-forgotten conference in Stockholm in 1953, and which established centres as
> far north as Thule in Greenland and Sassen in         Mr. Viiin6 Rissanen (1909-1973), the first
> the islands of Spitzbergen. Yet another stage of           in Finland to become a Baha'i.
> 130                                     THE B A HA'I WORLD
> 
> The followers of the Blessed Perfection             Baha'u'llah of increasing numbers of the
> gathered in H elsinki must direct their attention      Eskimo, Lapp and Gipsy people.s ; and the purto the urgent tasks of the second half of the          suit of the vital and challenging objectives of
> Five Year Plan: to the re-opening of Spitz-            the Plan beyond the frontiers of their homebergen; the winning of the thirty-four Local           lands .
> Spiritual Assemblies still to be formed in                It is our fervent prayer at the Threshold of
> Greenland, Iceland,         Norway, Swede n,           Baha'u'llah that this conference will produce
> Denmark and Finland; the acceleration of the           an upsurge of Baha'i activity throughout the
> translation and publication of Baha'i litera-          northern lands and in the islands of the North
> ture; the forging of still closer links of collab-     Sea and the Baltic that will outshine every
> oration with the Baha' i communities of                achievement made in those promising regions,
> Alaska, Canada and in the continent of                 and be an inspiration to your fellow-believers
> Europe; the enlistment under the banner of             in every country of the world.
> 
> B. TO THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCE IN ANCHORAGE, ALASKA
> 23-25 July 1976
> 
> Sixty years ago 'Abdu'l-Baha summoned the          divine rose garden and a heavenly paradise'.
> valiant North American believers to open the           Iceland, specifically mentioned by 'Abdu'lremote and inhospitable regions which form             Baha in the Tablets of the Divine Plan, was
> the climatic frontiers of the Arctic and the           opened and consolidated, and has, through the
> sub-Arctic. The full implementation of His             warm response of its inhabitants to the Call of
> wish had to be postponed for some years, until ,       God, undoubtedly become one of the shining
> under the leadership of His beloved grandson,          beacons of the 'lights of the Most Great Guidwell-grounded administrative bases were estab-         ance' in the North.
> lished from which Baha'i crusaders could set              As a result of these movements and orgaout in conquest of these prized and virgin lands.      nized activities, the call of the Kingdom reached
> As early as 1915, however, we see a first          'the ears of the Eskimos', and the divine spark
> wave of itinerant teachers and short-time set-         was struck in their lands. Praise be to God,
> tlers directing their steps towards Alaska in an       today there are many who justly belong to the
> attempt to open it to the light of Baha'u'llah.        rank of heroes from among that noble race,
> This was followed by a second wave of deter-           and whose hearts are burning with His love.
> mined pioneers and spiritual conquerors who,          Upon the zeal and endurance of these enkinever since the first Seven Year Plan, demon-           dled believers will depend the early fulfilment
> strated their exemplary enthusiasm and caused         of the Master's glowing promises. The teaching
> 'the breezes of the love of God' to 'perfume the       work among the Indians of the northern lands
> nostrils ofthe inhabitants' of that 'vast country' .   of the Western Hemisphere has likewise borne
> In Canada, in response to the Master's call , a       rich fruit, as tribe upon tribe has been enlisted
> succession of homefront pioneers settled and          under the banner of Baha'u'llah. Whether in
> opened the length and breadth of their land, so        Alaska's south-eastern islands and rugged
> rich in promise 'whether from a material or            mountains, or in Canada's huge Indian
> spiritual standpoint', and whose destiny is to          reserves from the west to the east, many
> 'become the object ofthe glance of Providence'.        Amerindian believers have arisen to serve the
> To the fringes of Greenland North American             Cause, and through their joint efforts, their
> and European pioneers brought the light of            sacrificial endeavours and distinctive talents
> God's Faith, and provided the means for the            they bid fair to accelerate the dawn of the day
> fire of His love to be kindled in that land, in        when they will be so 'enlightened that the whole
> anticipation of the day when it will become 'a        earth will be illumined'.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA ' f ACTIVITIES                              131
> Many are the goals which now challenge the       promised glories of the future, is a mightier
> peoples of the North under the Five Year Plan:      effort by every supporter of the Most Great
> encouraging and educating the children and          Name in those climes to increasingly deepen
> stimulating and guiding the youth; a wider par-     themselves in the teachings, to pour forth their
> ticipation of women in Baha'i services; a grea-     substance in the path of His love, to resolve to
> ter assumption by the indigenous inhabitants        conform their personal lives to the high stanof these regions of responsibilities in the lead-   dards set in His teachings, and to undertake
> ership and administration of the community; a       more daring tasks however great the sacrifice,
> bolder proclamation of the Faith by radio and       and more extensive travels however .arduous
> television ; and a more far-flung and intensified   the voyage. In this wise will they draw nearer to
> campaign of teaching, audaciously conceived         the Spirit of Baha'u'llah and become true and
> by National Spiritual Assemblies and their          radiant signs of His Most Great Guidance.
> agencies and vigorously executed by Local           These are the tasks! This is the work!
> Spiritual Assemblies and individual believers,        We pray at the Sacred Threshold that the
> aiming at a vast increase in the number of          Baha'ls of the North may in the not-too-distant
> adherents to the Faith from every segment of        future transform the Arctic into that spiritual
> society, a multiplication of Baha'i administra-     rose garden and heavenly paradise longed and
> tive instututions, and a richer and more diverse    yearned for by' Abdu'l-Baha, and that its peorange of publications in all media. What will set   ples may be bountifully blessed and lovingly
> the seal on the success of the Plan and pave the    guided in their selfless services to promote the
> way for the long-awaited and divinely-              Faith of Baha'u'llah.
> 
> c. TO THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCE IN PARIS
> 3-6 August 1976
> 
> The brilliance of Paris in the story of Euro-    which has contributed so richly to the unfoldpean civilization bids fair to be renewed with      ment of American civilization; the fountaineven greater splendour during the Day of the        head of American culture; the mother of Chris-
> Lord of Hosts and the establishment of God's        tendom, and the scene of the greatest exploits
> Kingdom on earth. The annals of Paris in this       of the followers of Jesus Christ', and experienc-
> Day have already acquired eternal lustre from       ing 'the first stirrings of that spiritual revoluevents of mightier import, of greater universal     tion' which must culminate in the permanent
> significance and more sacred character than         establishment throughout its diversified lands
> any which its past history has witnessed. The       of the divinely ordained Order of Baha'u'llah.
> visits of 'Abdu'l-Baha, the Centre of God's         This first centre was rapidly reinforced by the
> inviolable Covenant, alone outshine in histori-     conversion of the first English believer and of
> cal importance anything in the long history of      the first Frenchman to accept the Faith-the
> France, and are immortalized in the greatly-        distinguished Hippolyte Dreyfus, whose 'preloved collection of His discourses given in that    eminent role' it was to kindle 'the torch which
> capital city. Beyond this, we recall with awe       is destined to shed eternal illumination upon
> and pride that it was at 'Abdu'l-Baha's instruc-    his native land and its people'-and by Laura
> tion that the illustrious May Maxwell suc-          Barney, whose 'imperishable service' was to
> ceeded in establishing in Paris the first Baha'i    transmit to posterity Some Answered Quescentre on the European continent, a continent       tions. The steadfastness and devotion of the
> described by Shoghi Effendi as 'the cradle of a     Paris Baha'i community during the dark and
> civilization to some of whose beneficent fea-       sombre days of the Second World War earned
> tures the Pen of Baha'u'llah has paid significant   great praise from the beloved Guardian of the
> tribute; on whose soil both the Greek and           Faith, while the recent signs of widespread and
> Roman civilizations were born and flourished;       effective teaching work throughout France
> 132                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> The first Baha'i group of Paris, circa 1902. Standing, left to right: Mlle. Bignardi, Herbert W.
> Hooper, Florence Robinson, Hippolyte Drefus, Bertha/in Luxow, C. M. Remey, an
> unidentified believer, Mme. MacKaye, Mme. Bignardi, Mlle. Stephanie Hanvais, Sydney
> Sprague. Seated, left to right: Miss Edith MacKaye, Miss Holzbecker, Miss Edith Sanderson,
> Sigurd Russell, Thomas Breakwell, May Ellis Bolles, Mme. Hanel, Miss Marie Watson.
> 
> lend wings to the hope that this veteran,           far and wide. It is my hope that this soul-stirring
> sorely-tested and steadfast community is about      melody of the Abhd Kingdom may also be
> to gather the harvest of those potent seeds         raised high in Paris, for Paris is tumultuous in
> sown and nourished so lovingly by 'Abdu'l-          all things. I pray the Almighty that the music and
> Baha.                                               singing of the beloved of God will be so loud
> It is highly propitious that this city, thrice   that the vibrations thereof may cause the limbs
> blessed by the presence of the Master, should       of Paris to quake. I await very joyful tidings
> be the scene of the first international Baha'i      from the friends in Paris. Unquestionably the
> conference in France and one of the eight           divine melody will in the future be raised in that
> international conferences to be held around         city, but I long that this may happen in these
> the world during the Five Year Plan. You are        days of the Covenant, and that you will be the
> gathered in this historic spot to deliberate on     enchanting songsters and the sweet-singing
> the fortunes of that Plan, to derive inspiration    nightingales of that land.'
> from the deeds performed there in the heroic           Our hopes are high and we pray at the Saage of our Faith and from your association          cred Threshold that from this conference will
> together, to rededicate yourselves to the ser-      surge throughout Europe a wave of such
> vice of Baha'u'llah and to determine each and       sacrificial teaching as will impel large numbers
> every one, how best you can promote the vic-        of its diverse and highly-talented peoples to
> tory of the Five Year Plan. We call to your         embrace the Faith of God and dedicate themattention 'Abdu'l-Baha's words:                     selves to the redemption of mankind under the
> 'The call of Ya Bahd'u'l-Abhd can be heard       glorious banner of the Prince of Peace.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                133
> 
> D. TO THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCE IN NAIROBI, KENYA
> 15-17October1976
> 
> The flames of enthusiasm which ignited the
> hearts of the followers and lovers of the Most
> Great Name in Helsinki, in Anchorage and in
> Paris are now being kindled in a city which
> occupies a central and envied position at the
> very cross-roads of the vast African mainland
> and are destined to illumine its horizons. This
> conference marking the imminent approach of
> the mid-way point of the Five Year Plan which
> coincides with the anniversary of the birth of
> the Blessed Bab, will no doubt go down in
> Baha'i history as a further landmark in the
> irresistible march of events which have characterized the impact of the Faith of God upon
> that continent.
> We recall that in addition to Quddus the only
> other companion of the Bab on His pilgrimage
> to Mecca was an Ethiopian , and that he and his
> wife were intimately associated with Him and
> His household in Shiraz. During the Ministry
> of BaM'u'llah a few of His stalwart disciples
> reached the north-eastern shores of Africa,
> and under His direct guidance, announced the            Mr. Robert Turner, 'disciple of 'Abdu'lglad tidings of the New Day to the people of the        Bahti', the first member of the black race in
> Nile, thus opening to the Faith two countries of          the West to embrace the Baha'i Faith.
> the African mainland. Soon afterwards, His
> blessed person approached those shores in the          Prior to the conclusion of the first Baha'i cencourse of His exile to the Holy Land. Still later      tury the number of countries opened to the
> He voiced His significant utterance in which           Faith had been raised to seven, and the teach-
> He.'compared the coloured people to the black          ing work among the black race in North
> pupil of the eye', through which 'the light of the     America had entered a new phase of developspirit shineth forth.' Just over six years after His   ment through the continuous guidance flowing
> ascension, the first member of the black race to       from the pen of Shoghi Effendi , who himself
> embrace His Cause in the West, who was des-            traversed the African continent twice from
> tined to become a disciple of 'Abdu'l-Baha, a          south to north , and who , in the course of his
> herald of the Kingdom, and the door through            ministry, elevated two members of the black
> which numberless members of his race were to           race to the rank of Hand of the Cause,
> enter that Kingdom, came on pilgrimage to the          appointed three more believers residing in
> Holy Land with the first group of Western              Africa to that high office, and there raised up
> friends who arrived in' Akka to visit the Centre       four National Spiritual Assemblies.
> of the Covenant. This was followed by a steady            At the beginning of the Ten Year Crusade
> extension of the teaching work among the               the number of countries opened to the Faith
> black people of North America, and the open-           had reached twenty-four, including those
> ing to the Faith , by the end of the Heroic Age,       opened under the aegis of the Two Year Afriof two more countries in Africa, under the             can Campaign co-ordinated by the British
> watchful care of the Master, Whose three visits        National Spiritual Assembly. The Ten Year
> to Egypt have blessed the soil of that continent.      Plan opened the rest of Africa to the light of
> 134                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> God's Faith, and today we see with joy and           and of the spiritual life of its individual believpride in that vast continent and its neighbour-      ers must gather greater momentum; the founing islands the establishment of four Boards of      dations of its existing Local Spiritual Assem-
> Counsellors, thirty-four National Spiritual          blies must be more speedily consolidated; the
> Assemblies-firm pillars of God's Administra-         number of local l:Ja~fratu'l-Quds and of local
> tive Order-and over 2,800 Local Spiritual            endowments called for in the Plan must be
> Assemblies, nuclei of a growing Baha'i society.      soon acquired; the Baha'i activities of women
> Africa, a privileged continent with a past rich   and of youth must be systematically stimuin cherished associations, has reached its pres-     lated; the Baha'i education of the children of
> ent stage of growth through countless feats of       the believers must continuously be encourheroism and dedication. Before us unfolds the        aged; the basis of the recognition that the
> vision of the future. 'Africa', the beloved          institutions of the Faith have succeeded in
> Guardian assures us in one of the letters writ-      obtaining from the authorities must steadily be
> ten on his behalf, 'is truly awakening and           broadened; mass communication facilities
> finding herself, and she undoubtedly has a           must be used far more frequently to teach and
> great message to give, and a great contribution      proclaim the Faith; and the publication and
> to make to the advancement of world civiliza-        dissemination of the essential literature of the
> tion. To the degree to which her peoples accept      Faith must be given much greater importance.
> Baha'u'llah will they be blessed, strengthened       Above all it is imperative that in ever greater
> and protected.'                                      measure each individual believer should real-
> The realization of this glorious destiny          ize the vital need to subordinate his personal
> requires that the immediate tasks be worthily        advantages to the over-all welfare of the
> discharged, and the pressing challenges and          Cause, to awaken and reinforce his sense of
> urgent requirements of the Five Year Plan be         responsibility before God to promote and prowholeheartedly and effectively met and               tect its vital interests at all costs, and to renew
> satisfied. As the forces of darkness in that part    his total consecration and dedication to His
> of the world wax fiercer , and the problems          glorious Faith, so that, himself enkindled with
> facing its peoples and tribes become more criti-     the flames of its holy fire, he may, in concert
> cal, the believers in that continent must evince     with his fellow-believers, ignite the light of
> greater cohesion, scale loftier heights of hero-     faith and certitude in the hearts of his family,
> ism and self-sacrifice and demonstrate higher        his tribe, his countrymen and all the peoples of
> standards of concerted effort and harmonious         that mighty continent, in preparation for the
> development.                                         day when Africa's major contribution to world
> During the brief thirty months separating us      civilization will become fully consummated.
> from the end of the Plan, Africa must once              We fervently pray at the Holy Shrines that
> again distinguish itself among its sister conti-     these hopes and aspirations may soon come
> nents through a vast increase in the number of       true, and that the ' pure-hearted' and 'spirituits believers, its Local Spiritual Assemblies and    ally receptive' people of Africa may draw ever
> its localities opened to the Faith, and by           nearer to the spirit of Baha'u'llah, and may
> accelerating the process of entry by troops          become shining examples of self-abnegation,
> throughout its length and breadth . The              of courage and of love to the supporters of the
> deepening of the faith, of the understanding         Most Great Name in every land .
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                135
> E. TO THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCE IN HONG KONG
> 27-30 November 1976
> 
> With grateful and joyous hearts we extend         that continent to the life-giving, all-embracing
> our warmest greetings and express our highest        Message of Baha'u'llah. Such plans must prohopes to the followers of Baha'u'llah gathered,      vide opportunities for those thousands who in
> at this critical point of the Five Year Plan, in     recent years have swelled the rank and file, as
> this conference on Asia's eastern shore. This        well as for those veterans who have, for so
> great continent has nourished mighty civiliza-       many years, striven in the path of service to the
> tions; above its horizons the suns of major          Cause. It is through active participation of
> Revelations of God have risen; on its soil many      more and more new believers in both teaching
> of the heroes of this New Age have shed their        and administration that the consolidation of
> blood and offered their lives in token of their      the Baha'i community can best be achieved.
> love for Him Who is the Beloved of the World            In a continent so richly endowed, so greatly
> and the Desire of the Nations.                       blessed, new generations of Baha'is must con-
> What an imperishable glory has been be-           tinually be raised up, trained from childhood in
> stowed upon the people of Asia, the first to be      the school of the love of God, and nurtured
> illumined by the rays of God's Faith, the first      under the shadow of His Cause. Baha'is in
> recipients of His Call and the first promoters of    every country must be constantly urged and,
> His Cause. Their spiritual capacity is extolled      wherever necessary, assisted to pass on to their
> and the great role they are destined to play in      children as their most cherished legacy, the
> the strengthening of the foundation of the New       precious Faith they themselves have
> World Order of Baha'u'llah unhesitatingly            embraced. Those new generations of Baha'is
> affirmed by' Abdu'l-Baha in His Tablets of the       will have a vital role in consolidating the Cause
> Divine Plan .                                        of God on a firm foundation.
> This great continent contains within its             The establishment of Local Assemblies as
> boundaries the heart of the Faith and its Cra-       the basic administrative unit of the World
> dle, the lands wherein its Founders toiled and       Order of Baha'u'llah and as rallying points for
> suffered, and not only the great majority of the     the Baha'is of every community should, in
> human race but the great majority of the fol-        accordance with the objectives of the Five
> lowers of Baha'u'llah. The potentiality of such      Year Plan, be multiplied no matter at what cost
> a situation cannot be underestimated, nor must       of effort and endurance. The process of
> the great force latent within so large a propor-     invigorating the Local Assemblies requires,
> tion of the Army of Light be neglected. They         during the Five Year Plan, the consultation of
> must be mobilized to accelerate the expansion        all the institutions of the Cause.
> of the beloved Cause, to consolidate its vic-           Publication of literature in many languages
> tories, to enhance its prestige and to augment       as part of a determined campaign to win
> its influence. We appeal to every participant in     thousands upon thousands of diverse peoples
> this historic conference to become conscious of      in all spheres of life must be vigorously purthese tremendous but hidden potentialities           sued. Participation of all believers in supportwhich, if properly tapped and directed, can          ing the Baha'i funds, the life-blood of the
> hasten the process of the spiritualization of the    Cause, must be given adequate attention, and
> nations of Asia, the influence of which will         the blessings which reward the act of voluntary
> extend far beyond the confines of that conti-        giving for the promotion of the Faith, no matnent-even to the entire planet.                      ter how small the amount may be, must be
> We eagerly await news that from this confer-      lovingly and wisely explained.
> ence will surge throughout Asia a wave of vig-          May this conference become a landmark in
> orous activity devoted to the execution on the       the process of attracting vast numbers of the
> individual, local and national levels of system-     great Chinese race scattered throughout the
> atic plans designed to attract the great masses of   world. May it be a prelude to the unpre-
> 136                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> cedented expansion of the Faith in all the coun-     the Cause of God itself, the believers will not
> tries of Asia. May it become a source of             waver or become diverted from their course,
> strength to the supporters of the Most Great         but be ever more confirmed in their determina-
> Name so that despite the rising tide of trials and   tion to raise the edifice of the Faith of God as
> upheavals afflicting the world, and whatever         the last bastion of hope to a lost and wayward
> forces of opposition may be mounted against          humanity.
> 
> F. TO THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCE IN AUCKLAND, NEW ZEALAND
> 19-22 January 1977
> 
> With hearts full of love and admiration for       and the number of localities where Baha'is
> the followers of the Most Great Name in              reside in this vast oceanic area covering well-
> Australasia we send our warmest greetings to         nigh one-eighth of the earth's surface is more
> all assembled in this historic gathering in the      than 1,800. These accomplishments doubtheart of the Antipodes.                              less have been a source of great joy to the
> How great is your place in Baha'i history!        immortal soul of Shoghi Effendi, whose esteem
> How bright are the prospects for the future of       and affection for the followers of Baha' u'llah
> the Cause so lovingly nurtured for more than         labouring for His Cause in the Antipodes was
> half a century by hundreds of stalwart steadfast     frequently expressed in glowing terms in his
> believers, spiritual heirs of Hyde and Clara         letters to the Assemblies and friends in
> Dunn, who in direct response to the Tablets of       Australasia.
> the Divine Plan forsook their home and went             Dear friends , we have now passed the midto pioneer in Australia, and whose names             point of the Five Year Plan. You are met in the
> Shoghi Effendi wrote, were 'graven in letters of     beautiful city of Auckland to take stock and to
> gold' upon his heart. In March 1951, when in         make plans for attaining the victories which
> the entire Pacific area there was but one            will surely be yours .
> National Spiritual Assembly, the beloved                The National Spiritual Assemblies of the
> Guardian predicted that 'The prizes destined         New Hebrides and of the Marshall Islands are
> for the heroic warriors, battling for the Cause      to be raised up next Ric;lvan; plans for the
> of Baha'u'llah throughout the Southern               soon-to-be-erected Mashriqu' l- Adhkar of
> Hemisphere, and particularly Australasia, are        Samoa are in process; but although the goal of
> glorious beyond compare . The assistance to be       establishing Baha'i centres totalling 2,188 is
> vouchsafed to them from on high in their strug-      within easy reach, the Local Assembly goals
> gle for its establishment, its recognition and       assigned to each national community, totalling
> triumph is ready to be poured forth in astonish-     613, need prompt and decisive attention . The
> ing abundance.'                                      divine assistance spoken of by the beloved
> Now, twenty-five years later, the achieve-        Guardian in 1951 has ever been available, and
> ments are truly astounding . Begif!ning with the     is still ' ready to be poured forth in astonishing
> establishment of the National Spiritual              abundance ' . It is within your power during the
> Assembly of the Baha'fs of New Zealand at            coming year to win all assigned teaching goals,
> Ric;lvan 1957, the number of National Assem-         leaving the final year of the Plan for consolidablies has increased elevenfold; the Mashriqu'l-      tion and the winning of supplementary vic-
> Adhkar of the Antipodes has been erected             tories.
> near Sydney; His Highness Malietoa                      This will be achieved, not by resting on
> Tanumafili II of Western Samoa has become            laurels , but by manifesting those qualities of
> the first reigning monarch to embrace the            faith, judgment, vision, loyalty, courage and
> Cause of Baha'u'llah; the number of Local            self-sacrifice which earned the Guardian's
> Spiritual Assemblies now stands at over 360;         praise so frequently in past decades. Let the
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                              137
> 
> John Henry Hyde Dunn and Clara Dunn who established the Bahd'{ Faith in Australia in
> 1920. Mr. and Mrs. Dunn were appointed Hands of the Cause in 1952.
> 
> valiant Australasian Baha'i communities vie        South Pacific. Let those who can offer their
> once more with their sister communities            valued services to the teaching work arise
> throughout the world for the palm of victory       without delay; let those who cannot travel or
> and maintain their position in the vanguard of     pioneer deputize those who can go in their
> the Army of Light.                                 stead.
> Pioneers, travelling teachers a nd a fresh          We cherish the highest hopes for the success
> outpouring of funds are essential ingredients to   of your endeavours and it is our constant
> the onward march of the Cause throughout           prayer that Baha'u'llah will shower His richest
> Australia, New Zealand and the islands of the      blessings and confirmations upon you.
> 
> G. TO THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCE IN BAHIA, BRAZIL
> 27-30 January 1977
> 
> With joyous hearts we hail the convocation      tant cities in South America. Two years later
> of this first of the twin Latin American confer-   Leonora Holsapple Armstrong, mother of the
> ences closing the series of eight international    Baha'ls of Brazil, settled in Bahia. The teach-
> Baha'i conferences held during the midway          ing work in the continent progressed steadily to
> period of the Five Year Plan.                      the point where, in 1937, the beloved Guar-
> The ringing call of Baha'u'llah in His Most     dian launched his first Seven Year Plan paving
> Holy Book to the Rulers of America and the         the way for the raising in subsequent Plans of
> Presidents of the Republics therein was fol-       the institutions ofBaha'u'llah's Administrative
> lowed after an interval of more than four          Order in every one of its republics and in its
> decades by the revelation of 'Abdu' l-Baha's       islands. It was in the course of that first Seven
> Tablets of the Divine Plan in which the beloved    Year Plan that 'Abdu'l-Baha's beloved hand-
> Master stressed the importance of the Repub-       maid, May Maxwell , in 1940 won a martyr's
> lics of the South American Continent.              crown when she laid down her life in Argen-
> The first believer to respond to 'Abdu'l-       tina, thereby adding further lustre to the
> Baha's divine call was that star-servant of the    spiritual history of South America.
> Cause of Baha'u'llah, valiant, indomitable            How truly fitting, then, that this auspicious
> Martha Root, who in 1919 visited many impor-       conference have its venue in the city of Bahia,
> 138                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Mrs. Leonora Holsapple Armstrong, mother of the teaching work in South America.
> 
> singled out for special mention by 'Abdu'l-           accompanied by a continuous programme of
> Baha in His Tablets of the Divine Plan. And           translation of the Sacred Text into the major
> how timely it is at this crucial point in the Five    indigenous languages of the continent.
> Year Plan that the friends gathered in Bahia             The continental goals for South America of
> from many lands prayerfully consider, and             8,670 centres and 2,293 Local Spiritual
> arise to prosecute expeditiously, all measures        Assemblies must be won, and may even be
> aimed at achieving glorious victory in all goals      surpassed, for every country must achieve the
> of the Plan.                                          goals assigned to it. This calls for the dedicated
> Noteworthy progress has been achieved in           effort of every National Spiritual Assembly,
> many fields of service throughout the South           every Local Spiritual Assembly and indeed
> American Baha'i community, particularly in            every believer. All the divinely ordained
> attracting to the Cause large numbers of its          instruments of the Administrative Order of
> indigenous peoples. But myriads of pure-              Baha'u'llah must now unite in executing a
> hearted souls have not yet heard the clarion          symphony of victory in all the unfinished goals
> call of Baha'u'llah and hungrily await the            of the Five Year Plan , winning thereby the
> spiritual nourishment that only His followers         good-pleasure of the Blessed Beauty.
> can give them.                                            Beloved friends, go forward with complete
> Steps must be taken to attract members of          assurance that a continent so rich in spiritual
> every stratum of society to the divine circle of      promise, so diverse in its peoples and races, so
> the Faith through effective proclamation and          fertile for the planting of the seeds of Baha'-
> teaching. Greater utilization of radio broad-         u' llah's Faith will yield a brilliant harvest for
> casts is necessary, not only to reach all levels of   all who labour in that Divine Vineyard.
> society but also to deepen the believers them-            It is our fervent loving prayer at the Sacred
> selves. The valuable and dynamic services of          Threshold that Baha'u'llah's bountiful confirm-
> Baha'i youth must be multiplied in the fields of      ations and richest blessings may be showered
> pioneering and travel teaching. A far wider           upon you.
> dissemination of Baha'i literature must be
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i A C TIVITIES                             139
> 
> H.   TO THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CONFERENCE IN MERIDA , MEXICO
> 4-6 February 1977
> 
> With joyous hearts and eager anticipation             Praiseworthy indeed were these achievewe send warmest greetings to you the partici-         ments but the Baha'i communities of Central
> pants in the last of the eight great international    America and the West Indies must not be conteaching conferences marking the half-way             tent to rest on these laurels. The beloved
> point of the Five Year Plan .                         Guardian during the last months of his pre-
> The convening of this conference in the            cious life continually urged the friends of Latin
> Republic of Mexico , in the capital city of a state   America to pursue what he described as 'the
> that was once an important part of a g;eat            paramount task', the teaching work. How
> Indian empire, provides a unique opportunity          much more does that injunction apply today!
> to initiate what may well become the wide-            In less than thirty months, approximately 900
> spread reawakening of a people whose ances-           groups and isolated centres and over 400 Local
> tors more than 1,200 years ago developed one          Spiritual Assemblies must be added to those
> of the most brilliant pre-Columbian civiliza-         already existing in the mainland and island
> tions known to modern man. These present-             nations of Middle America!
> day descendants, many of whom have already               To accomplish this challenging task, intenembraced the Faith of Baha'u'llah and who             sive effort to attract new believers, be they
> consider the Yucatan Peninsula and the sea-           black, brown , red or white, from all strata of
> coast lowlands and rugged spine of mountains          society , must be exerted. Hand in hand with
> joining North and South America to be their           this endeavour, particularly in local comhomeland, are among the very people men-              munities, goes the development of the distinctioned by 'Abdu'l-Baha in His Tablets of the          tive character of Baha'i life. Prompt attention
> Divine Plan as having a great destiny once they       must also be given to the acquisition of local
> have accepted His Father's Cause . Here too,          I:Ia'.?iratu'l-Quds and endowments; and the
> and throughout Middle America, are those              translation and publication of Baha'i literawhose forefathers came from the Iberian               ture, especially in indigenous languages, must
> Peninsula, Africa and the Far East linking the        be accelerated .
> Old with the New World .                                 Dear friends, if at the close of the Five Year
> Conscious of 'Abdu'l-Baha's impassioned            Plan we are to witness the ensigns of victory
> plea to promulgate the oneness of mankind to a        lifted high, the wholehearted support of the
> spiritually impoverished humanity, a handful          followers of Baha'u'llah must be enlisted now
> of itinerant Baha'i teachers set forth four           and their energies systematically channelled
> decades ago, traversed the land bridge con-           into areas most in need. We cherish the hope
> necting the two continents of the Western             that at this final conference the friends will
> Hemisphere and carried the healing Message            arise with enthusiasm and determination not
> of Baha'u'llah to the Spanish American                only to win the remaining goals of the Plan but
> Republics. Their dedicated efforts were               to carry out Shoghi Effendi's injunction to win
> rewarded when, in 1938, the first Local               the allegiance of members of the various tribes
> Spiritual Assembly in Latin America was               of American Indians to the Cause, thereby hasformed in Mexico City. This initial triumph at        tening the period prophesied by the Master
> the inception of the first of the teaching plans      when the Indian peoples of America would
> formulated by Shoghi Effendi spearheaded              become a source of spiritual illumination to the
> other victories leading to the formation of two,      world.
> then of four, Regional Spiritual Assemblies;             Our hearts, our hopes and our prayers will
> and ultimately to the establishment of National       be with you during all the days of your deliber-
> Spiritual Assemblies in each of the republics of      ations. May Baha'u'llah inspire each and every
> Latin America and in the islands of the Carib-        one of you.
> bean.
> 140                                          THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 3. MESSAGE 1 OF MR. KURT WALDHEIM,
> SECRETARY-GENERAL OF THE UNITED
> NATIONS, TO THE INTERNATIONAL
> BAHA'I CONFERENCE, PARIS,
> 3-6 AUGUST 1976
> 
> I  AM pleased to have this opportunity to wish               environment and employment, the United
> the International Baha'i Conference and all                  Nations must be able to rely on the support of
> those participating in it every success in their             the peoples of the world, who are the cornerwork. Non-governmental organizations such                    stone of its Charter. This implies an important
> as yours, by dealing comprehensively with the                responsibility for those organizations who, like
> major problems confronting the international                 you, work hard to support the United Nations
> community and striving to find solutions which               and the principles and objectives laid down in
> will serve the interests of all nations, make a              the Charter.
> very substantial and most important contribu-                   In recent years the United Nations has
> tion to the United Nations and its work.                     embarked upon an unprecedented collective
> We live in a world which is undergoing a                  endeavour to create global strategies to meet
> transformation in its attitude towards finding               problems that are beyond the power of any
> solutions to the great global challenges of the              single nation to resolve. Our task is now to
> day. We must strive to ensure, therefore, that               implement the decisions taken at the sixth and
> effective solutions come about, not in anger                 seventh special sessions of the General
> and anarchy, but through the reasoned and                    Assembly on the establishment of a new interconcerted determination of all. Whether the                  national economic order, as well as at the world
> object is to complete the great task of                      conferences on trade and development, envidevelopment, to secure respect for the rights                ronment, population, food, the role of women
> and dignity of all men, to halt the disastrous               in society, industrialization and human settlearms race, to solve such diverse and complex                 ments. In this respect, your own contribution
> problems as those of food, population, the                   as a non-governmental organization, in consul-
> 'The message was read in English and in French by Mr. Luc    tative status with ECOSOC, is important and I
> Van Bellinghen, Director of the United Nations Informa-     wish you every success in your deliberations.
> tion Centre in Paris, at the opening session on August 4.
> 
> '
> IV
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT
> BAHA'I ACTIVITIES
> 1976-1979
> I. SURVEY BY CONTINENTS
> BASED ON REPORTS OF THE CONTINENTAL
> BOARDS OF COUNSELLORS
> A.   AFRICA
> A TOT AL of eight new National Spiritual              During the period 1976 to 1979, which
> Assemblies were to be formed in Africa during      witnessed the closing phase of the global Five
> the Five Year Plan . Niger, Sierra Leone, Togo     Year Plan significant changes took place in
> and Upper West Africa were formed at Ric;lvan      Central and East Africa, both within the Faith
> 1975. At Ric;lvan 1977 Upper Volta was             and in the life of the component nations, which
> formed with its seat in Ouagadougou, and at        deeply affected the Faith. Many of the coun-
> Ric;lvan 1978 Mauritania was formed with its       tries of Africa have been passing through a
> seat in Nouakchott. The National Spiritual         period of intense social, political, and
> Assembly of Burundi, first established in 1969,    economic change with consequent transitions,
> was dissolved in 1972 and re-established in        upheavals and repercussions.
> 1978.                                                 In Uganda, in October 1977, the Amin
> For the purposes of the work of the Conti-       regime finally banned the activities of the
> nental Boards of Counsellors the continent of      Faith, causing the dissolution of the National
> Africa is divided into four zones:                 Spiritual Assembly and its 1,550 Local
> Central and East Africa                          Spiritual Assemblies. After almost exactly
> Northern Africa                                  nineteen months, the ban was lifted in April,
> Southern Africa                                  1979. The community has now begun the slow
> Western Africa                                   process of emergence, in circumstances still
> considerably adverse.
> Central and East Africa                        In Congo, also, the Faith has been banned
> The National Baha'i communities of Central       since February 1978 by the authority in power,
> and East Africa can be divided into three gen-     the Assemblies dissolved and the properties
> eral categories: (1) Those where the peoples       confiscated. In both Uganda and Congo these
> were spiritually very receptive, where mass        actions against the Faith were part of sweeping
> teaching began in the village areas some           moves against all religious communities except
> twenty-five years ago, and where such teaching     a tiny handful of the older, long-established
> has been sustained to a greater or lesser extent   Faiths.
> ever since; i.e., Uganda, Zaire, Kenya and            The larger Baha'i communities, some of
> Tanzania. (2) Those countries where mass           which had earlier suffered heavy loss of Local
> teaching began in later years and has so far       Spiritual Assemblies through their inability to
> developed to a relatively lesser extent:           consolidate the victories ofthe Nine Year Plan
> Ethiopia, Rwanda, Central African Republic         rapidly enough, pulled themselves together
> and Congo. (3) Those places where circum-          towards the close of the Five Year Plan and
> stances within the country have for some years     surged forward again, so that at the end of the
> not permitted the necessary freedom for mass       Plan the teaching and property goals for the
> teaching: Burundi, Djibouti, Gabon, Somalia        zone had been substantially exceeded and litand Sudan.                                         erature and other numerical goals achieved .
> 142                                      THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> However, the strains and problems which con-            cially important matter when the Baha'i Pubsolidation imposes on large and rapidly grow-           lishing Trust of Uganda was forced to cease
> ing Baha'i communities in developing coun-              operations. Likewise the acquisition and erectries prevented these communities from fully            tion, in those countries where freedom existed,
> achieving their vital consolidation goals. At the       of numerous local J:l~iratu'l-Quds and
> time this report is being written the national          endowments, has paved the way for improving
> communities are facing the considerable chal-           the life and activities of the local communities.
> lenge of rescuing their lost Assemblies.                It will perhaps be useful here to pinpoint indi-
> There are certain very positive signs of the         vidually the more outstanding achievements of
> over-all advance of the Baha'i community in             some of the national communities.
> Central and East Africa. Probably the most                 The Burundi Community, despite two
> significant of these has been the expansion and         periods in recent years when official recogniconsolidation of the institution of the Auxiliary       tion of the Faith was temporarily withdrawn
> Board and the development by the Board                  and the exodus from the country of over 90 per
> members of their use of assistants. This has            cent of the believers (Zalreois refugee Baha'is
> resulted in a fairly large number of believers          returning to their homes), has managed to
> working with concern, knowledge and growing             retain its recognition and to begin now the real
> experience at the 'grass roots' level of the            process of bringing the Burundian people to
> Cause. A parallel growth in strength has occur-         the Faith. The new National Spiritual Assemred in the Regional Teaching Committees with            bly was elected in 1978. Although little progwhom the Board members are in close collab-             ress could be made in fulfilling the property
> oration . Although the continuing problem of            goals of the Five Year Plan, the translation and
> lapsed Assemblies indicates that there is still         publication of literature in the Kirundi lanmuch to be done to assist the local com-                guage has been a noteworthy accomplishment.
> munities, it is clear that a definite start has been      In Central African Republic the Faith has
> made in the right direction.                           continued to make very steady progress. All
> Two other aspects of Baha'i activity showed         goals of the Five Year Plan were accomplished.
> strong development during this three-year              As in so many countries of this zone transporperiod. The first is the translation, publication      tation to and communication with the comand dissemination of much more literature in            munities in the interior are difficult and slow,
> the major vernacular languages of each coun-            and this has had a quite detrimental effect on
> try by the increasingly strong and able National        the consolidation and follow-up process.
> Literature Committees. This became an espe-             Although mass teaching is potentially quite
> 
> Conference of Counsellors and Auxiliary Board members.for Central and Easl Africa; 19-24
> October 1976. Front row, left to right: Anselme Nkouka, Selemani bin Kimbulu, Paul
> Hanbury, Ola Pawlowska, Javon Gutosi. Back Row, left lO righl: Counsellor Hushang
> Ahdieh, Counsellor Oloro Epyeru, Festus Shayo, E. Fananapazir, Festus Sunguti, Sadegh
> Eghtessadi, Louis Kalombo, H. Khodadad, Counsellor Kolonario Oule, Chowghi Rouhani,
> Counsellor Isobel Sabri.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA't ACTIVITIES                                  143
> possible, actual progress is relatively less in       local communities.
> relation to other countries. However, the                Tanzania is a land rich in spiritual potential.
> believers are growing in maturity and experi-         During the closing years of the Five Year Plan
> ence.                                                 it became clear that the teaching work could
> The Ethiopian Baha'i community has long            flourish and the community grow in size and
> been a shining light in this zone. For some time      strength. There had long been a problem crenow there have been no pioneers whatever in           ated by the fact that few pioneers were settled
> the country. The Ethiopian believers them-            in the interior of the country, but in the past
> selves are deep in knowledge and faith,               few years this pattern has been altered and
> devoted and sincere in service, mature and            there are now very helpful nuclei of pioneers
> capable in experience. They shoulder with             living in some of the provincial capitals.
> exemplary zeal and results the entire affairs of      Through their help and that of the Regional
> their community, including all of the financial       Teaching Committees, Auxiliary Board memrequirements. Mass teaching areas have been           bers and assistants, the grass roots of the comopened in several parts of the country and are        munity are coming to life . The community
> being developed with characteristic wisdom,           achieved all of its teaching, property and literaconsistency and practical common sense.               ture goals. A helpful contribution to this
> Despite the recent severe political upheavals         accomplishment was made by the numerous
> across the land, the community pursued the            Zafreois refugee Baha'is living along the
> Five Year Plan goals to success.                      shores of Lake Tanganyika, also by the believ-
> In Kenya there has been very reasonable            ers on the islands of Lake Victoria.
> progress in some aspects of the Plan: the teach-         In Zaire the Faith continues to grow and
> ing goals; acquisition of properties; publication     develop with remarkable speed and ease. The
> of vernacu lar literature; the deepening of indi-     believers of the Zaire Community have long
> vidual believers. This is a very large commun-        shown themselves to be self-reli ant, indepenity, however, where there is a perennial prob-        dent and capable. Their local community life is
> lem of lapsing Assemblies and where there is          well developed , with men , women , youth and
> critical need of strengthening at the grass roots .   children all taking a very active part. Many
> Opportunities exist for extensive public rela-        Local Spiritual Assemblies have e rected their
> tions activities both with the government and         own local .f:la~iratu'l-Quds and there are now,
> with the various United Nations Agencies rep-         in Kivu Province, sixty Baha'i schools, includresented there. During the International              ing many primary and some secondary. All
> Teaching Conference held in Nairobi in 1976           numerical goals of the Five Year Plan were
> there was good use made of the press,                 well accomplished and in some cases surpasradio and television , as well as extensive con-      sed. The acute transportation and communicatact with responsible individuals in this and         tion problems in Zaire make it essential that
> other fields of public life.                          the Regional Teaching Committees and the
> Rwanda is a country whose people have              Auxiliary Board members in every province be
> responded very well to the message of Baha'u-         in very clost: and effective collaboration, which
> 'llah. The teaching work has been quite suc-          they are. Zaire is a vast country where opporcessful and has resulted in entry to the Faith by     tunities for the growth of the Faith at this
> many family groups; so much so that the chi ld        period are almost limitless.
> and youth population of the Faith exceeds that           The crises that have deeply afflicted the
> of the adu lts. The National Spiritua l Assembly      Baha'i community in some countries of the
> and the pioneers have been exemplary in their         zone have served well to stimulate the believefforts for the translation a nd publication of       ers in other places to greater efforts, deeper
> Baha'i literature in the Kinyarwanda language.        devotion and more effective service. Though
> Deepening and consolidation is also being             the inevitable opposition is steadily mounting
> accomplished through the active services of the       and the problems impeding activity increasing,
> Auxiliary Board members and their assistants.         as living conditions spira l down a nd infl atio n
> The property goa ls of the Five Year Plan were        accelerates, the steadfastness of the sincere
> accomplished a nd the numerous Baha'i                 believers is daily being tested and abundantly
> Centres are being of considerable value to the        demonstra ted .
> 144                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Northern Africa                         of three to nine months and encouraged the
> believers to accomplish them. Another tried to
> The Baha'f communities of the countries           encourage universal participation and instil
> bordering the southern shores of the Mediter-        fresh spirit into the body of the believers by
> ranean Sea comprise the zone of the Continen-        organizing Love-and-Fellowship Picnics where
> tal Board of Counsellors in Northern Africa.         the Baha'fs and their friends gathered together
> The circumstances obtaining in some of these         and enjoyed a day of social fe llowship and
> territories is described under 'Constant Efforts     prayers. Teaching teams were sent out
> to Protect the Faith from Persecution and to         weekends, public holidays and some evenings
> Free it from the Restraints Imposed by Religi-       in many parts of Southern Africa . The idea of
> ous Orthodoxy' in the section relating to World      teaching in groups was favoured by a few reg-
> Centre goals on pp. 78-81.                           ions and this resulted in outstanding success for
> those who used the method. It not only
> Southern Africa                         increased the number of believers and Local
> Assemblies but provided vital opportunities
> Although day by day, in the period under          for local believers to participate in the actual
> review, new obstacles seemed to present the m-       teaching.
> selves until the point was reached, midway              Various National Spiritual Assemblies held
> through the Five Year Plan, when it seemed           unity feasts on a regional basis to encourage
> impossible in the two and-a-half years remaining     community development and to increase
> before its expiry to accomplish the remaining        teaching activities. 'Each one teach one' was
> two-thirds of the goals assigned to the believers    emphasized in one national community, resultin Southern Africa, the tide was yet turned, and     ing in an increase in the number of believers
> the Baha'fs with greater force than ever placed      and Local Assemblies. As an aid to developing
> their reliance in the power of Baha'u'llah and       Local Assemblies, visits of deepened believers
> the infallible guidance of the Universal House       were arranged. These visiting teachers, called
> of Justice. The doors of guidance and confirma-      'walkers', greatly aided the progress of the
> tion began to open one after another and             Cause in their assigned areas.
> restored hope, light, and promise of success to         There was a significant circulation of both
> all who were labouring in service to the Faith.      international and national travelling teachers
> Thereafter new victories were witnessed              during the period, crowned by the bounty of
> almost every day, causing the believers to           the visits of three Hands of the Cause of God,
> rejoice and redouble their efforts until the         Dr. RaJ:imatu'llah Muhajir, Mr. John Robarts
> goals were won. Invigorated by the encour-           and Mr. Collis Featherstone whose presence
> agement they received from the World Centre          lent impetus to the work of the Faith and lifted
> of their Faith and the guidance of their             the morale of the believers. Programmes of
> National Spiritual Assemblies, and aided by          one kind and another were arranged for each
> the splendid efforts of the Auxiliary Board          travelling teacher whose visits to the friends ,
> members and their assistants, the friends per-       especially in the rural areas, warmed the hearts
> formed such outstanding services toward the          of the friends and helped advance the work.
> accomplishment of the goals that a renewed           Southern Africa was blessed not only with
> spirit appeared in the body of the believers in a     receiving an abundant number of travelling
> greater measure than was ever seen before.            teachers from Europe, America and Asia but
> This spirit manifested itself in countless differ-    produced its own travelling teachers as well.
> ent forms to further the Cause of God.                Malawi, Swaziland, Rhodesia and South
> In some localities intensive teaching cam-         Africa sent teachers to their neighbouring sispaigns were organized during which Baha'f             ter communities. The efforts of the teachers of
> youth and others would remain in an area for a        African descent were especially successful.
> week or two. This method was used with par-              The Southern African zone has made conticular success in Reunion. Its use always            siderable progress in consolidation of its comresulted in greater participation by local Baba' -    munities, the deepening of individual believers
> fs in teaching and giving talks at meeting and        and in fostering active participation in adminisconferences. Some regions set short-term goals        trative activities. The deepening of believers is
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                               145
> 
> Friends attending the first Bahd'{ Summer School of Rhodesia; 28 August-I September 1977.
> a result of many wonderful and persistent          BUILT it! But we have no grass for the roof . . .
> efforts made in consolidation programmes by        we need help ... '
> the various national communities. This has           And again, the chairman of a Local Assembeen achieved through the holding of national ,
> bly in Lesotho, writing to his National Spiritual
> regional, and local conferences; study classes,
> Assembly, states:
> and institutes; correspondence courses (which
> have been a going thing for some time); use of     'We are happy to find this opportunity of writ-
> Baha'i cassettes; the showing of Baha'i films;     ing this letter to you to inform you about things
> regular visits of National Assembly members        taking place in our village. It is with deepest
> and Auxiliary Board members to the com-            sorrow that we Baha'ls of Liphaleng have to
> munities and friends; an increase in translation   tell you about the death of one member of ours
> and the production of Baha'i literature; youth,    who died on the 30th December, 1977 and was
> women and children' s conferences; and the         buried on the 31st.
> holding of winter and summer schools. Indeed       'The deceased was a true Baha'i member
> the holding of these schools has gradually         because even during his last days of illness
> caught on and contributes much toward heart-       although he was questioned a lot about this
> ening the believers not only through the knowl-    Faith and was advised to agree to be baptized
> edge gained but through the provision of fel-      ... he refused, pledging his support to the
> lowship in a Baha'i atmosphere.                    Baha'i Faith until the last day.
> It is difficult to measure the quality of       'Thus we also inform you that he was buried by
> deepening that has occurred to a lesser or grea-   the Baha'i members and only Baha'i prayers
> ter degree in various parts of the zone but        were said ... He was the first man here to be
> perhaps the following two quotations from          buried the Baha'i way. His name was Mokete
> reports of Assembly secretaries will illustrate    Morai.'
> the progress that has been made. In a report
> Other activities which took place during this
> from the Local Spiritual Assembly of Chitengu
> period and which met with some measure of
> we find:
> success were in the fields of proclamation and
> 'We are thinking to build our own Centre. We       publicity: interviews on the radio and in televihave already collected stones, we have already     sion; radio programs, especially in Seychelles;
> made bricks for the walls, we have already cut     newspaper articles and advertisements; the
> down trees for the roof, we have already           holding of United Nations Day programmes in
> bought frames for the doors, we have already       Mauritius, Swaziland, Seychelles and Zambia;
> bought nails for the roof, we have already         and exhibitions of Baha'i books, posters and
> 146                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> materials at various trade and agricultu ral fairs   and a foundation is laid upon which, through
> in Seychelles, Botswana, Zambia and Swazi-           the infallible guidance of the Universal House
> land . In April 1979 during the Easter period        of Justice and the love and sacrifices of the
> the Faith was proclaimed to over 10,000 peo-         present believers, the Faith of Baha'u'llah wi ll
> ple at the dedication of the Interdenomina-          be firmly established and will surely go from
> tional Church in Swaziland. The King, gov-           strength to strength.
> e rnment officials and many diplomats were
> also in attendance and heard the message of
> Western Africa
> Baha'u'llah.
> This record would be incomplete without the          The continental zone of West Africa is commention of prayers that have been said               prised of twenty-two countries, islands and terth rougho ut the zo ne for the success of the        ritories: Mauritania , Senegal, the Gambia,
> goals. Almost every national community               Guinea-Bissau, the Cape Verde Islands,
> arranged several days when believers espe-           Guinea, Mali, Sierra Leone, Liberia , Ivory
> cially united in prayer and meditation. Also,        Coast, Upper Volta, Niger, Ghana , Togo,
> many communities in each region began to             Benin, Nigeria, Chad, Cameroon, Equatorial
> gather at least one earl y mo rning a week for       Guinea, Gabon, Sao Tome and Principe.
> praye rs . In addition , the Continenta l Board of   When this zone was first created in 1975, the
> Counsellors, toward the latter part of the Five      Universal House of Justice spoke of 'the
> Year Plan , requested through the National           mighty potentialities for growth and expansion
> Assemblies that all believers in their zone          in the western regio ns of Africa.' Progress durrecite the Tablet of AQmad on Mondays.               ing these three years clearly indicated the vast
> The Baha'i Faith in Southern Africa during        possibilities of the region and the receptivity
> the past three yea rs has made tremendous            and spirituality of its peoples.
> progress. Not only are there thousands ofBaha' -
> is everywhere throughout the zone but there          Formation of New National Assemblies
> are man y silent teache rs in the form of local         During this period, two new National
> and national I:Ia?fratu'l-Quds which stand as a      Spiritual Assemblies joined the twelve existing
> living proof of the solidarity and strength of the   National Assemblies: the National Spiritual
> Faith a nd, indeed, are known as symbols of          Assembly of the Baha'fs of U pper Volta with
> unity all over the regions. Although we have         its seat in Ouagadougou in 1977 and the
> not achieved the strength toward which we            National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of
> strive, a ve ry humble beginning has been made       Mauritania with its seat in Nouakchott in 1978.
> 
> Baha'( Booth, Trade Fair, Gaborone, Botswana; July 1976. Mrs. Cynthia Komanyane,
> Auxiliary Board assistant, served as one of the hostesses for visitors to the booth.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                               147
> 
> Both national conventions were blessed by the       and Cameroon, counselled National Assempresence of Hands of the Cause of God, sent as      blies, addressed gatherings of the friends, dedispecial representatives of the Universal House      cated local centres, spoke at public meetings
> of Justice: Mr. Enoch Olinga to Upper Volta         and met with Auxiliary Board members and
> and Dr. 'Alf-MuJ:iammad Varga to Mauritania.        their assistants. He particularly stressed the
> Unfortunately, the National Spiritual             importance of contacting authorities and peo-
> Assembly of the Baha'fs of Niger was lost dur-      ple of influence in each country.
> ing this same period, when in 197 8 all                The visits of each of these Hands of the
> administrative activities ceased through cir-       Cause furthered the proclamation of the Faith,
> cumstances beyond our control.                      since radio interviews were often secured for
> them and a number of courtesy visits made to
> Recognition of the Faith in Gabon                   officials.
> Through the untiring efforts of Dr. 'Azfz
> N avfdi working under the guidance of the Uni-      Teaching
> versal House of Justice, the Faith was officially      Already by Ric;lv:l.n 1976 a marvellous
> recognized by the government of Gabon in            momentum toward achieving the teaching
> April 1978.                                         goals had been generated. Inspired by a suggestion from Dr. Muhajir on an earlier visit,
> Visits of Hands of the Cause of God                 many of the National Assemblies in the zone
> In addition to the presence of Mr. Olinga        had committed themselves to win their teachand Dr. Varga at the inaugural conventions of       ing goals by the Nairobi Conference in October
> Upper Volta and Mauritania, Mr. Olinga              1976. Though only the Ivory Coast was able to
> travelled briefly in Senegal and Mauritania         achieve its teaching goals by that date, Ric;lvan
> before attending the International Youth Con-       1977 saw six more countries, Benin, Chad, the
> ference in Abidjan in July 1976; and Dr.            Gambia, Sierra Leone, Togo and Upper Volta
> Muhajir in 1976 and 1978, and Mr. Feather-          not only achieve their teaching goals but adopt
> stone in 1979, travelled extensively in the         supplementary goals. By the end of the Plan
> zone. As always, these visits by the Hands of       almost all of these same countries had nearly
> the Cause 'diffused the divine fragrances' and      doubled the assigned goals and in the case of
> were a source of great joy and inspiration to the   Chad, more than doubled.
> friends.                                              Not every country found such quick and easy
> Prior to the Nairobi International Teaching      success. Cameroon, Ghana, and Nigeria had all
> Conference, the Hand of the Cause                   lost large numbers of Assemblies in the early
> RaJ:imatu'llah Muhajir visited, in August and       years of the Plan and they struggled to regain
> September 1976, Senegal, the Gambia, Sierra         their original positions before advancing to win
> Leone, Liberia, Ivory Coast, Ghana, Benin,          the assigned goals. In a number of countries,
> Togo, Nigeria and Cameroon. During the              wisdom necessitated that the teaching work
> course of his visit, he encouraged National         should proceed at a slower pace, and in still
> Assemblies to collaborate on border teaching        others, circumstances prevented achievement
> projects and to strive for entry by troops. In      of the assigned goals.
> addition to consulting with the institutions of        Throughout these years intensive teaching
> the Faith and the friends, Dr. Muhajir travelled    projects were organized, generally during the
> in each of these countries, visiting villages and   long vacation periods and often utilizing youth.
> demonstrating how to teach. In January 1978         One such project in Togo resulted in the for-
> Dr. Muhajir was again able to visit Cameroon        mation of eight new Assemblies and the openwhere he consulted with the institutions of the     ing of thirty-three new localities in a six-week
> Faith and assisted in teaching, deepening and       period.
> proclamation activities in several localities.         Highly receptive areas were found in almost
> The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone        every country of the zone, and in Cameroon,
> accompanied by his wife travelled in West           Chad, Ghana, the Gambia, Ivory Coast,
> Africa for the first time in January and Febru-     Nigeria, Togo and Upper Volta, the comary of 1979. Mr. Featherstone visited many          munities moved closer to the stage of entry by
> localities in Ghana, the Ivory Coast, Nigeria       troops. This was most evident when in a given
> 148                                  THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Conference of Counsellors for Western Africa, members ofthe National Spiritual Assembly of
> the Cameroon Republic, members of the Auxiliary Board and assistants; Buea, Cameroon; 9
> May 1976. Standing on the extreme left is Counsellor H. Ardekanf; fourth from the left, back
> row, Counsellor Z. Kazemi. Seated on the extreme left is Counsellor Mihd{ Samandari; third
> from right, Counsellor Thelma Kelghati; on the exteme right, Counsellor Friday Ekpe.
> area, new believers arose to carry the Faith to   were formed, eight the result of extension
> nearby villages, and the process again repeated   teaching.
> itself. For example, in the Ife and Port Harcourt areas in Nigeria the Faith spread rapidly   Consolidation
> by this method in a relatively short period of       Two important goals of the Plan were to
> time. In Chad at one point, the growth was so     develop the distinctive character of Baha'i
> rapid that from month to month ten new            community life and to consolidate the victories
> Assemblies would be formed.                       already won. Efforts were made to fulfil these
> During this period the Baha'i community        goals, but on the whole, progress was slow and
> became more diversified through the entry of      much remains to be done.
> new tribal groups and was spread more widely         The most commonly used method of workthroughout each country . In Nigeria, at least    ing with communities was for individual
> one Local Assembly was formed in each State.      believers to visit nearby villages on a regular
> During the last year of the Plan in a number   basis. These visits often included general meetof countries, full-time teachers, Auxiliary       ings of the friends, meetings with the Local
> Board members and assistants were used to         Assembly , assisting with children's classes or
> insure fulfilment of all the goals.               Nineteen Day Feasts, etc. Usually these efforts
> The Plan had called for Local Spiritual        were co-ordinated by the National Teaching
> Assemblies to assume a greater share in the       Committee and in the case of Benin, Chad,
> teaching work. As such, Local Assemblies          Liberia, Nigeria and Togo, by Regional Teachwere assigned extension teaching goals by the     ing Committees as well.
> National Spiritual Assembly or in the case of        In addition to these regular visits, an increasstronger Assemblies spontaneously adopted         ing number of regional and local institutes
> them. However, the percentage of Assemblies       were held, often in collaboration with Auxiliwhich actually carried out a programme of         ary Board members. Generally lasting one or
> extension teaching remained quite small.          two days, these institutes deepened the knowl-
> Where efforts were made, the results were         edge of the friends and kindled their love for
> truly heartening. For example, in February        the Faith. During the summer of 1978, a par-
> 1977 Ghana was so far behind in its goals that    ticularly successful series of four regional instithe situation seemed hopeless. The National       tutes was held in Ghana as a joint effort of the
> Assembly embarked on an intensive teaching        National Spiritual Assembly and the Auxiliary
> campaign enlisting the help of Local Assem-       Board. These institutes were conducted comblies. That Ric;lvan, fourteen new Assemblies     pletely in the vernacular and used translations
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                 149
> of the sacred Writings as a basis.                   International Travelling Teachers
> A number of seven- to nine-day institutes            Throughout these years, but especially durwere held in Benin, Cameroon, Ghana, Ivory           ing the final year of the Plan, a host of interna-
> Coast, Togo and Upper Volta where the                tional travelling teachers lent invaluable assisfriends immersed themselves in the Writings of       tance to the teaching and consolidation work in
> the Faith and emerged with a deep commit-            every country of the zone. Many of these
> ment to serve.                                       teachers were able to stay in the same area for
> On the whole, the condition of Local              several months, and thus not only open new
> Spiritual Assemblies remained weak. The              localities and form new Assemblies, but leave
> efforts of the National Spiritual Assemblies to      behind functioning Baha'i communities.
> train at least one believer in every community          Special mention should be made of the
> and of the Auxiliary Board members to train          marathon voyage of Mohsen and Felicity
> their assistants brought some improvement,           Enayat, travelling teachers from Canada, who
> but not nearly enough.                               for nearly two years travelled across the length
> There was a slight increase in the number of      and breadth of West Africa, touching almost
> communities regularly holding Nineteen Day           every country in the zone. Their love, devotion
> Feasts and Holy Day observances. In                 and humility coupled with their deep knowl-
> Cameroon, Senegal and Niger, the publication        edge and creative methods of teaching and
> and distribution of programmes for the Feasts        deepening, made them especially effective
> and Holy Days greatly encouraged the com-            wherever they went.
> munities to observe these events.                      In addition to travelling teachers from
> Where practised, the gathering of the friends     abroad, Benin, Cameroon, Chad, the Gambia,
> for early morning prayers deeply enriched the        Ghana, Ivory Coast, Niger, Senegal, Sierra
> spiritual life of the community. Far more vil-       Leone and Togo, all sent travelling teachers to
> lage than town communities managed to                neighboring countries at some point during this
> achieve this goal on a regular basis, and where      period.
> not done on a community basis, often families
> adopted the practice of early morning                Pioneers
> prayers.                                                As always, the settlement of foreign pioneers
> For some years regular summer schools had         reinforced the efforts of the friends in every
> been held in Liberia, and during this period,        land. A number of native believers in
> Benin, Ghana, Ivory Coast, Sierra Leone and          Cameroon, Chad and Togo also arose as
> Togo began holding them as well.                     homefront pioneers to open new localities and
> A new approach to consolidation used with         strengthen weak or new areas.
> great success in Cameroon was a mobile institute, a Volkswagen bus equipped with litera-         Border Teaching
> ture, films, etc. and manned by a pioneer. The          Many National Assemblies found great sucmobile institute in this three-year period visited   cess by acting on Dr. Muhajir's suggestion to
> literally hundreds of communities.                   collaborate in teaching along common borders
> Another method of deepening were the              where the same tribal group lived on both sides
> introductory correspondence courses devel-           of the border. In the Casamance area of
> oped by Chad and Togo.                               Senegal near the Gambia border, the Gambian
> The national bulletins of each country con-       friends were able to form a number of Assemtinued to serve as a major link between the          blies among the Jola tribe, thus greatly aiding
> National Assembly and local communities.             the friends in Senegal to achieve their goals. A
> The quality of the national bulletin in Liberia      joint Ghana-Togo teaching project among the
> should be especially mentioned . In addition,        Ewe tribe in the Volta region of Ghana
> the National Assembly of Ghana wrote regular         resulted in the formation of seven new
> Feast letters to the communities sharing news        Assemblies and many new localities. Other
> and encouraging the friends, and the National        border areas between Liberia and Ivory Coast,
> Assembly of Nigeria published a bulletin after       Ivory Coast and Ghana, Ghana and Upper
> each of its meetings informing the friends of        Volta, Upper Volta and Togo, and Cameroon
> new decisions, and sharing information.              with her neighbors in Nigeria, Chad and the
> 150                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Central African Empire, all proved highly            appeared in the national paper the Daily
> receptive.                                           Times, and in a number of State papers. A
> committee was appointed to systematically use
> National Teaching Conferences
> the media for the proclamation of the Faith.
> The practice of holding annual National
> After Dr. Muhajir's visit in 1976 and at his
> Teaching Conferences begun early in the Plan
> encouragement, the Baha'is of Liberia secured
> grew to become a major event in the life of the
> a fifteen-minute weekly radio programme
> community. The situation of the goals was forcwhich continued throughout the remainder of
> ibly brought to the attention of the friends and
> the Plan. In addition, the Baha'is regularly
> often individual pledges were made to work for
> appeared on the devotional closing progachievement of the goals. These conferences
> ramme on television. In 1978, the Baha'is of
> brought the friends together in love and unity
> Cameroon also broadcast for six months a
> and generated enthusiasm to work harder for
> fifteen-minute weekly English language progthe Plan.
> ramme on the Faith.
> Usually these conferences were held in the
> national I:Ia'.?fratu'l-Quds, but Cameroon made      Contact with Authorities
> a practice of varying the location in order to          Systematic attempts were made to proclaim
> allow maximum participation from various             the Faith, its aims, history and present stature,
> areas.                                               to leaders of thought and government officials
> A number of the friends from the zone were        in every country, both nationally and locally.
> also able to attend the International Teaching       Directed by the National Assembly itself, and
> Conferences in Paris and Nairobi, and a young        in Cameroon, by a committee, this activity
> Ghanaian singer, Miss Ranzie Mensah, par-            became one of the most vital in every national
> ticipated in the program of the Paris Confer-        community.
> ence, and travelled to teach in several Euro-           As in expanding the use of media, the visits
> pean countries.                                      of Hands of the Cause and international travelling teachers enabled a number of courtesy
> Use of Media
> visits to be made to high government officials,
> The expanded use of media during this
> especially in Cameroon, the Gambia, Ghana,
> period gave an added boost to the proclama-
> Ivory Coast, Liberia, Nigeria, Sierra Leone
> tion of the Faith. In Cameroon, Chad, the
> and Togo.
> Gambia, Ghana, Ivory Coast, Liberia, Nigeria,
> A number of communities held United
> Sierra Leone, Togo and Upper Volta, the visits
> Nations Day observances which again aided
> of Hands of the Cause and international travelthe proclamation of the Faith. A delegation
> ling teachers enabled the friends to secure          representing the Baha'i International Comperiodic interviews on radio and television          munity attended the Economic Commission
> and, occasionally, newspaper coverage. In
> for Africa's Conference on the Integration of
> addition to the publicity secured by the Hands
> Women in Development, held in October
> of the Cause, these teachers were all tremend-
> 1977 in Nouakchott, Mauritania.
> ously successful in attracting coverage: Mr.
> Andre Bruguiroux, author of La terre n'est           International Conferences
> qu'un seul pays who visited francophone coun-           The efforts of the friends to teach and protries in West Africa in 197 8; Dr. Jane Faily, a     claim the Faith were greatly assisted by a series
> clinical psychologist who travelled in West          of International Youth Conferences sponsored
> Africa for one year on behalf of the Iranian         by the Continental Board of Counsellors in
> Teaching Training Committee for Africa and           collaboration with designated National
> as a Consultant on Women and Children's              Spiritual Assemblies. Held respectively in the
> affairs in Africa for the Baha'i International       Ivory Coast in 1976, Nigeria in 1977, and
> Community; Dorothy Hansen, a poet and                Cameroon in 1978, these conferences, in addiformer journalist; and Shamsi Sadeghat,              tion to stimulating the teaching work and
> Director of a Maternity Clinic and member of         deepening the knowledge of the friends, prothe National Assembly of Trinidad and                vided an occasion for the Baha'is of varied
> Tobago.                                              racial , national and religious backgrounds to
> In Nigeria especially, articles about the Faith   experience that unity which is the pivot of our
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                           151
> 
> Some who attended the Women's Conference
> sponsored by the National Spiritual Assembly
> of the Bahti'(s of Niger; January 1978.
> 
> First Baha'i Summer School of Sierra Leone,
> held in Magburaka; 27-30 December 1977.
> In attendance was Counsellor Friday Ekpe
> (centre, back row) and other Bahti'(s from 12
> African communities and two foreign
> countries.
> 
> Baha'i community of Rosso, Mauritania, with
> their guests; 1977.
> 152                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Some Baha'fs of Kumba , Cameroon
> Republic, photographed at their
> newly-acquired f:/a'r,fratu'l-Quds; May 1977.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone
> (back, extreme left), Mrs. Featherstone, and
> other Bahd'fs who attended the dedication of
> one of the Regional Centres acquired by the
> Baha'fs of Ghana during the Plan; 30 January
> 1979.
> 
> Some Bahd'(s of lllie-Etche, River State,
> Nigeria with their guests, photographed during
> the visit of a travelling teacher from Ghana,
> Mrs. D. Hansen (back row); 10 March 1979.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                               153
> Faith. In all three gatherings, large delegations   high-ranking officials were contacted as a
> from fran added greatly to the spirit and effec-    result of the conference.
> tiveness of the conferences.                        Translation
> The conference in Ivory Coast, held 9-11            The expansion of the Faith into new areas
> July 1976, attracted nearly 200 participants.       necessitated first translations into a number of
> Blessed by the presence of the Hand of the          tribal languages. In addition the number of
> Cause of God Enoch Olinga, the conference           translations of the Writings into existing tribal
> resulted in unprecedented publicity for the         languages was increased. For example, Chad
> Faith. On his arrival in Abidjan, Mr. Olinga        published a series of prayerbooks in the major
> was interviewed in the VIP lounge of the air-       tribal languages of the country. Ghana transport along with Dr. Mihdi Samandari, one of         lated and Togo published a prayerbook in Ewe.
> the Counsellors in West Africa, who was rep-        Senegal published a prayerbook in Wolof.
> resenting the Baha'i International Community        Several countries recorded translations of the
> at a United Nations Economic and Social             sacred Writings on cassettes, and in Niger a
> Council Conference being held in Abidjan at         series of deepening talks in Hausa and Djerma
> the same time. A number of radio and televi-        were recorded. Just prior to the International
> sion interviews were broadcast, and for three       Youth Conference in Nigeria, a pamphlet was
> successive days, articles appeared in the major     printed in Efik, Hausa, Ibo and Yoruba, to
> newspaper, twice with front page coverage.          assist with the teaching work.
> Multi-national delegations visited various gov-        Though most literature continued to be
> ernment officials including a number of minis-      ordered from publishing trusts abroad, a large
> ters. After the conference, many of the par-        quantity of the pamphlet, Basic Facts of the
> ticipants assisted in teaching projects in the      Baha'i Faith was printed in Ca meroon in both
> Ivory Coast and nearby countries.                   French and English for use throughout the
> Over 250 Baha'is from nineteen countries,        zone. Most countries also began developing
> gathered in Enugu, Nigeria from 12-14               teaching and deepening materials more suited
> August 1977. Inspired by a message of the           to their local needs. In Cameroon , a number of
> Universal House of Justice to the conference,       deepening booklets on various subjects were
> the friends consulted on ways and means to          prepared along with an introductory booklet to
> achieve the goals of the Plan, shared experi-       be sent to all new Baha'is. Chad likewise proences from their various countries and made         duced a number of deepening sheets for use in
> individual pledges to assist the work of the        their community.
> Plan. Again, the conference opened the way             The use of audio-visual materials also
> for widespread publicity, both newspaper and        became more widespread. In addition to the
> television.                                         slides, filmstrips and postcards available from
> For Cameroon, the conference held in             the International Audio-Visual Centre, new
> Yaounde in August 1978 became a turning             materials, slide shows, etc. were developed
> point for achieving the goals of the Plan. The       locally. A young Ghanaian artist developed a
> intensive teaching activities both prior to and     series of drawings illustrating various aspects
> after the conference provided the momentum          of Baha'i life.
> which carried the country through to victory in     Women's Activities
> the final year of the Plan. Of the over 380            Prior to the Five Year Plan, few conscious
> participants from nineteen countries, a virtual     efforts were made to involve women in the
> army arose with eighteen offers for interna-        activities of the Faith. During the years 1976 to
> tional pioneering, five for homefront pioneers,      1979 the numbers of women increased and
> and 112 offers for travelling teaching. In           women took an increasingly active role in
> Cameroon alone, twenty-three teaching teams         Baha'i community life. In five national comwent out from the conference. In addition to         munities, Benin, Cameroon, Chad, Liberia,
> consecrating their time and efforts, the par-       Sierra Leone and Togo, African women were
> ticipants made generous contributions in both       elected to the National Spiritual Assembly,
> cash and kind to be used for the work of the        and an increasing number of women served on
> Plan in West Africa and in achieving other           Local Spiritual Assemblies. African women
> international goals. A number of ministers and      were sent as travelling teachers from
> 154                                   THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> Cameroon to the Central African Empire,               One of the most touch ing moments of the
> from Ghana to Togo, and from Togo to Benin,         conference came when African women, many
> and played an increasingly important role in        of them from villages, began to speak about
> the teaching work of their own countries.           what the Baha'i Faith and their participation in
> During this period Benin, Ghana, Chad ,          the conference meant to them .
> Ivory Coast, Niger, Sierra Leone , Upper Volta
> Children 's Classes
> and Upper West Africa, all organized National
> Progress toward the goal of regularly estab-
> Women's Conferences. In addition, a number
> lished children's classes was sporadic a nd
> of these same countries plus Cameroon ,
> uneven . The Baha 'is of Chad achieved out-
> Nigeria and Togo organized regional and local
> standing success where by the year 1977 over
> women's institutes and conferences. These
> 2,000 Chadian children, both Baha'i and nonconferences gave Baha'i women the opportu-
> Baha'i, were enrolled in regular classes. A
> nity to learn more about the Faith, its teachings
> series of twelve lesson plans entitled ' Step by
> on the equality of men and women and the
> Step' were developed as an aid to teachers and
> education of children. In some instances, pracregular institutes were held for the training of
> tical training was given regarding health care,
> teachers.
> nutrition, sewing, etc.
> Many other countnes, Cameroon, the
> Most      countries   appointed       National
> Gambia, Ghana, Ivory Coast, Liberia, Niger,
> Women's Committees, so that the goal of
> Nigeria, Togo and Senegal likewise developed
> increasing the participation of women would
> lesson plans and conducted training courses.
> receive constant attention. The National
> Almost every country at one time or another had
> Committees in Chad and Niger were especially
> a number of children's classes in operation, but it
> effective. In Niger, the Home Life Committee
> proved difficult to maintain the classes over a
> regularly reproduced articles, often translalong period of time.
> tions of articles by the Hand of the Cause
> In the last year of the Plan, the training of
> 'Ali-Akbar Furutan concerning such topics as
> teachers for children's classes received a helpthe education of children , husband and wife
> ing hand from the Teacher Training Commitrelations, family life, etc. Bi-monthly the
> tee for Africa in fran. This Committee sent a
> friends would gather to discuss the articles, and
> number of Persian believers who held teacher
> they were also distributed to local communities
> training courses and assisted with children's
> throughout the country.
> classes in Cameroon , Liberia, Ghana, Sierra
> In Liberia, a women's page was included in
> Leone and Nigeria. Special mention should be
> the national bulletin.
> made of the extensive travels of Dr. Jane Faily
> who assisted with child education in all of the
> West African Bahti'{ Women's Conference
> above countries and the Ivory Coast and Togo.
> These various women's activities in each
> A number of countries included children's
> country culminated in the West African Baha'i
> pages in their national bulletins, and in
> Women's Conference held 28-30 December
> Cameroon , a quarterly magazine for children,
> 1978 in Monrovia, Liberia. The President of
> Anfs, was published in French and English.
> Liberia, the Honorable W. R. Tolbert sent a
> message of greeting to the conference which         Youth Activities
> was officially opened by the Minister of Post          Overall , the West African Baha'i community
> and Telecommunications. A number of other           is young and youth are intricately involved in
> messages were received including one from           all aspects of the work of the Faith. However as
> Helva Sipila, Assistant Secretary General of        the Plan called for specific youth activities a
> the United Nations Centre for Social                number of developments took place .
> Development and Humanitarian Affairs.                  National Youth Committees were appointed
> Extensive coverage was given the conference         in Cameroon and Chad; and in Chad and
> by radio, television and the press. For a public    Benin, local youth committees as well. A
> meeting held in conjunction with the confer-        number of Local Assemblies, Accra, Ghana;
> ence, the Minister of Information shared a          Calabar, Nigeria; and Lome, Togo appointed
> platform with Dr. Jane Faily, Consultant for        local youth committees.
> the Baha'i International Community.                    In increasing numbers youth arose as travel-
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                             155
> 
> Baha'i Children's Class, Chad.
> 
> Site of the future Mashriqu'l-Adhktir, Lome,
> Togo.
> 
> Bahti'[ Children's Class of Jkot Uba Village,
> Cross River State, Nigeria, taught by Mr. 0.
> E. Njang.
> 156                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> ling teachers and homefront pioneers and              Collaboration of Institutions
> committed their vacation time for special                Overall, the bonds of love and cooperation
> teaching projects.                                    between the institutions of the Continental
> University clubs continued to function at the      Boards of Counsellors and their Auxiliary
> University of Cameroon in Yaounde and the             Boards and the National Spiritual Assemblies
> University of Science and Technology at               and Local Assemblies grew stronger. The fre-
> Kumasi, Ghana. In addition, informal youth            quency of consultations between the Counselgroups were formed on university campuses in          lors and National Assemblies greatly
> Ivory Coast, Niger, Nigeria, Senegal, Togo and        increased. Periodic consultations between the
> Upper Volta.                                          Auxiliary Board members and National Teach-
> Niger continued publication of its excellent       ing Committees for the purpose of planning
> youth journal Bad{' and Chad and Cameroon             and sharing information were held in almost
> began publishing similar youth bulletins.             every country of the zone . Parallel with the
> In addition to participation in the Interna-       growth of the community , the number of Auxtional Youth Conferences, Chad and a few              iliary Board members increased from eleven at
> other countries held National Youth confer-           Ri<;lvan 1976 to forty at Ri<;lvan 1979 and over
> ences, and Cameroon started the practice of           250 assistants were appointed.
> devoting one night of the national convention
> to a youth conference.                                International Convention
> West Africa was blessed to have each
> Property Goals                                        National Spiritual Assembly represented at the
> With the exception of the Gambia, which had        International Convention in 1978. For Benin,
> acquired all of its local centres and endow-          Cameroon, Ghana, Togo and Niger, it was the
> ments by the end of 1976, property goals              first time an indigenous believer had ever set
> proved a real challenge to most national com-         foot in the Holy Shrines. The accounts and
> munities. Lack of experience, inflationary            memories of this precious spiritual experience,
> costs, difficulties in acquiring land, all combined   which were carried back by the participants,
> to make progress distressingly slow, and most         greatly enriched each community.
> goals were achieved only during the last year            Overall, these were years of growing maturof the Plan.                                          ity for the communities of West Africa. One
> The challenge proved well worth the effort         evident sign of this maturity was the fact that
> for wherever local centres were built, they           over half of the National Spiritual Assemblies
> became a source of unity and pride for the            in the zone became self-supporting during this
> community, a symbol of their love and devo-           period, and the remaining few greatly reduced
> tion to the Faith. Interestingly enough , often       the amount of assistance received from abroad.
> new communities arose with great enthusiasm           African believers increasingly played a leading
> to build local centres. For example in the north      role in the teaching and administration of the
> of Togo after a teaching project in which a           Faith. Growing numbers of individual Baha'fs
> number of Assemblies were formed and new              arose to serve the Faith with devotion, perselocalities opened, six new centres were built in      verance and sacrifice. One touching example of
> a short period with minimal assistance from the       this spirit was shown in Niger, where a number
> National Assembly. In southern Upper Volta,           of believers had saved enough money to attend
> after a similar project, three centres were built,    the Paris Conference in 1976, but as Niger was
> one completely on the initiative of the friends .     far behind in its teaching goals, decided to
> The regional centres served to enhance the         sacrifice their desire and the money, using it to
> prestige of the Faith and were successfully used      finance a travel-teaching safari throughout the
> as a site for conferences and institutes.             country.
> Among the national properties acquired                Much remains to be done in all areas. The
> during this time, Mauritania acquired its tem-        potential is great, and the corresponding
> ple site and national Centre, Ivory Coast new         responsibilities are great. However there is a
> land for a national Centre , Senegal its temple       growing awareness among the friends, and
> site, Sierra Leone its national endowment and         faith, that with continued effort our hopes will
> Upper Volta its temple land.                          be realized.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                157
> 
> B. THE AMERICAS
> 
> The Five Year Plan called for the formation of      organize such activities. Also, three successful
> one new National Spiritual Assembly in Cen-         international youth conferences took place
> tral, North and South America. At Ric_ivan          under the sponsorship of the Continental
> 1977 the National Spiritual Assembly of the         Board of Counsellors and the respective
> French Antilles came into being, with its seat in   National Spiritual Assembly: in San Jose,
> Guadeloupe. Surinam and French Guiana               Costa Rica, for the entire zone, in December
> formed at Ric_ivan 1977 with its seat in Para-      1977; in Santa Tecla, El Salvador, for the
> maribo, Surinam; and at Ric_lvan the following      northern part of Central America and Mexico,
> year the Bahamas formed their National              in December 1978; and in David , Panama, for
> Assembly with its seat in Nassau. The progress      the southern part of Central America and
> of the Faith in the thirty-three National           Panama, in January 1979.
> Spiritual Assemblies whose territories lie             Three principal objectives of the Five Year
> within the Americas are assisted by the Conti-      Plan are, by their very nature, continuing
> nental Boards of Counsellors whose spheres of       goals: the preservation and consolidation of
> service are divided into three zones, each with     past accomplishments; the broad and vast
> its own Board:                                      expansion of the Baha'i community; and the
> Central America                                  development of the distinctive character of
> North America                                    Baha'i life, especially in the local communities.
> South America                                    All three were embarked upon throughout the
> zone with varying degrees of intensity and
> Central America                         some success was noted. The training and
> In the area comprising Panama, Central           encouragement of Local Spiritual Assemblies,
> America, Mexico and the Antilles, the years         another aspect of the Five Year Plan which
> from 1976 to 1979 witnessed considerable            demands constant and continuing attention,
> social and political unrest which in some           was pursued in an effort to assist the Baha'is to
> instances disrupted the teaching activities of      achieve a fuller understanding of the administhe Baha'i communities and required the             trative order and to increase the number of
> forced departure of Baha'i pioneers; neverthe-      effectively functioning Local Assemblies.
> less, many thrilling victories were recorded.          Special events and highlights in the period
> Practically all areas with National Spiritual       under review included:
> Assemblies established the required number of          (1) Teams of five believers participated in
> Local Spiritual Assemblies and opened to the        two successful teaching projects of less than
> Faith the assigned number of new localities.        one month each along the north coast of Hon-
> Despite heroic efforts during the final year of     duras. As a result of the second project alone,
> the Plan it was not possible to acquire all local   1,009 people accepted the Faith, nineteen new
> and regional Centres nor to secure all endow-       Local Spiritual Assemblies were elected and
> ments. Much progress was made, however, in          thirty-four new localities were opened. The
> publishing new literature for children, and in      population among whom the projects took
> training teachers for newly-established classes     place comprises Carib and Mesquite Indians,
> for children. Special activities for women, and     Latins and people of African descent. William
> the increase of their participation in all phases   Stover, the Auxiliary Board member who was
> of Baha'i activities, received much attention,      the moving spirit in both projects, wrote: ' I
> and a successful international conference for       have been using "e ntrance in troops" and
> women was held in El Salvador under the             " mass conversion " in my reports and that is
> auspices of the Continental Board of Counsel-       exactly what we are now engaged in ... we
> lors and the National Spiritual Assembly. In        have whole villages which are either all Baha'fs
> addition , regional and national women's con-       or have a Baha'i population of well over fifty
> ferences were held in other countries.              per cent . . . every trip we make we witness
> Regional and national youth conferences          more and more Baha'is teaching the Cause and
> took place in those countries having a National     trying to deepen their knowledge of it and
> Youth Committee sufficiently developed to           abide by its laws.'
> 158                                           THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> (2) In Panama, a continuous proclamation                    stige and recognition of the Faith. The director
> and teaching campaign in areas around the                      and teachers will be Baha'ls.
> House of Worship resulted in 3,000 people                         (4) Another significant event in the Caribaccepting the Faith, approximately 800 of                      bean zone was the formation at Ri<;lvan 1977 of
> whom embraced it during the years 1976-                        the first National Spiritual Assembly of the
> 1979. A large number of believers participated                 French Antilles comprising the major Frenchin this activity. Recently a Teaching Centre was               speaking islands, other than Haiti, and includestablished at the House of Worship making                     ing Desirade, Guadeloupe, Iles des Saintes,
> possible a programme of continuous consolida-                  Marie-Galante, Martinique, St. Barthelemy
> tion of these new communities. The National                    and St. Martin.
> Spiritual Assembly reported that classes and                      (5) In the area under the jurisdiction of the
> other activities are carried on at the Teaching                National Spiritual Assembly of the Leeward
> Centre with a considerable economy of human                    and Virgin Islands and the National Spiritual
> and financial resources and draw attendance                    Assembly of Barbados and the Windward
> from the outlying communities. Various youth                   Islands, large-scale proclamation, teaching
> from these communities serve as teachers in                    and expansion has taken place in preparation
> regularly-scheduled classes to train adults,                   for the coming into being, at some future time,
> youth and children.                                            of a National Spiritual Assembly on each
> In December 1978 an inspiring conference                    major island.
> took place attended by Baha'ls from all parts of                  (6) At Ri<;lvan 1979 the National Spiritual
> the Ame ricas who gathered to study all aspects                Assembly of Mexico-another great republic
> of radio and television production and the writ-               mentioned by name in the Tablets of the
> ing of scripts . 1 The workshops and lectures                  Divine Plan-approved and inaugurated the
> were led by Baha'ls who are highly-skilled pro-                Jaguar Plan designed to establish the Faith
> fessionals in their various fields.                            among each of the sixty-four indigenous
> The inauguration of the newly-constructed                   groups composing the population. Already
> first Regional Teaching Institute of Bocade                    representatives of thirty-one groups in Mexico
> Soloy in the Guaymi area was attended by                       have embraced the Faith.
> almost 500 Baha'ls and their friends from all
> parts of the country.
> (3) In Haiti, one of the two 'black republics' 2                         North America
> mentioned by 'Abdu'l-Baha in His Tablets of
> the Divine Plrzn , an important event was the                                     ALASKA
> inauguration of construction of the Anis                          July 1976 brought a glimpse of the Baha'i
> Zanuzi School , located at Lilavoix, a short                   world to Alaska when more than 1,000 friends
> distance from the capital, Port-au-Prince.                     from twenty-two countries arrived in Anchor-
> According to the National Spiritual Assem-                    age to atte nd the International Teaching Conbly's report, this school which is being financed              ference called by the Universal House of Jusby a Baha'i, 'will house a pre-school class, six              tice. Alaskan believers had worked hard to
> elementary grades, and a technical school.                     arrange the Conference and to utilize the occa-
> Craft classes, agricultural projects and even-                 sion to publicize the Faith throughout the
> ing classes for th e local community are being                 State, but it was the presence of the friends
> planned.' A curriculum is being developed                     from other countries which provided the
> with a view to training children in Baha'i stan-              crowning touch to the occasion. The Universal
> dards of moral and spiritual conduct, as well as               House of Justice was represented by the Hand
> meeting national academic requirements. In                    of the Cause of God Collis Featherstone. He
> Haiti, whe re there is much illiteracy and where              was joined by his fellow Hands of the Cause,
> government schools are not available, this pro-                John Robarts and William Sears.
> ject assumes enormous importance for the pre-                    Immediately following the Conference a
> ' See 'Expansion of the Use of Radio and Television', p.       Native Council was held to focus on specific
> 92, 215.                                                       aspects of teaching and establishment of the
> In His Tablets of the Divine l'/an, p. 33, 'Abd u' l-Bahii
> refers to 't he two black republics, Haiti and Santo
> Faith among the A leuts, Eskimos, and Indians
> Domingo'.                                                      of North America.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                             159
> Apart from the International Teaching Con-      Endeavours, became available just prior to the
> ference the Hands of the Cause of God John         International Teaching Conference.
> Robarts, William Sears and 'Ali-Akbar Fun'.i-         The National Spiritual Assembly conducted
> tan made individual trips to Alaska. Counsel-      several 'concept conferences' tliat involved
> lor Florence Mayberry of the International         believers from various sections of the State
> Teaching Centre came again to visit Alaska.        sharing ideas on such individual topics as the
> The breaths from the World Centre brought by       Nineteen-Day Feast, youth planning for their
> these friends served to invigorate and inspire     futures, family unity, and child raising. Each
> the Alaska friends.                                year, as part of the Five Year Plan, a National
> The Continental Board of Counsellors in         Teaching Conference was held. In collabora-
> North America continued to encourage the           tion with the Continental Counsellors the
> individual believers and the institutions of the   National Spiritual Assembly provided seminars
> Faith. A regular feature relating to Auxiliary     on the art of Baha'i consultation; and encourboards, inaugurated by the Continental Board       aged the continued translation of Baha'i Writof Counsellors, was published in Alaska Bahli'f    ings into Alaskan native languages. The Alaska
> News. It was felt that direct consultation be-     Bahti'[ News ran a sixteen part series on
> tween the Continental Board of Counsellors         'Opposition and the Power of the Covenant' .
> and the National Spiritual Assembly benefi-           The Baha'i Information Office, ·a National
> cially influenced many projects thoughout the      Committee, took major steps in utilization of
> State.                                             mass media . A thirty-minute video tape was
> Among activities undertaken by the              produced in Pt. Barrow, the most northern
> National Spiritual Assembly one closest to the     community in Alaska. Performances by the
> hearts of all Alaskan believers was the publica-   singer Karen Gibbs were sponsored in sevention of the letters written to Alaska by the       teen communities and brought much favorable
> beloved      Guardian.    This book, High          publicity to the Faith.
> 
> Participants in teaching conference, Martinique, French Antilles, sponsored by the Continental Board of Counsellors for Central America; 20 August 1978. Seen on the extreme left, back
> row, is Mr. Hooper Dunbar of the International Teaching Centre. Four members of the
> Central American Board of Counsellors attended: Mr. Artemus La~b, fourth from left, back
> row; Mr. Alfred Osborne, third from right, back row; Dr. H. Af:zmadfyyih, third from left,
> third row; and Mrs. Carmen de Burafato, fourth from left, second row.
> 160                                THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Guay mi and Cuna Indian Baha'{s who participated in the satellite teaching conference held at
> the Magisterio Panameno Unidas, Panama; 10-13 February 1977.
> 
> Participants in the International Bahd'( Youth Conference held in San Jose, Costa Rica; 6-9
> January 1978. The conference, sponsored by the Continental Board of Counsellors for
> Central America and the National Spiritual Assembly of Costa Rica, attracted more than 150
> Baha'( youth from every country of Central America and from Puerto Rico, Venezuela and the
> United States.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                 161
> 
> The national /jar.fratu'l-Quds of the Bahamas, situated in Nassau.
> 
> The National Child Education Committee           of the State. This was finally completed in the
> continued to publish their bulletin, Northern       summer of 1978 when visiting teaching teams
> Lights. A 'Dawn Patrol', for youth aged ten to      went to the Pribilof Islands, to Sand Point on
> fifteen, sprang up in several towns. These          the Alaska Peninsula, and to Atka in the Aleuyouth groups inaugurated a variety of               tian Islands.
> activities. Nine-day Institute programmes, so          At the heart of all teaching work was the
> effective in Alaska, were held on several occa-     effort put forth by local Spiritual Assemblies.
> sions and there were many weekend deepening         Large Assemblies, such as Anchorage and
> classes as well as spiritually invigorating         Oceanview, made extensive use of the mass
> Winter and Summer Schools in southern and           media. The Local Spiritual Assembly of
> northern Alaska. Teaching activities included       Nenana, a small, predominately native comvisits to villages, settlement of pioneers, fair    munity, inspired the entire State with the way it
> booths, public meetings, prayer vigils, adver-      assisted other communities. The National
> tisements, correspondence with believers in         Assembly assigned to some Local Assemblies a
> remote areas, trained and organized home            'sister Assembly' with whom projects could be
> teaching teams, travel teachers, and firesides.     shared and help exchanged. Nenana was able
> It was noted with interest that one resource-    to help the teaching efforts of its sister comful and imaginative Baha'i community in a           munity at Pt. Barrow and assisted several local
> northern village donated, for the use of travel-    Spiritual Assemblies in the purchase of local
> ling teachers, caribou, seal oil, muktuk, sal-      Baha'i Centres.
> mon, and white fish.
> Alaskans assisted the teaching work in
> forty-six countries. The sponsoring by Alaska                     THE BAHAMAS
> of a Continental Indigenous Council resulted           The acquisition of a national I:Ia~fratu'l­
> in a well-attended Council on the White Swan        Quds in Nassau, Bahamas during the first year
> Reservation in the State of Washington.             of the Plan and the election of the first National
> Teaching teams supported by Auxiliary Board         Spiritual Assembly of the Bahamas in 1978
> members from Alaska were able to assist the         fulfilled an important goal of the Five Year
> Canadian friends in their final goals of the Five   Plan. A wave of travel teachers, settlement of
> Year Plan.                                          pioneers, and frequent and long-term visits of
> In 1971 Alaska began a systematic effort to      the Auxiliary Board member assigned to sercarry the message of Baha'u'llah to every part      vice the Bahamas were contributing factors. A
> 162                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> national endowment was also acquired during            The Continental Board of Counsellors in
> the first two years of the Plan.                     North America met with the National Spiritual
> When the Universal House of Justice called        Assembly in July 1978 to assist in formulating
> for the election of the Nationa l Spiritual          plans to win the remainder of their goals. A
> Assembly of the Bahamas by Ric;lvan 1978, the        great victory was achieved when twenty-six
> Baha'i Teaching Committee of the Bahamas,            radio programs on the Faith were broadcast
> under the direction of the National Spiritual        throughout the Islands. By Ric;lvan 1979 a ll the
> Assembly of the United States, redoubled all         goals of the Five Year Plan had been won,
> efforts. During this momentous year eleven           including the election of the eighth Local
> pioneers were settled; three additional Local        Spiritual Assembly, and the new pillar of the
> Spiritual Assemblies were elected, bringing the      Universal House of Justice ended its first year
> total to seven; five teaching institutes were        in triumph.
> held; and twenty-two youth from the United
> States participated in a teaching project.                              BERMUDA
> The first National Convention of the                 The friends in Bermuda experienced an
> Bahamas was held in Nassau on the weekend            exciting year in 1976-1977 when the Hand of
> of 20 May 1978 and was blessed by the pres-          the Cause Amatu'l-Baha RuJ:llyyih Khanum
> ence of the Hand of the Cause William Sears,         visited the islands for a period of one hundred
> the representative of the Universal House of         days.
> Justice. Counsellor Lloyd Gardner and Auxil-            The dedication of the local J:Ia'.?iratu'l-Quds
> iary Board member Dr. William Tucker also            occurred in February 1976. The Centre has
> attended, as well as Mr. Glenford Mitchell who       proven to be a real asset to the proclamation of
> represented the National Spiritual Assembly          the Faith. It is located in the busiest part of the
> of the United States. While the delegates were       island, downtown Hamilton, and presents a
> praying at the J:Ia'.?fratu'l-Quds before casting    lovely appearance. The friends are able to keep
> their ballots, the friends attendin g the conven-    the Centre open most of the time, with protion were also praying at the Temple site.           grammes which include children's classes, Holy
> The newly elected National Spiritual              Day celebrations, teaching and deepening
> Assembly immediately arose to fulfil the            institutes, and other events.
> request of the Universal House of Justice to           Auxiliary Board members Mrs Katherine
> open five new islands by going themselves to        McLaughlin and Dr. Adrienne Reeves are
> four and sending travel teachers to the fifth. In   providing continuing assistance to the friends.
> addition it sent one of its members to each         This service, together with support in teaching
> Baha'i community to conduct an institute on         activities provided by the National Spiritual
> teaching and consultation.                          Assembly of the United States and frequent
> 
> _--;~;"':•.";~
> i ~
> Participants in the first Canadian Bah{l'f Native Council held in Tyendinaga, Ontario; 6-7
> November 1976. Mrs . Melba Loft, a Chippewa Indian, who pioneered to Tyendinaga in
> 1949, is seen seated on the extreme left.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CU RRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIE S                                                                            163
> 
> I.'Ho111111esem/op/!Lrf!l71111/er/t((}true1terlel'kmn11e.
> L'Age au cours duquel nous txplo-         problftnel humalns Mpend de cette
> rions dn ttm:s et des mrrs inconnues &~ d«isive.
> est be! et bif'tl revolu. Crpendant, il Une acceptlltioil consciente de la
> 
> :i:!1:/~~:!':~~~de                          ::ut!~~.:=~
> penpicadtf et d'esprit d'aventure.             n'~lt le pouvoiratattw rel!cM
> Le defi nit beauoou.p plus gnnd          d.ms WW: lme qui dkouvre runiti de
> au;ourd'hui, puisque nou' devons          l'hurnanitE. La vie prrnd tout son sens
> etendre nos conq~es au-dell de                nee mte dtoouverte qui laisse rn·
> cettr fron~rt' ullime que ronstitue           trevoir un monde nouveau de rebinotre proprt natUJe humalne.              I.ions hum.a Ines; rtvelant d es c•padtb;
> Dy a plus de 120 ans,                                         tntiettment insoup-
> 
> ~~:!~;dateur de                  "Urqtn It    P'ld      ~on~~~a:=~
> laFoiBahi'fe,affinNi          pwissmitordotlnl,.rlt               senuinifesttr.
> que la prise de con·             Sfrigntur com~                Guidk par Its enscimce dt l'uniti de           JOWOmrinrrmldr.tla               seignementsde
> rh umanit~ scrait la~           ""'1odi.edu mondt:      BaM'u'W.h, des millions
> quiouvrirai1 un nouvel           a.°/!a~;:;Jf.r;,~,     de per.ionnesi travers Jc
> ~t~!:O~~=;t:                     J'uniondtlOUIStS        dn":'!t:;:~~~~
> de cette virilt fonda-         fKUpltS m unr o:iu:;t     ture. Ce sont les Baha'fs.
> men tale entrainera dans        unioersrltt, unt foi      PeuH!t~ aimeriez-vous
> son sillon \'unification de        rutrimuru:."         en savolr un peu plussur
> la planete. La solution de                                          l'objet de leur
> tousles autres                                                        decouverte.
> La Foi Baha':l.e
> -   -       -     -      -    Une promesse accomplie.- -                        -      -       -
> L"un dM pnnci~ dt Nw de 11 Foi &ha"~ nt qllll' rsnvrmptlOll de 11 Wntt nt k droll et
> Partial view of the Baha'i display and in for-        ~~ d~~~~"t~~N- ::Hf.j,P;:il~~~n~~~~n~t(~~~~~~
> T't:lUll681·~ ,QW~;l.5J'l•~.Montftil
> mation booth during the 'Symposium of                 NOM - - - - - - - - - - - - · - - - -- - -
> Philosophies and Religions,' held at the              ADRESSI::: - - - ·
> V I LLE ---·--·-·~·----·-                          CODF. rt.~TAL_ _ _ __
> Windsor Hotel, Montreal, Quebec, 6- 9
> April 1978. The booth was arranged by the             An example of the advertisements placed in
> Local Spiritual Assembly of LaSalle,                  Canadian publications which resulted in
> Quebec, and included a display of Bahli'(             hundreds of requests from the public for
> literature.                            information about the Baha'i Faith.
> 
> v1s1ts from travel teachers, inspires the hope     A uxiliary Board members Lauretta King and
> that the seventh Local Spiritual Assembly will     Fletcher Bennett from A laska. A pproximately
> be established by Ric;lvan 1980 thus providing a   sixty Assemblies were formed on Canadian
> good found ation for the election in the future    Indian reservatio ns. French Canadian believof the first National Spiritual Assembly of        ers played an increasingly important role in the
> Bermuda.                                           teaching work, and grew in numbers, while in
> CANADA                           British Columbia the fi rst Sikh Baha'fs were
> From Ric;lvan 1976 to Ric.Ivan 1979, the        enrolled, adding further to the diversity of the
> Canadian Baha'i community increased steadily       National community.
> in numbers of believers and in the number of          During 1978 and 1979 especially, Baha'fs all
> diverse people represented. During this            across the vast Dominion launched new and
> period, 138 new Local Spiritual Assemblies         vigorous campaigns of teaching. Collaboration
> were formed and 825 localities opened to the       between the institutions was an important key
> Faith, bringing the total achievement to 315       to success. The leadership of the National
> Local Spiritual Assemblies and 1,675               Spiritual Assembly was reinforced by the vislocalities, thus exceeding the m1mmum              ion and encouragement and services of the
> requirements of the Five Year Plan, under          Hands of the Cause residing in North America,
> which the number of Assem blies was to be          John Robarts, William Sears and Dhikru'llah
> raised to 300 and the number of localities         Khadem. The Board of Counsellors, their Auxwhere Baha'fs reside to 1,500.                     iliary Board members and assistants collabo-
> Many of these victories were won by teach-      rated closely with the friends in many new and
> ing teams which included Indian believers from     audacious teaching projects.
> Alaska, the United States and Canada, and             The recognition of the Faith was furthe r
> 164                                      THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> advanced with the increase of incorporated               The Canadian Association for Studies on the
> Assemblies from eighty-six to 168, during the         Baha'i Faith 1 was further developed to
> Five Year Plan . Through bold proclamation            increase contacts with universities and academcampaigns launched for the first time on a            ics in Canada. More Baha'fs responded to
> national scale in media across the entire coun-       requests for scholarly papers on the Faith and
> try, the Faith became better known, resulting         several volumes of Baha'i Studies have been
> in hundreds of requests for information about         printed.
> it from members of the public.                           Following the success of the film 'Invitation'
> Canada's international mission called for the      in 1975, which featured interviews with the
> provision of a total of 112 pioneers in all parts     Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha Rul:llyyih
> of the world. By Ric;lvan 1979 there were 223         Khanum, the National Spiritual Assembly crepioneers serving in seventy countries on six          ated a second successful film entitled 'Retrocontinents. Many of the pioneers became               spective', featuring reminiscences of the Hand
> members of National Spiritual Assemblies,             of the Cause John Robarts.
> national committees, or Auxiliary Board                  The institution of the Continental Board of
> members in their new homelands.                       Counsellors was expanded during the
> Travel teachers visited all of the regions         1976- 1979 period through the appointment as
> assigned. These · included Latin America,             Counsellor of Mr. Angus Cowan of Canada.
> Greenland, Africa, Europe and the islands of          Two additional Auxiliary Board members
> the Caribbean. In Greenland, Canada gave col-         were appointed to serve in Canada, raising the
> laborative support to the National Spiritual          total number serving Canada to thirteen and by
> Assembly of Denmark to assist in the acquisi-         Ric;lvan 1979 there were approximately 115
> tion of a I:Ia?.iratu'l-Quds, the opening of four     assistants to the Auxiliary Board members
> localities and the establishment of a Local           serving in the Dominion.
> Spiritual Assembly in the capital city of Nuuk         1
> See 'History of the Canadian Association for Studies on
> (Godthaab).                                            the Baha'i Faith, p. 197 .
> 
> .i; '       II
> Baha'i Children's Class, San Jose, California.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                165
> THE UNITED STATES OF AMERICA                           The visits of members of the Universal
> The period of Ricjvan 1976 to Ricjvan 1979        House of Justice brought inspiration and reaswitnessed significant expansion in the Ameri-        surance to the American believers who were
> can Baha'i Community.                                privileged to be in their presence as they
> The number of Local Spiritual Assem,blies         addressed the friends at the Mother Temple of
> showed an increase of eighty-one per cent            the West in Wilmette or in other cities where
> (from 822 to 1,489); Assemblies on Indian            they met with the believers. The American
> reservations reflected a nineteen per cent           Baha'i Community drew encouragement from
> increase (from 12 to 31); localities where Baha' -   the enlightening presentations given by Dr.
> is reside increased by thirty-three per cent         David Ruhe, Mr. H . Borrah Kavelin, Mr.
> (from 5,301to7,041); and counties opened to          Charles Wolcott, Mr. Hugh Chance, Mr. Amoz
> the Faith marked a nine per cent increase            Gibson, Mr. Ian Semple and Mr. Hushmand
> (from 1,753 to 1,911). Some states witnessed a       Fathea'zam.
> net increase in Assemblies in excess of one            Counsellors Hooper Dunbar, Florence
> hundred per cent during the Five Year Plan.          Mayberry and 'Aziz Yazdi also illumined the
> Enrolments showed a marked increase dur-          hearts and brought fresh inspiration from the
> ing the final year of the Plan. This activity was    World Centre during their brief visits in the
> sparked by the presence and dynamic leader-          United States.
> ship of Counsellor Hidayatu'llah Al)madiyyih           In 1977 the forty-five day visit of the Hand of
> of Belize, who brought system to the street          the Cause' Ali-Akbar Furutan and Mrs. Furuteaching techniques by the introduction of a         tan enriched and enlivened the sessions of varpractical teaching tool, the illustrated and col-    ious Baha'i Schools. Also, the third National
> ourful booklet, The Bahti'( Faith . Supplement-      Baha'i Youth Conference was blessed with the
> ing this concerted effort were the services of       presence of the Hands of the Cause 'Ali-Akbar
> the Auxiliary Board members and their assis-         Furt'.ttan, William Sears, and Dhikru'llah
> tants and the continuing leadership of the           Khadem. Each, in turn, addressed the 3,000
> National Spiritual Assembly in the directing of      Baha'i youth gathered on that occasion.
> its chief auxiliary teaching agencies.                 The increase from eighteen to twenty-eight
> -~~--
> 
> Facsimile of the bronze plaque mounted in the display area of foundation hall in the Mother
> Temple of the West in Wilmette, marking the recognition of the Bahti'( House of Worship as a
> national historic place by the United States government and its entry in the national Register
> of Historic Places on 23 May 1978.
> 166                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> in the number of Auxiliary Board members              DELIGHTED ACTION BY FEDERAL AUTHORITIES
> serving in the United States, and the concomit-       TO INCLUDE MOTHER TEMPLE OF THE WEST IN
> NATIONAL REGISTER OF HISTORIC PLACES
> ant increase in the number of assistants to
> STOP FRUITION YOUR EFFORTS ON 134TH
> Board members, brought significant strength           ANNIVERSARY OF DECLARATION HIS MISSION
> and effectiveness to the services provided            BY BLESSED BAB OBTAIN THIS SIGNIFICANT
> under the direction of the Continental Board          RECOGNITION DESERVES WARM COMMENDA-
> TIONS AND IS AN OUTSTANDING ACHIEVE-
> of Counsellors in North America, in close col-
> MENT.
> laboration with the National Spiritual Assembly.                                                    At Ri<;lvan 1976 during the National Baha'i
> With a view to achieving the much desired         Convention, the National Spiritual Assembly
> phase in the development of the teaching prog-        celebrated its fiftieth anniversary.
> rammes, described as ' initiating process entry
> by troops,' the National Spiritual Assembly
> staged some twenty-seven conferences entitled                      South America
> 'Each One Teach One', utilizing the compilation of the Universal House of Justice, The                           ARGENTINA
> Individual and Teaching: Raising the Divine              Argentina succeeded in establishing fifty-
> Call. These events were followed by support-          seven Local Spiritual Assemblies by Ri<;lvan
> ing projects and services initiated by the Hands      1979, with Baha'fs residing in 252 localities.
> of the Cause William Sears and Dhikru'llah            The major accomplishment of the Five Year
> Khadem, in co-operation with the National             Plan was a vigorous programme of teaching con-
> Spiritual Assembly .                                  ducted in all twenty-two Provinces of the country
> In 1976 an historic occasion was celebrated       and in the Territory of Tierra de! Fuego. Chile
> with the gift from the American Baha'i com-           and Uruguay also adopted teaching projects
> munity to the Cherokee Nation of a statue of          designed to reach all Provinces or Depart-
> Sequoyah by the internationally renowned              ments. Another important objective was
> sculptor and sandpainter, David Villasenor.           reached in all three countries with the forma-
> The Five Year Plan property goals in the          tion of at least one Local Assembly in each
> international field were achieved with the            major jurisdiction.
> acquisition, in the first year of the Plan, of a         Editorial Bahri'{ Indo-Latinoamericana pronational J:Ia~fratu'l-Quds in Nassau, Bahamas;        duced fifteen new books in the period, includand, in the period under review, of a local           ing the Spanish edition of Epistle to the Son of
> J:I~ratu'l-Quds in Bermuda and a district            the Wolf, and issued a considerable number of
> Centre in Fort-de-France, Martinique. In addi-        reprints of existing titles.
> tion, the United States community assisted               A further achievement was the purchase or
> with the acquisition of Temple sites in Bar-          construction of a local J:Ia~ratu'l-Quds in
> bados, Togo and Puerto Rico, a local Centre in       twelve localities including Cordoba, Mendoza,
> the Cook Islands and a national J:Ia~ratu'l­           Rosario, Burzaco, General Roca, Resistencia
> Quds in Sierra Leone. Another aspect of the          and Miraflores.
> international contribution of the American              The Argentinian Summer School acquired
> community involved sending more than 700              increasing importance and attracted many vispioneers to more than fifty designated coun-         itors from neighbouring countries.
> tries, plus numerous pioneers to assist in filling
> goals assigned to other national communities.                          BOLIVIA
> Twenty-five years after the opening to the           Bolivia continued to make firm progress
> public of the doors of the House of Worship in       which resulted in an expansion of the Faith in
> Wilmette, the United States government               all Departments and Provinces, an increase in
> announced that the Temple was being entered          the number of believers and the formation of
> in the National Register of Historic Places on       1,050 Local Assemblies. Effective measures of
> 23 May 1978, the 134th anniversary of the            proclamation of the Faith were undertaken
> Declaration of the Bab. The following cable          employing the mass media and increased conwas addressed by the Universal House of Jus-         tact was made with government figures and
> tice to the National Spiritual Assembly:             other public officials.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                           167
> 
> Bahti'{ Centre, San Francisco, California;
> opened November 1976. San Francisco was
> one of the first Bahti'{ communities in the
> United States. New York Bahti'fs also
> acquired a centre during the Five Year Plan.
> 
> 'Baha'i Week' proclamation materials,
> designed by the Bahti'(s of Los Angeles,
> California. Bahti'( week was observed in
> November 1977 in that community.
> 
> Baha'( exhibit, Dulles International Airport,
> Washington, D.C.; February 1976. Similar
> exhibits and dioramas were placed in airports
> across the United States and in Penn Central
> Station, New York. The exhibits honour the
> Bicentennial of the United States.
> 168                                            THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> The period witnessed a marked develop-                     National Visual Committee was formed.
> ment in the participation by women in teaching                    Book Fairs were held in various centres and
> activities both in urban and rural areas.                     the Publishing Trust, Editora Baha'i-Brasil,
> Another notable accomplishment was the                        enriched its list of titles by publishing translatranslation and publication of The Hidden                     tions of Call to the Nations and other works,
> Words of Bahti'u'llah in the Quechua lan-                     thanks in large part to the untiring efforts of the
> guage.                                                        Counsellor resident in Brazil, Mrs. Leonora
> Armstrong, who devotes herself to the task of
> BRAZIL                                    translating.
> The visit of the Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-                    A number of very successful Women's Con-
> Baha Rul)iyyih Khanum and members                             ferences were held on both the regional and
> of the extraordinary 'Green Light Expedi-                     national levels commemorating International
> tion'1 to Brazil in 1975 opened many doors for                Women's Year. An outstanding symposium
> teaching throughout the area. The first Baha'i                was held in Vitoria to mark the United Nations
> conference in the Amazon area was inaugu-                     International Year of the Child. Baha'i specialrated and dozens of Assemblies and groups                     ists in the education of children participated
> were established. An Amazon teaching project                  effectively.
> was launched along the border between Col-                        The Teaching Institutes for the north and
> ombia and Peru, extending from Para to                        south of Brazil, under the supervision of mem-
> Marco. There were valuable offers of pioneers,                bers of the Auxiliary Board, are making progtravelling teachers, funds and boats for the                  ress. In Gravatai there is a school for children
> transportation of teachers. Today in the Ama-                 ranging in age from four to six and government
> zon area there is a group of teachers who reside              recognition has been obtained for Baha'i Holy
> on a boat and conduct classes for children and                Days. The institute in Salvador trains travelling
> adults.                                                       teachers and produces valuable audio-visual
> The Hand of the Cause Enoch Olinga visited                 material including a book entitled Course for
> Brazil in November 1976 inspiring the friends                 Pioneers which is offered by the National
> with unforgettable addresses, and was cor-                    Pioneer Committee.
> dially interviewed by the press and on televi-                    A National Radio Committee was
> sion. The International Conference 2 held in                  developed in Belo Horizonte and devotes itself
> Salvador, Bahia in January 1977 was a glorious                to recording radio programmes on cassettes. A
> experience. Mr. Olinga was the official rep-                  National Music Congress was held which
> resentative of the Universal House of Justice at              heightened recognition among the friends of
> this gathering which attracted 1,300 believers                the value of music in teaching.
> including representatives from forty-six                          The National Spiritual Assembly appointed
> National Spiritual Assemblies and Indian Ba ha' -             highly effective national committees which lent
> is from seventeen tribes . Also in attendance                  a great impetus to the achievement of various
> were the Hands of the Cause Paul Haney and                    aspects of the consolidation work including the
> Dr. Ral).matu'llah Muhajir and all Counsellors                acquisition of Baha'i Centres which now
> from the South American zone.                                  number thirty. The innovative efforts of the
> Teaching conferences and winter and sum-                   national treasurer in dramatizing the needs of
> mer schools held twice a year prepared the                     the Fund led to a series of study classes on the
> youth for participation in teaching and deepen-               subject and resulted in a greater understanding
> ing activities. One result was the opening to the             and maturity on the part of individuals and
> Faith of the islands of Maraj6 and Isla Grande.               communities as they strove to achieve univer-
> The creation of 'Baha'i Week' in Sao Paulo                 sal participation.
> resulted in closer relationships being estab-                     From north to south the Counsellors give
> lished between the Baha'is and various relig-                 strong encouragement to the Baha'is in all
> ious and cultural organizations. Artistic talents             aspects of their activities and seek to collabowere revealed among the Baha'is and a                         rate in every way with the National Spiritual
> Assembly in its projects designed to fulfil the
> See The Bahti'f World, vol. XVI, pp. 419-448 .             goals set for it by the Universal House of Jus-
> See 'Eight International Teaching Conferences', p. 109.    tice.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                           169
> CHILE                           Baha'u'llah, a Prayer Book, a literacy manual
> Great progress was made in Chile during the      and other works; the success of a number of
> Five Year Plan. It doubled the number of            two-week teaching projects which were held
> believers and surpassed its goal calling for the    throughout the country with a view to proformation of seventy-five Local Assemblies by       claiming the Faith and consolidating the knowlestablishing 133 in the last year of the Plan.      edge of believers; and the establishment of a
> Baha'is now reside in 325 localities. Chile         radio recording studio in Bogota and a recordaccomplished its goal of acquiring nine local       ing studio in Cali which produces deepening
> J:I~iratu'l-Quds and nineteen endowments,           materials on cassettes. Both studios have promade great strides in teaching among the            vided the community with useful materials.
> Mapuches and elected seven Local Assemblies            This was the first Plan in which Colombia
> within the metropolitan area of Santiago, thus      was given the goal of sending pioneers abroad.
> augmenting the strength of the Baha'is in the       At Ric;lvan 1979 Colombia had five pioneers
> central zone of the country. Literature in Span-    serving in Venezuela; two in the United
> ish was enriched through the publication in         Republic of Cameroon; two in Costa Rica; and
> Chile of Los cielos estan rendidos (The             one in the countries of Ecuador, Nicaragua and
> Heavens are Cleft Asunder) and Tahirih, Poet-       Uruguay. Of the pioneers which Colombia
> isa y Martir def Iran (a study of the life of       received during the Plan, only seven remained
> Tahirih).                                           at Ric;lvan 1979, including two on San Andres
> 'School Nur' was established in the munici-      Island.
> pal district of Las Cisternas, within the city of
> Santiago. Maintained by a group of self-                               ECUADOR
> sacrificing Baha'i school teachers, this primary       Without doubt one of Ecuador's greatest
> regular school, which offers two years of sec-      blessings has been the establishment of Radio
> ondary level training, follows a curriculum that    Baha'i, the first Baha'i radio station in the
> includes the teaching of religion, a presenta-      world, 1 which facilitates regular communication of progressive revelation and basic Baha'i     tion with believers even in the most remote and
> history. The Baha'is now seek to have the           inaccessible areas. On 19 July 1977 the
> appropriate authorities accord 'School Nur'         National Spiritual Assembly was granted perofficial status as a co-operative school within     mission to operate a station in Otavalo (frethe Chilean system of education.                    quency 1420 KHz). The strategic Mojanda
> Pass was chosen as the site for the transmitter,
> COLOMBIA                           from which transmission could be made into
> Colombia surpassed its goal of 175 Local         the valleys of Otavalo and Cayambe. The first
> Spiritual Assemblies by forming 213 and             historic test broadcast was made on 12 October
> exceeded the 750 localities where Baha'isreside     1977 using a thirty-watt home-built transby achieving 885. There are at least two Local      mitter and a single tape recorder. More sophis-
> Assemblies in each State and forty of these are     ticated equipment was installed over the next
> incorporated.                                       two years enabling transmission with 1,000
> Several achievements during the last three       watts of power and programming adequate for
> years of the Five Year Plan deserve special         the needs of the region was developed. The
> mention. Among these are the strength and           view was to achieve, by December 1979,
> solid foundation achieved in the States of Valle    broadcasts extending over twelve hours each
> and Cauca; the constant flow from the National      day providing listeners, including 133 Local
> Audio-Visual Committee and 'Editorial Nur'          Spiritual Assemblies, with the life-giving mesof audio-visual and deepening materials which       sage of Baha'u'llah as well as programmes for
> are being used in many countries of Latin           cultural enrichment. A second phase of
> America; the establishment of a tutorial teach-     development was the raising of a shortwave
> ing institute (Rul).i) in Puerto Tejada where       facility at a site on Mount Cuicocha which was
> teachers from all parts of the country were         visited by the Hand of the Cause Enoch Olinga
> prepared in a month-long course; the enrich-        in August 1976. The first test broadcast was
> ment of literature in Guajira through the pub-      scheduled for 12 November 1979 (beyond the
> lication of translations of The Hidden Words of     ' See 'Expansion of the Use of Radio and Television', p. 215.
> 170                                              THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> period covered by this report). The plan is to                 then the Cuenca Summer School has become a
> have Radio Baha'i shortwave serve the entire                   popular annual event providing opportunity
> country, and possibly beyond its borders, and                  for deepening and fellowship: In October 1979
> to provide extensive deepening programming.                    the first Summer School for Quechua-speaking
> Radio Baha'i AM, it is expected, will continue                 believers was held in Cachaco, lmbabura, with
> to serve northern Ecuador with programmes of                   promising results.
> proclamation and the presentation of introduc-                    During the Five Year Plan Baha'i Prayers
> tory and basic outlines of the Baha'i teachings.               and The Hidden Words of Baha'u'llah were
> The Five Year Plan called for the formation                 translated into several local languages. The
> of at least one Local Spiritual Assembly in                    monumental task of translating into Quechua
> every County in Ecuador. Several Provinces                     Baha'u'llah and the New Era was completed by
> had not yet been opened to the Faith. The                      Sra. Clementina de Pavon shortly before her
> Baha'is of Cuenca in the south began to visit                  passing.
> the goal areas regularly. In the north, helped by                 The Continental Board of Counsellors of
> Radio Baha'i, more and more Indian believers                   South America compiled beautiful recordings
> arose to participate. The friends in Esmeraldas                of songs with Baha'i themes from all parts of
> on the coast opened up promising new mass                      the continent. The National Spiritual Assemteaching areas. The Amazon basin , remote and                  bly, in close collaboration with the Counseluncertain, proved to be a tremendous chal-                     lors, undertook the distribution of cassettes
> lenge. A few hardy souls made the adventurous                  of the Baha'i recordings through Radio
> journey in precarious boats and even on foot to                Baha'i.
> establish the Faith of Baha'u'llah in the few                     The third International Quechua Confervillages of the area. The teaching in central                  ence, or 'Tantanakuy ', was held in Otavalo in
> Ecuador seemed destined to decline and                         August 1977 , having as its aim the bringing
> perhaps fail. Teaching campaigns were vigor-                   together of the Quechua-speaking friends of
> ously carried out. Travelling teachers from                    Bolivia, Peru and Ecuador so that they could
> neighbouring countries came to lend assis-                     consult on teaching. Each country speaks a
> tance. Members of the Auxiliary Board went to                  different dialect of Quechua so another goal
> the goal areas and stayed there . Finally,                     was to give the friends the opportunity to
> through the combined efforts of all, the wall of               familiarize themselves with the other dialects
> defeat crumbled. Results of the formation of                   and thus more readily understand the Quechua
> Local Assemblies began trickling into the                      literature published in the three countries. An
> national office during the last months of the                  enormous nine-sided thatched auditorium to
> Plan. At Ric;lvan 1979 the heartening news was                 house the conference was built by the friends in
> proclaimed: Ecuador had won her goals, elect-                  volunteer work groups on the property of the
> ing 315 Local Assemblies, with at least one in                 Baha'i Institute named for the Hand of the
> every County.                                                  Cause Amatu'J-Baha Rul)iyyih Khanum. The
> Another major goal was the acquisition of                   result was the 'Choza', a building built in the
> nineteen local I:I~fratu'J-Quds. Most of these                 style of the villagers, though on a larger scale,
> were secured in the Esmeraldas area where the                  and both pleasing to the eye and low in cost .
> friends from each community helped to                          For the inauguration of Radio Baha'i a large
> acquire the land and building materials, and                   picture map of the Province was painted and
> then to raise the buildings. Teaching Institutes               placed as a backdrop for the stage. It gives the
> were constructed in Riobamba, in the central                   impression of viewing the entire Province from
> Andean region, and in Esmeraldas, on the                       afar. The building is crowned with the Greatest
> northern coast. In the city of Cuenca, in the                  Name, placed in the skylight.
> southern Andes, a regional l:l~fratu'l-Quds                       Since its construction the 'Choza' has been
> was begun.                                                     used for many activities including the Folk
> In July 1977 Ecuador's first Summer School                  Music Festival 'Nucanchi Tono' (literally, 'our
> was held in Cuenca. The sessions served as a                   music') sponsored by Radio Baha'i, and a
> satellite conference of the International Teach-               Children's Festival. Every Sunday the Baha'fs
> ing Conference held in Bahia, Brazil. 1 Since                  of the area meet there for morning prayers.
> 1   See ' Eight International Teaching Conferences', p. 109.   The 'Choza' is also the site of the National
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                           171
> 
> Some participants in the third All-Quechua
> Conference held in Otavalo, Ecuador; August
> 1977. Seen standing on the left are Andres
> Jachakollo and Sabino Ortega, Auxiliary
> Board members from Bolivia; Mario Le6n
> (back, centre), a member of the National
> Spiritual Assembly of Peru; and Rufino
> Gual<ivisi, standing second from the right, an
> Auxiliary Board member from Ecuador.
> 
> Street poster, Brazil. Thirty of these large
> posters announced meetings to be held during
> November 1978. While the posters were on
> display the Bahti'is of Sao Paulo observed
> 'Baha'i Week' .
> 
> Students of the Baha'i School of La Cisterna,
> Chile; 1976.
> 172                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Convention and of the National Teaching Con-         south. In the southern Department Qf Puno,
> ference held annually in December.                   180 Local Assemblies were formed. In all, 272
> In December 1976 Otavalo was host to the           Local Assemblies came into being, a consider-
> International Radio-Television Workshop              able increase over the 150 assigned to the
> when friends from Central and South America          country as a goal. In addition, Baha'is were
> met to discuss the use of mass media in the          established as residents in 924 localities at the
> teaching work.                                       end of the period under review. The goal for
> the acquisition of local I:I~ratu'l-Quds was
> GUYANA                           surpassed by two bringing the total to twenty-
> The processes of expanding and consolida-         nine, and although assigned forty-five endowting the Baha'i community moved forward              ments in the Plan, forty-seven were acquired.
> rapidly during this period. Through their con-          Representatives of various jungle tribes
> stant efforts the Baha'is of this richly varied      embraced the Faith in the period as a result of
> society increased their numbers and raised the       teaching activities in their home areas and satotal of Local Spiritual Assemblies and the          cred Writings were translated into the various
> total of localities where Baha'is reside to fifty-   tongues spoken by these believers. In March
> three and 153 respectively, both figures rep-        1978 it was reported that a team of teachers,
> resenting achievements far above the assigned        one of whom purchased a boat named Luz
> goals of the Five Year Plan. Large numbers of        Verde Maiden, were travelling in the Amazon
> believers including youth enthusiastically par-      area, introducing the Faith to people in villages
> ticipated in the annual summer teaching proj-        along the river system.
> ects, and in addition numerous local youth              'Women's Role in the Progress of Humanity'
> activities were held as well as an outstanding       was the theme of the first International Conannual Youth Camp.                                   ference of Baha'i women in South America
> A great increase in the number of local chil-     held during the last week of December 1977.
> dren's classes was complemented by the hold-         In attendance were 200 women from twelve
> ing of several successful national children's        countries. The First Lady of Peru, the wife of
> conferences. National teaching conferences           the President, sent a cordial and significant
> and national conferences for women were also         message to the conference, and good publicity
> held regularly.                                      was obtained. The prestige of the Cause was
> There was excellent progress in the work of       enhanced through the extensive use of radio
> consolidating Local Assemblies and training          broadcasting. A considerable increase in the
> them to function effectively. Many of these          number of Baha'is was recorded as well as a
> bodies began contributing regularly to the           growth in the number of localities where Bah a' -
> National Fund thus playing a part in enabling        is reside. In Peru, as well as in Bolivia and
> this national community to achieve financial         Paraguay, the contribution of the capable and
> independence. There were also successful             dedicated Baha'i youth was outstanding.
> efforts made to expand the use of radio for the
> proclamation of the Faith.                            SURINAM AND FRENCH GUIANA
> Teaching act1v1t1es during the year
> PARAGUAY
> 1976-1977 focused on extending geographi-
> Paraguay surpassed its goals with the formacally the foundations of the Faith and winning
> tion of thirty-seven Local Assemblies, and 114
> to its ranks a greater representation of the peolocalities were opened to the Faith. Extraorple of many races who comprise the populadinary progress was made in the Five Year Plan
> tion, in preparation for the formation of the
> by the believers of Paraguay who were able to
> first National Spiritual Assembly of Surinam
> p!,'oclaim the Faith through the use of radio and
> and French Guiana at Ric;lvan 1977. 1 The
> who succeeded in translating and publishing in
> Hand of the Cause Dhikru'ullah Khadem replocal languages a number of sacred Writings
> resented the Universal House of Justice at the
> including The Hidden Words of Baha'u'llah.
> The National Spiritual Assembly of Guyana, Surinam and
> PERU                                   French Guiana was formed at Ric;Ivan l 970 with its seat in
> Georgetown, Guyana. The seat of the National Spiritual
> Substantial progress was noted in various              Assembly of Surinam and French Guiana is in Paramaribo,
> parts of the country and particularly in the             Surinam.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                     173
> 
> inaugural convention which was held in an                Faith and the individual believers made susatmosphere of joy and excitement.                        tained efforts to spread the teachings of Bah a' -
> Under the guidance of the newly-elected               u'llah throughout every quarter of this nation
> National Spiritual Assembly the work of                  and among the people of different religious
> expansion and consolidation was carried for-             and racial backgrounds who comprise its popuward and the friends were inspired to action by          lation. The number of Baha'fs, localities and
> their attendance at several national and re-             Local Spiritual Assemblies increased steadily.
> gional teaching conferences. Although it is a            Baha'fs now reside in 323 localities and there
> young community the number of believers                  are 138 Local Assemblies.
> increased, localities where Baha'fs reside grew             Several successful national teaching conferto seventy-six and forty-seven Local Spiritual           ences were held, some of which w·ere blessed
> Assemblies were formed. The community also               by the presence of a Hand of the Cause. A
> achieved financial independence and acquired             number of conferences for children and for
> several properties for local or national use.            women took place; and the youth were stimu-
> Outstanding progress was made in establishing            lated to further service by their attendance at
> the Faith among the Bush Negroes of the                  two Youth Camps. Financial independence was
> Surinam River area which was visited by the              also achieved by the community.
> Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha RuJ:ifyyih                   Excellent publicity was obtained in radio
> Khan um and her team of photographers dur-               and television broadcasts with the result that
> ing the Green Light Expedition in 1975. 1 There          nearly all inhabitants of Trinidad and Tobago
> ·were expressions of thanksgiving at Ric;lvan             are aware of the existence of the Baha'i Faith.
> 1979 that all goals of the Five Year Plan had            Concerted activity in 1978 and 1979 enabled
> been achieved.                                           the community to acquire ten local
> I:la-?-fratu'l-Quds and ten local endowments.
> TRINIDAD AND TOBAGO                                  Thus, at Ric;lvan 1979, the believers of
> During this period the institutions of the              Trinidad and Tobago could•celebrate victori-
> ' See 'The Green Light Expedition of Rul)iyyih Khanum',   ous achievement of all goals of the Five Year
> The Baha'i World, vol. XVI, pp. 419-448.                Plan.
> 
> The President of Peru's National Constituent Assembly, Mr. Victor Raul Haya de la Torre,
> receiving a delegation of Peruvian Baha'is who had requested an opportunity to present the
> Baha'i concept ofadministration and justice to those charged with drafting a new Constitution.
> 174                                  THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Bahd'( Children's Class, Ecuador; 1976.
> 
> URUGUAY                           twenty-seven local endowments in Venezuela
> Thirty-eight Local Assemblies were formed       were secured in the Guajira Indian areas of the
> and seventy-nine localities were opened to the     State of Zulia during the last year of the Plan;
> Faith during the Five Year Plan. Within the        the opening to the Faith of Delta Amacuro
> nineteen Departments teaching activities were      (Federal Territory) and the establishment of the
> undertaken and a Local Assembly was estab-         first three Local Spiritual Assemblies in this
> lished in each.                                    area among the Warao tribe; the broadened
> expansion of the Faith in the State of Falcon
> VENEZUELA                          and the formation of five Local Spiritual
> At the end of the Five Year Plan Venezuela      Assemblies among the very receptive people
> had surpassed by seven its assigned goal of 250    who live there, many of whom arose to teach
> Local Spiritual Assemblies and Baha'fs resided     others; increased evidence that the Faith has
> in 830 localities. There is at least one Local     become solidly established among a growing
> Assembly in each State. An all-out effort on       number of youth throughout the country and
> the part of the entire community during the last   especially in Eastern Venezuela; and the
> months of the Plan brought ultimate victory.       development in many areas of the country of
> Among the achievements of this three-year       more deepened communities, demonstrating
> period there are several deserving of special      the effects of a programme of consolidation
> mention: the fact that all nineteen local          which had as its hallmark constancy, patience
> }.la~fratu'l-Quds and all but four of the          and perseverance.
> 
> c. ASIA
> Two new National Spiritual Assemblies were         Spiritual Assembly of the Marshall Islands
> formed in Asia as supplementary achieve-           with its seat in Majuro, at Ric;lvan 1977, and the
> ments of the Five Year Plan, the National          National Spiritual Assembly of the Mariana
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                                     175
> Islands with its seat in Guam, at Ric:Ivan 1978. 1              been supported by the holding of Summer
> The National Spiritual Assembly of Jordan,                   Schools, Teaching Institutes, conferences, spewith its seat in Amman, was established at                      cial teaching trips and the efforts of visiting
> Ric:Ivan 1975, fulfilling a goal of the Five Year               Baha'ls from many parts of the world.
> Plan.                                                              Two effective banquets were held at which
> For the purposes of the functioning of the                   awards were presented to two prominent
> Continental Boards of Counsellors, Asia is                      non-Baha'i women in recognition of their serdivided into four zones:                                        vice to their community. These provided excel-
> North-eastern Asia                                           lent publicity for the Faith. The award pre-
> South Central Asia                                           sented on each occasion is named for the Hand
> South-eastern Asia                                           of the Cause Agnes Alexander,2 and the event
> Western Asia                                                 becomes increasingly well known as the Agnes
> A number of the national communities                         Baldwin Alexander Awards Banquet.
> within these zones function under external
> difficulties inimical to the Faith. Although this                                   JAPAN
> circumstance renders it impossible to report in                    The visits of several of the beloved Hands of
> any detail on the development of the Baha'i                     the Cause of God provided great impetus to
> community in various countries, the situation                   the development of the Baha'i community
> in some of these territories is described under                 between 1976 and 1979. The National Teach-
> 'Efforts to Protect the Faith from Persecution                  ing Conference in December 1976 was graced
> and to Free it from the Restraints Imposed by                   by the presence of the Hands of the Cause
> Religious Orthodoxy' on pages 78 to 81 of this                  'Ali-Akbar Furutan and Dr. Ra9matu'llah
> survey.                                                         Muhajir. Mr. Furutan returned the following
> year for a second visit. The Japanese communtiy also received encouragement and guidance
> North-eastern Asia                                 from the Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone who stressed the need for widespread
> THE HAWAIIAN ISLANDS                                      proclamation of the Faith. Mr. Hushmand
> The National Spiritual Assembly of the                        Fathea 'zam of the Universal House of Justice
> Baha'ls of the Hawaiian Islands excelled in the                 also visited and discussed with the friends the
> area of proclamation of the Faith through the                   spiritual aspects of the Baha'i teachings, a topic
> creation and use of visual aids, displays,                      of particular interest to the Japanese believers.
> prize-winning floats, abundant radio coverage                      The Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha
> and programmes, advertising and television.                     Ru91yyih Khanum planned to travel through-
> Particularly successful was the television series               out Japan to encourage the friends, but
> produced in collaboration with the Hand of the                  because of illness she was forced to leave soon
> Cause William Sears. This series, and other                     after arriving in October 1977. In the same
> audio-visual aids, was generously shared with                   month of the following year she returned and
> other national communities.                                     was joyously welcomed. During her stay which
> Most goals of the Five Year Plan were                         extended over a period of two months she
> achieved but considerable difficulty was                        stimulated activity in each area she visited. All
> experienced in acquiring property due to the                    who met her were encouraged to arise in serunusual zoning laws obtaining in Hawaii as                      vice to the Cause and experienced an increase
> well as the great number of large privately-                    in confidence. Ru9fyyih Khan um was cordially
> owned estates.                                                  received by a large number of prominent indi-
> The work of teaching the Faith and con-                       viduals during her travels in Japan.
> solidating the gains has been constant and has                     Very significant to the development of the
> Faith in Japan during this period was the
> 'The National Spiritual Assembly of the North West Pacific
> Ocean came into being in 1972 with its seat in Ponape .
> appointment, in 1976, of Mr. Hideya Suzuki of
> Caroline Islands. The Caroline, Mariana and Marsha ll          Hokkaido to the Continental Board of Co unse l-
> Islands came within its jurisdiction. With the forma tion of   lors for North-eastern Asia.
> these two National Spiritual Assemblies at Ri<;lvan 1977
> the parent Assembly was renamed the National Spiritual
> Assembly of the Caroline Islands.                                  See "In Memoriam ', Th e Bah(/ { World , vol. XV, p. 423.
> 176                                   THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> A teaching team from the Philippines came        Koreans, a large number of whom engage in
> to Japan in 1978 and remained until the end of      farming, and therefore the winter months are
> the Plan. Their devoted and selfless efforts        fruitful for teaching. Assisted and co-ordinated
> encouraged many of the Japanese friends to          by the Auxiliary Board members, in large part,
> join them to achieve the unfulfilled goals of the   many teaching trips were undertaken and these
> Plan . During this period and particularly          served as an extremely effective means of
> toward the end of the Plan a wave of pioneers       establishing and deepening Local Assemblies
> and travelling teachers from the United States,     as well as drawing people to embrace the Faith.
> Canada, Alaska and Iran co-operated with the
> Japanese community in winning the goals. One        THE MARIANA, MARSHALL AND
> indication of the growth of the Baha'i commun-                CAROLINE ISLANDS
> ity in this country is that the National Assembly      The most significant administrative steps
> was able to send travelling teachers to assist      taken during this period were the formation of
> other national communities in their teaching        the National Assemblies of the Marshall Islands
> work. The gradual strengthening of the Japan-       in 1977, and of the Marianas in 1978. Their
> ese community created conditions which              parent body, the National Spiritual Assembly
> enabled the National Assembly, in 1979, to          of the North West Pacific Ocean, was renamed
> become financially independent.                     the National Assembly of the Caroline Islands.
> A large quantity of Baha'i literature was           The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone
> translated and published in the period under        represented the Universal House of Justice at
> review, thus creating for the Japanese-             the inaugural convention for the election of the
> speaking friends an opportunity to enrich their     first National Spiritual Assembly of the Marunderstanding of the verities of the Faith.         shall Islands. He visited the entire area of the
> Marshalls, the Marianas and the Carolines,
> KOREA                            greatly assisting and inspiring the friends.
> Stimulated and nurtured by the frequent and         At the formation of the first National
> inspiring visits to Korea of the much-loved         Spiritual Assembly of the Marianas, the Hand
> Hand of the Cause Dr. Ral).matu'llah Muhajir,       of the Cause Dr. Ral).matu'llah Muhajir was
> the Korean community developed well-                the representative of the Universal House of
> organized plans for teaching and consolidating,     Justice and during the same Ri<;lvan period he
> and achieved most of the goals assigned to          attended the National Convention of the
> them in the Five Year Plan. The efforts made        Baha'is of the Caroline Islands.
> to acquire one I:Ia'.?iratu'l-Quds in each Prov-       In the Marshall Islands the indigenous
> ince unfortunately met with difficulties which      believers were largely responsible for opening
> prevented the achievement of this goal,             every major island to the Faith as called for in
> although progress m other areas was                 the Five Year Plan, and the considerable
> significant.                                        number of believers who arose to serve as
> Teaching Institutes, conferences, Summer         travelling teachers was outstanding. One
> and Winter Schools and visits from travelling       native believer of the Caroline Islands deputeachers from Japan and the Philippines all         tized others to travel to districts other than his
> served to strengthen the fabric of Baha'i com-      own in order that they might spread the mesmunity life. A Women's Institute was held for       sage of Baha'u'llah; his gesture demonstrated
> the study of Baha'i education and the Baha'i        how the Faith has eliminated the barriers
> family; and classes for children, and youth         which have traditionally existed between disactivities, were particularly emphasized and        tricts.
> developed.                                             Local believers in the Mariana Islands by the
> Plans were undertaken for a more wide-           use of effective teaching teams doubled the
> spread proclamation of the Faith throughout         numbers enrolled in the Cause.
> Korea as a result of the visit of the Hand of the      The friends in the Mariana and Marshall
> Cause Collis Featherstone and although a            Islands fulfilled all the goals assigned them in
> beginning has been made toward this goal            the Five Year Plan. A National Centre was
> much more remains to be done.                       acquired in the Marshall Islands and is fre-
> The winter season is not busy for many           quently used. Located in a densely populated
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                              177
> 
> Participants in the National Teaching
> Conference held at Kinakopw, Ponape,
> Caroline Islands; 5-6 November 1977.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone
> (extreme right), Counsellor Richard Benson
> (second from left), members of the Auxiliary
> Board and their assistants who attended the
> first National Convention of the Bah<i'[s of the
> Marshall Islands; April 1977. (Left to right:
> Juliana Korean, Richard Benson, Ertin Eliu,
> Virginia Breaks, Betra Laipen, Edwin Pedro,
> Mr. Featherstone.)
> 
> Hawaiian Baha'lfloat, 'Aloha Week' parade,
> Honolulu; 14October1978. 'One
> World - One People' was the theme of the
> float which included a 15-foot statue of King
> Kamehameha, a globe of the world and the
> Hawaiian flag. The float was honoured by
> being chosen to close the parade.
> 178                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> area where many Baha'fs reside it is easily          the Five Year Plan . Pio neers have settled in
> accessible. The Local Centre situated on             goal towns so that many distric;ts of the co untry
> Ebeye in the Marshall Islands is very attractive     now have a pio neer in reside nce. Representain appeara nce. It was built with the consent of     tives of the Chakma , Mongh , T uria, Morung
> the gove rnme nt authorities and the traditional     and Santa i tribes have embraced the Faith and
> lea ders.                                            are deepening their knowledge of its verities in
> TAIWAN                           order to teach th eir fe ll ow tribesmen.
> A steady fl ow of travelling teachers and             Women 's activities have steadily increased
> pioneers to Taiwa n had a great effect upon the      and Baha'i women are being encouraged to
> teaching work. Through the consistent, well-         participate more fully in the work of the Faith .
> plann ed and devoted efforts of a team of travel-    A conference for wome n was he ld in Dacca,
> ling teachers made up of Baha'ls from                and women took part in the Nation a l Teaching
> Malaysia, H ong Kong, the Philippines, and the       Conference as well as the Wi nter Schools. Speenthusiastic co-operation of the Baha'ls of          cial study classes for wo men were also organ-
> Taiwan, all the goals of the Five Year Plan          ized. T he correspondence course is conducted
> were won. The spirit of sacrifi ce a nd determi-     by women.
> nation rose to new heights as the end of the             A sma ll number of ch ildren's tutorial classes
> Plan drew near and in the final three month s of     have been started and a re carried on satisfacthe Plan more than seventy people enro lled as       torily.
> Baha'ls.                                                 The Natio nal Spiritual Assembly of Bang-
> An hi storic moment occurred with the first       lades h had the distinction of being the first in
> mention of the Faith on rad io in Taiwan and         the South Central zone to complete its teaching
> the use of bus posters to proclaim the Faith was     goals . In addition , the Baha'ls of Bangladesh
> found to be effective. The appearance of the         acquired a Temple site and a national endowposters resulted in almost daily calls from          ment.
> enquirers seeking information about the Faith.                              INDIA
> The Faith was brought to the atten tion of gov-          One-third of the world's total numberofLocal
> ernment officials a nd use was made of news-         Spiritual Assemblies and localities where
> paper advertisements. A visit from the Hand of       Baha'ls reside are to be found in India. During
> the Cause Collis Featherstone in the opening         the Five Year Plan there was witnessed an upphase of the Plan stimul ated the development        su rge of participation by local believers. The
> of these means of proclamation.                      Nation al Spiritu al Asse mbl y and the Continen-
> Four regiona l conferences were he ld on the      tal Board of Counsellors, in res ponse to the
> Covenant, a nd there were other conferences          instructio ns of the Universal House of Justice
> devoted to o th e r topics. An increased receptiv-   to utilize local ma npower, ap pealed very
> ity and inte rest amo ng children a nd youth was     strongly fo r pioneers and trave lling teachers,
> noted during these years.                           and those who responded were directed to
> Toward th e end of the Plan the Baha'i com-       concentrate o n areas of greatest need. T hese
> munity of Taiwan was ho no ured by a visit from     efforts, combined with those of the friends who
> Amatu'l-Baha Rul:llyyih Khanum. Her visit           have pio neered to India from abroad, resulte d
> deeply affected the community and the spirit of      in India's surpassing the goals of the Five Yea r
> her service encouraged the friends to move          Plan. Although 7,000 Local Assemblies were
> forward more rapidly to complete the goals of         assigned, a total of 10,377 were formed. Baha'-
> the Plan. H er statement that 'consolidation'        ls now reside in 34,873 localities, exceeding
> may be summed up in two words, 'Go back!',          the assigned goal by 4 ,873.
> inspired man y of the Baha'ls in Taiwan to              Although the work of consolidating the
> devote themselves to preserving the goals won .     Local Spiritual Assemblies is hampered by
> illiteracy in the rural areas a solution is found in
> confirming and deepening th e village school-
> South Central Asia                         mas te r who is then able to train the local
> BANGLADESH                                believers in administrative practice . The mem-
> Systematically and surely the Baha'ls of            bers of the Auxiliary Board rendered valuable
> Bangladesh have striven to fulfill the goals of       service in appointing assistants who through
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                     179
> personal contact or correspondence deepened            these go a long way to inspire the believers.
> the knowledge of these key believers who were          Members of the Santhal and Majhi tribes have
> thus ab le to strengthen their own Local               accepted the Faith and in some of these States a
> Assemblies and in some instances others in            State Teaching Committee has been formed.
> nearby areas.                                             The East-West Project organized by the
> The National Teaching Committee organ-              National Youth Committee in Kera la during
> ized regular deepening classes which were held        the early years of the Five Yea r Plan was a
> in various centres. In the very centre of mass        great success. A number of be lievers from the
> teaching, in Gwalior and Indore, the classes           United States of America, the United Kingwere held at the Rabbani School and the Faizi         dom and other countries came to Kerala and
> Institute, and in the State of Uttar Pradesh ,         joined with the Indian Baha'i youth in promotwhich has the second largest number of Local           ing the Cause in south India.
> Assemblies, they were held in the Malhousie               Special teaching projects have been organ-
> Institute. Elsewhere a central village would be        ized in most parts of India including the eleven
> the host for such gatherings. The result of these      States specifically mentioned a mong the goals
> classes was the raising of a cadre of local friends    of the Five Year Plan.
> who were ready to serve in any capacity, and              The period under survey also witnessed
> the creation of an increased awareness of the          unimagined victories in the remote Andaman
> significance of the Cause.                             and Nicobar Islands. Within a short time after
> The South India Teaching Project-a brain-           the arrival of devoted pioneers, including a
> child of the Hand of the Cause Dr. Ra~matu'llah        member of the Auxiliary Board , eleven Local
> Muhajir and one which had the blessing of the         Spiritual Assemblies were formed, and despite
> Universal House of Justice-was the most                the distance separating the many islands
> important project undertaken in the period             reports arrived describing the strengthening of
> under review. Collaborating in the scheme              Local Assemblies and their wish to become, so
> were the National Spiritual Assemblies of              far as possible, self-supporting in their activities.
> India and Malaysia. The devotion and sincerity         Very recently a conference was held in the capital
> of the Malaysian friends who came to take part         city of Andaman, Port Blair, which drew the
> inspired enthusiastic support from the local           elite and the intellectuals to hear of the Faith.
> believers. The project set up its base at Sulur in        Another area deserving of special mention is
> Tamil Nadu and from there the participants            the tribal district of Dangs which is common to
> systematically visited all surrounding areas,         the States of Maharashtra and Gujarat.
> forming Local Spiritual Assemblies and then           Through the combined efforts of friends from
> moving outward. At the time of writing this           Bombay and nearby towns in Maharashtra,
> report a number of bases have been established        this district which consists of 313 villages, has a
> and more than 1,000 Local Spiritual Assem-            Local Assembly in each village-the first disblies have been formed.                               trict to achieve this distinction . The rate of
> The success achieved in this project encour-       illiteracy is high in the area and consequently
> aged the National Assembly to inaugurate the          the Faith is taught through songs to some
> East India Project. A lthough conceived on a          extent, the words of which are memorized and
> smaller scale the participants have succeeded         repeated. It is heartwarming to hear the tribal
> in opening to the Faith various States in             people singing songs of their own composition,
> north-east India and pioneers have settled in         accompanying themselves on their unsophisti-
> Arunachal Pradesh, Tripura, Nagaland,                 cated instruments. The songs tell the history of
> Assam and Meghalaya, areas fortunate enough           the Faith and describe its principles and teachto have been visited by Dr. Muhajir. In the           ings.
> district of Burdwan almost the total population          Summer and Winter Schools are regularly
> of two villages have embraced the Faith as a          held and these make their own valuable conresult of the efforts of teachers taking part in      tribution to the development of the Cause in
> the project and the Auxiliary Board member of         this country. The youth take leadership roles in
> West Bengal. A number of songs celebrating            many of these projects either under the
> the three Central Figures of the Faith have           National Youth Committee or the Local Youth
> been composed and are sung in Bengali and             Committees.
> 180                                           THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> There has been in recent years a break-                   blies and the National Spiritual Assembly; but
> through in the awareness of the media regard-                due to the efforts of the administrative commiting the Baha'i Faith. The radio authorities have             tee based in Kathmandu, some progress has
> been approached and for the first time have no               been made. Several local administrative comhesitation in mentioning Baha'i events and                   mittees have been formed and have been acticelebrations on various stations throughout the              vated and encouraged by the committee based
> country. Radio talks prepared in advance for                 in Kathmandu. Children's classes are being
> special Holy Days are now broadcast in the                   held and deepening conferences were held in
> local languages on local stations of All-India               some towns attended by friends from nearby
> Radio. The press has shown a greater willing-                villages. A bilingual Nineteen Day Feast Newsness to publish Baha'i articles and the believers            letter in Nepali and English is distributed and a
> have developed an increased recognition of                   Nepali translation of The Hidden Words of
> how to establish good relations with represen-               Baha'u'lltih was produced in collaboration
> tatives of the media.                                        with the Baha'i Publishing Trust of India. The
> The relationship between the various                      National Administrative Committee achieved
> Institutions of the Faith has been one of con-               another outstanding success in forming a
> stant co-operation and love and harmony, the                 Baha'i Trust for the safeguarding of Baha'i proelective and appointive agencies working hand                perties.
> in hand toward fulfilment of the goals assigned                                   SIKKIM
> by the Universal House of Justice.                              Progress of the Cause in the State of Sikkim
> More than 1,000 Baha'i women from all                     is made difficult because of the mountainous
> across Asia, with observers and speakers from                terrain and during the winter months especially
> Europe and America, gathered at Vigyan Bha-                  many parts are not easily accessible to pioneers
> van Auditorium in New Delhi from October                     who must travel from the plains.
> 13th to 16th, 1977 for the Asian Baha'i                         The Baha'i Primary School at Tadong has
> Women's Conference. 1 The presence of the                    acquired a good reputation throughout the
> Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha Rul)iyyih                     State. Recently there has been an increase in
> Khanum, the most distinguished guest and                     the number of pioneers some of whom have
> principal speaker for the event, was a source of             come to serve at the school. A devoted Baha'i
> great joy and happiness to the believers. The                who is an experienced teacher and who forgathering was the occasion for an unpre-                     merly served at the New Era School, Panchcedented degree of publicity through the news                gani, is now Principal. Fresh enthusiasm has
> media. Interviews appeared in many publica-                  been infused into the community and several
> tions. All-India Radio broadcast the news in                 deepening conferences have been held under
> Malayalam, the language of Kerala, and                       the joint aegis of the National Spiritual
> covered both the opening and conclusion of the               Assembly and the Auxiliary Board members.
> conference in both domestic and foreign                      A district l;la?'.fratu'l-Quds is under construcbroadcasts. The inauguration was also covered                tion at Singtham, the second largest town of
> by United Press International for foreign dis-               Sikkim. The location is very prominent and the
> tribution. The highlight of the conference was               existence of the l;la?'.fratu'l-Quds will itself
> the laying of the foundation stone of the                    proclaim the Faith in that region.
> Mother Temple of India by Rul)lyyih                             A successful Himalayan Conference was
> Khanum. 2 At the time of this report the work                held in May 1977 in Gangtok, Sikkim's capital,
> of levelling the land has been completed in                  fulfilling one of the goals of the Five Year Plan.
> preparation     for    construction     of the               Present at the gathering were members of the
> Mashriqu'l-Adhkar.                                           Continental Board of Counsellors, members of
> NEPAL                                    the Auxiliary Board, representatives of the
> Due to the present circumstances it has not               National Spiritual Assembly of India and other
> been possible to elect Local Spiritual Assem-                believers from as far away as Ireland, Belgium,
> 1 The first Asian Women's Conference was held in             Malaysia, iran and India. The Governor of
> December I 930 . A joint cable was sent to the assembled   Sikkim, the Speaker of the Legislative Assemfriends by Shoghi Effendi and the Greatest Holy Leaf.
> ' See 'The Mother Temple of the Indian Subcontinent', p.     bly of Sikkim and other state ministers and
> 368.                                                       heads of government departments honoured
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                               181
> 
> Some participants in the Baha'i Summer
> School, Taiwan; 9-12 July 1976.
> 
> Bahti'(s of the Lama tribe who participated in
> the Winter School, Bangladesh; 1977.
> 
> Participants in the third Western Asian Youth
> Conference held in Lucknow, India; August
> 1976. Seen are Baha'(s from Thailand,
> Sikkim, iran, India, Ireland and the United
> States.
> 182                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> the Baha'fs by attending the inaugural session.   where reference is made, under point No. 6, to
> Joint consultation between the representatives    the efforts that have been made to protect the
> of the National Assemblies oflndia and Sikkim     Faith from persecution and to free it from the
> resulted in facilitating greater co-operation     restraints imposed by religious orthodoxy. The
> between the two institutions in fulfilling the    Faith is not officially banned in Brunei, another
> goals in that area.                               country within this zone, but the activities of
> the Baha'ls there are restricted.
> SRI LANKA                           All countries in the zone where the Baha'ls
> The Faith in Sri Lanka experienced steady enjoy freedom achieved all the major goals of
> progress during this period, a notable accom- the Five Year Plan. This significant accomplishment being the settling of pioneers in the plishment required inter-Assembly co-opera-
> Maldive Islands. The fortunate situation geo- tion and the full support of all the Institutions
> graphically of Sri Lanka made it possible for of the Faith.
> Baha'i travelling teachers from different parts      Pioneers and travelling teachers, particuof the world to visit briefly and lend assistance larly from Malaysia and the Philippines, arose
> to the work.                                      in large numbers to aid the work in this region,
> The National Youth Committee has held as well as in Taiwan, the Pacific Islands and a
> various conferences as well as Summer number of other countries. In many cases their
> Schools.                                          efforts and sacrifices enabled the goals to be
> A correspondence course in the Tamil lan- met. Rural-born Tamil-speaking believers of
> guage has been inaugurated by a special com- Malaysia have provided the main thrust in the
> mittee and in collaboration with the Baha'i South India Teaching Project. The success of
> Publishing Trust of India a large number of these believers and their effectiveness as
> Baha'i books have been made available to the teachers illustrates that nothing is impossible
> Tamil-speaking people of the country. Transla- to those whose hearts are filled with a love of
> tions into Singhalese of a corresponding Baha'u'llah.
> number of books is now under way .                   The achievement of property goals has been
> Public lectures were sponsored by the Baha'- due in most instances to a growing desire on the
> ls to coincide with various United Nations part of the local friends to shoulder the finandays with participation by representatives of cial burdens of the Cause.
> the United Nations organization.                     In the field of publication there has been
> Deepening classes were conducted regularly great progress. In the past, translation, reviewin the Baha'i Centres which have been ing and printing were time-consuming and the
> acquired in the years under survey.               output was limited. The past years have witnes-
> The committees appointed by the National sed the publication of a number of books in
> Spiritua l Assembly functioned responsibly and Chinese, Tamil and other local languages
> the teaching conferences organized on a which have aided the friends in deepening their
> national level by these committees evoked understanding of the Faith. The sacrifice made
> good response .                                    by the friends who devoted themselves to producing these books which so greatly aid the
> teaching work must be appreciated.
> South-eastern Asia                       Deepening classes, conferences, Summer
> and Winter Schools have all contributed to
> This zone comprises one of the most densely strengthening the fabric of Baha'i community
> populated areas in the world and its population life and increased spiritual maturity.
> is representative of diverse cultural and all       The International Conference in Hong Kong
> major religious backgrounds. Owing to various in November 1976, 1 the regional conferences
> external circumstances the Baha'i com- in Port Dickson and Kuching, the conferences
> munities within the zone enjoy freedom in in Manila and Bangkok have played a major
> varying degrees. A brief comment about the part in revitalizing the enthusiasm of the
> situation in Kampuchea (Cambodia), Laos, believers, releasing in them a spirit that promp-
> Indonesia and Vietnam will be found under the ted them to serve as pioneers and travelling
> survey of'World Centre Goals' on pages 80--81, ' See 'Eight International Teaching Conferences', p. 109.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                             183
> 
> Participants in a nine-day Spiritual Institute,
> Malaysia; May 1977.
> 
> Participants in World Religion Day meeting,
> Hong Kong; 21January1978. Left to right:
> Dr. Paul Clasper, an Anglican clergyman;
> Mr. Chester Lee, Mr. H. A zizi, members of
> the National Spiritual Assembly of Hong
> Kong.
> 
> Students and fa culty of th e Rabbani Bahli'f
> School, Gwalior, India; 1977.
> 184                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> teachers, enabling plans to be formulated for
> various teaching projects for which the funds
> were forthcoming.
> The visits of the Hands of the Cause
> Amatu'l-Baha Rul)iyyih Khanum , Collis
> Featherstone, Dr. Ra~matu'llah Muhajir,
> Abu'l-Qasim Faizi and member of the International Teaching Centre, Mrs . Florence
> Mayberry, played a decisive role in guiding the
> National Spiritual Assemblies, the Board of
> Counsellors and the friends in this zone. Their
> timely visits broadened our perspective , raised
> our sometimes sagging spirits, inspired us to an
> awareness of the loftiness of the Faith, encouraged the launching of realistic projects and
> plans and generally propelled us to achieve our
> goals.
> The members of the Auxiliary Board and
> their assistants contributed a great deal to the
> successful completion of the Five Year Plan
> goals. In many countries they were invited to
> spearhead teaching projects and increasingly
> as they grow in their understanding of their          Siyyid Shah Muf:iammad, a Bahti'[ of the
> role and their services command the respect of        Lur Tribe of Buyr Af:imad, who at 105 years
> the communities they serve, they organize             of age is serving as a pioneer in a village
> training sessions for assistants, supervise their                  in Luristtin, lrtin.
> work, and initiate teaching plans . In many
> countries where local communities are young
> or weak the presence and work of the Auxiliary
> Board member is indispensable.
> Western Asia
> The youth in this region have played a key
> role in the development of the Cause and many            Western Asia, during the latter part of the
> serve effectively on committees. Women in this       Five Year Plan, was repeatedly engulfed in
> zone are emerging as a force in the Cause and        political unrest and upheavals. The events of
> larger numbers of them have arisen to take an        these tumultuous years remind us of the warnactive part in various fields of service. There is   ings, prophecies and exhortations of the Founa growing need for classes devoted to the edu-       ders of the Baha'i Faith, so forcefully called to
> cation of Baha'i children, the systematizing of      our attention by Shoghi Effendi in The Promsuch classes and the provision of appropriate        ised Day is Come. The calamities and persematerials.                                           cutions which, as the result of the turbulence,
> Special attention is being paid to the ques-      descended upon the Baha'ls in the cradle of the
> tion of teaching Chinese-speaking people with        Faith inevitably caused interruptions and setresults that appear to be encouraging.               backs in the final accomplishment of some of
> The growing number of believers, the              the goals of the Plan.
> increase in the number of Local Spiritual                In spite of political unrest and the conse-
> Assemblies and the proliferation of commit-          quent interruptions of the steady progress in
> tees serve to draw attention to a need for           the impleme[ltation of the Five Year Plan,
> improved organization; but in firm belief that      most of the goals assigned to the Pakistan
> the solution to these problems lies within the      Baha'i community were accomplished. These
> teachings of Baha'u'llah, a growing number of       included the acquisition of properties for local
> friends with administrative skills are emerging      l::la?-frat'ul-Quds; establishing local endowto meet the need in the communities of this           ments; translation of Baha'i literature into sevzone .                                               eral regional languages; the publication and
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                               185
> distribution of new and important titles by the      sive and helpful ro le in the success of these
> Baha'i Publishing T rust; holding well-pub-          programmes. The Teaching Institute in
> licized public meetings; and sponsoring              Thataha, the first of its kind in Pakistan , was
> conferences and activities aimed at deepening        completed and put into operation. The rural
> the friends, thus helping them to bring their        school established in Tharparker received a
> lives into closer conformity with Baha'i teach-      special welcome and the support of the local
> ings.                                                authorities. Finally there was the inauguration
> Although the total number of localities           of the 'New Day' Montessori School in a
> where Baha'is reside reached 301 , this was          befitting location adjacent to the national
> short of the assigned goa l of 350. The number       I;Ia~rat'ul-Quds. The school has attracted a
> of Local Spiritual Assemblies, however, rose to      large number of children from non-Baha'i
> 177 , greatly exceeding the goa l of 150. The        fami lies in Karach i and has already become a
> geographical distribution of the new Assem-          prestigious institution.
> blies was less uniform than planned. In some            The community of the Most Great Name in
> areas such as Sind there were unexpected vic-        Turkey, in the face of the restrictions and
> tories while in Baluchistan the number of func-      uncertainty caused by the political unrest
> tioning Assemblies fe ll below the required          redoubled their efforts and won the crown of
> number in the Plan.                                  victory. In the course of the successful comple-
> The most promising and appreciated vic-           tion of the goals of the Five Year Plan, they
> tories of the Plan occurred in the field of educa-   managed to exceed the assigned goals on a
> tion . The regular, well-attended and properly       number of occasions. They formed thirty-three
> managed Summer and Winter Schools drew               Local Spiritual Assemblies-one more than
> large numbers of friends from far and near           ca lled for-and exceeded by twenty-eight the
> including participants from other countries in       assigned number of localities where Baha'is
> Western Asia. The youth played a very deci-          reside , bringing the total to 103.
> 
> Baha'i Children's Class, Daglanlu Village, Adhirbtiyjan, iran; May 1977. The teacher is Mr.
> A. Ashjarf.
> 186                                             THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> In addition to intensified teaching and pro-                    The sufferings which engulfed the friends in
> pagation activities, Baha'i literature in Turkish               Iran during the concluding months of the Five
> received special attention and was enriched                     Year Plan galvanized their brethren in the
> substantia lly. The Summer School program-                      neighbouring countries in an unprecedented
> mes attracted a significant number of partici-                  manner and impelled them to rise to new
> pants from countries in Western Asia where                      heights of dedication and service. As the Five
> such activities are not yet feasible. The youth                 Year Plan was drawing to a close the
> continued to be active in teaching the Faith and                emergence of a new spiritual environment was
> in conducting classes. They regularly produced                  fully evident in the Baha'i communities of
> well-prepared periodicals.                                      Western Asia.
> 
> o. AUSTRALASIA AND THE PACIFIC ISLANDS
> With the formation of the Na tional Spiritual                leaving their home in the United States to plant
> Assembly of the New Hebrides at Ric,lvan                        the banner of the Faith in the Pacific. They
> 1977 , with its seat in Port Vila, a major goal of              were affectionately known as Father and
> the Five Year Plan was accomplished and the                     Mother Dunn and later were named Hands of
> number of National Assemblies in this zone                      the Cause of God. They set out by steamer,
> was raised to ten . The responsibility for the                  stopping at Pago Pago, Eastern Samoa, where
> establishment of this new pillar of the Univer-                 they raised the cry Ya Bahci'u'l-Abhci! and
> sal House of Justice rested with the National                   offered prayers before continuing on their way
> Spiritual Assembly of the South West Pacific                    to Australia . It was many of their spiritual
> Ocean whose territory now comprises New                         descendants who answered the call of the
> Caledonia and the Loyalty Islands. At Ric,lvan                  Guardian in the World Crusade (1953-1963)
> 1979 it was renamed the National Spiritual                      and opened to the Faith a number of the islands
> Assembly of New Caledonia and the Loyalty                       of the South Pacific. Today the Australasian
> Islands; its seat is Noumea, New Caledonia.                     zone, with its many diversified activities,
> This vast area of the world occupies a unique                administers its affairs through ten National
> place in the community of the Greatest Name .                   Spiritual Assemblies: Papua New Guinea,
> The ready support and encouragement of His                      Australia, Solomon Islands, New Caledonia
> Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II of Western                      and Loyalty Islands, New Zealand, New Heb-
> Samoa, the first reigning monarch to embrace                    rides, Kiribati and Tuvalu (formerly the Gilthe Faith of Baha'u'llah, 1 has been a source of                bert Islands) , Fiji, Samoa and Tonga. The
> joy and inspiration not only to the Baha'is of                  majority of the members of these Assemblies
> Samoa but to many who have come to know                         are people indigenous to the Pacific who have
> him.                                                            responded to the message of Baha'u'llah with
> The Australasian area, mostly covered by                     heart and soul and laboured mightily to estabthe waters of the South Pacific ocean, com-                     lish His Faith among their people.
> prises 2,300 communities scattered among                           The period from 1976 to 1979 was one of the
> thousands of tiny islands . Its inhabitants are                 greatest in the history of the Faith in
> from diverse races, Polynesian , Melanesian ,                   Australasia in terms of expanding and con-
> Micronesian, Caucasian and Aborigine, who                       solidating its foundations. By Ric,lvan 1979 the
> are becoming increasingly attracted to the                      National Assemblies had accomplished almost
> Faith.                                                          all their goals. Nine National Assemblies
> To the shores of the largest land mass,                      exceeded locality goals by almost 400, raising
> Australia, in 1919, came two wonderful                          the total to 2,376 in the zone . Six National
> pioneers, Mr. and Mrs. John Henry Hyde                          Assemblies exceeded Local Assembly goals,
> Dunn,2 who, although advanced in years,                         bringing the zonal total to 583 . More than half
> responded to the Tablets of the Divine Plan by                  the countries of the Baha'i world that have a
> See 'First Head of State Embraces the Cause of Baha'-       Baha'i population of one per cent or more are
> u'llah', The Baha'i World, vol. XV, p. 180.                 in Australasia. The islands of Kiribati and
> John Henry Hyde Dunn, see 'In Memoriam', The Baha'f
> World, vol. IX , p. 593; Clara Hyde Dunn, ' In Memoriam',
> Tuvalu have the highest per capita Baha'i
> The Baha'f World , vol. XIII, p. 859.                       population in the world, almost nine per cent,
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                        187
> 
> Conference of Auxiliary Board members and their assistants, held in Vavan, Tonga; June
> 1977.
> 
> Participants in Bahti'f Children's Conference, Samoa; April 1977.
> 188                                                  THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> an eloquent testimony to the heroism of the                           Tanumafili II, is an event that will never be
> early pioneers to the area and the sincere and                        forgotten in Samoa. The historic and colourful
> unprecedented response of the people. The                             ceremony was attended by many leading govnumber of believers in Australasia has grown                          ernment officials and hundreds of believers
> by leaps and bounds. Kiribati and Fiji almost                         from the villages together with delegates and
> doubled their numbers. By Ri<;tvan 1979                               friends from overseas. Several other islands of
> Australasia had an increase of well over one                          the Pacific had the privilege of welcoming
> hundred per cent.                                                     Ru~yyih Khanum. In New Zealand she spent
> The Hands of the Cause who visited the area                        much of her time among the Maoris. Throughin this period inspired many victories through                        out her extended visit to the Pacific islands she
> their love and encouragement, and the devo-                           participated in many meetings with the friends,
> tion of many local believers, the sacrifices of                       met government officials, was interviewed in
> the pioneers as well as travelling teachers who                       the press, on radio and television, and greatly
> laboured in the villages, brought the Five Year                       aided in enhancing the prestige of the Faith and
> Plan to a glorious conclusion. It is difficult in a                   its recognition by island governments. All who
> short survey to report the manifold activities in                     met her were inspired by her indomitable
> detail, but several important events stand out                        spirit.
> as vivid highlights.                                                     The year 1979 also marked the twenty-fifth
> The International Teaching Conference                              anniversary of the establishment of the Faith in
> held in Auckland, New Zealand in January                              many islands of the Pacific when the first
> 1977 1 attracted more than one thousand Baha'-                        pioneers answered the call of the beloved
> is from all over the Pacific and from other                           Guardian in 1953-1954. The celebrations that
> parts of the world. The meeting was blessed by                        took place in many of the islands commemoratthe presence of the representative of the Uni-                        ing this event added greatly to the proclamaversal House of Justice, the Hand of the Cause                        tion of the Faith. The zealous and hardworking
> Abu'J-Qasim Faizi, as well as the beloved                             National Assembly of Fiji arranged a series of
> Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone. The                            well-planned events for the visits of the Hands
> Prime Minister of New Zealand, the Hon. R.                            of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha Ru~iyyih
> Muldoon, attended the opening of the confer-                          Khanum, Dr. Ra~matu'llah Muhajir and Collis
> ence and gave an inspiring speech praising the                        Featherstone; for Dr. Victor de Araujo, the
> tenets of the Faith. After the conference, in                         representative of the Baha'i International
> spite of ill health, Mr. Faizi travelled to many                      Community at the United Nations; and others.
> islands of the Pacific pouring out his heart in                       Through their efforts many government, diplove and encouragement to the believers, par-                         lomatic, business and other leading people in
> ticipating in many interviews on radio and tele-                      the country learned of the Faith and of its aims
> vision and being received cordially by highly-                        and purposes.
> placed government officials.                                             The two Publishing Trusts in the zone-in
> The Hand of the Cause Dr. Ra~matu'llah                             Fiji and Australia-were further developed.
> Muhajir visited a number of areas including                           The Publishing Trust in Fiji began printing litsome of the more remote islands. His vision                           erature in a number of island languages.
> and inspiration resulted in the friends in many                          In 1978 and 1979 the Baha'i International
> localities undertaking ambitious teaching                             Community was invited to send observers to
> programmes which, in some areas, Jed to mass                          the annual South Pacific Commission Conferconversion.                                                           ences on social and economic development of
> The laying of the foundation stone of the                          Pacific island nations, attended by high-
> Temple in Samoa 2 at the end of January 1979                          ranking officials of Pacific island governments,
> by the representative of the Universal House                          and those of Australia, the United States,
> of Justice, the Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha                        France, Great Britain and New Zealand. On
> Ru~iyyih Khanum, in a ceremony graced by                              both occasions the Baha'i International Comthe presence of His Highness Malietoa                                 munity was able to present papers on topics
> being discussed.
> See 'Eight International Teaching Conferences', p. 109.
> See 'The First Mafil!riqu'l-Af!hkar of the Pacific Islands', p.      A vivid demonstration of co-operation and
> 371.                                                              assistance was the movement through the
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                       189
> 
> 'The Medina Dawn-Breakers', a Baha'i
> singing group of New Ireland, Papua New
> Guinea. Left to right: Wilson Elias;
> Josephine, Jennifer and Michael Homerang.
> 
> Baha'i Youth Conference, Port Vila, New
> Hebrides.
> 
> Participants in programme commemorating
> the International Year of the Child. The
> observance was held on 1 April 1979 in the
> Baha'i House of Worship, Sydney, Australia.
> Approximately 500 people attended.
> 190                                             THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> islands of a dedicated group of travelling                      of Aborigines some of whom embraced the
> teachers from Australia, North America, New                     Faith. The use of the House of Worship for
> Zealand, the Philippines, Iran and the Pacific                  special proclamation events also bore results.
> islands. They were of many races and back-                         This survey would not be complete without
> grounds, young and old. Particular mention                      mention of the continuing strengthening of the
> should be made of an American team and one                      ties between the Board of Counsellors and the
> from the Philippines, some members of which                     National Assemblies. The wholehearted, dedistill continue their services in Australasia. Mr.               cated and valiant services of a band of some
> A. K. Forudi of India was responsible for                       forty-five Auxiliary Board members scattered
> unprecedented victories amongst the Indians                     throughout the zone are recorded with
> in Fiji where his untiring efforts brought great                gratitude and appreciation. Without their tireresults. As a consequence of his activities many                less efforts, close association with local comother islands experienced a considerable                        munities and support of the plans of National
> increase in the number of believers.                            Assemblies , teaching and consolidation work
> The use of media gathered momentum.                          of the magnitude witnessed in the period would
> There was an increase in articles in the press,                 not have been possible . Their equally dediprogrammes on radio and television. A                           cated and committed assistants grew in
> number of National Assemblies undertook                         number to 300. The collaboration of the two
> continuous radio programmes and a weekly                        arms of the Administrative Order grew in
> half-hour television programme, later bi-                       dimension, and new formulas and ideas for
> weekly, was established in American Samoa.                      closer collaboration were developed. The
> Another interesting development was the                      cohesiveness and exemplary co-operation of
> erection in the islands of almost sixty buildings               the two Institutions was very evident in
> for use as local Centres. These were estab-                     Australia, to name but one country.
> lished primarily through the hard labour, love                     A signal victory won through the constant
> and sacrifice of village believe rs who prepared                efforts of the National Assembly of New Zeamost of the material from local sources and                     land and the patience and fortitude of the local
> constructed the buildings. They were aided in                   believers was the lifting of government restricthis by individual believers who lovingly                       tions imposed on the Faith in the Cook Islands,
> financed a portion of the cost of many of these                 an example of the assistance of the Concourse
> projects.                                                       on High which unfailingly attends the sincere
> Australia saw much development when its                     efforts of the friends.
> Local Assemblies grew by fifty per cent.                           At Ri<;lvan 1979 the ten National Conven-
> Through close collaboration between the                         tions throughout the zone celebrated the vic-
> Institutions of the Faith, a series of institutes on            torious conclusion of the Five Year Plan firm in
> the Covenant and the Local Assembly were                        their conviction that the communities of the
> conducted throughout the country . There was                    Australasian zone could shoulder any future
> a great emphasis in every State on the teaching                 responsibility placed upon them.
> 
> E.   EUROPE
> Seventeen National Spiritual Assemblies                      was the responsibility of the National Spiritual
> existed in Europe at the beginning of the Five                  Assemblies of Germany and the United King-
> Year Plan.' This total was increased by two with                dom respectively.
> the formation of the National Spiritual Assem-                     The years from 1976 to 1979 covered the
> bly of Greece, at Ri<;lvan 1977, with its seat in               larger part of the Five Year Plan and although
> Athens, and the formation at Ri<;lvan1978 of                    considerabl e planning and preparatory work
> the National Spiritual A ssembly of Cyprus                      had already been undertaken in Europe by
> with its seat in Nicosia. The establishment of                  Ri<;lva n 1976, there remained to be done a
> National Assemblies in Greece and in Cyprus                     significant degree of consolidation of the
> achieve ments recorded in the Nine Year Plan
> Austria, Belgium, Denmark, Finland , Fra nce, Germany,      (1964- 1973). The bulk of the goals of the Five
> Iceland, the Republic of Ireland , Italy, Luxembourg, the
> Netherlands, Norway, Portugal , Spain , Swede n, Switzer-   Year Plan therefore remained to be won at
> land , the United Kingdom.                                  Ri<;lvan 1976.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                             191
> 
> Baha'i exhibition and tent, Jokkmokk Winter
> Market, Sweden. Finnish, Norwegian and
> Swedish Baha'is participate in arranging the
> Baha'i exhibit annually. The city of
> Jokkmokk is north of the Arctic Circle.
> 
> Exhibit on 'Six World Religions', sponsored
> by the Local Spiritual Assembly of
> Cambridge, England and held in the central
> library; January 1978. At the request of the
> Chief Librarian the exhibit was held over for
> an additional period.
> 
> Baha'i information counter, Orebro, Sweden;
> June 1978.
> 192                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> The pattern of response to the Cause of         genuinely sacrificial homefront pioneering on
> Baha'u'llah in Europe varies from country to       the part of local believers, and the assistance of
> country and is not in every case as heartening     pioneers from abroad. Although in many cases
> as that witnessed in southern Europe and in the    national communities had to stretch their
> Republic of Ireland-due to factors which it is     manpower to severe limits, it may be said that
> beyond the scope of this report to comment         on the whole the European Baha'i community
> upon-and it was gratifying to note that            achieved a greater degree of stability by the
> towards the end of the Plan improved results       end of the Plan.
> were observed as a result of patient, devoted         It is difficult to compare achievements in a
> and often sacrificial effort. The last year,       continent which comprises nineteen national
> 1978/1979, was especially encouraging. The         Baha'i communities in countries varying in size
> National Spiritual Assemblies, not yet having      from Iceland (population 224,000) and Luxin each case seized the palm of victory, evinced   embourg (355 ,000) to the United Kingdom
> great resolution and determination as the Plan     with a population of approximately fifty-six
> drew to a close. Placing themselves firmly         million and Western Germany with sixty-one
> behind all efforts and projects designed to win    million. It is, however, worth noting that the
> the goals, they achieved complete success in a     total number of Local Assemblies in each of
> number of countries. Those countries where         the two smallest countries is in fact higher in
> total accomplishment was not achieved will         proportion to the total population than in any
> devote continued efforts to fulfilling the out-    of the other European countries.
> standing goals during the opening phase of the        The National Spiritual Assemblies of
> next Plan . The last few months of the Five Year   Greece and Cyprus were formed despite the
> Plan were charged with a heightened excite-        necessity of triumphing over the difficult condiment as the formation of new Local Assemb-         tions obtaining in those countries. Once
> lies all across Europe was reported with           formed, the National Spiritual Assembly of
> increasing rapidity. This broadening of the        Greece has built up a strong community, estabfoundation of the Faith in Europe, so ardently     lished Summer and Winter Schools, initiated
> longed for, involving an observable increase in    conferences and inaugurated youth activities.
> the number of believers, came about through        Particular problems are posed in Cyprus by
> 
> Participants in the first Bahli'( Winter School bf Malta; December 1978. Counsellor Anneliese
> Bopp of the Continental Board of Counsellors for Europe is seen in the centre of the second
> row.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                    193
> 
> Participants in the first Bahfi'{ Winter School of Cyprus held in Nicosia; December 1976. The
> Hand of the Cause Adelbert Miihlschlegel is seen standing in the centre of the first row; to the
> right of him is seen Counsellor Hooper Dunbar of the International Teaching Centre.
> 
> circumstances external to the Faith but some               Paris gathering, received wide coverage in the
> progress has been noted and successful Summer              press. Dr. Kurt Waldheim, Secretary General
> and Winter Schools have attracted good atten-              of the United Nations, sent a message which
> dance by local Baha'fs and friends abroad.                 was read to the friends assembled in Paris by
> Two International Teaching Conferences                  Mr. Luc Van Bellinghen, Director of the
> were held in 1976. 1 In July approximately 950             United Nations Information Centre in that
> believers gathered in Helsinki, Finland where              city. This was the first occasion on which the
> the Hand of the Cause Dr. Ugo Giachery rep-                United Nations, through a high-ranking
> resented the Universal House of Justice. The               officer, sent a message of goodwill to an interfollowing month the Hand of the Cause                      national Baha'i conference. 2 The great impetus
> Amatu'l-Baha RuJ:iiyyih Khanum represented                 given to the progress of the work by these
> the Universal House of Justice at the confer-              conferences was reinforced by a message of the
> ence in Paris where nearly 6,000 believers                 Universal House of Justice to the conference of
> gathered. Both conferences, but notably the                European Institutions of the Faith held in
> 'See 'Eight International Teaching Conferences', p. 109.       See p. 140 for text of the message .
> 194                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Langenhain in November 1978. The message               A special venture was the holding in June
> was read by the Hand of the Cause Paul Haney ,      1977, at the behest of the Universal House of
> the representative of the Universal House of        Justice, of two conferences ·specially for the
> Justice.                                            Persian-speaking Baha'is resident in E urope,
> On 12 September 1976 a historic event            one held in Germany and one in England. Both
> occurred when His Highness Malietoa                 were well attended, aroused much enthusiasm
> Tanumafili II visited the resting place of Shoghi   and resulted in generous contributions to the
> Effendi in the Great Northern London                teaching funds.
> Cemetery, New Southgate-the first such visit           An increasing number of young Baha'i
> by a reigning monarch.' A small delegation of       families are now numbered among the Eurofriends accompanied him, headed by the Hand         pean Baha'i communities. Special provisions
> of the Cause Dr.Ugo Giachery and including the      are made for the larger number of children who
> Hands of the Cause Dhikru'llah Khadem and           attend Baha'i functions , and special classes are
> 'Ali-Mul)ammad Varqa and six members of             provided in addition to the regular sessions.
> the National Spiritual Assembly of the United       Germany , which has for many years held an
> Kingdom.                                            annual children's Summer School, has also
> ' Seep. 69.                                         initiated children's conferences.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                                   195
> 
> 2. THE CHALLENGE AND PROMISE OF
> BAHA'I SCHOLARSHIP
> A Statement by the Universal House of Justice
> BAH A' f scholarship is of great importance            of rational investigation, confirmed by actual
> in the development and consolidation of the            experience, that true religion, far from being
> Baha'i community. Historical research, orien-          the product solely of human striving after
> talism and Islamic studies are obvious fields in       truth, is the fruit of the creative Word of God
> which Baha'ls can render great service to the          which, with divine power, transforms human
> Faith; there are many others. Indeed, it is not        thought and action.
> difficult to visualize the House of Justice, as           A Baha'i, through this faith in, this 'conscious
> Baha'u'llah's World Order unfolds , requiring          knowledge' of, the reality of divine Revelation,
> the services of distinguished Baha'i scientists in     can distinguish, for instance , between Chrisall fields.                                            tianity, which is the divine message given by
> Inevitably a number of problems will con-          Jesus of Nazareth, and the development of
> front Baha'i scholars, who will themselves have        Christendom, which is the history of what men
> to discover the solutions, both empirically and        did with that message in subsequent centuries;
> otherwise. Nonetheless it may be useful to             a distinction which has become blurred if not
> offer at this early stage of the development of        entirely obscured in current Christian theol-
> Baha'i scholarship a few thoughts on these             ogy. A Baha'i scholar conscious of this distincmatters.                                               tion will not make the mistake of regarding the
> It has become customary in the West to think       sayings and beliefs of certain Baha'is at any one
> of science and religion as occupying two dis-          time as being the Baha'i Faith. The Baha'i
> tinct-and even opposed-areas of human                  Faith is the Revelation of Baha' u'llah: His
> thought and activity. This dichotomy can be            Own Words as interpreted by 'Abdu' l-Baha
> characterized in the pairs of antitheses: faith        and the Guardian. It is a revelation of such
> and reason; value and fact. It is a dichotomy          staggering magnitude that no Baha'i at this
> which is foreign to Baha'i thought and should          early stage in Baha'f history can rightly claim to
> be regarded with suspicion by Baha'i scho lars         have more than a partial and imperfect underin every field. The principle of the harmony of        standing of it. Thus, Baha'i historians would
> science and religion means not only that relig-        see the overcoming of early misconceptions
> ious teachings should be studied in the light of      held by the Baha'f community, or by parts of
> reason and evidence as well as of faith and           the Baha'i community, not as ' developments of
> inspiration , but also that everything in crea-        the Baha'f Faith'-as a non-Baha'i historian
> tion, all aspects of human life and knowledge,        might well regard them-but as growth of that
> should be studied in the light of revelation as        community's understanding of the Baha'i
> well as in that of purely rational investigation.     Revelation. In scientific investigation, when
> In other words, a Baha'i scholar, when study-         searching after the facts of any matter, a Baha'i
> ing a subject, should not lock out of his mind        must, of course, be entirely open-minded, but
> any aspect of truth that is known to him.             in his interpretation of the facts and his evalua-
> It has, for example , become commonplace to        tion of evidence we do not see by what logic he
> regard religion as the product of human striv-        can ignore the truth of the Baha'i Revelation
> ing after truth , as the outcome of certain cli-      which he has already accepted; to do so would ,
> mates of thought and conditions of society.           we feel, be both hypocritical and unscholarly.
> This has been taken, by many non-Baha'i think-           Undoubtedly the fact that Baha'i scholars of
> ers, to the extreme of denying altogether the         the history and teachings of the Faith, believe
> reality or even the possibility of a specific reve-   in the Faith, will be a grave flaw in the eyes of
> lation of the Will of God to mankind through a        many non-Baha'i academics whose own doghuman Mouthpiece. A Baha'i who has studied            matic materialism passes without comment
> the Teachings of Baha'u'llah, who has                 because it is fashionable; but this difficulty is
> accepted His claim to be the Manifestation of         one that Baha'i scholars share with their fellow
> God for this Age, and who has seen His Teach-         believers in many fields of human endeavour,
> ings at work in his daily life, knows as the result   and the Baha'i principle of the harmony of
> 196                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> religion and science compels all Baha'is to pro-       should not transgress the bounds of tact and
> tect themselves from the prevalent diseases            wisdom, and in the words used there should
> resulting from the divorce of faith and reason.        lie hid the property of milk, so that the chil-
> The sundering of science and religion is but        dren of the world may be nurtured therewith,
> one example of the tendency of the human               and attain maturity. We have said in the past
> mind (which is necessarily limited in its capac-       that one word hath the influence ofspring and
> ity) to concentrate on one virtue, one aspect of       causeth hearts to become fresh and verdant,
> truth, one goal, to the exclusion of others. This      while another is like unto blight which
> leads, in extreme cases, to fanaticism and the         causeth the blossoms and flowers to wither.
> distortion of truth, and in all cases to some          God grant that authors among the friends will
> degree of imbalance and inaccuracy. A scholar          write in such a way as would be acceptable to
> who is imbued with an understanding of the             fair-minded souls, and not lead to cavilling by
> broad teachings of the Faith will always               the people.'
> remember that being a scholar does not                     Elsewhere He has written:
> exempt him from the primal duties and pur-             'Consort with all men, 0 people of Baha, in a
> poses for which all human beings are created.          spirit of friendliness and fellowship. If ye be
> Not scholars alone, but all men are exhorted to        aware of a certain truth, if ye possess a jewel,
> seek out and uphold the truth, no matter how           of which others are deprived, share it with
> uncomfortable it may be. But they are also             them in a language of utmost kindliness and
> exhorted to be wise in their utterance, to be          good will. If it be accepted, if it fulfil its purtolerant of the views of others, to be courteous       pose, your object is attained. If any one
> in their behaviour and speech, not to sow the          should refuse it, leave him unto himself, and
> seeds of doubt in faithful hearts, to look at the      beseech God to guide him. Beware lest ye deal
> good rather than at the bad, to avoid conflict         unkindly with him. A kindly tongue is the
> and contention, to be reverent, to be faithful to      lodestone of the hearts of men. It is the bread
> the Covenant of God, to promote His Faith              of the spirit, it clotheth the words with meanand safeguard its honour, and to educate their         ing, it is the fountain of the light of wisdom
> fellow-men, giving milk to babes and meat to           and understanding ... ' (Gleanings from the
> those who are stronger.                                 Writings of Bahli'u'llah: CXXXII)
> Scholarship has a high station in the Baha'i
> And again:
> teachings, and Baha'i scholars have a great
> responsibility to a growing, divinely-guided            'Should any one among you be incapable of
> world society. The ascertainment of truth and          grasping a certain truth, or be striving to
> the acquisition of a fuller understanding of the       comprehend it, show forth, when conversing
> subjects of their scholarship are worthy and            with him, a spirit of extreme kindliness and
> high endeavours. But Baha'u'llah has seen fit          good will. Help him to see and recognize the
> to dwell at some length on the way to offer the         truth, without esteeming yourself to be, in the
> fruits of scholarship and expose error:                 least, superior to him, or to be possessed of
> greater endowments.' (Gleanings from the
> 'Thou hast written that one of the friends hath       Writings of Baha'u'llah: V)
> composed a treatise. This was mentioned in             As more and more Baha'fs enter the world of
> the Holy Presence, and this is what was            higher learning they will have opportunities of
> revealed in response: Great care should be         exerting great influence in bringing about in
> exercised that whatever is written in these days   human consciousness and outlook that hardoth not cause dissension, and invite the          mony of religion and science which is so great a
> objection of the people. Whatever the friends      principle of their Faith. The distinction desired
> of the One true God say in these days is           by' Abdu'l-Baha for all Baha'fs Is certainly for
> listened to by the people of the world. It hath    attainment by Baha'i scholars, who by followbeen revealed in the Lawf:i-i-ljikmat: "The        ing the exhortations of Baha'u'llah to moderaunbelievers have inclined their ears towards       tion, kindliness, tact and wisdom, may restore
> us in order to hear that which might enable        scholarship to that high station of dignity and
> them to cavil against God, the Help in Peril,      admiration which it formerly held and which is
> the Self Subsisting." Whatever is written          confirmed by the utterances of Baha'u'llfih.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                             197
> 
> 3. THE CANADIAN ASSOCIATION FOR
> STUDIES ON THE BAHA'I FAITH
> 1975-1979
> 
> AT NA W-ROZ 1974, the Universal House               Assembly which would appoint the memberof Justice called upon the Canadian Baha'i          ship of the Executive Committee. This recomcommunity as one of their goals in the Five         mendation was approved by the National
> Year Plan to:                                       Spiritual Assembly at their meeting of 21 - 24
> 'Cultivate opportunities for formal presenta-       February, 1975. The newly appoin.ted Executions, courses and lectureships on the Baha'i       tive Committee met for the first time in May
> Faith in Canadian universities and other            1975, and during this and subsequent meetinstitutions of higher learning.'                   ings, decided that initially the Association
> In January, 1975, the National Spiritual         should direct all its attention to cultivation of
> Assembly of the Baha'is of Canada invited           opportunities for the formal presentation of
> some thirty individuals to a 'policy conference',   the Faith at Canadian institutions of higher
> a device which the Assembly had frequently          learning, as directed by the Universal House of
> and successfully used to find a way of meeting      Justice.
> ~arious new challenges. The participants were
> In the Committee's opinion, the choice of
> from various backgrounds and from all parts of      the word 'cultivate' encouraged careful atten-
> Canada, and were selected because it was felt       tion to the preparatory stages of a program
> they might contribute effectively to an exami-      designed to awaken the Canadian academic
> nation of this particular subject. The confer-      community to the existence of the Faith, to
> ence, which was held at the University of           make them aware of its intellectual and
> Ottawa, had two distinct functions: (a) consul-     spiritual integrity~ and to acquaint them with
> tation on the above-mentioned Five Year Plan        the quality of the academic resources which it
> goal and (b) holding a one-day conference with      offers.
> scientific, academic and artistic presentations        The Committee therefore felt that the
> on themes related to or inspired by the Baha'i      emphasis during the initial phase of work
> Faith and its Writings. A total of five presenta-   should be on the development of the Associations related to various scholarly disciplines,     tion's resources; and with this in mind, it was
> artistic expressions, and the history of the        decided to embark upon the objectives of (a)
> Baha'i Faith were given. As well, a piece by the    increasing membership and contribution in the
> Ballet Shayda,' a dance company of Baha'i           Baha'i community, (b) publication of Associaartists, was presented.                             tion Proceedings and various monographs
> The result of the consultation of the policy     (Bahli'f Studies), (c) publication of a textbook
> conference was a recommendation that the            on the Baha'i Faith, as the basis for the
> National Spiritual Assembly establish a 'Cana-      development of course outlines, ( d) convening
> dian Association for Studies on the Baha'i          annual meetings, and ( e) formal presentations
> Faith'. The conference believed that such a n       at Canadian universities and other institutions
> association represented a traditional mode of       of higher learning. The membership of the
> relating to the university system and one which     Association has been increasing steadily, and
> would be most likely to find easy acceptance by     in a most encouraging trend, many Baha'is
> the academic community. It would at once            from outside Canada have become members.
> relieve the administrative agencies of the Faith    The membership by 1979 had grown to 507.
> of a heavy load of largely extraneous tasks, a nd      Thus far, six volumes of Baha'i Studies have
> open up a new field of service for qualified        been published . The titles of the series are:
> believers. The Association would, in accord-        Vol. I-Proceedings of th e First Annual Meetance with Baha'i administrative principle,                   ing of the Canadian Association for
> take its basic direction from the National                   Studies on the Bahli'f Faith, Dr. H.
> 'See The Baha'( World, vol. XVI, p. 696.                     Danesh, Luc Dion, Dr. A. M. Ghadirian,
> 198                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Dr. Wm. S. Hatcher, Douglas Martin,       hundred and fifty . Four regional annual con-
> 0. D. Rogers; November 1976.              ferences are scheduled to be held simulta-
> Vol. 2-The Science of Religion, Dr. Wm. S.        neously from 28-30December1979 in Surrey,
> Hatcher; September 1977; revised          British Columbia; Saskatoon, Saskatchewan;
> edition March 1980.                       Bolton, Ontario and Dartmouth, Nova Scotia.
> Vol. 3-The Metaphorical Nature of Physical        The fifth annual meeting will be held in Ottawa
> Reality , Dr. John S. Hatcher;            in June 1980 and will be followed immediately
> November 1977.                            by an International Baha'i Conference on
> Vol. 4-Three Studies on Baha'i History,           Health and Healing.
> Douglas Martin , Jan T . Jasion, Dr. A.      During the first four years of its existence
> M. Ghadirian; December 1978.              (1976-1979) the Association has been able to
> Vol. 5-The Baha'i Faith in Russia: Two            hold the following formal presentations and
> Early Instances, A. A. Lee, Dr. A. M.     lectures, details of which are set out in Appen-
> Ghadiriaa; January 1979.                  dix III.
> Vol. 6-The Violence-Free Society: A Gift for
> Our Children, Dr. H. Danesh; April          1. Five lectures on the topic of Women in the
> 1979; revised edition October 1979.            Baha'i Faith at Laurentian University in
> Sudbury, Ontario.
> In 1976, the Executive Committee                 2. Lectures on the topic of Science and
> approached a group of scholars at the Univer-          Religion at the University of New Brunssite de Montreal who were collaborating with           wick and the University of Alberta at
> Editions Fides on a series of volumes on major         Edmonton.
> religions. The aim was to assure that the Faith     3. Two presentations on the topic of Women
> was correctly treated in the series. After             in the Baha'i Faith at Carleton University,
> further consultations, the group agreed to             Ottawa.
> publish a separate volume in the series on the      4. A presentation on the topic of the Funcsubject of the Faith under the title La Foi            tion of Revelation in Artistic Expression
> Baha'ie. Editions Fides also approved the              at the Banff Centre School of Fine Arts.
> project. The Association sought the advice of
> the House of Justice on suitable authors and         At the time of preparation of this report,
> approached several whom the House nomi-           plans have been approved for a non-credit
> nated. Eventually, two of these were commis-      extension course on the Baha'i Faith at the
> sioned and took up the task. The manuscript is    University of British Columbia. Also, negotianow in its final stages preparatory to publica-   tions are under way for a similar course at the
> tion . The Committee decided to go ahead          University of Toronto .
> simultaneously with an English language ver-         The significance of the activities and work of
> sion (The Baha'i Faith), also through a com-      the Association was recognized by the Univermercial publisher.                                sal House of Justice in a letter of 19 March,
> The first and second annual meetings were      1979:
> held at Cedar Glen in Bolton, Ontario from        'The Efflorescence of the Canadian Association
> 2-4 January 1976 and 31 December 1976-2           for Baha'i Studies has been, in the eyes of the
> January 1977 respectively, and each was           House of Justice, one of the very favourable
> attended by more than one hundred individu-       outcomes of the Five Year Plan and bodes well
> als. The third annual meeting took place in       for the maturation and eminence of the Cana-
> Surrey, British Columbia from 30 December         dian community.'
> 1977-1 January 1978 and the fourth at the
> The work of the Association was crowned by
> Ontario Institute for Studies in Education in
> the following goal given to Canada as part of
> Toronto from 26-27 January 1979. This latter
> the Seven Year Plan by the Supreme Body:
> meeting was open to the public and had as one
> of its speakers Professor W. G. Oxtoby, the       ' Expand the opportunities for teaching in
> head of the Department of Religious Studies at    Canadian institutions of higher learning and
> the University of Toronto. The attendance at      further develop the Canadian Association for
> the third and fourth meetings exceeded one        Studies on the Baha'i Faith.'
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                                          199
> APPEND IX I
> 
> TERMSOFREFERENCE-
> CANADIAN ASSOCIATION FOR STUDIES ON THE BAHA'I FAITH
> Name: The Canadian Association for Studies on the Ba ha'i          reference sources, recommendations for credits, etc. Non-
> Faith                                                        credit courses will also be developed for the use of Extension
> Departments. All such courses will be submitted to the
> Membership: Membership is open to all Bah a'is .
> National Assembly for approval before being offered to
> Membership fees: Individuals         -$15.00
> non-Baha'i institutions. The lecturers will receive the regu-
> Couples             - $25.00
> lar fees which universities normally pay (this latter, in order
> Students            -$ 10.00
> to place the operation on an academic footing, and avoid any
> Senior              -$ 10.00
> suggestion th at it represented merely a public information
> Outside North America -$1 0.00
> agency of the Baha'i community);
> Canadian Pioneers - free
> To encourage university students to work on the Baha'i
> Executive Committee: The executive committee has full              Faith as part of their regular academic activities; to collect
> responsibility for the direction of the affairs of the Associa-    and assess theses, papers, etc. , which are produced by Baha'i
> tion , in line with the consti tution and the directives of the    students; to provide a listing of these resources for the use of
> National Spiritual Assembly. The executive committee               the Centre and the Baha'i community;
> members are appointed annually by the National Spiritual              To undertake a study of holdings on the Bah a'i Faith at
> Assembly.                                                          Canadian university libraries, and provide advice to these
> same libraries on available so urce materi als;
> Administration: The Association will function on the basis of         To serve as a forum for the sharing of ideas among memguidelines established by the National Spiritual Assembly,         bers and for th e service of the deepening programs of the
> a nd all further steps to establish or amend the constitution      Canadian Baha'i community;
> will require the Assembly's approval;                                 To encourage the production of literature including scho-
> Direction of the Association would be through its Execu-        larly books on the Faith, articles, etc. It is intended that such
> tive Committee, which will have the responsibility of report-      material be published commercially, so as to stand on the
> ing regularl y to the National Spiritual Assembly of the Bah-      same footing with reference materials on other subjects ;
> a'is of Canada;                                                       To organize formal conferences for members and other
> All financing through fees charged for membership,              interested persons, in addition to the annual meeting of the
> revenue from special events, and charges for services per-         Association;
> formed (sale of literature, training courses, etc.) sup-              To publish th e proceedings of the Association's annual
> plemented by a grant from the National Assembly based on           meeting;
> consultation with the Executive Committee;                           To cultivate re lationships with university administrations,
> Personnel, eq uipment, materials, and space paid for out of     and to acquaint them with the nature and aims of the Baha'i
> the in come of the Association;                                    Faith ;
> Co-operation with Baha'i Campus Clubs across the coun-            To provide a schola rship (or scholarships) for Ba ha'i stutry, but no direct administrative relationship between these       dents;
> two types of operation.                                              To develop a bibliography on the Baha'i Faith , and to
> keep it updated ;
> Objecti ves: To work toward the creation of a 'Canadian
> To propose research projects to Baha'i scholars.
> Centre fo r Studies on the Baha'i Faith' ;
> To establish a lecture bureau to offer qualified Baha'i         Co ntact with Universities: It will be the responsibility of the
> lecturers to Canadian universities and other institutions of       Association , on behalf of its members and on behalf of the
> higher learning. Such lecturers wi ll be avail able to speak on    Canadian Baha'i community, to undertake all formal conboth the Baha'i Faith itself and on subjects that fall within      tact with universities, colleges, institu tes of arts and technoltheir own academic disciplines . The Association will estab-       ogy, semin aries, nursing and teachers colleges, etc., as
> lish the criteria of lectureship, guide the lecture rs, a nd       institutions. In this connection, a method will have to be
> ha ndle all contact with the universities and other institutions   developed to ass ure that Local Spiritual Assemblies are fu lly
> to whom their services we re offered;                              informed, and are in a position to take appropriate adva n-
> To develop formal courses on the Baha'i Faith including          tage of the work of the Association.
> 
> Participants in th e annual m eeting ofthe Canadian Association for Studies on the Baha'( Faith
> held in Bolton, Ontario; January 1976. Mr. Douglas Martin is seen standing on the extreme
> left.
> 200                                           THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Five publications produced by the Canadian Association for Studies on the Baha'i Faith.
> 
> APPENDIX II
> 
> MEMBERS OF THE FIRST EXECUTIVE COMMITTEE OF THE CANADIAN
> ASSOCIATION FOR STUDIES ON THE BAHA'I FAITH:
> 
> Hossa in Danesh (ch airm an)                                  Douglas Martin (secretary)
> G le n Eyford                                                 Michael Rochester (treas urer)
> William Hatche r                                              0. Don Rogers
> E lizabeth Larin
> 
> MEMBERS OF THE EXECUTIVE COMMITTEE OF THE CANADIAN
> ASSOCIATION FOR STUDIES ON THE BAHA'I FAITH FOR 1979-80:
> 
> Louis Brunet                                                  Will iam Hatcher
> Alan Coupe                                                    Douglas Martin
> Hossain Danesh (chairman)                                     Peter Morgan (secretary)
> G len Eyford                                                  Christine Zerbinis (treasurer)
> Jane Goldstone
> 
> APPENDIX III
> 
> / st Annual Conference: Bolton, Ontario; 2-4 January 1976       John Taylor, 'T he Baha'i Fa ith as an Agent of Social
> Don Rogers, 'The Function of Revelation in A rtistic          Change'
> Expression'                                               Dr. D. Smith, 'The Ba ha'i Community and the Group
> Dr. A . M. Ghadirian, 'A uguste Fore!: His Life and           Identity'
> Enlightenment'                                            Dr. J. Faily, 'The Group Phenomenon'
> Douglas Martin, 'The Baha'i Faith and Its Critics'          Dr. W. Hatcher, ' Healing: Physical and Spiritual'
> Dr. W. Hatcher, ' Science a nd Religion'                    Dr. N. Rasekh, ' Man, Ti me and Space'
> Glen Eyford, 'Spiritual Education'                           Douglas Martin, 'History of Green Acre and Sarah
> Michele Danesh, 'Woman' performed by the Ballet               Farmer'
> Shayda                                                    Michele Danesh , 'Journey' performed by the Ballet
> Luc Dion , 'La realite du monde et !'existence de Dieu'       Shayda
> Dr. H. Danesh, 'Violence and Apathy'                        Dr. H. Danesh , 'In Search of a Violence-Free Community'
> 2nd Annual Conference: Bolton, Ontario; 31 Dec. 1976-2          Dr. J. Hatcher, 'The Metaphorical Nature of Physical
> Jan. 1977                                                         Reality'
> Dr. P. Morgan, ' A Review of Reshaping of the Intern a-       Heidi Lakshman, 'The Covenant of Judaism'
> tional Order'                                              William Gossen, 'Recent History and the Future of Ideas,
> Dr. G. Eyford, 'The United Nations University'                  Unitary Science and Baha'i Philosophy'
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACT IVITIES                                                      201
> 3rd A nnual Conference: Surrey, British Columbi a; 30 Dec.        Dr. H. D anesh , ' Emotional Satisfaction and Spiritual
> 1977-1 Jan . 1978                                                    Enrichment'
> Kay Balser, 'Towards a Universal Auxiliary Language'            Jim Desson, 'Consider the Flowers of a Garden'
> Mr. K. Bloodworth , 'In Search of a New Visual Myth'            Dr. W. Hatcher, 'Economics and H uman Values'
> Ch ristopher Buck, 'Nazoraean/Ebionaean Christia nity           ' Rivann e Sandler, 'The Poetic Artistry of Qurratu ' I- ' Ay n:
> and the Emergence of Historical Theology'                        A Babl Heroine'
> Alan Coupe, 'Zarathustra and the Baha'i Faith'                  Akouete Akakpo-Vidah , ' Pour une etude scientifique de
> Dr. H. Danesh, ' Health and Healing'                               l'apport de la foi baha'le a la science de !'education'
> Ken Goldstone, 'The World Centre of the Baha'i Faith :          Jacobe Philippe, 'D ramatic Arts as a Catalyst for the
> An Analysis of the Sacred Landscape'                            Development of a Spiritual Civilization'
> Richard Heiser, 'The Legal Personality of Baha'i Assem-         David Bowie, ' By Their Fruits Ye Shall Know Them'
> blies'
> Formal Presentations:
> A nthony Lee , 'The Rise a nd Fall of the Russian Ba ha'i
> Carol Bowie;- T horneloe College, Laurentian U niver-
> Community: An Historical Sketch'
> sity, Sudbury, O nt. 'Women and Religion-the Baha'i
> Jane Nishi-Goldstone, 'A Review of Maitrya-Amitabha
> Viewpoint' 29 July 1977
> Has Appeared by Jamshed Fozdar'
> Laurentian U niversity, Extension class, Espanola
> Dr. Anne Schoonmaker, 'Erikson and the Worldwide
> Ontario, 6 Feb. 1978
> Crisis of Identity'
> Laurentian University, Sudbury, 13 June 1978
> 4th Annual Conference: Toronto, Ontario; 26-27 Jan. 1979             Laurentian Universi ty , Sault Ste. Marie, 14 June 1978
> 'W. G. Oxtoby, 'The Participant, the Observer and the             Laurentian U niversity , North Bay, 5 February 1979
> Study of Religion'                                             Laurentian U niversity, Sudbury, 6 February 1979
> P. W. Conway, 'The Psychology and Techniques of Trans-            Laurentian University, Sudbury, 7 February 1980
> cendence'                                                   Dr. H. B. Danesh; -Simon Fraser University, Dept. of
> Dr. H. Danesh , 'The Violence-Free Society: A Gift for            Criminology , British Columbia, Canada. A presenta-
> Our Children'                                                  tion based on The Violence-Free Society: A Gift for Our
> Dr. W. Hatcher, 'The Baha'i Concept of Spirituality'              Children , January 1980.
> Dr. P. Mo rgan, 'Values a nd Spiritual Education'                T he United Nations, a joi nt project between the Baha'i
> Paul Simpson, ' Folktoys and Their History'                       International Community and the Canadian Association for Studies on the Baha'i Faith , a presentation
> I st Regional Conferences
> based on The Violence-Free Society: A Gift for Our
> Surrey:                                                             Children , November, L979. Six hundred copies of vol. 6
> Ch ristopher Buck , 'The Lost Christianity of Peter'              of Baha'i Studies were distributed.
> Celena Benndorf, 'T he Door-to-Door Method: A                      'The Governor's Confe rence on Child Abuse', Reno,
> Sociological Study'                                            Nevada, U.S.A . Keynote speaker and workshop leader,
> Herbert Lee , ' Business in a Global Village '                    22-24 April 1980.
> Dr. Patrick Conway, 'Tra nscendental Psychology'                  'World Congress on Menta l Health', Salzburg, Austria,
> Andrew Pemberton-Pigott , 'M usic as Therapy'                     a joint project of the Baha'i International Community
> 'Joy Marompon , 'Joyo usness in Ed ucation Through                 and the Canadian Associati on for Studies on the Baha'i
> Music'                                                           Faith , Dr. Danesh, R epresentative, Bah a'i Interna-
> Glen Eyford , 'A Search for Community'                            tion al Community, 8- 15 July 1979. Five hundred
> Caroline Pemberton-Pigott, 'The Purpose of Education'             copies of The Violence-Free Society: A Gift for Our
> Robert Wilson, 'The Inmost Self                                   Children were distributed to all the participants of the
> Saskatoon:                                                          congress.
> Jane Nishi-Goldstone, 'Buddhist Eschatology and the             Glen Eyford;- University of Alberta, Dept. of Religious
> Baha'i Faith'                                                   Studies, Edmonton , Alberta, Canada. Two lectures
> Dr. G. Hanks, 'St. John the Baptist'                              February 1977: 'Oneness of Religion' and 'The Social
> Peter Rempel and 'Dr. Shigeru Kounosu , ' Is a Science of         Teachings of the Baha'i Fait h' .
> Peace Possible?'                                              William Hatcher;-Mount All ison University, Sackville,
> Ron Silver, 'Educati on '                                         New Brunswick, Canada. 10 February 1978. 'Science
> Helen Marshall, 'Prejudice'                                       and Religion' and 'Economics and Human Values' .
> Acadia U niversity, Wolfville, Nova Scotia, 9 March
> Dartmouth:
> 1977. 'Ethical Concepts'.
> Thaya Batdorf, 'The Baha'i Faith and th e Artist'
> University of Moncton, New Brunswick, Canada, Feb-
> 'Dr. A. P. Johnstone, ' Worldwide Development'
> ruary 1978. Presentation on the Baha'i Faith to Com-
> Bob Donnelly, 'Doris MacKay : a Biographical Sketch of
> an E arly Pioneer'                                              parative Religions class.
> Jan Jas ion, 'Mario n Jack'
> Saint-Louis-Maillet College, Edmundston, New
> Brunswick, January 1978. 'La science de la religion' et
> John T. Moore, 'A Theological Consideration of
> ' Principes spirituels et principes economiques'
> Baha' u' llah's Long Obligatory Prayer'
> Saint-Louis-Maillet College, Edmundston, New
> Dr. Peter Morgan, 'A Study of Baha'i Values'
> Brunswick, Canada, Jan uary 1979. 'Valeurs morales et
> Bolton:                                                             valeurs technologiques'
> Keith C. Jensen, 'The Covenant and the O riginal Position'       Concordia University Montreal, Quebec, Canada, Feb-
> Bob Morrison,' A Mayan Manifestation'                            ruary 1978. 'Science a nd Religion'
> Jack McLean , 'St. Paul and the Deification of Jesus'            Universite du Quebec at Trois-Rivieres to a class in
> Todd Lawson , 'The Crucifixion and the Qur'an'                    Political Economics, Spring, 1978. 'Les principes
> Mark Keedwell, 'The Concept of Prophethood in the                economiques de la fo i baha'le'
> Baha'i Faith and in Islam'                                  Elizabeth Kerr-Wilson;-Carleton University, Dept. of
> 'Velma Andrade, ' An Ethnographic St udy of a Winnipeg           Religious Studies, Ottawa, Ontario, Canada, 28 March
> Area Baha'i Group'                                             1978. 'Women in the Baha'i Faith'.
> George Armogan, 'A Comparison between the Ba ha'i             0. Don Rogers; -Banff School of Fine Arts, Alberta,
> Faith and the Saint Simon Movement'                            Canada, 26 November 1976. 'The Function of Revela-
> ' Denotes non-Baha'i participant                                    tion in Artistic Expression' .
> 202                                             THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 4. SURVEY OF ACTIVITIES OF BAHA'I
> WOMEN IN THE FIVE YEAR PLAN
> RACHEL COLLINS
> 
> PARTICULARLY CALL UPON BAHA' I WOMEN WHOSE CAPACITIES IN MANY LANDS STILL
> LARGELY UNUSED AND WHOSE POTENTIAL FOR SERVICE CA USE SO GREAT TO ARISE AND
> DEMONSTRATE IMPORTANT PART THEY ARE TO PLAY IN ALL FIELDS SERVICE FAITH.
> 
> TH ESE words of the Universal House of                      ial education. This education is particularly
> Justice from its cabled message of 24 March                 important when one considers that the future
> 1977 enunciated a special challenge to the                  expansion of the Baha'i Faith is to a large
> Baha'i world in the Five Year Plan to bring into            extent dependent upon spiritually-deepened
> reality one of the cardinal principles of the               mothers passing along their knowledge and
> Baha'i Faith: the equality of men and women.                conviction to their children.
> This task was not given to women alone; eighty                 What is perhaps the strongest reason for
> National Spiritual Assemblies were assigned a               encouraging the participation of women in the
> specific goal of organizing Baha'i activities for           work of the Cause was best explained by
> women. The full accomplishment of this goal                 ' Abdu'l-Baha:
> will touch the lives of all members of the Baha'i
> 'It is well established in history that where
> community: men, women, and children.
> woman has not participated in human affairs
> Why did the Universal House of Justice issue
> the outcomes have never attained a state of
> this call and set these goals for the first time
> completion and perfection.' 4
> during the Five Year Plan? The answer to this
> question is several fold. In singling out for                  Thus growth in the level of women's activity
> encouragement and development the role of                   in the Baha'i Faith could be viewed as a prerewomen in the Baha'i community, the House of                 quisite for the success of the Five Year Plan ,
> Justice has set an example for National and                 even as women's full participation in the life of
> Local Spiritual Assemblies, who, according to               the Cause will be essential to the future growth
> 'Abdu'l-Baha, 'must give unlimited encour-                  and expansion of the Faith , to the abolition of
> agement to women.''                                         war, and the evolution of a world civilization
> A second reason lies in the obvious discre-              rooted in the divine teachings proclaimed by
> pancy between the Baha'i standard of the                    Baha'u'llah.
> equality of men and women and the status of                    The history of the first 135 years of the
> women in most societies in the world. The                   Baha'i Cause gives ample evidence of the
> Baha'i standard is based on a divine teaching               capacity of women for teaching and sacrifice.
> enunciated for the first time in religious history          Indeed, as 'Abdu'l-Baha in viewing the work of
> by Baha'u'llah and stressed repeatedly by                   women during His lifetime pointed out ,
> 'Abdu'l-Baha: ' ... as all are created in the               'among the miracles which distinguish this sacimage and likeness of the one God, there is no              red Dispensation is this, that women have
> distinction as to sex in the estimation of God.' 2          evinced a greater boldness than men when
> And again, women and men are entitled to                    enlisted in the ranks of the Faith.' 5 Pre-eminent
> 'equal rights and prerogatives in all things                among early Baha'i heroines is the poetess
> appertaining to humanity.' 3 As more people                 whose courage and eloquence were instrumenfrom every possible background and culture                  tal in proclaiming the independent nature of
> enter under the shelter of Baha'u'llah's laws               the new Revelation. In an age and country
> and teachings, both women and men must                      where giving women even the rudiments of
> grow to an understanding of the spiritual                   education was considered unnecessary, even
> potential inherent in women, and the necessity               harmful , Tahirih acquired a grasp of Muslim
> of its development through spiritual and mater-             theology extraordinary among men, to say
> ' Tablets of'Abdu'l-Bahd, vol. II, p. 336.                  nothing of women. She was one of the first
> 2                                                           4
> The Promulgation of Universal Peace, vol. II , p . 388.     ibid . vol. I, p. 129.
> l ibid. p . 277.                                            ' The Advent of Divine Justice , p. 57.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i A C TIVITIES                         203
> eighteen people to recognize the truth of the        walks of life , from kings and queens , ministers
> Bab's mission and taught her new-found Faith         and statesmen to private individuals of all
> through her actions and her poetry with a fer-       creeds, color and classes. Crowning her efforts
> vor that astonished both friends and enemies.        was the acceptance of the Faith by Queen
> From the moment she cast aside her veil at the       Marie of Ruma nia on whom she called many
> conference of Badasht, announcing 'the day on        times and whose respect and admiration she
> which the fetters of the past are burst a-           won.
> sunder', 1 until she proclaimed to her execu-           Other women have continued the work
> tioners at her martydom in 1852 , 'You can kill      begun by these remarkable teachers, each
> me as soon as you like, but you cannot stop the      adding her own gifts to the effort to bring the
> emancipation of women ', 2 she did not hesitate      message of the Baha'i Faith to an everto challenge all people to cast aside the outworn    widening and increasingly diversified circle of
> traditions that obscure the light of spiritual       waiting souls. Very nearly one-half of the
> Truth.                                               pioneers who in the Guardian's Ten Year
> Tahirih's legacy of courage and spiritual         Crusade from 1953 to 1963 earned the title
> understanding was passed on to many of the           'Kn ight of Baha' u' llah' by settling in a country
> early Baha'f women in the West. Such was the         or territory previously unopened to the Baha'i
> fervor of women such as Lua Getsinger, enti-         Faith have been women. Sometimes alone ,
> tled by ' Abdu'l-Baha 'Herald of the Coven-          sometimes with family, they settled in such
> ant', May Maxwell, Helen Goodall, Ethel              far-flung posts as Dutch New Guinea, the
> Rosenberg, Agnes Alexander, Marion Jack,             Galapagos Islands, Spanish Guinea, and the
> and many others, that 'Abdu'l-Baha stated:           Nicobar Islands . The same pioneering spirit
> 'Today the women in the West lead the men in     has inspired many women to take up the chalthe service of the Cause, summon the people      lenge of international travel teaching for the
> under th e shade of the Blessed Perfection,      Faith. The efforts of some of these women
> and loosen their tongues in eloquent lectures,   constitute perhaps the most dramatic examples
> delivery of wonderful proofs and the elucida-    of women serving the Faith during the Five
> tion of new arguments. ' 3                       Year Plan.
> The travels of Amatu'l-Baha Ruryfyyih
> One woman of the East was called upon to
> Khan um, the widow of the Guardian, throughshoulder a burden unlike that of any other.
> out India and Africa during the Nine Year Plan
> After the passing of' Abdu'l-Baha in 1921, the
> are becoming legendary. During the past five
> daughter of Baha' u'llah , Bahfyyih Khanum,4
> years, she has represented the Baha'i Faith and
> the Greatest Holy Leaf, directed the affairs of
> the Universal House of Justice throughout the
> the Baha'i Cause for many months while
> world on many occasions, including the laying
> Shoghi Effendi recovered from the deep grief
> of the foundation stones of two new Baha'i
> which he suffered as a result of the passing of
> Houses of Worship , one in India, one in
> 'Abdu'l-Baha and the shock of knowing him-
> Samoa. She has met, challenged, and inspired
> self nominated Guardian of the Cause of God .
> with her message heads of state and govern-
> She alone among the members of the Holy
> ment, religious leaders, and men and women in
> Family during the time of the Guardian
> many other walks of life . But in particular
> remained exemplary in the steadfastness of her
> Ruryfyyih Khan um has sought out , and encourlove and devotion to the Centre of the Cause .
> aged other Baha'is to seek out for teach ing,
> Among the teachers of the Baha'i Faith durthose peoples whose lives have not been
> ing its first century one stands unsurpassed:
> tainted by the soul-consuming materialism that
> Martha Root. This woman , defying social and
> dominates the thinking of so much of the world
> material barriers, meager resources, often
> today. It was for this reason that she embarked
> perilous circumstances and ill-health , jourupon the 'Green Light Expedition'. 5 This
> neyed four times around the world, carrying the
> five-month journey took her with six others to
> message of the new Revelation to people in all
> the Amazon river basin to make a film docu-
> The Dawn-breakers , p. 296.                        menting the lives of numerous Indian and Bush
> God Passes By , p. 76.
> Star of the West , vol. l , no. 9 , p. 11.         Negro tribes in the river area, demonstrating
> ' Bah:i'iyyih KMnum.                                 ' See The Bahli'f World, vol. XVI, p. 419.
> 204                                   THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> Amatu'l-Baha Ru(tfyyih Khanum at the formal welcome accorded during her visit to the Maori
> Meeting House (Orakei Marae) near Auckland, New Zealand; January 1979. Seen with her
> are Mr. Ephraim Te Paa and Mrs. Ani Pihema.
> 
> the tremendous opportunities for teaching the       tion then visited three cities in the Amazon
> Faith of Baha'u'llah among these peoples, and       region of Brazil, meeting the governors of two
> the urgency of the need for pioneers and            states, lecturing at universities and schools, and
> teachers to reach them before outside               speaking with the Baha'is, exhorting them to
> materialistic values rapidly encroaching on         arise in service to the Cause. This proclamation
> their way of life have cut them off from their      was climaxed by the first Baha'i conference of
> spiritual roots. The expedition travelled to vil-   the Amazon region, held in Manaus during
> lages on the Orinoco River in the Amazonas          Ru!]iyyih Khanum's visit. The expedition then
> territory deep inside Venezuela, then up the        proceeded to the Peruvian Amazon region,
> Ventuari River as far as their boat would go.       where further documentary work was done.
> The second part of the trip involved travel by      The five-month journey ended high in the
> plane'and canoe into the jungles of the Guiana      Bolivian Andes with the filming of a Baha'i
> plateau in Surinam, seeking out the villages of     conference graced by the presence of many
> Bush Negroes, resulting in the acceptance of        Bolivian Indian believers, both men and
> the Faith by a number of villagers and the          women.
> election of the first Bush Negro Local Spiritual       The film of the 'Green Light Expedition' has
> Assembly. Rul]iyyih Khanum with the expedi-         been and is still being shown around the world,
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                              205
> accomplishing Rul)iyyih Khanum's goal of                  Mrs. Munsiff's first journey in 1975 took her
> demonstrating the potential for spiritual vic-         from Spain and Portugal throughout west and
> tories among villagers in remote areas. It also        part of central Africa . She visited Baha'i comtestifies to Rul)iyyih Khanum's great love for         munities in Senegal, the Gambia, Sierra
> these people , a love which gave her the               Leone, Liberia, Ivory Coast, Ghana, Togo ,
> strength to accomplish what she did, so that she       Dahomey (now Benin), Central African
> could truthfully say, 'If I at the age of sixty-four   Republic, and Chad, then back home to Engcan undertake such a trip, then surely the             land through France. Throughout her travels,
> younger generation of believers can do as              she met with government officials, from heads
> much.''                                                of state to vill age chiefs, and addressed public
> Rul)iyyih Khanum took the opportunity               meetings and gatherings of Baha'is. Among
> many .times during her travels to speak of the         the Baha'is she helped the believers to deepen
> important role of women in teaching the Faith.         their understanding, love, and faith in the
> At the Asian Baha'i Women 's Conference                Revelation of Baha'u'llah, encouraged the
> more than 1,000 Baha'i women from all over             pioneers in their work for the Faith, and, by
> Asia heard her outline the state of emergency          words and actions, ever stressed the unity and
> in the world that calls for a special effort by all    love between divers peoples that wholehearted
> Baha'is to spread the Word of God. She                 allegiance to the Cause of God can and must
> pointed out that men should actively encour-           bring about. In October 1976, Mrs. Munsiff
> age and assist their women in service to the           headed to the western hemisphere, visiting
> Faith, for if they do not, it will be doubly           Guyana, Surinam, French Guiana, Trinidad
> difficult for women to fulfill their respon-           and Tobago, Barbados, the Windward Islands,
> sibilities to the Cause. 'One of the failings of       the French Antilles, Puerto Rico, Haiti ,
> men in Asia and Africa is that they do not teach       Jamaica, and Mexico, returning to England in
> the Faith to their wives, mothers , and sisters,'      February 1977. Later that year, she taught the
> she stated.                                            Faith on the European continent, before leav-
> Prominent among women consecrating their            ing in October for the Asian Baha'i Women's
> energies and talents to the field of international     Conference in India . From India Mrs. Munsiff
> travel teaching during the Five Year Plan was          travelled to Australia, visiting Perth in the west
> Mehrangiz Munsiff. Born into the Zoroastrian           and Sydney in the east. Then she embarked on
> community of Bombay, Mrs. Munsiff                      the journey to the islands of the Pacific which
> embraced the Baha'i Faith at an early age ,            enabled her to finish encircling the world in
> earned the title of Knight of Ba ha'u' llah by         service to the Faith. She visited communities in
> pioneering to French Cameroon in 1954, and             New Caledonia, the New Hebrides, the Solhas energetically served the Cause at home in          omon Islands, Fiji , Tonga, Samoa, Tahiti, the
> England and abroad for many years. The Five            Tuamotu Archipelago, the Marquesa Islands
> Year Plan has seen the fulfilment of her               and the Cook Islands . Mrs . Munsiff completed
> lifelong desire to be able to travel teach in all      this extraordinary tour in Hawaii, where she
> parts of the world. When the Universal House           visited and prayed at the graves of Martha Root,
> of Justice asked her to undertake a journey to         her early mentor, and Agnes Alexander, the
> Australasia and the Pacific islands in 1977, she       first Baha'i in the Hawaiian Islands. After rest
> wrote in reply, thanking them for granting this        and recuperation made necessary by her arduwish by sending her to the one area of the world       ous efforts, Mrs. Munsiff travelled through
> she had not yet visited, saying:                       Italy, Germany and Luxembourg, returning to
> London in late July 1978. Her final travel
> 'When I was fourteen I looked after Miss
> teaching tour of the Five Year Plan took her
> Martha Root during her visit to Bombay and
> back to Africa, this time to Ghana, Nigeria,
> then traveled with her to Ajmer . . . (She J
> Zaire, South Africa, South West Africa, Reunlcvingly told me that she would pray that I
> ion, Mauritius, Madagascar and Kenya.
> may teach the Faith all over the world. How
> Throughout her travels, Mrs. Munsiffs actions
> little one believes in the statements of such
> and words attracted considerable attention and
> holy souls till they come true!'
> coverage from the news media in the countries
> Baha'( News (USA), May 1975, v. 52, no. 5, p. 3.   she visited. When questioned about the princi-
> 206                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Mrs. Menhrangiz Munsiff(last row, second from
> the right) with a group of Girl Guides, Santo,
> Espiritu Santo Island, New Hebrides; 177.
> 
> Dr. Jan e Faily (last row, extrem e left) with
> participants in a Teacher Training In stitute,
> Elele-Etchi, Nigeria; 1979. Dr. Faily travelled
> extensively in Africa during the year she spent
> there as a consultant for the Baha'i
> lniernational Community.
> 
> His Excellency James R. Mancham , President
> of Seychelles, (left) in cordial interview with
> Mrs . Lea Nys who is seen describing the route
> of Baha'u'llah's successive exiles. The visit
> took place on 11 November 1976.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                207
> 
> pies of the Faith , she never lost an opportunity   French-speaking areas of the West Indies durfor stressing the significance of Baha'u'llah's     ing the Five Year Plan, once early in 1977 and
> Revelation for the progress of humanity in this     once in 1978. Mrs . Nys also actively taught the
> day. She often spoke about the Baha'i principle     Faith for two months throughout Quebec,
> of the equality of men and women to Baha 'is        Canada in 1977, as well as in her native Beland to those inquiring about the Faith , and        gium and other French-speaking areas in
> often encouraged the women in communities           Europe, whenever she was not engaged in
> to arise to travel teach. The dramatic example      work in other parts of the world . Mrs . Nys's
> of Mrs. Munsiffs fearlessness and energy,           work has been particularly significant as she is
> however, has undoubtedly served more than           among the very first native French speakers to
> mere words to inspire both the women and the        arise to assist in the teaching and deepening of
> men she met throughout the world to under-          the many spiritually receptive peoples
> take a fuller service to the Cause of God.          throughout the world for whom French is
> Among the Baha'is of French-speaking             either the first or second language.
> countries throughout the world , the name of           Many other women as well have travelled to
> one travel teacher is particularly well-known:      the next town, province, country, or halfway
> Mrs. Lea Nys. Mrs. Nys was the first Belgian to     around the world in service to their Faith . Miss
> embrace the Baha'i Faith , and has taught the       Shamsi Sadeghat, from Trinidad and Tobago,
> Faith throughout Europe and the West Indies.        devoted much time to teaching throughout the
> Her repeated trips to Haiti, Guadeloupe, and        West Indies, and travelled to the northeast
> Martinique in particular have been instrumen-       United States as well. Shirin Boman and Zena
> tal to the growth of the Baha'i communities         Sorabjee, both serving on the Continental
> there. At the beginning of the Five Year Plan,      Board of Counsellors for South Central Asia,
> Mrs. Nys travelled for four months in French-       have been active throughout Asia, giving spespeaking Canada , the West Indies and the           cial efforts to the needs of Baha'i women. Mrs.
> United States. In July 1975 she left for Africa,    Boman travelled as well to the western hemistravelling alone for fifteen weeks to over sixty    phere to teach. In some cases, travel teachers
> cities and villages in Ghana , Zaire, Burundi,      from the more developed countries, because
> Tanzania , Madagascar, Reunion , Maruritius,        they were women, were able to reach women in
> the Seychelles and Kenya, by truck, taxi, or any    certain villlages for the first time in less techother available vehicle, often on foot in remote    nologically advanced societies. It is interesting
> areas. She visited officials and chiefs on the      to note too that the first travel teaching team
> national and local levels in every country, and     to go from Papua New Guinea to Australia
> received wide newspaper and radio publicity.        was made up entirely of women, girls and
> She returned to Martinique, Guadeloupe and          children.
> Haiti in January and February 1976, and then           Baha'i women are being recognized by the
> headed west to the Pacific Islands on a round-      world outside the Baha'i community as well for
> the-world teaching trip. Although she eventu-       their untiring and often sacrificial efforts
> ally had to discontinue this trip because of        towards better human understanding. Mrs. El ti
> illness, Mrs. Nys was able to visit all of the      Kunak, a Baha'i of Papua New Guinea,
> major French-speaking islands in the Pacific        received a British Empire medal for her work
> as well as several others, meeting with Baha'is,    in establishing women's clubs throughout the
> speaking at public meetings, visiting officials,    island of New Ireland in the Bismarck
> and giving press and radio interviews. From         Archipelago, having been named to the
> Tahiti she visited American and Western             Queen's Birthday Honours List in June 1975 .
> Samoa, where she met His Highness Malietoa          Mrs. Kunak and her husband were among the
> Tanumafili II, the first Baha'i reigning            first Baha'is to enrol in the Faith after the
> monarch . From there she went to Fiji, the New      Faith was introduced to New Ireland in 1957,
> Hebrides, the Loyalty Islands and New               and in 1974 she was the first native Papua New
> Caledonia. By October Mrs. Nys was                  Guinean woman to be elected to the National
> sufficiently recovered from her illness to return   Spiritual Assembly of that country. Although
> to Kenya, Mauritius, Reunion, and the               Mrs Kunak never went to school, she has
> Seychelles. She made two more trips to the          travelled extensively to lecture, organize
> 208                                  THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Participants in National Baha'i Women's
> Conference held in San Salvador, El
> Salvador; March 1977. Counsellor Artemus
> Lamb is seen on the extreme right, back row.
> 
> Participants in National Bah{i'{ Women's
> Conference, Senegal; April 1978.
> 
> Participants in first National Baha'i Women's
> Conference held in Dacca, Bangladesh;
> January 1977.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                             209
> women's clubs and represent the women of                    'The dearth of speakers available from this
> her country as the National President of                    part of the world who might be attending the
> Women's Clubs. She often emphasized that the                Conference, to take charge of certain substrength to fulfill these tasks is derived from her         jects, was extraordinary. We had enough
> faith in Baha'u'llah, and that His teachings                good Baha'i women speakers to cover the
> enable women to break the bonds of tradi-                   subjects but we should have had a choice
> tional life, to stand up straight and strong and            from a hundred speakers, and we didn't have
> create a good life for themselves and their chil-           it partly because they weren't coming here
> dren.                                                       and partly because the women are not com-
> In 1978, Mrs. Dorothy Francis, a Salteaux                ing forward enough to bear this aspect of
> Indian and a Baha'i since 1960, was awarded                 Baha'i service and there is no earthly reason
> the Order of Canada by the Canadian govern-                 why they should not ... Why are they not
> ment for her outstanding services to Canadian               coming forward? Why are they not bearing
> Indians in British Columbia and the Prairie                 this type of burden of service for the Faith of
> provinces. Mrs. Francis founded several Indian              Baha'u'llah?''
> Friendship Centres, which assist Indians to
> Despite the example of numerous early and
> adapt to urban life and employment, and
> modern-day Baha'i heroines, the potential of
> Indian Cultural Clubs, which seek to preserve
> women for understanding, enthusiasm, perseand enrich Indian culture and tradition in
> verance and sacrifice is a spiritual resource
> Canada. She also helped create the Winnithat has remained virtually untapped in many
> peg Arts and Crafts Centre, through which
> national communities. In many of the less
> many native Canadians market arts and
> developed countries where tradition has
> crafts.
> confined most women to a subordinate role in
> Another Baha'i woman whose work has
> all social, political and religious affairs, the
> been signally recognized is Dr. Dorothy Nelnumber of women believers enrolled in the
> son, treasurer of the National Spiritual Assem-
> Faith remains but a small fraction of the total
> bly of the United States and Dean of the Uninumber of Baha'ls. In India, for example, the
> versity of Southern California Law Centre.
> secretary of the National Spiritual Assembly in
> The Associates of the World Peace Through
> 1976 estimated that although many outstand-
> Law Centre awarded her the Pax Orbis Ex Jure
> ing Indian women have performed exceptional
> medal for her service as a lawyer in the cause of
> service to the Cause in their home country and
> world peace.
> around the world, only 0.5% of the total
> The work of these women and many other
> number of registered believers in India were
> individuals throughout the world dramatically
> women. 2
> demonstrates the capacity of Baha'i women to
> The major obstacle to the equal participaharmonize the different facets of their lives, as
> tion of women, as with the exemplification of
> mothers, as Baha'i teachers and adminisany Baha'i principle, lies in certain prevailing
> trators, as contributors to society through craft
> customs and traditions of the divers societies of
> and profession, and as the strongest promoters
> which the believers are a part; customs and
> of the cause of peace in the world. Their
> practices to which the Baha'i standards proaccomplishments during the Five Year Plan
> claim a marked and often startling contrast. This
> add lustre to the history of the Baha'i women.
> contrast exists in both under-developed and
> But why are there not yet many more Baha'i
> technologically advanced countries. The story
> women distinguishing themselves in all fields of
> of one Canadian pioneer in the Central African
> endeavor, indisputably demonstrating their
> Republic illustrates one of the main difficulties
> capacity and spiritual gifts to men, women and
> in bringing women into the Faith in many
> children both within and outside the Baha'i
> societies:
> community? Amatu'l-Baha Rul).iyyih Khanum
> frankly asked this question of more than a                   'There are very, very few women Baha'ls in
> thousand women assembled at the largest                      the Central African Republic ... I decided
> gathering of women during the Five Year Plan,          1
> Baha'( News (India), no. 29. Sept.-Dec. 1977, pp. 13- 14.
> the Asian Baha'i Women's Conference held in            2
> Extract from a report by Counsellor Hooper Dunbar,
> New Delhi in October 1977:                                 Bulletin Baha'( d'Haiti, April 1976, p. 12.
> 210                                             THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> to go out to the fields with them to dig ma n-             cases these conferences were the first region al
> ioc. I soon found out why few of them have                 or national Baha'i activity in ·which women
> time to come at night to listen to us! I went              from the more remote villages participated ,
> with three village women and walking a fast                and often they we re the first occasion on which
> clip, it took us exactly one hour to reach their           native women arose to speak publicly. The
> daily work. Once there, they spread a nice                 largest women 's conference, the Asian Conferclean cloth on a big pan and motioned me to                ence, was probably the first conference of its
> sit, but I refused and began to help them dig              type to take place anywhere in India. It, like
> and collect the tubers . . . I kept up to them             many of the other Baha'i conferences around
> all day, and when they hoisted great loads of              the world during the Five Year Plan, provided
> tubers on their heads, I put as many as I                  an unusual opportunity for the proclamation of
> could in an old cloth and hoisted them on                  the Faith, and in particular its principle of the
> mine ... We had four declarations from                     equality of men and women , to leading officials
> women! When they arrive home, the y have                   and to thousands of others through the news
> to walk sometimes as far as two or three kms.              media. Women travelling to and from the Conto get water, and carry it home on their heads             ference often took advantage of their journey
> to begin supper. For supper they had to chop               to teach the Faith to those they met, and many
> and make peanut butter, and spend an hour                  were able to initiate or assist organized travel
> "pillering" the manioc and then cook it all.               teaching projects .
> They are just too exhausted to come to meet-                  Other international women's conferences
> ings. Of course, the men of the village are all            were held in El Salvador, Peru and Liberia.
> fresh . . . because most of their day has been             More than one thousand believers from 122
> spent on a straw mat in the shade of a tree.' 1            Local Spiritual Assembly jurisdictions in Zaire
> gathered in September 1977 for a women's
> In many societies the kinds of activities in
> conference in Lueba , Kibundu in the Kivu rewhich women may participate are narrowly
> gion of the country , the largest of nine confercircumscribed by social convention, and meetences held in that area. In all, over 150 internaings in which both men and women are present
> tional, national and regional Baha'i Women 's
> and contribute are unheard of.
> Conferences sponsored by the Continental
> It is in an effort to develop the potential and
> Boards of Counsellors and National Spiritual
> engage the participation of all women who
> Assemblies were held between 1974 and 1979.
> believe in the truth of Baha.'u'llah's mission,
> Particularly noteworthy is the fact that many of
> and not just those women with education, that
> these conferences were held not in large cities but
> the Universal House of Justice has called for
> in villages and towns in remote areas , the home
> the development of women's activities. The
> territory of indigenous Baha'ls. Often the trip
> road to fulfilling 'Abdu'l-Baha's standard of
> to and from the conference was an important
> full and equal participation of women in all
> step in bringing the Baha'i women together as
> affairs is a long and difficult one. Important
> sisters. An account of the trip by participants
> first steps in this direction were taken by many
> in the first Baha'i Women's Conference of
> national communities through holding interna-
> Malaysia by launches and on foot to Kampong
> tional , national and regional women's confer-
> Temiang where the conference was held, tells
> ences and institutes to educate the believers in
> of the friendly spirit as women gathered from
> the standards set by Baha'u'llah and 'Abdu'leleven jungle communities:
> Baha. These conferences focused attention on
> the statements of 'Abdu'l-Baha on women's
> 'It was a happy journey with news being
> role in the progress of humanity, both within
> exchanged and the Baha'ls getting to know
> the family and outside the home; on the history
> each other as the launch proceeded through
> of Baha'i women such as the Greatest Holy
> the afternoon heat of the equatorial jungle
> Leaf, Tahirih, and Martha Root; on the impor-
> ... eventually we had to take to our feet and
> tance of the education of women who are the
> walk the last hour of our journey balancing
> first trainers of children; and on the vital role of
> on tree trunks neatly felled so that one can
> women in teaching the Cause of God. In many
> step from one to the other-a great deal
> ' Pulse of the Pioneer , no. 29, January 1979, pp . 14-15.      easier than walking through swampy land
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                              211
> 
> Four participants in the National Teaching
> Conference held al Umgababa, South Africa;
> October 1978. Judging entries in the arts and
> crafts exhibit are (left to right) Mrs. Anisa
> Cumberbatch, Mrs. Tabitha Tombisa, Mrs.
> Cecilia Nodada and Miss Dawn Jensen.
> 
> Participants in the first International
> Conference of Baha'i Women of South
> America held in Lima, Peru; December 1977.
> More than 200 women from 12 countries
> attended the conference which had as its theme
> 'Women's Role in the Progress of Humanity.'
> 
> Some participants in the first National Baha'i
> Children's Conference of Samoa; April 1977.
> The Hand of the Cause Abu'l-Qasim Faizi
> was present at this gathering which drew an
> attendance of approximately 100 children,
> parents and teachers.
> 212                                         THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Some participants in the Asian Baha'i Women's Conference held in New Delhi, India; October
> 1977. More than 1,000 women from Asia, Europe and America attended. Amatu'l-Baha
> Rul;zfyyih Khanum is seen in the centre.
> 
> . . . we were tired but so happy to arrive.' 1           ment of entire families in the Faith, and for
> raising up Local Spiritual Assemblies. Often
> Baha'i villagers from the Bouake, Man, and
> the women examined their local customs and
> Danane regions of the Ivory Coast walked dishabits in an effort to bring their lives more
> tances up to 400 miles overland to attend the
> closely in line with the principles of their Faith
> International Baha'i Women's Conference in
> and more consonant with their dignity as
> Monrovia, Liberia. Village women such as
> Baha'i women .
> these contributed actively to the success of
> Most important perhaps has been the fosterthese conferences throughout the world,
> ing of a new spirit among the Baha'i women
> speaking often for the first time before large
> who participated in the conferences, as their
> gatherings and translating addresses into the
> perception of their role in the progress of the
> native languages. Men as well as women con-
> Faith and of humanity in general was transtributed in a variety of ways to making these
> formed by learning of 'Abdu'l-Baha's
> meetings a success: in many cases the men
> revolutionizing statements on the importance
> attending the conference prepared the food,
> of women to the progress of all humankind. A
> washed the dishes, and cared for the children,
> Bolivian Indian woman who attended the first
> in order to allow the women to concentrate on
> International Conference of Baha'i Women in
> the discussion of their responsibilities and
> South America expressed well this change and
> development within the Faith and the imporits effect on her life:
> tance of their role as the first educators of the
> next generation of Baha'is. Such active and                     'I really could not understand why my huscheerful co-operation and service to the women                  band was so anxious to participate in the
> by the men is particularly interesting as in most               teaching work. I wanted him to stay home
> cases it was offered in marked contrast to social               with the family. Now I understand .. . in the
> customs prevailing in the world around them.                    future we will go out together for teaching,
> The enthusiasm created by these gatherings                      because I want to learn more and also want
> often resulted in women setting goals for them-                 to teach my people this unity, love, and
> selves for their own deepening and the deepen-                  peace.' 2
> ing of their families in the essential verities of
> the Faith, for the establishment of local classes            The exposition of the Baha'i view on the
> for women and children, for teaching the Faith             responsibilities and privileges inherent in
> locally and as travel teachers, for the enroll-            womanhood has not been limited to Baha'i
> ' Baha'f International News Service, no. 76, 17 November       Bahd'( International News Service, no. 91, 15 March 1978,
> 1975, pp. 11 - 12.                                           p. 7.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                           213
> 
> gatherings. The Baha'i principles of the equality of men and women and the importance of
> women to the spiritual and material progress of
> humanity have been clearly enunciated to
> many national, regional and local government
> officials around the world through personal
> interviews and written statements, and to the
> public at large through newspapers, radio and
> television. Public meetings, exhibitions and
> seminars in cities, towns, and universities have
> explored the subject in greater depth. Particularly significant has been the participation of
> the Baha'i International Community as a nongovernmental organization in United Nations
> conferences and seminars on women's
> participation in development held during and
> after International Women's Year. At each
> United Nations conference and seminar the
> women representing the Baha'i International
> Community took the opportunity to acquaint
> delegates of governments and other organizations from around the world with the Baha'i
> position, submitting statements challenging all
> people to recognize the spiritual equality of            Marion Jack (1866-1954) whose courwomen with men that must be firmly estab-                ageous exploits in service to the Baha'i Faith
> lished as the foundation for all other forms of          inspired Shoghi Effendi to describe her as an
> equality, whether legal, social, educational,            'immortal heroine' and a 'shining example
> economic or political. The world-wide Baha'i                ... to present and future generations.'
> community's contribution to the United
> Nations goal of the development of women so
> munity is playing its part throughout the
> that they may more fully contribute to the
> world in bringing about this change.' 1
> development of the societies in which they live
> was clearly stated by Mrs. Shantha Sundram of           What is inevitably needed, then, in order for
> Malaysia, representing the Baha'i Interna-           the realization of the Baha'i standard of equaltional Community at a United Nations regional        ity of rights and opportunities for both women
> seminar for Asia and the Far East in May 1974:       and men is for local Baha'i communities
> throughout the world to shoulder the responsi-
> 'It is inevitable at this time in the history of   bility of introducing this principle and bringing
> the Baha'i world community that there are          it into practice. The Five Year Plan has seen
> wide differences in the understanding, as          the inception of this in a number of areas.
> well as the application of these (Baha'i] prin-    Perseverance is needed, as is care and underciples ... Although the problems which dif-        standing, for the fullest expression of this prinferent local and national communities face         ciple must reflect the richness of the diversity of
> are different, the direction is determined and     the women and men throughout the world. The
> the growth and achievement already evident         most effective teachers of women are undoub-
> ... Man and woman alike are to search inde-        tedly other women. In many cultures the only
> pendently for truth. In attempting to put this     people able to approach women in the more
> principle into practice, we have found that        traditional villages, other than members of the
> cultural and religious prejudices are slowly       immediate family, are women. Because of this,
> being abandoned, and as women are usually          Baha'i teachers, who in these same cultures
> the upholders of tradition in the community,       1
> Statement of Mrs. Shantha Sundram at UN Regional Conthis brings about some important changes in            sultation for Asia and the Far East, Bangkok, 13-17 May
> attitude ... The Baha'i International Com-             1974, p. 2.
> 214                                            THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> have usually been men , have found it nearly               theBahti'i News of Cameroon for the benefit of
> impossible to attract women to meetings to                 all the Baha'is in the country.
> hear about the Faith. Individual women and                    As more Spiritual Assemblies take up the
> women in teams who have made a special                     task of giving 'unlimited encouragement to
> effort to share the Faith with village women               women', and encouragement to the men to
> have almost always found these women                       assist the women in their families to participate
> spiritually receptive. In India and several other          fully in the life of the Cause, the foundation will
> countries there have been a number of                      be laid for the growth of succeeding generainstances of nine women being the first people             tions of deepened and enthusiastic Baha'is. As
> in their village to accept the Baha'i Faith and to         more women prove their capacity to contribute
> form the first Local Spiritual Assembly. The               on the local level , they will also be given more
> story related by Mrs. Nasrin Fawbush, Auxili-              opportunity and responsibilities for serving on
> ary Board member in India, illustrates the pos-            the national and international levels. During
> sibilities for teaching among village women:               the Five Year Plan more women, and in particular indigenous women, have been elected
> 'During the remaining two days as I went                 to National Spiritual Assemblies than ever
> from house to house, the ladies welcomed                 before. The first Papua New Guinean woman,
> the Faith as though they were waiting for it.            Elti Kunak, was elected to the National
> Fifteen of them accepted the Faith and more              Spiritual Assembly of that country in 1974. In
> would have accepted had I stayed longer.                 1976 Miss Beatrice Camara, a member of the
> Among them were educated girls of eighteen               Temne tribe, was the first indigenous woman
> and married women, old and young. Four                   elected to the National Spiritua l Assembly of
> ladies whose husbands are working in                     Sierra Leone. The same year saw native
> Gauhati, Kanpur and Bhagalpur accepted                   women elected for the first time to the National
> the Cause. All asked for books and pam-                  Assemblies of the Solomon Islands and the
> phlets to send to their husbands. Now it is the          South West Pacific Ocean. The Baha'is of
> ladies who are going to teach their hus-                 Benin elected the first native woman to their
> bands.'1                                                 National Assembly in 1977. On the international level , a total of seventeen women are
> Other people instrumental in bringing knowpresently serving as members of the Contiledge of the Baha'i Faith to women are Baha'i
> nental Boards of Counsellors, and the Internahusbands, brothers and sons. As was pointed
> tional Teaching Centre has two women memout by RuJ:iiyyih Khanum at the Asian Baha'i
> bers: the Hand of the Cause of God Amatu'l-
> Women's Conference, not enough has yet been
> Baha RuJ:if yyih Khanum and Counsellor Flordone by men in teaching the Baha'i Faith to
> ence Mayberry.
> their wives . The Local Spiritual Assembly of
> Such growth in the participation by women
> Tiko, a coastal town in Cameroon, recognized
> in all levels of service to the Faith is a necessary
> this same difficulty, and addressed a letter to its
> step in the fulfillment of' Abdu'l-Baha's words:
> community 'as a challenge to the married male
> Baha'is whose wives are non-Baha'i' to                          ' ... the new age will be an age less masculine
> demonstrate the principle of equality of the                    and more permeated with the feminine ideals,
> sexes and thereby win the wholehearted                          or to speak more exactly, will be an age in
> allegiance of their wives and children to the                   which the masculine and feminine elements of
> Faith. This letter was subsequently printed in                  civilization will be more properly balanced. ' 2
> ' BahcJ'( News (India), no. 24, July-August 1976, p. 19.       Star of th e West, vol. 9, no. 7, p. 87.
> INTERNATION A L SURV E Y OF C URRENT BAHA'I A C TIVITIES                           215
> 
> 5. SURVEY OF THE EXPANDED USE OF
> RADIO AND TELEVISION IN THE FIVE YEAR
> PLAN
> As THE twentieth century began to unfold,            nine , have begun to use radio in their teaching
> the immense progress in the many forms of            programmes. And fortunately for all coninformation transmission evoked fr om ' Abdu' l-     cerned, the goal has caught the vision of indi-
> Bah a the observation that ' ... m eans of com-      vidual Baha'fs who have, through munificent
> munication have multiplied, and th e fi ve conti-    gifts, made possible much of the advancement
> nents of th e earth have virtually m erged into      here reported.
> one.' In 1946 Shoghi Effendi encouraged the             Many of the events recorded as achieveuse of radio and television , challenging the        ments of the Plan a re truly historic: the first
> Baha'i community to action by saying: 'The           international Ba ha'i Radio and Television Con-
> Baha'is should not always be the last to take up     fe rence in 1975 , the first centre for exchange of
> new and obviously excellent methods, but             radio materials established in 1976, and the
> rather the first, as this agrees with the dynamic    first broadcast from the first Baha'i radio stanature of the Faith which is not only progres-       tion in December 1977 .
> sive, but holds within itself the seeds of a new        The countries of Latin America and the
> culture and civilization.' By 1969, the Univer-      Caribbean were given the lion's share of goals
> sal House of Justice stated that: 'In country        in this field, and have ably achieved them. At
> after country the Cause has been featured for        both the Bahia and Merida Conferences in
> the first time in modern mass communications         January and February 1977 great attention
> media . The volume of this call to the people of     was given to the opportunities for use of the
> the world is increasing day by day and must so       mass media throughout the hemisphere. Councontinue , penetrating every stratum of society      try after country has taken up the challenge
> and the cumulative results have been most
> At Naw-Ruz 1974 the House of Justice              gratifying.
> assigned goals for the use of radio to thirty-nine
> countries and of television to twelve countries      Ecuador
> for procla mation, teaching and deepening of            The most notable effort has been the radio
> the believers. The Baha'i world generally was        activity in Ecuador, spurred by the vision of
> directed to vigorously pursue 'the proclama-         Counsellor Raul Pavon, the zeal of its National
> tion of the Faith , following established plans      Spiritual Assembly and special Radio Comand aiming to use , on an increasing scale, the      mission, and the technical and organizational
> facilities of mass communication.' Confirming        skills of K. Dean Stephens. Beginning in March
> the significance of this goal, the House of Jus-     1973 with time purchased on various local
> tice in May 1975 issued to National Assemblies       radio stations throughout Ecuador, the
> a compilation of references on the use of radio.     National Assembly developed plans for its own
> With these directions and impetus the Baha 'i        station whose studio was to be located in the
> community the world over set itself to obtain        RuJ:!fyyih Khanum Teaching Institute in
> access to the electronic media, an effort which      Otavalo. Surmounting great obstacles in securhas aided in lifting the Faith from obscurity.       ing the allocation of a medium wave frequency
> Radio in particular has been widely used as a        in early 1977, and thereafter in construction of
> means of deepening and teaching the friends , a      an effective working studio in the Institute,
> wide range of programmes has been devised to         plus a second studio and uniquely designed
> answer specific needs. Of the thirty-nine goal       transmitter in the hamlet of Cajas above the
> countries, eleven have been distinguished for        town, Radio Baha'f had its inaugural broadcast
> their activities beyond any expectations of the      on 12 December 1977 . This first Baha'f educa-
> Plan, while almost all others have met their         tional and cultural radio station, operating at
> commitments. In addition, very many Baha'f           1,000 watts, reaches Baha'fs and non-Baha'fs
> national communities, other than the thirty-         over a radius of approximately 50 kilometres.
> 216                                 THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> Site of a new short-wave broadcasting facility
> for Radio Baha'i, Otavalo, Ecuador. The new
> facility will expand the radio's signal to all of
> Ecuador and other areas of South and Central
> America.
> 
> Radio personnel preparing a tap e for
> broadcas1ing through the facilities of Radio
> Balui'f, Otavalo, Ecuador.
> 
> Silhouette of the antenna and the broadcasting
> studio, Cajas, from which on 12 December
> 1977 Radio Baha'i of Ecuador made its
> inaugural broadcast.
> INTERNATIO NAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                 217
> Beginning with a programme consisting            reaching into Panama. Shortwave broadcastprimarily of local a nd regional music, inter-      ing is to begin on 12 November 1979. Frespersed with Baha'i cunas-selected quota-           quency: 2,340 KHz (120 metre band).
> tions, Hidden Words, passages from the Writ-        Bolivia
> ings-from the outset the station has broadcast         On behalf of its large rural Baha'i populaheavily in Quechua for the predominantly            tion, the National Spiritual Assembly of
> Indian local population, but without neglecting     Bolivia has for some years broadcast in Span-
> Spanish. Steadily diversifying its programmes,      ish, Quechua and Aymara from stations in
> the station now broadcasts dawn prayers in          La Paz, Orum, Tarija and Santa Cruz, both
> both languages beginning at 4 a.m., has a con-      during free and purchased time in support of
> stantly expanding schedule of Baha'i teaching       teaching and deepening programmes . In 1976
> units, features a local newscast which has been     an operational radio production studio made
> very successful in its 'lost-and-found' service     possible a systematic preparation of continufor retrieving children and animals, and is in      ous programmes. Feasibility surveys have been
> process of developing programmes in agricul-        undertaken in the La Paz, Sucre and Potosi reture, health and nutrition, home economics          gions to consider possible establishment of a
> and literacy. It has been invited to be the first   full-time station for the Indian populations
> station to participate in classroom radio cur-      within signal range of each centre.
> ricula efforts of the National Department of
> Education. It has always maintained a large         Brazil
> schedule of local and national music with inter-      A production centre is reported in Salvador,
> vals of Baha'i messages. The station has spon-      with frequent but sporadic radio broadcasts
> sored public service events including music fes-    throughout the country.
> tivals for local bands, a children's festival for   Chile
> the International Year of the Child, and a            Small production units are functioning in
> rehabilitative child educational project housed     Punta Arenas and Temuco, and much free
> in the institute auxiliary building. It has         radio time has been secured, particularly by
> become the local station of the area, listened to   their musical groups.
> in preference to all others, the Baha'i prayers
> Colombia
> and songs being learned by children and adults,       Three active centres of radio production
> Baha'i and non-Baha'i alike.                        have been established, in Bogota, Leticia and
> The staff has steadily expanded, and consists    Cali. The radio building at Riohacha in the
> of fourteen full-time and part-time workers,        Guajira has temporarily been unusable because
> most of whom are local Quechua-speaking             oflocal disorders, but programmes recognized by
> volunteers teamed with a cadre of devoted           the Ministry of Communications continue in the
> pioneers . Not only does the staff work at the
> Guajiro language.
> station, but also undertakes a strong role in the
> teaching work in the Cayambe and Otavalo            Paraguay
> valleys among the many thousands of Indian             In 1977- 1978 systematic national probelievers. The radio takes an increasing            gramming was begun, with a year of national
> responsibility for encouraging observances, in      proclamation undertaken through extensive
> the region, of Feasts and Holy Days and for         time purchased on radio stations throughout
> election of Local Assemblies: 135 at Ricjvan        the country, thus achieving a uniquely effective
> 1979, up from 90 in 1978.                           coverage for teaching of the Faith.
> A second International Radio-TV Confer-          Peru
> ence was held in Ecuador in December 1976              A strong National Radio Committee has for
> attended by thirty-seven Baha'is from ten           several years succeeded in achieving countrycountries. A lso present were two Counsellors       wide decentralized radio efforts which have
> and several Auxiliary Board members.                been very effective in the teaching work; a
> Scheduled for 1979-1980 is the installation      number of radio production workshops have
> of a shortwave broadcast unit at Lake               been conducted. The House of Justice in 1977
> Cuicocha, whose programmes will range more          called for a feasibility study of a possible full -
> widely than with the medium wave coverage,          time radio station in Puno Province, on the
> 218                                TH E BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Participants in National Teaching Conference inaugurating the facilities of Radio Bahd'(,
> Cajas, Ecuado r; A ugust 1978.
> 
> ~
> ----·
> llES 21 ET 2t l•V
> 
> -~.........   -=-
> 
> A representative sampling of references to the Baha'i Faith which appeared in newspapers and
> journals between Ri(f,vdn 1976 and Ri(f,vdn 1979.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                   219
> shores of Lake Titicaca, with extensive coverage           Guatemala
> of Baha'i communities in both Peru and                       There have been intermittent programmes,
> Bolivia.'                                                  and Robert Porter's sound studio has produced
> Baha'i musical materials. Beginning in April
> Venezuela                                                  1978 spot broadcasting, three to six times daily
> A production centre has been equipped in
> on a radio chain , has taken place.
> the national I:Ia~fratu'l-Quds.
> Honduras
> Curai:;ao                                                     A recording studio was put into operation in
> This island goal of Venezuela has used radio             1977, and from 1978 there have been intermitfor Jong periods, broadcasting in Papiamento,              tent programmes from Siguatapeque, reaching
> English and Dutch.                                         Indian areas. Early in the Plan there was inten-
> Guyana                                                     sive activity in the La Ceiba area.
> In 1976 Guyana gained ten minutes of free               Mexico
> time weekly, on Sundays, on the national radio               In addition to coverage during the Merida
> channel, and has continued with these regular              Conference, spots have been used in Chiapas,
> programmes, but has also added paid spots.                 and interviews have originated in several cities.
> The Local Spiritual Assembly of Georgetown                 Nicaragua
> for some time has sponsored a ten-minute paid                 Baha'i programmes have been broadcast on
> programme every Baha'i Holy Day. Counsellor                the national station, and also recurrent pro-
> Peter McLaren and twenty-six other Baha'ls                 grammes from a local station in Bluefields up to
> from seven countries attended a Caribbean                  the time of the national disorder.
> Radio-TV Workshop held in December 1976.
> Panama
> Surinam                                                       A radio production centre in the lodge of the
> Effective access to the radio has been se-               House of Worship, an active Radio Commitcured in the capital and other cities; broadcasts          tee, and the needs of a large indigenous rural
> in Hindi from Nickerie have been well                      Baha'i population have motivated the producreceived.                                                  tion of local programmes, both free and paid,
> Belize                                                     via stations in Panama City (national chain), in
> After a lengthy series of weekly programmes              Chiriqui and Herrera Provinces, and elseover the single radio station in the country,              where. The Hemispheric Baha'i Radio and
> there was a two-year hiatus, but the Faith is              Television Conference was held in Panama in
> back on the air in both English and Spanish. A             1977, with 125 participants from twenty-four
> production centre is now being developed in                National Assemblies. A feasibility study for a
> Belmopan.                                                  full-time station has been conducted.
> The Bahama Islands
> Costa Rica
> In 1978, twenty-one weeks of island-wide
> Weekly Sunday morning programmes have
> broadcasts were run, followed by spots each
> been aired from Radio Golfit6, another series
> two weeks for six months.
> has gone out from Radio Cristal and still
> another from Limon.                                        Barbados and the Windward Islands
> Weekly free programmes ran for two years
> El Salvador                                                on Barbados's Caribbean Broadcasting Com-
> The National Spiritual Assembly of El Sal-              pany. Programme series have been run in Grevador sponsored CI RB AL (Centro para Inter-               nada and in St. Lucia.
> cambio Radiof6nico Baha'i de America
> Dominican Republic
> Latina) on behalf of the World Centre, and
> Beginning tardily, the Dominican Republic
> through its production centre broadcasts emitran thirty-six fifteen-minute programmes in
> ting from Radio Chalatenango and Radio
> 1978- 1979.
> La Paz. Excellent mini-programmes for its own
> teaching and for sharing abroad have been                  French Antilles
> produced.                                                    From 1973 onward, Barbara Joyce and the
> The station was authorized by the Universal House of   French Antilles Media Committee have had
> Justice in July 1979.                                  weekly Baha'i radio shows broadcast from the
> 220                                           THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> island of St. Maarten, with a listening audience      stations. The British Broadcasting Corporaon at least twelve islands, drawing content           tion's programme ' Report on Religion' has
> from Baha'i literature inducting The New Gar-         referred to the Faith more than once and at
> den, Fire on the Mountaintop, and God's Great         Ric;lvan 1979 extended 'Happy Ric;lvan' greet-
> Plan. Free programmes have been augmented             ings to Baha'is everywhere.
> by the purchase of spots.                              The United States
> Jamaica                                                   The National Assembly and its Public
> Beginning with the February 1973 presenta-          Information Office have concentrated on radio
> tion of a series of programmes on Radio                productions to be used by Local Spiritual
> Jamaica, the National Spiritual Assembly has           Assemblies on their local stations. These
> committed itself to radio as an effective way to       include 'The Jeff Reynolds Show' of thirteen
> reach everyone on the island and has spon-             half-hour programmes; twelve fifteen-minute
> sored a radio production centre, producing a           programmes based on talks given at the House
> continuing local programme, with broadcasts            of Worship; a series of fifteen five-minute
> also in the Cayman Islands.                            'fireside chats' in Spanish; ten five-minute
> Leeward and Virgin Islands                             spots on basic Baha'i themes; two radio specials
> Intermittent programmes from its produc-            featuring Linda Brown, England Dan and John
> tion centre in St. Thomas have utilized the            Ford Coley, and Archie Bell and the Drells;
> media professionals of the community. From             eight 'Fireside Playhouse' fictional dramatiza-
> Saba, pioneer Pauline Paul has been broad-             tions of Baha'i principles; thirty- and sixtycasting Baha'i messages for some five years,           second 'direct message' spots devised as comnow fifteen minutes bi-weekly. Many broad-             mercial announcements; and thirteen Race
> casts have emanated at intervals from Montser-         Unity Day spots. Local station utilizations
> rat, Antigua, St. Croix, Anguilla, St. Kitts and       have been reported as numerous and success-
> Tortola.                                               ful, often with minority groups being effectively reached.
> Puerto Rico
> Three 'firsts' are to the credit of Puerto          Hawaii
> Rico: the first Latin American Baha'i radio                The Hawaiian community is rich in persons
> production centre, in Mayaguez; 1 the first             trained in the mass media, hence radio prointernational radio and television conference          grammes have been regularly and frequently
> (the Caribbean Radio and Television Work-               aired; this has included many interviews, regushop in 1975); 2 and the first 'saturation' prog-       lar announcements of Special Event Days, etc.
> ramme of radio spots run simultaneously on              Particular effort has been expended to reach
> fifty stations throughout the country for one           the Filipino community through its station. A
> week in July 1977. Other activities have                notable achievement initiating the ongoing
> included use of the island's production facility        programme was the August 1974 show which
> to record songs for the albums 'Canci6nes de            was well advertised by radio and brought some
> Fe' and 'Flight'.                                       10,000 persons to the Waikiki Shell to enjoy a
> free concert by Seals and Crofts, and by Eng-
> Trinidad and Tobago                                     land Dan and John Ford Coley, followed by a
> With its radio production unit at the
> gigantic fireside meeting.
> National Centre, Trinidad has had frequent
> programmes, many by its radio professional,            Canada
> Lillian Fraser. Weekly free programmes are                Apart from individual community promatched with daily paid spots, and there are           grammes, in 1978- 1979 two radio spots were
> frequent Baha'i appearances on the pro-                produced by the National Office for commungramme 'Meditations'.                                  ity use.
> 
> In the northern countries of the hemisphere          Spain
> and in Europe with their intense media                   A strong National Radio Committee has
> development, many interviews and discussion            co-ordinated broadcasts from Fuengirolaprogrammes have been presented over local              Marbella, also received in Morocco; from Cor-
> See The Baha'i World, vol. XVI, p. 195.
> doba the airing of a series of half-hour progibid.                                              rammes featuring Baha'i singer Pancho; from
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                          221
> Radio Bilbao spots of Hidden Words each              New Zealand
> morning; and other programmes from                      Six to eight Baha'i communities have broad-
> Tarragona-Rens, Madrid, Cartagena, Tenerife          cast the mini-dramas and also there have been
> and Valencia. Some twenty persons serve as           interviews and special programmes .
> 'radio collaborators' and the committee issues
> Samoa
> a national newsletter.
> From 1977 to 1979 early morning devotion-
> In Africa, Asia and the Pacific sporadic activ-   als and fifteen -minute Sunday programmes
> ity in radio has been reported, and it is clear      have been broadcast in Samoan.
> that much more has occurred than has been
> Tonga
> recorded.
> A fifteen-minute Sunday evening pro-
> Cameroon                                             gramme m Tongan was aired during
> In 1978 a half-hour Sunday afternoon               1978- 1979.
> shortwave programme entitled 'New Horizons' ran for six months; scripts are now being         Among countries reporting radio activities
> widely shared.                                       some three or four have ready access to professional facilities , and about twenty have estab-
> Central African Republic'
> lished simple radio production centres.
> Beginning in 1973 the Committee for Radio
> It should be noted that travelling teachers
> has conducted a marathon programme of
> and their Baha'i hosts in very many countries
> thirty-minute bi-weekly broadcasts in English
> have become adept at telling of the Faith via
> and Sango. Programmes have been broadcast
> interview shows; of such interviews unnumfor more than five years on an essentially conbered programmes have been reported, many
> tinuous basis. The scripts in French have been
> featuring the Hands of the Cause, Counsellors,
> widely disseminated to other francophone
> and many others.
> communities.
> Liberia and Guinea                                   Special Radio Contributions
> In January 1979 a fifteen-minute weekly              Among the independent contributions to the
> radio programme of prayers began in English          radio efforts were a number worthy of menand local languages, called 'All Things Made         tion: (1) Produced in 1977 in India by Gloria
> New'.                                                Faizi, thirty half-hour programmes were
> Seychelles                                           broadcast in 1978 by shortwave Radio Sri
> Intermittent broadcasts have occurred since       Lanka, a station heard widely throughout
> 1967, but in 1979 a free ten-minute programme        south-eastern Asia; in 1979-1980 a repeat run
> was broadcast every two weeks over the single        was scheduled from the same station. The
> station of the islands.                              programmes have evoked many questions on
> the Faith, responded to by a committee in
> Eastern Malaysia                                     India, often by means of correspondence
> For some ten years the Baha'is have had           courses. The scripts and tapes have been
> fifteen-minute devotional programmes every           widely circulated. (2) Early in the 1970s Orpha
> fifth Sunday. In addition, a five-minute devo-       Daugherty , then in the Philippines, wrote thirtional period every fifth morning is conducted       teen mini-dramas; these have been widely disin the Iban language.                                seminated and used in a number of languages.
> India                                                In 1978, teamed with Jack Davis in Japan, Mrs.
> In 1977 India won official permission to          Daugherty produced forty-five tapes of a secmake announcements of Baha'i religious               ond series of mini-dramas, in English and
> events on All-India Radio; Baha'i Holy Days,         Japanese, each a lively sixty-second spot. (3)
> programmes of public functions , and inter-          Numerous radio interviews by the musician
> views of guests all have become possible.            team of Jimmy Seals and Dash Crofts and also
> Australia                                            countless broadcasts of their songs with Baha'i
> Weekly half-hour to full-hour programmes          themes have widely spread the name of the
> have been aired from several small local sta-        Faith in the United States and throughout the
> tions.                                               western hemisphere. ( 4) More recently, musi-
> See also The Baha'i World , vol. XVI, p. 141.    cal entertainers England Dan and John Ford
> 222                                     THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> Coley have give n much prominence to the              was produced by Barbara Joyce in St. Maarten,
> Faith in the United States and abroad through         Netherlands Antilles. Of the more than 200
> radio pe rformances. The fame ach ieved in the        programmes so far produced, and widely
> music world by America's jazz trumpeter John          shared as video-cassettes, thirteen videotapes
> Birks 'Dizzy' Gillespie, by England's promi-          were made at the Merida Confe rence in 1977.
> nent opera singer Norm an Bailey and by Italy's          (3) In Ca nada, beginning in 1976, a thirtynoted pianist Alfredo Speranza has been used          minute cablevision programme series called
> by them in media interviews and concerts for          'Baha'i News' was produced for a Toronto area
> wide-spread proclamation of the Faith.                cable syste m, a nd was continued to 1979,
> changing its name to 'Baha'i World' at that
> Television                                            time. Subscriptio ns to the programme were
> As in radio, television-mediated interviews        undertaken in some sixteen other Canadian
> have become a stock-in-trade of Baha'i trave l-       cities .
> ling teache rs, and many of the distinguished            (4) In Samoa, from 1977 through 1979, a
> membe rs of the Faith have used the ir access to      number of Sunday programmes have been
> television for proclaiming the Cause. The             telecast in both Engli sh and Samoan, including
> young French author Andre Brugiroux (La               the Hawaiian se ries and tapes from St. Maarterre n'esL qu'un seul pays) has been extremely       ten.
> successful in televisio n inte rviews in the             (5) T he National Assembly of the Central
> French-speaking countries; so, too, Lea Nys,          African Republic has produced several TV
> Shamsi Sedaghat and Meherangiz Munsiff dur-           series, and e nj oys free access to national televiing their extensive travel teaching for the           sion.
> Cause. The United Nations Yea r of the Ch ild            (6) The United States National Assembly
> was the occasion for a number of well-received        produced a series of fifteen videotapes for the
> television programmes, including one in the           enthusiast ically received Local Spiritual
> Central African Republic. The Faith was               Asse mbl y training progra mmes conducted
> increasingly mentioned on television in               nation-wide in 1976 .
> Europe. In October 1976 a Baha'i conference              (7) In the United States the musicians Seals
> held in Rimini , Italy in observance of Interna-      and Crofts had numerous TV appearances in
> tional Women's Year received television               which the Faith was mentio ned .
> coverage. Two wee ks later the compiler of the           (8) Puerto Rico telecast six monthly prog-
> National Television talk programme 'O re             rammes from November 1978 to April 1979 .
> Venti' approached the National Spiritual                 (9) In Liberia and Guinea, each Tuesday
> Assembly and obtained permission to devote           evening for five years the TV programme in
> an entire programme to the Baha'i Faith.              Monrovia has closed with a free five-minute
> French te levision gave excellent coverage of        spot.
> the Inte rnational Conference he ld in Paris in         (10) In Ca nada, in 1978-1979, an extensive
> August 1976 and in July 1978 the national            proclamation programme centred about a
> netwo rk carried a programme illustrating            single spot which was shown everywhere in the
> French workmen installing marble o n the Uni-        country on paid time.
> versal House of Justice building on Mt. Carmel.
> Ten te levision achievements stand out                The extraordi nary leve l of radio and televiamong the many single programmes reported.            sion activity throughout Latin America largely
> ( 1) In 197 5 there were released thirteen half-   stems from the indefatigable and expert work
> ho ur programmes produced in Hawaii , written        of radio and television engineer K. Dean
> by and featuring the Hand of the Cause Wil-          Stephens of Utah and Puerto Rico. His ceaseliam Sears, assisted by Robert Quigley and a          less travels and correspondence, his expertise
> supporting group. These programmes were               in virtually all aspects of radio and television ,
> repeated widely in Alaska, Canada , the United       have been of immense service .
> States and Samoa. Individual tapes have been            The Green LighL Expedition, 1 Step by Step
> shown elsewhere.                                      (Paso a Paso) and a ll other Baha'i films now in
> (2) Beginning in 197 4 a weekly fifteen-           distribution have found wide use on television.
> minute colour TV 'Baha'i Faith Programme'            1   See The Baha'f World, vol. XVI, pp. 419-448.
> INTERN AT IONAL SU RVEY OF CU RRENT BAHA ' I ACTIVITIES                         223
> 
> Participants in the international television and radio worksh op held al the 'A matu'l-Baha
> Ruf:ifyyih Khanum National Institute, Otavalo, Ecuador; December 1976. In attendance
> were represen1mives of ih e Continental Board of Counsellors for South America and other
> Baha'[s from ten countries.
> 
> Television spots and spot series have bee n      Motion Pictures
> produced by Canada, the United States,                 Canada has sponso red a motion picture pro-
> Puerto Rico and the Bahamas, among many            duction unit named Cine Baha'f which in 1976
> others.                                            produced a 16 mm. sixty-minute film on the
> Hand of the Cause A matu 'l-Baha Rul)fyyih
> Cl R BAL ( Cenrro para lntercambio
> Khanum, entitled lnvitaiion. In 1978 Cine
> Radiof6n ico Baha'i de America Laiina)
> Baha'i completed a seco nd interview film of
> In December 197 5 a clearing house for rad io
> fifty minutes with the H and of the Ca use John
> and TV materials for Latin America was pro-
> Robarts, entitled Retrospective. Both have
> posed at the Caribbean Radio and Te levision
> been widely used th roughout the Baha'i wo rld.
> Workshop . In June 1976 CIRBAL was author-
> Of motion pictures produce d during the Plan
> ized by the World Centre, with the Nationa l
> certainly the Green Light Expedition film was
> Assembly of El Salvador as host and Susa n
> the most significant. T his 16 mm . travelogue of
> Leich as director. A catalogue was published in
> Rui)fyyih Khanum 's South American teaching
> 1977; scripts and tapes were collected a nd distrip in 1976 along the Orinoco and Amazon
> seminated ; a nd Miss Leich actively travelled
> Rivers and in the A ndes, among the Indian
> throughout Latin America stim ul ating and
> peoples who have been so receptive to the
> developing local radio activities, conductin g
> Faith, was produced in English, Spanish and
> radio production workshops, often with K.
> Persian versions, and super-8 prints were also
> Dean Stephens. A Spanish-language newsletrun. Slide series and filmstrips of four parts
> ter, Ondas Baha'fs, has had six issues. CIR-
> each were available, deriving from the still
> BAL participated in the publication of a bookphotographic coverage. The film enj oyed
> let on mass media entitled Transmit Thy Knowlextensive use not only as a motion picture, but
> edge, in the distribution of the recording Canalso frequently on television.
> ciones de Fe, and has actively contributed to
> virtually every radio development in Latin         International Baha'{ Audio-Visual Cen tre
> America and world wide. CIRBAL moved to               Established in 1967 as an arm of the World
> Trinidad at the time of Miss Leich's marriage      Centre for distribution of audio-visual materito Counsellor Peter McLaren.                       als, the IBA VC in Victor, New York continued
> 224                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> throughout the Plan to be a major distribution      slides and fi lmstrips, a co-operative prochannel for a range of subjects in support of the   gramme was undertaken to modify and supply
> teaching and deepening work. Among its pro-         at low cost the excellent, small, battery- or
> ducts developed during the Plan were illumi-        line-operated projector, the Bikoh , now
> nated prayers and quotations in English and         renamed the Glory. Distributed from Kobe,
> Spanish , a new series of twenty-nine colour        Japan, with the assistance of Counsellor
> postcards of Baha'i subjects, a series of nine      RuJ:iu'llah Mumtazf and his staff, about 800
> six-slide sets of Baha'i Holy Places, Temples       projectors have thus far been placed in the
> and Baha'fs around the world, a series of eight     hands of travelling teachers, pioneers and
> Baha'{ Heritage notecards, two new filmstrips       others; this total excludes sales of the same
> entitled Pilgrimage to the House of the Bab and     projector by the United States.
> Arise. 1 Distribution of Baha'i identity jewel-        At the date of going to press, the IBA VC has
> lery, rings, ringstones, and other items con-       been transferred to Toronto , Canada, with
> tinued to be a staple service. The Centre han-      changed functions which exclude distribution
> dled the sale and distribution of the Green Light   of audio-visual material.
> Expedition motion pictures, slides and film-           In sum , the Plan has evoked a remarkably
> strips.                                             universal exploitation of mas~ media on behalf
> In order to make possible the field use of       of the Faith, creating thereby numerous bridgeheads which remain to be expanded and con-
> An adaptation appears on p. 109.                solidated as the Cause grows in every land.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                        225
> 
> 6. THE NEW ERA BAHA'I SCHOOL 1
> 
> IND I A, a land of more than half a billion                      The school already enjoys some internapeople, is known for its diverse geography, its               tional renown. Its student population represtradition of religious tolerance , and its social             ents more than twenty nations with less than
> caste system. About 200 kilometres (125                       half the total students coming from Baha'i
> miles) south-east of Bombay is the town of                    families. The remainder are from Buddhist,
> Panchgani, a Hindu word meaning five moun-                    Christian, Hindu, Muslim and other backtain tops. Three-fourths of the way up one of                 grounds. Many of the parents, Mr. White
> the five mountainsides, overlooking the                       explained, are prevented by tradition and
> Krishna River 457 metres (1,500 feet) below ,                 other factors from openly declaring the beauty
> is the New Era Ba ha 'i School which accommo-                 and validity of the Faith and from acknowledgdates 400 students from twenty-three coun-                    ing how successfully it is able to deal with
> tries. The mountain summits are flat and                      human behaviour, but others among them recovered with lakes.                                           cognize its value to the moral and intellectual
> The New Era School had its beginnings on 1                 development of their children. The students
> August 1945 when Mrs. Rezwan Mobedzadeh                       are united , largely because of an Eastern culand Mrs. Salisa Kermani left Poona, the Indian                ture that dictates submissiveness by students to
> town to which they had pioneered, and began a                 their environment and to adults and teachers .
> Baha'i children's hostel at the request of the                There are, of course, many things tradition
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of                 continues to carry forward that are not conduc-
> India and Burma. For the first six months the                 ive to unity among the students .
> school served only as a hostel offering spiritual                One such tradition is the inequality of men
> instruction to the children in the morning and                and women. Mr. White said that striving for
> evening. Gradually classes were added and in                  equality 'definitely produces conflict. But the
> 1948 the school was given the name 'New Era'.                 Guardian says truth goes through three stages:
> In 1953 a large property, 'Woodland', was pur-                conflict, questioning, and finally the selfchased. For the first time academic and physi-                manifestation of truth. Until educational
> cal education were offered.                                   institutions provide an environment where the
> Over the years the Guardian wrote many                     initial psychological and spiritual conflicts can
> statements and letters about the school, all of               take place, we will not proceed to the second
> them pointing to its future. In an early letter to            stage, that of questioning the validity of our
> the Spiritual Assembly of Panchgani he said he                own concepts of truth.'
> would 'pray for the growth and progress of the                   Cultural ties serve as a unifying force among
> Baha'i children's hostel so that it may become                students, Mr. White said. Over the years, the
> perfect and distinguished in every respect.' He               school curriculum has taken on many new
> later expressed the hope that it would someday                aspects, and today there is offered a full range
> become a Baha'i university.                                   of academic subjects and extracurricular
> Mr. Truitt White, acting vice-principal of the             activities. Inter-school events, including a sports
> school, said in an interview in the autumn of                 day, drama and school festival, are held each
> 1977, 'One of the things the Guardian men-                    year.
> tioned which the Universal House of Justice                      New Era is an accredited member of the
> re-emphasized in the Five Year Plan is the                    Maharashtra State Government educational
> need to develop the "distinctive characteristics              system and has proven itself a source of pride
> of Baha'i life." The more distinctive the school              and inspiration to both its local community and
> becomes, the more visible it will be. It will be a            the world community of Baha'is. The school is
> subject of criticism but it will become more                  co-educational, has both boarders and day sturenowned and appreciated at the same time.'                   dents, and offers instruction from kindergarten
> Adapted from Bahfz' ( News, a publication of the National   through the higher secondary level. The
> Spiritual Assembly of the United States, September 1977.      present-day functioning of New Era is the
> 226                                    THE BAHA 'I WORLD
> 
> result of continual guidance from the Universal      engineering works, strive in conju nctio n with
> House of Justice, the National Spiritual             the students to ra ise the standard of living in
> Asse mbl y of India and its appointed school         the villages. Students at the high school leve l
> committees.                                          who participate in the programme do not focus
> One reason the New Era School is growing is       on one field, as students at the junior college
> because it is one of the few E nglish-language       level might do, but are encouraged to gain as
> schools in th e area . Also, approximately one-      comprehensive a n education as possible . T hi s
> third of the students receive some form of scho-     course is compatible with the statement of
> larship for their tuition , room and board, which    'Abdu'l-Baha that true education is comis a re markable situation in India. These st u-     prehensive, and it fo llows the principle that
> dents would otherwise be unable to afford any        one should know something about everything
> English medium school in India, because a ll         and everything about something. A lthough it is
> other such schools charge tuition , even at the      independent of the school, the programme is
> e lementary level.                                   integrated into it through the students' partici-
> In the past ten years the government has          pation and it thus acts as an educationa l prostarted to subsidize village schools for up to       cess for them.
> seven years of education but the students are           The school co mpound consists of seventytaught in the local dialect which can isolate        nine hectares (thirty-two acres) and contai ns
> them educationally for the rest of their lives.      six dormitories, a large classroom building,
> 'People may live ten kilometres apart and not        kitchen and dining facil ities, a medical dispenbe able to communicate, and the cultures of          sary, a workshop and staff quarters. There is
> villages may be different enough to cause strife     also a large recreation area with facilities for
> should intermarri age betwee n the vill agers        many sports, including an indoor squash court.
> occur,' said Mr. White .                             There are many beautiful gardens . Surround-
> The Indian government encourages every            ing the buildings are agricultural lands where
> school to adopt a social service programme,          whea t and various fruits and vegetables are
> but few do as much as New Era. The older             grown fo r school use.
> students help to clean the school compound,              The first major structure to be built was a
> assist at school functions, make greeting cards      spacious classroo m building co mpleted in 197 5
> for hospitals, visit orphanages, assist local doc-    in time for the thirtieth an niversary of the
> tors, perform first aid, assist village people to    school. The cornerstone of this structure was
> plant trees and build roads, and take part in         laid by the late Hand of the Cause Tarazu' llah
> many other activities in a spirit of service. The     Samandari. It contains twenty-four classschool stresses the importance of social service      rooms, a science laboratory , art and music
> not only for the benefits it extends to the disad-    rooms, offices and a spacious library. A new
> vantaged, but also because it offers a needed         kitchen , dining hall and sports cen tre were conbalance in the education of the students. One         structed in 1977 . A t the present time ninety
> of the social service proj ects is the Rural          per cent of the teachers at the school are not
> Development Programme launched                  in    Baha'is. Mr. White said the administratio n
> October 197 5 and funded by do nations from           plans to increase the number of Baha'i teachers
> the Mottahedeh Foundation in New York. T he           as the school expands in the next few yea rs
> students assist the villagers in the valley below     from 400 to 600 or 700 students. Ninety per
> the school by helping to build roads, pull weeds      cent of the administrative staff members are
> or carry rocks. The studen ts may spend as            Baha'is, but this percentage will also increase .
> many as two or three days in a village, but              The aim of the school is to become a fullusually return to school each day as the villages     ftedged unive rsity where students may earn
> are only half an hour's walk down the moun-           doctorates, or degrees in medicine or law. T he
> tainside . An international tea m of Baha'is           New Era School is indeed unique in India, and
> trained in agriculture, anim al husbandry,            seems destined to grow in its distinctiveness.
> public health, hygiene, economi cs a nd
> INTERNATIONAL SURV E Y OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                   227
> 
> 7. RURAL DEVELOPMENT IN INDIA 1
> 
> A TE AM of a dozen Baha'fs with expertise in                agricultural tour offered by a local university.
> agriculture, education and medicine is working              The New Era Project also has its own bullock
> to build better living standards in villages                team and driver, as well as a van.
> around Panchgani in India, thus exemplifying                   Numerous improvements have been made in
> Baha'u'llah's command to serve one's fellow                 health care. The New Era Project is shifting its
> men. The team forms the core of the New Era                 emphasis from curative medicine to preventive
> Rural Development Project, begun in October                 medicine which is believed to be necessary for
> 197 5. It is the first project of its kind in the           long-term betterment of village health stan-
> Baha'i world. Donations from the Mottahedeh                 dards. Cholera injections and inoculations
> Foundation (established by Rafi and Mildred                 against other diseases have been given to a
> Mottahedeh) and individual believers have                   large percentage of the villagers. A plan for a
> enabled the team to provide education and                   sanitary closed-water system has been
> organizational guidance so that villagers may               developed. Meanwhile, the team secures the
> be led to develop their own capacities.                     villagers' permission to chlorinate the wells
> The site of the project is the village of Chikli.        from which drinking water is taken.
> Surrounding it is a network of smaller villages                Arrangements have been made with the
> called wadis, within a walking distance of                  nearby Wai Mission Hospital for a doctor to
> fifteen or twenty minutes. The project site was             visit Chikli monthly. He treats the ill and
> selected in consultation with the Universal                 ensures that serious cases are admitted to the
> House of Justice. It serves as a pilot project for          hospital. The Wai Mission Hospital has agreed
> similar undertakings in underdeveloped vil-                 to send a woman doctor to the villages to train
> lages in other parts of the world. The Universal            selected women in the rudiments of health
> House of Justice, the National Spiritual                    care, particularly in child delivery and child
> Assembly of India and the project team con-                 care. Information about health care is circusult on decisions to be made regarding the                  lated by the New Era team by means of a
> New Era Project. At the time of writing this                village bulletin and displayed on posters. Clasreport, in 1977, seven of the team members are              ses on the subject are taught at the community
> from India, while others are from Australia,                centre, where a clinic has been established.
> the Gilbert Islands and Tuvalu,2 New Zealand                Moral education classes are taught at the
> and the United States. Two of them are                      village school.
> women.                                                         As part of their training, students from the
> As a result of the project, a number of villag-          nearby New Era Junior College regularly proers have begun poultry farming; a new breed of              vide social services for the villagers and assist
> dairy cow with high milk production has been                with the New Era Rural Development Project.
> introduced; and mango, papaya, seedless lime                The school and the project are separate, although
> and silver-oak saplings have been planted .                 they bear the same name.
> These are just a few of the many developments                  Various short- and medium-range plans are
> completed or under way. Other agricultural                  in progress in the fields of agriculture, animal
> projects have included planting demonstration               husbandry, cottage industries, education and
> fields with rice that yields more grain than the            medicine. Chalk-making moulds and two tons
> usual type; developing a hybrid crop plan with              of gypsum were provided to two villagers in
> villagers financing eighty per cent of the cost;            1977 in order that they might establish themteaching the villagers to save for specific pur-            selves in this industry.
> poses, such as buying farm machinery; and                      Headway in the various components of the
> sponsoring two villagers to participate in an               project has not been as rapid as was hoped,
> Adapted from Baha'f News, a publication of the National
> largely because co-operation from the villagers
> Spiritual Assembly of the United States, November 1977.   came more slowly than expected. This has
> ' Until 1976, known as Ellice Islands.                      caused team members to develop a standard of
> 228                                       THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> success for the project based on attitude                whenever possible, and co-operation with govchange among villagers rather than on                    ernment officials is sought by the team in all its
> economic transformation. The team members                undertakings. Numerous state and local offifeel that changing the villagers' economic self-         cials have made visits to the project sites. The
> interest to concern for others is the key to             team recently expanded its contact with other
> bringing about sustained and enlightened rural           agencies involved in similar projects by attenddevelopment. Team members strive to exem-                ing a meeting at which eminent and experiplify Baha 'f virtues in the hope of in ft uencing the   enced persons of India and other countries who
> attitudes of the people in a positive way . In           are participants in rural development projects
> keeping with the instructions of the Universal           explained their successes and examined their
> House of Justice, no proclamation or teaching            failures .
> activities are held but several villagers have              Giving the villagers material goods is not the
> inquired about the Baha'i Faith, as time has             purpose of the New Era Rural Development
> passed and trust has been established.                   Project; rather, its aim is to provide education
> The New Era Rural Development Project                 and organizational guidance so that permanent
> team has co-ordinated its activities with gov-           improvements can be made .
> ernment rural development programmes
> 
> Inauguration of the New Era Rural Development Project, Chikli Village, India; October
> I975. On the right, seen performing the traditonal ceremony, is Mr. Vasant Rao Patil, the
> Minister of Irrigation and Power.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                              229
> 
> v
> THE BAHA'I FAITH
> AND THE UNITED NATIONS
> 1. SUMMARY OF THE YEARS 1947-1976
> IN the spring of 1947 the National Spiritual            With this communication the Guardian
> Assembly of the Baha'is of the United States         enclosed a summary of the history and teachand Canada was accredited to the United              ings of the Baha'i Faith which the National
> Nations Office of Public Information as a            Spiritual Assembly of the United States and
> national     non-governmental       organization     Canada reprinted and distributed widely.
> qualified to be represented through an                  The period 1954 to 1963 was a highly eventobserver. A year later the eight National            ful one, making an increase of strength through
> Spiritual Assemblies then existing were recog-       the participation of the newly elected National
> nized collectively as an international non-          and Regional Assemblies. These years witnesgovernmental organization under the title            sed, as well, the desperate appeal to the United
> 'Baha'i International Community'. These eight        Nations to save the lives of the Persian
> Assemblies were those of the United States           Baha'is. 1 As in previous years, the Baha'i
> and Canada; the British Isles; Germany and           International Community sent delegates to
> Austria; Egypt and Sudan; 'Iraq; Iran (Persia);      many international, regional and state confer-
> India, Pakistan and Burma; and Australia and         ences.
> New Zealand. Each National Spiritual Assem-             In 1956 Shoghi Effendi appointed a special
> bly in its application established the National      committee to be called into action for matters
> Assembly of the United States as its represen-       of international importance.
> tative in relation to the United Nations.               During the period of the Ten Year Crusade
> A significant action was taken in July 1947       the Baha'i observers accredited to the United
> when the United Nations Special Palestine            Nations were the Hand of the Cause Ugo R.
> Committee addressed a letter to Shoghi               Giachery, Europe; Mrs. 0. H . Blackwell,
> Effendi Rabbanf, Head of the Baha'i Faith,           United States; and Mrs. Mildred R . Motresident at the Baha'i World Centre in Haifa,        tahedeh, International.
> requesting an expression of the Baha'i attitude         When the United Nations wrote its Charter
> to the future of Palestine. In his reply, Shoghi     in 1945 in San Francisco, the member nations
> Effendi made it clear that 'Our aim is the           realized that changing world conditions might
> establishment of universal peace in the world        necessitate changes in its Charter. It therefore
> and our desire to see justice prevail in every       arranged for a Charter Revision Conference to
> domain of human society, including the               be convened in 1955. In anticipation of this
> domain of politics.' The Guardian also pointed       significant event each Baha'i National Spiritu~I
> out his concern that 'the fact be recognized by      Assembly was solicited for suggestions which
> whoever exercises sovereignty over Haifa and         might be incorporated in Baha'i proposals for
> 'Akka, that within this area exists the spiritual    Charter revision .2 Bearing these suggestions in
> and administrative centre of a world Faith, and      mind, a carefully conceived pamphlet reprethat the independence of that Faith, its right to    senting the first united effort of all the National
> manage its international affairs from this           Spiritual Assemblies in a non-Baha'i field was
> source, the rights of Baha'is from any and           prepared. Entitled 'Proposals for Charter
> every country of the globe to visit it as pilgrims   Revision Submitted to the United Nations by
> (enjoying the same privilege in this respect as      1
> For a detailed account of this action see The Baha'( World,
> Jews, Muslims and Christians do in regard to             vol. XIII, p. 329.
> The full text of the Baha'i International Community provisiting Jerusalem) be acknowledged and per-             posals for charter revision appears in The Baha'( World,
> manently safeguarded.'                                   vol. XV, pp. 376-377 and in other earlier volumes.
> 230                                            THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> the Baha'i International Community', a copy                   Days; active promotion of Human Rights and
> of this pamphlet, together with a covering let-               the equality of men and women .
> ter written by the executive secretary, Mr.                      In 1962 persecution of Baha'is made it
> Horace Holley, was sent to each of the dele-                  necessary to appeal again to the United
> gates at the Conference. In addition , copies                 Nations for redress. On 12 April 1962 a
> were presented to officials of many univer-                   number of the Baha'is of Morocco were
> sities, to librari ans, and newspaper men.                    arrested and imprisoned and were not finally
> In May 1955 there broke loose a sudden ,                   arraigned before the Regional Court of Nador
> violent storm of persecutions against the Baha'i              until 31 October. On 10 December they were
> community in Iran, threatening its very exis-                 tried in the Criminal Court of Nador. Death
> tence. Cables to the Shah and the Prime Minis-                sentences were imposed upon three, five were
> ter from Baha'is all over the world brought no                sentenced to life imprisonment, and one was
> cessation of the hostility and the widespread                 sentenced to imprisonment for fifteen years. 2
> massacre of Persian Baha'is, threatened in the                   An important step occurred in the developpress and in public meetings, became a real                   ment of the Baha'i relationship to the United
> danger.                                                       Nations in the period 1963-1973 when , under
> In July 1955 Shoghi Effendi cabled the Baha'i              the guidance of the Universal House of Justice,
> International Community to lodge with the                     the Baha'i International Community sought
> United Nations an appeal for immediate assis-                 and obtained, on 27 May 1970, consultative
> tance. A committee consisting of five Baha'is,                status, category II ,3 with the United Nations
> each from a different country, proceeded                      Economic and Social Council (ECOSOC).
> within thirty-six hours to Geneva where the                      In 1967 , the Universal House of Justice had
> Economic and Social Council of the United                     assumed the direction of the work of the Baha'i
> Nations was then meeting and engaged in                       International Community with the United
> ceaseless efforts to have their case presented.               Nations, a responsibility shouldered for so
> A competent lawyer was retained to frame the                  many years, with great distinction, by the
> appeal. 1                                                     National Spiritual Assembly of the United
> On 10 April 1959 representatives of the                   States; and, in view of the volume and scope of
> Baha'i International Community presented to                   these activities, decided to appoint a full-time
> the president of the Human Rights Commis-                     representative of the Baha'i International
> sion, Ambassador Ratnakirti Gunewardene of                    Community to the United Nations . Mrs .
> Ceylon (Sri Lanka), a statement endorsing the                 Mildred Mottahedeh, who had performed
> Genocide Convention.                                          devoted and distinguished part-time service in
> The United Nations Office of Public Infor-                 that office for nearly twenty years, asked to be
> mation, in co-operation with the executive                    relieved of the heavy responsibility, and Dr.
> committee of the non-governmental organiza-                   Victor de Araujo was appointed in her place.
> tions, called a meeting at United Nations                        As a result of its consultative status and its
> headquarters in May 1960 to discuss problems                  known concern for human rights, the Baha'i
> of co-operation 'with the United Nations fam-                 International Community was invited to send
> ily in so far as its programme affects the new                representatives to two special United Nations
> nations'.                                                     seminars for member-states in observance of
> The statement submitted on behalf of the                  International Year for Action to Combat Rac-
> Baha'i International Community was com-                      ism and Racial Discrimination, 1971. At the
> prehensive and noted 'vigorous assistance' to                first one, held in Yaounde, from 16 to 29 June,
> primitive peoples to help them integrate into                 the Baha'i International Community prethe more developed societies surrounding                      sented two statements explaining the Baha'i
> them; educational programmes for adults and                  point of view towards race and emphasizing the
> children; encouragement of a world point of                  2
> For a full account see Th e Baha'( World , vol. XIII , pp.
> view serving to eliminate traditional prejudices                  288-289.
> of nation, race and religion; annual obser-                  3
> Consultative status, category II, is given to 'organizations
> which have a special competence in, and are concerned
> vances of United Nations and Human Rights                        specifically with, only a few of the fields of activity covered
> 1   For a full account see The Baha'( World, vol. XIII, pp.       by the Council, and which are known internationally within
> 789-791.                                                      the fields for which they have or seek consultative status'.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                               231
> general principles concerning the oneness of       organized by that conference in the areas of
> mankind . The second special seminar was held       human rights, status of women and development.
> in Nice, from 24 August to 6 September, 1971.         One new area of Baha'i-United Nations
> The Baha'i participants were twice given the       co-operation concerned youth. In 1970, the
> opportunity to present the Baha'i viewpoint on     Baha'i International Community participated
> specific subjects being discussed, drawing a       in the World Youth Assembly, a conference
> great deal of attention and favourable com-        convened under United Nations auspices, at
> ments from many government delegates.              UN headquarters, as part of the observance of
> Again, as an outcome of its consultative status,   the twenty-fifth anniversary of the United
> the Baha'i International Community was             Nations, to explore issues of common concern
> invited to participate in the United Nations       to youth and the UN. Later, the Baha'i Inter-
> Conference on the Human Environment, held          national Community worked closely with the
> in Stockholm, during the first two weeks of        UN headquarters Youth Caucus, a group of
> June 1972. A Baha'i statement presented            representatives and observers designated by a
> before one conference session resulted in the      number of international non-governmental
> improvement of some conference recommen-           youth and youth-related organizations and
> dations . The Baha'i delegation also contri-       co-sponsored a statement submitted to the
> buted to a joint statement submitted to the        Economic and Social Council recommending
> conference by the representatives of many          the establishment of an international university.
> non-governmental organizations. A special             The relationship of the Baha'i world to the
> pamphlet, The Environment and Human Val-           United Nations Office of Public Information
> ues-A Baha'i View, was prepared for the            (OPI), begun in 1948, continued to expand
> occasion and distributed to the 1,500 govern-      during this period, as did participation of the
> ment delegates and 600 observers in atten-         Baha'i world in United Nations Day and
> dance. The Baha'i International Community          Human Rights Day programmes assisted each
> was also actively represented at the Environ-      year by new National Spiritual Assemblies and
> mental Forum held in conjunction with that         their communities.
> United Nations conference, where many non-            Baha'i International Community cogovernmental groups came together to present       operation with the Office of Public Informatheir views and discuss environmental issues.      tion was further recognized through the elec-
> Since the sessions of the Economic and          tion of Dr. Victor de Araujo to membership on
> Social Council and its commissions and com-        the     Executive      Committee      of    Nonmittees take place both at UN headquarters in      Governmental Organizations with OPI. He
> New York and at the Palais des Nations in          served as vice-chairman during 1969 and as
> Geneva, Mrs. Janet Lindstrom and Dr. Marco         ch~rmanduring1971 and1972.
> G. Kappen berger were appointed respectively          The Baha'i International Community found
> representative and alternate representative for    many opportunities to explain to UN delethe Baha'i International Community in              gates, representing by 1976 more than 140
> Geneva . In addition, Dr. 'Aziz Navidl was         independent countries and over ninety per cent
> named Baha'i International Community rep-          of the peoples of the planet, as well as to memresentative for the continent of Africa.           bers of the UN Secretariat, how its interest in
> In July 1972 Mrs. Mary Sawicki was              the goals of the United Nations Charappointed full-time executive assistant to Dr.     ter- world peace, universal human rights, and
> de Araujo . A larger headquarters was also         the full social and economic development of
> ~ought and found, across from the United           the peoples of the planet- was rooted in the
> Nations, at 345 East 46th Street, New York.        Baha'i teachings, principles and laws, and how
> Soon after obtaining consultative status, the   these Baha'i guidelines were relevant to a last-
> Baha'i International Community became a            ing solution of the world's problems. In addimember of the Conference of Non-                   tion, the Baha'i International Community was
> Governmental Organizations in Consultative         able to point to the way of life evolving in
> Status with the Economic and Social Council,       Baha'i communities around the world as an
> and participated actively, both in New York        embodiment of the Baha'i teachings.
> and in Geneva, in the work of committees              During this period, the Baha'i International
> 232                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Community added to its existing consultative           Community office in New York assisted with
> status with ECOSOC and its affiliation with the        matters of protection and recognition of the
> UN Office of Public Information, two new rela-         Baha'i world community. One of the important
> tionships: an affiliation with the United              assignments given by the Universal House of
> Nations Environment Programme (UNEP),                  Justice to its representative was the presentaheadquartered in Nairobi; and consultative             tion on behalf of the Universal House of Jusstatus with the United Nations Children's Fund         tice of The Proclamation of Bahti'u'lltih to
> (UNICEF). The association with UNEP,                   fifty-six Heads of State via their ambassadors
> begun in 1974, marks a continuation of the             to the United Nations. With but few excep-
> Baha'i concern for the environment, expressed          tions, for reasons beyond control, all the fiftyearlier through participation of the Baha'i            six ambassadors received this historic docu-
> International Community in the Stockholm               ment. In addition, under the direction and gui-
> Conference on the Human Environment                    dance of the Universal House of Justice, con-
> (1972). To act as liaison with UNEP in                 tacts were made on many occasions with the
> Nairobi, the Baha'i International Community            United Nations Missions and Secretariat. Here
> appointed as its representative Mr. Bonaven-           again a growing understanding of the nonture Wafula, and as alternate representatives          political and constructive nature of the Baha'i
> Mrs. Ruth Vuyiya and Dr. H. Tim Rost.                  International Community in the work of the
> The Baha'i International Community                  UN, aided by its consultative status, made
> received consultative status with UNICEF, a            access to key United Nations officials easier
> member of the UN family concerned for over             when a clear presentation of the Baha'i posithirty years with the well-being of the world's        tion was called for to foster the official recognichildren, on 8 March 1976. This accreditation          tion of the Faith or to prevent discrimination
> was most welcome, and promises to offer many           against a Baha'i community.
> opportunities for closer ties of the Baha'i world          Strengthening of the relationship between
> with the United Nations.                               the Baha'i International Community and the
> In the autumn of 1975, Mr. Will. C. van den         United Nations continued during 1973-1976
> Hoonaard, a member of the Baha'i community             with a noticeable increase in the range and
> of Canada, joined the Baha'i International             depth of Baha'i co-operation. The Baha'i
> Community United Nations Office serving as             International Community explored new
> alternate representative to Dr. Victor de              avenues of participation in United Nations
> Araujo. This addition brought the staff of the         areas of social and economic development, as it
> Baha'i International Community in New York,            worked closely with the Economic and Social
> by Ri<;ivan of 1976, to six persons, four serving      Council (ECOSOC) , its functional commisfull-time and two part-time. When Mrs. Janet           sions, committees and associated bodies. Not
> Lindstrom found it necessary to resign as rep-         only was it represented at sessions of UN
> resentative of the Baha'i International Com-           bodies concerned with issues of human rights,
> munity to the United Nations in Geneva, Dr.            social development, status of women, envi-
> Marco G. Kappenberger was appointed to                 ronment, human settlements, world food, scireplace her. Mrs. Mahshid Fatio was then               ence and technology, population, law of the
> named alternate representative.                        sea, crime prevention, narcotic drugs, youth,
> The world-wide results of Baha'i-UN co-             the family and the United Nations University,
> operation during International Women's Year            but it also furnished information, submitted
> were most gratifying. Over sixty National              statements and published brochures on most of
> Spiritual Assemblies reported activities during        these subjects. In addition, the Baha'i internathat year, and already the Baha'i world com-           tional Community participated in United
> munity is engaged in continuing the impetus of         Nations Years, in world conferences and conthis contribution of Baha'i men and women to           gresses, in regional conferences and in semithe equality of the sexes in a variety of activities   nars concerned with the socio-economic probduring United Nations Decade for Women.                lems of our planet, as well as in preparatory
> This Decade was proclaimed by the UN Gen-              and follow-up meetings and activities.'
> eral Assembly at its 30th session (1975).              1   For a full account of these activities see The Bah1ff World,
> As in the past, the Baha'i International                vol. XVI.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                233
> 
> 2. THE BAHA'I INTERNATIONAL
> COMMUNITY AND THE UNITED
> NATIONS 1976-1979
> VICTOR DE ARAUJO
> 
> BETWEEN Ri<;lvan 1976 and Ri<;lvan 1979,             social and economic issues of serious concern
> the Baha'i International Community con-              to the United Nations-extending now its
> tinued the steady growth of its consultative         cooperation to additional issues of deep U.N.
> relationship with the United Nations                 interest, such as disarmament and the well-
> Economic and Social Council (ECOSOC) and             being of children-as it took part in worldwide
> with the United Nations Children's Fund              U.N. conferences and seminars, and in the reg-
> (UNICEF), and its association with the United        ular periodic meetings of the Economic and
> Nations Environment Program (UNEP) and               Social Council, its functional commissions and
> the U.N. Office of Public Information                committees, and other U.N. bodies.
> (OPI)-which became the Department of                    Most gratifying was the increased awareness
> Public Information (DPI) on 1January1979.            and participation of national Baha'i com-
> During this period, the Baha'i International      munities, through their National Spiritual
> Community took part in the 1977, 1978 and            Assemblies, U.N. representatives and commit-
> 1979 sessions of the Committee on Non-               tees, in fostering the ties of the Baha'i world
> governmental Organizations, the functional           with the United Nations, not only through
> committee of ECOSOC in charge of fostering           national and local Baha'i U.N. activities, but
> the U.N. relationship with non-governmental          also by providing the assistance of knowledgeorganizations in the economic and social fields.     able Baha'is who helped to prepare statements
> The 1978 session of this committee was espe-         and pamphlets examining the implications of
> cially significant, since it reviewed the work of    the Baha'i teachings for the solution of specific
> non-governmental organizations in consulta-          world issues, as well as representing the Baha'i
> tive status with the Economic and Social Coun-       International Community at conferences. In
> cil for the previous four years. The Baha'i          addition, the involvement of National Spiritual
> International Community report, covering the         Assemblies in countries where U.N. conferperiod from May 1973 through September               ences or meetings took place by furnishing
> 1977, was fully approved. It showed an impres-       Baha'i personnel and services to ensure more
> sive roster of activities undertaken in the spirit   effective Baha'i participation, brought a
> of cooperation with the U.N.: participation in       clearer understanding of how each Baha'i
> U.N. conferences, seminars, and regular meet-        community shares in the Baha'i International
> ings; preparation and publication of informa-        Community's consultative status relationship
> tion, reports, statements, and brochures; as         with ECOSOC and UNICEF.
> well as dissemination of information on the             Baha'i communities continued during this
> U.N. through a variety of programs in obser-         period to plan programs for special United
> vance of special U.N. days and years, and            Nations days, years, and decades- such as
> through the media, both Baha'i and non-              United Nations/World Development Informa-
> Baha'i.                                              tion Day, Human Rights Day, Universal Chil-
> The Baha'i International Community kept           dren's Day, World Environment Day, the
> working closely, through personal contact by         International Year of the Child (1979), the
> its representatives, with U.N. offices and offi-     Decade for Action to Combat Racism and
> cials at U.N. Headquarters in New York-as            Racial Discrimination (1973-1983), and the
> well as with the U.N. offices in Geneva and          U.N. Decade for Women: Equality, Develop-
> Nairobi-and, with the assistance of represen-        ment, and Peace ( 197 6-1985). Yearly reports
> tatives of its member Baha'i communities, with       surveying the worldwide contribution of the
> U.N. field offices around the world. It con-         Baha'i world community to the observance of
> tinued to offer the Baha'i viewpoint on global       such occasions, in addition to the substantive
> 234                                            THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> contributions being made by the Baha'f Inter-           the total worldwide co-operation of individunational Community in its consultative status           als, groups and governments. '
> with ECOSOC and with UNICEF, as well as in                 In greeting the participants at both conferits association with UNEP, were submitted to            ences, Mrs. Sipila also expressed her awareness
> the United Nations during this period , and             of the Baha 'i work on behalf of women. She
> were gratefully acknowledged.                           even concluded her message to the West
> As government delegates and United                   African Conference by saying: 'I know that the
> Nations personnel increasingly witnessed the            Baha'i community supports fully the goals of
> Baha'f presence, through the diversity ofBaha'f         the United Nations Decade for Women. Many
> delegates, as well as the Baha'f statements             of your communities are striving to achieve the
> (almost always circulated as U.N . documents) ,         objectives of the World Plan because they
> they were becoming aware not only of the                closely parallel the goals of your own commuworldwide spread of the Baha'f community,               nity . This West African Women's Conference
> but also of the total Baha'i view-one resting           is an historic event. I take this opportunity to
> on a new spiritual and moral foundation-so              salute the West African Baha'i Women's Conessential for a lasting solution of the world's         ference and Baha'i communities everywhere.'
> problems and the building of a world civiliza-             In addition, a number of letters from United
> tion.                                                   Nations officials acknowledging reports,
> In fact, several expressions of recognition          information, statements, and brochures mailed
> and appreciation of the Baha'i role in its              by the Baha'i International Community indiassociation with the United Nations were regis-         cated the appreciation with which the efforts of
> tered during this period. For instance, the             the Baha'i world to assist the U.N. in its aims
> Secretary-General of the United Nations, Mr.            and activities were being regarded. One official
> Kurt Waldheim , sent a message to the Interna-          remarked that the report of worldwide Baha'i
> tional Baha'i Conference in Paris, of 3 August          activities was 'an impressive testament to the
> 1976, wishing the Baha'ls success in their              work of the Baha'i International Community';
> deliberations and commenting that 'Non-                 another, that 'the activities of the Baha'f Intergovernmental organizations such as yours, by            national Community on behalf of the United
> dealing comprehensively with the major prob-            Nations are worthy of special commendation .'
> lems confronting the international community            One other report was greeted with the acknowland striving to find solutions which will serve         edgement that it 'eloquently attests the serious
> the interests of all nations, make a very sub-          and effective work the Baha'ls undertake to
> stantial and most important contribution to the         redisseminate information about the many
> United Nations and its work'. 1                         facets of the work of the United Nations' and
> in turn, Mrs. Helvi Sipila, Assistant                that 'we count a great deal on the Baha'i Inter-
> Secretary-General,       Centre    for    Social        national Community's support of the United
> Development and Humanitarian Affairs, sent              Nations.' A newsletter, sent by the Baha'i
> special messages to the 1977 Asian Baha'i               International Community to stimulate Baha'f
> Women's Conference in New Delhi, India, and             co-operation with UNICEF, drew this comto the 1978 West African Baha'i Women's                 ment: 'If the response is as efficient and as
> Conference in Monrovia, Liberia. While out-             warm as seems to be typical of Baha'i Comlining to the conferences the direction of the          munities, I am afraid we will be inundated with
> work of the United Nations in fostering the             requests for information! ! ! '
> advancement of women, Mrs. Sipilii. spoke                  Attracted by the words of 'Abdu'l-Baha in
> warmly of the Baha'i contribution to this effort.       The Reality of Man, one high U.N. official, Mr.
> To the Asian Conference, she wrote that 'When           Robert G. Millier, Director and Deputy to the
> the Baha'i International Community sends a              Assistant Secretary-General, Office for
> representative to the United Nations, when a            Inter-Agency Affairs and Coordination,
> Baha'i Community anywhere in the world                  observed in his book, Most ofAll, They Taught
> focuses its attention on the UN and the Decade          Me Happiness, that his experience in prison
> for Women, when a single Baha'f does what he            reminded him of the testimony of a religious
> or she can do to help, it has a ripple effect on        leader,' Abdu'I-Baha, who spent many years in
> ' The full text of the message appears on p. 140.       prison. He then quoted a passage from
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                       235
> 
> Some participants in United Nations Day observance, Porto Alegre, Brazil; October 1977.
> Left to right: Mr. R. Taetz; Counsellor Mas'ud Khamsf; Mrs. Nylza Taetz; Mrs. Dercy
> Furtado, State Congresswoman; Professor Maria J. P. Motta.
> 
> 'Abdu'J-Baha's talk on 'Joy and Pain':                          the world. Secretariat News is read by some
> fourteen thousand United Nations staff mem-
> 'I myself was in prison forty years-one year
> bers in New York and abroad.
> alone would have been impossible to
> The sections that follow offer some details of
> bear-nobody survived that imprisonment
> the intensive and expanding work of the Baha'i
> more than a year! But, thank God, during all
> International Community with the United
> those forty years 1 was supremely happy!
> Nations.
> Every day, on waking, it was like hearing
> good tidings, and every night infinite joy was
> Human Rights
> mine. Spirituality was my comfort, and turn-
> The Baha'i International Community coning to God was my greatest joy. If this had not
> tinued during this period to participate in the
> been so, do you think it possible that 1 could
> yearly sessions of the Commission on Human
> have lived through those forty years in
> Rights and its Sub-commission on the Prevenprison?' 1
> tion of Discrimination and the Protection of
> One striking instance of U.N. awareness of                   Minorities, as well as to encourage its member
> the Baha'i presence appeared in the United                      communities to observe Human Rights Day,
> Nations Headquarters house organ, Secretariat                   10 December, as an occasion for programs to
> News, which ran a full article on 'The Baha'is'                 educate the public on the rights and responin its issue of 31 October 1978 . Describing the                sibilities of all peoples living on one planet and
> nature and range of the activities of the Baha'i                in a global society. It kept the UN Division of
> International Community, this piece included                    Human Rights informed of such worldwide
> photographs of Baha'i-U.N. activities around                    Baha'i activities through yearly reports. It also
> Robert Muller, Most of All, They Taught Me Happiness        advised the Division of the overall contribution
> (Garden City, New York: Doubleday & Company, Inc.,          which the Baha'i International Community
> 1978), p. 55. The words of 'Abdu'l-Baha are taken from
> The Reality of Man (Wilmette, Illinois: Baha'i Publishing   was making to the UN Decade for Action to
> Trust, 1962 ed.), p. 17.                                    Combat Racism and Racial Discrimination
> 236                                      THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> (1973-1983) through the implementation, in             dependence of all peoples, and the need for
> the lives of Baha'is everywhere, of the princi-        systematic efforts on the part of individuals and
> ple of the organic oneness of humanity and the         their institutions to eradicate all kinds of presystematic abolition of all prejudice, including       judice. Stressing that the 'only standards of
> that based on race.                                    justice valid today are those applicable to the
> To further stress its concern for the abolition     whole human race', he cited the experience of
> of racial prejudice, the Baha'i International          Baha'i communities of many years.
> Community took an active part in the World
> Conference to Combat Racism and Racial Dis-            Environment
> crimination, held in Geneva, Switzerland,                 Besides attending the yearly sessions of the
> August 197 8. Its four-person delegation, of           Governing Council of the United Nations
> African, European, Korean, and East Indian             Environment Program (UNEP) and the meetbackgrounds, representing the three main               ings for non-governmental organizations prior
> races, was in itself an illustration of the unity in   to those sessions, all held in Nairobi, Kenya,
> diversity of the Baha'i world community, and           the Baha'i International Community took part
> attracted much interest and many positive              in two major conferences concerned with
> comments, allowing the Baha'is rich oppor-             environmental problems: the U.N. Water Contunities to explain the Baha'i view of oneness         ference in Mar de! Plata, Argentina, March
> and its application to the conference proceed-         1977, convened to examine how it might be
> ings.                                                  possible to supply water to all people by 1990;
> A Baha'i statement confirming the positive          and the U.N. Conference on Desertification in
> and constructive Baha'i view of the oneness of         Nairobi, Kenya, August-September 1977,
> humanity and the need to promote and protect           organized to find ways of preventing the spread
> the rights of peoples of every ethnic back-            of deserts on the planet, and wherever posground was circulated to conference particip-          sible, to take action to restore desert areas to
> ants. It expressed comprehensively the Baha'i          fertility. The latter conference, which was less
> point of view on how it is possible to eliminate       technical in nature, offered more possibilities
> prejudice and discrimination of any kind, with         for Baha'i participation. A series of film showproper education, proper attitudes and values,         ings, lectures, and panel discussions on topics
> and proper motivation.                                 relevant to the conference consultations was
> Later, the Baha'i International Community           arranged, as a public service to the people of
> marked the occasion of the thirtieth anniver-          Kenya, at the National Baha'i Center in
> sary of the Universal Declaration of Human             Nairobi. In addition, the Baha'i delegates
> Rights, 10 December 1978, by sending the               made many contacts with the conference par-
> World Conference statement-along with the              ticipants, sharing the Baha'i views on the basic
> Baha'i pamphlet, Divine Law: Source of                 problems underlying the destruction of the
> Human Rights-A Baha'( View, prepared for               environment and resulting desertification.
> the twenty-fifth anniversary of the Declara-              The Baha'i International Community subtion-to every delegate attending the thirty-           mitted to UNEP, at the request of that U.N.
> third United Nations General Assembly, to              body, a report on environmental activities of
> acquaint them with the creative Baha'i pro-            the Baha'i world during 1975, 1976, and 1977,
> gram for the unification of the human race.            and a report on environmental development
> In September 1978, the Baha'i International         and development management. It also pre-
> Community took part in a U.N. seminar on               sented a paper on 'Global Cooperation and the
> 'National and Local Institutions for the Promo-        Environment' to the 1977 non-governmental
> tion and Protection of Human Rights', held in          organizations session, stressing among other
> Geneva, Switzerland. At one of the meetings,           points that 'more human beings should come to
> the Baha'i delegate offered the suggestion that        realize and think deeply about the fact that
> non-governmental organizations could under-            man is organic with the world and that his inner
> take among their members and society in gen-           life and his environment interact upon each
> eral programs to change attitudes and values,          other.' The statement explained further that
> by teaching from earliest childhood the reality        'effective counteraction of mankind's present
> of the organic oneness of humanity, the inter-         headlong rush toward environmental disaster
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                237
> will take place when man 's inner life, his            The Baha'i statement, published as a pamphattitudes and values, undergo profound              let entitled Building a Unified Community, was
> changes', changes that include a full realization   circulated to the conference as an official U.N.
> of the interdependence of humanity with its         document, as well as widely distributed as a
> environment, as well as an understanding that       brochure. The publication offered a Baha'i
> we are, 'as human beings, basically one and         glimpse of the community of the future, ceninterdependent.' Such a realization also            tered on a House of Worship with its surroundrequires 'fundamental changes in the inner          ing humanitarian institutions to nurture the
> lives, attitudes, and values of men and women       fundamental spiritual and moral needs of the
> everywhere.'                                        settlement's inhabitants. The pamphlet, in fact,
> began by suggesting that 'A human settlement
> Human Settlements: Habitat                          must first answer the question, "What is the
> The United Nations Conference on Human           purpose of our lives, as human beings, on this
> Settlements took place in Vancouver, Canada ,       planet?"' and proceeded to explore the nature
> May-June 1976. The Baha'i International             of a human settlement in which the physical,
> Community worked closely with the National          rational, and spiritual facets of human nature
> Spiritual Assembly of Canada in the prepara-        could be developed, with an understanding
> tion of a statement conveying the Baha'i view       that 'the community should reflect the basic
> on the kind of human settlement that is needed      purpose of human life, which in essence is to
> to provide for the happiness of people, and also    know and to worship God , and to carry forin the selection of a Baha'i delegation. Both the   ward an ever-advancing civilization.' The
> conference and the parallel non-governmental        brochure also examined the characteristics and
> organization Forum offered countless oppor-         values which the community should stimulate
> tunities for the Baha'i delegates to talk to        in its members, as well as the support which it
> prominent government and non-governmental           should give, through its administrative body.
> participants, with many opportunities to dis-       While realizing that ' the ultimate richness of an
> cuss the Baha'i solution.                           organically united humanity and the character
> 
> /                                                                  ~
> 
> Some participants in the United Nations Day observance, San Salvador, El Salvador; October
> 1976. Left to right: Mr. and Mrs. Edward Diliberto; Thelma O'Con, United Nations director;
> Counsellor Artemus Lamb; Mrs. Dee Lamb, representative of the Bah{/( community to the
> United Nations; Susan Leigh.
> 238                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> of individual and collective life within a future   eighteenth session of the United Nations
> world community can now be only dimly               Economic Commission for Latin America
> imagined,' the statement concluded by assert-       (ECLA) in La Paz, Bolivia, April 1979. On
> ing that 'the immediate steps that the respon-      both occasions, the Baha'i International
> sible leaders of a needy humanity should now        Community representatives had full opportuadopt, can be clearly discerned, and should be      nity to meet the delegates and discuss formally
> pursued with faith, courage, and determina-         and informally the Baha'i views on the topics
> tion.'                                              being considered .
> The Baha'i International Community has
> continued its interest in finding answers to the   Science and Technology
> complex issues of HABIT AT through partici-           Looking ahead to its participation in the
> pation in the first and second sessions of the     1979 United Nations Conference on Science
> Commission on Human Settlements-a body             and      Technology       for     Development
> established by the HABITAT Confer-                 (UNCSTD), the Baha'i International Comence-respectively in New York and Nairobi.         munity attended in Geneva and New York the
> One further expression of the Baha'i Interna-      regular yearly sessions of U .N. committees
> tional Community's interest in problems of         concerned with the appropriate application of
> human settlements was its participation in the     science and technology to assist developing
> Third Conference on Urban and Regional             countries, as well as meetings of a special
> Research, sponsored by the Committee on            committee to plan for UNCSTD. It also
> Housing, Building, and Planning of the             accepted appointment to the Board of the
> Economic Commission for Europe (ECE) held          NGO Committee on Science and Technology
> in Warsaw, Poland, May 1976. Although this         for Development and participated in the planconference was of a highly technical nature , the  ning of the Non-governmental Organizations'
> Baha'i presence marked the Baha'i concern for      Forum, an event to be held parallel to the U.N.
> problems affecting the living conditions of        Conference.
> peoples throughout the world.                         As a further expression of its interest in
> UNCSTD, the Baha'i International Commun-
> Economic and Social Development                    ity and the National Spiritual Assembly of the
> The Baha'i International Community con- United States co-sponsored a special meeting
> tinued its involvement in the general area of for members of the United Nations Secretariat,
> U .N . activities to promote the social and missions, and non-governmental organizaeconomic development of the peoples of the tions, in which a prominent Baha'i scientist
> planet, through participation in the two yearly explored the possibility that technology, unless
> sessions of the Economic and Social Council in correctly used, might well fail to satisfy the
> New York and Geneva (the first portion of the '""total needs of the human being.
> 1976 summer session was in Abidjan, Ivory
> Coast), as well as in the biennial sessions of the Narcotic Drugs
> Commission for Social Development. It also            Cooperation with the U.N. in the prevention
> followed closely the special preparatory meet- of drug abuse intensified during this period.
> ings convened for the elaboration of an Inter- Not only did the Baha'i International Comnational Development Strategy for the 1980s, munity participate in the 1977, 1978, and 1979
> so that it might offer the Baha'i view at an sessions of the Commission of Narcotic Drugs
> appropriate time.                                  in Geneva, but it also submitted to the Commis-
> In addition, the Baha'i International Com- sion reports with information on worldwide
> munity took part in the U.N. Conference on Baha'i activities to educate Baha'is as well as
> Technical Cooperation among Developing the public about the problems of drug abuse
> Countries in Buenos Aires, Argentina, and alcoholism, and on the cooperation of
> August-September 1978, a major meeting to Baha'i communities with civil authorities and
> explore joint action by developing countries to organizations concerned with this matter. In
> solve their social and economic problems; and addition, at the 1979 session, the Baha'i repin a regional meeting dealing with overall prob- resentative, in a supplementary oral statement,
> lems of economic and social development: the stressed the need for individual commitment to
> INTERN ATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                        239
> eradicate drug abuse, derived from the convic-             ishment only increaseth depravity, and by
> tion 'that man is a noble and spiritual being,             such means the desired aim cannot be propwhose purpose in life is to develop his latent             erly achieved. Therefore must the individual
> potential for service to humanity.' This com-              be trained from his infancy in such a way that
> mitment, the representative said, must be fos-             he will never undertake to commit a crime,
> tered within the family and reinforced by the              will, rather, direct all his energies to the
> community.                                                 acquisition of excellence and will look upon
> In addition, in August 1976 the Baha'i                  the very commission of an evil deed as in
> International Community had participated in                itself th e harshest of all punishments, considthe Second World Congress for the Prevention               ering the sinful act itself to be far more grievof Alcoholism and Drug Dependency in                       ous than any prison sentence. For it is pos-
> Acapulco, Mexico, a conference sponsored by                sible so to train the individual that, although
> the International Commission for the Preven-               crime may not be completely done away
> tion of Alcoholism, a non-governmental organ-              with, still it will become very rare.' 1
> ization with U.N. consultative status. A statement on the Baha'i view that basically 'there is     Status of Women
> no chemical solution to problem s which are             In addition to taking part in the twenty-sixth
> fundamentally spiritual' was included later as       (1976) and twenty-seve nth (1978) sessions of
> an annex to a report submitted to the 1977           the Commission on the Status of Women, and
> session of the Commission on Narcotic Drugs.         in preparations for the 1980 women's confere nce to be held at the mid-point of the U .N.
> Crime Prevention                                     Decade for Women (1976-1985), the Baha'i
> The Baha 'i International Community con-          International Community participated in two
> tinued to participate in the meetings of the         region al conferences on the integration of
> Committee on Crime Prevention and Control.           women in development: one for Asia, in
> It attended the fourth and fifth sessions, held      Kathmandu, Nepal, February 1977; and one
> respectively in 1976 and 1978 in New York            for Africa, in Nouakchott, Mauritania,
> and Vienna. Beyond that, it sent representa-         September-October 1977.
> tives to two of the regional preparatory meet-          The Baha'i International Community conings for the 1980 Sixth United Nations Con-          tinued, during the Decade for Women, to
> gress on the Prevention of Crime and the             cooperate with U.N. programs and activities to
> Treatment of Offenders: for Asia and the             achieve the equality of men and women. It not
> Pacific, May 1978, Manila, Philippines; and for      only kept the U.N. Branch for the Advance-
> Latin America, March 1979, San Jose, Costa           ment of Women informed of the work being
> Rica. These special meetings afforded the            done by Baha'i communities-through its
> Baha'i delegates excellent opportunities to          mid-197 6 report, for instance, of the activities
> share the Baha'i view on the essential moral         of over sixty national Baha'i communities dura nd spiritual dimensions of the problem of          ing International Women's Year (IWY) and a
> criminality. In fact, at the closing ceremonies of   later report, in reply to a U.N. questionnaire ,
> the Manila meeting, the Baha'i participant was       on the Baha'i activities from 1975 to 1978
> able to offer for the success of the Sixth U.N.      which had bearing on the implementation of
> Congress on Crime Prevention , a Baha'i              the World Plan of Action for Women-but it
> prayer for mankind, and to share the follow-         also kept before the U.N. bodies working to
> ing pertinent passage from the Baha'i Writ-          improve the status of women, through such
> ings expressing, in the words of' Abdu' l-B aha,     statements as those to the Commission on the
> the answer to crime prevention:                      Status of Women and to the African and Asian
> regional conferences, an understanding of the
> 'Observe how many penal institutions,              basic Baha'i teachings on the equality of men
> houses of detention and places of torture are      and women and their implications for the
> made ready to receive the sons of m en, the        development of the full potentialities of mempurpose being to prevent them, by punitive         bers of both sexes in building a world order.
> measures,    from     committing      terrible     1
> Bahti'f Education: A Comp ilation (Wilmette, Illinois:
> crimes - whereas this very torment and pun-            Baha'i Publishing Trust, 1977), p. 23.
> 240                                              THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> As Baha'i communities-through the                             coordinating agency. Alerting its worldwide
> fulfillment of the Baha'i goal of organizing                     affiliates of this special year to focus on the
> activities to integrate women more fully into                    needs of children , the Baha'i International
> Baha'i community life 1-increased their                          Community encouraged Baha'i communities
> involvement in changing the basic attitude                       everywhere to express their deep concern for
> towards women in society, the possibility grew                   children, already evident in their programs for
> for closer cooperation at community level with                   the education of Baha'i children, to the world
> United Nations agencies and regional                             at large through special activities. Plans
> economic commissions, as the Baha'i Interna-                     under way suggested that IYC had struck a
> tional Community began to share with person-                     creative chord.
> nel working with programs for women, infor-                         The relationship between the Baha'i Intermation regarding such Baha'i projects.                           national Community and UNICEF promises to
> be a warm and deepening one; and during this
> Children (UNICEF)                                                period several articles on the Baha'ls-and
> During this period, the Baha'i International                  Baha'i events- were featured in the
> Community exercised its consultative status                      NGO/UNICEF Newsletter. Examples: an artiwith UNICEF through participation in the                         cle on Mrs. Laura Dreyfus-Barney,2 who was a
> annual UNICEF Executive Board meet-                              founder of the UNICEF Advisory Committee
> ings-1976 and 1978 in New York, and 1977                         of International Non-governmental Organizain Manila, Philippines-and through involve-                      tions (the present NGO Committee on
> ment in UNICEF activities with non-                              UNICEF); a story on the participation of the
> governmental organizations to promote the                        Baha'i International Community members in
> well-being of children and mothers. Dr. Victor                   Universal Children's Day; and a feature on
> de Araujo became a member of the Steering                        the Baha'i farming and agriculture project in
> Committee of the NGO Committee on                                Panchgani, India. 3
> UNICEF for 1976-1977and1977-1978; and
> Health
> Mrs. Mary Sawicki, for 1978-1979. Mrs.
> It was through its consultative status with
> Sawicki also became Associate Editor of the
> UNICEF that the Baha'i International Com-
> NGO/UNICEF Newsletter. Dr. Will van den
> munity was invited to take part in an Interna-
> Hoonaard, in turn, chaired a special committee
> tional Conference on Primary Health Care, in
> to review UNICEF films for use by non-
> Alma Ata, U.S .S.R., September 1978, cogovernmental organizations and the public .
> sponsored by UNICEF and the World Health
> The Baha'i International Community partici-
> Organization (WHO). A short paper on 'The
> pated in the work of the NGO/UNICEF com-
> Technical and Operational Aspects of Primary
> mittees on Women in Development, Public
> Health Care' was delivered by the Baha'i
> Information (and its related Film Committee),
> International Community representative as a
> Nutrition, Primary Health Care, and the Intercontribution to the consultation in the final
> national Year of the Child (IYC). One specific
> session of one of the three major committees,
> activity was a unique joint UNICEF/NGO
> and the pertinent ideas presented formed the
> pilot project for village water in Kenya, a venbasis of two of the fina l conference recommenture initiated at the international level by nondations. Since then, the Baha'i International
> governmental organizations and UNICEF,
> Community has, through its membership in the
> with the participation of non-governmental
> UNICEF/NGO Committee on Primary Health
> organizations in Kenya, including the Baha'i
> Care, pursued its deep concern in achieving the
> community.
> goal of the Alma Ata Conference, that of
> In addition, the Baha'i International Comreaching an acceptable level of health for all
> munity encouraged Baha'i communities
> the peoples of the world by the year 2000.
> around the world to observe Universal Children's Day, and to plan programs not only for                   Disarmament
> that yearly event, but also for the International                 The Baha'i International Community
> Year of the Child, for which UNICEF was the                     entered a new era of cooperation with the
> See 'Survey of Activities of Baha'i Women in the Five Year       See ' In Memoriam', The Bahd'( World, vol. XVI, p. 535.
> Plan', p. 202.                                                   See 'Rural Development in India', p. 227.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                  241
> 
> BAMAIPRINCIPL
> 
> Some participants in the observance of the International Year ofthe Child, Karachi, Pakistan;
> December 1979. The observance was jointly sponsored by the Bahd'( Youth Committee and
> the Local Spiritual Assembly of Karachi. The week-long programme comprised many events,
> including a history quiz, involved 200 participants, and attracted an attendance of approximately 500 people.
> 
> United Nations when it participated in the            mailed, with a complimentary card, in the
> tenth special session of the United Nations           appropriate        language- either      English ,
> General Assembly, convened in New York,               French, or Spanish-to all delegates (some
> May-June 1978, to seek ways to achieve gen-           three thousand) attending the thirty-third regeral and complete world disarmament.                  ular session of the General Assembly.
> While the Baha'i view on disarmament and              'The Promise of Disarmament and Peace'
> peace had been offered at the founding of the         offered an introduction and selected passages
> United Nations through wide distribution to           from the Baha'i Writings, arranged under the
> U.N. de legations of the brochure, The Bahd'i         headings of ' Disarmament, Peace, and True
> Peace Program , the Baha'i International              Civilization' , 'The Oneness of Mankind' , and
> Community now prepared a new statement,               'A World Super-State'. The preface stressed
> entitled 'The Promise of Disarmament and              that disarmament is 'essential for the abolition
> Peace' , outlining the Baha'i view of the respon-     of war as a solution to human problems' and
> sibility of individuals and governments to work       that 'it is a goal for both governments and
> for peace in the world. Although the statement        peoples.' While recognizing that there is no
> was made available to participants in the Spe-        easy road to world peace, the statement
> cial Session by the U .N. Secretariat, the Baha'i     observed that disarmament demands an
> International Community sent copies of the            increase in the awareness of governments and
> brochure to prominent government represen-            peoples of the 'organic oneness of the human
> tatives attending the session and to high U.N.        race', as well as the creation of a world federaofficials, with a covering letter. Later that year,   tion with enough arms and armed forces at its
> on the occasion of United Nations/World               command 'to prevent one nation from attack-
> Development Information Day , 24 October,             ing another or, if this occurs, to put down the
> 'The Promise of Disarmament and Peace' was            aggressor'. The statement concluded by
> 242                                    THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> observing that while national governments            Public Meetings
> bear a responsibility to prevent war, it is ulti-       One new approach to c0operation between
> mately also the task of each person to establish     the Baha'i International Community and the
> 'true world unity and peace'-a condition in          United Nations began in 1976 with a series of
> which ' individual and social well-being will be     four to six yearly public meetings on issues of
> expressed in a civilization reflecting spiritual     deep concern to the U.N. These lectures, given
> values of love, compassion , and justice.'           by highly qualified Baha'is from the United
> States and Canada, were co-sponsored by the
> Law of the Sea, World Food, Population,              U.N. offices of the Baha'i International Com-
> Youth, and UN. University                            munity and of the National Spiritual Assembly
> The Baha'i International Community con-           of the United States. The topics broached were
> tinued to follow the deliberations of the Third      quite varied: the prevention of violence, the
> Confere nce on the Law of the Sea, in sessions       development of human potential , racial disthat took place from August 1976 through             crimination, the world economy, communica-
> March 1979, alternating between New York             tions, the family, life-long education, educaand Geneva, as representatives of the world's        tion for development, the education of chilgove rnments, through extensive and complex          dren for one world , the future of technology ,
> negotiations, tried to reach a comprehensive         the unfoldment of the potential of women , and
> global agreement regulating the seas and             the building of a unified community. These
> oceans of the planet. The Baha'i representa-         meetings, attended by guests from the U.N.
> tives made many contacts with delegates, to          missions, the U .N. Secretariat, and members of
> whom they were able to express the Baha'i            non-governmental organizations, were offered
> interest in an international regime for the sea,     as a contribution to the global solution of issues
> as a precursor of an eventual world federation       of on-going concern to the United Nations.
> for the whole planet.
> The Baha'i International Community like-          Cooperation with Non-Governmental Organwise continued to show its interest in the efforts   izations
> of the U .N. to provide adequate food for all the       The cooperation of the Baha'i International
> world's peoples, by sending representatives to       Community with other non-governmental
> the yearly sessions of the World Food Council        organizations working with the U.N. took the
> (both the earlier preparatory and the later          form of participation in the activities of the
> ministerial-level meetings) in Rome, 1976 ; in       Conference of Non-governmental Organiza-
> Rome and Manila, 1977; and in Mexico City,           tions in Consultative Status with the Economic
> 1978. The basic Baha'i view on the solution of       and Social Council and its many committees in
> world problems through unity, as well as the         New York and in Geneva, such as those on
> importance of agriculture as a human activity,       development, disarmament, world food, and
> which had been expressed earlier at the World        the status of women. The Baha'i International
> Food Conference, were brought to the atten-          Community was also active in the Youth
> tion of the participants on many occasions,          Caucus and the United Nations University
> both officially and through informal discus-         Task Force, both in New York, as well as in
> sions.                                               co-sponsoring from time to time statements
> Baha'i concern for the long-range U.N. pla n      with other non-governmental organizations for
> to resolve the many-faceted issue of world           presentation to U.N. bodies, when these
> population was also expressed during. this           documents were not openly or implicitly politiperiod through participation in the nineteenth       cal in nature or tone. In addition, the Baha'i
> (1977) and twentieth (1979) sessions of the          International Community continued its par-
> Population Commission. The Baha'i Intern a-          ticipation in the Annual Conference of Nontional Comm unity also kept alert to develop-        governmental Organizations arranged by the
> ments in the U.N. work with youth, as well as to      Office of Public Information (OPI) and the
> the expansion of the programs of the United           OPI/NGO Executive Committee. Mr. Will. C.
> Nations University , seeking opportunities to        van den Hoonaard, Alternate Representative
> be of assistance in proffering the Bah a'i an-       of the Baha'i International Community to the
> swers.                                                United Nations, was, in fact, elected Secretary
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                             243
> of the Executive Committee for 1977-1978                   Drugs, the Baha'i International Community
> and chosen as Vice-Chairman for 1978-1979.                 attended the Conference on the Law of the
> Mr. van den Hoonaard was also co-chairman of               World, the biennial meeting of the World
> the 1979 Annual Conference.                                Peace Through Law Center, in August 1978,
> As for participation in conferences spon-                as well as the Colloquium and Seminar on
> sored by non-governmental organizations,                   Rural Women, sponsored by the International
> besides the Second World Congress for the                  Council of Women, in February 1978 . Both
> Prevention of Alcoholism and Drug Depen-                   meetings took place in Manila, Philippines.
> dency, mentioned in the section on Narcotic
> ANNEX I
> 
> SPECIAL UNITED NATIONS CONFERENCES, CONGRESSES AND
> SEMINARS IN WHICH THE BAHA'1 INTERNATIONAL COMMUNITY
> PARTICIPATED
> 1976-1979
> 
> I. United Nations Conference on Human Settlements           9. Third United Nations Conference on the Law of the Sea
> (HABITAT); Vancouver, Canada; 31 May-11 June                 (Fifth session , New York, U.S.A., 2 August-17 Sep-
> 1976.                                                        tember 1976; Sixth session, New York, 23 May-15 July
> Reps.: Professor John Jameson Bond, Mrs. Sheila              1977; Seventh session, Geneva, Switzerland, 28
> Banani, Dr. Glen A. Eyford, Mrs. Lei Chapman, Mr.            March-12 May 1978, and New York, 21 August-15
> Donald R. McLaren , Mr. Kenneth Goldstone .                  September 1978; Eighth Session, Geneva, 19
> 2. United Nations Water Conference; Mar de! Plata,              March-27 April 1979).
> Argentina ; 14-25 March 1977.                                Reps. : Dr. Victor de Araujo, Dr. Will . C. van den
> Rep .: Mr. Carlos Talenti.                                   Hoonaard, Dr. Marco G. Kappenberger, Mrs. Mahshid
> 3. United Nations Conference on Desertification;                Fatio, Mr. Stephen Vickers .
> Nairobi, Kenya ; 29 August-9 September 1977.            10. Asia and Pacific Regional Preparatory Meeting for the
> Reps.: Mr. Peter Vuyiya, Mr. Bonaventure Wafula, Dr.         Sixth United Nations Congress on the Prevention of
> H. T. D. Rost, Mrs. Ruth Vuyiya, Dr. Richard St.-            Crime and the Treatment of Offenders; Manila, Philip-
> Barbe Baker (advisor).                                       pines; 15-19 May 1978.
> 4. World Conference to Combat Racism and Racial Dis-            Rep.: Mr. Wilfredo U. Bugia.
> crimination; Geneva, Switzerland; 14-25 August          11. Latin-American Regional Preparatory Meeting for the
> 1978.                                                        Sixth United Nations Congress on the Prevention of
> Reps.: Dr. Marco G. Kappenberger, Mr. Peter Vuyiya,          Crime and the Treatment of Offenders; San Jose, Costa
> Mrs. Soo Fouts, Miss Jyoti Munsiff.                          Rica; 31 July-4 August 1978.
> 5. United Nations Conference on Technical Co-operation          Rep.: Mr. Wallace D . Baldwin.
> among Developing Countries; Buenos Aires, Argen-        12. Regional Conference on the Implementation of
> tina; 30 August-12 September 1978.                           National, Regional, and World Plans of Action for the
> Rep.: Professor Ricardo Schvartzman.                         Integration of Women in Development; Nouakchott,
> 6. International Conference on Primary Health Care;             Mauritania; 27 September-2 October 1977.
> Alma Ata, U.S.S.R.; 6-l:l September 1978.                    Reps.: Mrs. Thelma Khelghati, Mrs. Laura Hill.
> Reps.: Dr. Alfred K. Neumann, Miss Anneliese Bopp.      13 . United Nations Seminar on the 'Participation of
> 7. Tenth Special Session of the United Nations General          Women in Political, Economic, and Social Develop-
> Assembly Devoted to Disarmament; New York, USA;              ment, with Special Emphasis on Machinery to Acceler-
> 23 May-28 June 1978.                                         ate the Integration of Women in Development'; Kath-
> Reps.: Dr. Victor de Araujo, Dr. Will . C. van den           mandu, Nepal; 15-22 February 1977.
> Hoonaard, Mrs . Mary Sawicki, Mrs. Betty de Araujo.          Reps.: Mrs. Zena Sorabjee, Dr. Penelope Walker.
> 8. Third Conference on Urban and Regional Research,        14. United Nations Seminar on 'National and Local Institu-
> European Economic Commission; Warsaw, Poland;                tions for the Promotion and Protection of Human
> 5-13 May 1976.                                               Rights'; Geneva, Switzerland; 18-29 September 1978.
> Rep .: Mr. Hans-Ulrich Schmidt.                              Rep. : Mr. James C. Taylor.
> 
> ANNEX II
> 
> STATEMENTS, REPORTS AND OTHER PUBLICATIONS PRESENTED BY
> THE BAHA'f INTERNATIONAL COMMUNITY TO THE UNITED NATIONS
> 1976-1979
> 1. Submission to the UNESCO study on 'The Effect of        3. 'Environmental Activities of the Baha'i International
> Rhodesian Policy on Education, Science, Culture, and       Community for the Years 1975, 1976, and 1977'.
> Information'; 14 May 1976.                                 Report submitted to the United Nations Environment
> 2. Building a Unified Community. Pamphlet prepared for        Program 10 June 1976.
> the United Nations Conference on Human Settlements:     4. 'Baha'i International Community Activities During
> HABITAT ; Vancouver, Canada; 31 May-11 June                International Women's Year: An Overview'. Report
> 1976.                                                      submitted to the United Nations Branch for the Promo-
> 244                                            THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> tion of the Equality of Men and Women; 15 June 1976.      15. Report submitted to the Committee on Non-
> 5. 'The United Nations Decade for Women's Equality,              governmental Organizations of the United Nations
> Development, and Peace, 1976-1985: Implementation             Economic and Social Council on activities of the Baha'i
> of the Declaration on the Elimination of Discrimination       International Community during the period May 1973
> Against Women'. Statement submitted to the twenty-            through     September        1977;    U.N.      document
> sixth session of the United Nations Commission on the         E/C.2/R.49/Add.70; 21November1977 .
> Status of Women; U .N. document E/CN.6/NG0/264;           16. Statement to the twenty-seventh session of the United
> 15 September 1976.                                            Nations Commission on the Status of Women; U.N.
> 6. 'Participation of the Baha'ilnternational Community in        document E/CN.6/NG0/279; 17 March 1978.
> the "Implementation of the Program for the Decade         17. 'The Promise of Disarmament and Peace'. Statement to
> for Action to Combat Racism and Racial Discrimina-            the tenth special session of the United Nations General
> tion": Report to the United Nations Division of Human         Assembly devoted to disarmament; 23 May-28 June
> Rights' . December 1976.                                      1978.
> 7. Report submitted to the United Nations Division of        18. Statement to the World Conference to Combat Racism
> Narcotic Drugs; 23 December 1976. Circulated before           and Racial Discrimination; Geneva, Switzerland;
> the twenty-seventh session of the United Nations              14-25 August 1978.
> Commission on Narcotic Drugs as U.N. document             19. 'An Overview of Baha'i-U.N. Activities During 1977
> E/CN.7/599/Add.l; 13 January 1977.                            Sponsored by the Baha'i International Community and
> 8. 'Survey of United Nations Day and Human Rights Day            Its National Affiliates' . Report submitted to the United
> Activities in 1974 Undertaken by the Baha'i Interna-          Nations Department of Economic and Social Affairs,
> tional Community'. Report submitted to the United             the Office of Public Information, and the Division of
> Nations Office of Public Information; January 1977.           Human Rights; 15 August 1978.
> 9. 'United Nations and Human Rights Observances and          20. 'Technical and Operational Aspects of Primary Health
> Activities Undertaken by Worldwide Baha'i Com-                Care'. Statement to the International Conference on
> munities, 1975'. Report submitted to the United               Primary Health Care; Alma Ata, USSR; 6-12 Sep-
> Nations Office of Public Information; 15 February             tember 1978.
> 1977.                                                     21. Statement to the United Nations Seminar on National
> 10. Statement to the United Nations Regional Seminar on           and Local Institutions for the Promotion and Protection
> the Participation of Women in Economic, Social, and           of Human Rights; Geneva, Switzerland; 18-29 Sep-
> Political Development with Special Emphasis on                tember 1978.
> Machinery to Accelerate the Integration of Women in       22. 'The Baha'is'. United Nations Secretariat News, 31
> Development; Kathmandu, Nepal; 15-22 February                 October 1978, pp. 6 & 7.
> 1977.                                                     23. 'Views of the Baha'i International Community on the
> 11. 'Global Cooperation and the Environment'. Paper pre-          Draft Declaration on the Elimination of All Forms of
> sented at the International Assembly of Non-                  Intolerance and of Discrimination Based on Religion or
> governmental Organizations Concerned with the Envi-           Belief. Statement submitted to the United Nations
> ronment; Nairobi, Kenya; 7-8 May 1977.                        Division of Human Rights; 10 November 1978.
> 12. Statement to the United Nations Regional Conference       24. 'Report of the Baha'i International Community on Its
> on the Implementation of National, Regional, and              Activities in the Prevention of Drug Abuse' . Report
> World Plans of Action for the Integration of Women in         submitted to the United Nations Division of Narcotic
> Development; Nouakchott, Mauritania; 27 Sep-                  Drugs; 10 November 1978.
> tember-2 October 1977.                                    25. Statement to the twenty-eighth session of the United
> 13. 'A Summary of Baha'i- U.N. Activities During 1976             Nations Commission on Narcotic Drugs; 12-23 Febru-
> Sponsored by National Affiliates of the Baha'i Interna-       ary 1979.
> tional Community'. Report submitted to the United         26. 'Reply of the Baha'i International Community to the
> Nations Department of Economic and Social Affairs,            Questionnaire on Implementation During the Period
> the Office of Public Information, and the Division of         1975- 1978 of the World Plan of Action Adopted at the
> Human Rights; 15 October 1977.                                World Conference of the International Women's Year';
> 14. 'Environment and Development and Environmental                submitted to the United Na lions Branch for the
> Management'. Report submitted to the United Nations           Advancement of Women; 4 April 1979.
> Environment Program; 17 October 1977.
> 
> ANNEX III
> 
> RELATIONSHIP OF THE BAHA'I INTERNATIONAL COMMUNITY
> TO THE SOUTH PACIFIC COMMISSION
> 
> The Baha'i International Community participated in the      South West Pacific Ocean, presented both a written and an
> eighteenth South Pacific Conference, in Noumea, New           oral statement to the Conference, outlining the Baha'i view
> Caledonia, 6- 13 October 1978. This was the yearly meeting    on 'Practical Spiritual Bases for Development'.
> of the South Pacific Commission, an intergovernmental            This first Bahli'i participation in the activities of this Pabody established to promote the economic and social wel-      cific body resulted in a later invitation to the Baha'i Internafare and advancement of the peoples of the twenty South       tional Community to attend a regional meeting of the South
> Pacific island countries and territories within its zone of   Pacific Commission, also held in Noumea, in March 1979, to
> action.                                                       discuss further a Pacific approach to rural development.
> The Baha'i International Community, which was rep-         Again, the Bahli'f views were ably shared, this time by Mrs.
> resented by Dr. Victor de Araujo and Mr. Ta Makirere, with    Tinai Hancock.
> the assistance of the National Spiritual Assembly of the
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                  245
> 
> A United Nations Day display sponsored by the Bahti'fs of Moen, Truk Islands (an island
> group in the central Caroline Islands, West Pacific Ocean.) The display was mounted in
> December I976.
> 
> Health educatur Nancy B. Mondschein, right, alternate representative at UN headquarters
> for the National Spiritual Assembly ofthe Bahti'{s ofthe United States, an affiliate ofthe Bahti'{
> International Community, works as an interne at UNICEF headquarters for Mrs T. Memet
> Tanumidjaja, UNICEF Senior Advisor Family Welfare, shown on left, who is preparing a
> study on the use of day care centres as a means of extending UNICEF basic services to rural
> communities.
> 246                                THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Governor George R. Ariyoshi of Hawaii signing the document proclaiming 18 September
> 1977 as World Peace Day, an observance sponsored annually by the National Spiritual
> 
> --
> Assembly of the Baha'(s ofthe Hawaiian Islands. Observing are (right) Miss Lani Tamanaha
> and (left) Mr. Tracy Hamilton.
> 
> BAHA'I
> CENTRE
> 
> Baha'{s who participated in the dedication of the local {lar.fratu'l-Quds, Annandale, Demerara, Guyana; 27 June 1976.
> VI
> RECOGNITION OF THE BAHA'I FAITH
> 
> 1. INCORPORATION OF NATIONAL SPIRITUAL
> ASSEMBLIES
> 
> Ritjvan 1976 to Ri<f,van 1979
> 
> In previous volumes, certificates of incorporation or other documents attesting
> recognition of various National Spiritual Assemblies have been reproduced.
> The following are representative of the forms of recognition obtained by
> National Spiritual Assemblies during the period covered by this volume.
> 
> 1. Certificate of Incorporation in American Samoa of the National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Baha'is of Samoa; 23 April 1976 . (This National Spiritual Assembly was incorporated in
> Western Samoa on 4 February 1971.)
> 2. Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of South and
> West Africa; 13 August 1976.
> 3. Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Bahfis of Singapore; 4
> October 1976.
> 4. Act of Parliament incorporating the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Guyana,
> passed on 9 December 1976.
> 5. Receipt for Declaration of Association of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of
> Gabon, issued by Ministry of the Interior; 8 April 1977.
> 6. Letter from the Ministry of Justice and Ecclesiastical Affairs confirming registration of the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Iceland as a religious society in Iceland, 29
> April 1977, with translation into English.
> 7. Certificate of Registration of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Suriname and
> French Guiana; 16 January 1978.
> 8. Extract from the Official Journal of New Caledonia for 3 November 1978, relating to the
> Declaration of Association of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of the New
> Hebrides, giving date of receipt issued 19 October 1978.
> 9. Extract from the Official Journal of the French Republic relating to the registration of the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the French Antilles; 5 January 1979.
> 10. Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Caroline Islands; 29
> January 1979.
> 11. Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Mariana Islands; 2
> April 1979.
> 
> 248                                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> GOY£RNM£NT OF AME.RICAN SAMOA
> PACO PAGO,_AM.£RlCAN SAMOA N1"
> ....... ...., ...
> ~· .156
> 
> CBRTIFIC~TE                                      O~   INCORPORATION
> 
> TO ALL '1'0 WHOM THESE PRESENTS SHALL COME 1
> 
> :r, WALTER H. JENSEN, Treasurer ot the Government of
> Allierican SlllllO&', do hereby certify that the NATIONAL
> SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY OF THE BAHA'IS OF SAMOA, INC., havinq
> fulfilled all requ.i rements of Tit:.e XIV, Section 52
> American Samoa Code and havinq bean 'found to be duly
> qualified and duly autho,:ized llC~rding to the law• of the
> Covernll8Dt of American Samoa i• here~y granted a Certificate
> of Incorporation to exist fifty years until dia•olved or
> . ..rved in accorc!ance with the lava of the Government of
> 
> ..Allerioan Samoa •
> '.l'be Article• of Incorporation ·of .t he tlATJ:ONAL SPIRITUAL
> AS811MBLY .OP TD BABA'IS OP SAMOA, INC., haw been recorded
> on VolU- It, -paqe 221•225 in the Office of Territorial
> R1e9.latru.
> 
> June 1, 1976
> Certified to be a true an:! correct copy of ~he ori~l
> in the possession of the national. Spiritua'.l ''issernbly or
> . t~ Baha'1s of samoa, , Ine.          -            ""'-.,
> JJJ.wt P.M:.rc " ·                              '·                '
> fllY comn1ssioo expires: 12/31!76
> 
> •   ~   : :   ·   .   4   .~   •
> 
> 1. Certificate of Incorporation in American Samoa of the National Spiritual
> Assembly of the Baha'{s of Samoa; 23 April 1976. (This National Spiritual
> Assembly was incorporated in Western Samoa on 4 February 1971.)
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                       249
> 
> '1 .
> FORM CM 3
> REPUBLIC OP SOUTH AFRICA
> COMPANIES ACr, 1973
> (Section 64)
> 
> Registration No. of company
> 21/7t>/zo
> 
> CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION OF A COMPANY
> NOT HAVING A SHARE CAPITAL
> 
> This is to certify that     THE NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY OF
> THE BAllA'IS OF SOUTH AND WEST AFRICA (Incorporated association
> not for gain) was today incorporated under the Companies Act,
> 61 of 1973, and that the company is a company lim~ted by
> guarantee and is incorporated under section 21 •
> 
> Signed and sealed at Pretoria this /°3
> .   4 day of A';/'" ~ I.
> one thousand nine hundred and seventy-six.
> 
> _#~·~·
> ~~-<---
> '11 R~istrar of Companies
> 
> 'Thie certificate is not valid 11nles11 it bears the seal of the
> Companies Registration Office
> 
> 2. Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Bahti'(s of
> South and West Africa; 13 August 1976.
> 250                                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> ...
> ft& IPJIHUAL . . . . . .? OI' 111 Ml&'IS U
> Tbis.lsto~lfytllel ................... . ..... .. ............ ...................................................... .
> 
> lllO&l'OU LTD. - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
> .,............................................................................................................................... .
> 
> il.•_,,._ ... .!t~!L. .. llayof ········ 0..ff.Mt .....,............ 19.1'~ ..,.._, ...... .
> ~
> • .......
> Acl.c.. '"· ....... Ille........., .........              UuW ~ Cear..,..
> ..................................................... ..
> 
> o.......,., ....... 1111. • ...............:!!!!!!!U!!!.................. *' ..t ........ *' ti1
> .....................~................... ~ ··~~        .                I
> 
> '   .
> 
> ·/atdud/r..A>
> {11.. ~ CllM)
> ....,~···· ~·;;;«:;~:··· ··
> 
> 3. Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'(s of
> Singapore; 4 October 1976.
> 
> •                                                        =
> '':· 1971) NATIONAL SPIRITUAi, :-::~~;:~ _o~· BAllA'IS                    (No. a
> 
> i:c:::,nofi~:~~i-:,,:..~t11e"T..:!.°.i~
> AasembJy of Baha'is in Guyana.
> GUYANA                                                  .       4. There shall not be at 1ny Ume more than niDe Tnuteu ~::.~""
> z
> ...,
> ACT No. 16 of 11176                                           :~ ~~;1~~~eof=: °!r!~~ .:~~::~ ~~
> act 11 llUdl. all or any of tbe powen conferNd bf 11111 Ad on .~,.                      tr1
> NATIONAL SPl1lITUA.L ASSEMBLY or BAHA.'U                                           the Trwlt- may be uen:lllod by tbe san!Wle or _ , 'N•-                                  :>:)
> OP' GUYANA (INCORPORATION OF TRUSTZF.8) ACT 11176                                      Trustees proyided always that their number ii not Jeu lllaa fin.                        z
> 5. All pn>pcrty movable or immovable of wb.atenr ~ 1~~ ~                            ...,>
> 1 -.
> 
> A. CHUNG.
> or kind hereafter bequeathed by will or - l i e P.. to lhe ,.. •-...
> Assembly shall be deeme<I to be the property of the Board.
> 6.' All property Yested In or herc>fter acquired by the : ;,"
> -z
> PJ'elidsll                                                                                                             >
> SJIJCTION
> ARRANGEMENT OF SECTIONS
> 30lh °""""'ber. 1976.
> Board shall be held by the '5oard for the ue and benefit of the ::,:.;••
> Assembly.                                                                 ..,.
> ''"' ",.,..
> 
> 7. 1n 111111111.en aat llp9dflclliJ proritlo4 fCll" 11J M Ad.::-:::..
> r
> [/)
> 
> c::
> :>:)
> 1.       Sbort UUe.                                                                    tho .8olnl ..... II) , . JI pl-adicllbll, , , _ . . . . . . . tlle .. -
> 2.       laterpntatlon.
> like power -    llllbarlly .. - !IC-' -           .-dloltl "' 1119 i:.r=
> <
> tr1
> 3.       lncorpontloa of 1be Boud of. Troll-.                                          AUemblJ and lta p.......iJngl sir.all be . . . . - "' ... law, -
> reguJaUo111, powen IDd inctlcet ol lbll botl1 Ill 11> ts • lbtlr ~                      ~
> '·
> 5.
> Deolh or - . . , . frocn Guyana of member or the Board or
> Tra-
> VOllU.ng of property in the Board.
> •~ not lncoasistelll wilb any la• In faroe ID Gu-.                  ""' w.               0
> 'r1
> 6.       T8Dlll'e of propertv for use and benefit of the Assembly.                             8.    A ala1-I that any -        nlll*i lhenlD llM 1 - . _                       ()
> 7.       Esercise by Board· or powers in matters not specifically pro                      appoint.cl a member of the Boanl ol TruoteM, purpoctlna to be ::,,."':""'"
> -.lded for by tbia Act.                                                           &igned by the Cba!Jman of the Asaemb!J, or ti. ~ of tllo ,.. -                       c::
> 8.       Evidence o! membership of tbe Board.                                              Assembly. shall be prtma fade evidence of tbe 1114 hcl                               :>:)
> 9.       Service of proecu.                                                                                                                                                     :>:)
> 9. All proau wblcb II required to be .-"'1 oo th Boor<' -                       tr1
> shall be deemed to be sufficiently served if served on a pers.111 :!-.,...           z
> ...,
> AN ACT to Incorporate Ille Boa.rd of Trustee& of tho Nallonal
> Spiritual Assembly O( Baha'is.                                                   ~:~b:t;,'!,,°:~~~.::.of~~ :r..,i::                                                   tll
> lhereo! is publbbed In the Gazette.
> >.1•-ltff-        Enacted by Ille Parliament of Guyana:-                                                                                                                                   >
> :i::
> ''"'
> mtt
> !. nu. Ac! may be cited as the National Spiritual !U&embly
> o( Baha'is of Guyana UneorporoUon of Truatees) Act 1976.
> >
> ..;;.
> lt1te.rpr.-utlitn.
> 2.   ln this Act ut'\less the context otherwise requires -                                                                                                          >
> "lbe Board of ·r~" or "lbe Boanl" me&111 the Board                                      f'o ~s,.d   f>y the National Autmbl~ OH 9th Dfc~mber. 1918
> ...,
> ()
> of Trustees of the National Spiritual .Assembly of
> Baha'is of. Guyana incorporated by thia Act;
> .<-
> " the Asseml>ly" means the National Spiritual Assembly
> of Baha'is in Guyana.                                                                                                                       F. A, Nararn.
> 3 tr1
> ln.«lt•               3.  Henl) Dolphm. Chairman, .John \'tera , V1ce-Cha1m1an,                                                                      Clerli: of tho National A..emblJ        [/)
> pOt•UOI~
> •t     the      r;ue11 Widm'!r. Se1.:rt!la r} , 1-:i tccn Hilt Treasurer . She lla 1.>olphh~.
> llo..:it"d  uf   Hcc-ording Sccn..'tar~ l\•an l-' raser. Meml>er. Lygia Vasild..i. Mcm·
> 11•ltn
> Iler, Edward Widmor . Member. Rooplall Dudnath, Member, and
> (Bill    18/11179).
> 
> N
> UI
> .......
> 4. Act of Parliament incorporating the National Spiritual Assembly of the Bah<i.'(s of Guyana, passed on 9 December 1976.
> N
> llHflSTEkC DC L'lNTC!il CUR                        RE;.. ueL1nuc - c .·, soN.. ISE                                                                                                               VI
> lklion - TtavaU - lu•tlc•                                                                                                                      N
> OlflCCTION GCN(u .. L[ or
> l 1 DCtlflSTll l. TION OU Tt. ;n norac                                                                                                    -   2    -
> OIRCCTION oC Ll ,.OIIHISTllttTl ON
> CCNCRJ,Lt
> Fr)CCCPISSC                                                      J!'S5:u :!"ft~~m) >~a!f\,;.r!:f1!r!t:!~ i:'~::!i~~=M4::1:•::::~1.
> cation• Orticioll•• pour rrete d'ln. . rtion eu )Or.Ind cttle&.l pl\1'9 .cflat
> da IO nU.Sro• dU lourMl, proda•votttal do 1•.:.aaom1'e ConaUtual'lte.
> t~·     IQ6         /•1/ocr.T/Oi'.G.-       Do Odclerotion d 'liHOcietlon
> ( Loi n• 35/62 du IO Odcallbn 1911 )                                        Cana .le d'1d dO trah •'-• le cNolanUon ht .. l'lt l 1objat d'°'
> pr••unt R6cdph .. dClvu ~he nMue publiqw d•n• le• fo,..• flt""~• O
> t•r,rtlcla IO do h Lol du to Olcallbn 1912.     ·
> LE IINISTRC OE L 1 INT£Al[Ufl DU Ci.BON
> Touto M>d1'1oot1on epportff awr $htute et tau• Oheft949Cntl •wt•
> donno ou.: peuonnaa ci-aprbe dddQn4•• R•o6pia•d da                                    vonua don• 1 1 ,,d•inhtrctton de le Oheotlon de l' Hootcitlan dovant Gtr.
> o•claration d'h.HOciation ddfinia co tit'l9 auit I                                    dticlorh dona un dt\lal d•un •la ot -.ntloftMa, en outn 1ur un l'foht.rr.
> tcnu au aibQt. da 1.odito .. •aoctotion.
> 
> TITRE Q[ l' i'. SSOCF.TION : • f1 SSCQBLEE SPIRITUELLE N.·.noNoiLC ocs 8AHl. 1 l5 •                          Co rdglatr-a dcere etrc prbontd, aur L:ur d.. -..tc:, ::ux ;.utorH ... •
> "d•inhtrativa. ou lud1c1o1roa./..
> .ru!l1I. ' Ell• • pour but 1
> - d' a n•dgnor le• principoa da la futarnltd 1 d• l 1 A.aur dOelntd ..                                                       rcit • Llbrov1Uo; l o I +lwr.U 1977
> res .. dont Porlant tou• lu proph?: teai                                                                                             P. L: tinhtra de 1 1 Jntdrtour
> .. de Qdror lea affaitoa at biene de le Co-.inoutd 8ah•'l du Gotlon,                                                               Lt. SGcrdtairo d'Ctot
> o n r•apoctent l o• principea du •y•ttib• adainiatr•tif •t•bl.1 par Bah•·u•                                                                                           -~                ....j
> Ll ti hi                                                                                                                                                                                ::i:
> - d '•ffaotuer tout• tran•action aobUttn at 1..obilttre, ecqufrir                                                                Jo11n.. c..,run ca.NC :,v;.••                tI1
> ou con•trulu do• centre• Baha'i•, te1111plaa , bibliothtquee, d1apanaalra• 1                                                                                                            O:I
> o tc • ••
> - d'orgeniaor doa activit4• divare•a f) car1cttra dducatit at hu--
> >
> nitciro on roapoctant acrupulauaoi;L;nt lea loh du paya, ot pro•uvoir                                                                                                                  ::i:
> par tou • lea moyono l o t:ut Baha 1 i,                                                                                                                                                >
> ~
> s1rcr seq ,L i LISUCVILLE ( Quo:tior li'IOnt-eoultt )
> ~
> ''°l!!S q PnENOms 1 Proeouion o t do111ic1lc de • dld111anta octu.lloeont chor-                                                                                                        0
> !)d• do 1 1 r,d•iniahotlon vt d;. lo Oiroction du l' r... ooiction c                                                                                                                   :i:i
> U. -20£ COY Jilromc, Cnbonah                                                                                                                                            r
> tnaUtutaur, soua-Oiruot uur                                                                                                                                         0
> Gdnd rol £n•oigno•ante acoloirca ,
> Liniv ur•itclroe ut de · lo Pddagogi~••••••••••• Prdeldont
> - or . lll<lvTJ..ca tSllIOL, rr n n~nla ·
> llddccin, Pol't - Gent1 1 •••• • •• •••••••••• ••••• , • Vicc-Pr6aie!unt!
> 
> -IOUU£lE Joooph, Gobanaie
> H6pitol G6ndral •••• • •••• • •••••• , • , ••• • •. • • ... Sacrdt'3irt;
> I
> -Bornord IGllC, Nigdrlnn
> Artieen de: •ublo
> OP 14.140 •••• •• , ••••• •. ,, •••••• ·••• ••• ••••••• Tr4aorior
> 
> t• r,a a ocietion aura nouf 1:tcurlhr1; e, l u a oinq aut-roe llO•brua aoront d( -
> e1Qnd• t.prb • le ror1110tlon do 1',; ••oc:iation •
> 
> ..... I .....
> 
> 5. Receipt for Declaration of Association of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Gabon, issued by Ministry of the
> Interior; 8 April 1977.
> < -r, • ''~la t                                 t• ,, •
> t'A.. 't   "I '·.),. nC" '--": ··~   f' )
> 
> OOMS. OC KIRl<IUMALAnADUNEYTID
> JU.nietry ot .Juatioe
> Ro;ltjovik.       29 . april 1977 •
> u4 looeleeiaaUoal l..t.t&in
> 
> 11M/llll                                                                            Re.rlt~aYik,   29tb April, 1977.
> 
> W1tb A letter, dated hb. l8tb, 1977, 7ou, Mr. evpr•e oo"" law;rer,
> 
> Meo br8r1, Os.gs. 18 . tebrUar sl., hat'10 }>Or, berra
> haT• requested on Mbalt ot tbe •a·U onaJ. Sp1r1 tul uat.bl.r ot the
> Bahl:ie ot Icolu4, that tho Ml1s1auo eacl•t.r at th• Bah.f:i la.1.ih 1A
> ..,z
> tTl
> h!ll6tat'6ttarUSgmaOur .. loitaO i>ese tyr1r h6nd Andlege J>j60N0a                 I celand be reg1etered u & Mligioue eoc1ety o\tt114t the ht.ion.al Cburob,                      :>;)
> Fla.ha ' 1a a 1:alant11, ao trU.t6lag Bahai-trUarinnar a Ialandi                   aa &llaw4 tor b.r 12.-13. article• at laws nr. l,8 1975 about r.lisJ.a119                      z
> verOl skriO sem trUt61ag utan ~366k1r)<Junnar ll4llli<:Vml>t he11111ld             aoo1et1e1. Vi th thia application wa• 1nclu4t4 1.n.to~t1on. about '11•                         ..,>
> 12.-1,, greinar laga. nr . 18 1975, um trUr6HSg . Ums6la":. f>esnri
> fylgd u jafnframt uppl$singar um l>au atr101,. sem tal1n eru i
> 1). gre1n lapnna, 1.-9. tHluliO.. R4.0uneyt10 staorest1l' h6r              1   I
> 1teu, that are nuabend 1D th• 13. &rtiole ot "\he•• law9, pa,racraphe
> 1 ... 9. !he IU.niatry bereb7 con.til'll9, that tbe religiou• aooi•V of tbe
> .Baht •1 h1 th ll Icelan4 1e accepted tor rep.etrat1on u & rel1&1oue
> -
> z
> me6 , aO trUf6lag Bahai-trUarinnar d. :t:elandi er viOurkennt                      eooiet7 1n Iceland, &eoordill& to II . HO"tion ot lava nr. l8 1975, coai-                      >
> r
> t11 s krAningar sem trUrOlag & !sland.1, akv. II. knt'la. laga                     paring tbe I. section of tbe lave, ua an ann.oua.oeMnt about tbie                              Cll
> nr. 18 1975, a br. I. kafla laganna, og mun auglYsing um t>'                     aooeptan.ce will be publlahe4 in the •at1onal Quette.                                          c:>;)
> v10urkenningu veroa birt i LlSgb1rt1ngabla01nu.                                       1!he MJ..niatry at the aaae time con.tirae, that it b&9 reoeiTed • notioe
> Jafnframt staOte.et1r r60uneyt10, ao riao hefur teklO v10                 about the election ot Oarl John Spencer, LJ"n&hac• 22, Re1ltl&Yfk, &e the                      <
> tTl
> . t1lkynn1ngu um kjHr Carl John Spenoer, Lyngh.age. 22, Reykjavik,                 lepl. opoke....,, at tbe Spiri tu&l .leH•bl.r ot ll&h&' ie 1A Reyk~a..ilc. Bo                  -<
> .sem !'orstOOumanns Mine And.legs. R&os · Baha 'ia 1 Reykjavik . Ber             1• obllpd to u.nderaign the declaration, that 1a inolucled bereb)' •                           0..,,
> honum aO und1rr1te. yf1r1Ys1ngu }>6.. eem her meO fylgir.                              !he Min1etry dn.we attent1on to the tact, ac) the lepl apolr:••• 4o••
> RdOuneyt10 vekur athygli A pv1 1 aO for e t HOWne.OUrinn                  not :tul.l.till the oonditione ot l. paracrapb, 17. utiole ot lave nr.                        ()
> 
> .tulln:ngir e kk1 skUyrOum L td.lsgr. 17 . gr. laga nr. 18/1975                   18/ 1975 , u reguda Icelandic c1Useub1p, but co.n.a1d.m it allowable                           c
> :>;)
> aO }'.Iv! er va r6ar i s lenz.l«l rikisborgararlitt. en tE>lur he1m1lt            to accept hilD ~a legal 1pokee:aan tor tbe ti.a• beiq, w1 tb reterenoe to                      :>;)
> at'J v10urkenna hann sem forstHOUmann aO svo ettsddu. meO hl10-                  tbe proY1eion t or exe•ption b-oa the ordinancee of tbe '5. art1ol• o'f                       tTl
> sj6n a f undanJ:>ti.gube1m1ld rn &kvMOum ,. greinar laga nr . '8
> 1954 .
> lava nr. '8 1954.
> !be Mi:n1atey f1nal.ly oon.ti:ma, 'that it ha.I noe1Ted a notice about
> ..,z
> the mt:11ber ehip of the board ot the Rational Spiritual. Aeeembl7 and 1te                    Ol
> RAOune;vt10 staOfoatir loks. aO l>aO hefur tek10 v10 tilkynn l n gu um s k1pa.n a tj6rnar bins Andlega ~j60r0.0s og e1nsta'krt.
> various depa.rtaent1.                                                  ·                      >
> On be halt or the Minietry,
> :r
> dt>ilda Pesa .
> .l l&ldur ffijller ( a1gn . )
> »
> ~                                                                       1'orldtu.r Pile eon ( •ign.)
> ~                ~
> P. h. r.
> >
> -..,..,<
> ()
> 
> Hr . hrl. HjHrtur Torfason
> VesturgHtu 17
> /1~~
> rn
> Reykjavik .                                  <                                                                                                                                 Cll
> 
> N
> 6. Letter from the Ministry of Justice and Ecclesiastical Affairs confirmin g registration of the National Spiritual Assem bly of th e                                                        Ul
> Baha'[s of Iceland as a religious society in Iceland, 2 9 A pril 1977, with translation into E nglish.                                                                        w
> 254                                       THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> E.T •
> .MINISTERIE VAN JUSTITIE
> EN POLITIE
> 
> ...,
> ~   n:
> · et Beetuur van de Stichd ng GBESTELIJKE RAAD VAN
> DE BAl!fl. 1 IS VAN SURINAME
> EN FRANS GUIANA              ·
> Nickerieetraat 27(Z.H.)
> Paramaribo.
> L                                   ...I
> Uw konmetk        Uw brief van      Ons kenmerk            oirum Paramaribo, /,_' januari 197~. l
> 
> Onderwerp:
> 3ericht op form. A
> I 5 :::
> dd. 8 december 1977.
> 
> ,,
> Hierbij heb 1k de eer U mede te delen,
> dat de Stichting GEESTELIJKE RAAD VAN DE
> BAHA 1 IS VAN Su:l.INAME EN FRANS GUIANA., gevestigd te Paramaribo,op 10 december 1977 in•
> · het Openbaar Stichtingenregiater is ingeschreven.
> 
> De Minister van Justitie en Politie,
> 
> 7. Certificate of Registration of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'{s of
> Suriname and French Guiana; 16 January 1978.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                         255
> 
> DECURA TION D'ASSOCIA TION
> Titre : ASSEMBLEE SPIRITUELLE HATIOHALE
> DES BAHA'IS DES HOUVELLES-HEBRIDES
> '
> Obj et : Diriger les acti vites baha 'ies de fa region
> pour arriver, parallelement aux activites des aucres
> Assemblees spirituelles nationales du monde, a eta·
> blir la Paix universelle par la realisation de l' unite.
> spirituelle et sociale du genre humain.
> Siege social : Centre Baha'i, Anabrou, Port-Vila.
> Comite responsable :
> President             · M. Kalman KIRI
> Vice-President           M. Jean-Marie SABLAN
> Secretairc               M. Qu~rles PIERCE ·
> Tresorier                M. Philip BEATTIE
> Recepisse declaratif no 96 CH/ AP du 19 .octobre 1978.
> 
> 8. Extract from the Official Journal of New Caledonia for 3 November 1978,
> relating to the Declaration of Association of the National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Baha'fs of the New Hebrides, giving date of receipt issued 19 October 1978.
> 
> 5 janvler 19i!l. Declaration a la sous-prefecture de Pointc·it·Pitre.
> 'Auemblee spirituel!e des Baha'is des Antille.s fran~aises. Ol>jct : pro·
> · pagation de~ principes ct'amour du genre humain, di! paix uni·
> Vf'rselle et de fralcrnitc dont p;irlent tou~ Jes prophetcs, princ:ipcs
> qui ont recu un rt'!'loun•au d'C>1wn!ic creatrice d:;ns !cs en~ei g ne­
> mcnts revc!cs par GahiA'u '!l.i h, eXf)fiqucs par Ab:i'ul' 13ahit N par
> Shogh1 Effendi et elargis ct mis en app!iC'alion par l;i .\Iaison unh·craelle de ju-;tire. l'organc supreme clc la foi Baha'i. Si~ge social:
> 48, rue fo'rani,;ois·Arago, 97110 Pointe-a-Pitre.
> 
> 9. Extract from the Official Journal of the French Republic relating to the registration of the National Spiritual Assembly of the French Antilles; 5 January 1979.
> 256                                        THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> ..._&rifit €orporation Qadir
> . .
> By nr- ol the ·~~rity            "'!""Ii '" the fflcb~c-a.~111
> ~ Tnaat Territon
> .   .of the Pacltlc bind•,
> .      .by Tide                 n; ....._ 1, 1',..t
> Terrtlory Code; Autborblnt lnuance oC a corporate~                       tie•-
>       .
> ciatiqA Of P«~On• (Or &ny lawful P\lrflOH other . dlu ~                         ,...t,
> Nllfl'lCIW. llPIK1'1UllL A9SBMllr.Y at ._ ~·fs ar 'lllB CID.DB - . - ;· 1• 1 •
> 
> i• ht<reby c911etltuted a non-ptoortt bocty corporate, ""b,.ct tj) the prori•'-
> 
> of th•• · charter, .the Article• of Incorpqr&t!on and By-Lawe of the oorpo•
> 
> ration filed with the Registrnr of Cor porn-~ ons, and to the lawl! of die Tnaat·
> 
> Territory.
> 
> .     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this chute r I• grant.eel to~~~
> at 'DlE BNJ/.•:6J at '1'11! CARlLINE l'.SLllNtS'
> .
> IHXJRFa!ATED----------
> provided, however, that this Charter, the Article• o(
> 
> Incorporation and the By-Lawe o! the corporation, ahall be eubject to
> 
> a mendment. auapen•ion, or revocation 'by any future law. procla.matioa,
> 
> regulation or apeclaL order of the H1 gh Cornmi~oioner applicable thereto
> 
> having the force of law.
> 
> Clven under my hand and ,seal of my, o!!ice thla          ;(.t/!/t!     day
> 
> o!~~~~-J-t~~-·iz.~~-·(_J~.·~;_·~~~~
> i.
> 
> Jli;lrian P. Wi.n.'<el
> 1'
> ~s ~5r~t~V of the Pacific I1lands                I
> 
> {SEAL)
> 
> JO. Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Caroline
> Islands; 2 9 January 1979.
> .,.,.,_" ..   _... .....
> pQRA'TlON. CERTfFte'.4 h
> ,         x                      -
> ...,z
> tT1
> :;o
> z
> ~co~                         .                        . c                      ...,>
> ~is is to anq          II.I""' .r#.litt/H 1 .f~--. {
> NATiaw. fl>Dll'lUAL AEISlllU
> z
> >
> r
> of tbe           .                            Vl
> 
> I<,,., I,,. ti.II~'!§,~,,~~,~ ~....Ju Jt!!!.. i1t /J,1                                        c
> :;o
> '~'"''"J •(.#,Pd,. </ J,.,..7-,."'" ;,. ""' q)~~ </{ft....,.. -' :;-_,,,._ ~........          <
> tT1
> -<
> Mell/   cf ~NONI.                                                                             0
> 'T1
> t)',n;,.. J0-30 A !lf9'-.. .~+ :f.-_ . .,, Jpril 2                          . /.9~'.      n
> 
> ti. l"s.~J "f"'"f »id .Jll~ { f~-'iM •-" Ii.,;,. ---.IM a,,,/
> "'""""'• .... """'' µ"IN """ ,..,fo-1. """"'.._.
> ""' -1'at1mpl   !!pir1t!llJ.
> -1'4      J.U
> A!!lllb1l of the
> c
> :;o
> :;o
> tT1
> .                                              1- of tbe Jlmr1-  ~ Inccrp:n.ted            z...,
> .r' tJ, ,,,,. . H-'       ,.,.
> ,/;;.,.,/-'.
> .,,;,1   sf"""" ., ·"""'~""""'· -' ·~ #r ,......
> '
> *""'J   IXI
> >
> :i:
> /                                                                    >-
> ....:;_
> >
> ...,n
> -
> <
> ...,
> tT1
> Vl
> 
> N
> VI
> 11. Certificate of Incorporation of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Mariana Islands; 2 April 1979.        --.]
> 258                                  THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 2. INCORPORATION OF LOCAL SPIRITUAL
> ASSEMBLIES
> 
> Ri(ivan 1976 to Ri(ivan 1979
> 
> In previous volumes, certificates of incorporation of approximately two
> hundred Local Spiritual Assemblies have been reproduced. More than two
> hundred Local Assemblies achieved incorporation in the period covered by
> this volume. The following documents were selected to illustrate this
> achievement.
> 
> 1. Certificates of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Ufwenuka
> Village, Zambia; 3 May 1976, and the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Mwiika
> Village, Zambia; 3 May 1976.
> 2. Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Perseverance
> Village (Couva), Trinidad and Tobago; 9 July 1976.
> 3. Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Tauranga City,
> New Zealand; 12 July 1976.
> 4. Extracts from Articles of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of
> Willemstad, Cura<;:ao, signed 6 December 1976 by representative of the Central Bureau of
> Juridical and General Affairs.
> 5. Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Portland
> Cottage, Jamaica; 29 September 1977.
> 6. Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Lipan, Papua
> New Guinea; 11 January 1978 .
> 7. Presidential Decree approving By-Laws and conferring Juridical Personality on the Local
> Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Palomita , Paraguay; 3 July 1978.
> 8. Extract from the Official Journal of French Polynesia of 15 July 1978, relating to registration
> of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Tahiti, giving date of receipt issued 22 June
> 1978.
> 9. Extract from the Official Journal of New Caledonia for 1 December 1978, relating to the
> Declaration of Association of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Fila Island, New
> Hebrides, giving date of receipt issued 23 November 1978.
> 10. Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Galway,
> Ireland; 20 February 1979.
> ~   . ..,
> ~ ~~ ~~ /-.L,..c.~.o .
> 
> OJUGI:'L\L                                                                                              r..•1• 1m
> 
> r-                                                       REPUBLIC                        OF ZAMBIA
> .;
> ·•,1
> ....... _, .,....._,....,.Act
> (°"""""""""' ........ _,
> ...
> ''·.•land• God Oo¢d• ffqJ;b1Q Act
> (Chaflk't' ?81 otU""' x..- ofM.mbt.)
> (&etion l 8)
> t                    ~"'
> TtiM~tt..'-11att~...,.u.cw..., .. . .. 2. . . . . . . . . . . . ..                   e.......•,. m 7.l                    ...,z
> Thisilil®lllllllt bu beai duly rq;iatmid •caortling fo law 1.1u. ,. ~ .•. ·• · . . ~ . • . , • • ~ . • •• , to ..?~
> 
> Rt'giUmd, No •.. ,a37 .c.,,.i .. ~...,.Onoolltu1CUU11
> Dutr Paid K ---
> ~!fo..2"'. c....t ... ... I Ul'f7MI~~
> 
> J>uty&klll -~
> F•hld.K 2. 50
> ii]                                            tl'I
> 
> "'z
> ,0076,{ ~
> 2 • .50
> fl /,,- ~I                                              >
> }'(U l'Aid K
> ...... !lo. 92ll'I. ........ ... .i ........ .. t ......~ . ....~. .       .                                              :l
> ••-ft·,(                  /.
> ·"fi~(!,;,~~:~;;;.-
> ~
> Hl'OciJM. No..9coC.. ... 1Wod. •• 2, . . . .. . . .8 ... .                                                                                l"rvrWoot;10 ..u"-*6ot'J.'Woi-otoe. •••• . . •_.,.., • • • •••                                                            0
> l'rmillioulll Ol'rti6ot.to of 'ntlo '-*I oo .•                                                                                            RllOlftaTOJ'UllllDf                                     •• ·· · · -'·· · -·• .. n· ···   .... ... .... .-('..~·"""        z
> R.nilm'\'   o•DUbS                                                                                                                        VclU.4,!hrO.UOOl'Z........                                        ....... tlf"'-"•""11U
> >
> r
> Ltr».U. l\SMlJJUe a- Zuou.
> [Jl
> 
> c:::
> ~
> 
> '                                            REPl!BUC        !I           OP ZA11111A
> "'
> <
> tl'I
> -<
> l. ,:
> REPUBLIC
> 
> OIRTil' ICA!l'E OP IllCORPORATI O!I
> OF ZAMDIA
> ,.,                                         Cllll!IPICAD or lllCOllPlllA'fllll
> !!!!!!!
> 'T1
> (')
> !!l!!l!l!.                                                                                                   TH LAlll> (PllRPlllttJAI. 800Cll8Sllll) Kit                                                         c:::
> t • 't
> 'l'llll LA1!D (Pl!RPl!'?OAI. sUCCBSSIO!I) Am
> •THIS IS TO CERTD'Y t hai t bo Tr ustees at the 'BAltA' IS have been
> TBTS IS TO CIR'l'IP!' that th• TruateH ot the BARA' 18 baT• be.en
> 'reg1atered aa a -corporate boly meter t.he . _ ot ""tRI LOCAL
> "'"'
> tl'I
> r egiater ed aa a corporate b<Xly under the name ot ~ LOCAL
> llPIRITOAL .ABSllll!lLY 0, TUB BABA'IS'Olf llW!W VltI.AOE lll!GISTIIUID                                                         ...,z
> llPIRITOAI. ASSl!N.'BLY Olf 'l'llll !!AHA' IS OF OFVIENUKA VILLAGE llEGIST&REI>
> 1'RUS'l'E!S• in pUl"auanc~ or &.a under- tbe pro~i11ona ot the LAllD
> 'fRUSTZ!S in p urauan.ce or and under tl:le provieione ot the LANI>
> (PZRPETUM. SUCCESSIOll) MJt subject to the conditione and
> (PERPl!TUAt SOCCl!BSIO!I) M:r s ubject to tbe c ondt Uona and                                                                   °'
> >
> directions htti'einatter aet r orth.                                                                                            :i::
> d1rect1oll& her et natter aet rortb.                                                                                         '                                                                                                                                           >
> wn'JO!SS lllJ' hana thto 1 -.d . (. "ll.;YJ)                  d..,. ~Mt.o,                            191,                      >
> (')
> wn'tnlBS llQ' bend tb1s ;,~;,c1)                                            dQ' o~          {"\.,. ~             19.1 b.                                                                                                                                                 ...,
> 
> oiaa s:>lii~'(t.U>.>
> ~ ~,......__                                              ~
> DP.~-;:r.                                                                      -
> <
> ...,
> tl'I
> lllJIIS!BR al l.AllDS, HATtllLl'L l!ESOORc&S
> l'                                                   UlflllrBll 011 LAJID8, J.M:Ui.Al. RESOURCllS                                            [Jl
> 
> .AllD TOUIISll
> All1l TOtlRI SM,
> 
> it
> ::.!-:· -
> N
> Vi
> 1. Certificates ofIncorporation ofthe Local Spiritual Assembly ofthe Bah<i'is of Ufwenuka Village, Zambia; 3 May 1976, and the                                                                                                                                                                 IO
> Local Spiritual Assembly of the Bah<i'is of Mwiika Village, Zambia; 3 May 1976.
> 260                                                       THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> '   J
> '
> ,--
> 
> Tll.INIDAD AND
> 
> Certificate of the Incorporation of a Company
> 
> 31 btrebp Ctrtifp tbat
> 
> ··-·-·----·----·-··-·················---·······················-·····J.~"~ .
> is this day Incorporated under the Companies
> Ordinance, Ch. 31. No. 1, and that the Company
> Is lciJR.!tetb unlimited.,~
> 
> Given under my hand at Port•of-Spaln
> this .......?.~......... day of ..... . .iMJI'...___ ·····-·--···
> one            thousand                 nine       hundred · and
> 3.nmtx.~·-············-·········---··-·········
> 
> ~...t..!1..'o!...1..J.. . . ~. :...Q~_t!.~ .
> 2nd ·Deputy      Ae&letrw.r ot Compa.n i•t
> 
> Registration Fees $ ..:1.9.a.!ML...............
> 
> Stamp Duty
> 
> --
> 2. Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Bahri.'is of
> Perseverance Village (Couva) , Trinidad and Tobago; 9 July 1976.
> J...lllldl.>Wll
> 
> •                                 . ,,   ~-'.1.976!1'•
> ..,z
> DEPARTMENT 01'' Jt:STI• E                                                                  tT1
> .       .
> 11G?   ..,"':i>
> z
> CERT~i;f~A~l~1~t~;~~Rtl;'QN
> '.
> z
> :;,~~      ...:;;..~·~- ·-...:,;..;.:
> :i>
> r
> Vl
> c
> J urtlfp t1iat TR •wnu~ rAL ASSEMBLY c ~ THE BAHA • ts :.> F TAUAANGA er TY
> "'
> <
> tT1
> -<
> lacorporated uader tile ....._ _.....        'T1
> Charitable Trasts Act, 1957                                                                                                                       n
> iflhdTD ........                                                                                             •                                    c
> 
> o.t.I at          AUC.i::.I.AJ :n                               th.ls.
> "'"'
> tT1
> ..,z
> ....!1'1.~.Y.... . .. . .                             .. 19 .'7.6.                                                                                til
> :i>
> 
> G. P..::'.~r
> · l' ;: /
> ~
> :i:
> :i>·
> 
> :i>
> ..,
> or
> - -.-..._......
> ·4~;~... ~ · ···
> ,,,,,,-   ..
> n
> <
> .ol™'-'O ...... /UTC                                                                                                                               :::;
> tT1
> Vl
> 
> N
> 3. Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Tauranga City, New Zealand; 12 July 1976.                                     °'.......
> N
> 
> °'
> N
> 
> Bijvoegeel van de ,.Cur. Courant" \'an 17 december 1976, No. 51
> Alie stemgereehtigde leden van de plaataelijke Bab!'l
> No. 31                                                  1976         gemeenschap zijn als !eden van de Plaataelijke Gectltelll·
> ke Raad verkiesbaar.
> STATUTEN van de                                                           De Plaatselljke Gestelljke Raad bereidt voor de jaarvergadering de agenda voor, waarin opgenomen de rap-
> BEGLEl\ID<"T VAN ORDE                               portering over de werkzaa.mheden van de Plaat.llfke
> Geestelijke Raad sinds zijn verkiezing, de financle1e vet'·
> slagen venneldende de lnkomsten en ultgaven val! sijn
> VOOB DE                                    fondsen en de rapporten van zijn comite's alsmede ande·
> re zaken de gemeenschap betreffende.
> Plaalselijke Geeslelijke Raad der Baha'is                           Znwel voor als na de verkiezing moet de Plaalllelijke
> Geestelijke Raad met de gemeenllCbap beraadslagen en
> VAN WJLLElllSTAD                                 haar vooratellen nanmoedigen, opdat hetgeen In de ge.-
> meenschap leeft weersplegeld worde In de plannen van de
> Plaatselijke Geeatelijke Raad.
> DEFINITIES:                                                              De uitslag van de verkiezing moet door de Plaatae-
> ..,
> lijke Geestelijke Raad dlrekt na ~n eerste vergadering        ::r:
> JN DI'l' REGLEMENT ZAL WORDEN VERSTAAN
> schriftelijk aan de Natlonale Geestelijke Raad worden         rn
> ONDER:                                                                                                                      tl:l
> medegedeeld.
> 1.     NATIONALE GEESTELIJKE RAAD:                                                           Artlkel 16                           >
> De recbtspersoonlijhbeid bezittende Nationale Gees·               De Plaatselijke Geestelijke Raad moet zonder onder·      ::r:
> telijke Ra.ad van de Baba'is van Vene:z.uela.                breklng. met tuBSenrulmte van 19 dagen, bijeenkomsten         >
> van de Baha'i gemeenachap regelen, in overeenatemmlng
> 2.     PLAATSELlJKE GEMEE."ISCHAP:                                  rrot de Leer en de Kalender van bet Bahi'l Geloof.            :...:
> De gemeenschap. der Baha'is van Willemstad.                                          ArtikeJ 17                            0
> :<:!
> Dit Reglement Vllll Orde kan alechta gewijzigd WOI'·      r
> 3.     GEMEENTE:         .                                          den door een besliaslng van de Natlonale Geestelijke Rud      0
> De Stad Willemstad.                                          genomen met volatrekte meerderheld van atemmen.
> De betreffende wijziglng is eehter nlet eerder van
> 4.     UNIVEf'..SELE HUIS VAN GERECHTIGDl'l.EID:                    kracht dan na goedkeuring door de Gouwrneur van de
> Hct Hoogbestuur van het. Bahai geloof voor de hele           Nederlandae Antmen.
> wereld, zittin~ hebbende te Haifa, Isreel
> Aldus vastgesteld in de buitengewone algemene le·
> denvergaderlng van 10 maart 1976.
> Goedgekeurd bij landabesluit dd. 19 nov 1976, No. 2.
> Willemstad, 6 dee 1978.
> Het wnd. Hoofd van bet Centraal Bu·
> rcau voor Julidische en Algemcnc Za.ken,
> w.g. Mr. M. MONTE·BOSKALJON.
> 
> 4. Extracts from Articles of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Bahti'is of Willemstad, Curar;ao, signed
> 6 December 1976 by representative of the Central Bureau of Juridical and General Affairs.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                         263
> 
> · filrrtiftratr nf tqr lttrnrpnrntintt nf a filnmpauy
> 
> I qrreby Q!rrttfy that
> 
> "THE SPIRI'i'UAL A33 ~MilLY 01'' 'r HE £ AHA' IS Ok' PORTLAND CO'.J.'TAGJ!:
> LilH 'fElJ"
> 
> was      ~ttruqinratrb              under the
> 
> Companies Act, 1965                                       as a      f!Jtmitrh       Company
> 
> on the      TWEN':rY-NI N'l'H                                  day of         SEPTEMBER
> 
> One thousand     nine hundred md SP.venty-seven.
> 
> Given under. my hand at Kingstv ·1 this                 TENTH                          day of
> 
> OC'l'OBER                One thou , and nine hundred and                     Seventy-seven.
> 
> ,.,.,.. .... .,- ..,
> ~ ·· ?"""'- <.: ; .... (_..:-
> Ac '.: .      Registrar of Co111pa11ies.
> 
> No. of Company 16,191.
> 
> 5. Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of
> Portland Cottage, Jamaica; 29 September 1977.
> 264                                       THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> -e:-
> A. 170
> 
> Form ;l.
> 
> ',\SSOCIATIOiiS INCORPORATION ACT 1966
> 
> CERTIFICATE OF mconPORJ\TIOtr OF . AN ASSOCIATION
> 
> T!!r:; IS 70 CE..'t'!IFY THAT
> 
> :!C S?IRITUAL ASSEMBLY OF THE BARA t rs OF LIPAN mCORPOMTED
> 
> in purses.nee of Section 9 of the Association Incorporation Act
> 
> 1966 hM this day been incorporated Ullder that Act.
> 
> ';J\IE:I •.rnder my hnnd nnd Seal this eleventh da,y of Jftlllla17, 1978,
> 
> 6. Certificate of Incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Bahti'fs of
> Lipan, Papua New Guinea; 11 January 1978.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                                       265
> 
> . i) .. · . .~- N~4o.509.-
> PRESIDENCIA DE LA REPUBLICA
> :ws
> .
> ······~·•to de lnte.io•
> ___.,_
> '
> POB EL CllAL SE APRUEBAN
> '
> ESTATUTOS SOCIALE
> Y SE RECONOCE U PERSONERIA JURIDICA DE LA EN
> II      f
> 
> I,         .             TIDAD DENOMINADA "ASAMBW ESPIRITUAL LOCAL Dr
> :WS BAHA'IS J!'M PA:LOMITA".-   .
> II
> .                   .   ..
> .      . Asuoci6o,Julio 3 de 1978.-         I
> VISTO:La presentaci6o hecha al Ministerio del i
> 1 Ioterior,eo  fecha 15 de marzo del cte.ei'l.o(Expte.N!!.204) 1
> lpor el Sr.Sirous Toutounchi Maragheh,en representsci6n j
> 1de la eotidad deoominada "ASAMBLEA !SPIRITUAL. :WCAL DE !I
> LOS BAHA'IS EN PA:WMITA",~o la que solicits le eproba- i
> Nf..               . ci6n de los Estatutos Soc1eles y el recooocimiento de !~
> I                   Persooeria Juridica de la misma;los iof~rmes favorablef
> , de l a Inspeocion General de Hacienda,Fiscalia General I
> ::~r ~stado Y Ases°.ria .Juridioa. del JUoisterio del Iote- ·
> .I                       EL PRESIDENTE DE LA REPUBLICA DEL PARAGUAY
> 
> I                                         . D E c R E T .A:
> Art.12.-Apru~banse los Estatutos Sociales de la entidadl
> denominada "AS.AMBLE! ESPIRITUAL :WCAL DE LOS BA+
> ,HA'IS EN PA:WJIITA".; y autorizase el fuocionaaieo ··
> to de la misma en oar~cter de Persona Juridioa, 11
> de acuerdo a· lo establecido en los Jrtd.~,,Inc.~
> y 45 del C6d1go Civil,y cooforme oooata en la Es
> critura N2.416 protocolizada en el Registro PU- !
> blico a cargo de don A.Hamon Berdejo G.,en fee~
> 10 d~ Di?iembre del aflo 1.977 .-                   J
> 
> .,Art.22.-comuniquese,pubHquese y d4se al Regietro Oficir
> 
> .,        ·-                           FOO: ALFREDO STROESSNER.-
> I                  ·;0111n 1
> ,~..,~
> . ,. .-
> "°~                o:>abioc A.)lontan~o.-
> I
> i
> ·
> •   ,
> 
> s. ;f. •'.\ ~ 1 0
> 
> /'A • ~- .....,
> ES COP -             •';;;:(,/ •                                  ~l---v
> ~,.,,, ,,,,,••'              RIO FILARYI'GA-
> Seoretarto
> - /
> .·
> )
> • '
> ... 1&8--cle-.SO                      .
> 
> 7. Presidential Decree approving By-Laws and conferring Juridical Personality on
> the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Palomita, Paraguay; 3 July 1978.
> 266                                                           THE BAHA'I WORLD
> ,_
> ··::-.;-~-                                   ·· --:-'-· r-·····-·                    ...   . , ... ....       - · -     ' •lf"9'
> I
> STATUTS o~· L'ASSEM!JL.Jt~ 'SPJHITUELLE llES
> · ,BAHA'IS QEFTAfflTI
> \_     •·'-:."!.r :,:.: ~  'I                      t '
> 
> ··· .J.l est cree l'Assemb.lf>e SpifitueJ!e : d~rs B~ha'is de ·1~ahiti
> ~:.lo·nt l'objet est )\administration de •~ Fqi b"iah;1 1 ie· l
> Tatiiti
> et dont le siege social est n.t>,'' Gi34: a-Pine, T.tlltl. . ·
> Les administrate·urs, l;'est~a ..cUre leJ me-mbres de ' r.,.\s~.
> s~mbl~e Spirituelle reconnai.n,t qu, cette actloti a 6te
> prise a. l'enti~r~ u.nanhnitc et. en t<>mpl~t accord. U8. .,,.
> r.unn~issent pour eux-memes 4!t ·pour \t~ compte • · 1e1irs
> si;t<;c~sseurs Ja . ~i&,qi.fication S~cf~ ~t 'e but \fR~versef de
> r~ · f~j a~h~'kdqnt 'f~s . e~~eign~~t#. et · lt19 . Jl:l:i~~pes re~~ .
> plj'~~n~ _ la pmme-~•~ chvine de· ~.P.~~~': les reUg1pne· rlv~l~~s .
> pffc~demment                                                              . c               .-                                       .     .            .
> "•
> ! . •      .
> .   :'                                              :
> 
> · (:9mposition di.a· burea~ :
> ~sident                                                FERTf: Ai~iri
> \li~·Pr~sident.                                        RAVF.A f(enri
> se·tr~t~ire                                            MAKEA TA.PEA ·uaniel
> ft.fS.(lrter                                           DEXTER ·D'1'!my.
> ·1_·::_ "
> .... .. .- .. ·-- · --                __ ......,.._"'II ___ , __   .                  ~     •,                                   •
> ·.{tecepisse n" 4'; i42 AA d~ 22 Ju,!~' t97M.
> ~=:"'"...:~ :''--·        H-- : ;. :: ..•:.;-~"'?"' "' · ---·· _;·~- ..•. .:. • •·-~~·
> •                       "<I~'}    ~'
> '··· - .. , • . ,_
> -·-·
> .. ...., _ _....:._::...:.::-::::
> 
> 8. Extract from the Officiallournal of French Polynesia of 15July1978, relating to
> registration of the Local Spiritual A ssembly of the Bahd'(s of Tahiti, giving date of
> receipt issued 22 June 1978.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                    267
> 
> DECLARATION D' ASSOCIATION
> Titre: ASSEMBLEE SP)RITUELLE DES BAHA'IS
> DE L'ILOT FILA
> Objet : Enseignement de la Foi Baha'ie, religiOn uni··
> verselle qui se presente comme l'aboutissement et le
> complement necessaire de toutes les anciennes croyances. 1
> Siege Social : Il~t Fila, Ile de Vate, Nouvelles-Hebri·
> des (B.P. 443, Port·Vila). '
> Bureau· responsable
> president               : M. r.fabia KALSAK.AU
> Vi ceoPresident          : M. Pet er KAL TOLI
> Secreraire              : Mlle Eva KIRI    .
> Tresoriere              : Mm~ Libebe KALUAT
> 
> Rece isse declaratif no 99 GI/ APA du 23.11.1978. 1
> 9. Extract from the Official Journal of New Caledonia for 1 December 1978,
> relating to the Declaration of Association of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the
> Bahr/is of Fila Island, New Hebrides, giving date of receipt issued 23 November
> 1978.
> 268                                              THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> I• 0
> G7223
> 
> UNLIMITED COMPANY ··
> 
> <Jtrrtifirntr nf JJnrnr.pnbttion
> 
> is this day lncorporat~d umkr the C'omj,aui,·s Act~ I %3. to   1977
> 
> _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __,,lay of
> 
> i!'.e.brunr.y. _ _ _ _ _ _...,nc· Thousand Nine llumlrcd aml.. .... ,: e:von.:ty,,.nine._ _
> 
> F~es and Deed Stamps L .5..? .•.5..0. ...... ..
> 
> 10. Certificate of incorporation of the Local Spiritual Assembly of the Bahti.'(s of
> Galway, lreland; 20 February 1979.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'f ACTIVITIES                                269
> 3. A SELECTION OF OTHER DOCUMENTS RECORDING
> OFFICIAL RECOGNITION OF THE BAHA'I FAITH
> 
> Ri<;lvan 1976 to Ri<;lvan 1979
> 
> 1. Document signed by primary school authorities in Wetzikon, Switzerland, permitting Baha'i
> students to be absent from school on Baha'i Holy Days; 19 April 1977.
> 2. Letter dated 15 October 1977 from Ministry of Lands and Settlement, exempting the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Kenya from payment of rates.
> 3. Letter dated 28 October 1977 from the office of the Minister of Home Affairs and Health,
> approving the appointment of Mr. Eric Wilson as Marriage Officer of Belize for the National
> Spii:itual Assembly of the Baha'is of Belize.
> 4. Letter dated 16 June 1978 from the National Register Coordinator, Division of Historic
> Sites, Illinois Department of Conservation, giving notice that the Baha'i House of Worship in
> Wilmette, Illinois was on 23 May 1978 entered in the National Register of Historic Places.
> 5. Certificate of Registration of the Baha'i Faith as a religious body in Tuvalu; 8 August 1978.
> 6. Certificates of Registration of two Baha'i symbols with the Office Africain et Malgache de
> Ia Propriete Industrielle (African Office of Industrial Property) on behalf of the National
> Spiritual Assemblies of the Central African Empire, the Cameroon Republic, and the Ivory
> Coast; 18 August 1978.
> 7. Extract from the Gazette of India for 9 September 1978, relating to exemption from income
> tax of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of India, with translation into English.
> 8. Letter dated 9 November 1978 from Ministry of Churches, legalizing Baha'i marriage in
> Denmark.
> 9. Certificate of Approval of Religious Organization authorizing establishment of the National
> Spiritual Assembly of the Bahfis of the Cook Islands, 20 December 1978, with cover letter.
> 10. Letter dated 3 February 1979 addressed to Court of Personal Status for Non-Muslims by the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of the Sudan, designating representative to
> appear before the Court in matters of Baha'i personal status, and in particular in matters of
> inheritance, with annotation of acknowledgment and filing by the Court.
> 11. Letter dated 9 March 1979 from the Procurer General of the Republic, confirming that the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Bahfis of Zaire obtained civil personality by ordinance
> on 9 June 1972, and is entitled to carry out its activities in conformity with its by-laws as long
> as that ordinance is not abrogated.
> 12. Resolution adopted 15 March 1979 by the House of Representatives of the Eighty-First
> General Assembly, State of Illinois, calling upon the President of the United States to urge
> the Government of Iran to recognize the religious character of the Baha'i Faith, and to assure
> the rights of all religious minorities including the Baha'is.
> 13. Letter dated 28 March 1979 signed by 22 members of the United States Senate, addressed to
> the Prime Minister of fran, expressing concern for the rights of religious minorities, including
> the Baha'fs, under the new Provisional Revolutionary Islamic Government of fran .
> 270                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Geiatiger Rat der Baha'i von Wetzikon
> I
> 
> Rei.lip 'fage cler Baha'i, an welohen die Arbeit ruht.
> 
> I
> 21. Dr•                    (IJeuJahr)
> 21. April                  ( Erater Ridvan)
> 29. April                  (Beunter Ridvan)
> 2.   Kai                   (Zw!S:y\er Ridvan)
> 23. 1'a1                   (Erlclli.rung dee 3ab)
> 
> ·-             29. Kai
> 9. Juli
> 20.0lctober
> 12. l'fovember
> (Todeatag Baha'u'llaahe)
> (Todeetag dee :ISab)
> (Geburtetag dee .tlab)
> ('9aha'u'llahe Gebu~tatag) ·
> 
> .7
> Baba'1-Sekretar1~~ ·
> 19.4.77    .'  ~
> J~Unsterberg 1/~
> \..· /
> •                         ~u1>-1ol.\ .......         ~~, rJ.o._
> \~~ o\l'.C~t.o ~hr-"4 ~c., . ~tl,)ilj: ~ t'- .
> f'r1mnrsc!iulpflege
> \'ct:i~on
> t"' ;    •rt\f'":
> 
> - - ----
> 
> 1. Document signed by primary school authorities in Wetzikon , Switzerland, permitting Baha'i students to be absent from school on Baha'i Holy Days; 19 April
> 1977.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                                                   271
> 
> MINISTllY OF LANDS AND IE'nl.IEMIENT
> 
> / Tck-arams .: .. LANDS"                                                                DEPARTMENT OF LANDS
> Telephone: 27471-at. ........... .
> P.O. Box )()()19, NAIROBI
> When replying pkasc quote
> 
> Rd. No.89.4~.9/?.L ....                                                      ...... ..1.5Jl.< ... ~9.~;?'!.:/~ ............ 111.".'"-
> aad date
> 
> ..
> National O:piritiAl of the l!ahe.i' s ot l'en:it,
> P.O. Boi:: 47562,
> llt. I ~Ol1I,
> 
> My letter ot 7th July, 1972 in d9l!l8!1'1 o! r ate11 on the
> above mr.ntioned property for the years 197'3 nnd 1914 hns heen
> concelled.
> 
> Your ro::iue'lt of 5th October to exempt :-ou f:roc payi?lf; rateo
> b~o     been accepted until further notice.
> 
> =+ ~
> ( D.J.l. !lguku
> -,-
> OF L'.'.''l~.
> for:oo1 2n~:u o r;,;:;:
> 
> 2. Letter dated 15 October 1977 from Ministry of Lands and Settlement, exempting
> the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Kenya from payment of rates.
> 272                                          THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> -
> 
> ......
> ·· ··~·
> ~
> ~-?..§.~-~:.?_~-~~-·; 77 : '
> 
> A:i ser.;b l y of   ~11e   i3ahai' s
> ,    ..
> 
> Mad.am-,
> " r.       ~
> #. . . . . . .   ~
> ' . • L~           l; am direct e d by t h·:? tioncurub l e l1i nist er , ~o
> i   .1-.• " .;in!orm yo-:.i of t he gra nt i n<; oi' :;.i s approv nl to t rie
> f-. . · appointmen t of l'ir. Eric ·..Ji lson as a I"larr i a ;;e Offi c er
> ,, • , ~-- of Belir.e for t he Nati cm:il d . ;> i r it u al "Assa :uly of .: 'ie
> ,.
> ' · j· '. Bahai' s of B ~ li t.a .
> .'.
> Respe c t fully yo u rs ,
> .. ?    • •••
> 
> ( D. A • .K . ii :.W..;01-i )           {   ,.
> r ur .i?e roanent Jec r :- tary
> ;,
> r c.c. Registrar Ge ne r~l
> ;D.AKG/oy
> I
> 
> 3. Letterdated28 October 1977 from the office ofthe Minister of Home Affairs and
> Health, approving the appointment of Mr. Eric Wilson as Marriage Officer of
> Belize for the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Belize.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA ' I ACTIVITIES                                                                      273
> 
> J:'
> . W  .
> UlinoisIJ                     Department of Conserve
> life and land together
> 
> 605 STATE OFFICE BUILDING• 400 SOUTH SPRING STRE ET • SPRINGFIELD G'70S
> 
> CHICAGO OFFICE - ROOM 'fOO. 160 NO. lASALLE 60601
> David Kenney, Director• James C. Helfrich. As:sistant O irect~u
> June 16, 1978
> 
> NA rt~ •..ti..   .:,:~ i."f:...AL ASSEMBLY.
> Bo\HA.'IS OF     T~~ ~~ITEO STATES_'
> National" Spiritual Aalll!llbley
> Baha'is of U.S.                                  Name:      Baha'i Tellple
> 112 Lirden Avenue                                 Date:      5/23/78
> Wllnette, Illlmis 60091
> Dear Sir:
> 
> 'Ihi..s lett.er is to notify you that the place iiarood atove ':'as
> entered in the National Register of Historic Places on the date
> listed above.
> I 11111 enclosing a brochure which details the National Register
> program.
> If you have any questions cxincerni.r.q this, please feel free
> to contact me.
> Sin:ierely yours,
> 
> ;{1!J1!fia~
> Keith A. Sculle
> National Register Coordinator
> Divisim of Historic Sites
> 
> JCS/j•
> 
> 4. Letter dated 16 June 1978 from the National Register Coordinator, Division of
> Historic Sites, Illinois Department of Conservation, giving notice that the Baha'(
> House of Worship in Wilmette, Illinois, was on 23May1978 entered in the National
> Register of Historic Places.
> 274                              THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> . .,
> 
> 5. Certificate of Registration of the Baha'i Faith as a religious body in Tuvalu;
> 8 August 1978.
> OFFICE AfltiCAJN el MAlGACHE
> DEMANOE D'ENREGISTREMENT
> de la Propttflj lnduurielle
> •            1   I'. ~:JI                  D'UNE MARQUE                              OfflCf AfllCAIN •• MAlGACHf            DEMANDE D'ENREGISTREMENT
> ~ ; OIJNDt IC '-'-O~"J                                                            d• la hopri4~ lndustrielle
> 
> ___
> g P. 887                         D'UNE MARQUE
> YAOUNOf (C. -W1' J                IM •-<kll!MtV1Ul•U,..._..•1 9') - - I U
> 
> MANOAlAIRf · N om _u1 od1e,ue ,
> ·-
> - - .llbort U!leau:. ' · - •
> ~"' d~ lo Mo•avo (•n N><t )
> ._..,__
> I • MANOATAIR:E • Nom et odrmse :
> 
> _........... . ........
> Modti. .   lo ~ ~ llOlrJ
> . . P. " ' • llonaaS       (s.c..1.)
> 
> _
> " - .....- ..._
> 2 ·ffP~..,~1-w::-.~1~• ',
> I/ ............. •ll&r&-.Je
> 
> _..
> -·---·~ l
> '-
> 
> ------·-·· I
> J ·~·~·'Ml!'~,·~~'~"~'
> ......u.•• j-       1
> ..
> ,.""--~
> 
> ..u - 1 . 4
> ~
> 
> ~                                          ..____. _
> .... " ' · -
> 
> ~I=-:,.T-9.::=1'°--==:s:
> ..,,,._
> =---r!'=;
> . ,r.:=i:.:
> .......... _,.._.
> ~_,.._- " a 11 ••--;-
> (-.C.A.J
> 2 • OUOSANT · Nom, ~a.fcUnomi notlonldomidle:
> 
> ·LJttl
> ~
> -z
> --l
> tr!
> :i:i
> z
> >
> --l
> ..   . . .... ~ ....i .     w
> -W-:-coo t:-·· . ~ ..._ ....                                                                    z
> ~-
> a
> 
> >
> t"'
> 
> ··-"""'""·
> • • Prodults designes :
> 
> "-           ~w de1) l!laM-.J111A'l'nr~ as:i= -*c-.1-                                                                .                                             ---""-.:.--.,.;;...
> "'c
> :i:i
> ---· - ------- -                           <
> tr!
> -<
> 'Tl
> ()
> c
> :i:i
> :i:i
> tr!
> z
> 
> ___
> --l
> 
> ..                      °'>
> 
> .. _... _.
> ::c
> c... ..................... ....
> ,        >
> >
> ~,                ...... ...... . .
> ~ ~ ....... ,. IO.MLP.l
> "
> ()
> 
> :l
> <
> tr!
> "'
> 
> N
> 6. Certificates of Registration of two Baha'{ symbols with the Office Africain et Malgache de la Propriete Industrielle (African                                                                  -...l
> VI
> Office of Industrial Property) on behalf of the National Spiritual Assemblies of the Central African Empire, the Cameroon
> Republic, and the Ivory Coast; 18 Aul(ust 1978.
> 276                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> \Allf-~
> 
> 1fiTolR'T~ 2 5 8 8.-if.•illf ~'.lfil~,   'lllf·i.fi~   ~Th~llit,    196 1
> ( 196 1   <fiT 4 3 )   cti1"     mu     1 o . 1¢1'    ~aru      ( 2 3-tr )   if;-
> ~ (v) lITU ~ ~ <fi1' ~                        rn ~I II~ ~~
> "if;qJI   m
> ~ ~ ~                    m
> ~,, -tr f'faf<c•1 ~ l 911-1s
> it ~ ~ « ~ a"ro it; Slail:Jt'11tf ~fu~f;u1 ~ ~I
> [~o 2420(1'ifo ~o 197/197/77 !Alo llfio ~I)]
> 
> INCOME TAX
> S.O. 2588.-In exercise of the powers conferred bv clause
> (v) of sub-section (23C) of section 10 of the Income-tax Act.
> 1961, (43 of 1961 ), the Central Government hereb:; notifies
> "National Spriritual Assembly of the Baba' is of India" for
> the purpose of .the said section for and from the assessment
> year(s) 1977-78 .
> .I
> {No. 2420 (F. No. 197 /197 /77-IT. AI)]
> 
> 7. Extract from the Gazette of India for 9 September 1978, relating to exemption
> from income tax of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Bahti'fs of India, with
> translation into English.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'i ACTIVITIES                                            277
> l...   '"' .. . . . . ;#ii    t·:,t
> h : ~ ~.,.   't \)j"'
> l.kt •. Journalnr. 6629-4
> f8ede"I. a~rl I •k.rl ...elwr
> d•n"'41 •-V ved'O'"'"I0..1
> 
> ""'"-IC,d. 9. november 1978.
> NB/"c
> 
> til r4deta andragende af 26. mart• 1974 akal man
> • at lliaiateriet vil vmre aindat pl dero• i hvert enkelt til•
> ~fft andrapnde at aeddele en peraon, der er -dlem a£ Dat
> ....lS.- rid for Bah&•ia i Dammark aller et a£ da lokale
> .... ---Sndtgelae til at foretage aigtevielae med borcerlig
> ~.......t at parterne eller en af dem barer til troaaaaf'un-
> 
> 1111i!;ll.I& ~re vere an forudaetning for meddelelae at' aL~an
> 1    at 4en fre11,gangam4de, der agtea fulgt ved vielaera fore•
> ......... af kirkelliniateriet, Jfr. herved. ecteakabalov-
> • :u.•••• i.
> b•       ••r   ...-tryk af qteakabel-en, ld.niahrieh bekendtger•
> ~ ..._,..,.., 19'9 og 1,5. l'ebruar .1971t        •-t cirkul11re af 16•
> .. •         IEUtleliC violH lldea for folllekirlrea, idet . . . - d
> ~ lllJI •        •• 'CM ,,.. ~YOlH el ............ -                              viehHbe- .
> ....... .....,....., t&~. 'oroll:riftol'lll9 1 cirkultlreta kapitel a.
> 
> llotnationule &ndolige r&d
> for Jkh& •is i nanmark
> v/Hr , Pnllc Bischof'f                                                  ro. be·1 Jensen
> Sofiuvcj 2!.I
> :!900 llellcru...,
> 
> 8. Letter dated 9 November 1978 from Ministry of Churches, legalizing Baha'i
> marriage in Denmark.
> ---"'"
> .                 --./-    ,.,.,,_ ~ -   ,   .:#',Ill ._,.~i.tlll!,~,11 ~ ,       L-......,.                                                                N
> 
> /
> -..J
> '                                                                                                                                                                   00
> 
> "'
> -·9'F9D1Wlertp
> ~~..:q
> ~
> 
> -                    Government of the Cook Islands                                                                                 H •
> ..........
> ........__ """"
> !'"" at . . ..u;p...
> .t....iiO ..........:
> .......
> Tda:Ml JIM
> 20-1171
> ......._.
> OIOO: ul lhc Mlnlau...- ol Justico,
> 
> ..........
> Mr Te-ata llakirere
> ~
> ,
> 
> ........ ..
> .--.i.......,.,
> ~
> 
> .,
> 
> L -··gr
> Dear llr ICakinre,                                                                                                                   09*~
> .,i
> ,   1 now h&ve pleuure in forvardi119 a C.rtif-icate
> of Approval of Reli9iowa Organisation e280Ut.d under                                                                                                     :i::
> 91 hand on 20 Deoemt»r, . 1978.                                                                                                                          tI1
> . . .t. wialau for Cbriatau an4 the -           Year.                                                        M'IEltJ,. !IWtl!P . . . . .           al
> >
> Your• alncerely,                                                                                             :i::
> .... Ollplli•._ _......... - 1'nt I,                         >
> ,_:;,
> r      ..., .      m:r -         . . . . ., .......
> ~
> ~ ..... ..,....i· •        ... en t" ·   r•' aa . .          0
> :xi
> -    Ia1-U et . . - . . . i ....,...,. .....a,., . .         r
> 
> .............. ..,.,.....,;"....
> .....la.                                                     0
> f< --
> ~"
> " ' - -----
> -
> (Y.&.&.1.--.. ._,
> - ~~= ---:-_=-.t;             '- -
> 
> I d - " 'rMM
> 
> ~
> 
> 9. Certificate ofApproval of Religious Organization authorizing establishment of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is
> of the Cook Islands, 20 December 1978, with cover letter.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                              279
> 
> ..
> ·1
> 
> ,,,..;..11 ~· .;• ~·
> ~I ,,,Al ~· Jt,- lll 'J'~..
> 
> 1...!.1 J,. ~,,...,
> ,ft)J ........      ........1 d"" '1b_
> IJlll,,t-      . - ~I ,.SI.di #
> 
> ,,. :... .
> .,_..
> .,...._.
> .-..1
> ~
> cl'- -" ,...l
> ..... ~......     ...--
> ..........""' {
> 
> -·- .,
> i,..-            .-.-JI .••,.,JI 1ḥ
> .,_.         . .-.-JI .....,. ~
> .,_..                 ..,.-  ...
> .,_..                ...~ ......
> 
> JO. Letter dated 3 February 1979 addressed to Court of Personal Status for
> Non-Muslims by the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'(s of the Sudan,
> designating representative to appear before the Court in matters of Baha'( personal
> status, and in particular in matters of inheritance, with annotation of acknowledgment and filing by the Court.
> 280                                                          TH E BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> -, ·::
> 
> p OOCUlfEUft
> .:     ..
> CONSl!IL JUDICL\IRB
> CMINET DU -llOEHT
> GEllEllAL DE IJI REl'll8UCIUE
> :.,;
> ,.J .•
> 
> ~:
> I ~~J i. ll ~ o:" f' r"if,..
> .~. ,.; ,. 1 +··,..11 p ~p + i.rf•'J" 1 ,.
> , ,. ... u~ · ·a • T~ ..: ,.. 1, ...
> .,...!",.,..,_t,..,. .,. '11 '7,~ .._,.."°' 4
> 
> -·
> 
> 11. Letter dated 9 March 1979 from the Procurer General of the Republic,
> confirming that the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'{s of Zafre obtained
> civil personality by ordinance on 9 June 1972, and is entitled to carry out its
> activities in conformity with its by-laws as long as that ordinance is not abrogated.
> INTERNATIONAL SURVEY OF CURRENT BAHA'I ACTIVITIES                                                       281
> 
> S1'ATE OF ILL/NO/$
> EIGHTY-FIRST GENERAL ASSEMBLY
> HOUSE 0/1 IUilltUENTATWU
> Ro.#R#OlllllollNo. IJO
> ()fferN by R.,,,__lllllH Mel'tlt1
> 
> WHEREAS. It 16 the aowtld /oH/tPI policy of IM Urtlt«I Sltlta of A'""'1al to
> ·~ ~ IWfḥcl                    for,,.. --..,.
> of.. dlll-ot• -itl;Mtl
> WHEREAS, TIN .....,~. dw ..... .....,.,.......,, a hl.16,,._
> jllllQ'...,,,.....,
> b"'llllJy tlltllcl:#d tllfll #ft#ll Of . . . . . . . . . . . . . UR I. . . .
> notl011;Md
> tftl
> 
> ·-from
> """ - ·P'O.._,. ,....,.,,
> WHEREAS. TIN .... ., COW11117 a .... ,,._Ml! u
> polllal «#Jiiiy. "~ -a'°--'~__,..,.,_
> of d /wlllu-1 ,,_,,,,. tlNI
> ~
> 1ff' _,,._,,..,,
> 
> _, -u _,.. ...........
> wflll ,,..,,,,,.,
> 
> tlwlr......,. '° ""'°"'
> WHEREAS. It· II "'-Jon -           ,.,.,,,,,. t1-t tlw _,.,.,..,,,. Mii .:ttmfflttl
> lllflOllS .,,.. lNlllM """""" ,.,.,. -     .... .,.._.. ,,. . . .,, ., ..,,..,. . .
> .,..., t/ley,.,.,. doM 0..,,.100 y_,, tlNI...,, alflldMI                               tltl lhtlNd
> StlllU; tlwefon, ff It
> 
> n.t """'°" ,,.._
> RESOLVED. BY THE HOUSE OF RURUENl'ATIYU OI' THE E1611TY·
> FIRST GENERAL ASSEM8LY OF THE STATI' OF IJ.LINOIS.                              w
> dent Outer to rt1qwlt A,...toaM IC""-*'l 911 dw            a.. ,.,_.•'ID .......,                dw
> 1Jait4'1 Flllth IU IOWly • nlfP»n - - 911 lo -                    tltl ,.,,,., of .... ,,,,., .. ,.
> llglous mlnorltlt1 lllcludlnl the ...,_'I. tll#ll """ /WI f/OIUft*. ftlltwwl tlRll .....,.,.. ...,,.
> and, be It further
> RESOLVED. 77tat o 1t1ll8bll copy of thl# ,,,_bk tllfll moAtlbt ff t-rr/ld
> to he!ldent C.ter and &cntuy of Stare Cy"" J'G11«.
> Adapted.by the Houu of Repn1mtattw1 on MOFch 15, 1979.
> 
> (µJL.. C<Rc~
> Sptaker of the House
> 
> 12. Resolution adopted 15 March 1979 by the House of Representatives of the
> Eighty-First General Assembly, State of Illinois, calling upon the President of the
> United States to urge the Government ofinin to recognize the religious character of
> the Baha'( Faith, and to assure the rights of all religious minorities including the
> Baha'fs.
> r                             ']!CniWI ~lcde• ~                               . '·
> ;',
> lib bulloncy llobdi laurgon
> Morda 21, 1979
> -tvo.                            N
> N
> March 28. 1979
> /}141 ·~
> f7~.·
> Hh Excellency ?1ehd1 B.azarean
> Prime Hiniater
> Provisional 'Revolutionary Ialamic
> Government of Iran                                                           Mu Bauc\18
> United StatN Senetor
> Tehran. lran                                                                                               ~tatHS-otor
> 
> ~~t:                              -d~
> Dear Hr. Prime Minister :
> 
> The people of Iran and the United States •hare a
> heritar;e of religious conviction and revolution•ry change.
> ~~~m ~1i~i~~~·;:r:~~~~j~n~n t~~~o~~~n~fY r!l~~l~~/b!lf:.h.                                                     :Kt Sta~;~:·:b
> ~~~~
> Thia deep hietorical experience has generated concern a1110ng
> 
> ·~.,...
> Americans when it appears that the freedom to "10rship is
> /T....,.
> e;;;,z:to•
> tht'eatened in this country or elsewhere .
> 
> ;a;~
> For thia reason, anxiety bas been expreaaed by many
> of our constituents over how recent event• in Iran will
> affect religious and ethnic minorities living there . Specifically, the co111J1Unities of Baha'is, Zoroastrian•. Jews
> and Christiana appear particularly vulnerable to rahtreatl!lent by some groupa claiming to act with the authority of                       Paul S. Sarbanea              Carl Levin
> your government.                                                                  United Statea Senator         ~ited   Stat•• Sanator           ..-j
> 
> c;i;;/;r~:·t.:7·
> ::c
> rb~~
> Hr . Prime Ki.nister. we l'ecogni~e and appreciate the
> rn
> · ~!{~I~: ~:~~e~:~~~~::~ ~~~,.~~= ~:~i!:nw~:~i:~t~~~~;                              ··11n•k   .                                                  tll
> to discuss the future of that religious minority in Iran.
> Moreover, 'the statement of the Ayatollah lChomeini concerning
> religious freedom made prior to his return to Iran provides
> Unit.e~at,, enoto/
> U..¢
> , -
> .ited Statea Scnatc>r
> .          '
> )>
> ::c
> 
> ~~
> us with • moat important source of a§surance on thia matter.
> . ~·'lh.,~- . .                   >
> ....:;,
> ~~~e~:~~c~s r~~;~~ r;!:~r~o ~~ ~h~u~u~~c c~~~~f:ie f~~ ~~~~ss-
> 
> ment of thcae religious eroups.                                                                                 8.I. Ra:r.U-        .__---
> United State• SeMitOT
> ~
> United Sta. .J : t o r                                         0
> 
> ~
> We would welcome any c-oimient or message of reasau't'ance
> 
> ~inz
> :>"
> ~~~~~r:~~~e!~u~ f:~~:e~~~~ a~~l!~~u~~e t~!~c:~• f:~c~ ~hose
> 
> ~~iea 1116
> t"'
> we represent.                                                                                                                                    tJ
> R.
> Thank you for taking these _concerns into account.                        un@)°      Sen•               United Stataa Senator
> 
> ~~
> J:i,</   J:v7ta
> i:1x1
> Birch  8a:~?t
> •
> Pd4/-./
> Lawton Chi le•
> United Sutea Senator          ~ 1-..S(}~
> Un
> • Mcr.overn
> tatea SenatoT
> United States Senator                  United States Senator
> 
> ih
> Al-Cr-toll
> Dnit. . ltatea Senator
> ~~r
> Donald V. Stewart
> United States Senat.01'
> 
> ~o/1-.tif                      6.le~~J\_
> Ge~ ~ml:.~
> •t.•;·
> lftt.t....I      cnator        Uni t~d States Senator
> 
> 13 . Letter dated 28 March 1979 signed by 22 members of the United States Senate, addressed to the Prime Minister of iran,
> expressing concern for the rights of religious minorities, including the [Jahti'(s, under the new Provisional Revolutionary Islamic
> Government of Iran.
> PART FOUR
> 
> THE WORLD ORDER OF
> BAHA'U'LLAH
> I
> THE UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE
> 
> 1. THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
> UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE
> Declaration of Trust
> IN THE NAME OF GOD, THE ONE, THE INCOMPARABLE, THE ALL-POWERFUL, THE ALL- KNOWING,
> THE ALL- WISE.
> 
> The light that is shed from the heaven of bounty, and the benediction that shineth from the
> dawning-placeofthe will of God, the Lord ofthe Kingdom ofNames, rest upon Him Who
> is the Supreme Mediator, the Most Exalted Pen, Him Whom God hath made the
> dawning-place of His most excellent names and the day-sprjng of His most exalted
> attributes. Through Him the light ofunity hath shone forth above the horizon ofthe world,
> and the law of oneness hath been revealed amidst the nations, who, with radiant faces,
> have turned towards the Supreme Horizon, and acknowledged that which the Tongue of
> Utterance hath spoken in the kingdom of His knowledge: 'Earth and heaven, glory and
> dominion, are God's, the Omnipotent, the Almighty, the Lord of grace abounding!'
> 
> WITH joyous and thankful hearts we testify               which flows from the Source of the Faith, to
> to the abundance of God's Mercy, to the per-             safeguard the unity of its followers, and to
> fection of His Justice and to the fulfilment of          maintain the integrity and flexibility of its
> His Ancient Promise.                                     teachings.
> Baha'u'llah, the Revealer of God's Word in               The fu.ndamental purpose animating the
> this Day, the Source of Authority, the Foun-             FaithofGodandHisReligion,declaresBaha'u'-
> tainhead of Justice, the Creator of a new World          llah, is to safeguard the interests and promote
> Order, the Establisher of the Most Great                 the unity of the human race, and to foster the
> Peace, the Inspirer and Founder of a world               spirit of love and fellowship amongst men. Suf
> civilization, the Judge, the Lawgiver, the               fer it not to become a source of dissension and
> Unifier and Redeemer of all mankind, has                 discord, of hate and enmity. This is the straight
> proclaimed the advent of God's Kingdom on                Path, the fixed and immovable foundation .
> earth, has formulated its laws and ordinances,           Whatsoever is raised on this foundation, the
> enunciated its principles, and ordained its              changes and chances of the world can never
> institutions. To direct and canalize the forces          impair its strength, nor will the revolution of
> released by His Revelation, He instituted His            countless centuries undermine its structure.
> Covenant, whose power has preserved the                     Unto the Most Holy Book, 'Abdu'l-Baha
> integrity of His Faith, maintained its unity and         declares in His Will and Testament, every one
> stimulated its world-wide expansion through-             must turn, and all that is not expressly recorded
> out the successive ministries of 'Abdu'l-Baha            therein must be referred to the Universal House
> and Shoghi Effendi. It continues to fulfil its           of Justice.
> life-giving purpose through the agency of the               The provenance, the authority, the duties,
> Universal House of Justice whose fundamental             the sphere of action of the Universal House of
> object, as one of the twin successors of Baha'u' -       Justice all derive from the revealed Word of
> llah and 'Abdu'l-Baha, is to ensure the con-             Baha'u'llah which, together with the interpretinuity of that divinely appointed authority             tations and expositions of the Centre of the
> 286                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Covenant and of the Guardian of the                   which have caused difference; to elucidate
> Cause-who, after 'Abdu'l-Baha, is the sole            questions that are obscure; to safeguard the
> authority in the interpretation of Baha'i Scrip-      personal rights, freedom and initiative of
> ture-constitute the binding terms of refer-           individuals; and to give attention to the presence of the Universal House of Justice and are        ervation of human honour, to the developits bedrock foundation. The authority of these        ment of countries and the stability of states;
> Texts is absolute and immutable until such               To promulgate and apply the Jaws and
> time as Almighty God shall reveal His new             principles of the Faith; to safeguard and
> Manifestation to Whom will belong all author-         enforce that rectitude of conduct which the
> ity and power.                                        Law of God enjoins; to preserve and
> There being no successor to Shoghi Effendi         develop the Spiritual and Administrative
> as Guardian of the Cause of God, the Univer-          Centre of the Baha'i Faith, permanently
> sal House of Justice is the Head of the Faith         fixed in the twin cities of' Akka and Haifa; to
> and its supreme institution , to which all must       administer the affairs of the Baha'i commuturn, and on it rests the ultimate responsibility     nity throughout the world;·to guide, organize,
> for ensuring the unity and progress of the            co-ordinate and unify its activities; to found
> Cause of God. Further, there devolve upon it          institutions; to be responsible for ensuring
> the duties of directing and co-ordinating the         that no body or institution within the Cause
> work of the Hands of the Cause, of ensuring           abuse its privileges or decline in the exercise
> the continuing discharge of the functions of          of its rights and prerogatives; and to provide
> protection and propagation vested in that             for the receipt, disposition, administration
> institution, and of providing for the receipt and     and safeguarding of the funds, endowments
> disbursement of the J:Iuququ'llah.                    and other properties that are entrusted to its
> Among the powers and duties with which the         care;
> Universal House of Justice has been invested             To adjudicate disputes falling within its
> are:                                                  purview; to give judgement in cases of violation of the Jaws of the Faith and to pro-
> To ensure the preservation of the Sacred         nounce sanctions for such violations; to pro-
> Texts and to safeguard their inviolability; to      vide for the enforcement of its decisions; to
> analyse, classify, and co-ordinate the Writ-        provide for the arbitration and settlement of
> ings; and to defend and protect the Cause of        disputes arising between peoples; and to be
> God and emancipate it from the fetters of           the exponent and guardian of that Divine
> repression and persecution;                         Justice which can alone ensure the security
> To advance the interests of the Faith of         of, and establish the reign of Jaw and order
> God: to proclaim, propagate and teach its           in, the world.
> Message; to expand-and consolidate the
> The members of the Universal House of Jusinstitutions of its Administrative Order; to
> tice, designated by Baha'u'llah 'the Men of
> usher in the World Order of Baha'u'llah; to
> Justice', 'the people of Baha who have been
> promote the attainment of those spiritual
> mentioned in the Book of Names', 'the Trusqualities which should characterize Baha'i
> tees of God amongst His servants and the daylife individually and collectively; to do its
> springs of authority in His countries', shall in
> utmost for the realization of greater cordialthe discharge of their responsibilities ever bear
> ity and comity amongst the nations and for
> in mind the following standards set forth by
> the attainment of universal peace; and to
> Shoghi Effendi, the Guardian of the Cause of
> foster that which is conducive to the enlight-
> God:
> enment and illumination of the souls of men
> and the advancement and betterment of the              'In the conduct of the administrative
> world;                                              affairs of the Faith, in the enactment of the
> To enact Jaws and ordinances not express-           legislation necessary to supplement the Jaws
> ly recorded in the Sacred Texts; to abro-           of the Kittib-i-Aqdas, the members of the
> gate, according to the changes and require-         Universal House of Justice, it should be
> ments of the time, its own enactments; to           borne in mind, are not, as Baha'u'llah's
> deliberate and decide upon all problems             utterances clearly imply, responsible to
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                      287
> those whom they represent, nor are they            The Universal House of Justice was first
> allowed to be governed by the feelings, the     elected on the first day, of the Festival of Ric,1-
> general opinion, and even the convictions of    van in the one hundred and twentieth year of
> the mass of the faithful , or of those who      the Baha'i Era, 1 when the members of the
> directly elect them. They are to follow, in a   National Spiritual Assemblies, in accordance
> prayerful attitude, the dictates and prompt-    with the provisions of the Will and Testament
> ings of their conscience. They may, indeed      of' Abdu'l-Baha, and in response to the sumthey must, acquaint themselves with the         mons of the Hands of the Cause of God, the
> conditions prevailing among the community,      Chief Stewards of Baha'u'llah's embryonic
> must weigh dispassionately in their minds       World Commonwealth, brought into being this
> the merits of any case presented for their      'crowning glory' of the administrative instituconsideration, but must reserve for them-       tions of Baha'u'Ilah, the very 'nucleus and
> selves the right of an unfettered decision.     forerunner' of His World Order. Now, there-
> God will verily inspire them with whatsoever    fore, in obedience to the Command of God and
> He willeth, is Baha'u'llah's incontrovertible   with entire reliance upon Him, we, the memassurance. They, and not the body of those      bers of the Universal House of Justice, set our
> who either directly or indirectly elect them,   hands and its seal to this Declaration of Trust
> have thus been made the recipients of the       which, together with the By-Laws hereto
> divine guidance which is at once the life-      appended, form the Constitution of the Uniblood and ultimate safeguard of this Revela-    versal House of Justice.
> tion.'                                          1
> 21 April 1963 A.D .
> 
> Hugh E. Chance
> 
> Hushmand Fatheazam
> 
> Amoz E. Gibson
> 
> David Hofman
> 
> H. Borrah Kavelin
> 
> Ali Nakhjavani
> 
> David S. Ruhe
> 
> Ian C. Semple
> 
> Charles Wolcott
> 
> Facsimile of signatures on the Constitution of the Universal House of Justice;
> 26November1972.
> 288                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> By-Laws
> PREAMBLE
> 
> THE Universal House of Justice is the su-            Baha'is of that locality. Every such Spiritual
> preme institution of an Administrative Order         Assembly shall be elected annually thereafter
> whose salient features, whose authority and          upon each successive First Day of Ric;!van. The
> whose principles of operation are clearly enun-      members shall hold office for the term of one
> ciated in the Sacred Writings of the Baha'i          year or until their successors are elected.
> Faith and their authorized interpretations.          When, however, the number of Baha'is as
> This Administrative Order consists, on the one       aforesaid in any locality is exactly nine, these
> hand, of a series of elected councils , universal,   shall on the First Day of Ric;!van constitute
> secondary and local, in which are vested legis-      themselves the Local Spiritual Assembly by
> lative, executive and judicial powers over the       joint declaration.
> Baha'i community and, on the other, of emi-          1. The general powers and duties of a Local
> nent and devoted believers appointed for the            Spiritual Assembly are as set forth in the
> specific purposes of protecting and propagat-           Writings of Baha'u'llah, 'Abdu'l-Baha and
> ing the Faith of Baha'u'llah under the guidance         Shoghi Effendi and as laid down by the
> of the Head of that Faith.                              Universal House of Justice.
> This Administrative Order is the nucleus          2. A Local Spiritual Assembly shall exercise
> and pattern of the World Order adumbrated by            full jurisdiction over all Baha'i activities and
> Baha'u'llah. In the course of its divinely pro-         affairs within its locality, subject to the propelled organic growth its institutions will             visions of the Local Baha'i Constitution. 1
> expand, putting forth auxiliary branches and         3. The area of jurisdiction of a Local Spiritual
> developing subordinate agencies, multiplying            Assembly shall be decided by tl:ie National
> their activities and diversifying their functions,      Spiritual Assembly in accordance with the
> in consonance with the principles and purposes          principle laid down for each country by the
> revealed by Baha'u'llah for the progress of the         Universal House of Justice.
> human race.
> III. NATIONAL SPIRITUAL
> I. MEMBERSHIP IN THE                                         ASSEMBLIES
> BAHA'f COMMUNITY                            Whenever it is decided by the Universal
> The Baha'i Community shall consist of all         House of Justice to form in any country or
> persons recognized by the Universal House of         region a National Spiritual Assembly, the vot-
> Justice as possessing the qualifications of Baha'i   ing members of the Baha'i community of that
> faith and practice.                                  country or region shall, in a manner and at a
> time to be decided by the Universal House of
> 1. In order to be eligible to vote and hold elec-
> Justice, elect their delegates to their National
> tive office, a Baha'i must have attained the
> Convention. These delegates shall, in turn,
> age of twenty-one years.
> elect in the manner provided in the National
> 2. The rights, privileges and duties of indi-
> Baha'i Constitution 2 a body of nine members
> vidual Baha'is are as set forth in the Writto be known as the National Spiritual Assemings of Baha'u'llah, 'Abdu'l-Baha and
> bly of the Baha'is of that country or region. The
> Shoghi Effendi and as laid down by the
> members shall continue in office for a period of
> Universal House of Justice.
> one year or until their successors shall be
> II. LOCAL SPIRITUAL                       elected.
> ASSEMBLIES                            1. The general powers and duties of a National
> Whenever in any locality the number of                 Spiritual Assembly are as set forth in the
> Writings of 'Abdu'l-Baha and Shoghi
> Baha'is resident therein who have attained .the
> Effendi and as laid down by the Universal
> age of twenty-one exceeds nine, these shall on
> the First Day of Ric;lvan convene and elect a            House of Justice.
> By-Laws of a Local Spiritual Assembly . Seep. 361.
> local administrative body of nine members to         2   Declaration of Trust and By-Laws for a National Spiritual
> be known as the Spiritual Assembly of the                Assembly. See pp. 337, 340.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                        289
> 2. The National Spiritual Assembly shall have        era! conduct of their affairs of self-contained
> exclusive jurisdiction and authority over all     aloofness, the suspicion of secrecy, the stifling
> the activities and affairs of the Baha'i Faith    atmosphere of dictatorial assertiveness and of
> throughout its area. It shall endeavour to        every word and deed that may savour of parstimulate, unify and co-ordinate the man-         tiality, self-centredness and prejudice; and
> ifold activities of the Local Spiritual           while retaining the sacred right of final decision
> Assemblies and of individual Baha'is in its       in their hands, to invite discussion, ventilate
> area and by all possible means assist them to     grievances, welcome advice and foster the
> promote the oneness of mankind . It shall         sense of interdependence and co-partnership,
> furthermore represent its national Baha'i         of understanding and mutual confidence becommunity in relation to other national           tween themselves and all other Baha'is.
> Baha'i communities and to the Universal
> V. THE UNIVERSAL HOUSE
> House of Justice.
> OF JUSTICE
> 3. The area of jurisdiction of a National
> Spiritual Assembly shall be as defined by the       The Universal House of Justice shall consist
> Universal House of Justice.                       of nine men who have been elected from the
> 4. The principal business of the National Con-       Baha'i community in the manner hereinafter
> vention shall be consultation on Baha'i           provided.
> activities, plans and policies and the election
> 1. ELECTION
> of the members of the National Spiritual
> Assembly, as set forth in the National Baha'i           The members of the Universal House of
> Constitution.                                        Justice shall be elected by secret ballot by
> (a) If in any year the National Spiritual            the members of all National Spiritual
> Assembly shall consider that it is imprac-      Assemblies at a meeting to be known as the
> ticable or unwise to hold the National          International Baha'i Convention.
> Convention, the said Assembly shall             (a) An election of the Universal House of
> provide ways and means by which the                  Justice shall be held once every five
> annual election and the other essential              years unless otherwise decided by the
> business of the Convention may be con-               Universal House of Justice, and those
> ducted.                                              elected shall continue in office until such
> (b) Vacancies in the membership of the                   time as their successors shall be elected
> National Spiritual Assembly shall be                 and the first meeting of these successors
> filled by a vote of the delegates compos-            is duly held.
> ing the Convention which elected the            (b) Upon receiving the call to Convention
> Assembly, the ballot to be taken by cor-             each National Spiritual Assembly shall
> respondence or in any other manner                   submit to the Universal House of Justice
> decided by the National Spiritual                    a list of the names of its members. The rec-
> Assembly.                                            ognition and seating of the delegates to
> the International Convention shall be
> IV. OBLIGATIONS OF MEMBERS                                 vested in the Universal House of Justice .
> OF SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLIES                             ( c) The principle business of the Interna-
> Among the most outstanding and sacred                     tional Convention shall be to elect the
> duties incumbent upon those who have been                    members of the Universal House of Juscalled upon to initiate, direct and co-ordinate              tice, to deliberate on the affairs of the
> the affairs of the Cause of God as members of                Baha'i Cause throughout the world, and
> its Spiritual Assemblies are: to win by every                to make recommendations and suggesmeans in their power the confidence and affec-               tions for the consideration of the Unition of those whom it is their privilege to serve;           versal House of Justice.
> to investigate and acquaint themselves with the         ( d) The sessions of the International Conconsidered views, the prevailing sentiments                  vention shall be conducted in such manand the personal convictions of those whose                  ner as the Universal House ofJ ustice shall
> welfare it is their solemn obligation to pro-                from time to time decide.
> mote; to purge their deliberations and the gen-         (e) The Universal House of Justice shall
> 290                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> provide a procedure whereby those                    ship on the Universal House of Justice
> delegates who are unable to be present               only with the approval of the Universal
> in person at the International Conven-               House of Justice.
> tion shall cast their ballots for the elec-   3. BY-ELECTION
> tion of the members of the Universal                If a vacancy in the membership of the
> House of Justice.                                Universal House of Justice occurs, the Uni-
> (f) If at the time of an election the Universal      versal House of Justice shall call a by-
> House of Justice shall consider that it is       election at the earliest possible date unless
> impracticable or unwise to hold the              such date, in the judgement of the Universal
> International Convention it shall deter-         House of Justice, falls too close to the date of
> mine how the election shall take place.          a regular election of the entire membership,
> (g) On the day of the election the ballots of        in which case the Universal House of Justice
> all voters shall be scrutinized and              may, at its discretion, defer the filling of the
> counted and the result certified by tellers      vacancy to the time of the regular election. If
> appointed in accordance with the                 a by-election is held, the voters shall be the
> instructions of the Universal House of           members of the National Spiritual Assem-
> Justice.                                         lies in office at the time of the by-election.
> (h) If a member of a National Spiritual
> 4. MEETINGS
> Assembly who has voted by mail ceases
> to be a member of that National                  (a) After the election of the Universal
> Spiritual Assembly between the time of               House of Justices the first meeting shall
> casting his ballot and the date of the               be called by the member elected by the
> counting of the ballots, his ballot shall            highest number of votes or, in his
> nevertheless remain valid unless in the              absence or other incapacity, by the
> interval his successor shall have been               member elected by the next highest
> elected and the ballot of such successor             number of votes or, in case two or more
> shall have been received by the tellers.             members have received the same high-
> (i) In case by reason of a tie vote or votes             est number of votes, then by the
> the full membership of the Universal                 member selected by lot from among
> House of Justice is not determined on                those members. Subsequent meetings
> the first ballot, then one or more addi-             shall be called in the manner decided by
> tional ballots shall be held on the per-             the Universal House of Justice.
> sons tied until all members are elected.         (b) The Universal House of Justice has no
> The electors in the case of additional               officers. It shall provide for the conduct
> ballots shall be the members of National             of its meetings and shall organize its
> Spiritual Assemblies in office at the time           activities in such manner as it shall from
> each subsequent vote is taken .                      time to time decide.
> (c) The business of the Universal House of
> 2. VACANCIES IN MEMBERSHIP                                 Justice shall be conducted by the full
> A vacancy in the membership of the Uni-               membership in consultation, except that
> versal House of Justice will occur upon the             the Universal House of Justice may from
> death of a member or in the following cases:            time to time provide for quorums of less
> than the full membership for specified
> (a) Should any member of the Universal
> House of Justice commit a sin injurious              classes of business.
> to the common weal, he may be dismiss-        5. SIGNATURE
> ed from membership by the Universal                 The signature of the Universal House of
> House of Justice.                                Justice shall be the words 'The Universal
> (b) The Universal House of Justice may at            House of Justice' or in Persian 'Baytu'lits discretion declare a vacancy with            ' Adl-i-A'?am' written by hand by any one of
> respect to any member who in its judge-          its members upon authority of the Universal
> ment is unable to fulfil the functions of        House of Justice, to which shall be affixed in
> membership.                                      each case the Seal of the Universal House of
> (c) A member may relinquish his member-              Justice.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                        291
> 6. RECORDS                                                 Local Spiritual Assembly to the
> National Spiritual Assembly which shall
> The Universal House of Justice shall pro-              determine whether it shall take jurisdicvide for the recording and verification of its           tion of the matter or refer it back to the
> decisions in such manner as it shall, from
> Local Spiritual Assembly for reconsidtime to time, judge necessary.
> eration. If such an appeal concerns the
> membership of a person in the Baha'i
> VI. BAHA'f ELECTIONS
> communtiy, the National Spiritual
> In order to preserve the spiritual character            Assembly is obliged to take jurisdiction
> and purpose of Baha'i elections the prac-                  of and decide the case.
> tices of nomination or electioneering, or any          (b) Any Baha'i may appeal from a decision
> other procedure or activity detrimental to that            of his National Spiritual Assembly to the
> character and purpose shall be eschewed. A                 Universal House of Justice which shall
> silent and prayerful atmosphere shall prevail              determine whether it shall take jurisdicduring the election so that each elector may               tion of the matter or leave it within the
> vote for none but those whom prayer and                    final jurisdiction of the National
> reflection inspire him to uphold.                          Spiritual Assembly.
> (c) If any differences arise between two or
> 1. All Baha'i elections, except elections of
> more Local Spiritual Assemblies and if
> officers of Local and National Spiritual
> these Assemblies are unable to resolve
> Assemblies and committees, shall be by
> them, any one such Assembly may bring
> plurality vote taken by secret ballot.
> the matter to the National Spiritual
> 2. Election of the officers of a Spiritual Assem-
> Assembly which shall thereupon take
> bly or committee shall be by majority vote of
> jurisdiction of the case. If the decision of
> the Assembly or committee taken by secret
> the National Spiritual Assembly thereon
> ballot.
> is unsatisfactory to any of the Assem-
> 3. In case by reason of a tie vote or votes the
> blies concerned, or if a Local Spiritual
> full membership of an elected body is not
> Assembly at any time has reason to
> determined on the first ballot, then one or
> believe that actions of its National
> more additional ballots shall be taken on the
> Spiritual Assembly are affecting
> persons tied until all members are elected.
> adversely the welfare and unity of that
> 4. The duties and rights of a Baha'i elector may
> Local Assembly's community, it shall, in
> not be assigned nor may they be exercised
> either case, after seeking to compose its
> by proxy.
> difference of opinion with the National
> Spiritual Assembly, have the right to
> VII. THE RIGHT OF REVIEW
> appeal to the Universal House of Jus-
> The Universal House of Justice has the right            tice, which shall determine whether it
> to review any decision or action of any Spiritual          shall take jurisdiction of the matter or
> Assembly, National or Local, and to approve,               leave it within the final jurisdiction of the
> modify or reverse such decision or action. The             National Spiritual Assembly.
> Universal House of Justice also has the right to
> intervene in any matter in which a Spiritual         2. An appellant, whether institution or indi-
> Assembly is failing to take action or to reach a        vidual, shall in the first instance make appeal
> decision and, at its discretion, to require that        to the Assembly whose decision is quesaction be taken, or itself to take action directly      tioned, either for reconsideration of the case
> in the matter.                                          by that Assembly or for submission to a
> higher body. In the latter case the Assembly
> VIII. APPEALS
> is in duty bound to submit the appeal
> The right of appeal exists in the circum-            together with full particulars of the matter.
> stances, and shall be exercised according to the        If an Assembly refuses to submit the appeal,
> procedures outlined below:                              or fails to do so within a reasonable time, the
> 1. (a) Any member of a local Baha'i commu-              appellant may take the case directly to the
> nity may appeal from a decision of his           higher authority.
> 292                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> IX. THE BOARD OF                         propagation of the Faith , the numbers of
> COUNSELLORS                            whose members shall be set by the Universal
> House of Justice . The members of these Aux-
> The institution of the Boards of Counsellors      iliary Boards shall serve under the direction of
> was brought into being by the Universal House       the Continental Board of Counsellors and shall
> of Justice to extend into the future the specific   act as their deputies , assistants and advisers.
> functions of protection and propagation con-        1. The members of the Auxiliary Boards shall
> ferred upon the Hands of the Cause of God.              be appointed from among the believers of
> The members of these boards are appointed by           that zone by the Continental Board of
> the Universal House of Justice.                         Counsellors.
> 1. The term of office of a Counsellor, the          2. Each Auxiliary Board member shall be
> number of Counsellors on each Board, and             alloted a specific area in which to serve and,
> the boundaries of the zone in which each             unless specifically deputized by the Counsel-
> Board of Counsellors shall operate, shall be        lors, shall not function as a member of the
> decided by the Universal House of Justice.           Auxiliary Board outside that area.
> 2. A Counsellor functions as such only within       3. An Auxiliary Board member is eligible for
> his zone and should he move his residence           any elective office but if elected to an
> out of the zone for which he is appointed he        administrative post on a national or local
> automatically relinquishes his appointment.         level must decide whether to retain mem-
> 3. The rank and specific duties of a Counsellor        bership on the Board or accept the adminisrender him ineligble for service on local or        trative post, since he may not serve in both
> national administrative bodies. If elected to       capacities at the same time. If elected to the
> the Universal House of Justice he ceases to         Universal House of Justice he ceases to be a
> be a Counsellor.                                    member of the Auxiliary Board.
> 
> XI. AMENDMENT
> X. THE AUXILIARY BOARDS
> This Constitution may be amended by deci-
> In each zone there shall be two Auxiliary         sion of the Universal House ofJustice when the
> Boards, one for the protection and one for the      full membership is present.
> 
> The Hands of the Cause Amatu'l-Bahti Ru.l:ziyyih Khtinum and Paul Haney (to the right) with
> members of the Universal House of Justice elected at Riljvtin 1978. Left to right: Mr. 'A[(
> Nakhjavtin(, Mr. H. Borrah Kave/in, Mr. Amoz Gibson, Mr. Hushmand Fatheazam, Mr. Jan
> Semple, Dr. David S. Ruhe, Mr. Charles Wolcott, Mr. David Hofman, Mr. Hugh Chance. A
> reproduction ofone ofM ishkfn-Qalam's illuminated designs o f'The Greatest Name' forms the
> backdrop.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                       293
> 
> 2. THE FOURTH INTERNATIONAL
> CONVENTION FOR THE ELECTION OF
> THE UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE
> Ri9van 1978
> 
> THIRTEEN Hands of the Cause of God ,                        gift of Baha' u'llah, the refuge and hope of
> fifty-two members of twelve Continental                     mankind.
> Boards of Counsellors, and 474 members rep-                    'You are privileged to vote for the Univerresenting 108 National Spiritual Assemblies                 sal House of Justice, the body that watches
> gatheted at the World Centre of the Faith dur-              over the destinies of the Faith of Baha'u'llah,
> ing the Ric;lvan Festival for the Fourth Interna-           the body that guides, protects, and encourages
> tional Baha'i Convention. The nine members                  us as we steer our course to the Kingdom of
> of the Universal House of Justice and the three             God on earth .'
> Counsellors residing in the Holy Land were                     She concluded: 'How great, how sacred is
> also present.                                               the responsibility that confronts those who
> The delegates enjoyed three days of pilgrim-            vote in this election, seeking help, guidance,
> age and prayers at the Shrines and Holy Places              and inspiration from Baha' u'llah.'
> of the Faith, cast their votes in the election of              Then, as Ru9iyyih Khanum presided, the
> the Universal House of Justice, saw and heard               chief teller-Mr.         Jameson    Bond      of
> reports on the progress of the Faith during the             Canada-began to call the roll of the 1,107
> first four years of the Five Year Plan, and par-            members of the 123 National Spiritual
> ticipated in many hours of consultation on the              Assemblies in the Baha'i world.
> means required for the complete achievement                    As the delegates moved to the auditorium
> of the goals of the Plan.                                   stage to cast their votes, the remaining dele-
> In addition , the fifty-two Counsellors                 gates and visitors spontaneously applauded as
> remained in the Holy Land for another five                  the names of National Assemblies were calldays for consultation with the thirteen Hands               ed-in some cases with increased enthusiasm
> of the Cause and the three Counsellors who ,                as particularly great achievements of the
> with the remaining three Hands of the Cause 1               believers in some areas of the world were
> who were unable to be present, constitute the               remembered, or particular hardships recalled.
> International Teaching Centre of the Faith.                    Many of the delegates were dressed in the
> The members of the Universal House of Jus-                  costumes of their homelands, and the total
> tice also joined in the consultation.                       effect of the colourful procession was one of
> solemn dignity, great enthusiasm and joy, and
> Saturday, 29 April                                          humble awareness of the importance of the
> The delegates, who had previously enjoyed                 election itself.
> three days of prayers in the Shrines of the Faith              Fifteen of the 123 National Spiritual
> and pilgrimage to many of its Holy Places,                  Assemblies , through circumstances beyond
> gathered in Haifa Auditorium for the election               their control, were not able to be represented
> of the Universal House of Justice .                         at the Cortvention. The tellers cast their bal-
> The Hand of the Cause of God Amatu'l-                     lots, which had been sent by mail, as .t he roll
> Baha Ru9iyyih Khanum, who presided, wel-                    was called. Nine National Assemblies had all of
> comed the delegates to the first session of the             their members present: Canada, Denmark,
> Convention and set the theme for the election               Germany, fran, Italy, Portugal, Switzerland,
> with these words: 'World society is disinte-                the United Kingdom, and the United States.
> grating before our eyes- political, social,                 Eleven others had eight members present, and
> economic, and religious systems alike- and                  twelve were represented by seven members.
> the only refuge that remains for mankind is this               The election process took all morning to
> Dr. Adelbert Miihlschlegel , Enoch Olinga, l;lasan M.   complete. The tellers then retired to tabulate
> Balyiizi.                                               the results of the election.
> 294                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Counsellor Thelma Khelgati of Western Africa (back row, centre) with delegates from Niger
> who participated in the fourth International Convention for the election ofthe Universal House
> of Justice; Rit;lvtin 1978. Left to right: Mrs . Doris Dejwakh, Mr. Moussa Kangai Kamaya,
> Mrs. Parvin Djoneidi, Mr. Hassane Adanou, Mr. Mohammad Djoneidi.
> 
> Early in the afternoon, the participants         since the role of the Universal House of Justice
> assembled at the construction site of the Seat of   is to protect, enforce, and enact new laws for
> the Universal House of Justice-on the Arc of        the world in the Name of Baha'u'llah. 'From
> Mt. Carmel in the vicinity of the Shrine of the     this source (the House of Justice) will come the
> Bab and just above the .resting-places of the       Justice that Baha'u'llah speaks of in His Writ-
> Sister, Mother, and Brother of 'Abdu'l-             ings,' she said, pointing out that today-when
> Baha-for a solemn but joyous ceremony in            the Administrative Order is still being built and
> which a casket containing Dust from the             the Faith is still attempting to spread itself
> Shrines of the Bab and Baha' u'llah was placed      throughout the world-we are enjoying the
> in the structure by Amatu'l-Baha RuJ:ifyyih         'paternal and loving forebearance of the gui-
> Khan um on behalf of the Universal House of         dance and protection of the House of Justice.'
> Justice.                                            Then she added: 'But the day will come when it
> The Hand of the Cause Dr. Ugo Giachery ,         will blaze with Justice! That will be the day of
> who presided, pointed out to the delegates that     the solution of all the problems of the world!'
> it was 'something unique we are witnessing             RuJ:iiyyih Khanum then unveiled a box ,
> here', and he recalled how Shoghi Effendi, in       which contained a silver casket (a gift to her
> anticipation of the establishment of the Uni-       from the Guardian) in which were sealed two
> versal House of Justice, had called into exis-      small boxes containing the Dust from the two
> tence the International Baha'i Council. The         Holy Shrines and a scroll written in English and
> audience applauded warml y as Dr. Giachery          Persian which described the contents of the
> called to the front of the group Miss Ethel         casket.
> Revell , who with RuJ:ifyyih Khanum and Dr.            As the assemblage quietly sang Alltih-u-
> Giachery was a member of the original Council       Abhti, RuJ:iiyyih Khanum-accompanied by
> appointed by Shoghi Effendi.                        architect I:Iusayn Amanat and 'Aziz
> Then RuJ:iiyyih Khanum established the           Khabfrpur, the resident engineer for the contheme and purpose of the ceremony. She              struction-ascended a set of temporary steps
> pointed out that, to her, the Shrine of Baha'u'-    to a small niche which had been prepared in the
> llah is a 'Wellspring of Peace' on the planet;      building, high above the main entrance. With
> that out of His Resting-Place pours a fountain      her own hands, she placed the casket in the
> of peace. 'But from this building will e manate     niche, took up a trowel , and sealed it into place.
> the Laws of the Dispensation of Baha' u'll ah',        The ceremony was preceded and followed
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                     295
> 
> Mr. Anthony Providence of St. Vincent,            Partial view of the exhibit on display during
> Windward Islands, addressing his fellow              the fourth International Convention.
> delegates during the fourth International
> Convention.
> 
> Delegates from Japan who participated in the fourth International Convention for the election
> of the Universal House of Justice; Rit;ivan 1978. Left to right: Mr. Abbas Katirai, Mr. A.
> Moghbel, Mr. Yuzo Yamaguchi, Miss Nobuko lwakura, Mrs. Barbara Sims, Mr. Shigeyuki
> Hayashi.
> 296                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> by a programme of prayers and readings in            Cause. Many told of difficulties the friends in
> Persian, English, Portuguese, Swahili, and           their areas had met and overcome in their
> French.                                              efforts to spread the Teachings and promote
> Immediately afterwards, the delegates             the work of the Cause.
> assembled in the Pilgrim House courtyard, in            Finally, at the close of the session, Mr.
> the vicinity of the Shrine of the Bab, for the       Haney called for the report of the tellers. The
> celebration of the Ninth Day of Ric;lvan. The        chief teller reported that 1,056 ballots had
> Hand of the Cause Abu'l-Qasim Faizi presided         been received and 9,333 votes had been tabuat the programme. After readings and prayers         lated. Then, as he read the names of the nine
> in English, Arabic, French, Persian, and Span-       men elected to the Universal House of Justice,
> ish, the delegates and visitors-led by               each made his way to the stage to stand before
> RuJ:ifyyih Khanum and Mr. Faizi-circumam-            the Convention. They were:
> bulated the Shrine in which are entombed the                    Mr. Ali Nakhjavanf
> earthly remains of the Bab, the 'Martyr-                        Mr. Hushmand Fatheazam
> Prophet and Herald' of the Faith of Bah-                        Mr. Amoz Gibson
> a'u'llah, and of 'Abdu'l-Baha, the Centre of                    Mr. Ian Semple
> Baha'u'llah's Covenant with mankind.                            Dr. David Ruhe
> On Saturday evening, the delegates reas-                     Mr. David Hofman
> sembled in Haifa Auditorium for an audio-                       Mr. Charles Wolcott
> visual presentation on the state of the Five                    Mr. Hugh Chance
> Year Plan. The Hand of the Cause William                        Mr. H. Borrah Kavelin
> Sears presided and helped narrate an impres-            The delegates stood in spontaneous
> sive slide programme which recounted the             applause, and after Mr. Nakhjavanf spoke a
> manifold accomplishments of the Baha'fs of           few words on behalf of the men of the House of
> the world during the first four years of the Plan,   Justice, the session closed with the delegates
> and pointed the way to victories yet to be           singing Allah-u-Abhti and Ya-Bahti'u'l-Abhti.
> achieved.                                               Consultation continued in the afternoon ses-
> In his closing remarks, Mr. Sears reminded        sion, with the Hand of the Cause H . Collis
> the Baha'fs that, although significant victories     Featherstone presiding. He recalled the mornhad been achieved, there was still a 'consider-      ing's events with these words: 'Future generaable distance to go to win the kind of victory       tions would love to have been present this
> that would bring joy to the heart of Shoghi          morning on the occasion of the election of the
> Effendi and to the Universal House of Justice'.      Universal House of Justice and the events we
> He pointed out that final victory could be won       were privileged to witness. As the outside
> if each would dedicate himself to personal           world sinks beneath a burden of trials and
> transformation of his own spiritual life.            tribulations, we are seeing the development of
> the Cause of God in its resistless march toward
> Sunday, 30 April                                     victory.'
> The Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha                    The Sunday evening time was given over to
> RuJ:if yyih Khanum opened the session by read-       consultation between representatives of
> ing the Universal House of Justice's message to      National Assemblies and the Continental
> the Convention. She was introduced by the            Boards of Counsellors in their respective
> Hand of the Cause Paul Haney, who presided.          zones. In addition, National Assemblies con-
> The House of Justice's message was distri-         sulted among themselves and with each
> buted to all the delegates present and subse-        other-as they did throughout the Convenquently forwarded to all National Spiritual          tion-on the means for winning the final goals
> Assemblies for dissemination by them to the          of the Plan and on the co-ordination of mutual
> believers in their jurisdictions.                    activities and programmes.
> Then Amatu'l-Baha RuJ:ifyyih Khanum
> opened the Convention to the first of five con-      Monday, 1 May
> sultative sessions. She particularly called on         The third day of the Convention was entirely
> the assembled delegates to recount some of the       dedicated to consultation. The Hand of the
> stories of difficulty and trials suffered for the    Cause John A. Robarts presided at the morn-
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                                   297
> 
> Delegates from Ghana who participated in the fourth International Convention for the election
> of the Universal House of Justice; Rir;f,van 1978. Left to right: Mr. David Tanyi, Mr. Beattie
> Casely-Hayford, Mr. Philip Smith, Mr. Andrew Sagde, Miss Eleanor O'Callaghan, Mr. Yaw
> Asare, Mrs. Blanche Musah. Many delegates wore the costumes of their homelands.
> 
> Mr. Kawku Negble Attigah, a delegate from         Mr. Adrien Zanou Gnambode, a delegate
> Togo.                                          from Benin.
> 298                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> ing session . He commented that 'a recurring           their experiences and victories in the teaching
> theme of the remarks of the delegates was the          work among various groups.
> recognition of the power of the Holy Spirit, and
> the fact that it can and does assist us. This is the   Tuesday, 2 May
> power to which we can all turn and the assis-             The Hand of the Cause Dhikru'llah Khadem
> tance will be given to complete our goals,' he         presided over the final consultative session of
> said, adding: 'Let us make this universal, divine      the Convention. He reminded the friends that
> power our guide in directing our energies to the       Shoghi Effendi was delighted to be able to say
> tasks before us. Only through clinging to this         that 'The Cause of God has reached places that
> power of the Holy Spirit can we overcome our           are difficult to pronounce!' He told the deleown weaknesses and frailties, ignore the short-        gates: 'We must respond to win the goals; we
> comings of others, and be led to ultimate vic-         must teach ourselves and then teach others.
> tory.'                                                 We have a grave responsibility .. . If we our-
> The Hand of the Cause Dr. RaJ:imatullah             selves arise and take the lead in the teaching
> Muhajir presided at the afternoon consultative         work, the friends will follow us.'
> session. He invited the delegates to direct their         In the closing address to the Convention , the
> attention to the subject of mass conversion.           Hand of the Cause Dr. Ugo Giachery summar-
> He pointed out that 'We do not know when            ized the events of the preceding days, and then
> the Formative Age will give way to the Golden          repeated the theme that had recurred through-
> Age,' but that Shoghi Effendi once said that           out the long sessions of the Convention: That
> the efforts of the Baha'fs would 'herald the           the members of the National Spiritual Assemadvent of the Golden Age of the Faith of               blies themselves had a responsibility to be an
> Baha'u'llah.' Therefore, Dr. Muhajir said , the        example of selfless devotion, of unremitting
> Baha'fs can bring the Golden Age nearer by             acitivity, of constant service to the Cause.
> tireless and effective teaching among the                 He warned that the administrators of the
> masses of humanity.                                    Faith must not believe that administration
> 'This is the time for growing, for gaining          alone would win the victories of the Five Year
> numerical strength in the Cause. The time is           Plan and of the Plans that would be unveiled in
> ripe-it was always ripe, for this. The Master          the future, and thereby hasten the advent of
> said that humanity would enter the Faith in            the Golden Age of humanity. ' We must have
> troops.'                                               passion for the Cause,' he said.
> Dr. Muhajir called to the stage Baha'fs from           In the afternoon , the participants assembled
> several regions of the world , who discussed           at Bahjf for the celebration of the Twelfth Day
> 
> Silver box holding two containers of Dust from the Shrines of Bahti'u'lltih and the Bab which
> was placed by the Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Bahti Rul:ziyyih Khtinum in the new building
> which will serve as the Seat of the Universal House of Justice.
> ....,
> :c
> tr1
> ~
> )Cl
> t""
> 
> "'
> tr1
> )Cl
> 'T1
> l:ll
> >
> :c
> >·
> c:
> t""
> t""
> >·
> :c
> 
> The Hands of the Cause and Counsellors gathered at Mazra'ih; May 1978. Amatu'l-Bahti Ru/:iiyyih Khtinum is seen in the centre of the
> second row .
> 
> N
> \0
> \0
> 300                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> of Ric;lvan. The Hand of the Cause' Ali-Akbar      the Continental Boards of Counsellors began a
> Furlitan presided. The nearly 600 Baha'is were     series of plenary and zonal sessions with the
> seated in a giant arc around the outer perime-     sixteen members of the International Teaching
> ter of the f:laram-i-Aqdas, facing the Shrine of   Centre who were present in the Holy Land.
> Baha'u'llah, as prayers and readings were          The members of the Universal House of Jusoffered in Arabic, Spanish, English, Persian,      tice also attended the sessions.
> and French.                                           The meetings were for the purpose of discus-
> Then, in solemn procession, Amatu'l-Baha         sing the objectives of the Five Year Plan and
> Ru!)fyyih Khanum and Mr. Furutan led the           the development of the Institution of the
> assemblage in humble circumambulation of           Counsellors and their Auxiliary Boardsthe Shrine of Baha'u'llah, in Whose Name the       including the use of assistants-in areas of
> Convention had gathered, and for the               concern such as the protection of the Faith and
> advancement of Whose Cause their lives were        the propagation of the Cause in years ahead.
> dedicated.                                         The zonal meetings dealt with points of more
> regional concern.
> Wednesday-Sunday, 3-7 May                             On the final day, the Hands of the Cause and
> After the National Spiritual Assembly            Counsellors were received by the Universal
> members began dispersing to their homes            House of Justice at a farewell luncheon held at
> throughout the world, the fifty-two members of     Mazra'ih.
> 
> Mr. Alibe Mimba, a delegate from Surinam, having just cast his ballot, is invited by Amatu'l-
> Bahti Ruf:dyyih Khtinum to pause for a photograph. Ruf:ifyyih Khanum had enjoyed Mr.
> Mimba's hospitality during her visit to the Bush Negro communities of Surinam on her Green
> Light Expedition in 1975.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                                     301
> 
> 3. THE HISTORIC SIGNIFICANCE OF THE
> ERECTION OF THE SEAT OF THE
> UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE
> Address of the Hand of the Cause Paul Haney to the Baha'i
> International Teaching Conference in Merida, Yucatan,
> Mexico, February 4- 6, 1977
> 
> THE destiny of the Holy Land in relation to          its splendour will have been disclosed before
> our Faith, as every Baha'i knows, has been           the eyes of all mankind' .2
> foretold in the sacred Writings of the prophets         In referring to the International Archives
> of old, in Tablets revealed by Baha'u'llah and       building, standing in the shadow of the Shrine
> 'Abdu'l-Baha and in the writings of Shoghi           of the Bab, Shoghi Effendi told us that the
> Effendi.                                             completion of this edifice would in turn herald
> The fu lfilment of these prophecies and allu-     the construction of several other structures
> sions began with the banishment of Baha'u'llah       which would serve as the administrative seats
> and His arrival in 'Akka in 1868. Since that         of the divinely ordained institutions of the
> historic event the spiritual heart and the nerve     Faith at its World Centre. He stated that these
> centre of the Baha'i world has been located in       edifices would be in the shape of a far-flung arc
> the Holy Land, first in 'Akka, and then in both      and would surround the resting-places of the
> Haifa and 'Akka, following the transfer of the       Greatest Holy Leaf, the Purest Branch and the
> remains of the Bab to Mount Carmel and their         Holy Mother, and that their completion would
> interment in the bosom of that Holy Mountain.        mark the culmination of the development of
> From the Holy Land, the world spiritual           the world-wide, divinely-appointed adminiscentre of the Faith since 1868, the Master, and      trative order of the Faith, and would fulfil the
> later the Guardian, as the divinely-appointed        glad tidings and promises revealed by Baha'u'-
> Centres of Baha'u'llah's Covenant, fostered          Ilah in the Tablet of Carmel.
> and directed the spiritual and administrative           It was the Tablet of Carmel which generated
> development of the Cause throughout the              the spiritual impulse for the rise and establish-
> Baha'i world.                                        ment of the Baha'i international institutions in
> During both the early and later years of his      the Holy Land, a process which Shoghi Effendi
> ministry, Shoghi Effendi gradually disclosed to      told us 'may be traced as far back as the conthe believers the future evolution of the World      cluding years of the Heroic Age of the Faith,' 3
> Centre and the glory of the divinely ordained        and which will attain its final consummation in
> Institutions which would be established there.       the Golden Age, 'through the raising of the
> In these successive and majestic messages the        standard of the Most Great Peace and the
> beloved Guardian described the relationship          emergence in the plenitude of its power and
> of these Institutions to the Shrines and Holy        glory of the focal centre of the agencies con-
> Places which had long comprised the world            stituting the World Order of Baha'u'llah. The
> spiritual centre of the Faith . Of these the         final establishment of this seat of the future
> Shrine· of the Bab on Mount Carmel stands            Baha'i World Commonwealth will,' he told us,
> pre-eminent, surpassed only by the Tomb of           'signalize at once the proclamation of the
> Baha'u'llah in Bahji. The Guardian referred to       sovereignty of the Founder of our Faith and the
> the resting-place of the Bab as 'a focal centre of   advent of the Kingdom of the Father .. .'4 Thus
> divine illumination and power' 1 which would,        it was the Tablet of Carmel which is the charter
> as the institutions comprising the World             for the development of the institutions of the
> Administrative Centre of the future Baha'i           Faith at its World Centre, including the estab-
> 2 ibid.
> Commonwealth became established, continue            3
> Shoghi Effendi, Messages to the Balun World 1950-1957,
> to flourish and expand 'until the full measure of      pp. 74-75 .
> Shoghi Effendi, God Passes By, p. 277.           • ibid.
> 302                                           THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> lishment of the supreme edifice of the Universal                Vivifier of mouldering bones and the Source
> House of Justice.                                               of infinite grace and bounty . It stands as the
> Let us attempt to understand, through these                  emblem symbolizing the basic unity of all
> majestic words of our beloved Guardian, the                     nations, governments and peoples, and as
> extent of the blessing conferred upon the entire                the seat of sovereignty and the dawningworld through the establishment of the Uni-                     place of both spiritual and temporal power.
> versal House of Justice, and particularly the                   It is the supreme Centre to which the followsignificance of the seat of that mighty institu-                ers of His most sublime and glorious Faith
> tion which the Baha'is of the world are now                     must turn and the focal point which will mircalled upon to build . In explaining the                        ror forth the effulgent splendours of the
> significance of the Tablet of Carmel as the                     Kingdom of God, the Almighty, upon all
> charter for the establishment of the Universal                  regions. It is the fountainhead of divine civi-
> House of Justice, Shoghi Effendi stated that:                   lization, the fairest, the noblest fruit of the
> 'In this great Tablet (of Carmel) which                      Baha'i Revelation-a civilization whose
> unveils divine mysteries and heralds the                     effects will, during the third, the Golden Age
> establishment of two mighty, majestic and                    of the Baha'i Dispensation and in the course
> momentous undertakings . .. the Spiritual                    of the future Dispensations, become clearly
> and Administrative World Centres of the                      manifest, and whose bountiful outpourings
> Faith ... Baha'u'llah refers to an "Ark,"                    will, like unto a torrential flood, burst forth
> whose dwellers are the men of the Supreme                    upon all mankind.' 3
> House of Justice, which in conformity with                   And in other passages referring to the time
> the exact provisions of the Will and Testa-                when the Supreme Institution of the House of
> ment of the Centre of the Mighty Covenant                  Justice would be established and function from
> is the body which should legislate on laws not             the Holy Land, Shoghi Effendi told us that:
> explicitly revealed in the Text. In this dis-                'Through it the pillars of the Faith on this
> pensation, these laws are destined to flow                   earth will be firmly established and its hidfrom this Holy Mountain, even as in the                      den powers be revealed, its signs shine forth,
> Mosaic Dispensation, the law of God was pro-                 its banners be unfurled and its light be shed
> mulgated from Zion. The "sailing of the Ark"                 upon all peoples.' ... 'Then will be unveiled
> of His laws is a reference to the establishment              before our eyes the inauguration of an era
> of the Universal House of Justice, . . .' 1                  the like of which has never been witnessed in
> In another passage the Guardian referred to                 past ages.' ... 'Then will the throne of
> the Supreme Body of the House of Justice as                    Bah:i'u'llah's sovereignty be founded in the
> 'the dome of the Edifice' (of the Administra-                  promised land and the scales of justice be
> tive Order of the Faith) that would have to be                 raised on high. Then will the banner of the
> raised 'on its prescribed site on the slopes of the            independence of the Faith be unfurled, and
> divine Vineyard, the "Mountain of the Lord',                   His Most Great Law be unveiled and rivers
> to adorn the institutions of God's New Order                   of laws and ordinances stream forth from
> with this crown of high distinction'. 2                        this snow-white spot with all-conquering
> Therefore the construction of the building                  power and awe-inspiring majesty, the like of
> which will be the seat of the House of Justice on              which past ages have never seen. Then will
> Mount Carmel is really an instruction, a com-                  appear the truth of what was revealed by the
> mand, from our beloved Guardian, as well as                    Tongue of Grandeur. " Call out to Zion, 0
> from the House of Justice, to which all of us,                 Carmel, and announce the joyful tidings: He
> the Baha'is of the world, must respond, and in                 that was hidden from mortal eyes is come.
> so doing hasten the dawn of that glorious era so               His all-conquering sovereignty is manifest.
> clearly foreshadowed in these majestic pas-                    His all-encompassing splendour is revealed
> sages from the writings of Shoghi Effendi:                     . .. 0 Carmel . . . well is it with him that
> 'This World Administrative Centre of the                    circleth around thee, that proclaimeth the
> Baha'i community constitutes the pivot of                   revelation of thy glory, and recounteth that
> the New World Order of Him Who is the                       which the bounty of the Lord, thy God, hath
> showered upon thee" .' 4
> Shoghi Effendi, Message to the Baha'is of Persia, Naw-Ruz   l ibid.
> 1955.                                                       ' Shoghi Effendi, Message to the BaM'is of Persia, 27
> ibid.                                                         November 1929.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                             303
> 
> 4. THE CONSTRUCTION OF THE
> BUILDING FOR THE SEAT OF THE
> UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE
> 
> The Greatest Single Undertaking of the Five Year Plan
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha RulJJyyih Khdnum is seen placing
> the casket containing Dust from the Holy Shrines of the Faith in a niche
> above the front entrance ofthe Seat ofthe Universal House ofJustice, in the
> outer wall of the council chamber during the International Convention on
> 29April1978. Assisting her are architect Jjusayn Amanat, right, and 'Aziz
> Khabfrpur, the resident engineer for the building's construction.
> 304                         THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> In Chiampo, Italy sections of
> the fluted columns are viewed
> by, left to right, Sohrab
> Youssefian, ljusayn Amanat,
> 'Aziz Khabfrpur and G. B.
> Danda, director of Industria
> dei Marmi Vicentini.
> Fifty-eight columns in the
> Corinthian style are used in
> the building and were carved
> by master craftsmen of
> Chiampo.
> 
> A view of part of the
> entablature. White Pentelikon
> marble from Greece, also
> known as 'Caesar's white', is
> used in the structure.
> Pentelikon marble was used in
> the building of the Parthenon.
> 
> Each column is 10.80 metres
> high and is adorned with a
> capital ornamented by a triple
> row of acanthus leaves.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                      305
> 'It is now both necessary and possible to        UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE AT COST JUST
> initiate construction of a building that will not   OVER TWO MILLION DOLLARS STOP FIRST SHIP-
> MENT FINISHED MARBLE DELIVERED SITE
> only serve the practical needs of a steadily consolidating administrative centre but will, for
> centuries to come, stand as a visible expression       By March 1978 construction had reached
> of the majesty of the divinely ordained institu-    the level of the floor immediately above the
> tions of the Administrative Order of Baha'u'-       council chamber and more than 2,200 tons of
> llah,' the Universal House of Justice announc-      finished carved marble had been delivered to
> ed to the Baha'fs of the world on 5 June 197 5.     the site. A contract was signed with a French
> On 17 June 1975 the House of Justice             firm for placing the marble on the building
> cabled:                                             after the completion of the concrete shell.
> Exterior concrete construction was completed
> JOYFULLY    ANNOUNCE      COMMENCEMENT
> EXCAVATION SITE UNIVERSAL HOUSE JUSTICE             by April 1979 except for the entablature , main
> BUILDING ARC MOUNT CARMEL STOP CON-                 staircase and the annex to the lower basement.
> TRACT ENTAILS REMOVAL FORTY THOUSAND                The placing of the marble to sheathe the main
> CUBIC METRES ROCK AND EARTH AT COST                 structure and the erection of all columns and
> APPROXIMATELY TWO HUNDRED THOUSAND
> DOLLARS STOP INVITE ALL BELIEVERS CONTRI-
> capitals is now completed and the placing of
> BUTE UNSTINTINGLY BUILDING FUND UNIN-               the entablature marble has commenced.
> TERRUPTED PROGRESS HISTORIC UNDERTAK-               Interior finishing work has begun and fabrica-
> ING ,                                               tion of doors and windows in Italian walnut, as
> and on 10 January 1977:                             well as the plaster elements for cornices, mould-
> JOYFULLY ANNOUNCE SIGNATURE AGREEMENT               ings and domed ceilings, is proceeding at sup-
> GENERAL CONTRACTOR FOR ERECTION SEAT                pliers' factories in Italy.
> 
> The site of the Seat of the Universal House of Justice on the slopes of Mt. Carmel as it
> appeared when excavation commenced on 17 June 1975.
> 306                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> When this photograph was
> taken on I 7 February I 977
> the first concrete footings were
> being poured.
> 
> In June I 977 the walls were
> being constructed for the
> upper and lower basements
> (looking eastward).
> 
> Pouring concrete for the
> foundation; I 0 June 1977.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                       307
> 
> Pouring the concrete floor of
> the lower basement;
> 29 June 1977.
> 
> A northward view shows the
> walls of the upper basement in
> place; 5 July 1977.
> 
> Pouring the central columns
> which support the dome as
> well as, in part, the council
> chamber; 15 July 1977.
> 308                           THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Further progress in
> construction of upper and
> lower basements;
> 31August1977.
> 
> .... .                          - ,,..- '
> ,
> ..
> ~
> 
> The first slab of the outer
> perimeter at the ground floor
> level as it appeared on
> 12 October 1977.
> 
> The upper and lower
> basements;
> 26 November 1977.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                        309
> 
> The main staircase leading
> from the grand concourse to
> the council chamber floor as it
> appeared on 8 January 1978.
> 
> Pouring concrete on the
> council chamber level of the
> building; 16 January 1978.
> 
> Forms for the walls of the
> third floor are seen in place on
> 24 March 1978.
> 310                        THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> The third floor walls were
> completed when this
> photograph was taken on
> 12 April 1978.
> 
> View of some of the delegates
> to the fourth International
> Convention who gathered on
> 29 April 1978 for the
> ceremony during which the
> Hand of the Cause
> Amatu'l-Bahti Rul:zfyyih
> Khanum placed in a niche in
> the outer wall of the council
> chamber a casket containing
> Dust from the Holy Shrines.
> 
> By 30 June 1978 progress had
> been made toward
> constructing the roof and the
> octagon of the dome.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                         311
> 
> The first piece of marble, a
> pilaster base, is seen being
> lifted into place; 31July1978.
> 
> This view of the construction,
> taken from the International
> Archives building, shows the
> progress as of
> 4 October 1978.
> 
> Part of the marble cladding
> and a section of a column are
> seen in this view showing the
> advancement made as of
> 24 October 1978. ·
> 312                       THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> By 30 November 1978
> additional cladding had been
> affixed and the columns along
> the east side of the building
> had begun to rise, section by
> section.
> 
> The columns and capitals on
> the east and north sides as
> they appeared on
> 13 December 1978.
> 
> By 24 January 1979 all the
> columns on the north and east
> sides had been placed and
> forms prepared for pouring
> supports for the entablature.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA ' U'LLAH                            313
> 
> A pre-cast coffered soffit is seen being hoisted into position; 3 May 1978.
> 314                                              THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 5. A TRIBUTE BY CHIAMP0 1
> A stirring and poignant chapter in the history ofthe erection ofthe Seat ofthe Universal
> House of Justice-the mighty Centre from which God's Law shall go forth to unite and
> perfect mankind-was written not at the World Centre of the Faith, but in the village of
> Chiampo, Italy, where the marble for the new building was carved by the remnant of a
> dwindling race of master workmen in the white stone which has quickened man's senses
> for aeons.
> 
> ON      4 July 1979, the Mayor of the city of                   economy and local resources had offered for
> Chiampo, Italy , wrote an unusual letter.                       over two millennia. Over the years the school
> Addressed to the resident engineer in charge of                 trained hundreds of young people in design ,
> the construction of the new building for the                    pottery, the history of art, and the working of
> Seat of the Universal House of Justice, the                     marble. The school no longer exists, and only
> letter said, in part:                                           its last pupils remain in Chiampo, 'heirs to the
> 'I have the honour to be the Mayor of                        splendid and ancient art which now-unhap-
> Chiampo-that is, of the town which, through                     pily-is perhaps dying out in our area.'
> the Industria dei Marmi Vicentini, has had the                     The booklet continues: 'However, the comprivilege of carving the marble for the Seat of                 petence, virtuosity, and dedication of these last
> the Universal House of Justice , Baha'i World                   stonecutters are gifts still recognized, appreci-
> Centre, Haifa.                                                  ated, and sought after in the world-and it is
> 'In remembrance of this work, my Adminis-                    thanks to them that today, on Mount Carmel,
> tration has asked-and obtained permission of                    in Haifa, Israel, is rising the "Parthenon of
> the Industria dei Marmi Vicentini-for a du-                     Chiampo".'
> plicate of one of the columns, to be erected in                    The document then describes the station and
> our main square in witness of the ingenuity, the                the role of the Universal House of Justice and
> art, and workmanship of our valley, and also in                 explains some of the history and principles of
> memory of a work of art and a Faith that will                   the Faith, adding: 'And so, in the way of all
> live for centuries for the peace and brother-                   civilized peoples of the world, and in witness of
> hood of the human race ... .'                                   their own ideals, they wanted to enrich the
> The Mayor's letter added that he and the                     earth by the construction of a monumental
> citizens of Chiampo hope that their contribu-                   edifice in marble-a project almost anachtion to the beauty and perfection of the new                     ronistic in an era when the protagonists of
> building will not be forgotten. And he enclosed                  building and architecture are cement, iron ,
> a booklet that the city published for the dedica-                aluminium, a nd glass.'
> tion of the column on 17 June 1979.                                The building is compared with the Parth-
> The booklet is a remarkable document. It                      enon (it is larger and more beautiful), and
> relates the history of the stonecutters of                       recalls 'a similar edifice, in Ionic style and with
> Chiampo-the origins of which are 'lost in the                    smaller dimensions' which was built in Haifa in
> mists of time', and tells how son succeeded                      1957 also by lndustria dei Marmi Vicentini-a
> father in the 'noble profession' almost as a                     reference to the Baha'i International Archives
> religious vocation, and the valley 'rang with the                building, erected by Shoghi Effendi as the first
> sweet song of hammers and chisels' as                            of the great Institutions of the Administrative
> stonecutting became a ' notable and charac-                      World Centre to be placed around the Arc on
> teristic source of life, riches, and art for the                 the face of Mt. Carmel.
> people of Chiampo'.                                                 The booklet notes that although 2,000
> In 1904, the town of Chiampo helped estab-                    workers laboured for fifteen years to build the
> lish a local School for the Arts and Professions                 Parthenon, the 2,400 cubic metres (about
> in an attempt to direct some of the local young                  9,600 metric tons) of marble for the Seat of the
> people into the one activity which the local                     Universal House of Justice were cut, shaped,
> 1   Adapted from Baha'( Internatio11a/ News Service, Bulletin    and carved by twenty workmen in only 26
> No. 102, 31August1979.                                       months- 'a prodigy made possible by the use
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                     315
> of machines alongside manual work' in all of        columns of the building in Haifa-identical in
> the geometrically-designed pieces. It points        material and execution-should be put in the
> out, however, that painstaking hand carving by      centre of the square in witness of the flourishtrue artists was necessary on many of the           ing art of our region and as an example and a
> pieces-the capitals, entablature, and cornices      warning to the younger generations, so that
> 'where the marble cutting and relief work had       they would not abandon an ancient and glorito recreate the magic play of light and chiaros-    ous tradition.'
> curo which is so enchanting in ancient build-          A parchment scroll was inserted into the
> ings'.                                              column as it was erected, explaining the pur-
> Then the booklet points out the reason for       pose for its existence and giving the names of
> erecting a duplicate of one of the columns in       all of the workmen who participated in the
> the main public square of Chiampo:                  'admirable collaboration' between the people
> The workmen realized that there was a dis-       of Chiampo and the Baha'i World Centre.
> tinct danger, because so few fine marble struc-        The booklet contains a long poem, of forty
> tures are being built today, that in Chiampo        stanzas, written in the dialect of the Veneto by
> itself 'of such great dedication and demon-         one of the marble-workers, Giulio Piazza.
> strated executive skill there would remain only     Some excerpts in both the original language
> the memory, inevitably destined to fade with        and in a somewhat literal translation are set out
> the passing of time. The marble workers, to         below:
> avoid this, decided that a sample of one of the
> 
> 'La xe la vera storia              'This is the true story
> de on tempio tanto caro            of a very rare temple,
> on laoro cuss{ raro                of such a dear one
> che lo devo racontar . ...         that I want to tell you of it. . . .
> 'Sto gran capolavoro               This great masterpiece
> che xe sta Jato a Ciampa           which was made in Chiampo
> i lo ga Jato artisi                was shaped by artists
> ancor de vecio stampo.             of the good old kind.
> Che ga Jato 'sto laora             This work was done
> xe sta tanta brava gente           by many good people
> e gh'e mancii poco                 and they would have done it
> che i lo fassa anca par gnente.    for nothing.
> Dire come l'e sta Jato             There is only one way
> ghe xe solo 'na solusion           to say how it has been done:
> no l'e sta Jato par intaresso,     Not for profit was it done,
> ma solo per passion . ...          but only for love ... .
> A stemo completando                We are now completing
> on laoro grande e belo             a great and beautiful work
> e tuto sarii messo                 which will be raised
> sul bet monte Carmelo.             on beautiful Mount Carmel.
> Xe scrito so la Bibia,             It is written in the Bible
> e non la xe legenda,               -and it is not a fablech'el sarii de Dio                 that it will be
> la so grande tenda . . . . '       the Great Tent of God . . . .'
> 
> (Translated from the booklet 'Una Colonna,
> Una Storia' ['A Column, A Story'] published in
> June 1979 by the town of Chiampo, Italy)
> 316                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> The Ita lian firm of lndustria dei Marmi         the design of the building itself.
> Vicentini in the spring of 1978 published an           They point out that their quarries will proimpressive eight-page brochure designed to          vide 85,000 cubic feet of 'Caesar's White'
> acquaint potential customers with the quality       marble of Pentelikon quality, the same marble
> of their work in architectural marble. The          that was used in the Parthenon in Athens. They
> entire booklet is devoted to the new Seat of the    further point out that the Parthenon has forty-
> Universal House of Justice .                        six columns each 31.5 feet high , while the new
> In many impressive pictures and rn               Seat of the Universal House of Justice has 'A
> accurately-written passages, the firm tells of      peristyle of fifty-eight columns, each thirtythe history of the Faith, the role of the Univer-   three feet high ... decorated with magnificient
> sal House of Justice, and gives some details of     entablatures and surmounted by a great dome.'
> 
> Booklet published by the town of Chiampo, Italy to commemorate the erection in the main
> public square of a duplicate of one of the columns which grace the new building for the Seat of
> the Universal House of Justice.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                              317
> 
> II
> THE HANDS OF THE CAUSE OF GOD
> 
> 1. THE HANDS OF THE CAUSE OF GOD AND
> THE EXTENSION OF THEIR FUNCTIONS INTO
> THE FUTURE
> A. THE RULERS AND THE LEARNED
> 
> IN every society and community of human                   Spiritual Assemblies and the Universal House
> beings there are those who are revered for their          of Justice , while the institutions of the
> learning and wisdom, and there are those who              'learned', which exercise no governing authorare invested with authority to govern. In relig-          ity over the believers, are accorded an exalted
> ious communities it has been usual for the legis-         rank which enables them to exert their benefilative and governing authority to be held by the          cent influence over all parts of the community.
> learned who have thus, as priests or as doctors           Commenting on this feature of the Baha'i
> of religious law, combined both capacities in             Administrative Order, the Universal House of
> the same persons. Other communities have,                 Justice wrote in its message of 24 April 1972:
> only too often, been riven by the conflict be-            The existence of institutions of such exalted rank,
> tween church and state, between priests and               comprising individuals who play such a vital role ,
> kings, or, in more modern terms, between                  who yet have no legislative, administrative or judicial
> intellectuals and the establishment. In the               authority, and are entirely devoid of priestly func-
> World Order of Baha'u'llah these two                      tions or the right to make authoritative interpretaextremes, of the over-concentration of author-            tions , is a feature of Baha'i administration unparality on the one hand and of division and conflict          leled in the religions of the past . . .
> on the other, are eliminated. The way this is             Developing this theme, the Universal House of
> achieved is one of the unique features of that            Justice referred in that same message to a letter
> Order and confers unimagined benefits upon                written on behalf of the Guardian on 14 March
> the Baha'i community.                                     1927, to the Spiritual Assembly of Istanbul, in
> In the Kitab-i-'Ahd (The Book of the                   which he expounded the Baha'i principle of
> Covenant) Baha'u'llah wrote, Blessed are the              action by majority vote. In this letter Shoghi
> rulers and the learned in Bahli. The Guardian,            Effendi points out how, in the past, it was cerinterpreting this passage, stated on 4                    tain individuals who 'accounted themselves as
> November 1931:                                            superior in knowledge and elevated in posi-
> In this holy cycle the 'learned' are, on the one hand     tion' who caused division, and that it was those
> the Hands of the Cause of God , and , on the other, the   ' who pretended to be the most distinguished of
> teachers and diffusers of His teachings who do not        all' who 'always proved themselves to be the
> rank as Hands, but who have atta ined an eminent          source of contention'. He praises God that
> position in the teaching work. As to the ' rulers' they   Baha'u' llah had withdrawn authority from 'the
> refer to the members of the Local, National and           unyielding and dictatorial views of the learned
> International Houses of Justice . The duties of each of   and the wise', rejected the assertions of indithese souls will be determined in the future. (Transviduals, even though recognized as the most
> lated from the Persian.)
> accomplished and learned among men, as
> Since those words were written the Baha'i               authoritative criteria, and 'ordained that all
> Administrative Order has developed rapidly                matters be referred to authorized centres and
> and is now functioning throughout the world.              assemblies' . Thus the institutions of the
> Under the supreme authority of the revealed               learned in the Baha'i Faith, while invested with
> Law of God the Baha'i community is governed               high rank and exercising invaluable moral
> by its elected institutions: Local and National           authority and influence, have no executive
> 318                                         THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> power other than in the direction of their own             contemplate its adm inistrative structure uninstitutions.                                              influenced by concepts from past ages, will the vital
> The difficulty of establishing a clear under-           interdependence of the 'rulers' and 'learned' in the
> standing of this administrative concept, new in            Faith be properly understood, and the inestimable
> the history of religion, is reflected in the con-          value of their interaction be fully recognised.
> cluding passage of the message of the Univer-                 Only now, as these two arms of the worldsal House of Justice, of 24 April 1972, quoted             embracing system of Baha'u'llah begin to funcabove:                                                     tion in their separate but complementary roles
> ... The newness and uniquen ess of this concept            towards a common achievement, are intimamake it difficult to grasp; only as the Baha'i commu-      tions caught of the divine beneficence of that
> nity grows and the believers are increasingly able to      system.
> 
> B. THE HANDS OF THE CAUSE OF GOD
> 
> Baha'u'llah Himself created the institution                 . .. The Hands oft he Cause of God must elect from
> of the Hands of the Cause and appointed a few              their own number nine persons that shall at all times
> of His followers to serve Him as Hands in His              be occupied in the important services in the work of
> the Guardian of the Cause of God. The election of
> own lifetime. In the Tablet of the World He
> these nine must be carried either unanimously or by
> refers to the Hands of the Cause in words
> majority from the company of the Hands of the Cause
> descriptive of the station of service to which             of God and these, whether unanimously or by a
> they are called:                                           majority vote, must give their assent to the choice of
> Light and glory, greeting and praise be upon the           the one whom the Guardian of the Cause of God hath
> Hands of His Cause through whom the light of for-          chosen as his successor ...
> titude hath shone forth and the truth hath been estab-        0 friends! The Hands of the Cause of God must be
> lished that the authority to choose rests with God, the    nominated and appointed by the Guardian of the
> Powerful, the Mighty, the Unconstrained, through           Cause of God. All must be under his shadow and obey
> whom the ocean of bounty hath surged and the fra -         his command . ...
> grance of the gracious favours of God, the Lord of            The obligations of the Hands of the Cause of God
> mankind, hath been diffused. We beseech                    are to diffuse the Divine Fragrances, to edify the souls
> Him-Exalted is He-to shield them through the power         of men, to promote learning, to improve the character
> of His hosts, to protect them through the potency of       of all men and to be, at all times and under all condi-
> His dominion and to aid them through His indomit-          tions, sanctified and detached from earthly things.
> able strength which prevaileth over all created things.    They must manifest the fear of God by their conduct,
> Sovereignty is God's, the Creator of the heavens and       their manners, their deeds and their words. This body
> the Lord of the Kingdom of Names.                          of the Hands of the Cause of God is under the direction of the Guardian of the Cause of God. He must
> The Will and Testament of 'Abdu'l-Baha                  continually urge them to strive and endeavour to the
> contains many references to the Hands of the               utmost of their ability to diffuse the sweet savours of
> Cause, including explicit definitions of their             God, and to guide al/ the peoples of the world, for it is
> station and functions , as well as various admo-           the light of Divine Guidance that causeth all the universe to be illumined. To disregard, though it be for a
> nitions addressed to them:
> moment, this absolute command which is binding
> Salutation and praise, blessing and glory rest . .. upon   upon everyone, is in no wise permilled, that the surthe Hands of the Cause of God that have diffused           face of the earth may become heavenly, that contenwidely the Divine Fragrances, declared His Proofs,         tion and conflict amidst peoples, kindreds, nations
> proclaimed His Faith, published abroad His Law,            and governments may disappear, that all the dwellers
> detached themselves from all things but Him, stood         on earth may become one people and one race, that
> for righteousness in this world, and kindled the Fire of   the world may become even as one home.
> the Love of God in the very hearts and souls of His
> 'Abdu'l-Baha did not Himself appoint any
> servants; ... the Hands of the Cause of God must be
> additional Hands of the Cause. He did, however watchful and so soon as they find anyone beginning to oppose and protest against the Guardian oft he     ever, refer to certain outstanding teachers of
> Cause of God cast him out from the congregation of         the Faith as Hands.
> the people of Bahci and in no wise accept any excuse         During the first three decades of his ministry
> from him . ..                                              as Guardian of the Faith, Shoghi Effendi
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                               319
> designated certain outstanding Baha'is as                         tion of the Faith, to act as the 'assistants,
> Hands posthumously. Then, in December                             deputies and advisers' of the Hands of that
> 1951, he raised twelve living believers to this                   continent.
> exalted rank, a development of the Adminis-                          The epic story of how in November 1957,
> trative Order which thrilled the entire Baha'i                    the Hands of the Cause of God, called by the
> world . In February 1952 he appointed a                           Guardian the 'Chief Stewards of Baha'u'llah's
> further seven, and in 1957 eight more, bringing                   embryonic World Commonwealth', rallied the
> the total number to twenty-seven.' In these                       grief-stricken and stunned Baha'is of the
> brief six years the Guardian not only estab-                      world, guided them to the victorious accomlished this institution on a firm foundation                      plishment of the Ten Year Crusade which he
> throughout the world, with a body of four                         had launched, and convened the members of
> Hands of the Cause residing in the Holy Land                      the National Spiritual Assemblies for the first
> to act as the liaison between himself and the                     election of the Universal House of Justice in
> Hands in each continent, but he brought into                      April 1963, has been told in befitting detail in
> being in each continent two Auxiliary Boards,                     Volume XIII of this publication.
> one for the protection and one for the propaga-
> 
> C. THE CONTINENTAL BOARDS OF
> COUNSELLORS
> The establishment of the Universal House of                    of Justice as the supreme and central institution of
> Justice in 1963 ushered in a new phase in the                     the Faith to which all must turn.
> evolution of the institution of the Hands of the                     That same message announced increases in
> Cause. In October 1963 the House of Justice                       the number of the members of the Auxiliary
> decided 'that there is no way to appoint or                       Boards for propagation in every continent, and
> legislate to make it possible to appoint a second                 the Hands were requested to appoint one or
> Guardian to succeed Shoghi Effendi'. There-                       more members of each Auxiliary Board to act
> fore, among the first questions which it was                      in an executive capacity on their behalf and in
> necessary for it then to consider were the man-                   the name of each Hand, for the direction of the
> ner in which the institution of the Hands of the                  work of the Boards. The message continued:
> Cause was to continue to perform its appointed                    The exalted rank and specific functions of the Hands
> functions, the relationship which should exist                    of the Cause of God make it inappropriate for them
> between the House of Justice and the Hands of                     to be elected or appointed to administrative instituthe Cause, and how the indispensable func-                        tions, or to be elected as delegates to national contions of the Hands of the Cause could be                          ventions. Furthermore, it is their desire and the
> extended into the future, since, according to                     desire of the House of Justice that they be free to
> devote their entire energies to the vitally important
> the text of the Will and Testament of 'Abdu'lduties conferred upon them in the Holy Writings.
> Baha, The Hands of the Cause of God must be
> nominated and appointed by the Guardian of                           At the same time the House of Justice
> the Cause of God.                                                 confirmed the request of the Hands of the
> Following consultation with a conclave of                      Cause that, henceforth, members of the Auxilthe Hands in October- November 1964, the                          iary Boards should be freed from administra-
> Universal House of Justice announced to the                       tive responsibilities, including service on combelievers in its message of November 1964 the                     mittees and as delegates to conventions.
> following decisions:                                                 On 21 June 1968 the House of Justice
> announced by cable to the Baha'i world the
> There is no way to appoint, or to legislate to make it            decision to establish eleven Continental
> possible to appoint, Hands of the Cause of God.
> Boards of Counsellors for the protection and
> Responsibility for decisions on matters of general                propagation of the Faith and , in a written mespolicy affecting the institution of the Hands of the              sage issued on 24 June, outlined in detail the
> Cause, which was formerly exercised by the beloved                nature and scope of this action. Because of its
> Guardian, now devolves upon the Universal House                   great significance to the evolution of the
> See 'The Instituiion of the Hands oft he Cause of God', The   Administrative Order, the entire text of this
> Baha '{ World, vol. Xlll, p. 334.                             message is quoted:
> 320                                 THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> The Continental Board of Counsellors for
> Australasia; January 1977. Left to right: Mr.
> Owen Battrick, Dr. Peter Khan, Miss Thelma
> Perks, Mr. Suhayl 'Ala'(, Miss Violet
> Hoehnke, Mr. Howard Harwood.
> 
> The Continental Board of Counsellors for
> Central America; March 1977. Seated, left to
> right: Mr. Artemus Lamb, Mrs. Carmen de
> Burafato, Dr. Hidayatu'llah Al:tmadfyyih.
> Standing, left to right: Mr. Rowland Estall,
> Mr. Alfred Osborne, Mr. Paul Lucas.
> 
> The Continental Board of Counsellors for
> North America; October 1976. Left to right:
> Mr. Lloyd Gardner, Dr. Sarah M. Pereira,
> Mrs. Velma Sherrill, Miss Edna True, Mr.
> Angus Cowan.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                               321
> The majestic unfoldment of Baha'u'llah's world-         laborating with Nationa l Spiritual Assemblies, and
> redeeming administrative system has been marked             keeping the Hands of the Cause and the Universal
> by the successive establishment of the various institu-     House of Justice in formed concerning the conditions
> tions and agencies wh ich constitute the framework of      of the Cause in their areas.
> that divinely-created Order. Thus, more than a                 Initially eleven Boards of Counsellors have been
> quarter-of-a-century after the emergence of th e first     appointed, one for each of the following areas:
> National Spiritual Assemblies of the Baha'i world           Northwestern Africa, Central and East Africa,
> the institution of the Hands of the Cause of God was       Southern Africa, North America, Central America,
> formally established, with the appointment by the          South America, Western Asia, Southeastern Asia,
> beloved Guardian, in conformity with the provisions         Northeastern Asia, Australasia and Europe.
> of 'Abdu'l-Baha's Will and Testament, of the first            The members of these Boards of Counsellors will
> contingent of these high-ranking officers of the Faith.    serve for a term, or terms, the length of which will be
> Following the passing of the Guard ian of the Cause        determined and anno unced at a later date, and while
> of God, it fell to the House of Justice to devise a way,   serving in this capacity, will not be eligible for memwithin the Administrative Order, of developing 'the         bership on nationa l or loca l administrative bodies.
> institution of the Hands of the Cause with a view to       One member of each Continental Board of Counselextension into the future of its appointed functions of    lors has been designated as Trustee of the Continenprotection and propagation', and this was made a           tal Fund for its area .
> goal of the Nine Year Plan. Much thought and study            The Auxiliary Boards for protection and propagahas been given to the question over the past four          tion will henceforth report to the Continental Boards
> years, and the texts have been collected and               of Counsellors who will appoint or replace members
> reviewed. During the last two months, th is goal, as       of the Auxiliary Boards as circumstances may
> announced in our cable to the National Conventions,        require. Such appointments and replacements as
> has been the object of prolonged and prayerful con-        may be necessary in the initial stages will take place
> sultation between the Universa l House of Justice and      after consultation with the Hand or Hands previthe Hands of the Cause of God. All this made evident       ously assigned to the continent or zone.
> the framework withi n which this goa l was to be              The Hands of the Cause of God have the prerogaachieved, namely:                                          tive and obligation to consult with the Continental
> The Universal House of Justice sees no way in            Boards of Counsellors and National Spiritual
> which additional Hands of the Cause of God can           Assemblies on any subject which, in their view,
> be appointed.                                            affects the interests of the Cause. The Hands residing
> in the Holy Land will act as liaison between the
> The absence of the Guardian of the Faith brought         Universal House of Justice and the Continental
> about an entirely new relationship between the           Boards of Counsellors, and will also assist the Uni-
> Universal House of Justice and the Hands of the          versal House of Justice in setting up, at a propitious
> Cause and called for the progressive unfoldm ent         time , an international teaching centre in the Holy
> by the Universal House of Justice of the manner in       Land, as anticipated in the Guardian's writings.
> which the Hands of the Cause would carry out                The Hands of the Cause of God are one of the
> their divinely-conferred functions of protection         most precious assets the Baha'i world possesses.
> and propagation.                                         Released from administration of the Auxiliary
> Whatever new development or institution is initi-        Boards, they will be able to concentrate their enerated should come into operation as soon as pos-          gies on the more primary responsibilities of general
> sible in order to reinforce and supplement the work      protection and propagation, 'preservation of the
> of th~ Hands of the Cause while at the same time         spiritual health of the Baha'i communities' and 'the
> taking full advantage of the opportunity of having       vitality of the faith' of the Baha'is throughout the
> the Hands themselves assist in launching and guid-       world. The House of Justice will call upon them to
> ing the new procedures.                                  undertake special missions on its behalf, to represent
> it on both Baha'i and other occasions and to keep it
> Any such institution must grow and operate in
> informed of the welfare of the Cause. While the
> harmony with the principles governing the func-
> Hands of the Cause will, naturally, have special contioning of the institution of the Hands of the Cause
> cern for the affairs of the Cause in the areas in which
> of God.
> they reside, they will operate increasingly on an
> In the light of these considerations the Universal      intercontinental level, a factor which will lend tre-
> House of Justice decided, as announced in its recent       mendous impetus to the diffusion throughout the
> cable, to establish Continental Boards of Counsel-         Baha'i world of the spiritual inspiration channelled
> lors for the protection and propagation of the Faith.      through them-the Chief Stewards of Baha'u'llah's
> Their duties will include directing the Auxiliary          embryonic World Commonwealth.
> Boards in their respective areas, consulting and col-         With joyful hearts we proclaim this further
> 322                                         THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> unfoldment of the Administrative Order of Baha' u'-        iary Board members to appoi nt assista nts,
> llah and join our prayers to those of the friends          whose duti es would be to activate and encourthro ughout the East and the West that Baha'u'llah         age Local Spiritual Assemblies, to call the
> may continue to showe r his confirm ations upon the
> attention of Local Spiritual Assembly me meffo rts of His servants in the safeguard ing and promotion of His Faith .                                       bers to the importance of reg ul a r meetings, to
> e ncourage local communities to gather for
> A clarification of the status of Co unsello rs          Nineteen Day Feasts a nd Holy Days, to he lp
> and their re lationship to National Spiritual              deepen their fellow-believers' understanding
> Assemblies was made by the House of Justice                of th e teachings , and genera lly to assist the
> in a letter to a National Spiritual Assembly in            A uxi li ary Board me mbe rs in the d ischarge of
> May 1975:                                                  their duties. T he adv ice, at that time, was to
> ... (it) must be one of warm and active collabora-         proceed graduall y with this new step so that
> tion, a full sharing in the excitement and the chal-       ex perie nce could indicate the most effective
> lenge of the teaching work and the establishment of        manner of its operation. Since then, as a result
> living and growing Baha'i communities . . . While the
> of the proven value of this expanded service,
> role of the Co unsellors is normally to adv ise, encourappo intm ents of assis ta nts in each zone have
> age and reinfo rce, and they have no legislative or
> administrative authority, they nevertheless occupy a       been steadily and rapidly a ugme nted. The le tra nk superi or to that of the National Assembly or its    ter of 8 June 1973 stated that 'believers can
> members and each individual Counsellor is a high           serve at the same time both as assistants to
> officer of the Faith entitled to the respect, honour       A uxi liary Board members a nd on administraand courtesy due to his ra nk. Each country which is       tive institutions'.
> privileged to have a resident Counsellor should prize         Adjustments to the number of Continental
> that privilege. Each National Assembly which has a         Boards of Counsellors are made as the Univer-
> Counsell or at hand for frequent consultations             sal House of Justice deems necessary, entailing
> should, without relinquishing any portion of its
> adjustments to zones assig ned to th e Boards, to
> divinely assigned authority, call upon him often for
> the number of Counsellors and to the numbers
> his views and accord great weight to his advice.
> of A uxiliary Boards a nd A uxiliary Board
> On 8 .Tune 1973 a further directive was sent            me mbers. 1 Thus th e institution operates a t all
> to the Continental Boards of Co unsellors                  levels throughout the world, reaching into the
> which answered the need discussed by the                   basic structure of local community life and
> Co unsellors during their sessio ns in the Holy            exerting its enco uraging an d uplifting influence
> Land, at th e time of the Interna tion a l Conven-         upon the li ves of indi viduals and the deliberation of th a t year, for some method to enable             tions of institutions, constantly watching over
> their institution to reach more deeply in to the           the securit y of the Faith , pointing the way to
> fabric of the Baha'i world comm unity. The                 the promotion of its best interests, and to the
> House of Justice authorized each Board of                  ever wider dissemination of its healing mes-
> Counsellors, at its discretion, to permit Aux il-          sage.
> 
> D. THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING
> CENTRE
> 
> Assurance of the extension into the future of           ship of Contine nta l Boards of Counsellors to
> the appoint~d functions of protection and                  Na tion al Spiritual Asse mblies will follow the
> propaga tion conferred upon the Hands of the               pattern of the relationship betwee n the Hands
> Cause was accomplished by the establishment                of the Cause and National Spiritual Assemof the Continental Boards of Counsellors.                  blies, outlined by the beloved Guardian in vari-
> However, tha t vital goal hav ing been accom-              o us communications'.
> plished, the problem remained of o rdering the                The cablegram addressed by the Unive rsal
> work of th e new institution so that it wou ld             House of J ustice to all National Spiritual
> grow organically with the Faith itself.                    ' At Ri<jvan 1979 there are thirteen Continental Boards of
> In a letter addressed to all National Spiritual           Counsellors, each Continenta l Board having two Auxiliary
> Boards, one for protection and one for propagatio n; and
> Assemblies on 24 June 1968 the Universal                     each Auxiliary Board member having assistants as needed
> House of Justice confirmed that ' th e relation-             and authorized .
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                                        323
> 
> Assemblies on 21 June 1968 announcing the                       provisions of the Will and Testament of the Centre of
> establishment of Continental Boards of Coun-                    the Mighty Cove nant is the body which shou ld lay
> sellors had contained a reference to the 'future                down laws not explicitly revealed in the Text. In this
> Dispensation, these laws are destined to flow from
> establishment international teaching centre
> this holy mountain , even as in the Mosaic Dispensa-
> Holy Land foreshadowed writings beloved
> tion the law of God was promulgated from Zion. The
> Guardian.'                                                      'sa iling of the Ark' of His laws is a reference to the
> In October 1971 the Hands of the Cause                       es tabli shment of the Universa l House of Justice,
> were notified that afte r the International Con-                which is indeed the Seat of Legislation, one of the
> vention for the election of the Universal House                 branches of the World Administrative Centre of the
> of Justice during Ric;lvan 1973, their presence                 Baha'fs on this holy mountain. It will be housed in a
> in the Holy Land for a period of time in order                  separate building near the International Archives
> to consult on a number of important subjects                    building, now under constructio n, on a site in the
> would be most welcome. The foremost topic                       neighbourhood of the Shrine of th e Bab, and overwould be the establishment of the international                 lookin g the sacred an d illumined Monuments. In the
> neighbourhood of these two stately edifices and two
> teaching centre about which the Hands had
> mighty Institutions (i.e. the Archives Building and
> previously been requested to submit their writ-                 the edifice for the House of Justice), another edifice
> ten views. The Universal House of Justice, in                   will gradually be erected which will be the Seat of the
> its letter to the Hands of the Cause in October                 Guardianship, the Centre which will interpret,
> 1971, cited, amongst others, the following three                expound and prepare commentaries on explicitly
> quotations from the Guardian which antici-                      revealed laws, and will reinforce and supplement the
> pated the evolution of the World Administra-                    legislative body. Yet another ed ifi ce to supplement
> tive Centre of the Faith on Mount Carmel and                    these three edifices will be the Centre for the propathe establishment there of an international                     gation and teaching of the Faith, the Seat for the
> teaching centre as the seat of the Hands of the                 Hands of the Cause, who, in accordance with the
> explicit text of the Will and Testament are charged
> Cause of God:
> with the security, the preserva tion and protection of
> ... it must be clearly understood, nor can it be                the Cause, the safeguarding of the unity of the comsufficiently emphasized, that the conjunction of the            munity , the promotion of God's religion and the
> resting-place of the Greatest Holy Leaf with those of           spread of His Word. These majestic and mighty
> her brother and mother incalculably reinforces the              edifices, which will be constructed gradually in
> spiritual potencies of that consecrated Spot which,             accordance with a beautiful and unique style of
> under the wings of the Bab's overshadowing Sepul-               architecture around the sacred Monuments, are all
> chre, and in the vicinity of the future Mafillriqu'l-           considered as branches of this highly-exalted,
> Adhkar, which will be reared on its flank, is destined          firmly-grounded and broadly-based World Administo evolve into the focal centre of those world-                 trative Centre of the followers of the Cause of Him
> shaking, world-embracing, world-directing adm inis-             Who is the Lord of this Age and the Ruler of Creatrative institutions, ordained by Baha'u'llah a nd              tion. '
> anticipated by' Abdu'l-Baha, and which are to func-                The raising of this edifice (International Baha'i
> tion in consonance with the principles that govern              Arch ives) will in turn herald the construction, in the
> the twin institut ions of the Guardianship and the              course of successive epochs of the Formative Age of
> Un iversal House of Justice. Then, and then only, will          the Faith, of several other structures, which will serve
> th is momentous prophecy which illuminates the con-             as the adm inistrative seats of such divinely appointed
> cluding passages of the Tablet of Carmel be fulfilled:          institutions as the Guardianship, the Hands of the
> Ere long will God sail His Ark upon thee (Carmel)               Cause, and the Universal House of Justice. These
> and will manifest the people of Bahd who have been              edifices will , in the shape of a far-flung arc, and
> mentioned in the Book of Names. 1                               following a harmon izing style of architecture, sur-
> In this great Tablet which unveils divine mysteries          round the resting places of the Greatest Holy Leaf,
> and heralds the establishment of two mighty, majes-             ranking as foremost a mong the members of her sex in
> tic and momentous undertakings-one of which is                  the Baha'i Dispensation, of her brother, offered up
> spiritual and the other administrative, both at the             as a ransom by Baha' u'llah for the quickening of the
> World Centre of the Faith-Baha'u'llah refers to an              world and its unification, and of their mother, pro-
> 'Ark' , whose dwellers are the men of the Supreme               claimed by Him to be His chosen 'consort in all the
> House of Justice, which, in conformity with the exact           worlds of God'. The ultimate completion of this
> stupendous undertaking wi ll mark the culmin ation of
> Shoghi Effendi, letter to the National Spiritual Assembly
> of the United States, 21December1939; see Messages to           Shoghi Effendi, letter in Persian to the BaM'is of the East,
> America, pp. 32-33 .                                            Naw-Ruz 111 (1954).
> 324                                            THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> the development of a world-wide divinely-appointed            of the Cause, which must be raised on the arc on
> Administrative Order whose beginnings may be                  Mount Carmel in close proximity to the Seat of the
> traced as far back as the concluding years of the             Universal House of Justice.
> heroic Age of the Faith.'                                       The duties now assigned to this nascent institution
> On 5 June 1973, following the International                are :
> Convention and the consultations with the                        To co-ordinate, stimulate and direct the activities
> Hands of the Cause, and less than a month                        of the Continental Boards of Counsellors and to
> act as li aison between them and the Universal
> after the Counsellors had left the Holy Land to
> House of Justice.
> resume their services within their zones, the
> following announcement was cabled by the                        To be fully informed of the situation of the Cause
> Universal House of Justice to all National                      in all parts of the world and to be able, from the
> Spiritual Assemblies:                                           background of this knowledge, to make reports
> and recommendations to the Universal House of
> ANNOUNCE ESTABLISHMENT HOLY LAND LONG                           Justice and give advice to the Continental Boards
> ANTICIPATED INTERNATIONAL TEACHING CENTRE                       of Counsellors.
> DESTINED EVOLVE INTO ONE THOSE WORLD SHAK-
> To be alert to possibilities, both within and without
> ING      WORLD      EMBRACING       WORLD      DIRECTING
> the Baha'i community, for the extension of the
> ADMINISTRATIVE          INSTITUTIONS      ORDAINED      BY
> teaching work into receptive or needy areas, and
> BAHA'U'LLAH         ANTICIPATED      BY   'ABDU'L-BAHA
> to draw the attention of the Universal House of
> ELUCIDATED BY SHOGHI EFFENDI STOP MEMBER-                       Justice and the Continental Boards of Counsellors
> SHIP THIS NASCENT INSTITUTION COMPRISES ALL                     to such possibilities, making recommendations for
> HANBS CAUSE GOD AND INITIALLY THREE COUN-                       action.
> SELLORS WHO WITH HANDS PRESENT HOLY LAND
> To determine and anticipate needs for literature ,
> WILL CONSTITUTE NUCLEUS ITS VITAL OPERATIONS
> pioneers and travelling teachers and to work out
> STOP CALLING UPON HOOPER DUNBAR FLORENCE                        teaching plans, both regional and global, for the
> MAYBERRY AZIZ YAZDI              PROCEED    HOLY LAND           approval of the Universal House of Justice.
> ASSUME THIS HIGHLY MERITORIOUS SERVICE STOP
> All the Hands of the Cause of God will be mem-
> OFFERING PRAYERS HEARTFELT GRATITUDE SAC-
> bers of the International Teachin g Centre. Each
> RED       THRESHOLD       THIS    FURTHER      EVIDENCE
> Hand will be kept regularly informed of the activities
> ORGANIC        EVOLUTION      ADMINISTRATIVE       ORDER      of the Centre through reports or copies of its
> BAHA'U'LLAH.                                                  minutes, and will be able, wherever he may be resid-
> It was followed three days later by this                    ing or travelling, to convey suggestions, recommenexpanded announcement to the Baha'fs of the                   dations and information to the Centre and, whenever
> he is in the Holy Land, to take part in the consultaworld:
> tions and other activities of the Centre .
> The centennial year of the revelation of the Kitab-           In addition, we now appoint Mr. Hooper Dunbar,
> i-Aqdas has already witnessed events of such capital          Mrs. Florence Mayberry and Mr. 'Aziz Yazdi to
> significance in the annals of the Baha'i Dispensation         membership of the International Teaching Centre,
> as to cause us to contemplate with awe the rapidity           with the rank of Counsellor. These believers, who
> with which Divine Providence is advancing the                 have been serving with distinction on the Con tinen-
> Cause of the Most Great Name . The time is indeed             tal Boards of Counse llors in South America, North
> propitious for the establishment of the International         America a nd Central and East Africa respectively,
> Teaching Centre, a development which , at one and             will henceforth reside in Haifa and will, together with
> the same time, brings to fruition the work of the             the Hands present in the Holy Land, constitute the
> Hands of the Cause residing in the Holy Land and              nucleus of the operations of the Centre.
> provides for its extension into the future , links the           Authority for the expulsion and reinstatement of
> institution of the Boards of Counsellors even more            Covenant-breakers remains with the Hands of the
> intimately with that of the Hands of the Cause of             Cause of God. All such matters will be investigated
> God, and powerfully reinforces the discharge of the           locally by the relative Continental Board of Counselrapidly growing responsibilities of the Universal             lors in consultation with any Hand or Hands who
> House of Justice.                                             may be in the area. The Continental Board of Coun-
> This International Teaching Centre now estab-              sellors and the Hands concerned will then make their
> lished will, in due course, operate from that building        reports to the International Teaching Centre where
> designated by the Guardian as the Seat for the Hands          they will be considered. The decision whether or not
> Shoghi Effendi, letter to the BaM'is of the world, 27     to expel or reinstate will be made by the Hands of the
> November 1954; see Messages to the Baha'i World, p. 74.   Cause residing in the Holy Land who will, as at
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                        325
> present, submit their decision to the Universal         the request of the House of Justice the Teach-
> House of Justice for approval. ...                      ing Centre also evolved a plan for international
> The decisions now announced are the outcome of        collaboration on travelling teaching projects.
> deliberation extending over a number of years, rein-       The divinely ordained institution of the
> forced by consultations with the Hands of the Cause
> Hands of the Cause of God, having been
> of God, and especially with the Hands residing in the
> Holy Land who were requested in 1968 to assist the
> brought into active reality by the Guardian of
> Universal House of Justice in the establishment of      the Faith according to the directives of
> the International Teaching Centre, a task that now      ' Abdu'l-Baha's Will and Testament, was conincreases in magnitude as that Centre begins its        fronted in its infancy with an appalling crisis in
> work .                                                  the life of that Faith whose protection was its
> One of the first tasks assigned by the Univer-       prime duty. During the interregnum between
> sal House of Justice to the International Teach-        the passing of the Guardian and the election of
> ing Centre was to devise the broad outlines of          the Universal House of Justice, the Hands of
> the global teaching plan to begin at Ric;lvan           the Cause as its Chief Stewards, maintained the
> 1974 and conclude five years later at Ric;lvan          integrity and unity of the Faith. The functions
> 1979. This comprehensive and detailed survey            of protection and propagation appointed to
> of the entire Baha'i world community provided           this great institution have now been extended
> an opportunity for the Teaching Centre to               into the future in a manner consonant with the
> become thoroughly acquainted with the condi-            principles of the Faith. The Continental
> tions, needs and potentialities of the one              Boards of Counsellors with their attendant
> hundred and thirteen national Baha'i com-               Auxiliary Boards for protection and propagamunities which made up the Baha'i interna-              tion, the assistants to the Auxiliary Board
> tional community at Ric;lvan 1973. A greatly            members, all co-ordinated and kept in relaincreased flow of vital information from the            tionship to the Universal House of Justice by
> Continental Boards of Counsellors was called            the International Teaching Centre, form the
> for by the International Teaching Centre,               fabric of the appointive arm of the Administrawhich promised, in turn, the development of an          tive Order of the Faith, which will in increasing
> increasingly close relationship between itself          measure exert its spiritualizing influence upon
> and the Boards through a similarly increased            the development of the Baha'i community and
> flow of materials from the Teaching Centre. At          of all mankind .
> 
> •
> The Hand of the Cause Abu'l-Qasim Faizi (second from right) during his visit to Fiji in March
> 1977 presented copies of The Proclamation of Baha'u'llah and The Baha'i World, vol. XV, to
> Professor L. F. Brosnahan (second from left), Deputy Vice-Chancellor and acting Head o fthe
> School of Education, University of the South Pacific, Suva. Also seen are Mr. John Weeks,
> Reader in Education (far left), and Mr. Ivan Williams, Lecturer in Education (far right).
> 326                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 2. THE WORK AND TRAVELS OF THE HANDS
> OF THE CAUSE
> As    the Five Year Plan came to an end it was     believers in their teaching work and in the
> possible to see in perspective the vital role of   decoration of their newly-acquired I::Ia?fratu'lthe Hands of the Cause of God as they con-         Quds, and became so attached to the Bermuda
> tinued their worldwide services of protecting      Baha'fs that she later described herself as a
> the Cause, proclaiming its truths, deepening the   'mini-pioneer' to that island.
> knowledge of its adherents and, by example,            In the latter half of 1977 Rul).fyyih Khan um
> inspiring them to greater heights of dedicated     returned to India where, in addition to reactivity. The section of this volume that deals    visiting some centres she had visited previwith the growth of national communities bears      ously , she travelled to Chandigarh, joint capinumerous references to the stimulating visits of   tal of Punjab and Haryana States, and to
> the Hands as they criss-crossed the Baha'f         Kashmir. She also revisited Nepal. A gracious
> world in their travels. The section on the eight   reception was accorded her by various people
> International Teaching Conferences features        prominent in Government and public life in
> their outstanding contributions to those extra-    India . Mid-October found her in New Delhi as
> ordinary occasions of proclamation and of          the guest of honour at the Asian Baha'f
> ingathering of the friends. The list of twelve      Women's Conference attended by more than
> inaugural Conventions points to those Hands         1,000 women from some thirty countries. Folwho, as representatives of the Universal House     lowing this she represented the Universal
> of Justice, graced these gatherings, while all      House of Justice at the ceremony of the laying
> who were able to do so attended the fourth         of the foundation stone of the Mashriqu'l-
> International Baha'f Convention in Haifa in         Adhkar of India.
> April 1978.                                            Illness forced the abandonment of Ru!Jfyyih
> The following is a brief summary of major        Khanum's long-cherished plan to visit the
> travels and works during the three years           Japanese friends immediately following her
> covered by this volume, a summation which          Indian tour. She broke her journey in Australia
> can do little more than hint at the influence      where she sought treatment and recuperation
> exerted by the Hands of the Cause through           but even here, though her activities were cirtheir presence, their constant correspondence      cumscribed by her impaired health, she met
> or their direct endeavours in support of the        with the friends and made herself available for
> manifold programmes of expansion and con-          interviews with representatives of the media.
> solidation organized by the believers.             En route to the Holy Land in February she
> stopped off in the Philippines and in Bombay
> Amatu'l-Bahti Rul:ziyyih Khtinum                   for meetings with the Baha'fs, a nd in April
> In addition to her services in the Holy Land     took part in the sessions of the fourth Internaas a member of the International Teaching           tional Baha'i Convention in Haifa.
> Centre, Amatu'l-Baha Rul).fyyih Khanum in              A globe-girdling trip of eight months' durathe period under review made a number of            tion commenced in July. After visiting Baha'f
> journeys, visiting Baha'f communities in            communities in Europe and the United King-
> Europe, Asia, the Far East and the Pacific re-      dom Amatu'l-Baha proceeded to Japan to realgion. Her attendance as the representative of       ize the plan she had reluctantly abandoned the
> the Universal House of Justice at the Interna-      year before, visiting thirty-five centres on the
> tional Teaching Conference held in Paris in         four principal islands, Honshu, Hokkaido,
> August 1976-largest of the eight conferences        Shikoku and Kyushu, where meetings with the
> in the series held during the Five Year Plan and    friends, addresses to non-Baha'f organizations
> reported in detail elsewhere in this vol-           and interviews with prominent officials fully
> ume-was a source of great inspiration and joy       occupied her time, a pattern of intensity which
> to the friends, approximately 6,000 in number,      did not lessen on her subsequent visit to
> who were present. Later that year she spent         Taiwan, Hong Kong and Macau.
> several months in Bermuda assisting the                 Following this Ru!Jfyyih Khan um spent nine
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA ' U ' LLAH                                  327
> weeks in another hemisphere, the pivot of this    Europe, attending many summer and winter
> period being her attendance as the representa-    schools, teaching and youth conferences,
> tive of the Universal House of Justice at the     national conventions, and travelling at interceremony for the laying of the foundation         vals to inspirit the friends in various countries.
> stone of the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar of Samoa , par-    He was the representative of the Universal
> ticipating in this significant event with His     House of Justice at the inaugural convention of
> Highness Ma lietoa Tanumafi li II, Head of        the National Spiritual Assembly of Cyprus in
> State of Western Samoa, in whose capital,         1978. As special missions from the Universal
> Apia, the Temple will rise. A warm and hospit-    House of Justice, Dr. Giachery journeyed to
> able reception was accorded by His Highness       London in September 1976 to meet His Highand enthusiastic welcomes greeted her visits to   ness Malietoa Tanumafili II at the time of his
> the three main islands of Savai'i and Upolu       visit to the resting place of Shoghi Effendi. In
> (Western Samoa) and Tutuila (American             May 1977 Dr. G iachery journeyed to Western
> Samoa).                                           Samoa to participate, as the representative of
> Proceeding by way of Fiji , New Hebrides       the House of Justice, in the observance of
> and New Caledonia where she met with the          Independence Day.
> friends and reinforced their teaching efforts,
> Rul:Uyyih Khanum arrived in New Zealand           'Ali-Akbar Furutan
> where she visited both the North and South           Continuing his triad of services to the Cause
> Islands, taking particular delight in the meet-   in the Holy Land, Mr.' Ali-Akbar Furutan has
> ings held on the Maori Maraes which provided      devoted his energies to the International
> an opportunity of becoming acquainted with        Teaching Centre, to the many pilgrims and
> the Maori Baha'fs and believers from other        visitors, and to scholarly researches and writing
> Pacific islands. Travelling homeward at the end   in areas of importance to the Faith. In the
> of March she met again Baha'fs of Hong Kong       summer periods he has cor.centrated on sumand Bombay.                                       mer school activities afield while undertaking
> other teaching assignments: to the U.S.A. and
> Ugo Giachery                                      Canada in 1976, proceed ing thence to India for
> From his home in Monaco, Dr. Ugo                conferences and proclamation activities and to
> Giachery has been involved primarily with aid-    Hong Kong for the International Teaching
> ing and stimulating the Baha'i communities of     Conference; in 1977 to England, the U.S.A.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause 'AU-Akbar Furutan (second from left) paying a courtesy call on Mr.
> Krishan Chand, Lieutenant Governor of India; November 1976. Left to right: Counsellor
> Zena Sorabjee, Mr. Furutan, Mr. Krishan Chand, Mrs. Furutan, Mr. R. N . Shah.
> 328                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> and Canada, on to Alaska , Japan and to Iran        Miihlschlegel has continued steadily to write
> for four months of intensive teaching; and in       on behalf of the Faith and to engage in schol-
> 1978 to western Europe to teach at four sum-        arly, studies. In June 1977 the National
> mer schools and visit believers in six countries.   Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of Germany ,
> in tribute to Dr. Miihlschlegel, produced
> Dhikru'llah Khlldem                                 through its Publishing Trust a selection of his
> In August 1976 Mr. Dhikru'llah Khadem            poems . After visiting the Holy Land in
> completed an extensive International Registry       November 1977 Dr. Miihlschlegel returned to
> of Bahti'{ Holy Places and Historic Sites in th e   Greece where he has continued to assist that
> Holy Land for the International Baha'i Arc-         young and struggling community.
> hives. In March 1977 he finished work on a
> comprehensive, scrupulously documented              Ja/6.1 Khazeh
> study of places visited by the Master in Eng-          In Persia, Colonel Jalal Khazeh has conland and America . A lthough he devoted him-        tinued his aid to the community in the work of
> self primarily to assisting the national com-       teaching, and in the difficult duties of protecmunities of the United States and Canada            tion at a trying time in the evolution of the
> through attendance at innumerable confer-           Faith in that land. He attended the Internaences, schools sessions and other gatherings,       tional Convention in 1978 and visited the Holy
> and through consultations with National             Land on one other occasion during that year.
> Assemblies and the Continental Board of             Recently he has transferred his residence from
> Counsellors in North America, Mr. Khadem            Tihran to a locality near Babu!.
> has also undertaken several international
> journeys: in April 1977 to represent the Univ-      Paul Haney
> ersal House of Justice at the inaugural conven-        Deeply involved in the development and
> tion of the National Spiritual Assembly of          administration of the International Teaching
> Surinam and French Guiana, followed by visits       Centre, Mr. Paul Haney has participated
> to Trinidad and Guyana; and in May 1978 to          actively in its day-to-day work, and in services
> represent the Ho use of Justice at the first con-   to pilgrims and visitors. In 1977 he attended
> ventions of two national communities in western     the International Teaching Conferences in
> Asia, combined with a visit to Persia.              Bahia and Merida, representing the Universal
> House of Justice at the latter. In November
> Shu'a'u'llah 'Ala'i                                 1978 he was in Germany for conferences fol-
> During turbulent days for the Faith in Iran,     lowing which he met with the friends in Bel-
> General Shu'a'u'llah 'Alfi has continued his        gium and took part in the dedication of the
> work with the National Spiritual Assembly and       National I:Ia?fratu'l-Quds.
> Counsellors on the difficult problems relating
> to the protection of the Cause. He was able to      'Ali-Mul;zammad Varqa
> leave Persia for visits to the Holy Land and for       Assigned by the Universal House of Justice
> consultation with the International Teaching        the special task of assembling reliable accounts
> Centre in 1977 and again in 1978, and was           of the beginnings and initial stages in the
> present at the International Convention at          development of the Faith in various parts of the
> Ri9van 1978. He took up residence in France         world, Dr. ' Ali-Mul)ammad Varga has been
> in late 1978 and attended the National Con-         gathering narratives, documents, tapes and
> vention of the Baha'fs of Austria in 1979.          other materials from early believers and
> pioneers. Simultaneously he has continued his
> Adelbert Muhlschlegel                               duties as Trustee of the I:Iuququ'llah. In
> Dr. Adelbert Miihlschlegel made his home          April/May 1977 he was the representative of
> in Germany in 1973, but in February 1977,           the Universal House of Justice at the first Conafter participating in Baha'i schools in Cyprus     vention of the French Antilles and, thereafter,
> and Greece, he moved to Athens and in April         travelled extensively in the Caribbean zone. In
> of that year represented the Universal House        May 1978 he represented the House of Justice
> of Justice at the inaugural convention of the       at the inaugural Conventions of Mauritania
> National Spiritual Assembly of Greece. Dr.          and Burundi, after attending the International
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA ' U'LLAH                                  329
> 
> The Hand ofthe Cause 'Alf-Mufwmmad Varqa (extreme right) visiting the Amerindian village
> of Organabo, French Guiana; Spring 1979.
> 
> Baha'i Convention, and following which he          William Sears
> travelled in the United States and Canada.            Devoting himself primarily to activating and
> Departing from Tihran in the autumn of 1978         reinforcing the American and Canadian
> he taught in western Europe and then pro-           homefronts from his base in Canada, Mr. Wilceeded to Canada where he now makes his            liam Sears has continued to display characterishome. He attended the 1979 Convention of           tic creativity in many fields of Baha'i
> the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is     endeavour: initiating an annual 'Gathering' in
> of Brazil.                                          Ontario , beginning a new television series of
> thirteen programmes to be produced in
> Enoch Olinga                                       Hawaii, issuing exhortatory letters and tapes,
> Beginning in the early summer of 1976 Mr.       working on new books, and developing dramat-
> Enoch Olinga initiated a lengthy trip, first to    ic programmes of proclamation and teaching
> eight countries of western Africa , then to a      including a five-city 'Victory Campaign' in the
> number of South American countries prior to        United States, 'Abdu'l-Baha 'Souvenir' prohis attendance at the International Confer-        grammes, and the ARISE campaign. He
> ences in Bahia and Merida. He was the rep-         attended both the Anchorage and Nairobi
> resentative of the Universal House ofJustice at    International Conferences, and was the repthe Bahia Conference. He then proceeded to         resentative of the Universal House of Justice at
> visit many of the Baha'i communities of the        the latter. Subsequently he made teaching
> Caribbean islands and returned to Africa to        tours in Canada. In bot"1 Canada and the
> attend the Annual Convention of Senegal and        United States Mr. Sears has contributed to
> the inaugural Convention of the National           conferences, schools, National Conventions
> Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Upper         and has had stimulating consultations with the
> Volta. Mr. Olinga attended a teaching confer-      National Spiritual Assemblies and the Contience in Nigeria in July 1977, followed by travel   nental Board of Counsellors. In May 1978
> to various neighbouring countries, and since       he represented the Universal House of Justice
> that time has confined his work to the support     at the first Convention of the Bahama Islands
> and organization of his beleaguered home           after attending the International Convention
> community of Uganda .                              in the Holy Land .
> 330                                   THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> John Robarts                                        H. Collis Featherstone
> Mr. John Robarts has focused upon the               Mr. H. Collis Featherstone made global
> special needs and opportunities of Canada,          journeys for the Faith. He began a round-theparticipating in all national programmes to         world trip in June 1976, going first to the
> strengthen the Faith in that forward-striding       Anchorage Conference where he was the repcommunity, travelling extensively at intervals,     resentative of the Universal House of Justice,
> attending the National Conventions, and con-        then proceeding to East and Southern Africa
> sulting regularly with the National Assembly        and Baha'i communities in the Indian Ocean.
> and the Continental Board of Counsellors.           He travelled in East Asia in December,
> After attending the Anchorage, Paris and            attended the Auckland Conference in January
> Nairobi International Teaching Confer-              1977, and at Ric;lvan represented the House of
> ences-doing       European     teaching     en      Justice at the inaugural Convention of the
> route- Mr. Robarts undertook assignments in         Marshall Islands. He attended the Convention
> Southern and East Africa. In 1978 he visited        of the Mariana Islands, followed by further
> the American South, and in February 1979            travels in East Asia. In the autumn of 1977 he
> travelled to Mexico.                                visited many Baha'i communities in islands of
> the South Pacific and during the winter
> H. M. Balyuzi                                       returned to Southern Africa. After attending
> Continuing his arduous scholarship on the        the International Convention at Ric;lvan 1978 ,
> origins of the Faith, Mr. J:lasan M. Balyuzi in     Mr. Featherstone methodically visited the
> 1976 published a monumental and illuminat-          countries of Southern Asia and the South-east
> ing work Muftammad and the Course of Islam,         Asian islands, adding in the fall another extenand has been devoting himself since to his          sive journey throughout Pacific Oceania. In
> comprehensive Life of Baha'u'llah, a study in       that winter and the spring of 1979, Mr. Feathfour volumes. The first, a biography of the         erstone made a third African journey to west,
> Manifestation, is scheduled for publication in      east, and south Africa and en route to his home
> late 1979 and will be in circulation as this vol-   in Australia visited the Baha'is of Mauritius
> ume of the international record goes to press.      and Reunion.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause John Robarts (centre) and Mrs. Robarts (seated to the left) with some
> participants in the Irish Baha'i Summer School; August 1976.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                                    331
> Ra!zmatu'lltih Muhtijir                            versa! House of Justice at the latter- and
> With extraordinary energy and zeal, Dr.         attendance at the International Convention in
> Ra~matu'llah Muhajir has devoted himself to        Haifa, Dr. Muhajir travelled in the South Pacthe needs of the world-wide Baha'i national        ific, returning to East and South Central Asia .
> communities, few of which have failed to feel      After visits to Europe and the Holy Land, in
> the stimulus of his dynamic presence and share     early 1979 he returned again to Africa before
> the vision of their futures; many countries have   hastening to East Asia and the Annual Consprung to new life and taken fresh initiatives     ventions of the Philippine and Malaysian
> from his guidance in relation to expansion and     Baha'i communities.
> consolidation. From the Brazilian Convention
> of 1976 Dr. Muhajir journeyed northward            Abu'l-Qtisim Faizi
> through Latin America, ultimately to the              From his home in the Holy Land Mr.
> United States, and to Europe for Summer            Abu'l-Qasim Faizi continues his heavy burden
> Schools and conferences, then onward to West       of correspondence with friends around the
> Africa, and so on to the Nairobi Conference in     world, devotes himself to the pilgrims and vis-
> East Africa; thence to East Asia for the Hong      itors to Haifa, to his ongoing scholarly studies,
> Kong Conference and its satellite gatherings.      and to the duties of the International Teaching
> In 1977 he returned to South and Central           Centre. In 1976 Mr. Faizi travelled extensively
> America for the International Conferences of       in the Northwest Pacific and later in the South
> Bahia and Merida and their related program-        Pacific. He was the representative of the Unimes, and toured various islands and countries      versal House of Justice at the Auckland Internaof East and South-eastern Asia before attend-      tional Conference in January 1977 from
> ing the Annual Convention of India. Later he       whence he visited various island communities
> undertook a European tour, attended a              before attending the inaugural Convention of
> number of Summer Schools and conferences,          the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is
> and proceeded to the Holy Land and fran. An        of New Hebrides at Ridvan . From there he
> extensive autumn journey to Africa was cut         proceeded to India and iran. After attending
> short in Cameroon. Soon he was again in fran,      the International Convention Mr. Faizi
> and revisiting countries of Europe in early        attended three European Summer Schools in
> 1978. Following the inaugural Conventions of       the summer of 1978 and visited seven other
> the Caroline Islands and the Mariana Islands in    countries inspiring the friends through his wise
> May- he was the representative of the Uni-         counsel and loving spirit.
> 
> The Hand of the Cause Collis Featherstone (left) visiting the site of the local Baha'i Centre of
> Fagafau, Savai'i, Western Samoa; 12 April 1977. Mr. and Mrs. Pula Ofila, who donated the
> site and are building the structure, are seen in the centre of the photograph.
> 332                                 THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> The Hand ofthe Cause Amatu'l-Bahti RuJ;zlyyih Khtinum (centre) and her fellow Hands ofthe
> Cause who participated in the International Teaching Conference in Paris at which RuJ;zlyyih
> Khtinum represented the Universal House of Justice. Left to right: Mr. John Robarts, Dr.
> 'AU-Mul;zammad Varqa, Dr. Ral;zmatu'lltih Muhtijir, Mr. Dhikru'lltih Khtidem, Mr. Collis
> Featherstone.
> 
> The Hand ofthe Cause Ral;zmatu'lltih Muhti-      The hand of the Cause Ugo Giachery
> jir and Mr. Mazco Kucel, a Mayan Bahti'[ of      (centre) and Mrs. Giachery with some of the
> Quintana Roo, Mexico, photographed dur-          130 participants from 24 communities who
> ing the International Teaching Conference,       attended the Teaching Conference held in
> Merida, Yucatan; February 1977.                    San Zana, Italy; May 1976.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                                   333
> 
> 3. HANDS OF THE CAUSE WHO
> REPRESENTED THE UNIVERSAL
> HOUSE OF JUSTICE AT CONVENTIONS
> FOR THE ELECTION OF NATIONAL
> SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLIES
> Listed below are the Hands of the Cause who represented the Universal House of
> Justice at inaugural Conventions held in the period 1976-1979, the name of the new
> National Spiritual Assembly, its seat, the parent or sponsoring National Assembly and,
> in chronological order, the dates of the Conventions.
> 
> Rifi,van 1977
> Abu'l-Qasim Faizi                      New Hebrides-Port Vila
> (South West Pacific Ocean)
> Apri l 22-24
> Dr. Adelbert Miihlschlegel            Greece-Athens
> (Germany)
> Apri l 23-24
> Dr. 'Ali-MuJ:iammad Varga              French Antilles-Pointe-a-Pitre, Guadeloupe
> (Leeward and Virgin Islands)
> April 23-24
> H. Collis Featherstone                Marshall Islands-Majuro
> (North West Pacific Ocean)
> April 23-25
> Dhikru'llah Khadem 1                   Surinam and French Guiana-Paramaribo, Surinam
> (Guyana, Surinam and French Guiana)
> April 30-May 1
> Enoch Olinga                           Upper Volta-Ouagadougou
> (Ivory Coast, Mali and Upper Volta)
> May 2- 3
> 
> 1978
> William Sears                         The Bahamas- Nassau
> (The United States of America)
> May 19-21
> Dr. Ugo Giachery                      Cyprus-Nicosia
> (The United Kingdom)
> May 20- 21
> Dr. 'Ali-MuJ:iammad Varga             Mauritania-Nouakchott
> (Upper West Africa)
> May 27- 28
> Dr. RaJ:imatu'llah Muhajir            The Mariana Islands-Agana, Guam
> (North West Pacific Ocean)
> May 26-28
> 
> ' Mr. Dhikru'llah Khadem also attended the inaugural Conventions where two new National Spiritual Assemblies in Western
> Asia were established in May 1978.
> 334                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> III
> THE NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY
> 
> 1. INTRODUCTION
> 
> THE sacred Writings of the Baha'i Faith cre-           bers of the National Spiritual Assembly, from
> ate organic institutions having a membership           among all the friends in that country ...
> elected by the Baha'i community. Baha'u'llah              'With it, too , rests the decision whether a
> called these institutions into being; their estab-     certain point at issue is strictly local in its
> lishment, definition, training and development         nature ... or whether it should fall under its
> came later, in the ministry of' Abdu'l-Baha and        own province and be regarded as a matter
> in that of the Guardian appointed in 'Abdu'l-          which ought to receive its special attention.''
> Baha's Testament.                                         'The need for the centralization of authority
> Since the passing of 'Abdu'l-Baha in 1921,          in the National Spiritual Assembly, and the
> the formation of Local Spiritual Assemblies            concentration of power in the various Local
> has multiplied in East and West, and the               Assemblies, is ... manifest.' 2
> institution of the National Spiritual Assembly            'The authority of the National Spiritual
> has become firmly established. Concerning this         Assembly is undivided and unchallengeable in
> national administrative body Shoghi Effendi            all matters pertaining to the administration of
> has provided clear information and direction.          the Faith [throughout its country].' 3
> Its purpose, its power, its responsibility and its        The individual Baha'i has spiritual citizenfunctions and duties are definitely prescribed.        ship in a world community of believers acting
> 'Its immediate purpose is to stimulate, unify       through local, national and international
> and co-ordinate by frequent personal consulta-         bodies. There is no division of interest or
> tions the manifold activities of the friends           conflict of authority among these institutions,
> [believers] as well as the Local Assemblies; and       for ever since the ascension of Baha'u'llah in
> by keeping in close and constant touch with the        1892 His Faith has possessed infallible gui-
> Holy Land [Baha'i World Centre], initiate              dance by virtue of His Covenant, which
> measures, and direct in general the affairs of         specifically provides it. The action of a Baha'i
> the Cause in that country.                             administrative body, therefore, while ration-
> 'It serves also another purpose, no Jess            ally determined by constitutional principles,
> essential than the first ... in conjunction with       operates in a spiritual realm revealed by the
> the other National Assemblies throughout the           Manifestation of God and maintained free
> Baha'i world, to elect directly the members of         from political pressure and the influence of
> the International House of Justice, that Su-           materialism . Apart from the appointed
> preme Council that will guide, organize and unify      Interpreter, no Baha'i has individual authority.
> the affairs of the [Faith J throughout the world.      Decisions are confined to the sphere of action
> ' ... it has lo exercise full authority over all   and are made by a body of nine persons.
> the Local Assemblies in its province, and will           The advice and direction clarifying the
> have to direct the activities of the friends,         nature and operation of a National Spiritual
> guard vigilantly the Cause of God, and control        Assembly have been compiled by the Ameriand supervise the affairs of the [Faith) in gen-       can Baha'is from letters written to them by
> eral.                                                  Shoghi Effendi. 4
> 'Vital issues, affecting the interests of the
> Cause in that country ... that stand distinct         1
> Bahli'{ Administration (1960 edition) pp. 39-40.
> from strictly local affairs, must be under the full   2
> ibid ., p. 42
> jurisdiction of the National Assembly. It will          Bahli'( Procedure (1949), p. 63.
> Bah(J'( Administration: Declaration of Trust and By-Laws
> have to refer each of these questions ... to a          of the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of the
> special committee, to be elected by the mem-            United States.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                                  335
> During the ministry of ' Abdu' l-Baha, after        from the legalisms and devices acting within
> He had approved the petition submitted to Him          every human institution.
> by the American Baha'is expressing their desire           While the transition from Baha'i Temple
> to construct a House of Worship, these Baha'is         Unity to National Spiritual Assembly in North
> formed a national body known as Baha'i                 America emphasizes certain _principles inher-
> Temple Unity, incorporated for the purpose             ent in Baha'i institutions, the formation of a
> of gathering funds and co-ordinating plans to          National Spiritual Assembly in a new area reerect the Temple in Wilmette. That body,               presents more profoundly the creation of a new
> though national in scope and elected by dele-          type of society. Every national Baha'i comgates representing the various local Baha'i            munity has gone through some evolution recommunities, was not a National Spiritual              flecting its historical background before its
> Assembly. It is interesting to note that in Baha'i     National Assembly was established.
> Temple Unity the American Baha'is estab-                  The functions of a National Spiritual
> lished a body reflecting their own national his-       Assembly are manifold: the publication of
> torical experience. The local communities pre-         Baha'i literature; national teaching plans;
> ceded the national body in time and each exer-         supervision of local communities; encouragecised an independent authority in the conduct          ment and direction of all the Baha'is in their
> of its own affairs. When their representatives         service to the Faith; and representation of the
> agreed to form a national Baha'i body with full        Baha'is in relation to the civil authorities. Each
> jurisdiction over Temple matters, they trans-          national body prepares and adopts its own conferred to it powers which vested final decision,       stitution, formulated on the basis of the model
> not in its directors, but in the Annual Conven-        approved by the Guardian of the Baha'i Faith.
> tion. The vital distinction between Temple             All the National Spiritual Assemblies collec-
> Unity and the National Spiritual Assembly              tively, under the title of the Baha'i Internawhen later established lay in this field of ulti-      tional Community, constitute an international
> mate authority. The National Spiritual Assem-          non-governmental organization whose delebly possessed original authority, powers and           gates are accredited by United Nations for
> functions of its own. It came into existence           attendance and participation in its regional
> through election of its nine members at a              conferences. 2
> National Convention but constituted a con-                Through the institution of the National
> tinuing authority derived from the Baha'i              Spiritual Assembly, Baha'is are enabled to
> teachings and not conferred by any action of           carry out plans of considerable magnitude , colthe believers, whether as local communities or         laborate with Baha'is of all other lands in matas delegates. This authority emerged supreme           ters of international interest, maintain comin relation to Baha'i matters within the               mon standards of administrative principle, and
> national community but subject to the higher           take advantage, in the appointment of commitauthority of the Guardian and also of the              tees, of particular talents and aptitudes possesfuture International House of Justice. 1               sed by individual believers. The National
> Within its own realm the National Spiritual         Spiritual Assembly stands as one of the pillars
> Assembly is an institution created by the              supporting the Baha'i world community. Par-
> Teachings of the Faith independent of the              ticipation in national Bah:3.'i activities serves to
> Baha'is who elect its members and of the Baha'is       insulate the individual Baha'i from infection by
> composing its membership. In no way does               the psychic ills which afflict modern society as a
> this institution reflect either the political or the   result of its lack of faith and spiritual direction.
> ecclesiastical influences of its environment,          Within the shelter of this emerging order the
> whether in America, Europe or the East. This           storms of partisanship cannot engulf the soul.
> fact has paramount importance. On the one
> hand it reveals the existence of an organic                                                    HORACE HOLLEY
> religious society; on the other hand it demonstrates the freedom of this new community              2
> Consultative stat us with the United Nations Economic and
> Written in 1954.                                       Social Council was obtained on 27 May 1970.
> 336                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> National Spiritual
> Assemblies formed
> Rifl,van 1977
> 
> The National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Bahd'(s of Greece; Rirjvdn 1977. The Hand of
> the Cause Adelbert Muhlschlegel who
> represented the Universal House of Justice at
> the inaugural convention is seen in the front
> row, second from the left.
> 
> The National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Bahd'(s of the French Antilles; Rirjvdn 1977.
> The Hand of the Cause 'AU-Mu(lammad
> Varqd who represented the Universal House
> of Justice at the inaugural convention is seen
> at the extreme left, front row. Rowland Estall,
> of the Continental Board of Counsellors in
> Central America, is seen at the extreme right,
> front row.
> 
> The National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Bahd'(s of the Marshall Islands; Rirjvdn 1977.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                       337
> 
> 2. A MODEL DECLARATION OF TRUST
> AND BY-LAWS
> for a
> 
> NATION AL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY
> 
> FOREWORD
> 
> THE 1926-27 National Spiritual Assemb ly of the Baha'ls of the United States and Canada
> completed a task which, while pertaining to the outer and more material aspects of the Cause,
> nevertheless has a special significance for its spirit and inward sacred purpose. This task consisted
> in creating a legal form which gives proper substance and substantial character to the National
> Spiritual Assemblies and the administrative processes embodied in the Baha'i teachings by a form
> of incorporation recognized under common law. This Declaration of Trust, with its attendant
> By-Laws, became the model to be followed, with adaptations as local laws and circumstances
> required, by other Na ti on al Spiritual Assemblies. The years following the election of the U niversal House of Justice witnessed a great increase in the number of National Spiritual Assemblies
> (from 57 in 1963 to 130 by Ric;lvan 1979) and the House of Justice itself provided a model
> document, largely based on the one devised by the National Spiritual Assembly of the United
> States, to be followed as closely as possible by all new National Spiritual Assemblies as they
> became incorporated, which they were required to do under the Nine Year Plan.
> Careful examination of the Declaration and its By-Laws will reveal the fact that this document
> contains no arbitrary elements nor features new to the Baha'i Cause. On the contrary, it
> represents a most conscientious effort to reflect those very administrative principles and elements
> already set forth in the letters of the Guardian, Shoghi Effendi, and already determining the
> methods and relationships of Baha'i collective association. The provision both in the Declaration
> and in the By-Laws for amendments in the future will permit the Natio nal Spiritual Assemblies to
> adapt this document to such new administrative elements or principles as may at any time be given
> forth. The Declaration, in fact, is nothing more nor less than a legal parallel of those moral and
> spiritual laws of unity inherent in the fullness of the Baha'i Revelation and making it the fulfilment
> of the ideal of religion in the social as well as spiritual realm. Because, in the Baha'i Faith, this
> perfect correspondence exists between spiritual and social laws, the Baha'ls believe that administrative success is identical with moral success, and that nothing less than the true Baha'i spirit of
> devotion and sacrifice can inspire with effective power the world-wide body of unity revealed by
> Baha'u'llah.
> 
> DECLARATION OF TR UST
> By the NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY OF THE BAHA'fs
> OF .. . ..
> 
> WE,
> duly chosen by the representatives of the Baha'fs of ... at the Annual Meeting held at ... , on
> . . . , to be the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of ... , with full power to establish a
> Trust as hereinafter set forth, hereby declare that from this date the powers, responsibilities,
> rights, privileges and obligations reposed in said National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'ls of .. .
> by Baha'u'llah, Founder of the Baha'i Faith, by 'Abdu'l-Baha, its Interpreter and Exemplar, by
> 338                                        THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Shoghi Effendi, its Guardian, and by the Universal House of Justice, ordained by Baha'u'llah in
> His sacred Writings as the supreme body of the Baha'i religion, shall be exercised, administered
> and carried on by the above-named National Spiritual Assembly and their duly qualified successors under this Declaration of Trust.
> The National Spiritual Assembly in adopting this form of association, union and fellowship ,
> and in selecting for itself the designation of Trustees of the Baha'is of ... , does so as the
> administrative body of a religious community which has had continuous existence and responsibility for .... In consequence of these activities the National Spiritual Assembly is called upon to
> administer such ever-increasing diversity and volume of affairs and properties for the Baha'is of
> ... , that we, its members, now feel it both desirable and necessary to give our collective functions
> more definite legal form. This action is taken in complete unanimity and with full recognition of
> the sacred relationship thereby created. We acknowledge in behalf of ourselves and our successors in this Trust the exalted religious standard established by Baha'u'llah for Baha'i administrative bodies in the utterance: Be ye Trustees of the Merciful One among men; and seek the help of
> God and His guidance in order to fulfil that exhortation .
> 
> (Signatures of the nine members)
> Date
> 
> ARTICLE I
> The name of said Trust shall be the 'National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of .. . .'
> 
> ARTICLE II
> Sharing the ideals and assisting the efforts of our fellow Baha'is to establish, uphold and
> promote the spiritual, educational and humanitarian teachings of human brotherhood, radiant
> faith, exalted character and selfless love revealed in the lives and utterances of all the Prophets
> and Messengers of God, Founders of the world's revealed religions-and given renewed creative
> energy and universal application to the conditions of this age in the life and utterances of
> Baha'u'llah-we declare the purposes and objects of this Trust to be to administer the affairs of
> the Cause of Baha'u'llah for the benefit of the Baha'is of ... according to the principles of Baha'i
> affiliation and administration created and established by Baha'u'llah, defined and explained by
> 'Abdu'l-Baha, interpreted and amplified by Shoghi Effendi, and supplemented and applied by
> the Universal House of Justice.
> These purposes are to be realized by means of devotional meetings; by public meetings and
> conferences of an educational, humanitarian and spiritual character; by the publication of books,
> magazines and newspapers; by the construction of temples of universal worship and of other
> institutions and edifices for humanitarian service; by supervising, unifying, promoting and generally administering the activities of the Baha'is of ... in the fulfilment of their religious offices,
> duties and ideals; and by any other means approp riate to these ends, or a ny of them.
> Other purposes and objects of this Trust are:
> 
> a. The right to enter into, make, perform and carry out contracts of every sort and kind for the furtherance
> of the objects of this Trust with any person, firm, association, corporation, private, public or municipal
> or body politic, or any state, territory or colony thereof, or any foreign government; and in this
> connection, and in all transactions under the terms of this Trust, to do any and all things which a
> co-partnership or natural person could do or exercise, and which now or hereafter may be authorized by
> law .
> b. To hold and be named as beneficiary under any trust established by law or otherwise or under any will or
> other testamentary instrument in connection with any gift, devise, or bequest in which a trust or trusts is
> or are established in any part of the world as well as in .. . ; to receive gifts, devises or bequests of money
> or other property.
> c. All and whatsoever the several purposes and objects set forth in the written utterances of Baha'u'llah,
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                             339
> ' Abdu' l-Baha and Shoghi Effendi, and enactments of the Universa l House of Justice , under which
> certain jurisdiction, powers and rights are gra nted to Nationa l Spiritual Assemblies.
> d. Generally to do all things and acts which in the judgement of said Trustees, i.e., the Nationa l Spiritual
> Assembly of the Baha'fs of . . . , are necessary , proper and advantageous to promote the complete and
> successful admini stration of this Trust.
> 
> ARTICLE III
> SECTION 1. All persons, firms , corporations and associations extending credit to, contracting
> with or having any claim against the Trustees, i.e., the National Spiritual Assembly, and the
> members thereof, of a ny character whatsoever, whether legal or equitable and whether arising
> out of contract or tort, shall look solely to the funds of the Trust and to the property of the Trust
> estate for payment or indemnity , or for payment of any debt, damage , judgement or decree or any
> money that may otherwise become due or payable from the Trustees, so that neither the Trustees
> nor any of them, nor any of their officers or agents appointed by them hereunder, nor any
> beneficiary or beneficiaries herein named shall be personally liable therefor.
> SECTION 2. Every note, bond , proposal, obligation or contract in writing or other agreement or
> instrument made or given under this Trust shall be explicitly executed by the National Spiritual
> Assembly, as Trustees, by their duly authorized officers or agents .
> 
> ARTICLE IV
> The Trustees , i.e., the Nation3l Spiritual Assembly, shall adopt for the conduct of the affairs
> entrusted to them under this Decla ration of Trust, such by-laws, rules of procedure or regulations
> as are required to define and carry on its own administrative functions and those of the several
> local and other elements composing the body of the Baha'fs of ... , not inconsistent with the
> terms of this instrument and all in accordance with the instructions and enactments of the
> Universal House of Justice.
> 
> ARTICLE V
> The central office of this Trust shall be located in ....
> 
> ARTICLE VI
> The seal of this Trust shall be circular in form, bearing the following inscription:
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of ....
> 
> ARTICLE VII
> This Declaration of Trust may be amended by majority vote of the National Spiritual Assembly
> of the Baha'fs of ... at any special meeting duly called for that purpose, provided that at least
> thirty (30) days prior to the date fixed for said meeting a copy of the proposed amendment or
> amendments is mailed to each member of the Assembly by the Secretary.
> 340                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> BY-LAWS OF THE NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY
> 
> ARTJCLE I
> 
> THE National Spiritual Assembly, in the fulfilment of its sacred duties under this Trust, shall
> have exclusive jurisdiction and authority over all the activities and affairs of the Baha'i Cause
> throughout . .. , including paramount authority in the administration of this Trust. It shall
> endeavour to stimulate, unify and coordinate the manifold activities of the Local Spiritual
> Assemblies (hereinafter defined) and of individual Baha'ls in ... and by all possible means assist
> them to promote the oneness of mankind. It shall be charged with the recognition of such Local
> Assemblies, the scrutiny of all membership rolls, the calling of the Annual Meeting or special
> meetings and the seating of delegates to the Annual Meeting and their apportionment among the
> various electoral districts. lt shall appoint all national Baha'i committees and shall supervise the
> publication and distribution of Baha'i literature , the reviewing of all writings pertain ing to the
> Baha'i Cause, the construction and administration of the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar and its accessory
> activities, and the collection and disbursement of all funds for the carrying on of this Trust. It shall
> decide whether any matter lies within its own jurisdiction or within the jurisdiction of any Local
> Spiritual Assembly. It shall, in such cases as it considers suitable and necessary, entertain appeals
> from the decisions of Local Spiritual Assemblies and shall have the right of final decision in all
> cases where the qualification of an individual or group for continued voting rights and membership in the Baha'i body is in question. It shall furthermore represent the Baha'ls of . . . in all their
> co-operative and spiritual activities with the Baha'ls of other lands, and shall constitute the sole
> electoral body of ... in the election of the Universal House of Justice provided for in the sacred
> Writings of the Baha'i Cause. Above all, the National Spiritual Assembly shall ever seek to attain
> that station of unity in devotion to the Revelation of Baha'u'llah which will attract the confirmations of the Holy Spirit and enable the Assembly to serve the founding of the Most Great Peace.
> In all its deliberation and action the National Assembly shall have constantly before it as Divine
> guide and standard the utterance of Baha'u'llah:
> It behooveth them (i.e. , members of Spiritual Assemblies) to be the trusted ones of the Merciful
> among men and to regard themselves as the guardians appointed of God for all that dwell on earth.
> It is incumbent upon them to take counsel together and to have regard for the interests ofthe servants
> of God, for His sake, even as they regard their own interests, and to choose that which is meet and
> seemly.
> 
> ARTICLE II
> The Baha'ls of ... for whose benefit this Trust is established shall consist of all persons of the
> age of 15 years or over resident in ... who are accepted by the National Spiritual Assembly as
> possessing the qualifications of Baha'i faith and practice required under the following standard set
> forth by the Guardian of the Faith:
> Full recognition of the station of the Bab, the Forerunner; ofBaha'u'Ilah, the Author; and of'Abdu'l-Baha,
> the True Exemplar of the Baha'i religion; unreserved acceptance of, and submission to, whatsoever has
> been revealed by their Pen; loyal and steadfast adherence to every clause of 'Abdu'l-Baha's sacred Will;
> and close association with the spirit as well as the form of Baha'i Administration throughout the world.
> 
> Those residing in the area of jurisdiction of any Local Spiritual Assembly recognized by the
> National Assembly may declare their faith to, and be enrolled by, the Local Spiritual Assembly;
> those living outside any such area of local Baha'i jurisdiction shall be enrolled in such manner as
> shall be prescribed by the National Assembly.
> Upon attaining the age of 21 years, a Baha'i is eligible to vote and to hold elective office.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                    341
> 
> National Spiritual
> Assemblies formed
> Rirjvan 1977
> 
> The National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Baha'is of the New Hebrides; Rief, van 1977.
> 
> .
> The National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Bahli'is of Surinam and French Guiana;
> Rief, van 1977. Jn the centre, holding the   '
> Greatest Name, is the Hand of the Cause
> Dhikru'l/ah Khadem who represented the
> Universal House of Justice at the inaugural
> convention.
> 1sT NATtON/\L BAHA'I
> ~JNVEN TI
> 
> '   ...am..:~•
> 
> The National Spiritua l Assembly of the
> Bahli'is of Upper Volta whose inaugural
> convention was held 2-3 May 1977.
> 342                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> ARTICLE III
> The National Assembly shall consist of nine members chosen from among the Baha'fs of ... ,
> who shall be elected by the said Baha'fs in manner hereinafter provided, and who shall continue
> for the period of one year, or until their successors shall be elected.
> 
> ARTICLE IV
> The officers of the National Spiritual Assembly shall consist of a Chairman, Vice-Chairman,
> Secretary and Treasurer, and such other officers as may be found necessary for the proper
> conduct of its affairs. The officers shall be elected by a majority vote of the entire membership of
> the Assembly taken by secret ballot.
> 
> ARTICLE V
> The first meeting of a newly-elected National Assembly shall be called by the member elected
> to membership by the highest number of votes or, in case two or more members have received the
> same said highest number of votes, then by the member selected by lot from among those
> members; and this member shall preside until the permanent Chairman shall be chosen. All
> subsequent meetings shall be called by the Secretary of the Assembly at the request of the
> Chairman or, in his absence or incapacity, of the Vice-Chairman, or of any three members of the
> Assembly; provided, however, that the Annual Meeting of the Assembly shall be held at a time
> and place to be fixed by a majority vote of the Assembly , as hereinafter provided.
> 
> ARTICLE VI
> Five members of the National Assembly present at a meeting shall constitute a quorum, and a
> majority vote of those present and constituting a quorum shall be sufficient for the conduct of
> business, except as otherwise provided in these By-Laws, and with due regard to the principle of
> unity and cordial fellowship involved in the institution of a Spiritual Assembly. The transactions
> and decisions of the National Assembly shall be recorded at each meeting by the Secretary, who
> shall supply copies of the minutes to the Assembly members after each meeting, and preserve the
> minutes in the official records of the Assembly.
> 
> ARTICLE VII
> Whenever in any locality of ... , the number of Baha'is resident therein recognized by the
> National Spiritual Assembly exceeds nine, these shall on April 21st of any year convene and elect
> by plurality vote a local administrative body of nine members, to be known as the Spiritual
> Assembly of the Baha'fs of that community . Every such Spiritual Assembly shall be elected
> annually thereafter upon each successive 21st day of April. The members shall hold office for the
> term of one year or until their successors are elected and qualified.
> When, however, the number of Baha'fs in any authorized civil area is exactly nine, these shall
> on April 21st of any year, or in successive years, constitute themselves the Local Spiritual
> Assembly by joint declaration. Upon the recording of such declaration by the Secretary of the
> National Spiritual Assembly, said body of nine shall become established with the rights, privileges
> and duties of a Local Spiritual Assembly as set forth in this instrument.
> SECTION 1. Each newly-elected Local Spiritual Assembly shall at once proceed in the manner
> indicated in Articles IV and V of these By-Laws to the election of its officers, who shall consist of a
> Chairman, Vice-Chairman, Secretary and Treasurer, and such other officers as the Assembly
> finds necessary for the conduct of its business and the fulfilment of its spiritual duties. Immediately thereafter the Secretary chosen shall transmit to the Secretary of the National Assembly the
> names of the members of the newly-elected Assembly and a list of its officers.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                        343
> SECTION 2. The general powers and duties of a Local Spiritual Assembly shall be as set forth in
> the writings of Baha'u'llah , 'Abdu'l-Baha and Shoghi Effendi, and as laid down by the Universal
> House of Justice.
> SECTION 3. Among its more specific duties, a Local Spiritual Assembly shall have full jurisdiction of
> all Baha'i activities and affairs within the local community, subject, however, to the exclusive and
> paramount authority of the National Spiritual Assembly as defined herein.
> SECTION 4. Vacancies in the membership of a Local Spiritual Assembly shall be filled by election
> at a special meeting of the local Baha'i community duly called for that purpose by the Assembly.
> In the event that the number of vacancies exceeds four, making a quorum of the Local Assembly
> impossible, the election shall be held under the supervision of the National Spiritual Assembly.
> SECTION 5. The business of the Local Assembly shall be conducted in like manner as provided
> for the deliberations of the National Assembly in Article VI above.
> SECTION 6. The Local Assembly shall pass upon and approve the qualifications of each member
> of the Baha'i community before such members shall be admitted to voting membership; but
> where an individual is dissatisfied with the ruling of the Local Spiritual Assembly upon his Baha'i
> qualifications, such individual may appeal from the ruling to the National Assembly, which shall
> there upon take jurisdiction of and finally decide the case.
> SECTION 7. On or before the 1st day of November of each year the Secretary of each Local
> Assembly shall send to the Secretary of the National Assembly a duly certified list of the voting
> members of the local Baha'i community for the information and approval of the National
> Assembly.
> SECTION 8. All matters arising within a local Baha'i community which are of purely local interest
> and do not affect the national interests of the Cause shall be under the primary jurisdiction of the
> Spiritual Assembly of that locality; but decision whether a particular matter involves the interest and
> welfare of the national Baha'i body shall rest with the National Spiritual Assembly.
> SECTION 9. Any member of a local Baha'i community may appeal from a decision of his Spiritual
> Assembly to the National Assembly, which shall determine whether it shall take jurisdiction of
> the matter or leave it to the Local Spiritual Assembly for reconsideration. In the event that the
> National Assembly assumes jurisdiction of the matter, its findings shall be final.
> SECTION 10. Where any dissension exists within a local Baha'i community of such character that
> it cannot be remedied by the efforts of the Local Spiritual Assembly, this condition shall be
> referred by the Spiritual Assembly for consideration to the National Spiritual Assembly, whose
> action in the matter shall be final.
> SECTION 11. All questions arising between two or more Local Spiritual Assemblies, or between
> members of different Baha'i communities, shall be submitted in the first instance to the National
> Assembly, which shall have original and final jurisdiction in all such matters.
> SECTION 12. The sphere of jurisdiction of a Local Spiritual Assembly, with respect to residential
> qualification of membership, and voting rights of a believer in any Baha'i community, shall be the
> locality included within the recognized civil limits.
> All differences of opinion concerning the sphere of jurisdiction of any Local Spiritual Assembly
> or concerning the affiliation of any Baha'i or group ofBaha'is in ... shall be referred to the National
> Spiritua l Assembly, whose decision in the matter shall be final.
> 
> ARTICLE VIII
> The members of the National Spiritual Assembly shall be elected at an annual meeting to be
> known as the National Convention of the Baha'fs of .... This Convention shall be held at a time
> and place to be fixed by the National Assembly. The National Convention shall be composed
> jointly of representatives chosen by the Baha'fs of each ... under the principle of proportionate
> representation, and the members of the National Spiritual Assemb ly.
> Notice of the annual meeting shall be given by the National Assembly sixty days in advance in
> the Convention Call which sets forth the number of delegates assigned to the various electoral
> units in proportion to the number of Baha'fs resident in each such unit, to a total of . . . delegates
> for the Baha'fs of ....
> 344                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> SECTION 1. All delegates to the Convention shall be elected by plurality vote. Baha'ls who for
> illness or other unavoidable reasons are unable to be present at the election in person shall have
> the right to transmit their ballots to the meeting by mail. The meeting held in each ... for the
> election of delegates shall be called by the National Spiritual Assembly and conducted by the
> Baha'ls present under whatever procedure may be uniformly laid down by said body. Immediately after the meeting a certified report of the election containing the name and address of each
> delegate shall be transmitted to the National Spiritual Assembly.
> SECTION 2. All delegates to be seated at the Convention must be recognized Baha'ls and
> residents of the ... represented by them.
> SECTION 3. The rights and privileges of a delegate may not be assigned nor may they be
> exercised by proxy.
> SECTION 4. The recognition and seating of delegates to the National Convention shall be vested
> in the National Spiritual Assembly.
> SECTION 5. Delegates unable to be present in person at the Convention shall have the right to
> transmit their ballots for election of the members of the National Assembly under whatever
> procedure is adopted by the National Assembly.
> SECTION 6. If in any year the National Spiritual Assembly shall consider that it is impracticable
> or unwise to assemble together the delegates to the National Convention, the said Assembly shall
> provide ways and means by which the annual election and the other essential business of the
> Convention may be conducted by mail.
> SECTION 7. The presiding officer of the National Spiritual Assembly present at the Convention
> shall call together the delegates, who after roll call shall proceed to the permanent organization of
> the meeting, electing by ballot a Chairman, a Secretary and such other officers as are necessary for
> the proper conduct of the business of the Convention.
> SECTION 8. The principal business of the annual meeting shall be consultation on Baha'i
> activities, plans and policies, and the election of the nine members of the National Spiritual
> Assembly. Members of the National Assembly, whether or not elected delegates, may take a full
> part in the consultation and discussion but only delegates may participate in the election of
> Convention officers or in the annual election of the members of the National Assembly. All action
> by the delegates, other than the organization of the Convention , the transmission of messages to
> the World Centre of the Baha'i Faith, and the election of the National Assembly, shall constitute
> advice and recommendation for consideration by the said Assembly, final decision in all matters
> concerning the affairs of the Baha'i Faith in ... being vested solely in that body.
> SECTION 9. The general order of business to be taken up at the Annual Convention shall be
> prepared by the National Spiritual Assembly in the form of an agenda, but any matter pertaining
> to the Baha'i Faith introduced by any of the delegates may upon motion and vote be taken up as
> part of the Convention deliberations.
> SECTION 10. The election of the members of the National Spiritual Assembly shall be by
> plurality vote of the delegates recognized by the outgoing National Spiritual Assembly, i.e., the
> members elected shall be the nine persons receiving the greatest number of votes on the first
> ballot cast by delegates present at the Convention and delegates whose ballot has been transmitted to the Secretary of the National Spiritual Assembly by mail. In case, by reason of a tie vote or
> votes, the full membership is not determined on the first ballot, then one or more additional
> ballots shall be taken on the persons tied until all nine members are elected.
> SECTION 11. All official business transacted at the National Convention shall be recorded and
> preserved in the records of the National Assembly.
> SECTION 12. Vacancies in the membership of the National Spiritual Assembly shall be filled by a
> plurality vote of the delegates composing the Convention which elected the Assembly, the ballot
> to be taken by correspondence or in any other manner decided upon by the National Spiritual
> Assembly.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                      345
> ARTICLE IX
> Where the National Spiritual Assembly has been given in these By-Laws exclusive and final
> jurisdiction, and paramount executive authority, in all matters pertaining to the activities and
> affairs of the Baha'f Cause in ... , it is understood that any decision made or action taken upon
> such matters shall be subject in every instance to ultimate review and approval by the Universal
> House of Justice.
> 
> ARTICLE X
> Whatever functions and powers are not specifically attributable to Local Spiritual Assemblies
> in these By-Laws shall be considered vested in the National Spiritual Assembly, which body is
> authorized to delegate such discretionary functions and powers as it deems necessary and
> advisable to the Local Spiritual Assemblies within its jurisdiction.
> 
> ARTICLE XI
> In order to preserve the spiritual character and purpose of Baha'f elections, the practice of
> nominations or any other electoral method detrimental to a silent and prayerful election shall not
> prevail, so that each elector may vote for none but those whom prayer and reflection have inspired
> him to uphold.
> Among the most outstanding and sacred duties incumbent upon those who have been called
> upon to initiate, direct and co-ordinate the affairs of the Cause as members of Local or National
> Spiritual Assemblies are:
> To win by every means in their power the confidence and affection of those whom it is their
> privilege to serve; to investigate and acquaint themselves with the considered views, the prevailing sentiments and the personal convictions of those whose welfare it is their solemn obligation to
> promote; to purge their deliberations and the general conduct of their affairs of self-contained
> aloofness, the suspicion of secrecy, the stifling atmosphere of dictatorial assertiveness and of
> every word and deed that may savour of partiality, self-centredness and prejudice; and while
> retaining the sacred right of final decision in their hands, to invite discussion, ventilate grievances, welcome advice and foster the sense of inter-dependence and co-partnership, of understanding and mutual confidence between themselves and all other Baha'fs.
> 
> ARTICLE XII
> These By-Laws may be amended by majority vote of the National Spiritual Assembly at any of
> its regular or special meetings, provided that at least fourteen days prior to the date fixed for the
> said meeting a copy of the proposed amendment or amendments is mailed to each member of the
> Assembly by the Secretary.
> 346                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 3. A PROCEDURE FOR THE CONDUCT OF THE
> ANNUAL BAHA'I CONVENTION
> I. CONVENTION CALL                        This agenda may include, as part of the
> THE National Spiritual Assembly deter-               National Assembly's annual report, the premines the date, duration and place of the            sentation of specia l subjects by well qualified
> Annual Convention and provides for such              members, committee representatives or nonmeetings in connection wit h the Convention as       Baha'i experts whose exposition is necessary or
> it may fee l are desirable.                          desirable for the information of the delegates .
> On motion duly made, seconded and voted,
> II. CONVENTION PROCEDURE
> any such subject may be omitted, and also on
> The Twenty-sixth Annual Convention [of
> motion duly made , seconded and voted, any
> the Baha'ls of the United States and Canada],
> other sub ject may be proposed for special conheld in 1934, voted a recommendation calling
> sultation.
> upon the Nationa l Spiritual Assembly to sup-
> Annual Election: The election of members
> ply a parliamentary procedure for the conduct
> of the National Spiritual Assembly is to take
> of the Annual Convention, and the present
> place approximate ly midway during the Conmaterial has been prepared to meet the need
> vention sessions, so as to enable the delegates
> indicated by that recommendation.
> to consult with both the outgoing and incoming
> Order of Business                                    Assemblies, in accordance with the Guardian's
> Prayer and devotional readings, provided by       expressed desire .
> the outgoing National Spiritual Assembly.
> Opening of the Convention by Presiding            Conduct of Business
> Officer of the National Spiritual Assembly.             Every deliberative body, to fulfil its func-
> Roll ca ll of delegates by the Secretary of the   tions, must conduct its deliberations in accor-
> National Spiritual Assembly.                         dance with some established rules of order.
> Election by secret ballot of Convention           The parliamentary procedure here set forth for
> Chairman and Secretary. The Convention               the Convention is based upon the procedure
> Officers are to be e lected by the assembled         already adopted for meetings of Local
> delegates from among the entire number of            Assemblies and communities. It accordingly
> delegates who are present at the Convention.         extends to sessions of the Annual Convention,
> Annua l Report of National Spiritual              the same procedure under which the delegates,
> Assembly.                                            in their other Baha'i activities, are accustomed
> Annual Financial Report of National               to conduct discussions and consultation.
> Spiritual Assembly.                                     The purpose of consultation at the Annual
> Convention message to the World Centre of         Convention is threefold: to arrive at full and
> the Baha'i Faith.                                    complete knowledge of the current conditions,
> Annual Committee Reports: These are to be         problems and possibilities of the Faith in
> considered as part of the report of the National     America; to give the incoming National
> Spiritual Assembly. They are whenever pos-           Assembly the benefit of the collective wisdom,
> sible published in Baha'i News in advance of the     guidance and constructive suggestions of the
> Convention date, for the information of the          assembled delegates, and to contribute to the
> delegates.                                           unity, in spirit and in action, of the entire
> Subjects for Consultation: Any delegate           American Baha'i community.
> may, before the Convention convenes,                    The freedom of each and every delegate to
> recommend to the National Assembly such              take part in discussion and to initiate motions is
> topics as he deems of sufficient importance to       untrammelled save as the undue activity of one
> be included in the Convention agenda; and the        delegate might hamper the rights of the other
> National Spiritual Assembly, from the list of        delegates. Any necessary limitation to be
> topics received from delegates, and also sug-        placed upon individual discussion shall be
> gested by its own knowledge and experience, is       determined by the Chairman in the absence of
> to prepare an agenda or order of business as its     any specific motion duly voted by the delegates
> recommendation to the Convention.                    themselves.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                                   347
> It shall be the duty of the Chairman to        call prepared by the National Spiritual Assembly.
> encourage general consultation and make              Ballots and tellers' report forms shall be
> possible the active participation of the greatest provided by the National Assembly.
> possible number of delegates .                      The election shall be conducted by the Con-
> The Chairman has the same power and vention, but delegates unable to attend the
> responsibi li ty for discussion and voting upon Convention shall have the right to vote by mail.
> motions as other delegates. Members of the          The Chairman shall appoint three te llers,
> outgoing and incoming National Assembly chosen from among the assembled delegates.
> who are not delegates may participate in the         The electoral method shall be as follows:
> consultation but not vote.                           1. The Convention Secretary shall call the
> A resolution, or motion, is not subject to     roll of delegates, whereupon each delegate, in
> discussion or vote until duly made and sec- turn, shall place his or her ballot in a ballot box;
> onded. It is preferable to have each resolution   and as the names are called ballots received by
> clear and complete in itself, but when an         mail shall be placed in the ballot box by the
> amendment is duly made and seconded, the          Secretary of the National Assembly.
> Chairman shall call for a vote on the amend-         2. The ballot box shall then be handed to the
> me nt first and then on the motion. An amend- tellers, who shall retire from the Convention
> ment must be relevant to, and not contravene,     hall to determine the result of the e lection.
> the subject matter of the motion.                    3. The result of the election is to be reported
> The Chairman shall call for votes by oral by the tellers, and the tellers' report is to be
> expression of ayes and nays, but where the approved by the Convention.
> result of the vote is doubtful then by a show of     4. The ballots, together with the tellers'
> hands or a rising vote. A majority vote deter- . report, certified by all the tellers, are to be
> mines.                                            given to the National Spiritual Assembly for
> Discussion of any matter may be terminated preservation.
> by motion duly made, seconded and voted ,
> III. THE CONVENTION RECORD
> calling upon the Chairman to bring the matter
> The permanent record of each successive
> to an immediate vote or proceed to other busi-
> Annual Convention shall consist of the followness.
> ing:-( I) Convention Call as issued by the
> The transactions of the Convention shall be
> National Spiritual Assembly; (2) List of accrerecorded by the Secretary, and when certified
> dited delegates; (3) Annual Reports of the
> by the Convention officers shall be given to the
> National Spiritual Assembly and of its Com-
> National Spiritual Assembly.
> mittees; ( 4) Messages sent to and received
> Annual Election                                   from the World Centre; (5) Resolutions and
> The electors in the Annual Election shall other transactions of the assembled delegates;
> consist of those delegates included in the roll (6) The result of the Annual Election.
> I
> 
> /
> 348                                       THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> National Spiritual
> Assemblies formed
> 1978 1
> The National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Bahli'fs of the Bahamas whose inaugural
> convention was held 19-21 May 1978.
> 
> Baha'fs attending the inaugural convention for
> the election of the National Spiritual Assembly
> of Cyprus, 21-22 May 1978. The Hand of the
> Cause Ugo Giachery is seen seated in the
> centre, holding the Greatest Name; Mrs.
> Giachery is to the left. To the right of Dr.
> Giachery is Erik Blumenthal of the'
> Continental Board of Counsellors in Europe.
> 
> The National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Bahli'{s of the Mariana Islands (one member
> absent.) The inaugural convention was held
> 26-28 May 1978.
> 
> Baha'fs attending the inaugural convention for
> the election of the National Spiritual Assembly
> of Mauritania; 27- 28 May 1978.
> 
> In addition, two new National Spiritual Assemblies were formed in Western Asia.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                         349
> 
> IV
> THE LOCAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBL Y 1
> 1. THE INSTITUTION AND ITS SIGNIFICANCE
> 
> THE institution of the Spiritual Assembly                 Formation of a Local Spiritual Assembly
> was created by Baha'u'llah and is an integral                 When the requisite conditions exist, the local
> part of His Revelation, together with the teach-          group of Baha'is is obligated to establish an
> ings, principles, supplications, truth, and laws           Assembly. It is not an optional matter.
> written in the Books and Tablets. It is the                   The requisite conditions are simple. They
> foundation stone of the new World Order, the               include the following:
> establishment of which is the essential aim of                1. There must be nine or more adult Baha'is
> the Baha'i Faith. Through the loyalty of the               in good standing resident in the community.
> believers who assist in the unfoldment of its                 2. These Baha'is are to be declared and reclatent attributes and powers, divine guidance             ognized believers, all meeting qualifications of
> and reinforcement is promised, and the forces             faith laid down by the Guardian. If one or more
> of unity, justice, affection and fellowship are            members of the group are such newlymade to prevail over the negative elements                confirmed Baha'is that they are not yet
> which prey upon and destroy the civilization of           recorded as believers by the National Spiritual
> an unbelieving age.                                       Assembly, these new believers are to take a full
> ' ... To it (Local Assembly) all local matters          part in the formation of the Assembly, subject
> pertaining to the Cause must be directly and              to later determination of their Baha'i status.
> immediately referred for full consultation and               3. Each Local Assembly has a definite area of
> decision. The importance, nay the absolute                jurisdiction. In most cases the area is that of the
> necessity of these Local Assemblies is manifest           civil boundaries of an incorporated village,
> when we realize that in the days to come they             town or city. An Assembly may also be formed
> will evolve into the local House of Justice, and          by nine or more Baha'is who reside in the same
> at present provide the firm foundation on                 township or county or unincorporated village.
> which the structure of the Master's Will is to be             Where the area of jurisdiction is a township,
> reared in future.' B.A., p. 37.                           there must be nine or more adult Baha'is resi-
> 'In order to avoid division and disruption ,           dent therein outside the limits of any incorpothat the Cause may not fall a prey to conflicting         rated town or city in the township, as each
> interpretations, and lose thereby its purity and          Baha'i civil area must be separate and distinct
> pristine vigour, that its affairs may be con-             from other areas where an Assembly might
> ducted with efficiency and promptness, it is              later be formed .
> necessary that every one should conscien-                    Where the area of jurisdiction is a county,
> tiously take an active part in the election of these      the county itself must be small enough to per-
> Assemblies, abide by their decisions, enforce             mit all the believers to meet regularly. The
> their decree, and co-operate with them                    county unit constitutes a Baha'i area of juriswholeheartedly in their task of stimulating the           diction only when in it there are nine or more
> growth of the Movement throughout all re-                 Baha'is who have access to no smaller civil area
> gions. The members of these Assemblies, on                such as township or permanent electoral distheir part, must disregard utterly their own              trict. Postal areas and school districts do not
> likes and dislikes, their personal interests and          represent areas of jurisdiction for Baha'i
> inclinations, and concentrate their minds upon            Assemblies.
> those measures that will conduce to the welfare              4. At the present time there is only one date
> and happiness of the Baha'i community and                 when Local Assemblies can be formed- April
> promote the common weal.' B.A., p. 41.                    21 of any year. As the Baha'i calendar consists
> From The Baha'i Community, Baha'i Publishing Trust,   of days which begin and end at sunset rather
> Wilmette, 1963.                                       than midnight, the time to form an Assembly is
> 350                                     THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> after sunset on April 20 and before sunset on            Assembly members are elected by plurality
> April 21 except in special circumstances.             vote. The believers receiving the nine highest
> 5. Where there are more than nine adult            votes on the first ballot are elected, unless two
> Baha'fs, they form an Assembly by e lecting the       or more are tied for ninth place. In case of a tie,
> nine members of the Spiritual Assembly.               a second ballot is cast by those present, and on
> Where there are exactly nine adult Baha'fs, they      this ballot the voter is to write the name of one
> establish an Assembly by joint declaration, and       of those who are tied in the first ballot.
> all nine members must participate. The                   Contrary to the ways of the world, Baha'i
> National Spiritual Assembly provides different        elections are approached in a spirit of prayer
> types of report forms for these two methods           without preliminary electioneering or nominand the group should apply for the proper form        ating of candidates. Before the ballots are cast,
> in advance.                                           prayers should be read and all participating
> (For further information refer to the follow-      ask for guidance in selecting those best fitted
> ing section on 'The Annual E lection and              to serve. In this regard the Guardian wrote:
> Organization.')                                          ' ... Let us recall His[' Abdu'l-Baha's] explicit
> and often-repeated assurances that every
> The Annual Election and Organization                  Assembly e lected in that rarefied atmosphere of
> 'These Local Spiritual Assemblies will have        selflessness and detachment is, in truth, apto be elected directly by the friends, and every      pointed of God, that its verdict is truly inspired,
> declared believer of 21 years and above, far          that one and all should submit to its decision unfrom standing aloof and assuming an indiffer-         reservedly and with cheerfulness.' B.A., p. 65.
> ent or independent attitude, should regard it            ' ... the elector ... is called upon to vote for
> his sacred duty to take part conscientiously and      none but those whom prayer and reflection
> diligently, in the election , the consolidation       have inspired him to uphold. Moreover, the
> and the efficient working of his own Local            practice of nomination , so detrimental to the
> Assembly.' B.A., p. 39.                               atmosphere of a silent and prayerful election, is
> 'Pending its (the Universal House of Justice)      viewed with mistrust . .. Should this simple sysestablishment, 1 and to ensure uniformity             tem (based o n plurality) be provisionally
> throughout the East and throughout the West,          adopted, it would safeguard the spiritual prinall Local Assemblies will have to be re-elected       ciple of the unfettered freedom of the voter,
> once a year, during the first day of Ric;lvan , and   who will thus preserve intact the sanctity of the
> the result of polling, if possible, be declared on    choice he first made .. .' B.A., p. 136.
> that day.' B.A., p. 41.                                  'The newly-elected Assembly is called to-
> The annual meeting on April 21, called for         gether by the believer who received the highest
> the election of the Spiritual Assembly, pro-          number of votes, or in case two or more memvides the occasion for the presentation of            bers have received the same said highest
> annual reports by the Assembly and by all its         number of votes, then by the member selected
> committees.                                           by lot from among those members; and this
> The chairman of the outgoing Assembly              member shall preside until the permanent
> presides at this meeting.                             chairman is chosen.' By-Laws of a Local
> Spiritual Assembly, Art, VIII.
> The order of business includes:                          It is preferable to have the election of the
> Reading of the call of the meeting                    officers of the Assembly immediately following
> Reading of appropriate Baha'i passages bearing        the annual election or formatio n by joint declaupon the subject of the election                    ration; however, all nine members of the
> Appointment of tellers                                Assembly must be given an opportunity to vote
> Distribution of ballots
> for the officers. In rare instances a meeting for
> Prayers for the spiritual guidance of the voters
> the election of officers cannot be called
> The election by secret ballot
> Presentation of annual reports                        because of inability on the part of one or more
> Tellers' report of the election                       members to attend. In such cases, the best pro-
> Approval of the tellers' report                       cedure is to elect or appoint immediately a
> temporary chairman and secretary to serve
> ' Written in 1923.                                    until such time as all members of the Assembly
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                                     351
> can be present to vote in person.                     The various functions of the Local Spiritual
> Permanent officers are elected by secret bal-    Assembly , and its nature as a constitutional
> lot and by majority rather than by plurality        body, are duly set forth in Article VII of the
> vote. (Plurality is the largest number; majority    By-Laws of the National Spiritual Assembly ,
> is the number greater than half, which, in this     and more definitely defined in the By-Laws of a
> case, is at least five out of the nine.)            Local Spiritual Assembly approved by the
> When an Assembly is organized, it is to          National Spiritual Assembly as recommended
> report its formation and election of officers to    by the Guardian. Each Local Spiritual Assemthe National Spiritual Assembly, together with      bly of the United States, whether or not legally
> whatever relevant facts may be necessary for        incorporated, is to function according to those
> recognition of the Assembly.                        By-Laws, and all members of the local Baha'i
> community shall be guided and controlled by
> Dissolution of a Local Spiritual Assembly           their provisions.
> Once elected or formed by joint declaration,        An essential function of Local Spiritual
> an Assembly continues to exist until the next       Assemblies is to act as intermediaries between
> annual election or until the National Spiritual     the local communities and the National
> Assembly acts to declare the Assembly dis-          Spiritual Assembly. The Local Assembly is,
> solved . This decision is not to be made by the     therefore, the proper medium through which
> members of the Local Assembly itself nor by         local Baha'i communities can communicate
> any regional or national committee.                 with the body of their national representatives.
> If the number of adult Baha'is in the community becomes less than nine, or other condi-      Appointment of Committees
> tions arise which make it impossible for the           In the appointment of committees, only
> Local Assembly to function, the facts should be     those committees needed to carry out the
> reported to the National Assembly for final         activities of the community are necessary. Such
> determination of the status of the Assembly.        committees are appointed by the Assembly
> from among the entire membership of the
> Authority and Functions                             community, have specific functions to perform,
> The Loca l Spiritual Assemblies are 'invested    and are responsible to the Assembly who will
> with an authority rendering them unans:wer-         exercise constant and general supervision over
> able for their acts and decisions to those who      their work. Before making appointments, it is
> elect them; solemnly pledged to follow, under       usually beneficial to discuss the special
> all conditions, the dictates of the "Most Great     abilities, aptitudes and personal wishes of the
> Justice" that can alone usher in the reign of the   members under consideration in relation to the
> "Most Great Peace" which Baha' u'llah has           tasks which a re to be performed by the comproclaimed and must ultimately establish;           mittees.
> charged with the responsibility of promoting at
> all times the best interests of the communities     Meetings
> within their jurisdiction, of familiarizing them       A meeting of the Spiritual Assembly is valid
> with their plans and activities and of inviting     only when it has been duly called, that is, when
> them to offer any recommendations they might        each and every member has been informed of
> wish to make; cognizant of their no less vital      the time and place. The general practice is for
> task of demonstrating, through association          the Assembly to decide upon some regular
> with all liberal and humanitarian movements,        time and place for its meeting throughout the
> the universality and comprehensiveness of           Baha'i year, and this decision when recorded in
> their Faith; dissociated entirely from all sec-     the minutes is sufficient notice to the members.
> tarian organizations, whether religious or secu-    When the regular schedule cannot be followed ,
> lar; assisted by committees annually appointed      or the need arises for a special meeting, the
> by, and directly responsible to them, to each of    secretary, on request of the chairman, or, in his
> which a particular branch of Baha'i activity is     absence or incapacity, of the vice-chairman, or
> assigned for study and action; supported by         of any three members of the Assembly, should
> local funds to which all believers voluntarily      send due notice to all the members.
> contribute .. .' G.P.B., p. 331.                      The procedure for the calling of the Annual
> 352                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Meeting is outlined in Article XI of the By-          resull is light, and should the least trace of
> Laws of a Local Spiritual Assembly.                   estrangement prevail the result shall be darkness
> upon darkness ... If this be so regarded, thal
> Prime Requisi1es                                      assembly shall be of Cod, but otherwise it shall
> The prime requisites for !hem that lake coun-      lead 10 coolness and alienation that proceed
> sel together are purify of motive, radiance of        from the Evil One . .. Should they endeavour to
> spirit, detachment from all else save Cod, a11rac-    fulfil lhese conditions the Crace of the Holy
> tion 10 His Divine Fragrances, humility and           Spirit shall be vouchsafed unlo !hem, and that
> lowliness amongst His loved ones, patience and        assembly shall become the centre of Divine bleslong-suffering in difficulties and servitude to His   sings, the hosts of Divine confirmation shall
> exalted Threshold. Should they be graciously          come lo their aid, and they shall day by day
> aided to acquire these atlributes, viClory from       receive a new effusion of spirit. 'Abdu'l-Baha.
> the unseen Kingdom of Bahti shall be vouch-           B.A., pp. 22-23.
> safed to them. In this day, assemblies of consul-
> Recommended Agenda and Procedure
> tation are of the greatest importance and a vital
> Since order is an important characteristic of
> necessity. Obedience unto them is essential and
> the Baha'i Faith, Baha'is should conduct their
> obliga1ory. B.A., p. 21.
> business in an orderly manner.
> The firs! condition is absolute love and har-
> The following agenda is suggested for meetmony amongst the members of the Assembly.
> ings of the Local Spiritual Assembly:
> They must be wholly free from estrangement
> and must manifest in themselves the Unity of          Prayer.
> Cod, for they are the waves ofone sea, the drops      Reading and approval of minutes of previous meeting.
> of one river, the stars of one heaven, the rays of
> Report of Secretary (or Corresponding Secretary)
> one sun, !he trees of one orchard, the flowers of
> including correspondence of interest and concern
> one garden . Should harmony of thought and              to the body of the believers, and any and all
> absolute unity be non-existent, the gathering           recommendations duly adopted by the community
> shall be dispersed and that Assembly be brought         at the last Nineteen Day Feast.
> to naught.                                            Report of Treasurer.
> The second condition:-They must when               Report of Committees.
> coming together turn their faces to the Kingdom       Unfinished business.
> on High and ask aid from the Realm of Glory.          New business, including conferences with members
> They must then proceed with the utmost devo-            of the community and with applicants for enrolment as members of the community.
> tion, courtesy, dignity, care and moderation to
> Closing prayer.
> express their views. They must in every matter
> search out the truth and not insist upon their           A Spiritual Assembly in maintaining its
> own opinion, for stubbornness and persistence in      three-fold function of a body given (within the
> one's views will lead ultimately to discord and       limits of its jurisdiction) an executive, a legislawrangling and the truth will remain hidden. The       tive and a judicial capacity, is charged with
> honoured members must with all freedom                responsibilities for initiating action and making
> express their own thoughts, and it is in no wise      decisions. Its meetings, therefore, revolve
> permissible for one to belittle the thought of        around various definite matters which require
> another, nay, he must with moderation set forth       deliberation and collective decision, and it is
> the truth, and should differences of opinion          incumbent upon the members, one and all, to
> arise a majority of voices must prevail, and all      address themselves to the chairman on the submust obey and submit to the majority. It is again     ject under discussion and not introduce matnot permitted that any one of the honoured            ters irrelevant to the subject.
> members object to or censure, whether in or out          Baha'i principles of consultation and majorof the meeting, any decision arrived at previ-        ity rule are requisite characteristics in Baha'i
> ously, though that decision be not right, for such    Administration, and represent radical deparcriticism would prevent any decision from being       tures from the generally accepted rules of parenforced.                                             liamentary procedure. In Baha'i Assembly
> In short, whatsoever thing is arranged in          action, the chairman takes part in the discusharmony and with love and purity of motive, its       sion, and a majority decision becomes unani-
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                         353
> mous and binding upon all. There is no minor-       has been given to all members to express their
> ity opinion in Baha'i Administration ; the deci-    views.
> sion of the majority is the decision of all.           A motion to adjourn is always in order and
> Every subject or problem before an Assem-        has priority over all other motions except the
> bly is most efficiently handled when the follow-    motion to fix the time of the next meeting. The
> ing process is observed:                            motion to adjourn is not debatable and cannot
> First , ascertainment and agreement upon the     be amended. It requires a majority vote .
> facts;                                              Before voting, however, the presiding officer
> Second , agreement upon the spiritual or         should point out items of unfinished business
> adminstrative principle which is involved;          on the agenda, so that the members will know
> Third , full and frank discussion of the mat-    whether to vote for or against adjournment at
> ter, leading up to the offering of a resolution;    that moment.
> and                                                    A motion may be withdrawn by the mover,
> Fourth, voting upon the resolution.              provided no one objects, and before a vote has
> A resolution, or motion, is not subject to       been taken.
> discussion or vote until duly made and sec-            When the Assembly has taken action upon
> onded . It is preferable to have such resolution    any matter, the action is binding upon all
> clear and complete in itself, but when an           members, whether present or absent from the
> amendment is duly made and seconded, the            meeting at which the action was taken. Indichairman shall call for a vote on the amend-        vidual views and opinions must be subordiment first and then on the original motion. An      nated to the will of the Assembly when a deciamendment must be relevant to, and not con-         sion has been made. A Spiritual Assembly is an
> travene, the subject matter of the motion. Only     administrative unit, as it is a spiritual unit, and
> one motion should be considered at a time. The      therefore no distinction between 'majority'
> procedure for handling motions is:                  and ' minority' groups or factions can be recog-
> 1. Statement of motion                           nized. Each member must give undivided loy-
> 2. Second                                        alty to the institution to which he or she has
> 3. Discussion of the motion                      been elected.
> 4 . Voting                                          Any action taken by the Assembly can be
> 5. Announcement of the result of the voting.     reconsidered at a later meeting, on motion duly
> Amendments are to be voted on before the         made, seconded and carried. This reconsideramain motion. Motions can be amended only            tion , according to the result of the consultation ,
> once, by one of the following actions: adding,      may lead to a revision or the annulment of the
> striking out, inserting, striking out and insert-   prior action. If a majority is unwilling to reconing, substituting, dividing.                        sider the prior action, further discussion of the
> An action may be agreed upon by the              matter by any member is improper.
> Assembly without going through the formality
> of making a motion and voting upon it ; how-        Vacancies on Assembly
> ever, if the agreement is not unanimous the            The Assembly has a responsibility in filling a
> question must be put to a vote.                     vacancy caused by the inability of any member
> The ·chairman , or other presiding officer,      to attend the meetings. 'It is only too obvious
> has the same right and responsibility as other      that unless a member can attend regularly the
> members of the Assembly for discussing and          meetings of his Local Assembly, it would be
> voting upon all matters being considered by the     impossible for him to discharge the duties
> Assembly.                                           incumbent upon him, and to fulfil his respon-
> Discussion of any subject before the Assem-      sibilities as a representative of the community.
> bly may be terminated by a motion duly made,        Membership in a Local Spiritual Assembly carseconded and voted , calling upon the chairman      ries with it, indeed, the obligation and capacity
> to put the matter to a vote or to proceed to the    to remain in close touch with local Baha'i
> next matter on the agenda. The purpose of this      activities, and ability to attend regularly the
> procedure is to prevent any member or mem-          sessions of the Assembly.' Letter from Shoghi
> bers from unnecessarily prolonging the discus-      Effendi, 16 Feb. 1935.
> sion beyond the point at which full opportunity        When a vacancy on an Assembly involves
> 354                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> The Spiritual Assembly of Ocean Island ( Banaba); Ri(ivtin 1977. This island lies approximately fifty-seven miles south ofthe equator and is within the territory ofthe National Spiritual
> Assembly ofthe Gilbert Islands (Kiribati) and Tuvalu. The Local Assembly was elected for the
> first time at Ri(ivtin 1976.
> 
> The Spiritual Assembly of Nuuk, Greenland, formed in 1979. This is the first Local Spiritual
> Assembly in Greenland.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                                    355
> also one of its officers, the Assembly vacancy is    onding motions or making comments during
> filled in the usual manner by election at a spe-     the discussion. Names are of importance, howcial meeting of the local Baha'i community,          ever, when the minutes record reports given on
> after which the entire Assembly elects the new       special assignments or situations, or when
> officer.                                             assignments are given to particular individuals.
> If a decision is adopted by common consent
> Minutes                                              without the formality of a motion, even this
> The Spiritual Assembly, as a permanent            decision should be clearly stated by the chairbody, is responsible for maintaining all minutes     man and recorded in the minutes so that there
> of its meetings, important records and corre-        is no question as to what action was agreed
> spondence, and financial records throughout its      upon by the group.
> existence as a Baha'i institution. Each officer,        Correspondence should be listed in the
> therefore, on completing his or her term of          minutes. Copies of important outgoing correoffice, shall turn over to the Assembly all          spondence , in addition to the incoming letters,
> records and files pertaining to the business of      should be kept for the files.
> the Assembly. A permanent record of minutes             Record should be made in the minutes of
> is of special importance and necessity when an       consultation with individuals meeting with the
> Assembly is incorporated, because situations         Assembly, whether requested by the individual
> could arise which would make it necessary to         or the Assembly.
> produce the minutes for inspection by state             Minutes should be written or typed legibly.
> authorities.                                         They should be corrected and approved by the
> Other items which would be of historical          Assembly before they become a matter of
> interest in the future should be kept in the local   permanent record.
> archives.                                               Records of Nineteen-Day Feasts need
> It is vitally important that each Local           include only the recommendations made by
> Spiritual Assembly maintain a complete file of       the community to be presented to the Local
> Bahri'{ News and the U.S. Supplement for             Spiritual Assembly, with the background
> reference on various directives regarding laws       necessary for understanding them.
> and procedures, teaching suggestions, and               Minutes of Assembly meetings are not read
> other pertinent information. It should also          at the Nineteen-Day Feasts; only the actions
> maintain and keep up to date a file of all special   taken by the Assembly which concern the
> instructions and statements from the National        community affairs are reported at Feasts. The
> Spiritual Assembly dealing with matters of           judgement of what should be shared at the
> permanent value.                                     Feasts belongs to the Local Spiritual Assem-
> Minutes are the permanent official record of      bly.
> the meeting taken by a secretary. If the community is large and the Assembly handles a           Legal Incorporation
> great amount of business, a recording secretary         Local Assemblies having fifteen or more
> may be elected to record the minutes. The            active adult believers in the community are
> minutes should include all essential details,        authorized to effect legal incorporation.
> such as the election of the Assembly and its            To do so the matter should be presented at
> officers at the beginning of each year, by-          a Nineteen-Day Feast and a recommendation
> elections for filling vacancies on the Assembly      adopted which expresses the desire of the
> occurring during the year, attendance of all         community that the Spiritual Assembly be lemembers at its meetings, new enrolments and          gally incorporated.
> transfers, marriages and deaths.                        The Baha'i World volumes reproduce many
> All carried motions are recorded in the           local Certificates of Incorporation which supminutes. The minutes should be written in such       ply models for consideration by the Assembly's
> a way as to provide sufficient background to         attorney. What is incorporated is the Spiritual
> understand the reason for the motions and            Assembly, not the entire community. The
> decision , but the entire discussion does not        community is associated with the instrument
> need to be recorded. It is not necessary to          through the annual election of the Local
> record names of individuals making and sec-          Assembly and the Spiritual Assembly's author-
> 356                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> ity to enrol new believers and determine the           material feast and social meeting of all the
> membership list.                                       believers, and should maintain the spiritual
> The Articles of Incorporation are to make           nature of the Feast.
> proper reference to the Central Figures of the            In selecting the readings for the devotional
> Faith and to the National Spiritual Assembly.          part of the Feast the friends may be gu ided by
> If necessary, the National Assembly on request         the instructions printed in Bahli'f News quoting
> will provide an example of how this is to be           the following excerpt from a letter to a believer
> done.                                                  from the Guardian through his assistant sec-
> Before the Incorporation papers are                 retary dated 27 April 1956, 'The Writings of
> recorded, a copy is to be sent to the National         the Bab and Baha' u'llah can certainly be read
> Spiritual Assembly for final approval. After           at any time at any place ; likewise the Writings
> recording, three photostatic copies of the             of 'Abdu'l-Baha are read freely during the
> recorded Articles are to be sent to the National       spiritual part of the Feast. The Guardian has
> Spiritual Assembly, together with a photo-             instructed that during the spiritual part of the
> graph of the nine Assembly members.                    Feast, his own writings should not be read. In
> Incorporation must be preserved in accord-          other words, during the spiritual part of the
> ance with the manner prescribed by state law.          Feast, readings should be confined to the Writings of the Bab, Baha'u'llah and to a lesser
> THE NINETEEN-DAY FEAST                           extent, of the Master; but during that part of
> the Feast the Guardian's writings should not be
> The institution of the Nineteen-Day Feast           read. During the period of administrative disprovides the recognized and regular occasion           cussion of the Feast, then the Guardian's writfor general consultation on the part of the            ings may be read. Of course, during the
> community, and for consultation between the            administrative part of the Feast there can be no
> Spiritual Assembly and the members of the              objection to the reading of the Writings of the
> community. The conduct of the period of con-           Bab, Baha'u'llah or 'Abdu'l-Baha.' Baha'i
> sultation at Nineteen-Day Feasts is a vital func-      News, Jan. 1959.
> tion of each Spiritual Assembly.                          Baha'is should regard this Feast as the very
> From words of 'Abdu' l- Baha: The                   heart of their spiritual activity, their participa-
> Nineteen-Day Feast was inaugurated by the              tion in the mystery of the holy utterance, their
> Bab and ratified by Baha'u'llah, in His Holy           steadfast unity one with another in a universal-
> Book, the Aqdas, so that people may gather             ity raised high above the limitations of race,
> together and outwardly show fellowship and             class, nationality, sect, and personality, and
> love, that the Divine mysteries may be disclosed.      their privilege of contributing to the power of
> The object is concord, that through this fellow-       the Cause in the realm of collective action.
> ship hearts may become perfectly united, and
> reciprocity and mutual helpfulness be estab-           Attendance
> lished. Because the members of the world of               Only members of the Baha'i community and
> humanity are unable to exist without being             visiting Baha'is from other localities may
> banded together, co-operation and helpfulness is       attend these meetings. Young people between
> the basis of human society. Without the realiza-       fifteen and twenty-one years of age, who have
> tion of these two great principles no great            declared their acceptance of the qualifications
> movement is pressed forward. B.W., Vol. XII,           of membership in the Faith are considered as
> p. 298.                                                members although they are referred to as Baha'i
> The Nineteen-Day Feast has been described           youth. Children up to age fifteen, of Baha'i
> by the Guardian as the foundation of the               parents, may also attend the Nineteen-Day
> World Order of Baha'u'llah. It is to be con-          Feasts.
> ducted according to the following programme:              Regular attendance at the Nineteen-Day
> the first part, entirely spiritual in character, is   Feast is incumbent upon every Baha'i, illness
> devoted to the reading of Baha'i prayers and          or absence from the city being the only
> selections from the Baha'i sacred Writings; the        justification for absence. Believers are
> second part consists of general consultation on        expected to arrange their personal affairs so as
> the affairs of the Cause; the third part is the       to enable them to observe the Baha'i calendar.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA ' U ' LLAH                                    357
> Order of Business for the Consultation Period       and concentrating upon the one aim to further
> The chairman or other appointed represen-        the interests of the Faith.
> tative of the Spiritual Assembly presides dur-         Baha'i visitors attending a Feast do not take
> ing the period of consultation.                     part in the consultation of the community
> The Spiritual Assembly reports to the com-       unless invited to do so.
> munity whatever communications have been               The secretary of the Assembly records each
> received from the World Centre and the              resolution adopted by the community, as well
> National Spiritual Assembly, as well as other       as the various suggestions advanced during the
> correspondence of concern to all believers of       meeting, in order to report these to the
> the community. This does not necessarily mean       Spiritual Assembly for its consideration.
> that all communications must be read in full at     Whatever action the Assembly takes is to be
> the Feast.                                          reported at a later Nineteen-Day feast.
> A matter of vital importance at this meeting        It should be borne in mind that the consultais consideration of national and international      tion period of the Nineteen-Day Feast is not
> Baha'i affairs, to strengthen the capacity of the   the time for the Local Spiritual Assembly to
> community to co-operate in promotion of the         consult and make decisions.
> larger Baha'f interests and to deepen the              Matters of a personal nature should be
> understanding of all believers concern ing the      brought to the Spiritual Assembly and not to
> relation of the local community to the Baha'i       the community at the Nineteen-Day Feast.
> world community.                                    Concerning the attitude with which believers
> The Assembly likewise reports its own            should come to these Feasts, the Master has
> activities and plans, including committee           said, You must free yourselves from everything
> appointments that may have been made since          that is in your hearts, before you enter.
> the last Feast, the financial report, arrangements made for public meetings, and in general                    CONSULTATION
> shares with the community all matters that             In this Cause, consultation is of vital imporconcern the Faith. These reports are to be fol-     tance; but spiritual conference and not the mere
> lowed by general consultation.                      voicing of personal views is intended ...
> Provision is to be made for reports from         Antagonism and contradiction are unfortunate
> committees, with discussion of each report.         and always destructive of truth .. . The purpose
> The meeting is to be open for suggestions        is to emphasize the statement that consultation
> and recommendations from individual believ-         must have for its object the investigation of
> ers to the Local Spiritual Assembly on any          truth. He who expresses an opinion should not
> matter affecting the Cause. Such recommenda-        voice it as correct and right but set it forth as a
> tions must be adopted by majority vote of the       contribution to the consensus ofopinion; for the
> community members present before constitut-         light of reality becomes apparent when two
> ing a resolution to be considered by the Local      opinions coincide . ... 'Abdu'l-B aha. P.U.P.,
> Spiritual Assembly.                                 pp. 68-69.
> Through this means individual Baha'fs find          'The principle of consultation, which conin the Nineteen-Day Feast the channel through       stitutes one of the basic laws of the Adminiswhich to make suggestions and recommenda-           tration, should be applied to all Baha'i activities
> tions to the National Spiritual Assembly.           which affect the collective interests of the Faith
> These recommendations are offered first to the      for it is through co-operation and continued
> local community, and when adopted by the            exchange of thoughts and views that the Cause
> community come before the Local Assembly,           can best safeguard and foster its interests. Indiwhich then may in its discretion forward the        vidual initiative, personal ability and resourcerecommendations to the National Spiritual           fulness, though indispensible, are, unless sup-
> Assembly accompanied by its own considered          ported and enriched by the collective experiview.                                               ence and wisdom of the group, utterly incap-
> Upon each member of the community lies           able of achieving such a tremendous task.'
> the obligation to make his or her utmost con-       Shoghi Effendi, Baha'( News, Nov. 1933.
> tribution to the consultation, the ideal being a       'Shoghi Effendi firmly believes that consulgathering of Baha'is inspired with one spirit       tation must be maintained between the
> 358                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> National Spiritual Assembly and the entire           decision made. The National Assembly can
> body of the believers, and that such consulta-       decide only upon the facts presented to it;
> tion, while the Convention is not in session , can   therefore, when a matter is submitted to it, all
> best be maintained through the agency of the         obtainable facts , together with supporting
> Local Assemblies, one of whose essential func-       documentary evidence should be included.
> tions is to act as intermediaries between the        The National Assembly's decision, whether
> local communities and their national represen-       approving or disapproving the original decitatives. The main purpose of the Nineteen-Day        sion of the Local Assembly, will be communi-
> Feast is to enable individual believers to offer     cated to both the Local Assembly and to the
> any suggestion to the Local Assembly which in        person or persons who made the appeal.
> its turn will pass it to the National Spiritual         This procedure is in accordance with both
> Assembly. The Local Assembly is, therefore,          the national and local By-Laws.
> the proper medium through which local Baha'i            Any complaint received by the National
> communities can communicate with the body of         Assembly from a member or members of a
> the national representatives.' Letter on behalf      local community who have not first submitted
> of Shoghi Effendi, 18 Nov. 1933.                     their complaint to the Local Assembly will be
> 'Let us also remember that at the very root of    returned to those making the protest, with a
> the Cause lies the principle of the undoubted        copy of the letter being sent to the Local
> right of the individual to self-expression, his      Assembly for its information. In such a case the
> freedom to declare his conscience and set forth      Local Assembly is to call the person or persons
> his views ...                                        in for consultation and act upon the complaint.
> 'Let us also bear in mind that the keynote of        An essential function of the Local Spiritual
> the Cause of God is not dictatorial authority        Assembly is the maintenance of unity and devobut humble fellowship, not arbitrary power,          tion among the believers. As 'Trustees of the
> but the spirit of frank and loving consultation.     Merciful' the Spiritual Assembly must be
> Nothing short of the spirit of a true Baha'i can     selfless and impartial, considerate of the rights
> hope to reconcile the principles of mercy and        of the individual, but firm and steadfast in
> justice, of freedom and submission, of the sanc-     upholding the vital truths of the Revelation
> tity of the right of the individual and of self-     and obedience to its institutions. Therefore,
> surrender, of vigilance, discretion and pru-         they must discriminate between situations
> dence on the one hand, and fellowship, can-          which are transient and trivial and those which
> dour, and courage on the other.' B.A., pp.           threaten to disrupt the community. A distinc-
> 63-64.                                               tion is to be made between personalities who
> cause disturbances because they lack ground-
> DECISIONS AND APPEALS
> ing in the basic Teachings and attitudes of the
> At this crucial stage in the history of our        Baha'i life, and those who deliberately cause
> Faith it seems advisable to emphasize to each        trouble because in their hearts they do not
> Local Assembly an important principle of             accept the principle of authority as vested in
> administration which has been too frequently         the Manifestation, or in the institutions of the
> overlooked. This principle establishes the           Baha'i world community.
> National Assembly as the court of appeal from           The Local Assembly is responsible for dealdecisions of Local Assemblies when protested         ing with all local problems, but can call upon
> by one or more members of the community as           the National Spiritual Assembly for advice if
> unjust or as not conforming to the actual facts.     necessary.
> A court of appeal is not responsible for              The National Assembly, in any case involvdetermining the facts but only for reviewing         ing two or more local communities, however,
> the local decision based upon the facts assem-       acts directly and deals with the problems as the
> bled by the Local Assembly itself. On receiving      court of original jurisdiction, since no Local
> an appeal the National Spiritual Assembly will       Assembly has authority outside its own civil
> send a copy of it to the Local Assembly and          area.
> request its opinion. When this is received the          'The authority of the National Spiritual
> case will be studied in the light of the facts       Assembly is undivided and unchallengeable in
> presented to the National Assembly and a final       all matters pertaining to the administration of
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                                   359
> 
> the Faith throughout the United States, ...         ible source . To be continually giving out for the
> therefore, the obedience of individual Baha'is,     good of our fellows undeterred by the fear of
> delegates, groups a nd Assemblies to that           poverty and reliant on the unfailing bounty of
> authority is imperative and should be               the Source of all wealth and all good-this is
> wholehearted and unqualified. He is convinced       the secret of right living .' Shoghi Effendi,
> that the unreserved acceptance and complete         Bahri'[ N ews , Sept. 1926.
> application of this vital provision of the             'As the activities of the American Baha'i
> Administration is essential to the maintenance      community expand, and its worldwide prestige
> of the highest degree of unity among the            correspondingly increases, the institution of
> believers, and is indispensable to the effective    the National Fund, the bedrock on which all
> working of the administrative machinery of the      other institutions must necessarily rest and be
> Faith in every country.' Letter from Shoghi         established , acquires added importance, and
> Effendi through his secretary. BahCi'f News,        should be increasingly supported by the entire
> Jul y 1934.                                         body of the believers, both in their individual
> capacities , and through their collective efforts,
> THE BAHA'I FUND
> whether organized as groups or as Local
> 'As the progress and extension of spiritual      Assemblies. The supply of funds, in support of
> activities is dependent and conditioned upon        the National Treasury, constitutes, at the presmaterial means, it is of absolute necessity that    ent time , the lifeblood of these nascent instituimmediately after the establishment of Local        tions you are labouring to erect. Its importance
> as well as National Spiritual Assemblies, a         cannot , surely, be overestimated. Untold bless-
> Baha'i Fund be established, to be placed under      ings shall no doubt crown every effort directed
> the exclusive control of the Spiritual Assembly .   to that end.' M.A., p. 5.
> All donations and contributions should be              ' In connection with the institution of the
> offered to the treasurer of the Assembly, for       National Fund ... I feel urged to remind you of
> the express purpose of promoting the interests      the necessity of ever bearing in mind the cardiof the Cause , throughout that locality or coun-    nal principle that all contributions to the Fund
> try. It is the .sacred obligation of every con-     are to be purely and strictly voluntary in
> scientious and faithful servant of Baha'u'llah      character .. .' B.A., p. 101.
> who desires to see His Cause advance, to con-          'Moreover, we should , I feel , regard it as an
> tribute freely and generously for the increase      axiom and guiding principle of Baha'i
> of th1t Fund. The members of the Spiritual          administration that in the conduct of every
> Assembly will at their own discretion expend it     specific Baha'i activity, as different from
> to promote the Teaching Campaign, to help           undertakings of a humanitarian, philanthropic,
> the needy, to establish educational Baha'i          or charitable character, which may in future be
> institutions, to extend in every way possible       conducted under Baha'i auspices, only those
> their sphere of service. I cherish the hope that    who have already identified themselves with
> all the friends , realizing the necessity of this   the Faith and are regarded as its avowed and
> measure will bestir themselves and contribute,      unreserved supporters, should be invited to
> however modestly at first, towards the speedy       join and collaborate.' B.A., p. 182.
> establishment and the increase of that Fund            A statement from the National Treasurer is
> .. .' B.A., pp. 41-42.                              included in an issue of the Baha'i News each
> 'We must be like the fountain or spring that     year, setting out the various funds-internais continually emptying itself of all that it has   tional, national, and local-with instructions
> and is continually being refilled from an invis-    for making contributions to each of them .
> ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS SECTION
> B.A.             Bahri'{ Administration
> Bahri'[ News     U.S. Bahri'{ News
> B.W.             The Bahe/{ World
> G.P.B.           God Passes By
> M.A.             Messages to America
> P.U.P.           J:he Promulgation of Universal Peace
> 360                               THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> The first Spiritual Assembly of Imphal, Manipur, India; March 1979. Standing, third and
> fourth from the left, are Auxiliary Board members Gautam Das of Ca/cul/a and Ganesh
> Shenoy of Sikkim . One m ember of the Local Assembly was not present.
> 
> The first Spiritual Assembly of Emmen, th e Netherlands, formed in 1977. By Ri(iwin 1979
> there were 25,511 Local Spiritual Assemblies throughout the world.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                   361
> 
> 2. BY-LAWS OF A LOCAL SPIRITUAL
> ASSEMBLY
> WE,    the undersigned members of the Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of . . . , desiring to
> incorporate this body do hereby adopt the following By-Laws:
> 
> ARTICLE I
> The Trustees, i.e., the members of the Spiritual Assembly, recognize that this action has been
> taken in full unanimity and agreement. They acknowledge for themselves and on behalf of their
> successors the sacred meaning and universal purpose of the Baha'i Faith, the teachings and
> principles of which fulfil the divine promise of all former revealed religions.
> 
> ARTICLE II
> In administering the affairs of the Baha'i religion under this Corporation for the benefit of the
> Baha'is of ... in accordance with the religious teachings and administrative principles of this
> Faith, the Spiritual Assembly shall act in conformity with the functions of a Local Spiritual
> Assembly as defined in the By-Laws adopted by the National Spiritual Assembly and published
> by that body for the information and guidance of Baha'is throughout ... '
> 
> ARTICLE III
> The Spiritual Assembly, in the fulfilment of its obligations and responsibilities under this
> Corporation , shall have exclusive jurisdiction and authority over all the local activities and affairs
> of the Baha'i community of . . . , including paramount authority in the administration of this
> Corporation. It shall be responsible for maintaining the integrity and accuracy of all Baha'i
> teaching, whether written or oral, undertaken throughout the local community. It shall make
> available the published literature of the Faith. It shall represent the community in relationship to
> the National Spiritual Assembly, the Universal House of Justice, other local Baha'i communities
> and the general public in . . . It shall be charged with the recognition of all applicants requesting
> membership in the local Baha'i community . It shall pass upon the right of any and all members of
> the community whose membership is in question to retain their status as voting members of the
> community. It shall call the meetings of the community, including the Baha'i Anniversaries and
> Feasts , the Meetings of consultation, and the Annual Meeting at which the members of the
> Assembly are elected . It shall appoint and supervise all committees of the Baha'i community. It
> shall collect and disburse all funds intended for the maintenance of this Corporation. It shall have
> full and complete custody of the headquarters or meeting place of the Baha'i community. It shall
> have exclusive authority to conduct Baha'i marriage ceremonies and issue Baha'i marriage
> certificates within the area of its jurisdiction. It shall report to the National Spiritual Assembly
> annually, or when requested, the membership roll of the Baha'i community, for the information
> and approval of the National Assembly. The Spiritual Assembly, however, shall recognize the
> authority and right of the National Spiritual Assembly to declare at any time what activities and
> affairs of the Baha'i community of ... are national in scope and hence subject to the jurisdiction
> of the National Assembly. It shall likewise recognize the right of any member of the community to
> appeal to the National Spiritual Assembly for review and decision of any matter in which the
> previous decision of the Local Spiritual Assembly is felt by the member to be contrary to the
> explicit teachings of the Baha'i Faith or opposed to its best interests. It shall, on the other hand,
> have the authority and right to appeal from the decision of the National Assembly to the
> Universal House of Justice for review and final decision of any matter related to the Faith in ...
> 
> ARTICLE IV
> The Spiritual Assembly, in administering this Corporation, shall ever bear in mind the ideals
> upheld in the sacred Writings of the Baha'i Faith respecting the relationships of a Spiritual
> Name of country or region.
> 362                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Assembly to its Baha'i community, respecting the relations of Baha'ls to one another in the
> community, and the relationships of Baha'ls to all non-Baha'ls, without prejudice of race, creed or
> nationality. The Assembly shall therefore above all recognize its sacred duty to maintain full and
> complete unity throughout the Baha'i community, to relieve and comfort the sick and distressed,
> to assist the poor and destitute, to protect the orphans, the crippled and the aged, to educate the
> children of Baha'ls according to the highest religious and intellectual standards, to compose
> differences and disagreements among members of the community, to promulgate the principles
> of Divine Civilization revealed by Baha'u'llah, and to promote in every way possible the Baha'i
> aim of the oneness of mankind. It shall faithfully and devotedly uphold the general Baha'i
> activities and affairs initiated and sustained by the National Spiritual Assembly. It shall cooperate wholeheartedly with other Local Spiritual Assemblies throughout ... 1 in all matters
> declared by the National Spiritual Assembly to be of general Baha'i importance and concern. It
> shall rigorously abstain from any action or influence, direct or indirect, that savours of intervention on the part of a Baha'i body in matters of public politics and civil jurisdiction. It shall
> encourage intercourse between the Baha'i community of ... and other recognized Baha'i
> communities, issuing letters of introduction to Baha'ls travelling from . . . and passing upon
> letters of introduction issued by other Baha'i Assemblies. It shall regard its authority as a means
> of rendering service to Baha'ls and non-Baha'ls and not as a source of arbitrary power. While
> retaining the sacred right of final decision in all matters pertaining to the Baha'i community, the
> Spiritual Assembly shall ever seek the advice and consultation of all members of the community,
> keep the community informed of all its affairs, and invite full and free discussion on the part of the
> community of all matters affecting the Faith.
> 
> ARTICLE V
> The Baha'fs of ... for whose benefit this Corporation has been established shall consist of all
> persons of the age of 15 years or over resident in ... who are accepted by the National Spiritual
> Assembly as possessing the qualifications of Baha'i faith and practice required under the following standard set forth by the Guardian of the Faith:
> Full recognition of the station of the Bab, the Forerunner; of Baha'u'llah, the Author; and of
> 'Abdu'l-Baha, the True Exemplar of the Baha'i religion; unreserved acceptance of, and submission to, whatsoever has been revealed by their Pen; loyal and steadfast adherence to every clause
> of 'Abdu'l-Baha's sacred Will; and close association with the spirit as well as the form of Baha'i
> Administration throughout the world.
> Upon attaining the age of 21 years, a Baha'i is eligible to vote and to hold elective office.
> 
> ARTICLE VI
> The Spiritual Assembly shall consist of nine Trustees chosen from among the Baha'ls of ... ,
> who shall be elected by these Baha'ls in a manner hereinafter provided and who shall continue in
> office for the period of one year, or until their successors shall be elected.
> 
> ARTICLE VII
> The officers of the Spiritual Assembly shall consist of a Chainnan, Vice-Chairman, Secretary
> and Treasurer, and such other officers as may be found necessary for the proper conduct of its
> affairs. The officers shall be elected by a majority vote of the entire membership of the Assembly
> taken by secret ballot.
> ARTICLE VIII
> The first meeting of a newly-elected Assembly shall be called by the member elected to
> membership by the highest number of votes or, in case two or more members have received the
> same said highest number of votes, then by the member selected by lot from among those
> members; and this member shall preside until the permanent Chairman shall be chosen. All
> subsequent meetings shall be called by the Secretary of the Assembly at the request of the
> Chairman or, in his absence or incapacity, of the Vice-Chairman, or of any three members of the
> Name of country or region.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                               363
> Assembly; provided , however, that the Annual Meeting of the Assembly shall be held on April 21 ,
> in accordance with the administrative principles recognized by all Baha'i Assemblies .
> SECTION 1. Five members of the Assembly present at a meeting shall constitute a quorum, and a
> majority vote of those present and constituting a quorum shall be sufficient for the conduct of
> business, except as otherwise provided in these By-Laws, and with due regard to the principle of
> unity and cordial fellowship involved in the institution of a Spiritual Assembly. The transactions
> and decisions of the Assembly shall be recorded at each meeting by the Secretary, who shall have
> the minutes adopted and approved by the Assembly, and preserve them in the official records of
> the Assembly.
> SECTION 2. Vacancies in the membership of the Spiritual Assembly shall be filled by election at a
> special meeting of the local Baha'i community duly called for that purpose by the Assembly. In
> the event that the number of vacancies exceeds four, making a quorum of the Spiritual Assembly
> impossible, the election shall be under the supervision of the National Spiritual Assembly.
> 
> ARTICLE IX
> The sphere of jurisdiction of the Spiritual Assembly, with respect to residential qualification of
> membership, and voting rights of a believer in the Baha'i community, shall be the locality
> included within the civil limits of . . .
> ARTICLE X
> SECTION 1. In the event that any decision of the Assembly is unacceptable to any member or
> members of the community, the Assembly shall, after endeavouring to compose the difference of
> opinion , invite the said member or members to make appeal to the National Spiritual Assembly
> and notify that body of the condition of the matter and the readiness of the Assembly to become
> party to that appeal.
> SECTION 2. In the same manner, if any difference arises between the Assembly and another
> Local Assembly , or Assemblies, in ... 1 , the Assembly shall report the matter to the National
> Assembly and inform that body of its readiness to make joint appeal together with the other
> Assembly or Assemblies.
> SECTION 3. If, however, the result of such appeal is unsatisfactory to the Spiritual Assembly, or
> the Assembly at any time has reason to believe that actions of the National Spiritual Assembly are
> affecting adversely the welfare and unity of the Baha'i community of ... , it shall, after seeking to
> compose its difference of opinion with the National Assembly in direct consultation, have the
> right to make appeal to the Universal House of Justice.
> SECTION 4. The Assembly shall likewise have the right to make complaint to the National
> Spiritual Assembly in the event that matters of local Baha'i concern and influence are referred to
> the national body by a member or members of the local community without previous opportunity
> for action by the Local Assembly.
> 
> ARTICLE XI
> The Annua l Meeting of the Corporation at which its Trustees shall be elected shall be held on
> April 21, at an hour and place to be fixed by the Assembly, which shall give not less than fifteen
> days' notice of the meeting to all members of the local Baha'i community.
> SECTION 1. The Assembly shall accept those votes transmitted to the Assembly before the
> election by members who by reason of sickness or other unavoidable reason are unable to be
> present at the election in person.
> SECTION 2. The election of members to the Spiritual Assembly shall be by plurality vote.
> SECTION 3. All voting members of the local Baha'i community are eligible for election as
> members of the Spiritual Assembly .
> SECTION 4. The Assembly shall prepare an agenda for the Annual Meeting in which shall be
> included reports of the activities of the Assembly since its election , a financial statement showing
> all income and expenditure of its fund, reports of its committees and presentation of any other
> matters pertaining to the affairs of the Baha'i community. The Assembly, both preceding and
> Name of country or region.
> 364                                     THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> following the annual election, shall invite discussion and welcome suggestions from the community, in order that its plans may reflect the community mind and heart.
> SECTION 5. The result of the election shall be reported by the Spiritual Assembly to the National
> Assembly.
> ARTICLE XII
> In addition to the Annual Meeting, the Assembly shall arrange for regular meetings of the
> Baha'i community throughout the year at intervals of nineteen days, in accordance with the
> calendar incorporated in the teachings of the Baha'i Faith.
> 
> ARTICLE XIII
> The seal of the Corporation shall be circular in form , bearing the following inscription:
> The Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of .. . .
> 
> ARTICLE XIV
> Alternative 'A'
> These By-Laws may be amended by majority vote of the Spiritual Assembly at any of its regular
> or special meetings, provided that at least fourteen days prior to the date fixed for the said meeting
> a copy of the proposed amendment or amendments is mailed to each member of the Assembly by
> the Secretary.
> 
> Alternative 'B'
> These By-Laws may be amended only by majority action of the National Spiritual Assembly,
> which, in making amendments, does so for the By-Laws of all Local Spiritual Assemblies
> throughout . . .. 1
> Name of country or region.
> 
> The first incorporated Spiritual Assembly ofthe Baha'(s of Hamilton Township, New Jersey,
> U.S.A. The Assembly achieved incorporation on 28 October 1977.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                      365
> 
> v
> THE INSTITUTION OF THE
> MASHRIQU'L-ADHKAR
> 
> 1. FOREWORD                      4"
> 
> Blessed is he who directeth his steps towards the Mashriqu'l-Adhkdr at the hour of dawn,
> communing with Him, attuned to His remembrance, imploring His forgiveness. And
> having entered therein, let him sit in silence to hearken unto the verses of God, the
> Sovereign, the Almighty, the A ll-Praised. Say, the Mashriqu'l-Adhkdr is in truth any
> House raised in towns or villages, for mention of Me. Thus hath it been named before His
> Throne; would that ye know it.                               Baha'u'llah, Kitab -i-Aqdas
> 
> MANY discerning minds have testified to              ideas of the churches and cathedrals of the
> the profoundly significant change which has          past. The Ma§hriqu'l-Adhkar fulfils the origitake n place during recent years in the character    nal intention of religion in each dispensation,
> of popular re ligious thinking. Religion has         before that intention had become altered and
> developed an entirely new emphasis, more             veiled by human invention and belief.
> especially for the layman, quite independent of         The Mashriqu'l-Adhkar is a channel releasthe older sectarian divisions.                       ing spiritual powers for social regeneration
> Instead of considering that religion is a mat-    because it fills a different function than that
> ter of turning toward an abstract creed, the         assumed by the sectarian church. Its essential
> average re ligionist today is concerned with the     purpose is to provide a community meetingpractical applications of religion to the prob-      place for all who are seeking to worship God,
> lems of human life. Religion, in brief, after        and achieves this purpose by interposing no
> having apparen tly lost its influence in terms of    man-made veils between the worshipper and
> theology, has been restored more powerfully          the Supreme. Thus, the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar is
> than ever as a spirit of brotherhood, an impulse     freely open to people of all Faiths on equal
> toward unity, and an ideal making for a more         terms, who now realize the universality of
> enlightened civilization throughout the world.       Baha'u'llah in revealing the oneness of all the
> Against this background, the institution of       Prophets. Moreover, since the Baha'i Faith has
> the Mashriqu' l-Adhkar stands revealed as the        no professional clergy, the worshipper entering
> supreme expression of all those modern religi-       the Temple hears no sermon and takes part in
> ous tendencies animated by social ideals which       no ritual the emotional effect of which is to
> do not repud iate the reality of spiritual experi-   establish a separate group consciousness.
> ence but seek to transform it into a dynamic            Integral with the Temple are its accessory
> striving for unity. The Mashriqu'l-Adhkar,           buildings, without which the Mashriqu'lwhen clearly understood, gives the world its         Adhkar would not be a complete social institumost potent agency for applying mystical vis-        tion. These buildings are to be devoted to such
> ion or idealistic aspiration to the service of       activities as a school for science, a hospice, a
> humanity. It makes visible and concrete those        hospital, an asylum for orphans. Here the circle
> deeper meanings and wider possibilities of           of spiritual experience at last joins, as prayer
> re ligion which could not be realized until the      and worship are allied directly to creative serdawn of this universal age.                          vice, eliminating the static subjective elements
> The term 'Mashriqu'l-Adhkar' means liter-         from religion and laying a foundation for a new
> ally, 'Dawning-place of the praise of God.'          and higher type of human association.
> To appreciate the significance of this Baha'i
> institution, we must lay aside all customary                                        HORACE HOLLEY
> 366                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 2. THE SPIRITUAL SIGNIFICANCE OF THE
> MASHRIQU'L-ADHKAR
> 
> A LETTER FROM SHOGHI EFFENDI
> 
> IT shou ld be borne in mind that the central          and ever-watchful Father Who, in the past, and
> edifice of the Mashriqu' l-Adt1kar, round which       at various stages in the evolution of mankind,
> in the fullness of time shall cluster such institu-   has sent forth His Prophets as the Bearers of
> tions of social service as shall affo rd relief to    His Message and the Manifestations of His
> the suffering, sustenance to the poor, shelter to     Light to mankind, cannot at this critical period
> the wayfarer, solace to the bereaved, and edu-        of their civilization withhold from His children
> cation to the ignorant, should be regarded            the guidance which they sorely need amid the
> apart from these dependencies, as a house sole-       darkness which has beset them, and which
> ly designed and entirely dedicated to the wor-        neither the light of science nor that of human
> ship of God in accordance with the few yet            intellect and wisdom can succeed in dissipatdefinitely prescribed principles established by       ing. And thus having recognized in Baha'u'llah
> Baha'u'llah in the Kitab-i-Aqdas. It should not       the source whence this ce lestial light proceeds,
> be inferred, however, from this general state-        they will irresistibly feel attracted to seek the
> ment that the interior of the central edifice         shelter of His house, and congregate therein ,
> itself will be converted into a conglomeration        unhampered by ceremon ials and unfettered by
> of religious services conducted a long lines          creed, to render homage to the one true God,
> associated with the traditional procedure             the Essence and Orb of eternal Truth, and to
> obtaining in churches, mosques, synagogues,           exalt and magnify the name of His Messengers
> and other temples of worship . Its various            and Prophets Who, from time immemorial
> avenues of approach, all converging towards           even unto our day , have, under divers circumthe central hall beneath its dome , will not serve    stances and in varying measure, mirrored forth
> as admittance to those sectarian adherents of         to a dark and wayward world the light of
> rigid formu lae and man-made creeds, each             heavenly guidance.
> bent, according to his way, to observe his rites,         But however inspiring the conception of
> recite his prayers, perform his ablutions, and        Baha'i worship, as witnessed in the central
> display the particular symbols of his faith           edifice of this exalted Temple, it cannot be
> within separately defined sections of                  regarded as the sole, nor even the essential ,
> Baha'u'llah's Universal House of Worship. Far        factor in the part which the Ma~r iqu ' l ­
> from the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar offering such a             Adhkar, as designed by Baha'u' llah, is desspectacle of incoherent and confused sectarian        tined to play in the organic life of the Baha'i
> observances and rites, a condition wholly             community. Divorced from the social,
> incompatible with the provisions of the Aqdas          humanitarian, educational and scientific purand irreconcilable with the spirit it inculcates,    suits centring around the dependencies of the
> the central House of Baha'i worship, enshrined         Mashriqu'l-Adhkar, Baha'i worship, however
> within the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar, will gather              exalted in its conception, however passionate
> within its chastened walls, in a serenely              in fervor, can never hope to achieve beyond the
> spiritual atmosphere, only those who, discard-        meagre and often transitory results produced
> ing forever the trappings of elaborate and            by the contemplations of the ascetic or the
> ostenatious ceremony, are willing worshippers         communion of the passive worshipper. It canof the one true God, as manifested in this age in     not afford lasting satisfaction and benefit to the
> the Person of Baha'u'llah. To them will the           worshipper himself, much less to humanity in
> Mashriqu'l-Adhkar symbolize the fundamen-             general, unless and until translated and transtal verity underlying the Baha'i Faith, that          fused into that dynamic and disinterested serreligious truth is not absolute but relative, that    vice to the cause of humanity which it is the
> Divine Revelation is not final but progressive.       supreme privilege of the dependencies of the
> Theirs will be the conviction that an all-loving      Mashriqu'l-Adhkar to facilitate and promote.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U 'LLAH                                      367
> Nor will the exertions, no matter how disin-        assuredly upon the consciousness of the
> terested and strenuous, of those who within the     efficacy of the Revelation of Baha'u'llah, reinprecincts of the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar will be          forced on one hand by spiritual communion
> engaged in administering the affairs of the         with His Spirit, and on the other by the intelligfuture Baha'i commonwealth, fructify a nd           ent application and the faithful execution of
> prosper unless they a re brought into close and     the principles and laws He revealed , that the
> daily communion with those spiritual agencies       sa lvation of a world in travail must ultimately
> centring in and radiating from the central          depend. And of all the institutions that stand
> shrine of the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar. Nothing            associated with His Holy Name, surely none
> short of direct and constant interaction be-        save the institution of the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar
> tween the spiritual forces emanating from this      can most adequately provide the essentials of
> House of Worship centring in the heart of the       Baha'i worship and service, both so vital to the
> Mashriqu'l-Adhkar, and the energies con-            regeneration of the world. Therein lies thesesciously displayed by those who administer its      cret of the loftiness, of the potency, of the
> affairs in their service to humanity can possibly   unique position of the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar as
> provide the necessary agency capable of             one of the outstanding institutions conceived
> removing the ills that have so long and so          by Baha' u' llah.
> grievously afflicted humanity. For it is                                          25 October 1929.
> 
> The Mother Temple of the West, Wilmette, Illinois, U.S.A. The corner-stone was laid by
> 'A bdu'l-Baha on 1May1912. On 23May1978 the structure was designated by the United
> States government 'one of the nation's cultural resources worthy ofpreservation' and listed in
> the National Register of Historic Places.
> 368                                   THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> 3. THE LAYING OF THE FOUNDATION STONE
> OF THE MOTHER TEMPLE OF THE INDIAN
> SUB-CONTINENT
> 
> 1 7 October 1977
> 
> DURING the Ten Year Crusade, 22 acres of land in New Delhi were acquired for the
> Magiriqu'l-Adhkar, but this property was requisitioned by the Government for a green belt area.
> After several years of constant negotiation by the National Assembly, and upon viewing the
> beautiful design for the Temple, the Government agreed to release the entire 22 acres , as
> reported on 1 February 1978.
> On the occasion of the All-Asia Baha'i Women's Conference in New Delhi , and at a special
> ceremony on 17 October 1977 at the Temple site , the Hand of the Cause Amatu' l-Baha Rul)iyyih
> Khanum laid the foundation stone for this important edifice.
> The Universa l House of Justice has approved a design prepared by Farfburz ~ahba, who has
> been retained as architect for this Temple . Working drawings are being prepared by Mr. ~ahba
> and the structural engineers in England.
> On 27 February 1979 a cable was received stating that the necessary permit for the construction of the House of Worship had been issued by the authorities and that excavation of the area
> had begun.
> 
> Photograph of the architect's model of the desigri for the Mother Temple of the Indian subcontinent, to be erected near New Delhi, India. Th e architect is Farfburz $ahbd. Initiation ofthe
> construction of the House of Worship was one of the go als of th e Five Year Plan.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                         369
> OVERJOYED REMOVAL OBSTACLES USE TEMPLE SITE WELCOME PRESENCE AMATULBAHA
> RUHIYYIH KHANUM IN YOUR MIDST OCCASION WOMENS CONFERENCE ENABLING YOU HOLD
> BEFITTING CEREMONY MARKING INITIATION PROJECT CONSTRUCTION MOTHER TEMPLE INDIAN
> SUB-CONTINENT STOP CALLING ON AMATULBAHA REPRESENT HOUSE JUSTICE MOMENTOUS OCCA-
> SION LAY FOUNDATION STONE HISTORIC EDIFICE STOP FERVENTLY PRAYING NOBLE INSTITUTION
> SOON TO BE REARED YOUR SOIL WILL ATTRACT ADDED DIVINE BLESSINGS UPON COMMUNITY
> WHOSE TEACHING SUCCESS STANDS UNEQUALLED ENTIRE BAHAI WORLD.
> Universal House of Justice
> Cablegram dated 10 October 1977
> 
> how does it grow? It grows in a swamp, and it
> raises its head out of the slime absolutely clean
> and perfect. Now this is what the Manifestation
> of God is in the world. He comes out of the
> slime. He comes from the worst place in the
> planet. He appears amongst the worst people
> in the planet, so that nobody can say that we
> made Him. They say only God can bring forth
> such a Being from such an environment. This is
> perhaps the greatest symbolism of the lotus
> and I think that it is so beautiful that we who
> are the followers of Baha'u'llah should have
> this design in this part of the world where it is so
> deeply associated with two of the world's
> greatest religions-Buddhism and Hinduism.'
> The Baha'fs from many lands who had
> gathered in New Delhi for the Women's Conference arrived by buses, taxis and private cars
> at the bright pavilion on the site of the future
> Temple of India. A thousand Baha'fs repre-
> Amatu'l Bahti Ruf:ifyyih Khtinum and some          senting most Asian countries as well as Europe,
> of the other Bahtifs who attended the              America, Australasia and Africa gathered in
> ceremony at which she laid the foundation          the tent and heard prayers chanted in many
> stone.                           languages, beginning with Sanskrit.
> A cool breeze began as Amatu'l-Baha spoke
> of how Zoroaster, Krishna, Moses, Christ and
> Excerpt from the Address of the                     the Bab and Baha'u'llah and the celestial concourse would be taking a keen interest in the
> Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha
> proceedings. This was the time to forget per-
> RuJ:iiyyih Khanum                             sonality and be sanctified to spiritually commune with God on this site of the Temple. The
> 'When I was invited by the Universal House       believers then formed a crowded circle, some
> of Justice to go and see this design, I was         standing on rocks and vantage points while
> apprehensive . Because being an architect's         Amatu'l-Baha laid the corner-stone. The
> daughter I know what a difficult problem it is to   architect, Mr. F. ~ahba of Iran, was beside her
> design a nine-sided building, but when I saw        as she firmly pressed down the commemorathis beautiful model I was deeply impressed         tive stone in a speciall y prepared concrete bed.
> and I think that it will be a wonderful thing and      It took more than two hours for the excited
> very much loved in India. There is one thing that   believers to disperse in buses from the slopes of
> Mr. ~ahba did not mention. The lotus has not        that gently rising land , bordered by parks. The
> only an association with Buddhism and Hindu-        lotus-shaped Temple to be raised here must
> ism, but par excellence, it is the symbol of the    surely evoke a deep spiritual response from all
> Manifestation of God. The lotus is probably         in the countries of the East, as it is a symbol of
> the most perfect flower in the whole world. It is   religion, a flower of purity and beauty arising
> symmetrical; it is exquisitely beautiful. And       out of the mud.
> 370                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Amatu'l-Bahd' Ru/:iiyyih Khlinum laying the foundation stone of the Mother Temple of the
> Indian sub-continent on 17 October 1977. Assisting her is Mr. Fariburz $ahbti, the architect,
> whose unique. design grew out of his profound love and intense study of the architecture,
> culture and peoples of India.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                     371
> 
> 4. THE LAYING OF THE FOUNDATION STONE
> OF THE FIRST MASHRIQU'L-ADHKAR OF
> THE PACIFIC ISLANDS
> 
> 27 January 1979
> 
> IN November 1975 , the National Spiritual Assembly of Samoa purchased a site for the Temple,
> a 12-acre lot at an elevation of 1,800 feet , overlooking the city of Apia and not far from Vailima,
> the official residence of His Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II. His Highness visited the land and
> was delighted with its location. Most of the city of Apia can be seen from the site, and when the
> Temple has been erected it should be clearly visible from a wide area below.
> Mr. I:Iusayn Amanat was appointed as architect for the Temple at Ri<;lvan 1978. His design was
> submitted to the Universal House of Justice in September of that year and to His Highness
> Malietoa Tanumafili II shortly thereafter. Following its approval, plans were made for the laying
> of the foundation stone. This ceremony took place on the Temple site on 27 January 1979 with
> His Highness laying the stone. Amatu'l-Baha RuQiyyih Khanum, the representative of the
> Universal House of Justice , participated by placing in a niche in the stone a small casket of dust
> from the Most Holy Shrine. Over 500 Baha'fs attended the ceremony and the Conference which
> was held concurrently. Sixteen national communities from all parts of the Pacific area were
> represented.
> Additional land has been acquired adjacent to the Temple site to the east to provide an
> approach to the Temple from the main road.
> 
> Photograph of the architect's rendering of the design for the new Baha'i House of Worship for
> Samoa, which will be erected on a site near Apia, Western Samoa. Initiation of construction
> of the building was a goal of the Five Year Plan. Architect lfusaynAmanat, who also designed
> the building for the Seat of the Universal House of Justice, created the Samoan Temple.
> 372                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> A. Text of Address Delivered by His Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II
> 
> IT is a joy for me today to be participating in the laying of the
> foundation stone of the Baha'i House of Worship in Samoa-an
> edifice which is the first of its kind to be erected in the Pacific.
> This occasion represents a significant hour for the people of
> Samoa and most certainly an important hour for the Baha'fs in the
> world and in the Pacific. For the people of Samoa, because it
> signifies another milestone in their dedication to the cause of God
> and their worship of their Creator. It signifies a positive and
> forward step in the cause of universal brotherhood and the recognition of one single God, the common Father of all humanity. It is
> an important hour for the Baha'fs because of the fact that the
> Teachings of this young Faith were brought to our shores only
> some twenty-five years ago. The Teachings of Baha'u'llah represent the noble idea of the unity of God, the unity of His Holy
> Messengers-the great Redeemers of mankind, such as Krishna,
> His Highness Malietoa           Moses, Christ, Mul)ammad and Baha'u'llah-and the unity of all
> Tanumafili II             the peoples of the earth.
> Humanity today is in desperate need of a unifying spirit; a spirit that will engender in the hearts
> and minds of every member of the human family the belief that we all 'belong to the same
> household'.
> The laying of the foundation stone of this House of Worship in the Pacific is the visible sign of
> such unity in our midst and, hopefully, this building will rise and become the emblem of a greater
> spirit of unity in our islands and in the whole of the Pacific. For almost fifteen decades Samoa has
> shown love for God and has founded a nation that is aware of its Lord. Over this long period many
> men of God have laboured and toiled in our islands in an effort to bring us closer to that true spirit
> which requires us to be better human beings. Our Government is founded on God. We promote
> freedom of worship and know little of the prejudices that afflict many other countries of the
> world.
> On this occasion, as Head of State of Western Samoa and on behalf of the people of Western
> Samoa, I wish the Baha'fs every success in this undertaking-the building of this House of
> Worship which will open its doors to people of all races and religious backgrounds. When
> completed this edifice will undoubtedly strengthen and develop further that mysterious power in
> the spirit of man that once it is attracted to the true worship of its Creator will bring about
> happiness, brotherhood and unity.
> Soifua!
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                     373
> 
> B. Excerpts from the Address of the Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Baha
> Rul).fyyih Khanum
> 
> Y    0 UR Highness, honoured guests and fellow Baha'is and
> many esteemed visitors who are present today. It is a very great
> day for me . A day of happiness and of joy to be here ... We
> a lready have ... some 'Mother Temples' in the Baha'i world. The
> first one, strangely enough, was built at the beginning of this
> century in Russia, and it was very dear to the hearts of the Baha'is.
> It was built at the time of ... ' Abdu'l-Baha Who succeeded His
> Father, and He had the joy of seeing this Temple completed.
> Unfortunately it was destroyed by a very severe earthquake .. .
> The second Baha'i Temple ... cornerstone was laid by 'Abdu'l-
> Baha Himself ... in 1912 (in Wilmette, Illinois).
> The first was the Mother Temple of Asia, the second was the
> Mother Temple of North America, and since we have built in
> Frankfurt, Germany, the Mother Temple of Europe; in Sydney,
> Australia, the Mother Temple of the Antipodes; in Uganda, in the The Hand of the Cause
> city of Kampala, the Mother Temple of Africa ... and we now Amatu'l-Bahti Ruf:ziyyih
> have in Panama ... the Mother Temple of South and Central                      Khtinum
> America ... In 1977 the stone was laid in New Delhi for the Mother Temple of the Indian
> sub-continent and today we are gathered on this very joyous and auspicious and historic occasion
> to have His Highness lay the cornerstone of the Baha'i Temple of the Pacific Ocean. It also will be
> a great Mother Temple, and its sole message is one of love and of understanding and of lack of
> prejudice and of working for peace and harmony and brotherhood ... it will be open to people of
> all denominations; it will be open to people of no denomination. The devout follower of whatever
> religion he may belong to, and the atheist will be welcome to come into our Temple , to be
> peaceful, to be quiet, to meditate, to pray, and if he cares to, to attend our regular services.
> 
> Text of inscription to be placed at an appropriate place inside the Temple after it has been
> constructed:
> 
> 'The Foundation Stone of this first Baha'i House of
> Worship in the Pacific Islands was laid by His Highness
> Malietoa Tanumafili II, and the representative of the
> Universal House of Justice, Amatu'I-Baha RuJ:tfyyih
> Khanum, set therein a casket containing Dust from the
> Sacred Shrine of Baha'u'llah. 27 January 1979.'
> 374                                THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> His Highness Malietoa Tanumafili /1 placing   The Hand of the Cause Amatu'l-Bahti
> the foundation stone of the Mother Temple     Ru/:z(yyih Khtmum, the representative of the
> of the Pacific Islands.            Universal House of Justice, inserting into a
> niche in the foundation stone a box
> containing Dust from the Shrine of
> Baha'u'llah.
> 
> The silver box, about six centimetres in diameter, containing Dust from the Shrine of
> Bahti' u' llah.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAH A'U'LLAH                                       375
> 
> 5. THE DESIGNATION OF THE MOTHER
> TEMPLE OF THE WEST AS A NATIONAL
> HISTORIC PLACE BY THE UNITED STATES
> GOVERNMENT
> DELIGHTED ACTION BY FED E RAL AUTHORITIES TO INCLUDE MOTHER TEMPLE OF THE
> WEST IN NATIONAL REGISTER OF HISTORIC PLACES STOP FRUITION YOUR EFFORTS ON
> 134TH ANNIVERSARY OF DECLARATION HIS MISSION BY BLESSED BAB OBTAIN THIS SIGNI-
> FICANT RECOGNITION DESERVES WARM COMMENDATION S AND IS AN OUTSTANDING
> ACHIEVEMENT.
> UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE
> 22 June 1978
> 
> ON 23 May, 1978, exactly 134 years after the         spiritua l guidance will radiate ."'
> historic Declaration of the Bab, the Bah a'i            Because the House of Worship is not old
> House of Worship in Wilmette, Illinois, was          enough for consideration as a ' historic place', it
> designated 'one of the Nation's cultural             was nomin ated on the basis of its architectural
> resources worthy of preservation' and listed in      uniqueness.
> the National Register of Historic Places.               The nine-sided structure, which symbolizes
> The National Spiritual Assembly , in its letter   the unity of religions and the oneness of manto the American Baha'i community for the             kind, was designed by French-Canadian
> Feast of Kalimat, emphasized the importance          architect Louis Bourgeois. The cornerstone
> and the significance of such recognition:            was laid by the Master, ' Abdu' l-Baha, on 1
> 'It means that the Federal authorities recog-     May 1912.
> nize the architectural importance of the build-         The House of Worship was nominated for
> ing and are committed to preserving it as a          the National Register by the National Assem-
> United States historic site.                         bly in 1974 on advice from the Wilmette His-
> 'Thus our efforts to protect the physical exis-   torical Society.
> tence of this sublime edifice have now been             The nominating process included the subfortified a thousandfold.'                           mission of photos and written information
> The National Assembly was notified offi-          about the House of Worship to the Illinois
> cially of the listing by Keith A. Scalle, National   Department of Conservation, which, upon
> Register coordinator for the Division of His-        approval , forwarded the materials to the
> toric Sites, Illinois Department of Conserva-        Illinois Historic Sites Advisory Board.
> tion. The notification came shortly after the           The materials were then sent to Washington,
> House of Worship welcomed the four millionth         D.C., for consideration by the U.S. Departvisitor since its public dedication in May 1953 .    ment of Interior's National Parks Service,
> 'In this new recognition coming from the          which is responsible for compiling the National
> Federal authorities,' said the National Spiritual    Register of Historic Places.
> Assembly, 'we experience a fresh measure of             'Dearly-loved Friends,' the National
> the dynamic quality which is implied in the          Assembly said in its Feast letter, 'may our indibeloved Master's description of the Temple as        vidual and collective efforts to win the pressing
> "silent teacher"; and we sense more fully the        goals of the Five Year Plan be spurred on by
> spell it casts as the "ordained source", in          this outstanding achievement.'
> Shoghi Effendi's words, "from which rays [of)
> 376                                THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> I
> I        I
> I                                    J         l
> 
> Two views of'Abdu'l-Baha taken on 1May1912 during the dedication ofthe site and laying of
> the corner-stone of the Baha'i House of Worship , Wilmette, Illinois, U.S.A.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                      377
> 
> VI
> THE NON-POLITICAL CHARACTER
> OF THE BAHA'I FAITH
> EXCERPTS FROM THE WRITINGS OF SHOGHI EFFENDI
> 
> THE B aha'f principles clearly define and                 mirror fo rth His commandments. Let your acts
> explain the non-political character of the Faith,         be a guide unto all mankind, for the professions
> and serve as a guide for conduct in the relatio ns        of most men, be they high or low, differ from
> of Baha'fs with one another, with their fellow            th eir conduct. It is through your deeds th at ye
> men , and in their relations with different               can distinguish yo urselves from others.
> departments of the civil government. A brief              Through th em the brightness of your light can
> summary of excerpts from the Baha'f Writings              be shed upon the whole earth ... 2
> will show that non -participation in po litica l              The aim of the Fa ith is to produce the reality
> affairs is one of the basic ax ioms of Baha'f             of virtu e in souls and evolve institutions caaction.                                                   pable of dealing with social matters justly, in the
> The keynote to this theme may be found in             light of the revealed truths. This is en tirely
> the Writings of Baha'u'llah. He has stated:               distinct from the province filled by partisan
> That one indeed is a man who, today, dedi-            civil institutions.
> cateth himself to the service of th e entire human            'Abdu'l-Baha counse lled the Baha'fs from
> race. The Great Being saith: Blessed and happy            the early beginnings of the America n Baha'f
> is he that ariseth to promote the best interests of       community not to discuss political affairs.
> the peoples and kindreds ofthe earth. Jn another              ... All conferences (i.e., all consultation a nd
> passage He hath proclaimed: It is not for him to          discussion) must be regarding the matters of
> pride himself who lo veth his own country, but            benefit, both as a whole and individually, such
> rather for him who loveth the whole world. The            as the guarding of all in all cases, their protecearth is but one country, and mankind its citi-           tion and preservation, the improvement of
> zens. 1                                                   character, the training of children , etc.
> Sow not the seeds of discord among men, and               If any person wishes to speak of government
> refrain from con tending with your neighbour              affairs, or to interfere with the order of govern -
> . . . Open, 0 people, the city of the human heart         ment, the others must not combine with him
> with the key of your utterance ...                        because the Cause of God is withdrawn entirely
> That which beseemeth you is the love of God,          from political affairs; the political realm perand th e love of Him Who is th e Manifestation of         tains only to the Rulers of those matters; it has
> His Essence, and the observance of whatsoever             nothing to do with the souls who are exerting
> He chooseth to prescribe unto you, did ye but             their utmost energy to harmonizing affairs,
> know it.                                                  helping character and inciting (the people) to
> Say: Let truthfulness and courtesy be your            stri ve for perfections. Therefore no soul is
> adorning. Suffer not yourselves to be deprived            allowed to interfere with (politica l) matters, but
> of the robe of forbearance and justice, that the          only in that wh ich is commanded. 3
> sweet savours of holiness may be wafted from                  With the development of a world-wide
> your hearts upon all created things. Say: Beware,          ad ministrative stru cture within the Baha'f
> 0 people of Bah6., lest ye walk in the ways of             Faith, in stitutio ns have been set up in national
> them whose words differ from their deeds.                  and local areas which ass ure the unity and
> Strive that ye may be enabled to manifest to the           integrity of the Faith. In unfolding these
> peoples of the earth the signs of God, and to             2
> ibid. , pp. 303-305.
> 1                                                         3
> Gleanings from the Writings ofBaha'u'llah, p. 250.        Baha'i World Faith, p. 407.
> 378                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> administrative institutions Shoghi Effendi has         calculations, the transient passions that agitate
> reiterated the importance of the non-political         the face , and engage the attention , of a changcharacter of the Baha'f teach ings in a letter         ing world . It is their duty to strive to distin -
> written 21 March 1932, to the Baha'fs of the           guish , as clearly as they possibly can, and if
> United States and Canada:                              needed with the aid of their elected representa-
> 'I feel it, therefore, incumbent upon me to         tives, such posts and functions as are either
> stress, now that the time is ripe, the importance      diplomatic or political from those that are
> of an instruction which, at the present stage of       purely administrative in character, and which
> the evolution of our Faith , should be increas-        under no circumstances are affected by the
> ingly emphasized, irrespective of its applica-         changes and chances that political activities
> tion to the East or to the West. And this princi-      and party government , in every land, must
> ple is no other than that which involves the           necessarily involve. Let them affirm their
> non-participation by the adherents of the Faith        unyielding determination to stand, firmly and
> of Baha'u' ll ah, whether in their individual          unreservedly, for the way of Baha'u'llah, to
> capacities or collectively as Local or National        avoid the entanglements and bickerings
> Assemblies, in any form of activity that might         inseparable from the pursuits of the politician,
> be interpreted, either directly or indirectly, as      and to become worthy agencies of that Divine
> an interference in the political affairs of any        Polity which incarnates God's immutable Purparticular government . Whether it be in the           pose for all men.
> publications which they initiate and supervise;            'It should be made unmistakably clear that
> or in their official and public deliberations; or      such an attitude implies neither the slightest
> in the posts they occupy and the services they         indifference to the cause and interests of their
> render; or in the communications they address          own country, nor involves any insubordination
> to their fellow-disciples; or in their dealings        on their part to the authority of recognized and
> with men of em inence and authority; or in their       established governments. Nor does it constiaffiliations with kindred societies and organiza-      tute a repudiation of their sacred obligation to
> tions, it is, I am firmly convinced, their first and   promote , in the most effective manner, the best
> sacred obligation to abstain from any word or          interests of their government and people . It
> deed that might be construed as a violation of         indicates the desire cherished by every true and
> this vital principle. Theirs is the duty to demon-     loyal follower of Baha'u'llah to serve, in an
> strate, on one hand, their unqualified loyalty         unselfish, unostentatious and patriotic fashion,
> and obedience to whatever is the considered            the highest interests of the country to which he
> judgement of their respective governments.             belongs, and in a way that would entail no
> 'Let them refrain from associating them-            departure from the high standards of integrity
> selves, whether by word or by deed, with the           and truthfulness associated with the teachings
> politica l pursuits of their respective nations,       of his Faith.
> with the policies of their governments and the             'As the number of the Baha'f communities in
> schemes and programmes of parties and fac-             various parts of the world multiplies and their
> tions. In such controversies they should assign        power, as a social force, becomes increasingly
> no blame, take no side, further no design, and         apparent, they will no doubt find themselves
> identify themselves with no system prejudicial         increasingly subjected to the pressure which
> to the best interests of that worldwide Fellow-        men of authority and influence, in the political
> ship which it is their aim to guard and foster.        domain, will exercise in the hope of obtaining
> Let them beware lest they allow themselves to          the support they require for the advancement
> become the tools of unscrupulous politicians,          of their aims. These communities will moreor to be entrapped by the treacherous devices          over, feel a growing need of the good-will
> of the plotters and the perfidious among their         and the assistance of their respective governcountrymen. Let them so shape their lives and           ments in their efforts to widen the scope, and to
> regulate their conduct that no charge of se-          consolidate the foundations, of the institutions
> crecy, of fraud, of bribery, or of intimidation       committed to their charge. Let them beware
> may, however ill-founded, be brought against           lest, in their eagerness to further the aims of
> them. Let them rise above all particularism and        their beloved Cause, they should be ted unwitpartisanship, above the vain disputes, the petty       tingly to bargain with their Faith, to compro-
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                              379
> mise with their essential principles, or to          nor the allurements of honours and rewards,
> sacrifice, in return for any material advantage      will ever induce them to surrender their trust or
> which their institutions may derive, the integ-      to deviate from their path. Let their words
> rity of their spiritual ideals. Let them proclaim    proclaim, and their conduct testify, that they
> that in whatever country they reside, and how-       who follow Baha' u'llah, in whatever land they
> ever advanced their institutions, or profound        reside, are actuated by no selfish ambition, that
> their desire to enforce the laws, and apply the      they neither thirst for power, nor mind any
> principles, enunciated by Baha'u'llah, they          wave of unpopularity, of distrust or criticism,
> will, unhesitatingly, subordinate the operation      which a strict adherence to their standards
> of such laws and the application of such princi-     might provoke.''
> ples to the requirements and legal enactments           And again: 'The Baha'i Faith as it forges
> of their respective governments. Theirs is not       ahead throughout the western world and parthe purpose, while endeavouring to conduct           ticularly in lands where the political machinery
> and perfect the administrative affairs of their      is corrupt and political passions and prejudices
> Faith, to violate, under any circumstances, the      are dominant among the masses, should
> provisions of their country's constitution,          increasingly assert and demonstrate the fact
> much less to allow the machinery of their            that it is non-political in character, that it
> administration to supersede the government           stands above the party, that it is neither apathetof their respective countries .                      ic to national interests nor opposed to any
> 'It should also be borne in mind that the very    party or faction, and that it seeks through
> extension of the activities in which we are          administrative channels, rather than through
> engaged, and the variety of the communities          diplomatic and political posts to establish,
> which labour under divers forms of govern-           beyond the shadow of a doubt, the capacity,
> ment so essentially different in their standards,    the sane patriotism, the integrity and highpolicies, and methods, make it absolutely            mindedness of its avowed adherents. This is the
> essential for all those who are the declared         general and vital principle; it is for the National
> members of any one of these communities to           representatives to apply it with fidelity and vigavoid any action that might, by arousing the         our.'2
> suspicion or exciting the antagonism of any one         These instructions raised the question
> government, involve their brethren in fresh          whether Baha'is should vote in any public elecpersecutions or complicate the nature of their       tion. A Tablet revealed by 'Abdu'l-Baha to
> task. How else, might I ask, could such a far-       Mr. Thornton Chase was sent to the Guardian,
> flung Faith, which transcends political and          and the following reply was received, dated 26
> social boundaries, which includes within its         January 1933 :
> pale so great a variety of races and nations,           'The Guardian fully recognizes the authenwhich will have to rely increasingly, as it forges   ticity and controlling influence of this instrucahead, on the good will and support of the           tion from 'Abdu'l-Baha upon the question. He,
> diversified and contending governments of the        however, feels under the responsibility of statearth- how else could such a Faith succeed in        ing that the attitude taken by the Master (that
> preserving its unity, in safeguarding its inter-     is, that American citizens are in d uty bound to
> ests, and in ensuring the steady and peaceful        vote in public elections) implies certain reserdevelopment of its institutions?                     vations. He, therefore, lays it upon the indi-
> 'Such an attitude, however, is not dictated by    vidual conscience to see that in following the
> considerations of selfish expediency, but is         Master's instructions no Baha'i vote for an
> actuated, first and foremost, by the broad prin-     officer nor Baha'i participation in the affairs of
> ciple that the followers of Baha'u'llah will,        the Republic shall involve acceptance by that
> under no circumstances, suffer themselves to         individual of a programme or policy that conbe involved, whether as individuals or in their      travenes any vital principle, spiritual or social,
> collective capacities, in matters that would         of the Faith.' The Guardian added to this letter
> entail the slightest departure from the funda-       the following postscript: 'I feel it incumbent
> mental verities and ideals of their Faith.           upon me to clarify the above statement, written
> Neither the charges which the uninformed and         1
> The World Order of Baht!'u'lltih, pp. 64-67.
> the malicious may be led to bring against them,      2
> U.S. Bahti'( News, December 1932.
> 380                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> in my behalf, by stating that no vote cast, or        tions, ennobled their motives, co-ordinated
> office undertaken, by a Baha'i should necessar-       their efforts, and transformed their outlook.
> ily constitute acceptance, by the voter or office     While preserving their patnot1sm and
> holder, of the entire programme of any politi-        safeguarding their lesser loyalties, it has made
> cal party. No Baha'i can be regarded as either a      them lovers of mankind , and the determined
> Republican or Democrat, as such. He is, above         upholders of its best and truest interests. While
> all else, the supporter of the principles enunci-     maintaining intact their belief in the Divine
> ated by Baha'u'llah, with which , I am firmly         origin of their respective religions, it has
> convinced, the programme of no political party        enabled them to visualize the underlying puris completely harmonious.n                            pose of these religions, to discover their merits,
> In a letter dated 16 March 1933 , the Guard-      to recognize their sequence, their interdepenian sent these further details:                       dence, their wholeness and unity and to ac-
> 'As regards the non-political character of the    knowledge the bond that vitally links them to
> Baha'i Faith, Shoghi Effendi feels that there is      itself. This universal , this transcending love
> no contradiction whatsoever between the Tab-          which the followers of the Baha'i Faith feel for
> let (to Thornton Chase, referred to above) and        their fellow-men, of whatever race, creed, class
> the reservations to which he has referred. The        or nation, is neither mysterious nor can it be
> Master surely never desired the friends to use        said to have been artificially stimulated. It is
> their influence towards the realization and           both spontaneous and genuine. They whose
> promotion of policies contrary to any of the          hearts are warmed by the energizing influence
> principles of the Faith. The friends may vote , if    of God's creative love cherish His creatures for
> they can do it, without identifying themselves        His sake, and recognize in every human face a
> with one party or another. To enter the arena         sign of His reflected glory.
> of party politics is surely detrimental to the best      'Of such men and women it may be truly said
> interests of the Faith and will harm the Cause.       that to them " every foreign land is a father-
> It remains for the individuals to so use their        land, and every fatherland a foreign land." For
> right to vote as to keep aloof from party poli-       their citizenship, it must be remembered, is in
> tics, and always bear in mind that they are           the Kingdom of Baha'u' ll ah. Though willing to
> voting on the merits of the individual, rather        share to the utmost the temporal benefits and
> than because he belongs to one party or               the fleeting joys which this earthly life can conanother. The matter must be made perfectly            fer, though eager to participate in whatever
> clear to the individuals, who will be left free to    activity that conduces to the richness, the hapexercise their discretion and judgement. But if       piness and peace of that life, they can, at no
> a certain person does enter into party politics       time, forget that it constitutes no more than a
> and labours for the ascendancy of one party           transient, a very brief stage of their existence,
> over another, and continues to do it against the      that they who live it are but pilgrims and
> expressed appeals and warnings of the Assem-          wayfarers whose goal is the Celestial City, and
> bly, then the Assembly has the right to refuse        whose home the Country of never-failing joy
> him the right to vote in Baha'f elections.' 2         and brightness.
> That this principle, as do all Baha'f princi-        'Though loyal to their respective governples, has world-wide application is made clear        ments, though profoundly interested in anything
> by Shoghi Effendi in a letter dated 11 March           that affects their security and welfare, though
> 1936.                                                 anxious to share in whatever promotes their
> 'The Faith of Baha' u'llah has assimilated, by     best interests, the Faith with which the followvirtue of its creative, its regulative and             ers of Baha'u'llah stand identified is one
> ennobling energies, the varied races,                  which they firmly believe God has raised high
> nationalities, creeds and classes that have           above the storms, the divisions, and controversought its shadow, and have pledged unswerv-         sies of the political arena. Their Faith they
> ing fealty to its cause. It has changed the hearts    conceive to be essentially non-political, supraof its adherents, burned away their prejudices,       national in character, rigidly non-partisan,
> stilled their passions, exalted their concep-         and entirely dissociated from nationalistic
> ' U.S. Bah(J'( News, April 1933 .
> ambitions, pursuits and purposes. Such a Faith
> ibid., January 1934.                                 knows no division of class or of party. It sub-
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                              381
> ordinates, without hesitation or equivocation,        government of the country they reside in , and
> every particularistic interest, be it personal, re-   no interference whatsoever in political matters
> gional, or national to the paramount interests of     or questions. What the Master's statement
> humanity, firmly convinced that in a world of         really means is obedience to a duly constituted
> interdependent peoples and nations the advan-         government, whatever that government may
> tage of the part is best to be reached by the         be in form. We are not the ones, as individual
> advantage of the whole, and that no abiding           Baha'ls, to judge our government as just or
> benefit can be conferred upon the component           unjust- for each believer would be sure to
> parts if the general interests of the entity itself   hold a different viewpoint, and within our own
> are ignored or neglected.' 1                          Baha'i fold a hotbed of dissension would spring
> The unity of Baha'i action throughout the          up and destroy our unity. We must build up our
> world is further emphasized in a letter from          Baha'i system , and leave the faulty systems of
> Shoghi Effendi to the Baha'ls of Vienna, writ-        the world to go their way. We cannot change
> ten in 1947 through his secretary, in which he        them through becoming involved in them; on
> said in part:                                         the contrary, they will destroy us.' 4
> 'We Baha'ls are one the world over; we are             Another application of this principle conseeking to build up a new world order, divine in      cerns the right, propriety or usefulness of exertorigin. How can we do this if every Baha'i is a        ing Baha'i influence for the enactment of legismember of a different political party-some of          lative measures reflecting more or less the purthem diametrically opposite to each other?            pose of some Baha'i principle or teaching. For
> Where is our unity then? We would be divided          example, should a Baha'i community, local or
> because of politics, against ourselves and this is    national , lend the name of the Baha'i Faith to
> the opposite of our purpose. Obviously if one         support legislation which seeks to abolish race
> Baha'i in Austria is given freedom to choose a        and religious discrimination in matters of
> political party and join it, however good its         industrial employment, or intervene when
> aims may be, another Baha'i in Japan or               measures concerning military training of youth
> America, or India, has the right to do the same       are before a legislature?
> thing and he might belong to a party the very             The National Spiritual Assembly of the
> opposite in principle to that which the Austrian      Baha'ls of the United States has stated that, 'as
> Baha'i belongs to. Where would be the unity of        a general policy subject to the Guardian's
> the Faith then? These two spiritual brothers          specific direction in special cases, Baha'ls and
> would be working against each other because           their administrative institutions should not feel
> of their political affiliations (as the Christians    obligated to adopt a " Baha'i" attitude or
> of Europe have been doing in so many fratrici-        course of action on matters of civil legislation.
> dal wars). The best way for a Baha'i to serve his     Our teachings and basic principles speak for
> country and the world is to work for the establish-   themselves. These we can always declare and
> ment of Baha'u'llah's World Order, which will         set forth with all possible energy whenever
> gradually unite all men and do away with divisive     occasions arise. But a truth which is sundered
> political systems and religious creeds .. .' 2        from its sustaining spiritual Source, lifted out
> In the Will and Testament of 'Abdu'J-Baha           of its organic relationship to the Baha'i comthe Baha'ls are instructed to obey and be the         munity , broken off from the other truths, and
> well-wishers of the governments of the land,          made subject to the storm and stress of secular
> regard disloyalty unto a just king as disloyalty to   controversy, is no longer a truth with which we
> God Himself and wishing evil to the govern-           can usefully have concern. It has become an
> ment a transgression of the Cause of God. 3 In        enactment to be carried out by institutions and
> explanation of this statement the Guardian            groups committed to other enactments, other
> wrote, in a Jetter dated 3 July 1948:                 aims and purposes and methods not in conform-
> 'Regarding your question about politics and         ity with the "Divine Polity" entrusted to
> the Master's Will: the attitude of the Baha'ls        those alone who give full loyalty to Baha'u'-
> must be twofold, complete obedience to the            llah. Far better for us to strive to mirror forth
> radiantly the individual and community virtues
> The World Order of Bahti'u'l/tih , pp. 197-198.
> U.S. Baha'f News, April 1949.                     of a new era than to hope that others than
> Bah(l'( Administration (1960 ed.), p. 4.          'U.S. Bahti'( News , January 1949.
> 382                                          THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> believers will achieve the holy mission of the        vindicate by their life-blood the sincerity of
> Faith. We Ba ha'fs have in reality accepted a         their conviction, that no power on earth,
> world order and not merely a new decalogue of         neither the arts of the most insidious adversary
> truths or commands. On the other hand,                nor the bloody weapons of the most tyrannical
> obedience to civil government is an obligation        oppressor, can ever succeed in extorting from
> laid by Baha'u'llah upon every Baha'f.' 1             them a word or deed that might tend to stifle
> Shoghi Effendi points out, as a guiding prin-      the voice of their conscience or tarnish the
> ciple of Baha'i conduct, that 'in connection          purity of their faith. 2
> with their administrative activities, no matter         'Small wonder if by the Pen of Baha'u'llah
> how grievously interference with them might           these pregnant words, written in anticipation
> affect the course of the extension of the             of the present state of mankind, should have
> Movement, and the suspension of which does            been revealed: It is not for him to pride himself
> not constitute in itself a departure from the         who loveth his own country, but rather for him
> principle of loyalty to their Faith, the consid-      who loveth the whole world. The earth is but one
> ered judgement and authoritative decrees              country and mankind its citizens. And again,
> issued by their responsible rulers must, if they      That one indeed is a man who today dedicateth
> be faithful to Baha'u'llah's and 'Abdu'l-             himself to the service of the entire human race.
> Baha's express injunctions, be thoroughly             Through the power released by these exalted
> respected and loyally obeyed. In matters, how-        words, He explains, He hath lent a fresh
> ever, that vitally affect the integrity and honour    impulse, and set a new direction, to the birds of
> of the Faith of Baha'u'llah and are tantamount        men's hearts, and hath obliterated every trace of
> to a recantation of their faith and repudiation       restriction and limitation from God's Holy
> of their innermost belief, they [the Baha'fs] are     Book.' 3
> convinced , and are unhesitatingly prepared to       2
> Baha'i Administration (1960 ed.), p. 162.
> 1                                                    3
> The Bahiff World, vol. X, pp. 278-279.               The World Order of Baha'u'l/ah, p. 198.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA 'U'LLA H                                                       383
> 
> VII
> RELATIONSHIP TO GOVERNMENT
> 1 . LOY AL TY TO GOVERNMENT
> 
> WHEN a great social crisis sweeps through a                      and peoples of the world. We must obey an d be
> civilization, mora l values become impaired and                  the well-wishers of the governments of th e land
> •4
> mo ral issues confused. In the crisis of our time ,
> members of the Baha'f Faith go on record as                          The followers of Baha'u'llah are exhorted to
> firmly upholding the principle of loyalty to                     be 'good citizens'. 5 The Baha'i teachings foster
> gove rnme nt .                                                   in the individua l ad herent an appreciation of
> Baha' u' Il ah, the Founder of the Baha'i                     authority a nd a n intellige nt and balanced pat-
> Faith , laid upon His fo llowers this sacred                     rio tism. The Baha'f is e nco uraged to 'serve in
> ob liga tion : 'In every country where any of this               an unselfish, unoste ntatio us a nd patriotic fash -
> people (Baha'is) reside, th ey must behave                       ion , the hi ghest inte rests of the country to
> towards the government of that country with                      which he belongs, a nd in a way that would
> loyalty, hon esty and truthfulness.' 1 T he Baha'i               enta il no departure from the high standards of
> Writings state further, ' The essence of the                     integrity and truthfulness associa ted with the
> Baha'i spirit is that in order to establish a better             teachings of his Fa ith .' 6
> social order and economic condition, there must                      A llegia nce to gove rnment, far from being a
> be allegiance to the laws and principles of gov-                 concept to which the Baha'f gives lip service, is
> ernment'2 Sho uld a Baha'f act contrary to the                   a spiritua l ob ligation reinforced by and
> laws of the gove rnment his conduct would                        in separab le from those teachings of Baha ' u'-
> be considered reprehe nsible before God, for                     Il ah's on which His followers pattern their
> members of this community 'should at all tim es                  individual spiritual deve lopment. 'Let integrity
> manifest . .. truthfulness and sincerity' and 'be                and uprightness distinguish all thine acts,' 7
> constant in ... faithfulness and trustwo rthi-                   Baha'u'llah e nj o in s.
> ness.'3                                                              Without integrity of character in its citizens
> In elucidation of this cardinal spiritual and                 and without loyalty to gove rnment, a nation
> social principle 'Abdu' l-Baha, the authorized                   will find itse lf torn asunder and unable to func-
> Interpreter of the Faith, has written: 'Accord-                  tion as an orga nic society. Not only do the
> ing to the direct and sacred command of God we                   Baha'i teachings obligate members to be loya l
> (the Baha'is) are forbidden to utter slander, are                to their government- they also specifically
> commanded to show forth peace and amity, are                     forb id them from taki ng part in subversive
> exhorted to rectitude of conduct, straight-                      political and social movements.
> fo rwardness and harm ony with all the kindreds
> ''A bdu'l-Baha : The Will and Tesramenr of Abdu'l-Bahd p.
> ' Baha'u'llah: Bi~arat, Ta biers of Baha'u'l/dh revealed after     8.
> rhe Kirab-i-Aqdas, p. 22-23.                                   ''A bdu' l-Baha: Selecrions from rhe Wrirings of 'Abdu'l-
> 'Abdu'l-Baha: The Promulgarion of Universal Peace, p.            Bahti, p. 3 19.
> 233.                                                             Shoghi Effendi : The World Order of Bahti'u'l/dh, p. 65.
> 'Abdu' l-B aha : Selecrions from rhe Wrirings of 'Abdu'l-      ' Baha' u' llah: Gleanings from rhe Wrirings of Bahd'u'lldh, p.
> Baha, p. 294.                                                    285.
> 384                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 2. THE BAHA'I VIEW OF PACIFISM
> 
> IN a letter published in U.S. Baha'i News,             nor does it exalt him to the point of making him
> January 1938 , Shoghi Effendi, the Guardian of         an anti-social creature, a me nace to society. As
> the Baha'i Faith wrote through his secretary:          in everything, it follows the "golden mean."
> 'With reference to the absolute pacifists or        T he only way society can function is for the
> conscientious objectors to war: their attitude,        minority to follow the will of the majority.
> judged from the Baha'i standpoint, is quite               'The other main objection to the conscienanti-social and due to its exaltation of the indi-     tious objectors is that their method of establishvidual conscience leads inevitably to disorder         ing peace is too negative . Noncooperation is
> and chaos in society. Extreme pacifists are thus       too passive a philosophy to become an effecvery close to anarchists, in the sense that both       tive way for social reconstruction . Their refusal
> of these groups lay an undue emphasis on th e          to bear arms can never establish peace. There
> rights and merits of the individual. The Baha'i        should first be a spiritual revitalization which
> conception of social life is essentially based on      nothing, except the Cause of God, can effecthe subordination of the individual will to that       tively bring to every man's heart.'
> of society. It neither suppresses the individual
> 
> 3. SUMMARY OF THE GUARDIAN'S
> INSTRUCTIONS ON THE OBLIGATIONS OF
> BAHA'fS IN CONNECTION WITH MILITARY
> SERVICE
> 
> IMMEDIATEL Ypriorto World War II the                   service which is not specifically aggressive or
> Baha'i position on military training and ser-          directly military . Such forms of national work
> vice, and the obligation of individual Baha'is to      as air raid precaution service, ambulance
> apply for and maintain a non-combatant stat us         corps, and other humanitaria n work or activity
> when this is possible under the laws of their          of a non-combatant nature, are the most suitcountry, were clearly stated by the Guardian of        able types of service the friends can render, and
> the Faith. On 27 November 1938 he instructed           which they should gladly volunteer for, since in
> his secretary to write to the National Spiritual       addition to the fact that they do not involve any
> Assembly of the British Isles: 'He has noted           violation of the spirit or principle of the Teachyour Assembly's request for his advice as to           ings they constitute a form of social and
> what forms of national service the friends may         humanitarian service which the Cause holds
> volunteer for in times of emergency. While the         sacred and emphatically enjoins.'
> believers, he feels, should exert every effort to         A further query from that National Spiritual
> obtain from the authorities a permit exempting         Assembly dated 9 May 1939 evoked the folthem from active military service in a combat-         lowing reply on 4 June 1939, in amplification
> ant capacity, it is their duty at the same time , as   of the above principles:
> loyal an d devoted citizens, to offer their ser-          'His instructions on this matter, conveyed in
> vices to their country in any field of national        a letter addressed to your Assembly during last
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                                     385
> November, were not intended for that particu-           may be slight prospect of their obtaining the
> lar occasion , but were meant for present condi-        consent and approval of the authorities to their
> tions, and for any such emergencies as may              petition.'
> arise in the immediate future .                            After the war, on 20 July 1946, the National
> 'It is still his firm conviction that the believ-   Spiritual Assembly of the United States
> ers, while expressing their readiness to unre-          enquired of the Guardian whether the exisservedly obey any directions that the                   tence of the United Nations in its present form
> authorities may issue concerning national ser-          changed the attitude of the Baha'is toward
> vice in time of war, should also, a nd while there      military duties which might require the taking
> is yet no outbreak of hostilities , appeal to the       of human life. The Guardian' s reply, written by
> government for exemption from active military           his secretary, was:
> service in a combatant capacity , stressing the            'As there is neither an International Police
> fact that in doing so they are not prompted by          Force nor any immediate prospect of one comany selfish considerations, but by the sole and         ing into being, the Baha'is should continue to
> supreme motive of upholding the Teachings of            apply, under all circumstances, for exemption
> their Faith, which make it a moral obligation           from any military duty that necessitates the takfor them to desist from any act that would              ing of life. There is no justification for any
> involve them in direct warfare with their              change of attitude on our part at the present
> fe llow-humans of any other race or nation.             time.'
> 'The Baha'i Teachings, indeed, condemn,                The Guardian therefore has made it clear
> emphatically and unequivocally, any form of             that it is obligatory and not an optional matter
> physical violence , and warfare in the battlefield      for all Baha'is to apply for and maintain a
> is obviously a form , and perhaps the worst form        non-combatant status if this is possible under
> which such violence can assume.                         the law. Where such a law exists, Baha'is can-
> 'There are many other avenues through                not voluntarily enlist in any branch of the
> which the believers can assist in times of war by       armed forces in which they would be subject to
> enlisting in services of a non-combatant                orders to engage in the taking of human life.
> nature- services that do not involve the direct            The Universal House of Justice amplified
> shedding of blood-such as ambulance work,               this later statement:
> anti-air raid precaution service , office and              'There is no objection to a Baha'i enlisting
> administrative works, and it is for such types of       voluntarily in the armed forces of a country in
> national service that they should volunteer.            order to obtain a training in some trade or
> 'It is immaterial whether such activities            profession , provided that he can do so without
> would still expose them to dangers, either at           making himself liable to undertake combatant
> home or in the front, since their desire is not to      service.
> protect their lives, but to desist from any acts of        'There is likewise no objection to a Baha'i
> wilful murder.                                          seeking or continuing a career in the armed
> 'The friends should consider it their con-           forces , provided that he can do so without makscientious duty, as loyal members of the Faith ,        ing himself liable to undertake combatant serto apply for such exemption , even though there         vice.'
> 386                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> VIII
> BAHA'I CALENDAR, FESTIVALS AND
> DA TES OF HISTORICAL SIGNIFICANCE
> 
> 1. FOREWORD
> 
> Excerpt from Baha'u'llah and the New Era by Dr. J. E. Esslemont
> 
> AMONG different peoples and at different           calendar to the solar year. The Bab named the
> times many different methods have been             months after the attributes of God. The Baha'i
> adopted for the measurement of time and            New Year, like the ancient Persian New Year,
> fixing of dates, and several different calendars   is astronomically fixed, commencing at the
> are still in daily use, e.g., the Gregorian in     March equinox (21 March), and the Baha'i era
> Western Europe, the Julian in many countries       commences with the year of the Bab's declaraof Eastern Europe, the Hebrew among the            tion (i.e., 1844 A . D., 1260 A . H . ).
> Jews and the Mul)ammadan in Muslim coun-              In the not far distant future it will be necestries.                                             sary that all peoples in the world agree on a
> The Bab signalized the importance of the        common calendar.
> dispensation which He came to herald by               It seems, therefore, fitting that the new age
> inaugurating a new calendar. In this, as in the    of unity should have a new calendar free from
> Gregorian Calendar, the lunar month is aban-       the objections and associations which make
> doned and the solar year is adopted.               each of the older calendars unacceptable to
> The Baha'i year consists of 19 months of 19     large sections of the world's population, and it
> days each (i.e., 361 days), with the addition of   is difficult to see how any other arrangement
> certain 'intercalary days' (four in ordinary and   could exceed in simplicity and convenience
> five in leap years) between the eighteenth and     that proposed by the Bab.
> nineteenth months in order to adjust the
> 
> 2. BAHA'I FEASTS, ANNIVERSARIES AND
> DAYS OF FASTING
> Feast of Ric;!van (Declaration of Baha'u'llah), 21 April-2 May 1863.
> Feast of Naw-Ruz (New Year), 21 March.
> Declaration of the Bab, 23 May 1844.
> The Day of the Covenant, 26 November.
> Birth of Baha'u'llah, 12 November 1817.
> Birth of the Bab, 20 October 1819.
> Birth of 'Abdu'l-Baha, 23 May 1844.
> Ascension of Baha'u'llah, 29 May 1892.
> Martyrdom of the Bab, 9 July 1850.
> Ascension of' Abdu'l-Baha, 28 November 1921.
> Fasting season lasts 19 days beginning with the first day of the month of' Ala' , 2 March-the Feast
> of Naw-Ruz follows immediately after.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                      387
> 
> 3. BAHA'I HOLY DAYS ON WHICH WORK
> SHOULD BE SUSPENDED
> 
> The first day of Ric;lvan,
> The ninth day of Ric;lvan,
> The twelfth day of Ric;lvan,
> The anniversary of the declaration of the Bab,
> The anniversary of the birth of Baha'u'llah,
> The anniversary of the birth of the Bab,
> The anniversary of the ascension of Baha'u'llah,
> The anniversary of the martyrdom of the Bab,
> The feast of Naw-Ruz.
> 
> NoTE: 'Abdu'l-Ba ha, in one of His Tablets addressed to a believer of Nayriz, Persia, has written
> the following: Nine days in the year have been appointed on which work is forbidden. Some
> of these days have been specifically mentioned in the Book. The rest follow as corollaries to
> the Text . .. Work on the Day ofthe Covenant (Fete Day of 'Abdu'l-Baha), however, is not
> prohibited. Celebration ofthat day is left to the discretion ofthe friends. Its observation is not
> obligatory. The days pertaining to the Abhti Beauty (Baha'u'llah) and the Primal Point (the
> Bab), that is to say these nine days, are the only ones on which work connected with trade,
> commerce, industry and agriculture is not allowed. In like manner, work connected with any
> form of employment, whether governmental or otherwise, should be suspended.
> 
> As a corollary of this Tablet it follows that the anniversaries of the birth and ascension of
> 'Abdu'l-Baha are not to be regarded as days on which work is prohibited. The celebration
> of these two days, however, is obligatory.
> 
> Baha'is in East and West, holding admi nistrative positions, whether public or private,
> should exert the utmost effort to obtain special leave from their superiors to enable them to
> observe these nine holy days.
> 
> 4. ADDITIONAL MATERIAL GLEANED FROM
> NABIL'S NARRATIVE REGARDING THE
> BAHA'I CALENDAR
> 
> THE Badi' Calendar (Baha'i Calendar) has                (1844 A.D.), the year of the Declaration of the
> been taken by me from the Kittib-i-Asmti', one          Bab, must be regarded as the beginning of the
> of the works written by the Bab. As I have              Badi' Calendar.' The Declaration of the Bab
> observed in these days that certain believers           took place on the evening preceding the fifth
> are inclined to regard the year in which Baha'u'-       day of Jamadiyu'l-Avval, of the year 1260 A.H .
> llah departed from Ba~dad to Constan-                   It has been ordained that the solar calendar be
> tinople as marking the beginning of the Badi'           followed and that the vernal Equinox, the day
> Calendar, I have requested Mirza Aqa Jan, the           of Naw-Ruz, be regarded as the New Year's
> amanuensis of Baha'u'llah, to ascertain His             Day of the Badf' Calendar. The year sixty, in
> will and desire concerning this matter. Baha'u'-        which the fifth day of Jamadiyu'l-Avval coinllah answered and said: 'The year sixty A.H. 1          cided with the sixty-fifth day after Naw-Ruz,
> (i.e. , 1260 A.H.)                                  has accordingly been regarded as the first year
> 388                                    THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> of the Badf' Calendar. As in that year, the day         Soon afte r Baha' u'll ah had left the fortress
> of Naw-Ruz, the vernal Equinox, preceded by          of 'Akka and was dwelling in the house of
> sixty-six days the date of the Declaration of the    Malik , in that city, He commanded me to
> Bab, I have therefore, throu ghout my history,       transcribe the text of the Badf' Calendar and to
> regarded the Naw-Ruz of the year sixty-one           instruct the believers in its details. On the ve ry
> A . H. (the Naw-Ruz immedi ately fo llowing the      day in which I received His co mmand , I com-
> Decl ara tion of the Bab) as the first Naw-Ruz of    posed, in verse and prose, an exposition of the
> the Badf' Ca le ndar. I have acco rdin gly consid-   main features of that Calendar a nd presented it
> ered the Naw-Ruz of this prese nt year, the          to him . The versified copy, being now un availyear 1306 A.H., which is the 47th solar year         able, I am herein transcribing the versio n in
> after the Declaration of the Bab, as the 46th        prose. The days of the week are named as
> Naw-Ruz of the Badf' Calendar.                       fo llows:
> 
> Days             Arabic Nam e        English Name                 Translation
> 1st              Jala I              Saturday                     Glory
> 2nd              Ja mal              Sunday                       Beauty
> 3rd              Kama l              Monday                       Perfectio n
> 4th              Fic;lal             T uesday                     Grace
> 5th              ' Ida!              Wednesday                    Justice
> 6th              Istij lal           Thursday                     Majesty
> 7th              Istiq lal           Friday                       Independence
> 
> The names of the month s, wh ich are the same as the days of each month , are as fo llows:
> 
> Month            Arabic Name         Translation                  Firs! Days
> 1st             Baha                Splendour                    March 21
> 2nd             Jalal               Glory                        April 9
> 3rd             Jamal               Beauty                       Ap ril 28
> 4th             'A~a m at           Grandeur                     May 17
> 5th             Nur                 Light                        June 5
> 6th             Ral)mat             Mercy                        June 24
> 7th             Kali mat            Words                        July 13
> 8th             Kamal               Perfection                   August 1
> 9th             Asma'               Names                        A ugust 20
> 10th             'Izzat              Mig ht                       Septe mber 8
> 11th             Mashfyyat           Will                         Septe mber 27
> 12th             ' Ilm               Knowledge                    October 16
> 13th             Qudrat              Power                        Nove mber 4
> 14th             Qawl                Speech                       November 23
> 15th             Masa'i l            Questions                    December 12
> 16th             Sharaf              Honour                       December 31
> 17th             Sult an             Sovereignty                  Ja nuary 19
> 18th             Mulk                Dominion                     February 7
> 19th             ' Ala'              Loftiness                    Marc h 2
> 
> Ayyam-i- Ha (Intercalary Days) 26 Febru ary to 1 March inclusivefour in ordinary and five in leap years.
> 
> The first day of each month is thus the day of     ing of 19 months of 19 days each, with the
> Baha, and the last day of each month the day of      addition of certain inte rcalary days. He has
> 'Ala'.                                               named the New Year's Day, which is the day of
> The Bab has regarded the solar year, of 365        Naw-Ruz, the day of Baha, of the mont h of
> days, 5 hours, and fifty odd minutes, as consist-    Baha. He has ordained the month of' Ala' to be
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                         389
> the month of fasting , and has decreed that the        1. Alif                 A.
> day of Naw-Ruz should mark the termination             2. Ba '                B.
> of that period. As the Bab did not specifically        3. Ab                  Father.
> define the place for the four days and the frac-       4 . Dal                D.
> tion of a day in the Badf' Calendar, the people        5. Bab                 Gate.
> of the Bayan were at a loss as to how they             6. Vav                 V.
> should regard them. The revelation of the              7. Abad                Eternity.
> Kitab-i-A qdas in the city of' Akka resolved this      8. Jad                 Generosity.
> problem and settled the issue. Baha'u' llah            9.Baha                 Splendour.
> designated those days as the Ayyam-i-Ha and           10. I:Iubb              Love.
> ordained that they sliould immediately pre-           11. Bahhaj              Delightful.
> cede the month of' Ala' , which is the month of       12.Javab                Answer.
> fasting. He enjoined upon His followers to            13. Al)ad               Single.
> devote these days to feasting, rejoicing, and         14. Vahhab              Bountiful.
> charity. Immediately upon the termination of          15. Vidad               Affection.
> these intercalary days, Baha'u'llah ordained          16. Badf'               Beginning.
> the month of fasting to begin. I have heard it        17. Bahf                Luminous.
> stated that some of the people of the Bayan,          18. Abha                Most Luminous.
> the followers of Mirza Yal)ya, have regarded          19. Val)id              Unity.
> these intercalary days as coming immediately
> after the month of' Ala' , thus terminating their       Each cycle of nineteen years is called Val)id.
> fast five days before the day of Naw-Ruz. This,       Nineteen cycles constitute a period called
> notwithstanding the explicit text of the Bayan        Kull-i-Shay'. The numerical value of the word
> which states that the day of Naw-Ruz must             Val)id is nineteen , that of Kull-i-Shay' is 361.
> needs be the first day of the month ofBaha, and       Val)id signifies unity, and is symbolic of the
> must follow immediately after the last day of         unity of God .
> the month of 'Ala'. Others, aware of this con-          The Bab has, moreover, stated that this systradiction, have started their fasting on the fifth   tem of His is dependent upon the acceptance
> day of the month of 'Ala', and included the           and good-pleasure of 'Him Whom God shall
> intercalary days within the period of fasting.        make manifest'. One word from Him would
> Every fourth year the number of the inter-         suffice either to establish it for all time, or to
> calary days is raised from four to five. The day _    annul it forever.
> of Naw-Ruz falls on the 21st of March only if            For instance, the date of the 21st of April,
> the vernal Equinox precedes the setting of the        1930, which is the first day of Ric;lvan, and
> sun on that day . Should the vernal Equinox           which according to the Kitab-i-Aqdas must
> take place after sunset, Naw-Ruz will have to         coincide with the 'thirteenth day of the second
> be celebrated on the following day.                   Baha'i month,' and which fell this year (1930)
> The Bab has, moreover, in His Writings             on Monday, would, according to the system of
> revealed in the Arabic tongue, divided the            the Badf' Calendar, be described as follows:
> years following the date of His Revelation into         'The day of Kamal, the day of Qudrat, of the
> cycles of nineteen years each. The names of the       month of Jalal, of the year Bahhaj, of the fifth
> years in each cycle are as follows:                   Val) id, of the first Kull -i-Shay'.'
> 390                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 5. HISTORICAL DATA GLEANED FROM
> NABIL'S NARRATIVE REGARDING
> BAHA'U'LLAH
> Works Revealed          Houses Occupied
> During This Period      During This Period
> A.BAGHDAD
> Arrival latter part Jamadiyu ' !.b.-Thanf,   Kullu ' t-Ta'am         House of I;Ia jf 'Alf-
> 1269 A.H.                                                           Madad
> 12 March-10 April 1853 A.D.                                           (in old Ba~dad)
> Departure for Sulaymanfyyih on Wed-                                  House of Sulaymannesday , 10 April 1854 A.D.-Rajab                                   i-Ghannam
> 12, 1270A.H.
> 
> B. SULA YMANIYYIH                                 Prayers
> Before reaching Sulaymanfyyih , He          Qa~fdiy-i-Varqa'fyyih
> lived for a time on the Sar-Galu
> mountain .
> During His absence from Bagbdad             Saqf-Az-Ghayb-i-
> His family transferred their residence     Baqa
> from House of I;Iajf 'Alf-Madad to
> that of Su layman-i-Ghannam.
> Nabfl arrived at Bagbdad 6 months
> after Baha'u ' llah's departure for
> Sulaymanfyyih.
> 
> c. BAGHDAD                                        Tafsir-i-l;IurUfat-i-
> Muqaga'ih
> Arrived from Sulaymaniyyih on Wed-         ~al:iffiy-i-Shagfyyih
> nesday, 19 March 1856 A. D.-             Haft-Vadf
> Rajab 12, 1272 A.H.                         (Seven Valleys)
> Departure from Bagbdad for Consta n-       Tafsir-i-Hu
> tinople, Wednesday afternoon (first      L a wI:i-i-l;Iurfyyih
> day of Ri<;fvan) , 22 April 1863 A. D.   Kitab-i-fqa.n
> -Dhi'l-Qa'dih 3, 1279 A.H.                Kalimat-i-Maknunih
> (Hidden Words)
> SubI:iana-Rabbfya'l-
> A 'la
> Shikkar-Shikan-
> Shavand
> I;Iur-i-'Ujab
> Halih-Halih-Ya
> Bisharat
> Ghulamu'l-Khuld
> Az-Ba~- i-Il ahf
> Baz-Av-u-Bidih-Jamf
> Short stay in Mazra'iy-i-Vafil}fil!ash     MallaI:iu'I-Quds
> during above period to celebrate           (Holy Mariner)
> Naw-Ruz ended with departure on
> Thursday, 26 March 1863 A.D.-
> Shavval 5, 1279 A.H.
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U ' LLAH                                           391
> 
> Works Revealed               Houses Occupied
> C. BAGHDAD-continued                               During This Period           During This Period
> 
> Arrival at Garden of Najibfyy ih            Suriy-i-$abr revealed
> (Garden of Ric.Jvan) , 22 April 1863         on first day of
> A. o .-Dhi' l-Q a'dih 3, 1279 A.H .         Ric.Jvan
> 
> Arrival of Baha'u'llah's Fam il y at
> Garden of Ric.Jvan on eighth day
> after first of Ric.Jvan .
> 
> Departure from Garden of Ric.Jvan for
> Constantinople last day of Ric.Jvan
> at noon on Sunday, 3 May 1863
> A.D.-Dhi' l-Qa'dih 14, 1279 A.H.
> 
> Length of overland journey from
> Garden of Ric.Jvan to Samsun on
> Black Sea: 110 days.
> 
> Firayjat (arrived early afternoon-                       I::Iasan-Aqa,
> sta yed seven days) arrived on Sun-                    Mardin,
> day, 3May1863 A.o .-Dh i' l-                          Dfyar-Bakr,
> Qa' dih 14, 1279 A.H. (Firayjat is                    Ma'dan-Mis,
> about 3 miles distant from Baghdad)                   Kharput (stayed 2 or 3 days),
> Judaydih,                       -                        Ma'dan-Nuqrih,
> Dilf-'Abbas,                                             Dilik-Tash,
> Qarih-Tapih ,                                            Sfvas,
> Salal:Jfyyih (stayed 2 nights),                          'fuqat,
> Dust-Khurmatu,                                           Amasia (stayed 2 days) ,
> Tawuq,                                                   Ilahfyyih (while approaching Samsun,
> Karkuk (stayed 2 days),                                     'Lawl:J-i-Hawdaj' was revealed) , (last
> Irbfl ,                                                     day of overland journey),
> Zab River,                                               Samsun (stayed 7 days), Black Sea port;
> Ba r\allih ,                                                sailed in a Turkis h steamer about
> Mosu l (stayed 3 days),                                     sunset for Constantinople,
> Zakhu,                                                   Sinope (arrived next day about noon),
> Jazfrih,                                                    Black Sea port: stayed few hours,
> Nu~aybfn                                                 Anyabuli (arrived next day).
> 
> D. CONSTANTINOPLE                Works Revealed                   Houses Occupied
> During Th is Period              During This Period         Duration
> 
> Arrival at noon on      Subl:Janaka-Ya-Hu                House of Shamsi Big          1 month
> Sunday, 16 August     Lawl:J-i- ' Abd u ' l- ' Azfz     (near the mosque of
> 1863 A.O .-             Va-Vukala                       Khirqiy-i-Sharif
> Rabf'u'l-Avval 1,
> 1280A.H.
> 392                                THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> D. CONSTANTINOPLE-               Works Revealed             Houses Occupied
> continued                     During This Period         During This Period      Duration
> 
> Length of sea voyage                               House of Vfsf Pasha       3 months
> from Samsun to                                    (3-storey, nearSu l!an
> Constantinopl e: 3                                MuI?ammad
> days.                                             Mosq ue)
> 
> Length of journ ey
> from Constantinop le to A drianople: 12 days.
> 
> 1. Kuchik-Chakmachih (3 hours from Constantinople- spent one night)
> 2. Buyuk-Chakmachih (arrived abo ut noon)
> 3. Salvari        4. Birkas            5. Baba-Iskf
> 
> E. ADRIANOPLE                    Works Revealed             Houses Occupied
> During This Period         During This Period      Duration
> 
> Arrival on Saturday,    Suriy-i-A~I?ab             1. Khan -i-' Arab         3 ni ghts
> 12 December 1863                                     ( caravanserai,
> A.D.- Rajab 1,                                        two-storey, near
> 1280A .H .            LawJ:i-i-J:Iajj I              house of 'Izzat-
> Aqa)
> 
> Length of stay : 4
> years, 8 month s,
> 22 days.              LawI?-i-J:Iajj II
> 
> Length of overland      Kitab-i-Badf'              2. House in Muradfy-      1 week
> journey from Con-     Suriy-i- Mu lu k               yih qu arter, near
> stan tinople to Ad-     (Tablet of the               Takyiy-i-Mawlavf
> rianople : 12 days.     Kings)
> 
> Departure from Adri-    Suriy-i-Amr                3. House in Muradfy-      6 months
> a nople on Wednes-     Suriy-i-Da mm                  yi h quarter, near
> day, 12 A ugust        A lva9-i-Laylatu'l-            house 2
> 1868 A.D.- Rabf-          Q uds                   4. Khaniy-i-Amru'llah
> 'u'th-Thani 22,        Munaj a thay-i-$iyam           (several storeys,
> 1285A.H .                 (Prayers for Fasting)       near Sul!an-Salim
> Mosque)
> LawJ:i-i- Sayyah           5. House of R ic;la Big   1 year
> LawJ:i-i- Napulyun I       6. House of A mru' llah   3 months?
> (First Tablet to             (3-storey, north
> Napoleon III)                of Sul! an-Salim
> Mosq ue)
> LawI?-i- Sul!an            7. House of 'Izzat-Aqa    11 months
> (Tablet to the Shah
> of Persia)
> LawI?-i-Nuq!ih
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA'U'LLAH                                       393
> 
> 1. Uzun-Kuprf
> 2. Ka~anih (arrived about noon . LawJ:i -i-Ra'fs [Tablet of Ra'fs] was revealed in th is place)
> 3. Gallipoli (length of journey from Adrianople to Gallipoli about 4 days)
> (after a few days' stay sailed before noon in Austrian steamer for Alexandria, Egypt)
> 4. Made llf (arrived about sunset-left at night)
> 5. Smyrna (stayed 2 days, left at night)
> 6. Alexandria (arrived in the morning, trans-shipped and left at night for Haifa)
> 7. Port Said (arrived morning, left the same day at night)
> 8. Jaffa (left at midnight)
> 9. Haifa (arrived in the morning, landed and after a few hours left on a sailing vessel for
> 'Akka)
> 
> F. ' AKKA                           Works Revealed              Houses Occupied
> During This Period          During This Period         Duration
> 
> Arrival on Monday,        Kitab-i-Aqdas               1. Barracks                 2 years, 2
> 31 August 1868          LawJ:i-i-Napulyun II                                      mo nths
> A. o.-Jamadfyu'l-         (Second Tablet to                                       5 days
> Avval 12, 1285 A.H.       Napoleon III)
> 
> LawJ:i-i-Malikih            2. House of Malik           3 months
> (Tablet to Queen          3. House of Rabi'ih
> Victoria)
> LawJ:i-i-Malik-i-Rus        4. House of Man~ur          2 or 3
> Purest Branch died on        (Tablet to the                                          mo nths
> Thursday, 23 Ju ne         Czar)
> 1870 A.D.- Rabf-         Suriy-i-Haykal              5. House of 'Abbud
> 'u' l-Avval 23, 1287     LawJ:i-i-Burhan                 (where Kitab-i-
> A.H .                LawJ:i-i-Ru'ya                  Aqdas was re-
> LawJ:i-i-Ibn-i-Dhi'b            vealed)
> (Epistle to Son of        6. Mazra'ih
> the Wolf)
> LawJ:i-i-Pap                7 . Qa~r
> Passed away 29 May           (Tablet to the                  (Mansion , where
> 1892 A.D.                  Pope)                           He passed away)
> 394                                              THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 6. DATES OF HISTORICAL SIGNIFICANCE IN
> THE RISE OF THE BAHA'I FAITH
> Birth of Baha'u'llah .. . .. 12 Nove mbe r 1817 Re lease of 'Abdul-Baha from His incarcera-
> Birth of the Bab .. .... .... 20 October 1819                        tion ... . . . . . .......... .September 1908
> Declaration of the Mission of the Bab in Interment of the Bab's remains on Mt. Ca rm e l
> Shfraz ........... . ........ 23 May 1844                           ..... . . .. . . . ..... . ...... 21 March 1909
> Birth of 'Abdu'l-Baha ....... .23 May 1844 Opening of the first A merican Baha'f Conven-
> Departure of the Bab on His pilgrimage to                            tion ............ . ... . . .. 21 March 1909
> Mecca .. .. . . . .. . . . ..... September 1844 'Abdu' l-Baha's departure from Egypt ... . . .
> Arrival of the Bab in Mah-Ku, Ad hirbayjan                              ... .. ... .. . ........ . ... September 1910
> ..................... .. .. Summer 184 7 'Abdu'l-Baha's arrival in Lo ndo n . . . .. .. .. .
> Incarceration of the Bab in Chihriq , Adhir-                             ...... . ..... . . . .. . .. .4 Septe mber 1911
> bayjan . .. . ..... . .... . ... ... A pril 1848 'Abdu' l-Baha's arrival in America ........ .
> Conference of Badasht ......... .June 1848                              . .. ....... .... ........... 11April 1912
> Interrogation of the Bab in Tabriz, Adh ir- Laying of the corn er-sto ne of the Mash riqu'lbayj an ..... . ........ .. . .... . .July 1848                    Adhkar in Wilmette, Ill., by 'Abdu'l-Baha
> Martyrdom of the Bab in Tabriz, A dhirbayjan                             . ... . .... . ......... ... . ... 1May1912
> ............................ 9 July 1850 Second visit of 'Abd u' l-Baha to Europe and
> Attempt on the life of Na~ iri 'd-Dfn Shah ...                       tour throu gh the U nited Kingdom, France,
> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 August 1852   Germany, Hu ngary and Austria ....... . .
> Imprisonment of Baha'u'llah in the Sfya h-Cha l                          ...... ... .. December 1912 to June 1913
> of Tihran . . .. . ......... .. .A ugust 1852 'Abdu'l-B aha's return to the Holy Land .. . .
> Banishment of Baha'u'llah to Baghdad .....                             . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 Dece mber 1913
> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 January 1853 U nveiling of the Tablets of the Divine Plan
> Wi thdrawal of Baha'u'llah to Kurdistan . . ..                           . ............... .. ......... April 1919
> ..... ... ... . ...... ... .... 10 April 1854 Passing of 'Abdu'l-B a ha 28 November 1921
> Return of Baha'u'llah from Kurdistan . . . .. . Verdict of the Islamic Court in Egypt pro-
> . . . ... . ........... ...... 19 March 1856                    nouncing the Faith to be an independent
> Declaration of the Mission of Baha'u'llah ...                        religion ................... 10 May 1925
> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 April 1863 Martha Root's first interview wi th Q ueen
> A rrival of Baha' u'llah in Constantinople ....                      Marie of Romania . . .... 30 Janua ry 1926
> .. ... . ................. 16 August 1863 Resolution of the Council of the League of
> A rrival of Baha'u'llah in Adrianople ...... .                       Nations upholding the claim of the Baha'f
> . . .. .. .... . .......... 12 December 1863                      community to the House of Baha'u'llah in
> Departure of Baha'u'llah from A drianople ..                         Baghdad ... ............. .4 March 1929
> .... . .... . ......... . ... 12 A ugust 1868 Passing of the Greatest Holy Leaf July 1932
> Arrival of Baha'u'llah in 'Akka ........... . Inception of the First American Seven- Year
> ....... . ..... . .. . ... . .. 31 August 1868                  Plan .. .. .................. .April 1937
> Death of the Purest Branch .. .23 June 1870 Celebra tio n of the Centenary of the Declaration
> Ascension of Baha'u'llah ..... 29 May 1892                           of the Bab ........ . . . . . . .. 23 May 1944
> First public reference to the Faith in America Inception of the Second American Seven-Year
> .................... 23 September 1893                            Plan ................... . . . .April 1946
> Establishment of the first Baha'f centre in the Centenary of the Martyrdom of the Bab ....
> West ........... . ... .. . . .February 1894                           ..... . ..................... 9 July 1950
> Arrival of the first group of Western pilgrims in Completion of the Arcade and Parapet of the
> 'Akka ...... .. ....... 10 December 1898                           Shrine of the Bab on Mt. Carmel ....... .
> Arrival of the Bab's remains in the Holy Land                            .. .............. .. . . ....... 9 July 1950
> ......... ... . . .. ...... 31 January 1899 Inauguration of the Centenary Celebrations of
> Reincarceration of 'Abdu'l-Baha in 'Akka                              the birth of Baha'u'llah's Prophetic Mission
> ......... .... ...... .... 20 A ugust 1901                          . . ................. ... ... October 1952
> Commencement of the construction of the First Baha'f Intercontinental Teaching Confer-
> Mashriqu'l-Adhkar of 'Ishqabad ........ .                          ence, Kampa la, Uganda, Africa ........ .
> ..... . ........ . ...... 28 November 1902                             . ............. ... . 12-18 February 1953
> THE WORLD ORDER OF BAHA 'U 'LLAH                                                              395
> Inauguration of the Ten-Year International                             His Highness Malietoa Tanumafi li II, of Western
> Baha'i Teaching and Consolidation Plan ..                              Samoa, embraced the Faith ... .. ....... .
> ... . ......... . ............ Ricjvan 1953                             . .. . .. . . . ...... . ... . .. 19 February 1968
> Baha'i dedication of the Mashriqu'l-Adhkar in                          Establishment by the Universal House of Jus-
> Wilmette , Illinois ........ . . . 1 May 1953                          tice of the Continental Boa rds of Counsellors
> Public dedication .......... . 2 May 1953                                  . . ....... ...... .. .. . .. . . . 21 June 1968
> All-American Baha'i Intercontinental Teach-                            First Oceanic Conference, Palermo, Sicily
> ing Conference, Chicago . . .3- 6 May 1953                               ......... . .......... 23-25 August 1968
> Third Baha'i Intercontinental Teaching Con-                            Commemoration of 1 OOth anniversary of
> ference , Stockholm, Sweden .. .. . ..... . .                          arrival of Baha'u'llah in the Holy Land ...
> ............. . .... . . . .. 21-26 July 1953                              . . ...... . ..... . ...... . . 31 August 1968
> Fourth Baha'i Intercontinental Teaching Con-                           The Baha'i International Community accredference, New Delhi, India . .. .. . ...... . .                         ited with consultative status to the United
> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-1 5 October 1953            Nations Economic and Social Council ... .
> Completion of the construction of the Shrine                                . .... .. . . . . ....... . ....... 27 May 1970
> of the Bab ................ October 1953                             Commemoration of lOOth anniversary of the
> Expansion of the Faith to 100 additional                                  death of Mirza Mihdi, 'The Purest Branch'
> countries and islands by settlement of the                                 ................. . . . ..... 23 June 1970
> Knights of Baha'u'llah .. . .. . . 1953-1 954                        The holding of eight Oceanic and Continental
> Completion of exterior of International                                   Confere nces . . .... . ................ . . .
> Archives Building . ........... . .... 1957                             ....... 14 August 1970- 5 September 1971
> Passing of Shoghi Effendi 4 November 1957                              Commemoration of 50th anniversary of the
> The holding of five Intercontinental Teaching                            passing of' Abdu' l-Baha ........ . ...... .
> Conferences successively in Kampala, Syd-                                  ... . . .. ... ....... 26-28 November 1971
> ney , Wilmette, Frankfurt, Djakarta/Singa-                           Completion of erection of Obelisk , Mt. Carmel
> pore .... .. ....... .. ....... . .. . . .. 1958                           . . . . .... .. .. . ....... 19 December 1971
> First dependency of a Mashriqu'l-Adhkar,                               Dedication of the Mother Temple of Latin
> the Baha'i Home for the Aged, opened in                                 America, Panama . . . . . . .. .29 April 1972
> Wilmette , Illinois, U.S.A .. .. . . ......... .                     Adoption by the Universal House of Justice of
> ... .. .... . . . .............. January 1959                         its Constitution . ...... 26 November 1972
> Dedication of the Mother Temple of Africa,                             Publication by the Universal House of Justice
> Kampala, Uganda ..... . 14 January 1961                                of A Synopsis and Codification of the Laws
> Dedication of the Mother Temple of the                                   and Ordinances of the Kitab-i-Aqdas .....
> Antipodes, Sydney, Australia .......... .                                  . . . .... . ............ ... ... Ricjvan 1973
> . ........ .. ......... 16 September 1961                         Establishment by the Universal House of Jus-
> Completion of the Ten Year Crusade . . .. . .                             tice of the International Teaching Centre .
> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ricjvan 1963        . .. ...... ..... ..... .. ... . .. 5 June 1973
> Election of the Universal House of Justice . .                         Extension and development of the gardens at
> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21April1963         Bahji surrounding the Most Holy Shrine . .
> Celebration of the Most Great Jubilee, in                                  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1963-1979
> London . ... ......... . ...... April 1963                           His Highness Malietoa Tanumafili II of
> Launching of the Nine Year Plan .... . . . .. .                          Western Samoa, visits the resting place of
> ......... .. ... . ............. April 1964                          Shoghi Effendi . . . ... . 12 September 1976
> Dedication of the Mother Temple of Europe,                             The holding of eight Intercontinental Connear Frankfurt, Germany .... .4 July 1964                              ferences between July 1976 and January 1977
> Celebration of the Centenary of the Revelation                         Commemoration of the Centenary of the
> of the Suriy-i-Muluk . . . . .. ...... .. . . .. .                     termination of Baha' u'llah's Confinement
> ............... September/October 1967                               in the prison-city of 'Akka .. . . June 1977
> Opening of period of proclamation of the                               Laying of the foundation stone of the Mother
> Cause, inaugurated by the presentation by                              Temple of the Indian sub-continent ... .. .
> the Universal House of Justice to 140 Heads                              . . . . ... ..... . . ..... .... 17 October 1977
> of State of a special edition of The Proclama-                       Laying of the foundation stone of the first
> tion of Baha'u'llah ........ .October 1967                             Mashriqu'l-Adhkar of the Pacific Islands ..
> The holding of six Intercontinental Conferences                             ... . ...... .. .. .. .. .... .27 January 1979
> ......................... October 1967
> 396   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> PART FIVE
> 
> IN MEMORIAM
> IN MEMORIAM
> 
> RAMONA ALLEN BRAY BROWN                                    that this intuitive faculty was like 'the tinkling
> 1889-1975                                          of bells' and that people could develop this
> quality in themselves. She always treasured a
> Ramona Allen Brown was one of that special                     special volume of Tab/els of 'Abdu'l-Bahli,
> company of American Baha'is who had the                        took it with her when she travelled, and would
> privilege of welcoming' Abdu'l-Baha when He                    open it for guidance. Ramona took the bestvisited the United States. Several of her family               known photographs of the Master in Oakland
> were distinguished Baha'is. She was a cousin of                and Berkley: one with University of California
> George Orr Latimer, 1 a prominent believer                     students from India and one of the Master
> who was a member of the National Spiritual                     walking alone. 3 She also photographed the
> Assembly of the United States, and her                         Master after He gave His historic address on 8
> mother, Frances Orr Allen, was author of an                    October 1912 at Leland Stanford Junior Uniaccount of' Abdu'l-Baha's California sojourn ,2                versity near Palo Alto.
> valuable for its details of the Master's meeting                  In 1916 Ramona married Joseph Grandin
> with the Japanese of Oakland. Ramona's                         Bray 4 who was to become a much-loved Baha'i
> father, Dr. Woodson Hargis Allen , was a                       teacher. The couple had two children: J. Allen
> pioneer physician in northern California.                      Bray, well known in the San Francisco Bay
> Ramona was born in Boulder Creek, Califor-                     area for his support of youth, ecology and the
> nia on 10August1889. Later the family moved                    arts; and Barbara Bray West of Rancho Palos
> to Berkeley.                                                   Verdes, an ardent teacher of the Faith. At her
> In 1905 Ramona and her mother, as guests                    death, Ramona was the widow of Arthur Merof Georgia Ralston, attended a tea at the Oak-                 rill Brown, a prominent San Francisco businessland home of Helen S. Goodall. Kanichi                         man who died in 1950. Ramona had seven
> Yamamoto, who later became the first Japa-                     grandchildren and eight great-grandchildren;
> nese Baha'i, ushered them into the gathering.                  several members of her family have become
> Hearing the Baha'i message for the first time                  members of the Baha'i Faith. In the spring of
> from Mrs. Goodall's daughter, Ella Goodall                     1954 Ramona made a pilgrimage to the Holy
> Cooper, Ramona instantly accepted the Faith                    Land and was planning to return in 1957 when
> that afternoon. She was sixteen years old at the               the Guardian suddenly died.
> time. She was one of the small circle of young                    Throughout her life Ramona travelled
> women known as 'the Peaches' who were                          widely in service to the Faith. As a young
> invited to attend Mrs. Cooper's Baha'i gather-                 woman she spent a year (1934) in Honolulu
> ings; these young ladies affectionately called                 where she held Baha'i classes with Agnes
> Ella Cooper 'Mother Peach'. Ramona was                         Alexander and Katherine Baldwin. She visited
> blonde and beautiful and although a constant                   Turkey, pioneered for one year (1956) with
> sufferer from asthma she retained her beauty                   Jean and Tova Deleuran in Palma de Mallorca,
> and elegance throughout her life.                              and accompanied the Hand of the Cause
> Ramona unceasingly shared her accounts of                   Agnes Alexander to Rome . At the Guardian's
> visits with 'Abdu'l-Baha while He was in the                   direction she visited Baha'i pioneers through-
> San Francisco Bay area, and has left a written                 out the islands of the Mediterranean. Early in
> record of those days. She described how the                    1957 she joined Carl and Lili Olitski Hermann
> Master would look at her and His eyes would                    and Harold and Marzieh Gail in Salzburg,
> twinkle and He would laugh; no doubt her                       Austria and in April of that year became a
> light-heartedness would have been recognized                   member of that city' s first Spiritual Assembly
> by Him. He praised her perceptivity, telling her               and, later, its chairman. She also taught in the
> ' See 'In Memoriam', The Baha'( World, vol. XI, p. 511.        surrounding villages. In her written account of
> See 'Abdu'l-Baha in San Francisco', Star of the West, vol.
> III, no . 12, 16 October 1912, p. 9; vol. III, no. 13 , 4     See Star of the West, vol. IV, no. 12, 16 October 1912, p.
> November 1912, p. 11; (vol. 2, George Ronald edition          202, p. 204; (vol. 2, George Ronald edition 1978).
> 1978).                                                       'See 'In Memoriam', The Bahd'( World , vol. VIII, p. 672.
> 400                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> be estimated at this time. She never missed an
> opportunity to teach. Once , from her sick-bed ,
> she sent a copy of Baha'u' ffah and the New Era
> to a scientist stationed at the North Pole, the
> son of a woman she had met while a patient in
> the hospital. Her ease of communication was
> such that once, although knowing no Greek ,
> she 'conversed' by gestures with women
> inhabitants she met on the island of Rhodes.
> Although her life was not without its stretches
> of difficulty and sorrow, there was a constant
> air of festivity , hospitality, elegance and grace
> about her. In spite of almost continual illness
> she would readily, albeit with great effort,
> leave her sick-bed to attend a party or Baha'i
> gathering. Her light-heartedness, good taste
> and dignity appealed especially to younger
> friends. One of her characteristic sayings when
> selecting a restaurant in an unfamiliar city was
> ' ... and let's pay a dollar for the atmosphere! '
> While a patient in a Salzburg hospital she said
> to a visitor, 'I wake up in the night and find my
> Ramona Allen Bray Brown                   heart has stopped; so I shake myself and start it
> going again!'
> her experiences in Austria she stated: 'In              On 23 February 1975 , after a short illness,
> August (1957) I was receiving treatment from        Ramona passed into the Abha Kingdom.
> a young Austrian woman who became curious           Many expressions of tribute and condolence
> to know why I was there (Salzburg) alone, ill       reached her family. In appreciation of her long
> and so far from home. I told her about the          and distinguished Baha'i career the National
> Faith. She became interested and we had daily       Spiritual Assembly of the United States
> chats about the Teachings ... In October 1957       cabled:
> she, Editha Wehrle, declared her faith, the first     DEEPLY GRIEVED LOSS RAMONA ALLEN BRAY
> Austrian Baha'i in Salzburg under the Ten             BROWN STALWART MEMBER AMERICAN BAHAI
> Year Plan.' In June the following year,               COMMUNITY WHOSE LONG LIFE EXTRAORDINARY
> Ramona records, Fritzi Klap, another                  SERVICE TO CAUSE BAHAULLAH WAS MADE DIS-
> Austrian, accepted the Faith. In December             TINCTIVE BY HER ATTAINMENT TO PRESENCE
> 1963 ill health forced Ramona to return to            MASTER ABDULBAHA STOP HER NOBLE EXAMPL E
> California where she settled in La Jolla, near        UNSTINTING    DEVOTION AND AUTHORSHIP IN
> the border of Mexico. The climate there, it was       HER    WANING    YEARS   OF   MANUSCRIPT    HER
> hoped would foster her return to health . The         MEMORIES BELOVED MASTER WILL DOUBTLESS
> community, site of the University of California ,     SHED   LIGHT UPON     PATH    EVOKE GRATITUDE
> offered great opportunities for Baha'i service.       GENERATIONS TO COME STOP WE PRAY THAT HER
> Ramona took up residence at La Jolla's                SOUL WILL RE CEIVE ABUNDANT REWARD IN
> Colonial Inn , teaching constantly, visiting          ABHA KINGDOM.
> many centres in southern California and
> From the Universal House of Justice came
> receiving in ever-increasing numbers the
> this memorial of her historic life:
> young Baha'ls and their friends who flocked
> to meet her, listening to her talks and asking        INFORMED PASSING 17 MULK STEADFAST SER-
> questions for hours at a time.                        VANT CAUSE RAMONA BROWN WHOSE DEVOTED
> Ramona's great gift was her power to attract       HIGHLY MERITORIOUS SERVICES DURING FOR-
> and confirm individuals in the Faith, in what-        MATfVE AND HEROIC AGES FAITH INCLUDING
> ever country or circumstance she found her-           PIONEERING ACTIVITIES EUROPE AND MEDITER-
> self. Her wide-ranging influence can scarcely         RANEAN AREA LOVINGLY REMEMBERED STOP
> IN MEMORIAM                                            401
> OFFERING ARDENT PRAYERS HOLY THRESHOLD
> PROGRESS HER SOUL ABHA KINGDOM CONVEY
> BARBARA WEST FAMILY LOVING CONDOLENCES .
> 
> (Adapted from a memoir by Marzieh Gail
> and Barbara West.)
> 
> MARK TOBEY
> 1890-1976
> 
> Mark Tobey occupies a unique position in
> the history of art: a painter of genius who also
> was deeply inspired through most of his productive life by the dynamic of a new religious
> impulse, the renewal of God's Word through
> Baha'u'llah. As a result, he has produced a
> body of work which has stirred controversy,
> been extraordinarily praised and grossly
> misunderstood, had a strong influence on
> trends in art which is still not fully grasped, and
> has helped a substantial number of people to                            Mark Tobey
> become aware of the meaning and significance
> of the Baha'i Faith.                                  work of famous illustrators and portrait pain-
> His childhood years were much in the spirit        ters, and eventually discovered Rembrandt
> of Tom Sawyer. He was born in Centerville,            and Michelangelo , first from prints, then the
> Wisconsin , on 11 December 1890. When he              originals in the Chicago Art Institute . By 1911
> was four years of age the family moved to             his confidence had grown to the point where he
> Trempealeau, Wisconsin, a village of 600 on           settled in Greenwich Village, New York,
> the banks of the Mississippi , where Mark spent       determined to make good as a fashion illusthe next twelve years as a typical mid-western        trator. Indeed, he obtained a good job in this
> 'barefoot boy'. He studied and enjoyed nature         fie ld with McCall's Magazine and continued
> avid ly, attended school and the Congrega-            comparable work both in Chicago and New
> tional Church, and aspired in turn to be a            York for the next six years.
> minister, a taxidermist, a storekeeper a nd a            During this period his skill as a charcoal
> trader. There is evidence that he showed              portraitist beca me recognized. He did portraits
> aptitude for art early. However, the only for-        of many famou s people , including Mary Garma l art training he was to receive was at Satur-     den, the opera star (his partroness for a while),
> day classes in watercolours and oils at the           Muriel Draper, Anthony Drexel Biddle and
> Chicago Art Institute and after two years Mark        Governor Bell of New York , which were exhihad to drop out of high school and seek work          bited in a modern gallery run by Marie Sterner
> because of the illness of his father .                at M. Knoedler and Co. A year later Mrs.
> From 1909 to 1911 , after the family moved         Sterner was to change the course of his life. She
> to Chicago, Mark changed jobs frequently.             invited him to dinner, where he sat next to
> While working as a blueprint boy in a steel mill      Juliet Thompson who introduced him to the
> he studied mechanical drawing and spent his           Baha'i Faith. He became a Baha'i in 1918 and
> free time copying magazine covers. Several            made a deep and continuous study of the
> jobs later he was an errand boy for a fashion         Teachings. William C. Seitz, whose essay in the
> studio, when it was discovered he had a talent for    catalog for the Museum of Modern Art exhibidrawing and he was engaged to draw the faces          tion is the most profound analysis yet pubfor cata logue illustrations, at a substantial        lished of the impact of the Baha'i Faith on
> boost in salary. He clipped and studied the           Tobey' s art, said: ' Without doubt, this (accep-
> 402                                           THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> tance of the Baha'i Faith) was the crucial                     and principles . Many of his students from both
> spiritual redirection of Tobey's life and of his               the Cornish School and his private classes have
> development as an artist.' 1 In 1919 he spent                  testified that he was a masterful teacher.
> some time in Mexico City, a centre to which                    Mark claimed that it was a reciprocal process
> ' Abdu'l-Baha had directed the attention of the                and that his own artistic development evolved
> Baha'is in 1916 in His Divine Plan Tablets.                    in the process.
> Later he returned to New York. A ferment was                      In 1923 Tobey became close friends with
> taking place in Tobey's approach to his art,                   Teng Kuei, a young Chinese artist studying at
> particularly a reaction against ' the Renaissance              the University of Washington, and learned
> sense of space and order. ' He was also storing                from him both the technique and philosophy of
> up experiences that would surface later in                     Chinese calligraphy. This influence, as Seitz
> many of his important paintings. The day                       correctly remarks, Tobey applied later as 'a
> World War I ended he walked the streets of                     means of opening solid form, giving tangibility
> New York with his friend Janet Flanner who in                  to empty space, and of breathing life into static
> future years was to write the famous Letter                    Western realism.' 5
> from Paris under the name of Genet in The                         In 1925 Tobey went to Europe, settling for
> New Yorker, and who first wrote in a major                     several months in Paris. Then, in 1926, he
> article of Mark's dedication to the Baha'i                     accompanied friends to Spain, Greece, Turkey
> Faith. 2 This period was a montage of 'sirens,                 and Lebanon , and later took advantage of the
> dynamic lights, brilliant parades and returning                chance to make his first visit to the Baha'i
> heroes. An age of confusion and stepped-up                     Shrines and World Centre at Haifa. After visitrhythms.' 3                                                    ing the Shrine of Baha'u'llah he spent an hour
> In the early 1920s Mark Tobey became                        with Shoghi Effendi: 'His grace when I first saw
> known for his caricatures of theatrical people ,               him is never to be forgotten, nor did he change
> some of which were published in the New York                   when, years later, I had the opportunity to see
> Times , and for his drawings of burlesque and                  him for a longer time ... Of course, in Haifa
> vaudeville personalities. A brief, unhappy                     many things happen and yet all seems to melt in
> marriage in 1922 and growing social demands                    time which is no time. You are there-that's
> caused him to want to get away from New                        enough. Just to sit down in a chair seems as
> York. A friend was returning home to Seattle                   important as going to town . You are released
> and offered to share train space and a bag of                  from yourself.' 6
> oranges, so a new home was found. Seattle did                     In 1930 Mr. and Mrs. Leonard Elmhurst
> not have the intellectual and cultural stimula-                offered Mark a six-month appointment as head
> tion of New York, but it did offer spaciousness,               of the painting department at Dartington Hall ,
> great natural beauty, a slower, more relaxed                   a progressive school of the arts in Devonshire,
> pace, a diffuse light that has been likened to                 about 200 miles from London. Tobey stayed
> that of Paris, and some devoted, often discern-                eight years. Here he associated with such inteling, friendships. • It also enabled Tobey to find              lectual leaders as Aldous Huxley, Rabina new activity that was to be a meaningful part                dranath Tagore, Arthur Waley, Pearl Buck ,
> of his artistic life for the next three decades:               and dancers Shankar and the Jooss Ballet. He
> teaching. He was offered a post at the Cornish                 also formed a firm friendship with potter Ber-
> School and evolved a unique method of teach-                   nard Leach, which in time led to Leach's acceping, concentrating more on stimulating the                     tance of the Baha'i Faith. In 1932 further
> imagination of the student, encouraging a love                 travels in Europe were made possible, and a
> for art and overcoming the barrier of lac:k of                 second pilgrimage to the Baha'i World Centre .
> confidence than following structured procedures                Two years later he accompanied Bernard
> William C. Seitz, Mark Tobey, New York, The Museum of        Leach to the orient, spending time in Shanghai
> Modern Art, 1962; p. 43.                                     with his friend, Teng Kuei, and then visiting
> Janet Flanner, 'Tobey, mystique errant', L' Oeil , 15 June
> 1955. Reprinted in English in Selective Eye , New York ,
> Japan where he entered a Zen monastery for a
> Random House, 1955.                                           month to study calligraphy and painting, and to
> Seitz, ibid . p. 45.
> Betty Bowen, The Story of a Collection, exhibition           ' Seitz, ibid. p. 4 7
> catalogue, Tobey's 80: A Retrospective, Seattle Art            Recorded interview of Mark Tobey by Arthur L. Dahl, 21
> Museum , University of Washington Press, 1970.                 September 1963.
> IN MEMORIAM                                           403
> 
> write poetry and meditate.                          house in the old section of this Swiss commu-
> The paintings he did in 1935 or 1936, after      nity, which afforded an atmosphere conducive
> he had returned to Dartington Hall, rep-            to his work and refuge from the invasion of
> resented the birth of his mature style and the      privacy which fame brought him.
> discovery of a new language in art. These              In 1961 the Musee des Arts Decoratifs, the
> included Broadway Norm, Broadway and Wel-           modern wing of the Paris Louvre, offered a
> come Hero and in them he made use of the            monumental one-man Tobey exhibition con-
> Chinese calligraphic impulse and a vision of the    taining almost 300 works. Mark was the first
> energy of the city-the result was occidental        living artist who was not French ever to be so
> and was, in fact, New York. He was forty-four       honored, and for the occasion the museum
> when he painted them. The next significant          made major alterations in the huge rooms to
> move, and the beginning of his life as a mature     accommodate the small, intimate scope of
> artist, came in 193 8 when he returned to the       Tobey's paintings. The opening-day reception
> United States and settled again in Seattle. Here    was attended by Andre Malraux , representing
> began the massive outpouring of vitally origi-      the French government, and Ambassador
> nal paintings incorporating the new 'white writ-    James Gavin represented the United States.
> ing' technique on which his early fame rests.       That evening the Ambassador gave a brilliant
> Fame and financial success came slowly to       reception in his home in Tobey's honor.
> Mark Tobey, and late in his life. He was fortu-        The crowning moment, however, was the
> nate in his dealers. In 1939 he was introduced      exhibition in 1974 at the National Collection of
> to Marian Willard (now Marian Willard John-         Fine Arts, a branch of the Smithsonian Instituson) of the Willard Gallery in New York, who        tion, Washington , D.C., called 'Tribute to
> bought his significant painting Broadway. The       Mark Tobey'. Consisting of seventy works,
> Willard Gallery presented its first Tobey exhi-     more than half painted within fifteen years of
> bition in 1944 and offered them frequently in .     the exhibit-or after Tobey was sixty-seven
> subsequent years. He was first represented in       years of age-it was an amazing testimony to
> the United States section of the Venice Bien-      Mark's creativity and stamina at an advanced
> nale in 1948. In 1952 a twenty-minute film,         age.
> Mark Tobey, highly subjective, experimental           During the years of productivity Mark was
> and sensitive, directed by Robert Gardner and       continually faced with the problem of how to
> with Tobey reading his poetry on the sound         divide his time and energy between his art and
> track, replete with Baha'i concepts of oneness,    direct service to the Baha'i Faith. While he
> was shown at the film festivals of Venice and      lived in England at Dartington Hall he served
> Edinburgh. Tobey's first one-man exhibition        on the British National Spiritual Assembly. In
> was held in Seattle in 1954 at the gallery of      the years at Seattle he served on the Local
> Otto Seligman, a close friend and the subject of   Spiritual Assembly and once moved briefly to
> one of his paintings. His international reputa-     Victoria, British Columbia, in neighbouring
> tion began in 1955 with his first showing at the   Canada, to save the Local Assembly there.
> Galerie Jeanne Bucher in Paris, and was             While in Switzerland he was chairman of the
> further extended when he was represented by          Local Spiritual Assembly of Basel for sixteen
> the Galerie Beyeler in Basel. In recent years      years. At both locations he gave numerous lecthe Foster-White Gallery has represented            tures and firesides, and took advantage of spe-
> Mark in Seattle. The high regard with which he     cial opportunites to talk about the Faith, such
> was held in Europe in the late 1950s was            as on an ocean voyage (he feared airplanes and
> demonstrated by the award to him of the first        took alternative means of transportation
> prize for painting at the Venice Biennale in        wherever possible). During his years in Seat-
> 1958. He was the first American to win it since    tle he frequently attended the Geyserville
> Whistler in 1895.                                   Baha'i School, which he loved, and talked both
> In 1960 Tobey made a change he had been         formally and informally, but always elocontemplating for a long time, moving with his      quently, making art come alive and giving
> close friend , Pehr Hallsten, and his secretary,     many their first glimpse of the meaning and
> Mark Ritter, from Seattle to Basel where he         purpose of abstract art. He published three
> settled in a charming and spacious 500 year old     articles in World Order: 'The One Spirit'
> 404                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> (August 1935); 'Art and Community' (April            material. He could appreciate and respond to
> 1939); and 'The Dot and the Circle' (March           the physical beauties of the world to an extra-
> 1949). He contributed generously to the Funds        ordinary degree, yet he was always aware that
> of the Faith.                                        there was much more than this, and his paint-
> Possibly his largest service was the indirect     ing stretched to discover new means and dimenone of being so much in the public eye in his        sions of expression and vision, offering special
> later years and being identified as a Baha'i.        insight into man 's eternal quest to grasp the
> After 1955 almost every article, interview or        nature of reality. Tobey once said: 'Mankind
> book about him (some of which are in refer-          has preoccupied itself too much with the outer,
> ence works that will be used for decades)            the objective, at the expense of the inner world
> mentioned the Faith and usually outlined those       wherein the true roundness lies.'
> Baha'i principles which had specific applica-           Mark Tobey died in his sleep at 1.15 p.m. on
> tion to his art.                                     24 April 1976 at his home in Basel. The funeral
> Numerous honors flowed to Mark after he           was held at St. Alban's Church, not far away,
> reached his mid-sixties. In 1956 he was elected      with about 150 in attendance. It included two
> to the National Institute of Arts and Letters,       musical works composed by Mark; biographiand won the United States National Prize in          cal remarks by Dr. Ott, professor of theology at
> the Guggenheim International Award. In 1957          the University of Basel; an address by Amin S.
> he was awarded the American Institute of             Khamsi for the Swiss Baha'i community; com-
> Architects' Fine Arts Medal. In 1958, in addi-       ments about Tobey's place in art by Ernest
> tion to the top prize at the Venice Biennale, he     Beyeler; and some personal observations by
> won the first 'Art in America' award . In 1960       Virginia Barnett, a close friend from Seattle
> he was elected a member of the American              and wife of Mark's attorney . She said in part:
> Academy of Arts and Sciences, but did not            'He could be both teacher and student. He
> accept the election. In 1961, at the time of the     could both give and receive friendship. He was
> Louvre exhibition, he won first prize at the         generous in money and time and encourage-
> Carnegie Institute's 'Pittsburgh International       ment to young and old, while also sharply dis-
> Exhibition of Contemporary Painting and              criminating in terms of character and values
> Sculpture.'                                          ... He was touchingly human, vulnerable, ten-
> Tobey had a strong, memorable personality         der, proud , irascible, forgiving- and, in my
> and made a legion of devoted friends both            view, a ranking creative genius of this century.'
> within the Baha'i Faith and in the world at             On 26 April 1976 the Universal House of
> large. He was a brilliant conversationalist and      Justice cabled:
> with his acute powers of observation he could
> DEEPLY GRIEVED ANNOUNCE PASSING DISTIN -
> find meaning and beauty in the most common-
> GUISHED    DEDICATED    SERVANT   BAHAULLAH
> place objects. An unforgettable memory of the
> MARK TOBEY STOP EVER REMEMBE RED HIS CON -
> writer is that of standing with Tobey in one of
> STANT SUPPORT BAHAI COMMUNITY PARTICIPA-
> the great redwood forests of Northern Califor-
> TION ACTIVITIES DEVOTED SERVICES ENGLAND
> nia, sensing his response to the cathedral
> JAPAN SWITZERLAND UNITED STATES UNSTINT-
> majesty of the great trees with the sun filtering
> ING TESTIMONY INSPIRATION FAITH AS HIS FAME
> through their massive trunks. He also had an
> INCREASED STOP ARDENT PRAYERS OFFERED
> encyclopaedic knowledge of Western art, and            SACRED THRESHOLD PROGRESS HIS SOUL ABHA
> was a superb companion in a museum. He
> KINGDOM.
> loved people from all walks of life and had the
> ARTHUR L. DAHL
> capacity of forming deep and long-lasting
> friendships. His creativity extended to the
> other arts. He wrote a considerable amount of
> sensitive and spiritually intuitive poetry,                       CHOO YEOK BOON
> enjoyed playing the piano, and composed sev-                         1945-1976
> eral works for it and other instruments.
> Mark Tobey's long and productive life was         On 26 April 1976 a helicopter of the Royal
> an unending search to find and understand his        Malaysian Air Force crashed at the northinner self, and to reconcile the spiritual and the   ern border of the Malay Peninsula in the course
> IN MEMORIAM                                             405
> By nature Yeok Boon was irrepressible and
> joyous, generous and buoyant, yet he possessed a striking simplicity, humility and dignity,
> He was, in every aspect of his life, an admirable
> example of what a Baha'i should be. Although
> his position with the Air Force would have
> permitted him to live on a grand scale, he and
> his wife, Grace, created a home in which all felt
> welcome. 'I want my home to be a place of
> refuge, not of retreat,' were the words of this
> friend who was lost to us in the prime of his life.
> At the peak of his career he did not forget his
> humble origin. He would visit Naka, the little
> village in Kedah where his less fortunate relatives lived, and would bring them to his home
> in Butterworth for joyful reunions. His material success did not cause him to forget his
> dearly-loved mother who had toiled and suffered to raise him, nor his only sister who early
> in life had sacrificed her chances of an education to help her mother produce and sell cakes
> so that her young brother could go to school.
> Choo Yeok Boon                          Although Boon experienced his share of
> misfortune he did not allow the trials and vicissitudes of life to dampen his radiant spirit. The
> of an official mission. All eleven passengers in     happiness he exuded increased the joy of any
> the craft lost their lives including Air Captain     gathering. One always felt better for being in
> Choo Yeok Boon. At the time of his death he          his presence. He had a boundless enthusiasm
> was a member of the National Spiritual               for the Faith and always had stirring and uplift-
> Assembly of Malaysia, one of the youngest            ing stories to share. His service as a pilot took
> members of the Malaysian Baha'i community            him to various parts of the country and wherever
> ever to have served on that body. He was uni-        he travelled, whether to city, village or jungle
> versally loved by the friends in Malaysia to         outpost, he always took the time to visit the
> whom he was affectionately known as 'Boon'           friends, bringing them news and encourageand from the time of his acceptance of the Faith     ment .
> in the early 1960s he served it with the utmost         Boon was the first Sino-Thai of Malaysia to
> devotion in various capacities.                      have accepted the Faith of the Ancient Beauty
> Yeok Boon was a youth from Alor Star in           and was one of those beloved early youth of
> the State of Kedah. Although he knew about           Alor Star whose services made it a thriving
> the Baha'i Faith for some time and encouraged        centre of teaching activity. The roles he played
> his friends to investigate it, he postponed offi-    in establishing at the Technical College the first
> cially affiliating with the Baha'i community         Baha'i campus society in Malaysia, as a valued
> through loyalty to his mother who had vowed          member of the National Spiritual Assembly
> that he would shave his head and serve as a          and as the sole link between that body and the
> monk for one month at the Buddhist temple.           Asli believers in the remote jungles give those
> When one of the Baha'is assured him that there       who came to love him better than their own
> was no conflict arising from his obligation to his   kinsmen the proof and evidence of the greatmother and his service to the Baha'i commun-         ness of his spirit, the degree of his devotion to
> ity he immediately declared his acceptance of        Baha'u'llah and the magnitude of his love for
> the Faith of Baha'u'llah and with unshakeable        all who crossed his path. He died in the course
> conviction and ceaseless energy arose in its         of duty to his country having served the govservice. His mother did not press him to dis-        ernment with the loyalty and faithfu lness
> charge the obligation.                               which Baha'u'llah enjoins upon His followers.
> 406                                               THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> We grieve with his mother and his wife and                      Majesty, Mikado, became the cause of the
> sorrow for ourselves at Boon's untimely death,                   material progress of Japan. I hope that you
> our solace being drawn from the assurance of                     may become the cause of her spiritual
> Baha'u'llah that the heart which was faithful                    development. This is the principle of proguntil the moment of death ascends to God and                     ress."'
> knows no sadness.                                                   'Abdu'l-Baha, before His visit to the United
> SPIRITUAL AssE:viBLY OF THE                    States in 1912, expressed His hope in Tablets
> BAHA'is OF MALAYSIA                            addressed to Fujita that after perfecting himself in his profession (practical electricity)
> Fujita might return to Japan and promulgate
> the Baha'i Faith in his native land. The follow-
> SAICHIRO FUJITA                                ing passages from Tablets beautifully express
> 1886-1976                                   the love and aspirations which the Master
> cherished for him: 4 'O thou fresh plant in the
> On 7 May 1976 Saichiro Fujita passed to the                      garden of the Love of God! ... Consider what
> Abha Kingdom in his ninety-first year, in                        bounty God has manifested for thee, whence
> Haifa, after a brief illness and heart attack. The               thou art and from whence are we . Yet,
> news of his passing spread quickly around the                    nevertheless, such a candle of love is burning in
> Baha'i world for Fujita, as he was affection-                    the hearts that its light is radiating from the
> ately called, was known and deeply loved by                      East to the West and from the West extending
> the friends in every land who had felt the                       to the East. Rest assured thy name is registered
> warmth of his love and the radiance of his spirit                in the Book of God ... If thou art confirmed as
> when they were on pilgrimage in the Holy                         thou oughtest to be, thou wilt certainly estab-
> Land. To each it brought the sense of loss of a                  lish an eternal kingdom. This kingdom is greaprecious and loving friend. As one expressed                     ter than that of Mikado, for the sovereignty of
> it: 'A small person has left our midst. He has                   the Emperor of Japan is for numbered days,
> left behind a great legacy.'                                     but this sovereignty is lasting and will stand
> Fujita was born in Yanai, Japan on 15 April                   unto the Eternity of Eternities ... 'And again:
> 1886 and emigrated to the United States at the                   'Look thou not upon thine own capability, the
> age of seventeen in search of the best educa-                    Invisible Divine Confirmations are great, and
> tional advantages. From the time of his arrival                  the Protection and Providence of the Beauty of
> in California the events of his life seemed to                   Abha is the helper and the assistant. When a
> unfold as though predetermined by the destiny                    drop draws help from the ocean, it is an ocean
> that was in store for him. That he chose Oak-                    itself ... Therefore do not consider thy capacland as the place in California in which to settle               ity and merit, but rely upon the infinite Bounty
> seems more than merely fortuitous for in that                    and trust to His Highness the Almighty ... '
> city there existed one of the few groups of                         Fujita was working in Cleveland, Ohio when
> Baha'is in that part of the country at that time.                'Abdu'l-Baha came to America. He unfortu-
> Mrs. Kathryn Frankland 1 was teaching the                        nately missed seeing the Master Who made a
> Faith to a group of young Japanese students                      short stop-over in Cleveland on His return to
> one of whom, Kanichi Yamamoto, 2 had                             New York from His first visit to Chicago.
> accepted the Faith in Hawaii in 1902, thus                       Shortly thereafter 'Abdu'l-Baha again visited
> becoming the first Japanese Baha'i in the                        Chicago and Fujita arranged to be at the railworld; in 1905 Fuj ita became the second.                        way station in that city to greet his beloved
> The declaration of these two young men                        Master upon His arrival there. Lost in the large
> brought unusual joy to the beloved Master                        crowd of Baha'is who had gathered at the sta-
> Who, in a Tablet addressed to Mrs. Isabella D.                   tion , and unable to see over their heads, Fujita
> Brittingham,3 dated 8 October 1907 wrote:                        climbed up a conveniently-placed lamp post in
> 'Announce greetings on my behalf to the two                      order to get a glimpse of' Abdu'l-Baha. As the
> young Japanese and say: "His Imperial                            Master entered the car that was to transport
> See 'In Memoriam', The Baha'f World, vol. XIV, p. 337.       ' The full text of the Tablets, dated 10 November 1906 and
> See 'In Memoriam', The Baha'f World, vol. XIII, p. 931.        29 May 1907 respectively, appears in Japan Will Turn
> See 'In Memoriam',Starofthe West, vol. 14, no. 12, p. 376.     Ablaze, Baha'i Publishing Trust of Japan (1974).
> IN MEMORIAM                                                          407
> Him to the home of Corinne True' where a
> reception in His honour was to be held, He saw
> Fujita in his high perch and called him to come
> down. He then embraced Fujita and asked him
> to follow Him to Mrs. True's. Fujita was
> invited to join the dinner party and after the
> first course, when he noticed that a number of
> people were longing to talk with the Master, he
> offered his place at the table to Mrs. Elizabeth
> Greenleaf.
> The next morning Fujita went with the Master to Kenosha, Wisconsin. It was during this
> visit that 'Abdu'l-Baha invited him to accompany Him and His party on their visit to
> California, which Fujita accepted without hesitation. Throughout these travels it was Fujita's
> great privilege to serve the Master in many
> ways which contributed to His physical comfort, health and amusement during those days
> and nights of arduous and demanding
> activities. Fujita did not speak often in detail
> about those experiences, but on one evening at
> the dinner table during his last visit to Wilmette
> Saichiro Fujita
> in 1971, he seemed inspired to recall those
> wonderful days of serving his beloved Master.
> Both his manner and tone of voice expressed                   exceedingly difficult, particularly in the Middle
> the depth of their meaning to him and his long-               East. Fujita proceeded to Italy where he
> ing to have been able to serve 'Abdu'l-Baha for               planned to obtain the special permit that was
> many, many years. His services to his blessed                 required to pass through Egypt but was unable
> Master were unique indeed and indicated his                   to obtain it. This resulted in a long delay at this
> own spiritual worthiness of such great bless-                  point in his journey with no reply being
> ings.                                                         received from Cairo to the cables sent almost
> During 'Abdu'l-Baha's visit in America                     daily on his behalf. Mrs. True and her daughter,
> Fujita expressed his great desire to return to                 Edna, were about to sail from Trieste to the
> Haifa with Him and to devote the remainder                     Holy Land when they heard of Fujita's plight
> of his life to serving Him. The Master accepted                and they immediately changed plans and
> this touching offer and promised to send for                   joined Fujita in Naples. Their reunion with
> him when circumstances would permit. Mrs                       Fujita was unforgettable; his distress was
> Corinne True invited Fujita to stay in her home                pathetic and his joy in seeing them deeply movwhile he prepared himself for the kinds of ser-                ing. Unable to solve the problem from Naples,
> vice the Master would require of him, and for                  the Trues embarked for Egypt and upon arrival
> the next seven years Fujita lived with the Trues               in Cairo immediately applied to the authorities
> as a welcomed and much loved member of the                     and were assured that the permit would be
> family. During this time he was carefully                      dispatched at once to Fujita in Naples. Fujita
> guided, through Tablets the Master addressed                   arrived in Haifa with Mr. and Mrs. William H.
> to him, in the studies and the work he should                  Randall 2 and Mr. George Latimer 3 whom he
> pursue.                                                        had met in Naples . To the delight of the Trues
> The outbreak of the First World War                        they were still in Haifa and could participate in
> delayed Fujita's departure but finally, in 1919,               welcoming Fujita.
> came the long-anticipated invitation to pro-                      With the exception of a three-month visit to
> . ceed to the Holy Land . Government regula-                     2
> See 'In Memoriam', The Bahti'f World, vol. III, p. 213 ; vol.
> . tions were still restrictive and travel was                        XV, p. 463
> 1                                                               3
> See 'In Memoriam', The Bahti'f World , vol. XIII, p. 846.       See 'In Memoriam', The Baha'f World, vol. XI, p. 511.
> 408                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Japan to see his family in 1936, Fujita             and support to me in my work .. .'
> remained continuously in Haifa until 1938,             (Letter to an individual believer, 27 January
> serving the beloved Master and later the            1924)
> beloved Guardian. His manifold services                'I wish to assure you personally of my
> included his important assistance in installing     genuine satisfaction in hearing about Mr.
> and operating much needed electrical                French's splendid idea to help towards the welappliances, maintaining and driving the Mas-        fare and comfort of our dear Fujita. He fully
> ter's automobile, beautifying the gardens and       deserves it and I have for him nothing but
> caring for the visiting pilgrims. In addition, he   unqualified admiration. He is truly an exemtranslated from Japanese many of the letters        plary assistant and servant to the Cause .. .'
> which were by then being sent from Japan and           (Letter to an individual believer, 10 April
> translated the replies to accompany the origi-      1926)
> nal messages from the Holy Land . His talents          No one could resist Fujita's radiant spirit, his
> were many and varied. He designed and made          gentle and delightful sense of humour. His pargardens with the artistry unique to the Japan-      ticular heritage to posterity is his beauty of
> ese. He was a skilled chef, serving with grace      character and his complete dedication to the
> the Master, Shoghi Effendi, visiting dignitaries    Faith he loved so well.
> and countless pilgrims .                               In a Tablet to him dated 15 May 1913, writ-
> In 1938 the Guardian, in his concern about       ten from Paris on His return journey back to
> Fujita's safety because of the growing antago-      the Holy Land, 'Abdu'l-Baha counselled
> nism toward his countrymen, arranged for            Fujita about preparing himself for service in
> Fujita to return temporarily to Japan. There he     the Holy Land, emphasizing his attaining efficremained for seventeen long years, filled with      iency in his profession, and then He added:
> loneliness and yearning to return to what he        'When thou shalt learn these things, then I will
> felt to be his real home in Haifa . At last, in     send for thee. Thou wilt be confirmed to render
> 1955 , Shoghi Effendi was able to arrange for       a great service and this will become the cause of
> his return to the Holy Land where he con-           thy everlasting glory.' How true was his
> tinued many of his usual services. From this        beloved Master's vision of the spiritual journey
> time, until his death, Fujita remained in           through life of this man of small stature but of
> Haifa, serving the Guardian and, after the pass-    such greatness of heart and spirit.
> ing of Shoghi Effendi, the Hands of the Cause          The following cablegram dated 9 May 1976
> of God and the Universal House of Justice.          from the Universal House of Justice
> Always he was eager to do everything he could       announced the passing of this beloved friend
> for the visiting pilgrims who will ever             from the earthly plane of existence:
> remember his thoughtfulness and kindness.
> DEARLY LOVED TIRELESS STEADFAST SAICHIRO
> Among the treasures which they took away
> FUJITA PASSED TO ABHA KINGDOM AFTER LONG
> with them from the Holy Land were the
> YEARS SERVICE SACRED THRESHOLD STOP HIS
> heart-warming memories of meeting Fujita
> RANK IN VANGUARD FIRST JAPANESE BELIEVERS
> and of feeling the tender love which filled his
> HIS LABOURS WORLD CENTRE HIS DEDICATION
> great heart. His love of Baha'u'llah, the Mas-
> HUMILITY SINCERITY LOVE WILL FOR EVER BE
> ter, the Guardian and all the friends whom he
> REMEMBERED AND PROVIDE SHINING EXAMPLE
> met was inexpressible in words but was elo-
> TO RJSING GENERATIONS JAPANESE BAHAIS WHO
> quently declared in his gracious and kindly
> WJLL VIEW WJTH PRIDE DISTINCTION CONFERRED
> manner and his evident concern and regard for
> UPON HIM STOP PRAYING HOLY SHRJNES PRO -
> everyone's welfare and happiness.
> GRESS HIS RADIANT SOUL UNDER LOVING GRACE
> In the following passages from letters of the
> HIS MASTER AND GUARDIAN BOTH OF WHOM HE
> beloved Guardian we find expressed his love
> SERVED    SO   WELL   ADVISE   HOLD   BEFITTING
> and esteem for Fujita and his appreciation of
> MEMORIAL GATHERINGS JAPAN.
> his se'rvices:
> EDNA TRUE
> '. .. Fujita is with us: happy, active and
> extremely helpful. His presence is such a help
> IN MEMORIAM                                              409
> AMELIA BOWMAN
> 1897-1976
> 
> The hearts of the believers throughout Scandinavia were saddened at the news of the passing of Amelia Bowman on 8 May 1976. She
> was born in Montana, U.S.A. in 1897 and
> became a Baha'i in 1933. Twenty-nine years of
> her life of Baha'i service were devoted to
> pioneering in Europe, and twenty-three of
> those were spent in Norway. She was an ardent
> teacher and in the first years of her Baha'i life
> attracted a number of people to the Faith
> including most of her family. In a letter written
> on behalf of the beloved Guardian by his secretary on 30 July 1935 we read: ' I wish to
> express, in particular, his genuine appreciation
> of your labours with the Teaching Committee
> of the E liot (Maine) Assembly, and also to
> express the hope that through your efforts and
> those of your distinguished and able collaborator, Mrs. Elizabeth Greenleaf, you may
> be able to bring the Message to all the main
> Amelia Bowman
> towns in the vicinity of Eliot ... '. Penned in the
> Guardian's own hand were the words: 'I am
> delighted to hear of your work and to note the        bly in 1948, Amelia proceeded to Gi:itheborg.
> devotion and zeal with which you are labouring        Soon after the arrival there of two other
> for so great a Cause. I wish to assure you in         pioneers she was asked by the European
> person of my . prayers for your success and           Teaching Committee, in the autumn of 1949,
> spiritual advancement. May the Beloved                to settle in Oslo, Norway. Amelia was active in
> guide, cheer and sustain you in your high and         various organizations including the Esperanconstant endeavours.' In this period she              tists, the International Friendship League, the
> worked with Florence Morton and Martha                United Nations and various clubs, all the while
> Root to extend the Faith in New Hampshire.            giving full attention to the work of the Baha'i
> For five years she acted as hostess at the Ole        community on the local level and in the field of
> Bull Cottage at Green Acre Baha'i School. She         extension teaching. In 1952 she moved to
> entertained women's clubs and other organiza-         Bergen and was instrumental in the establishtions at teas or evening meetings. For a number       ment, in 1955, of the Local Assembly. In addiof years, and extending to 194 7, she performed       tion to her various teaching activities througha major service as a member of the United             out Scandinavia she served as a news corres-
> States Baha'i National Teaching Committee             pondent for the United States Baha'f News.
> which directed pioneering and teaching                   Her pilgrimage to the Holy Land in March
> activities of the first Seven Year Plan. She then     1953 , during which she heard from the lips of
> arose as a pioneer herself.                           Shoghi Effendi an outline of the goals of the
> In October 1947 she arrived in Sweden with         Ten Year Crusade and was encouraged by him
> Nancy Gates; they were the thirty-fifth and           to speak to the friends of the significance of this
> thirty-sixth pioneers of the second Seven Year        world-encircling teaching plan, prepared her
> Plan to settle in Europe. When Dorothy Baker          even more fully for her role in the teaching field
> visited Stockholm in the spring of 1948 she           in Europe. She participated in the Convention
> reported finding ' large and flourishing classes'     in Stockholm in 1957 which witnessed the birth
> and mentioned that among the newly-found              of the regional National Assembly of Scanbelievers was Mr. Eskil Ljungberg. After the          dinavia and Finland. Later that year she was
> formation of the Stockholm Spiritual Assem-           requested to serve in France for two years.
> 410                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Here she was a valued member of the National          GRIEVED PASSING SERENE DEVOTED MAIDSER-
> Teaching Committee of the newly-established           VANT BAHAULLAH AMELIA BOWMAN HER SER-
> French National Assembly. She returned to             VICES PION EERING FIELD SCANDINAVIA SINCE
> Norway in 1959 and assisted in establishing the       OPENING YEARS SECOND SEVEN YEAR PLAN
> first Local Spiritual Assembly of Stavanger           UNFORGETTABLE PRAYING HOLY SHRINES PROG-
> and, later, that of Hetland, and from the time of     RESS   HER   RADIANT   SOUL   ABHA   KINGDOM
> its formation in 1962, until 1967, she was            ADVISE HOLD BEFITTING MEMORJAL GATHER-
> elected a member of the National Spiritual            INGS THROUGHOUT NORWAY.
> Assembly of Norway.                                                                  GERD STRAND
> With the exception of the year or so she
> spent in Lofoten to maintain the strength of the
> Local Assembly, Amelia lived the remainder
> of her life in Stavanger where the milder cli-                DORIS RICHARDSON
> mate was beneficial to her health. She had a                       1901-1976
> frail constitution, a heart condition and suf-                 Knight of Baha'u'llah
> fered from a persistent bronchial ailment. All
> who crossed her path were given the Message         Doris Richardson was born into a family that
> of Baha'u'llah. Amelia's manner of presenta-        was both highly individualistic and deeply
> tion was scholarly, dignified and warmhearted.      committed to Canada. Her mother was the first
> She was compassionate by nature and serene          white child born on Manitoulin Island in Georand regal in her bearing. She had inexhaustible     gian Bay; her daughter, Helen Charters, is a
> patience and was hospitable toward all without      Baha'i who lives on the Island of Grand
> discrimination. Steadfastness and persever-         Manan, New Brunswick, which was opened to
> ance were the hallmarks of her character.           the Baha'i Faith in 1953 through the pioneer-
> In 197 5 Amelia's strength began to fail ,       ing efforts of Doris herself, a service for which
> although the fire in her soul still shone in her    she was named a Knight of Baha'u'llah. Doris
> eyes which radiated love, devotion and the          had an openness and freshness of mind which
> spirit of prayer. She went to her last rest on 8    qualified her to mingle in ease with people of
> May 1976, honoured and mourned throughout           many schools of thought, and a purity of heart /
> Scandinavia. The funeral service was attended       which enabled her to recognize immedia}efy
> by many friends, Baha'i and non-Baha'i. A           the truth of the Cause of Baha'u'Ilah'. She
> beautiful memento comprising a printed book-        became a Baha'i in 1939 through t4e teaching
> let with excerpts from the teachings and a pic-     efforts of Howard and RicJvanjyyih (Mabel)
> ture of the Shrine of the Bab was given to all      Ives and from that time, unyvher death on 13
> who were present. Her grave in Stavanger is         May 1976, she dedicated her life to the Blessed
> surrounded by green, peaceful woodland.             Beauty. Her home, in the words of Mrs. Char-
> An early believer, Winnie Ringstad of Oslo,      ters, was 'the refuge of seekers of all races,
> wrote in a eulogy: 'We are all greatly indebted     religions and schools of thought- blacks,
> to Amelia, but still have much to learn from        Indians, Asians, Rosicrucians and clairher. Let us bear this in mind when com-             voyants. Baha'i visitors and travelling teachers
> memorating the thirty-fifth member of the Bat-      mixed harmoniously with the boarders and
> talion of Baha'u'llah in Europe.'                   friends and neighbours came and went, warmly
> The National Spiritual Assembly of the           and graciously received , and always superbly
> United States cabled the friends in Norway:         fed.' She cared for all those who came in con-
> HEARTS   SADDENED     BY   PASSING   STEADFAST    tact with the Faith with a sweet and personal
> AMELIA BOWMAN WHO AROSE WITH DEDICA-              love, kept in touch with them and fostered their
> TION TO ANSWER CALL FOR PIONEERS FROM             interest. She spoke with an eloquence and sim-
> HER BELOVED GUARDIAN STOP PRAYING AT              plicity that was unforgettable. She settled in
> HOLIEST HOUSE WORSHIP THAT HER SOUL WILL          Scarborough, Ontario and became a member
> RECEIVE RICH HEAVENLY REWARD FOR DEVOTED          of the first Spiritual Assembly there. Her
> SERVICES FAITH.                                   Saturday firesides became the focal point of the
> Great comfort was found in the cablegram of       teaching efforts in the region. As a member of
> the Universal House of Justice:                     the first teaching committee of the Province of
> IN MEMORIAM                                            411
> death from cancer but she remained, as always,
> radiant and content. Her physical beauty
> attested an inner harmony and beauty of spirit
> that was unforgettable. 'The effect of her spirit
> remains strong in Grand Manan,' writes Mrs.
> Charters. 'Her influence upon the islanders,
> the members of her family and her many
> friends here will long continue in the
> memories, in the hearts.'
> The words of the Universal House of Justice
> summarize both the quality of her spirit and the
> significance of her services to the Canadian
> Baha'i community:
> ASSURE PRAYERS SHRINES PROGRESS SOUL ABHA
> KINGDOM KNIGHT BAHAULLAH DORIS RICHARD-
> SON HER DEVOTED SERVICES CAUSE ENRICH
> ANNALS FAITH CANADA.
> 
> AJ:IMAD $AMfMf
> Doris Richardson                                        1893-1976
> 
> Al)mad $amfmf was born in Hamadan, fran in
> Ontario she travelled frequently in the 1940s        1893. His father, Mul)ammad-J:lasan, was an
> to the few communities that existed at that          early follower of Baha'u'llah who suffered tritime. In 1948 she was elected to the first           als and persecution as a result of his acceptance
> National Spiritual Assembly of Canada.               of the Blessed Beauty. Plundered of his posses-
> She read with the sensitivity of both experi-     sions again and again, he was finally forced to
> ence and understanding the appeals of Shoghi         quit his home town and, with his wife, Khavar
> Effendi in which he admonished the believers         Khanum, their three daughters and son,
> to disperse from the major cities and immedi-        Al)mad $amfmf, aged four, to settle in Tihran.
> ately responded, in 19 51, by pioneering to the      Mul)ammad-J:lasan died a year later and his
> Maritime region of Canada. She assisted in the       widow, who was a Baha'i of great courage and
> formation of the Spiritual Assembly of Monc-         determination, resolved to give her children a
> ton, New Brunswick and, in 1953, when the            Baha'i upbringing and education, no matter
> Guardian launched the Ten Year Crusade, she          what the cost and sacrifice. The attributes of
> arose to settle in Grand Manan where she             persistence and perseverance, of diligence and
> remained to see the first Assembly formed.           integrity, which she instilled into her children
> Throughout her life she was a tireless and        characterized Al)mad $amfmf's act1V1tles
> active person, not only as a teacher of the          throughout his life and were the cause of his
> Cause which she loved greatly but in other           progress in his undertakings.
> undertakings as well . At one time she was a            Al)mad $amfmf was educated at the Baha'i
> women's commentator for a radio station and          Tarblyat School and at the age of sixteen he
> wrote all her own scripts; at another, she trav-     entered the postal service, operated by the
> elled all round the Maritimes selling biscuits. On   Belgians at that time under a concession, and
> Grand Manan Island, from 1953 until 1974,            his honesty and attention to his duties wo n
> she managed a summer hotel which was popu-           their commendation. Eventually he was prolar for its atmosphere of hospitality and warm       moted to the post of deputy-chief of the Departcourtesy. Later, to augment her income, she          ment of Supplies. He married Khujastih, the
> became matron of a girls' school.                    granddaughter of Nizamu'l-Mulk, and, in
> In the last months of her life Doris faced        1919, secured employment in the British
> 412                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> and foreigners. In 1943 , at the request of
> Shoghi Effendi, he arranged a meeting in his
> home of the members of the National Spiritu al
> Assembly with Sir Ronald Storrs, Oriental
> Secretary of the British Agency, who had great
> respect for 'Abdu'l-Baha whom he had met in
> Palestine in 1909.
> AJ:imad $amimi went three times on pilgrimage to the Holy Land, twice during the Guardian's lifetime . In 1938, on his second visit, he
> received Shoghi Effendi's permission to attend
> the American Convention and visit various
> Baha'i centres in the United States. In 1945 the
> Guardian advised him to teach in India which
> he did for a period of three months, visiting the
> Baha'is from coast to coast; and later
> pioneered there for five years beginning in
> 194 7. He was elected to serve on the National
> Spiritual Assembly of that country and was its
> chairman for a period. He pioneered to
> Indonesia for five years beginning in 1956 and
> was secretary of the National Spiritu al Assem-
> Af:imad $am[m{                      bly of South-East Asia for a time. On the
> advice of the Hands of the Cause resident in
> the Holy Land, AJ:imad $amimi in 1961
> Embassy where he rose to be Secretary, a post       accompanied the Hand of the Cause Tarazu'-
> he held until his retirement in 194 7. He was       llah Samandari during his travels in West
> awarded the Order of the British Empire in          and East Pakistan, India, Sri Lanka and Singarecognition of his faithful service. He also        pore. He then pioneered to Salzburg, Austria
> received an Insignia from the late king of fran,    and returned to Tihran in 1964. He ascended
> Ric;Ia Shah-i-Pahlavi.                              to the Abha kingdom in July 1976 at the age of
> His affability, courtesy and willingness to      eighty-three.
> help won AJ:imad $amimi the respect and affec-         To the cable from the Persian National
> tion of all with whom he came into contact. His     Spiritual Assembly announcing his death, the
> patience and single-mindedness enabled him          Universal House of Justice replied:
> to deal with the voluminous work referred to
> SADDENED PASSING FAITHFUL DEVOTED SER-
> him by innumerable callers and, no matter how
> VANT CAUSE AHMAD SAMIMI STOP SUPPLICATE
> great the stress of his official duties, he never
> DIVINE THRESHOLD HIS LONG YEARS SERVICE BE
> failed to respond with advice and guidance
> RICHLY REWARDED ABHA KINGDOM STOP ASSURE
> whenever the machinery to carry some poten-
> FAMILY FRIENDS DEEP SYMPATHY.
> tial Baha'i pioneer to his post was to be set in
> motion. He was fluent in French, English and        (Adapted from a report prepared by the
> Arabic and conversant with German , Russian         National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of
> and Turkish. Active in various Baha'i spheres,      Persia and translated by Rustom Sabit.)
> he will be most remembered for his long membership and valuable service on the Committee
> for Unity of the East and West. He received
> many Tablets from 'Abdu'l-Baha and letters                     JOSEPH ENONGENE
> from the Guardian. Introductions and connec-                       1931 - 1976
> tions secured through his occupation were
> turned to good account in expounding the            Jospeh Enongene was born in Nninong,
> teachings of the Faith to people of note. His       Cameroon in 1931 and became ardently
> home was a rendezvous for prominent Persians        attracted to the Baha'i Faith in 1953 through
> IN MEMORIAM                                             413
> 
> mother, both accepted the Faith and his children became enthusiastic students of classes
> for young people. Enongene, his eldest son, in
> turn became a teacher of children's classes at
> Tiko and Tombel.
> In September 1975 he underwent surgery in
> Tiko hospital but it was not successful, the.
> disease being far graver than was thought at
> first. Visitors found him gay and confident. He
> was then transferred to Yaounde hospita l
> where he taught the Faith to the patients in
> various wards. When a visitor told him he was
> 'pioneering' to the hospital and was now doing
> 'extension teaching', Joseph was delighted.
> Although he knew he was seriously ill he
> remained buoyant in spirit.
> His last four months were spent in his home
> village where, from his sick-bed, he continued
> to teach and encourage the friends; largely
> through his efforts a new Spiritual Assembly
> was formed in Ebonemin at Ric;lvan 1976.
> Joseph passed away on 17 July 1976. A
> Joseph Enongene                       memorial meeting was held in Tiko in the
> presence of the Hand of the Cause Enoch
> Olinga and his wife, Elizabeth. Although the
> meeting began on a solemn note it gradually
> Mr. Enoch Olinga, the Knight of Baha'u'llah          became joyous as the friends listened to Mr.
> for that country. Joseph was a lover of music.       Olinga recount the story of Joseph's life and his
> He enjoyed singing and took part in the con-         great dedication to the Faith of Baha'u'llah.
> certs held in Victoria Botanical Gardens.            Later, all joined in singing some of the songs
> When he embraced the Faith he organized and          Joseph had composed. That his death should
> trained a choir and began composing songs            have brought the friends together in love and
> with Baha'i themes, many of which are sung by        harmony, with songs and inspiration and even
> the Baha'is of Cameroon to this day. He was a        laughter, seemed to be the most fitting tribute
> staunch defender of the Covenant and utterly         to pay this devoted soul.
> devoted to the Guardian and the Universal                                        URSULA SAMANDARf
> House of Justice. After the passing of Shoghi
> Effendi he accompanied the Hand of the Cause
> Enoch Olinga on his tour to help the Baha'is in
> their understanding of the Covenant. Joseph                     LETICIA FRANCHINO
> composed a special song for this tour and                            1916-1976
> taught it to the friends in the communities they
> visited.                                             Leticia Franchino was born on 23 November
> When the call came for pioneers for               1916 in Quillota, Chile; she was the youngest
> Equatorial Guinea, Joseph was one of the first       in a family of six children. Leticia studied to be
> to volunteer. In Fernando Po where he settled        a biology and chemistry teacher. On a study
> he suffered persecution and was imprisoned           tour with her fellow students to the extreme
> for weeks. Although he was finally forced to         south of Chile she met the North American
> leave, his spirit remained undaunted and the         Baha'i pioneer, Artemus Lamb. She did not
> natural gaiety of his disposition unclouded. He      become a Baha'i immediately but when she
> settled in Tiko in 1971 and helped to build a        accepted the Faith in 194 7 she did so
> strong, active community with successful and         wholeheartedly, expressing her love for Baha'u' -
> lively children's classes. His wife, Olga, and his   llah through courageous and indefatigable
> 414                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> teristic perseverance she succeeded in opening
> several provinces to the Faith, always returning
> to encourage the new Baha'is while simultaneously seeking new places to plant the seeds of
> the Faith. She was on a teaching trip in Los
> Andes when she died. At a meeting there two
> people had accepted the Faith and Leticia was
> very happy and content. She was leaving the
> town the next morning and feeling tired she
> rested on a bench in the plaza while a friend
> bought her bus ticket; when the friend
> returned minutes later Leticia was dead of heart
> failure. It was difficult to accept-she had been
> so cheerful and full of life, making plans for
> further teaching.
> Leticia exemplified strongly the qualities of
> detachment and generosity. She settled in outlying communities to serve the Faith and
> devoted her vacations and weekends to spreading the Baha'i teachings in remote places.
> Many times, when the needs of the Baha'i fund
> were outlined at Baha'i gatherings, she was
> seen asking the treasurer quietly how much
> Leticia Franchino
> was needed, and on one occasion, to help meet
> a financial emergency described at the
> service to the Chilean Baha'i community.               National Convention, she contributed the
> It is not common in Chile to leave the capital       money she had saved toward her pilgrimage.
> for the provinces. Leticia, however, left her job      She was frank , open-handed and endowed with
> as a biology teacher in Santiago to go to the          a delightful sense of humour. Those who had
> north of the country, first to the town of             the privilege of knowing Leticia remember her
> Antofagasta and then to La Serena, always              with love and admiration.
> actively teaching the Faith. In 1961, when the            When it was informed of her passing on 21
> South American countries elected their first           July 1976, the Universal House of Justice sent
> individual National Spiritual Assemblies,              the following cable to the National Spiritual
> Leticia was elected to serve on the first              Assembly of Chile:
> National Assembly of Chile. She served on it,
> GRIEVED LEARN PASSING LETICIA FRANCHINO
> as well, in subsequent periods.
> DEVOTED MAIDSERVANT BAHAULLAH VALIANT
> Leticia went north again in 1965, this time to
> TEACHER    CAUSE    MEMBER    FIRST    NATIONAL
> Iquique, where she established the foundations
> ASSEMBLY    CHILE    STOP   OFFERJNG    ARDENT
> for the future Local Spiritual Assembly.
> PRAYERS    DIVINE THRESHOLD PROGRESS HER
> Returning to Santiago two years later was
> RADIANT SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> difficult for her as she did not feel well living in
> this large city. She overcame this frustration by                           SERGIO AND .KATE APARICIO
> settling in Villa Alemana, a little town in Valparaiso, where she served on the Local
> Spiritual Assembly and constantly stimulated                        EMMA WA YENECE
> the community to action.                                               1927-1976
> When the Universal House of Justice
> launched the Five Year Plan in 1974, Leticia           Therefore it is the hope of'Abdu'l-Bah<i that . ..
> immediately arose to assist achieving the goals        ye may carry the fame of the Cause of God to
> assigned to Chile . She was appointed to the           . . . the three great island groups of the Pacific
> Regional Teaching Committee and used her               Ocean-Polynesia, Micronesia and Melanesia,
> free time to travel extensively. With charac-          and the islands attached to these groups ... with
> IN MEMORIAM                                                415
> hearts overflowing with the love of God, with
> tongues commemorating the mention of God,
> with eyes turned to the Kingdom of God . ..
> 'Abdu'l-Baha
> Tablets of the Divine Plan 1
> 
> Emma Wayenece had the distinction of being
> the first Melanesian woman of New Caledonia
> and the Loyalty Islands to accept the Faith
> of Baha'u'llah. From the day of her conversion, Emma served the Cause with an
> exemplary courage and humility. Her dedicated efforts, together with those of her husband Georges, formed a solid foundation for
> the Caledonian community in its early, formative years.
> The circumstances in which Georges and
> Emma encountered the Faith are quite extraordinary. The Wayeneces were from the island
> of Mare in the Loyalties (Emma's village was
> Wakuarory); and Mare was one of the first
> islands in the territory to be evangelized
> around the early 1840s, near the beginning of
> Emma Wayenece
> the Baha'i era. The Wayenece clan had been
> one of the first to accept the Christian Faith and
> subsequently assisted to establish it throughout     into contact. The fruits of her labours are
> the rest of the territory. Following in the foot-    impressive. All her brothers and sisters became
> steps of their ancestors, Georges and Emma           Baha'ls, one brother serving for many years on
> were the prime movers in the construction of         the National Spiritual Assembly of the South
> their tribe's first church, in the late 1950s and    West Pacific Ocean. Other close relatives
> early 1960s. They were never to set foot in it.      whom she had taught served on the Local
> While they were in the capital, Noumea, work-        Spiritual Assembly of Mare, the first alling to pay for furnishings for the newly-built       Melanesian Local Assembly. Emma raised her
> church , they came into contact with Margaret        nine children in the spirit of the Faith with the
> Rowling, the dedicated spiritual mother of the       Baha'i principles and laws and all are active in
> New Caledonian community. Miss Rowling               its service. It was a special joy for her to have
> had just begun a study of French and the             her oldest son elected to the National Spiritual
> Wayeneces did not know English; nevertheless         Assembly of the South West Pacific Ocean just
> they investigated independently the few Writ-        before her passing. Emma made many teachings that were available in French at that           ing trips to goal areas all over the main island,
> period. They were quickly convinced of the           as well as frequent tours of the Loyalty Islands,
> truth of Baha'u'llah's mission and declared          especially Mare. She made two trips to Baha'i
> their belief on 8 July 1961. Thus their clan was     functions in the New Hebrides and was a
> again honoured, this time as being the first to      member of the New Caledonian delegation
> accept God's Universal Manifestation, through        which attended the Oceanic Conference in
> the Wayeneces.                                       Suva, Fiji in 1971. She and Georges pioneered
> From the moment of her acceptance of the          to Yahoue, a suburb of Noumea, and helped
> Faith, Emma actively served. She was elected         form the first Local Spiritual Assembly there.
> to the first Local Spiritual Assembly of                Emma was truly one of those candles which
> Noumea, in 1962, and persuasively presented          'Abdu'l-Baha so vividly described as weeping
> the Cause to her family, relatives, fellow           its life away, 'drop by drop in order to give
> Mareans, and all those with whom she came            forth its flame of Iight.' 2 In spite of frail health
> Tablet dated 11April1916.                        'An Early Pilgrimage, May Maxwell, p. 42 .
> 416                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> she laboured tirelessly for her family and the
> Faith. Although visibly worn by the care and
> struggle to educate her large family , which
> often included nieces, nephews and other relatives in addition to her own children , she
> always mustered energy to teach the Faith with
> enthusiasm, and warmly received a neverending stream of Baha'i guests and other visitors. For the reception of guests from overseas
> she always offered as a gesture of friendship
> and love a delicious earth-baked local dish,
> bougna , which demands great effort in preparation. None could fail to be touched by the
> way she gave of herself. Her heartfelt wish was
> to go on pilgrimage to the Holy Land and she
> was to have done so with Georges in 1977, but
> on 1 August 1976, in her forty-ninth year, she
> passed away as a result of a lung disease which
> had long troubled her and caused great suffering.
> The Universal House of Justice cabled this tribute.:
> SADDENED NEWS PASSING EMMA WAYENECE
> FIRST   MELANESIAN   WOMAN     BELIEVER   NEW                    Gulbanu Safrang
> CALEDONIA LOYALTIES ASSURE FAMILY FRIENDS
> LOVING PRAYERS HOLY SHRINES PROGRESS HER
> his acceptance of the Baha'i Faith. Gulbanu,
> SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> too, soon recognized Baha'u'llah as the prom-
> JOHN AND SIMONE KENDALL
> ised Shah Bahram of the ancient Zoroastrian
> religion.
> In 1946, under one of the teaching plans of
> the National Spiritual Assembly of India, Mr.
> a nd Mrs. Safrang settled in Wai, a small rural
> GULBANO SAFRANG                          community in the interior approximately
> 1904-1976                            twelve kilometres from Panchgani, and here
> they remained as staunch pioneers until the
> Dispossessed in all save God                    end of their lives. They soon won acceptance
> The pioneers endure                             by the Hindu, Christian and Muslim residents
> To gain the wealth another world                of Wai by being living examples of the teach-
> Shall lavish on the pure.                       ings of Baha'u'llah. At first they maintained
> James West              themselves by managing a restaurant. After
> her husband became ill , Gulbanu eked out a
> Mrs. Gulbanu Safrang ascended to the Abha           meagre living by accepting lodgers and by the
> Paradise on 20 September 1976. Her mortal           sale of sweets and bread to the townspeople.
> remains were laid to rest alongside those of her    Although they had no children of their own
> husband, Khud adad, in the community of Wai,        they raised a niece, Ffruzih Yiganigf, who was
> Maharashtra, India to which they had                na med a Knight of Baha'u'llah for her pioneerpioneered.                                          ing services in Goa.
> Gulbanu was born in Yazd, fran in 1904. She         After the death of her husband in 1961 Gulmoved to Bombay with her Zoroastrian family         banu, who was affectionately known as 'Goland at a young age married Khudadad Safrang,        bai' , was encouraged to move to a more comalso a Zoroastrian . Through contact with the       fortable and less isolated area but she adamstrong Baha'i community which existed from          antly refused saying that it was her wish to
> the early years in Bombay Khudadad declared         continue her service in her pioneering post
> IN MEMORIAM                                             417
> and to be buried alongside her husband when
> the time came. Through her simplicity of manner and sincerity of heart she attracted many
> people to the Faith. Her home was a centre of
> warm fellowship and friendly discussion where
> gathered the rich and poor, literate and
> unlearned, Hindu and Muslim and Christian.
> All were welcomed and found in her a friend.
> She befriended the local priest and some of the
> staff of the mission hospital in Wai and was ever
> ready to help those who came to the hospital by
> offering them accommodation at no cost and
> by visiting and praying for the patients. Her life
> was dedicated to the Cause of Baha'u'llah. In
> addition to serving in her own community she
> would support activities in Panchgani and
> assist the newly-formed New Era School
> through contributions from her limited
> income. Through her unstinting efforts the
> Baha'i community of Wai began to flourish and
> the Local Spiritual Assembly was formed. The
> Assembly was registered in 1975, just one year
> before her death, a crowning tribute to her                     Angela Annette Anderson
> dedicated life's work .
> A memorial meeting was held in Wai to
> mark her passing attended by many people of          Angela Anderson was born into a wealthy famvarious religious persuasions who offered            ily , with servants and ' nannies', and led a shelprayers for the spiritual progress of her soul.      tered life during childhood. In her late teens
> The love and unity which was demonstrated by         she experienced the first glimmering of the
> the diverse participants epitomized the teach-       possibility that life could be regarded from
> ings of Baha' u'llah which Gulbanu had in life so    points of view quite different from those she
> clearly exemplified.                                 had acquired in her cultured world of material
> On 25 September 1976 the following cable          comfort. When she entered the business world
> was received from the Universal House of Jus-        at eighteen she began to meet people from
> tice:                                                other social backgrounds. She was later to
> SADDENED PASSING STEADFAST COURAGEOUS              write in her book The Valley of Search that
> PIONEER GOLBANU SAFRANG STOP HER EXEMP-            'there was something in me that yearned for
> LARY    DEVOTION     PERSEVERANCE     SERVICES     ordinariness.'
> CAUSE WORTHY HIGH PRAISE ASSURE RELATIVES             In her twenties she was confined to bed with
> FRIENDS ARDENT PRAYERS HOLY SHRINES.               a grave illness for four years during which she
> had time to read and think. She examined her
> SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY OF THE
> life and began her quest for the meaning of
> BAHA'fs OF PA N CHGANI
> existence. Hers was a long and difficult search.
> After investigating many religious movements,
> philosophies and value systems she found her
> ANGELA ANNETTE ANDERSON                          spiritual home in the Baha'i Faith in 1959, in
> 1926-1976                                Edinburgh , and in it found complete fulfilment . Although reserved and quiet by
> DEEPLY GRIEVED PASSING ANGELA ANDERSON             nature she at once made every effort to give the
> DEDICATED PIONE E R AFRICA ASSURE PRAYERS          message of Baha'u'llah to her friends and
> PROGRESS HER SOUL EXTEND SYMPATHY FAMILY           associates. She pioneered from Edinburgh to
> FRIENDS.                                           Inverness and served on the first Local
> Universal House of Justice      Spiritual Assembly of the latter at Ric;lvan
> 418                                     THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> 1961. While there she wrote the greater part of       needs of the youth there.
> her book describing the search that led her to           After a few months, however, her health
> the Baha'i Faith. The book was, she felt , her        began to deteriorate. Although she had to stop
> 'child', in one sense, and she hoped it would         earning her living , she concealed knowledge of
> assist others who were in spiritual need.             her illness and continued tire lessly serving the
> Later she moved to Bolton and in the late          Cause for another year, devoting her time to
> 1960s pioneered to Plymouth, Devon where              committee work, teaching projects and the
> she worked unceasingly to lay the foundations         work of the Auxiliary Board. Early in 1976 she
> for the future growth of the Faith in the west of     accepted the fact that she could not go on and
> England. Once, overcoming her shyness, she            was admitted to hospital. A month later she
> spoke about the Faith from the pulpit of the          was flown to hospital in England. She was
> Unitarian Church.                                     greatly missed by all her friends in Africa who
> In her private life she tried to live by the       were much in her thoughts. She wrote offering
> Baha'i teachings in absolute detail. Although         suggestions for the Intern ational Teaching
> she had private means she always earned her           Conference to be held in Nairobi in October
> living by office work. She lived very simply , as     1976 and made pla ns to return as a pioneer to
> far as her health would allow. She wanted to be       Tanzania. This was not to be. Some months
> responsible for the education of a Baha'i child       later it was recognized that she was suffering
> and arranged to pay the tuition fees of a small       from a brain tumour. By then her life had
> girl. The child benefited from this early train-      become a burden and a veiled existence. She
> ing; she was awarded scholarships and success-        was released from her suffering on 1 October,
> fully completed a college course .                    just days before the Nairobi conference.
> Another phase of Angela's life began when             In Kenya it was said 'Tears are falling from
> she arrived in Kenya in 1971 as a pioneer . She       the eyes of those Baha'ls who have heard this
> threw herself wholeheartedly into the life of         news.' 'She served our beloved Faith diligently
> the Baha'i community in this new field of ser-        and well as a pioneer', wrot~ the National
> vice, serving as secretary of the National            Assembly of Kenya.
> Teaching Committee and the National Litera-              The memorial stone marking Angela
> ture Committee and as assistant to a member           Anderson's resting place in the Dorking Muof the Auxiliary Board. She undertook many            nicipal Cemetery, Surrey is inscribed with these
> travelling teaching trips and wherever she went       Words of Baha'u'llah:
> was deeply loved by the African believers. She
> 0 Son of Man! Ascend unto My hea ven,
> carried out all her duties with a loving spirit and
> that thou mayest obtain the joy of reunion,
> great humility. For many years she had
> and from the chalice of imperishable glory
> believed that nothing had any significance
> quaff the peerless wine.
> except that which was done from the motive of
> BARBARA LEWIS
> love. She gave steadfast and untiring service,
> inspiring a fellow pioneer to say of her, 'Her
> life in the service of the Cause is an example
> worthy of emulation.' She visited Tanzania as a
> travelling teacher; studied Swahili to help in                    ADELAIDE SHARP
> teaching and correspondence and in the hope                          1896-1976
> of preparing simple Baha'i pamphlets; and
> wrote a small book about the Faith for transla-       Born in Texas in 1896, Miss Adelaide Sharp
> tion into the vernacular languages. In Africa,        spent her childhood in Mexico, moved in com-
> Angela led a life of extreme simplicity and          pany of her mother to California to pursue her
> great personal economy, although she had no           studies, and after graduation from college took
> need to. She taught secretarial subjects in a bus-   up teaching work in the Italian quarter of San
> iness college and, when she pioneered to              Francisco. Her father, Horace M. Sharp, who
> Luanda in south-western Kenya, she started           died during Adelaide's infancy, was a Christian
> her own school, overcoming many difficulties         but Adelaide, when still young, received the
> to do so. Because many Baha'ls live in this          Message of Baha'u'llah from her mother, Clara
> area, Angela hoped to serve the educational          Sharp-a devoted Baha'i-and accepted it.
> IN MEMORIAM                                            419
> In 1929, when the distinguished Baha'i, Dr.
> Susan I. Moody, 1 who was then seventy-seven
> years of age, undertook to emigrate to Persia a
> second time at the Guardian 's request, she
> received his permission and hearty approval to
> take Adelaide along with her to serve at the
> Tarblyat School in the capital.
> The two pioneers covered the first stretch of
> their journey by ship to the Holy Land where
> the glory of pilgrimage to the Holy Shrines for
> twelve precious days was heightened by the
> guidance and spiritual strength received from
> the beloved Guardian, a bounty that would be
> their mainstay during the long and difficult
> years ahead. Proceeding thence by the overland route to Tihran, Miss Sharp settled in her
> post as the school's principal on arrival and
> discharged her duties with exemplary diligence
> until the school was closed down. RliQanglz
> FatQ-'A~am 2 and I§.braqlyyih DhablQ 3 collaborated with her in this arduous task and were
> her unfailing support throughout this period .
> After some two years' stay in Tihran, Miss                                   A de/aide Sharp
> Sharp asked the Guardian if she might invite
> her mother over, too. Shoghi Effendi assented
> readily and graciously cabled instructions to                translation of Baha'i Scriptures into English.
> America for Mrs. Sharp's travel to Tihran, and                  On the occasion of her second visit to the
> so it was that Clara Sharp found herself work-               Holy Land in 1937, Miss Sharp was again the
> ing in the cradle of the Faith beside her daugh-             recipient of the loving kindness of the Guardter in the field of Baha'i education.                        ian . In 1954 when he ruled that women could
> When the school was closed down , Miss                    from then on serve on Baha'i administrative
> Sharp stayed on in Persia on the Guardian's                  bodies in Persia, she was the first woman to be
> advice and gradually organized classes for boys              elected to the National Spiritual Assembly,
> as well as girls to study writings in English such           serving in this role for fourteen years. Almost
> as Baha'i Administration, The Promised Day is                to the last she acted as foreign correspondent
> Come, The World Order of Baha'u'llah and                     of the National Assembly and was also
> other superb works from the Guardian's                       assigned the responsibility of issuing credeninspired pen. Many young Baha'ls from these                  tials to Persian Baha'ls who were going abroad.
> classes have since risen to eminence in service              She attended the Intercontinental Conference
> to God's Faith within and without Persia's bor-              in the United States (it was during this period
> ders.                                                        that her mother passed away), the World Con-
> Supervising and teaching at the Tarblyat                  gress held in London during Ri<;lvan of 1963 to
> School were not the sole outlets for Miss                    celebrate the Most Great Jubilee and partici-
> Sharp's unflagging energy. At one time or                    pated in the election in the Holy Land of the
> another she was active on various committees                 Universal House of Justice at both the first and
> including the international committee which                  second International Conventions.
> gathered material for The Baha'i World vol-                     Miss Sharp never married. Starting at an
> umes, the Children's Service Committee, the                  early age and extending almost to the very end,
> Reviewing Committee , Unity of the East and                  her talents and energy were dedicated to the
> the West and the committee charged with the                  service of the Cause and its servants in the land
> of its birth. This single-minded devotion won
> See ' In Memoriam', The Baha'( World, vol. VI, p. 483.
> ' See ' In Memoriam', p. 467.                                her warm tributes both from the beloved
> ' See ' In Memoriam', The Bahti'fWorld, vol. XVI , p. 517.   Guardian and the Universal House of Justice.
> 420                                      THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> She was the object of special favour at the            the magazine Ahang-i-Badf' carried articles
> hands of Shoghi Effendi. In hi s missives to her       written by some of her closest friends bearing
> the Guardian addressed her as his 'dear co-            upon incide nts in her unbroken record of serworker' and enjoined the Persian National              vice which disclosed intimate glimpses of her
> Spiritual Assembly to take the greatest care of        sterling worth .
> her.                                                      If asked to single out one or two distinctive
> Her physical strength and powers deterio-            traits from among the many characteristics that
> rated sadly during the last two or three years of      endeared Miss Sharp to her numerous friends,
> her life when she was confined to bed by vari-         we would point to her unflinching loyalty and
> ous ail ments from which death released her on         deep attachment to our beloved Guardian
> 5 October 1976. When informed of her passing,          which provided the strength and solace with
> the Universal House of Justice, in a message to        which she met the tests and difficulties attenthe Persian National Assembly, recognized her          dant upon her service. May Baha'u'llah's blesslong and laborio us services in these gracious         ings be showered upon her in rich abundance!
> terms:
> (Adapted from a report prepared by the
> DEEPLY GRIEVED PASSING DEDICATED STEAD-              National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of
> FAST    PROMOTER    CAUSE     DEARLY         LOVED   Persia and translated by Rustom Sabit).
> ADELA1DE SHARP WHOSE SELFLESS LABOURS
> NEARLY FIVE DECADES COMMUNITY CRADLE
> FAITH IN EDUCATING ITS CH ILDREN INSPIRING
> ENRICHING     SPIRITUAL     LIFE     ITS     YOUTH
> ANGUEL MARIA SALAZAR
> RESEARCHING    TRANSLATING        WRITINGS    CON-
> ?- 1976
> SOLIDATING ITS ADMIN ISTRATIVE INSTITUTIONS
> AND AS FIRST WOMAN MEMBER ITS NATIONAL
> Anguel Maria Salazar, a Quechua Indian of
> SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY WILL ALWAYS BE LOV-
> Tunibamba, Canton Cotacachi, in the Province
> INGLY REMEMBERED STOP HER DEVOTED SER-
> of Imbabura, Ecuador accepted the Baha'i
> VICES WON HER PRAISE BELOVED GUARDIAN
> Faith in 1967 through the teaching efforts of
> REINFORCED TIES BINDING AMERICAN BAHAI
> Raul Pavon and Rufino Gualavisi. Mr. Salazar
> COMMUNITY TO FRIENDS BAHAULLAHS NATIVE
> became a very dedicated and firm follower of
> LAND STOP FERVENTLY PRAYING HOLY SHRINES
> Baha ' u'llah and although illiterate he learned
> CONTINUOUS PROGRESS HER SOUL ABHA KING-
> the Baha'i prayers, teachings and songs by
> DOM STOP ADVISE HOLD BEFITTING MEMORIAL
> heart. On the first visit of the Hand of the
> GATHERINGS     HONOUR       HER     NAME      STOP
> Cause Amatu'l-Baha Rul)iyyih Khanum to
> NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY UNITED STATES
> Ecuador in the spring of 1968, Mr. Salazar had
> HOLDING MEMORIAL GATHERING MASHRIQUL
> the honour of receiving this distinguished guest
> ADHKAR.
> and the members of her party in his humble
> The International Teaching Centre, too, as          home and subsequently he accompanied her
> well as the American National Spiritual                party when she visited Baha'is in other Indian
> Assembly cabled messages expressing their              communities.
> grief at Miss Sharp's passing and their appreci-          With his family, Mr. Salazar steadfastly
> ation of the spirit of selfless devotion that had      attended meetings at the National Teaching
> marked her work for the Cause in Baha'u'llah's         Institute to deepen in the knowledge of the
> native land for a period of almost half a cen-         Faith. He was a potter by profession and in
> tury. Hundreds of sorrowful mourners from              spite of his frugal circumstances each time he
> among the Baha'is ofTihran paid their respects         attended the Institute he brought an object he
> at the last resting-place of their Baha'i sister;      had made as a contribution to the fund . In 1968
> and hundreds of other believers throughout the         he was elected as a delegate to the National
> country attended memorial meetings held in             Convention and, throughout his Baha'i life,
> her memory, demonstrating by this act the              assisted the work of the Local Spiritual
> great love and esteem with which they                  Assembly in his community, constantly opened
> regarded her. An account of her life was pub-          his home for Baha'i meetings and offered hoslished in the Baha'i news organ of Persia, while       pitality to travelling teachers.
> IN MEMORIAM                                                      421
> His father died in 1923 . His mother, Sarah , 1
> a non-conformist free thinker and a member of
> the Higher Thought Temple , had learned of
> 'Abdu' l- Baha's visit to London in 1911 and,
> attracted by what she read of His life and teachings, sent for literature about the Baha'i Fiath.
> When the Hands of the Cause Clara and Hyde
> Dunn visited New Zealand in 1923 they were
> invited to the Blundell home in Remuera,
> Auckland. This was the first Baha'i meeting in
> New Zealand.
> Through contact with Mother Dunn, Mrs.
> Blundell and Hugh' s older sister, Ethel ,
> became Baha'is . In 1925 Hugh accompanied
> them in the first party of Australasians to go on
> pilgrimage to the Holy Land. Although not a
> Baha'i, Hugh was deeply impressed by Shoghi
> Effendi and in July the following year he
> declared his belief in Baha'u'llah as the Manifestation of God for this age. Thus began a
> lifetime of devoted service to the Baha'i Cause.
> He served on the Local Spiritual Assembly of
> Auckland from 1927 onwards, often as treas-
> Anguel Marfa Salazar
> urer, and for a number of years was a member
> of the National Spiritual Assembly of Austra lia
> and New Zealand. He was a member of
> Until his passing on 15 October 1976, Mr.       numerous committees, both national and re-
> Salazar remained firm of faith, radiant of heart   gional, and travelled widely throughout New
> and deep in his love for Baha'u'llah , transmit-   Zealand and the Pacific Islands in service to the
> ting his conviction with force and eloquence to    Faith.
> other indigenous believers.                           New Zealand's first independent National
> NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY       Assembly was elected in April 1957 and in
> OF TH E BAHA'fs OF ECUADOR        October a letter came to Hugh from the Hands
> of the Cause Mother Dunn and Collis Featherstone confirming the cable Hugh had received:
> ADVISE YOUR APPOINTMENT MEMBER ADDITIONAL
> AUXILIARY BOARD DEAREST LOVE PRAYERS YOUR
> HUGH K. BLUNDELL                        GUIDANCE. Hugh was overwhelmed and
> 1884-1976                        replied: 'The latter part of yo ur cable is tremendous consolation and a brilliant light in a
> DEEPLY GRIEVED LEARN PASSING DEVOTED             very dark world. With sincerest appreciation of
> LONGTIME SERVANT FAITH HUGH BLUNDELL             your faith and trust in my humble ability and
> FIRST AUXILIARY BOARD MEMBER IN NEW ZEA-         with a prayer from my heart that I will be
> LAND PRAYING SACRED THRESHOLD PROGR ESS          worthy of your confidence .. .' He wrote this
> HIS SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.                           the day the beloved Guardian died, and being
> Universal House of Justice      both a member of the Auxiliary Board and one
> of the few New Zealand Baha'is to have met
> Hugh Blundell was born in England on 21            Shoghi Effendi , he was able to be a tower of
> October 1884, the youngest of seven children.      strength to the saddened community, and to
> The Blundell family immigrated to New Zea-         inspire them to fulfil the goals of the Ten Year
> land when Hugh was two years old, and he           Crusade.
> received all his education in New Zealand             He served as a Board member with selfless
> schools.                                           1
> See 'In Memoriam', The Bahli'f World, vol. VJ, p. 496.
> 422                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> GARRET AH. BUSEY
> 1893-1976
> 
> GRIEVED PASSING GARRETA BUSEY SELFSACRI-
> FICING FOLLOWER BAHAULLAH STOP HER SER-
> VICES   FIELD   BAHAI   PUBLICATIONS   IN   THE
> UNITED STATES LOVINGLY REMEMBERED PRAY-
> ING HOLY SHR INES PROGRESS HER SOUL.
> Universal House of Justice
> 
> Garreta Helen Busey was born on 1 March
> 1893 in Urbana, Illinois and lived most of her
> life in that community. She was talented and
> versatile, yet unassuming. Before 1918 s.he
> travelled through Illinois making advance preparations for rallies and meetings supporting
> Women's Suffrage and during the First World
> War served with the International Red Cross in
> France and Switzerland. She worked for several years on the New York Herald-Tribune's
> Book Review section. Her novel The Windbreak was published in 1938. Her father
> Hugh K. Blundell                     helped establish the Commercial Bank of
> Champaign and she was on its Board of Directors for thirty-five years, attending meetings
> tenacity for eleven years. In his quiet, polite,    until just a month before her death, and was on
> gentleman ly way 'Uncle Hugh', as he became         the faculty of the University of Illinois.
> known, gave of his time, effort and self gener-        Her Baha'i activities were manifold. She first
> ously. He travelled regularly throughout the        attended Baha'i meetings because she felt
> country visiting and encouraging the friends. In    sorry for her mother who was always having to
> 1959 the Hands of the Cause in the Holy Land        go to them alone, but gradually came to conwrote: 'Please convey to our dear brother,          sider herself a Baha'i, and about 1934 she fully
> Auxiliary Board member Hugh Blundell, our           identified herself with the Faith. During her
> heartfelt appreciation of the wonderful teach-      sabbatical leaves from the university she
> ing trips he is undertaking in these days when      served the European Teaching Committee,
> the New Zealand community needs it most.'           spending one year in the Netherlands. She was
> He extended hospitality to all visiting Baha'is     a member of the Urbana Spiritual Assembly
> and accompanied the Hands of the Cause on           for forty years; her contributions to consultamany of their visits including the historic visit   tion were wise, compassionate and practical.
> Enoch Olinga made to the Maori people in            At the request of the National Spiritual
> 1959.                                               Assembly she helped with the development of
> As age began to take its toll, Hugh found it     Spiritual Assemblies in Indiana, Kentucky and
> increasingly difficult to travel and in Sep-        Ohio . Her writing and editorial skills were
> tember 1968 he offered his resignation as Aux-      placed at the service of the Faith. She served on
> iliary Board member. He felt the future of the      the editorial staffs of World Order magazine,
> Faith lay in the hands of the young Baha'is and     Bahli'( News and The Baha'i World and on the
> he continued to guide and love these youth          National Literature Reviewing Committee.
> until his death on 16 October 1976.                 Her beautiful old home was opened to the
> His warm, gentlemanly presence at summer         friends and was a focal point of activities for
> schools and conventions will be a cherished         many years. With the consent of her family it
> memory to those of the New Zealand commu-           was bequeathed to the Spiritual Assembly of
> nity who were fortunate enough to have known        Urbana.
> Hugh Blundell.                                         From 1936 until 197 4 Garre ta was the
> IN MEMORIAM                                            423
> 
> October 1976. All those who gathered to celebrate her life felt them to be appropriate.
> ELEANOR HUTCHENS
> 
> CHARLOTIE M. LINFOOT
> 1895-1976
> 
> Charlotte May Linfoot, a leading figure in the
> growth and development of the Baha'i Faith in
> the United States for almost half a century,
> died on 30 October 1976 in Wilmette. The
> National Spiritual Assembly of the United
> States cabled the Universal House of Justice:
> LOYAL    DUTIFUL INDEFATIGABLE CHARLOTTE
> LINFOOT WINGED HER FLIGHT TO ABHA REALM
> TODAY    LEAVING   BEHIND   IN    HER   BELOVED
> AMER ICAN COMMUNITY WHICH SHE SERVED SO
> ILLUSTRIOUSLY A TRAIL OF GRATEFUL           BUT
> BROKEN HEARTS.
> Garreta H. Busey
> In reply the House of Justice advised the
> holding of a befitting memorial service in the
> Temple and said, in part:
> faculty advisor of the University of Illinois
> SHARE GRIEF PASSING DEARLY LOVED CHAR-
> Baha'i Club , one of the first college clubs in the
> LOTTE LINFOOT STOP HER TIRELESS SELFLESS
> United States. She had special love for youth
> SERVICE WHOLEHEARTED COMMITMENT TEACH-
> and offered them understanding and encour-
> INGS   AND   ADMINISTRATION      OF CAUSE SHE
> agement. One Baha'i, recollecting the college
> EMBRACED NEARLY FIFTY YEARS AGO INDELIBLY
> club meetings, wrote: 'I felt that Garreta saw
> INSCRIBED ANNALS AMERICAN BAHAI COMMU-
> everything-all our weaknesses, follies, even
> NITY . . .
> our unwillingness to accept aspects of the
> teachings- but she was patient and would wait            For twenty-two years, until she suffered a
> lovingly for us to grow up. Hundreds of times at      disabling stroke in December 197 5, Miss Linthose Friday evening firesides I saw her sit          foot served as assistant secretary of the
> quietly as we uttered our vain fancies-even           National Spiritual Assembly. The assembly, in
> our blasphemies-never arguing, never push-            its annual report for 1976, paid tribute to her
> ing a point. When we'd all worn ourselves out         'constant, heroic service' and lamented the
> with hair-splitting, she'd say, "Well, you know,      'staggering blow' dealt the American communit seems to me .. ." and then she'd quote             ity through her death.
> exactly the passage to answer every dilemma!             She was born in North Dakota on 30 May
> She was truly a masterful teacher. '                  1895, attended high school in Saskatchewan,
> Once when she was in her eighties and, as          Canada and received degrees from Saskatoon
> usual, trying to serve beyond her strength in         Teachers' College and Saskatoon Business
> many areas at once, she laughingly said,              College . After graduation she taught elemen-
> 'Baha'fs are not promised rest from their             tary school and during summer vacations
> labours, but a service in both worlds.'               worked as a reporter and as editor of the
> Baha'u'llah's words 'The light of a good           women's section of a local newspaper.
> character surpasses the light of the sun' were on        In the early 1930s Miss Linfoot moved to
> the printed programme of the memorial ser-            California to work for the American Red
> vice held for Miss Busey who died on 21               Cross, soon becoming assistant director of the
> 424                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Her appointment as assistant secretary
> almost immediately after her election to the
> National Assembly caused her to transfer her
> residence from Piedmont, California to Wilmette. She served as secretary of the Asia
> Teaching Committee in the Ten Year Crusade
> until the American community's goals in the
> Pacific areas were accomplished, in about
> 1961; simultaneously she worked on the
> editorial committees for Baha'{ News and The
> Bahti'( World. In 1961 she participated in the
> election of the International Baha'i Council
> and in the first election of the Universal House
> of Justice in Haifa at Ric;lvan 1963 and
> attended the Baha'i World Congress in London immediately thereafter; she also participated in the subseq uent elections of the Universal House of Justice in 1968 and 1973. On
> various occasions she represented the United
> States·National Spiritual Assembly at international conferences.
> 'She had a quick and telling wit and a never-
> Charlotte M. Linfoot                    failing sense of fun,' one friend recalls. 'A few
> years before I came to Wilmette in 1969 she
> Junior Red Cross for the Pacific area. Her main       had fallen on the ice one dark night and susactivity was the developing of international          tained an injury to her hip which left her with
> programmes with school systems. During this           the occasional need to use a cane for the rest of
> period she also travelled extensively in Europe       her life. I remember with affection her curious
> to advise Red Cross Societies on that conti-          blend of gallantry, determination and vulneranent.                                                 bility as she tapped her way from the office to
> Miss Lin foot first heard of the Baha'i Faith in   her home in treacherous and inclement
> Oakland, California and soon became active in         weather. She took great delight in collecting
> the work of the administrative order. She was         music rolls for an old playe r piano she had in
> appointed to the first Nation al Teaching             her home; she also kept pet birds on which she
> Committee in 1934, serving as its Western sec-        lavished attention. I shall always remember the
> retary, and throughout the subsequent years           day we spent in the country buying a barrel of
> was a member of one or more natio nal commit-         new apples; she brought a sense of adventure
> tees. Those who were privileged to work with          and zest and happiness to simple pleasures of
> her during those years speak with admiration          this kind. She was always youthfully trim,
> of her undaunted fa ith, unswerving loyalty,          impeccably groomed and sma rtly attired, her
> selfless devotion and tireless vigour, and praise     appearance thus reflecting her alertness of
> the inestimable magnitude of her gifts of mind        mind, her imposing organizationa l skills.'
> a nd spirit which she poured out unstintingly in         Miss Linfoot's demanding services as assisservice to the Cause of Baha' u'llah. The Hand        tant secretary to the National Assembly
> of the Cause Leroy Ioas wrote to her from the         included the guidance of Local Assemblies and
> Holy Land congratulating her on her election          individuals in their application of Baha'i stanto the National Assembly in the autumn of             dards to individual lives. Each day her desk was
> 1953 a nd remarking: 'Your long hours of work         piled high with letters appealing to the
> in the Teaching Committee, and other Com-             National Assembly for guidance in a limitless
> mittees, was always an example to me, and I           range of human struggles and needs. The baloften think, when I am tied up for especially         ance of integrity, firmness and deep compaslong hours of work, how faithfully , quietly and      sion which she exemplified qualified her to
> efficiently you carried on for so long.'              become a finely-tuned instrument through
> IN MEMORIAM                                          425
> which the Assembly could effectively respond
> to the needs of the community. But such work
> takes its toll of those who give it. Her record of
> service is a n illustration of the degree of
> 'administrative heroism' which the beloved
> Guardian told us the advancement of the
> Cause requires.
> Shoghi Effendi's appreciation of Miss Linfoot is found in a letter written on his behalf on
> 6 September 1957 and serves as a befitting
> conclusion to this memoir: 'The Guardian has
> instructed me to inform you of how much he
> appreciates and values your devoted and
> sacrificial services to the Cause of God. You
> have served the Faith diligently, efficiently,
> and well over a long period of time, in outstanding and historic fields of service: as secretary of the National Teaching Committee
> during the first Seven Year Plan , the success of
> which was, in no small measure, due to your
> ceaseless labours, and since that time, on teaching committees bringing the Faith to numerous
> parts of the world. Now you are combining                      Siyyid Muf:iammad 'Azzav{
> teaching and administrative service, in your
> outstanding services on the National Assembly . The Master will richly reward you for your     obtained his Master of Arts degree from the
> indefatigable services in the Kingdom .'             University of Cairo. Religious prejudice
> On 11 December 1976 a memorial service            thwarted his efforts to obtain the degree of
> was held for Charlotte Linfoot in the House of       Doctor of Philosophy but he qualified for this
> Worship in Wilmette within the shadow of             with distinction in 1969.
> which she had performed many of those feats             His professional pursuits after his return
> which cause her memory to be 'indelibly              from 'Iraq included serving as Director of the
> inscribed' in the annals of the American Baha'i      Office of Translation of the Vice-President of
> community.                                           the Republic, acting as assistant to the
> Director-General for Statistics, assisting the
> ministry concerned with the management of
> municipal affairs and serving as Director-
> SIYYID MUl;IAMMAD 'AZZA Vf                      General of the Centre of Information for the
> 1920-1976                              Presidency. He contributed to the modernization of the curriculum of the thousand-year-old
> The entire Baha'i world , but the Egyptian           Al-Azhar University and was co-author with
> community in particular, suffered a grievous         MuJ:iammad Khayrf Harb of History of Educaloss in the untimely passing of Dr. Siyyid           tion and Teaching in the Twentieth Century. He
> MuJ:iammad 'Azzavf. His endeavours as an             was a gifted translator from English into
> educator bring to mind the words attributed to       Arabic of literary and educational works,
> MuJ:iammad, the Messenger: 'The ink of the           combining extraordinary speed with great
> scholar is more precious than the blood of the       accuracy . His efforts in this area included the
> martyr.'                                             translation of documents for UNESCO and
> Dr. ' Azzavi was born in Egypt on 1 April         association with the Franklin Library project
> 1920 and received his education there. From          for rendering a thousand standard English
> 1942 to 1950 he was a teacher of education and       works in Arabic. Methods of language teaching
> psychology at the Men 's Teacher Training Col-       interested him greatly. He prepared television
> lege in 'Iraq. He returned to Egypt in 1950 and      programmes designed to combat illiteracy,
> 426                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> experimented in teaching Arabic to African          a keen sense of humour and a· gift for storystudents a nd to persons of widely-ranging          telling. He showered love and devotion on his
> ethnic backgrounds and participated in writing      five beautiful children-ornaments of a
> a series of textbooks on teaching Arabic by         remarkable marriage- a nd with affection and
> radio. He was delegated to present modern           expertise guided their education, an activity
> methods of teaching Persian at the College of       promoted by his own exemplary zeal for learn-
> Arts at 'Ayn Shams University. The prepara-         ing. Animated by a spirit of self-sacrifice for the
> tion of a children's encyclopedia appealed to       Faith he suffered discrimina tion in terms of
> him in his dual role of father and educator.        position, salary and promotion, and ultimately
> Dr. 'Azzavl encountered the Baha'i Faith         was incarcerated for his beliefs. His Egyptian
> while living in ' Iraq when he approached Miss      roots made it imperative for him to remain in
> Bahia (Baha'iyyih) Faraju'Uah, a fellow             his native land rather than to seek an easier and
> teacher of Iranian background, to enquire           more luxurious life in countries of greater freewhether she would teach him Persian. His            dom and prosperity. One midnight, in 1965,
> interest was immediately aroused and the            there came a knock at the door of his home.
> comprehensive Baha'i library of the                 The police entered and seized every Baha'i
> Faraju 'llah family was made available to him.      book they could find, and Dr. 'Azzavl and
> He read avidly and in time accepted the Faith.      other Baha'is were cast into prison. The
> Not long after, when the Faraju'llah family         authorities interrogated him at odd hours to
> departed for the Holy Land as pilgrims, Dr.         break his rest and brought Islamic divines to
> 'Azzavl asked them to convey his love to the        dispute with him, but their arguments were
> Guardian and beg his prayers that he might one      swept away like leaves in the autumn wind.
> day be of service to the Cause . In response,          Eventually he was freed. He started a pub-
> Shoghi Effendi requested Dr. 'Azzavl to trans-      lishing house which he hoped might develop
> late into Arabic a selection of passages from       into an important instrument of service of the
> God Passes By, the Guardian's own incompa-          new world order. He revised his translation of
> rable history of the Faith. Dr. 'Azzavl set to      God Passes By, remarking that his understandwork with great enthusiasm, postponing com-         ing of the text had changed profoundly in the
> pletion of his studies for his degree in order to   course of his experience of twenty-five years as
> devote full time to this task. He also translated   a Baha'i.
> a number of other works including the Persian          In 1976, Dr. 'Azzavl accepted an invitation
> Hidden Words of Bahti'u'llah , the talks of         to lecture at the Baha'i Summer School in Iran
> 'Abdu'l-Baha in Europe, The Dispensation of         where the friends derived great benefit from
> Bahd'u'llah, The Promised Day is Come and           his knowledge of the Qur'an and Baha'i literaother letters of the Guardian. Some time later      ture. He visited the House of Baha'u'llah in
> when Dr. 'Azzavf made a pilgrimage to the           Tihran and the House where the Bab declared
> Holy Land the beloved Guardian referred to          His mission in Shiraz. This journey, so aboundhim as ' my excellent translator.'                 ing in confirmations, marked the culmination
> After serving in 'Iraq for eight years, Dr.      of a distinguished career of service to the Cause
> 'Azzavi returned to Cairo and about a year          of Baha'u'llah. Notified of Dr. 'Azzavl's death
> later married Miss I:Iuriyyah Jalal. Shortly        on 14November1976, the Universal House of
> thereafter he accepted a teaching post in the       Justice cabled:
> Sudan where he served as chairman of the
> DEEPLY GRIEVED PASSING MUHAMMAD AZZAVI
> Spiritual Assembly of Khartoum and was help-
> HIS DEDICATION CAUSE HIS STEADFASTNESS HIS
> ful in obtaining official registration of the
> SCHOLARLY WORK UNFORGETTABLE STOP FER-
> Baha'i burial ground. He then returned to
> VENTLY PRAYING SHRINES PROGRESS HIS SOUL
> Egypt where he served on the National Spiritual
> ABHA KINGDOM ASSURE HIS WIFE CHILDREN
> Assembly of North East Africa, the Local
> FRIENDS DEEP LOVING SYMPATHY.
> Spiritual Assembly of Cairo and the National
> Translation and Publication Committee until                            BAHIA FARAJU'LLAH GULICK
> 
> the dissolution of Baha'i institutions in Egypt
> in 1960.
> He was a man of commanding presence , with
> IN MEMORIAM                                         427
> 'ABDU' L-I:IAMID EL KHEMfRi
> 1906-1976
> 
> Mr. ' Abdu ' l-f:Iamid el Khemirf was born in
> Tunis during the year 1906, his family being
> members of the Berber community. He was
> raised in a strict Muslim community and his
> childhood was similar to that of others of his
> generation.
> In 1921, when he was only fifteen ,
> 'Abdu'l-f:Iamid and his friend , Mul)ammad
> Vahbf Kas ravi, encountered and accepted the
> Baha'i Faith. One afternoon, on the main
> boulevard of Tunis , the two youths noticed a
> middle-aged gentleman of respectable and distinguished appearance whom they recognized
> as being a Shaykh from the renowned Azhar
> University of Cairo and, acting on an impulse,
> the young men asked to speak to him . The
> gentleman was Mul)yf'd-Dfn Sabrf Kurdi
> Kanimeshkani who had accepted the Faith during the ea rly years of its establishment in
> Egypt, a nd whom ' Abdu'l-Baha had singled
> out to open Tunis to the Faith . The young men
> were very impressed by the wisdom and kind-
> 'Abdu'l-ljamld el Khem{ri
> ness of Shaykh Mul)yf'd-Dfn. They attended
> regularly the meetings he held with inquirers
> every evening and soon 'Abdu'l-f:Iarnid, with                  (the Medina) where he counselled and guided
> his friend Kasravi, became the first Tunisian                 them as an older and more experienced
> Baha'fs.                                                      brother would.
> In 1928 'Abdu'l-f:Iarnid made a pilgrimage                    'Abdu'l-l:farnid served on the Spiritual
> to the Holy Land and was blessed by his meet-                  Assembly of Tunis from the time of its inceping with the beloved Guardian. The experience                  tion in the 1930s until his home area became an
> of pilgrimage transformed him. He travelled to                independent civil unit in 1970. In 1956 when
> Egypt and Syria where he met with the believ-                 the beloved Guardian called for the formation
> ers and had the joy of reunion with his boyhood                of the Regional Spiritual Assembly of North
> friend , Kasravf, who had settled in Syria.                    West Africa 'Abdu'l-l:farnid el Khernirf was
> Upon returning to Tunis 'Abdu'l-l:lamfd                    elected to that body and remained a member
> joined his efforts with those of Mustapha                     for four consecutive years. He visited many
> Bouchoucha 1 (Mu~tafa Bushusha), a fellow                     Baha'i centres in Morocco in 1956 and, in later
> Tunisian Baha'i, in propagating the Faith                     years, he attended Baha'i summer schools in
> among their countrymen . 'Abdu'l-l:larnid's                   France and Switzerland to bring back to the
> shop at 175 rue de la Kasbah became a land-                    Tunisian Baha'is the spirit and news of the
> mark for visiting Baha'fs. Evening after even-                friends in Europe.
> ing, 'Abdu'l-l:larnid would         visit Mr.                    The last two years of his life he devoted to
> Bouchoucha's home for meetings with Baha'fs                   visiting the Baha'is and receiving them at his
> and their friends. With the launching of the                  home. Increasingly, severe arthritis confined
> Guardian's Ten Year Crusade in 1953 and the                   him to his bed and armchair. He sold his shop
> arrival of pioneers in Tunisia, young Tunisians               and contributed the entire proceeds to the
> started to enter the Faith. They found comfort                Fund. As he felt the end drawing near he disand inspiration through their visits to                       tributed amo ng the friends the Baha'i litera-
> 'Abdu'l-f:Iarnid's little shop in the old town                ture, magazines, reviews and articles he had in
> See 'In Memoriam', Th e Bahti'f World, vol. XV, p. 463 .   his possession . Each time we visited him we
> 428                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> were offered some literature or relics of the
> Faith. Until the last moment of his earthly existence on 5 December 1976 the greeting
> 'Allah- u-Abha!', which he upheld for over
> fifty-five years, was on his lips.
> 'The services of Mr. Khemiri will always be
> remembered for he was not only among the
> early believers in Tunisia, but served the Faith
> for one-half a century in that land with faithfulness, devotion and dedication,' wrote the
> Universal House of Justice on 9 January 1977
> in memory of that dear believer.
> R. MUSTAPHA
> 
> ELSE JORGENSEN
> 1907-1977
> 
> GRIEVED    NEWS    PASSING   ELSE   JORGENSEN
> DEVOTED MAIDSERVANT BAHAULLAH STOP SUP-
> PLICATING SACRED THRESHOLD PROGRESS HER
> SOUL ALL WORLDS GOD.                                                 Else Jorg ensen
> Universal House of Justice
> 
> Else JOrgensen was born in Trondheim, Nor-          a time when the utmost wisdom and discretion
> way on 28 December 1907. She was working as         were necessary and the risk of imprisonment
> a hairdresser in Guayaquil, Ecuador in Febru-       was considerable. She introduced the teachings
> ary 1945 when she first heard about the Baha'i      by giving language lessons and with admirable
> Faith from Virginia Orbison , a resident            foresight organized, in collaboration with the
> pioneer. The Spiritual Assembly of Guayaquil        Spiritual Assembly of Barcelona, a committee
> was to be formed at Ric.Ivan if one additional      for the protection of the Faith. Significantly, a
> adult believer could be found. Virginia             few years later, she was appointed to the Auxarranged an appointment for April 17th              iliary Board for the protection of the Faith in
> ostensibly to have Else give her a permanent        Latin America. Throughout the time she spent
> wave, and Else accepted the Faith before the        in Spain Else had no holidays, no visits to her
> end of the day. On April 20th the Spiritual         family and not one moment of rest.
> Assembly was formed with Else as a member.             In July 1953 Else returned to Norway and
> By 1948 Else had returned to Norway and at       married Roberto Cazcarra. At the Interconti-
> Ric.Ivan became a member of the first Spiritual     nental Teaching Conference held in Stockholm
> Assembly of Oslo. With a view to pioneering in      that month the couple offered themselves as
> Spain Else, who was already fluent in Spanish,      pioneers to Spitzbergen but were not able to
> took secretarial training, and in November          meet the requirements governing residence in
> 1949 she settled in Madrid where she assisted       those islands. Accompanied by Mildred Clark'
> in consolidating the efforts of the Spiritual       who in August of that year had become the
> Assembly. In April of the next year she moved       Knight of Baha'u'llah for the Lofoten Islands,
> to Barcelona to assist that struggling young        Else travelled by ship to Spitzbergen to investicommunity. With her aid the Spiritual Assem-        gate the possibility of settling there but this and
> bly grew in strength and other Local Assemb-        all subsequent efforts failed.
> lies were established in nearby areas in addi-          At the request of the European Teaching
> tion to groups being formed and new localities      Committee she remained as a pioneer in Oslo
> opened. Words cannot describe the meritori-         until November 1954 when she was asked to
> ous work done by Else for the Cause in Spain at     ' See ' In Memoriam ', The Baha'( World, vol. XIV, p. 303.
> IN MEMORIAM                                                       429
> assist with the teaching and consolidation work          Else was the first pioneer from Norway and
> in Portugal where she laboured intensively for        her saintly life won the respect of the friends
> the strengthening of the community and the            who met her. She was an example of patience
> opening of new centres. Her efforts met with          and endurance, living frugally, sharing whatsuccess despite her inability to obtain a perma-      ever she had with those who were in need. At
> nent residence visa and the mischievous               the time of her passing a devoted friend wrote
> activities of a few disaffected Baha'is who           in tribute to her services, 'Else embodied the
> attempted to undermine all that she did,              high standards of the Norwegian people and in
> threatened to denounce her to the authorities,        particular the quality of dignity. Present and
> and continually harassed her and menaced her.         future Baha'i friends in your country should be
> With the approval of Shoghi Effendi she left       proud of having a Norwegian in the galaxy of
> Portugal in October 1956 to join her husband          heroes and heroines of the Faith of Baha'u'-
> who was under contract to a Swiss firm in             llah.'
> Uruguay and within two weeks of arriving in              The mortal remains of this beloved friend
> Montevideo, and despite the intended private          were laid to rest beside those of the Knight of
> nature of her visit, Else was elected to the          Baha'u'llah Loyce Lawrence 1 in Trondheim's
> Spiritual Assembly and later was asked to             Tilfredshet cemetery.
> serve on the National Teaching Committee of                                                      GERO STRAND
> the Regional National Spiritual Assembly of
> South America. At Ric;lvan 1957 she and her
> husband were elected to the National Spiritual
> Assembly of Argentina, Chile, Uruguay, Paraguay and Bolivia . At the request of that institu-                MARION LORD MAXWELL
> tion Else undertook a five-month tour of the                            1889-1977
> five countries, visiting each Local Spiritual
> Assembly, giving public addresses, obtaining          Marion Lord Maxwell was the first Jamaican to
> radio and press interviews. She returned to           embrace the Baha'i Faith in Jamaica. Her
> Uruguay to find awaiting her a letter announc-        acceptance of the Faith, in October 1942,
> ing her appointment to the Auxiliary Board for        resulted from the teaching efforts of Dr. Malthe protection of the Faith and a pressing            colm King 2 who pioneered there in the First
> request to meet with the National Assembly            Seven Year Plan. Miss Maxwell was elected as
> for consultation. She had not even unpacked           a member of the first Spiritual Assembly of
> her bags. Thus began a lengthy series of travels      Kingston at Ric;lvan 1943 and became its first
> throughout which she did not fail to maintain         treasurer. Thereafter, she served the Cause
> an extensive correspondence frequently                faithfully, remaining steadfast in the Covenaveraging eighteen letters a day.                     ant to her last breath.
> Exhausted and ill, Else returned to Bar-              Born on 26 January 1889 in the capital,
> celona in June 1962 and the following year            Kingston, Marion was the youngest of six chilsettled again in Norway. Although her last            dren. She used her boundless energy in teachyears were blighted by an incurable illness she       ing Sunday school classes and in active service
> participated to the extent she could in Baha'i        to the Y.W.C .A. and the Shamrock Social
> community life until her soul was released from       Organization. In 1907 she joined the General
> its physical prison, in Trondheim, on 27 Janu-        Post Office staff as a money order clerk and in
> ary 1977.                                             this capacity served her community for forty-
> 'With the deepest sorrow I received the sad        two years, gaining the respect of both her felnews of the passing of our dear Else Jorgen-          low workers and the public. She retired in
> sen,' wrote the Hand of the Cause Dr. 'Ali-           1949.
> Mu~ammad Varqa to the National Spiritual                 Marion was known as 'Miss Mac' to her close
> Assembly of Norway. 'She was a wonderful              acquaintances and was a mainstay to her family
> soul, dedicating her life to the service of the       on all occasions, whether happy or sad. In 1929
> Faith of God. I pray from the bottom of my            she became the guardian of her sister's three
> heart for the progress of her brilliant soul in the   1
> See 'In Memoriam', The Baha'i World, vol. XV, p. 446 .
> Abha Kingdom .. .'                                    2
> See 'In Memoriam', The Bahli'( World, vol. XIV, p. 316.
> 430                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> EDMUND MIESSLER
> 1902-1977
> 
> 'He is in my heart.' These were the tearful,
> half-whispered words of one who knew
> Edmund Miessler well, when informed of his
> passing. Others, in tribute to his memory, dedicated a month of sacrificial teaching. Two who
> had been separated from Baha'i activity,
> remembering his influence upon their lives,
> pledged renewal of service to the Cause of
> Baha'u'llah. And in a flood of telegrams, letters and personal messages the sentiment was
> expressed: he was so dedicated , so loving and
> understanding, and so very humble .
> Edmund Miessler was born in Chicago on 13
> March 1902 and was reared in a very strict,
> religious-minded family of Lutherans, his
> father being a pastor and his mother the daughter of Lutheran missionaries. His first wife,
> Elma, came from a similar background. The
> couple keenly desired spiritual knowledge and
> Marion Lord Maxwell                     made an intensive study of the Bible. While
> living in Lima, Ohio the home community of
> Dorothy Baker, 1 they learned of the Baha'i
> children; and to her two nephews and nieces,
> Faith from her and after a year's study became
> whose parents were in Costa Rica, she became
> confirmed and devoted Baha'is. Almost
> more than an 'Aunt'.
> immediately, they were publicly excommuni-
> A Jehovah's Witness before accepting the
> cated from their church as incorrigible sinners .
> Baha'i Faith, Marion never forced her belief on
> They became active members of the Lima
> any member of her family nor on her friends,
> Baha'i community and with their three chilbut quietly attended meetings and participated
> dren, Bob, Margot and Carol, held fireside
> in Baha'i community life . She was recognized
> meetings. Elma's death in the eleventh year of
> as a dependable and giving person and it was
> her marriage left the young father and the
> through the example of her life that she was
> three children in difficult circumstances.
> known as a Baha'i. In her later years, although
> Three years later Edmund married Muriel
> handicapped by deafness, she was at the centre
> Auble who also became a fervent Baha'i. The
> of every happy gathering, regaling the guests
> family had moved to their first pioneering post
> with stories from her storehouse of memory,
> in Columbus Grove, not far from Lima, and
> often clapping her hands in spontaneous joy. In
> there they continued with their local Baha'i
> the nursing home where she spent her last
> work in addition to serving on the Louhelen
> three years, Marion was ever mindful of her
> (Davison) Baha'i Summer School Committee
> fellow patients to whom she offered assistance
> and the Regional Teaching Committee of
> and comfort. She eagerly received her Baha'i
> Ohio, Indiana and Kentucky.
> visitors, often exclaiming, 'I am so happy to be a
> Following the death of Carol in 1945 the
> Baha'i!' Baha'u'llah's name was frequently on
> family realized their long-held dream of
> her lips. She passed away peacefully in her
> pioneering abroad . With Carol as the family's
> sleep, having lived a full eighty-seven years.
> 'guardian angel', as it were, and in close consul-
> On 27January1977, the Universal House of
> tation with their intimate friend, Mrs. Dorothy
> Justice cabled:
> Baker, who was then chairman of the National
> SADDENED PASSING MARION MAXWELL CONVEY
> Appointed a Hand of the Cause by Shoghi Effendi on 24
> FRIENDS    RELATIVES    ASSURANCES     PRAYERS         December 1951. See 'In Memoriam', The Bahti'{ World,
> SHRINES PROGRESS SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.                    vol. XII, p. 670 .
> IN MEMORIAM                                               431
> ing as his responsibility, at first, several countries of South America and, at the time of his
> passing, a large region comprising several
> states of Brazil as well as the Falkland Islands.
> Edmund loved his work for the Faith and
> was devoted to his many Baha'i friends. He
> tried to visit each community in his territory at
> least once a year and more accessible areas
> oftener, and he carried on a voluminous correspondence, advising, inspiring, praising,
> admonishing-always quoting suitable passages from the Writings. Copies of his letters
> written during the period of his service on the
> Auxiliary Board fill five large file drawers. He
> did not teach from his own viewpoint but
> rather with words from the Writings which he
> recorded in a small notebook and carried with
> him, available at the moment it was needed;
> and to illustrate the points he wished to
> emphasize he would recount telling stories.
> In 1963, as a member of the National
> Spiritual Assembly of Brazil, Edmund was a
> delegate to the first International Baha'i Con-
> Edmund Miessler
> vention for the election of the Universal House
> of Justice and he lavished upon this new
> Spiritual Assembly of the United States and           divinely-ordained institution the great Jove and
> Canada, it was decided that they should settle       loyalty he had felt for the beloved Guardian. A
> in Sao Paulo, Brazil. When they arrived the          similar devotion was expended upon the
> following year following some months of pre-         institutions of the Hands of the Cause and the
> paration and a brief stay in Rio de Janeiro, their    Continental Board of Counsellors, under both
> hearts were rejoiced by the awaiting telegram         of which he had worked. Love was the touchfrom the beloved Guardian in which he stated         stone of Edmund's life. His heart was filled
> that he was praying for them at the Holy             with love for the Cause and for all humanity
> Shrines that they might realize all their earnest    and he was, in turn, much loved by the many
> desires in the Path of Baha'u'llah.                  friends he led to the Faith and others who knew
> In Sao Paulo they began to teach the Faith         him. It is felt that the beautiful thoughts expresvigorously, assisted by two young new Baha'fs        sed in the cablegram received from the Uniwho had accepted the Faith through a travel-         versal House of Justice when advised of
> ling teacher, and by a third who had accom-           Edmund's passing on 7 February 1977 aptly
> panied them from Rio de Janeiro. At Ric;lvan         describe this noble soul:
> 194 7 the first Local Spiritual Assembly of Sao
> DEEPLY GRIEVED PASSING BELOVED DEVOTED
> Paulo was formed. The community grew in size
> SERVANT     BAHAULLAH       EDMUND      MIESSLER
> and in time became one of the strongest and
> WHOSE DISTINGUISHED DEDICATED SERVICES
> most active in South America.
> SOUTH    AMERICA    SPANNING     PERIOD   THIRTY
> Edmund served constantly as a member of
> YEARS SET NOBLE EXAMPLE FOLLOWERS BLESS-
> the institutions of the growing administrative
> ED BEAUTY STOP CONVEY FAMILY OUR LOVING
> order. He was elected to the first regional
> CONDOLENCES AND ASSURE FERVENT PRAYERS
> National Spiritual Assembly of South America
> DIVINE THRESHOLD PROGRESS HIS SOUL.
> and to those assemblies which succeeded it
> MURIEL MIESSLER
> including, finally, Brazil which formed its own
> National Spiritual Assembly in 1961. In addition, he was appointed a member of the Auxiliary Board for the protection of the Faith hav-
> 432                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> ANT6NIO FRANCISCO EBO
> ?-1977
> 
> Antonio Francisco Ebo, the first Angolan
> Baha'i, was born near Malange some sixty
> years ago and was a member of the KiMbundu
> tribe which inhabit the area around the capital ,
> Luanda, and the territory stretching beyond
> Malange in the east. Angola was a Portuguese
> colony so he grew up speaking both his native
> language and Portuguese. Not much is known
> of Mr. Ebo's life as a child and young man but it
> is known that as an adult he moved to Luanda
> in order to find a better economic climate for
> his family. He was head of a large 'extended'
> family which, in African tradition, embracesin addition to brothers and sisters- cousins,
> nieces, nephews and other kin.
> In January 1956 Mr. Ebo who was a member
> of the Evangelical Church in Luanda heard
> Rodolfo Duna, a Baha'i from Moc;;ambique,
> speak to the congregation about the Baha'i
> principles at the invitation of the minister.                   Ant6nio Francisco Ebo
> Intrigued, Mr. Ebo and his nephew, Jose
> Avelino, followed Mr. Duna to the place where
> he was staying and requested to hear more           assistance of Mr. Duna and his wife, Angelica,
> about this new message. It was there that Mr.       the first Spiritual Assembly of Luanda was
> Ebo heard for the first time the name of            formed and shortly afterward a pioneer couple
> Baha'u'llah. Night after night he returned to       arrived from Portugal to help in consolidating
> hear more, each time becoming increasingly con-     the knowledge of the new believers. Mr. Ebo
> vinced that this was indeed a message from          and Mr. Duna joined Sampaia in his teaching
> God, one that he wished to share with his           efforts in Malange where a great receptivity to
> remarkable uncle, Sampaia, whose spiritual          the Faith developed. At Ric;lvan 1957, with Mr.
> quest had strongly influenced Mr. Ebo's             Eba's assistance, the first Spiritual Assembly
> nature. Sampaia, who was considered a mystic        was formed there. Mr. Ebo was appointed to
> and spiritual guide to his friends and family and   the teaching committee and yearned to pioneer
> whose wisdom, love and counsel won him great        to the south to establish the Faith in Nova
> respect, had refused to affiliate with a formal     Lisboa. In 1961, before these plans could get
> system of belief, having declared that when         under way , Angola was swept up in a maeltruth appeared he would recognize it. To this       strom of political unrest and although the Baha'is
> uncle Mr. Ebo wrote a brief explanation of the      had followed strictly Baha'u'llah's teaching
> Revelation of Baha'u'llah. In his reply, Sam-       about non-participation in all subversive and
> paia asked three simple questions about the         political movements, they too fell victims of the
> origin of the Faith, the location of its World      suspicion and chaos that engulfed the country.
> Centre and the central teaching of its Founder.     Incited by the clergy who had joined forces in
> Upon being informed that the mission of             accusing the Baha'is of subversive activity the
> Baha'u'llah is the unification of all mankind       police obtained a decree outlawing the Faith
> Sampaia wrote: 'This is the Faith that I have       and began seizing and interrogating the
> been waiting for!'                                  Baha'is. The pioneers were expelled, leaving the
> Mr. Ebo, radiantly happy over the accep-         young community on its own. The police came
> tance of the Faith by Sampaia, began vigorous       to Sampaio's home in the dead of night,
> teaching activities and enrolled most of his        arrested him, threatened his wife never to have
> family in the Faith. At Ric;lvan 1956, with the     any meetings again nor even permit anyone to
> IN MEMORIAM                                            433
> stay at her house, and took Sampaio away to an      refuge and comfort. The last pioneer left in
> unknown destination. He was never seen              October 1975 without being able to say goodagain.                                              bye to the Angolan friends because communi-
> In October 1963 Mr. Ebo was arrested, his        cation, even within Luanda, had become
> home searched, and he was imprisoned with           almost impossible.
> three other Baha'ls from Luanda. When speak-           Mr. Ebo continued to correspond with
> ing of that period at a later time Mr. Ebo would    friends outside Angola, speaking of the teachsmile sadly and say, 'We were not treated very      ing efforts, the holding of Nineteen Day Feasts,
> well,' but he uttered not a further word of         the efforts to establish a Baha'i Centre and to
> complaint. Eventually Mr. Ebo and the other         seek from the government official recognition
> prisoners were transferred to the prison island     of the Faith. In one of his last letters he wrote
> of Baia dos Tigres off the coast of southern        that he was still firm in his conviction to spread
> Angola where they rejoiced at meeting, among        the teachings and that his goal was to enrol five
> their fellow prisoners, six Baha'ls from            hundred believers so that recognition could be
> Malange. During the six years they remained         granted to the Baha'ls.
> there they would gather together to pray, to           Mr. Ebo departed from this earthly life on 1 7
> discuss what they could remember of the             April 1977 following a brief illness. His spirit
> Baha'i teachings and to sing and compose new        and strong faith have influenced the other
> songs in praise of Baha'u'llah. While in prison     Baha'ls in their efforts to carry on his work and
> Mr. Ebo grew in faith and dedication. He no         to live the Baha'i life. They reported that Mr.
> longer needed to look to Sampaio for strength       Ebo was given a beautiful Baha'i funeral in
> but drew on his own spiritual powers. The           accordance with the Writings and that they are
> other Baha'i prisoners looked to him as their       hopeful of eventually obtaining official recog-
> 'father'; he remained optimistic and assured        nition for the community.
> them that one day they would be free and               Upon hearing of his passing the Universal
> pioneers would come and help them spread the        House of Justice wrote on 7 June 1977, express-
> Faith.                                              ing the hope that his life might prove to be an
> Indeed, pioneers had arrived in the interval     inspiration to the friends in Angola.
> and were brought into contact with the African         From the Abha Kingdom, Mr. Ebo's radiant
> believers after Mr. Ebo's release from prison.      spirit will support the supplications of his fel-
> It was a radiant and tearful reunion. A new         low believers in his native land that the healing
> period began in the history of the Faith in         message of Baha'u'llah may be carried to every
> Angola during which Mr. Ebo emerged as the          city and village of Angola and that the call of
> 'father' of the community. He served on the         'Ya Baha'u'l-Abha' may be heard in all its
> re-formed Spiritual Assembly of Luanda and          regions.
> was a member of the National Teaching Com-                                            MARVEL GRAY
> mittee. It was Mr. Ebo who was ever ready to
> take a teaching trip to nearby villages, who
> encouraged and stimulated the other believers,
> who composed a number of songs with Baha'i           RUJ:I'U'LLAH TA YMURI-MUQADAM
> themes, who was at the centre of all joyous                   Martyr of Fac;lil Abad
> meetings and spiritual gatherings. He revived                     1940-1977
> the Malange community, giving strength and
> hope to the believers there, and again laid         If these companions be not the true strivers after
> plans to pioneer to Nova Lisboa.                    God, who else could be called by this name?
> Another crisis struck the Angolan commu-                                              Baha'u'llah
> nity with the outbreak of the tragic civil war in
> 1974. As the situation worsened the pioneers        RuJ:i'u'llah Taymurf-Muqadam was born on 18
> were required to leave and soon the Angolan         August 1940 in the village of Asyaban, near
> believers were again left alone. Their love for     Bfrjand, in the province of Khurasan, fran, a
> the pioneers was so great that they offered to      member of a devoted Baha'i family who had
> adopt them into their families in order that        responded to the call of Baha'u'llah in its early
> they might remain, and offered them food,           stages. The trials and difficulties which beset
> 434                                      THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Three years later he and his uncl e pio neered to
> Fac;lil Abad in the province of G urgan. When
> his uncle left the area in 1962, Rul)'u' ll ah
> remained alone in his pioneering post and
> faced many difficulties. He served the Cause
> there for twe nt y-one years and was a member
> of the Local Spiritual Assemb ly, frequently
> acting as treasurer. He was married and had
> two children. He gained the love and respect of
> people aro und him and was known for his honesty, integrity and trustworthiness.
> On the eve ning of Saturday, 14 May 1977 ,
> so me members of a fa natical e lement in the
> a rea who, aroused by jealousy and enmity, had
> been plotting against the Baha'fs, scaled a wall
> and e ntered the home of Rul)'u'llah
> Taym urf- Muqada m. Paying no heed to the
> tearful pleas of his mother they struck and
> injured her. When hi s sister, Parvin, came for -
> wa rd holding in her upraised hand a copy of the
> holy Qur'a n a nd bidding them to leave in
> peace , without respect even for their own sa-
> Rufl 'u'llah Taymuri-Muqadam                   cred book, they struck her on the head with an
> axe, threw her half dead to the grou nd and
> rushed towards Rul)'u'llah cleaving his head
> his grandfathers on both sides of the fami ly,         with savage blows of the hatchet. Soon his sou l
> and which they bore with admirable steadfast-          took its flight to the eterna l realm. At the age of
> ness, foreshadowed the persecutions that befell        thirty-seven he beca me yet a nother martyr of
> subsequent ge nerations in their service to the        the Cause of Baha'u'llah in the la nd of its birth.
> Cause, culminating in the martyrdom of                 His sister, although serio usly wo unded, even-
> Rul)'u'llah at the ha nds of misguided assassins.      tually recovered and later made her pilgrimage
> It is ironic that Rul)'u' llah's maternal gra nd-      to the Holy Land.
> fath!'!r was the recipientofa Tablet from Baha' u' -      The fam ily of Rul) ' u'll ah Taymurfllah in which the Blessed Beauty stated, in            Muqadam were hono ured by receiving the foleffect, that He addressed the populace in the          lowing cable from the Universal House of Juslanguage of the people in order that all might         tice sent to them on 16 May 1977:
> comprehend the purpose of their creation a nd
> SADDENED TRAGIC NEWS EXPRESS OUR SYM -
> be admonished by recalling the afflictions
> PATHY FAMILY RUHULLAH TAYMURI ASSURE
> which befell the loved ones of God in times
> RELAT IV ES FRIENDS ARDENT PRAYERS SHRINE
> past at the hands of those who were preve nted
> BESEECHING    PROGRESS    SOUL   STOP   PR AY IN G
> by their idle fancies and vai n im aginings from
> BEHALF TAYMURI'S SISTER AWAITING NEWS.
> recognizing the Promised One.
> As a three year old child , Rul)'u'llah shared,       (Translated and adapted from             various
> in the path of God, the calamities which befell        reports by Gloria Momen)
> his family when the Baha' is of Asyaban were
> persecuted , abused, injured and their be longings plundered . Their very houses were pulled
> down and their trees uprooted. Following this
> upheaval , Rul)' u'llah's father was imprisoned              DOROTHYKEDIBONESENNE
> in Bfrjand.                                                        1931-1977
> In 1953, after completing his studies as a
> junior, Rul)'u'llah went to live with his uncle in     She stood in the doorway of the small school in
> Mashhad where he continued his education.              Alexandra, Johannesburg-a friendly, spark-
> IN MEMORIAM                                                      435
> 
> ling person . The three pioneers who were helping to teach handcrafts in the school paused to
> say goodbye. 'Wait,' Dorothy said, 'I have a
> question. There's something different about
> you; what is it that you have?' Helen Miller
> spoke for the other two, Doris Ballard and
> Bahiyyih Ford. 'We're Baha'fs,' she said . That
> was the beginning.
> Dorothy was born in Alexandra Township in
> February 1931, the fifth daughter in a family of six chi ldren. She was of the well-known
> Sebolao family of Thaba'nchu in the Orange
> Free State, the ancestral home of the Tswana
> people. She attended Holy Cross Mission
> School, Moroka High School, and Ohlange
> College in Natal. She taught in several places
> and in 1972 became principal of Mokoena
> Community School. She had decided when she
> was a child that she wanted to become a
> teacher.
> In 1953, Dorothy and Ephens Nti Senne
> were married at Kgale in Phokeng, Rustenburg, Transvaal. On the wedding day, Ephens                        Dorothy Kedibone Senne
> introduced her to a guest as 'one of my best
> friends.' This was a touching and significant
> compliment and Dorothy remembered it all            the days of the Bab, that captured hearts,' but
> her life. Four daughters and a son were born to     ham and potato salad!
> the Sennes.                                            On the journey back to Johannesburg, Mr.
> Dorothy became interested in the Baha'i          Masehla joined Dorothy in asking questions
> Faith from the time she asked her first ques-       about the Faith. The little car sped along carrytion. Early in her study, she spoke of her hus-     ing two souls who were to become the earliest
> band living at Rustenburg, wishing that she         pillars of the Faith in Southern Africa.
> could share with him what she was learning.            Dorothy became a Baha'i in January 1955 ,
> The pioneers delightedly arranged to take           the first African woman in South Africa to
> Dorothy to Rusten burg. Arriving at Dorothy's       embrace its truth. She began at once to teach
> home early in the morning, the pioneers were        the Faith and many hearts were attracted. She
> introduced to a fine-looking man, Dorothy's         was deeply sincere, clear-thinking and honest
> brother-in-law, William Masehla (now a              in her approach to life and desired to build her
> member of the Continental Board of Counsel-         life on truth. When she found the answer to her
> lors in the Southern African zone) who was to       seeking, her enthusiasm knew no bounds. Her
> chaperon her because she was venturing out          gay, outgoing spirit drew people to her; she
> alone with strangers.                               taught with conviction and love. Dorothy had a
> It was a happy day with singing and laughter     superlative capacity to adjust herself to people
> on the way. The pioneers met Mr. Senne and          of all walks of life; she was comfortable and
> other members of his family. At noon the            happy with those who could not read and write
> picnic basket was unpacked and typical Ameri-       as well as with the educated. The Faith grew.
> can picnic fare was spread out-cold ham,            Baha'i communities in and around Rustenburg
> potato salad and apple pie. The pioneers did        were born. In addition, through her efforts and
> not realize that such food was strange to their     those of Bula Stewart who had settled in Preguests but the unfailing courtesy of the African    toria as a pioneer, more than forty-five people
> people prevailed and the lunch seemed to be         embraced the Faith.
> eaten with relish. Ever since, the Sennes have      1
> See E.G. Browne, A Traveller's Narrative, (Introduction)
> said that in South Africa it was not tea, like in       p. 38 .
> 436                                              THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> As the years passed, Dorothy's favourite
> study became the Covenant. Her last talk , at
> the national teaching conference in 1976, dealt
> with this subject which is at the heart of commitment to the Cause of Baha' u'llah. She passed from this life on 8 June 1977. Her funeral
> was as she wou ld have wanted it to be , a means
> of teaching the Faith. Over one thousand people, including many non-Baha'fs, gathered to
> pay tribute to one who had been a source of
> happiness, spiritual rebirth and love. Voices
> were raised on all sides: 'Our mother has left
> us.' Her husband, now a member of the Auxiliary Board, movingly paid tribute: ' Up to the
> time of her death, Dorothy remained loyal ,
> devoted, dedicated, God-loving and Godfearing in rendering service to the divine Cause
> of God.'
> The following cable dated 9 June 1977 was
> received from the Universal House of Justice:
> GRIEVED PASSING DOROTHY SENNE FIRST AFRI-
> CAN    WOMAN      BELIEVER SOUTH        AFRI CA STOP
> KINDLY EXTEND OUR WARMEST SYMPATHY HER                                      Wilma Thomas
> FAMILY     AND    FRIENDS     STOP    PRAYING        HOLY
> SHRINES PROGRESS HER SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> tionship with her mother who was an outstand-
> 'Abdu'l-Baha, in the Divine Plan Tablets, 1                   ing elementary school teacher. Wilma spent
> has written: It is said that in South Africa, a                  her childhood and youth in a small town in
> diamond mine is discovered. Although the mine                    Michigan, U.S.A. and later lived in Upslandia
> is most valuable, yet after all it is stone. Per-                and Detroit. She attended Wayne State Unichance, God willing, the mine of humanity may                    versity, but her studies were interrupted by her
> be discovered and the brilliant pearls of th e                   first marriage. Her two sons , Tom and Robert
> Kingdom be found.                                                Ridley, were born prior to her return to university from which she graduated in sociology. She
> began her spiritual search early and made a
> study of different religions. While taking a university course in comparative religions she
> WILMA THOMAS                                  encountered and embraced the Baha'i Faith.
> 1913- 1977                                 Later she married Irving Thomas.
> Wilma served the Faith as a pioneer in
> Baha'u'llah has written: 0 Son ofthe Supreme!                    Ecuador, Peru, Colombia and Venezuela, thus
> I have made death a messenger of joy to thee.                    furthering the Divine Plan during the Ten Year
> Wherefore dost thou grieve? 2 Wilma Thomas                       Crusade from 1955 to 1963 , the Nine Year
> believed in these words. She was in this life-                   Plan from 1969 to 1972, and the present Five
> and how much more so in the realms of light!-                    Year Plan , until her passing on 10 June 1977.
> a happy and noble being, sincere in her faith,                   Before the establishment of the National
> radiant and content, spiritually consecrated,                    Spiritual Assembly of Colombia in 1961 ,
> and dedicated to serving others .                                Wilma was the secretary of the National Teach-
> She was born on 3 June 1913, and was an                       ing Committee which had the responsibility for
> only child. Her father died when she was a                       winning the goals and preparing that national
> young girl and she enjoyed a very close rela-                    community for its election. She was a member
> 1   Tablet dated 11 April 1916.                                  of that first National Assembly in 1961 and
> 2 The Hidden    Words of Bahti'u'lltih (Arabic) No. 32.          attended the first international convention in
> IN MEMORIAM                                                       437
> 
> Haifa, Israel in 1963 to elect the Universal
> House of Justice.
> When Wilma came to Venezuela in June
> 1969 she spent her first months in Cabimas,
> later transferring to Barquisimeto where she
> taught English at the University of Lara and
> came to be loved not only by the Baha'is but by
> the university faculty and students. In 1973 she
> was appointed a member of the Auxiliary
> Board for propagation of the Faith in Venezuela and in 1976 was appointed to the protection board, a service for which she was especially well qualified for she was perceptive,
> spiritually radiant and compassionate. She was
> exemplary in her firmness in the Covenant, and
> outstanding in her loyalty to Baha'u'llah and
> His institutions.
> Toward the end of her life Wilma suffered
> from a heart condition and although she was
> aware that she might not live much longer she
> declined to return to the United States for
> surgery because the cardiologist had made it
> clear that she might not be able to return to                             Maria T. Irizarry
> Venezuela after the operation. Death found
> her at her pioneer post, faithful and active to       married Martin Lopez and moved to Santo
> the end. The International Teaching Centre            Domingo, Dominican Republic, where she
> wrote on 12 July 1977: 'It is a blessing that her     accepted the Baha'i Faith as a result of the
> dedicated work in the Cause of Baha'u'llah            teaching efforts of the German believer, Marcontinued to the very end of her earthly life. '      garet Lentz, 1 in the opening phase of the first
> Tribute was also paid by the Universal House          Seven Year Plan (1937 - 1944) under which
> of Justice in its cable of 13 June:                   the Teachings of Baha'u'llah were to be carried
> to 'every state within American Republic and
> GRIEVED LEARN PASSING DEVOTED DEDICATED
> every Republic in American continent.' 2 Thus
> MAIDSERVANT     BAHAULLAH     WILMA     THOMAS
> Dona Tete became the first person to accept
> MEMBER    AUXILIARY   BOARD   PIONEER SOUTH
> the Faith in the Dominican Republic as well as
> AMERICAN    NINE   YEAR   PLAN   STOP   ARDENT
> the first native born Puerto Rican believer.
> PRAYERS PROGRESS HER SOUL OFFERED AT SAC-
> She returned to Puerto Rico in the early
> RED THRESHOLD STOP CONVEY LOVING SYM -
> 1940s and was the only Baha'i on the island for
> PATHY HER FAMILY.
> a time . Shortly thereafter some pioneers
> DONALD R. WITZEL
> , arrived from the United States. In approxi-
> DOROTHY WHALEN
> mately 1947, Dr. Edris Rice-Wray, an American pioneer, settled in Puerto Rico and lived in
> the home of Dona Tete. Regular meetings
> were held in her home during this period and a
> MARIA T. IRIZARRY                          number of the earliest Puerto Rican believers
> 1903-1977                              accepted the message of Baha'u'llah as a result
> of those gatherings.
> On 27 July 1977 the Baha'i community of                  Being extremely timid by nature, Dona Tete
> Puerto Rico was saddened by the loss of its first     left her home but infrequently. However, she
> and much loved Baha'i, Dona Marfa T. (Tete)
> Irizarry. Dona Tete was born Marfa Teressa              See 'In Memoriam', The Baha'i World, vol. XIV, p. 354;
> 'The Seven Year Plan', The Bahti'f World, vol. IX, p. 192.
> Martin Quinones in San German, Puerto Rico,         2
> Shoghi Effendi, message to United States convention,
> on 9 September 1903. At a young age she                 1936, The Baha'i World, vol. IX , p. 187.
> 438                                      THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> served the Faith well not only by teaching it to
> all those with whom she came in contact but as
> a member of the Spiritual Assembly of the
> Baha'ls of San Juan for many years, by serving
> on several committees and through opening
> her home for countless meetings. All who
> knew her speak of the atmosphere of peace and
> ease she created. She was the personification of
> tolerance and patience and literally could not
> bear the thought of hurting another person.
> She always spoke in a kindly and positive way.
> When asked whether she did not get lonely she
> would respond, 'No, 'Abdu'l-Baha is always
> with me.' One would always be treated to a
> meal in her home since it was her charming
> custom to prepare a portion for' Abdu'l-Baha'
> which would be shared with unexpected visitors.
> Dona Tete was married a second time, to
> Mr. Jose C. Irizarry. She is survived by her only
> child, an adopted daughter, Sara Maria
> Irizarry.
> Informed of her passing, the Universal                           Aflmad Yazdani
> House of Justice cabled on 1August1977:
> DEEPLY GRIEVED PASSING DEVOTED BELIEVER
> Fatimih. Following the customary trend,
> MARIA IRIZARRY FIRST PUERTO RICAN BAHAI
> AJ:imad Yazdani learned to read and write and
> STOP ASSURE FRIENDS RELATIVES PRAYERS HOLY
> gained a knowledge of the Qur'an. He studied
> SHRINES PROGRESS HER SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> at the newly-established schools for elementary and secondary education and following
> that enrolled in an engineering course conducted by French tutors.
> Hearing of the Baha'i Faith from a pedlar in
> AI:IMAD Y AZDANf                     Nl§.hapur, AJ:imad Yazdani sought further
> (Mf RZA        AI:IMAD KHAN Y AZDANf                information from the Hand of the Cause Ibn-
> KASRAWf)                         i-Abhar and from the renowned teacher,
> 1891-1977                       Akhavan -i '~ - Safa. After eight months of
> intense investigation and study of the Baha'i
> GRIEVED PASSING AHMAD YAZDANI HIS MANY            Holy Writings he accepted the Faith at the age
> YEARS SERVICE CAUSE CLOSING PHASE HEROIC          of twenty-two. From then until his death on 5
> AGE HIS DEVOTED UNREMITTING LABOURS BOTH          July 1977, his thoughts and actions were con-
> TEACHING     ADMlNISTRATIVE     SPHERES   BAHAI   stantly channelled in the path of service to the
> ACTIVITIES    HIS   ERUDITION   AND   ASSIDUOUS   Faith. He served with distinction on the Local
> SCHOLARLY WORK WILL ALWAYS BE REMEM-              Spiritual Assembly ofTihran in the early years.
> BERED BY FRIENDS CRADLE FAITH STOP ASSURE            When he was twenty-three years of age,
> SYMPATHY BEREAVED FAMILY FERVENT PRAYERS          AJ:imad Yazdani married MiftaJ:iu'l-Malakut
> PROGRESS HIS SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.                   MiftaJ:i, a member of an aristocratic fami ly. His
> Universal House of Justice   wife was a Muslim but some years later she,
> too, embraced the Cause. The letters she
> AJ:imad Yazdani was born in Tihran on 24            received from the Guardian attest the zeal with
> April 1891 into a devout Muslim family. His         which she served the Faith. Mr. and Mrs. Yazfather, Mirza I:Iasan Khan Mu'ln-Dlvan, was         dani had three daughters and two sons.
> Auditor-in-Chief during a period of the                In 1915 a group of people in Holland,
> Qajatiyyih era. His mother's name was               exploring paths to peace, constituted them-
> IN MEMORIAM                                             439
> 
> selves into a body known as the Central Organ-                  fastness of their faith in their recent trials and
> ization for a Durable Peace with its Executive                  sufferings.
> Committee based in the Hague. Their constitu-                      When he retired from government service in
> tion was published by the press the world over.                 1949, A9mad Yazdani was able to realize his
> A9mad Yazdani, in consultation with two                         long-cherished desire of devoting all his time
> other Baha'is, prepared in French a paper                       and energy to the Faith. He engaged in teachembodying the Baha'i principles and sent it to                  ing activities, assumed various responsibilities
> that organization with the suggestion that their                as an educator of the youth and children, was
> search for ways to a permanent peace would be                   frequently in demand as a speaker and, in addifacilita ted if they sought guidance on the sub-                tion to his Baha'i activities, was active in the
> ject from 'Abdu' l-Baha. The organization                       promotion and spread of Esperanto. He travelresponded by submitting through A9mad                           led for the Faith over a wide area of Iran and in
> Yazdani a letter to the Master. The letter,                     1950, with the permission of Shoghi Effendi,
> however, did not reach 'Abdu'l-Baha until                       he accepted the invitation of the National
> after World War I was over. In 1919 the Mas-                    Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of India and
> ter summoned the Hand of the Cause Ibn-i-                       Pakistan to visit those countries where he spent
> A~daq and A9mad Yazdani to the Holy Land                        eight months presenting the Faith at colleges
> and delegated them to take a Tablet, 1 with its                 and other educational institutions.
> English translation, to the organizers of the                      When A9mad Yazdani returned home, the
> peace movement. Taking a boat from Egypt,                       Guardian asked him to go to Kuwait, Bahrain,
> they arrived in Holland to learn that the origi-                Qatar and Dubai and cheer the hearts of the
> nal organization had disbanded on termina-                      pioneers with the latest news of the Faith and
> tion of the war and a new one had taken its place.              with a message of loving greetings and encour-
> They met its president and secretary, presented                 agement from Shoghi Effendi and an expresthe Master's Tablet and took their reply back                   sion of his admiration of their services. From
> to Him. 'Abdu'l-Baha sent them another Tab-                     there, A9mad Yazdani was sent on a similar
> let which reached them duly.                                    mission to 'Iraq and l:lijaz.
> During his stay in Holland, A9mad Yazdani                       The next task entrusted to him by the
> established contact with the Esperantists as he                 beloved Guardian took him to Turkey. Apart
> knew their language well and was a member of                    from visiting the friends, establishing Baha'i
> their branch in Tihran. He attended their meet-                 study classes, teaching the Faith and stimulatings in Holland and gave stirring talks on the                  ing public interest in it through press articles,
> Faith. Having completed his assignment, he                      he assisted in the formation of three Local
> returned to the Holy Land whence, after a                       Spiritual Assemblies in Turkey before returnmonth and a half, he returned home by way of                    ing to Iran. The Guardian called on him next to
> Turkey.                                                         go to Afghanistan, where he stayed for some
> In Iran A9mad Yazdani secured employ-                        time.
> ment in government offices and discharged his                      In 1922, A9mad Yazdani was invited by the
> duties with exemplary zeal and probity. He                      Persian National Spiritual Assembly, to edit
> could not, however, curb his passion to teach                   the Baha'i News of Iran. This journal is curthe Faith and thus was openly identified as a                   rently published under the title Akhblir-i-
> Baha'i. His indiscretion triggered off the hostil-              Amri. He served as its editor-in-chief for
> ity of enemies of the Faith who made allega-                    twelve years and wrote an article regularly in
> tions against him which, though false , still                   every issue on the aims, objectives and princiresulted in his being imprisoned. Confined for                  ples of the Cause. He was associated with most
> several months, but irrepressible as ever, he                   Baha'i publications in Persia and was one of
> told his fellow-prisoners about the Faith. Even-                the founders of, and a contributor to, the
> tually his innocence was established and he was                 Taraniy-i-Umid, (Baha'i Women's Journal).
> set free. Arriving home, he was overjoyed to                    He also contributed articles to Ahang-i-Badi'
> receive a letter from the Guardian highly                       (Baha'i Youth Magazine) and the Year Book
> commending him and his family on the stead-                     of the Iranian Baha'i youth.
> ' See Tablet to the Central Organization for a Durable Peace,      In addition to his vast literary output the
> the Hague; The Baha'i World , vol. XV, pp. 29-37.             outstanding achievements of A9mad Yazdani
> 440                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> include his invaluable work over the years on
> the National Spiritual Assembly, the Local
> ·Spiritual Assembly ofTihran and the National
> Teaching Committee; his great contribution to
> the education and progress of women; his
> review of Baha'i publications over a period of
> no less than half a century and his prodigious
> labours in collating and classifying extracts
> from several thousand Tablets of Baha'u'llah
> and' Abdu'l-Baha and of numberless letters of
> the Guardian. His faithful service drew ma ny
> gracious comments from the Universal House
> of Justice . We conclude with a free translation
> of an extract from one of the letters written to
> him on its behalf:
> 'That precious friend is happy and privileged
> to dedicate his time fully to the service of God's
> Cause . He does so in a spirit of noble and
> self-sacrificial endeavour, immersing himself in
> the ocean of the Sacred Writings to discover
> pearls of wisdom. That dear, spiritual brother
> can rest assured that he is lovingly remembered
> in our supplications at the Holy Shrines and
> Elsa Maria Grossmann
> that our prayers are offered at the Sacred
> Thresholds for the descent of still greater blessings on his efforts.'                                his Samaritan service caught the disease himself
> THE NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY OF           and died. It was these influences perhaps which
> THE BAHA'is OF IRAN                          prepared her for her acceptance of the Baha'i
> (Translated by Rustom Sabit)                 Faith which she first encountered in 1919 or
> 1920.
> Her brother, Hermann , 1 had spontaneously
> embraced the Faith during a lecture given in
> ELSA MARIA GROSSMANN                          Leipzig by an American Baha'i couple, Harlan
> 1896-1977                              and Grace Ober,2 who were returning to the
> Knight of Baha' u'llah                     United States after being on pilgrimage in the
> Holy Land where they had visited 'Abdu'l-
> Elsa Maria Grossmann was born into a Ger-            Baha. Hermann returned to Hamburg and was
> man family on 19July1896 in Rosario , Argen-         met at the railway station by Elsa to whom he
> tina. She and her brothers spent a happy child-      related his deep conviction of the truth of the
> hood there and throughout her entire life she        Baha'i Faith. From this point onward, love for
> loved her Argentine homeland. In 1909 her            Baha'u'llah and His Message became the
> family moved to Germany, settling first in           centre of her life. She rendered many services
> Hamburg and later in Neckargemiind. Elsa             to the Faith in Hamburg; on her various travels
> Maria's character was deeply moulded by the          for the Cause; in the Baha'i International
> warm, receptive and inquiring atmosphere of          Bureau in Geneva; and as a Baha'i delegate to
> her parental home, and by the world-oriented         Esperanto Congresses, through which she
> mentality of Argentina which knew no prej-           gained the close friendship of Lydia
> udice of race or religion. She was also strongly     Zamenhof. During the 1920s an active corresinfluenced by her maternal grandmother, a            pondence linked her to the Guardian of the
> pious woman, and by her maternal grandfather
> who, during the last epidemic of yellow fever in       Appointed a Hand of the Cause in 1951; see ' In
> Memoriam', Th e Baha'f World , vol. XV, p. 416.
> Argentina, voluntarily committed himself to          ' See 'In Memoriam ', The Baha'i World, vol. VIII, p. 656;
> caring for indigent victims and in the course of       vol. XIII, p. 866.
> IN MEMORIAM                                                     441
> Faith whom the Grossmanns much admired.                 Let Elsa's spirit speak to those who would
> On their pilgrimage to the Holy Land in 1937,        follow her example in these words from a
> shortly before Himmler's ordinance outlawed          report she wrote from the Frisian Islands, 1
> the Baha'i Faith in the Third Reich, Elsa and        described by Shoghi Effendi in his 1954 con-
> Hermann and his wife, Anna, had the incom-           vention message as 'wind-swept' and 'inhospitparable privilege of meeting Shoghi Effendi.         able':
> In the course of the difficulties caused by the      'It may happen to you that, being-perhaps
> Gestapo in northern Baden , Elsa Maria was           in autumn-quite alone on the solitary, endless
> imprisoned for nine days in Heidelberg               dunes and perceiving nothing but this primary
> because of her Baha'i convictions. She was           landscape with its infinite sky and sea, you
> freed through the intervention of her brother        suddenly feel that tremendous, almost
> who made representations to the Gestapo              annihilating loneliness as it might have been
> headquarters in Karlsruhe.                           experienced by a first man in a first creation.
> At the Stockholm conference in 1953 she           The story of the opening of the Frisian Islands
> responded to the call of Shoghi Effendi for          to the Cause of God is, as yet experienced, not
> pioneers to unopened areas in the Ten Year           a very crimson-coloured one , when compared
> Crusade. Elsa moved to Westerland, one of the        with many others from more radiant pioneer
> Frisian Islands, a service for which she was         places. This was for a long time a heavy load on
> named a Knight of Baha'u'llah. She held her          us here, but only the fact that our beloved
> lonely, storm-swept pioneering post for eleven       Guardian was fully aware of the situation and
> years until a serious illness forced her to return   often transmitted to us his inspiration and lovto the mainland. She was highly talented: in         ing comfort, lightened its weight .
> addition to translating from English into Ger-          'We think of the little white lighthouses
> man Gleanings from the Writings of Bahti'u'-         everywhere on these islands, looking over the
> lldh, as well as the compilation of Baha'i           sea calmly and firmly , and fully indifferent to
> prayers most widely used in Germany (and, in         the storms and tempests around them, just
> collaboration with her brother, The Proclama-        showing the seeking sailor the right route. This
> tion of Baha'u'llah and a new translation of         exactly is our way: to be like lighthouses of His
> Paris Talks), she painted and composed verse.        Cause for whomsoever seeks His Path. And
> She remained interested in scientific progress       this finally, if God be willing, may lead to His
> and world affairs to the end of her life.            spiritual victory.'
> With the years her inner harmony and
> spiritual joy grew; she radiated these attributes
> in her surroundings and profoundly affected                        LUISA MAPA GOMEZ
> young people. She remained active to the end                            1892-1977
> and was happy to be able to teach the Faith to
> four people at the nursing home, among them              GRIEVED LEARN PASSING DEVOTED MAIDSER-
> the Catholic priest of the home. On 6 August             VANT     LUISA    MAPA     GOMEZ      STOP   PRAYING
> 1977, near midday, her soul took its flight to           SHRINES PROGRESS HER SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> another world. The Universal House ofJustice                                  Universal House of Justice.
> paid tribute in these words:
> DEEPLY GRIEVED PASSING KNIGHT BAHAULLAH            Luisa Mapa (Mrs. Jose Virto Gomez) was born
> ELSA MARIA GROSSMANN STOP HIGH COMMEN-             into a prominent family in Talisay, Occidental
> DATION , EXPRESSED BY BELOVED GUARDIAN HER         Negros, Philippines in 1892. She was gradu-
> DISTINGUISHED SERVICE TRANSLATION GLEAN-           ated from the University of the Philippines
> INGS AND ABOVE ALL HER SINGLE HEARTED              (College of Education) and, adopting as her
> DEVOTION    HISTORIC WORK     PIONEER FRISIAN      motto 'Knowledge does not occupy space' she
> ISLANDS    ENSURE   HER   HIGH   RANK   GERMAN     encouraged every youth she met to obtain an
> BAHAI HISTORY AND PROVIDE SHINING EXAMPLE          education. Her children were urged to study
> SUCCEEDING      GENERATIONS      STOP   KINDLY     languages so they might communicate with
> EXTEND LOVING SYMPATHY RELATIVES ASSUR-            more people of the world. Her outlook was
> ANCE ARDENT PRAYERS SACRED THRESHOLD               truly universal and she had a great capacity for
> PROGRESS HER SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.                        Bal11i'f News (U.S.A.), August 1958.
> 442                                    THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> centres in America and Europ.e; her acceptance of the Faith was confirmed. Although she
> had lived , as it were, within the spirit of the
> Baha'i teachings all her life , her search for a
> religion with which to identify had now ended.
> After she became a Baha'i her home became
> the focal point of Baha'i activities until the
> purchase of the national f:la~iratu'l-Quds . The
> frequent visits of the Hands of the Cause
> Agnes Alexander and RaJ:imatu'llah Muhajir
> brought her much pleasure and she enjoyed
> cooking for Miss Alexander dishes reminiscent
> of Hawaii. Luisa was an active teacher and a
> mother to the pioneers from f ran and the
> United States. One American pioneer wrote in
> Luisa's guest book, 'To come pioneering to the
> Philippines is to join the family beneath this
> roof. You are a Mamsu to all of us.'
> Mrs. Gomez served on the National Spiritual
> Assembly from its inception in 1964 until 1975
> and was often its treasurer. The first endowment received by the National Assembly, a
> Luisa Mapa Gomez                       tract of land in Quezon City , 400 square metres
> in area, was given by her.
> understanding the needs of people. Because of           In 1962, when Luisa was near death and was
> her love of humanity and her sense of fairness,      rushed to the hospital for a serious emergency
> relatives and friends sought her counsel. Hers       operation, she called her children together and
> was a happy home and when her seven children         asked them to be always united. One daughter,
> came together beneath its roof the rafters rang      Neva Gomez Dulay, who provided the inforwith laughter. She was open-handed and hos-          mation for this memoir and who is now a
> pitable and the home was often filled with           member of the National Spiritual Assembly of
> guests including foreign students, refugees,         the Philippines, declared at that time her
> armed services personnel and tourists, all of        acceptance of Baha'u' llah. She writes: 'I was
> whon:i. were befriended by her and many of           intellectually convinced of the principles enunwhom became lifelong correspondents and              ciated by Baha'u'llah but a spiritual bar born of
> friends.                                             years of agnosticism clouded my heart. Seeing
> Luisa had an independent and inquiring            mother close to death, the veil lifted and I was
> mind and investigated many schools of relig-         able to tell her that I would become a Baha'i. I
> ious thought. Through contact with Mrs. Nina         announced my intention realizing that I might
> Nadler and Mrs. Hazel Mori in 1953 she began         be making her happy for the very last time.
> to think of herself as a Baha'i and made her first   Mother answered very weakly, "Good. There
> written declaration of acceptance on a hospital      is plenty of work to be done ."'
> admission card where she described herself as a         Death came on 23 September 1977 . People
> Baha'i in the space provided for religious           from all strata of society attended the funeral.
> designation. Her daughter was much chagrined         Although she was known to be a Baha'i it was
> by this, thinking that her mother, at age sixty-      only during the readings and prayers that many
> one, was venturing into unknown waters with-         were able to appreciate the depth and beauty
> out sufficient investigation, and considerable       of the Faith; thus even in death she taught.
> curiosity was aroused among the hospital staff          During his visit to the Philippines at Nawwho thought that a local religion had been born       Ruz 1977 the Hand of the Cause RaJ:imatu'Ilah
> because 'bahay' in the Tagalog language means        Muhajirpresented Mrs. Gomez with a copy of
> 'house'. In 1954 Luisa went abroad for medical       Selections from the Writings of the Bab which
> treatment and visited a number of Baha'i              gave much joy to her heart. Inscribed within
> IN MEMORIAM                                           443
> were the words, 'To dearest Mamsu- My
> greatest love and humble respect .'
> In the life of Luisa Gomez was seen exemplification of the words of 'Abdu'l-Baha: Do
> not be content with showing friendship in words
> alone; let your heart burn with loving kindn ess
> for all who may cross your path . .. Let it be
> seen that you are filled with universal love.
> 
> KATHLEEN, LADY HORNELL
> 1890-1977
> 
> Kath leen, Lady Hornell, was born in Sussex,
> England on 1 July 1890, the daughter of Dr.
> A ugustus Hayter Walker and Annie Louisa
> Walker. In a brief outline of her Baha'i life
> and service written in 1966, Lady Hornell
> states: 'I was fortunate enough to have been
> allowed great freedom of thought and no prejudices were encouraged. I was never a
> member of any re ligious organization until I                        Kathleen, Lady Horn ell
> met the Baha'i Faith on 16 October 1922 in
> London. My spiritual mother was Elizabeth                   Early in 1951 Lady Hornell travelled to
> Herrick, author of Unity Triumphant. 1 I was             Edinburgh and Glasgow as a public speaker
> accepted as a believer at Ri<;lvan 1923 and              a nd in November of that year visited the young
> became a voting member of the Faith. There               and struggling Baha'is in Belfast where she also
> were no formal declarations in those days.               spoke at a public meeting. She relates that her
> Ever since embracing the Cause my faith has              address brought strong opposition from some
> grown stronger, enabling me to serve the                 members of the audience who were of Chris-
> Cause both administratively and in teaching. I           tian background and notes that ironically it was
> have had the truly glorious experience of two            a Buddhist who arose to defend her. In May
> pilgrimages to the Holy Land, the first in 1954          1953 she settled in Belfast as a pioneer and,
> when Shoghi Effendi was my host and the sec-             when that community had grown in strength,
> ond in 1966.                                             she pioneered to Bangor where she remained
> 'From 1936 until 1954 I was a member of the           until a Spiritual Assembly was formed at Ri<;l-
> National Spiritual Assembly of the British Isles         van 1959, the first homefront goal to be won
> and served as treasurer and assistant secretary.         for the British National Assembly in the Ten
> I was also treasurer of the British Publishing           Year Crusade. 'All were Bangor citizens
> Trust Committee and, for a short time, secre-            except myself,' she wrote, 'and I stayed
> tary of the National Teaching Committee and a            another year so that the friends might experimember of the Summer School Committee.                   ence the work of a Local Assembly.'
> 'As a member of the London community I                   When the Baha'i community of the United
> served on the Local Spiritual Assembly from              Kingdom was called upon to aid the believers
> 1932 until 1945 except for a period of one and           in Europe in achieving the goals of the Ten
> a half years when I was in Torquay, Devon-               Year Crusade, Lady Hornell immediately
> shire, during World War II, where I served on            responded. In July 1960 she settled in Venice
> the Local Spiritual Assembly . In Otober 1945 I          where she remained until 1965 at which time
> pioneered to Nottingham, a goal of the British           she pioneered to Cagliari, Sardinia a goa l
> Six Year Plan, remaining there until the pas-            assigned to the Italian believers in the Nine
> sing of Sir William on 22 September 1950.'               Year Plan. Her last years were spent in London
> ' London: Kegan Paul Trench Trubner and Company, 1923.   where she passed away on 24 September 1977.
> 444                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> In the cable sent at the time of her passing the
> Universal House of Justice paid tribute to this
> distinguished early believer:
> PASSING LADY HORNELL ROBS BRITISH COM -
> MUNITY ONE OF FEW REMAINING LINKS EARLY
> DAYS FAITH. HER UNWAVERING FAITH CON -
> STANT DEDICATED SERVICES PIONEER TEACHING
> ADMINISTRATIVE FIELDS OVER SO MANY YEARS
> ASSURE HER HIGH STATION ANNALS CAUSE PRO-
> VIDE SHINING EXAMPLE PRESENT FUTURE GEN-
> ERATIONS. ADVISE HOLD BEFITTING MEMORIAL
> MEETING.   ASSURE ARDENT PRAYERS SACRED
> THRESHOLD PROGRESS HER LOVING SOUL ABHA
> KINGDOM.
> 
> Not Jong after, at a teaching conference held
> in Alexandra Palace , North London, the British community commemorated her memory.
> Present was her daughter, Mrs. Hasan Balyuzi,
> and approximately 1,800 other Baha'i friends.
> Mr. Philip Hainsworth, on behalf of the
> National Spiritual Assembly, recalled her life
> of indefatigable dedication and service . 'She is                           Nathulal Gupta
> an.outstanding example for the British Baha'ls ,'
> he said. 'She recognized the Faith at once,          convinced by the irrefutable logic of the Baha'i
> immediately arose to serve it and continued to       teachings a nd accepted the Faith with great
> do so uninterruptedly, to the best of her ability,   fervour .
> for more than half a century.'                          Mr. Gupta's open declaration of faith and
> fearless exposition of the teachings of Baha'u' -
> llah led to his receiving letters threatening
> his life. His family, consisting of the widow and
> NATHULAL GUPTA                          children of his adopted son, were antagonistic
> 1890- 1977                           towards the Faith. In spite of his meagre financial resources he once sold a village home he
> Mr. Nathulal Gupta was born into a family of         owned so that he could donate money for the
> orthodox Sanatani Hindus in 1890 at Barai,           purchase of printing machinery for the Faith.
> near Gwalior, India and received his education       The National Spiritual Assembly of India
> in Hindi and Sanskrit, as was the custom of the      returned with appreciation his offer of the
> time. Later he grew dissatisfied with the Sana-      house in which he lived since the rent from it
> tani policy which he felt discriminated against      supported his dependents.
> those of lower caste and became a member of             From sources he had known as schola rthe Arya Samaj. He delved deeply into the            devotee of the Arya Samaj, Mr. Gupta
> ancient Vedic, Puranic (Hindu mythological)          developed the conviction that the Persian schoand philosophical literature of India and            lar, whose acquaintance led Rishi (Saint) Dayauthored two scholarly books in defence of           anand to formulate the principles of Arya
> Arya Samaj ideology. A zealous Arya Samaj-           Samaj, was actually Jamal Effendi, 1 the
> ist, Mr. Gupta was intolerant of other religions.    teacher sent to India by Baha'u'llah, with
> Yet, it is a measure of his pure-heartedness that    whom Rishi Dayanand had come in contact in
> in 1956, when he heard an exposition of the          1
> See 'A Short Historical Sketch oftheBaha'iMovement in
> Baha'i Faith by Mr. M. H . Ilmi at the Gwalior           India and Burma' , by Mu~\afa Rumf, , Baha'i Magazine,
> Arya Samaj Hall, he was greatly attracted and            vol. 22. No . 3, June 1931 (and subsequent vols.);
> Ma~a biJ:i-Hidayat by ' Azizu'llah Sulaymani, vol. VIII , p.
> began meeting regularly the local Baha'ls and            125; and 'In Memoriam', Mu~\afa Rumf, The Bahli'(
> studying Baha'i literature in Hindi. He became           World, vol. X, p . 517.
> IN MEMORIAM                                          445
> Bombay at the time of Queen Victoria's coronation as Empress, a suggestion which perhaps
> will be the subject of study by future Baha'i
> scholars. His zeal and erudition are reflected in
> the Hindi-language Baha'i magazine Abhti
> which he launched in the early 1960s with the
> approval of the National Spiritual Assembly .
> He served as editor until failing health forced
> him to relinquish this activity in 1973. His
> extensive knowledge and his familiarity with
> Hindu scripture were reflected in his writing
> which was a source of confirmation to those of
> Hindu background.
> The memory of this frail old man who, for
> example, walked three miles so that he might
> teach the inmates of the local jail, and his
> strength of spirit and depth of knowledge, are
> not forgotten by local citizens.
> On 9 December 1977 the Universal House
> of Justice cabled:
> GRIEVED PASSING DEDICATED SERVANT BAHAU-
> LLAH NATHULAL GUPTA STOP HIS CONTRIBU-
> TIONS SPREADING MESSAGE GOD PARTICULARLY                         Muzaffer Ganey
> THROUGH ASHA      MAGAZINE    UNFORGETTABLE
> ASSURE RELATIVES FRIENDS ARDENT PRAYERS
> his graduation from military school, entered
> the army as a lieutenant.
> HOLY SHRINES PROGRESS HIS SOUL.
> In spite of hindrances arising from his profession Muzaffer strove constantly to observe
> the tenets of Islam. The fact that sometimes the
> conditions under which he lived prevented him
> MUZAFFER GONEY                          from carrying out his religious duties induced
> 1910- 1977                           him to reflect upon this discrepancy between
> the spiritual and the material worlds and he
> Muzaffer Giiney was born in the town of Fila        began to search for an answer to this dilemma.
> which was then situated within the territory of        When he was transferred to Sivas, Turkey in
> the Ottoman .empire and is now part of Yugo-        1955 he befriended Mal_imud 'Agar and his
> slavia. His father was a military officer and the   family , Baha'fs who had pioneered from Iran.
> family moved to Istanbul when Muzaffer was          Although his days were filled with the demandfour years old. He was raised in a family           ing activities of his profession, his evenings
> atmosphere which was pious without being            were devoted to long conversations with
> overzealous. When he had reached the age of         Mal_imud 'Anar and reflections upon certain
> twelve, Muzaffer was already recognized for         statements in the Qur'an and other religious
> the beauty of his voice and the depth of his        texts. This led to Muzaffer Giiney's acceptance
> religious beliefs, as a result of which he was      of the divine call of the Faith of Baha'u'llah.
> from time to time entrusted with chanting the       His entire family embraced the Cause with him
> adhan, the Muslim call to prayer, from the          and were welcomed into the Baha'i commuminaret of the Fatil.i mosque, an experience        nity. From that time forward he endeavoured to
> which filled him with bliss and won him admira-     familiarize with the divine teachings all those
> tion. At age thirteen he became spiritually         with whom he came into contact some of whom
> devoted to Mawlana (Rumi) and for a year            accepted the Faith or showed tolerance toward
> attended the ceremonies of worship at the           it and some of whom warned and threatened
> Mawlavf Lodge as a whirling dervish. Mean-          him. The grace of God protected him from
> while, he continued his education and, following    harm. In 1960, when he had retired from the
> 446                                         THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> army with the rank of Colonel, he was able to              SIYYID MAl:fFUZ:U'L-l:fAQ 'ILMf
> devote himself completely to service to the                         1894-1978
> Faith and was thus able to bring the Faith to the
> attention of a greater number of people a nd            Siyyid Mal)fU;::u'l-l:faq 'Ilmi (Mehfoozu lhuz
> engage in teaching activities without restraint.        Ilmi) was born into a devout and educated
> The Giiney family in February 1964 had the              Muslim family in 1894 in the village of Sathappiness of making a pilgrimage to the Holy            baria, district of Chittagong, Bangladesh. He
> Land and in April of the same year Muzaffer            was an excellent student and with the encourhad the honour of being e lected to serve on the        agement of one of his teachers who recognized
> National Spiritual Assembly of Turkey.                  the youth's capacity he pursued ardently a
> That year also saw his appointment to the            study of Arabic and resolved to become a
> Auxiliary Board, his activities thus being              teacher. In 1920 he obtained his degree from
> expanded to include the whole country.                  Punjab University. He taught at Shamsu'I
> Through the years he travelled to every region          'Ulum Theological College in Badaun, provof Turkey, never retreating even in the face of         ince of Uttar Pradesh, India for several years
> severe circumstances. Always he returned                and went on to become a lecturer in Ilahiyyat
> home filled with the inner peace that the               Theological College in Kanpur. Here he met
> fulfilment of duty induces. He also travelled           the outstanding educator Mawlana 'Abdu' labroad several times to carry out Baha'i mis-           Qadir, respected for his saintly character, who
> sions, visiting India once and Iran twice. His          had met Baha'is in Bombay; he favoured the
> faith was invincible, his love for Baha'u' llah         teaching methods of the Baha'is and encourwholehearted , and his obedience and devotion           aged his students to follow them.
> exemplary. It was his habit to rise each day               'Ilmi was a good writer and while still a stubefore dawn for prayers and although he was             dent had won an award for one of his articles
> quiet by nature and enjoyed meditating in the           which was published in an Urdu newspaper in
> evening hours he took the greatest pleasure in          Lahore. He later won fame as a poet, his poems
> discussing the Faith with others and considered         in Urdu winning him an appreciative audience
> a day wasted if no inspirational conversation           throughout the Inda-Pakistan subcontinent.
> took place . He undertook all activities to the         His poems were often on themes of love, jusutmost of his capacity and was committed with           tice and the fulfilment of spiritual prophecies
> his whole being to spreading the Baha'i teach-          and he used to give addresses in which he
> ings. Even a month after his passing, acquain-          recited passages from his verse. He worked as a
> tances were still calling at his house to borrow        freelance journalist for a time.
> books or telephoning for interviews.                        While living in Qadiyan where he had
> Muzaffer Giiney was instrumental in guiding          become a prominent and active member of the
> many souls to the Cause of God and being                 Al)madiyya (or Qadiyani) sect, 'Ilmi learned
> extremely modest was never satisfied with his           about the Baha'i Faith and was confirmed in his
> level of activity and always sought to increase          acceptance of it through Mirza Mal)mud-iit. May God's mercy and grace be upon him                Zarqani who was then visiting Qadiyan . He
> and may his work on this earthly plane be                immediately arose to proclaim the truth of the
> favoured with divine acceptance in the worlds            Baha'i Revelation and continued to make an
> beyond . When informed that he had passed                exhaustive study of its scripture, a process
> away on 14 December 1977, the Universal                  facilitated by his command of Persian and
> House of Justice cabled:                                Arabic. Very soon he launched a monthly
> Baha'i magazine, Kawkab -i-Hind, the first
> GRIEVED PASSING      DEVOTED SERVANT CAUSE
> issue appearing in May 1924, published in
> GOD   MUZAFFER      GUNEY    STOP   HIS    SERVICES
> Agra, India. This edition carried a scholarly
> UNFORGETTABLE      ADVISE    HOLD        MEMORIAL
> article written by him in which he set forth the
> GATHER INGS     ASSURE      RELATIVES      FRI ENDS
> principles of the Baha'i Cause, explained the
> ARDENT    PRAYERS    HOLY    SHRINES      PROGRESS
> station of Baha'u'llah and challenged the
> SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> members of the Al)madiyya group to investi-
> AYDIN MUZAFFER
> gate with open minds the claim of Baha'u'llah.
> His outpouring of writings, his moving and
> IN MEMORIAM                                                 447
> 
> which are the inevitable accompaniment of a
> life dedicated, as was 'Ilmf's, to service to
> spiritual principles, he was happy and continued to write prolifically.
> On 8 February 1978, after more than a half
> century of uninterrupted service, 'Ilmf passed
> away and was buried in the Baha'i cemetery at
> Lahore. The Universal House of Justice in its
> cable of 12 February honoured this pillar of the
> Cause in Pakistan:
> GRIEVED      PASSING        MEHFOOZULHUQ       ILMI
> LIFELONG      DEVOTED       EXEMPLARY     SERVICES
> FAITH SCHOLARLY ACHIEVEMENT UNFORG ETTA -
> BLE    ASSURE     RELATIV ES    FRIENDS    ARDENT
> PRAYERS SA CRED THRESHOLD           PROGRESS   HIS
> SOUL    ADVISE     HOLD      BEFITTING   MEMORIAL
> GATHERING.
> 
> (Adapted from a memoir written by Anisur
> Rehman Dehlavi , Editor, Baha'i Magazine,
> Karachi.)
> 
> Siyyid Maf:ifUiu'l-ljaq '/lm{
> 
> cogent addresses, his visits to leading figures in
> many walks of life in both India and Pakistan ,      MARTHA 'NAKIYA' NOYAKUK TRIGG
> to whom he presented Baha'i literature,                                    1944-1978
> attracted many eminent people to investigate
> and accept the Faith. Those of Muslim back-          Should you display an effort, so that the fragground are rarely well accepted by Hindus and        rances of God be diffused amongst the
> it is a measure of ' Ilmf's success as a Baha'i      Eskimos, its effect will be very great and farteacher that he was instrumental in drawing to       reaching.
> the Faith numerous Hindus among whom were                                'Abdu'l-Baha
> some prominent pundits of the orthodox Arya                              Tablets of the Divine Plan 1
> Samaj sect. 'Ilmf's wife , Zaynab Bagum, also
> embraced the Baha'i Faith and lent him every         Martha Trigg's Eskimo name, Nakiya, is highly
> assistance.                                          significant. It means 'a point for guidance'.
> One of the most important services rendered       When native hunters or travellers were out in
> by 'Ilmf was the translation into Urdu of many       their skin boats, a familiar landmark could
> Baha'i books thus meeting an urgent need of          mean the difference between life and death.
> the Baha'i community . He is appreciated, as         Perhaps because Martha's early life had been
> well, for the many pamphlets he wrote, and for       difficult and filled with hardship she was often a
> his poems, the collection published under the        point of guidance for others to whom she
> title $ur-i-Israfil being particularly well known    offered assurance, new hope and gentle but
> and valued by the Baha'is. He was an effective       sound advice.
> public speaker and frequently addressed pre-            She was born in Mary's Igloo, Alaska on 18
> stigious gatherings of educated people who           January 1944. Most of her childhood years
> were much affected by the simplicity of his          were spent with her grandparents, John and
> nature and the compelling force of his remarks.      Alice Kakaruk, from whom she learned to
> In Pakistan he served as a member of the Aux-        value her Eskimo heritage. She studied the
> iliary Board. Despite the difficulties of mis-       dances, songs and legends of her people. Her
> understanding or rejection by friends and rela-      great-grandfather had been a shaman-a
> tives and the reduced financial circumstances        'Tablet dated 5 April 1916 .
> 448                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> a wa tchword whi ch wo uld move her to acti on
> throughout her li fe .
> In Ja nuary 1963 Martha married Jero me
> Trigg, Jr. The couple a nd their four children
> Valerie , Pamela , Jerome III (Koodook) and
> Sara (Suki) were much loved wherever they
> we nt. T hey lived at various times in the Baha'i
> communities of Anchorage, Nome, Soldotna ,
> Hain es , Bethel and Kotzebue. In each place,
> from schoo l authoriti es and neighbo urs, would
> be heard: 'What a nice fam il y; they are always
> welcome back.' It was o ne of Martha's greatest
> joys that members of he r fami ly including her
> beloved gra ndmothe r, two sisters, a n uncle a nd
> the four Trigg childre n accepted the Faith .
> When her husband , Jerome, became a Baha'i
> d uring the visit of the Hand of the Cause John
> Robarts at Ric;lvan 1967 , the Triggs became the
> firs t Eski mo Baha 'i couple in the world.
> Martha was o ne of th e first to reali ze that
> particular efforts must be made to reach the
> native people and was freque ntly consulted
> Martha 'Nakiy a' Noyakuk Trigg               about means of bringing Baha' u' ll a h's message
> to her people. She participated in a panel durme dicine man, or holy man-who had seen the         ing the national conve ntio n of Alaska in 1969.
> good in Chrisiti anit y and encouraged his peo-     As a result of these deliberations and the e nsuple to embrace it.                                  ing activity a majo r break-th ro ugh occurred in
> In her thirteenth yea r, while living in No me   teaching among the Eskimos. She and Jero me
> on the Berin g Sea, Mart ha enco untered t he       were in the vanguard of the proclamation pro-
> Baha'i Faith t hrough Warren and Kat hy Rod-        gra mm es la unched in the ea rly 1970s. With
> gers who had pioneered to the area. Many of         pride and dignity, Martha would do n he r
> her friends were frightened by this new teach-      beautiful fur traditonal dancing parka , handing and turned away but Martha developed a          made by her gra ndmother and decorated with
> deep interest and introduced her grandmother        unique designs, and perform the ancient
> to the Bah a'i teach ings. Although warned by       Eskimo dances; she would speak of the old
> the clergy that the Baha'i Faith was from the       ways of her people a nd ex pl ain abo ut the comdevil and that association with the Bah a'is        ing of Baha' u'll ah. In the north, the west, the
> wou ld result in her being consigned to hell , a    A leutian chain , Kodiak Islands and in citi es
> bond of love grew up between Martha and her         and vi llages throughout south-east Alaska she
> new friends. Abo ut three yea rs late r, Martha     danced and told he r audiences about the Blessbecame a live-in baby-sitter in our home in the     ed Beauty.
> Anchorage area, lea rning more about the               On 9 February 1978 the house in which
> Ca use as she helped with the household tasks .     Martha was temporarily staying in Nome
> She was whimsicall y attached to san, the           caught fire. Fo ur people, including Martha,
> Oriental term of endearment, a nd was known         died in the blaze; no other me mbers of her
> in our home as Mart ha-san. She call ed me          fam il y were present. Her well-worn prayer
> Papa-sa n and my wife, Beverly, Ma ma-san.          book which survived the fire was used at her
> In February 1961 Mart ha became a Baha'i.        burial service. Her casket was surrounded by
> She loved the Writings and history of the Faith     the roses she loved so well and which to he r
> deeply. 'Mount your steeds, 0 heroes of             symbolized the many blessings of Baha'u'llah's
> God! '-the cry of Mulla I;Iusayn which was          Revelation. Tributes were received from sevtake n up by the besieged Babis at Fort             eral Hands of the Cause and from other Baha'i
> Tabarsi-touched her profoundly a nd became          friends. I read during the service the words
> IN MEMORIAM                                           449
> Mart ha had penned inside the front cover of
> her prayer book: 'O God! Thou Who art
> adored! I am from Thee and unto Thee I
> co me.'
> (Adapted from a memoir by John Kolstoe,
> A laska Baha'f News, November 1978)
> 
> CHADWICK MOHAPI
> 1888-1978
> 
> MARY MOHAPI
> ?-1 968
> 
> C hadwick Mohapi a nd hi s wife, Mary, were the
> first to accept the Faith in Lesotho (formerly
> Basuto land) as a result of the te aching efforts
> of Fred and Beth Laws 1 who were named
> K nights of Baha'u'llah upon their arrival, in
> October 1953, in that tiny mounta inous country in Southern Africa. The teaching trips                            Chadwick Mohapi
> take n by Mr. and Mrs. Laws on the o ld roads
> o ut of Maseru , the capital, led them past the        they could live with us. I said to my wife, "Let
> beautiful tree-shaded home of the Mo h a pis. A        us try this o ut and see whether these people are
> friendship developed between the two couples           genuine." The Laws returned to Maseru to
> and the Mo hapis became the first Basotho to           pick up their luggage a nd returned in the eve ne mbrace the Faith of Baha'u'llah in their ho me       ing. "We were puzzled because we had been
> co untry. Mr. Mohapi has left an acco unt of           joking and they had, in innocence, taken us
> the ir first meeting:                                  seriously. We were now surprised and a lso
> ' One day in the afternoon of a day in 1954,        fr ightened,"' Mr. Mohapi recalled .
> my wife and I were sitting outside in the sun              'That very evening they invited us to dinner in
> when we saw a strange car .. . people of E uro-        the rondoval with them. We were afraid of
> pean descent came from the car. We then se nt          going in there with them, but we saw what
> o ur first so n, Selai , to find out where they came   beautiful faces they had .. . they served us with
> from: he came to us with them ... they asked           meals instea d of us serving them with meals.
> us if they could be pe rmitted to have the use of      T he follow ing morn ing they inv.ited us for
> one wall over which they could put a canvas for        breakfast and through the great love they
> the day (for she lter). We asked them who they         showed they made friends with our yo ung chilwere, where they had come from . . . we                dre n by the end of the second day . We sti ll
> wanted to know their intentions. They told us          asked ourselves what these Euro peans wanted
> they had come from a fa r-off la nd , that they        living amongst us. T he eve of the third day they
> were looking for people to whom the y cou ld           invited us not for a meal , but for prayers. We
> teach the Word of God . Clowningl y, I sa id           were greatl y surprised . It appeared to us that
> ·'You can come and live wit h us in thisrondoval       we had come by a bone that had very nice
> (ro und hut) over here!" They said the y wou ld        marrow in it. Then they stayed and they
> be grateful to do that. We asked them , "How           became our rea l friends. We gave them new
> are yo u goi ng to live with black people? Don't       names-the man , Lerato (Love), and the lady,
> you know that we do not love white people?             Ma lerato (Mother of Love).'
> We have never stayed with white people                     The Mohapis sti ll had many moments in
> before.'' They said that did not matter to them ,      which they wondered abo ut their unusu al
> ' Elizabeth Laws, see 'In Memoriam', p. 459.           guests but they enj oyed bein g with them for
> 450                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> prayers and discussion of Bible proph-               wick began planting seed lings. He served his
> ecies-Mrs. Mohapi had always had a keen              country in many ways: as roa? party foreman
> interest in Bible su bj ects. The Laws gradually     for the construction of new roads, as chauffeur
> introduced the Baha'i teachings to them. Mr.         to the Resident Co mmissioner, as driver for
> Mohapi recalled , 'Then they told us the Mes-        the guardian of the young king; and was honsage they had brought and we the n under-            o ured by being made a gazetted headman of
> stood.' But it was the exa mple of their lives       the mountain vill age of Rapo leboea. He
> which spoke loudest: 'They fed us li ke their        retired to 'Seqonaka' where he later met the
> own children. One day my wife and I fe ll sick at    Laws and accepted the Faith and became
> the same time; they took our children and lived      involved immediately in plans 'to go outside
> with the m and they assisted us and helped us        and reach other people.'
> heal. The fea rs we had e ntert ained gradua ll y        T hey went first to Mary's home area,
> disappea red until we really realized ... they       Sepha pos, which became Lesotho's second
> were like our own brother a nd sister. Now we        Baha'i community. Many of Mary's family
> really accepted their statements.'                   accepted the Faith including Chief Jacob and
> Chadwick Mohapi was then sixty-six yea rs          Armstrong Sephapo and their wives. 'My wife
> old . But he and his wife were to spea rhead the     was really the leader,' said Chadwick, 'she
> first teaching efforts to reach other parts of       really had the potential.' T hey carried the Faith
> Lesotho. Other Baha'ls visited the peaceful          to the mountainous area of Qacha's Nek where
> shady ho me of the Mohapis, which they ca lled       their son, A lfred, and a nurse at the local hospi-
> 'Seqonaka', and it beca me a centre for meet-        tal became Baha'ls, and to the royal village of
> ings which drew in people from surroundin g           Matsieng where they informed the Paramount
> villages. Many were curious to see 'Europeans'       Chief about the Baha'i teachings. They turned
> (the te rm used by ma ny Africans for all white      their attentio n to the north and east, teaching
> people) and Africans living toge ther.                in Butha Buthe, Leribe and even the Orange
> Chadwick Mohapi was born in 1888 into a            Free State in South Africa; and on another visit
> distinguished family in the Berea area. His           to the mountains where their married daughter
> fa mily was of the Bakoena clan , the royal clan      lived, she and her husband, the chief of the area,
> of Lesotho, descend ants of Moshoeshoe I, the         became Baha'ls, as did many others. Meanfa ther of the Basuto nation . As a body, Chad-       wh ile the work at Seqonaka continued, resultwick herded cattle for his fat her who showed         ing in the format ion of several active comhim favour; he was the only son to go to school       munities.
> and one of the first yo ung men in Lesotho to            After Mary's passing in 1968 Chadwick
> study mechanics at Lerotholi Technical Insti-         reflected : 'We used to sing Baha'i songs and
> tute in Maseru. Maseru grew from a sma ll vil-        say prayers with our children . . . now my
> lage to a busy town and Chadwick was involved         health is not good and I cannot go on teaching
> in repairing cars, insta lling water faci li ties,    trips, I am now tired ... I am very grateful that
> repairing mills. From 1916 to 1918 he served          I now see Baha'ls calling on me. If you plant a
> in the armed forces and trave lle d to France a nd    little flower, eventually it makes many beauti-
> Britain. He said to a friend , prophetically , 'We    ful big flowers-this gratifies yo u. I am very
> are blazing paths for our children to travel          grateful to see the success of the Faith in
> across the seas.' In recent times three of his        Lesotho. I liken my position to that of
> sons and several grandchildren have gone              Moshoeshoe I who accepted the first (Christabroad for study and work.                            ian) missionaries and brought his people a
> Mr. Mohapi was deeply impressed by the            great deal of knowledge.' Chadwick particinumber of trees he saw in E urope and resolved       pated in Baha'i activities until the time of his
> to plan t trees when he returned to his own          passing . During the Five Year Plan , at the
> country which had been stripped of trees years        dedication of a site for a regional centre at Ha
> earlier. In 1918 he married; his wife, Mary, was      Rampa, he planted two seedling trees, carried
> of the Bataung cl an, a direct descendant of the      in his hands from 'Seqonaka'. In his remarks at
> famous chieftain , Moletsane. They had six sons       the dedication ceremony he employed an analand two daughters. T he Mohapis set up their         ogy very suited to Lesotho whi ch has many
> home at 'Seqonaka' in 1922 and here Chad-            diamonds . He li kened the discovery of the
> IN MEMORIAM                                                 451
> Some months before his passing the Lesotho
> Baha'is erected a bronze plaque on this spot
> which had been given to the Faith. The inscription, in Sesotho and English, reads in part:
> 'This site is dedicated as a Baha'i meeting place
> in honour of Morena Chadwick Mohapi and
> Mary Mohapi-First Basotho in Lesotho to
> recognize Baha'u'llah as God's Messenger for
> today.'
> Chadwick Mohapi passed away on 4 April
> 1978. His funeral was attended by approximately 800 mourners including the Queen of
> Lesotho, several government ministers and
> officials, principal chiefs and leaders of the business and professional community. A statement read during the programme made reference to the Baha'i concept of death and
> described Mr. Mohapi's position as the first
> believer in Lesotho: 'Mr. Mohapi will always
> occupy a special place in the hearts of the
> Baha'is all over the world because he was the first
> Basotho Baha'i in Lesotho, having become a
> Baha'i in 1954. By this simple act of faith, by
> Mary Mohapi                                 this simple declaration in Baha'u'llah as the
> Prophet for today, Mr. Mohapi unknowingly
> Faith to finding a diamond and said,' At first the                  assured his place in the annals of Baha'i hisstone might look like all the others, but when it                   tory.'
> has been cut and polished it has the power to                          The cablegram received from the Universal
> make a man wealthy for the rest of his life.'                       House of Justice was read at the service:
> And addressing a Unity Conference at the
> GRIEVED PASSING CHADWICK MOHAPI LONG-
> National Baha'i Centre he paid tribute to the
> TIME STEADFAST DEVOTED BELIEVER LESOTHO
> Laws, cautioning the Baha'is: 'Be kind to vis-
> ASSURE    FAMILY     FRIENDS    PRAYERS      HOLY
> itors, friends-you never know who the impor-
> SHRINES PROGRESS HIS SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> tant ones may be.'
> Chadwick Mohapi was honoured by the                                Also read was the tribute cabled by the Con-
> Baha'is of Lesotho in early 1975, marking the                      tinental Board of Counsellors in Southern
> twentieth anniversary of the establishment of                      Africa:
> the Faith in that country. Nearly one hundred
> DEEPLY SADDENED DEPARTURE DEARLY LOVED
> friends gathered at 'Seqonaka' for speeches,
> CHADWICK MOHAPI HIS DISTINGUISHED STATUS
> feasting, and the presentation to Mr. Mohapi
> FIRST BELIEVER LESOTHO MANY SERVICES CAUSE
> of a photograph of the Shrine of the Bab. He
> ASSISTANCE EARLY PIONEERS AND BELIEVERS
> responded by saying, 'Extol me by extolling my
> SURELY    ATTRACTS    CONFIRMATION      BLESSED
> Faith.' He gave a beautiful tree-shaded portion
> BEAUTY ASSURE RELATIVES FRIENDS OUR FER-
> of his land to the Baha'is, marking the corners
> VENT   PRAYERS     PROGRESS    SOUL   STOP    HIS
> with white-painted stones. He hoped that a
> RADIANT SPIRIT WILL ALWAYS BE REMEMBERED.
> prayer house, similar to the Laws' old rondo val
> could be built so that the Baha'is could come,                       He was a man ahead of his time. Through his
> en joy the trees, and pray. In 197 6 the Hand of                   foresight in planting trees at 'Seqonaka', today
> the Cause John Robarts and his wife, Audrey, 1                     the friends enjoy their shade. Similarly,
> had a joyful visit with Mr. Mohapi reminiscing                     through his planting the spiritual seeds of the
> about the early days of the Cause in Lesotho.                      Baha'i Faith in Lesotho, the tree of the Cause
> Mr. and Mrs. Robarts and their son, Patrick , are Knights of   has grown strong and extends its benefits to the
> Baha'u'llah for Bechuanaland (now Botswana) .                  people of that land. He was blessed not only
> 452                                              THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> with an adored wife, many children, grandchildren and great-grandchildren, a number of
> whom have recognized the Faith, but was
> further blessed with spiritual children in
> Lesotho-those who have become Baha'is
> and those unnumbered who will recognize the
> truth of Baha'u'llah's teachings and who will
> remember with grateful hearts the place of
> Chadwick and Mary Mohapi in the Baha'i history of Lesotho.
> CAROLE J. ALLEN
> 
> ELLSWORTH BLACKWELL
> 1902- 1978
> 
> Ellsworth Blackwell was born in Greenville,
> Mississippi on 1 August 1902 to Philip and
> Mary Blackwell of that city. He attended the
> University of Iowa and was a member of the
> Kappa Alpha Psi fraternity. In 1937 he married Ruth Browne, a member of the Chicago
> Ellsworth Blackwell
> Baha'i community, and from that union was
> born a son, Philip Ellsworth, who died in
> infancy.                                                  elected; Ellsworth was the first chairman of
> Ellsworth became a Baha'i in 1934 m                    these institutions. He later became Haiti's first
> Chicago, having studied the Faith at the                  Auxiliary Board member, serving in that
> fireside classes of Mr. and Mrs. Edgar                    capacity until 1970 when he returned to the
> Edwards, and from that time forward ardently              administrative service of the Faith in Haiti on
> participated in all phases of the teaching and            the national level.
> administrative work of the Cause of Baha'u'-                 During their long years in Haiti the Blackllah. He served on the Spiritual Assembly                 wells were strengthened and encouraged by
> of Chicago and was, for a time, a member of the           letters from Shoghi Effendi with whom they
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of             were in frequent correspondence. In his own
> the United States. His pioneering activity                hand the Guardian wrote on 15 April 1941,
> spanned almost a quarter of a century begin-              shortly after they arrived as the first pioneers in
> ning in 1940 under the first Seven Year Plan of           Haiti: 'The work you have done, the sacrifices
> Shoghi Effendi when Ellsworth and his wife                you have made, the historic mission you have
> settled in Haiti, an area where Mr. and Mrs .             initiated, are highly praiseworthy, meritorious
> Louis G. Gregory had spent six months in                  and unforgettable. I will specially pray for you
> 1934, 1 and came to an end when he passed                 both that in whatever field you may labour in
> away at his post in Kananga, Zaire during the             the days to come, Baha'u'llah may reinforce,
> course of the present Five Year Plan of the               guide and bless you and aid you to enrich the
> Universal House of Justice. The Blackwells                record of your pioneer services.' On 21
> spent the years 1940 to 1943 in Haiti; returned           December 1941 Shoghi Effendi wrote: 'I wish
> there for a second period beginning in 1950,              to assure you in person of my deepest and
> under the second Seven Year Plan; and went                abiding appreciation of your devoted and
> there again in 1960, remaining until 197 5. The           indeed historic services. Perseverance will
> first Spiritual Assembly of Haiti was formed in           crown your labours with imperishable glory.
> the capital, Port-au-Prince, in 1942, and in              Rest assured, and never relax in your efforts
> 1961 the first National Spiritual Assembly was            which the rising generation will extol and
> See ' The Bahti'( Centenary: 1844-1944', p. 197 .     admire . You are often in my thoughts and
> IN MEMORIAM                                           453
> prayers. I will always be glad to hear from you,
> and will pray that your dearest hopes may be
> speedily and completely realized.'
> In October 1975 the Blackwells pioneered
> to the Malagasy Republic on the island of
> Madagascar where Ellsworth served on the
> National Spiritual Assembly in 1976-1977.
> Finally, in 1977, they were assigned to the
> Republic of Zaire in Central Africa. Ellsworth
> ascended to the Abha Kingdom on 17 April
> 1978 after a short illness, the first pioneer to lay
> down his life in that African nation. A gleaming white monument marks his resting place
> which overlooks the rolling green countryside
> near Kananga.
> Ellsworth Blackwell was also active in Rotary International in Haiti, Madagascar and
> Zaire. His funeral was attended by a representative of the Rotary Club of Kananga who
> offered a graveside eulogy.
> Ellsworth was a Baha'i speaker and teacher
> of great renown and his voice was heard in
> many far corners of the world; he was highly                     'Inayatu'llah Fananapadhfr
> regarded by all who knew him and worked with
> him in our beloved Faith.
> On 20 April 1978 the Universal House of             father a grounding in the teachings and princi-
> Justice cabled the following tribute:                  ples of the Faith. 'Inayatu'llah, too, was a fine
> penman and was blessed with a keen mind and
> GRIEVED PASSING VALIANT LONGTIME SERVANT
> a prodigious memory . When only fourteen
> CAUSE BAHAULLAH ELLSWORTH BLACKWELL
> years of age, he studied the Kitab-i-Aqdas; the
> STOP OUTSTANDING ENDEAVOURS PIONEERING
> I~fahan Spiritual Assembly assigned him the
> TEACHING     ADMINISTRATIVE     SERVICES   MANY
> task of teaching the Baha'i youth of Najaf-
> LANDS EVIDENCE HIS DEVOTION DEDICATION
> Abad. As a result of a meeting with the Hand
> FAITH HE DEARLY LOVED STOP ASSURE WIFE
> of the Cause Tarazu'llah Samandarf and wit-
> FAMILY FRIENDS PRAYERS HOLY SHRINES PROG-
> nessing the consecration and zeal that charac-
> RESS HIS SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> terized his services to the Cause, 'Inayatu'llah
> RUTH BLACKWELL          vowed to dedicate his life to the Faith in a
> similar manner and by his subsequent services
> proved right to the very end his fidelity to his
> pledge.
> 'INAYATU'LLAH FANANAPADHfR                             At the request of the Persian National
> 1919-1 978                                Spiritual Assembly, 'Inayatu'llah settled in
> Tihran and conducted training institutes until
> 'Inayatu'llah Fananapadhfr (Fananapazir) was           the inception of the forty-five month Plan in
> born into a devout Baha'i family in I~fahan, in        October 1946 when the National Spiritual
> 1919. His father, Fa<;llu'llah Nurf, was a Baha'i      Assembly accepted his request to proceed as a
> teacher and calligraphist of distinction; exquis-      pioneer to 'Iraq. For some two years he resided
> ite examples of the transcriptions he made of          at Ba_g!!dad and Karbila and Kazimayn conveynumerous sacred Writings of the Faith may be           ing the message to the people in those areas
> found even today in Baha'i homes in I~fahan            until the day when most of the friends were
> and environs.                                          constrained to return home. 'Inayatu'llah was
> 'Inayatu'llah completed his secondary edu-          among this number and at the instance of the
> cation in his home town and received from his          National Spiritual Assembly he went to
> 454                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Khuzistan to teach the Faith and animate the         hearty appreciation of the National Spiritual
> believers. Later he was assigned similar work        Assembly of Persia and the Local Spiritual
> in Kirman where, in the following year, he           Assembly ofTihran alike. He continued in sermarried 'Ishrat Khanum Ghaybf (Rabbani).             vice thus until 19 April 1978 when he suddenly
> Two sons and one daughter, the issue of that         passed away.
> union, are all qualified physicians today a nd          Among the published and unpublished
> worthy       servants in      God's      Vineyard.   works of 'Inayatu'llah Fananapadhfr are
> 'Inayatu'llah's teaching efforts in Kirman bore      Manahiju'l-Hidayat, Dururu'l-Akhbar and
> a goodly harvest. He moved thereafter to Barn,       Aftsanu'l-Tafasirih. In addition he wrote pam-
> Zahidan , Khash, Saravan and fran-Shahr, car-        phlets for senior Baha'i students and articles
> rying on the teaching and consolidation work.        for publication in the Baha'i journal of Persia.
> Then came a short break in his full-time Baha'i         In tribute to his services, the Universal
> service. Turning his hand to trade for a time        House of Justice cabled:
> and bringing to bear upon it the full force of his
> DEEPLY GR IEVED PASSING DEVOTED SERVANT
> intelligence and initiative, he soon achieved
> FAITH    INAYATULLAH     FANANAPAZIR    WHOSE
> substantial success in the material field.
> SERVICES    TEACHING   WORK   CRAD LE    FAITH
> In 1954 while on pilgrimage to the Holy
> PIONEERING FIELDS AFRICA WILL ALWAYS BE
> Land the beloved Guardian advised him to
> LOVINGLY REMEMBERED STOP ASSURE FAMILY
> devote his full time and thought to Baha'i
> PROFOUND      SYMPATHY     FERVENT     PRAYERS
> work. On his return home, acting on the
> SHRINES PROGRESS HIS SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> instructions of the National Spiritual Assembly, he visited a number of centres in Iran to       (Memorial compiled by Dr. Masha'allah
> stimulate Baha'i pioneering activity and, in         Mushrif-Zadih at the request of the National
> 1957, with the encouragement of Shoghi               Spiritual Assembly of Persia. Translated and
> Effendi, he arose and, surmounting the many          edited by Rustom Sabit.)
> obstacles that beset his path, went as a pioneer
> to Africa. He was resident in the Gambia, his
> first post, for four years when illness forced him
> ERNEST GREGORY
> to leave for Marrakesh. Regaining health , he
> 1899-1978
> attended the Jubilee celebrations in London
> after which he returned to Marrakesh. Under
> It is difficult for me to write about my dear
> instructions from the Universal House of Jushusband and beloved companion in Baha'i sertice , he then went to Kenya where he stayed
> vice. There is little I can add to the wonderful
> fifteen years. During this period he visited
> tributes paid to his outstanding qualities and
> other centres in Africa, teaching non-Baha'is
> devoted service to the Cause he loved so sinand stimulating Baha'is to still greater effort.
> cerely.
> Among the countries he visited were Tanzania,
> On his passing the Universal House of Jus-
> Uganda, Ethiopia, Zambia, Rhodesia, Malawi,
> tice cabled the National Spiritual Assembly of
> Botswana, Somali and Sudan, and finally, in
> the United Kingdom:
> accordance with directions from the World
> Centre, he proceeded to visit Mali, Senegal,           ANNOUNCE PASSING TO ABHA KINGDOM MORN-
> the Gambia, Ghana and the Ivory Coast.                 ING OF FIRST DAY OF RIDVA N DISTINGUISHED
> On this journey he fell ill and was forced to       SERVANT BAHAULLAH ERNEST GREGORY STOP
> return to Kenya. Following a period in hospital        HIS     OUTSTANDING    CONTRIBUTION     GROWTH
> he returned to fran to visit relatives and             BRITISH BAHAI COMMUNITY AS MEMBER MANY
> friends . The warmth and affection of the wel-         YEARS    NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLY AND
> come accorded him attested the esteem in                LATER MEMBER AUXILIARY BOARD ENSURES HIM
> which he was held by the Baha'is. Full advan-          HIGH PLACE THAT COMMUN ITYS ANNALS STOP
> tage was taken of his presence and full use            HIS STERLING QUALITIES ENDEARED HIM TO ALL
> made of his talents, especially in the fields of      AT WORLD CENTRE FAITH WHERE HIS           LOSS
> teacher-training and of delivering the message         KEENLY FELT STOP ADVISE BRITISH COMMUNITY
> to students in the higher grades. His strenuous       JOIN PRAYERS THANKSGIVING HIS LIFE PROG-
> labours in these various fields won him the            RESS HIS SOUL.
> IN MEMORJAM                                             455
> 
> the British Isles. Ernest and I married in 1959
> and served together on the National Teaching
> Committee, until my appointment to the Auxiliary Protection Board in 1960.
> In 1963 he accepted appointment to the
> Auxiliary Board for Propagation , serving on
> this Board until 1974. His area of Auxiliary
> Board service covered the north and midlands
> of England , the western and northern isles of
> Scotland, Iceland and Farnes. He had a great
> love for the islands and visited the pioneers and
> local believers there frequently. As a teacher
> he was single-minded, indefatigable and dedicated. Baha'fs young in the Faith have spoken
> of the inspiration they received from his frankness and directness. During the closing years of
> his life he had periods of intense suffering but
> even at these times he maintained always that
> sense of humour which characterized his life
> and endeared him to so many friends.
> From 1974 until the time of his death on the
> first day of Ric;lvan 1978, we both served at the
> Ernest Gregory                        World Centre. When at one time I asked him
> what had drawn him towards the Faith he
> replied: 'The administrative order-the World
> Ernest was the third local resident to accept       Order of Baha'u'llah.' Of this, Amatu'l-Baha
> the Bah a 'f Faith in Sheffield, England in 1951.      Ru~fyyih Khanum said to me, 'Moreover, he
> He was at that time a widower with one son . He        understood it.'
> was very actively associated with, and had                Through the bounty of Bahii' u'llah he rests
> achieved a high position in, Freemasonry. With         now on God's Holy Mountain so near to where
> much sacrifice he severed himself from this            the arc of the administration-the physical
> association and, in this connection , a letter         expression of that World Order - is presently
> dated 5 August 1955 was received by the                taking shape.
> National Spiritual Assembly of the British Isles                                         JOAN GREGORY
> (as it was then known) from the beloved Guardian through his secretary containing the following message: 'He wishes you to thank Mr.
> Gregory on his behalf for the spirit of devotion                      JAVAN GUTOS
> to the Faith which he has shown in connection                           1916-1978
> with this matter ... The older Baha'fs, through
> their example in such matters, form rallying           Javan Gutos, known as 'Gutosi', was born in
> points around which the younger Baha'fs not            Tome Village in South Bugisu District,
> so steady yet on their spiritual legs, so to speak ,   Uganda. His family were members of the Buta
> can cluster.'                                          sub-clan. Javan was the third of ten children
> Ernest served on the British National               born to his parents, Mr. and Mrs. Wamai, and
> Spiritual Assembly from 1954 to 1963. During           early in his life he evinced praiseworthy characthese years he was also chairman of the                teristics. As a child he assisted in caring for his
> National Teaching Committee and when he                younger brothers and when he grew older
> was without family responsibilities he devoted         served as his father's goat-herd. He attended
> every hour, beyond the requirements of his             Nabumali Intermediary School and then
> profession, to these services; it was as though        King's College Buda, from 1936 through
> he had become the father of all the small and          1937, but was unable to go on to university.
> new Local Spiritual Assemblies up and down             When his schooling was completed he joined
> 456                                    THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> tral and East Africa, 1 his own home being a
> focal point of activities of the Cause in Uganda.
> In 1974 he was appointed to the Auxiliary
> Board for protection in Central and East
> Africa and, until the appointment of additiona l
> members to the Board, his territory embraced
> the whole of Eastern , Karamoja, Northern and
> Nile Provinces in Uganda. In spite of failing
> health in the last few months of his life, he
> insisted on accompanying the members of the
> Board of Counsellors on a major tour of his
> area during the difficult period when the Faith
> was under proscription .
> He passed away peacefully on 7 May 1978 .
> The Hand of the Cause Enoch O linga was in
> attendance at his funeral with Mrs. Olinga.
> Also present were two members of the Continental Board of Counsellors and many other
> Baha'is, members of his fami ly and a number of
> prominent government officials. Informed of
> his passing the Universal House of Justice
> cabled on 11 May:
> Javan Gutos                             .. . HEARTS FILLED SORROW NEWS PASSING
> DEVOTED PROMOTER FAITH JAVAN GUTOS I CON-
> VEY LOVING SYMPATHY HIS BEREAVED FAMILY
> PRAYING HOLY SHRINES PROGRESS HIS SOUL .
> the East African Railways and Harbours in
> Nairobi, retiring in 194 7 from his position as                                              KOLONARIO 0ULE
> station master. For the next ten years he
> worked as an overseer for the Bugisu Coffee
> Union in Uganda and later as a salesman for
> Mr. 'Aziz Yazdi's Nairobi-based company,                                 GORDON LAITE
> International Products. In 1962 he began farm-                             1925-1978
> ing in Uganda. He was appointed Parish Chief
> for the territory under the jurisdiction of the      Striving for excellence was characteristic of
> Mba le Municipal Council near his home in            Gordon Laite in all his endeavours. He excel-
> Busamaga, and served with distinction until his      led in his profession as a painter and illustrator
> retirement in 1977.                                  of children's books, achieving national acclaim
> Mr. Gutos was a devout Christian. His early       for published work. His paintings hang in prispiritual training disposed him to accept the        vate collections scattered about the globe.
> Baha'i Faith when he encountered it in Mbale         Exhibits of his work have served to proclaim
> in 1953 where a Baha'i community had been            the teachings of Baha'u'llah, and his illustraestablished a year previous to this as a result of   tions have graced the pages of Baha'i publicaa spontaneous visit made by Mr. Enoch Olinga         tions. Drawing upon his scholarly knowledge
> and Mr. 'Ali Nak!!javani en route to their           of history, art, architecture and costume, he
> intended destination in the Teso District. He        incorporated accurate details, fine draftsmanbecame a member of the first Local Spiritual         ship and boundless imagination into a unique
> Assembly of Mbale in 1953 when he had been           expression, reaching the highest level in those
> a Baha'i but three months and served on local        paintings which explored the realms of spirit
> and national committees with exemplary devo-         and expressed concepts of the new age .
> tion . He greatly loved the Faith and until 1974         This regional assembly existed from 1956 until 1964 when
> it was subdivided into three bodies, the National Spiritual
> rendered remarkable services on behalf of the            Assemblies of Tanzania, of Kenya, and of Uganda and
> Regional National Spiritual Assembly of Cen-             Central Africa.
> IN MEMORIAM                                             457
> The same grasp of history and attention to
> detai l helped Gordon develop as a teacher and
> administrator within the Baha'i community.
> He served on several Local Spiritual Assemblies in the United States and in pioneer posts in
> Latin America; as a delegate to the national
> conventions of the United States, Honduras
> and Puerto Rico; and as a member of the
> Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Puerto
> Rico which , until 1972 , was under the jurisdiction of the United States National Assembly.
> His presentations of the Revelation of Baha'u' -
> llah in fireside discussions, public talks,
> classes at Baha'i schools and conferences were
> enhanced by direct quotations from the Writings, usually from memory, a nd often by
> de lightful visual aids created for the occasion.
> Gordon also excelled in his passage through
> the tests and trials of this earthly plane. His
> hearty laugh, his vigorous stride as he walked
> about the city or countryside always seeking
> those souls who hungered for spiritual knowledge, his desire to create beauty whether in                                    Gordon Laite
> arranging flowers, in decorating a room, in
> painting an impression of spirit or in helping to
> draw forth the inherent beauty of an insecure                  the New York World's Fair. He first investior unhappy person, his sympathetic and strong                  gated the Baha'i teachings when his wife's
> counsel centred in the Sacred Texts-these                      mother, Jean Marshall Ball, embraced the
> qualities dominated in even the most difficult                 Faith. Through that introduction, followed by
> and discouraging times. Perhaps more than in                   the loving and dedicated teaching efforts of Dr.
> any other way, he excelled in the transition                   and Mrs. David Ruhe, the Laites entered the
> from his earthly life, meeting the pain of termi-              Cause of God on 11 November 1955 in Kansas
> nal illness with calm, joyous and truly radiant                City, Missouri. A quiet, almost reclusive life at
> acquiescence, going eagerly to meet his Lord in                once changed quite dramatically . The Laite
> the longed-for realms of light.                                home became a centre of Baha'i activity, a
> The journey of Gordon's soul began in New                   condition which remained constant throughout
> York city where he was born on 11 July 1925.                   Gordon's life . As the ocean of divine knowl-
> His mother, Blanche Fisher Laite, an illus-                    edge was entered, Gordon's work underwent
> trator of chi ldren's books, took him to live for              significant changes too. An influx of spirit was
> a time in Paris; French was his first language.                experienced, emerging in a totally new expres-
> As a young man he studied at the Chicago Art                   sion. He became established as an illustrator, a
> Institute in which building the Baha'i Faith was               development which enabled the Laites to
> first mentioned in the West during the Con-                    move , with their son, Winter, and daughter,
> gress of Religions as part of the Columbian                    Gina, to Gallup, New Mexico, to help offer the
> Exposition of 1893. 1 A fellow art student,                    healing message of Baha'u'llah to the Indian
> Jeanne Sanchez Marshall, later became his                      people. They remained in New Mexico for elevwife .                                                         en years, finding it an enriching experience
> Gordon visited the Baha'i House of Worship                  and developing cherished friendships among
> in Wilmette, Illinois and the Baha'i exhibit at                the Navajo, Zuni, Hopi, Taos and other of the
> south-west tribes . Gordon was given the Zuni
> See 'The Ba ha'i Faith Comes to America', The Bahli 'f     name ChahBah (Grasshopper) and the Navajo
> Centenary 1844-1944, p. 78. The Congress met in the Hall
> of Columbus, a part of the Memorial Art Palace, now the    name Hosteen BahaZhonie (Happy Man); he
> Chicago Art Institute.                                     often signed his paintings with these honorifics .
> 458                                     THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> They later pioneered to Honduras and Puerto
> Rico where Gordon, with typical enthusiasm,
> embraced a new culture and language. The
> Laites served on a vigorous Local Spiritual
> Asse mbly and lived for five yea rs in the Baha'f
> Centre in Mayaguez, Puerto Rico. T hose years
> brought man y bounties including pilgrimage to
> the Holy Land and attendance at the International Conference held in Merida, Yucatan in
> February 1977 where the warm and gracious
> welcome by the Mayan Indian people provided
> a spirit-lifting view of the futur e Baha'f World
> Commonwealth enhanced by the special qualities of the indigenous peoples .
> Attendance as delegates to the 1978 International Convention in Haifa for the election of
> the Universal House of Justice had been joyfully anticipated by Gordon and Jeanne but
> was not possible because Gordon underwent
> extensive surgery; nevertheless they felt they
> had been granted a divine bounty in being
> enabled, during a brief period of recuperation,
> to pray together and to cast their ballots by
> Marian Steffes
> mail.
> Following Gordon's release to the next
> world on 26 May 1978 the Universal House of           rediscovery and rebirth of the spiritual princi-
> Justice, on 30 May, cabled:                           ples inherent in the true Indian way of life. She
> was among the first American Indians to accept
> SHA RE SORROW AT PASS ING GORDON           LAITE
> the Cause of Baha'u'llah and for over forty
> DEVOTED ZEALOUS SERVANT BLESSED BEAUTY
> years, until her health fa iled, she devoted her-
> WHO H AS TIRELESSLY JOYO USLY EXPENDED HIS
> self to teaching the Faith to members of various
> TALENTS FOR CAUSE STOP ASSURE WIFE FAMILY
> Indian tribes throughout the United States,
> PRAYERS OFFERED HOLY SHRINES PROGRESS HIS
> using her own funds to cover her travelling
> SOUL ABHA KI NGDOM.
> expenses. One of her first teachers was the
> JEA NNE SANCH EZ DE LAITE        beloved Baha'f, 'Auntie' Victoria Bedikian, 1
> who accompanied her on some of her travels.
> Together they travelled through the State of
> Wisconsin introducing the Faith for the first
> time to the Indian people there. Of particular
> MARIAN STEFFES                           interest to Marian were the Baha'f concepts of
> 1900-1978                              social justice, respect for human rights, the
> need for developing spiritual faculties and
> Marian Steffes was born on 14 June 1900 in            maintaining sound health of mind and body,
> Oneida, Wisconsin where she lived with her            and the emphasis on peace among the nations
> family on a large farm. Her parents were              in which she saw hope for harmony among all
> Oneida Indians, o ne of the six American              Indian tribes.
> Indian tribes belonging to the Iroq uo is Nation.        Marian was known and loved by many peo-
> It was during her early years with her parents        ple for her kindness , gentleness and warmthat she lea rne d the Iroquois culture which         heartedness, and dedicated herself to passing
> strongly influe nced her life . At age thirty-five,   on good values to her children and grandchilwhile living in Milwaukee, Wisconsin with her         dren. She passed on to the Abha Kingdom on
> husband and children, she became interested           14 June 1978. On her headstone is inscribed
> in the Baha'f Faith which to her represented a        1
> See 'In Memoriam', The Baha'i World , vo l. XIII, p. 884.
> IN MEMORIAM                                           459
> 'She walks in beauty'-an adage of the Navajo
> culture as well as a phrase from Byron's poem .
> On 19 June a cablegram came from the Universal House of Justice:
> GRIEVED LOSS STAUNCH OUTSTANDING NATIVE
> AMERICAN TEACHER CAUSE MARJAN STEFFES STOP
> KINDLY CONVEY FAMILY OUR LOVING SYMPATHY
> AND ASSURANCE PRAYERS FOR THE PROGRESS OF
> HER SOUL IN THE KINGDOMS OF GOD.
> 
> ELIZABETH S. LAWS
> 1888-1977
> Knight of Baha'u'llah
> 
> Elizabeth S. Laws, 'Beth', was born in St.
> Louis, Missouri on 20 September 1888. When
> she was still a small child her family moved to
> Spokane, Washington . It was from there that
> most of her childhood memories and stories
> came. When Beth was just thirteen years old
> Elizabeth S. Laws
> her mother became very ill and died. After a
> short time the family was broken apart and
> Beth was sent to live with her grandparents in     soon thereafter moved to San Diego, Califor-
> Grand Rapids, Michigan . Grandfather Adams,        nia to help rebuild the Spiritual Assembly.
> a graduate of Dartmouth, was a Christian           Some years later they returned to the Pacific
> minister and although strict, seemingly to the     Northwest where Frederick attended Oregon
> point of cruelty, he nevertheless cared for her.   State University.
> She was able to complete her formal education         In response to the call of the Guardian, Beth
> and ultimately to earn her teaching certificate.   and Frederick Laws decided to pioneer to
> While Beth was teaching in a little one-room       Africa. On 23 January 1953 they loaded their
> school in Indiana she met Walter Ware. They        belongings in their little car and trailer and
> married in 1910 and had four children : John       headed for New York , sailing aboard The Afri-
> Walter, born in 1912; James Albert, in 1914;       can Sun to their pioneering post in Nairobi,
> Imogene Frances, in 1917; and Lewis Adams,         Kenya. After a long trip across the Atlantic,
> in 1921.                                           down the west coast of Africa, around the Cape
> The Ware family moved to Seattle,               of Good Hope and back up the east coast, they
> Washington in 1923. Beth, always a keen Bible      arrived only to find that they were not needed
> student, became very active in the Presbyterian    in Nairobi as the goal had already been met and
> church and her children were given the training    the Faith appeared to be flourishing. Shoghi
> that such an association had to offer. Eventu-     Effendi had called upon Baha'i communities
> ally the marriage ended in divorce and Beth        with more than fifteen believers to send
> remained in Seattle with the children. She         pioneers to virgin areas. As Beth said, 'He
> became interested in Esperanto and while           dangled a carrot before us.' In his cablegram of
> attending classes taught by Lauren Jackson, a      28 May 1953 1 the Guardian called for ' the
> Baha'i, she found both the Baha'i Faith and a      dispersal, immediate, determined, sustained
> young man named Frederick Laws. Frederick          and universal, throughout the unopened terwas younger than she but they became loving        ritories of the planet,' describing it as 'the
> friends and shared a devotion which took them      paramount issue challenging the spirit and
> through many years and many places through-        resources of the privileged prosecutors of the
> out the world. They were married in 1939 and       'Messages to the Baha'f World , p. 48.
> 460                                            THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Ten Year Plan' and announcing his plan 'to                     returned to the northwestern United States.
> inscribe, in chronological order, the na mes of                Then in August 1958 Beth returned to Liberia
> the spiritual conquerors on an illuminated Roll                for a short time where she taught in the school
> of Honour, to be deposited at the entrance                     at Bombi Hills. However, she found herself
> door of the inner Sanctuary of the Tomb of                     incomplete without her partner and returned
> Baha'u'llah, as a permanent memorial' and to                   to America.
> make 'periodic announcements of the names of                      After Frederick's retirement they once again
> the valiant knights upon their arrival at their                decided to return to Africa to help fulfil the
> posts to discharge their historic missions.'                   goals of the Five Year Plan. On 8 April 1976
> Frederick built a 'little house' on the chassis             they left for a new post in Tanzania. Their stay
> of their utility trailer and the couple headed                 there was very short, only eight months. They
> south traversing 3,000 miles of difficult roads                were unable to obtain permanent visas to
> to reach their new-chosen destination, the little              remain in the country and by this time Beth was
> country then called Basutoland (now                            beginning to feel a loss of physical stamina.
> Lesotho). They arrived on 13 October 1953                      Their parting gesture was to make a generous
> just three days before the end of the Holy                     contribution to the cost of constructing Baha'i
> Year. 1 In his cablegram sent on 14 October                    Centres in Tanzania.
> 1953 to the Intercontinental Teaching Confer-                     In the spring of 1977 Beth and Frederick
> ence held in New Delhi, the Guardian                           moved to Wapato, Washington on the Yakima
> announced thirteen additions to the Roll of                    Indian Reservation where their help was
> Honour including Frederick and Elizabeth                       needed to maintain the Local Spiritual Assem-
> Laws, Knights of Baha'u'llah for Basutoland.                   bly. It was here that Beth passed on to the
> The Laws lived in Basutoland for about                      Abha Kingdom on 24 June 1978. As the end
> thirty months, setting up housekeeping in a                    neared, I recall her taking her pencil and pad
> little round house owned by Mary and Chad-                     and writing, 'I'm dying- thank God-Abha
> wick Mohapi. 2 Beth loved the people very                      Kingdom.'
> much and through simple acts of kindness won                      On 18 July the Universal House of Justice
> love in response. In time Beth was given an                    cabled the National Spiritual Assembly of the
> African name which translated from Basuto                      United States:
> meant 'Mother of Love'. Despite difficulties
> INFORM FREDERICK LAWS WAPATO WASHING -
> with the language the Cause grew. Reflecting
> TON GRIEVED NEWS PASSING KNIGHT BAHAU-
> on her experiences Beth wrote some years
> LLAH DEAR BETH WHOSE PIONEERING TEACHING
> later: '. . . the Cause moves forward. Our
> SERVICES LOVINGLY REMEMBERED ASSURE HIM
> mighty Lord takes our inadequate words, our
> FERVENT PRAY ERS PROGRESS HER SOUL.
> puny efforts, and causes them to bring great
> results. Those who hear go out to tell many                                                   LEWIS A. WARE
> others- the chain is endless to eternity.'
> It was time to move on. The Laws went south
> to Johannesburg where they spent about six
> weeks with William and Marguerite Sears;                       GHULAM-'ALI IBRAHfMJt KACHWALA
> then, after consultation with the Hands of the                          (KURLA WALA)
> Cause Musa Bananf and Paul Haney, they pro-                                1896- 1978
> ceeded to Gambia and Liberia. In Liberia Fre-                         Knight of Baha'u'llah
> derick worked for an engineering firm building
> roads in rural areas where he and Beth were                    Ghulam-'Ali Kachwala (known as Ghulamali
> able to live and work once again with the Afri-                Kurlawala) was born in 1896 into a family
> can people, always teaching .                                  descended from the ancient Hindu Rajput
> In December 1957 Beth and Frederick                         princes who were known for their exploits on
> The 'Year Nine', marking the centenary of the year 1269      the battlefield and it was perhaps from them
> A.H. The centenary of the birth of the mission of Baha'u'-   that he inherited his indomitable courage, fiery
> llah was observed throughout the Baha'i world during the     nature and quick temper. He heard of the Baha'i
> year mid-October 1952 and mid-October 1953. See The
> Baha'{ World, vol. XII, p. 25.                               Cause in 1926 from the well-known Baha'i
> See 'In Memoriam', p. 449.                                   teacher, Dr. M. E. Luqmani, and for one full
> IN MEMORIAM                                               461
> 
> year resisted it with all his might, arguing that
> divine revelation ended with Islam. Dr. Luqmani being well versed in Islamic scripture was
> able to adduce quotations to prove his point
> and as a result Ghulam-' Ali's inner eye was
> opened and he accepted the Faith. Then began
> Ghulam-' Ali's transformation as he struggled
> to curb his temper. Such was his success that
> one observer remarked , 'He was a lion and he
> has become a lamb. This is a miracle of the
> Baha'i Faith!'
> Although he had attended primary school
> for only two years and could write only a
> broken and elementary Gujarati, he made
> efforts to improve his situation after he
> embraced the Cause. Baha'i literature in Urdu
> was available; he learned the language and
> read and re-read the Baha'i books. He was a
> I
> plumber by occupation and also repaired sewing machines and stoves; he could manufacture
> replacement parts for machines of any description. He was extremely industrious a nd honest
> and therefore popular among his customers.                             Ghulam-'A[{ Kurlawala
> But he did not submerge himself in his work.
> His love for the Faith was so great that if he did
> not find an opportunity to present the message          serve Them wholeheartedly and with devotion,
> to one or more persons during the day he could          I will be dismissed.' And serve he did, faithnot sleep at night. He lacked urbanity and              fully , indefatigably and fearlessly. There are at
> finesse and taught in a direct manner, coming           least 20,000 Muslims living in one locality in
> to the subject without any preface. He would            Kurla and to one and all he gave the message.
> discuss the religions of the past and the               Some responded with scorn , some called him
> prophecies in the holy books referring to the           mad, some abused and ridiculed him. He
> advent of the Promised One and then would               received at least ten beatings to my knowledge,
> speak of the fulfilment of these prophecies             but he was unaffected and continued to teach
> through the coming of Baha'u'llah. He was no            the Cause, his talks centring around Baha'u'-
> less frank in rejecting the financial inducement        llah and His World Order.
> offered to him by a Muslim high priest who                 He served as vice-chairman of the Spiritual
> sought to entice him back to Islam. Divine              Assembly of Andheri, a suburb of Bombay,
> truth, he said in effect, cannot be bought or           from 1937 until Andheri was incorporated into
> sold, and he invited the priest to investigate the      the municipality of Bombay, and then in 1942
> claim of Baha'u'llah. He was summarily dis-             he pioneered to Bhopal where his non-stop
> missed and considered a 'lost soul'.                    teaching activities set fire to the dovecots of the
> Although his family name was Kachwala,              mullas. At that time Bhopal was a native state
> meaning a dealer in glass and glassware,               ruled by a Muslim nawab (governor) who was
> Ghulam-Ali was known in the Baha'i commu-               under the influence of the mullas. Offended by
> nity as Kurlawala because he resided in Kurla , a       Ghulam-'Ali's assertion that the days of
> suburb of Bombay. He was proud that 'Ali was           efficacy of Islam had come to an end, they rose
> part of his name, and would often smile and            up with full force against him. He telegraphed
> say: 'I am the slave of 'Ali. 'Ali is the first part   the scholarly Siyyid Mal)flq:u'l-I:Iaq 'Ilmi 1 who
> of the name of the Bab ('Ali Mul)ammad) and             came to his assistance accompanied by Mrs.
> the last part of the name of Baha'u'llah               Shirin Boman. For one month they met with
> (I:Iusayn 'Ali); therefore I must always be            the Muslim priests without avail although one
> faithful to both my glorious Masters. If I do not       1
> See 'In Memoriam', p. 446.
> 462                                            THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> of the Muslim scholars, Maulavi Sondagar,                     found him in bed. We summoned a doctor,
> conceded that the language of the Writings of                 bathed and nursed him and cleaned his house,
> Baha'u ' llah was as inspired as that of the                  and soon he recovered. We also met the Baha'i
> Qur'an. The mullas of that citadel° of Islam,                 community. Not long after this his teach ing
> having seen the stuff Ghulam-' Ali was made of                activities resulted in some elements of the Musand being apprehensive of his further teaching                lim community lodging a complaint against
> efforts, brought pressure to bear on the nawab                him . A police inquiry ensued the finding of
> and secured an order expelling him from                       which was that he was a peace-loving, law-
> Bhopal state where he had stayed but six                      abiding citizen who adhered to and taught an
> months. Undeterred, he then spent some                        independent religion advocating international
> months assisting Mrs. Boman at her pioneering                 peace. Stricter security measures were
> post in Ujjain.                                               enforced so that he could teach more effec-
> In 1949, under the Indian Six Year Plan , he               tively .
> pioneered to Jaipur where he remained for two                    After he returned to Bombay he pursued his
> years. Here he established a Local Assembly                   occupation and continued his service to the
> and a stable community. His sense of self                     Cause of God. Although his neighbours and
> respect always prevented him from accepting                   fellow-workers continued to act prejudicially
> assistance from the friends and institutions; to              toward him he was undaunted in his teaching
> support himself he drove a rickshaw in Jaipur.                efforts.
> While there he visited the head priest and                       On one occasion in this period he learned
> informed him that the Day of Judgment had                     that a Shi'ite mulla was delivering in the
> come and that the Manifestation of God for                    Mughul Masjid in Bombay MuJ:iarram sermons
> this age, Baha'u'llah, had announced His                      in which he misrepresented the Baha'i teach-
> World Order. The mulla, much incensed ,                       ings, so he hastened to attend. More than a
> asked him to leave his house at once and never                thousand people had gathered to hear the serto pass by that road thereafter.                              mon during the course of which the mulla
> In 1953 Ghulam-'Alf was named a Knight of                  heaped abuse on the Baha'is and inquired
> Baha'u'llah 1 for his service in pioneering to                whether anyone would like to know more.
> Daman, Portuguese Goa, where he remained                      Ghulam-' Ali raised his hand and said, in effect,
> for approximately two years. Teaching the                     that if the Baha'is were as they had been
> Faith was extremely difficult because prohibi-                 described-unscrupulous liars and adultertion was in force in India and many people                    ers-how could it be that the Baha'i Faith was
> from nearby Indian areas came to Daman to                     growing so rapidly? I have many friends who
> buy foreign goods and liquor. The local people                 are Baha'is, he continued , and I find them honbrewed liquor in their homes and nearly all,                  est, conscientious and of excellent moral
> young and old, men and women, drank heavily.                  character. The priest denounced him as a Baha'i
> I once asked him how he could have hoped to                   and the congregation set upon him beating
> find listeners in such a discouraging environ-                 him about the head and leaving him unconment and was told, 'Two things prompted me                     scious. His clothing had been torn and his wrist
> to make ceaseless efforts in giving the Message,               watch and purse stolen. He was taken to a
> the need of the people to be brought from the                  hospital and after a night's treatment was sent
> path of negativity to the path of God, and my                  home. So great was the impact upon the mulla
> desire to please our beloved Guardian.' His                    that he ceased from that point on abusing the
> efforts were blessed and found fruition in the                 Baha'is. Ghulam-'Alf remained as fearless and
> formation of a Spiritual Assembly with mem-                    brave as ever in presenting the Faith to all who
> bers of various backgrounds.                                   would listen.
> During his time in Daman word reached the                      In 1970 he sustained an injury as the result
> National Spiritual Assembly of India that                      of an explosion and after a long period of time
> Ghulam-' Ali was in ill health and at the request              recovered, although from that time forward he
> of the assembly Mr. G. A. Amreliwala , then a                  had only partial use of one arm. When he
> memberof that body, and I, visited Daman and                  returned to work he was not the same man. He
> Messages to the Baha'( World, Shoghi Effendi, cablegram    had had a strong build and lived an active life,
> 20 September 1953 , pp . 50-52 .                           often under hardships, and was accustomed to
> IN MEMORIAM                                            463
> carrying heavy loads in his trade asa plumber. By
> this time he had spent more than forty years in
> service to the Cause , travelling from place to
> place, pioneering from city to city. Now he
> began to show signs of fatigue . He changed his
> modus operandi, remaining in his shop , so that
> all who wished to see him had to come there. It
> is praiseworthy that even at this stage he did
> not reduce the tempo of teaching. His energy
> had ebbed , his temper had sobered , but his
> spiritual enthusiasm and his love for Baha'u' -
> llah appeared to increase. Despite the
> uncertainties of transportation, the lengthy
> delays and the distances he was required to
> walk , he regularly attended all Baha'i gatherings. His eyesight failed three years before his
> death so he could only sit in his shop and talk of
> the Blessed Beauty. He was confined to bed for
> the last month of his life and on 3 July 1978 he
> left this transitory world.
> Although he was neither educated nor wealthy, Ghulam-'Ali was a spiritual king. He was
> generous of heart and delighted in serving                             Ruth J. Moffett
> everyone. He loved the Baha'fs and wholeheartedly associated with them. He spent
> more than half a century in the service of            teacher and writer passed away, the entire
> the Cause and under its banner he was always           Baha'i world lost one of those shining examactive, eager to do anything to serve it. When         ples of courage and sacrifice that lights the way
> he joined the Faith there were only a few             for others. On learning of her passing, the Unihundred Baha'fs in India. He lived to see it           versal House of Justice in a cablegram dated 6
> strike deep roots in our soil and produce a            July 1978 addressed to the National Spiritual
> flourishing community now numbering more               Assembly of the United States, lauded her serthan half a million. He played his part valiantly      vices in these words:
> and well.
> DEEPLY    GRIEVED   NEWS    PASSING   DEVOTED
> In its letter of 28 September 1978 the Uni-
> MAIDSERVANT BAHAULLAH RUTH MOFFETT. HER
> versal House of Justice wrote: 'Mr. Ghulam-
> INDIVIDUAL    TEACHING     EFFORTS    SPANNING
> , Alf Kurlawala's devoted services to the Faith are
> HALF     CENTURY    UNFORGETTABLE     OFFERING
> surely rewarded by the Blessed Beauty and his
> ARDENT PRAYERS HOLY SHRINES PROGRESS HER
> name as a Knight of Baha' u'llah has become
> SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.
> immortal in the history of the Formative Age
> of the Cause.'                                            Born Ruth J. Ellis on 19 January 1880 in
> (Adapted from a memoir written by Prof. Dip-           Eau Claire, Wisconsin, she grew up in a tradichand Khianra) .                                       tional Baptist home. On 8 June 1910 she married Robert Lee Moffett and had two children
> by him, both of whom died in their childhood
> years.
> RUTH J. MOFFETI                             In 1912 she began an ardent search for
> 1880-1978                             'Abdu'l-Baha Whom she saw briefly from a
> train platform in Chicago. She recalled that
> Ruth Moffett was an indomitable spirit whose           moment: 'He looked up at me, smiled and
> valiant efforts on behalf of the Cause of Baha' u' -   raised His hand.' Finally, having attended one
> llah extended over a period in excess of half          of 'Abdu'l-Baha's lectures, Ruth became an
> a century. When this noted Baha'i lecturer,            active Baha'i in 1919 and began her unceasing
> 464                                      TH E BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> and concentrated efforts toward promoting the           seize and utilize it for the glory a nd triumph of
> Message of Baha' u' ll ah.                              o ur sacred Faith.' (15 March 1932)
> She was a special delega te to th e League of           ' I wish to ass ure yo u in person of my deep
> Nations in Geneva and was se nt by Washing-             and abiding se nse of appreciation of th e histo n University of St. Louis, Missouri as an            toric services you are renderi ng the Ca use of
> acc redite d observer to the birth of the United        God in these days of unprecede nted suffering
> Na tions in San Francisco. She also attended            and turmoil. The part yo u have played, and the
> a nd repo rted on nine World Co ngresses in             share yo u are still contributing for the promo-
> E urope.                                                tion of the Faith, future generations will extol
> Mrs. Moffett atte nded Oberlin Co llege and         a nd remember with gratitude a nd pride . . .'
> the U nive rsities of Chicago, Wisconsin and            (11 May 1933)
> Nor thweste rn , in the United Sta tes, and Uni-            At the suggestion of the Guardian , Ruth
> ve rsite de Geneve, in Switzerland. With her            kept a record of her acti vities and eventuall y
> husband , she conducted a Training School and           compiled them into a rathe r extensive collec-
> E ducation al Forum in Chicago fo r fifteen             tion. More rece ntl y, he r teaching work took
> yea rs; she also taught at George Williams Co l-        he r to the deep South of the United States
> lege, Chicago, for seven yea rs.                        where she participated in the first efforts to
> Ruth was a champion teacher for the Cause           reach the masses. Ruth also served on various
> of God. Her early teaching efforts, preceding           national committee s a nd was often seen guida nd during the first Seven Year Plan                   ing at the House of Worship in Wilmette.
> (1937-1944), were instrum ental in helping                  Ruth's dedication and loving personalit y
> establish the Baha'i Faith in the United States.        attracted others, parti cularly the youth, with
> She travelled extensively, lecturin g in uni ver-       whom she had a special rapport. She often to ld
> sities, coll eges and high schools a nd speak ing       the m, 'I am just a yout h myself.' Despite fai ling
> on rad io and te levision. Her act ivities took her     health, Ruth remain ed a potent example to
> through Europe , the Near East, Asia, Egypt             others until she passed away in her ninetya nd Canada as well as the United States. She           e ighth yea r. Until he r last days she continued
> ma intaine d, until hi s dea th , a frequent co rres-   to teach, holding classes fo r friends a nd seekpondence with the Guardian, reporting on her            e rs , serving the Ca use which she loved so
> activities, seeking guidance, as kin g questions        dearly.
> the answers to which would aid her in her                   She adopted a nd used the na me
> teaching. The following exce rpts are glea ned          ' RuJ:ianfyyih' (or RawJ:ianiyyih) which was
> from letters she received from Shoghi Effend i          give n her by the Greatest Holy Leaf. The na me
> penned in his own ha nd:                                connotes spirituality, joy and bea uty; and cer-
> ' . .. I am deeply gratified to learn of the con-   tainly Ruth had a spiritua l beauty which
> sta nt and exe mplary services yo u are rendering       en riched the li ves of many and progressed the
> to the Cause of God. You a re sure ly a pillar of       Cause of Baha'u'llah. T he loss of this gall ant
> His Faith in that la nd , and your magnificent          soldier will be felt most by the co mmunit y she
> pioneer service will live and adorn the anna ls of      served so steadfastly, as is acknowledged by
> God's immortal Cause. Persevere in yo ur                the cable se nt by the National Spiritual
> efforts, and rest assured th at my prayers will         Assembly of the United States when it learn ed
> continue to be offered in yo ur behalf at the           of her passing o n 5 July 1978:
> Shrine of Baha' u' llah.' (20 November 1931)
> 'The magnificent and unforgettab le services          MOURN LOSS DEARLY LOVED RUHANIYYIH RUTH
> yo u have recently rendered theCauseofBaha' u'-           MOFFETT CHAMPION TEACHER CAUSE BAHAU-
> ll ah will enrich and ennoble the annals of               LLAH ONE MOST OUTSTANDING MEMBERS AMER I-
> our immortal Faith. They have great ly                    CAN BAHAI COMMUN ITY STOP RANGE AND VARJ-
> inspired, cheered, and hea rte ned me in my               ETY HER SERVICES I N TEACHING FI ELD HERE
> strenuous labours. Persevere in yo ur noble task          AND ABROAD FOR OVER HALF CENTURY BEYOND
> and rest assured that my fervent prayers will             RECKONING BOUND TO EXERT DEEP I NFLUENCE
> continue to be offered in your behalf a t th e            ON PROGRESS COMMUN ITY FOR GENERATIO NS TO
> sacred Threshold. Yours is a unique and                   COME STOP     ESPECIALLY    RECALL    HER IND E-
> priceless opportunity. I am confident you will            FATIGABLE EFFORTS WHICH SWEPT LIKE FLAME
> IN MEMORIAM                                           465
> OF FIRE FROM PLACE TO PLACE IN AS YET DARK
> DAYS OF FAITHS OBSCURITY DURING SECOND
> QUARTER THIS CENTURY STOP HER SPIRIT MUST
> DOUBTLESS BE REJOICING AT STEADY WORLD-
> WIDE EMERGENCE CAUSE FOR WHICH SHE GAVE
> FULL STRENGTH HER UNBOUNDED ENERGIES
> STOP FERVENTLY PRAYING PROGRESS HER SOUL
> THROUGHOUT DIVINE WORLDS.
> 
> PAMELA DEROZHINSKY
> 1922-1978
> 
> Pamela was always a seeker and nonconformist. After she arrived in Fiji in 1967
> with her husband , Dmitri, she became
> interested in the Baha'i Faith through Mrs.
> Bobbie Leedham (now McLaren). After many
> hours of talking with Mrs . Leedham and then
> with the Hand of the Cause Abu'l-Qasim Faizi,
> Pamela became confirmed in her belief in
> Pamela Derozhinsky
> Baha'u'llah, in 1969. Through her example,
> Dmitri also accepted the Faith.
> With acceptance of Baha'u'llah came             conducted the delicate negotiations for purinvolvement in many Baha'i activities. Pamela      chase of new I:Ia~fratu'l-Quds.
> became secretary of the Suva Local Assembly,          In 1974 Pamela and Dmitri went to live in
> a member of the National Spiritual Assembly        Bangladesh . As a pioneer on behalf of the
> of the Fiji Islands , and served on many commit-   National Spiritual Assembly of India, she
> tees. Her marked capacity for dealing with         made a considerable impression on the local
> people as individuals drew many to study and       community through her understanding,
> embrace the Faith. Her love and respect for        humour, love, humility, common sense and
> young people was warmly reciprocated by            example, and her many activities received the
> them; she was friend and adviser to many.          constant support and encouragement of her
> When answering the questions of inquirers at       husband. Those in distress often turned to
> fireside meetings, Pamela always referred to       Pamela for comfort and advice.
> the Writings and read answers from the Baha'i         During a critical period for the Faith in
> books. She was concerned to foster an              Bangladesh when the National Baha'i Centre
> increased understanding of Baha'i admin istra-     in Dacca was in danger of being expropriated,
> tion and to create a balanced community of the     Pamela accompanied Counsellor Shirin
> kind that results from recognition that teaching   Boman in calling daily for two weeks on leadand administration, progress and consolida-        ing government figures until they were successtion, go hand in hand.                             ful in having the order rescinded.
> After her pilgrimage to the Holy Land, she         One of Pamela's joys was keeping up a corbecame even more active in proclaiming the         respondence with Baha'ls in different parts of
> Faith to government leaders, civil servants and    the world. In this way she a lso deepened her
> members of the business community. She             knowledge of the Faith. The booklet she predemonstrated the Faith in her life through her     pared for the use of local teachers of the Faith
> integrity in business and through her attitude     in Bangladesh has been translated into Bengali
> toward her work. She was instrumental in           and two thousand copies have been distributed
> briefing Baha'i delegations and proclamation       to officia ls and dignitaries.
> teams and on behalf of the National Assembly          In 1977 Pamela underwent surgery for
> 466                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> cancer of the oesophagus in London but was Administration. Their first pos·t was in Talable to return to Bangladesh for a short time . keetna-a small , cold, remote mining com-
> Meanwhile , Dmitri's work had taken him to munity on the Susitna River, nestled in the
> Chittagong where Pamela, although weak and Talkeetna mountains. The main link with the
> handicapped, again began teaching the Faith . outside world was the slow and meandering
> After several months she had to return to Lon- Alaska Railroad with its somewhat irregular
> don for further treatment. In spite of pain and schedules. The one-room log cabin they lived
> discomfort and the certain knowledge that she in had no plumbing and the heat was supplied
> was dying, she was, through her cheerfulness by a wood-burning stove. Jack had to use a
> and her faith in Baha'u'llah , an inspiration to dog-sled to go to school. It was a far cry from
> patients and hospital staff and visitors. Doctors the life the Huffmans had known in Kansas,
> and nurses sat by her bed and discussed the and at first Evelyn hated it. But soon the friendteachings of the Faith, amazed at her serenity , liness and spirit of the frontier captured her
> joyousness and sense of peace. Her favourite heart and she came to love Alaska.
> prayer was the Tablet of Visitation revealed by      When the Aleutian Islands were invaded
> the Master.                                       during World War II , the authorities insisted
> In the early hours of 21June1978, with her that dependants be evacuated. In order to
> husband at her side, Pamela ascended to the . rejoin her husband, Evelyn developed a skill
> Abha Kingdom. She now lies in the Great considered necessary for the war effort. By
> Northern London Cemetery, New Southgate, becoming a radio operator she was able to be
> close to the resting place of the beloved Guar- with Vern in the extreme northwest area of
> dian. Advised of her passing, the Universal Alaska. After the war they settled in Anchor-
> House of Justice on 21 August cabled the age where they learned of the Faith through
> National Spiritual Assembly of Bangladesh:        Vern's interest in radio. In February 1945 Evelyn became a Baha'i, and Vern in December of
> DEEPLY GRIEVED NEWS UNTIMELY PASSING
> that year. They were part of the Anchorage
> DEVOTED HANDMAIDEN BAHAULLAH PAMELA
> community-the only one in Alaska at that
> DEROZHINSKY PRAYING SHRINES PROGRESS HER
> time-until they secured a property about ten
> SOUL ASHA KINGDOM KINDLY CONVEY LOVlNG
> miles from town and began homesteading.
> SYMPATHY HER HUSBAND.
> Soon they became part of the nucleus of
> believers who formed Alaska's second Local
> Spiritual Assembly . They served that community for more than twenty years, Vern usually as
> VERN HUFFMAN                       treasurer and Evelyn often as chairman. Twice
> 1906-1974                      Evelyn was elected as the delegate from
> Alaska to the annual convention of the
> EVELYN HUFFMAN                      National Spiritual Assembly of the United
> 1911-1978                      States and in 1957, with the formation of the
> Alaskan National Assembly, Evelyn found
> There are two ways in which devotion to herself in rapid succession secretary of the con-
> Baha'u'llah can be shown; by what one does vention, a member of the newly-formed
> and by the kind of person one becomes. In both National Spiritual Assembly and then its
> achievement and character Evelyn Huffman secretary, a post she filled for seven of her tenand her husband, Vern, excelled; their names and-a-half years on that body. As secretary,
> are virtually synonymous with the early growth much of the responsibility of incorporation and
> and development of the Baha'i Faith in Alaska. other details fell upon her capable shoulders.
> Their lives were an example of the spirit of Vern, in his quiet unassuming way, did much to
> service and selfless devotion-it would be assist Evelyn in her duties.
> impossible to count the number of people who        One of the goals of the new National
> have enjoyed their unstinting hospitality.       Spiritual Assembly was to acquire a Temple
> In 1940 Evelyn and her two children, Jack site. The Huffmans donated three acres of their
> and Mary Sue, joined Vern in Alaska where he homestead property-half the present Temple
> worked for what is now the Federal Aviation site. The present J:Ia~iratu'l-Quds of Alaska
> IN MEMORIAM                                                 467
> World Centre of the Faith in Haifa from April
> 1976 to March 1977.
> Shortly after returning to Alaska, Evelyn
> suffered a stroke which slowed her down but
> did not stop her. A week before her death of a
> heart attack at the age of sixty-seven in July of
> 1978, Evelyn had been on a teaching trip
> among the Eskimos in Kotzebue and was making plans to pioneer to Japan.
> All dedicated Baha'is dream of serving the
> Faith to their very last breath. The Huffmans
> succeeded. Little wonder that the Universal
> House of Justice would immortalize them with
> these cables upon learning of their deaths:
> On 15 January 1974:
> ASSURE PRAYERS SHRINES PROGRESS SOUL ABHA
> KINGDOM VERN HUFFMAN VETERAN ALASKAN
> PIONEER     STALWART SUPPORTER         FAITH   STOP
> EXPRESS CONDOLENCES DEVOTED WIFE FAMILY
> ADVISE HOLD MEMORIAL SERVICES.
> 
> And on 27 July 1978:
> Evelyn and Vern Huffman                     GRIEVED LEARN PASSING DEVOTED SERVANT
> CAUSE EVELYN HUFFMAN STOP HER YEARS OF
> SERVICE     AS   MEMBER     NATIONAL    SPIRITUAL
> ASSEMBLY ITS EARLIEST YEARS AND WITH HUS-
> was built on the Huffman homestead land
> BAND AS PIONEER PRINCE OF WALES ISLAND
> because of an exchange made possible by gifts
> AND DONOR KEY NATIONAL PROPERTIES WILL
> of endowment property. The last remaining
> BE     ALWAYS    REMEMBERED    AS     MERITORIOUS
> portion of the homestead, the 1.3 acres where
> CONTRIBUTIONS ANNALS FAITH ALASKA STOP
> the well-known house was located, was
> CONVEY      CONDOLENCES      FAMILY    ASSURANCE
> bequeathed to the Faith by Evelyn on her
> PRAYERS HOLY SHRINES PROGRESS HER SOUL
> death. In 1963 Evelyn was an Alaskan dele-
> ABHA KINGDOM STOP ADVISE HOLD MEMORIAL
> gate to the first International Convention for
> SERVICE.
> the election of the Universal House of Justice.
> JoHN KoLSTOE
> Under the Nine Year Plan, in 1965, despite
> Vern's having had open heart surgery but two
> years earlier, the Huffmans pioneered to
> Prince of Wales Island, one of the five virgin
> goals assigned to Alaska. Vern quickly became
> RUI:fANGfZ FATI:f-'AZ,AM
> 'Mr. Fixit', repairing an endless variety of
> 1898-1978
> broken radios and small appliances. The couple were dearly loved by the Tlingit Indians of
> the island. Vern's deteriorating health made it        DEEPLY GRIEVED PASSING DEVOTED HANDMAID
> necessary for them to leave their goal, but they       DEDICATED       PROMOTER     CAUSE     RUHANG!Z
> left behind two confirmed Baha'is and a secure         FATHEAZAM HER LIFELONG SERVICES IN MANI-
> foundation for further development of the              FOLD CAPACITIES BOTH CRADLE FAITH FOREIGN
> Faith on the island . Vern's death in 1974 ended       PIONEERING FIELD ADD LUSTRE TO ACCOMP-
> a decade-long battle with heart problems and           LISHMENTS MEMBERS HER DISTINGUISHED FAM-
> general ill health. While his death was a grievi-      ILY   PRAYING   HOLY SHRINES PROGRESS HER
> ous blow and loss for Evelyn, she continued to         RADIANT SOUL CONVEY SYMPATHY RELATIVES
> serve the Cause she loved so well, crowning            FRIENDS.
> her distinguished service by working at the                               Universal House of Justice
> 468                                            THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Miss Ru9angiz Fat9-' A~am (Fatheazam) was a               still a young woman, served as a teacher and
> prominent maidservant of Baha'u'llah in fran              later became its administrator working in close
> whose life from her earliest youth was dedi-              collaboration with Miss Adelaide Sharp,4 the
> cated to the service of God and man. Born in              principal. So efficiently did they administer the
> the village of Ardistan, Iran in 1898, she was            affairs of the school that its fame spread
> one of the very few women in the entire coun-             throughout the country attracting as students
> try to receive a good education , at a time when          large numbers of the daughters of prominent
> almost all Persian women were illiterate. As a            non-Baha'i families. Through her devoted and
> result of the encouragement of' Abdu'l-B aha,             capable services 'Ru9angiz Khanum', as she
> she and a few other Baha'i girls were given an            was known to Baha'is and non-Baha'is alike,
> opportunity to study English, although very               gained the admiration , respect and affection of
> few Persians, men or women, in that period                the hundreds of students who passed through
> knew the language.                                        the school, as well as the love and esteem of
> She was born into a family whose members               their families.
> had the bounty of being among the first to                   When the Iranian government closed
> recognize the twin Manifestations of God and              Tarbiyat School, Ru9angiz took employment
> to declare allegiance to the new Revelation               as an officer in the National Bank of fran, one
> from its inception.                                       of the few women in the country to be
> Her maternal grandfather, Mulla 'Ali-Akbar-            appointed to a position of this type at that time.
> i-Ardistani, 1 and Quddus and Mulla ?adiq-i-                 From her earliest years Ru9angiz dedicated
> Muqaddas, were the first three believers to be            her life to service to the Cause. Hardly a day
> persecuted in Shiraz where they suffered                  went by when she was not engaged in promotpunishment and indignities. After being severely          ing the Faith and building up its institutions.
> beaten a hole was bored in the nose of each               For many years she was a member of the Local
> through which a string was passed by which                Spiritual Assembly of Tihran, in some years
> they were led through the streets. An account             serving as its secretary, which gave full play to
> of their suffering was published in the London            her executive skills in co-ordinating the
> Times of 19 November 1845.                                activities of almost 60,000 Baha'is. She also
> Mirza Fat9-'Ali, 2 her paternal grandfather,           served on a number of important national
> was one of the few Ba bis who recognized the              committees including those relating to the edustation of Baha'u'llah before His declaration,            cation of Baha'i children, the progress of
> when he met Him in Ba.s!!dad. Baha'u'llah                 Baha'i women and the relations between
> honoured him with the surname Fat9-i - A'~am              believers of the East and West.
> (the Most Great Victory) and said of him that                In the winter of 1965, when she was sixty-
> 'all the way from Ba~dad to Constantinople,               seven years of age, she responded to the call of
> he was with Him in spirit, though not corpore-            the Universal House of Justice in the Nine
> ally .' 3                                                 Year Plan for pioneers to open new territories.
> Shortly after Ru9angiz's birth her father,             Leaving her home, friends and comfort she
> Aqa Siyyid Shah3.b, had to leave Ardistan to be           settled on the island of Capri in the Bay of
> spared the persecution instigated by Shaykh               Naples where there were no Baha'is. She was
> Mu9ammad Taqiy-i-Najafi, surnamed by                      unaccompanied and knew neither Italian nor
> Baha'u'llah 'the Son of the Wolf'. Abandoning             the local dialect . Although a popular place for
> their land and possessions the family estab-              tourists in the summer months, Capri offers a
> lished themselves in Tihran where Ru9angiz                lonely and isolated existence in the winter and
> obtained her education. When still only in her            few of the residents speak English . On arrival
> teens she was employed by the Ministry of                 in the winter, she was unable to find accommo-
> Education as a teacher in one of the few                  dation in a private residence. Hotels refuse to
> school for girls which had recently been estab-           accept guests in the off season because their
> lished in Persia. When the Tarbiyat School for            doing so would require paying taxes to the
> girls was established by the Baha'is Ru9angiz,            government. Exhausted and weary she went
> from hotel to hotel but was refused admission.
> The Bab, H. M. Balyuzi, pp. 76-78.
> Baha'u'llah, the King of Glory, H. M. Balyuzi, p. 47.
> Evening was drawing on when she applied for
> ibid. p. 261.                                           'See 'In Memoriam', p. 418.
> IN MEMORIAM                                           469
> pose was not only to improve and perfect her
> command of Italian but also to succeed in winning warm friendships among the nuns, the
> children and their parents. She had loved children all her life and devoted herself to their
> training and she soon commanded the love of
> her classmates. Arriving at class a few minutes
> late on one occasion she was surprised when
> the children applauded as she took her seat.
> When she asked about it one child explained:
> 'His customary when a student is late for the
> teacher to require him to sit in a corner as
> punishment-we are so glad the teacher didn't
> make you do that!' Although handicapped by a
> still elementary knowledge of Italian she
> enjoyed the respect of the nuns and was
> gratified some years later to meet one of them,
> no longer wearing a habit, at a Baha'i summer
> school in Italy.
> Ostensibly to improve her knowledge of
> Italian, Rul:Jangfz offered free English lessons
> to the people of the island, thus increasing her
> circle of friends and contacts through the mag-
> Ruf:zangiz Fatf:z-'Aiam
> netism of her personality and the genuine love
> she radiated. From her students there graduaccommodation at the last hotel on her list and       ally developed a circle of close friends and
> was again rejected. A passerby noting her dis-        admirers of the teachings of the Faith. She
> tress and the tears of discouragement in her          began teaching openly only afte r having won
> eyes directed her to the outlying village of          the respect, confidence and trust of the popula-
> Anacapri where she found a room in a hotel            tion and in 1972, in the sevenq1 year of her
> managed by a kindly man who spoke some                stay., the first Local Spiritual Assembly was
> English. Alone in her room she offered prayers        formed. Its establishment had been hampered
> of gratitude. An early riser, she would waken at      by the fact that many who were drawn to the
> dawn and stroll along the seashore and then           Faith eventually had to leave the island to find
> devote her time to rereading Nabil's narrative,       employment abroad . The eighth and ninth
> drawing inspiration from the lives of the early       believers who made formation of the Assembly
> dawn-breakers of the Faith. She purchased a           possible were a young married couple. The
> 'teach yourself' book and began to study              man had attended firesides regularly and arriv-
> Italian.                                              ing late at the meeting one evening was lov-
> On one of her morning visits to the seashore       ingly chided by Rul:Jangfz. He apologized by
> she was befriended by a woman and her daugh-          explaining that this was the eve of his wedding.
> ter who had watched her daily visits with interest.   Not long after this Rul:Jangfz spent an entire
> Although she knew only a few words of Italian         night in prayer imploring the Blessed Beauty to
> by that time a friendship developed between           lead one more soul to the Faith in order that
> them culminating in an invitation to have             the Assembly could be elected. Early the next
> Rul:iangfz tutor the daughter in English in           morning a young woman presented herself at
> exchange for Italian lessons. The girl's father       Rul:Jangfz's door and declared her belief in
> was the head of the postal and telegraph ser-         Baha'u'llah-it was the bride who had just
> vice on the island and the family extended            returned from her honeymoon. Not knowing
> assistance in many ways.                              the girl well , Rul:Jangfz inquired why she had
> At a later time she received permission to         been prompted to make her decision. Pointing
> attend a school run by nuns where she took            to a photograph of' Abdu'l-B aha in Rul:Jangfz's
> lessons with a class of small children. Her pur-      room the girl explained: 'I dreamed of the Mas-
> 470                                    THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> ter last night-he told me I must do this.'          abroad. But Rul)angiz's concern was even
> Selflessness and generosity were among           greater: there were only eight other Baha'is
> Rul)angfz's outstanding qualities. Although         on the island. Would the Local Assembly be
> she lavished hospitality and gifts upon others      lost?
> she lived modestly, ate simple food and dressed        When her family arrived they found that
> in dignified, practical and plain clothes. When     Rul)angfz was paralyzed and had lost the
> her relatives from Europe lovingly scolded her      power of speech, although she remained very
> for giving away the presents they would make        alert. She knew, for instance, that the Local
> of clothing and other things she replied, 'If I     Assembly was to be formed the next day.
> dress as you would have me do the people            Restricted to communicating by motions of her
> would not be comfortable in coming to visit         head and muffled grunts she nonetheless made
> me; they accept me dressed as I am in simple        apparent to the secretary of the Assembly her
> taste.'                                             distress at the prospect of the Assembly being
> She rented the ground floor of a house situ-     lost. The secretary assured her that a ninth
> ated at the apex of two main streets of             person had just accepted the Faith and the
> Anacapri and although the noise level was high      Assembly was secure. Fearing that the secreshe chose it because it was convenient for pas-     tary had said this merely to comfort her,
> sersby to drop in. Her door was literally open      Rul)angfz demanded that she recite the
> the whole day and it led directly into the draw-    names of the nine which, with the slight motion
> ing room which she had decorated in the man-        possible to her, she ticked off on her fingers.
> ner of a Baha'i Centre with appropriate photo-      Still unconvinced and fearing that the friends
> graphs and ample supplies of Baha'i literature .    might be humouring her she then insisted that
> Although she had a constant stream of               the new believer be brought into her presence!
> guests-travelling teachers and inquirers-she        Meeting him she burst into tears of relief. Such
> would allow no one to deprive her of the            was her determination that the Assembly be
> privilege of serving them . During the summer       safeguarded.
> when the water supply of Capri is often inter-         It was the saddest moment of her life when
> rupted and water must be drawn in buckets           the doctor advised that she might be incapacifrom a common well, Rul)angiz, then past            tated for years . Not wishing to be a burden on
> seventy and rather frail, would arise long          the friends of Capri, Rul)angfz reluctantly conbefore her guests and with great difficulty bring   sented to leave the island for hospital treatbuckets of water to the house. She became a         ment. Two years after leaving her pioneering
> familiar figure in Anacapri and after seven         post she passed away on 27 September 1978 in
> years there was literally no one who did not        Tihran. In her room in the hospital there was a
> know her, respect her, and who had not heard        picture of 'Abdu'l-Baha and photographs of
> of the Faith from her. 'I did not begin teaching    the Spiritual Assembly of Capri.
> at once,' she said. 'When I had won the trust of
> the people I felt that they would listen closely
> when it came time to speak of the Faith.' So
> great was her popularity that she was called
> upon to act as Godmother of some of the children
> of her Catholic friends on the island. On one of         JEANNETTE HILDA BA TTRICK
> these occasions she explained to the Catholic                    1922-1978
> Priest that she was not a Christian. 'But you
> believe in Jesus Christ?' he asked . 'All Baha'is   Jeannette was born on 2 March 1922 in Scaraccept Jesus Christ as one of the Manifesta-        borough, Yorkshire, England of hard-working
> tions of God,' she told him. 'That's enough,        Christian parents who were animated by a
> then,' the Priest said.                             pioneering spirit. She had an enquiring mind
> In April 197 5 after ten years of dedicated      and from an early age was encouraged by her
> service she suffered a stroke. Her disability       father to investigate questions that interested
> caused great distress to both the Baha'is and       her. After the death of her first husband Jeannon-Baha'is of Anacapri. Immediately her            nette, who was still in her early twenties, went
> concerned frie·nds telephoned her relatives         to Switzerland with her infant daughter, Ilona,
> IN MEMORIAM                                            471
> to learn the hotel business. While there she met
> a fellow student, Owen Battrick, whom she
> married in 1948. For a time they operated a
> hotel in North Wales and in 1951 they moved
> to Reading, Berkshire where they started two
> food catering business.es. The businesses prospered and the young couple led a life of material comfort but they grew increasingly more
> dissatisfied with the conventional round of
> empty social activities. Their concern about
> what they felt to be a growing spiritual lethargy
> and their interest in finding solutions to pressing social questions led them to seek diligently
> for truth. They investigated various groups and
> sects and, their search seeming fruitless, grew
> dispirited and sought refuge in their own home,
> praying for an answer.
> In books taken from the public library they
> found reference to the Baha'i Faith and
> hastened to obtain other Baha'i books from a
> local bookshop . They were not then aware that
> their 'discovery' had coincided with the arrival in
> Reading of Beryl de Gruchy, a Baha'i pioneer                      Jeannette Hilda Battrick
> to the area, who several weeks later advertised
> the holding of a Baha'i public meeting in the
> George Hotel. Jeannette exhorted Owen to               islands of the North Sea-the Shetlands,
> attend and find out more. 'You must get there          Orkneys and Farnes. To all of these the
> early,' she said, 'as there will be thousands of       Battricks travelled excepting the Farnes to
> people in attendance.' In fact, there were only       which their daughter, Ilona, pioneered in
> four people present, including Beryl, and all          1972. In addition, throughout the Crusade,
> were Baha'is. The outcome of the meeting,             Jeannette served on many committees includhowever, was the acceptance of the Faith by           ing, in the final year of the Ten Year Plan, the
> the Ba ttricks.                                       National Teaching Committee. The Guardian
> Those were the early days of the Ten Year           had approved their moving to the South Pacific
> Crusade. Jeannette immediately threw herself          when circumstances permitted. In 1967, followinto the service of Baha'u'llah in both the           ing full family consultation, the Battricks moved
> teaching and administrative fields with a devo-       to the southern hemisphere fulfilling a long
> tion that was to characterize her entire Baha'i       cherished desire to pioneer to the Pacific
> life. Her pilgrimage to the Holy Land in 1957,         region. Only three months before their departure
> and her meeting with Shoghi Effendi, further          in August of that year it was learned that Jeangalvanized her and charged her activities with a      nette had breast cancer; she underwent surgery
> vitality that did not dim with the years.             and subsequent treatment but she did not allow
> Pioneering became part of her everyday life. In       this setback to prevent her pioneering.
> April 1957 with her son, Richard, then only               Jeannette, with her two youngest children,
> six, she went to Edinburgh for six months to          sailed for New Zealand whilst Owen flew to the
> help re-establish the Local Assembly. She next        Solomon Islands for a six-month period to
> pioneered to Luxembourg in 1960 with her              assist the Blums. From here he gained a footthree-year old daughter, Sarah, and stayed for        hold in New Caledonia, their pioneering post,
> approximately ten months before returning to          and prepared the way for the family to join
> England to devote the remainder of the Ten            him. Meanwhile, Jeannette was elected secre-
> Year Crusade, as the Guardian had suggested,          tary of the National Spiritual Assembly of New
> to teaching in the pivotal centres of Edinburgh,      Zealand at Ric;Ivan 1968. Her services in that
> Cardiff, Belfast, Dublin, London and in the           country endeared her to Baha'is throughout
> 472                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> the land. She travelled extensively throughout
> the North Island and was especially conscious
> of the need to teach the Maori people.
> Although she was re-elected in 1969 she left
> New Zealand in May to settle in New
> Caledonia. Here, and later in the Loyalty
> Islands, Jeannette attained the pinnacle of her
> services. Tireless in her devotion , selfsacrificing of her time , health and material
> means, and patient in her love of the indigenous people, she burned herself out. Often her
> husband or children would find her asleep over
> her typewriter and would urge her to go to bed
> for proper rest. Stirring herself, she would say
> 'I've only a few more lines to type and then I've
> finished,' and on she would go.
> Jeannette was secretary of the National
> Spiritual Assembly of the South West Pacific
> when it moved its seat to Noumea, New
> Caledonia in 1971 and served in this capacity
> until she and her husband left to pioneer to
> Ouvea , Loyalty Islands. She remained on that
> National Assembly until she was forced by ill-
> Ismail Hiwari Meymoun
> ness to settle in Auckland, New Zealand in
> 1975. Those eighteen months spent in Ouvea
> were probably some of the happiest of her life;          ISMAIL HIWARI MEYMOUN
> she was sustained by the memory of that period       (ISMA'IL HUY ARf MA YMUN 'UMAR)
> during the last three years of her life as the                   1938-1978
> cancer took its toll. In March 1976 Owen was
> appointed to the Continental Board of Coun-         Isma'fl Huvarf Maymun 'Umar was born in
> sellors and made his base in New Zealand.           Nador, Morocco in 1938 and was educated in
> Jeannette served as his secretary whilst under-     Nador and Tetuan. He accepted the Baha'i
> going rigorous chemotherapy. Her indomi-            Faith in 1958 after hearing about it through a
> table courage during this time became an            devoted pioneer, Mr. Fawzi Zanyu'l-'Abidin, 1
> example to all who knew her. She never              and in 1960 when the first Spiritual Assembly
> allowed the disease to overwhelm her and to         of Nador was established he was one of its
> the very end she served the Cause of Baha'u'-       members. At the time the persecution and
> llah as best she could, spending long hours         imprisonment of Baha'is began in Nador 2 in
> praying for the friends in the Cook Islands and     1962, Isma'fl was living in Casablanca. He
> elsewhere whom she could no longer visit.           served as liaison between the families of the
> On her passing on 6 October 1978, the Uni-       Baha'i prisoners and the Administrative
> versal House of Justice cabled the National         Committee which had been established for the
> Spiritual Assembly of New Zealand:                  protection and welfare of the Baha'i community. He travelled far and wide to render any
> HEARTS GRIEVED UNTIMELY PASSING HEROIC
> service he could to the friends and paid visits to
> SELFSACRIFICING    MAIDSERVANT    BAHAULLAH
> Baha'is who had been imprisoned in Kenitra
> JEANNETTE BATTRICK HER UNTIRING SERVICES
> and Meknes.
> CAUSE   BRITAIN   EUROPE AND     PACIFIC   AREA
> In 1966 Isma'il obtained leave of absence
> INSPIRING EXAMPLE RISING GENERATION BAHAI
> from his job and devoted a year to travel
> PIONEERS PRAYING HOLY SHRINES PROGRESS
> teaching in the countries of north-western
> HER RADIANT SOUL.
> Africa, bearing all the expenses despite his
> 'See 'In Memoriam ', The Bah{/( World , vol. XVI , p. 545.
> 2 See The Baha'( World , vol. XIII , p. 288 .
> IN MEMORIAM                                                       473
> modest circumstances. Upon returning to
> Morocco he participated with great enthusiasm
> in various Baha'i activities on the local, regional and national levels. He was elected to
> serve on the National Spiritual Assembly for
> several years and was at various times a
> member of the Spiritual Assemblies ofTetuan,
> Nador, Casablanca and Ujda. In 1969 he
> arranged a transfer in his employment and was
> appointed Director of the Post Office in Tarjist
> thus satisfying his desire to pioneer to a goal
> area . His marriage in that same year to a
> devoted Baha'i was the first between Moroccan believers to be solemnized in full accord
> with the Baha'i teachings without an additional
> ceremony.
> Salient among the distinguishing characteristics of this dear friend were his faithful -
> ness, his generosity and his indefatigable
> efforts to serve others. He cherished the companionship of the Baha'i friends and braving all
> dangers would travel long distances to be with
> them. Within and without the Baha'i commu-
> Otto Hafner
> nity, all who knew him will long remember this
> radiant and tender youth whose constant
> pleasure was to be of service.                         Mr. Hafner's early childhood already bore
> Isma'fl's death occurred on 2 November           the imprint of deep spirituality through the
> 1978 in tragic and mysterious circumstances;        firm belief of his parents in the Revelation of
> his burnt body was found inside his automobile      Baha'u'llah. An event in his childhood which
> along the highway approximately six                 only few were privileged to experience- that
> kilometres from Tarjist. Informed of his death,     of meeting the Master-illumined his path
> the Universal House of Justice cabled:              through life. At the age of three in Paris in
> 1911 and again at the age offive in Esslingen in
> . . . GRIEVED NEWS PASSING ISMAIL HIWARI
> 1913 1 he was privileged, together with his par-
> MEYMOUN ASSURE RELATIVES FRIENDS ARDENT
> ents, to be in the presence of' Abdu'l-Baha on
> PRAYERS SACRED THRESHOLD PROGRESS SOUL
> several occasions. Photographs of that time
> KINGDOM GOD.
> show 'Abdu'l-Baha embracing him. In Fellback, where he grew up , the hospitable home
> of his parents was for a long time the meeting
> OTTO HAFNER
> place of the Baha'i friends for deepening in the
> 1908- 1978
> new Revelation and for happy fellowship.
> After completing his education, Mr. Hafner
> Otto Hafner was called to the heavenly realm
> turned to the study of mathematics and ended
> on 3 November 1978 after a brief illness. All
> his professional career about five years ago
> who knew him had a sincere affection for him,
> after working for many years as director of a
> since his cheerful, sociable and loving nature
> large insurance company .
> was the basis for joyous companionship. The
> He served the Cause of Baha' u'llah with
> Universal House of Justice cabled on 7
> loyal devotion. For over two decades he was a
> November:
> member of the National Spiritual Assembly of
> GRIEVED   NEWS   PASSING   DEVOTED    VETERAN     Germany, undertaking the responsible office
> BELIEVER OTTO HAFNER EXTEND LOVING SYM-           of treasurer. Often the volume of work con-
> PATHY BEREAVED FAMILY PRAYING PROGRESS            1
> See 'In Memoriam', Anna Koestlin , The Bahd'f World, vol.
> HIS SOUL ABHA KINGDOM.                                xv, p. 511.
> 474                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> nected with this post taxed his strength, but out    tomb of Mlle. Tabrfzi, the first Baha'i pioneer
> of love for 'Abdu'l-Baha he carried out the          to Corsica.
> duties assigned him. He continued to serve as a         During the last years of his life Clarence
> member of the Local Spiritual Assembly of            lverson's physical condition was extremely
> Esslingen to the end of his life and threw him-      feeble. He will be remembered as a person who
> self wholeheartedly into the project of rebuild-     overcame physical and financial difficulties
> ing the Baha'i home there. We remember with          over a period of ten years in order to remain at
> gratitude his services as a member of the            his pioneer post. He also will be remembered
> National Finance Committee and the valuable          as one who exemplified the Baha'i ideals, and
> assistance he rendered toward the construction       as a dear friend to all.
> of the House of Worship in Langenhain. His
> last years were spent in a suburb of Esslingen;
> thus the place where 'Abdu'l-Baha stayed and
> where Mr. Hafner was privileged to be in His
> presence as a child became his last resting                     EMMA MARGARET
> place.                                                         TIJSSEN-HARTMANN
> The German Baha'is remain bound to Otto                          1888-1979
> Hafner across the borders of this earthly life by
> ties of deep love and profound gratitude .           Margaret Tijssen was born on 15 March 1888
> DR. EUGEN SCHMIDT         and passed away in Stuttgart at Naw-Ruz 1979
> in her ninety-first year. Margaret's father was
> part of the academic life of Stuttgart where he
> taught history and the history of art and under
> his guidance his daughter entered a world rich
> CLARENCE JOHN IVERSON                         in cultural opportunities-concerts, theatre,
> music and painting. She studied art herself and
> 1909-1979
> became a drawing teacher at a school for girls.
> Mr. Clarence John Iverson, a man with an             In 1921 , together with her husband who was a
> unswerving desire to serve the Faith of              contemporary and friend of Dr. Adelbert
> Baha'u'llah, arose at the International Oceanic
> Conference held in Palermo, Sicily in August
> 1968, tovolunteeras a pioneer in Bastia, Corsica,
> an island belonging to France. He received his
> assignment from the National Spiritual
> Assembly of France on 19 November 1968,
> and was informed by the National Spiritual
> Assembly of the Baha'is of the United States
> on 21May1969 that he would be included in a
> new United States quota of pioneers for
> France, thereby fulfilling one of the goals of the
> Nine Year Plan.
> Clarence Iverson was born on 7 February
> 1909 in Wahoo, Nebraska. He enrolled in the
> Baha'i Faith in 1930 and pioneered to El
> Salvador, Central America, from 1939 to
> 1946. As a result of his studies he had received
> a B.A. in Arts and Sciences, and earned his
> living as a piano teacher while pioneering. He
> spoke Spanish and French fluently.
> Clarence died in the Bastia Hospital on 17
> February 1979, following an automobile accident on a highway near his home in Bastia. He
> is buried in the cemetery of Bastia, close to the          Emma Margaret Tijssen-Hartmann
> IN MEMORIAM                                                   475
> Miihlschlegel, she accepted the Baha'i Faith.
> Mr. Tijssen passed away in 1955.
> In 193 7 the family came to the Netherlands
> and settled in the Hague. One of their two sons,
> Walter Frank, and his wife Dora , a lso accepted
> the Faith. The older Baha'is of the community
> of the Netherlands and especially those from
> the area of the Hague maintain a memory of
> Margaret as a radiantly contented being.
> Although her life was not free of tragedy she
> had the gift of a happy nature and the capacity
> to look upon the positive aspects of any situation. Even when confined to a nursing home
> toward the end of her life she expressed happiness with her lot. In her great simplicity and
> modesty, and with her deep faith, she felt herself united in sympathy and love with all forms
> of God's creation, and she expressed this
> through her devoted service to others. At
> whatever time she was needed, and in whatever capacity, Margaret would be found at the
> Baha'i Centre in the Hague. After visiting the
> J:Ia~iratu'l-Quds in 1971 the Hand of the
> Georgette VanSombeek
> Cause Abu'l-Qasim Faizi wrote: 'The special
> and loving services of this dearly loved "invisible" lady who hides herself in the kitchen are
> of great importance and are a source of happi-     always existed between the girls, and it was
> ness and inspire gratitude in everyone who has     natural that Jetty should express an interest in
> the chance to meet her. She is a treasure!'        the Cause which her sister had embraced so
> Margaret expressed her love for flowers in      wholeheartedly. However, Jetty did not
> very delicate drawings. One of these has been      immediately become a Baha'i.
> left to the Baha'i community and is preserved         In 1946 the Guardian launched the second
> at the Baha'i Centre.                              Seven Year Plan which had as one of its purposes the secure establishment of the Faith in
> ten goal countries of Europe including Holland.' The sisters returned that year to the
> Netherlands-Rita's activities already being
> GEORGETTE STRAUB-VAN                        harnessed to the needs of the Cause- and on 2
> BLEYSWIJK SOMBEEK                         February 194 7 the Guardian's secretary was
> 1906- 1979                           instructed to write a letter addressed jointly to
> Miss Rita Van Sombeek and Mrs. Jetty Straub:
> Georgette 'Jetty' Straub was one of the first      'He was so happy to see that your sister has
> Baha'is of the Netherlands. Her sister, Miss       embraced the Faith and arisen to serve it with
> Rita Van Sombeek, had spent the years of           you with so much devotion and enthusiasm ...
> World War II in America and in 1946                The work in Holland is very promising, and he
> embraced the Baha'i Faith. In a letter dated 5     feels sure you both, with Mr. van Ogtrop, will
> March 1946 written on behalf of Shoghi             soon see tangible results of your devoted
> Effendi by his secretary, the Guardian wel-        labours.' The offer the women had made to
> comed Miss Van Sombeek 'as a co-worker' and        immediately begin translating the literature of
> expressed his intention to accede to her request   the Faith from English into Dutch was warmly
> by praying 'that your sister may also accept the
> 'See The Bahti'( World, vol. XVI, p. 81: Portugal, Spain,
> Faith'. Jetty was visiting her sister in America    Italy, Switzerland, Luxemburg, Belguim, the Netherlands,
> at the time. A strong bond of affection had         Denmark. Norway and Sweden. Finland added later.
> 476                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> commended. In his own hand the Guardian               Baha'i community of the Netherlands is deeply
> wrote: 'The work on which you and your dear           grateful to Jetty and her sister, Rita, and that
> sister have embarked is historic, meritorious,        handful of friends who in those early days
> and rich in possibilities. Future generations will    laboured for the Faith in Europe, guided from
> extol your labours and derive inspiration from        Geneva by the European Teaching Committhe example you have set. I am deeply grateful        tee. The name of Jetty Straub-like that of her
> to you both, admire your spirit, will pray for        sister-remains inseparably linked with the
> your success, and am eager to receive the             history of the Faith in the Netherlands. She
> report of your activities. Never lose heart , be      passed away in Zeist on 7 April 1979. On 16
> assured, happy and grateful.'                         April the Universal House of Justice cabled:
> In a tribute written at the time of Jetty's
> passing in 1979 the National Spiritual Assem-           GRIEVED NEWS PASSING JETTY STRAUB VAN-
> bly acknowledged its debt of gratitude for the          SOMBEEK WHOSE      DEVOTED SERVICES CAUSE
> earliest translations of Dutch literature includ-       BAHAULLAH    HAVE ENDOWED      NETHERLANDS
> ing the first prayer book, The Hidden Words of          BAHAI    COMMUNITY      WITH       IMPERISHABLE
> Bahd'u'lltih and Bahti'u'lltih and the New Era.         BENEFITS STOP CONVEY LOVING SYMPATHY HER
> 'Jetty gave all her strength to this labour of love     SISTER MEMBERS HER FAMILY STOP PRAYING
> and without her this would not have been                HOLY    SHRINES   PROGRESS   HER    SOUL   ABHA
> achieved,' the National Assembly stated. 'The           KINGDOM.
> .j:o.
> -...J
> 
> -l
> :i:
> m
> °'>
> :i:
> >·
> ::;::
> ;o
> r
> 
> One of the ornamental urns which graci; the gardens surrounding the Shrine of the Bab.
> PART SIX
> 
> DIRECTORY, BIBLIOGRAPHY,
> GLOSSARY
> I
> BAHA'I DIRECTORY 1976-1979
> 133 - 135 OF THE BAHA'I ERA
> 
> 1 . THE UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF JUSTICE
> Address: 10 Haparsim Street, 35 055 Haifa, Israel (P.O. Box 155, 31 001
> Haifa)
> 
> 2. THE HANDS OF THE CAUSE
> Address : 7 Haparsim Street, 35 055 Haifa, Israel (P.O . Box 155, 31 001 Haifa)
> 
> THE HANDS OF THE CA USE RESIDING IN
> THE HOLY LAND
> 
> Amatu'I-Baha Rul)fyyih Khanum      Abu' I-Qasim Faizi
> 'A li-Akbar Furutan                Paul E. Haney
> 
> CONTINENTAL HANDS OF THE CAUSE
> 
> Shu'a'u'llah 'Ala'!                Ral)matu ' llah Muhajir
> J:Iasan M. Balyuzf                 Adelbert Miihlschlegel
> H . Collis Featherstone            Enoch Olinga
> Ugo G iachery                      John A. Robarts
> Dhikru'Ilah Khadem                 Wi lliam B. Sears
> Jalal Khazeh                       'A lf-Mul)ammad Varga
> 
> 3. THE INTERNATIONAL TEACHING CENTRE
> Address: 38 Allenby Road , 35 055 Haifa, Israel (P.O. Box 155, 31 001 Haifa)
> 
> 482                                         THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 4. CONTINENTAL BOARDS OF COUNSELLORS*
> Africa                                              Asia
> Central and East Africa                             North-eastern Asia
> Northern Africa                                     South Central Asia
> So uthern Africa                                    South-eastern Asia
> Western Africa                                      Western Asia
> 
> The Americas                                        A us tra las ia
> Central America                                     Australasia
> North America
> South A merica                                      Europe
> Europe
> 
> 5. BAHA'I INTERNATIONAL COMMUNITY
> D r. Victor de Araujo,
> 345 East 46th Street, Room 809,
> New York, New York 10017,
> U.S.A.
> 
> 6. NATIONAL SPIRITUAL ASSEMBLIES
> At Ric;lvan 1976 there were 117 Baha'i National Spiritual Assemblies throughout the world, and
> at Ric;lvan 1979 there were 130-37 in Africa, 33 in the Americas, 31 in Asia, 10 in Australasia
> and 19 in Europe. Current addresses are available from the Baha'i World Centre, P.O. Box 155,
> 31 001 Haifa, Israel.
> 
> 7 . BAHA'I PUBLISHING TRUSTS
> 
> ARGENTINA                                                   BRAZIL
> E.B.I.L.A.,                                                  Editora Baha'i-Brasil,
> Av. Santa Fe 5085 ,                                          Rua Engenheiro Gama Lobo, 267 ,
> 1425 Buenos Aires ,                                          Vila Isabel,
> Argentina .                                                  20000 Rio de Janeiro RJ,
> Brasil.
> AUSTRALIA
> Baha'i Publishing Trust,                                  FIJI ISLANDS
> P.O. Box 166,                                                Baha'i Publish ing Trust,
> Mudgee, N.S.W. 2850                                          P.O. Box 2007,
> A ustrali a.                                                 Government Buildings,
> Suva,
> BELGIUM                                                        Fiji Islands.
> Maison d'Edi tio ns Baha'ie,
> 205 rue du Trone,                                         GERMANY
> 1050 Brussels,                                               Baha'i-Verlag GMBH,
> Belgium.                                                     Eppsteiner Strasse 89,
> D-6238 Hofheim-Langenhain,
> Germany .
> 
> •Current post office addresses are available from Baha'i World Centre, P.O. Box 155, 31 001 Haifa, Israel.
> BAHA ' I DIRECTORY                                        483
> INDIA                                                   NORWAY
> Baha'i Publishing Trust,                                 Baha'i Forlag,
> 6, Canning Road,                                         P.O. Box 127,
> Post Box 19,                                             N-1430 As,
> New Delhi, 110001                                        Norway.
> India.
> PHILIPPINES
> IRAN*                                                     Baha'i Publishing Trust,
> P.O. Box 4323 ,
> ITALY                                                     Manila,
> Casa Editrice Baha'i)                                    Philippines.
> Circonvallazione Nomentana, 484-A/l,
> 00162 Rome,                                            PAKISTAN
> Italy.                                                    Baha'i Publishing Trust,
> P.O. Box 7420,
> JAPAN                                                      Karachi 3, Pakistan.
> Baha'i Publishing Trust,
> P.O. Box 878,                                          SPAIN
> Osaka, Japan 530-91.                                      Editorial Baha'i de Espana,
> Paseo Dr. Moragas,
> KOREA                                                      168 , 2°, 2•, Santa Marie de Barbara,
> Baha'i Publishing Trust,                                  Barcelona, Spain.
> 249-36 Huam-dong,
> Yongsan-ku,                                            SWEDEN
> Seoul 140                                                 Baha'i-Forlaget,
> Republic of Korea.                                        Matilda Ljungstedts viig 27,
> 122 35 Enskede,
> MALAYSIA                                                   Sweden.
> Baha'i Publishing Trust,
> 32 Jalan Angsana, Setapak,                            TAIWAN
> Kuala Lumpur 14-11,                                      Ta Tung Chiao Publishing Trust,
> Malaysia.                                                26, Lane 18, Ta Hsieh Road,
> Tainan 700, Taiwan .
> NEAR EAST*
> UGANDA *
> NETHERLANDS
> Stichting Baha'i Literatuur,                           UNITED KINGDOM
> Riouwstraat 27 ,                                          Baha'i Publishing Trust,
> The Hague ,                                               2 South Street,
> The Netherlands.                                          Oakham, Rutland/Leics, LE15 6Hy,
> England.
> 
> UNITED STATES
> Baha'i Publishing Trust,
> 415 Linden Avenue,
> Wilmette, Illinois 60091,
> U.S.A.
> 
> •Address communications to Baha'i World Centre, P.O. Box 155, 31 000 Haifa, Israel
> 484                                THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> II
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY
> 
> 1. BAHA'U'LLAH'S BEST-KNOWN WORKS
> 
> AlvaJ:i-i-Laylatu'l-Quds.                      LawJ:i-i-J:Iusayn.
> A~l-i-Kull u'I- Kha yr.                        LawJ:i-i-Ibn-i-Dhi'b (Epistle to the Son of the
> Az-Bagh-i-Ilahi.                                 Wolf).
> Baz-A v-u-Bidih-J ami.                         LawJ:i-i-IttiJ:iad.
> Bi~arat (Glad Tidings).                        LawJ:i-i-Jamal.
> Chihar-Vadf (Four Valleys).                    LawJ:i-i-Karim.
> Haft-Vadf (Seven Valleys).                     LawJ:i-i-Karmil.
> Halih-Halih-Ya-Bisharat.                       LawJ:i-i-Kullu't-Ta'am.
> J:Iur-i-'U jab.                                LawJ:i-i-Malikih (Tablet to Queen V ictoria).
> J:IurUfat-i-' Allin.                           LawJ:i-i-Malik-i-Rus (Tablet to the Czar of
> Ishraqat (Splendours).                           Russia).
> Kalimat-i-Firdawsfyyih (Words of Paradise).    LawJ:i-i-MallaJ:iu'l-Quds (Tablet of the Holy
> Kalimat-i-Maknunih (Hidden Words).               Mariner).
> Kitab-i-'Ahd (Book of Covenant).               LawJ:i-i-Manikjf-$aJ:iib.
> Kitab-i-Aqdas (Most Holy Book).                LawJ:i-i-Maq~ud.
> Kitab-i-Badf'.                                 LawJ:i-i-Maryam.
> Kitab-i-iqan (Book of Certitude).              LawJ:i-i-Mawlud.
> LawJ:i-i-' Abdu'l-'Azfz-Va-Vukala.             LawJ:i-i-Mubahilih.
> LawJ:i-i-'Abdu'l-Vahhab .                      LawJ:i-i-Napulyun (First Tablet to Napoleon
> LawJ:i-i-' Abdu'r-Razzaq.                        III).
> LawJ:i-i-AJ:ibab.                              LawJ:i-i- Napulyun II (Second Tablet to
> LawJ:i-i-AJ:imad (Tablet of AJ:imad).            Napoleon III).
> LawJ:i-i-Amvaj.                                LawJ:i-i-Na~ir.
> LawJ:i-i-Anta'l-Kaff.                          LawJ:i-i-Nuqtih.
> LawJ:i-i-Aqdas.                                LawJ:i-i-Pap (Tablet to the Pope).
> LawJ:i-i-Ashraf.                               LawJ:i-i-Pisar-' Amm.
> LawJ:i-i-' Ashiq-va-Ma'shuq.                   LawJ:i-i-Qina'.
> LawJ:i-i-Ayiy-i-Nur.                           LawJ:i-i-Quds.
> LawJ:i-i-Baha .                                LawJ:i-i-Raff'.
> LawJ:i-i-Baqa.                                 LawJ:i-i-Ra'fs (Tablet to Ra'fs).
> LawJ:i-i-Basfta tu '1-J:Iaqfqih.               LawJ:i-i-Raqsha.
> LawJ:i-i-Bismilih.                             LawJ:i-i- Rasul.
> LawJ:i-i-Bulbulu'l-Firaq.                      LawJ:i-i-RuJ:i.
> LawJ:i-i-Burhan.                               LawJ:i-i-Ru'ya.
> LawJ:i-i-Dunya (Tablet of the World).          LawJ:i-i-SaJ:iab.
> LawJ:i-i-Fitnih.                               LawJ:i-i-Salman I.
> LawJ:i-i-Ghulamu'l-Khuld .                     LawJ:i-i-Salman II.
> LawJ:i-i-J:Iabfb.                              LawJ:i-i-Samsun.
> LawJ:i-i-Haft-Pursish .                        LawJ:i-i-SayyaJ:i.
> LawJ:i -i-J:Iajj.                              LawJ:i-i-Shaykh-Fanf.
> LawJ:i-i-Hawdaj.                               LawJ:i-i-Sultan.
> LawJ:i-i-I;Iikmat (Tablet of Wisdom).          LawJ:i-i-TawJ:ifd.
> LawJ:i-i-Hirtfk.                               LawJ:i-i-Tibb .
> LawJ:i-i-J:Iuriyyih.                           LawJ:i-i-Tuqa.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                   485
> Lawl)-i-Yusuf.                                       Suriy-i-J:Iajj II.
> Lawl)-i-Zaynu'l-Muqarrabfn.                          Suriy-i-Haykal.
> Lawl)-i-Zfyarih .                                    Suriy-i-J:Iif?.
> Madfnatu'r-Ri<;la.                                   Suriy-i-Hijr.
> Madfnatu't-Tawl)fd.                                  Suriy-i-'Ibad.
> Mathnavf.                                            Suriy-i-Ism.
> Munajathay-i-$fyam.                                  Suriy-i-Ismuna'l-Mursil.
> Qad - Il)taraqua'l-Mukhli~un.                        Suriy-i-Javad.
> Qa~fdy-i-Varqa'fyyih.                                Suriy-i-Khitab.
> Rashl)-i-' Arna.                                     Suriy-i-Ma ' anf.
> Ri<;lvanu'l-' Adi.                                   Suriy-i-Man' .
> Ri<;lvanu'l-Iqrar.                                   Suriy-i-Muluk.
> $al)ffi y-i-Shat(f yyih.                             Suriy-i-Nida.
> $alat-i-Mayyit (Prayer for the Dead).                Suriy - i-Nu~l).
> Saqf-Az-Ghayb-i-Baqa.                                Suriy-i-Qadir.
> Shikkar-Shikan-Shavand.                              Suriy-i-Qahfr.
> Subl)ana-Rabbfya'l-A'la.                             Suriy-i-Qalam.
> Subl)anaka-Ya-Hu.                                    Suriy-i - Qamf~.
> Suratu'llah.                                         Suriy-i-$abr.
> Suriy-i-Al)zan.                                      Suriy-i-Sultan.
> Suriy-i-Amfn.                                        Suriy-i-Vafa.
> Suriy-i-Amr.                                         Suriy-i-Zfyarih.
> Suriy-i-A'rab .                                      Suriy-i-Zabur.
> Suriy - i - A~l)ab.                                  Suriy-i-Z,uhur.
> Suriy-i-Asma'.                                       Tafsir-i-Hu.
> Suriy-i-Bayan.                                       Tafsir-i-J:I urllfat-i- Muq aga 'ih.
> Suriy-i-Damm.                                        Tafsir-i-Suriy-i-Va'sh-Shams.
> Suriy-i-Dhabfl).                                     Tajalliyat (Effulgences).
> Suriy-i-Dhibl).                                      Tarazat (Ornaments) .
> Suriy-i-Dhikr.                                       Zfyarat-Namih (The Tablet of Visitation).
> Suriy-i-Fa<;ll.                                      Zfyarat-N amiy-i-Awliya.
> Suriy-i-Fatl).                                       Zfyarat-Namiy-i-Babu' l-Bab va Quddus.
> Suriy-i-Fu'ad.                                       Zfyarat-N amiy-i-Bayt.
> Suriy - i-Ghu~n (Tablet of the Branch) .             Zfyarat-Namiy-i-Maryam.
> Suriy-i-J:Iajj I.                                    Zfyarat-Namiy-i-Siyyidu'sh-Shuhada.
> 
> (Note: the works of Baha'u'llah, translated into English by Shoghi Effendi, are listed on p. 488.
> under the subheading, 'Translations'.)
> 
> COMPILATIONS IN ENGLISH
> Tablets of Bah<i.'u'lltih revealed after the Kittib -i-Aqdas
> 
> 2. THE BAB'S BEST-KNOWN WORKS
> 
> The Arabic Bayan.                                    Khasa'il-i-Sab'ih.
> Commentary on the Surih of Kaw!b_ar.                 Kitab-i-Asma'.
> Commentary on the Surih of Va'l - 'A~r.              Kitab-i-Panj -Sha'n.
> Dala'il-i-Sab'ih.                                    Kitabu'r-Rul).
> Epistles to Mul)ammad Shah and J:Iajf Mirza          Lawl)-i-J:I urllfa t.
> Aqasf.                                             The Persian Bayan.
> 486                                    THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> Qayyumu' l-Asma'.                                  $al)ffy-i-J a ' fari yyih.
> Risaliy-i-' Adliyyih.                              $al)ffiy-i-Makhzunih.
> Risaliy-i-Dhahabfyyih.                             $al)ffiy-i-Ra<;lavfyyih.
> Risali y-i-Fiq hiyyih.                             Suriy-i-Tawl)fd.
> Risaliy-i-Furu' -i-' Adliyyih.                     Tafsf r-i-N ubuvvat-i-Kha~~ih.
> $al)ffatu'l-J:laramayn.                            Zfyarat-i-Shah-' Abdu'l-' Ai:f m.
> 
> (Note: The Bab Himself states in one passage of the Persian Bayan that His writings comprise no
> less than 500,000 verses.)
> 
> COMPILATIONS IN ENGLISH
> 
> Selections from the Writings of the Bab
> 
> 3. 'ABDU'L-BAHA'S BEST-KNOWN WORKS
> 
> IN PERSIAN AND ARABIC
> Ad'fyyih va Munajat.                               Lawl)-i-Mul)abbat.
> Alval)-i-Tablfghi-i-Imrika.                        Lawl)-i-Tanzfh va Taqdfs.
> Alval)-i- Va~aya.                                  Lawl)-i-Tarbfyat.
> Khitabat dar Urupa va Imrfka.                      Madanfyyih.
> Lawl)-i-Aflakiyyih.                                Makatfb-i-' Ab du '1-Baha .
> Lawl)-i-'Ahd va Mithaq (Imrika).                   Maqaliy-i-Sayyal).
> Lawl)-i-'Ammih.                                    Mufava<;lat.
> Lawl)-i-Ayat.                                      Sharl)-i-Fa~~-i-N igf n-i- Ism-i-A ·~am.
> Lawl)-i-Du-Niday-i-Falal) va Najal).               Sharh-i-Shuhaday-i-Yazd va I~fahan.
> Lawl)-i-Dr. Fore!.                                 Sfyasfyyih.
> Lawl)-i-Haft Sham'.                                Tadhkiratu'l-Vafa.
> Lawl)-i-Hizar Baytf.                               Tafsfr-i-Bismi 'Ila hi ' r- Ral)man i'r- Ral)f m.
> Lawl)-i-Khurasan.                                  Tafsfr-i-Kuntu Kanzan Makhfiyyan.
> Lawl)-i-Lahih.                                     Zfyarat Namih.
> Law:i-Mal)fil-i-Shawr.
> 
> IN ENGLISH
> 
> The Secret of Divine Civilization. Baha' i Pub-    Tablets of the Divine Plan. Baha'i Publishing
> lishing Trust, Wilmette Illinois, 1957. Origi-     Trust, Wilmette, Illinois, 1959.
> nally published by Cope & Fenwick, Lon-          A Traveller's Narrative. Translated into Engdon, 1910, under the title The Mysterious          lish by Edward Granville Browne under the
> Forces of Civilization. Subsequently pub-          title A Traveller's Narrative written to illuslished by Baha'i Publishing Society,               trate The Episode of the Bab. Cambridge
> Chicago, 1918.                                     University Press , 1891. Baha'i Publishing
> Some Answered Questions. First printed by            Committee, New York, 1930.
> Kegan , Paul, Trench, Trubner and Co. Ltd.,      Will and Testament. Baha'i Publishing Com-
> London, 1908. Subsequently published by            mittee , New York, 1925 , 1935. Baha'i Pub-
> Baha'i Publishing Society, Chicago , 1918,         lishing Trust, Wilmette, Illinois, 1944, 1968,
> and other Baha'i Publishing Trusts.                and other Baha'i Publishing Trusts.
> Tablet to the Central Organization for a Du-       Memorials of the Faithful. Translated from the
> rable Peace, the Hague. Baha'i Publishing          original Persian and annotated by Marzieh
> Committee, New York, 1930.                         Gail. Baha'i Publishing Trust, Wilmette,
> Tablet to Dr. Fore/. Baha'i Publishing Commit-       Illinois, 1971.
> tee, New York, 1930.
> BAHA'i BIBLIOGRAPHY                                        487
> COMPILATIONS IN ENGLISH
> Foundations of World Unity; a se lection of let-     and the United States in 1912. Baha'f Pubters and public add resses. Baha'f Publishing      lishing Society, Chicago, 1922 a nd 1925.
> Trust, Wilmette, Illinois, 1945 .                Selections from th e Writings of'A bdu'l-Baha;
> Paris Talks; a compi latio n of His addresses in     compile d from His correspondence with
> Paris. G. Bell and Son Ltd., London, 1923.         individu al believers, groups and Asse mblie s
> Subsequently published by Baha'f Publish-          of the East and West. World Centre Publicaing Trust, London, 10th edition 1961; and in       tions, 197 8.
> the United States under the title The Wis-       Tablets of'Abdu'l-Baha, vols. I , II, Ill; a comdom of 'Abdu'l-Baha; Brentano's, New               pilation of His letters to individual believers
> York, 1924 .                                       in America. Baha'f Publishing Society,
> The Promulgation of Universal Peace, vols. I,        Chicago, 1909 , 1915, 1916.
> II; a compilation of His add resses in Canada
> 
> 4. SOME COMPILATIONS FROM THE WRITINGS OF
> BAHA'U ' LLAH, THE BAB AND 'ABDU'L -BAHA
> The Baha'i Revelation. Baha'i Publishing           Prayers and Meditations by Baha'u'llah. Baha'i
> Trust, London, 1955.                               Publishing Committee, Wilmette, Illinois,
> Baha'i World Faith. Baha'i Publishing Com-           1938, 1954, and other Baha'i Publishing
> mittee, Wilmette, Illinois, 1943, 1956.            Trusts.
> The Covenant of Baha'u'ullah. Baha'i Publish-      The Reality of Man . Baha'i Publishing Coming Trust, London, 1950; revised, 1963.            mittee , Wi lmette, Illinois, 1931; revised,
> The Divine A rt of Living. Baha'i Publishing         1962.
> Co mmittee, Wilmette, Illino is, 1944;           Selections from the Writings of the Bab. World
> revised, 1960.                                     Centre Publications, 1976.
> Gleanings from th e Writings of Baha'u'llah .      Tablets of Baha'u'llah revealed after th e
> Baha'i Publishing Committee , Wilmette,            Kitab-i-Aqdas. World Centre Publications;
> Illinois, 1939, 1952, and other Baha'i Pub-        1978.
> lishing Trusts.
> (Note: A large number of Prayer Books compiled of prayers revealed by Baha' u'llah, the Bab and
> 'Abdu'l-Baha has been published by Baha'f Publishing Trusts and National Spiritual
> Assemblies throughout the world.)
> 
> 5. SHOGHI EFFENDI'S BEST-KNOWN WORKS
> The World Order of Baha'u'llah. February,          America and the Most Great Peace. April,
> 1929 .                                             1933.
> The World Order of Baha'u'llah, Further Con -      The Dispensation of Baha'u'llah . February,
> siderations. March , 1930.                         1934.
> The Goal of a New World Order. November,           The Unfo ldment of World Civilization. March,
> 1931.                                              1936.
> The Golden Age of the Cause of Baha'u'llah.
> March, 1932 .
> (Note: The a bove seven essays have been published in one volume entitled The World Order of
> Baha'u'llah. Baha'f Publish ing Trust, Wilmette, Illinois, 1938. Revised edition, 1955;
> second printing, 1965.)
> The Advent of Divine Justice. Baha'i Publish-       Trust, Wilmette, Illinois, 1941.
> ing Trust, Wilmette, Illinois, 1939.             God Passes By. Baha'i Publishing Trust, Wil-
> The Promised Day is Come. Baha'i Publishing         mette, Illinois, 1944.
> 488                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> TRANSLATIONS (see note p. 485).
> 
> The Dawn-Breakers, by Mu~ammad-i-Zarandi ,         Prayers and Meditations by Bah ti' u' I/ah . Baha'i
> surnamed Nabil-i-A':-i:am. Baha'i Pub lishing      Publishing Trust, Wilmette, Illinois, 1938,
> Committee, New York , 1932 , and other             1962, and other Baha'i Publishing Trusts.
> Baha'i Publishing Trusts.                        Tablet to the Central Organization for a Dur-
> Epistle to the Son of the Wolf, by Baha'u'llah.      able Peace, The Hague, by 'Abdu'l-Baha,
> Baha'i Publishing Trust, Wilmette, Illinois ,      dated December 17, 1919. Published as a
> 1941, 1953, and other Baha'i Publishing            leaflet by Baha'i Publishing Trust, London.
> Trusts.                                          Tablet to Dr. Fore/, by 'Abdu' l-Baha . Pub-
> Cleanings from the Writings of Bahti'u'l/tih.        lished in Star of the West, vol. xiv, no. 4, July
> Baha'i Publishing Trust, Wilmette, Illinois,       1923 , p. 101. Subsequently published as a
> 1939, 1952, and other Baha'i Publishing            leaflet by various Baha'i Publishing Trusts.
> Trusts.                                          Tablet of the Holy Mariner, by Baha'u'llah.
> The Hidden Words of Ba/11i'u'lltih (Arabic and       Published in Star of the West, vol. xm, no. 4,
> Persian). Baha'i Publishing Committee ,            May 1922, p. 75. Subsequently published in
> New York, 1924. Baha'i Publishing Com-             Prayer Books and other compilations .
> mittee, London, 1932, a nd other Baha'i          The Will and Testament of'Abdu'l-Baha . Baha'i
> Publishing Trusts.                                 Publishing Committee, New York, 1925,
> Kittib-i-lqan, by Baha'u'llah. Baha'i Publishing     1935. Baha'i Publishing Trust, Wilmette,
> Trust, Wilmette, Illinois, 1931, 1950, and         Illinois, 1944, 1968, and other Baha'i Pubother Baha'i Publishing Trusts.                    lishing Trusts.
> 
> SOME COMPILATIONS FROM HIS WRITINGS
> 
> Bahti'{ Administration. Baha'i Publishing          Messages to Canada . National Spiritual
> Committee, Wilmette, Illinois, 1928, 1960.         Assembly of the Baha'is of Canada, 1965.
> Messages to America (1932-1946). Baha'i            Letters from the Guardian to Australia and New
> Publishing Trust, Wilmette, Illinois, 194 7.       Zealand (1923-1957). National Spiritual
> Messages to the Bahti'{ World (1950-1957).           Assembly of Australia, 1970.
> Baha'i Publishing Trust, Wilmette, Illinois,     Dawn of a New Day-Messages to India
> 1958.                                              (1923-1957). Baha'i Publishing Trust, New
> Principles of Bahti'{ Administration. Baha'i         Delhi, 1970.
> Publishing Trust, England, 1950.                 Directives from the Guardian. Baha'i Publish-
> Guidance for Today and Tomorrow. Baha'i              ing Trust, New Delhi, 1970.
> Publishing Trust, London, 1953.                  High Endeavours: Messages to A laska.
> Citadel of Faith (Messages to America                National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'isof
> 194 7-1957). Baha'i Publishing Trust, Wil-         Alaska, 1976.
> mette, Illinois , 1965.                          Call to the Nations. World Centre Publications,
> 1977.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                          489
> 6. LANGUAGE AND LITERATURE
> ACHIEVEMENTS OF THE FIVE YEAR PLAN
> Ric;lvan 197 4- Ric;lvan 1979
> 
> PRE VI 0 US volumes of The Bahd'( World list more than 550 languages, major dialects and scripts
> into which the Sacred Writings and other literature of the Baha'i Faith have been translated. The
> promotion of such translations has been an important objective of the international teaching
> plans conducted by the Baha'i world community over the years, with the purpose of making
> available to the believers in many lands the Scriptures of their faith in their own tongues.
> Information about the languages in which Baha'i literature is currently available may be obtained
> from the Baha'i World Centre, P.O. Box 155, 31 001 Haifa, Israel.
> Listed below, by continent, are the languages and dialects into which translations of Baha'i
> literature were first made, and those in which literature has been added, during the period between
> Ri<;lvan 1974 and Ri<;lvan 1979. These accomplishments include translations, publications and
> recordings on tape, although not all have been achieved in each of the languages listed.
> The usage and spelling chosen for primary listings and indication of dialect relationships
> follow, where possible, C. F. and F. M. Voegelin, Classification and Index of the World's
> Languages.' It is recognized by the compilers of this list that these designations sometimes do not
> reflect the name by which a particular language or dialect is best known , or the designation
> preferred by its speakers. Some variant names and spellings, including variants previously
> reported, appear in parentheses.
> The major countries, islands or territories where the languages are spoken are shown in italics.
> Where no such entry is given , the places where the language is spoken are so numerous and so
> widely scattered that to list them would be unwieldy; many of these languages are found
> world-wide.
> A. AFRICA
> 
> Newly Translated:
> 
> 1.      Anyi: Baule (Baoule) dialect (Ivory               16.        Diola: Kasa (Casa) dialect (The Gam-
> Coast)                                                      bia)
> 2.       Asu (Pare; Kipare) (Tanzania)                     17.       Ewe: Watyi (Ouatchi; Waci) dialect
> 3.       Awing (Cameroons)                                           (B enin; Togo)
> 4.       Bambara (Mali; Senegal; Upp er Volta)             18.       Frafra (Ghana)
> 5.       Bamoun (Cameroons)                                19.       Gurma (Gourma ; Gourmantche) (To -
> 6.       Bargu (Bargou; Bariba) (Benin; Togo;                        go; Upper Volta)
> Nigeria)                                          20.       Herero (Namibia/South West Africa)
> 7.       Bassa (Gbasa) (Liberia)                           21.       ~j9 (Ijaw) (Nigeria)
> 8.    te-Beembe (Kibembe) (Zafre)                          22.       Kaba (Sara Kaba) (Central African
> 9.       Berba (Benin)                                               Empire; Chad)
> 10.       Bete (Ivory Coast)                                23.       Kasem (Kasseme; Kasena; Kassena)
> 11.       Bini (Edo) (Nigeria)                                        (Ghana; Upper Volta)
> 12.      tBulu (Boulou) (Cameroons or Gabon)                24.       Kefa (Kaffa; Kaffigna) (Ethiopia)
> 13.       Busoong (Kuba; Bakuba; Bushong)                   25.    ra-Kpa (Bafia) (Cameroons)
> (Zaire)                                           26.       Krio (West Africa)
> 14.       Chiripon-Lete-Anum      (Cherepong;               27.       Kusal (Kusaal) (Ghana; Upper Volta)
> Guan) (Ghana)                                     28 .      Kwakum (Bakoum) (Cameroons)
> 15.       Dan (Gio; Guere; Yacouba) (Ivory                  29.       Kweni (Gouro) (Ivory Coast)
> Coast; Liberia)                                   30.       Maka (Makaa) (Cameroons)
> Foundations of Linguistics Series; Elsevier, New York and Amsterdam; 1977.
> tEfforts to obtain exact identification continue.
> 490                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 31.     Mano (Guin ea; Liberia)                      39.     Tamazight (Algeria; Libya; Mali;
> 32.     Moba (Chana; Togo; Upper Volta)                      Morocco; Nigeria)
> 33.     Nankanse (Nankani) (Chana; Upper             40.     Tiv (Nigeria)
> Volta)                                       41. t Tobote (Busari; Bassar) (Chana;
> 34.     Riff (Tarifit) (Algeria; Morocco)                    Togo)
> 35.     Sara: Sara-Majingai dialect (Central         42 . ci-Tonga, Malawian (Kitonga; Siska)
> African Empire; Chad)                                (Malawi)
> 36.     Somba: Niende (Gnia nde) dialect             43.     Tupuri    (Toupouri) (Cameroons;
> (Benin; Togo)                                        Chad)
> 37 .    Songhai (Sonrai): Dendi dialect              44.     Wescos (Cameroonian Pidgin) (West
> (Upper West Africa)                                  Africa)
> 38.     Songhai (Sonrai): Songhai dialect
> (Upper West Africa)
> 
> Insufficient Information (Further identification is needed to determine whether the
> following represent new accomplishments or enrichment of existing literature) :
> 
> 1.    t Batua (Lutua-Bambote)         (Rep orted     2.    Mende: Kpa dialect (Sierra Leone)
> from Zai're)                                  3.   t Yaoure (Yahore)    (Reported from
> Ivory Coast)
> 
> Literature Enriched:
> 1.       Adangme (Chana)                            23.     Fu! (Fula; Fulani; Peulh; Toucouleur)
> 2.       Afrikaans (South Africa)                           (West Africa)
> 3.       Akan: Asante (Ashanti) dialect             24 .    Ga (Ga) (Chana)
> (Chana)                                    25.     Gambai (Sara-Gambai; Ngambaye;
> 4.       Akan: Fante (Fanti) dialect (Chana)                Gombaye) (Chad)
> 5.       Akan: Twi (Akwapem) dialect                26. olu-Ganda (Luganda) (Uganda)
> (Chana)                                    27 .    Gbaya (Baya) (Central African
> 6.       Akoli (Acholi) (Sudan; Uganda)                     Empire; Cameroons; Congo)
> 7.       Amharic (Amarigna) (Ethiopia)              28.eke-Gusii (Kisii) (Kenya)
> 8.       Bassa (Koko; Mvele) (Camero ons)           29.     Hausa (Haoussa) (West Central
> 9. ici-Bemba (Wemba) (Zai're; Zambia)                      Africa)
> 10.       Creole, Indian Ocean (Mauritian            30.     Igbo (Ibo; Igho) (Nigeria)
> Creole) (Mauritius; Reunion; Seychel-      31. ke-Kamba (Kikamba) (Kenya)
> les)                                       32.     Kanuri (Chad; Niger; Nigeria)
> 11.        Dagbani (Dag bane) (Chana; Togo)          33.     Kikuyu (Kenya)
> 12. t Dinka (Sudan)                                  34.     Kongo (Kikongo) (Angola; Cabinda;
> 13.        Diola (Jola) (Upper West Africa)                  Congo; Zai're)
> 14.        Diola (Jola): Fogny (J6ola F6oiii)        35.     Kongo: Laadi (Lari; Balari; Kilari)
> dialect (The Cambia; Guinea; Senegal)              dialect (Cabon; Congo)
> 15 .       Duala (Douala) (Cameroons)                36.     Kpelle (Guinea; Liberia)
> 16.        Efik (Cameroons; Nigeria)                 37.     Logooli (Luragoli; Maragoli; Ragoli)
> 17.        Ekoi; Ejagham dialect (Cameroons;                 (Kenya)
> Nigeria)                                   38 .    Losengo: Mangala (Lingala) dialect
> 18.        Ewe (Benin; Chana; Togo)                          (Zai're)
> 19.        Ewe: Adjadia lect(Benin)                  39. si-Lozi (Zambia)
> 20.        Ewe: Ge (Mina) dialect (Benin; Niger;     40. ki-Luba-Katanga (Shaba) (Zai're)
> Togo)                                     41.     Luba-Lulua (Tshiluba; Ciluba) (Zai're)
> 21.        Ewe: Gu (Goun) dialect (Benin;            42.     Luba-Lulua:      Luba-Kasai     dialect
> Chana; Togo)                                      (Tshiluba of Kasai) (Zai're)
> 22.        F6 (Fon; Dahomeen) (B enin)               43.      Luhya: lu-Tiriki dialect (Kenya)
> t Efforts to obtain exact identification continue.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                      491
> 44. ci-Lunda (Angola; Zafre; Zambia)                           68.     Ruanda     (Kinyarwanda;      Runyar-
> 45. ci-Lunda: Ndembo dialect (Zafre)                                   wanda) (Rwanda)
> 46.      Luo (Kenya; Tanzania)                                 69. iki-Rundi (Kirundi) (Burundi)
> 47 .     Lwo (Uganda)                                          70.     Sango (Central African Empire;
> 48. ci-Makonde (Shimakonde) (Mozambi-                                  Chad; Congo)
> que; Tanzania)                                        71.     Sara: Sara Ngama dialect (Central
> 49 .     Malagasy (Madagascar)                                         African Empire; Chad)
> 50.      Masa (Massa) (Chad; Cameroons)                        72.     Serer (Serere) (The Gambia; Senegal)
> 51.      Masaba: ulu-Bukusu (Lubukusu)                         73.     Shilha (Algeria; Morocco)
> dialect (Kenya; Uganda)                               74.     Shilluk (Sholuk) (Ethiopia; Sudan)
> 52.      Mashi (Zafre; Zambia)                                 75.     Shona (Mozambique; Zimbabwe-
> 53. ke-Mero (Kimeru; Meru) (Kenya)                                     Rhodesia)
> 54.      More (Mossi) (Ghana; Togo; Upper                      76.     Sidamo (Sidamigna) (Ethiopia)
> Volta)                                                77. lu-Songe (Kisonge) (Zafre)
> 55. isi-Ndebele (Sindebele) (Zimbabwe-                         78.     Songhai: Zarma (Djerma) dialect
> Rhodesia)                                                     (Niger; Nigeria)
> 56.      Nguni: isi-Swati (SiSwati; Swazi)                     79.     Sotho, Southern (se-Sotho; Sesotho)
> dialect (Swaziland; South Africa)                             (Lesotho; South Africa)
> 57.      Nguni: isi-Xhosa (!Xhosa; Kaffir)                     80.     Swahili (Kiswahili) (East Central
> dialect (Botswana; Transkei, South                            Africa)
> Africa)                                               81.     Temen (Themne, Temne) (Sierra
> 58.      Nguni: Zulu dialect (South Africa)                            Leone)
> 59.eke-Nyakyusa: Ngonde (Konde) dialect                        82.     Teso (Ateso) (Kenya; Uganda)
> (Malawi; Tanzania)                                    83.     Tigrinya (Ethiopia)
> 60. ki-Nyamwesi (Nyamwezi) (Tanzania)                          84. ci-Tonga, Zambian (Plateau Tonga)
> 61.      Nyang (Kenyang) (Cameroons)                                   (Zambia)
> 62. ci-Nyanja (Malawi; Zambia)                                 85. se-Tswana       (Botswana;     Zimbabwe-
> 63. ci-Nyanja: ci-Cewa (Chichewa) dialect                              Rhodesia; South Africa)
> (Malawi; Zambia)                                      86.     Tumbuka (ci-Tumbuka; Timbuka)
> 64 . olu-Nyole (Lunyore; Lunyole) (Kenya)                              (Malawi; Tanzania; Zambia)
> 65. oru-Nyoro (Runyoro-Rutoro) (Uganda)                        87.     Wolof (Jolof; Oulof) (The Gambia;
> 66 .     Oromigna (Galla; Galligna) (Ethiopia;                         Mauritania; Senegal)
> Kenya)                                                88. ci-Yao (Chiyao) (Malawi; Mozambique;
> 67. shi-Ronga (Shironga) (Mozambique;                                  Tanzania)
> South Africa)                                         89.     Yoruba (Benin; Nigeria)
> 90. olu-Ziba (olu-Haya) (Tanzania)
> 
> B. THE AMERICAS
> 
> Newly Translated:
> 
> 1.       Alacaluf (Chile)                                     10.      Lokono      (Arawak,    Continental)
> 2.       Amuesha (Peru)                                                (French Guiana; Guyana; Surinam)
> 3.       Campa (Peru)                                         11.    t Ma cu (Maco) (Venezuela)
> 4.     t Catio (Colombia; Panama)                             12 .     Masco: Huachipairi (Amaracaeri)
> 5.     t Chinantec: Chinalteco de Tuxlepec                             dialect (Peru)
> (Mexico)                                            13.       Mascoy: Lengua dialect (Paraguay)
> 6.     t Chinantec: Chinalteco de la Sierra                  14.       Maya:     Mopan    dialect  (Belize;
> (Mexico)                                                      Guatemala)
> 7.     t Chiquitano (Bolivia)                                15.       Mazatec (Mexico)
> 8.       Conibo: Shipibo dialect (Peru)                      16.       Mbaya-Guaicuru: Payagua (Lengua)
> 9.       Cubeo (Brazil; Colombia)                                      dialect (Toba Lengua) (Paraguay,
> t Efforts to obtain exact identification continue.                      Bolivia, Brazil)
> 492                                              THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> 17.       Menomini (United States)                         25.      Tupi: Guarayu dialect (Bolivia)
> 18.       Mixtec (Mexico)                                  26 .     Tzeltal (Mexico)
> 19.       Ojibwa (Chippewa): Mississagi dialect            27.      Uapichana (Wapishanna) (Brazil;
> (Canada)                                                  Guyana)
> 20.       Paez (Colombia)                                  28.      Yagua (Brazil; Colombia; Peru)
> 21.       Piaroa (Venezuela)                               29.      Yupik, Central Alaskan: Yuk dialect
> 22.       Piro (Peru)                                               (Alaska)
> 23.       Tanaina: Kenai dialect (Alaska)                  30.    t Zamucoan,       Northern      (Ayon~,
> 24.       Tucuna (Ticuna) (Brazil; Co lombia;                       Ayoreo) (Bolivia; Paraguay)
> Peru)
> 
> lnsufficienl lnformalion (Further identification is needed to determine which of the
> following represe nt new accomplishments and which enrichment of existing
> literature):
> 
> 1.       Zapotec: Zapoteco de! Istmo (Mexico)               2.   t Zapotec: Zapoteco de la Sierra (Mexico)
> 
> Lilerature Enriched:
> 1.      Aleut (Aleutian & Pribiloff Islands;              22.      Koyukon (Alaska)
> Alaska; U.S.S.R.)                                 23.      Kuchin (Kutchin; Fort Yukon;
> 2.      Ashushlay (Chulupi; Tapiete) (Para-                        Loucheux) (Alaska; Canada)
> guay)                                             24.      Machiguenga (Peru)
> 3.      Aymara (Bolivia; Peru)                            25 .     Mapuche (Araucanian) (Argentina;
> 4.      Blackfoot (Canada; Uni1ed Slates)                          Chile)
> 5.      Bribri (Costa Rica; Panama)                       26.      Mataco (Argentina; Bolivia; Para-
> 6.      Cakchiquel (Guatemala)                                     guay)
> 7.      Carib (Brazil;      Guyana;     French            27.      Maya (Belize; Guatemala; Mexico)
> Guiana; Surinam)                                  28.      Miskito (Honduras; Nicaragua)
> 8.      Carib: Galibi (Carina; Karinja) dialect           29.      Otomi (Mexico)
> (Brazil; French Guiana; Guyana;                   30.      Paiute, Southern: Ute dialect (United
> Surinam; Venezuela)                                        States)
> 9.      Carib, Island (Garifuna) (Belize;                 31.      Papiamento       (Aruba;     Bonaire;
> Guatemala; Honduras)                                       Cura9ao)
> 10.      Cayapa (Ecuador)                                  32.    t Quechua (Argentina; Bolivia; Chile;
> 11.      Creole, Haitian (Haili)                                    Colombia; Ecuador; Peru)
> 12.      Cuna (Kuna) (Colombia; San Blas                   33.      Quiche (Guatemala; Mexico)
> Islands, Panama)                                  34.      Shuara (Jivaro) (Ecuador; Peru)
> 13.      Dakota (Sioux) (Canada; United                    35.      Shuara (Jivaro): Aguaruna dialect
> States)                                                    (Ecuador; Peru)
> 14.      Epera, Northern (Chocoe; Embera)                  36.      Sranan (Sranan Tongo; Surinamese;
> (Colombia; Panama)                                         Taki-Taki) (Surinam)
> 15.      Goajiro (Guajiro) (Colombia; Ven-                 37.      Sumo (Honduras; Nicaragua)
> ezuela)                                           38.      Tanana: Tan across dialect (Alaska)
> 16.      Guahibo (Colombia; Venezuela)                     39.      Tlingit (Alaska; Canada)
> 17.      Guaymi (Panama)                                   40.      Toba (Argentina)
> 18.      Haida (Alaska; Canada)                            41.      Tupi: Guarani dialect (Argentina;
> 19.      Inuit (Inupiaq): Kobuk (Kotzebue)                          Brazil; Paraguay)
> dialect (Alaska)                                  42.      Yaqui (Mexico; Uniled States)
> 20.      Jicaque (Xicaque) (Honduras)                      43.      Yaruro (Venezuela)
> 21.       Kekchi (Ketchi) (Belize; Guatemala)              44.      Yukpa (Colombia; Venezuela)
> t Efforts to obtain exact identification continue.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                        493
> c. ASIA
> Newly Translated:
> 1.      Azerbaijani (Adhirbayjani; Azeri)                     8.    Maldivian (Divehi Bas) : Divehi script
> (iran; Soviet Adhirbayjan)                                  (Maldives; Minicoy Island)
> 2.      Bisaya (Sarawak; Borneo; Brunei)                      9.    Maldivian (Divehi Bas): Latin script
> 3.    t Dangi (India)                                               (Maldives; Minicoy Island)
> 4.      Dayak, Land (Bidayuh): Jagoi                         10.    Melanau: Oya/Dalat dialect (Sarawak)
> (Biratak) dialect (Borneo; Sarawak)                  11 .   Pala wan on (Philippine Islands)
> 5.      Japanese,Katakanascript(newscript)                   12 .   Rajasthani: Gujuri (Gujari) dialect
> 6.      Kazakh: Cyrillic script (Kazakh S.S. R.;                    (India; Pakistan)
> China)                                               13.    Sanskrit
> 7.      Kazakh: Latin script (Kazakh S.S. R.;
> China)
> 
> Insufficient Information (Further identification is needed to determine whether the
> following represent new accomplishments or enrichment of existing
> literature):
> 1.    t Agta (Philippine Islands)                             3.    'Dialect of the Montagnards' (Viet-
> 2.       Murut, Sarawak (Malaysia, Indonesia)                       nam)
> Literature Enriched:
> 1.       Arabic                                              23 .     Kurdish    (Afghanistan;      Armenian
> 2.       Armenian                                                    S.S.R.; iran; 'Iraq; Syria; Turkey)
> 3.       Balochi (Baluchi) (Afghanistan; Ara-                24.     Lao (Laotian) (Laos; Thailand)
> bian Peninsula; India; iran; Pakistan;               25.     Malayalam (India, including Lacca-
> Turkmen S.S.R.)                                              dive Islands)
> 4.       Bengali (Bangladesh; India)                         26.     Marathi (India)
> 5.       Bengali: Assamese dialect (Northeast-               27.     Melanau: Mukah dialect (Sarawak)
> ern India)                                           28.     Nepali (Nepalese) (Nepa l)
> 6.       Bengali: Tripuri (Kok-Borok) dialect                29.     Oriya (Orija) (India)
> (India)                                              30.     Oriya: Halbi (Halabi) dialect (India)
> 7.       Biko! (Bicol) (Philippine Islands)                  31.     Pangasinan (Philippine Islands)
> 8.       Burmese (Burma; Bangladesh)                         32.     Panjabi (Punjabi) (India; Pakistan)
> 9.       Chinese                                             33 .    Persian (Farsi)
> 10.       Dayak, Land (Bidayuh): Bukar                        34.     Sebuano       (Cebuano)      (Philippine
> Sadong (Tebakang) dialect (Borneo;                           Islands)
> Sarawak)                                             35.     Sindhi (India; Pakistan)
> 11.       Dayak, Sea (!ban) (Borneo; Sarawak)                 36.     Sinhalese (Sri Lanka)
> 12.       Gondi (India)                                       37.     Tagalog (Filipino) (Philippine Islands)
> 13.       Gujarati (India)                                    38.     Tamil
> 14.      Hanun6o (Philippine Islands)                         39.     Telugu (India)
> 15.       Hindi (India; Africa; Fiji Islands;                 40.     Thai (Thailand)
> Guianas; Surinam)                                    41.     Tibetan, Central (Bh6!iii): Lhasa
> 16.      Ilocano (Philippine Islands)                                 (Dbus) dialect (India , Tibet)
> 17.      Ilonggo     (Hiligaynon)     (Philippine             42.     Turkish
> Islands)                                             43.     Turkmen       (Turkoman)       (Turkmen
> 18.      Japanese                                                     S.S.R.; iran; Afghanistan)
> 19.      Kannada (Kanarese) (India)                           44 .    Urdu (India; Pakistan)
> 20.      Kashmiri (India; Pakistan)                           45.     Vietnamese (Vietnam; Kampuchea;
> 21.      Khmer (Cambodian) (Kampuchea;                                Laos; Thailand)
> Thailand; Vietnam)                                   46.     Waray (Waraywaray; Samar-Leyte;
> 22.      Korean (Korea; China; Japan)                                 Samarefio) (Philippine Islands)
> t Efforts to obtain exact identification continue.
> 494                                              THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> o. AUSTRALASIA AND THE PACIFIC ISLANDS
> 
> Newly Translated:
> 
> 1.       Akei (Navaka) (New Heb rides )                        7.   Me le: Fila dialect (Fila & Efate Islands,
> 2.       Carolinean (Caroline Islands; Sa ipan)                     New H eb rides )
> 3.       'Fiji Hindi ' (Fiji Islands)                          8.   Rennellese: Bell ona dialect (Solomon
> 4.       Gao (Solomon Islands)                                      Islands)
> 5.       Kara (Papua New Guinea)                               9.   Tanna: Le nake l dialect (New Heb-
> 6.     t Kombe (Papua New Guinea)                                   rides)
> 
> Literature Enriched:
> 
> 1.       Areare (Solomon Islands )                           21.    Palauan (Pa lau) (Caroline Islands;
> 2.       Baining (New Britain Island, Papua                         Guam)
> New Guinea)                                         22.    Pidgin , Fijia n (Fiji Islands)
> 3.       Bogutu (Solomon Islands)                            23.    Pidgin, New Hebrides (Bislama) (New
> 4.       Chamorro (Guam and oth er Mariana                          Hebrides)
> Islands)                                            24.    Pidgin , Pap uan (Neo-Me lanesia n)
> 5.       Easte r Isla nd (Pascuense) (Easter                        (Papua New Guinea, including Admir-
> Island)                                                    alty Islands)
> 6.       Efate (Efatese) (New Heb rides)                     25.    Pidgin , Solomon Islands (So lomon
> 7.       Efate: Erakor dialect (New Hebrides)                       Islands)
> 8.        Fijian (Fiji Islands)                              26.    Ponapean (Eastern Caro lin e Islands)
> 9.       Gilbertese (Kiribati; Nauru; Ocean                  27 .   Roviana (Solomon Islands)
> Island)                                             28 .   Samoan (Samoa; New Zealand; United
> 10.        Hawaiian (Hawaiian Islands)                               States)
> 11.        Kosraean        (Kusaiea n)  (Carolin e            29.    Tahitian (So ciety Islands; Tuamotu
> Islands )                                                  A rchipelago;      Marquesas    Islands;
> 12.       Kwara?ae (Solomon Islands )                                Gambier & Austral Islands)
> 13.        Langalanga (Solomon Islands)                       30.    To nga n (Tonga Islands; Uvea (Wa llis)
> 14.        Lau (Solomon Islands)                                     Island, Loyalty Islands)
> 15.        Lifu (Lifouan) (Loyalty Islands)                   31.    Trukese (Caroline Islands)
> 16.        Maori, Coo k Islands (Rarotongan)                  32 .   T uva luan (Ellicean) (Tuvalu; Nauru;
> (Cook Islands )                                            Toke lau Islands; New Zealand;
> 17.        Maori, New Zealand (New Zealand)                          Hawaiian Islands; Swain 's Islan d,
> 18.        Marshallese (Marshall Islands)                            Samoa)
> 19.        Motu, Hiri (Papua New Guinea)                      33 .   Ya pese (Caroline Islands)
> 20.        Nengo ne (Mareen) (Loyalty Islands)
> 
> E. EUROPE
> 
> Newly Translated:
> 
> 1.       Breton (Northwestern France)                        4.    Latin
> 2.       Italian: Logodurese dialect (Sardinia)              5.    Romany: Sin to dialect (Northern Italy)
> 3.       Ladin (Italian & Swiss Tyrol)
> 
> t Efforts to obtain exact identification continue.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                          495
> Literature Enriched:
> 1.     Albanian (Albania; Bulgaria; !1aly;        19.       Greek , Modern (Greece; Cyprus;
> Greece; Unired States; Turkey; Yugo-                 Egypt; Italy; Balkans; Western Europe;
> slavia)                                              Africa; North & South America;
> 2.     Arabic: Maltese dialect (Maira)                     Australia; Turkey)
> 3.     Basque     (France,     Spain,   North     20.       Hungarian
> America)                                    21.       Icelandic (Iceland, United States)
> 4.     Bielorussian       (White      Russian)    22.       Italian
> (Bielorussian        S.S.R.;     Poland;    23.       Lettish (Latvian) (Latvia)
> Lithuania)                                 24.       Lithuanian
> 5.     Bulgarian       (Bulgaria;      Greece;    25.       Norwegian:       Riksmal     (Bokmal)
> Rumania; U.S .S .R.; Yugoslavia)                     (Norway, Unired States)
> 6.     Croatian (Serbocroatian, Latin script)     26.       Polish    (Poland;    Czechoslovakia;
> (Yugoslavia; Austria; Czechoslovakia;               Canada; Germany; Rumania; United
> Hungary; Italy; Rumania)                             Srares; U.S.S. R.)
> 7.     Czech     (Czechoslovakia;      Poland;    27.       Portuguese
> United States)                             28.       Romansch: Sursilvan dialect (Switzer-
> 8.     Danish (Denmark; Germany; United                    la nd)
> States)                                     29.       Rumanian (Rumania; Albania; Bal-
> 9.     Dutch                                               kans; Canada; United States; U.S.S. R.)
> 10.     English                                    30.       Russian
> 11 .    Estonian                                   31.       Serbian (Serbocroatian, Cyrillic script)
> 12.     Farnese (Faroe Islands)                             (Yugoslavia; Austria; Czechoslovakia;
> 13.     Finnish (Finland; Estonia; Sweden;                  Hungary; Italy; Rumania)
> Unired States, U.S.S.R.)                   32.       Slovak (Czechoslovakia; Hungary;
> 14.     French                                              Yugoslavia)
> 15.     Frisian (Frisian Islands; Germany; The     33.      Slovene (Yugoslavia; Austria; Italy;
> Netherlands)                                        Hungary; United States)
> 16.     Gaelic, Irish (Erse; Irish) (Ireland;      34.       Spanish (Spain; Africa; Caribbean;
> Unired Kingdom)                                     Central America; Philippine Islands;
> 17.     German                                              South America; United States)
> 18 .    German:       Luxembourgian      dialect   35.       Swedish (Sweden; Canada; Estonia;
> (Luxembourg)                                        Finland; United States)
> 
> F. INVENTED LANGUAGES
> 
> 1.    Espe ranto
> 
> G. TOTAL BY CONTINENTS
> 
> Needing
> Newly                Further          Literature
> Translated         I demifica tio n     Enriched
> Africa                        44                      3                90
> The Americas                  30                      2                44
> Asia                          13                      3                46
> Australasia and the
> Pacific Islands               9                                      33
> Europe                          5                                      35
> Invented langu ages
> 
> 101                     8              249
> 496                                     THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 7. THE SHORT OBLIGATORY PRAYER
> IN 391 LANGUAGES, DIALECTS OR SCRIPTS
> 
> I bear witness, 0 my God, that Thou hast created me
> to know Thee and to worship Thee. I testify, at this moment, to my powerlessness and to Thy might, to my
> poverty and to Thy wealth.
> There is none other God but Thee, the Help in Peril,
> th e Self-Subsisting.
> 
> Short Daily Obligatory Prayer in Arabic and English.
> 
> ABOVE is the original Arabic and its translation into English of one of the prayers
> revealed by Baha'u'llah and prescribed for fulfilment of the daily obligatory prayer. It is
> known as the Short Obligatory Prayer, and when used is recited once in twenty-four
> hours, at noon.
> Following are translations of this prayer in 389 additional languages, dialects or
> scripts listed according to the continents to which those languages are indigenous.
> Included are some recent translations which are not reflected in the preceding statistical
> listing.
> The usage and spelling chosen for primary listings, and indication of dialect relationships, follow , where possible, C. F. and F. M. Voegelin, Classification and Index of the
> World's Languages. It is recognized by the compilers of this list that these designations,
> therefore, sometimes do not reflect the name by which a particular language or dialect is
> best known, or the designation preferred by those who speak it. Some variant names a nd
> spellings, including variants previously reported , appear in parentheses.
> Exceptions to Voegelin & Voegelin's usage have been made in a few cases: where the
> name of a language has been officially changed in the country in which it is spoken;
> where Voegelin & Voegelin 's primary listing is known to be considered pejorative by
> speakers of the language or dialect; and in a few other instances. Also, certain of the
> European dialects of Scandinavian and Netherlandic-German have been listed as
> separate languages, on the basis of their long separate histories as literary languages.
> BAHA ' I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                           497
> Where ide ntification in term s of this standard refe rence has not yet bee n comple ted, the
> nome ncl ature reported to the World Ce ntre by the Nationa l Spiritual Asse mbly
> responsible fo r the accomplishment has been used, and such translatio ns are indicated
> by a dagger. An aste risk denotes an improved translation made ava il ab le for this volume
> in a language which has appeared in earlier vo lumes.
> The major countries, islands or territories where the la nguages are spoken are shown
> in italics; wh ere no such entry is given, the places where the language is spoke n are so
> numerous and so widely sca ttered that to list them would be unwield y: ma ny of these
> la nguages are found worldwide.
> Totals for each continent are: Africa, 129; th e Americas , 89; Asia, 90; Australasia
> and th e Pacific Islands, 31; E urope, 49; Invented languages, 2; Braille, 1. The total
> number of translations and transliterations is 391 .
> 
> A. AFRICA
> 
> * Denotes revised translatio ns.        t Effo rts to obtain exact id entification continue.
> ADANGME (G hana)                                     Otumfo:>, medi hia buroburo na WoyE :>defo:>.
> Oo TsaatsE Mawu i ye:> he odase kaa 0 b:> mi         Onyame fofor:> biara nni h:> ka Wo ho, :>haw
> konE ma le Mo nE ma ja Mo. Pi:> hu i ngE he          mu Boafo:>, Wo na wote Wo hone W'ase.
> odase yee kaa i be he wami ko; Moji he wamitsE,
> AKAN: Fante dialect (Ghana)
> ohi afo ji mi se Mo LEE niatsE ji Mo NgE Ose :>
> Mawu ko be hu . Moji wa yemi kE buab ngE                0 , m'Ewurad ze, mid zi dase dE :>wo ab:> me dE
> haomi mi nE haa w:> wami.                            munhu Wo na monsom Wo. Midzi dase sesei
> dE mennyi a ho:>dzen biara na :)wodze EyE
> AFRIKAAN S* (South Africa)                           Otumfo, mid zi hi a neminemi na :)wo EyE
> :>dzefo.
> E k getuig, 0 my God, dat U my geskape het            Ewuradze, obiara nnyi h:> kii wo ho, :>haw
> om U te ken en U te aanbid. Ek betuig op             mu :) boafo, :)wo a :Jwoara Etse W'ase.
> hierdie oomblik my magteloosheid en U mag,
> my armoede e n U rykdom.                             AKAN: Twi (Akwapem) di alect (Ghana)
> Daar is gee n ander God buite n U nie, die            0 me Nyankop:>n, Midi Ada nse SE Wo na
> Hulp in Gevaar, die Self-Bestaande.                  Woab:> me SE min hu Wo na mensom Wo. Midi
> adanse w:>saa d:>n yi mu SE me de memfra na wo
> AKAN : Asante (Ashanti) di alect (Ghana)             na Wow:> tumi, meyE ohiani na Wo na Wo yE
> 0 me Nyame, medi adanseE SE Woab:J me SE           :)defo.
> menhu Wo na mensom Wo. Medi adanseE seesei              0 Nyame bi nni baabi SE Wo nkutoo Kore
> SE menni aho:>den biara na Wo deE WoyE               Ahohia mu Boafo ne Onyame a:)nnan obi.
> 
> AMHARIC (AMARIGNA : AMARINYA) (Ethiopia)
> 1'9°1\h. tr.et hi·,./ "/P,m-:t>'i' "(l"l.F.-f.\U?" 11/.l'..· 1,/J.'.
> l.mch~ 1,ou(lnt-t\o· trH· ;1c or~:nC'l·)· 1111.u':)·· ·1. 11. f~»
> ~ti"'IH·'i f'}·,.1 ~.~f.\~;I. ! n1 9°llh./~·)·'i' f1·,.1 '/11:1·9"~·}
> 1'G:J"l"1"V- o tn-1· 'lJ.'.•"J 1.11. t:~·)· hr·hnar'i 0·111 1,.(luyn
> h9°..,. 'i Gll>- '\9° l\h    Oil.,..,,
> c t\.I '\9" I h f" 9° I
> A WING (Cameroon Republic)                           nfomeh, nsi pe h mbeh tsu yi mbe chiki nfoh .
> Nsi yi tsih langna yo h koh tchipo le tsoyoh
> Mbi Nsi-me h pah-aneh tsunkene me nge h
> mbo-oh kwal e meh mbo nge h, mbo-oh wa
> ngo nke-yeh.
> me-meh .
> Nji yanengeh mangleh nwu te meteneh, Nsih
> peh nchi ne metiem eh chemeh, mangleh
> 498                                      THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> BAMBARA (Mali, Senegal, Upper Volta)                   BERBA (Benin)
> Mbi shereya , E Alla, ka don ko e de ye nda             N'fare natwag::im alahf:n tiyorriptu adwose
> ko nki'don, ki'batu. N'tikera'ka ka'don ko se te       b::inaars mma mantE m'mafaa. Swamswam n'nye
> ne ye, setiki de ye eye, fen nte ne fe , fen tiki de   n'yal)::isi nem pwat::im n' nwam a big::i. Tuwo kpa
> ye eye.                                                be katawe, a we bega w a pwase hirbe a nwan
> A ll a were shi'te fo eke len , E m in be se ka      hira ntinwe hira n 'fusu u hiim.
> mogo demen ka bo geleyala, E min ma da fen             BULU t   (BOULOU)             (submi11ed     from
> re.                                                    Cameroon Republic )
> Me ne nga a Zambe worn, na Onga te ma na
> yeme Wo a kan fe Wo. Ma mem eyon ji na ,
> BAMOUN (Cameroon Republic)
> Ngul jam eno momo ve enjoe nje ene, name ne
> 0 nyinyia me na kuot nta mi U ka puoma mi            azoe ve Wo One Kum; Zambe mfe anji bo ve
> njiU mbe kuepehU . Nj i na mi Upua' Fossku             Wo etam, Ny6 a vo l6 eyon ya njuk , Ny6 a vee
> mbe fueke't, mbua mbure u pe Fon yamyum.               be emien .
> Mo ' Nyinyi ndi' a Ii na vou , U pua nga yi
> BUSOONG(KUBA, BAKUBA , BUSHONG)
> ngamii tu ngue ', U pira' Nkake.
> (Zaire)
> NANAYEPE NTSHIAMIEME , WAMPUAN-
> BASSA (GBASA) (Liberia)                                GIDI AD!OYO DIA YEPE A DIA TSH!NI.
> NANAYEPE A !TENIKUYI, BUOLO BUEME,
> 1V1 Nr-1 zase o N,- Gedep5~ ka bi                     BUKUOKOYO BUAWA, NTANA MUEME , A
> mml m bi rh ke In dyl dyvto :; ke bi rh                BUDIYI BUAWA . KUA NTSHIAMA YEKE A
> MUNA WENE , ANAMANA BAMUENGU,
> ke m bie 0... M Zaa /1\IS'xn ho kaim ofe               OLOKATUONO WENE MIETE.
> N/ kfe[ riyt hwi hui.. ::; ke de /YI kpe
> CHIRIPON-LETE-ANUM (CHEREPONG ,
> b ede hede l't7Llc. d.b N,·ga dye dye mu               GUAN) (Chana)
> J ke  de  N; bJ ba lril.{[ G8dep:5) k.ako
> 0 1 Me Onyankop::m ; megyi adanse SE Wo ::ib::i
> do se ni .:i se  rn
> doon m!J rn Ja Ny::; )n              me SE me bEbE hu Wo ne me si Wo. Megyi
> 9bo kpa Np de de Seen mUE.. , ke Jn                    adanse kaake m::i SE me mmi; a yule akoa ne wole
> sea_gbo kpa Nyj m!J kE, ,                              Wo de ayule mm::iodahwE. Megyi ehia buburo
> ne wolei; Wo de sika mm::iodahwE.
> Onyankop::m akoa bi;ti; ka Wo so. Wo ne Wo
> BATUA (LUTUA-BAMBOTE) t (submitted                     hu rne mm::ib::i borne amanehunu tE. Wo ne Wo
> from Zai're)                                           EfE yi Wo yo so .
> MAKUY IMBANGA WOBE NTSHAMBE WAMI                       CIOKWE (CHOKWE) (Ango la, Zaire)
> WANGUANGILA BUA MEME KUKUYIBA
> MA KUKUNEMEKELA MIYIBANGA DIOM-                          Yami nguli chela che, 0 Yihova , Zambi
> BANTSHL BUNTALADI BUAMI NGOLO-                         yami wangutangile mumu ngukuningike ni
> SHABE, MUTANDA WAMI KUD!Yl BUABE.                      ngukuhalise. Ngunatawiza ha sh imb u line,
> KAKU TSHAMBE WIKA YELELE MULIOBE                       kulela cha mini tachije, ushwale wami ni upichi
> MUKUIDIDI WAMBANA MUENGU UL!                           we. Kushi Zambi mukwongwe yene, Yoze wa
> OBENKE.                                                kupulula atu mu lamba lia ufwe, ni Yoze uli ni
> mwono wa mutolo mu li iye mwene.
> 
> ici- BEMBA (WEMBA) (Zaire, Zambia)                     CREOLE, INDIAN OCEAN                   (Mauritius
> Island, Reunion, Seychelles)
> Ndes ininkisha, Mwe Lesa wandi, ukuti
> Nimwe Mwa ne nge le uku Mw ishaba ku                     Mo temoigne, Bon Die, qui to fine cree moi
> Mpuepa. Nde su mina , pa kashita aka ,                 pour conne toi et adore toi. Mo confesse mainku lu bulwa amaka yand i nakubukulu Bwenu ,            tenant mo impuissance d ivan to puissance et
> kubupabi bwandi naku bukankala Bwenu.                  mo pauvrete divan to richesse.
> Takuli Lesa urn bi kanofye Im we, Kafwa mu             Na pena ene lote Bon Die qui toi, celui qui
> Buchush i, Mwe Baikalila Mweka .                       aide dans danger et existe par Ii meme.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                         499
> DAGBANI (DAGBANE) (Chana , Togo)                    Kpeh Obasi ettat chang breh Weh , nyoh
> anyangane Kpekpe nah Nfoneh arr ingeh Bejih
> Nti , ti Duma Nawuni yeda , kaman nyini n
> Ebeh.
> Nam ma, ni n mi Nawuni , ka dzemdi nuni Na
> titam la na. N ti yeda punpno , kaman Naa n
> kani n pahi nuni Na ti tam lana; nun tiri nira    EMBUNt (submitted from Zai're)
> fara ni buni.
> Mwenzem, me lengyuy: Nze oweng me
> Sheli ka m n kani n pahi la nuni Nawuni Nati
> ongir eyu , ongir eboyi , Lale owu kapah , me ngy
> tam lana; nuni yihiri mira fukunsi ni , kao nam
> eyu obets onze, ngol anze , ompur ome, obwel
> saxinrla o ko .
> onze.
> Nze mur kabe fan , kadze Nzem asa ne Nze ,
> DIOLA (JOLA) (Upp er West Africa)
> Nze okolume bar engots , Nze oye kabewang.
> Fetan fet , aw Atty Jamet, mate a w tepan min
> emanji de pop ne kobe. Ka bajati oum sembe
> ku fetanfet nyemi mo may, de samba ye yourley     EWE * (B enin, Chana, Togo)
> yamakaye, kabajatiyoum waff de fu bajafoley          Meqi qase, 0 nye Mawu , be Ew::im be man ya
> famakafu.                                         Wo eye masub::i wo. Meqi qase le yeyiyi sia me le
> Bajut Atty Jamet ake a wujumi aw , aranbay      nye IJuseman::>IJU kple Wo giinyenye l)Uti, le nye
> nawu de bu gall aw akum fange.                    hla kple wo kesin::inuwo l)Uti.
> Mawua qeke megali wu Woo, Kpeqel) ut::i le
> DIOLA (JOLA): Fogny (J6ola F6oni) dialect         Xaxame. Amesi le agbe le edokui si .
> (The Cambia, Guinea, Senegal)
> Fiitanfiit, Jamit I Mati aw u tuukaam man i    EWE: Ge (Mina) dialect (Benin, Togo)
> manji , ni saafi. Tan emmi iIJje let waaf, aw u
> IJOOlenum wanoosan , ni maIJmaIJ mati fnje           Mougni dasse, o gne Mawu, odom be madjessigne eye massomonye. Mougnan Ouelebe
> asukateen, aw u kaanum erfmbaa n.
> Bajut e mit yaakeen leejaa taw, apakenem di    kea ape housin mado. Coudo apo hounsin
> katakasak, aw awbom di fuk6i.                     dodo ape aya coudo opo tchikpokpo .
> Nouctekpe mougbade ouwo, ame ke hona na
> DUALA (DOUALA) (Cameroon Republic)                ameo be afocoume amekele edokesia.
> 
> Ne mboil , a loba lam na o weki mba o bia oa
> na o sesa oa. Na dub~ tatan bgb9 lam ngiilang9,   EWE: Watyi (Ouatchi , Waci) dialect (Benin,
> tue lam mbwan mgng9.                              Togo)
> Loba dip~p~ di titi buka t~ oa m~n~ mg
> Me <{u qase, o Mawuyen, be ye <{6wun ne ma
> mongwanedi o ndutu nu nye na mgm~n~.
> jesiye eye ne ma sum::iye. Le gayame a, me yan
> EFIK: lbibio dialect (Nigeria)                    wunsenmaqoyen ku wunsenqoqoo, ayayen ku
> q::ikuo. Mawu <tokpo me gba lei t6vo neo,
> Ami medi ntiense O! Abasi mi, nte ke Afo        kpe<{eamewuntit::i le Xaxame, Ame ke su eqokoi
> okobot mi, man ndiono Fi , nyun nkpono Fi.        ji a.
> Ami metin iko ntiense kemi ndiwut unana
> odudu mi, ye odudu Fo , nyun nwut nko ubuene
> mi ye inyene Fo.                                  FO (FON, DAHOMEEN) (Benin)
> Abasi efen iduhe ke ebede Fi , Andinyana          Ijeri ng Mahu che, dg yewe dami do gbeme
> kini nanenyin , Akama idem ikpon.                 b9 wa tu.
> Mahu che unt dote nou houe do houi we se
> EKOI: Ejagham dialect (Cameroon Republic,
> mi do be me bo ni na do tun houe bo na non sin
> Nigeria)
> houe. Unt do gbe gni nou troue we do hon
> Njime ntiese Atta Obasi, bre Weh otureme       lonhon Ion che so nou de a gna che kpo do
> se nding Wah na nyube Wah.                        dokou mi ton kpo.
> Meh nwoh otti kah njgime nyih, kah ogong         Nou de bou so de bo hou houegna houi me
> ohome na kah ikonm Effah, kah okpagk              de e non houin !in gbe gan bo ka non sous sous
> ohome nah kah effonome Obah.                      hoye nou me houin de sous non.
> 500                                      THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> FUL (FULA, FULANI, FULFULDE, PEUL,                     GBA YA (BA YA) (Central African Empire,
> TOUCOULEUR) (West Africa)                              Cameroon Republic, Congo)
> Mohal berde di labbinta ha dir berde an Allah       Mi ne sadako, i So ko' m, Me dee am ha' m me
> an, a kesuna kala ku mi wadata dir herde an,           ding-Me in me gasi Me. Mi to kinii gaa ko'm in
> wala wadowo bo sai an mo hisintammi . Der              ngai ko-Me, tal aka ko'm in pkamo ko-Me.
> berde ma di labbinde a usatan ko dume ha                  Ma So bona, Kaa ne Me, Wan ne gbak mo ,
> berde am, ya an mo yidiyam hedi labbinde               sai fio, Wan ne duk ne te-A ne te-A.
> mangol ma, a holliyam gidol ma, de ni an on
> timitorde ku'a yidi. Defte warol ma di von-            GOUNt (Benin)
> natako waddi beldum ha dir berde an, an mo
> timminta be bo yokkowo do yukkol.                      Yin we yi kpajjle, oklu non ton, de da na dg yon
> in bg na dg sin . Yin wle tg wenin nou do ma do
> gan tche kpg houhlon tg we kpg wa mon non
> FUL: Torado dialect (Senegal)                          gni gni tche pg ado koun tg we kpg.
> Ye do kpg non we gni ji we ye we, ye me non
> Mi sedi, Ala , a'tagi lang mi andu mi julane.        de me son ahou fiessa me , ye de kg gni nou da
> Mijabi heh wasude dole ang de heh mounti-              hg na de we.
> nare ma, heh wasude am heh kebal ma ang.
> Wode Ala godo sina mada, walo wo fowu                GURMA (GOURMA, GOURMANTCHE)
> darani do hore mung. (O'do julde foti halade           (Togolese translation)
> nyarol ma wo nyarolma.)
> N'tie Seeda O ntienou, kaata gume, Ke min
> banda Ke ya dona- m'band molane m' bame
> GA: Accra dialect (Ghana, Togo)                        yen ayabam, N'tan larem yen aya piam. Furn
> bare n' ba yaka tien Kiye Kebe guna tipo ti tuo
> Miiye odase, Oo mi-Ny:>IJm:>, akE Ob:i mini
> mbire. Wan ye bin loucoul.
> male Boni madza 0. Mi ye::> he odase IJmEh:tswaa
> DEE. Miiye migb:idz:im:i IE kE OhewalE IE, mihia
> kE Oninam:i IE he odase.                               GURMA (GOURMA, GOURMANTCHE)
> Ny:iIJm:i kroko ko bE OsEE Dza Bo. Buab YE          (Upper Volta translation)
> fim:i beiaIJ kE m:i ni YE ha Le-dirntsE ehe.              n tie siedi, oo n tienu, k'a tagin ni ke min
> band' a, gi go ya jand'a
> n tuo moala moala ne ke n bani ke n tadi gaa
> GAMBA!         (NGAMBAI,          NGAMBA YE)           pia paalu, gi go tuo ken bani k'a pia upaalu , gi
> (Chad)                                                 go tuo ke n luo, k'a pia
> Tien to gii ye kaa tie fin bebe yua n fa bidi gi
> Ei Allah !em, mam'too jee naige taree, I ya ram
> nyandi fala ciamun ni.
> kam geri !em mba kam mosso kul noin'g !em.
> yua n fidii ye o yuli po.
> Mayan missi noin'g basine , ma m'to nje rem
> I too je singa mon'g, ma m'to nje ndoo I too nje
> ne kinga.                                              HAUSA (Nigerian dialect)t (Chad, Niger,
> Allah I ya ge kari ba, I ya too je la ge doje log   Nigeria)
> toobel g I ya too deou doroi.                            Na shaida, Ya Allah na cewa ka halicce ne
> domin in yi maka sujada. Ina furci a wannan
> lokacin cewa ni mara iko ne ta wajen ikon ka
> olu-GANDA (LUGANDA) (Uganda)                           domin patara ta ta wurin yalwarka. Babu wani
> Allah sai kai domin ka yi taimako cikin wahala.
> Nina obujjulizi, Ai Katonda wange, nti wan-          Kai da kake mai riko .
> tonda okukumanya n'okukusinza. Nkakkasa
> mu kiseera kino obutesobola bwange,
> HERERO (Namibia/South West Africa)
> n'olwobuyinza bwo, mu bwaavu bwange, ne
> mu bugagga bwo.                                          Ami meri hatoi Jehova kutja ove uendji
> Tewali Katonda mulala okugyako, Ggwe,                utira odu kutjiua noku ku kumbira . Ami
> Omuyambi mu kabi, Eyemalirira.                         moruveze nekui meyeta okuhinomasa kuandje
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                             501
> momasa uoye, ousyona uandje momautumbe                        KASEM (KASSEME, KASENA, KASSENA)
> uoy e .                                                       (Ghana. Upper Volta)
> Kapena Mukuru ua rue pendje naove omu-                         A yi kashetu, o a ko WE, ni mu mu yi teru, mun
> vatere uo momauzeu nomurikuramene.                            kia a m u, si a ta she mu.
> Lele kun t u a ye a bw;:m;i, mu yi dan mama tu
> .>.. -                                                    a n yi yi ni g;i tu, mi yi !JOO m a ma tu .
> HOA t (Botswana)
> WE di don da ter;i, ku na da mu, WE din di joIJ
> Mace. \1111 st 1lGa111a he .        ·o c·eo ·a ma          tim , WE dim di kati wur;i tim.
> n [ne ma ct     ·a ·u    ken [ne st   ce\5-su ·u.  Ma
> e-KELE (LOKELE) (Zaire )
> qhalce. k'1 [he'e ha kl. kl \1111 s~ kt- [go'oa kl
> ' ii u-s t ke ·r1 sl kt-11'6 . kl 'i1m st ki-[go'oa kl           0 Mungu wami, isornE mbo okelimi eoka
> iluweke la iinelek' AE . Iswimela nda eye mbileye
> Il ka ·a qa ke ·nsi kt-jua
> bowandu wami la bofoka w'AE; iuw'ami la
> Ya [gci'oa llGama Oktii ha yi1 n [hM ka
> lifoka liaE.
> b ·o. Ki- [nui ox·oe. wA. ki           1·E.e.                    AngoEnE M un gu wasi sakoloko AE, oyo
> a tosungaka nda mbile ya tale, oyo ayali laya
> la ya.
> HUA (!XO)t (B otswana)
> NI e Ku-:J:e , ma ll'ha ka gllkqon [i te: Inga r.idi        KIKUYU (GIKUYU) (Kenya)
> Inga i- lga. lyta ll' ha cen kona ll'a : te: Inga ih ll' ha     Ndi muira Ngai ati niwanyumbire niguo
> ka kona Ii te: Inga , !J1 ll' ha cen la t'hani lui te:        ngumenye na ngugocage wee Mwathani Ngai.
> Inga ih ll' ha ka la t'hani ll'ali te: Inga.                  Ninjui kahinda-ini gaka ni wa unini wakwa hari
> Ku-:J:e te'e r.i ll'a ka le !'an ti, ah'a: kar.i lgHbi      Wee na uthini wakwa ni undu wa utonga waku.
> uhi: , ah'a: !ngoa ka tam .                                     Gutiri Ngai ungi thengi a Niwe hari uteithio
> waku mathin a-ini na Uhoti Waku.
> IGBO (IBO , IGHO) (Nigeria)                                   KIMPIN (KIPINDI) t (Zai're)
> A bum onye aka-ebe, 0 Chinekem na                           Kierek, a Nzem a mi, Nze le mandoen umuin
> ikerem kam mara Gi n'etokwa Gi. E kwuputawo                   mukukuyebanga ti mukukufukiminanga . Tan
> kwe m, n' oge dj ugbua, adjghj ike m ma Gj                    a lia, ekis bumol ba mi ti bungol ba Nze, busui
> Onwe Gj dj ike; A dim ogbeye ma Gi Onwe G j                   ba mi ti bunvam ba Nze. Kukitene, lo kufuyini
> bara uba Odighi C hine ke QZQ ma ewezuga Gi.                  ti Nzem a mben , kaka Nze mbwes Nzem , u
> Onye iye aka na mgbe nmek pa a ru, Onye Nwe                   useresa band mu bigonz, u uzing a mumpil e
> Onwe ya.                                                      nzien mbwes.
> 
> KONGO (KIKONGO) : ki-Tuba (Kituba)
> KABA (SARA KABA) (Central African
> dialect (Angola, Congo Republic, Zai're)
> Empire, Chad)
> Ngienina mbangi, o Nzambi ame, vo wan-
> Alama! Ma mi-gi ta kundoy ma, ta ki gi m- a i,
> vanga mu kuzaya ye mu kufukamena . Yisunta koso ma kur kajama nui. Ta yo ton , m-ob
> gamena mu ntangu yayi kiwayi kiame ye kim -
> han ma ma te togon nge, bi I a te togon bo, ma
> fumu kiaku, ki sukami kiame ye kimvuama
> mate ndon , bi I ate na n ndeyn.
> kiaku.
> Ala nge kumboi ndete . Iba i nge kajade, Iba
> Ngeye mosi kaka i Nzambi, Ngeye
> i nge ngom roi te njoi.
> wusadisanga muna sumbula, Ngeye wuzinganga mun a Ngeye masi .
> KANURI (Chad, N ige r, Nigeria)
> KONGO: Kimanianga dialectt (Zai're)
> Wuye shadan gcr na, Ya Ala. nyiga notcrga
> a batt crga garo wuga alakkamro. Wuye sa allan                   Ntele kimbangi, 6 Nzambi ami, i Ngeye wa
> tabatkcrskcrna nem duno ban yiga du no ncrmgaro               mvanga mp asi vo yakuzaya ye kuzitisanga
> ncrm denyiga ncrm qwowa ncrm garo.                            mpe. Ye buabu , ngieti zaya vo lebakana kuami
> Nyilan nguron Ala gade ba , banama yim                     i lulendo luaku , bumputu buami i kimvuama
> banna 'be, kcrndcrga kcrla ncrmbelan kargam.                  kiaku.
> 502                                           THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> Kakuena Nzambi ya nkaka ko , ye mu ntangu                  ko ul ne koul mo Gw6, ne louko mo gwiimbo,
> a mpasi Ngeye wusadisanga, kadi Ngeye wena                   ne ikoum mo Gwo.
> mu Ngeye kibeni.                                               Che fete ne Chambo u f6kou chimio, Mo
> kamlche o bocho, Mo ndonch nyoutche dje
> KONGO:         ki-Ntaandu        (Kintandu)       dialect    tchitche.
> (Zaire)
> oci- KWANYAMA (KUANJAMA, KUANY-
> 0 Nza mbi a me , ngin a mbangi bonso
> AMA) (Angola, Namibia/South West Africa)
> unga nga mu kuzaya ye mu kuzitisa. Yi kuzeyi
> bungangi mu ngolo za ku ye bumo lo bumunu ,                     Ondi sisi, Kalunga ka nge, no ku ti a ove ua
> mu kimvuama kiaku ye kimputu ki a mu. Ga                     sitange ndi ku sive, ndi ku linjongamene. O ha
> nkatu Mfumu nkaka bonso Ngeye, Yu ukunk-                     ndi, hokolola , pe fimbo eli , mo ku he na e non o
> atu la mu kigonsa , Mfumu ya ni mosi ukiga nga.              kuange ndelene mo lu eno no Doje, mo luhepo
> la nge no mo luo upun a Uo je.
> KONGO: ki-Zombo                 (Kizombo)        dia lect       Kape na nande Okalunga va mue ndelene
> (Angola, Zafre)                                              Ove, Omukuafi, uopo up atekedi , O u mu Ove
> E Nza mbi 'a ma, nsidi 'e kimbangi vo Ngeye                M ue ne.
> wa mpa nga mukuzaya ye kukunda . Ewau
> !KWit (Botswana)
> ntambuluidi 'e nbovok 'ama ye ngolo zaku,
> kimputu kiama ye kimvu ama kiaku.                               Tse xo sa khe khoa I ha, II Kama kha khi di be,
> Kavena Nza mbi 'e nkaka ko vo ka Ngeye ko,                 kha tsae qxo kh e a ts'ao ta tsa a kh a, ta tsa
> Ona unanga usadisi muna sum bul a, Ona                       tsaoama kha. Khe khoa dtkum nlngi lkam, khi
> unanga mun a Yani kibeni.                                    kha tsaa sa tsa kha kh edi se he, khi kha 1xo m xa
> tas kha khobe se he.
> KPELLE (Guinea, Liberia)                                        I Kama hk a lk li be ha be tsa lkwi' e, xwe kxam
> l)a I maa seri faa kc, 0 IJ a ra lai, a gEE ya gbEt£      tsa se' ua, qx'oe kha tsa lkwidi s kha.
> IJa bbl) IJa I fi:li. l)a faa ma kp:m::i IJi IJa fii kp EE
> LOGO (LOGOTI) (Sudan, Zaire)
> SU da I wala laa da kolo laa da I t::i::i laa i, ra la da
> kp::ini fe na fEE n::i ya t::in::i, l kp::iIJ maai kukul a      0 Djuka, miba ta ma a mi ni zo mpe
> mrni kpulu su, I kEtEi I kpil) kpon6i.                       amiakumbamelizo. A nd ra konidi, mali mivo
> amitada ma ngufwa yo, am i ngufu lavu lavu
> KRIO (West Africa)                                           ama tiza mpe ami mosoro.
> God, a h know say you make me for know                        Djuka az ia yo paka mi , api mon dia alunguli
> yo u, e n pray to you. Ah day te ll you new wit all          ta mabi a, api adrile ise.
> me heart say ah can' t do nattin without you
> becoss you power pass all, en oar you han all tin            LOSENGO:         Ma ngala     (Lingala)    dialect
> day. Nor o rd e r God no r day pass you: oar you             (Zafre)
> day ep way trouble can en day keep life                        Nazali nze ne ne ke, o Nzambe wa ngai, 'ta
> together.                                                    okeli ngai mpo nayeba Yo mpe natondo Yo;
> nakondima bebe na bolembo bwa ngai mpe
> KUSAL (KUSAAL) (Ghana, Upper Volta)                          bokasi bwa Yo, na bobola bwa ngai mpe
> Mam nil) F u kaseta, 0 ma m Winam , ye F u                bokumi bwa Yo .
> mal mam ye mbaIJi Fu ka dol-li Fu. Mam nil)                    Nzambe mosusu lokol a Yo aza li te , ozali oyo
> yada nanna OE ma m nE bu m::it paIJa nE Fu nE                akosalisa otango ya mpasi, oyo akotikala se Ye
> m::it pal); nE mam nE m::it O:Jl) nE Fu nE m::it naam.       moko.
> Winam hi gal) Fu; Fu s::in it kyE beene; F u
> pal) kyEi beene.                                             si-LOZI (Zambia)
> Kina paki mulena mulimu waka, uni bupezi
> KWAKUM               (BAKOUM)              (Cameroon
> kuli ni kuzibe hape ni ku lapele . Na lumela ka
> Republic)
> nako ye kuli niya fokola wena ki wena ya ma ta ,
> Ndji mo chenle o Chambou wiimbo, gwe chi                   na mi shebile we na ufumile. Akuma mulimu
> me kwa mbe, n'na mben chenlo. Nyi nko                        usili kwanda ahao , kiwena mutusi mwamatchimio nyi nkache tchin g none , nyi mbek ne                nyando aluna, upil a katato yahao.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                       503
> ki-LUBA-KATANGA (KILUBA) (Zai're )               eni ami nidiku ni ngolu, Ayi Nzambi Pungu,
> ami nidi musuyi , Ayi mvwama.
> Na kwabij a , 6 Leza wani , wampangile
> Nzambi Pungu mweka kadiku , Ayi wokutmwanda wa kukuyuka ne kukutota. Pa kifuko
> susadisanga mu yigon sa, Ayi Fumu wodifuka .
> kino , nas a ma ky a kanwa kyami , kukulombola
> bunkomo-nkomo bobe, kulandapala kwami,           LWO (Uganda)
> ne buipeta babe.
> I Kutupu Leza mukwabo enka abe ,                 Ai Lubanga, aye ni In icweya me ngeno In ki
> witabanga mu bya malwa , kudi yewa ukulupie      me woro In. Anyutu kombedi ni tekona pe
> mudi aye mwine.                                  ento diti tye , ni an laca n In lalonyo.
> Pe tye dok Lubanga mukene kono In ,
> LUBA-LULUA        (TSHILUBA ,      CILUBA)       La kony ican , dok Ikwo giri keni.
> (Zaire )
> ci-MAKONDE (SHIMAKONDE) (Mozam-
> Ndi njadika , Wewe Mvidi-Mukulu wanyi, ne      bique, Tanzania)
> wakamfuta bua kukumanya ne bua kukutendelela. Ndi njadika mu tshitupa tshihi emu,        Ninkukupa utestamunya, wako Nnungu
> bufuba buanyi ne bukole Buebe, bupele            wangu, kuchi doni Wako uningumba nangu
> buanyi ne bubanji Buebe.                         mwaha nikumanya na nikujugwe. Nink-
> Kakuena Muidi-Mukulu mukuabo bu                ulyaula, mu yola ai Kupo la kwangu na
> Wewe, M-Muambuluishi wa mu Dikenga ,             dimongo dyako , umachikini wangu na utaju li
> Nyeye udi wikalaku anu Yeye-Nkayende.            Wako .
> Pachanya    Pakoapali    Nnungu       unji ,
> ci-LUNDA (Angola , Zaire, Zambia)                Wakupochela mu chijoidyo, ulikuluysila wako.
> Eyi Nzambi yami, eyi inkeni wankeneli
> i-MAKUA (MAKHUWA)t (Mozambique,
> kulonda nikiwluki kulonda nikulombeleli.
> Malawi)
> Nacheseki, hampinji yinu, ha kubula inovu
> jami, mukulema kweyi muwuzweni wami                Kinniwerelani namona, Kho Mulukwaka,
> muku heta kweyi.                                 wera wi Nyuwo Mokipatusha wi miyo Nyuwo
> Kosi Nzambi ji Kwawu ja cheniku china eyi      Kosuweleni ni wokokhorani Kinnilapa mwa
> hohu. Eyi inkwashi inhembi wayuma yejima.        chuhu yela ethu yohiwereya mene ikuru sanyu,
> muthonyero aka ni muhakhwanya.
> ci-LUNDA: Ndembo dialect (Zaire)                   Khavovo Muluku Mukina opwaha NYuwo,
> Nidi kanbaji keyi 0 Nzambi yami , netu yeyi    okikhunela mu sawopiha yowo onikhala Mwa
> wanleneli mulona wakukwiluka ni kuku             yowo Mekhaiye .
> hameka. Nashimuni chalala lelu dinu kuzeya
> MALAGASY (Malagasy Republic)
> kwami ni novu jeyi, uzweni wami ni kuheta
> kweyi.                                             Toviko, Andriamanitro 6 , fa Ianao no
> Kosi Nzambi mukwau china yeyi hohu, on a       namorona ahy , mba ha halala Anao sy ho tia
> wakulana mu malwa, ona wahaya ny a ka kudi       Anao. Tsaroako amin ' izao fotoana izao ny
> eyi aweni.                                       fahalemeko miolotra amin'ny herinao, sy ny
> fahantrako mano loana ny harenao. Tsy misy
> LUO (Kenya, Tanzania)
> Andriamanitra afa-tsy Ianao, dia Ilay miaro
> An Janeno Nyasacha ni ichweya mondo            amin'ny loza, Ilay misy tokoa amin'ny mahaang'eyi kendo apaki. Awacho sani kuom            Andriamanitra Azy.
> nyawona kendo kuom ekoni kuom dhier na
> kendo kuo mmwanduni . Onge Nyasaye               MANDINKA (MANDINGO) (Upper West
> machielo ngang' mak mana in, Jakony e ndalo      Africa)
> mag chandruok, Nyasaye manyalo duto.               N'sedeya , n'mari ko I'ye n'da le ke !'long
> aning ka I'batu.
> ki-LUUWA (KILUW A) (Zaire)
> N'sonta n'na sembeng tang ya la aning I'te la
> Nakumbula ha mesu matshu akhima eni ayi        bungba ya, N'fua re ya anina I'la bana ya. Ala
> Nzambi wonguhangidi mu sambu die kuk-            koteng mang soto fo I'te, I'dembari la, I'meng
> wizika ni kukufukimina. Kikitsudi eki, nezika    ye !'fang tarandi.
> 504                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> MASA      (MASSA)         (Chad,     Cameroon          Wennam ato ka lebe n bee, kal Yamb bala,
> Republic)                                           Yamb yaa asoaba ninga s'h fiingda se n data
> fiingere , Yamb yaa asoaba ninga sen bee ne a
> Nan wi touanou nan sama souloukna Launa
> meng panga.
> vanou nang la nou, a nan wangou grivangou.
> Wili ni nan wala toutga vanou ti denota van-
> NAMA: Damara dialect (Namibia /South West
> gou, haouta vanou nan tia tangou.
> Africa)
> Lau mara meidi kouta kan nangou samara
> ma soua meidi.                                         TI TA GE RA tGOM !KHOB !NA, TSl lllB A
> GURU AO !KAI SA 111 BA TA NI :j:AN TSl
> MASABA: ulu-Bukusu (Lubukusu) dialect               IGORE II SE. TI tKA WU-SA SIB TSI llIB IGAIB ,
> (Kenya , Uganda)                                    TI IGASA SIB TSI llIB !KHUSUB, !KHU I XARE
> I HA TAMA HA lllB OSE, HUIB TSO !GAB DIB,
> Esendi ne bung'ali, 0, Wele wase, sikila Ewe      TSl +oBAN HOAN !NA.
> wanonga khumanye ne khu khusikamila Ewe.
> Nga ndola luno luri, khu mani kase kamakekhe        oru-NDANDI (KINANDE) (Zai're)
> khu bunyali Bwowo, khu butambi bwase, khu
> lndi kyimisho, 0 Nyamuhanga waghe
> buhinda Bwowo.
> Ngoko wanyihangika okwikuminya n'okwik-
> Saliho Wele okundi nokhali Ewe, Omuyeti
> wanza n'olwanzo lunene Ngaminya okonmubutinyu , Oliyo yeng'ene.
> dambi'eno ovolo vwaghe n'ovutoki vwaghe
> MASHI (Zai're, Zambia)                              Ovusama vwaghe n'ovungi vwaghu.
> Sihali wundi   Nyamuhanga oyuti'iwe
> Neci Yagirwa Nnamahanga , manyirire oku           Oyukasavula omonavi, oyuliho okwiye musa.
> wandemire mpu nkumanye na nkuharamye .
> Bunola nyemire obuzamba bwani n'Obuhashe            isi-NDEBELE (SINDEBELE) (Zimbabwebwawe, obukenyi bwani n'Obugale bwawe.              Rhodesia)
> Wene Nnamahanga nta wundi, we burhabale
> Ngiyafakasa, 0 Nkulunkuly wami, ukuthi
> omu mbaka, we Nnamubaho.
> wangidala     ukuthi    ngikwazi,     njalo
> ki-MBUNDU (KIMBUNDU)t (Angola)                      ngikukhonze. Ngiyufakaza kathesinje, ngingelamandla kuwe OMkhulu, ebumpofini bami
> Ngabana umbangi uami u Nzambi iami,               lekunothemi kwakho.
> mukonda eie ua ngi bange pala ku kuijia ni
> Akakho omunye UNkulunkulu ngaphandle
> kukubeza.                                           kwakho. UnguMgcini eziNgozini Ungo
> Ngadifisala mu kitangana kiki o kubuila           Ncedayo .
> kuami ne kutena kue, uadiama uami ni
> unvuama ue. Kanaku Nzambi iengi kikale Eie          ci-NDONDE (KIMAWANDA, KONDE)t
> ng6, u Mubuludi bu i bidi, u Lenda-dia lenda.       (Tanzania)
> MENDE: Kpa dialect (Liberia, Sierra Leone )           Nilikumanya, wako Nungu wangu, doni
> Selim:> b a nge. 0 nya Yew:ii kE Bia mia Bi     undingumba     nikumanye    nikupambedye
> nya gbatcni b:i ngi Bi g:>:> ngi yaa a hEE Bi ma.   Wako. Niku-kumanyia kwa wakati hau,
> Nyaa gayema kiahuna, kE kpaya gbi ii nya WE,        kudidimanga kwangu na chakulula Chako, na
> kE !eke Bia kpaya Maha Wai a Bie; nya               umasikini wangu na uhumu Wako.
> vi::Eling:>e, kE !eke Bia Kpati::i gbi i Bi yeya.     Apali Nungu junji ni Wako, Wakupwazela
> Ngew:i weka gbi ii na aa wie kia Bi na.         Mu-mauvilo Muwikala Umwene wa uti.
> Bia mia Ba gb:i mu ma kpundi:: gbi hu. Bia
> oci-NDONGA (AMBO, OCHINDONGA)
> yakpe mia Ndi::vui i Bi hu kunafJ va .
> (Namibia/South West Africa)
> MORE (MOSS!) (Ghana , Togo, Upper Volta)
> Gena okutumbulwa lumwe mootundi
> Mam yaa kaset soaba, 0 mam Wennam , ti            Omilongo mbali na ne, Omutenya.
> yamb naana ma ti m bange la waoge Yamba.              Ongame otandi hempulula Kalunga Kandje,
> Mam wilga Yamba mam pan-komsem                    kutya ongoye wa shiti ndje ndi ku tseye ngame
> morsa, la Yamb panga; mam na6ngo la Yiimb           ndi ku longele nokukugalikana. Otandi hemaezegse.                                            pulula mpaka uunjengwi wandje moonkondo
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                     505
> dhoye noluhepo lwandje mUuyamba woye.           ki-NY AMWESI (NY AMWEZI) (Tanzania)
> Kakuna Kalunga gulwe ponto yoye , Ongoy
> Ndisanizya, Guku Mulungu wane ati wam-
> Omukwathi mUudhigu, Ongoye Omuyapuki.
> bumba kigele nkumanye na kukwisenga
> B'eb'e. Ndizumilizya, henaha ku vugayiwa
> NGUNI: isi-Swati (SiSwati, Swazi) dialect
> nguzu kwane na kuvusondo wako, kubapina
> (Swaziland, South Africa)
> wane na kuvusavi wako.
> Ngiyafakaza, Maye Nkulunkulu Wami, kutsi         Kuduhu Mulungu ungi sumbwa B'eb'e wakungidalele kwekuba ngikwati ngikukhonte .       isa mumaluduko na wa kuhola kuhanya.
> Ngiyafakaza, manje, kutsi anginawo emandla
> Wena unemandla lesabekako, ngimphofu            NYANG(KENYANG) (Cameroon Republic)
> Wena ucebile.
> Ntei ntise o ta Mandem , be me kewoke Wo,
> Akekho lomunye Nkulunkulu nguWe
> ndu bering~ Wo ne besepti Wo, ntei ntise tete
> kuphela, uMsiti etiNgotini, Wena lotiPhilela
> ne, ndu bepab ebah ne betang Ebe, bdu nchep
> ngeKwakho.
> eya ne kefor Eke, Mandem achek apu ane acha
> Wo, Mpeme ndu esongeri ane atei chi ndu
> NGUNI: isi-Xhosa (!Xhosa , Kaffir) dialect
> metyi.
> (Botswana, Transkei, South Africa)
> Ndiyangqina 0 Thixo wan ukuba undidalele      ci-NYANJA      (CHINYANJA)         (Malawi,
> ukuba ndikwazi ndikunqule . Ngako oko           Zambia)
> ndiyangqinisisa ngalo eli thuba ngokun-
> Ndicitila umboni , 0 Ambuye, Mulungu
> gabinamandla kwam, nobungangamsha Bakho,
> wanga, kuti munandilenga kuziwa Inu ndi
> ngobuglwenpu barn, nangobutyebi Bakho.
> kukondani Inu. Ndibvomela panthawi ino
> Akukho Thixo ngaphandle kwakho Oluncedo
> kulefuka kwanga ndi kukula kwa mphamvu
> emngciphekweni Ozimele ngokukokwakhe.
> zanu, kusauka kwanga ndi kulemela kwanu.
> Kulibenso Mulungu wina koma Inu nokha
> NGUNI: Zulu dialect (South Africa)              Muchinjilizi, Mwini zonse.
> Ngi yafakaza, Nkulunkulu wami ukuthi
> ungidalele ukuba ngi kwazi nokuba ngi Ku        ci-NYANJA: ci-Cewa       (Chichewa)   dialect
> konze. Ngi ya qinisa, kulo mzuzu, ukuthi angi   (Malawi, Zambia)
> namandla wena u namandla onke, nokuthi            Ndicitira umboni, O! Mulungu wanga , kuti
> ngimpofu mina u cebile Wena.                    munandirenga ine kuti ndikudziweni ndi
> Amukho omnye u Nkulunkulu ngaphandle          kukupembedzani. Nditsimikiza pa nthawi ino,
> Kwakho, U wu Msizi e ngozini, U zimele ngo      kufooka kwanga ndi kukula kwa mphamvu
> Kwakho.                                         Zanu, kusauka kwanga ndi kulemera Kwanu.
> Palibe Mulungu wina koma Inu nokha ,
> eke-NYAKYUSA: Ngonde (Konde) dialect            Wothandiza pa tsoka, Wodzithandiza Nokha.
> (Malawi, Tanzania)
> oru-NYORO          (RUNYORO-RUTORO)
> Nguyagha nketi wako, E! Kyala wangu,
> (Uganda)
> ukuti walimbelile une ukuti ngumanye,
> nukukwiputa yuyuwe. Ngwitikisya akabililo         Nimpayo obukaiso, Ai Ruhanga wange, ngu
> aka, nensita maka, kangi Mmaka ghako            niwe wampangire nkuramye kandi nkumanye ,
> amakulumba, mbutolwe bwangu na mbukabi          nindanga omukasumi kanu, mu bugara
> Bwako.                                          bwange kandi mu buguuda bwawe.
> Akayako Kyala uyungi Ioli yuyuwe popapo,        Busaho Ruhanga ondi , Kwihaho iwe wenka,
> We ntuli mbutolwe, Uliko kubumi wi Mwene .      Omukonyezi omukabi, Anyakwomeera.
> 506                                                                      THE BAHA ' I WORLD
> 
> OROMIGNA (GALLA , GALLIGNA , GALLINYA) (Ethiopia , Keny a)
> 
> ~q 1 :J>t 1    >i•nl'l.O.h·t.                >i'111'l.t'l·1P.. .<". ,,.,..,, .... h. ·l·h-t ,,..)nn(llJt,. 11
> ff:' h'H: M.              ~.4fl·l·h-t 1          kl: ~'"f.\-i.;1· ·H'"!1. >ih'f.1'·1ml' :"1hi":·'"'h.1'1.
> ., '} 'I '"I ti
> >d:      flt· l llS }'""'# ·1c;1i:ti 'l lf'.:f' J.t:}fl·I : (l.11"/t,'1" h-"7') 11.'1.lr
> 
> ), h» )( /..     ., ')II .• ,    II
> 
> PHIKAHNi t (submitted from Mo zambique )
> Ndzi maha a fakazi, oh Xikuembu xa mina.
> Lesuaku hambi lesui u ndzi Wumbeke aku ku
> tiva ni kuku khiza mela. Ndzi maha fakazi hi
> xikhati xai suosui. Agomeni la mina, mintanwini ya Wen a . Aussiwanini la mina awumpfundzini la wena.
> Akuna Xikuembu xinwana handlhe ka wena
> mumpfuni wa tink a rhato ni nwinhi Wamintamu.
> 
> RIFF (TARIFIT) (Algeria, Morocco)
> 0       -   ,,.                                   0          /
> "-         ~;,)                 ........ -:.""J-""'                           ,...              ·:·
> ,~~l(rif.;J?~I y; ~~~
> o ....   i         ~ ,..       ~ ~
> d% i"..;.; ._::.;:,:~ j__;. t~I • t..i..: ;,;: I
> ..I                    -   -   -;                          :   .....
> 
> 0         .....                     _.                                  0       ;;; ...    0      -       ,,,...
> 
> ~v- ..C:.);~~ .:y;.~1 ~.;
> pt]~~.; . Ci,(~.); JJ , D,;{
> (~;; \:'.:~ g.; ~J, .z .c.:: a5J. 01;;
> "              0            j                             "
> 
> /~f ~~fi;p~i(~& j(
> 
> shi-RONGA (SHIRONGA) (Mo zambique,
> South Africa)                                                                                           RUANDA                                        (KINYARWANDA,       RUN-
> y AR WAND A) (Rwanda)
> Ni hamba bumboni Oh! Sikwembu fanga.
> Lesaku nambi lesi uni bumbiki akuku tiba niku                                                         Ndemera Mungu wanjye, ko wandemeye
> ku nkhinsamela, ni yentfa bumboni hi nka ma                                                         kukumenya no kugusenga. Muli aka kanya,
> wa §osi agomeni danga ami ntanwini yaku,                                                            nemeye amagara make yanjye n'ubushobozi
> abusiwanini bya nga abu pfundini byaku.                                                             Bwawe,   ubukene bwanjye n'ubukungu
> Akuna Sikwembu simbe handle kwaku,                                                                Bwawe. Ntayind'Imana ibaho itali wowe,
> mupfuni wa ntikarato nwinyi wa mintamu.                                                             Umufasha mu byago , Ubaho kubwe wenyine.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                                   507
> iki-RUNDI (KIRUNDI) (Burundi)                                         togoum goto ngang Yai o, ndo yam o i yan
> kingue Yai.
> Ndi icabone, 6 Mana yanje, ko Wandemye
> Allah krang ki toi goto, Yi ngue korjiko kem
> ngo nkumenye kandi ngo nkusenge. Ndemeje
> yah ki madjal guetio, Yi kba tel roi yi Allah.
> murak' akanya ubuto bwanje n' ubushobozi
> bwawe, ubworo bwanje n'itunga ryawe.
> SHONA (Mo zambique, Zimbabwe-Rhodesia)
> Ntayind'Imana iriho atari Wewe, Utabara
> mungorane, Uwibeshejeho .                                               Ndinopupura, 0 Mwari wangu, kuti makandisika kuti ndimuzivei nokukunamatai. Ndine
> umboo panguva ino, mukushaya simba
> SANGO (SANGHO) (Central                             African           kwangu nesimba Renyu, kuurombo hwangu
> Empire, Chad, Congo Republic)                                         nekuupfumi Hwenyu.
> Mbi yeke temoin, O Nzapa ti mbi, biani Mo                             Hakuna mumwe Mwari kunze Kwenyu
> sala mbi , si mbi lingbi ti hinga Mo, ti vuro Mo,                     Muhatsiri mumatambudziko, Uyo asingade
> mbi fa sioni ti mbi na ngoi' so na gbele Mo, passi                    rubatsiro.
> ti mbi na ndoye ti Mo.
> Mbeni Nzapa nde ayeke pepe, gui Mo oko                             SHONA: Kalanga dialectt (Botswana,
> Mo Jo ti bata ajo na ya ti ngangou, Mo yeke                           Zimbabwe-Rhodesia)
> la koue lakoue.                                                          Ndo pa malebeswa, mu Ndizmu, kuti
> makandi e ta kuti ndi mu zibe ne ku Mu shin-
> SARA: Sara-Majingai (Madingaye) dialect                               gila. Ndo tendeka mu tjibaka i tjetji, kuti shaya
> (Central African Empire, Chad)                                        masimba kwangu ne simba Lenyu, Bushayi
> gwangu ne fumwa Yenyu. A kuna mwe
> M'Guergo Nuba yam, kade oubum, m'Gueri                             Ndzimu kuzhe Kwenyu. Ntjidzi mu magwadzi,
> o, m' ndoi' o. M'Guer rokum, ngolan'to Togum                          ntjili muli Moga.
> goto, yi Tog yai', Rondo yam ke yan kinga yai'.
> Nuba ke rang ke toi' goto, ngue kordje kem                         SHUA (SHUAKHWE) (Botswana)
> yam ke madjalgue te, ngue tog.
> Tse hu sere o ke ta k6 , ti Tora to, tsa ta 'a se
> nya aha, ti tsa 'a 'a na tsa 'a hyaa ma tia . Take e
> SARA: Sara Ngama dialect (Central African
> lkam an ll'a u, ta ci o lhoa tsa kari lhoa ta ye o
> Empire, Chad)
> lhoa tsa ll'ai lhoa.
> Me guer go Allah yam, Kad yi ram Kad                                  Tora ka ny:e h :a tsam se, Tho ke hu 'a kwara
> m'guerio m'doi o. M'guer go rotam, tam ri wa                          kwe, lklii se hk'oe kwe.
> 
> SID AMO (SIDAMIGNA, SIDAMINY A) (Ethiopia)
> 
> '"I ,1 <;'Y   >H; >a. ·n 'l"t;'             'l" cf1'· h. ,,. )./,. "'I '°lti&.'J" 11
> flr? 1-o <fP '/.   1.1.
> >"ti;   ti. P..   f!W f. t:. "'I. '1°     f <; 1 k. P' A 4: 'f IL., 'i It-to
> mJ.'.·I; "l        ·I;
> :";'a "1 ~ lit. n-m.:t; ...,,. td: P;.t."'/ h·l'\,'I" "
> J..i: O·if f<; '11\>i1Y. h.ti.f-<J·i'i" "'1.(1.h.>. )!t..f· "7;.Jt O.c\- 9'fto
> '"1.? >. -'t 'i d
> 508                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> SOMALI       (Somalia,    Djibouii,    Kenya,     Ha ho Molima o mong hape haese Uena,
> Ethiopia)                                        Mothusi litlokotsing, Ea iphelisang-ka-
> Boeena.
> Waxaan marag ka a hay, Eebbow , in aad ii
> abuurtay aqoonsigaaga iyo caabudidaada .
> Waxaan hadderba marag ka ahay ta bardar-         ki-SUKUMA (Tanzania)
> ridayda iyo karitaankaaga, cayrnimadayda iyo       Na linzunya, Bebe Mulugu wane , giki
> hodanimadaada.                                   ukanisumba nakumane Bebe na kukulemilija .
> Eebbow, Ilaah kale majiro adiga mooyee,       Dmzunya ung'wi ikanza iii, ubusunduhazu
> dhibkabixiye, weligijire.                        bone na kunzu jako, mubihabi bone na usabi
> boko Bebe.
> lu-SONGE (KISONGE) (Zai"re)                        Hatiho Mulugu ugi hambunu Bebe Nduhu
> Ng' wambilija wa Mayaga, Uyokikalaga
> Nankumina shi, Obe Yaya Efile Mukulu ngi       Muweyi Ng'wenikili.
> bampangile bua kukuiuka na kukuuma. Kano
> kapindji nambuela bobofule buande na
> SW AH I LI (Central and East Africa)
> bukome buobe, bulanda buande na bulolo
> buobe.                                             Nashuhudia, Ewe Mungu Wangu, kwamba
> Takui mungi Efi le bu Obe ni nya, anka Obe     Wewe Umeniumba mimi kukujua Wewe na
> apasana ku masaku , Obe namene shi mukit-        kuku a budu Wewe. Nahakikisha, katika wakati
> shibue na mungi.                                 huu, juu ya unyonge wangu na uwezo Wako,
> juu ya umasikini wangu na utajiri Wako.
> Hakuna Mungu mwingine ila Wewe ,
> SONGHAI: Zarma (Djerma) dialect (Niger,
> Msaada katika Mashaka, Aliyepo-Mwenyewe.
> Nigeria)
> Al Koy-Bero! Alga salda ni nal taka al mini    SWAHILI: Mashingoli dialectt (Somalia)
> bay-se, a1 mi ni berey di mo.
> Al tabatandi al hinabana-ga dini gabo-ga, al     NA SHAHIDHI MNUNGU YUANGU KAMA
> tabatandi-mo al djang-a dini dura-ga.            WEYE KUNUMBA NI KUMAGNE NA
> IBAOHA Y AKO NA SH AHIDHI KAMA JERO
> Koy-si kan nin daru, nin kan tchi faba-ko,
> KUA UZIVU NA NGUVUZAKO NA BILLA
> nin kan nini bon taka.                           NGUVU NA GUDURA YAKO NA UFAGHIRI
> UANGU NA UTAGIRI UAKO HAKUNA
> SOTHO, NORTHERN (se-PEDI) (South                 MNUNGU MTUHU ILLA NI UEYE NA
> Africa)                                          HUKUMU Y AKO UEYE.
> 
> Xore e rapelwe xa tee ka moraxo za masome
> TEMEN (TEMNE, THEMNE): Northern
> a mabedi le mentso e mene ya di Iri, Xoba
> (Sanda) dialect (Guinea, Sierra Leone)
> mosexare o moxolo.
> Ke nea bohlatse, 0 Modimo waka , xobane            I S::>IJ m::1 seri OKuru kami, mun::>IJ po bEmpa mi
> 0 mpopile xore ke xo tsebe, Ke xo o              t::> k tara mu ; yi bbatho mu r::1m;i lompi. I lanE ka
> khunamele. Ke ineela mo nakong e, bofokodi       abb aIJe. I teba ayEthE mi ka mun::>IJ kaba af:is:i:
> byaka maatleng a Xaxo, bohumanexing byaka        ka am::>n E mami yi mun::>IJ ka rayola ramu.
> Khumong ya Xaxo. Xaxo Modimo e mong xa e         Ukuru ubm :iyi yEs::> thambe mun::>IJ. Ka mar mi
> se Wena. Mothusi melekong, Wena E o tiileng.     ka masibo, mun::>IJ I yi gbora t;ikbatho.
> 
> SOTHO,    SOUTHERN           (se-SOTHO,          TESO (ATESO) (Kenya, Uganda)
> SESOTHO) (Lesotho, South Africa)
> Arai eog ikajenan , Wu Ekadeke, ebe Ijo ibu
> Ke paki, U Molimo oa ka, Uena U mpopet-        kosub eog aijen ljo kakukonokin Ijo.
> seng hore ke be le tseho ea Hau, 'me ke U        Etogogogit kapak kana, akalogwau ka
> khumamele.                                       agogong Kon, ikabakor ka amio Kon.
> Kea itlhatlhoba, motsotsong ona, ho              Emamei bobo Edeke ece dimarai Ijo,
> hlokeng matla hoaka ho Ea matla 'ohle,           Ekesigalikinan kotoma Amudiaro, elopetbofumeng ba ka ho ea ruileng tsohle.             Aijar.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                      509
> TIGRINYA (Eritrea)                                se-TSWANA        (CHUANA)       (Botswana ,
> South Africa, Zimbabwe-Rhodesia)
> j     ~~~IT~!hltimh1         ~~ITh1:
> Ke supa bopaki , 0 MOdimo wa me , gore ke
> h91111&.m ch 'l h91> t'lh c ~n-fi:. ::            Wena yo 0 ntlhodileng go Go itse le go Go
> M1 H h 'f f H)'I h ~ : t'l 1 fi: 'i ~ 1 If) ~ti   direla. Ke paka, mo motsotsong o', bokowa ba
> me go matleng a Gago, khumanego ya me go
> 'l1:    t'lhH~1       'lfH'l1    h.iJ1~ ::        khumong ya Gago.
> <11.H. IWtl     i~l\:    fl1Hh Cht'lfl hit           Ga gona ope o mongwe Modimo ga ese
> Wena , Mothusi mo Botlhokong. Motshidi ka
> ~fl   c: flVhfl titi h ~~Mi qf'w'1 ::             Esi ba Gagwe.
> TIV * (Nigeria)
> TUMBUKA (TIMBUKA, CHITUMBUKA)
> Mo mngugh shiada, Aondo warn, mfa U            (Malawi, Tanzania, Zambia)
> gbam wer mfaugh man shi mchivir We. Me
> Nkucita wukaboni , A! Ciuta wane , kuti muli
> fatyo u oron he n shighen ne mer, mo yo mngn a
> kundilenga ine kuti ndimumanyani imwe, na
> agee ga kpaa ka We tseegh u lu a Tahav ye, shi
> kumusopani imwe . Nkupan ikizga panyengo
> mngu a kwagh mom mom ga kpaa ka We
> iyi, kwambula nkongono kwane na kwa nkon -
> tseegh u lu a ha nma kwagh ye.
> gono zinu zikuru , ku wukavu wane na
> Ma Aondo ugen je ngu ga saa We, We u lu
> kuwusambazi Winu.
> lwasen yam hen sghighen u kwagh atserem
> Kulive Ciuta munyakhe kweni ndinwe pera ,
> kpaa ye, man ka we stsegh u Ju Ityongh you
> Muvwiri muvisuzgo, Muliko bamoyo Mwekha.
> mtswen ye.
> 
> TOBOTE (BUSARI, BASSAR)t (Ghana,                  WOLOF* (JOLOF, OULOF) (Th e Gambia,
> Togo)                                             Mauritania, Senegal)
> N'sah sedah danh, 6 N'botou , yi Ahsah            Seedenaa ne, yow suma yala ne dangama sos
> woun' nameh yi m'besseh kn'gnonkisseh .           ngir ma xam la, jaamu la, Seedenaa ci jamano
> N'dakah n'yountineh n'wofiyi ah ponhou         ci suma nak katan ak ci sa magaay, ci suma
> n'sori ah gadjatih.                               mbaadola a k sa am-am .
> N' botih oubo catibi ki kouti Apouh, Oun' d-      Beneen yale amul ku moy yow , ndimbal gi ci
> joh im' koumneh, Oune' dibih Oubahpoueh.          mu~ba , ki dul daanu.
> 
> ci-TONGA, MALAWIAN                 (KITONGA,
> ci-Y AO (CHIYAO) (Malawi, Mo zambique,
> SISKA) (Malawi)
> Tanzania)
> Ndichitiya ukaboni , 0 Chiuta wango, kuti
> Nguwichila umboni 0 Mlungu jwangu! Kuti
> mukundilenga kuti ndikuziweni ndikumuso-          Mwanenjile une, kuti nim'manyilile nikumpani Imwe . Ndikhozga, panyengu yinu,
> popela. Ngwitichisya pa-je ndawi jino, kulemkufowka kwangu ndikukuwa kwanthazi zinu,
> buka kwangu niukulu wa machili Genu, kulaga
> kusawuka kwangu ndikuleme ra kwinu. Palivi
> kwangu nikupuka Kwenu.
> Chiuta munyaki kweni Imwi-pe , wakovy a
> Pangali Mlungu jwine akawe M'mwe Jikape ,
> pasoka, wambura kusowa kanthu.
> Wakamusya muyakogoya.
> ci-TONGA,   ZAMBIAN                (PLATEAU
> TONGA) (Zambia)                                   YAO URE (Y AH ORE) t (supplied from Ivory
> Coast)
> Ndime kamboni mwami Leza wangu , kuti
> wakandilengela    kuti   nkuzibe  alimwi            Bie na ye. E Bali, Bie man gnain ambolah ,
> nkukombe. Ndazumina cino ciindi kuti              Biandre yemito gnenmipan. Bian pah lah nah
> ndimuteteete webo ndiwe singuzu, mebo             goo.
> ndimucete pele webo ulimuvubi.                      Bie plehble le main pleuble. Kah e kiand
> Kunyina umbi Leza zunze kwako ndiwe             ahngna ya leh tehzan , gnien bre ki fe yezan Bali
> mugwasyi     mumapenzi     esu,  ulapona          peh kah lenah ble. Ouizoude oui pehnon yeh
> mukuyanda kwako.                                  qui guir re yahe evleeah .
> 510                                              THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> YORUBA (Benin , Nigeria)                                            Meinongo kula Mboli balo 'te, Kuka na
> hundo a bolo lo lungo yo, K uka nala na a ga la
> Mo ~e ij (,'.ri i si i, Iw9 Ql9run mi , pe Iw9 da mi
> nitiko.
> la ti m9 Q a ti la ti sin Q Mo j(,'.WQ ni akoko yi niti
> ai lagbara mi , at initi ag ba ra R(,'. , niti a ini at i niti
> Q la R(,'..
> Ko si Q l9run mi ran bi ko ~e Iw9 O lu ra nl 9w9             o lu- ZIBA (olu-HA YA) (Tan zania)
> ni gba i~oro , J;: ni ti ki i ku , J;: ni ti o le da duro .
> Ninjuliza lwe Katonda wa nge, okwo N iwe
> wan tonzi le   In ye    kukumanya         kandi
> ZAN DE (Central African Empire, Congo
> noukuabudu lwe. Ni njuli za akanya aka , omb u-
> Republic, Sudan, Za fre)
> jege bwange kandi nom um a ni Gawe, no
> Mi ni gamu bolo, ai Mboli , wa ma vungule                     omubunaku bwange kandi nomubutun gi
> tip a hinolo , tipa hili solo . Mi idi, ti ku logobo le          Bwawe .
> gi mi nan ga la na gamu ngulu , gim i lun go n a                   Taliyo Kato nd a ondijo shana lwe, Omujuni
> gam u hiliso.                                                    omunak u, Nyakuba ho .
> 
> B. THE AMERICAS
> 
> *Denotes revised translation.               t Efforts to obtain exact identification continu e.
> 
> ALACALUF (Chile)                                                  AMACH , ES'NE'PIO, TARANA PEHUAMEN
> NANA AMA ES NE'CHENO. PA ATAR PE'
> C hao quij e na, O Arka K'seles chewe.                           CHEQU E M AMA' ENALLE POPON YOMPOR
> C hao illata na chi quijen a, chi afsaksta.                      ENE PIA NET YEYENPUENE ERA PIAREN
> C hao quij ena laf, che keap .                                   YE'SEN NET ENALLETETSA NOT.
> C h ao checha l-eche, che keap , chao ak iai.
> C hao tarso ak'se nes, chao a la'a i. Che asar.                  APACHE: Mescale ro dialect (United States)
> C hao ak'senes.                                                    Bik:egui nda n ne na sha ; 13ik'eguindan nibik a'
> n s hin ~ti, negu sii, ashi ni cHi itedishd9ii binka.
> ALEUT: Easte rn dial ect (Cyrillic characters)                   Dak ugu ad ishd i. shi shin dzi,Qeyaedi. Ndi ni
> (Alaska, A leutian Islands, Siberia)                             dzileguli , shi te'n si ine. aku ndi ya t'a diyi di~e
> /
> nii;'.shi j as h . Na'sh i duh an kat'6 bik'egu dahin-
> HM H HZ> AH'AC.);"'f H);.O A Ki_                         dada, da ndin a nik'egu dahinda, naicKudanne .
> ~HH.Z>           f'lririHz;. Arl\HZ.    'T'HN.O
> "rHHAX               o.KtfxrrxHH.O, 'T'HH:Z.                    Ha'a duguzh ud a a ag ut'eg u dandi nik'eguinda.
> "'l':'..b.'T'Ot..A HX b.   KM-0X-.b H N\H Hb
> KO.Mft..KHHZ. 7 tSo.Hz;. l'l\Cb.M:Z. H _                        ARAUCANt (subm itted from Panama)
> -,\b.H.O C~Ne.xb 'fH'bHo.ro.Ctt.HM-1_
> b~'6xb L\Kt\'ft\KiKHH:z>                       KO.K'lX.A        Testigo nankue
> KO.AH MHtt".6       <.\H'~H~)\.b    l\Hl'.l..HZ>.               Nas Kakaravfco,
> HBHZ>.           KHtns rH'T'b. Ctl.KtSKHHb                       Ma na n hiz a na
> KO.t-OXZ>.        rriKtSC~Hb.N.Z..,                              Yuesanguas i nagasanangiiasi.
> Iva testigo na me m ag u asiri av inaskavf m are
> Xr°"b.KHMHNb       ft.r5r5xb                              n6masina guneri,
> b....\b.KO.'(Z>. Bl'Ab..KHMHHZ. b.H'_                            Ay ua Zakaravico cu ni maim an i.
> O.'T'~M.t' ti.Mb. M~-'rt(Kb.HO.H8_                               Be maseingunamase gacaca
> Ab.'(b HAb.Hb 'TH MHHZ. CH _
> Berna nenan av ua nkin .
> CM'11K~XZ>.              ~AO.K~);:Z>..
> ARHUACOt (Colombia)
> AMUESHA (Peru)
> NA' PA NECHMETENEP' NEPARESTSS                                    Matuni gukui naji Gha lag hwasha ma nag h-
> YOS PACA NEYECHCATE.                                             wama le m a natunanamighzeja (y adorarte)
> ANEQUEPOCHNECHMETAPNAMAOCH                                      matun i gukwa gha ika gwasu nituku , ma
> NESHERWIAP.                                                      ghamamekwa ya daznada nashi dazna gh awia,
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                         511
> ayzc nadaki ya Ghalaghwasha y6nagholija                CARIB: Galibi (Carina, Karinja) dialect
> niashi y6nghwapa.                                      (Brazil, French Guiana, Guyana, Surinam,
> Venezuela)
> AYMARA (Bolivia, Peru)                                   AOU SOUGOUCA TAMOUCHI, TWUE
> GASSER 0 OIR OIR A YOU OUCOUTOMER
> Nayajja uiijtwa Dius Tatay, jumawa lurista          MENGAR 0 SE OIRTIOMER.
> nayaru jumaru uiit'aiiataki, yupaychaiiataki,            AOU SOUGOUCA ET LOU MELO, AOU
> nayajja uiijtwa anchhicha uruna jani                   PALIPEOIR A YOU ABOROT MENGAR
> ch'amanita ukama; juma ch'amanitama, naya-             QUADAMADOR A YOU OIR BOROT
> jja uiijaraktwa anchhicha uruna jani kunanita          RICHEMINS.
> ukama, juma taqe kunanitama, janiwa yaqha                A MOEIR OUR TE LA P ASMENT
> TAMOUCHI A OIR LA NO COLAT DANDER
> Dius Awkijja utjkiti. Juma spakitawa, jumawa
> DA A YOU PANPAMANOLANT, MANCOLOT
> yanapt'iritajja taqe jan walinakansa, jumawa
> COMOMINPOENT OA ASSEQUERO .
> utjta juma pachapata.
> 
> CARIB: Moreno dialectt (submitted from
> BAURE (Bolivia)                                        Honduras)
> Di reshit6u, to vekiyir, piti kem shok6vi             Au pu'uneauwa . 0 Lloso kl:mt, amoro puaskesko vichipti ash vekiyichip. Di reshir6u             canenpo a moro mana adupu'ustoome erome
> nerekike, doka nase rejen ash piti aserokon, di        6seguachoome. Au pu'uneauwa co'ollene
> pohour ash piti k6tir6n.                               eropo, au pioresmaba erome amoro tit
> Do kat kap6np6u ponshohue piti. Piti as            paripiin, au poreauwa erome amoro tu cabalinkor6bi ash chapch6vi doka kanserpou tikuer           lero .
> ti.                                                       Lla'aba Lloso amu batuman abiiioscopore,
> abapune !Japiopunta adasta, amantoto aseque
> BRIBRI (Costa Rica, Panama)                            tu cugiientarumue.
> YERUR BEBIKETSU BERO YE SIBU
> ECUEKY BETUYEYU EDIRIRSU EBIKETSU                      CARIB, ISLAND (CARIBE)t (submitted
> YE W ASCHEN Y YERURET A YE QUE                         from Honduras)
> DIRIRCHETA, BERCHE TAIE YE SIORARA
> Lun nasiianeyaa lidaa ven gaadeirei daan
> BE BURU TAIE ER KIO QUE SIBU SCA TU BE
> lidas dimii amiidi Ian maniguaty munilla vaa-
> IMEKE YISCATU YEI SKIMENE ISURUETA
> !ERB! IBUBRABA IEBUSCO IBUBRABA.                       nibey bo ubabey .
> ! Bungui neigeichy. Bugiellaa agureajaavadinaa.
> CAKCHIQUEL (Guatemala)
> Sun nazubu dirunibieu . Sun biciendeiu:
> Yin nibij riyeht, nu Dias, yin aquiytisan ri chi     nugulaa bobabey lindao danlee luagu beere
> nuguatamaj aguach y gantiguaj6.                        suma billarianaa.
> Yin nibij ri jun ti rato re ri nu ban y riyalan ri      Luguli luma Birizi.
> aguachuka, ri nu mebahil y ri abellomal.                  Uvaaty amu Bungiu.
> Majun chik jun Dias mas que regui riyet, ri             Bubedigisa le Hidajabey lidaan Hinavariny
> gatohon chere ru queyebal, ri xa ban riret             Luagu. Buriguana ru .
> m1smo.
> CATfOt (Colombia)
> CAMPA (Peru)
> Bfltru mua asia Bflra caira cawabamanea
> Naka cantacotiriri, nashi nowabani abirota-          Bflra zhi biara jaraita . Mlia jaraya j6malia Bfl
> qui ovettzikaquena, oncantcha niyotantaiymiri          ne eaba mlia o be ea. Bflra warinu obeya. Miua
> nancanenpi. Nocantaco timpi ironaca te                 zhi supuriata Bflra shi wai b1ta bara b1tta.
> noshinttzitage       pishinttzincaqui   Noca             Bflra Caragabia tewara ne ea. Shi dai ne
> nashinonca. Abiroka pashararo. Tekattzi                cazhirua cawade ni mi burn ewate Bfl trn
> pashini pawa. Abiroka pamitacotana ocaven-             careba bua Bflra to aba bua tewara wai ea bu
> cati, ab iroka anincari.                               ea.
> 512                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> CHEROKEE (United States)                           CONIBO: Shipibo dialect (Peru)
> l l!\Y9. .ll Vf' ;)V.1                  Enra mia onanque nocon Dios, min ca jonia
> iqui mia onanti itan rabite, Enra ohuiquen
> ;)XW ll!\Y9. DlV!' ~V .1 &~ TGGA.1                 ramabicon yosma betan min coshi, ea jahue-
> DlVf';)V.1 bS fRT. TS DCTGE~T.                    quioma itan mia jahuequiya
> DB lrSW, lrZ?, hlJ ;)XJ\WOB,                 Yamaraque huetsa Dios mia quesca, jan noa
> .;ḥ9.~ DB hE Enf'Y TGf';)V.1~, Do
> aquinti onsanconia, mia iqui minbish ja.
> hE E@l Vf';;i!l!\.1~.
> DB EhfR hEJ\, lrZ?, AE Df'-                CREOLE, HAITIAN (Haiti)
> f'RT. DB e:n: hEEe f RT, M
> Moin temoin, 0 mon Dieu, que ou cree um
> CEhEE @hEl.            Do DYBiT M
> pou moin reconnait ou, pou moin Adore ou,
> YBTG HZ @hEl .
> iEZ q[,o ~J\W~E 15.Y, hE CREG              moin gin conscience ya de impuissance moin
> .;()Y;;JSf':& Do .;()YG [, o;;dY hS i T Do         avec pouvoir, grandeur ou et richesse ou tou .
> Pa gin lot bon Dieu cancou ou, ce ou qui
> hM9.T.
> secouri nan tout mauvais moment ce Ou qui
> hE C& D!' :2S !' ;;ctY •                     fort passe tout.
> 
> CUNA (KUNA) (Colombia, Panama)
> CHIP A YA (PUKINA) (Bolivia)
> Be nuga an nudakedi , Be an Baba, Pe pin-
> Wertre     Yooz     distike    amchuaweke        sadf anudakegala. Pe purba anualicagwa,
> pachamke paj zapa, amkin Mayziz zapa, anz-         pergufnanmala an bendake. Pe purba anse
> chiruktra tee urake, wuer am azizaricha, wer       ogilaegala, neitirpimakar abdaibugua. Pe do di
> anachullchica, amke thapa chulltakchichmcha,       napiraguad tule tumad , percuable per carmadi.
> mazek yakha Yooz zallzzie, yanapt'icha
> anawalinakista, amzestra personkistra.             DAKOTA (SIOUX): Lakota dialect (Canada,
> United States)
> 
> CHIQUITANOt (Bolivia)                                Wakan Tonka mitawa slol ceye na ceyo
> onihau kta ca maya gage .
> Y quiococa hoy baistuparra tagu na hay samute        Mahon ke sni na neye ni waski, onma si he na
> para suputaru y anauno. Chusa quisrr               naye nejinca, lei owape hin el epin kte.
> napanaucu chacusivica taya acheca. Chanapii          Okokipe na ni som onyanki yapi, Wakan
> tiatarrs bacher un tana naqui baiytuparrs          Tonka ni some towa wi sin.
> bayura ino untanas ugge chusa quirrs
> DIEGUENO (KUM-YIY) (Mexico, United
> States)
> CHOC6, COLOMBIANt (Colombia)
> Nea mat-e-ken6p, o Myha, Nea-p6w
> Mi marchi, en bera, ma criabua ma criama        we-6w Whee ach-pfe Whee. Nea mat-e-kenop
> tachi afuni. Mi marchi empera muena, quema         nea-p~l splr-mauw Myha quaw-tfe, ti-pulI
> quinupineabua mu trua, paratani quinu emp-         Shin nea WU queen-a-wlich quaw-tfe.
> era patabarabia. Tachi sese audubua, care facia       Nea ma-eye nea mltch ta-pa mauw Myha
> pea bodota tachi sese ituba bua.                   Shin, Myha nu-ii( Nlumbe nea wu Ma-lie
> me-toy-ydm, Yike na Mitch-pashow.
> CHOC6, PANAMANIANt (Panama)                        GOAJIRO (GUAJIRO) (Colombia,             Venezuela)
> Milira testigua tayhi Ancore bedea devena
> bilia odavera injasita bili cavavai carea y bili     Tatuja auch, pia Maleiwaa, piain ainjin taya
> carea triabaya.                                    zupula terrajuin pia ma aijachin tapula pia
> Milira testigua nahua enda fuerza nee           Tatuja auch jolucho, marchin taya ma piainja
> bilfmina y bilira necua bilfmina, pobre bilfmina   katchin, mulieshtaya puma piainja washirin.
> y bilira nejoma iri bilfmina, Dayhf Ancorera         N6joish wane maleiwa makaika pia, ja
> ababtiiri bili umera neea , Tayhi care bavarira    makai jumuin ekai mojuin mukuwaipa, chi
> porque biliabira pueabirf joma mana bilibera.      ekai numUinwa .
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                          513
> GUAHIBO (GUAJIBO) (Colombia, Ven-                    INUIT (INUPIAQ):             Keewatin       dialect
> ezuela)                                              (Canada)
> JjanH tanHjH, Oh taja Dios, nejjaname                . C-b,..;<l<Y<l>L-        JnL ~a.c...t>··
> cayapHtajitsietsi pinijiy6mH. JjanH tanHjH           l,L    bt><L d~l.,            "Jr'<Jt--rcL~J
> ajena conoiiae tanHjH paepainajn, jjamH              Q_Jda..L          L4 Q .AJcrbra..L
> asaHbejemH; jjanH bijy6bHnH y jjamH                  /\J<Yd)l.,f\"       <J.._Jl,, L <J~\, bf'a.facabecobHyeimH.                                      <lr'cr JncbrL              b.f Pr/ L'.16-·
> Apoejanaimu itsa Dios pecatojjentsinu,             ~ n :x, t-.   Jn :n~ 6 .
> bajara-pon\f necayayenena piayai-cujiro,
> ecarapeju pon\f piyesautja.                          INUIT (INUPIAQ):           Kobuk      (Kotzebue)
> dialect (Alaska)
> GUA YMi (Panama)                                     Ookauheieah , aungayootmang, eilvich einik·
> taheima eilichoheilotin sooli pikhaheitcoplo-
> Ti es gade, Oh Nubu tigiie! Magues ti miga ni
> tin . Ookauheieach ahkoovuk syaktoiliah
> tuba Madruga! gade ti-e. Buta tigiie es
> sungeepnune; nohleiliah oomalholiknune.
> matarede. Ti-e gade m~uare . Ti tu brai mati1
> Autlamik     aungayotachuke      ahvatipcoon,
> cribida. Ti tabre riqueza mahiie buta.
> ekahyokti nuvaynami, engmik pityi.
> Nubu muda iiacarr.
> Mabe itibe ma ara de migaga ma ara ni noba        INUIT (INUPIAQ): South Baffin Island
> bidiga.                                              dialect (Eastern Arctic Syllabics) (Canada)
> ) .... c..t>L,   Jnt,<,   '-.~c..t>l.4\l.   bt>•
> HAIDA (Alaska, Canada)                               ~L7~Jjn           t>~AM   )~~4\t>dj{)
> t>~A-       L~c    P'-.c)L    ~~L      ~r~rA,
> Hlaa, weiyat suus uu dii dung TI'aahlaany;
> '-.r~)/nc,         ~J/Lc      )~~~d
> eihl uu saa dungeng dii guudengaan. Uhl giisluu wy'aat tlii dii xaagaas k'an uu, is siis dii     ALr)L"M           ~~~     JnCbrL<-
> k ' ungis~dygaas k'ang tlii dung iitlaa gadaas.      bA~~)Cbc<'              A~c~~)J~>n
> Dung squun nuueitl dung klaaiidunggung.              ~L~       6r~     A~c    A~cJ~))~n-
> 
> Dung ki l Eihl ging gets sqwaagu saang.
> JICAQUE (XICAQUE) (Honduras)
> 
> INUIT (INUPIAQ): Barren Grounds dialect                jO Dios Mand! An timnon ni na maya , si
> (Canada)                                             suanda was ten iga. Po qui noi es sun. Dios, te
> qua la ti way, na polra monse sa a ti qui Dios pa
> Uvanga qauyititsivunga tapsuma Gutip              ha Ii cum. Pan u hay Dios, in oy le Dios, un ving
> sanala ursimamanga imminik qauyimaqupluni            baten Dios.
> tugsiavigiqublunilu. Tukisititsivungalu manamit pitguniqanginimnik tapsuma pitguni-             KALISPEL (SALISH):            Flathead      dialect
> qaninganut, akslunimnutlu aksluinirnut.              (United States)
> Asingnik Gutitaqangilaq igvit kisiuit, ikay-
> Quin Kolinstuten, Ju ti! Anawee U ko
> uqtauyargiaqaniptinit   ilingnit    ayugaqankolintwhu Ju que ks soohum U que ks
> gitumit.
> putenem. Ku yes konkonstinum yetilwha Ju ye
> ti! eas s.hopt U jasyoyit, U ye ti! eas konquint U
> INUIT (INUPIAQ): Barrow (North Slope)                jas s.koyoleewhu.
> dialect (Alaska)                                         Tat suewet wes olkosheetums oopen es
> I!isimarauru1p Godiil), IliIJnun saval)atilaam-      olkosheetwhu Ju es yapastenee. Lu ta epl
> nik IJisimatquvlutin suli nangaquvlutin. Quli-       chinaks Kolinstuten, e.chimish Anawee.
> aqtuagigiga akkupak suaIJl)ataiiiiiiga suli ilvich
> KOYUKON* (Alaska)
> sual)l)atiqpaiii, uval)a i!iappauniga suli ilvich
> umialgunigiii.                                          Ego ninh nit'odeetaaghat.ft'aa' ts' a nits'a
> Allamik Godaitchuq ilvich avatikkun,              hadeenaaghasdaak ts'a haghanee go ninh
> ikayuiJ!arutin siggagniugnami suli ilimik            kkokk'a neeseeneenhaanh ts'a isee hHyif
> al)alatchumiiiaiqftini iJiruni.                      asiniyh. Sinh nitfil eent'aanh dahoon see ha!'
> 514                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> eelst-l" ilaa. Doyonh eenlaanh dahoon saahaa          nari oca maicca teranagabe pagabeaquena
> k'its'oh1tdeeh'aa ts'a eesee koon h1tyi-l'asinihy.    teranonsanmafte Viro pashe.
> Ninh yaan' adit'o deenlit'aa ts 'a ninh yaan'         Mameri pashiniacpari6shi payoyabisaqui-
> Dinaah1tto' eenlaanh.                                 viro irirori ymectacutaqueri notsaroganaque,
> iriori ictfmira por irirori.
> KUCHIN (KUTCHIN) (Alaska)
> Nawa ndak     shi'ii,   shiVit'eegwijyaahcy'aa      MAPUCHE (ARAUCANIAN) (Argentina,
> s h99hts~ii naahashandaii ts' a' na ts'a' khagihih-   Chile)
> jyaa geenjit. Juk geegwaldak shat'aii kwaa ,
> Ng illatun raIJin a ntii men.
> nat'aii nitsii shigehdan t'oo nchy'aa nidehtee
> Iflche w;:iJd::i IJun, Eimi Ng;:inec hen , Eimi
> gwintsii.
> tremiimen tami kimafiel ta~il)illatuael. Iflche
> Neeghaii .faa K'eegwaadh at gwanlii kwaa
> w::ild::iIJun feula tami neweIJen, inche yafiiIJelan;
> gogw~~jat d~i' gwits'iinyaa. Khik gwandaii gintami iilmenIJen, inche weshacheIJen. Ngelai ka
> i'jj.
> Ng::inechen Eimi m::iten, kellukelu kunin men,
> kishu mol)elnieulu.
> KUCHIN (KUTCHIN): Fort Yukon dialect
> (Alaska)
> MAPUCHE: Chilean dialect t (Chile)
> Osi vittekueichanchyo, netitinihsha, Nit
> tsut . Kititihchya tenitenitutul a Kenjit, kuikit       Feipiael, iilkantuael, rani antiile zeuma.
> sidhatsei choog. Tzut-nikueinidhut. Sut tei,            Wiil zunun ta inch e, Awem Niinechen , eimi
> Kkuea ei tzut. Sinersitkwichachyo , nitsi,            mi tremumol, tami kimafiel, tami poienael.
> nichile Kitinichi. Nekhe, vittekwichanchyo            Mupi n, feula tani wezakonanen, ka tami
> Koolikkua, nunrzi, kookontrhi. Tei , kwutsut          newen nen , tani kunifall nen ka tami ulmen
> thitihndul. Kokwadhun.                                nen. Eka nelai Nii nechen Eimi miiten, Kellukelu ta kuniu meo, Kizu Monen nelu.
> KUCHIN: Loucheux dialect (Canada)
> MASCO: Huachipairi (Amaracaeri) dialect
> Sit ve tte kwut cha chyoo ny a le sen dei ako
> (Peru)
> nit tsut ki le ti chya choog. Kwe tha zit te let ti
> nja. Sit tei kkwa, kwit zit nun nit chi tei, sit ne     Do a Waadic apagapi, pecuite Diosta wacrsil kwit cha chyoo kwi zit. Ako nit kwit chilee      nopunwate,   yadpaunwate       wanopunwate
> chi zyoo kkwa nun zi.                                 wabua nda wayoro queri paida iue un dicnanda
> Vitte kwit cha chyoo kouko nyoo, kwut tsut         inupuene catembet iene nunda apag ewe ue
> tri chi iii.                                          ununin wambachiwapuere, dacue eete joaeri.
> 
> LOKONO (CONTINENTAL ARAWAK)                           MASCOY: Lengua dialect (Paraguay)
> (Guyana , French Guiana, Surinam)                        Acyasamco coo Dios Sivaninquiscama alhta
> A baa bekotoi gia ka de Wathinathie bie wa         !hip yuyan oyicpilcojo quinjan opayicsojo.
> maritana da de dei thien bia be goe nang da           Acyasamco coo Dios janj ay apyimate mlhip
> sika da-ka-ke-wa gowe babong. Tataa-go                acma apquilatam paj poc Dios apasmom najan
> damo ng ka sjoko dja rong, bee wa tataa abo-          ayaso mquilh a avanquilhip Dios emyoc.
> na, matho damoeneka dja ko mahto baboewa
> djako. Abathie go sabona , Adajaali bie rong          MATACO (Argentina , Bolivia, Paraguay)
> kie, bie rong kie boeroewata na ma da de
> Ohap okalethtayajwo, oka Dios, Ta Am ta
> da moeneka loko de bie rong kie.
> enekno ya mlek otajwueth amej wet ochaame.
> Ohap okelethtayajwo hapet atana ta tek okaj-
> MACHIGUENGA (Peru)
> nayaj ihi wet Am akajnayaj, hap opathtseyaj
> Naro    noncamantaqueteria ,    Aparioshi ,         wet Am aniyatyaj.
> camictitaqeria     Viro        pitomidakena             Tsi tek iche eth Dios thamet Am, o-eth ta
> narunocama taqueri narotaqui noneaquitem-             lchote ta owitay ihinya, o-eth Tek latunjbira y nungamagitaquembira Viro. Pineaque-            wuaihi.
> BAHA'i BIBLIOGRAPHY                                              515
> MA YA (Belize, Cuarema/a, Mexico )                     tumevijch'a, nuti p6vreno ene piti ricovi'i.
> Nahina ponena Viy31 pkevorichu piti,
> Ten ile , oh , in Jajal-Dios, tech dzaen yo lal in
> p'ayudachvok6wi te' to vyatahib6no, ema
> kajoltquech yola l kulquech. Ten ilae ti jun-          make-vorichu kj_6wrik6wri . -
> zutaj, minaan in muk, teche yan a muk , otzilen;
> teche ayiklech yetel yacunail. Minaan u laak           NAVAJO (United States)
> Jajal-Dios, chen tech , tech ca antaj can anac
> Diyin Shitaa' NinfliQi shH' beehozin ef
> baa! kaz, cu cuxtal chen letf.
> a-!'hfnahodiilzj!h biniighe ashi!nlaa aad66 Niji'
> sodiizin do . T'aa k'ad bee haszii', haala shich 'j'
> MICMAC (Canada)
> nahwii' na aad66 Ni t'eiya Nidziil, te'e'i shidaa h
> Oeligtjitjito, 0 NJSGAM , Gil gisiitepotjit         ndahkai aad66 Ni t'eiya t'aa aftsoni Ni holq .
> gisi nenolin a gepmitelmolim . Oelnimito , enge           T'aa Ni t'eiya Alaadi Diyin nil{ haala nihich'i'
> asma, nin mnag6tim ag Gil migign6tim,                  nahwiihia'igii t':;i:;i' iininsin, Hool'aag66 Honilq .
> nineolegeagnin ag Gil milsotim. Mo eimog
> piloei Nisgam pasig Gil tan Apognimasoti               OJIBWA (CHIPPEWA): Mississagi dialect
> metoegigtog ag Gil laptjoei.                           (Canada)
> Gi windimon, Nimin Dom geget Geen ogee
> MISKITO           (MOSKITO)            (Honduras,      ozhi yun odji kenmin nan gaie odji Anamie ton
> Nicaragua)                                             Nan.
> Yang witnisna 0 God man yangra paskatma              N windima gae nongoom, ezhi bedjee wee
> man kaikaia bara man mayunaia. Yang nan                yan Geen dush epeecheeweeyun, Nigidiwitnisna naha pyua sip apia kapri bara man             magiziwin pee dush Geen gwandiziwin . Kawin
> karnikamra; yang umpira lakasna bara man               waia bikan Manido Geen eta, Widokazwin
> ai lalka.                                              Sinagaziwining, Mindjimnaman Bimadziwin.
> Bahara God apusa bamansma. Help Patra,
> ba mita witin Seip rayasa.                             OJIBWA (CHIPPEWA): Salteaux (Saulteaux) dialect (Canada, United States)
> MOHAWK (Canada , Unired States)                           Gee Kayne dah mah zon , Ke shay Manito,
> Wa-geh-ni-wha-gwa-risi , Ook Niyo, Neh              che ke kayn ne me nan , Shegwah che mah wim
> Ihse da-ka-dis-son ne a-gon-yen-de-rih-hok             we to nan , Che mean e go e ze yan. Che ke
> ta-non da-gon-non-wha-ra-don-sek. wa-geh-              kayne ne me nan ke kaye da ma zo n ke zong e
> ri-wha-ni-rot, nook-non-wa. ji-niah-teh-geh-           ze win she quah neen aye pee chee nay sou e ze
> suts-teh ta-non Ihse , ji-ni-seh-sots-tens-seh-        yan , shegwa ka ape chee we note e ze yun. She
> ro-waneh , ji-ni-wa-ki-d en ta-non ji-ni-sah-          gwah neen apee chee ke tee mak e ze anne .
> gwe-nya-tsa-ro-wa-nen . Ihya-gonega oya ne                Keen aye ta go ka Manito win, ka we che tas
> niyo nfok Ihse, ne-gah-yeh-na-wa-tsera neh-            so win , A pee saig e ze an, kah ke kay kah ah ya
> yo-da-ri-hok, ne-ihse sa-ri-wha-gwa-noh.               yin.
> 
> OJIBWA (CHIPPEWA): Woodlands dialect
> MOTILON (Venezuela)
> (Canada, United States)
> Aue cut~ Papachf yupune, amo sanuta
> Neen dibaindaun kikaindamowin 0 neend
> tacomena centopo yopone, aue cut~ amicha
> Gitche Manitou, tchi keen ge gezhetod neend
> yarsna i muquepe, aue camisique i amo
> tchiway kikaindjigay keen gahyay tchiway
> apeny6ntaca. Guaneque conipa Papachi,
> aunamiaytahwah     keen,    Neen    megiway
> cumarco Papachf agiieyabo a'n'tace anipape
> debaudjimowin, tchigayi mahndan ningopasguaneque y6ntaca.
> sangwaubiwin, tchiway neen kawween gashkiyaywisiwin gahyay tchiway ke mash-
> MOXO: Trinitarios dialect (Bolivia, Brazil,
> kauwisiwin, tchiway neend kitimaugisiwin
> Paraguay)
> gahyay tchiway ke dauniwin. Eemahgay kauw-
> Nuti nechoy6re, oh Viya, piti pepyakn6'i             sen bahkaun Gitche Manitou, anishaydask
> taye'e nimotviraviyre ene nfiruchviyre. :Necho-        keen, widokaugaywin pindje bapinisiwaugan,
> v6y!e te fuiti naripu-tahina ntumayvina. Ene pi ti     tebinahway aupidanisiwin yegibimadis.
> 516                                       THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> OTO MI (M exico)                                        QUECHUA: Ecuadorian dialectt (Ecuador)
> Ji testfgueska , o h juchiti tata diosi , eskarini      Nuca di us tistigu cani nucaman vinachiscant'u kueraska parakini mftini ka k'eri ambe              gui Ca nm an sirvin gapa alabaringapa. Tistigu
> arhinguini. Ji testfgueska ia ias i, juchiti            cani cay ratuta nuca, mana ushay cani, Canmi
> jukaparhakueri ka chiti uiIJ apikueri para              tucuy ushay Cangui, nuca pubri cani Quiquin
> iamindu am be uni, juchiti komu ja l)gue ri ka no       chari cangui Mana Tianpash shug Dius ashta
> ma jatsfkuarhikueri          ka    chiti     kanikua    ya li hurmana huraspi yanapang ui Canmandaljakaparhakueri jimbok ari ia mindu ambe jat-            latami causangui.
> siska.
> No jarhasti materu tata diosi el)ga sanderu          QUICHE (Mexico , Guatemala)
> k'erika eska cha, emaIJga ja rh6ajpka el)ga
> kanikua uetarh ijka, emal)ga jarhajka mentku              In xin wil6 , oh nu Dios, chi ri at xinaq'uisaj
> isi najkiru no nem a jarh6ataka.                        rech quin weta'maj awach y quin lok 'o k'ej
> awach Weta' am quin ri camic ri ' na c'o ta ri nu
> chok'ab y ru, nimal ak'ij ri at, ri nu meba' li in ri
> P APIA MENTO (Aruba, Bonaire, Cura~ao)                  ak'inoma l ri at.
> Mi ta doena testimonio, o mi Dios, coe Bo a            Maj jun chi Dios xew ri at, at ri cat tob pa ri
> cria mi pa mi conoce Boy pa mi adora Bo. Mi ta          jun c'ax , y ri ca c'aslic chi rilic rib.
> testigo nae momenta aki di mi flaqueza y di Bo
> poder, di mi pobreza y di Bo rikeza.                    SALISH, PUGET SOUND (United States)
> No tin ningun otro Dios, sino Bo, e auxilio             '>;ist;ifildxw bd, s;iq si"ab, d;ibad dx""al
> den Peliger, Esun coe ta subsisti di su mes.            kwi t(u)adshuyuc dxw"al kwi gw;ids;is(h)aydubicid . gw;il ";iskw;idicu t k"i gw;id siiwi+.
> PIRO (Peru)                                             dxw'>al d;igw i". l;ic ut bd "al ti";)" "al ti xwi"
> Gita testigo goyakalo pixa gira uturu                 gwddsqw iq " '>j t(i) adsg"a'> adsqw iq"". dxw"al
> petashatanru nunanu gita gi ixchcota gika gike          ti";i('>)   ds;is"us;ibabdxwil   "i   t(i)   adsg"a"
> wanciru, pixa waneru ponikolu maleshnu satu             "itqah. xw i'> kwi b;il;ili"     ~    s i"ab dxw"al
> goyakalu. Pixa satu pupxakan nukyo wikolni
> d;igwi", dxwskwaxw;ixw "al SXa~ il , k"'i '>a
> pixa pagoone tengogne
> ck waq id '>;is'>ist;i.
> 
> QUECHUA: Bolivian dialectt (Bolivia)
> SHOSHONI (SHOSHONE) (United States)
> Noga rikuni, Aa Apu Yaya Diusniy, Qan
> NEE 00-KOO TI SOOM BADUGH UPEH
> rikhurichiwasqaykita rejsisunaypaj , yupay-
> SOOK DA-MEH UH NU-MEH NfP-H UMEH
> chasunaypaj. Cheqamanta yachani kunan-
> DA-MEH SOOM BA-DO-H KHANDO-H UMEH
> pacha mana atiyn iyoj kasqayta, Qan Manchay             DA-MEH    OIYOS   NA-NEH   SHOON-Df
> Jatun atiyniyoj kasqaykita, mana imayoj kas-            KHAN-DOH . NEH UGH SOOKA DA-GWATS,
> qayta jinataj Qan Qhapaj Kasqaykita. Mana               NEH Wl-H GA HEENA MA-BA-Nf-Wf-H 0NEH
> Waj Apu Yaya Dius kanchu Qanmanta                       Wl-H   DA-MEH   GOO-PANDH,     WI-HU
> astawan , Pichus mana allimpi yanapakuj ,               DA-MEH DIH TIH HAUNC UMEH WI-HU
> Pichus Kaj Payllamanta.                                 DA-MEH OYOI-DEH-WHUP. 0NEH WI-HU
> DA-MEH UPEH GA-DEAS 00-AH NEESH
> DA-MEH UPEH Bf-H ONEH WI-DU DA-MEH
> QUECHUA: Cuzqueno dialect (Peru)                        BOONIH UPEH , DA-MEH DEH-MA-Zl-DH
> Noqan yachani, Diosniy, qampaq kanawas-               DIH TIH DA-MEH NA KHANC OIYO-GOOS
> kayquita    recsinaypaq,   yupaychanaypac .             HE-INH GOO-PAS NANA-SOO-WOO GINDH.
> Yachanitaqui kunan pachapi, nana atiyniyoq
> qqaskayta, qampaq jatun atiyniyoq kaskayta ,            SHUARA           (JIVARO):       Aguaruna     dialect
> waqcha kaskayt, kcapaq cayniquita.                      (Peru)
> Manan joc Diosniy kanchu qanmanta as-                    WIRJAf ETSEGNUNUK, MINA APUJU,
> tawan nana allinkunamanta yanapaqniykun ,                EMEMATJITI WAITUKTUSAM NAJATUA-
> qqanllan Diosniy kausanqui qqanllamanta.                 W AIT AN DUWI.
> BAHA'i BIBLIOGRAPHY                                           517
> WITJAI CHICHAGKAGTINUK YA BAISH-               TANANA (Alaska)
> KAM, AME SENCHIJUM SUGUSBA WA DUWI
> Y ABAIK AGKAN PUJAJAI.
> Senogh-1-k'okhoodelet, see Bet'odeeh'a, see
> TIKICHIK AMEA IBA UK ATSA WAI, ISHA-           dheehseen na.f esdeney, nek'okhoochedhet.
> MAINUMY AIJATMAINUK,      AMEKETNIE              Senoghclk'okhoodelet, k'odeeyeet, seteeya'
> PUJUT SUKAGTINMEX.                               ku la, eentl'eth. Tajoo nosoditlt'a, doyon eenlan.
> SIRIONO (Bolivia)                                   Nen yan' Bet'odeclt'a eenlan. Soghun
> neeneenneek, dek'onadheelton.
> EBii aba chee dau chee. Sa dau abatu chee ,
> ima-chee chiian Sande imachee chian Sande.
> Yasu tata a. De-aygue de-quiran cuantuchii       TANANA: Tanacross dialect (Alaska)
> mbia chii. Tendam nandeiiti taua de-aygue
> chee chaura nyebe eirachee rache-equia dejera        Maghhihhey, Sht'oxt'iht'eh, shihtsi, me'ishdeningue Dios-ra.                                daey , paghhexnuhdet. Maghnihhey, k'ah du'
> De-aygeu chee dea-catura.                      t'ey-;- sht'aey kol, Nt'eay xuntl((h. Shelzaz' kol ,
> Nelzaz' zuntl((h.
> SRANAN          (SRANAN-TONGO,                       Wut'oxt'iht'eh wukaedh kol. Ts'axunt'eh
> SURINAMESE, TAKI-TAKI) (Surinam)                 neghanitandaek. Wut'oxt' iht'eh k'aa nits'-
> axandaeg'.
> Mie e kotoigie-o mie Gado-datie Joe
> mekie mie foe sabie en aanbedjie Joe. Mie e
> kotoigie na tapoe na momenti diesie, mie zwat-   TEW A: Santa Clara Pueblo dialect (United
> jie en Joe maktie, mie potiefasie en Joe         States)
> goedoe. No wang tra Gado no de lekie Joe, na
> Naa o toh ne (Nave Taa jo sii) (HaY ti) UU
> Helpiemang ini notoe , na Wang-Die-De-Na-
> Ti Te PAA Na wi TAAE UU He-ta wi Jo sii a
> Hing-Srevie.
> mi tee (naa o TUUNI) (Naa bo) Navi Ka bi ni
> gati He ta UUVE (Kaa-in ga ta) Nave CHE
> SUMO:      Musawas     dialectt   (Honduras,     Biin in gata He ta uuvi CHE IN GATA wiaa wi
> Nicaragua)                                       na aan pi wi Taa jo sii UUT AH; KHA GA TE
> Yang witninis yang Papahnki yang yamus         D i Khun WO DA TE Wi boh gi moi.
> naman yang matilik man kul makulnini.
> Aka minit yang witninis yang sip awas sai
> TLINGIT (Alaska, Canada)
> yangki man paun makaupak sipki, yang
> minikun yangkat man yankli mankat.                XAT YEEKAXNEEK AX DIKEE ANKOW
> Papahn ukdiska man waliki, patkaupa ilk        YOO   XA TYEEKLEEYETK    EE  KASA-
> maiataman, witin silp sanka litki.               KOOWOO EE YA SCHKAKA WK. XA T
> YEEKAXNEEK YA YEEDAT KLETH XAT
> OOTSEEN KA YEE KLITHSEENA, KA XAT
> SUMO: Twahka dialect (Nicaragua)                 KANISHKEEDEI, KA YEE ANKA W.
> WE EE CHEEKLEINAK DIKEE ANKA W
> Yang witnis yang, yang Godki Man yabina-
> YEE SITEE KA YEE YEDASHEE, KA
> man Man ma talyang anik. Yang warakat laik
> CHEEWEAH-SKEEDANEEK.
> yultayang yang paraski Man parasnikira Man.
> God has lapki, Man Kamank ki, ya paras
> taman dutni Man Kau, A las Sawonki.              TOBA (Argentina)
> Ayem naq'taxananeq, oh yalamxat' Dios, ye
> TACANA t (Bolivia, Peru)
> 'am ayem ad'onataq savotaique da 'am
> He marda mi que testig6, oh mia dada           savat'ton qataq' shioqhen. Saq'taxan vetoigui
> Diushu, mia dada ve peitia Diushu eshenapa       nagui da iqalaxa qataq' da ad'anxaq', yachopuji. He marda mi que testig6 ye orashu mi que   qyic qataq' da ad'sallxa.
> poder mi que impotencia, que ma purf que ma        Qaica ca lya Dios napacaleq' 'am, Nimaye
> mi que riqueza. Hay ma ve pia Diushu, mi         detaunaxan da souqapoigui ca !chic, Nimaye
> dabai ejejena, mi dabai Diushu ejejena.          qaica ca iben'a.
> 518                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> TUCUNA (TICUNA) (Brazil,                Co lombia ,    Y AQUf (Mexico, Un ited States)
> Peru)
> Inapoone testic6 in Dios, e npoone y6t uri ac
> Llumaen pora tocuchigan                             paq ue ne e nchita ll ane . Paque te e nchiwatane.
> Cho ma curi guh e n, C um a pa chori tupan a        Inapon e testico en lautipo , caemo beki jume in
> tac ufa choun cu na goe n iiima na cha cuhan iii       uteam cae n utean bequi impovea poovetan a
> na cugo na charf inin.                                 e mporftoo rico. Cabe intok Dios, ju ll eani ame,
> E ho hin na curi guh e n ii o mar gun e ngo chori   e npo jibap6 be ch ii bo jiapsa .
> tura y curi pora, chori ta hunma cur i guhinm a.
> Tauma a nay a tupa na, curin poraqui , toin ri
> YARURO (Venezuela)
> guhenqui iiim a ch ie nfa . iiim a por aqui
> nichata ha n.                                            Dademene kone. Dademene kone kod e uni
> optea. Mene cua ja no re derrer dabaicreine .
> Dabaicreine cua j a mene de rrer. Daicre
> TUPI: Chirigua no         (Chahuanco)       dial ect
> udercre uchercre. G uardemercre guamerene
> (Arg entina, Bolivia)
> cheregua merenene .   Aeme     vei optaedi
> Che a icua ma che Tumpa , de che apoaba              kanemedi optaed i. Optaedi da ju a di chi cu a .
> rocua baera jare romboete baera. Che aicua               Optaedi da diu di que juing.
> m a a 1'i a ve che chep ue rea co ba jare depuere ,
> che cheparabete jare. De denbaeyecou Baetij
> YUKPA (Colombia, Venezuela)
> imru T umpa ma De giii ba, Poromborij
> icabibae peba, jare iyeu guiiio oicoba.                  A un ene, o l Cf!moco, 01±ncat a uy1±ne 6ope
> oyenepe , aa pera aya mpo auya t6cshinco.
> Aunene, j1±arketau, y6 itpai auvia, amorcotip-
> TUPI: Guarani dialect (Argentina, Brazil,
> shin, aumerejera'ya amo ri mava re jaapera ma.
> Paraguay)
> O loco mak am6roco 61mak , C1±moco t6c-
> She aiku a'a she Tupa , Nde jap6 ha giie ,          shinco, 61ok oyeme ruca ne cupetu6coyo,
> roikua'a hagiia, har6 Tupa'itu hag iia.                toapa no pera m.
> Aik ua'a avef koaga, la she kangy ha, ha Nde,
> Nde mbareteha , Ha she Mbo ri ahu, ha Nd, Nde          YUPIK, CENTRAL ALASKAN: Kuskokrik o ha.                                              wim dialect (Alaska)
> Nda i pori ambu 'eishagiia, Nandejara, Nde
> iioite pytyvo hara roime va'f jave, Nde ii o ite          Nallrun itua, Agayu tm a Piliaqellru avnga
> reik6 Nde je heve .                                    Nallunricesqelluten Ciktarvikesqelluten-llu.
> Watua,        Nallrunritua    Pingailucimnun
> Pingirpanun-llu , Arrsaucimnun tukuutevnun-
> TUPI: G uarayu dia lect (Bolivia)
> llu.
> Che dey vyindar chen1 tumpa , de cheapo                Allamek agayucetait uq Ta ugaa m e lliirek,
> heve de cuag iia deli . Che yeroyy augiia aiien-       Ikayulaa vkut Aarna rq ellramek, Ca mek e lpet
> cua vehy de li c6 corintein deli che vae ca usa de     Piunrilavet.
> rec6 pirantaza vein 6 che para izusavein 6 de
> rec6 yemboe teisa vein6 dipoiri a mbuae tum pa         YUPIK, CENTRAL ALASKAN : Yuk dialect
> de no ite hore pytyinbyin vae, vae yabaete vae         (Alaska)
> sui . Deahe ere ye upivae de recocuer pype.
> Kahnaryahan      aungakaka,      Agaeutma.
> Doyooha bill yakelrhuavoonga, nahtlooskif-
> YAGUA (Brazil, Co lombia, Peru)
> kanuk , cha le ookfak ishkatlootin. Wa neheuha
> Ra a ndiatene , unindano sun, dejano un ra          nahtlunre hkaw chaywelujekah etlpet dowghan
> andiante , ragita hu anta nani Unge R agita dat-       ga haywa vit. Chale a hrsowlowa etlpet dowghera Unge tunshonda ne andieta ne datera ne             ken chut dummyeta h bektlooghe . Awtlamikttrate n i criquitin .                                  loo owahte n Agaeutche tdownnuneh, cheyun-
> T ie q ui sauchera U nge uirti qui sauchera          a hrbootloo nawtloovghahrngow nakoo aw hurinde n6 Su nu chera uni cho sa nsq uita unich-       rnahgeg unn. Keevitl oo ahn ehrtoores htenera ninda.                                             goolootin .
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                          519
> ZAMUCOAN , NORTHERN                     (A YORE,         ZAPOTECt (Mexico)
> A YOREO)t (Bolivia, Paraguay)                              NA QUE TESTIGU SHIOSE, YEB LU BAS LA
> Urepiseyu, Dupadea, uje je vapesute yu,                NAHRE TE GUMBE, CHANE LAZ SE YEBLU.
> ujetiga yiraja uato ega uj etiga yisi vabay.             NAKQUE TESTIGU NAH SHTEN YEL GU ,
> BIH'N , SHTEN YEL NAZAK.
> Yfgome ua uje que y6 bajopire gotique, uje
> mataqueyu jeque cuchapeua, que Dupade                      Ruti steh dad Joh yeb lu, ni rak ne nu re che
> uneque cusego gusuua. Ua u uje barate yoque,             cayac nadzin , ni nabahn shteb tis.
> ome cucha gajnaregone, uje je ua u cuchadej -
> nese.
> 
> c. ASIA
> * Denotes revised translation . t Efforts to obtain exact identificat ion continue.
> 
> AGT At (Philippine Islands)                              AKLANON (Philippine Islands)
> SAKS! AKO, 0 KANA KONG DIYOS , NA                         May pagtestigo aco, 0 Guino-o, nga·kao ro
> MINA AKO, KANIMONG LINALANG TAN-                         nag himo cacon para magquilala kimo cag mag
> GANING MA MIDBID TAKA SAKA SAM-                          ampo sa atubang mo . Nagtestigo aco sa sining
> BAHON KA. SUMASAKSI AKO SA ORAS NA                       momento, sa aeon buya cag sa imong ng ca
> ADIE SAKANI MONG PAG KAODA KAN
> cusog, sa aeon ca pobrehon cag imong mangad.
> KUSOG    SAKA    KANIMONG      KAPAN-
> GY ARIHAN , SA KANAKONG KADUKHAAN
> Owa Ion it ibang imong Dios con indi-lcao,
> SAKA SA KAN IM ONG KAY AMANAN.                           mananabang sa tanan capiligrohan cag ang
> ODA !BANG DIOS KUNDE !KA SANA,                          mainantuson.
> NAGTATABANG      SA   PELIGRO,   ANA
> KANIMO BA SA KANY ANG SADIRI.
> APA YAOt (Philippine Islands)
> Apo Kabunian, inuman ko un Sika din
> AGUSANON           (AGUSAN)t           (Philippine
> nangwa kan Sakon tan matagammuak kan
> Islands)
> mapadayawak Sika. Testigoak sinsaton, maid
> Ako motindog nga saksi, oh akong Dios, nga           kabkaboolak kan Sika , kamas dan! Bilongno ,
> -lkaw nagb uhat kaniko para magkila kanimo               kinakapus ko kan kina Babalin no.
> hasta magsimba kanimo. Ako mosaksi ini                    Maid udom si apowok no adi Sika, Katulun-
> <loon , sa ako pagka wa do-oy ga hum , sa akong         gan di makasapul , Sika din Mannakabalin.
> pagkapobre, hasta sa ako bahandi. Wi nay lain
> iban Dios kondi -lkaw, ang panabang sa                  ARABIC
> ka lisud , ang nagkaugalingon nangabuhi.                 Seep. 496.
> 
> ARMENIAN
> "flr/ S!; r ' /·cf IJ.umna..w~     II   .+r i1+-1i,J nr 'l-na..'h ,,/•u .,_,,.,_
> ,...,~ 6u ~lr'I. l.w'ltl1.u11na.. £. ~£'/_ UJW:-"l"'- 1e1UJ11111 1 /I J" rJ.iu11-
> ft£w~/•M !tr /unnauw/_U1'1.!-J -+-ruL/ilfu."r.u I.. 'f.n1. 'l.ornc../ilfu'lly,
> J.J wy.pwen,.a.p[u.'l.u '- 'fl,,,_ fowruuonc/I Ju-lly t ~lr'lJ'I; 9u1ur
> tlJJtn11a.w•   l't"'I • fll-1"""1..,i,"'l I. /t"t.'1'hwynJ .,,:
> 520                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> AZERBAIJANI (ADHIRBAYJANi , AZERI) (iran, Soviet Azerbaijan)
> 
> -•--.....S....~ ~ •,~__,,.•w,' ~J ..L.J vi..,;___ •
> ~ ....___      .:,,,..:a-• c.S ,,_ v:w.- .,, _,___.,., ,, /liJ "'..__. ;. _ v...6-;- - - -
> •   ...
> .._ _ _ _,_,_.  Ill ...,.
> ,..., •'"!---olitlt
> ~          I I ...lo.
> ____............
> 
> BAGOBO: Gianga (Guianga) dialect (Philip·               BAJAU (BADJAO) (Borneo, Celebes, Sulu
> pine Islands)                                           Archipelago)
> Manna 0 nama ko, ngo poggali no ogo para                Aku makasaksi, Ya Tuha ku, dah bay hinang
> kohaddon asta nikko. Mallo-a kloni mismo                aku ni katoo-nan maka ni duwaahan. Aku
> ngo hago lomilomit nikko keng kollos, ngo ogo           nulay ma kadjapan iti ni kalunaan maka ni
> keng kaayo-ayo, hikko keng malikoddo anda               kamiskinan ku maka dayan.
> ottad ngo nama, hikko na eng kotawang neng                Mahananiya saddi Tuhan suga siga nabang
> hirap eng boy-yottow neng naw-wo mo.                    ma kalaatan Kaulluman.
> 
> BENGALI (Bangladesh)
> 
> C~ ~T~H ~".!~, ~~ ~i~TC<;; "(fil <::f:'iT~ C3!::fE <f~ ~!Tf.T<1nt ~'21
> <!!<!~ C~T~~~ ~~rn <f'Bl<!F! ~"!J, C'l'.<: Yi'Tt.;fi ~ '!:!Tf:r ~ <f.fiicef~ I
> ~ra ~Kt ~rfir ~T"l'Vi lfff2i~l ;r.:.-, .!l~ Z C~ T ~Fl ~'.']'-':~ "ffo ·G \!ifT~rrn
> ~Tfi'f=:1 c~<f~ CZT~n! ~~C~Ei WTTCT ?[f~~~fa I
> ~fir ~1 \!?1 \5fFl C<f.TG11     !;f".;Q"   'TT~, Pi?fl1<f.T r:o'f ~ f?r ~   ?j 1<1 :;fT'01,
> 
> fu1"H~1 I
> 
> BENGALI:         Assamese         dialect    (No rth east India)
> 
> ~ ~. ~ m! ~uittoi1c't~~~~·~~
> ~ elf~ ~(! "fi~ I ~~ 1!_~ ~ ~ <fi~ ~ ~ ~*"'. ~
> 
> ~. ~ ~~ ~ ~1;. ~ illtM, ~~91_'1'; ~ crt~ ~
> ~~l~I
> BAHA ' I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                                                       521
> BENGALI: Tripuri (Kok-Borok) tdialect (India)
> 
> •   ~Ti5 ii~ilTf ~)n~ ~'If, "I 'll\Jl~.              '!TJlf"l         ;~"1'11, i1 -~
> f"fo;011 <lT'ft \!1~ 9JYVi-"11 ~T'I>.: ~:;~Toi ~Tiff~~ GiT>l1 I                           ~ 1~
> tf101-~~~. ~~ ~1;;-.,,\011~. '611~ fi1~1-11rn1, ?i'.'~ <=1~ 11f: '-:
> ~tltf'T~,-"!1°1• 'el1i; <llH~'f-~ ~tl!C'lll ~T~~ 111'1'11 1'
> 
> '11\!l~-oi ~HIT~ '!ii ~~T~H f~1'il0 illG'!'.~ ~11~-f~il : t
> llT~1C'I~ ~0\-0\l~ ('\! ,.~ 't~~ I
> 
> BIHARI: Bhojpuri dialect (India)                            BISA YA (Sarawak, Borneo, Brunei)
> Akujadie saksi , 0 Tuhan ku, Ikau nganjadie
> ~ ~~ {1f iitan{T ~er        oo fifi a)~r <t fo/~       di jaie supaya aku ngatuie di !jun, sarata
> arr a'kt ~ <ti~ lITTITT ~ (1f'lT ~ cl~ !fi"\i~ or~ 1        nyambah di !jun, Tito no aku mara, karana
> tir ~ tn"t ~,<!! <ti~cr orT;;i fit;' t:ir ihrifcr iifl;ft   sangaie-ngaie no di jaie kurang, sangaie-ngaie
> arr i;i: ~ ~ar u •FtTI orr~ ,ir ~fi.il~~     •n;;rorr ~     no Ikau Yang Bakudarat, sarata ombo saja
> ontob alap ku , aku akan mamanau perintah
> mr nfCI' u 11~ 9:~ ll'Tl flf ~ •ri<rr arr ~                 Mu.
> Uiif ~l'T'l'l:~T ~' I                                         Onjop aro lagie Tuhan Yang lain, melainkan
> ")(~r ~      w.- ~ ii'~~ itR" q<imin ""'-@"        1   Ikau nga no Tuhan, Yang nulu ng musim suat
> ~T {~ 1!1fTlr.r d~ U 6T{~ I~ or! ~f;i'lf ~                  susah, Yang Panakuara.
> 
> BUKIDNON (Philippine Islands)
> Testigosan ko, 0 Magbabaya ko, ha iyan ka
> nigtul-tul kanak ho pagkilala imo daw pag-
> BIKOL (BICOL) (Philippine Islands)                          simba imo. Matun-an ko ha laus taini ha
> Nagpapatotoo ako, 0 Dias ko, na linalang                  gutlo-a ha hura ko agkabaloy daw sa gahum no ,
> Mo ako na mamidbid Ika asin sambahon Ika.                   sa ka pobre ko da sa Bahandi no.
> Nagpapatotoo ako, sa oras na ini, sa pagka dai                 Hura un lain ha Magbabaya; kodi Ynaka,
> ko nin kapangyarihan asin sa Saimong Kusog,                 magbubulig ho Katalagman; nagkinaugalinsa sakuyang kadukhaan asin sa Saimong                       gun-ho Pagpanginabuhi.
> kayamanan.
> Dai nin ibang Dias kundi Ika, an Tabang sa                BURMESE (Burma, Bangladesh)
> Peligro, an Mismong Nagdadanay.                                             ~:i;i$lCCD'.>OC\::l(C\'.>:             OJO>CI :i;i51e.1~~'.)I
> 
> rucji"jcfi I :i;> Sl C.n( 'i <><!' 5m <>O"J '.> Cj $
> oo~@. <>O"J 5:i;i '.>l
> 
> ".S;o c: <>00 5 'io.icJin( t\>fu@Jo.icjiu w l <>ru '.> <>ru-:>
> 
> BILAAN (Philippine Islands)                                 ;o<.li )' '.)   oo~;!i. <>O"J 5c:I      •H.!3 c:          t e. :g 5l c.r o'i ~I
> 
> Fnanglut go 0 Duwata na ge i ftabo deg na                  <>oo519e: I oo~@.<>005~ ;oC:                              ~f~I       J1 §c1
> mimo deg agmade ge na mangamfo de ge.                       tE. :i;isicci fll<.lio .. 4,p: [3e: 1.;c: I o.S~ OI
> Gade go de kagkahon ani de klande gnagan go,
> dee de akgaganam de kablasok go na dee de
> kalgadom. Lande dame Duwata ko la loghe de
> <>O"J 5 'i <>OJ'.)    :i;>   $l C )100 Jl:   I   :i;i [~p: "'t!iOJ~:J{ Cj '.)l !j
> lande sen kafyem na tabongam di kat sato de
> gami.                                                       "'~ Ul
> 522                                   THE BAHA ' f WORLD
> 
> .     ~!-   fii
> /~J         -1ft- '       a!.J
> ~-1        j:_
> 
> •
> 'r:ll fl
> ~J('fj;
> 1f   5~ ft-
> ..l. 69 ~
> ~ '         -t
> ' ft- il!J
> ft- :ll
> :ll ~        ~
> 1ḥ ~t       r1FJ
> ~i 6~       1t
> CUYUNON (Philippine Islands)                         DAY AK, LAND (BIDA YUH): Bau dialect
> Naga testigo aco Dios co nga icao ang may         (Sarawak)
> buat canaquen, nga ki lala ta cao ig ing                 Oku mo ogi menyaksi, 0 Topa ku, nang
> gueguegman. Naga testigo aco sa mga oras nga          Ingan mo ogi nai oku dah puan dup Ingan duch
> dia Dios conga inde sarang macacomparar ang           nyomah Ingan. Oku mo pikirien tarah adin itis
> aqueng keseg sa canimo ig ang aqueng calised          dengan doii kuasa ku nudu kuasa Ingan de
> sa imong manggad. lcaco lamang ang Dios, ig           ayuh manah duoh dengan penyusah ku nudu
> icao lamang ang sarang macabawi canamen sa            pongipaguh Ingan.
> tanang cacorian .                                        Doii loh Topa de bokun pakeh Ingan de
> DANGit (India)                                        jagin Penu lung daang penyusah duoh de Pingidip.
> \ll 'tll~ "t•l~ltt, l      \Wtl i-'4't
> W-t o.•u ·it1 Ul ~~ult :utrt      Q,..n  av ~'-'      DAY AK, LAND (BIDA YUH): Bukar
> Sadong (Tebakang) dialect (Sarawak , Borneo)
> ~titull ~~ ltteu \~L !4<1,1. ltl ·~~Ult
> \lL..fi sU\tU\('\I ~"1. ~.{ ~"1.·(' ~llt~'..fi,       Aku jaji saksi ndug tanpa aku, akam mbuh
> ngundah supaya aku empuan akam serta lalu
> ltl.tl :i1;llofi.{ ('\~l ~~l 'tl~ufi ~·'4-t·
> nyembah akam. Aku besaksi ndug iti seh,
> "'..{ 'tll~ ~'tl'l\l.                                minan semoa pengurang kuasa aku ndug
> semoa pengagah akam , serta dingan pinyiranta
> Q.~ r~~(lf.t &_'tl~l     5'1-tlav ~~ct~        aku dengan pingiraja akam.
> ~,,1. ~~ ~~' 9l~Uot! ~~Uot('\ltl~ot                     Anyap tanpa da bekun masu akam, pinu lung
> masa susah, pinulung adup.
> "'~'~ "~' tctfot'~'t.
> BAHA ' I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                                                                  523
> DA YAK, SEA (IBAN) (Sarawak, Borneo)                                           GONDI: Bethul dialect (India)
> Aku nyadi saksi ka Petara Aku , Nuan udah                                             ~ >T'T'«'f-'f'll ~~ if•~ ~e:            cr't;;ofl~ <1<ra               3ff"G" f"'
> ngaga awak ka aku nemu Nuan sereta lalu                                        ;rl~;r "~ irrrr<'frii:;i; 3R <prr            '!i't<'!r~"'     ,;>fn: 'l"i'a'T'f 1
> nyembah Nuan . Aku besaksi ka diatu , ngena                                    'f'll   rt"' "''l';;JT <!ITT!H 3f'f f'rirr ~il'            ITT'! f<ra'f'f 'l''aT'f,
> samoa pengurang kuasa aku, ka samoa penger-                                    q;r t'r!fflfr lf'f S'R"'rrr't '!'ffr q;r 'f'fT 'T<Tif orrm;r 1
> ing Nuan, sereta enggau penyeranta aku
> enggau pengeraja Nuan.                                                                  f~F a'ml;r          ~H~:r       >T'l<ITT' ~,         f;rm<ft           ~ for
> Nadai bisi Petara kalimpah ari Nuan,                                        3fFl:'f, 3f'f f;r1nrr Hil!T'ff'!f "'THii:T'l'fITT'1 !
> Penulong leboh Tusah, Penulong Diri.
> 
> GADDANG                   (GADDUNG)                        (Philippine         GUJARATI (India, Pakistan)
> Islands)
> Pacuruhuan co , 0 Dios co , se pinaratunac ta                                      '~ ~1~ :uu~ ~. ~ lU~t l:Pct~, } <t:::i.
> quesi maamuan ta Ca e idayadayo ta Ca. Tad-                                    :i>U<11utcu <\~ C\l:fl ...- \<It !J~CU ct" ~:l, ~~
> danggan cu, sitoya ya quinacafec e ya pacapanguam , ya diyariyat co e ya quinamayamannu.
> u. :uu ~~ ~ lll:fl ~--1,)c\l :11\:::i. cU:fl ~ct'­
> ~ Gt lll•fl(Q!t-<l,             lU :fl       ,R~ C\I              :ḥt:::i.         (\!:fl
> Awan a corhuan a Dios nu baccan a Icca , na
> ~C('>l:! '1('itCU.fi
> 
> <\~        lU:fl       llll:U&t           :11\:::i_      <\lltJ
> Acquisesalacan si Quetaggacan , na Acquitaronan.                                                                       'lxlt~L lt~'..fi ~l~ ~l~ !i.'
> 
> GARHWALI (India)
> ~ "11 lfqf'l' f11 17f         iil'T'f'F    lfqf~ ~~ f.,; f'!~~           HANTIK (ANTIQUENO) (Philippin e Islands)
> ~IJ.TilI !!!llTT ah 'fir         £t pr n;TJr r:p<r                  "TT\<'         May pag testigo aco , 0 Guino-o co, nga-lcao
> if 'flt I fll 'fl if!'! •g l1il~ q~ f'<i '): fl'iif'1 .., ' '= 1H               ang nag himo canacon para mag quilala
> ~IM'f<: ~~, fq •HT<r ~;j q)<: ? 'ff'F'l ,                         fq tit;::     canimo, cag mag ampo sa atubang mo. Nag
> testigo aco sa sining momento , sa aeon caluya
> ~::..· 'IT 'fTl1 fl'i( '!!~ ~il I
> cag sa imong ca cusog , sa aeon ca pobrehon cag
> sa imong manggad.
> clf l\O ~Ol'T'fT '!_'~ "l1T      "l11J'ff'1     'IT"1f I ;q-lfT if;<ror
> Wa ra ron it iba nga Dios con indi-lcao, manifs r ~OcT       l1   'TIT      'f; '{f!T[   q~     ~. ~   '!~T      cqf~ft     anabang sa tanan capilogrohan cag ang
> fl'~llHiT ~\!T'[ T 'f   1 '>. ~ I                                               mainantoson.
> 
> HEBREW
> ,';ii?K ,l'J!l? ;"11'YK
> .o?w J::i?::i iiJy?i 1=>,, nyi? 'lnK,J :inK '=>
> ,o ' J 1 K , 0 n ' l K i ;i , 1 ::l l ;i 1 ? ., ::>                            D 1 ' ;i        ' J K ;i 1 1 7.J
> .?::>1        ?~in        :inxi          71'JKi            'JK ?i
> ,a,r.i?iy;i 'D?K ,:i,l ny::i :iJiY ,1'1y?::ir.i :ii?K                                                                  l'K
> HINDI (India)                                                                  HINDI , EASTERN:                            Chhattisgarhi dialect
> (India , Nepal)
> ~ foq-<:: I
> lf ~Heft ~T ~ f.:t; <_!"il; ~TrR "Af>:
> it '11)<:: "l1ircrT'f, i?.f~'<"f 'Ill<: 11crr~r ~~ f;r, af~"-"f
> a--i: r ~r ~ 'f;<::'°1 ifi fun: ?:'°1 ~it
> ;j(q<'"f   f'fi'ln i 1
> 'lll'fT '!'flit ~        aoo qf~'flif li!Tfo<:: !R';a<: oT<:: 'J_>;tT
> if ~ 81~ ~T'f>H 'F"1T ~ f~ rt 'A~ ~ ITT<: ?;
> fl'~~llR t ~ ef<:~ ~ 0-<h?; ~S,:<T ~,if~
> "'~ l'!'Tfin: 1 ~ it il'fiffi ii il'ra iir;:ra if~ f<ti'                       iin 'Ill
> ~~ ~mn ;:r~ ~ afll:~ ll:T ~~lm;r El:~"' 1 ft
> ~ ITT ?; ~'111>.f ~ I
> 'fg"i'l'"f    inlor ~)q- ffi!T mit <n:lfin ~ ~;rr ll~ 1
> a-'t 1Af1 h'A' 'IA"lT "'1~ 'RllWH il5T ~ I ?: ~T                         ah ffl'C!Tlf "'T'l'T ~' 'lllTCfT'f '!'~ ~ I o~~ ll:~~
> '1'"'Cl1T'fil, ~~Olll''lT ~ I                                                   ;;f<l''f ~11-f 'Ill -in<: ~ll:T!fOT lfi?:: "°lfio ll:~ ~<:
> afll:~ WR ~<: f;r~<: ll:"'~ I
> 524                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> ILOCANO (Philippine Islands)                        JAHAI (Mala ysia, Thailand)
> Ipanecnecco , 0 D ios ko, a Sica ti namarsua         Yek tanggongk an ley sa-bagai saksi , Mei
> caniac nga umammo Kenca ken man-                    Tuhan yek , Pai yei manjad ik-kan yek ney
> gidaydayaw Kenca. Pa necnecac, iti daytoy a         ge long yek kene l Pai dan bersembahyang Pai .
> canito, ti kinacapuyco ken awan bilegco ke n ti     Yek luek saksi bahawa peryam ta'ah , ok lemeh
> kinabi legmo, ti kinapanglawco ken ti kinabac-      yek dan ok et et Pa i maken basat yek dan
> nangmo.                                             Kayak Pai.
> A wan ti sabali a Dios no di Sica laeng, ti          Berak T uhan peu chan lebah Pai, Tulung
> Catulong iti tiempo ti peggad , ti puon ken gub-    keleng Bahayak , yang He njan Belak.
> buayan dagiti is u- amin .
> 
> ILONGGO        (HILIGA YNON)        (Philippine     JAKUN (Malaysia)
> Islands)
> H'ma mena-ngongkan dirik sabagai saksi, 0
> Nagasaksi ako, 0 Guino-o ko , nga                 Tuhan h'ma, bahawak Ajeh telah menjadikan
> guinahimo Mo ako ag ud makak ilala -kao cag         h'ma ontok mengenoo Ajeh dan semayang
> makaha lad sa Imo . Naga pamatu-od ako sa           Ajeh. H'ma naik saksi, pada masa ka , akan
> subong nga ti-on sang akon kakabus cag sa Imo       kelehoman h'ma dan kudrat Ajeh, padah
> gahum, ang akon kapobre, cag sa Imo nga             kepapaan h'ma dan kekayaan Ajeh .
> mangaranon.                                            Hempak Tuhan lain daripada Aje h,
> Wala iban nga Guino-o kondi·kao ang bulig        Menulung dalam Chelaka, Yang Berdirik Sensa katalagman ang mabinuhaton.                      dirik .
> 
> JAPANESE
> 
> l
> l
> r:. -"                   r-..
> ~      t                 '1')
> 
> 1J
> )-_,
> ~~
> '"'
> O")
> 
> 1(. f)
> ~.     '.i
> 
> ........
> 
> KALIN GA         (KALINGGA)          (Philippine     tu awa-awayya anna y dacal nga pacawayyam;
> Islands)                                             to quinapobre anna ta quinaricum.
> Awatta tanacuan nga Dios nu ari laman Sic-
> Sacan y test igo 0 Diosco nga Sicaw y
> sicaw; y Cabbag ta tiempo na ziga anna Mannamaravvu ta niacan tape nu ammuattaca anna
> gyawa ta ngamin nga mawmawag.
> dayawattaca. Testguaccu ta sangaw y cawaccu
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                                  525
> KANNADA (KANARESE) (India)
> d,~.,, ;::jtS.s;i<i cloir.1 !    ~~;S'     ~!,          ~1..;:$~     "O:d>W ~3~
> ~~~ tJO'Cl/?;i;:u:> j:)e_~ ~1 ~ ~iicJ~Qeo3.:i;                         ~~ &.>u~~;:$, ~e~
> t.)t.>1:>~~;   N<lr::S.> z.>al~, (:)e~ ~eo:s.:io;I.         "Qc:S~        ~~en        ~o d'~~
> ~,;S.      ~~ c;;JJ<;dj.:i o:S.:i~o:j de>:ld..<Oi ,..~.            r.t~t. t11n~3d,        ~~
> ~O~e&F' !
> 
> BEHDENG SENG AK KATALAU LA' AN MEH
> UH TENANGAN BIH IKA'TUA , ALENG
> NYEKANG AKUI, ALENG TE' MURIP
> NYELIMAN.
> 
> KHALKHA (MONGOLIAN)                       (Mo ngolia,
> China, Tibet, U.S.S.R.)
> T3HDp Ta! Ta HaMattr 611tt 6011rocoH
> Hb 611 TaHhir M3):(3X 6a XYH)J.3TDXl1HH
> KA YAN (Borneo, Sarawak)                                      Te11ee IOM nnrnttr 611 np'1113he. E11 onoo
> 11 MHHHH •mna1irvttr, TaHhI lfana11Tattr 6a
> AKUI NAH !TUNG TAKSI KA ', 0 TUHAN ,
> TENANGAN KU!, !KA' ALENG UH NYELUNG                           Yr11ttrYYr Ml1Hh, 6a51Jlfblf '111Hb DplfJ13be.
> AKUI NA! JADI' JAM !KA' DAHIN NYEPIDA                            Tattaac eep T3HDp 6attxrYH, Ta fopx
> !KA'. KERA! NIH AKUI BARA LEMA KU!                            3osnoHrnHH norop naHnaa aspan Tye
> KATY AHA DAHIN KUASA KA ', KETAH KU!                          6atttta naa. Ta eepee aMh 3yyrq T3HDp
> DAHIN KAY A' KA ' . USI'TE' KET A LENG HA                     IOM.
> 
> KHMER (CAMBODIAN)(Kampuchea, Thailand, Vietnam)
> 
> anlJiui:rn~p~ ~~a11~ru~1rurn Ln:n~rns1:11~n~ 1~aj~J
> '                                                  I
> 
> ~ 1nJLO:H~ s~urnnLn:Hw '1 ~im1rurn:~llllt1J1iirnrn B'3J1 Ul ta~~~~
> o                                               I
> 
> w
> U'll~ ~ l.Tfl lt1 ~lfl:H~ fi1lUi ru mnrn ~ SM1lll1 IH1.lllJ~aniu(\} []1:H~ '1
> 1Lfi1tit,n:H~IG ITJ ~1S tn:m~1 (\} ~n 1~Ul Ul rillr\ltUJU~IJG'lSl(iUl '1
> tp:H~ ci1~ng witrn:~ ~f\rn 1uh) n.i~                Ln: 1:~ n6 rn Hl1s~ ·1
> 
> KOREAN (China, Japan, Korea)
> .Q.  :zi£>J o f ::. ~ . •jJ ,~ ~-o.it ~ %c.-~ t-I. r::J~ l
> oj .z1 ~ *J-± i; ~..c: I ~ ~ -2._1-~- oi"-12. 2;j~I~~ 7j ~~
> ii~5'-~- iiH.1-<H~- 4 o Jr:: ~       xJ-j}- oJ 1:-~~ol J .X. :<i
> 21 -T-~H !- jl ~ ~ ~1 .9 J 7J- "-1t H! * . i cJ2 :zi£>J
> 7~ <.J-q )- jl ~ ~ ~.9 J Jf-i> ~ 'd * ij] 7 ~ OJ i-iiH;- 4 oJ
> r::~.
> 
> ~J i..,}olJ -'i .L .2~ ? -'I 2 !:.!:..£ .9 J ""d ~ ..£ "IJ -'I
> ·t- ~~ oJ9JolJ r::~ ~ o f :::. ~o J ~ -< ~%4 o J r:: ~
> 526                                                                      T H E BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> KUI (KHONDI) (India)                                                                             LAMBADit (In dia)
> ~IJ~ ~ Q~ >;(J, Qlol:Q, QO>;Q 'l._(,'_'J.I l)>[OQ <JOQI                                         ;SJ.6'4=- 051            tk o~ 1          o-o        ~.,. sCJ.,.~;S
> Q;;>I 1)>1°Q Q I ~ Q!ll&,IQ <lQ QQI 'flG) llG, l;Q\'IQ I !:lli Ql:O
> 613 N" :J3 se4.1 .;'.)~ 8J.os> cmos£ ~ .,.{; .;S;S.1~
> OOIQ 'fl-t i \i>IQ ".} 0 QI QIQ 9 1tl 1'1€/'IQIQ, 001 lll<;(.ql <J0 Qi
> QIQI \'!~I QIQ q1£11 GQ\'I I                                                                     ~~.S~ el ~.,.g .:Si§ ;J.s5J~    .,                    Ef ~.s &< c§!)1 B4
> (;> Q Q.\flQI ti>:t <Jq l Q >;Q<l
> Gil~ 'J(;'f I Q~ ~ I                 2.6 s- ~ ;.)):$=' S"6 5i ;;hJ' B4 O'o ~.,. ~ CJ5 ~
> Q1,IQI IHI i; (jl "l ~I !:ll;;>l 't-'1 1111\ill~ 91QI 91(;> <li~IQ I
> '( §       :Si~d.     ~   c .5 1 ();6i;J"              ~a~o            tJ>66 13;SJ.
> D'v-066 a~;::u. ~o-~~. o- 6 L~;::u.b                                   e..o 613 .         ..J"
> 
> 6~6 ~o= sOr>.1 . ;;J.::i8J. ;SJ.Os ti, .:Si§ ;;J.OlJ'
> S"6 5i s.:;,...1 ;Si;;j.1 ·
> "'
> KUMAUNI          (KOUMANl ,                                     KUMAONI)
> (India , Nepa l)
> 
> lf rn1:, ~<:5 -lry,1 O\T"{'!"!T-q?;q'!H f\?~,
> qfr "{'l"!T ~, q ll~ \I T~ t
> 31 TIJ.f'ur 'J"IT f\'l~                                                                          LAO (LAOTIAN) (Laos, Thailand)
> li l!im ~r ~~ ~l: M~ <l'ITl:~ q, ~1fbr                                                                 tg ~s : ~CtJul1'1 2"1~ o : ili lVu1JJ:u1uJ1 1JJ:~ltiull1tc)~'iie'i
> '                                       '
> air'lfur ~qtf ; q ~f ar'!'i' ~ '1\'!Tfi:rnl ~T\9'f I                                            ws:ilim (( @: e'iw s :il) es'iJi/Jls :il) u@:lii1su~~11>1s:il) e~llO)
> ... ".n       ...       ...                  ....      -         '
> ctJu~us~nn JO ~ J 1UU~OJ1~U             129)21/JJS:Q J lC@ : n~J1UW~ )CC1~ lU1
> t !i~- 9't'l"! , lG~<1'1° ~T ~ iH~ a'I"                                                    ,    1
> 
> -                       -                    -
> 'II
> 
> wrn29 J~s:9 Jlil' n@ :nlilJrn~n
> '        oi u~ue 9 JIJJS :g Jlil"
> 
> ~'~~f'<l''ll                                                                                           J~ws : wctJ-uc1'1il1~u1n ugn11n~ s :~ctJ-uc1'1~s:il1nclJ, w
> '
> i°Jlm~~J1U~ Oo cm@gl UC ~gJl U2itJ9-UOS W ,
> '
> wi
> J'(m.~ J 1UCtJ-Udfl
> .
> nn                         '                   '                   '
> !?00
> 
> KURDISH (Afghanistan, Armenian S.S.R.,
> Iran , 'Iraq, Syria, Turkey)
> 
> MALAY (Ma laysia, In donesia)
> Saya me nanggongkan diri sa-bagai saksi, Ya
> T uhan saya, bahawa Kamu telah me njadika n
> ~                     .             .                  /   saya unt ok mengenal Kamu dan bersem-
> '   C:..,p    J o_,.·r ·~ ~ { _). ; )                                         bahyang Kamu. Saya naik saksi, pada bentar
> ini, akan kelemahan saya dan kud rat Kam u,
> u \_,J- l' ,... r.,_, . ,>- -:~· . L ~
> •         •              '..>
> - 1/
> .,.------- r' Ii. (           ,.;
> ;       kapada kemiskinan saya dan kekayaan Kamu.
> Tiada Tuhan lain da ripada Kam u , Penolong
> 
> 0 __,    r_.;. J./.:;.                 _; ~ L1;             O_.J     r_,, .                 da lam Bahaya, Yang Berdir Sendiri.
> 
> '             J                  -              • -                                 /
> J     L5_, _,               •   _y ( ~ L1_,, ) ,_, l! .__,__, .J
> MALAYALAM (India , including Laccadive
> JI->? ~'-" ~ r-                                   _}       ~ ~L          ?_,>
> Islands)
> u_; lS' ,_ L           0_..1 _, 0_.)
> 1· r' f - j
> ,                   ~
> \'......---=--- .
> r'°'
> 6l6l'30.J<!.1l, 'lrnlO<!l'.f "{1)6HTn 'W~l~. '1!1l>6lt!UB
> "G)ml.a& 0 0m~lJ:l.Jod!6lomu, GaaQJB "{l)mld!Q" ..._,.,,
> "'""'oo.
> ut; .,_,                                .B<lonooaru6Tlll.
> n(J)6lo!>O
> 12~"
> Ul).&<l!\lalll~:JO~o,
> Ill'!>
> '911l600~Q)S
> cn101~11tlb
> UOCND>l~o,
> "{1)6lnl>o      '3ol01(3hC\!o 1       '81llQJB~6l5           lf\l<YlJ<gg/o          Ollll:xib
> 
> '81001~.             .i~o      rT\l'°'o'·
> d1>Q5'9~°'""" lll6lOOO<m 016leru0J<11~-rulru<3l
> <068:].e.o, ~'\ruc.urno>·
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                        527
> MALD IVI AN (DIVEHI BAS) Divehi character (Maldive Islands, Minicoy Islan d)
> o/-'tv,..      D ?/       /O/        _,,,    c.o      ,../>,,.       \xN/          c.o'-/!.'/
> -/l//l//f /.?V ..5"/.PJ;/d .>/'-?,.P.,.--'a>--:J                        -~v !_/'A/ .>"'"i
> 
> MALDIVIAN (DIVEHI BAS) Latin character (Maldive Islands, M inicoy Island)
> ~ \j{fuftcr    am:.
> +ft R~          am:
> ITT i
> ~4~1f<ta+11'1 31$f, +ft Htl'l an%: ITT
> Alhaa hed hdhevi kalakko!
> Hasuvaameenge dheelathi vaatha ka mua              i~crm~!                   arirm m~
> alhaa ufad hdhavaa fai va nee Hasuvaameenge
> a h alhuk an kusumahttakai kamah a lhu
> :pfl Cfl I <d'J.
> hek iva meve. Mihin'dhu alhu he hi vameve .                ~<field ~ <fl <011 u ~~ arm
> A lhaa ge mika methi kamashaai Hasuvaa meenge kulhadhun vantha kamah adhi alhaa
> ~Q;m~ar$T.
> ge mika methi kamashaai Hasuvaameenge
> fudh i- vodigen vaa kameve. Hasuvaameenge
> fiyav ai Haahaku ne iy kamashaai hunihaa
> ka maka h eka laa nge dhemivodigen vaa kamah          MELANAU: Mukah dialect (Sarawak)
> hekivaa ieve.                                            Akou menyaksi, 0 Tuhan kou , wak Ka 'a u
> me nyadin ako u itou bei-lah bak mena'a u
> Ka'au jegum bak menyembah Ka'au. Ajau
> itou kawak ako u menyader ji-wak lemah akou
> MANOBO t (Philippine Islands)
> jegum ji-wak kuasa nyat Ka 'au, kawak ji-wak
> Bannala n ko no kadd in nad Langagan na id        miskin akou jegum ji-wak kaya raya Ka'au .
> baballan do siak a mid killa kik aw owayd simba          Nda bei Tuhan ke keman Ka'au , un wak
> kikaw . Kaddin nad pangintowan kaungkay               ken a bak Menuluong akou Lian Susah, jegum
> edda kaddin wara sadda tat kikawn katussan            Lian Lubieng Siksa.
> oway edda kikawn kat ussan tat kaddin kapobri a n oway tat kikawn kayamanan.
> Warad as-san manama gawas kikaw, eddad
> ta bang ta kahimpan, oway naa ntay ta sa lili rin.    MELANAU: Oya/Dalat dialect (Sarawak)
> Ako men yaks i, 0 T uhan ko ien Kaau nga
> manamangun ako ba ta-a u Kaa u jegum ba
> MARATHI (India)                                       menyebah Kaau. Ako pasadei jaka ito , ji ako
> nda bei keku asa jad jegum Kaau a-kuasa
> ~~~r! ~~f;:r                                        temegah , ji ga ko a-sase jegum ga Kaau a-kaya
> berkuasa. Ien la h nda bei Tuhan ke kida Kaau ,
> ~ m        mor
> i ~ Rfm ~                                        a Menyapul Mara-bahaya Udipan Kakal.
> 528                                                         THE BAHA 'I WORLD
> 
> NEPALI (NEPALESE) (Nepal, Sikkim)
> 
> ~ ~~r {~~ ! i:r ~Te-TT f~ fifi fo;fi
> ~r{ f'<f?T, ~mr ~r~ fa~ c.i:;;rr ~-rr ir;f
> frri:r) ~ in9'T{ ~~?T if~<r) I if '>l'f~~ lfl
> Pfr<f\H iT~~ fifi l'.f" if~lffi g, ITT fa;i-') ri-
> ~f<f~"l'H g), if ~~i:: g, ra~r ~ci «1=~
> ~ a~r l'.f" Tg ~· fcr;i-) «cf ~;i-if mI
> fcrID qfuf~cr ~ ~                            'Hl=f"T~l'.f"T
> 18~ 1 fcrift ~ ~1 ~<rT~ifi ~ificm i.'l'T~
> ~HT ~cf m~ f;r~~ I
> 
> ORIYA (India)
> 
> W:J(;l'i QISl'QI           El lQ    6 GJEJ(;l'l'Q      ~819.91 EllQ S~lr;'Q . ~~ QQ\;ilt;;);
> g~ S~ ! 8'.'. g~l(;l SQG!f>l, -<JQ s:J._~"-~SQ, 8'.'. S~IQ '1§~901 6 GJEJ(;l'l'Q €1§~\Sl,
> ~IQ sQQ'i 6 CJEJ(;l'l'Q                    mtQQ g~l(;l ~f>l I
> QEJQSQ         9.~I~ 6 GJs:J_-g99 ~IQ(;] EllQ 'CJEJ(;]Q> ~I ~9'1 SQQ SQQQI
> 91~19 1 '
> 
> ORIYA: Halbi (Halabi) dialect (India)                                          PANGASINAN * (Philippine Islands)
> 
> ~ trh! 'llTf 1'T;; I ift"l"T 1Z ~ir 1Z '!lo "fl ~ff f~                    SAMBAAN KO, 0 DIOS KO, YA SIKA Y
> <pft ~ i1tfit; Oflifffl<: lltf~ffl<: ~J;if an;n: i!tf"fl ~Of!                  AMALSA ED SIAK PIAN KABA TEN T AKA,
> TAN GALANGEN TAKA. TESTIGUAN KO ED
> ~<:'fl' ~Ti or.ITll <'fr 3fHf 1 irlit; 1Z '!To fl'ff <'flit# f.t;
> SAY AN BEKT A SO KAKAPOY AN KO TAN
> Jl'h) <'fiT iIB fl'ffii~ if~ fiftrrll, 3TT'3"<: <!ll'"fl OllT ~ff~             SAY PAKAPANYARIM, SAY KAPOBRIYAN
> iIB ITT~ <!?ff ~<f~ ifOl"ifTif 31rn, ift"l"T ~ ~;;;i;                          KOT AN SAY INKA Y AMAN MO.
> '!f<:ilT arr#' ITT'3"<: 'J:tf"fl 1''1" ~ff'fi lll_!~ ;;p:i;; arr ii I ~iril;     ANGGAPOY AROM A DIOS NO AGSAY
> ~;; 31T'3""'. ~);;!. "lf'lifT'f ?;~Tif,<J:ll'T f;;;;r ~ ~ ~mr , i!tfl          SIKA, MANANULONG ED KAIRAPAN ,
> l'fif-lf<:<Tl-~U l'f~fll';ii" 3ITl1 I                                          ONTALINDEG -ED-KABUKBUKORAN.
> 
> PALA WANON (Philippin e Islands)                                               PANJABI (PUNJABI): Gurmukhi character
> (India, Pakistan)
> SAKS! AKO 0 DAKEN AMPO NA BLUAL
> MO AKO AMPANG KUMILALA DIMO AT                                                       ~ Ha 11~Hl }!~ ElE'1a ! w' !ER ~ ~1 ~1vl
> SUMIOM SA DIMO. SUMASAKSI AKO SA
> DAKEN KAYANG BASAG AT SA DIMONG
> ~'~· ut r~ 3 AA ~11 ~ ~ ilfl31 5 11' H'
> ~ l.JC'~l ~ = 3~ ~;:r ~ I H- ~                            llii'
> BASAG, SA DAKEN KALYUTAN AT
> 11~fllil•a ilia~ ui f};r ~· ~ tll3 j   'llQl:I "R>lau   S', )f
> KODYONG KAKA Y AHAN.
> KA YA IBA PANG AMPO LIBAN DIMO ANG                                           ~1 "'3 i ~ 5' r 3a ~i iii> iiil ~~a n.ft. 1
> TABANG SA MAGKAKLAS, ANG SARIRING                                              i <fl ~S«il llf3 'Ri!13 ~ 5' I
> HANG ALO.                                                                      "'
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                                              529
> 
> PANJABI (PUNJABI): Persian character                      RAJASTHANI: Gujuri dialect (India, Paki-
> (India, Pakistan)                                         stan)
> 
> .(;}*' u; ,IJ,&iv: ~~Lr;.,do/.i,
> ~.,.::,,,vU:.1 ~~ ~~,
> '-/.T-
> ,ZtfJ~Ji
> \>..:t.>"" L~ ~ 1 U/> lS' 1_! U~
> '    ...... .... ' '
> u->~0;12-~l_,~1 0 [_,. ~ .f
> (.      -
> •    '      -    .,         fl       '
> 
> <£l..vcL:4>f I> i,f,1~(// 4-1'-(I""'.~                     4_, ~IU~ - c.I~\~ ~\_,
> .Jl['r''-/./f'i.JiLvt ~}V: -vJ 11.1!}11,.,::t(jl           L I - -.::___::, u, 0~- ;_ c.5.;..:: ~ 0v I
> -'-'!1i..1i""vJ~c-/-:J~v~i..-J}!!c..C'~I                d\2-1,,.01,;                    I       --               •        ~
> ~               D     L--.>~      L5/ L- <5v5'-.S'' ....                ~
> 
> PULA           (MANGY ANPULA)               (Philippine    c:_>~\f
> ~
> J,,1~1 ~.2_l5/
> ~
> ·(
> Jv-
> Islands)                                                   UJ..,1        . l ·                 .. /
> /:   ~           A/ ../.Y'     ~ y - u f.I ~,I
> Kangko patuhuyan gid , 0 kangko Pan-                   G.-        '   /             c                        '    ... '
> ginoong Dios, ako gid kanmo binu' at hampay                i,,1\u.JJ...e! v~uL' ~../ ~>
> kawo ay ki lalanon kag sambahon. Kangko                                                                         c
> patuhuyan inda pag udas sa kanme on man
> may kapangyarihan kag sa kanmo pakusog sa
> kangko pagkurian kag sa kanmo pag man-                    RAJASTHANI:                  Marwari          dialect      (India,
> garangon .                                                Pakistan)
> On man may Panginoong Dios no kontay
> ~ ~~Cf<: ' ~ ~r~I ~<i q ...... fqm<f ;:i- al(
> kawo lamang ti umawat sa tanan nga palad kag
> sa on man may katabuha.
> cPn ~<:r ~~r ~<:ii' m'{, if ~ifr q;n fifilil ~: 1 it
> ~ ifl'f(l JfJ!_<: if.~ 1 f'i il f'fi(:f ~ ~h: ';I: ~<f­
> ~l'f~ll'Tif ~: it rr<:'Tif ~ t;rl~ <;i: arg-a- <Hr ~= if?ir
> PORTUGUESE, MALACCA CREOLE                                Ji 1,!"~ 1_ <PH ';J: ~TIHl!I' ~: I
> (PAPIA KRISTANG) (Malaysia)                                   i'r~ qqr<fT r,r1<: if.T! ~ll'WH <lil'fT 'A ~')
> •Frrrt~ 1f<liC: tj CfHl'lT ~H ~1'l: ~rin'/1 ~= I
> Jenti ja beng, you-sa Deyu, pra fala Bos ja
> faze ku yo supaya yo mesti sabe dan reza ku
> Bos. Agora-agora yo ta testifika yo mulyadu
> dan Bos forti; yo pobri dan Bos riku.                     SAMAL (SAMAL BAHASA) (Philippine
> Nte utu Deyu, teng Bos nsong, keng ta juda             Islands)
> ku nu na tempu di mal fortuna, Bos keng                      Mu makasaksi, Ya Tuhan ku, dah bay
> nggere utu jenti pra juda ku Bos.                         hinang aku ni katoonan maka ni duwaahan.
> Aku nulay ma kadjapan iti ni kalunaan maka ni
> kamiskinan ku maka dayah Mahananiya sakki
> RAJASTHANI (India, Pakistan)                              Tuhan Suga Siga nabang ma kalaatan kaulluman.
> w ~qr qprr('qr lj ij'Rf ~\J> i ~ tiR
> trQi-vtt ~m,, 'irfr ?tT ~l: ~n:a-
> SANSKRIT
> fr ~ '1~ \i111J ft;li)' '        I fOT'" ~ 'if ~T{t
> ~· ~m) 3f:-~ I ~ 11lr ~~) I ~t m:~Ti
> 'f~T ~ l"ffCT «~T, tiroft. ~iifi:mT 1f      ~             Tiffll~· ~ t<J~· ~~(~er: 1 ~r;ftq~f 3flffl' ·
> 'iTtr ~~zf(fT ~ trp:rrf'ara ~             i I t.lTt       ~~r?fl:, acr             ma
> irer:n: ~~fuar<Jr: Cfq
> ~ ~Pl';;m1lfr: ~r~ ~crrfi:r •
> fc:1;iT ~~ ~)"{ "PfcfH q;f          .fr {! ~ ti..   t
> ~           ~fl:r<fi:,        ami:rfi'I'~•:,       ~t       fOT;rr,
> <Jilscll~lf: ~·qwrr ;;rf~ 1
> 530                                           TH E BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> SEBUANO           (CEBUANO ,               VISA YAN)         bahyang ha-J un. E ng perhut . saksi, ku-ma
> (Philippin e Islan ds)                                       seadeh, ha ke le ma ha n e ng ru ha kekuasaa n
> Jun , ru ha na hajap e ng ru ha keliayak Jun.
> Saks ih a n ko , 0 Diyos ko , nga fk aw mao a ng
> Walah Tuhan asik ju pader Jun , Jun Penolok
> nag lala ng ka nako sa pag-i la Ka nimo ug pagkate Bahaya , ya ng der C huku p Jun Sendiri .
> simba Kanimo. Matud-a n ko niining gutl oa, sa
> akong kawa lay ma himo ug sa Imong ga hom , sa
> SENOI: TEMIAR (NORTHERN SAKAI)
> ako ng ka ka bus ug sa Imo ng bahandi.
> (Malaysia)
> Wala nay laing Diyos kondili lkaw, a ng
> tabang sa katalagman, a ng Nagk ina uga ling-                  Yeeq me nanggongkan diri yeeq-de h re
> o ng- Pag kin ab uhi.                                        saksi, 0 T uhan yeeq , naq Haaq-top me nteqe lkan yeeq untok ne h-ne h Haaq wab bersem-
> SENOI: SEMAI (CENTRAL                         SAKAI):
> bahyang Haaq , Yeeq naik saksi , ma-mentar-
> (Mala ysia, Indon esia)
> deh, akan teq bersil yeeq wab bersil Haaq ,
> E ng me na nggo nkan berok ng sa baga i saksi,             kapada kemiskinan yeeq wab ke kayaan Haaq.
> Ya Tuhan eng, aje h-lah Jun te la h perjadikan                 Hoi Tuhan ya ng moi num Haaq, Pembese h
> ha e ng untok ha pa nnei ha-Ju n ru ha sem-                  da ll a m Ba haya, ya ng Ehtet tet tenaq .
> 
> SI NDHI (India , Pakistan)
> 
> 9S::.i r J3 ; '1~ ~ ,; s~ L... cilo dU· ~"'f-4 ~
> y.:b I~. .r. U !Jr L-4 l ...;;1 9~·+·1. i:: b~ ~ 9~·
> ... ~ '~ ~f-'i ~ W1 ) J 9~~-'!. r.:; i..,              J o~ . 9~I
> ': ~~) ~· ': ~lb 9~~ ': ~9) ~ 9~~.
> .i,=, .1,.... ci ts' .>3" • Ji v l1. Jb /=~~,.... .j 4!) 9~
> ~ ~1 } ~ J J.o ~ ...? F '-:rte-S '1 y . ~1 ,i F J ~. I
> . ~1 j.L~ r.:;L.. ~..}'?= ~'"' ~~·
> 
> SINHALESE (SINHALA) (Sri Lanka)
> 
> eJGcfi Gc;~c.33),     C?lQ) Dunsfod'   <fVGaB'w l:llO mz~O~, ail ilwrocl'c)
> 
> <ilc?ld'Z5l:>6    zroe>?§ ~toJ a<il tlt!lrod' tlJ az.Q Q)i)c) c?Jc?) e!icl'&l GOO .    c}J Gm
> 
> G,<3Vez§W om BO)Gcsr oo~rn(Jz:E, c?loGW <fe560JZl)c?) e5W Cki)GCJl' Gf.!l~CSli.sc.5z§
> 
> B~~D.             Ge   GaiGeDJG~tD~ ea OO~©J~ Gvd.
> 
> c~~ood'~ <fOWJO lS>O~<ilJt;/~ Wc30d"~~cl''            aQ) wi!Gd'   roz6 GV25l
> Gt;V GZllG<ll~ ~zoi .
> 
> TAGALOG (FILIPINO) (Philippine Islands)                      ang Iyong lakas, sa ak ing karukhaan a t a nd
> Iyong kayamanan.
> Ako ay sum asaksi, 0 Diyos ko, na ako ay
> Walang iba ng Panginoong Diyos malib an sa
> Iyo ng ni likha up a ng Ik aw ay kilalanin at sam-
> Iyo, a ng Siyang Tumutulong sa la hat ng panbahin . Aking pin a tutun aya n, sa mga sa nd aling
> ga nib at ang Walang Kawakasan.
> ito , and a king kawalan ng kapangyarihan at
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                                                                                     531
> T AGBANU A (Philippin e Islands)                                                     ~ru;;:i.)§"'l:O"~§                            ~;;i)d._            ~~O~l:O"~§
> Taksi ako 0 Dios ko nga pianak manan mo                                           ~eJ~O'\P~~ -Oj.Jc:Q"i:)§ ;j;;i) ;;)-01_~~
> a ko nga sumonod Kanimo ba w ikaw e nag buat
> kanaum. Natandaan ko kayte nga yon kiarotan                                                             ~ ~;;i)
> d;il. N" l!il?I' _...,                             ~ ( _.,
> § ~                             iiJ'> ~6
> ko nga sabap, kanimo ba w kat Kakorongan ko
> 8"S"'~d._ ~ ;Joj6;;i) ~ <S).lllo~ ~ ;:So~s'
> daasi kat ka doonan ko baw yan Kadoonan mo .
> Uga nay bakun ng Dios ekaw lamang, nga                                            B~N"d._~·
> mananabang et Kakorean baw Ka gayonan et
> usa baw usa.                                                                                         llf"~e:>!!5'd                 ;;J;;p~ex e!i~~ ;Jo~
> 
> TAMIL (India, Malaysia, Sri Lanka)                                                   :;S.);:5       j6}~,'\~o ~                       ~ ~o                  ~~.S                       ~;:)..)
> f;T   fin-    6 L   6lj   a
> 6Y7" ,    ,si5 t.iJ & 2srr   JJ/ ;J Ji; §ii Gil ifJ   ~o~;'.)~ ej6},
> uG&J~jl              Go.rnC1&1 m 6li>~u                     U6l!lL~fil®$             TEMUANt (Malaysia)
> Q,r0fr            6TfflU/Jfa(!!J          ~IT(Jtilfr        .f'trL&J,      @ti          Akuk menanggongkan dighik sabagai saksi ,
> ft(!!ORIW,            "'~          utN,JIQJT %~/i>(!!Jtn             &..ii;~eln      Yak Tuhan-Kuk , bahawak-lah Ong, telah
> menjadikan akuk untok mengenal dan memuavGV6Vl!Slwa.~w,                   61   tizJ Ql.aJi""w&~w ~,;;~.,;,
> jik Ong. Akuk nait saksi, padak waketu nin,
> Q,,,a,61J~ tt.~fi>®Ui #r<L-filu.Jw -s....AJ1iY'tJJ;6i>i.                             akan kelemah akuk dan kekuasak Ong, kemiskinan akuk dan kekayak Ong.
> ~u%fi}6'J                  6&1Tu.JaD,            8HLJ    2...~&JU.tr611T"
> Nyap adak Tuhan melainkan Ong, Pelin-
> /T,I i.J tHY>     mp (; 6V JJi lLJ n(!f liJ 6-\l a,, .                               dong dalam Bahaya, yang Bedighik Sendighik.
> TAW SUG (JOLOANO SULU) (Philippine
> THAI (Thailand)
> Islands, Borneo)
> Aku , in sa ksi , 0 Allah , ika w in nagpapanjari
> kak u, umingat kaimu iban magsumba kaimu.
> Sapahan ku ha way kung ku iban ha gaus mu ha
> ka miskin ku iban ha daya mu.                                                                                                  o                 1.-        .....   I            ..(
> 
> Ell'U l 'l'IJ!)J'V l WL 'l lfl!)~YlliL fl 'lf'lltJJ
> Wayruun dugaing Tuhan hambuuk-buuk da
> '           I           ..,                a,,         I;               I                ...       .:,
> 
> ikaw, tabang ha kasusahan , in way nagpapan-                                         W1~!)Jf1              fl !)f11 1lJ'll fl l:'l'U'lJ!)J'lJ1WL 'l lLLft~fl !)f111lJlJJf1J
> jari.                                                                                'lJ!)JW1~!JJf1
> '
> 
> TELUGU (India)                                                                                      '~~W1~L'll~'U 1fl'U!)n'llnW1~!)J~                                        W1~!)Jf1t:-l
> '    .
> J~1EJ 1-u11EJ~'UflHI LLft~W1~!)J~~mJfil1J!)ci 1f1EJ~lY-l~J
> '
> e.. or' o~. ;;i)~.S ;:S;i)d.. ~ XJ8o ~                             m
> '                           '
> 532                                              THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> TIRURA Y (Philippine Islands)
> Ge-ti ndego ko T ulus si be-em me'y le-me-                          ~v~;::s<:o•.           n(3e       :ir.:;::s<:c:;•   w~..ios•o•jci   eide,
> nimbag ge begen inok ge-tuwa ku be-em brab                            L deo3d
> ge-datu-o ko be-em. Ge-safa-a ku bene'y enda
> e ke-ataga ku brab ati'y barakat Mu-we, e
> ke-meskina ku-we brab keungangen mu-we.
> Enda e se-giyo Tulus we-e Be-em sa-en , e                            TURKISH
> Temabang ngo enok u-wen ni kamarasayan, e                                IJahi! Senin, beni, Seni tanimak ve Sana tap-
> Turu n.                                                               mak ii;:in yaratmi§ olduguna §ahadet ederim. Su
> anda kendi ac.z:ime ve Senin Kuvvetine; kendi
> TULUt (India)                                                         .z:aafima ve Senin iktidarina ve kendi fakir-
> '"'                          ligim e ve seni n .z:enginligine taniklik ediyorum.
> ~t;1d ! eidos• ~OOO)d il.:CO' .    eidos' ~~
> Miiheymin ve Kayyum Ilah a ncak Sen sin.
> ~:ie.;oJ d mc:i• eio·~~os· ~' ~ o:3:i~o'. OOJ.>OS' z-8-_,
> ~e.J
> 
> mo~~C>OO)? eio• ;?Jt;::fo:!, o:lJC>OS' i..i~j.     eio•
> !iJe~:io~.
> 
> TURKMEN (TURKOMAN) (Afghanistan, lriin, Turkmen S.S.R.)
> 
> /./                                              " /                            -         /
> J:./~j .__;;,; /., ~ if'/ (-0.../~ u J <~ _L/ J4V
> ;,.J, o.J !:>_y, 0 ~./.__:.,_, i,.;;,        , ~_,; ._;fi ,:._,, ~_,             c,; Li·
> Jfcr'~ J(y;,, ;,)_, 6~) J!::/_, ,.;;_;};~
> , ~s~ J~ j.i/u.J! ~;_,                                                ib_,01
> ~(~' J~~ 0                                     i:_.::,~ (.;)__,;._,/(.)_}_
> 
> VIETNAMESE (Indochina)
> L1.1y lh1H.r11g-D~ ci1n c·on, con :-.i11
> chlrng n!1 ::111 rtu1g :'\l~t.:·6' 1, dU t::io cnn
> d~ hiC11 IJi l:t ~GL"0' J, d~ tUu tl1U
> NCC'6'I. Con xi11 th(1. 1il1(rn ngoy !1:c
> ni1y con thi)l lit h:it-li_    rc· tnrr·rc 1.1~·-lt.rc
> ci1:i Nl;L'·(n ,.!   n~hCo -n irn Lnrt'.tc :>1.r
> phong-1.l1li ci1a :\Gl'-6°1.
> Kh Ong cr'i ni ngo:\i ~GU6'I l~1 ThmJng
> BP, ~Gc·<n J; B~ng Clrn-khU ClrU-L:)n
> Bang T1_r-Tiin Ti; -Tni.
> 
> WARAY (SAMAR-LEYTE, SAMARENO,
> W ARA YW ARA Y) (Philippine Islands)
> Testigos ako Nimo, Dios namon, nga Ikaw
> a n naghimo ha aeon para kilal-on ka ngan
> tuuron. Natuod ako hini yana nga oras nga
> waray aco gahom ug ha imo gahom, ha aeon
> kawarayan ug ha imo caricohan.
> Waray na iba nga Dios con diri Ikaw, ma
> naracop han maka-luluoy, ug mga waray na
> paglaom.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                            533
> 
> D. AUSTRALASIA AND THE
> 
> PACIFIC ISLANDS
> * Den otes revised translation
> t Efforts to obtain exact ide ntification continue.
> 
> BAINING (New Britain Island, Papua New                FIJIAN (Fiji Islands)
> Guinea)
> Au sa qai kila , 0 i Kemuni na noqu Kalou, ni
> Ngo tes nas, aingo gu Kalau. Sana rang na          sa i Kemuni ga Koni a vakatuburi au mai me'u
> nge ivengo taram inge dilotu. Ai langit ingo          kilai Kemuni ka dau masu vei Kemuni . Au sa
> koir kunga kurot dap ai nge di di kurot. Aingo        kila tu e na gauna oqo ni'u sa ka malumalumu
> di ama ralak ka na ngo dap a inge di ama              wale Koni sa kaukauwa Ko i Kemuni, ni'u sa
> hurong bara ka na nge. Ai re Varivat ki di koir       ligalala Koni sa vutuniyau Ko i Kemuni.
> a nga Kalau dokop sokop nge. Katat naramut               Sa sega tale ni dua na Kalou au kila sa i
> na mara ma guvengirong, kosaki koir memar             Kemuni duadua ga , 0 i Kemuni Koni sa
> varung dokop sokop e Lalau.                           Dauveivukei e na Guana ni Leqa, 0 i Kemuni
> na Kalou Bula Vakai Koya ga.
> CHAMORRO (Guam and other Mariana
> Islands)
> FUTUNA (Futuna (Hoorn) Islands)
> Mandeklara yo', si Us'us-hu, na un fatinos
> Ekau tui maoki loku Atua, na ke faka tupu
> yo' ya para bai bu tungo' Hao yan para bai hu
> au ke kau iloa ma atolasio ki Jou agai.
> adora Hao. Tumestitigu yo' pago' na
> Ekau tui maoki ile temi nei, iloku gaegae ki
> Momenta , ni tai nina' sina-hu yan ma acom-
> Jou puleaga, loku mativa ki Jou kalasia.
> para gi fuetsa-mu, i pobla-hu yan i
> Tie kau tui fuai kile Atua etasi, kole pule
> Abundasia-mu Taya mas ke guaiya na Yu'us i
> taualuga mo mafimafi.
> a'ay uda gi pelegro i todo i tiempo layana na
> Eina saofaki tatou mei le fakasala, mo
> Yu'us .
> tuutamaki kesekese ole malama .
> EASTER ISLAND (P ASCUENSE) (Easter
> Island)                                               GILBERTESE            (Kiribati,   Nauru,   Ocean
> Au testigo , o tooku Atua, a au ianga i iaau       Island)
> memahani i atu i a koe . Hanga rahi i te horo nei        Atuau, I kaotia ma te koaua ba Ko a tia ni
> taaku mee hanga rahi tamee itau tetahi mee i          karikai ba N na ataiko, N na tangiriko ao N na
> tau ono.                                              noboiko. Ao I kaotia n te tai aei ba boni moan
> Ina tetahi Atua ko koe noma, tangata               te m'aaka Ngkoe ao ngai boni moan te manmoaina ite ati, tangata mohapao ia ia tangata         gori. Moan te korakora Ngkoe ao ngai boni
> riva riva .                                           moan te kainn ano. Bon akea te Atua temanna
> ba ti Ngkoo ae Ko maiu i bon Iroum ao te Tia
> EFATE (EFATESE)t (New Hebrides)                       Buokiira.
> A noa pae nalomauana Supe anginau, 0!
> Nanga ningo ku dawonaki nau nanga anga                HAWAIIAN (Hawaiian Islands)
> ataeko po do lotu kingo. Doko rangi waia a noa
> KE HI'I NEI AU I KA'U HOIKE, E KUU
> pae nalomauana nanga kinau a manainai ngo a
> AKUA, UA HANA MAI OE IA'U EIKE IA OE A
> dika nakasuana ma ningo ku peani nakasuana
> E HOOMANA IA OE . KE HOIKE NEI AU , I
> waina e parua Jiu; a pei tea tika sa ma ningo         KEIA MANA WA, I KO'U PALUPALU A I KOU
> kupei tea songolapa ki sara naleo.                    IKAIKA I KO'U ILIHUNE A I KOU W AIW Al.
> Ningo ku masikima pei Supe, ku silae doko           AOLE HE AKUA E A ' E 0 OE WALE NO, KE
> rangi ni nariesokiana ngo ku mariatae dumama          KOKUA I KA MANA WA POINNO, KE KOKUA
> doko pae nakasuana aningo masikima.                   0 KEIA KINO NOU NA POMAIKA'l.
> 534                                       THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> KOSRAEAN          (KUSAIEAN)               (Eastern     MARSHALLESE (Marsha ll Islands)
> Caroline Islands)
> Ij , kamol , 0 ao A nij , bwe Kwoar koma nmo n
> Nga fwakak , 0 God luk Korn orey ul a nga in         io bwe in je la kin Yuk. Ij kwalok, kio, kin
> ete ko m a in alu nu Sum , Nga fwakak ingena ke         mwojno ko ao, nae Kajur eo Am, kin jeramol
> munas luk a ke ku Lorn, nu ke sukasrup luk a            eo ao, nae maron eo Am. Ejel ok bar A nij
> ke kasrup Lorn.                                         ij e lokim , Dri jiban ilo ie n ban , Dri binmur ilo
> Mangin God Sayom, mwe kasre kut in pal in            ien ote mjij.
> fosrgna , a ma ku in sifwana .
> 
> MELE: Fil a dialect (Fila and Efate Islands,
> LAU (Solomon Islands)                                   New Hebrides)
> Nau ku fa ma mana oe, a God nau , na o,                Feuia fok i akoe Atua akoe gani konia a uau
> hau ngai nau, ur ia kua haitama mu , ma ku a foa        sirtaea akoe, go akoe ga ni komaro.
> hatam u. Nau ku fitoomu asi kada na, kua a lu a         Tmaramararaga niau iaro maramana poulapa ,
> makeso la nau gi, i fafo na rigita la oe, na siofa      kit te ulia go mujia miefa geia tm o uri raga. Go
> la na u i fafo na initooa oe, e langi lau ta God,       kainugia foki akoe geia nekeke la gani
> teeni oe na , na fufa kada ana ta'a la, ma a toto       mafitlakena toturu a koe A tu a.
> firi.
> 
> MOTU, HIRI (Papua New Guinea)
> LIFU (LIFOUAN) (Loyalty Islands )
> La u hereva momokani, la uegu Dirava e, Oi
> Akotesie ti fe, nyipici koi ni !aka Cili e la Atre   ese lau karaia Oi diba bona Oi tomadiho henia
> xupi ni matre troni a ad raie Cilie. Ini a ohn e        gwa uraia . Lau gwa uraia, harih ari, lauegu
> hnyawa e nehil a !a ka Atre ka kucakuca ni , nge        manoka bona Oiemu goada dekenai, lauegu
> the i Cilie la egocatr. Atre ka pe mo ni, nge Cilie     ogoga mi bona Oiemu ko hu dekenai .
> la trena mo .                                             Dirava ta be lasi, Oi sibona, Durua-Dika-
> Nyipici , pe ko ketre Akotesie hui E netilai,        Dekenai, Sibona-Noho Diravana.
> Joxu , la Atre i xatua ngone la ijine hace, la A tre
> ka ci le huti epineti palua .
> NENGONE (MAREEN) (Loyalty Islands)
> Kolo ca Madra run go, uni ci aseseko ni , ko
> MAORI, COOK ISLANDS (RAROTON-
> hnei Buango hn a puli nu thu bane carajewe du
> GAN) (Cook Islands)
> Buango, ne a hmani Buango, inu ci waamilu du
> Ko au te kite E ta ku A tu a e Naau a u i anga      Buango ri gul a hawa ome, wenore kogo ke inu
> mai kia kite ia Koe e kia aka mori ia Koe. Te           ri tadawaien 'ore nene ni Buango , ka deko ace
> akapa pu nei au i teia nei i toku puapingakore e        ke inu ri tadawaien 'ore aca ace ni Buango, ka
> i Toou ririnui, ki toku putaua e ki Toou ki e           deko se Makaze, ka Buango so 'ore thu thakui
> manga nui . Kare atu e Atua ke mari ra ko Koe           nu ri tadan 'ore tango, ne Buango 'ore ci wien
> anake, te Tauturu i rota i te tuatau o te kin o, te     kani Buango ko.
> 'l:a uturu o te oraanga.
> 
> PALAUAN          (Western     Caro line    Islands,
> M     RI, NEW ZEALAND ' (N'w z,,Jand)                  Guam)
> E me inga ana e au, E toku A tua, Nau au i               Akmui e l medengei, 0 Dias erngak, el kmo
> hanga ki a mohio ki a Koe a ki a koropiko ki a          kau a milebak el mome dengelkau e meng ull er
> Kpe. E whaka puak i ana au, i te nei wa , ki toku       Kau. Makuuchais er che lechal time e l kirel a
> ngoikore a ki T6u kaha, ki toku poh ara a ki            elitechetuk ma klisichem , ma elebulek , ma
> Tou oranga.                                             chiltetem.
> Kahore he Atua i tu a atu ko Koe a nake, te              Ngdiak a ngodech e l Dios ngkm al di kau el
> Awhina i rota i te Mate, te Mana noho                   tang. E l mesiou ra chelebuul edingar e l mo
> Motuhake .                                              cherechar.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                           535
> PIDGIN, NEW HEBRIDES (BISLAMA,                         TAHITIAN (Society Islands, Tuamotus, Mar-
> BICHELAMARE) (New Hebrides)                            quesas Islands, Gambier and Austral Islands)
> Mi talem stret 0 God blong mi se yu mekem             Te ite nei au eta 'u Atua e ua hamani Oe ia'u
> mi blong save yu mo prei long yu. Long smol            Note iteraa ia e te haamuriraa atu hoi ia Oe.
> taem ia mi save talem tru long wik paoa blong            Te ite nei hoi au na roto i teie nei taime i to'u
> mi mo long strong paoa blong yu; mo mi talem           nei paruparu I mua i to Oe na Puai Hope, e,
> se mi kat nating be yu yu kat planti samting . I       to'u nei veve i mua i te rahi 0 ta Oe na Tao' a.
> no kat nara fala God be yu: yu yu help long               Aore roa e Atua e atu maori ra o Oe ana'e ,
> taem blong trabol mo yu yu save stap oltaem yu         Oia tei hi'o aroha mai i tae i te mau taime ati,
> wan no mo.                                             Oia tei tupu mai mai torn mai ia'Na iho .
> 
> PIDGIN , PAPUAN (NEO-MELANESIAN)
> (Papua New Guinea)                                     TANNA: Nupuanmen (Weasisi, Whitesands)
> dialect (Tanna Island, New Hebrides)
> 0 God bilong mi. Mi tokaut nau long Yu yet
> i bin wokim mi baimbai mi nap long save long              Iau iakani nuparian, o rahak Iarumanig, in
> Yu na mi nap long preia long Yu. Nau tasol mi          namol iau iakarun ik iakafaki kamik. Iau iakani
> tokaut, olsem mi no strong na Yu i strong moa.         nuparian u roaiu o rahak napauian, ik iatam
> Na mi tokaut tu olsem mi rabis pinis na Yu i           askasik iau iatos takaku.
> holim olgeta samting.                                     Iarumanig katimun tika matou ik pusin ama,
> I no gat narapela God. Yu tasol i stap. Na Yu       ik nakasiru ia nian raha narahain, ik pusin ama.
> i halivim ol long taim bagarap i laik kisim ol na
> Yu tasol i lukautim Yu yet.
> TONGAN (Tonga Islands)
> PON A PEAN (Eastern Caroline Islands)
> Lotu Ho'ata. Ko e fakamo'oni au 'e hoku
> I wia kadehdeh, Oh ai Koht, me Komwi me              ' Otua, kuo Ke ngaohi au, ke u 'ilo koe mo u hu
> ketin kapikiedahr en esei Komwi oh en kaun-            kiate koe, 'Oku ou faka-mo'oni'i 'i he
> dok ohng Komwi. I patohwanehr, ni ansou                momeniti ni ki hoku vaivaf pea ki Ho'o Malohi,
> kiset, me ngehi me leut oh Komwi me mana-              ki hoku masiva pea ki Ho'o Koloa 'ia. 'Oku
> man, oh sohte ahi mehkot ah Omwi te                    'ikai ha toe 'Otua kehe ka ko Koe, ko e tokoni
> mehkaros.                                              'i he tu'utamakf, ko e mo' ui pe fate Koe,
> Sohte pi! emen Koht pwe Komwih te, me
> Sawasepen ansoun apwal , oh Koamoaur Poatpapoat.
> TRUKESE (Eastern Caroline Islands)
> 
> ROTUMAN (Rotuma Island)                                   Ua puaratta, 0 ai Kot, pun En ka fori inisi
> pun upwe sile En o fel ngeni En. Ua puer
> Gou aier'<)k 'otou ' Aitu, ne ' Ae ta fup'<)kim      nganuk non ei atun pun ngang use fakkun
> gou la 'inea 'Ae. Gou aier'ak 'e ao pf!u hete'is,      tufich nge En ka atufichi ai, ua osupuang nge
> ne gou 'af' af ka ' Ae ne ' ne', gou kei<) ka 'Ae'es   En ka apiseki ai.
> koroa.                                                    Ese wor eman Kot pun En chok. Ewe Tufich
> Kat 'es 'A it hoi'<)kit ra, 'Ae 'esea Gagaja , ne    Ion feiengau , 0 Ewe-unusan Anuwor.
> asoa gou 'e ao noanoa. 'Ait se 'es a'ofige.
> 
> SAMOAN (Samoa, New Zealand)                            URIPIV (Malekula Island, New Hebrides)
> Lo'u Atua e, ou te molimau atu, na faie , e             Inti nurai weritun, o Atua suk, ga nik kuloli
> Lau Afio a'u ina ia ou iloa Oe ma tapuai atu ia        inure borong wosi nik ko re bosrove nik.
> te Oe. Ou te tautino atu i lenei itula , lo'u             Inu nurai weritun leligen wolik re inu sete nu
> augavale ma Lou malosi, o lo' u mativa i le ma         teter ko teterin som, re jorok ejki ko re jorom
> Lou tamaoaiga.                                         elep.
> E leai lava se tasi Atua na o Oe , o le                 Atua san ejki ko nik, ku metmet kem re nanu
> Fesoasoani i Puapuaga, o le Puna-o-le-Ola.             ga marsej, nik ga kumaur tetajer.
> 536                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> UVEA, WEST (OUVEAN) (Uvea Island,                      gn'hi i go me oumo wehn: go tchogn' here neme
> Loyalty Islands )                                      Gn'hon venviirii ton ra. Gn'hon bo tonhenran
> nohu ta vi patou, mon na ta ko'hen me vinnire.
> Oge me haihnathuu , Khong 16, uje up nya
> Gn'hon tai, Gn'hon Yova, aya kon, tdha
> me oge mehe ka oganou. Me hai hnathuu oge
> mon ari ko a.
> me haio monu hnyi traem ang hnyi hnyimiikan
> hniim hna hu, me iinyam hnathu me anyik
> thedruoc me hniim hna tren.                            YAPESE (Western Caroline Islands)
> Ebe ke Khong ae iicii mou, at ae hana je iinyi
> A Got kemichu wun'ug
> hia , me he ka hum ota hnyi hwetr ae gan, uthibi
> Ni kam sunmiyeg
> at ae tibentenge.
> Ni ngug mathange-luwol.
> Nigem mug liyor ngom.
> V AHO t (New Caledonia)
> Gum nang ni gage dariy
> Gotchogn ' here neme Gn'hon Yova.                    Rogog ma gure gab fala-ab.
> Gn'hon ro wera me gorowe atche we Gn'hon.              Dariy rebe Got ni taareb
> Gn'hon tai go me noue ka Gn'hon. Aregn'h               Rogon ngom mi wod
> wehn gn'hin gn'hre gn'hiri , ka, iken, mon wehn        Fanam mathange luwol.
> 
> E. EUROPE
> • Denotes revised translation.
> tEffo rts to obtain exact identification continue.
> 
> ALBANIAN                                               banaiz neure botererik ezaren lekuko, zure
> Deshmoj a Zot, i em Perendi! qe ti me ke            ahalmenarena, bai eta neure pobrezia eta zure
> krijue mue per mete njoftun tye dhe per mete           aberastasunarena.
> adhurue tye. Deshmoj kete i;eshtje ne dobsi-             Ez dago Zu baino beste jainkorik, arriskuan
> nen t'ime dhe ne fuqine tate, ne vobeksine             laguntzen duena, bere baitan bizi dena.
> t'eme dhe ne pasunine Tate, S'ka tjeter
> Perendi per vec se teje, Mbrues, i vet-gjendun!
> 
> ARABIC: Maltese dialect                                BIELORUSSIAN               (BYELORUSSIAN,
> WHITE RUSSIAN)              (U.S.S.R., Poland,
> Nagfiti xhieda, 0 Alla tiegfii, Ii Int fil aqt ni
> Lithuania)
> biex nagfiarfek u nagfitik qima. Nistqarr fdan
> il-waqt kemm jien bla fiila u kemm Int set-               .51 ChBe.JJ.'l.y, 0 Eo)l(a, wTo Thi Msrne
> gfiani; nistqarr il-faqar tiegfii wil-gfiana           crnaph1y, Ka6 si na3Hay LI,si6e i LI,si6e cnatiegfiek. M'hemmx Alla iefior gfiajrek, il-            siy . .51 ChUhBSIP.JJ.)l(alO y DTYIO xsiniHy MalO
> Gfiajnuna fit-Tigrib, Inti Ii Tgfiix fik Innifsek.     6e3.JJ.anaMO)l(HaChUh i Tsaio MO~, Maio
> y6orachUh i Tsaio seni"I.
> BASQUEt (France)                                          HsiMa iHwara Eora, anpa"!a LI,si6e, LlanaMO)l(Ua y 6si.JJ.3e, CaMaicHyIO'ihI.
> Seguratzendut oi nere Jainkoa egin na zula
> zu ezagutuzeko eta adoratuzeko. Seguratzendut orai nere ahalgabetasuna eta zure poderia
> nere behartasuna eta zure ontasuna.                     BRETON (Northwestern France)
> Esta bertze Jainkok zu besik , bera iraun
> dena Gure lagintza galbitdetan.                           Test on, o ma Doue, ac'h eus krouet
> ac'haron evit da anaverout hag azeulin. Anzar
> a ran d'ar c'houlz-man ma dic'halloud ha da
> BASQUEt (Spain)
> galloudegezh ma faourantez ha da binvidigezh.
> Ene Jainko hori, Zu ezagutzeko eta adorat-              N'eus Doue all Eset egedout, an hini a sikour
> zeko egin nauzula sinesten dut. Une honetan             e-barzh an danjer, an hini a zo drezhan e-unan.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                           537
> CATALAN (Andorra,            Balearic    Islands,   ESTONIAN
> France, Sardinia, Spain)
> Tunnistan, oh my Jumal , et Sa oled mind
> S6c testimoni, jOh Deu meu! que tu m'has         loonud Sind tundma ja teenima. Se! hetkel
> creat per a coneixer-te i adorar-te. S6c testi-     tunnistan oma jouetust ja Sinu Vagevust, minu
> moni en aquest moment, de la meva impoten-          vaesust ja Sinu rikkust.
> cia i del Teu poder, de la meva pobresa i de la        Pole muud Jumalat kui Sin a, Abi hadas,
> Teva riquesa.                                       Iseolev.
> No existeix altre Deu, mes que Tu , el que
> Ajuda en el Perill , el que substitueix per Sf      FAROESE (Faro e Islands)
> Mateix.                                                Eg asanni, Gud min , at tu skapaoi meg til at
> CROATIAN (SERBOCROATIAN, Latin                      kenna teg og tilbidj a teg .
> character) (Austria, Czechoslovakia, Hungary,         Sanneliga kenni eg, i hesu 1¢tu, mitt hjalparloysi og tfna megi, mitt fatrekd¢mi og titt veldi .
> Italy, Romania, Yugoslavia)
> Eingin annar Gud er ti! uttan tu, bert tu
> Ispovedam se, o Gospode, Boze moj! Ti si         hjalpur i vanda, bert tu ert um alt annao fer.
> stvorio mene da spoznam i obofavam Tebe.
> Ispovedam u trenutku ovom slabost moju a            FINNISH
> moc Tvoju, siromastvo moje a bogatstvo
> Todistan, oi Jum alani, etta olet luonut minut
> Tvoje. Nema drugog Boga sem Tebe , Svespafavajuci Samopostojeci!                           tuntemaan sinut ja palvelemaan sinua. Tuan
> julki talla hetkella oman voimattomuuteni ja
> sinun voimasi, oman koyhyyteni ja sinun rik-
> CZECH *                                             kautesi. Ei ole mitii.an nuuta Jumalaa kuin sin a,
> Dosvedcuji, 6 mt'.ij Bofo, ze jsi me stvoi'il,   apu hadassa, itsestii.an oleva.
> abych Te poznal(a) a vzyval(a) Te.
> Doznavam v tomto okamziku svou bezmoc-           FRENCH
> nost a Tvoji moc, svou chudobu a Tve bohat-           Je suis temoin, 6 mon Dieu, que Tu m'as cree
> stvf.                                               pour Te connaitre et pour T'adorer. J'atteste
> Neni jineho Boha krome Tebe, Pomocnfka v         en cet instant mon impuissance et Ton pouvoir,
> Nebezpetf, Sama v Sobe Existujiciho.                ma pauvrete et Ta richesse.
> II n'est pas d'autre Dieu que Toi , Celui qui
> DANISH                                              secourt dans le peril, Celui qui subsiste par
> Lui-meme.
> leg bevidner, o min Gud, at du har skabt
> mig, for at jeg ska! kende og tilbede dig. Jeg      FRISIAN* (Frisian Islands, Germany, The
> vidner i denne stund om min afmagt og din.          Netherlands)
> styrke, om min armod og din rigdom.
> Der er ingen anden Gud end dig, hjrelpen i         Ik tsjugje, o myn God, dat Jo my skepen
> farens stund, den eneradende.                       hawwe om Jo te kennen en te oanbidden. Ik
> betsjugje op dit pas myn machteleazens en Jo
> macht, myn earmoede en Jo rykdom .
> DUTCH                                                 Der is gjin oare God as Jo, de Helper yn
> need, de Troch-Himsels-Besteande.
> Ik getuig, o mijn God, dat Gij mij hebt ges
> chapen om U te kennen en te aanbidden. Ik
> betuig op dit ogenblik mijn machteloosheid en       GAELIC, IRISH (ERSE, IRISH)
> Uw macht, mijn armoede en Uw rijkdom.                 Tugaim fianaise, a Dhia, gur chruthaigh tu
> Er is geen ander God dan Gij, de Helper in        me chun thu a aithint agus a adhradh.
> nood , de Bij-Zich-Bestaande.                       Dearbhafm san am seo mo neamheifeacht agus
> do Neart, mo bhochtaineacht agus do Shaibhreas.
> ENGLISH
> Nil Dia ar bith eile ann ach tu, an Cunt6ir i
> Seep. 496.                                        mBaol, an FeinChothaitheach.
> 538                                     THE BAHA 'i WORLD
> 
> GAELIC, SCOITISH                                      jelen pillanatban gyenges¢gemet es a Te
> Hatalmadat, szegenysegemet es a Te Gazdag-
> Tha mi toirt fianuis, 0 mo Thighearna, gun do
> sagodat. Rajtad kivi.il nines mas Isten csak Te,
> chruthaich Thu mi gu eolas a chur ort ag us gu
> a Yedelmea'i, az bnmagaban Letea'i .
> aoradh a dheanamh Dhuit. Tha mi ag
> aideachadh, aig an am seo, mo laigse fhln agus
> ICELANDIC
> Do chumhachdsa , mo a innis agus T'ionmhaissa.                                                 Eg ber pess vitni , 6 Guo minn , ao PU hefir
> Chan' eil Dia eile ann ach Thu , a r Com-           skapao mig til pess ao pekkja Pig og tilbioja
> hnuidh ri am gabhaidh, an Uile-bheo.                  Pig. Eg staOfesti a 1>essu augnabliki, vanmatt
> minn og matt Pinn, tatrekt mfna og auolego
> GERMAN                                                I:>lna.
> Enginn er Guo nem a Pu , Hjalpin f Nauoum ,
> lch bezeuge, o mein Gott: Du hast mich             hinn Eilifi.
> erschaffen, Dich zu erkennen und Dich
> anzubeten. Ich bezeuge in diesem Augenblick           INUIT (INUPIAQ): Greenlandic              dialect
> meine Ohnmacht und Deine Macht, meine                 (Denmark , Greenland)
> Armut und Deinen Reichtum.
> Upernarsauvunga,        Gutiga     a,    Ivdlit
> Es ist kein anderer Gott ausser Dir, dem
> pfngortfkangma        ilisariniasagavkit     pat!-
> Helfer in Gefahr, dem Selbstbestehenden.
> dorfiginiasagavkitdlo.
> Manakorpia~ navsuerpunga pigfnauniki-
> GERMAN: Alsatian dialect (France)
> ningnut ivdlitdlo pfssaunel'<arnernut, pltsuning-
> Isch bezel, o min Gott, dass di.i mish erschafft    nut ivdlitdlo pissujunernut.
> hash, disch ze erkenne un anzebette.                     Avdlamik Guti~angila~ Ivdlit kisivit,
> Isch bezel en dem Ai.iebleck mini Schwasche         navianartune ikiorte~ , tamanut sapiga~angit­
> un dini Macht, mini Armut un din Rischdum.            sok.
> Es get ken Gott i.isser der, dem Beschetzer.
> dem ewich selende .                                   ITALIAN
> lo faccio testimonianza , o mio Dio, che Tu
> GERMAN: Luxembourgian dialect (Luxem-                 mi hai creato per conoscer Ti e adorar Ti.
> bourg)                                                  Io attesto in questo momento la mia
> Esh bezeien , 0 mei' God, dass Du mech             debolezza e la Tua potenza , la mia poverta e la
> erschaffen heust Dech ze erkennen an Dech             Tua ricchezza.
> unzeibeden. Esh bezeien an dessem Ableck                Non v'e altro Dio all'infuori di Te , l' Aiuto
> meng Schwachhet an Deng Macht, meng                   nel pericolo, Colui che Esiste da Se.
> Armut an Dein Reichtom.
> Et get ken anere God ausser Dier, dem Hel-          IT A LIAN: Corsican dialect (Corsica, Italy)
> lefer a Gefohr, den <lurch sech selwer beste't.          So testimone, u me Diu , chi mi hai fattu per
> conocedi e per amarti Digu, da stu momentu a
> GREEK                                                 me debuleza e a to forza, a me poereza e a to
> MapTvpw , w 8ee µov , 6T1 µe 5riµ1ovpyT)aes y1c'x     richeza.
> vc'x LE avayvwpi~w xa vc'x LE AOTpEVW. ' Eml3e-         Un ce altro Diu chi tu, l'a uido in u periculu,
> 1301wvw OVTi'\V Ti'\V aTtyµfiv Ti'\V Cx0Vvaµiav µOV   quellu chi e per ellu stessu.
> µrrp6s aTfiv laxvv Iov, Tfiv rreviav µov µrrp6s
> aTOV TTAOUTO V LOV. t.Ev vrrapxe1 OAAOS 8e6s          ITALIAN: Piedmontese dialect (Northwe:·t-
> EXTOS CxTTO LEVO, TOV 1301')66 aTOV x ivovvov,        em Italy)
> Tov AvToavvT~OT)TO.
> Mi faso testimoniansa, o N6sgnor, che Ti 'T
> !'has creame per conoss Te e adore Te. Mi
> HUNGARIAN
> diciaro ant c6st moment mia deb6Iessa e T6a
> Oh Uram, oh Istenem! Tanusaga vagyok                p6tensa , mia p6verta e T6a richessa.
> annak, hogy Te teremtettel engem, hogy                   A j'e gnun au tr Signor che Ti, l' Agiut ant el
> megismerjelek es imadjalak. Beismerem a               perfcol , Col ch'a esist dasperchiel.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                           539
> 
> ITALIAN: Sardinian dialect (Sardinia, Italy )        ROMANSCH: Uppe r             Engadine      (Puter)
> dialect (Switzerland)
> Deo fatto distimonia , Deus meu , chi Tue mi
> has fattu omine/femina , pro Ti connoscher e            Eau fatsch testimoniaunza , o mieu Dieu , cha
> pro Ti adorare.                                      Tii am hest cre6 per At recugnuoscher e per At
> In custu momentu, deo attesto sa debilesa         adorer.
> mia e i-sa potenzia Tua, sa poberesa mia e i-sa         Eau attest in quaist momaint mia deblezza e
> ricchesa Tua.                                        Tia potenza , mia poverted e Tia richezza.
> Non b' hat atteru Deus a in foras de a Tie ,         I nu do iingiin Dieu oter co Te , quel chi giida
> Azudu in su pe rigulu, Cussu chi est solu dae Se.    nel prievel , quel chi exista in Se stess.
> 
> NORWEGIAN: Nynorsk (Landsmal)
> ROMANY
> Eg vitnar, o min Gud , at Du har skapa meg
> Penau, Devla , ke Tute sas ka kerdyan mate
> sa at eg kan kjenna Deg og tilbe Deg. Eg vitnar
> ~anau Tut,  hai te rudziv Tuke. Penau akana,
> i denne stund om mi maktesl¢yse og Din
> ke me siim slabo 'ai Tu san zoral6; ke me siim
> styrke , om min fattigdom og Din rikdom.
> cor6 'ai Tu san barwal6. Nai kaver Devel, feri
> Der er ingen annan Gud enn Deg, Hjelparen
> Tu hfnka; o afotim6s and'e prikaza. Tu kai
> i fare , den Evig Sj¢1vstaande.
> k6rkoro a:Zutis Tu, Ci trubul Tuke avren.
> 
> NORWEGIAN: Riksmal (Bokmal)
> ROMANY: Anglo-Romany dialect (Canada,
> Jeg bevitner, o min Gud, at Du har skapt
> United Kingdom, United States)
> meg for at jeg kan kjenne Deg og ti I be Deg . Jeg
> vitner i denne stund om min maktes1¢shet og             Mandy's acai te sikka as it 'uz Tooty as caired
> Din styrke , om min fattigdom og Din rikdom.         mandy te jin Tooty, ta te del cooshty borra Javs
> Der er ingen annen Gud enn Deg, Hjelpe-            to Tooty sasky Tooty's morra Divvel. Ocknaw
> ren i fare, den Selvbestaende.                       mandy's rokkarin trustel mandy's bee-roozlo
> ta Tooty's tacherly roozlo, ta mandy's chorro
> POLISH                                               and Tooty's barvallo. There's kakkava Divvel
> ner Tooty , morra haskipen canna mendy's dray
> Swiadcz~, 0 Panie, Boze m6j, tzes mnie            waffody cherras, Tooty con kakka corns
> stworzyl, ai:ebym znal Ci~ i wielbil. Swiadcz~ w     chommany te ge along.
> tej chwili mojej slabosci a Twojej mocy, memu
> ub6stwu a Twemu bogactwu . Nie ma Boga
> pr6cz Ciebie, Obroitcy, Samoistnego.                 ROMANY: Sinto dialect (Northern Italy)
> Me crava zaiga , o Mur Devel, che Tu kerdal
> PORTUGUESE                                           man Ti pingiarap tut unt camap tut. Me ginava
> in cava ziro miri schwacha unt tiri zor, miri
> Dou testemunho, 6 meu Deus, de que Tu me
> elenta unt tiri barvapen. Na hi vavro Devel har
> criaste para eu Te conhecer e adorar.
> Tu vri Tuter, holfa an u ferlocho, cova cai hi
> Confesso neste memento, minha incapapeske.
> cidade e Teu poder, minha pobreza e tua
> riqueza.
> Nao ha outro Deus alem de Ti , o amparo no
> RUSSIAN
> perigo, o que existe por sf pr6prio.
> 51 CB11)leTeJ1bCTBY10, o MOH Eo)l(e, 1no
> Tb1 c0Tsop11n MeH.H, 11To6b1 .H noJHaJJ
> ROMANIAN
> Te6.H 11 noKJJOH.HJJC.H Te6e. 51 no)lTBep-
> Stau marturie. 0 Stapane, pentru a Te              )l()lalO B :ny Ml1HYTY CBOe 6ecc11J111e 11
> cunoa§te §i a Te sllivi. Marturisesc In clipa        TsolO MOlllh, CBOIO cKy)lHOCTb 11 Tsoe
> aceasta sllibiciunea mea §i Puterea Ta, saracia      0611n11e.
> mea §i Imbel§ugarea Ta. Nu e alt Dumnezeu               HeT Eora, KpoMe Te6.H, noM01UH11Ka B
> decat Tine, Cel Ocrotitor, Ce! de Sine Stlitator!    onacHoCT11, Tsop11TeJ1.H caMocy1Uero.
> 540                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> SAME (LAPP): LULESAMISKA (LULE                         SLOVENE (Austria , Hungary, Italy, Yugo-
> LAPP) (Swedish Arctic)                                 slavia)
> Man vattau vihtenastemau, Jupmelam , tan               Priznavam , o moj Bog, da si me ustvaril , da
> pirra, aht Tan !ah sjiunjetam mu , vai man             Te spoznavam in molim. Prinznavam v tern
> taptau Tu ja rahkatalau Tunji . Man taptasta u         trenutku svojo ~ibkost in Tvojo moc, svojo
> talle ietjam famotisvuotau ja Tu famov, mu             rev~cino in Tvoje bogastvo.
> hadjovuotau ja Tu pantavuotau.                            Ni Boga razen Tebe, Za~Citnika, Vecnobiva-
> I Jah ietja Jupmel ka Tan, viehkke vata aiken       jocega .
> kuhti !ah ietjanat.
> SPANISH
> Soy testigo , oh mi Dios, de que Tu me has
> SAME (LAPP) : NORDSAMISKA (NORTH-
> creado para conocerte y adorarte. Atestiguo en
> ERN LAPP) (Scandinavian Arctic)
> este momenta mi impotencia y Tu poder, mi
> Man addan duoaastusa , Ibmilan , dan ala,           pobreza y Tu riqueza.
> atte Dan lret siv'dnidan mu , vai man davdan Du          No hay otro Dios masque Tu , el Que Ayuda
> ja gabmirdan Du. Man duoaa ~ tan dal iecca n           en el Peligro , el Que Subsiste por Sf Mismo.
> haeddjovuoaa ja Du fa.mo, iecean gefudaga ja
> SWEDISH
> Du rig'gudaga .
> Ii lret ieza Ibmil ga Dan , vrek'ki hrec!i aigis,      Jag bar vittnesbord om, 0, min Gud, att Du
> gutte lret ie~-aldad.                                  har skapat mig for att Jara kiinna Dig och for att
> tillbedja Dig. Jag betygar i detta ogonblick min
> SAME (LAPP): SYDSAMISKA (SOUTH-                        svaghet och Din styrka, min fattigdom och Din
> ERN LAPP) (Norway, Sweden)                             rikedom.
> Det finnes ingen annan Gud utom Du, Hjal-
> Manne vitt'enusteb, 0 muv Jubmeele, dan             pen i farans stund, den i sig sjalv Varande.
> bijre, atte Dadne manneb leah ~ ugniedamme,
> juktie manne dabdeb Dadneb jih rukkedalleb             UKRAINIAN
> Dadneb. Manne dabdesteb dalie jez'ene vie-                51 e csiL1.KOM , o Mii1 oo)l(e, lUO T11 MeHe
> siesvuodeb jih Duv famoub, jez'ene giehvies-           cornop1rn Ha Te, lU06 H ni3Has(na) Te6e
> vuodeb jih Duv boadnaavuodeb.                          i noKJJaHHBCH(nach) To6i. 51 csiLl.'IY B uiil:
> Ij leah jeazah Jubmeele guh Dadne, gutt'e            XBMJJMHi npo MOIO cna6iCTh i TBOIO CMJJy,
> leah viekkie varan ajgien, gutt'e leah jez'esis-       npo MOIO s6oricTh i Tsoe 6araTCTBO.
> nie arruomienie.                                          HeMa iHiuoro I>ora, n11we T11, TioMi-
> 'IHHK B Helilacno, CaMo6yTHHi1.
> SLOVAK (Hungary, Slovakia, Yugoslavia)                 WELSH (CYMRAEG)
> SvedCim 6 moj Bo:le: Tyvsi ma stvoril, aby som            Tystiaf, 0 fy Nuw, mai Ti a'm creaist i'th
> Ta spoznal(a) a Teba vzyval(a) . V tomto               adnabod ac i' th addoli. Tystiaf, y funud hon ,
> okamihu dosvedeujem svoju bezmocnosf a                 i'm gwendid fy hun ac i'th nerth Dithau, i' m
> Tvoju moc, svoju chudobu a Tvoje bohatstvo.            tlodi i ac i'th gyfoeth Di. Nid oes Dduw arall
> Niet ziadneho Boha okrem Teba, Pomaha-               ond Tydi, y Cynorthwywr mewn Perygl , yr
> juceho v nebezpecenstve, Samobytneho.                  Hunanfodolwr.
> 
> F. INVENTED LANGUAGES
> 
> ESPERANTO                                              INTERLINGUA
> Mi atestas, ho Sinjoro, mia Dio , ke Vi kreis           Io testimonia, o mie Deo, que tu me ha cremin, por ke mi konu kaj adorn Vin. Mi atestas          ate, pro Te cognoscer e adorar. Io testimonia
> Cimomente pri mia senforteco kaj pri Via               in iste instante a mie debilitate ea Tie potentia,
> Potenco, pri mia malriceco kaj pri Via Riceco.         a mie paupertate e a Tie ricchessa. No existe
> Ne ekzistas alia Dio krom Vi, la Defendanto, la        altere Deo salvo Tu, le adjutor en perfculo, le
> Mem-Ekzistanto.                                        in se mesmoexistente.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY             541
> 
> ..,
> ., ...    -. . ... ... ......   ~
> 
> .
> ... .. ........
> 
> Facsimile of the Short Obligatory Prayer in Braille (English), Grade II, courtesy of
> Ba ha'{ Service for the Blind, a committee of the National Spiritual Assembly of the
> Baha'fs of the United States.
> 
> Baha'i literature display sponsored by the Bahe/( Publishing Trust of Taiwan during a
> nation-wide book exhibition held from 17 December 1977 to 8 January 1978 at International
> House in Taipei.
> 542                                     THE BAHA ' i WORLD
> 
> 8. MAJOR WORKS AND PARTIAL LIST OF
> LANGUAGES IN WHICH THEY ARE AVAILABLE
> 
> Ric;lvan 1979
> 1 - Arabic         3 - French         5 - Persian       7 - Spanish
> 2 - English        4- German          6 - Portuguese
> 
> A. WORKS OF BAHA'U'LLAH
> Epistle to the Son of the Wolf: 2, 3, 4, 5, 7         Prayers and Meditations by Baha'u'Llah (Com-
> Gleanings from the Writings of Bahd'u'llah              pilation): 1, 2, 4, 5
> (Compilation): 2, 3, 4, 6, 7                        The Proclamation of Baha'u'llah (Compila-
> The Hidden Words: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7                   tion): 2, 3, 4, 6, 7
> Kitab-i-lqan (The Book of Certitude): 1, 2, 3,        The Seven Valleys a nd The Four Valleys: 2, 3,
> 4,5,6, 7                                              4,5, 7
> 
> B. WORKS OF THE BAB
> Selections from the Writings of the Bab: 2, 6
> 
> C. WORKS OF' ABDU'L-BAHA
> Foundations of World Unity : 2, 7                     Tablets of the Divine Plan: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 7
> Paris Talks: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7                      The Talks of 'Abdu'l-Bahd in America and
> The Secret of Divine Civilization: 2, 3, 4, 5           Europe, vols. I, II: 1, 5
> Some Answered Questions: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7          A Traveller's Narrative: 1, 2, 5
> Tablet to th e Central Organization for a Dur-        Will and Testament: 1, 2, 3, 4 , 5, 6, 7
> able Peace, The Hague : 1, 2, 4, 5                  Memorials of the Faithful: 2, 5
> 
> D. WORKS COMPILED FROM THE WRITINGS OF BAHA'U'LLAH,
> THE BAB AND' ABDU'L-BAHA
> Baha'[ Prayers: 1, 2 , 3, 4 , 5, 6, 7                 A New Way of Life (What it means to be a
> The Baha'i Revelation: 2, 6                             Bahd'f Youth): 2, 6
> Baha'i World Faith: 2, 3                              The Pattern of Baha'( Life: 2, 3, 4, 6
> The Divine Art of Living: 2, 3, 4, 7                  The Reality of Man: 2, 7
> 
> E. WORKS OF SHOGHI EFFENDI
> The Advent of Divine Justice: 2, 3, 4, 6, 7           God Passes By: 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7
> The Dispensation of Baha'u'llah: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 , 6,   The Promised Day is Come: 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7
> 
> Some Compilations from his Writings
> Baha'i Holy Places at the World Centre: 2, 5          The World Order of Baha'u'llah: 2, 4
> Principles of Baha'i Administration: (U .K.): 2,
> 3,4,6, 7
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                    543
> 
> 9 . A SELECTION OF INTRODUCTORY AND
> EXPOSITORY WORKS AND PARTIAL LIST OF
> LANGUAGES IN WHICH THEY ARE AVAILABLE
> Ri<;lvan 1979
> 
> 1 - Arabic       3 - French         5 - Persian        7 - Spanish
> 2 - English      4- German          6 - Portuguese
> 
> A.GENERAL
> BAL YUZI , H. M.                                     HOFMAN, DA YID
> Bahd'u'lltih: 2, 6                                   Commentary on the Will and Testament of
> Bahti'u'lltih : The King of Glory : 2                  'Abdu'l-Baha: 2
> Th e Bab : 2                                         The Renewal of Civilization: 2, 3, 6, 7
> 'Abdu'l-Bahd: 2                                    HOLLEY, HORACE
> Mu/:iammad and the Course of lsltim: 2               Religion for Mankind: 2
> Edward Granville Browne and the Baha'i             HUDDLESTON , JOHN
> Faith: 2                                           The Earth is But One Country : 2
> BLOMFIELD , LADY                                     IVES, HOWARD COLBY
> The Chosen High way : 2                              Portals to Freedom: 2, 3, 4, 5, 7
> BRAUN , EUNICE                                       MARTINEZ, EMILIO EGEA
> From Strength to Strength: 2, 3, 7                    La Gran Promesa: 7
> BROWN , RAMONA ALLEN                                 MAXWELL, MAY
> Mem ories of'Abdu 'l-Bahd: 2                         An Early Pilgrimage: 2, 7
> BRUGIROUX, ANDRE                                     MEHRABKHANI , R.
> La terre n'est qu'un seul pays : 3                   Transcendencia del Kitab -i-fqan: 7
> COBB, STANWOOD                                         La Aurora de! Dia Prometido: 7
> Security for a Failing World: 2, 3, 5, 6             Naches Navidenas: 7
> COY, GENEVI E VE                                     MIGETIE , LUCIENNE
> Co unsels of Perfection: 2                           Le Cycle de !' Unite : 3
> ESSLEMONT, J.E.                                      MOFFETI, RUTH
> Bahd'u'llah and the New Era: 1, 2 , 3, 4 , 5, 6,    New Keys to the Book of Revelation: 2
> 7                                                NAKHJA V ANl, BAHIYYIH
> FAQL, MIRZA ABU'L                                      When We Grow Up: 2
> Baht'i 'i Proofs : 1, 2                            NAKHJA V ANi, YIOLETIE
> FA IZ I, GLORI A                                       Amatu'l-Bahti Visits India: 2
> Th e Bahti'f Faith: 2 , 4 , 7                      PAVON, RAUL
> Fire on th e Mountain Top: 2                         La Voz de Dias: 7
> FATHEAZAM, HUSHMAND                                  RABBANf, RUJ:!IYYIH
> The New Garden: 2, 3, 6 , 7                          The Good Message: 2
> FERRABY , JOHN                                         Prescription for Living: 2, 4, 6, 7
> All Thin gs Made N ew (rev . ed.): 2                 The Priceless Pearl: 2, 3, 5, 7
> FOZDAR, JAMSHED                                      ROST, H. T. D.
> Buddha Maitrya -Amitabha Has Appeared: 2             The Brilliant Stars: 2
> GAIL, MARZI E H                                      SABET, HUSCHMAND
> Dawn Over Mt. Hira, and other essays: 2              Der Gespaltene Himmel: 2, 4 , 7
> The Sheltering Branch: 2                           SCHAEFER, UDO
> GIACHERY, UGO                                          Der Baha'i in der modernen Welt: 4
> Shoghi Effendi-Recollections : 2                     The Light Shineth in Darkness: 2
> GROSSMANN , HERMANN                                  SEARS, WILLIAM
> Der Baha'i und die Baha'i-Gemeinschaft: 4            Release the Sun: 2, 6
> 544                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Thief in the Night: 2, 3, 4, 6, 7                  The Mission of Bahd'u'lldh and Other Liter-
> The Wine of Astonishment: 2, 3                       ary Pieces: 2, 7
> The Flame: 2                                       The Promise of All Ages: l, 2, 3
> (with Robert Quigley)                              WARD, ALLAN L.
> The Prisoner and the Kings: 2                     239 Days: 2
> SHOOK, GLENN                                       WHITE, ROGER
> Mysticism, Science and Revelation: 2               Another Song, Another Season: 2
> TAHERZADETH, ADIB                                  WHITEHEAD, 0. Z.
> The Revelation of Bahd'u'lldh, vol. I: 2; Vol.     Some Early Bahd'fs of the West: 2
> II: 2                                          WOOLSON, GAYLE
> TOWNSHEND, GEORGE                                   Divina Sinfonia: 2, 7
> Christ and Bahd'u'lldh: 2, 3, 4, 6, 7              Rumbo Hacia el Futuro: 7
> The Glad Tidings of Bahd'u'llah: (A compi-       ZARANDf, NABfL-I-
> lation of Baha'i Writings with notes and         The Dawn-Breakers (Translated by Shoghi
> introduction by George Townshend): 2               Effendi): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 7
> The Heart of the Gospel: 2, 3
> (Note: Baha'i Publishing Trusts and National Spiritual Assemblies throughout the world constantly issue pamphlets and leaflets on various aspects of the Teachings.)
> 
> B. FOR CHILDREN
> CHRISTIAN, ROBERTA K.                              MEYER, ZOE
> A Bahd'( Child's ABC: 2, 3, 4                       Stories from 'The Dawn-Breakers': l , 2, 3, 4,
> HOFMAN, DA YID                                         7
> God and His Messengers: 2, 3, 4, 7               REED, BETTY
> LEE, ANTHONY A.                                      Stories of Bahd'u'lldh as told by Pokka: 2
> The Black Rose: 2                                TRUE, MARGUERITE
> The Cornerstone: 2                                 Living Today for Tomorrow's World: 2, 3
> The Proud Helper: 2                                Bahd'( Prayers for Children (Compilation):
> The Unfriendly Governor: 2                           2, 4, 6, 7
> LINDSTROM, JANET                                   WALCOTT, CYNTHIA K.
> The Kingdoms of God: 2, 3, 4                       The Gift: 2, 7
> MEHRABI, JACQUELINE                                Compilation: 0 God Guide Me (Prayers): 2, 7
> Stories for Children: 2, 3                        Let Thy Breeze Refresh Them: Prayers and
> Nine Holy Days: 2                                     Tablets for Children: 2
> Prayers and Tablets for Children: 2, 4
> 
> C. PERIODICALS
> Bahti'( Studies: Monograph Series: 2               World Citizen (Youth Magazine):
> Published by the Canadian Association for         Published by the National Baha'i Youth
> Studies on the Baha'i Faith.                      Committee of the United States.
> Editorial Office: 224 Fourth Ave.,                Editorial Office: 10110 Margate Drive
> Ottawa, Ontario KlS 2L8,                          Houston, Texas 77099
> Canada.                                           U.S .A.
> 
> Opinioni Baha'(: Italian                           Child's Way: 2
> Published by the National Spiritual Assem-         Published by the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of Italy.                        bly of the Baha'is of the United States.
> Editorial Office: c/o Centro Baha'i                Editorial Office: 6446 Ridge Lake Rd.
> Via A Stoppani, 10                                 Hixson, Tn.37343
> 00197 Roma                                         U.S.A.
> Italia
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                      545
> Glory (Youth Magazine)                           La Pensee Bahd'fe : 3
> Published by the National Baha'f Youth           Published by the National Spiritual Assem-
> Committee of India .                             bly of the Baha'fs of Switzerland.
> Editorial Office: P.O . Box 19,                  Editorial Office: P.O . Box 175
> Panchgani412805 ,                                1260 Nyon , Switzerland
> Maharashtra, India.
> 
> World Order Magazine: 2
> Published by the National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'fs of the United States.
> Editorial Office: 2011 Yale Station
> New Haven, Connecticut
> 06520, U. S. A
> (Note : There are , in addition, numbers of domestic organs, issued by National Spiritual Assemblies or their Committees, for use by the Baha'f communities.)
> 
> D . INTERNATIONAL RECORD
> 
> Th e Bahd'f World, vols. I-XVII (1925 - 1979): 2
> 
> Some current Baha'[ periodicals. Clockwise, from bottom: Puthia Oli (Malaysia, in Tamil);
> Baha'f Family Life (Ne w Zealand); Baha'f Vizier (Netherlands, in Dutch); Opinioni Bah:l.'f
> (Italy, in Italian); Child's Way (United States); World Order (United States); Glory, Baha'i
> Youth Magazine (India); La Pensee Baha'ie (Switzerland, in French).
> 546                                              THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 10. T H E PUBL ICATI O N AND DISSEMINATION OF
> B A H A'I LITERATURE IN ENGLISH
> W I LLIAM P. COLLINS
> 
> I testify tha t no sooner had the First Word proceeded, through the potency of Thy will and
> purpose, out of His mouth ... than the whole creation was revolutionized, and all that are
> in the heavens and all that are on earth were stirred to the depths. Through that Word the
> rea lities of all created things were shaken, were divided, separated, scattered, combined
> and reunited, disclosing in both the contingent world and th e heavenly kingdom, entities
> of a new creation . ... '
> 
> THE desce nt of the e te rn al Wo rd of God, the                  ity to respo nd. Th is blessed Word, through
> Logos, and its ex pression in a pe rfect Being                    which 'the whole creation was revolutionized',
> and a Revela tio n, a re t he centra l facts of each              must by its very nature exercise a transforming
> of the di vin ely-appo inted re ligious D ispensa-                power over all mankind, ind ividua ll y and coltions . Moses and the Tora h, Krishna and the                     lectively. It is to th is goa l of bringing the heal-
> Gita, Zoroaste r and the Avesta, Jes us and the                   ing Message of Baha' u'll ah and the fruits of
> Gospels, M u~ a mm a d and the Q ur'a n- these                    spiritual progress to every sou l on the planet
> are the dual mani fes ta tio ns of God's time less                that Ba ha'i pub li cation is dedicated .
> Uttera nce, inexorably wedded and intertwin ed. O ne is the livin g Mo uthpiece of the
> I. Early Baha'i literature in England and
> divine will ; the othe r, a perspicuo us Book, a
> America.
> witn ess to all natio ns that God speaks and will
> not be silent. In our own time, the Creator has                        A ltho ugh there existed hand-copied ma nuvo uchsafed to the wo rld a fres h measure of His                 scripts in the original Persian and Arabic, and
> inexhaustible Word th ro ugh the Twi n Messen-                    isolated publications in those languages were
> gers for this era of human history- the Bab                       made in I ndia du ring the late nineteenth cenand Baha' u'llah, a nd th ro ugh the Scriptures                   tury, the earliest estab lished agencies for the
> revealed by T heir untiring pe ns.                                officia l dissem ination of Baha'i literature were
> In conjunction with the manifes tation of the                  located in the West.
> Logos in the towering Figures of the Bab and                           During the final decade of the nineteenth
> Baha' u' ll ah and in T heir inco mparab le Writ-                 century, Edward Granville Browne, the British
> ings, God has willed that His holy Speech be                      orienta list, published translatio ns of two early
> protect.ed, preserved and interpreted . T he                      Babi-Baha'i works- ' Abdu'l-Baha'sA Travelstro ng and bi ndin g Covena nt ordained by                       ler's Narrative Wrillen lo Illustrate the Episode
> Baha' u'llah established 'A bdu'l-Baha as t he                    ofthe Bab (Cambridge University Press, 1891)
> Interpreter a nd Perfect Exe mplar of Baha'i                      and Mirza I:Iusayn of Hamadan 's Tarfkh-i-
> Teachings. 'Abdu' l- Baha was fo ll owed by                       Jadfd (1893).
> Shoghi Effe ndi , G uardia n of the Cause of God .                     Dr. Ibrahi m Khay ru ' ll ah, a Syrian convert to
> T he continued expressio n of that part of God's                   the Baha'i Faith, who settled in America in
> good-pleasure no t expressly recorded in the                       1892, was the first Baha'i to reach its shores
> Baha'i Ho ly Texts is assured by Ba ha' u' llah's                  and begin a systematic teach ing of the precepts
> pen th ro ugh the powers gra nted to the Univer-                   of the Faith. The first pub lication in the United
> sa l Ho use of Justice to legislate upo n all mat-                 States attempti ng to expound Baha'i principles
> te rs no t dea lt with in those Texts.                             was Khay ru 'll ah's Za -ti-et A l-Lah: the Identity
> T he Baha'i religion has been fo un ded upon                    and Personality of God (Ch icago: Grant's Prinnea rl y for ty-six yea rs of divine Revelation and                tery, 1896) , later en larged into a book entitled
> sixty-five years of a uthe ntic interpretation of                  Bab-ed-din: the Door of True Religion . ..
> the God- given message. T he Will of God for                       Revelation from the East (Chicago: Charles H.
> this age has been sta ted ; it is th e t_urn of hum a n-           Kerr & Co., 1897). A ltho ugh of interest as the
> ' Baha' u' lla h. Prayers and Medita tions by Baha'u'l/ah {Wilfi rst books by a Baha'i in English,
> mette: Baha'i Publishing Trusts, 1969), p. 295.                  Khayru' llah's works were by i:_io means an
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                            547
> 
> authoritative statement of Baha'f beliefs. It                   Most pilgrims' notes record statements and
> was rather through the prayers and Tablets                   talks by 'Abdu'l-Baha. Such records of the
> received from 'Abdu'l-Baha that the early                    Master's conversations, tho ugh ed ifying to the
> Western believers received their deepest edu-                believers in that early period of the Faith's
> cation in the verities of the Baha'f Cause.                  development in the West, do not constitute
> These few early believers excha nged type-                   a!1thentic or exact reports of His words. A
> written copies of communications received                    major exception to this, however, is Some
> from ' Abdu'l-Baha, treasuring each new mes-                 Answered Questions, a book unique in the hissage as a special gift from their beloved Master .           tory of religions. It is a compilation of the
> By 1900-1901 two major centres of Baha' i                 responses given by 'Abdu' l-Baha to certain
> publishing         emerged      in    the    United          questions posed by Laura Clifford Barney dur-
> States-New York and Chicago. The 'Bahai                      ing 1904-1906. The Master's replies were
> Board of Counse l' in New York , and the                     recorded in Persian with the assista nce of His
> ' Bahais Supply and Publishing Board' (later                 secretaries, and were later reviewed, corrected
> the Baha'i Publishing Society') in Chicago                   and approved by Him. Some Answered Quesbecame the first ofAcia l age ncies for the publi-           tions was translated by La ura Barney and pubcation and dissemination of literature about                 lished in London in 1908. The answers to Miss
> the new Revelation. The fou nding of these two               Barney's questions, given by' Abd u'l-Baha in
> publishin g ventures , as well as support from                His 'tired moments', contain a wealth of insight
> individu al Baha'fs and commercial publishers                into the nature of God, the Manifestations and
> in E ngla nd, made it possible for English-                  man; the powers of soul, mind and spirit; and
> speaking Baha'fs to receive a greater measure                various Christian doctrines.
> of Baha'u ' ll ah's inspired Works. Within less                  In 1911-1912 the Master undertook His
> than a decade, severa l basic Baha ' i Texts were            epic missionary tour of Europe and America.
> ava il ab le , includin g the Suratu 'l-Hay ka/, The          During that journey He gave dozens of talks in
> Hidden Words of Bahd'u'llah, Tablets of                      churches, univers1t1es a nd philosophical
> Baha'u'llah , and the Kitab-i-Jqan.                          societies. Three major antho logies of His
> addresses appeared in the 1920s-The Wisdom of 'Abdu'l-Baha (now known as Paris
> 2. Talks and Writings of'Abdu'l-Bahti, Pilgrim
> Talks), 'Abdu 'l-Bah6 in London, and The
> Reports
> Promulgation of Universal Peace. These reveal
> The first contingent of Western Baha'f pil-                 the facility and power with which He spoke on
> grims to visit' Abdu'l-B aha arrived in' Akka in              a wide range of topics.
> 1898 . From that time until the Ascension of                     During the course of World War I,
> 'Abdu' l-Baha in 1921, a steady stream of pil-                'Abdu'l-B aha revealed a series of letters to the
> grims from the Occident attained His presence,                American Baha'i community. These Tablets of
> some of whom later shared the experiences and                the Divine Plan are the charter for the worldimpressions of the Master in published                       wide spread of the Baha'i Faith under the
> accounts. Among the most significant and mov-                 mandate give n to the Baha'is of North
> ing is May Maxwell's An Early Pilgrimage                      America. The international teaching plans
> (Chicago: Bahai Publishing Society, 1917) 1                   launched under the aegis of the Guardian and
> which recounts the spirit of the original party ot            the Universal House of Justice all derive their
> Western believers to reach the spiritua l centre              inspiration from the guidance given by
> of their Faith. T hornton Chase 's In Galilee                 'Abdu'l-B aha in these Tab lets.
> (1908), Helen S. Goodall and Ella G. Cooper's                    As mentioned earlier, the Western Baha'fs
> Daily Lessons Received at 'Akka (1908), Julia                 received their best knowledge of the Faith dur-
> M. Grundy's Ten Days in the Light of 'Akka                    ing the early twentieth century through letters
> (1910), and Lady Blomfield's The Chosen                       from 'Abdu'l-Baha. A large number of such
> Highway (1940) also provided the early Baha'is                letters to Spiritua l Assemblies and individual
> with insight into the life of' Abdu'l-Baha .                  believers was brought together and published
> in three volumes known as Tablets of Abdul
> ' George Ronald, revised edition 1953; reprinted 1969 with
> Baha Abbas (Chicago: Bahai Publishing Socinew Foreword.                                               ety, 1909-1916).
> 548                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> The Mysterious Forces of Civilization,             vision of that Golden Age of the Baha'i Reve-
> 'Abdu'l-Baha's appeal for the spiritual trans-        lation destined to emerge from its chrysalis in
> formation of Persia's people and government,          the fullne ss of time. The Advent of Divine Juswas first published in 1918 in a translation by       tice (1939) a nd The Promised Day Is Come
> Yuhanna Dawud . In 1957 this remarkable               (1941) define the spiritual prerequisites for the
> treatise on true civilization was republished in       American Baha'i community in the prosecua translation by Marzieh Gail en titled Th e Se-      tion of its tasks, and describe the sign ifi cance of
> cret of Divine Civilization. Marzieh Gail , a dis-    world-wide cataclysms and wars for the buildtinguished and erudite Baha'i, and an accom-          ing up of the new World Order proclaimed by
> plished poet, essayist and translator, also sup-      Baha'u'llah. Other compilations of the Guardplied the Baha'ls with a touching rend ition into     ian 's letters have been made under the titles .
> English of 'Abdu'l-B aha's Memorials of the           of Messages to America 1932-1946, Citadel of
> Faithful (Wilmette: Baha'i Publishing Trust,          Faith, Messages to the Baha'i World, Messages
> 1971). It is a compendi um of 'Abd u'l-B aha's        to Canada, Messages to Australia and New Zeamemories of more than seventy of the early            land, an dHigh Endeavors: MessagestoAlaska. 1
> believers.                                                In add ition to Shoghi Effendi's analysis of
> The Will and Testament of 'Abdu'l-Baha is           the world situation, his contributions to Baha'i
> the crowning touch to His many years of gui d-         historical scho larship are astounding. The only
> ance to t he Baha'i world. Though a short             actual book the Guardian wrote was God Pasdocument , Shoghi Effendi describes the Will as       ses By, the history of the first century of the
> 'supplementary' to the Kitab-i-Aqdas, and 'the        Faith . It is such a distillatio n of Baha'i hi s-
> Charter of a future world civi lization'. In it,       tory-both fact ual and interpretative-that
> 'Abdu' l-B aha establishes the G uardianship,          hundreds of other historical works may be
> the Hands of the Cause of God, the National or         inspired by it in the future. Furthermore,
> Secondary House of Justice , the principles of         Shoghi Effendi edited , translated, and sup-
> Baha'i administration, and defines the method          plemented the first part of Nabfl's narrative
> of election of the Universal House of Justice.         The Dawn-Breakers, one of the most important and meticulously-recorded sources on the
> time of the Bab.
> 3. Writings and Translations of Shoghi Effendi
> Shoghi Effendi's major contribution to Baha'i
> Shoghi Effendi, the Guardian of the Baha'i          literature, and the greatest testimony to his
> Faith from 1921 to 1957, was a master of the           brilliant knowledge of Arabic, Persian and
> English language , with which he sought to             English, are his unequalled renditions of
> interpret for the West, in luminous prose, the         Baha' u'llah's Writings into English. Between
> basic truths a nd social programme of the Baht.'i      his accession to the Guardianship in 1921 and
> movement. In a succession of cogent letters,           the beginning of World War II Shoghi Effendi
> Shoghi Effendi expanded the vision of the              translated The Hidden Words of Bahci'u'llah,
> believers and clearly defined for them the             The Kitab-i-Iqan, and The Epistle to the Son of
> nature of their weighty responsibilities under         the Wolf, and compiled Gleanings from the
> 'Abdu' l-B aha's divine pla n.                         Wri tings of Baha'u'llah and Prayers and Medi-
> Shoghi Effendi's early letters to the western       tations by Bahci'u'llah. The translations of
> Baha'ls awakened them to the newly-emerging            Shoghi Effendi are not only models of beauty,
> administrative institutions of the Faith. In            but also provide a standard with which subse-
> 1928, a collection of the Guardian's letters was       quent translations of Baha'i Scriptures in Engpublished in the United States under the title         lish can be compared.
> Baha'i Administration. The series of letters
> penned by the Guardian between 1929 and               4. Introductory Texts
> 1936, published separately, and then collectively under the title of The World Order of            A number of Baha'i authors have given a
> Baha'u' llcih , provide a treatise on the processes   systematic exposition of the history and funshaping the Baha'i community, a mandate for           ' At time of writing the National Spiritual Assembly of the
> United Kingdom has in preparati on a compilation entitled
> the role of the American believers in raising           The Unfolding Destiny of the British Baha'f Community. A
> Baha'u'llah's World Commonwealth, and a                 full list of compilations appears on page 488.
> BAHA ' f BIBLIOGRAPHY                                           549
> damental precepts of the Baha'i Revelation.
> 5. Children 's Literature
> The most outstanding example is John E.
> Esslemont in his Bahli'u'llah and the New Era ,                    In the Five Year Plan , specific goals were set
> first published in 1923 in Great Bntain. This                   for activities relating to children. Several of the
> book had, by 1944, been published in thirty-                    earliest attempts to produce quality Baha'i
> seven languages, and is now available in dozens                 children's books were made in the 1950s and
> more in its fourth revised edition. Its enduring                1960s: Janet Lindstrom's The Kingdoms of
> value as the major introductory Baha'i text-                    God, David Hofman's God and His Messen -
> book and its place in the vanguard of Baha'i                    gers and Zoe Meyer's Stories from the Dawnliterature, is attested by Shoghi Effendi in his                Breakers deal with the realms of existence ,
> message at the time of Esslemont's death: 'His                  progressive revelation, and Babl saints and
> book, however-an abiding monument to his                        martyrs. Children's p~ayer books have been
> pure intention-will , alone, inspire genera-                    published to introduce young Baha'ls to the
> tions yet unborn to tread the path of truth and                 Sacred Texts of their Faith; colouring books,
> service as steadfastly and unostentatiously as                  puzzles and games have been developed; and
> was trodden by its beloved author.' 1                           several books, including the very successful
> The foremost expounder of Baha'u'llah's                      The Gift by Cynthia Walcott, have been pubteachings to the Christian world was George                     lished along with cassette narration of the
> Townshend, sometime Canon of St. Patrick's                      stories.
> Cathedral Dublin, and Archdeacon of Clonfert. His introduction to God Passes By, and his
> 6. Scholarly Works, Biographies, Translations
> three volumes-The Promise of All Ages, The
> Heart of the Gospel, and Christ and Bahli'u'-                      From the time of the appearance of tvfirza
> llah-are an abiding witness to the power                        Abu'l-Fac.fl's Hujaju'l-Beheyyeh: The Behai
> of the eternal Word , as revealed in Baha'u'llah,               Proofs in 1902, until recently, scholarly Baha'i
> to seize upon the heart of this ecclesiastical                  books have appeared at irregular intervals. In
> figure and enable him to use his extraordinary                  the current decade , however, the results of
> powers of expression in the advancement of                      much fine scholarly research have been pub-
> God's Cause.                                                    lished. The British publisher, George Ronald,
> Since its appearance in 1957 John Ferraby's                  has been a major source of this type of work.
> All Things Made New has established itself as                   Particularly noteworthy has been the prodigianother classic of Baha'i expository writing.                   ous output of H. M. Balyuzi, whose Edward
> Unlike Baha'u'llah and the New Era, this work                   Granville Browne and the Bahli'( Faith (1970)
> gives a lengthier and more comprehensive pic-                   and Muf:iammad and the Course of Islam
> ture of the history of the Faith and its Adminis-               (1976) have provided a wealth of historical
> trative Order, while preserving a universal and                 material and analysis on topics of Baha'i intertimeless appeal. A revised edition with                         est. Mr. Balyuzi is currently working on the
> updated information was published by the                        final parts of his trilogy on the Central Figures
> Baha'i Publishing Trust of the United King-                     of the Baha'i Faith. His The Bab: The Herald of
> dom in 1975.                                                    the Day of Days and 'Abdu'l-Bahli: the Centre
> Those who, for various reasons , may find the                of the Covenant of Bahli'u'llah have already
> aforementioned introductory texts too difficult                 appeared, and in a short time his final work on
> or lengthy to read, have three other works on                   the life of Baha'u'llah is expected to be comthe Baha'i teachings which they may consult.                    pleted.
> Rul:ilyyih Rabbani's Prescription for Living,                      Rul:ifyyih Rabbani's The Priceless Pearl
> Hushmand Fathea'zam's The New Garden and                        (London: Baha'i Publishing Trust, 1969) and
> Gloria Faizi's The BahO.'( Faith: an Introduc-                  Ugo Giachery's Shoghi Effendi: Recollections
> tion are relatively short and simplified accounts               (Oxford: George Ronald, 1973) have afforded
> of the Baha'i teachings and have been trans-                    the English-speaking Baha'ls the first coherent
> lated into many languages.                                      tableau of their Guardian and the many aspects
> of his dynamic personality.
> Shoghi Effendi. Baha'f Administration. (Wilmette : Baha'i      Adib Taherzadeh, a member of the Conti-
> Publishing Trusts, 1968), p. 97.                            nental Board of Counsellors for Europe, has ·
> 550                                           THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> emba rked on a four-volume survey of the Writ-                for the Christian church. The Light Shineth In
> ings of Baha'u' llah and so me of the events                  Darkness is a collection of essays by Udo
> associated with their revelation. Two volumes                 Schaefer on the Baha'f Faith and Islam , and on
> of The Revelation of Bahd 'u'llah appeared in                 refutations of orthodox Christian criticisms of
> 1974 and 1977, covering the Baghdad and                       the Baha'f Faith.
> Adrianople periods respectively, and unveiling
> to the Western believers a glimmer of the scope
> 7. Periodicals
> and magnitude of Baha'u'llah 's abundant outpouring of divine Utterance.                                     The first Baha'f magazine in English was Star
> One of the goals of the Five Year Plan was to              of the West, 2 issued in Chicago from 1910
> 'cultivate opportunities for courses on the                   through 1935. In its presentation of first-hand
> Faith in Canadian institutions of higher learn-               reports abo ut people and events connected
> ing' . This goal led to the establishment of the              with the early development of the Faith, it is an
> Canadian Association for Studies on the Bah-                  unparallel ed source of historical information .
> a'i Faith, I which has produced three issues of               Of special importance was its publication of
> its journal Baha'[ Studies , and is engaged in the            Tablets from' Abdu'l-Baha and its coverage of
> preparation of French and English editions of a               'Abdu'l-Baha's trip to Europe and America.
> textbook on the Baha'f Faith to be used in                    The first fourteen years of this periodical were
> comparative religion courses throughout                       reprinted in 1978 by George Ronald publisher.
> Canada .                                                      In Australia , Herald of the South published
> Jamshed Fozdar has been the Baha'i Faith's                 news of Australasia's Baha'is between 1926
> foremost scholar on Buddhism. After finishing                 and 1960, and in a new series in 1965-1970
> a book on the concept of God in Buddhism                      and 1974-1975. World Order magazine , the
> (TheGodofBuddha. New York: Asia Publish-                      successor to Star of the West, was published in
> ing House, 1973), he embarked on his monu-                    the period 1935-1949 and in a new series since
> mental and important work to interpret                        1966. It publishes essays on Baha'i philosophy
> Buddhism a nd the Baha'i Faith to each other.                 and beliefs in their relation to contemporary
> Buddha Maitrya-Amitabha Has Appeared was                      problems. Several other magazines under Baha'i
> published in 1976 by the Baha'i Publishing                    auspices are directed to specific audiences,
> Trust of India. Its scope reflects a thorough                 such as Child's Way from the United States and
> knowledge of Hinduism, Buddhism and the                       Glory: Baha'i Youth Magazine from India.
> Baha'f Faith , which Mr. Fozdar compares and                  Some 130 National Spiritual Assemblies now
> relates doctrine for doctrine.                                exist, each of which publishes its own internal
> One of the Baha'f Faith's most talented writ-              newsletter; a large number of these is in Eng- ·
> ers and essayists was Horace Holley, a Hand of                lish.
> the Ca use and for many years secretary of the
> National Spiritual Assembly of the Baha'is of
> 8. The Baha'i World
> the United States. Among hi s writings are The
> Modern Social Religion (London: Sidgwick &                       No discussion of Baha'i literature in English
> Jackson, 1913), Baha'i, the Spirit of the Age                 would be complete without mention of the
> (New York: Brentano, 1921), and a selection                   multi-volume survey of the activities of the
> of essays, Religion for Mankind (George                       international Baha'f community, The Baha'i
> Ronald , 1956).                                               World. Now in its seventeenth volume , and
> There have also been several translations                  spanning over half a century, it is a source book
> into English of scholarly Baha'f works origi-                 for information on current activities, growth
> nally published in other languages. The                       and development of the Baha'f administrative
> Heavens Are Cleft Asunder by Huschmand                        order, biographies of deceased Baha'is, poetry
> Sabet reached high into theological circles in                and articles. The contents of this one publica-
> Germany under its original title Der Gespal-                  tion bear witness that the Baha'i Faith is a
> 1ene Himmel where it provoked much discus-                    well-established, international and indepension of the significance of Baha'u'llah's claim s             dent religion, steadily growing and developing
> ' A report of its activites in the period 1975-1979 appears
> new institutions and powers.
> o n p. 197.                                                     Published in its first year under the title BahO'( News.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                              551
> 
> Examples of Bahd'{ literature in English. Clockwise from bottom: Star of the West, Reprint
> (1978) ; God's Heroes by Laura Barney (191 O); The Priceless Pearl by Rul:zfyyih Rabbani
> (1969); Baha' u'llah and the New Era by J. E. Esslemonr (1923); The Dawn-breakers by
> Nab([ (1976 printing); The Mysterious Forces of Civilization by 'Abdu'l-Bahti (1918); The
> Book of Ighan by Bahd'u'lltih (1915); God Passes By by Shoghi Effendi (1965 printing);
> Gleanings from the Writings of Baha'u'llah, 2nd rev. ed. (1976).
> 
> 9. Audio-Visual Materials
> film on the Baha'i Faith, And His Name Shall
> Technological innovations in the twentieth         Be One, by the American television network
> century have led the Baha'is to develop a fas-        C.B.S., sparked the making offilms among the
> cinating array of films, filmstrips, slides, cas-     Baha'is. A New Wind by the Canadian
> sette tapes, posters and exhibit materials . The      documentary film producer George C. Stoney,
> official impetus for the full-scale production of     was commissioned by the National Spiritual
> such materials came from the Universal House          Assembly of the United States to show the
> of Justice in 1967 with the establishment of the      world-wide diversity of the Baha'i community.
> International Baha'i Audio-Visual Centre in           A number of Baha'i film companies have since
> Victor, New York, U.S.A.' The Baha'i Pub-             produced a diverse selection of films featuring
> lishing Trust of the United States also became        youth conferences, interviews with Hands of
> an important source of audio-visual produc-           the Cause of God, and dedications of Baha'i
> tion .                                                Houses of Worship . Perhaps the most ambi-
> Since the midpoint of the last decade, over        tious was the two-hour film of The Green Light
> two dozen filmstrip programmes have been              Expedition. 2 It is a priceless glimpse into the
> produced on such topics as Baha'i history,            spiritually-rich lives of South American
> administration, general introductions to the          Indians, accompanied by RuQ.iyyih Khanum's
> Faith, and international Baha'i conferences.          characteristic insights into the meaning of
> The production and broadcasting of a general.         pioneering.
> 
> 2   The Baha'( World, vol. XVI, 1973-1976. pp. 419-448.
> ' The Baha'( World, vol. XIV, 1963-1968, pp. 91-92.
> 552                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> versa[ House of Justice, A Synopsis and Codi-
> 10. Sources of Publications
> fication of the Laws and Ordinances of the
> Of the sources of Baha'i publications in         Kitab -i-Aqdas, and the three compilations of
> English, the New York Bahai Board of Coun-          Scripture called for in the Five Year Plan. 1
> sel and Chicago's Bahai Publishing Society
> have already been mentioned. Since the time
> 11. The Five Year Plan and Publishing in
> of the establishment of these two publishing
> English
> institutions in 1900, the Baha'i world has
> expanded to such a degree that there are now           As in previous international teaching plans
> over twenty Baha'i Publishing Trusts. A             of the Guardian and the Universal House of
> significant number of these publish in English,     Justice, the Five Year Plan had a sizeable
> including the United Kingdom, Australia, the        number of goals devoted to the production and
> United States and India. Even the Baha'i Pub-       dissemination of literature in many languages.
> lishing Trust of Japan has issued landmark          Seven new Publishing Trusts were called for;
> Baha'i books in English. Of the 130 National        Baha'i literature has been translated into many
> Spiritual Assemblies and their subordinate          new languages, and enriched in many more,
> committees, nearly all issue publications in var-   including English.
> ious formats; many of them are in English. Not         The major Five Year Plan goal for publicaonly are Baha'i works issued by Publishing          tion of Baha'i literature in English was
> Trusts and National Assemblies, but one other       assigned by the Universal House of Justice to
> publisher, George Ronald in England, has            the Baha'i World Centre. The goal-to publish
> issued only Baha'i books in the past few years.     three compilations of Sacred Scripture-
> The Baha'i World Centre has also produced a         significantly increased the range of Baha'i
> series of outstanding publications: The Pro c-      Holy Writings in English. In 1976 the first of
> lamation of Bahti'u'llah, Bahti'{ Holy Places at
> the World Centre, The Constitution of the Uni-      1
> See section 11 of this article.
> 
> Baha'i Literature display featuring literature produced by Editora Baha'i Brasil exhibited
> during the annual Street Book Fair held in Belo Horizonte, Brazil; October 1977.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                         553
> the three volumes, Selections from the Writings      newly-translated excerpts from the corpus of
> ofthe Bab, appeared , releasing for the first time   Baha'i Scripture and interpretation on such
> to the Baha'ls of the West the mighty torrent of     topics as teaching, education , youth , children,
> the Bab's utterance. Tablets of Baha'u'llah          opposition to the Faith, and consultation .
> Revealed After the Kitab-i-Aqdas was released            This review has not attempted to give a
> approximately eighteen months later. Included        definitive survey of Baha'i literature in Engin this anthology were retranslations of several     lish; it has, rather, indicated the broad
> Tablets which had been translated in the days         categories of Baha'i publication. Nevertheless,
> of the Master, as well as much material previ-       the importance of the publication and dissemiously unavailable in English . In late 1978,          nation of Baha'i literature in English cannot be
> Selections from the Writings of 'Abdu'l-Baha          over-emphasized. Not only is English a lancompleted the trilogy of newly-translated             guage rich in expression, but it is currently one
> Sacred Texts. The dynamic spirit infused into         of the most widely spoken . It is also the tongue
> the Baha'i community by the appearance of             in which a significant portion of Shoghi
> these volumes has contributed significantly to        Effendi's writing was composed, and the lanthe stimulation of the herculean efforts exerted      guage into which his authentic translations of
> to achieve the assigned tasks of the Five Year        Baha'u'llah's Writings were made. It is not
> Plan.                                                 from the original Persian and Arabic, but
> A supplementary achievement of the World          rather from the authorized English editions of
> Centre was the publication in 1977 of excerpts        Baha'i Holy Texts, that nearly all translations
> from various letters of the Guardian under the        into other languages of the West are made.
> title Call to the Nations. Extracts from the four        The Word of God for this era of the earth's
> books just named appear elsewhere in this vol-        spiritual history has appeared as the sun in the
> ume.                                                  East in exalted verses of Arabic and Persian; it
> At the request of the Universal House of           has been focused clearly and unambiguously
> Justice, the Research Department of the               for the West in unmatched English prose, from
> World Centre has from time to time compiled           which, as light through a prism, its rich texture
> appropriate passages from the Baha'i Writings         and colour reach the whole of mankind in a
> on various subjects. These compilations have          myriad tongues.
> brought together previously-translated and
> 554                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 11. BIBLIOGRAPHIES
> 
> A. A BIBLIOGRAPHY OF BAHA'I BOOKS AND BOOKLETS IN
> THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE
> 
> Compiled by Robert E. Cadwalader
> 
> (i) THE WRITINGS OF BAHA'U'LLAH
> 
> Abbrevia1ions
> NSA-Nat io nal Spiritu al Asse mbl y
> LSA-Local Spiritual Asse mbl y
> BPS-Baha'i Pu blishing Society ( L902- 1922)
> BPT-Ba ha'f Publishing Trust
> BPC-Baha'f Publishing Committee
> 
> 1. Blessed is the Spot. n.p . n.d. National              1940. Wi lmette: BPC, 1943 , 1952 a nd
> Teaching Co mmittee. paper.                           1954. Wilmette: BPT, 1954, 1963, 1966,
> 2. Book of Assurance, Th e. tra ns . Ali Kuli            1970, 1971 a nd 1975. London: BPT,
> Khan. New York: Brenta no's, (1924).                  1944, 1949, 1966 a nd 1975. New Delhi:
> New Yo rk : BPC, 1929. cloth.                         BPT, 1964 a nd 1973. paper a nd cloth.
> 3. Book of lghan, The. tra ns. A li Kuli Khan.      11. Hi dden Words from the Arabic, The. Lon-
> New York: George V . Blackburne Co. ,                 don: Kenneth Mackenzie , 1915. paper.
> 1904. Ch icago: BPS, 1907 a nd 1915.             12 . Hidden Words from th e Arabic, Th e. fore -
> cloth.                                                wo rd by Sidney Sprague. London: The
> 4. Ep istle to th e Son of th e Wolf trans. Julie        Priory Press, Mayle 's Penny Series, 1908.
> Chanler. New York: BPC, 1928. parc h-                 paper.
> me nt o n ha rd cover.                           13 . Hidde n Words from the Persian-
> 5. Epistle to the Son ofth e Wolf trans. Shogh i         Revealed by th e Blessed Perfection.
> Effe ndi . Wilmette: BPC, 1941 and 1953.               New York: The Board of Co un se l. paper.
> Wilmette: BPT, 1962, 1969, 1970, 1971            14. Hidden Words-Th e Seven Valleys. two
> and 1976. cloth.                                      works bound together, the first work has
> 6. Gleanings from th e Writings of Bahri'u'-             no mention of tra nslator (Fareed) , the
> llrih. comp. and trans. Shoghi Effe ndi.              second was translated by Ishteal Ibn
> New York: BPC, 1935 a nd 1939. Wil-                   Kalantar (Ali Quli Khan). C hicago: BPS,
> mette: BPC, 1943 , 1946, 1948, 1951 and               n.d. lea th er.
> 1952. Wilmette : BPT, 1956, 1963 , 1969          15. Hidden Words Translated from the Perand 1976 . London: BPT, 1946 and 1978.                sian, The. trans. A ntun F. Haddad. n.p .
> pape r, fa brikoid and cloth.                         n.d. paper.
> 7. Hidden Wo rds . trans . Shoghi Effendi.          16 . Kitrib-El-Ah'd-The Bookofthe Covenant,
> London: 1923. New York: 1924, 1925                    The Will and Testament of the Baha'o' /lah.
> and 1929. paper and leather.                          Chicago: BPS, 1913. paper.
> 8. Hidden Words, The. tra ns. A meen 'U ll a h      17. Kitrib-i-fqan-The Book of Certitude,
> Fareed. Ch icago: BPS, 1905, 1914 and                 The. trans. Shoghi Effendi . New York:
> undated. London: The Unity Press, 1911.              BPC , 1931 and 193 7. Wi lmette: BPC,
> paper and leather.                                    1943, 1950 and 1954. Wilmette: BPT,
> 9. Hidden Words, The. (Persian section on ly)            1954, 1960 (this edition has two varieties
> Chicago: Behais Supply a nd Publishing                of dust jacket: the first states erroneously
> Board, Press of the Hollister Bros. n.d.               that the Iqan was revealed in 1858 while
> pape r.                                               the latter correctly gives the date 1862) ,
> 10. Hidden Words, The. trans . Shoghi                      1970 a nd 1974. London: BPT, 1946 a nd
> Effendi. New York: BPC, 1932, 1939 a nd               1961. cloth.
> BAHA'i BIBLIOGRAPHY                                        555
> 18. Lawh-El-Akdas-The           Holy    Tablet      27. Source of Spiri1ual Qualifies, The. New
> Revealed by the Blessed Perfection ( Baha           York: BPC, 1924. paper
> Ullah) al Baghdad. Stuttgart, Germany:         28. Suratu'l-Hykl-Sura of the Temple.
> Dr. Edwin Fisher, Stitzenburgstrasse,               Chicago: The Behais Supply and Publish-
> 1907. Chicago: BPS, 1913. a lso n.p. n.d.           ing Board, 1900. paper.
> paper.                                         29. Synopsis and Codification of 1he Kitab -i-
> 19. Mission of Baha'u'llah, The. Wilmette:               Aqdas, The. Haifa: The Universal House
> BPT, 1952 and 1971. paper.                          of Justice, 1973. cloth .
> 20. Prayers and Meditations . comp. and trans.      30. Tablet of lshrakal. trans. Ali Kuli Khan .
> Shoghi Effendi. New York: BPC, 1938.                Chicago: BPS, 1908. paper.
> Wilmette: BPC, 1954. Wilmette: BPT,            31. Table! of Tarazat, Tablet of the World,
> 1962, 1969 and 1974. London: BPT,                   Words of Paradise, Tablet of Tajalleyat,
> 1978. fabrikoid and cloth.                          The Clad Tidings Revealed by Baha'u'llah
> 21. Proclamation of Baha'u'/lah, The. Haifa:             at Acea. trans. Ali Kuli Khan. Ch icago:
> The Universal House of Justice, 1967 and            BPS, 1906 and 1913 . cardboard.
> 1972. paper and cloth.                         32. Table! of !he Branch, The. n.p. n.d. (New
> 22. Selected Writings of Baha 'u'!lah . Wil-             York: December, 191 2). paper.
> mette: BPC, 1942. Wilmette: BPT, 1972          33. Tablels of Baha'u'llah. trans. Ali Kuli
> and 1975. paper.                                    Khan. Chicago: BPS, 1917 . cloth.
> 23. Selections from the Hidden Words of             34. Tablets of Baha'u'llah Revealed after the
> Baha'o'/lah. Chicago: BPS, n.d . paper.             Kitab-i-Aqdas. comp. the Research Dept.
> 24. Seven Valleys, The. trans . lshteal lbn              of the Un iversal House of Justice . trans.
> Kalantar (Ali Quli Khan). Chicago: BPS,              Habib Taherzadeh. Haifa: Baha'i World
> 1906 and n.d. paper and leather.                    Centre, 1978. cloth.
> 25 . Seven Valleys and the Four Valleys, The.       35 . Three Obligatory Prayers. trans. Shoghi
> trans. Ali Quli Khan. New York: BPC,                Effendi. New York: BPC, 1937. paper.
> 1936 and 1937. paper and fabrikoid.            36. Three Tablets of Baha'o'llah. trans. Ali
> 26 . Seven Valleys and the Four Valleys, The.            Kuli Khan. Chicago : BPS, 1918 . paper.
> trans. Ali Quli Khan and Marzieh Gail.         37. Tokens from the Writings of Baha'u'l/ah .
> Wilmette: BPC, 1945, 1948, 1952 and                 comp. Jay and Co nstance Conrader. Wil-
> 1954. Wilmette: BPT, 1957, 19??, 1967,               mette: BPT, 1973 and 1975 . paper and
> 1968 and 1975. pape r and cloth.                    cloth.
> 
> (ii) THE WRITINGS OF THE BAB
> 
> 1. Bab's Instructions to the Letlers of the Liv-        comp. Research Dept. of the Universal
> ing, The. Wilmette: BPC, 1944 also n.p.              House of Justice. trans. Habib Tahern.d. paper.                                          zadeh. Haifa: Baha'i World Centre, 1976.
> 2. Selections from the Writings of the Bab .            cloth.
> 
> (iii) THE WRITINGS OF 'ABDU'L-BAHA
> 
> 1. 'Abdu'l-Baha in Canada . comp . NSA of           4. Abdul Baha in New York. comp. LSA of
> Canada. 1962. paper.                                New York City. New York: 1922. New
> 2. 'A bdu'l-Baha in Edinburgh . comp. NSA              York: BPC, 1931. paper.
> of the British Isles. London: 1963. paper.       5. Abdul Baha on Divine Philosophy. comp.
> 3. Abdul-Baha in London . comp. Eric                   Isabel Fraser Chamberlain. Boston: The
> Hammond. London: Longmans Green &                   Tudor Press, 1916 and 1918. paper. see
> Co., 1912. East Sheen, Eng.: The Unity              #6.
> Press, 1912. Chicago: BPS , 1921. paper.         6. Abdul Baha on Divine Philosophy. comp.
> 556                                 THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Soraya Chamberlain. New York: BPC,                Wilmette: BPC, 1941and1946. paper.
> (1928). paper. see #5.                       24 . Japan Will Turn Ablaze. Japan: BPT,
> 7. America's Spiritual Mission. (trans.              1974. cloth.
> Ahmad Sohrab). New York: BPC, 1936.          25. Letter and Tablet from Abdul Baha to the
> Wilmette: BPC, 1948. paper. see #58 and           Central Organization for a Durable Peace,
> 68.                                               The Hague. Chicago: BPS, 1920. paper.
> 8. Baha'i Peace Program, The. New York:         26. Letter from Abdul-Baha Abbas to the
> BPC, 1930. paper and fabrikoid.                   Friends in Persia. trans. Ameen 'Ullah
> 9. Christians, Jews and Muhammadans.                 Fareed. Chicago: BPS, Jan. 21, 1906.
> Wilmette: BPC, 1945. paper                        paper.
> 10. Christ's Promise Fulfilled. Wilmette: BPC,   27. Letter from St. Jean d'Acre. London: The
> 1954. Wilmette: BPT, 1954, 1959, 1970,            Bahai Press, 1906. paper.
> 1975 and 1978. paper.                        28. Letter of 'Love' from ABDUL-BAHA
> 11. Compilation of Utterances from the Peno f         ABBAS to the 'beloved' in America,
> Abdul Baha Regarding His Station. n.p.            Received by Mr. George £. Witte at New
> November 26, 1906. paper.                         York, December 7, 1902. Chicago: BPS,
> 12. Definition of Love by Abdul Baha. New             1902. paper.
> York: December 7, 1902. paper.               29. Letters to the Friends in Persia. Chicago:
> 13. Divine Art of Living, The. comp. Mary M.          BPS, 1906. paper.
> Rabb. All but first two #s of Star of the    30. Life Eternal. comp. Mary Rumsey
> West dealing with Rabb's compilation              Movius. East Aurora, N.Y.: The Raycroft
> bound in ~ leather. Chicago: Bahai News           Shops, 1936 and 193 7. fine cloth.
> Service, 1924.                               31. Memorials of the Faithful. trans. Marzieh
> 14. Divine Art of Living, The. comp. Mary M.          Gail. Wilmette: BPT, 1971. cloth.
> Rabb. New York: Brentano's, 1926.            32. Messages from Abdul Baha to the Honpaper and cloth.                                  olulu Bahais. Honolulu: Advance Press,
> 15. Divine Common Sense from the World's              1924. Honolulu: NSA of the Hawaiian
> Greatest Prisoner to His Prison Friends.          Islands.
> Boston: The Tudor Press, 1916. paper see     33. Mysterious Forces of Civilization, The.
> #20.                                              trans. Johanna Dawud. London: Cope &
> 16. Faith for Every Man. London: BPT, 1972.           Fenwick, 1910. Chicago: BPS, 1910 and
> paper.                                            1918. cloth.
> 17. Foundations of World Unity. comp.            34. Mystery of God, The. comp. Mrs. Iran F.
> Horace Holley. New York: World Unity              Muhajer. New Delhi: BPT, 1971. cloth
> Publishing Corp., 1927. New York: BPC,            and leather.
> 1936. Wilmette: BPC, 1945. Wilmette:        35. Paris Talks. comp. Beatrice Marion Platt,
> BPT, 1955, 1968 and 1971. paper and               Mary Esther Blomfield, Rose Ellinor
> cloth.                                            Cecilia Blomfield, and Lady Sara Louisa
> 18. From Abbas Effendi to a Lady who Visited          Blomfield. London: BPT, 1951, 1961,
> Acre in Feb., 1906. Edinburgh: T & A              1969, 1971and1972. paper and cloth. (see
> Constable, 1907. paper. see #19.                  #63 and 73 of this section).
> 19. From Abdul Baha to a Lady who Visited        36. Prayers and Tablets-Abdul-Baha Abbas.
> Acre in February, 1906. trans. Monever            n.p. 1906. paper.
> Khanum. London: The Unity Press, 1907.      37. Promulgation of Universal Peace, The.
> paper.                                           Vol. I. (comp. Howard MacNutt).
> 20. From the World's Greatest Prisoner to His         Chicago: BPC, 1922. (New York): BPC,
> Prison Friends. Boston: The Tudor Press,          1922 (actually 1925). cloth.
> 1921. paper. see #15.                       38. Promulgation of Universal Peace, The.
> 21. Garden of the Heart, The. comp. Frances           Vol. II. (comp. Howard MacNutt) . New
> Esty. East Aurora, New York: The Ray-            York: BPC, 1925. cloth.
> croft Press, 1930. fine cloth.              39. Promulgation of Universal Peace, The.
> 22. He Is God. Chicago: BPS, 1913. paper.             combined edition. (comp. Howard Mac-
> 23. Industrial Justice. New York: BPC, 1940.          Nutt). (New York): BPC, 1922 (1939).
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                       557
> Wilmette: BPC, 1943. cloth.                      (comp. Albert R . Windust). Chicago:
> 40. Reality of Religion-Tablet of Abdul              BPS, 1915 and 1919. New York: BPC,
> Baha, The. New York: BPC, 1924. paper.            1940. cloth.
> (see #41).                                   56. Tablets of Abdul Baha Abbas. Vol. III.
> 41. Reality of Religion- Words of Abdul              (comp. Albert R. Windust). Chicago:
> Baha, The. New York: BPC, 1924, paper.           BPS, 1916 and 1919 . New York: BPC,
> (see #40).                                        1930. cloth.
> 42. Secret of Divine Civilization, The. trans.   57. Tablets of Abdul Beha Abbas to Some
> MarziehGail. Wilmette: BPT, 1957, 1970           American Believers in the Year 1900. New
> and 1975. cloth.                                  York: Board of Counsel, 707-708 Car-
> 43. Selected Writings of 'Abdu'l-Baha. Wil-           negie Hall, April, 1901. paper.
> mette: BPC, 1942. paper.                     58. Tablets of the Divine Plan, The. (trans.
> 44. Selections from the Writings of 'Abdu'l-          Ahmad Sohrab). Wilmette: BPT, 1959,
> Bahti. comp. the Research Dept. of the            1962, 1965 and 1971. (see also #7, 59 and
> Universal House of Justice. trans. by a          68). paper.
> Committee at the Baha'i World Centre        59. Tablets of the Divine Plan, The. trans. varand Marzieh Gail. Haifa: The Baha'i              ious scholars. Wilmette: BPT, 1977. cloth.
> World Centre, 1978. cloth.                        (see also #7, 58 and 68).
> 45. Some Answered Questions, comp. Laura         60. Tablets Revealed by Abdul Baha Abbas to
> Clifford Barney. London: Kegan Paul,             the East and the West. trans. Ahmad
> Trench, Trubner & Co., 1908. Chicago:            Esphahani (Sohrab). Washington: Bahai
> BPS, 1918. New York: BPC, 1930 and                Assembly of Washington, D.C., 1908.
> 1937. Wilmette: BPC, 1943, 1947 and              paper.
> 1954. Wilmette: BPT, 1957, 1964, 1968        61. Tablets Revealed by the Master Abdul
> and 1971. London: BPT, New Delhi:                Beha Abbas to the House of Justice at
> BPT, 1973. cloth.                                Chicago, to the Ladies' Assembly of Teach-
> 46. Some Christian Subjects. London: BPT,            ing, to Mirza Assad 'Ullah and to Other
> 1946.paper.                                      Individuals, also One to the Believers in
> 47. Tablet to the Beloved of God in America.         Persia. Chicago: Press of the Hollister
> trans. Ali Kuli Khan . Cambridge, Mass.:         Bros., 1901. paper.
> 1906. paper.                                 62. Tablets to Japan. (comp. Agnes Alexan-
> 48. Tablet to the Beloved of God of the Occi-         der). New York: BPC, 1928. paper.
> dent. trans. Ahmad Esphahani (Sohrab).       63. Talks by Abdul Baha Given in Paris.
> Chicago: BPS, 1906. paper.                       comp. Beatrice Marion Platt, Mary Esther
> 49. Tablet to the Hague. London: BPT, n.d.            Blomfield, Rose Ellinor Cecilia Blomfield,
> paper.                                            and Lady Sara Louisa Blomfield. London,
> 50. Tablets Communes and Holy Utterances.             East Sheen: The Unity Press, 1912.
> n.p. (1897). paper.                               Chicago: BPS, 1912. London: G. Bell and
> 51. Tablets Containing General Instructions.         Sons, Ltd., 1915, 1916 and 1920. paper.
> trans. M. A. E. (Mirza Ahmad Esphahani           (see also #35 and 73).
> Sohrab). Washington: Bahai Assn. of          64. Traveller's Narrative Written to Illustrate
> Washington, D.C., 1907. paper.                   the Episode of the Bab, A. trans. Edward
> 52. Tablets Containing Instructions. trans.          Granville Browne. London: Cambridge
> Mirza Ahmad Esphahani (Sohrab) and               University Press, 1891 (this edition issued
> Ali Kuli Khan. Washington: Bahai Assn.           in two volumes of which the first is the
> of Washington, D.C., 1906. paper.                Persian text). New York: BPC, 1930.
> 53. Tablets from Abdul Baha to E. E. Wrestl-         cloth.
> ing Brewster. Chicago: BPS, 1902. paper.     65. True Belief-Abdul Baha Abbas. n.p. n.d.
> 54. Tablets of Abdul Baha Abbas. Vol. I.             paper.
> (comp. Albert R. Windust). Chicago:          66. True Gardener, A Talk Given by Abdul
> BPS, 1909, 1912 and 1919. New York:              Baha, The. comp. L.A.C.B. Rangoon,
> BPC, 1930. cloth.                                Burma: Rangoon Standard Press, 1903.
> 55. Tablets of Abdul Baha Abbas. Vol. II.            London: The Unity Press, n.d. paper.
> 558                                 THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 67. Twelve Basic Teachings Compiled from              1950. paper.
> the Words of Abdul Baha. New York :         72. Will and Testament of 'Abdu'l-Baha,
> 1926. paper.                                     Selections from the. New York: BPC, 1935
> 68 . Unveiling of the Divine Plan, The. trans.        and 1940. Wilmette: BPC, 1944 and
> Mirza Ahmad Sohrab. New York: 1919.              1948.paper.
> paper. see #7 and 58.                       73. Wisdom of Abdul Baha, The. comp. Beat-
> 69. Utterances of Abdul Beha Abbas to Two             rice Marion Platt, Mary Esther Blomfield,
> Young Men, American Pilgrims to Acre,            Rose E llinor Cecilia Blomfield and Lady
> 1901. New York : Board of Counsel, 1901.         Sara Louisa Blomfield. New York: BPC,
> paper.                                           1924. Wilmette: BPC, n.d. cardboard and
> 70. Visiting Tablets for Our Recent Martyrs           cloth . see #35 and 63.
> Who Suffered in Persia in 1901 with some    74. Wisdom Talks of Abdul-Baha (Abbas
> Tablets and Prayers for the American             Effendi) at Chicago, Illinois . April 30th to
> Behais. New York: Behais Board of Coun-          May 5th, 1912 . Chicago: Press of Bahai
> sel, 1902 . paper.                               News Service, n.d. paper.
> 71. Will and Testament of'Abdu'l-Bahd, The.      75 . Woman's Great Station in the Bahai Dis-
> Wilmette: NSA of the USA and Canada ,           pensation. n.p . 1913. paper.
> 1942. Wilmette: BPC, 1944. Wilmette:       76 . World Order Through World Faith. Wil-
> BPT, 1968, 1971 and n .d. London: BPT,          mette: BPC, 1946. paper.
> 
> (iv) WORKS COMPILED FROM THE WRITINGS OF BAHA'U'LLAH
> AND 'ABDU' L-BAHA
> 
> 1. Arise and Serve: A Compilation. New               1957,1962,1967, 19691970,1973 , 1975
> Delhi: BPT, 1971. paper and cloth.                and 1978. cloth and paper.
> 2. Baha'i Answers: A Compilation. comp.         11 . Baha'i Prayers. comp. NSA of USA. Wil-
> Olivia Kelsey. Independence, Mo. : Lam-           mette: BPC, 1954. Wilmette: BPT 1954
> bert Moon Printers and Publishers, 194 7          and 1970. cloth . (the 'White' Prayer book
> and 194 7 rev. cardboard and cloth.               which includes only the first section of
> 3. Baha'i Community, The. Wilmette: BPC,             #10).
> 1947 and 1954. Wilmette: BPT, 1963.          12. Bahti'( Prayers. comp. NSA of Malaysia .
> New Delhi: BPT, 1964. paper.                      (Kuala Lumpur): BPT, 1970. paper.
> 4. Baha'( Education: A Compilation. Wil-        13 . Baha'i Prayers: A Selection. comp . NSA of
> mette: BPT, 1977. paper.                          the British Isles. London: 1951. cloth.
> 5. Baha'i Institutions: A Compilation. New      14. Baha'i Prayers: A Selection. comp. NSA of
> Delhi: BPT, 1973 . paper.                         the British Isles. London: BPT, 1945 a nd
> 6. Baha'i Meetings, The Nineteen Day Feast.          1951 . cloth. (this edition contains only the
> comp. the Universal House of Justice.             first section of #13).
> Wilmette: BPT, 1976. paper.                  15. Baha'i Prayers: A Selection . comp. NSA of
> 7. Bahti'( Prayers. comp. NSA of USA and             the British Isles. London : BPT, 1967 and
> Canada. New York: BPC, 1929 and 1929               1975 . cloth.
> (1936 with newer translations). cloth .      16. Baha'i Prayers and Meditations - The
> 8. Baha'i Prayers. comp. NSA of USA and              Bab, Baha'u'llah, 'Abdu'l-Baha. paper.
> Canada. New York: BPC, 1935 and 1937 .             (contains two pictures of the Louhelen
> paper.                                             Baha'i School). n.p. n.d.
> 9. Baha'i Prayers. comp . NSA of USA and        17 . Baha'i Prayers: An Introductory Selection.
> Canada. Wilmette: BPC, 1941, 1942,                 comp. NSA of Malaysia. (Kuala Lumpur):
> 1944, 1945, 1947, 1949 and 1952. paper             BPT, 1973. paper.
> and cloth.                                   18 Baha'( Prayers for Special Occasions. Lon-
> 10. Baha'i Prayers. comp . NSA of USA. Wil-            don: BPT, 1945. cloth .
> mette: BPC, 1954. Wilmette: BPT, 1954,       19. Baha'i Revelation. comp. NSA of the Brit-
> BAHA ' I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                    559
> ish Isles. London: BPT, 1955 and 1970.         1956. Oxford: George Ronald, 1975.
> cloth.                                         paper and cloth.
> 20. Baha'( Scriptures. comp. Horace Holley.    36. God and His Manifestations. comp. Maye
> New York: Brentano's, 1923. New York:          Harvey Gift. New York: BPC, 1925.
> BPC, 1928. cloth.                              paper.
> 21. Baha'( World Faith. comp. NSA of USA       37. Holy Utterances Revealed by Baha' Ullah
> and Canada. Wilmette: BPC, 1943 and            and the Master, Abdul Baha Regarding the
> 1943 (the second 1943 edition was bound        Necessity for Steadfastness and Effort in
> m red leather and inscribed in gold           the Present Time, That Thereby the Believ-
> 1844-1944 as a special centennial             ers May Be Strengthened and Made Ready
> souvenir-only 500 copies). Wilmette:           Under All Conditions, to Stand Firm in the
> BPT, 1956, 1966, 1969, 1971and1976.            Covenant. Compiled 1905. n.p. paper.
> cloth, fabrikoid and leather.              38. Individual and Teaching, Raising the
> 22. Bahd'( Writings. (comp. Amelia Collings         Divine Call, The. Wilmette: BPT, 1977.
> and Alice S. Cox). Wilmette: BPC, 1942         paper.
> and 194 7. paper and cloth.                39. Life After Death. comp. Barbara Mason.
> 23. Book of Prayers. n.p . n.d. paper and          Honolulu: Hawaii Baha'i Press, 1976.
> leather.                                       p<:1per.
> 24. Chalice of Immortality, The. comp.         40. Mighty River, A. comp. Audrie Reynolds.
> Hushidar Mutlagh. New Delhi: BPT,              Wilmette: BPT, 1977. paper.
> (1979).                                    41. New Day: Prophecies and Precepts from
> 25. Communion With God. Wilmette: BPC,             the Utterances of Baha'o'llah and Abdul
> 1950. ten subsequent printings. paper.         Baha. comp. Isabel F. Chamberlain. New
> 26. Compilation No. 9 Concerning the Most          York: The Fellowship Press Service, 191-.
> Great Peace. Boston: The Tudor Press,          paper.
> 1918.paper.                                42. Pattern of Baha'( Life, The. comp. NSA of
> 27. Compilation of the Holy Utterances of          the British Isles. Manchester: BPT, 1948.
> Baha'o'llah and Abdul Baha Concerning          London: BPT, 1953, 1963, 1968 and
> the Most Great Peace, War and Duty ofthe        1970. paper.
> Bahais Toward Their Government. n.p.       43. Peace: A Divine Creation. n.p. 1943.
> 1918 and 1918 rev. paper.                      paper.
> 28. Covenant of Bahd'u'llah, The. Manches-     44. Power of the Covenant, The. comp. NSA
> ter, Eng.: BPT, 1950. London: BPT,             of USA. Wilmette: BPT, 1956 and 1972.
> 1963. cloth and fabrikoid.                     paper.
> 29. Daily Prayers-Bahd'u'llah, Bab, 'Abdu'l-   45. Power of the Covenant Part One, Bahd'u'-
> Bahd. New York: BPC, n.d. paper.               llah's Covenant With Mankind, The.
> 30. Daily Prayers-Prayers and Meditations.         comp. Dr. Jane Faily et al. n.p. NSA of
> New York: BPC, 1931. paper.                   Canada, February, 1976. paper.
> 31. Dawn of World Civilization, The. n.p.      46. Power of the Covenant Part Two, The
> World Order Magazine, 1945.                   Problem of Covenant-Breaking, The.
> 32. Divine Art of living, The. comp. Mabel         comp. Dr. Jane Faily et al. n.p. NSA of
> Hyde Paine. Wilmette: BPC, 1944, 1946,        Canada, October, 1976. paper.
> 1949 and 1953. Wilmette: BPT, 1956,       47. Power the Covenant Part Three, The Face
> 1960, 1965, 1970, 1972, 1973 and 1974.        of Opposition, The. comp. Dr. Jane Faily
> cloth and fabrikoid.                           et al. n.p. NSA of Canada, April, 1977.
> 33. Divine Pearls. comp. Victoria Bedikian.        paper.
> n.p. n.d. paper.                          48. Prayer of Bahd'u'llah and Prayers and
> 34. Divine Wisdom of Bahd'u'llah and               Tablets of 'Abdu'l-Baha. trans. Shoghi
> 'Abdu'l-Bahd. comp. NSA of the British         Effendi. Boston: 1923. paper.
> Isles. Manchester: BPT, 1946. paper.       49. Prayers Revealed by Baha'u'llah, The Bab,
> 35. Glad Tidings of Bahd'u'llah, The. comp.        and 'A bdu'l-Baha. trans. Shoghi Effendi.
> George Townshend. London: John Mur-            New York: BPC, 1939. paper.
> ray, Wisdom of the East Series, 1949 and   50. Prayers, Tablets, Instructions, and Miscel-
> 560                                 THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> leny Galhered by American Visitors to the         'A bdu'l-Baha . n.p. n.d. paper.
> Holy City During the Summer of 1900.         57. Some Special Bahd'{ Prayers and Tablets.
> Chicago: The Adair Press, 1900. paper.            London: BPT, 1945.
> 51. Racial Amity. comp. M. H. and M. M.          58. Spiritual Opportunity of the Bahti'fs of the
> (Mariam Haney and Mountfort Mills).               United States and Canada, The. comp. the
> n.p. 1924. paper.                                 NSA of the USA and Canada. New York:
> 52. Reality of Man, The. New York: BPC,               BPC, 1926. paper.
> 1931, 1935 and 1939. Wilmette: BPC,          59. Splendour of God, The. comp. Eric Ham-
> 1942, 1945 and 1947 . Wilmette: BPT,              mond. New York: E. P. Dutton, 1910.
> 1956, 1962, 1966, 1972 and 1975. New              London: John Murray, The Wisdom ofthe
> Delhi: BPT, 1971. paper and cloth.                East Series, 1909 and 1910. cloth.
> 53. River of Life, A Selection from the Teach-   60 . Tablets Revealed by the Blessed Perfection
> ings of Baha Ullah and Abdul Baha wilh            and Abdul Beha Abbas Brought to this
> Explanation and Preface by Johanna                Country by Haji Mirza Hassan, Mirza
> Dawud. London: Cope & Fenwick, 1914.              Assad' Ullah and Mirza Hussien. New
> 54. Selections from Bahti'f Scripture. comp.          York: Board of Counsel, 1900. paper.
> David Hofman. Manchester, Eng.: BPT,         61. Tablets Revealed in Honor of the Greatest
> 1941. cloth.                                      Holy Leaf New York: J. J. Little and Ives
> 55. Selections from the Holy Utterances on !he        Company, 1933. paper.
> Subject of Unity (i·om Bahti'u'lldh and      62. Victory Promises. Honolulu: NSA of the
> 'A bdu'l-Bahti. n.p. n.d. paper.                  Baha'fs of the Hawaiian Islands, 1978.
> 56. Selections from the Holy Writings on the          paper.
> Subject of Unity from Bahti'u'lldh and
> 
> (v) THE WRITINGS OF SHOGHI EFFENDI
> 
> 1. Advent of Divine Justice, The. New York:      8. Bahti'{ Youth: A Compilation. comp. NSA
> BPC, 1939 and 1939. Wilmette: BPC,                of USA. Wilmette: BPT, 1973. paper.
> 1940 and 1948. Wilmette: BPT, 1956,           9. Call to the Nations. comp. the Universal
> 1963 , 1969, 1971 and 1974. New Delhi:            House of Justice . Haifa: Baha'i World
> BPT, n.d. paper, cloth and fabrikoid.             Centre, 1977. cloth.
> 2. America and the Most Great Peace. New        10. Challenging Requirements of the Present
> York: BPC, 1933. paper.                           Hour, The. Wilmette: NSA of USA and
> 3. Bahti'{ Administration. New York: BPC,            Canada, 1947.paper.
> 1928, 1933 and 1936. Wilmette: BPC,          11. Citadel of Faith. Wilmette: BPT, 1965 and
> 1941 , 1945 and 1953. Wilmette: BPT,              1970. cloth.
> 1960, 1968 and 1974. paper and cloth.        12 . Citadel of Faith of Bahd'u'lldh, The. Wil-
> 4. Bahti'{ Faith, Statistical Information            mette: NSA of the USA , 1948. paper.
> 1844-1944, The. Wilmette: BPC, 1944.         13. Continental Boards of Counsellors. comp.
> paper.                                            the Universal House of Justice. NSA of
> 5. Bahd'f Faith, Statistical Information             Canada, (1970). London: BPT, n.d.
> 1844-1950, The. Wilmette: BPC, 1950.              paper.
> paper.                                       14. Covenant and Administration, The. Wil-
> 6. Bahd'f Faith, Statistical Information             mette: BPC, 1950. Wilmette: BPT, 1956
> 1844-1952, The. Wilmette: BPC, 1953.              and 1969. paper.
> paper. (see also section on Universal        15 . Dawn of a New Day, The. New Delhi:
> House of Justice #3 and section on 'Writ-         BPT, 1970. paper and cloth.
> ings on the Baha 'i Faith' #24) .            16. Dawn of World Civilization, The. Wil-
> 7. Bahd'{ Procedure. New York: BPC, 1937.            mette: BPC, 1945. paper.
> Wilmette: BPC, 1942. paper and cloth.        17. Destiny ofAmerica, The. New York: BPC,
> (the 1937 .e dition is loose-leaf).               1940.paper.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                      561
> 18. Directives from the Guardian. comp. Ger-          BPT, 1970. London: BPT, n.d. paper.
> trude Garrida. New Delhi: BPT, 1973 and     37. Messages from the Guardian 1932 - 1940.
> n.d. cloth and paper.                            New York: BPC, 1940. paper.
> 19. Dispensation of Baha'u'llah , The. New       38. Messages to America 1932-1946. Wil-
> York: BPC, 1934, 1937 and 1940. Wil-             mette : BPC, 194 7. fabrikoid.
> mette: BPC, 1943 and 1947. Wilmette:        39. Messages to Canada. NSA of Canada,
> BPT, 1970. London: BPT, 1947. paper              1965. cloth.
> and cloth.                                  40. Messages to the Baha'f World 1950- 1957.
> 20. Earth is God's, The. London: BPT, 1947.           Wilmette: BPT, 1958 and 1971. cloth.
> paper.                                      41. National Spiritual Assembly, The. comp.
> 21. Faith of Baha'u'llah, The. Wilmette: BPC,         the Universal House of Justice. Wilmette:
> 1947. paper.                                     BPT, 1972. paper.
> 22. Future World Commonwealth, The. NSA          42 . Passing of Abdul Baha, The. co-authpr
> of the USA and Canada, 1936. paper.              Lady Blomfield. Haifa:          Rosenfeld
> 23. Goal of a New World Order, The. New                Brothers, 1922. London: BPT, n.d. paper.
> York: BPC, 1931. Wilmette: BPC, 1931        43. Pattern for Future Society, A. Wilmette:
> (not the true date). Wilmette: BPT, 1971.        BPC, 1940, 1946 and 1948. paper.
> paper.                                      44. Principles of Baha'f Administration. Lon-
> 24. God Given Mandate, A. Wilmette: BPC,               don: BPT, 1950, 1963 and 1973. paper
> 1946.paper.                                      and cloth.
> 25. God Passes By. Wilmette: BPC, 1944,           45. Principles of Mass Teaching. comp . the
> 1945 and 1950. Wilmette: BPT, 1957,              Universal House of Justice. NSA of
> 1965, 1970 and 1974. paper and cloth.            Canada, 1971. see #31. paper.
> 26. Golden Age of the Cause of Baha'u'llah,       46. Promised Day is Come, The. Wilmette:
> The. New York: BPC, 1932. paper.                 BPC, 1941, 1943 and 1951. Wilmette:
> 27. Guidance for Today and Tomorrow .                  BPT, 1961 and 1967. New Delhi: BPT,
> comp. NSA of the British Isles. London:          1976. cloth and paper.
> BPT, 1953 and 1973. cloth and paper.        47. Religion a Living Organism. New York:
> 28. Generation of the Half Light: A Compila-           BPC, 1940. paper.
> tion for Baha'f Youth. comp. Arjun Ras-      48. Rising World Commonwealth, The. Lontogi. New Delhi: BPT, 1974. paper.               don: BPT, 1945. paper.
> 29. Guidance for Youth. comp. NSA of the          49. Selected Writings of Shoghi Effendi. Wil-
> United Kingdom. London: BPT, 1969.               mette: BPC, 1942. Wilmette: BPT, 1975 .
> paper.                                            paper.
> 30. Guidelines for Local Spiritual Assemblies.    50. Special Measure of Love, A. Wilmette:
> comp. NSA of USA. Wilmette: BPT, 1975             BPT, 1974. paper.
> and 1976. paper.                             51. Spiritual Potencies of that Consecrated
> 31. Importance of Teaching Indigenous                  Spot. n.p. 1939 . paper.
> People, The. comp. the Universal House       52. Unfoldment of World Civilization, The.
> of Justice . NSA of Canada, 1968. paper.          New York: BPC, 1936. Wilmette: BPC,
> 32. Letters from Shoghi Effendi. New York:             1945. paper.
> BPC, 1925. paper.                            53. World Government and Collective Sec-
> 33. Letters from the Guardian to Australia and         urity. New Delhi: NSA of India, Pakistan
> New Zealand I 923-1957. Melbourne:                and Burma, 1953. paper.
> NSA of Australia and New Zealand, 1970       54. World Moves on to Its Destiny, The. Wiland 1971. cloth.                                  mette: BPC, n.d. paper.
> 34. Lifeblood of the Cause. comp . the Univer-    55 . World Order of Baha'u'llah, The. New
> sal House of Justice. London: BPT,                York: BPC, 1929. paper.
> (1970). paper.                               56. World Order of Baha'u'llah, The. New
> 35. Living the Life. comp. NSA of the British          York: BPC, 1938. Wilmette: BPC, 1944.
> Isles. London: BPT, 1974. paper.                  Wilmette: BPT, 1955, 1969 and 1974.
> 36. Local Spiritual Assembly, The. comp. the           cloth fabrikoid and paper.
> Universal House of Justice. Wilmette:        57. World Order of Baha'u'llah - Further
> 562                                THE BAHA•t WORLD
> 
> Considerations, The. New York: BPC;           58. World Order Unfolds. Wilmette: BPC,
> 1930.paper.                                       1952.paper.
> 
> (vi) MESSAGES AND COMPILATIONS OF THE UNIVERSAL HOUSE OF
> JUSTICE
> 
> 1. Analysis of the Nine Year International       5. Constitution ofthe Universal House ofJus-
> Teaching Plan 1964 - 1973. Wilmette:             tice, The. Haifa: The Universal House of
> BPT, 1964. paper.                                Justice, 1972. paper.
> 2. Analysis of the Five Year International       6. Five Year Plan, The. Wilmette: BPT,
> Teaching Plan 1974-1979. Welwyn Gar-              1974. paper.
> den City, Hertfordshire: Broadwater,          7. Five Year Plan, 1974-1979: Statistical
> 1975. paper.                                     Report, Ridvan 1978, The. Haifa: Baha'i
> 3. Baha'i Faith, Statistical Information            World Centre, 1978. paper.
> 1844 - 1968, The. Haifa: P. Schaut, 1968.     8. Messages from the Universal House ofJuspaper. (see also section on Shoghi Effendi       tice 1968- 1973. Wilmette: BPT, 1976.
> #4-6 and the section entitled "Writings          paper and cloth.
> on the Baha'i Faith" #24) .                   9. Wellspring of Guidance, Messages from
> 4. Baha'i Holy Places at the World Centre,          the Universal House ofJustice 1963-1968.
> The. Haifa: The Universal House of Jus-           Wilmette: 1969 and 1970. paper and
> tice, 1968. cloth.                               cloth.
> 
> (vii) WRITINGS ON THE BAHA'f FAITH
> 
> 1. 'Abdu'l-Baha, Fiftieth Anniversary of His     9. Amatu'l-Baha Visits India. Violette
> Passing. Wilmette:       World Order             Nakhjavani. New Delhi: BPT, n.d .
> Magazine, 1971. paper and cloth.                 paper.
> 2. Abdul Baha in Egypt. Ahmad Sohrab.           10. Appreciations of the Baha'( Faith. Wil-
> New York: New History Foundation,                mette: BPC, 1941, 1947, and 1948.
> 1929. London: Ryder & Co., n.d. cloth.          paper.
> 3. 'Abdu'l-Baha the Center of the Covenant.     11. Architectural Compositions in the Indian
> Juliet Thompson. Wilmette: BPC, 1948.            Style. Designs for Temples and Shrines.
> paper.                                           Charles Mason Remey. Boston: The
> 4. 'Abdu'l-Baha the Centre of the Covenant          Tudor Press, 1923 . paper.
> of Baha'u'llah. Hasan M. Balyuzi. Lon-       12. Architectural Exhibition of a Series of
> don: George Ronald, 1971 and 1972.               Preliminary Designs by Charles Mason
> paper and cloth.                                 Remey for the Mashrak El Azkar ( Baha'(
> 5. Abdul Baha's First Days in America.              Temple). n.p. n.d . paper.
> comp. Juliet Thompson. East Aurora,          13. Auguste Foret and the Bahti'( Faith with
> N.Y.: The Roycrofte rs, 1924. paper.             Commentary by Peter Muhlschlegel.
> 6. Addresses. Abdel Karim Effendi Tehe-             Oxford: George Ronald, 1978. paper.
> rani. trans. Anton F. Haddad. Chicago:       14. Bab, the Herald of the Day of Days, .The.
> Behais Supply and Publishing Board,              Hasan M. Balyuzi. Oxford: George
> 1900.paper.                                     Ronald, 1973 and 1973. paper and cloth.
> 7. Akka Lights. Mr. & Mrs. Joseph H. Han-       15. Bab-Ed-Din, the Door of True Relignen . 1909. paper.                                ion.   Ibrahim      George    Kheiralla.
> 8. All Things Made New. John Ferraby.               Chicago: Chas. H. Kerr and Company,
> London: George Allen & Unwin, 1957                1897.paper.
> and 1960. New York: Macmillan Co.,           16. Bahti'( Appeal for Religious Freedom in
> 1958. Wilmette: BPT, 1960 and 1963.             Iran. NSA of USA. Wilmette: BPT,
> London: BPT, 1975. paper and cloth.               1956.paper.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                       563
> 17. Bahai Attitude Toward War, The. San               Mason Remey . Chicago: BPS, 1919.
> Francisco Baha'i Assembly n.d. paper.           cloth. (same as #204).
> 18 . Bah{/{ Case Against Mrs. Lewis             35. Bahai Manuscripts. Charles Mason
> Stuyyvesant Chanler and Mirza Ahmad            Remey . Newport, R.I.: 1923 . paper.
> Sohrab-A Statement Prepared for the       36. Bahai Martyrdoms in Persia in the Year
> Members of the American Baha'i Com-            1903 A.D. Haji Mirza Haydar Ali. trans.
> munity, The. Wilmette: NSA of the USA          Dr. Youness Khan. Chicago: BPS, 1904
> and Canada. 1941. paper.                       and 1917 rev. paper.
> 19. Bahd'f Centenary 1844-1944, The.            37. Bahai Message, The. comp. Horace Hol-
> Wilmette: BPC, 1944. fabrikoid.                ley. Chicago: BPS, 1920. paper.
> 20. Bahai Congress. Chicago: 1916 . paper.       38. Bahai Movement, A Series of Nineteen
> 21. Bahai Faith, The. G. Palgrave Simpson.            Papers Upon the Bahai Movement, The.
> London: 1920. paper.                           Charles Mason Remey. Washington: J.
> 22. Bahd'( Faith, An Introduction, The.               D. Milans and Sons, 1912 and 1912
> Gloria Faizi. Beirut, 1971. Wilmette:          (actually printed several years later) .
> BPT, 1972, 1975 and 1978. paper.               cloth.
> 23. Bahd'( Faith by a Methodist Layman,          39. Bahai Movement for Universal Religion,
> The. A. J . Truesdell. New York: BPC,          Brotherhood, and Peace, A Sketch of Its
> 1925.paper.                                    History and Teachings, The. Charles
> 24. Baha'i Faith, Statistical Information             Mason Remey . Washington: Persian-
> 1844-1963, The . comp. the Hands of the        American Bulletin, 1912. paper.
> Cause Residing in the Holy Land. Ramat    40. Baha'i Movement: Aims & Purposes of
> Gan Israel, Peli-P.E .C. Printing Works        the Bahd'f Faith, Outline of History, Prin-
> Ltd. paper. (see also the section on           ciples of Administration, Excerpts from
> Shoghi Effendi #4-6 and the section on         the Sacred Writings, and Reading List,
> the Universal House of Justice #3) .           The . comp. NSA of USA and Canada.
> 25. Baha'( Faith, The Dawn of a New Day,              New York: BPC, 1931. paper.
> The. Jessyca Russell Gaver. New York;     41. Bahai Movement in Its Social-Economic
> Hawthorn Books Inc., 1967. cloth. (same        Aspect, The. Helen Campbell. Chicago:
> as #113) .                                     BPS, 1915. paper. (see# 50).
> 26. Bahd'( Follower ofthe Light. Ray Meyer.      42 . Bahai       Movement- Its         Spiritual
> NSA of Australia, 1972 . Wilmette: BPT.        Dynamic, The. Albert R. Vail. n.p. n.d.
> paper.                                         paper.
> 27. Bahd'( Glossary. Marzieh Gail. Wil-          43. Baha'i Persecutions in Persia. comp.
> mette: BPT, 1955 and 1969. paper.              NSA of USA and Canada. New York:
> 28. Bahd'( Group, The. comp. NSA of USA.              BPC, 1926. paper.
> Wilmette: BPT, 1958. paper.               44. Bahai Proofs. Mirza Abu! Fazl. trans.
> 29. Bahai House of Worship, Description of            Ishteal Ibn Kalantar (Ali Quli Khan).
> the Temple with Illustrations, The.             Chicago: BPS, 1914. New York: BPC,
> Charles Mason Remey. Chicago: BPS,             1929. cloth. (see also #78) .
> 1917.paper.                               45. Bahai Religion, The. Horace Holley and
> 30 . . Bahai Hymns and Poems. Louise R.               Ruhi Afnan. New York : BPC, 1925 .
> Waite . Chicago: BPS, 1904. New York:          paper.
> BPC, 1927 . paper.                         46 . Bahai Revelation, The. Thornton Chase.
> 31. Bahai Hymns of Peace and Praise. L. R.            Chicago: BPS, 1909, 1913 and 1919.
> Waite. n.p. 1908 . paper.                      New York: BPC, (1928) . paper and
> 32. Bahai Indexes. Charles Mason Remey.               cloth.
> Newport, R.I.: 1923 . paper.              47. Bahai Revelation, The. Mrs. Scaramucci.
> 33. Bahai Library Committee. Charles                  London: The Priory Press, 1911. paper.
> Mason Remey. Firenze, Italy: 1925.         48. Bahai Revelation and Reconstruction,
> paper.                                          The. Charles Mason Remey. Chicago:
> 34. Bahai Library of Constructive Religion,           BPS, 1919. paper and cloth.
> The Peace of the World, The. Charles       49. Bahaism: The Modern Social Religion.
> 564                                THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Horace Holley. London: Sidgwick &                1976), The. Haifa: The Baha'i World
> Jackson Ltd., 1913. New York: Mitchell           Centre. 1979. cloth.
> Kennerly, 1913. cloth.                      70. Baha'i Writings, A Concordance. comp.
> 50. Bahaism in Its Social- Economic Aspect.          Hugh Carden. NSA of New Zealand,
> Helen Campbell. Chicago: BPS, 1910.              Feb. 1975, Aug. 1975, Jan. 1976. and
> paper. (see also #41 of this section).          Sep. 1976. paper.
> 51. Bahaism the Religion of Brotherhood         71. Bahti'{ Year Book Volume 1 (1925 -
> and Its Place in the Evolution of Creeds.        1926), The. New York: BPC, 1926.
> Francis Henry Skrine. London: Long-              cloth. (see #53-67 of this section).
> mans Green and Company, 1912. cloth.        72. Baha'u'llah. Hasan M. Balyuzi. London:
> 52. Bahai Teachings, The. Charles Mason             BPT, 1938 and n.p. 1938, paper.
> Remey. Washington: J. D. Milans &           73. Bahti'u'llah. Hasan M. Balyuzi. London:
> Sons, 1917. cloth.                              George Ronald, 1963, 1968, 1970,
> 53. Bahai Temple: Press Comments, Symbol-           1972, 1973, 1974 and 1976. paper and
> ism, The. comp. Louis Bourgeois.                cloth.
> Chicago: 1921. paper.                       74. Bahli'u'llah and the New Era. John
> 54. Bahai the Spirit of the Age. Horace Hol-        Ebenezer Esslemont. London: George
> ley. London: Kegan Paul Trench                  Allen & Unwin Ltd., 1923 and 1940.
> Trubner & Co., 1921. New York: Bren-            New York: Brentano's, (1924) and
> tano's, 1921. cloth .                           (1925). New York: BPC, 1927, 1930,
> 55. Bahli'( World Volume II (1926-1928),            1931, 1932, 1937, 1938 and 1940. Wil-
> The. New York: BPC, 1928. cloth.                mette: BPC, 1942, 1944, 1946, 1948,
> 56. Bahli'( World Volume 1Il (1928 - 1930),         1950 and 1953. Wilmette: BPT, 1956,
> The. New York: BPC, 1930. cloth.                1960, 1966, 1970, 1975, 1976 and 1978.
> 57. Bahli'[ World Volume JV (1930 - 1932),          London: BPT, 1952 and 1974. cloth ,
> The. New York: BPC, 1933 . cloth.               fabrikoid and paper.
> 58. Bahli'{ World Volume V (1932-1934),         75. Bahti'u'llah and His Message. J. E.
> The. New York: BPC, 1936. cloth.                Esslemont. n.p. 1938. paper.
> 59. Bahli'( World Volume VJ (1934-1936) ,       76. Bahti'u'llah's Ground Plan of World Fel-
> The. New York: BPC, 1937. cloth.               lowship. George Townshend. London:
> 60. Bahli'( World Volume VII (1936-1938),           World Congress of Faiths, 1936 and
> The. New York: BPC, 1939. cloth.               1938. paper. (see The Bahti'{ World, vol.
> 61. Bahli'f World Volume VIII (1938-                VI, p. 614).
> 1940), The. Wilmette: BPC, 1942.           77. Before Abraham Was I Am. Thornton
> cloth.                                         Chase. Chicago: 1902. paper.
> 62. Bahli'( World Volume IX (1940-1944),        78. Behai Proofs, The. Mirza Abu! Faze!.
> The. Wilmette: BPC, 1945. cloth.               trans. Ishteal Ibn Kalantar (Ali Quli
> 63. Bahli'( World Volume X (1944-1946),             Khan). New York: J. W. Pratt Co., 1902.
> The. Wilmette: BPC, 1949. cloth.               cloth. (see also #42 of this section).
> 64. Bahli'( World Volume XI (1946-1950),        79. Bounties of the Kingdom - A Fairy Play,
> The. Wilmette: BPC, 1952. cloth.               The. Evangeline Elizabeth Crowell Dun-
> 65. Baho.'{ World Volume XII (1950 - 1954),         lop. Riverton, N.J.: The New Era Press,
> The. Wilmette: BPT, 1956. cloth.               1916.paper.
> 66. Bahti'( World Volume XIII (1954-            80. Brief Accountofthe Bahai Movement, A.
> 1963), The. Haifa: The Universal House         G. Palgrave Simpson and Ethel J.
> of Justice, 1970 and 1971. cloth.              Rosenberg. West Kensington, Eng.:
> 67. Bahti'( World Volume XIV (1963-                 Burnside Ltd. n.d. London: The Priory
> 1968), The. Haifa : The Baha'i World           Press, J.M. Watkins, 1911. paper.
> Centre, 1975 . cloth.                      81. Brief Account of My Visit to Acea, A.
> 68. Baho.'{ World Volume XV (1968 - 1973),          Mary L Lucas . Chicago: BPS, 1905.
> The. Haifa: The Baha'i World Centre,           paper.
> 1976. cloth.                               82. Brief Sketch of Behaism, A. Ethel J.
> 69. Bahti'{ World Volume XVI (1968-                  Rosenberg. London: R . F. Hunger, 310
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                       565
> Euston Rd., N.W., 1905. paper.                    Mu~ammad - i-Zarandi.      trans. Shoghi
> 83. Brilliant Proof, The. Mirza Abu! Faz!.             Effendi . New York: BPC, 1932 (a
> Chicago: Bahai News Service, 1912.                limited edition specially bound number-
> Wilmette: BPC, 1949. paper.                       ing 150 copies autographed by the trans-
> 84. Buddha and Amitabha. Shirin Fozdar.                lator) and 1932 (the regular edition) .
> Calcutta: Daw Sen & Co ., printed at the         Wilmette: BPC, 1953. Wilmette: BPT,
> Anna Art Press Private Ltd. paper.               1962, 1970 and 1974. London: BPT,
> 85. Buddha       Maitraya Amitabha Has                 1953 and 1975 . leather, cloth and paper.
> Appeared. Jamshid Fozdar. New Delhi:         99. Dawn of Knowledge and the Most Great
> BPT, 1976. cloth and paper.                      Peace, The. Paul Kingston Dealy.
> 86. Call of God, The. George Orr Latimer.              Chicago: BPS, 1903, 1905 and 1908.
> Chicago: BPS , n.d . paper.                      paper.
> 87. Character, A Sequence in Spiritual           100. Dawn Over Mount Hira and Other
> Psychology. Stanwood Cobb. Washing-              Essays. Marzieh Gail. Oxford: George
> ton: The Avalon Press, 1938 and 1971.            Ronald, 1976. cloth.
> paper and cloth.                           101. Declaration of Trust and By-Laws of a
> 88. Chosen Highway, The. Lady Blomfield.               Local Spiritual Assembly. New York:
> London: BPT, n.d. Wilmette: BPC, n.d .           BPC, 1933. Wilmette: NSA of the USA
> Wilmette: BPT, 1967 and 1970 . paper             and Canada, 1945. Wilmette: BPC,
> and cloth.                                       1949. Wilmette: BPT, 1965 , 1969 and
> 89. Christ and Bahd'u'llah. George Towns-              1975.paper.
> hend. London: George Ronald, 1957,         102. Diary Letters of Mirza Ahmad Sohrab .
> 1957,1966,1967, 1971 , 1972and1976.              Chicago: Mrs. Fanny G. Lesch. (various
> Wilmette: BPT, 1967 and 1970. paper              volumes) cardboard.
> and cloth.                                 103 . Divine Revelation the Basis of All Civil-
> 90. Christianity of Jesus, The. Richard                ization . Anton F. Haddad. New York:
> Backwell. Portlaw, Ireland: Volturna             Boa rd of Counsel, 1902. paper.
> Press, 1972. cloth.                        104. Divine Secret for Human Civilization,
> 91. Closer Than Your Lije V ein. Henry A .             The. n.p. n.d. paper.
> Weil. NSA of Alaska, 1978. paper.          105. Divine Secret for Human Civilization,
> 92 . Coming of the Glory. The. Florence E .            The. Josephine D. Storey. Geneva,
> Pinchon. London: Simpkin Marshall                Switz.: Quo Vadis, 1928. paper.
> Ltd., 1928. cloth .                        106. Divine Springtime. Daniel Nelson
> 93. Commentary on the Will and Testament               Wegener.      Tegucigalpa,      Honduras:
> of 'Abdu'l-Baha. David Hofman . Lon-             Union Press, 1977. paper.
> don: George Ronald, 1943, 1947 and         107. Divine Symphony. Gayle Woolson. New
> 1955.paper.                                      Delhi: BPT, 1971and1977. paper.
> 94. Constructive Principles of the Bahai         108 . Do' a: The Call to Prayer. Ruth Ellis Mof-
> Movement. Charles Mason Remey.                   fett. Chicago: 1933 , 1938 and 1953.
> Washington: J. D. Milans & Sons, 1917 .          paper.
> Chicago: BPS, 1917. paper and cloth.       109. Do' a: On the Wings of Prayer. Ruth Ellis
> 95. Continuity of the Prophets, The. Myrtle            Moffett. Des Moines, Ia.: Wallace
> W. Campbell. New York: The Pageant               Homestead Co ., 1974. paper.
> Press, 1952. cloth.                        110. Dr. J. E. Esslemont. Moojan Momen .
> 96 . Covenant, The. Charles Mason Remey.               London: BPT, 1975.paper.
> Washington: Bahai Assembly of              111. Drama of the Kingdom, The. Mrs. Basil
> Washington D.C., 1912. paper and card-           Hall. London: The Weardale Press,
> board.                                           1933. cloth.
> 97. Daily Lessons Received at Acea, January      112. Dream of God, The. Albert Durant Wat-
> 1908. Helen S. Goodall and Ella Goodall          son. Chicago: BPS, 1922. paper.
> .cooper. Chicago: BPS, 1908 and 1917.       113. Dynamic New Religion Bahti'[ Faith,
> cardboard.                                       The. Jessyca Russell Gaver. New York:
> 98. Dawn-Breakers, The. Nabfl-i-A'pm                   Award Books, 1968 and 1968. paper.
> 566                                 THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> (see also #25 of this section).                 a Continent. Commemorating the Fiftieth
> 114. Early Pilgrimage, An. May Maxwell. n.p.          Anniversary of the Arrival of the Baha'i
> 1917. London: George Ronald, 1953,              Faith in Australia 18 April 1970. Pad-
> 1969, 1974 and 1976. paper.                     dington, New South Wales: NSA of
> 115. Earth is but One Country, The. John              Australia, 1970. paper.
> Huddleston. London: BPT, 1976. cloth.      131. Freedom of Religion on Trial in
> 116. Edward Gran ville Browne and the Baha'i          Morocco-The Nador Case. New York:
> Faith. Hasan M. Balyuzi. London:                Baha'i Information Center, 1963. paper.
> George Ronald, 1970. cloth.                132. From Strength to Strength. Eunice Braun.
> 117. Episodes in the Life of Moneereh                 Wilmette: BPT, 1978. paper.
> Khanum. trans. Ahmad Sohrab. Los           133. Glimpses of Abdul Baha. 'Roy'
> Angeles: Persian-American Publishing            (Wilhelm) and M. J. M. (Mountfort J.
> Co., 1924. paper.                               Mills). n.p. n.d. paper.
> 118. Epistle to the Bahai World, An. Mirza       134. Glorious Kingdom of the Father Fore-
> Badi'Ullah. trans. Dr. Ameen'Ullah              told, The. Virgie V. Vail. New York:
> Fareed. Chicago: BPS, 1908. paper.              BPC, 1940. fabrikoid.
> 119. Essential Mysticism, The. Stanwood          135. God, His Mediator and Man-A Study in
> Cobb . Boston: The Four Seas Company,           Comparative Religion. Pritan Singh and
> 1918. cloth.                                    Doris McKay. Wilmette: BPT, 1958.
> 120. Eternal Voice, The. Cornelia A. Norder.          paper.
> Rhinelander, Wis.: Legacy Press, 1972      136. God Loves Laughter. William Sears.
> and 197 5. paper.                               London: George Ronald, 1960, 1961,
> 121. Explanations Concerning Sacred Mys-              1964, 1968, 1970 and 197 4. paper and
> teries. Mirza Assad'Ullah. trans. Dr.           cloth.
> Fareed. Chicago: Behais Supply and         137. God's Heroes. Laura Clifford Barney.
> Publishing Board, 1902. cloth.                  London: Kegan Paul Trench Trubner &
> 122. Fallacy of Ancestor Worship, The.                Co ., 1910. Philadelphia: Lippincott,
> Jamshed Fozdar. Bombay, 1965. paper.            1910. cloth.
> 123. 52 Baha'i Talks for Every Occasion. S. I.   138. Great Themes of Life. Eric Bowes. Wil-
> Dean. NSA of Malaysia, (1965) and               mette: BPT, 1958. cloth.
> 1977. paper.                               139. Heart of the Gospel, The. George Towns-
> 124. Fire on the Mountaintop. Gloria Faizi.           hend. London: Lindsay Drummond,
> London: BPT, 1973. paper.                       1939. New York: BPC, 1940. London:
> 125. Firmness in the Covenant. Charles Mason          George Ronald, 1951, 1955 and 1960.
> Remey. 1918. n.p. paper.                        Wilmette: BPT, 1972. paper and cloth.
> 126. Five Preliminary Architectural Sketches     140. Heralds of Peace. Beatrice Irwin. n.p.
> for the Temple of the Mashrak-El-Azkar,          1938.paper.
> which the Followers of the Bahai Move-     141. Heavenly Feast, Some Utterances of
> ment are to Build Upon the Shore of Lake        Abdul-Baha to Two American Pilgrims
> Michigan at Chicago. Washington: 1916.           (Charles and Mariam Haney) in Acea,
> paper.                                           Syria, February 1909-lnterpreted by
> 127. Flame of Fire, A. A. Q. Faizi. New Delhi:         Dr. Fareed and Taken Down in Steno-
> BPT, 1969 and 1973. paper.                      graphic Notes by Mariam Haney During 9
> 128. Flame-The Story of Lua, The. William              Days in Acea, A. n.p. n.d. paper.
> Sears and Robert Quigley. London:          142. Heavenly Vista, A. Louis Gregory.
> George Ronald, 1972. paper and                  Washington: R. L. Pendleton, 1911.
> encased.                                         paper.
> 129 . Flowers Culled from the Rose Garden of     143. Heavens are Cleft Asunder, The. Husch-
> Akka. Ida A. Finch, Fanny A . Knobloch           mand Sabet. Oxford: George Ronald,
> and Alma S. Knobloch. n.p. (1910).              1975. paper and cloth.
> paper.                                    144. History of the Bahti'( Faith in Japan
> 130. Follow a Dream Time, Father and                   1914-1938. Agnes Baldwin Alexander.
> Mother Dunn the Spiritual Conquerors of          Japan: BPT, 1977. paper.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                       567
> 145. Illustrated Description of a Design in the          Center, n.d. paper.
> Persian-Indian Style of Architecture for     157. Lectures Giving the Solution of the
> the First Mashrak El Azkar ( Bahai Tem-            World's Problems from a Universal
> ple) to Be Erected in America. Humbly              Standpoint Series No. 4, Man is the Col-
> Offered to the Center of the Covenant              lective Center of All Phenomena, etc.
> through the Bahai Temple Unity by                  Mirza Jenabe Faze!. trans. Mirza Ahmad
> C.M.R. April 26-28, 1920. Washington:              Sohrab. Seattle: The Bahai Literature
> C.M.R., 1920. paper.                               Center. paper.
> 146. In Galilee and In Spirit and In Truth.        158. Lectures Giving the Solution of the
> Thornton Chase and Arthur S. Agnew.                World's Problems from a Universal
> Chicago: BPS, 1908. paper. (see #147).             Standpoint Series No. 5, The New Vision
> 147 . In Galilee and In Wonderland. Thornton             of Immortality, etc. Mirza Jenabe Faze!.
> Chase and Arthur S. Agnew. Chicago:                trans. Mirza Ahmad Sohrab. Seattle: The
> BPS, 1921. paper. (see #146).                      Bahai Literature Center, n.d. paper.
> 148. Indian Style ofArchitecture, The. Charles     159. Lesson in Religion. Mohammed Ali
> Mason Remey. Boston: 1925. paper.                   Alkany. trans. Edith Roohie Sanderson.
> 149. Instruction Given by Mirza Assad Ullah              Boston: The Tudor Press, 1923. paper.
> to Isabella D. Brittingham in Johnstown,     160. Lessons on the Beha Revelation, in sepa-
> New York November, 1900, and Taken                 rate parts. W. Hooper Harris. Bayonne,
> Down in Notes from His Lips as He                   N.J.: Charles E. Sprague, (1901). paper.
> Spoke, An . n.d. n.p. paper.                 161. Letter from Honolulu, A. Charles Mason
> 150. Instructions Concerning Genesis and the             Remey. Honolulu: Charles Mason
> Mystery of Baptism. Mirza Assad 'Ullah.            Remey, Feb. 17, 1917. paper.
> trans. Alla Khuli Khan. n.p. n.d. paper.     162. Letter Written by Mirza Abu/ Hussein on
> 151. Karma and the Fallacy of Reincarnation.             Behalf of the 'Friends' of Isfahan Persia,
> Jamshed Fozdar. Malaysia: BPT, 1977.               to the American Believers. trans . Mirza
> paper.                                             Ameen 'Ullah (Fareed). April 25, 1902.
> 152. Knock and It Shall Be Opened to You.                n.p. paper.
> 'Roy' (Wilhelm) and M. J.M. (Mountfort       163. Life and Teachings of Abbas Effendi,
> J. Mills). n.p. n.d. paper.                         The. Myron H. Phelps. New York: G. P.
> 153. Knowing God Through Love and                        Putnam's Sons, 1903, 1904 and 1912.
> Farewell Address of Mirza Abu! Faz/.               cloth.
> Washington:      Bahai Assembly of          164. Life Plan, A. Peter Esslemont. London:
> Washington D.C., 1904. paper.                     George Ronald, 1953. cloth.
> 154. Lectures Giving the Solution of the           165 . Life with Nayan. Stanwood Cobb.
> World's Problems from a Universal                  Washington: Avalon Press, 1969. paper.
> Standpoint Series No. 1, Fulfillment in      166. Light of the World, The. by a group of
> this Age of the Old and New Testament              pilgrims. Boston: George Orr Latimer,
> Prophecies etc. Mirza Jenabe Faze!.                1920.paper.
> trans, Mirza Ahmad Sohrab. Seattle: The      167. Light Shineth in Darkness, The. Udo
> Bahai Literature Center, n.d. paper.               Schaefer. Oxford: George Ronald, 1977.
> 155. Lectures Giving the Solution of the                 paper.
> World's Problems from a Universal            168. Martinist's Report, An Investigation of
> Standpoint Series No. 2, The Ideals of the         Bahaism. Gabriel Sassi. trans. Honore J.
> New Age etc. Mirza Jenabe Faze!. trans.            Jaxon. Chicago: Behais Supply and Pub-
> Mirza Ahmad Sohrab. Seattle: The                   lishing Board, 1901. paper.
> Bahai Literature Center, n.d. paper.         169. Mashrak-El-Azkar.        Charles Mason
> 156. Lectures Giving the Solution of the                 Remey. n.p. 1916. paper.
> World's Problems from a Universal            170. Mashrak-El-Azkar, Descriptive of the
> Standpoint Series No. 3, The Universal             Bahai Temple and Illustrative of an
> Consciousness of Christ, etc. Mirza                Exhibition of Preliminary Designs for the
> Jenabe Faze!. Trans. Mirza Ahmad                   First Mashrak-El-Azkar to be Built in
> Sohrab. Seattle: The Bahai Literature              America, Showing Nine Varying Treat-
> 568                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> ments in Different Styles of Architecture.   187. Nabfl's Narrative Abridged. Zena Sorab-
> Charles Mason Remey. Washington: J.               jee . New Delhi: BPT, 1974 and 1976.
> D. Milans & Sons, 1917 . cloth.                   cloth and paper.
> 171. Mashriqul Adhkar and the Bahai Move-          188. NarcissustoAkka, The. A.Q.Faizi.New
> ment. Jean Masson. Chicago: Executive             Delhi: BPT, n.d . paper.
> Board of the Bahai Temple Unity, 1921.       189. National Spiritual Assembly o fthe Bahd'(s
> paper.                                            of the United States. Wilmette: NSA of
> 172. Maxim of Bahaism, The. Anton F. Had-               USA, 1975. paper.
> dad. New York: Board of Counsel. n.d.        190. New Day, The. Charles Mason Remey.
> paper.                                            Chicago: BPS, 1919. paper and card-
> 173. Meditations of a Bahai Christian. E . T.           board.
> Hall. Manchester: C. E. Bennet and           191. New       Garden ,    The.      Hooshmand
> Company, 1912. paper.                             Fathea'zam . New Delhi: BPT, 1958,
> 174. Memories of 'Abdu'l-Bahd. Stanwood                 1963 and 1971. paper.
> Cobb. Washington: The Avalon Press,          192. New Holy City, The. Arthur Pillsbury
> n.d. paper.                                       Dodge. New York: Mutual Publishing
> 175. Memorial Services of Abdul Saha on                 Company, 1901. cloth.
> Mount Carmel, Palestine. comp. Dr. Zia       193. New Keys to the Book of Revelation.
> Bagdadi. n.p. 1922. paper.                        Ruth J. Moffett. New Delhi: BPT, 1977.
> 176. Message from Acea, A. Anton F. Had-                cloth and paper.
> dad. Board of Counsel (New York), n.d .      194. New Light on the Spirit Path, The. Ted
> paper .                                           Claus. Wilmette: BPT, 1971. paper.
> 177. Message of the Kingdom of God, The.           195. New Revelation: Its Marvelous Message,
> James F. Brittingham. Chicago: BPS,               The. Col. Nathan Ward Fitzgerald.
> 1907 and 1909. paper.                             Tacoma, Wash.: 1905. paper and cloth.
> 178. Message of Unity-The Bahai Move-              196. Nonagonal Temple in the Indian Style of
> ment, The. Charles Mason Remey.                   Architecture, A. Charles Mason Remey.
> Washington: Oct. 19, 1908. paper.                 Italy: 1927. paper.
> 179. Milly, A. Tribute to Amelia E. Collins.       197. Notes Taken at Acea. Corinne True.
> Abu'l-Qasim Faizi. Oxford: George                 Chicago: BPS, 1907. paper.
> Ronald, 1977. paper.                         198. Not Every Sea Hath Pearls. Loulie Albee
> 180. Mission of Bahd'u'llah and Other Liter-            Mathews. Milford, N.H.: The Cabinet
> ary Pieces, The. George Townshend.                Press, 1951. paper (earlier printings have
> London: George Ronald, 1952. Wil-                 the title imprinted on the spine).
> mette: BPT, 1967 and 1971. cloth.            199. Observations of a Bahai Traveller.
> 181. Most Great Peace, The. Boston: The                 Charles Mason Remey. Washington:
> Tudor Press, 1916. Shanghai, China: Ta            Carnahan Press, (1909). Washington: J.
> Tung She, 1932. paper.                            D. Milans and Sons, 1915. paper and
> 182. MU.Ila /:fusayn. L. Johnson . n.p. n.d.            cloth.
> Toronto: NSA of Canada, n.d. paper.          200. Oneness of Mankind, The. comp.
> 183. My Pilgrimage to the Land of Desire.               Mariam Haney and Louis Gregory. New
> Marie A. Watson. New York: BPC,                   York: BPC, 1927. paper.
> 1932.paper.                                  201. Open Letter to the Bahais of America,
> 184 . Mysticism and the Baha'i Revelation.              An. Charles Mason Remey. n.p. 1918.
> Ruhi Afnan. New York: BPC, 1934.                  paper.
> paper.                                       202. Oriental Rose or the Teachings of Abdul
> 185. Mysticism, Science and Revelation.                 Saha, The. Mary Hanford Ford. New
> Glenn A. Shook. London: George                    York: Broadway Publishing Company,
> Ronald, 1953, 1954 and 1964. Wilmette:            1910 (of the two printings of the New
> BPT, 1967, 1970, 1974 and 1976. cloth .           York edition the first has a seriffed mono-
> 186. My Visit to Abbas Effendi in 1899. Mar-            gram on the spine, the second a 'bullsgaret Bloodgood Peeke. Chicago: The               eye' monogram). Chicago: BPS, 1910
> Grier Press, 1911. cloth.                         (actually printed at a later date). cloth.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                        569
> 203. Passing of Shoghi Effendi, The. Ruf:ifyyih    215. Protection of the Cause of God, The.
> Khanum and John Ferraby. London:                    Charles Mason Remey. n.p. 1918. paper.
> BPT, 1958. paper.                             216 . Quddus. L. Johnson. n.d. n.p. Toronto:
> 204. Peace of the World, The. Charles Mason              NSA of Canada , n.d. paper.
> Remey. Chicago: BPS, 1919. paper. (see        217. Quest for Eden, The. Elena Maria Maralso #34).                                          sella . New York: The Philosophical Lib-
> 205. Personal Recollections of a Ba ha'{ Life in         rary, 1966 . paper and cloth.
> the Hawaiian Islands, Forty Years of the      218. Race and Man. Maye Harvey Gift and
> Baha'i Cause in Hawaii, 1902 - 1942 .               Alice Simmons Cox. Wilmette: BPC,
> Miss Agnes Alexander. NSA of the Bah-               1943 and 1945. paper.
> a'is of the Hawaiian Islands, 1974. paper.    219 . Radiant Living.         Stanwood Cobb.
> 206. Persian-American Educational Society                Washington: Avalon Press , 1970. paper.
> Incorporated Statement and Constitution       220. Rays from the Sun of Truth. Ida Finch .
> and By-Laws. Washington: 1910. paper.               n.p. n.d. paper.
> 207. Pilgrimage to Thonon, A. Horace Hol-          221. Reconciliation of Races and Religions,
> ley. Letchworth, Herts .: Garden City               The. Thomas Kelly Cheyne. London:
> Press, Ltd., 1911. paper.                           Adam and Charles Black, 1914. cloth.
> 208. Portals to Freedom. Howard Colby Ives.        222. Release the Sun. William Sears. New
> New York: E. P. Dutton & Co ., 1937.                Delhi: BPT, 1957. Wilmette: BPT, 1960,
> Cynthiana , Kentucky: The Hobson                    1964, 1970 and 197 5 . cloth and paper.
> Press, 1943. London: George Ronald ,          223. Religion for Mankind. Horace Holley.
> 1943, 1946, 1948, 1953, 1962and1969.                London: George Ronald, 1956 and
> Wi lmette: BPT, 1967 and 1972. paper                1963. Wilmette: BPT, 1966 and 1976.
> and cloth.                                          paper and cloth.
> 209. Prescription for Living. Ruhiyyih Rab-        224. Religious Unity. Charles Mason Remey.
> bani. London: George Ronald, 1950 (an               June. 1906. n.p. paper.
> edition of 300 copies i'n dark blue cloth     225. Renewal of Civilization, The. David
> serial numbered and autographed by the              Hofman. London: George Ronald,
> author), 1950 (regular edition), 1960               1945,1946,1947,1949,1953,1960and
> and 1969. paper and cloth.                          1969. New Dehli: BPT, 1969 . Wilmette:
> 210. Priceless Pearl, The. Ruhiyyih Rabbani.             BPT, 1970 and 1972. paper and cloth .
> London: BPT, 1969 (an edition of 1500         226. Report of the Bahai Committee of Incopies in red cloth serial numbered and             vestigation 1917-1918. Charles Mason
> autographed by the author) and 1969                 Remey, H. Emogene Hoagg, George 0.
> (regular edition). cloth and paper.                 Latimer and Louis Gregory. n.p. n.d.
> 211. Prisoner and the Kings, The. William                paper.
> Sears. Toronto: General Publishing            227. Report to Abdul Baha of the Bahai
> Company, Ltd., 1971. paper.                         Activities in the States of North Carolina,
> 212. Promise of All Ages, The. Christophil               South Carolina, Georgia and Florida
> (George Townshend) . London: Simpkin                U.S.A Charles Mason Remey. n.p.
> Marshall Ltd., 1934. New York: BPC,                 March-April, 1919. paper.
> 1935. cloth. (see #210).                      228. RevelationofBaha Ullah, The. Isabella D.
> 213. Promise of All Ages, The. George                    Brittingham. Chicago: BPS, 1902 and
> Townshend. New York: BPC, 1938 .                    9th ed. 1920. paper.
> London: Lindsay Drummond, (1940).             229. Revelation of Bahti'u'lltih Volume I
> Wilmette: BPC, 1944. London: George                 (1853-1863).         Adib      Taherzadeh.
> Ronald, 1948 and 1961. Wilmette: BPT,               Oxford: George Ronald, 1974 and 1975.
> 1972. paper and cloth.                              paper and cloth.
> 214. Prospectus: A Series of Five Lectures         230. Revelation of Bahti'u'lltih Volume II
> Upon the Universal Religious and Social             (1863-1868).         Adib      Taherzadeh.
> Principles of the Bahai Movement, A.                Oxford: George Ronald, 1977. cloth.
> Charles Mason Remey. Washington:              231. School of the Prophets, The. Mirza
> 1919.paper.                                         Assad'u'llah. trans. Dr. Fareed. Chicago:
> 570                                 THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> BPS, 1907. cloth.                                Board of Counsel, 1901. paper.
> 232. Secret of Life, The. Mary Hanford Ford.      247. Story of the Bahti'( Movement, A Univer-
> San Francisco: Press of A. Carlisle and          sal Religion, The. Sidney Sprague. Lon-
> Co., Upham and Rutledge Inc., 1933 .              don: The Priory Press, Mayle's Penny
> paper.                                           Series, 1907, 1908 and 1912. paper.
> 233. Security for a Failing World. Stanwood       248. Story of Louis G. Gregory, The. Elsie
> Cobb. Washington: Avalon Press, 1934             Austin. Wilmette: BPT, 1955. paper.
> and 1940. New York: BPC, 1934 and           249. Studies in Jewish Mysticism. Loulie
> 1940. Wilmette: BPC, 1947. New Delhi:            Mathews et al. n.p. n.d. paper.
> BPT, 1971and1977. paper and cloth.          250. Success in Teaching. Rul)iyyih Khanum.
> 234. Series of Twelve Articles Introductory to         Wilmette: BPT, 1965. paper.
> the Study of the Bahti'( Teachings, A.      251. Sunburst. Loral Schopflocher. London:
> Charles Mason Remey. Florence, Italy:            Ryder & Co., 1938. cloth.
> 1925. cloth.                                252. Table Talks by Abdul Baha Taken Down
> 235. Seven Articles Upon the Bahti'( Religious         in Persian by Mirza Hadi at Acea, Feb.
> Movement. Riverton, N.J., 1919. paper.           1907. Trans. A. U. Fareed at Chicago Jul.
> 236. Sheltering Branch, The. Marzieh Gail.             1907, Also Notes Taken by C. True.
> London: BP!, 1941. London: George                Chicago: BPS, 1907. paper.
> Ronald, 1959. Wilmette: BPT, 1968 and       253. Tab le Talks at Acea. Arthur S. Agnew.
> 1970. London: George Ronald, 197 4.              Chicago: BPS, Nov. 1907. paper.
> cloth.                                      254. Table Talks with Abdul Baha in Febru-
> 237. Shoghi Effendi Recollections. Ugo                 ary, 1904. Mr. and Mrs. George T . Win-
> Giachery. Oxford: George Ronald,                 terburn. trans. Mirza Youness Khan.
> 1973. cloth .                                    Chicago: BPS, 1908 and 1915. paper.
> 238. So Great a Cause. Kenneth D. Stephens.       255. I)ihirih. Clara A. Edge. Grand Rapids,
> Healdsburg, Calif.: Naturegraph Pub-              Mich .: Edgeway Publishing Company,
> lishers, 1973. paper and cloth.                   1964. cloth.
> 239. Social Principle, The. Horace Holley.        256. Ttihirih. L. Johnson. n.p. n.d. Toronto:
> New York: L. J. Gomme, 1915 . encased.            NSA of Canada, n.d.
> 240. Some Early Bahti'(s of the West. 0. Z.       257. Ttihirih the Pure: Iran's Greatest Woman.
> Whitehead. Oxford: George Ronald,                 Martha Root. n .p. 1938. paper, cloth and
> 1976 and 1977. cloth.                             cloth with gold lettering.
> 241. Song Celestial, The. Howard Colby Ives.      258. Tarikh-i-Jadid, The. Mirza Husayn of
> Portland, Ore.: Shankle Printing, 1938.           Hamadan. trans. Edward Granville
> Chicago: The Landon Press, 1938 .                 Browne. Cambridge, Eng.: Cambridge
> (reprints of the Shankle printing-with            University Press, 1893. cloth.
> frontispiece 1962 and in reduced size       259. Ten Days in the Light of Acea. Julia M.
> 1973). fabrikoid and cloth .                      Grundy. Chicago: BPS, 1907 and n.d.
> 242. Songs of Prayer and Praise. comp. Louise           Wilmette: BPT, 1979. paper and cloth.
> R. Waite. Chicago: 1912 . paper.            260. Thief in the Night. William Sears. Lon-
> 243. Spell of the Temple, The. Allen Boyer              don: George Ronald, 1961, 1964, 1968,
> McDaniel. New York: The Vantage                   1969, 1972, 1977 and 1978. paper.
> Press, 1953. cloth.
> 261. This Earth One Country. Emeric Sala.
> 244 . Spiritua l Assembly's Growing Pains, A.            Boston: Bruce Humpheries Inc., 1945.
> Amatu'I-Baha Ru~yyih Khanum. New                  cloth.
> Delhi: BPT, n.d. Sydney: NSA of             262. Three Meditations on the Eve of
> Australia, 1976. paper.                           November the Fourth. Abu! Qasim Faizi.
> 245. Statement on the Will and Testament of             London:BPT,1970and1972.cloili.
> 'Abdu'l-Bahti, Charter of a Divine Civil-   263. Through Warring Countries to the Mounization. Wilmette: NSA of USA and                 tain of God. Charles Mason Remey.
> Canada, 1942.paper.                               Washington: Charles Mason Remey,
> 246. Station of the Manifestation and the               1915. cloth.
> Greatness of the Day, The. New York:        264. Tomorrow and Tomorrow. Stanwood
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                        571
> Cobb. Washington: Avalon Press, 1951.        270. Trustees of the Merciful. NSA of the
> Wilmette: BPC, 1951. Wilmette: BPT,                USA. Wilmette: BPT, 1958, paper.
> 1960 and 1970. paper.                        271. Trustees of the Merciful. Adib Taher-
> 265. Translation of a Letter Written by the             zadeh. London: BPT, 1972. paper.
> Hebrew Assembly of the Bahais of Tehe-       272 . Truth of It, The. Arthur Pillsbury Dodge .
> ran Persia to the House of Spirituality            New York: The Mutual Publishing Com-
> Chicago Ill. for the Perusal of all Ameri-         pany, 1901. cloth.
> can Friends. New York: Baha'i Board of       273. Twenty-Five Years of the Guardianship.
> Counsel, n.d. paper.                               RuJ:i.iyyih Khanum. Wilmette: BPC,
> 266. Translation ofthe French Footnotes ofthe           1948. paper.
> Dawn-Breakers.        Emily       McBride    274. 239 Days, 'Abdu'l-Baha's Journey in
> Perigord. New York: BPC, 1939. Wil-                America. Allan L. Ward. Wilmette: BPT,
> mette: BPT, 1970. paper.                           1979. cloth.
> 267. Treasures of the East. Dr. Zia M. Bag-       275. Two Shall Appear. Olivia Kelsey. n.p.
> dadi. Chicago: (1929). cloth.                      1943. Independence, Mo.: Lambert
> 268. Tribute to Shoghi Effendi, A. Amelia               Moon, 1943. paper.
> Collins. Wilmette: BPT, n.d. paper.          276. Unity-The Revelation of Baha' Ullah.
> 269. Trouble, How to Meet It-Better Still               Charles Mason Remey. n.p. 1905. paper.
> How to Avoid It. Stanwood Cobb.              277. Unity Through Love. Howard MacNutt.
> Washington: Avalon Press, 1970. paper.             from notes of Hooper Harris. Chicago:
> 
> Bahli'( literature display sponsored by the Bahli'f Publishing Trust of Italy during the annual
> Milan Trade Fair held on I 4-23 April I 978. Bahli'f books in ten languages and in Braille were
> exhibited.
> 572                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> BPS, 1906 nd 1908. paper.                         Mathews. New York: BPC, 1929. paper.
> 278. Unity Triumphant. Elizabeth Herrick.         287. Whence? Why? Whither? Man! Things!
> London: Kegan Paul Trench Trubner &               Other Things! Arthur Pillsbury Dodge.
> Company, 1923. cloth.                             Westwood, Mass.: The Arie l Press, G. E.
> 279. Universal Consciousness of the Bahti'(            Littlefield, 1907. cloth .
> Religion, The. Charles Mason Remey.          288. Whoso Readeth Let Him Understand.
> Firenze, Italy: Tipografia Sordamoti,             David. New York: n.d. paper.
> 1925 . paper and cloth.                      289. Wine of Astonishment, The. William
> 280. Universal Principles of the Bahti'f Move-         Sears. London: George Ronald, 1963,
> ment, Social, Economic, Governmental,             1970 and 1974. paper.
> The. Washington: The Persian-Ameri-          290. Wise Man From the East, A. Felicia R.
> can Bulletin, 1912. paper.                        Scratchard. The Unity Press, 1912.
> 281. Universal Religion, The. E . T. Hall. NSA         paper.
> of the British Isles, 1927. paper.           291. World Faith, A. New York: BPC, 1936.
> 282. Universal Religion: Bahaism, The. Hip-            paper.
> polyte Dreyfus. London: Cope & Fen-          292. World of Abdul Baha, The. Mary Hanwick, 1909. Chicago: BPS, 1909. cloth.            ford. New York: Reality Publishing Cor-
> 283. Views of Acea, Haifa , Mount Carmel and           poration, 1921. New York: J. J. Little &
> Other Holy Places. Chicago: Behais Sup-           Ives, 1935 and n.d. also n.p. n.d.
> ply and Publishing Board, n.d. Chicago:      293. Year With the Ba ha is ofIndia and Burma,
> BPS, 1918. paper, cloth and leather.              A. Sidney Sprague. London: The Priory
> 284. What is a Bahai? J. E. Esslemont. Burn-           Press, 1908 and 1908. paper and cloth.
> side Ltd., n.d. Chicago: Louis Bourgeois,    294. Za-Ti-Et Al-Lah; The Identity and the
> 1921. paper.                                      Personality of God. Ibrahim George
> 285. What Went Ye Out For to See? Thornton             Kheiralla. Chicago: Grant's Printery,
> Chase. n.p. n.d. paper.                           1896.paper.
> 286. Whence Comes the Light? Loulie
> 
> B . AN ALPHABETICAL LISTING OF AUTHORS, COMPILERS AND
> TRANS LA TORS OF BAHA'I BOOKS AND BOOKLETS IN THE
> ENGLISH LANGUAGE
> 
> Compiled by Robert E. Cadwalader
> 
> Abbreviations
> A-'Abdu'l-Baha
> B -Baha'u'llah
> C -Compilat ions of the Writings of the
> Central Figures of the Faith
> S -Shoghi Effendi
> W-Writings on the Baha'f Faith
> 
> Abu'l-Fac;ll, Abul Fazl, or Abul Fazel see Gul-   Ameen'Ullah (Aminu'llah Farid) see Fareed,
> paygani, Mirza Abu'l-Fac;ll                       Mirza Ameen 'Ullah
> Abu'I Hussein, Mfrza-W- 159                       Assad'Ullah, Mirza (Asadu'llah)-W-121,
> Afnan, Ruhi-W-45, 184                               150,231
> Afrukhtih, Dr. Youness Khan (Dr. Yunis            Austin, Elsie-W-248
> Khan Afrukhtih)- W-36, 254                      Backwell, Richard-W-90
> Agnew, Arthur S.- W- 146, 147, 250                Badf'Ullah, Mirza (Badf'u'llah)-W-118
> Alexander, Agnes-A-62; W-144, 205                 Bagdadi, Zia (:Qfya Baghdadf)-W-175, 267
> Alkany, Muhammed Ali Mu~ammad-'Ali                Balyuzi, Hasan M.-W-4, 14, 72, 73, 116
> Alkany-W-159                                    Barney, Laura Clifford-A-45, 66; W-137
> BAHA'i BIBLIOGRAPHY                                            573
> Bedikian, Victoria- C-33                         Fozdar, Shirin- W-84
> Blomfield, Mary Esther-A- 35, 63 , 73            Gail , Marzieh-B-26; A- 31 , 42 , 44; W-27,
> Blomfield, Rose Ellinor Cecilia-A-35 , 63 ,        100, 236
> 73                                            Garrida, Gertrude-S-18
> Blomfield, Lady Sara Louisa- A - 35 , 63 , 73;   Gaver, Jessyca Russell- W-25 , 113
> S-43; W- 88                                   Giachery, Ugo-W-237
> Bourgeois, Louis-W-53                            Gift, Maye Harvey-C- 36; W- 218
> Bowes, Eric- W-138                               Goodall , Helen S.- W-97
> Braun, Eunice-W-132                              Gregory Louis-W-142 , 200, 225
> Brittingham, Isabella D .- W-149 , 228           Grundy , Julia M.- W-259
> Brittingham, James F.-W- 177                     Gulpayganf) Mirza Abu'l-Fadl- W-44, 78 ,
> Browne, Edward Granville-A-64; W-258               83, 153
> Campbell, Helen W.-W-41 , 50                     Haddad , Anton F. (Ant(m Haddad)-B- 15;
> Campbell, Myrtle W.- W-95                          W-103 , 172, 176
> Carden, Hugh_:_ W-70                             Hadi, Mirza-W-252
> Chamberlain, Isabel Fraser or Soraya- A - 5,     Hall , Mrs. Basil- W-111
> 6; C- 41                                      Hall, E. T. - W-173, 281
> Chanler, Julie-B- 4                              Hamadanf, Mirza l;lusayn-i-- W-258
> Chase, Thornton-W-46, 77, 143 , 146, 285         Hammond, Eric- A-3; C-59
> Cheyne, Thomas Kelly-W-221                       Haney, Mariam-C- 51; W-141, 200
> Christophil see Townshend, George                Hannen , Mr. & Mrs. Joseph H .- W-7
> Claus, Ted- W- 194                               Harris, W. Hooper-W- 160, 277
> Cobb, Stanwood-W-87, 119, 165, 174, 219,         Haydar Ali, Haji Mirza (l;lajf Mirza l;laydar
> 233,264,269                                     'Alf)-W- 36
> Collins, Amelia- C-22; W-268                     Herrick, Elizabeth-W- 278
> Conrader, Jay and Constance- B- 37               Hoagg, H. Emogene- W-226
> Cooper, Ella Goodall- W-97                       Hofman, David-C- 54; W-93, 225
> Cox, Alice Simmons-C-22; W-218                   Holley, Horace-A-17 ; C-20; W-37 , 45 , 49 ,
> David- W- 288                                      54, 207 , 223 , 239
> Dawud, Johanna- A - 33; C- 53                    Huddleston, John- W- 115
> Dealy, Paul Kingston- W-99                       Irwin , Beatrice-W- 140
> Dean , S. I.-W-123                               Ishteal Ibn Kalan tar see Khan, ' Alf Qulf
> Dodge , Arthur Pillsbury- W-192, 272 , 287       Ives, Howard Colby-W- 208, 241
> Dreyfus, Hippolyte- W-282                        Jaxon , Honore J.- W-168
> Dunlop, Evangeline Elizabeth Crowell             Jenabe Faze! (Jinab-i-Fac;lil-Mirza Asadu'llah
> - W- 79                                         Fac;lil) see Mazindarani , Mirza Jenabe Faze!
> Edge, Clara A.- W- 255                           Johnson, L.-W-182, 216, 256
> Esphahani, Mirza Al:imad see Sohrab , Al:imad    Kelsey, Olivia- C-2; W- 275
> Esslemont, John Ebenezer-W- 74, 75 , 284         Khan , ' Alf Qulf or Ali Kuli- B-2, 3, 14, 24 ,
> Esslemont, Peter-W- 164                            25 , 26, 30, 31 , 33 , 26; A - 47 , 52 ; W- 44 , 78,
> Esty, Frances-A-21                                 150
> Faily, Dr. Jane et al-C-45 , 46, 47              Kheiralla, Ibrahim George (Ibrahim George
> Faizi, Abu'l-Qasfm- W-127 , 179, 185, 262          Khayru'llah)-W- 15, 294
> Faizi, Gloria- W- 22, 124                        Knobloch, Alma S.-W- 129
> Fareed, Ameen'Ullah-B- 8, 14; A- 26;             Knobloch , Fanny A.- W- 129
> W- 118, 121, 162, 231, 252                    Latimer, George Orr- W- 86, 226
> Fathea'zam,      Hooshmand        (Hushmand      Lucas, Mary L.-W-81
> Fatheazam)-W- 191                              McDaniel, Allen Boyer- W- 243
> Ferraby, John- W- 8, 203                         McKay, Doris-W-135
> Finch, Ida A.-W-129, 220                         MacNutt, Howard- A - 37, 38, 39 ; W- 277
> Fitzgerald, Col. Nathan Ward- W- 195             Marsella , Elena Maria-W- 217
> Ford, Mary Hanford- W-202 , 232, 292             Mason, Barbara-C-39
> Fozdar, Jamshid- W-85 , 122, 151                 Masson, Jean-W-171
> 574                              THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Mathews, Loulie Albee-W-198, 249, 286        Scaramucci, Mrs.-W-47
> Maxwell, May-W-114                           Schaefer, Udo-W-167
> Mazindarani) Mirza Jenabe Faze!- W-154,      Schopftocher, Lorol- W-251
> 155, 156, 157, 158                         Scratchard, Felicia R.-W-290
> Meyer, Ray- W-26                             Sears, William-W-128, 136, 211, 222, 260,
> Mills, Mountfort-C-51; W-133, 152              289
> Moffett, Ruth Ellis-W-108, 109, 193          Shoghi Effendi-B-5, 6, 7, 10, 17, 20, 35;
> Momen, Moojan-W-110                            Bab-I; S-passim; C-48, 49; W-98, 187
> Moneereh Khanum (Munfrih Khanum)             Shook, Glenn A.-W-185
> -W-117                                     Simpson, G. Palgrave-W-21, 80
> Monever Khanum (Munavvar Khanum)             Singh, Pritam-W-135
> -A-19                                      Skrine, Francis Henry- W-51
> Movius, Mary Rumsey-A-30                     Sohrab, AQmad-A-7, 48, 51, 52, 58, 60, 68;
> Muhajer, Mrs. Iran F.-A-34                     W-2, 102, 117, 154, 155, 156, 157, 158
> Miihlschlegel, Peter- W-13                   Sorabjee, Zena-W-187
> Mutlagh, Hushidar-C-24                       Sprague, Sidney-B-12; W-247, 293
> Nabil-i-A'~am      (Mulla    MuQammad-i-     Stephens, Kenneth D.- W-238
> Zarandf)- W-98, 187                        Storey, Josephine D.-W-104, 105
> Nakhjavanf) Violette-W-9                     Taherzadeh, Adib-W-229, 230, 270
> Norder, Cornelia A.-W-120                    Taherzadeh, Habib-B-34; Bab-2
> Paine, Mabel Hyde-C-32                       Teherani, Abdel Karim Effendi (Abdu'I-
> Peeke, Margaret Bloodgood- W-186               Karfm-i-Tihranf)- W-6
> Perigord, Emily McBride- W-266               Thompson, Juliet-W-3, 5
> Phelps, Myron H.-W-163                       Townshend, George-C-35; W-89, 139, 180,
> Pinchon, Florence E.- W-92                     212,213
> Platt, Beatrice Marion-A-35, 63, 73          True, Corinne-W-197, 252
> Quigley, Robert-W-128                        Truesdell, A. J.-W-23
> Rabb, Mary M.-A-13, 14                       Vail, Albert R.-W-42
> Rabbani, RuQfyyih Khanum- W-203, 209,        Vail, Virgie V.-W-134
> 210,244,250,273                            Waite, Louise R.-W-30, 31, 242
> Rabbani, Shoghi Effendi-see Shoghi Effendi   Ward, Allan L.-W-274
> Rastogi, Arjun-S-28                          Watson, Albert Durant-W-112
> Remey, Charles Mason-W-11, 19, 29, 32,       Watson, Marie A.-W-183
> 33,34,35,38,39,48,52,94,96, 125, 126,      Wegener, Daniel Nelson- W-106
> 145,148,161,169,173,178,190,196,199,      Weil, Henry A.-W-91
> 201,204,214,215,224,226,227,234,263,       Whitehead, 0 . Z.- W-240
> 276,279                                    Wilhelm, Roy-W-133, 152
> Reynolds, Audrie-C-40                        Windust, Albert R .-A-54, 55, 56
> Root, Martha- W-257                          Winterburn, Mr. & Mrs. George T .- W-254
> Rosenberg, Ethel J. - W-80, 82               Woolson, Gayle-W-107
> RuQfyyih Khanum see Rabbani, RuQfyyih        Youness Khan see Afrukhtih, Dr. Youness
> Khan um                                     Khan (Dr. Yunis Khan Afrukhtih)
> Sabet, Huschmand-W-143                       Zarandi, Muhammad-i- see Nabil-i-Azam
> Sala, Emeric-W-261                             (Nabil-i-A'~am;     Mulla   MuQammad-i-
> Sanderson, Edith Roohie- W-159                 Zarandf)
> Sassi, Gabriel- W-168
> BAHA'i BIBLIOGRAPHY                                      575
> C. A BIBLIOGRAPHY OF BAHA'I CHILDREN'S LITERATURE IN
> THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE - 1917-1979
> 
> Compiled by Robert E. Cadwalader
> 
> 1. Bad!'. Kamal Ma'ani. NSA of Thailand,        14. Baha'i Lesson Plans Grade 7: History,
> 1977. paper and boards.                          Religions etc. ed. Advisory Committee on
> 2. Baha'i Child's ABC, A. Roberta K. Chris-          Education: Wilmette: BPT, 1968 and
> tian. ii. Rochelle Boonshaft. Wilmette:          1976.paper.
> BPC, 1944. 6th ptg. Wilmette: BPT, 1965.    15. Baha'i Lesson Plans Grade 8: History,
> paper .                                          Heroic Age of the Faith, etc. ed. Advisory
> 3. Baha'i Child's Song Book, A. verses               Committee on Education. Wilmette: BPT,
> Roberta K. Christian. music Eugene Bab-          1968 and 1976. paper.
> cock. ii. E . Butler McHenry.               16. Baha'i Lesson Plans Grade 9: History,
> 4. Baha'i Founders. Child Education Com-             Formative Age of the Baha'i Faith, etc. ed.
> mittee. New York: BPC, 1939. paper.              Advisory Committee on Education. Wil-
> (based on Baha'u'llah and the New Era).          mette: BPT, 1968 and 1976. paper.
> 5. Baha'i Holy Days, Grades 1 - 9. ed. Advis-   17. Bahai Prayers for Children. n.p. n.d.
> ory Committee on Education. Wilmette:             (prayers from the 1929 USA prayer
> BPT, 1968 and 1976. paper.                       book). paper.
> 6. Baha'i Lesson Outline for Children. comp.    18. Baha'i Prayers for Children. ii. Jean
> Committee on Training and Teaching               Hutchinson.
> Children. 4 parts. New York: BPC, 1935.     19. Baha'i Principles. comp. Child Education
> paper.                                            Committee. Wilmette: BPC, 1946. paper.
> 7. Baha'i Lesson Plans Grade K: History,        20. Baha'i Puzzle Book for Young People
> Progressive Revelation etc. ed. Advisory         from 8 to 80. National Child Education
> Committee on Education. Wilmette: BPT,           Committee of the NSA of the Hawaiian
> 1968 and 1976. paper.                            !~ands, 1974. paper.
> 8. Baha'i Lesson Plans Grade 1: History,        21. Baha'i Quotations on Education. National
> Baha'i Heroes etc. ed. Advisory Commit-           Child Education Committee of the NSA of
> tee on Education. Wilmette: BPT, 1968             the Hawaiian Islands.
> and 1976. paper.                             22. Baha'is Around the World Grade K, Social
> 9. Baha'i Lesson Plans Grade 2: History, the         Teachings, Baha'i School Lessons Plans.
> Bab etc. ed. Advisory Committee on Edu-           Katherine Patton et al. Advisory Commitcation. Wilmette: BPT, 1968 and 1976.             tee on Education. n.p. n.d . paper.
> paper.                                       23. Baha'i Teacher's Handbook, Baha'i
> 10. Baha'i Lesson Plans Grade 3: History,            School Lesson Plans Grade K. ed. Advis-
> Baha'u'llah etc. ed. Advisory Committee          ory Committee on Education. Wilmette:
> on Education. Wilmette: BPT, 1968 and            BPT, 1963. paper.
> 1976 . paper.                                24. Baha'i Teaching Guide for Children,
> 11. Baha'i Lesson Plans Grade 4: History,            Primary. comp. Alice Cox and Evelyn
> 'Abdu'l-Baha etc. ed. Advisory Commit-           Musacchia. ii. Lynn Hutchinson. Wiltee on Education. Wilmette: BPT, 1968            mette: BPT, 1966. paper.
> and 1976. paper.                             25. Baha'( Teaching Guide for Children,
> 12. Baha'i Lesson Plans Grade 5: History,            Pre-Primary. comp. Alice Cox and Evelyn
> Shoghi Effendi etc. ed. Advisory Commit-         Musacchia. ii. Lynn Hutchinson. Wiltee on Education . Wilmette: BPT, 1968           mette: BPT, 1966. paper.
> and 1976. paper.                             26. Bahti'( Teaching Guide for Children,
> 13. Baha'( Lesson Plans Grade 6: History,            Intermediate. comp. Alice Cox and Evelyn
> Hands of the Cause etc. ed. Advisory             Musacchia. ii. Lynn Hutchinson. Wil-
> Committee on Education. Wilmette: BPT,           mette: BPT, 1966. paper.
> 1968 and 1976. paper.                        27. Baha'i Teaching Guide for Children,
> 576                                  THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Teacher's Manual, Pre-Primary and Pri-       43. Kingdoms of God, The. Janet Lindstrom.
> mary. comp. Alice Cox and Evelyn Musac-           ii. Anna Stevenson. Wilmette: BPT, 1961.
> chia. ii. Lynn Hutchinson. Wilmette: BPT,         cloth.
> 1966. paper.                                 44 . Lessons in Religion. Mohammad Ali
> 28. Bahti'[ Teaching Guide for Children,               Alkany . trans. Edith Roohie Sanderson.
> Teacher's Manual, Intermediate. comp.             Boston: The Tudor Press, 1923. paper.
> Alice Cox and Evelyn Musacchia. ii. Lynn     45 . Let Thy Breeze Refresh Them, Baha'[
> Hutchinson . Wilmette: BPT, 1966. paper.          Prayers and Tablets for Children. London:
> 29 . Blessed is the Spot. Baha'u'llah. ii. Anna        BPT, 1976. cloth .
> Stevenson . Wilmette: BPT, 1958. hard-       46 . Living Today for Tomorrow's World.
> cover.                                            Marguerite True. ii. Jean Hutchinson.
> 30. Children's Course in Bahti'[ Principles            Wilmette: BPT, 1956.
> with Pictures to Color. Child Education      4 7. Magazine of the Children of the Kingdom,
> Committee. New York: BPC, 1939.                   The. quarterly. Dec. 1919 through the mid
> paper.                                            1920's.
> 31. Children's Stories from the Dawn-             48. Magnified Be Thy Name. London: BPT,
> Breakers. Zoe Meyer. i( Carl Scheffler.           1963. cloth.
> Wilmette: BPT, 1955 and 1964. cloth.         49. Manual of Suggestions for Organizing a
> 32. Child's Prayer Book, A. Wilmette: BPC,             Bahti'[ Children's Hour. Child Education
> 1942 and 1943. paper.                             Committee. ca. 1945.
> 33. Child's Way. Child Education Committee.       50. Manual of Suggestions for Organizing a
> quarterly and bi-monthly. 1949 to date.           Children's Class. American Indian Service
> 34. Coloring Book, Bahti'[ Places Around the           Committee. (1964). (Beatrice Bechtold).
> World. comp. Evelyn Musacchia. ii. Dor-      51. 0 God Guide Me (A selection of Baha'i
> rine Sadilek. National Child Education            Prayers). Wilmette: BPT, 1974. hard-
> Committee of NSA of Hawaii, 1975 .                cover.
> paper.                                       52. Principles of Child Education in the Bah(;/[
> 35. Comprehensive Study Outline for Chil-              Faith, The. Wilmette: BPT.
> dren. Child Education Committee. New         53. Reading Supplement to a Baha'( Picture-
> York: BPC, 1940. Wilmette: BPC. paper.            Coloring Book. NCEC of the NSA of the
> 36. Creation. illustrated. Child Education             Hawaiian Islands, 1971. by Evelyn
> Committee. New York: BPC, 1940.                   Musacchia. paper.
> paper.                                       54. Sing a New Song. ii. Anna Stevenson.
> 37. Creative Plan of God, The. Child Educa-            comp. Baha'i Committee on Music.
> tion Committee. Wilmette: BPC, 1940.         55. Stories for Children. Jacqueline Mehrabi.
> Wilmette: BPT, 1958. paper.                       London: BPT, 1970. paper.
> 38 . Gift, The. Cynthia K. Walcott. ii. Lynn      56 . Stories from the Dawn-Breakers. Zoe
> Hutchinson Reynolds. Wilmette: BPT,               Meyer. ii. Carl Scheffler. Wilmette: BPT.
> 1976 . cloth.                                     cloth.
> 39. God and His Messengers. David Hofman.         57. Stories of Bahti'u'llah as Told by Pokka.
> ii. Geoffrey Rideout. Oxford: George              Betty Reed. ii. John Hollins. London:
> Ronald, 1953 , 1958 and 1967. ii. Zohreh          BPT, paper.
> Zahra'i. Wilmette: BPT, 1973. cloth and      58 . Stories of the Master. National Child Edupaper.                                            cation Committee of Alaska. Eileen Lit-
> 40. Heroic Lives. Albert R. and Emily                  terel & Katy Main. ii. Katy Main. ed.
> McClellan Vail. Boston: The Beacon                Eugene B. Van Zanten. n.d. paper.
> Press, 1917. cloth.                          59. Study Course for Baha'u'llah and the New
> 41. Heroic Lives in Universal Religion,                Era. Child Education Committee. Wil-
> Teacher's Manual. Albert R. and Emily             mette: BPC, 1942. paper.
> McClellan Vail. Boston: The Beacon           60. Suggested Materials for Teaching Child-
> Press, 1917 and 1928. cloth.                      ren's Classes. comp. (Beatrice Bechtold).
> 42 . Junior's Book of Religion, A. Marguerite          American Indian Service Committee,
> True. Wilmette: BPC, 1945. paper.                 1964.paper.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                      577
> 
> 61. Teacher's Handbook Volumes V and VI,         64. World Fellowship, A Universal Bahai
> Children's Classes; Crafts and Games,            News Letter of Consultation - Service for
> combined. ed. Advisory Committee on              Orphans-Education of Destitute and
> Education.                                       Helpless Children . Montclair, N. J. Vol. I,
> 62. To Live the Life. Child Education Com-           1923-.
> mittee. New York: BPC, 1938. paper.          65. Nine Holy Days. Jackie Mehrabi. London:
> 63. Wonder Lamp, The. A. Q. Faizi. New               BPT, 1975. paper.
> Delhi: BPT, 1972. paper.
> 
> D. A PARTIAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF ENGLISH-LANGUAGE
> BOOKS BY NON-BAHA'fS IN WHICH MENTION IS MADE
> OF THE BAHA'I FAITH
> Compiled by Maureen Thur
> 
> 1. Abbott, Evlyn and Campbell, Lewis.            14. - - . Seven Years That Changed the
> Life of Benjamin Jowett. London: Mur-            World, 1941-1948. Los Angeles: Kosray, 1897. Vol. 2: p. 466.                       man Press, 1940. p. 15.
> 2. Adams, Rev. Isaac. Persia By a Persian.       15. Andrews, Fannie Fern. The Holy Land
> n.p., 1900. pp. 453- 490.                        Under Mandate. 2 vols. Boston: Hough-
> 3. Addison, James Thayer. The Christian              ton Mifflin Co., 1931. Vol I: pp.
> Approach to the Moslem. New York:                 200-201.
> Columbia University Press, 1942.             16. Anthony, A. P. , ed. Year Book and
> 4. Algar, Hamid. Mfrzii Malkum Khiin: a              Almanac of the Holy Land. Chicago:
> study in the history of Iranian modernism.        Holy Land Almanac, 1936.
> Berkeley: University of California Press,    17. Arberry, Arthur John. Oriental Essays:
> 1973.pp.11,46,58- 68,213-16,221-5,               Portraits of Seven Scholars. London:
> 227, 306.                                        George Allen & Unwin, 1960. pp.
> 5. - - . Religion and state in Iran,                 168- 171.
> 1785 - 1906: the role of the Ulama in the     18. - - . Shiraz, Persian City of Saints and
> Qajar period. Berkeley: University of             Poets. Centers of Civilization Series,
> California Press, 1969. pp. 136, 138-44,         Book 2. Norman, Okla.: University of
> 146-51.                                          Oklahoma Press, 1960. pp. xii, 25- 28.
> 6. Allen, Cady H. The Message of the Book        19. Arguments with a Non-Catholic. Pulaski,
> of Revelation. Nashville: Cokesbury               Wis.: Franciscan Printer, 1959.
> Press, 1939. p. 188n.                        20. Armajani, Yahya. Iran. Englewood
> 7. Allen, Devere. The Fight for Peace. New           Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hall, 1972. pp.
> York: Macmillan Co., 1930. pp. 619,              115- 117.
> 628.                                          21. - -. Middle East Past and Present.
> 8. Ali, Ameer. The Spirit of Islam. London:          New Jersey: Prentice-Hall, 1970. pp. 10,
> Christophers, 1922. pp. 357-359, 482.             42, 224, 252-254.
> 9. A lter, S. Neale. Studies in Bahaism.         22. Armisadeghi, Hossein, ed. Twentieth
> Beirut: American Press, 1923.                     Century Iran. New York: Holmes &
> 10. Anderson, Norman. Christianity and                Meier, 1977. pp. 2, 5, 80, 186, 187.
> comparative religion. Leicester: Inter-       23. Arnold, Arthur. Through Persia by
> var~ty, 1970.pp. ~ 14,48-9.                       Caravan. New York: Harper & Bros.,
> 11. - - . The World's religions. Leicester:           1877. pp. 278-280 .
> In tervarsity, 19 5 0.                        24. Arnold, Matthew. Essays in Criticism.
> 12. Anderson, Wing. Prophetic Years                   Chap. 7: A Persian Passion Play. Lon-
> 1947-1953. Los Angeles: Kosmon                    don: Macmillan & Co., 1893. pp.
> Press, 1946. p. 103 .                             226- 227; New York: A. L. Burt Co.,
> 13. - - . Prophetic Years 1948- 1954. Los             n.d. pp. 166-167.
> Angeles: Kosmon Press, 194 7.                 25. Aschner, Ernest and Server, Zachery.
> 578                                 THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> Journal to Israel, a Pictorial Guide. New         Qajars, 1858-1896. London: Ithaca
> York: Monde, 1956.                                Press, 1978. pp. 24, 324.
> 26. Ashbee, Charles Robert. A Palestine          42 . Ballou, Robert 0. The Viking Portable
> Notebook I918-1923. Garden City,                  Library World Bible. New York: 1944.
> N.Y: Doubleday, Page & Co., 1923. pp.             pp. 448-449.
> 116-120.                                     43. Barrows, John Henry. Christianity the
> Chap. 10: 'Abbas, the Bahai'                   World Religion. Chicago: A. C. McClurg
> 27. Atherton, Gertrude. Julia France and              & Co., 1897. pp. 38-39.
> Her Times. New York: Macmillan               44. Barrows, Rev. John Henry, ed. The
> Co., 1912.pp. 277-278,280,298.331.                World's Parliament of Religions. 2 vols.
> 28. Atkins, Gaius Glenn. Modern Religious             Chicago: Parliament Publishing Co.,
> Cults and Movements. New York: Flem-              1893. Vol. 2: pp. 1125-1126.
> ing Revell, 1923. pp. 328-335.               45. Barton, George A. The Religions of the
> 29. Atkins, Gaius Glenn and Braden, C. S.             World. 4th ed. Chicago: University of
> Procession of the Gods. New York:                 Chicago Press, 1937. p. 111.
> Richard R. Smith, 1930. p. 451; London:      46. Barton, James L. The Christian
> Constable, 1931. New York: Harper &               Approach to Islam . Boston: Pilgrim
> Bros. , 1936.                                     Press, 1918, pp . 197-200.
> 30. Avery, Peter. Modern Iran. London:           47. Baudouin,        Charles.  Contemporary
> Ernest Benn, 1965 & 1967. pp. 44,                 Studies. Trans. E. and C. Paul. New
> 52-67,76,80,81,91,97,llO,ll4-115,                 York: E. P. Dutton, 1925. pp. 131-146.
> 121, 132,276,277, 279,469.                           Chap.: 'Bahaism. A Movement
> 31. Ayres, Lew. Altars of the East. Garden               Toward the Community of Mankind'.
> City, N.Y.: Doubleday & Co., 1956. pp.       48. Bayne, E. A. Persian Kingship in Transi-
> 258-259.                                          tion. New York: American Universities
> 32. Bach, Marcus. The Circle of Faith. New            Field Staff, 1968. pp. 45-46, 247.
> York: Hawthorn Books, 1957. pp.              49. Bell, Archie. The Spell ofthe Holy Land.
> 47-83, 186, mention on dust cover.                Boston: Page Co., 1915. pp. 258.
> 33. - - . Let Life Be Like This! New                  304-321.
> Jersey: Prentice-Hall, 1963 . p. 195.                Full page photo: Abbas Effendi, p. 304
> 34. - - . Report to the Protestants.                     facing page.
> Indianapolis: Bobbs-Merrill Co., 1948.       50. Bell, Lady, ed. The Letters of Gertrude
> pp. 180, 181, 184-185 , 187, 191-192,             Bell. London: Ernest Benn, 1927: New
> 193, 199-200,205,212,217,218,219,                 York: Boni & Liveright, 1927. Vol I: pp.
> 231.                                              131-132.
> 35. - - . Shoghi Effendi, An Apprecia-           51. Bell, Gertrude Lowthian . Syria the
> tion. New York: Hawthorn Books, 1958.             Desert and the Sown. London: W.
> Reprint of chap. 3, The Circle ofFaith.        Heinemann, 1907; New York: E. P. Dut-
> 36. - - . Strangers at the Door. Nashville:            ton, 1907.pp. 148, 150, 193.
> Abingdon Press, 1971. pp. 74-95.                     Picture of Mishkin-Qalam, p. 149.
> 37. - - . They Have Found a Faith.               52. Ben-Horen, Eliahu. The Middle East:
> Indianapolis: Bobbs-Merrill Co., 1948.            Crossroads to History. New York: W.W.
> pp.189-221, 229, mention on dustcover.             Norton & Co., 1943.
> 38. Baedekar, Karl. Baedekar's Palestine         53. Benjamin, S. G. W. Persia and the Perand Syria. London: Unwin , 1912.                  sians. Boston: Ticknor & Co., 1887. p.
> 39. Baha'ism. St. Louis, Mo.: Concordia                353-355.
> Tract Mission, n.d.                         54. Bentwich, Norman. The Religious Foun-
> Pamphlet, 16 pp.                               dations of Internationalism . London:
> 40. Bahm, Archie J. The World's Living                 George Allen & Unwin, 1933. pp. 178,
> Religions. New York: Dell Publishing              179.
> Co., 1964.pp. 333-334,356,368.              55. - -. A Wanderer in the Promised
> 41. Bakhash, Shaul. Iran: monarchy,                   Land. New York: Charles Scribner's
> bureaucracy and reform under the                  Sons. 1933.p. 78-80.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                     579
> 56. Bercorize, Zion. For Immediate Release.      72. Bowen, William C. The Church at Work
> Sheridan House, 1936 .                           in the Moslem World. University of
> 57. Berry, G. L. Religions of the World. New         Chicago Press, 1936.
> York: Harper & Row, Barnes & Noble           73. Braden, Charles Samuel. Jesus Com -
> Books, 1947and1956; reprinted., 1968.            pared.     Englewood       Cliffs,   N .J.:
> p. 126.                                          Prentice-Hall, 1957. p. 86.
> 58. Bethmann, Erich W. Bridge to Islam.          74. - - . Scriptures of Mankind. New
> London: George Allen & Unwin, 1953 .             York: Macmillan Co., 1952. pp.
> p. 162.                                          472-473 .
> 59. Bevington, Colin. New light from the         75. - - . These Also Believe. New York:
> East. London: Falcon Booklets, 1974.              Macmillan Co., 1949. p. 464.
> pp. 19-23.                                   76. - - . The World's Religions. Nashville:
> 60. Bibesco, Princess George V. (Marthe) .            Cokesbury Press, 1939 . p. 232.
> The Eight Paradises. Trans. from French.     77. Bradshaw, Jane. Eight major religions in
> New York: E . P. Dutton & Co., 1923. pp.         Britain. London: Edward Arnold, 1979.
> 31-36.                                            pp. 155-70.
> 61. Binder, Leonard. Iran. Berkeley, Calif.:     78. Brandow, S. G. F., ed . Dictionary of
> University of California Press, 1962. pp .       Comparative Religion. New York:
> 74, 161-163,243,296.                              Charles Scribner's Sons, 1970. pp.
> 62. Binning, Robert B. M. A Journal of Two            124-126.
> Years' Travel in Persia, Ceylon, etc. 2      79. Brick, Daniel and Riwkin-Brick, Anna.
> vols. London: W. H. Allen & Co., 1857.           Palestine. Cleveland: World Publishing
> Vol. I: pp. 403-408.                              Co., 1949.
> 63. Bishop, Mrs. (Isabella L. Bird) .Journeys           Reference: photo Shrine of Greatest
> in Persia and Kurdistan . 2 vols. New               Holy Leaf, Haifa; pages not num-
> York: G. P. Putnam's Sons, 1891. Vol. I:            bered.
> p. 273.                                      80. Brockelmann, Carl. History of the
> 64. Bishop, Peter D. Words in world reli-            Islamic Peoples. Trans. Joel Carmichael
> gions. London: SCM Press, 1949. p. 120.           and Moshe Perlmann. New York: Put-
> 65. Bliss, Frederick Jones. Religions of Mod-         man's, 1947 . pp. 326, 424-427.
> ern Syria and Palestine. New York:           81. Broderick, Robert C. Historic Churches
> Charles Scribner's Sons, 1912. pp.               of the United States. New York: Wilfred
> 19- 20 .                                          Funk, 1958.pp. 186-190.
> 66. Blunt, Wilfred. A Persian Spring. Lon-              Photos Baha'i House of Worship,
> don: James Barrie Brooks, 1957.                     Wilmette, pp. 187, 189, 190.
> 67. Boeckel, Florence Brewer. Between War        82. Browne, Edward Granville. 'Bahaism' in
> and Peace. New York: Macmillan Co.,              Religious Systems of the World. London:
> 1928 . pp. 102- 103.                              Swan, Sonnerschein & Co., 1905. pp.
> 68. Bolitho, Hector. A Biographer's Note-             333-355.
> book. New York: Macmillan Co., 1950.        83. - - . A History of Persian Literature
> p. 22.                                           1500-1924.       Cambridge      University
> 69. Bouiton, Marjorie. Zamenhof, Creator              Press, 1924.
> of Esperanto. London: Routledge and                 This is Vol. 4 of A Literary History of
> Paul Kegan. pp. 211-212.                            Persia, same author.
> 70. Bouquet, Alan Coates. Comparative            84. - - . A History of Persian Literature
> Religion. Middlesex, England: • Har-              Under     Tartar     Dominion      (A.D.
> mondsworth. Penguin Books, 1941. p.             1265-1502). Cambridge University
> 283.                                             Press, 1920. pp. 432, 452, 470.
> 71. - - . Sacred Books of the World.                    This is Vol 3. of A Literary History of
> Middlesex, England: Harmondsworth,                  Persia, same author.
> 1941. Penguin Books, 1954. pp. 310- 312.     85. - - . A Literary History of Persia. 4
> Companion source-book to Compara-             vols. Cambridge: Cambridge University
> tive Religion.                                  Press, 1924. passim .
> 580                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 86. - - . Materials for the Study of the Bab{         103. Cheyne , Thomas Kelly. The Reconcilia-
> Religion. Cambridge: Cambridge Uni-                    lion of races and religions. London:
> versity Press, 1918. passim.                            Adam and Charles Black, 1941.
> 87. - - . A Persian Anlhology. London :               104. Chirol , Sir Valentine. Th e Middle East-
> Methuen & Co., 1927. pp. 26 , 38-40,                   ern Question . London: J. Murray, 1903.
> 59-60, 68-73.                                    105. Christofferson , Gerda. From the Dusty
> 88.            Th e Persian Revolution of                   Haunts of Man . Christofferson Enter-
> 1905-1909. Cambridge: Cambridge                        prises. chap . 7.
> University Press, 1910. pp. xvi- xvii, xx ii ,   106. Christopher, John B . Th e Islamic Tradi-
> 45,60-62 , 106-107, 148, 424-429 .                     tion. New York: Harper & Rowe , 1972 .
> 89. - -. Press and Poelry in Modern Per-                    pp. 83-85.
> sia. Cambridge: Cambridge University             107. Clark , Elmer T. Th e Small Sects in
> Press , 1914. pp. 18, 59, 235- 236 , 294 ,             America. Nashville: Cokesbury Press,
> 310.                                                   1937. pp. 29, 183.
> 90. - - . A Y ear Amongst the Persians.               108 . Clawson, Mary. L e11ers from Jerusalem.
> London: A. & C. Black, 1893. passim.                  London: Abelard-Schuman , 1957. p. 95.
> 91. Butler, Donald G. Man y ligh1s. London:           109. Clemen, Prof. Carl. Religions of the
> Geoffrey Chapman, 1975. pp . 157-161.                 World. Tra ns. Rev. A. K. Dallas. New
> 92. Byng, Edward J. The World ofth e Arabs.                 York: Harcourt, Brace & Co., 1931. pp.
> Boston: Little , Brown & Co ., 1944. pp .             469-470.
> 270, 307.                                       110. Coke, Richard. The Heart of the Middle
> 93 . Canney , Maurice . An Encyclop edia of                 East. London: Thornton Butterworth,
> Religions. London: Routledge, 1921. pp .               1925. p. 211.
> 48-50.                                          111. Comay, John. Israel: An Uncommon
> 94 . Canney, J. E. Comparalive Religions.                   Guide. New York: Random House, 1969.
> London: Routledge, 1921.                              pp. 257-258, 270-271.
> 95. Carpenter, Edward. Pagan and Chrislian            112. Cotta m, Richard W. Nationalism in Iran.
> Creeds: Th eir Origin and Meaning. New                 Pittsburgh, Pa.: University of Pittsburgh
> York: Blue Ribbon Books, 1920. pp.                    Press, 1979. pp. 87-89, 342, 357 .
> 153. 214-217; New York: Harcourt ,              113. Cousins, Norman. Who Speaks for Man?
> Brace & Co., 1920.                                    New York: Macmillan Co., 1953. pp.
> 96 .Carpenter, Joseph Estlin. Comparali ve                  232 , 234 , 236-237, 239 , 241.
> Religion . New York: Henry Holt & Co .,          114 . Cowles, Alton House. The Conquering
> (1913). pp. 70- 71, 188.                              Horseman. Boston: Christopher Publish-
> 97. Carty, James W., Jr. Nashville as a World               ing House, 1923.
> Religious Center.                                115 . Cragg, Kenneth. The Call of the Minaret.
> 98. Carns, Paul. Philosophy as a Science.                   New York: Oxford University Press,
> Chicago: Open Court Publishing Co .,                  1956. p. 133.
> 1909. p 98.                                     116. - - . The House of Islam. Encino,
> 99. Cash, W. Wilson. Christiandom and                       Calif.: Dickenson Publishing Co., 1975.
> Islam. New York: Harper& Bros., 1937.                  p. 81.
> pp. 68. 133.                                    117. Curtis, William Eleroy. To -Day in Syria
> 100. - - . The Expansionoflslam. London :                    and Palestin e. Fleming Revell Co., 1903.
> Church Missionary Society, 1928. pp. 8,'        118 . Curzon, George N. Persia and the Per-
> 117-121.                                              sian Question. 2 vols. London: Long-
> 101. Cave, Sydney. An Introduction to th e                   mans, Green & Co., 1892. Vol 1: pp. 43,
> Study of Some Living Religions of the                  269 , 414, 417, 496-504: Vol. 2: pp. 43,
> East. London: Duckworth & Co ., 1921 ;                 103.
> New York: Charles Scribner's Sons,              119. Cannavarro, Marie De S. Insight into the
> 1923. pp . 234- 235.                                  Far East. Los Angeles: Wetzel Publish-
> 102. Cavendish, Richard, ed. Man, Myth, &                    ing Co., 1925 . pp. 156-157, 165, 168.
> Magic. New York: Marshall Cavendish ,           120. Daniel , Rabbi Mooshie G. Modern Per-
> 1970. Vol. 2: pp. 208-209.                            sia. Wheaton : Wheaton College Press,
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                       581
> 1897. pp. 145-152.                               164-166.
> Chapter titled 'BOBEISM'.                138. Dutcher, George M. Modern Persia, Vol.
> 121. Das Gupta, Kedarneth. Essence of Reli-            5 in The History of Nations. 25 vols.
> gions. New York: World Fellowship of             Henry Cabot Lodge, gen. ed. New York:
> Faiths, 1941. pp. 10, 135-139.                   P. F. Collier & Son Co., 1928. pp.
> 122. Davidson, Abraham A. The Story of                  362- 363, 401.
> American Paintings. New York: Harry         139. Eddy, (George) Sherwood. God in His-
> N. Abrams Publishers, 1974. p. 140.              tory. New York: Association Press,
> 123. Davis, Rev. John Tyssul. A League of               1947. p. 169.
> Religions. London: Lindsay Press, 1926.     140. - - . A Portrait of Jesus. New York:
> chap. 10.                                         Harper & Bros., 1943.
> 124. De Lorey, Eustache and Sladen, Doug-         141. Edelman, Li ly. Israel. Edinburgh:
> las. Queer Things about Persia. Philadel-         Thomas Nelson & Sons, 1958. p. 42.
> phia: Lippencott, 1907. pp . 268 ,         142. - - . New People in a New Land. New
> 307-317.                                          York: Thomas Nelson & Sons, n.d. p. 42.
> 125. Dennis, James S. The New Horoscope of        143. Edwards, Arthur Cecil. A Persian Cara-
> Missions. New York: Fleming H . Revell,           van. New York: Harper & Bros., 1928 .
> 1908. p. 94.                                     pp. 14-23.
> 126. Dexter, Harriet Harmon . What's Right        144. Ehrenpreis, Marcus. The Soul of the
> with Race Relations. New York: Harper             East. New York: Viking Press, 1928. p.
> Bros., 1958.pp. 195- 196.                         206.
> 127. Dilling, Elizabeth. The Red Network.         145. Ellis, Harry B. Heritage of the Desert.
> Kenilworth, Ill.: By the Author, 1934. p.         New York: Ronald Press, 1956.
> 128.                                       146 . Ellwood, Charles A. The Reconstruction
> 128. Dodd, Edward M. and Fose, Wilson                   of Religion. New York: Macmillan Co.,
> Dodd . Mecca and Beyond. Committee                1922.
> on United Study of Foreign Missions.        147. Ellwood, Robert S. Religious and
> 129. Donaldson, Dwight M. The Shi'ite Relig-            spiritual groups in modern America.
> ion. London: Luzac Co., 1933.                     Englewood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hall,
> 130. Dooley, Dr. Tom . Dr. Tom Dooley's                  1973. pp. 275-81.
> Three Great Books: Deliver Us from Evil,    148. Elwell-Sutton, Laurence Paul. Modern
> The Edge of Tomorrow, The Night They              Iran. London: George Rutledge Sons,
> Burned the Mountain. New York: Farrar,             1941; reprint 1942.
> Straus & Cudahy, n.d. pp. 308-309.          149. Emanuel, W. V. The Wild Asses, a Jour-
> 131. - - . The Night They Burned the                    ney Through Persia. London: Jonathan
> Mountain. New York: Farrar, Straus &              Cape, 1939.pp. 88, 109.
> Cudahy, 1960.pp. 87- 88.                    150. Emerson, Edwin, Jr. A History of the
> 132. Dos Passos, John. Journeys between                 Nineteenth Century Year by Year. 3 vols .
> Wars. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1939 .            New York: P. F. Collier & Son, 1900.
> 133. Douglas, William 0. Strange Lands and              Vol. 2: p. 1131.
> Friendly People. New York: Harper &         151. Eskelund, Karl. Behind the Peacock
> Bros., 1951. p. 51.                               Throne . London: Alvin Redman, 1965.
> 134. - - . West of the Indus. New York:                  pp. 75-85.
> Doubleday & Co., 1958. pp. 254, 272,        152. Farah, Caesar E. Islam Beliefs and
> 279-280,417-418,427.                              Observances. Woodbury, N.Y.: Barron's
> 135. Drake, Durant. Problems of Religion.                Educational Series, 1970. pp. 220,
> Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1916 . pp.              243-248 .
> 211,231.                                    153. Ferguson, Charles W. The Confusion of
> 136. Dubin, Joseph W. The Green Star.                    Tongues. Garden City, N.Y.: Double-
> Philadelphia: National Institute of                day, Doran & Co., 1928. pp. 13,
> Esperanto, 1944.                                  231-250,450-451 .
> 137 . Dunning, H. W. To-Day in Palestine.         154. - -. The New Books of Revelation.
> New York: James Pott & Co., 1907. pp.             Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran &
> 582                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Co., 1929.pp. 13,231-250,450-451.                  Mohammedanism: An Historical Survey.
> Same as above, retitled .                       London: Oxford University Press, 1949.
> 155. Ferguson, John. War and Peace in the               pp. 164, 186.
> World's Religions. New York: Oxford           170. Gibran, Kahlil and Jean. Kahlil Gibran.
> University Press, 1978 . pp . 149-155.             Boston: New York Graphic Society,
> 156. Ferre, Nels Frederick Solomon. Know                1947 . pp. 273,287-288.
> Your Faith. New York: Harper Bros.,                  Pencil drawing of 'Abdu'l-Baha done
> 1959. p. 34.                                         by Kahlil Gibran in 1912, p. 288.
> 157. Filmer, Henry (pseud. for James Rives         171. Gibbons, Herbert Adams. et al. Great
> Childs). The Pageant of Persia.                    Religions of the World. New York:
> Indianapolis: Bobbs-Merrill Co., 1936.             Harper & Bros., 1901. pp. 187-215; rev .
> pp . 28, 196-200,202-203.                          ed., 1912. pp. 187-215.
> 158. Fitch, Florence Mary. Allah, the God of              Pages cited: BABISM by E. Dennison
> Islam. New York: Lothrop, Lee &                      Ross. New preface in 1912, revised
> Shepard Co., 1950. p. 136.                           edition.
> 159. Forbes, Murray. Hollow Triumph.               172. Gordon, General Sir Thomas Edward.
> Chicago: Ziff-Davis Publishing Co.,                Persia Revisited. London: E. Arnold,
> 1947.pp.215,233-234,267.                           1896. pp. 81-91.
> 160. Forlong, Major General J. G. R. Faiths        173. Grabbe, Paul. The Story of Orchestral
> of Man, A Cyclopaedia of Religions. 3              Music and Its Times. New York: Grosset
> vols. London: Bernard Quaritch, 1906.              & Dunlop, 1942. p. 68.
> Vol 1: pp. 223-224.                           174. Gratus, Jack. The False Messiahs. New
> 161. Forman, Henry James and Gammon,                    York: Tarplinger Publishing Co., 1976.
> Roland. Truth is One. New York: Harper             pp. 209-211.
> &Bros., 1954.pp. 218-222.                     175. Green, Gerald. The Stones of Zion. New
> Photographs: Baha'i House of Wor-               York: Hawthorn Books, 1971. pp.
> ship, Wilmette, p. 218; Dr. Hushang             305-307, 318.
> Javid and Horace Holley, p. 218.           176. Green, Phillip Leonard. Pan-American
> 162. Fradenburgh, J. N. Living Religions; or            Progress. New York: Hastings House,
> the Great Religions of th e Orient. Cincin-        1942 .
> nati: Cranston & Stowe, 1888. pp.             177. Groseclose, Elgin. Introduction to Iran.
> 476-477.                                           New York: Oxford University Press,
> 163. Frye, Richard N. The Heritage of Persia.           1947 . p. 14.
> Cleveland, 0 .: World Publishing Co.,         178. Gruber, Ruth. Israel Today, Land of
> n.d. p. 212.                                       Many Nations . New York: Hill & Wang,
> 164. - - . Iran. New York: Henry Holt &                 1958. p. 17.
> Co., 1953. pp. 11, 66.                        179. Guerard, Dr. Albert Leon. Education of
> 165. Gairdner, W. H. T. The Reproach of                 a Humanist. Cambridge: Harvard Uni-
> Islam . London: Student Volunteer Mis-             versity Press, 1949. p. 250.
> sionary Union, 1909. p. 351.                  180. Haas , William S. Iran . New York: Co l-
> 166. Gartler, Marion; Laikin, Judith; and               umbia University Press, 1946. pp .
> Hall, George. Understanding Israel. Sac-           90-91.
> remento, Calif.: California State Series,     181. Hadley, Earl J. Magic Powder. New
> 1964.                                              York: Putnam, 1945. pp. 200-201.
> Colour photo, Shrine of the Bab, on                Frontis: Photo of Baha'i House of
> cover.                                             Worship, Wilmette; facing page 197,
> 167. Geden, Alfred S. Studies in Comparative              photo House of Worship detail.
> Religion. London: Charles H. Kelly,           182. Haines, Charles Regin ald. Islam as a
> 1898. pp. 291 - 300.                               Missionary Religion. London: Society for
> 168. Gellhorn, Eleanor Cowles. McKay's                  Promoting Christian Knowledge, 1889.
> Guide to the Middle East. New York:           183. Hall, William H. The Near East: Cross-
> David McKay Co., 1965. pp. 160-161.                roads of the World. New York: Inter-
> 169. Gibb, Hamilton Alexander Rosskeen.                 church Press, 1920. p. 66.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                       583
> 184. Hamilton, Elizabeth. Put Off Thy Shoes.            Textbook. New York: Macmillan Co.,
> New York : Scribner's, 1957. p. 86.               1947. p. 399.
> 185. Handley-Taylor, Geoffrey, comp. Bib-         200. Hodgson, Marshall G. The Order of the
> liography of Iran. Chicago: St. James              Assassins. The Hague, Netheriands:
> Press, 1969. pp. 107, 108, 109.                   Mouton & Co., 1955. pp. 276, 291.
> 186. Harris, Warren G. Gable and Lombard.         201. Hoffman, Daniel P. India's Social Mira-
> New York: Simon & Schuster, 1974. pp.             cle. Healdsburg, Calif.: Naturegraph
> 137, 153.                                         Co., 1961. pp . 39, 68, 95.
> 187. Harrison, Marguerite Elton (Baker).          202. Holiday Magazine Travel Guide, Israel.
> There's A lways Tomorrow. New York:               New York: Random House, 1973. pp. 91,
> Farrar & Rhinehart, 1935. p. 644.                 94.
> 188. Harry, Myriam. A Springtide in Pales-                  Photo of Shrine of the Bab and Intertine. Boston: Houghton Miffin, 1924.                  national Archives Building, page, 91.
> pp. 25-26.                                  203. Holisher, Dersider. The House of God.
> 189. Hart, Walter C. First Course in Algebra.            New York: Crown Publishers, 1946. p.
> Boston: D. C. Heath, 1947. p. 76.                  171.
> 190. Hartman, William C., comp. and ed.                     Photo of Baha'i House of Worship,
> Hartman's Who's Who in Occult, Psychic                Wilmette, page 171.
> and Spiritual Realms. New York: Occult       204. Holmes, John Haynes. Palestine To-Day
> Press,1925.pp. 17,33,85-87,165,187.               and To-Morrow. New York: Macmillan
> 191. - - . Who's Who in Occultism, New                   Co., 1929. pp. 33-36.
> Thought, Psychism and Spiritualism.          205. Hoople, Ross E. et al. Preface to
> Jamaica, N.Y.: Occult Press, 1927. pp.             Philosophy: Book of Readings. New
> iv, vi-viii, 1-2, 7, 11, 13 , 16, 18, 39,          York: Macmillan Co., 1946. pp. 308,
> 51-52, 58, 60, 77, 177, 226, 230, 235,             312, 379-384.
> 241, 251-253.                                206. Hoover, W. I. T. Religionisms and Christ-
> 192. Hasan-E-Fasa-i. History of Persia under            ianity. Boston: Stratford Co., 1924. pp. v,
> Qajar Rule-Farsnama- Ye Naseri. Trans.             165-178.
> Heribert Busse. New York: Columbia           207. Hopkins, E. Washburn. The History of
> University Press, 1972. pp. 277, 290-             Religions. New York: Macmillan Co.,
> 294, 302-304.                                      1918. pp. 479, 482.
> 193. Hayes, Carlton Joseph Huntley. A Polit-       208. Houghton, Walter R. ed. Neely's History
> ical and Cultural History of Modern               of the Parliament of Religions and Religi-
> Europe. 2 vols. New York: Macmillan               ous Congresses at the World's Columbian
> Co., 1939. Vol. 2: p. 450.                        Exposition. Chicago: F. T. Neely, 1893.
> 194. Hertz, Rabbi Richard C. Jewish Life                pp. 640-641.
> Today. Detroit: Temple Beth El, 1962.        209. Howe, Mark Anthony De Wolfe, comp.
> 195. Higgins, Harold H. Shadows to the                  Holmes-Pollack Letters, 1874-1932. 2
> Unseen . Montpelier, Vt.: Driftwood               vols. Cambridge: Harvard University
> Press, 1937.                                      Press, 1941. Vol. 1: p. 206.
> 196. Hilu, Virginia. Beloved Prophet-The           210. - -. John Jay Chapman and His Let-
> Love Letters of Kahlil Gibran and Mary            ters., Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1937. p.
> Haskell and Her Private Journal. New              260.
> York: Alfred Knopf, 1972. pp. 74, 77.        211. Howells, Rulon S. Do Men Believe What
> 197. Hitti, Phillip K. The Near East in History.        Their Church Prescribes. Salt Lake City,
> Princeton, N.J.: D. Van Nostrand Co .,            Utah: Desert Book Co., 1932. p. 160.
> 1961.pp.391,403-407.                         212. Howen, Herbert H.Asia, a Short History
> 198. Hocking, William Ernest. Living Reli-              from Earliest Times to the Present. Bosgions and a World Faith . New York:               ton: Little, Brown & Co., 1936.
> Macmillan Co., 1940. pp. 180, 212.           213. Huart, Clement.A History ofArabic Lit-
> 199. Hocking, William Ernest; Blanshard,                erature. London: W. Heinemann, 1903;
> Brand; Hendel, Charles W.; and Ran-                New York: D. Appleton & Co., 1903. p.
> dall, John H., Jr. Preface to Philosophy           212.
> 584                                  THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 214. Hubbard, Elbert. Hollyhocks and Gol-              World of Today. 1929.
> den Glow. East Aurora, N.Y.: Roycrof-        232. Kahn, E. J., Jr. Who, Me? New York:
> ters, 1912. pp. 21-40.                           Harper, 1949. p. 179.
> 215. - -. Selected Writings. Vol. 10:             233. Kamshad, Hassan. Modern Persian Prose
> Hundred-Point Men . East Aurora, N.Y.:            Literature. Cambridge: University Press,
> Roycrofters, 1922. pp. 320- 332 .                 1966. pp.48, 51, 194.
> Photo of 'Abdu'l-Baha, page 320.         234. Keddie, Nikki R. An Islamic Response to
> 216. Hughes, Thomas Patrick . Dictionary of            Imperialism. Berkeley, Calif.: University
> Islam. London: W. H. Allen & Co.,                 of Ca lifornia, 1968. pp. 10-11, 30, 43 ,
> 1865.                                            158.
> 217. Hume, Robert Ernest. The World's Liv-        235. - - . Religion and Rebellion in Iran .
> ing Religions. New York: Charles                  London: Frank Cass & Co., 1966. pp. 56,
> Scribner's Sons, 1924. p. 212.                    71, 72, 102, 107-109, lB, 132, 136,
> 218. Hume-Griffith, M. E. Behind the Veil in           143, 144.
> Persia and Turkish Arabia. London:           236. - - . Sayyid Jamal Ad-Din 'A/-
> Seeley & Co., 1909.                               Afghani'. Berkeley, Calif.: University of
> 219. Hunter, Stanley Armstrong. Temple of              California, 1972. pp. 19-22.
> Religion and Tower of Peace. San Fran-       237. Kellett, E. E. A Short History of Relicisco: Temple of Religion and Tower of            gions. London: Victor Gollancz, 1948.
> Peace, 1940. pp. 10,54, 85.                  238. Kennedy, J. M. The Religions and
> 220. Hurgronje, C. Snouck. Mohammedan-                 Philosophies of the East. London:
> ism. New York: G. P. Putnam's Sons.               Werner Laurie, 1911.
> 221. Iqbal, Sir Mohammad. The Reconstruc-         239. Keyserling, Hermann. The Travel Diary
> tion of Religious Thought in Islam. Lah-          of a Philosopher. 2 vols. New York:
> ore: Muhammad Ashraf, 1958. p. 152.               Harcourt,Brace&Co ., 1925. Vol.1: pp.
> 222. Israel Ministry for Foreign Affairs,               160, 178; Vol. 2: p. 273.
> Information Department. The Arabs in         240. Kohn, Hans. A History of Nationalism in
> Israel. Jerusalem, April 1961.                    the East. New York: Harcourt, Brace,
> 223. Jackson, A. V. Williams. Persia, Past and         1929.pp.31-36,430.
> Present. London: Macmillan & Co.,            241. Kolarz, Walter. Religion in the Soviet
> 1906.pp . 28,48-50,119,273,328,376.              Union. London: Macmillan & Co., 1966.
> 224. Jackson, Stanley. pseud. (Samuel). The            pp. 470-473, 497; New York: St. Mar-
> Sassoons. London: William Heinemann ,             tin's Press, 1961.
> 1968.                                                Mention on dust cover, back.
> 225. Jacobsen, Ernst Ludwig Harthern.             242. Kirkland, Winifred. As Far as I Can See.
> Going Home. London: Jarrolds, 1938.               New York: Scribner's, 1936.
> 226. Jacoby, F. J., ed . The Anglo-Palestine      243. Kirkpatrick, Clifford. Religion in Human
> Year Book I947-I948.             London:          Affairs. London: John Wiley & Sons,
> Anglo-Palestine Publications.                      1929. pp. 212,291,307,487.
> 227. Jessup, Henry Harris. Fifty-three Years in   244. Kisch. Col. Frederick Hermann. Pale-
> Syria. 2 vols. New York: Fleming Revell,          stine Diary. London: V. Gollancz, 1938.
> 1910. Vol. 1: p. 329; Vol. 2: pp. 605,       245. Kohn, Hans. A History of nationalism in
> 636-638.                                          the east. Grosse Point, Mich.: Scholarly
> 228. Jewett, Mary. Reminiscences of My Life            Press, 1969. pp. 15, 20, 31-34, 320, 328.
> in Persia. Cedar Rapids, la.: Torch Press,   246. Kuwaldo, Boris and Fyuel, T. R . This is
> 1909.                                             Israel. North Dakota: Bruno Cassirer.
> 229. Jiggetts, J. Ida. Israel to Me, a Negro      247. Lammens, Henri. Islam Beliefs and
> Social Worker, Inside Israel. New York:           Institutions. Trans. E. Dennison Ross fr.
> Bloch Publishing Co., 1957. pp. 90, 92.           the French. London: Methuen & Co.,
> 230. Jones, L. Bevan. The People of the                1929; New York: E. P. Dutton & Co.,
> Mosque. Calcutta, India: Association              1929. pp. 189-196; New York: Stokes,
> Press, Y.M.C.A., 1932. pp. 141-146.               1930.
> 231. Jordan, Rev. F. M. The Muhammadan            248. Landor, A. Henry Savage. Across
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                      585
> Coveted Lands. 2 vols. New York:                   Palestine. London: Macmillan & Co.,
> Charles Scribner's Sons, 1903. Vol. 1: p.          1922. pp. 33,58-59, 105, 107.
> 391.                                         264 . Lumby , Christopher. Cook's Traveller's
> 249. Landis, Benson Y. Religion in the United            Handbook to Palestine, Syria and Iraq.
> States. New York: Barnes & Noble,                  London: Simpkin Marshall, 1934. pp.
> 1965. pp. 3-4, 104.                                248 , 254.
> 250. - - . World Religions. New York: E. P.        265. Lytton, Noel Anthony Scawen Wilfred.
> Dutton & Co., 1957. pp . 24- 25.                   Scawen Blunt, a Memoir. London: Mac-
> 251. Lavan, Spencer. The Ahmadiyah Move-                 donald & Co., 1961.
> ment. New Delhi: Manonar Book Ser-           266. McDaniel , Robert A. The Shuster Mis -
> vice.                                              sion and the Persian Constitutional
> 252. Lenczowski, George. The Middle East in              Revolution. Minneapolis, Minn.: Bib-
> World Affairs. New York: Cornell Uni-              liotheca Islamica, 1974. p. 54.
> versity Press, 1956 . pp. 205 , 374.         267. Macintosh , Douglas Clyde. The Pilgrim-
> 253. Levi, Avraham . Bazak Guide to Israel,              age of Faith. Calcutta, India: University
> 1977- 1978. New York: Harper & Row,                of Calcutta, 1931. p. 33 .
> 1977. pp. 285, 299, 307, 311, 322, 327.      268. McKibben-Harper, Mary, M.D. The
> Colour photo of Shrine of the Bab, page         Doctor Takes a Holiday. Cedar Rapids,
> 314; colour photo of Shrine, pages              Ia.: Torch Press, 1941.
> 296-297; drawing of Shrine of the         269. MacMunn, Lt. Gen. Sir George . The
> Bab, page 302.                                  Religions and Hidden Cultsoflndia. New
> 254. Levy, Reuben. The Sor;ial Structure of              York: Macmillan Co., 1932. p. 200.
> Islam. London: Cambridge University           270. Mahmud, Sayyid Fayyaz. The Story of
> Press, 1957. p. 39.                                Islam . London: Oxford University Press,
> 255. Lewis, John . The Religions of the World            1959. p. 290.
> Made Simple. New York : Doubleday &          271. Malcolm, Napier. Five Years in a Persian
> Co., 1958 . p. 90.                                 Town. New York: E . P. Dutton, 1907.
> 256. Ling, Trevor. A History of Religion East      272. Markham, Clements Robert. A General
> and West. London: Macmillan & Co.,                  Sketch of the History of Persia. London:
> 1968. pp. 388-389.                                 Longmans, Green & Co., 1874.
> 257. Linkl ater, Eric. The Man on My Back.         273. Marlowe, John. Iran a Short Political
> London: Macmillan & Co., 1941. pp.                 Guide. New York: Praeger, 1963. pp. 9,
> 137- 138.                                          104.
> 258. Linton, Bishop J. H. Persian Sketches.        274. Martin, A lfred (Wilhelm) . Comparative
> London: Church Missionary Society,                 Religion and the Religion of the Future.
> 1923.                                              New York: Appleton & Co ., 1926. pp .
> 259. Longrigg, Stephen H. The Middle East.               81-91.
> London: G. Duckworth , 1963; Chicago:        275. Martin, Walter R. The Kingdom of the
> Aldine Publishing Co., 1963; rev. ed.,             Cults. Minneapolis: Bethany Fellowship,
> 1970. p. 95.                                       1965; rev. ed., July 1968 . pp. 252- 258,
> 260. Lorimer, John Gordon. Gazetteer of the              351 , 438.
> Persian Gulf, 'Oman, and Central              276. Mason, Myra . Wh ere Do You Belong?
> Arabia. 6 vols. Vol. 1 Historical, part 2:          Philadelphia: Fellowship of Divine
> pp. 2350, 2356, 2384- 2385.                         Truth , 1939.
> 261. Luk ach, Harry Charles. The Fringe ofthe      277. Masse, Henri. Islam . Trans. Halide Edib
> East. London: Macmillan & Co., 1913.                fr. the French. New York: G. P. Putnam's
> See: Luke, Harry Charles Joseph .                Sons, 1938.pp. 217,248,255 - 259.
> 262. Luke, Sir Harry (Charles Joseph). A Por-      278. Mathews, Shailer and Smith, Gerald
> trait and an Appreciation, Cyprus. Lon-             Birney. A Dictionary of Religion and Ethdon: George G. Harrap & Co., 1957. pp .             ics. Chicago: Christian Century Press,
> 122-123.                                            1922. p. 46.
> 263. Luke, Harry Charles (Joseph) and              279. Mathison , Richard R. Faiths, Cults and
> Keith-Roach , Edward. The Handbook of               Sects in America. New York : Bobbs-
> 586                                   THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Merrill, 1960. pp. 104-106.                  296. Mounsey, Augustus H. A Journey
> 280. Matthews, Joseph Brown and Duvall,                 through the Caucasus and the Interior of
> Sylvanus M. Conflict or Cooperation.              Persia. London: Smith, Elder & Co.,
> New York: American Committee, World               1872 . pp. 103-107 .
> Youth Congress, 1928.                        297. Mumford, Lewis. The Conduct of Life.
> 281. Maud , Constance E. Sparks among the               New York: Harcourt, Brace & Co.,
> Stubble. London: P. Allen & Co., 1924.            1951. p. 117.
> pp. 26-27,81 - 112.                          298. Nakosteen, Mehdi and Kragh, Agnes. In
> Portrait of 'Abdu'l-Baha facing page           the Land of the Lion and the Sun. The
> 83.                                            Country, Customs and Cultures of My
> 282. Mead, Frank S. Handbook of Denomina-               People. Denver: World Press, 1937. pp.
> tions in the United States. New York:             79-80.
> Abingdon-Cokesbury Press, 1951. pp .         299. Nariman , G. K. Persia and Parsis. Bom-
> 24-25, 185; 5th ed.: Nashville: Abing-            bay, 1925.
> don Press, 1970. pp . 29-31, 221, 237.       300. Nasr, Seyyed Hossein. Iran (Persia).
> 283. Means, I. and L. E. Creative Energy.               Tehran: Offset Press, 1973.
> London: John Murray, 1931.                   301. - - . Islam and the Plight of Modern
> 284. Melton, J. Gordon. The Encyclopedia of             Man. London: Longman, 1975. pp. 118,
> American religions. Wilmington , N.C.:            119.
> McGrath, 1978. vol. 2: pp. 351-354.          302. Newman, Edward M. Seeing Egypt and
> 285 . Miller, Herbert A. The Beginning of               the Holy Land. New York: Funk & Wag-
> Tomorrow. New York: F. A. Stokes,                 nalls Co., 1928. pp. 164-165 , 204.
> 1932.                                                 Photo of 'Abdu'l-Baha, page 204.
> 286. Miller, Janet. Camel Bells of Baghdad.        303. Nicholson, Reynold A. The Mystics of
> Boston: Houghton Mifflin , 1934. pp.              Islam. Beirut, Lebanon: Khayats, 1966.
> 218, 220, 264.                                    p. 89.
> 287. Miller, Milton G. and Schwartzman, Syl-       304. Norden, Herman . Under Persian Skies.
> van D. Our Religion and Our Neigh-                Philadelphia: Macrae, Smith Co., n.d.
> bors. New York : Union of American                pp. 51-52, 127, 208,226-227,243.
> Hebrew Congregations, 1963. pp. 6,           305. Noss, John B. Man's religions. New
> 209-210, 273 .                                    York: Macmillan, 1949. p. 556.
> 288. Miller, William McElwee. The Baha'i           306. Nweeya, Samuel Kasha. Persia and the
> Faith: its history and teachings. South           Mos/ems. St. Louis: Press of Von Hoff-
> Pasadena: William Carey Library, 1974.             mann, 1924. pp. 148-170.
> 289. - - . Bahaism: Its Origin, History and                 Pages cited, 'BABISM' .
> Teachings. New York: Fleming Revell         307. - - . Persia the Land of the Magi.
> Co., 1931.                                        Indianapolis: S. K. Nweeya, 1904. pp.
> 290. - - . What is the Baha'i Faith? Grand               81-96 (chap. 11: 'The Kurds and Bobs');
> Rapids: Eerdmans, 1977 .                           Philadelphia: S. K. Nweeya, 1907. pp.
> 291. Mills, Lady Dorothy. Beyond the Bos-                110-115 (chap. 11: 'The Kurds and
> phorus. Boston : Little, Brown & Co.,              Bobs'); Philadelphia: S. K, Nweeya,
> 1926. pp. 97- 100.                                 1916. pp. 226-248 (chap. 12: 'Babism,
> 292. Modern Art in the U.S.A. New York:                  Its Relation to Mohammedism and
> Knopf, 1956. p. 263.                               Christianity').
> 293. Montagu, Edwin Samuel. An Indian              308. Official Guide (Panama-Pacific Interna-
> Diary. Edited By V. Montagu. London:             tional Exposition, San Francisco, 1915).
> Heinemann, 1930.                                  Wahlgreen Co., 1915. p. 61.
> 294. Moore, George Foot. History of Reli-          309. O'Leary, DeLacy Evans. Islam at the
> gions . 2 vols. New York: Scribner's Sons,         Crossroads. London: Kegan Paul,
> 1919. Vol. 2: pp . 509-519.                       Trench, Trubner & Co., 1923; New
> 295. Mott, Francis John. Christ th e Seed. Bos-          York: E. P. Dutton & Co., 1923 .
> ton: A. A. Beauchamp, 1939; London:         310. Oliphant, Laurence. Haifa, or Life in
> Gate Publishing Co. , 1939.                       Modern Palestine. Edinburgh: William
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                      587
> Blackwood, 1887; New York: Harper &                Meridian Books, 1958. pp. 42-43.
> Bros., 1887.pp. 103- 107.                    326. - - . Ethics of the Great Religions.
> Pages cited titled: 'The Babs and Their         London: Watts & Co., 1948. pp.
> Prophet'.                                       212-213.
> 311. Orizu, Akweke Abyssinia Nwafor.               327. Pole, Wellesey Tudor. Private Dowding.
> Without Bitterness. New York: Creative             New York: Dodd, Mead & Co., 1919.
> Age Press, 1944.                                   pp. 74-75.
> 312. Orni, Ephraim and Efrat, Elisha. Geo-         328 . - - . The Silent Road. London: Neville
> graphy of Israel. Jerusalem: Israel Pro-           Spearman, 1960. pp. 24-26, 75 - 80,90.
> gram for Scientific Translations, 1966.      329. - - . Some Deeper Aspects of the War.
> pp. 217-218.                                       Bristol, England: Taylor Bros., 1914.
> Photo of Shrine of the Bab, page 218.     330. - - . Writing on the Ground. London:
> 313 . Ovington, Mary White. The Walls Came               Neville Spearman, 1968. pp. 135-165,
> Tumbling Down. New York: Harcourt,                 172, mention on flap of dust cover.
> Brace & Co., 1947. pp. 125-127.                       Photo 'Abdu'l-Baha, facing page 135.
> 314. Palestine. London: Ernest Benn, 1934.         331. Pole, Wellesey Tudor and Lehmann,
> 315. Palmer, Edward Henry. Oriental Mysti-               Rosamond. A Man Seen from Afar. Loncism. London: Luzac& Co., 1938. p. 44.             don: Neville Spearman, 1965. pp. 53, 77.
> 316 . Parrinder, E. Geoffrey.A BookofWorld         332. Port, Weimer. Chicago the Pagan.
> Religions. Amersham: Hulton Educa-                 Chicago: Judy Publishing Co., 1953. pp.
> tional, 1965.                                       167-168.
> 317. - - . Comparative Religion. New               333. Potter, Charles Francis. The Faiths Men
> York: Macmillan Co., 1962. pp. 23, 82,            Live By. New York: Prentice-Hall, 1954.
> 108.                                              pp. 307-308.
> 318. - - . A Dictionary of non-Christian           334. Prather, Nelson, ed. Who's Who in
> religions. Philadelphia: Westminster               Hawaii. Honolulu, T.H.: Midpac Pub-
> Press, 1971. pp. 7, 38-39.                        lishers, 1947. p. 10.
> 319. - - . What World Religions Teach.             335. Price, Willard. Adventures in Paradise.
> London: George G. Harrap, 1968. pp.                 New York: John Day, 1955. pp .
> 107- 109, 140, 190.                                180-181.
> 320. Parrish, Maude. Nine Pounds of Lug-           336. Radford, Ruby L. Many Paths to Cod.
> gage. Philadelphia: J.B. Lippincott Co.,           Wheaton, III.: Theosophical Publishing
> 1939. pp. 368-373.                                 House, 1970.pp.2, 122-125, 127,.
> 321. Pemberton, Lovell Bearse. A Modern                     Photo of Baha'i House of Worship,
> Pilgrimage to Palestine. Philadelphia:                Wilmette, page 23.
> Dorrance & Co., 1925. pp. 67, 73 , chaps,    337. Radhakrishnan, Sir Sarvepalli. Eastern
> 9, 10 & 11 (pp. 74- 104), 149, 156, 189            Religions and Western Thought. New
> chap. 26 (pp. 190-197), 263-264.                   York: Oxford University Press, 1959. p.
> Illustrations: drawing of Baha'i House          340.
> of     Worship,      Wilmette,    Louis   338. Rand. Abby. The American Traveller's
> Bourgeois' model, dust cover and fron-          Guide to Israel. New York: Charles
> tispiece; Garden of 'Rizwan, Near               Scribne~sSons, 1972.pp. 13,74, 199 .
> Haifa', p. 92; 'Abdu'l-Baha, p. 100.               Photo of Shrine of the Bab, page 196.
> 322. Petersen, William J. Those Curious            339. Rasooli, Jay M. and Allen, Cady H. The
> Cults. New Canaan, Conn.: Keats Pub-               Life Story of Dr. Sa'eed of Iran. Grand
> lishing, pp. 181-190, 213.                         Rapids: Grand Rapids International
> 323. Phelps, Vivian. Concerning Progressive              Publications, 1958. pp. 90. 92, 103, 115.
> Revelation. London: Watts & Co., 1936.       340. Reeder, Paul A. Introduction to Philosop. 105.                                            phy. Lucas Bros., 1960.
> 324. Piggot, John . Persia - Ancient and Mod-      341. Reinach, Salomon. A History of Reliern. London, 1874.                                 gions. Trans, fr . the French, London: G.
> 325. Pike, E. Royston . Encyclopaedia of                 P. Putnam Sons, 1909.
> Religion and Religions. New York:            342. Religious Bodies 1916. 2 vols. Washing-
> 588                                     THE BAHA ' l WORLD
> 
> ton , D.C.: Department of Commerce                    London: Society for the Promotion of
> Bureau of Census, 1919. Vol. 1: pp . 36,              Christian Knowledge, 1932.
> 74 , 78 , 142, 154-155 , 164-165 ,              351. Robertson, John M. Pagan Christs. Lon-
> 182-183,184- 185 , 198- 199,202-203 ,                 don: Watt & Co., 1911. pp . xvi-xviii .
> 208-209,214- 215,228- 229,232-233 ,             352 . Rodford , Ruby L. Many Paths to God.
> 358-359,378- 379, 380-381,430-431,                    Wheaton : Theosophical Publishing
> 448-449,478- 479, 490- 491 , 494- 495 ,               House, 1970. pp . 122-125.
> 512-513, 526- 527; Vol, 2: pp. 43-45.           353. Ross, Sir Edward Dennison. Both Ends
> 343. Religious Bodies 1926. 2 vols, Washing-                of the Candle. London: Faber & Faber,
> ton, D.C.: Department of Commerce                     1943 .
> Bureau of Census, 1930. Vol. 1: pp. 10,         354. - - . The Persians. Oxford: Clarendon
> 82-83,92,97, 102, 112, 117, 122-123,                  Press, 1931. pp. 67-69, 75, 76.
> 148-149, 166- 167,192- 193 ,194-195 ,          355 . Ross, Emory and Myrta. Africa Dis-
> 216-217 , 220- 221,230-231 , 270-271,                 turb ed. New York: Friendship Press,
> 276-277,296- 297 , 360,369,374 ,378,                 1959 .
> 381, 389,392, 394,406,408, 446 , 451 ,         356. Rowley, Peter. New Gods in America.
> 457,468 , 470,472,475,477 , 482 , 486,               New York: David McKay Co., 1971. pp .
> 490,496,502 , 507,510,515 , 521 , 536,               3, 8, 12-17, 205.
> 540, 548, 563,572,573; Vol. 2: pp. 70-76.      357. Rudhyar, Dane. Astrological Timing.
> 344. Religious Bodies 1936. 3 vols . Washing-               New York: Harper & Row, Harpe
> ton , D.C.: Department of Commerce                   Calophon Books, 1972, pp. 42, 53,
> Bureau of Census, 1941. Vol. 1: pp. 12,              63 - 64, 109, 114, 139- 140, 141,
> 86-87,98,104,110,116,126,136-137,                    142- 143 , 151.
> 146-147, 176- 177 , 190- 191 , 198-199,        358. - - . The Astrology of Personality.
> 224-225,226- 227,232-233,248-249,                    New York: Lucis Publishing Co., 1936;
> 254-255,264- 265 , 300-301 , 306-307 ,               reprint ed. , Garden City, N.Y.: Double-
> 314-315,316- 317,350- 351 ,440, 442 ,                day & Co., 1970. pp. 209- 210 , 233, 238,
> 448,455,461,464, 466,470,472 , 480 ,                 246, 272, 322, 421.
> 483,485,488,490,497,499, 502, 505,             359. - -. Birthpatternsfor anewhumanity:
> 515,520, 528, 542,546, 553 , 555, 560,                a study of astrological cycles structuring
> 564, 565, 566, 568 574, 581, 584, 585,                the present world crisis. The Netherlands:
> 589, 592,594,595 , 600,605 ,6 10,617,                 Servire-Wassenar, 1969. pp. 42, 53 , 102,
> 621,623,626,630,632 , 634,63 5,640,                   114, p9, 142-4, 151, 191 , 211.
> 646,652,653 , 655 , 659 , 666,669 ,673 ,       360. - -. Cycle of Culture and Sacrifice .
> 678 , 679,681 , 686, 691,692, 700, 713 ,              Carmel, Calif: Hamsa Publications, 1929.
> 715; Vol. 2, pt. 1: pp. 76- 82.                 361. - -. Gifts of the Spirit. Los Angeles:
> 345 . Rice, C. Colliver. Persian Women and                   New Age Publishi ng Co., 1946. p. 128.
> Their Ways. London : Seeley Service,           362. - -. New Mansions for New Men . New
> 1923 . pp. 21,24, 155-156,275- 276.                   York: Lucis Publishing Co., 1938. p. 236.
> 346. Rice, Clara C. Mary Bird in Persia. Lon-         363. - -. Rania, an Epic Na rrative. San Frandon : Church Missionary Society, 1916.               cisco: Unity Press, 1973. pp. 176- 178.
> pp . 37-40, 71, 102, 107 , 143, 191.           364. - -. The Sun ls A lso a Star. New York:
> 34 7. Rice, Edward. Eastern definitions: a                   E. P. Dutton, 1975. p. 97.
> short encyclopedia of religions of the         365 . - - . The Sun Is Also Astral. New
> Orient. Garden City: Doubleday, 1978.                 York: E. P. Dutton , 1975. p. 97.
> pp . 45 - 46 .                                 366. - -. Synthetic Drama As a Seed of
> 348 . - -. Ten Religions of the East. New                   Civilization. Oceano, Calif.: Harbinson
> York : Four Winds Press, 1978 . pp. 2-3,            & Harbinson .
> 127, 133- 141.                                367. Rumble, Rev. Dr. Leslie and Carty, Rev.
> 349. Richards, Fred. A Persian Journey. New                  Charles Mortimer. Radio Replies. 3 vols.
> York: Jonathon Cape & Harrison Smith,                St. Paul, Minn.: Radio Replies Press,
> 1932 .                                               1942. Vol. 3: p. 42.
> 3 50. Richa rds, J. R. The Religion ofthe Baha'is.   368. Rutland, Jonathan . Looking at Israel.
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                       589
> London: Adam & Charles Black;                   382. Sharma, Rosha n Lal. Holy Men and
> Philadelphia: J.B . Lippencott Co. , 1970.            Holy Cows. New York: Exposition Press,
> 369. Rypka, J. History of Iranian Literature.              1968. pp . 163-164.
> Dordrecht, Holland: D. Reidel Publish-          383. Shedd , W. A. 'Second Study' . The Vital
> ing Co., 1968. p. 374.                                Forces of Christianity and Islam. J. H.
> 370. Saghaphi, Mirza Mahmoud Khan. Jn the                  Golden , ed. London : Humphrey Mil-
> Imperial Shadow. Garden City, N.Y.:                   ford , 1915.pp. 51-52, 57, 62,63 , 74.
> Doubleday, Doran & Co., 1926. p. 400.           384. Shephard, Judy and Rosenfeld, Alvin.
> 371. St. John , Robert and editors of Life.                Ticket to Israel. New York: Rhinehart &
> Israel. New York: Time, 1962. pp.                     Co., 1952 . pp . 202 , 218 , 230 .
> 129-130, 131.                                   385. Sheil, Lady. Glimpses of Life and Man -
> 372. Samuel, Viscount Herbert Louis. Belief                ners in Persia. London: John Murray,
> and Action. London: Cassel & Co., 1937 .               1856. pp . 176-181 , 272-282.
> 373. Sasek , Miroslav. This is Israel. Italy:        386 . Shimoni, Yaacov and Levine, Evyatar.
> Printed by Fratelli Fabbri editori, 1962;             Political Dictionary of the Middle East in
> reprint ed. , 1966. 27, 33.                           the 20th Century. Jerusalem: Jerusalem
> Children's book of drawings with cap-              Publishing House, 1972. p. 63.
> tions: Shrine of the Bab, page 27; view               Photo of Shrine of the Bab, page 63.
> of Bay of Haifa from Mt. Carmel show-        387. Shuster, W. Morgan. The Strangling of
> ing Shrine of the Bab and Baha'i Ar-              Persia. New York: Century Co., 1912.
> chives building which are not identified.         pp . 21-22 .
> 374. Savage, Minot J . The Passing and the           388 . Siddiqi, Aslam. Modernization Menaces
> Permanent in Religion. New York: G. P.                Muslims. Lahore: E. Muhammad
> Putnam's Sons, 1901. p. 147.                          Ashraf, 1974. pp. 63 , 277.
> 375. Schnapper, Edith B. , comp. One in All.         389. Sinclair, Upton . The Profits of Religion.
> Wisdom of the East series . London: John              Pasadena, Calif.: Upton Sinclair, 1918;
> Murray, 1952. pp. xv, 15-16, 30-31,                   New York: Vanguard Press, 1927. p.
> 45-46 , 62- 63, 78, 92- 93, 109- 110,                 254.
> 126- 127, 142-143, 149.                         390. Singer, Caroline and Baldridge, Cyrus
> 376. Searight, Sarah. The British in the Middle            LeRoy . Half the World is Isfahan. New
> East. London : Wiedenfeld & Nicholson,                York: Oxford University Press, 1936. p.
> 1969; New York: Athenum, 1969. pp.                    36.
> 81-82, 142.                                     391. Skinner , Clarence R. A Religion for
> 377. Sedych, Andrei. This Land is Israel. New              Greatness. Boston: Murray Press, 1945 .
> York: Macmillan Co., 1967. pp. 68-7 1.          392. Smart, Ninian. The Religious Experience.
> Photo of Shrine of the Bab, pages 69               New York: Charles Scribner's Sons,
> and 86.                                            1976 . pp.22 , 435-436.
> 378. Seitz, William C. Mark Tobey. New               393. - - . The Religious Experience of
> York: Museum of Modern Art, 1962. pp .                Mankind. New York: Charles Scribner's
> 10, 12-15,44,45,47,50,90, 91.                         Sons, 1969.pp.417-418 .
> 379. Sell, Edward. Bahaism. Islam series.            394. Smith, R. Bosworth. Mohammed and
> London: Madras & Colombo: Christian                   Mohammedanism . London: Smith Elder
> Literature Society for India, 1912.                   & Co., 1874; New York: Harper &
> 380. - - . The Faith ofIslam. London: Soci-                Bros., 1875 .
> ety for the Promotion of Christian Knowl-       395 . Smith, Wilfred Cantwell. Islam in Modedge, 1920. pp. 184-209.                              ern History. Princeton University Press,
> 381. Shabaz, Absalom D. La.nd of the Lion                  1957. pp. 135, 153.
> and the Sun . Madison, Wis.: by the             396. Solomon, Victor. A Handbook of Con -
> author, 1901 and n.d. pp. 49-51.                      versions to the Religions of the World.
> 1901 edition has photo of 'Abdu'l-                 New York: Stravon Educational Press,
> Baha, page 51. Undated edition has an              1965. pp. 362-367.
> illustration of 'Mohammed and the                    Photo of Baha'i International Arc-
> Koran' on page 51 in its place.                       hives and Shrine of the Bab, page 364
> 590                                  THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> and House of Worship , Wilmette, page         1937. pp .67, 322 ,332 .
> 366.                                             American title of above 'Orientations'.
> 397 . Soper, Edmund Davison. The Religions        413. Strachan, Francoise, ed. The Aquarian
> of Mankind. New York: Abingdon-                   Guide to Occult, Mystical, Religious,
> Cokesbury, 1938. pp. 311-312; 3d rev.             Magical London and Around. London:
> ed., 1951. p. 223.                                Aquarian Press, 1970. pp. 5-6.
> 398. Speer, Robert Elliott. The Finality of       414. Sweet, William Warren. The Story of
> Jesus Christ. Westwood, N. J.: Fleming            Religion in America. New York: Harper
> H. Revell Co., 1933.                              & Bros., 1930, 1939. p. 626.
> 399. - - . The Light of the World . West          415. Swift, A. C. Religion Today. New York:
> Medford , Mass.: Central Committee on             McGraw-Hill, 1933.
> the United Study of Missions, 1911. pp .    416. Sykes, Percy Molsworth. A History of
> 214-216.                                          Persia. 2 vols. London: Macmillan & Co.,
> 400. - -. Missionary Principles and Prac-               1915. Vol. 2: pp. 443-447; rev. ed.,
> tices. New York: Fleming H. Revell Co.,           1930. Vol. 2: pp. 341-345.
> 1902 .                                      417. - - . Persia. Oxford: Clarendon Press,
> 401. - -. Missions and Modern History.                  1922. pp. 127-129.
> New York: Fleming H. Revell Co., 1904.      418. - -. Ten Thousand Miles in Persia or
> Vol. I: pp . 121 - 182.                           Eight Years in Iran. London: John Mur-
> 402 . - - . The Unfinished Task of Foreign              ray, 1902.
> Missions. New York: Fleming H. Revell       419 . Thielman, Baron Max von. Journey in
> Co., 1926.                                        the Caucasus, Persia and Turkey in Asia.
> 403. Spengler, Oswald. The Decline of the               2 vols. London: n.p., 1875 . Vol. 1: p.
> West-Perspectives of World History. 2             262; Vol. 2: pp. 52, 90-91.
> vols. New York: Alfred Knopf, 1928 . p.     420. Thompson, Ernest. Spiritualism and the
> 228.                                              Evolution of Religion. London: Psychic
> The abridged edtion has no Baha'i             Book Club, 1953.
> mention.                                421. Tillyard. Aelfrida . Spiritual Exercises
> 404. Spiegelberg, Frederic. Living Religions            and Their Results. New York: Macmillan
> of the World. Englewood Cliffs, N.J.:             Co., 1927; London: Society for Promot-
> Prentioe-Hall, 1956 . pp. 419-421.                 ing Christian Knowledge , 1927.
> 405. Stark, Freya. Baghdad Sketches. Lon-         422. Titus, Murray T. The Young Moslem
> don: E. P. Dutton & Co., 1938 and J.              Looks at Life. New York: Friendship
> Murray, 1939.                                     Press, 1937. pp. 61-62 .
> 406. Steiner, M. J . Inside Pan-Arabia.           423. Todd, A. J. Theories of Social Progress.
> Chicago: Packart, 194 7 . p. 211.                  New York: Macmillan Co., 1924.
> 407. Stevenson, Dwight Eshelman. Faiths           424. Tolstoi , Leo Nikolaevich.- Kingdom of
> That Compete for My Loyalty. St. Louis,          God, What is Art? What is Religion? New
> Mo.: Christian Board of Publication,              York: Thomas Y. Crowell, 1899. p. 353 .
> 1948 . pp. 71-72.                          425. - - . What is Religion? And Other New
> 408. Stewart, George Rippey. American Way               Articles and Letters. Trans. V. Tchertkoff
> of Life. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday,             and A. C. Fifield. London: Free Age
> 1954. pp. 67, 69 .                                Press, 1902. p. 174.
> 409. Stoddard, Lothrop. The New World of          426. Toynbee, Arnold J. Christianity among
> Islam. New York: Charles Scribner's              the Religions of the World. New York :
> Sons, 1922. p. 324.                               Charles Scribner's Sons, 1957. p. 104.
> 410. Storer, Rev. J. Thoughts That Build. New     427. - -. Civilization on Trial. New York:
> York: Macmillan Co., 1924.                        Oxford University Press, 1948. p. 204 .
> 411. Storrs, Sir Ronald. Orientations. Lon-       428. - - . A Study of History. London:
> don: Nicholson & Watson, 1939. pp. 67,            Oxford University Press, 1939. Vol. 5: p.
> 322, 332.                                         174.
> 412. - - . The Memories of Sir Ronald             429. Tritton, Arthur Stanley. Islam; Beliefs
> Storrs. New York: G . P. Putnam's Sons,           and Practices. London: Hutchinson Uni-
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                        591
> versity Library, 1954. pp. 157-158.                  lishing Corp., 1970. pp. 79-90.
> 430. Trout, David M. Religious Behavior.            444. Vitzetelly, Frank H. Who? When?
> New York: Ma,cmillan Co., 1931. pp.                 Where? What? New York: Funk & Wag-
> 281-282.                                            nalls Co., 1920 and 1925.
> 431. Tweedie, Ethel Brilliana ('Mrs. Alec-                    Dictionary: 'Baha'i', page 8.
> Tweedie'). Mainly East. New York: E. P.       445. Voss, Carl Hermann. In Search of Mean-
> Dutton, 1922. pp. 252-253; London:                  ing. Cleve land, 0.: World Publishing
> Hutchinson & Co., 1922.                             Co., 1968. pp . 158-159 .
> 432. Underhill, Evelyn. The Life of the Spirit      446. - - . The Universal God. Cleveland,
> and the Life Today . London: Wetheren                0.: World Publishing Co., 1953. p. 269.
> & Co., 1925.                                  447. Vreeland, Herbert H. Iran. New Haven,
> 433. Upton, Joseph M. The History of Mod-                 Conn.: Human Relations Area Files,
> ern Iran, an Interpretation. Cambridge,              1957. pp. 101 , 254,296,297.
> Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1965.        448 . Waamani, Israel T. Israel: A Profile. New
> pp . 10-11.                                         York: Praeger, 1972. pp. 9, 78.
> 434. Uris, Leon. Exodus Revisited. New              449. Wadia, Ardaser Sorabjee N. The Mes -
> York: Doubleday, 1960.                              sage of Mohammed. London: J.M. Dent
> Photo of Baha'i International Ar-                 & Sons, 1923. p. 141.
> chives building, page 32.                   450. Wagar, W. Warren. The City of Man:
> 435. Ussher, John. Journey from London to                 Prophecies of a World Civilization in
> Persepolis. London: n.p., 1865. pp. 120,             Twentieth-Century Thought. Boston:
> 627--629.                                           Houghton Mifflin Co., 1963 . pp. 7,
> 436. Van Baalen, Jan Karl. The Chaos of                    117-120, 300.
> cults: a study in present-day isms. 4th rev.   451. - - . Building the City of Man. New
> & en!. ed. Grand Rapids: Eerdmans,                   York: Grossman Publishers, 1971. p. 56.
> 1973. pp. 146-61.                             452. Wallis, Wilson D. Messiahs: Christian
> 437. Vanderbilt, Cornelius, Jr. Man of the                and Pagan. Boston: Richard G. Badger,
> World, My Life on Five Continents. New               1918. pp. 111-116,228- 229.
> York: Crown Publishers, 1959. pp.              453. Walstrum, Mary Price. The Nineteenth
> 311-312,317-318,320- 321 .                           and Twentieth Centuries: Reminiscences.
> 438. Van Passen, Pierre. Days of Our Years.               Philadelphia: Dorrance & Co ., 1935:
> New York: Hillman-Curl, 1939. p. 30.           454 . Warren, Edith, comp. Important Ameri-
> 439. Van Sommers, Tess. Religions in                      can Poets and Songwriters. 194 7. p. 141 .
> Australia. PIX Series Extended to 41           455. Watson, Robert Grant. A History of
> Bel iefs. Adelaide, Australia: Rigby,                Persia. London: Smith Elder & Co., 1866.
> 1966. pp. 17-23.                                    pp. 347-352, 360-362, 385-395,407-
> Photo of interior of Baha'i House of              410.
> Worship, Sydney, Australia, page 17 .       456. Watt, W. Montgomery. Islamic Surveys.
> 440. Vaughan, George. Temple and Towers                   Vol. 1: Islamic Philosophy and Theology.
> (A Survey of the World's Moral Out-                   Edinburgh: University Press, 1962. pp.
> look). Boston: Meador Publishing Co.,                 171, 188.
> 1941.pp.429- 431,551 - 552.                    457. Watts, Harold H. The Modern Reader's
> Photo of Horace Holley facing page                Guide to Religion. New York: Barnes &
> 336 .                                             Noble, 1964. pp. 501, 584.
> 441. Vaughan, John Gaines. Religion, a              458 . Welch, Anthony. Calligraphy in the arts
> Comparati"JJC Study. Cincinnati, 0.:                 of the Muslim world. Austin: University
> Abingdon Press, 1919.                                of Texas Press, 1979. pp. 168-9.
> 442. Vilnay, Zev. The Guide to Israel.              459 . Whalen, William J. Faiths for the Few.
> Jerusalem: By the author, 3d rev. ed.,                Milwaukee, Wis.: Bruce Publishing Co.,
> 1958; 3d rev. ed., 1960. pp. 28,                      1963. pp. v, vii, 36- 41; mention on dust
> 346- 347, 359.                                       cover.
> 443. Vines, Ernest M. Gems of the East, or          460. White, Lyman Cromwell. International
> God in every nation. Sydney: West Pub-               Non-Governmental Organizations. New
> 592                                 THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University              Whitman and His Times. New York:
> Press, 1951.                                     Harper, 1941.
> 461. Whittingham, George Napier. Th e            477. Wismer, Don. The Islamic Jesus. New
> Home of Fadeless Splendour. New                  York: Garland Publishing Co., 1977 . p.
> York: E.P. Dutton & Co. , (1921). pp.            254.
> 234-236.                                   4 78. Wolcott, Leonard and Carolyn. Reli-
> Photo of 'Abdu'l-Baha being knigh-            gions around th e World. Nashville:
> ted, facing page 234.                         Abingdon Press, 1967. pp . 171,
> 462. Widgery, Alban G. Living Religions and            174-175 , 182.
> Modern Thought. London: Williams &                  Children 's book illustrated by Gordon
> Norgate, 1936. pp. 212-200.                         Laite.
> 463. Wiedyke, Robert G. and Hurd, Mary K. ,      479. Wollaston, Arthur N. The Sword of
> comps. American Concrete Institute 55            Islam. London: John Murray, 1905.
> Year Index 1905-1959. Detroit, Mich. :     480 . Wons, Anthony . Tony's Scrap Book.
> American Concrete Institute , 1960 . pp.         Chicago: Reilly & Lee , 1932. p. 41.
> 15, 234 , 236.                             481. Wood , Clement. The Outline of Man's
> 464. Wilber, Donald N. Iran-Past and Pres-             Knowledge. New York: Grosset & Dunent. Princeton, N.J .: Princeton Univer-         lap, 1927. p. 517.
> sity Press, 1948. pp. 79-80.               482. Wright, Denis. The English amongst the
> 465. Williams, David Rhys . World Religions            Persians. London: Heinemann, 1977.
> and the Hop e for Peace. Boston: Beacon          pp.44, 120, 164.
> Press, 1951. pp. 142-151, 203, 218,        483. Wysner, Gloria M. Near East Panorama.
> mention on dust cover.                           New York: Friendship Press, 1950 . pp.
> 466 . Williams, Henry Smith, ed. The His-              59-60.
> torians' History of the World. 25 vols.    484. Young, Barbara. This Man from Leba-
> London: Hooper & Jackson , 1904. Vol.            non. New York: Alfred A. Knopf, 1945;
> 24: pp. 493-494,499.                             1961, pp. 68- 69.
> 467. Williams, John Alden, ed. Themes of         485. Younghusband, Sir Francis. The Gleam.
> Islamic Civilization . Berkeley, Calif.:         London: John Murray, 1923. pp.
> University of California, 1974. pp.              182-214.
> 242-243.                                   486. - - . Modern Mystics. London: John
> 468. Williamson, George Hunt. Road in the              Murray, 1935; New Hyde Park, N.Y.: E.
> Sky. London: Neville Spearman, 1959.             P. Dutton& Co., 1935. pp. 97 - 142, 252,
> 469. - - . The Saucers Speak. London:                  253.
> Neville Spearman, 1963. p. 110.            487. - -. A Venture of Faith Being a
> 470. Wills, C. J. In the Land of the Lion and          Description of the World Congress of
> the Sun, or Modern Persia. London: Ward          Faiths Held in London, 1936. London:
> Lock & Co ., 1891. pp. 144, 153-156,             Michael Joseph, 1937. pp. 50, 152-156.
> 164, 201,272,317, 339.                     488 . Yonan, Isaac Malek. The Beloved Physi-
> 471. - - . Persia as It Is. London: Sampson,           cian of Teheran . Nashville: Cokesbury
> Low, Marston, Searle & Rivington,                Press, 1934. pp. 88-90.
> 1887. pp. 7-8.                             489. Zwemer, Samuel M. Heirs of the
> 472. Wilson, Sir Arnold Talbot . The Modem             Prophets. Chicago: Moody Press, 1946.
> World. London: Ernest Benn, 1932.                p. 118.
> 473. - - . Persia. London: Ernest Benn,          490. - - . Islam, a Challenge to Faith. New
> 1932.                                            York: Student Volunteer Movement for
> 474. Wilson, Rev. Samuel Graham. Bahaism               Foreign Missions, 1907. pp. 147-149,
> and Its Claims. New York: Fleming                248.
> Revell Co., 1915.                          491. - - . The Moslem World. Cleveland,
> 475. - - . Persian Life and Customs . New              0.: J. H. Lamb, 1908. p. 200; Boston:
> York: Fleming H. Revell Co., 1895. pp.          United Society of Christian Endeavor,
> 12,62, 146, 185- 186,221.                        1908. p. 200.
> 4 76. Win war, Frances. American Giant: Walt     492 . Zwemer, Samuel M. and Brown, Arthur
> BAHA'I BIBLIOGRAPHY                                      593
> J. The Nearer and Farther Eas1. New               ference on Behalf of the Mohammedan
> York: Macmillan Co., 1908. p. 98.                 World Held at Cairo, April 4th - 9th,
> 493. Zwemer, Samuel M. et al, ed. The                  1906. New York: Young People's Mis-
> Mohammedan World of To-Day being                  sionary Movement, 1906. pp. 17, 115,
> Papers Read at the First Missionary Con-          116, 117-118, 121, 129-130.
> 
> E. A PARTIAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF ENGLISH-LANGUAGE ITEMS
> BY BAHA'IS IN WHICH MENTION IS MADE OF THE
> BAHA'I FAITH
> 
> (published under non-Baha'i auspices)
> 
> Baker, Richard St. Barbe. I Planted Trees.        Gillespie, Dizzy. To Be or Not .. . to Bop.
> London: Lutterworth, 1944.                        Garden City: Doubleday, 1979.
> - - . My Life My Trees. London: Lutter-           Hayden, Robert. Angle of Ascent. New York:
> worth , 1970.                                     Liveright, 1975.
> Banani, Amin. The Modernization of Iran ,         - - . The Night-Blooming Cereus. London:
> 1921-1941. Stanford: Stanford University          Paul Breman, 1973.
> Press, 1961.                                    Kazemzadeh, Firuz. Russia and Britain in Per-
> Bausani, Alessandro. The Persians from the          sia, 1864 - 1914. New Haven: Yale Univer-
> Earliest Days to the Twentieth Century . Lon-     sity Press, 1968.
> don: Elek , 1971.                               Leach, Bernard. Beyond East and West. Lon-
> Cobb, Stanwood. The Real Turk. Boston: Pil-         don: Faber and Faber, 1978.
> grim Press , 1914.                              - -. Drawings, Verse and Belief London:
> Cole, W. Owen, ed. World Religions: a Hand-         Jupiter Books, 1973.
> book for Teachers. London: Commission for       Murchie , Guy. The Seven Mysteries of Life.
> Racial Equality, 1977. Article by Philip          Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1978.
> Hainsworth.                                     - -. Song of the Sky. Cambridge: Riverside
> Danner, Ma rgaret Esse. The Down ofa Thistle.       Press, 1954.
> Waukesha : Country Beautiful, 1976.             Prickett, John, ed. Initiation Rites. London:
> Dunne, Finley P., ed. World Religions Speak         Lutterworth Educational, 1978. Article by
> on the 'Relevance of Religion to the Modern       Philip Hainsworth.
> World.' The Hague: Dr. W. Junk, 1970.           Scrutton, Robert. The Other Atlantis. Jersey:
> Article by Dr. H . M. Munje.                      Neville Spearman, 1977.
> Fozdar, Jamshed. The God of Buddha. New           Vail , Albert R. and Vail, Emily McClellan.
> York: Asia Publishing House, 1973.                Heroic Lives. Boston: Beacon Press, 1917.
> 
> F. A PARTIAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF THESES RELATING TO THE
> BAHA'I FAITH
> 
> Asander, Margit. (1974) Baha'[-Jsmen. Stock-      Berger, Peter L. (1954) From Sect to Church:
> holms     Universitet,  Religionshistoriska       A Sociological Interpretation of the Baha'i
> Institutionen.                                    Movement. Ph.D., New York: New School
> Baghdadi, Guita. (1977) Religion, Sante et          of Social Research.
> Medecine: Place de la Foi Baha'i. M.D. ,        Beveridge, Kent. (1977) Die gesellschaft-
> Universite de Grenoble.                          spolitische Rolle der Baha'i-Verwaltung-
> Behroozi, Shahla B. (1971) The Role of Balza'{     sordnung innerhalb der Gemeinschaft der
> Faith in the Social Development of Baha'i         Baha'i, unter besondere Betrachtung der zwei
> Youth in Los Banos Laguna. Masters of            leitenden lnstitutionen (The sociopolitical
> Social Work, University of the Philippines.       role of the Baha'f administrative order inside
> 594                                   THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> the Baha'i community, with special refer-           Shi'i Islam. Ph.D. , Cambridge University.
> ence to its two leading institutions). Docto-     Murthi, R . Ganesa. (1969) The Growth of the
> rate, Vienna.                                      Bahti'( Faith in Malaysia. University of
> Garrigues, Steve L. (1976) The Bahft'fs of             Malaya.
> Malwa: Identity and change among the             Ong, Henry. (1978) Yan Kee Leong: a Biogra-
> Urban Bahft'[s of Malwa. Ph.D., Lucknow            phy of a Malaysian Cartoonist. M.S., Iowa
> University .                                       State University.
> Hakim, Christine. (1971) Naissance de la Foi        Parnian, Shahnaz. (1974) A Study of the
> Bahft'(e, et Son Processus Social. M.A. , Uni-      Methods of Communication Used by Bahti'(s
> versite de Nanterre.                                in Educating Persons to Adopt Bahti'{ Faith.
> Hakim-Samandari, Christine. (1979) Etude              B.A. University of Rajasthan.
> d'une     Institution   Religieuse: 'l'Ordre      Philipp, Mango! Bayat. (1971) Mirza Aqii
> Administratif Baha'i et la communaute des           Khiin Kirmiini: 19thC Persian Revolutionary
> fideles. Ph.D., Ecole des Hautes Etudes en          Thinker. Ph.D., University of California at
> Sciences Sociales.                                  Los Angeles.
> Izadinia, Foad. (1977) Centro de £studios de        Rafati, Vahid. (1979) The Development of
> Post Grado para Panama. M.A., Univer-              Shaykhf Thought in Shtf Islam. Ph.D.,
> sidad de Panama, Facultad de Arquitectura.         University of California at Los Angeles .
> Jackel, Rudolf. (1951) Die Glaubenslehren der       Ross, Margaret J. (1979) Some Aspects of the
> Bahti't-Religion. Ph.D., University of             Bahti'( Faith in New Zealand. M.A. , Univer-
> Ti.ibingen.                                         sity of Auckland.
> Johnson, Vernon Elvin. (1974) An Historical         Rost, Harry. (1969) The Possible Nature and
> Analysis of Critical Transformations in the         Establishment of Bahti'( Universities and Col-
> Evolution of the Bahti'{ World Faith. Ph.D.,       leges Based Upon a Study of Bahti'( Litera-
> Baylor University, Texas.                          ture. D .Ed., University of South Dakota.
> Kahn, Sandra Santolucito. (1977) Encounter          Schaefer, Udo. (1957) Die Grundlagen der
> of Two Myths: Bahti'( and Christian in the          Verwaltungsordnung der Bahti'( (The foun-
> Rural American South-A Study in Trans-             dations of the Baha'i administrative order).
> mythicization. Ph.D ., University of Califor-      Doctorate, Heidelberg.
> nia at Santa Barbara.                            Schmitz, Anke. (1973) Das Prophetenver-
> Khazei, S. (1963) Finanzpolitische·Probleme in        stiindnis der Baha'(-Religion aus der Sicht
> der 'Neuen Weltordnung' auf Grund der              ihrer Grunder. M.A., Millheim-Ruhr.
> Bahti't-Lehre (Finance-political problems        Scholl, Steven D. (1980) Imiimi Shi'ism and
> in the 'New World Order' based on the Baha'i       the Bahti'( Faith: a Preliminary Study. B.A.,
> teachings). Doctorate, Innsbruck.                   University of Oregon.
> Loi, Luciano. (1974) Alcuni Aspetti delta Fede      Szepesi, Angela. (1968) A Proposed World
> di Bahti'u'lltih (Some aspects of the faith of     Order: Bahti'( Teachings and Institutions.
> Baha'u'llah). Universita degli Studi di Cagli-      M.A., Laval University, Quebec.
> ari Facolta di Scienze Politiche.                Ward, Allan Lucius. (1960) An Historical
> Mahmoudi, Jalil. (1966) A Sociological                Study of the North American Speaking Tour
> Analysis of the Bahti'( Movement. Ph.D.,           of'Abdu'l-Baha and a Rhetorical Analysis of
> University of Utah.                                His Addresses. Ph.D ., Ohio University.
> Martin, James Douglas. (1967) The Life and          Yazdani, Farhan. (1976) Les Deux Ailes d'un
> Work of Sarah Jane Farmer, 1847-1916.              Oiseau, ou: une introduction ii la Conception
> M.A. University of Waterloo, Ontario.              Baha'ie de la Sante. M.D., Universite de
> McEoin, Denis. (1977)A Revised Surveyofthe             Lyon.
> Sources for Early Bab( Doctrine and History.     Zabih, M. (1949) Die Losung der sozialen
> Fellowship Dissertation, King's College,            Frage auf Grund der Bahti't-Lehren (The
> Cambridge.                                          solution to the social question according to
> McEoin, Denis. (1979) From Shaykhism to                the Baha'i teachings). Doctorate, Stuttgart.
> Babism: a Study in Charismatic Renewal in
> ORIENT AL TERMS                              595
> 
> III
> ORIENT AL TERMS
> 
> 1. TRANSLITERATION OF ORIENTAL WORDS
> FREQUENTLY USED IN BAHA'I LITERATURE
> 
> 'Aba               'Aziz                Fars                 I~fahan
> Abadih                                  Farsakh              'Iwqabad
> 'Abbas             Bab                  Fat9-'Ali            Iwraqat
> 'Abdu'l-Baha       Babi                 Firdaws              Ifil}tihard
> 'Abdu'l-I:Iamid    Babu'I-Bab           Firdawsi             Islam
> 'Abdu'l-I:Iusayn   Baghdad                                   Isma'iliyyih
> 'Abdu'llah         Baha                 Ganjih               'Izzat
> Abha               Baha'i               Gflan
> Abu'l-Fa<;ll      Baha'u'llah          Gui                  Jal al
> 'Adasiyyih         Bahiyyih             Gulistan             Jamadiyu'l-Avval
> Adhan              Bahji                Gurgin               Jamal
> Adhirbayjan        Baluchistan                               Jamal-i-Mubarak
> Afnan              Bandar-' Abbas       I:Iabib              Jamal-i-Qidam
> Agh~an             Baqir                I:Iadilh             Jasb
> 'Ahd               Baqiyyatu'llah       I:Ia<;trat           Jubbih
> A9mad              Barfurush            I:Ia ji
> A9sa'i            Ba~rih               I:Iaji Mirza Aqasi   Ka'bih
> Ahvaz              Ba turn              I:Iajj               Kad-Khuda
> Akbar              Bay an               Hamadan              Kalan tar
> 'Akka              Bayt                 I:Iaram              Kali mat
> 'Ala'              Big                  I:Iasan              Kamal
> 'Ali               Birjand              Hawdaj               Karand
> 'Ali-Mu9ammad      Bifil}arat           I:Iaydar-' Ali       Karbila
> Allah-u-Abha       Bismi'llah           Haykal               Kaw an
> Alva9              Bukhara              I:Ia?iratu'l-Quds    Kawkul
> Alva9-i-Salatin    Burujird             l:lijaz              Kawmu'~-~a'ayidih
> Amatu' l-Baha      Bushihr              Hijrat               Kawlhar
> Amin               Bufil}ru'i           Himmat-Abad          Ka?im
> Amir               Buwruyih             I:Iujjat             Ka?imayn
> Arnir-Ni?am                             I:Iusayn             Khalkhal
> Amru'llah          Chihriq                                   Khan
> Amul                                    Ibrahim              Khaniqayn
> Anzali             Dala'il-i-Sab'ih     fl                   Khayli Khub
> Aqa                Darughih             'Ilm                 Khurasan
> Aqdas              Dawlat-Abad          Imam                 Khuy
> 'Arabistan         DhabiQ               Imam-Jum'ih          Kirman
> Asma'              Duzdab               Imam-Zadih           Kirmanshah
> Astarabad                               fqan                 Kitab-i-' Ahd
> 'Avashiq           Fara'id              fr an                Kitab-i-Aqdas
> Ayadi              Fa ran               'Iraq                Kitab-i-Asma'
> Azal               Farman               'Iraqi               Kitab-i-Badi'
> 'A?amat            Farrash-Bashi        'Iraq-i-' A jam      Kitab-i-fqan
> 596                                   THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Kulah                  Mu~!afa                Rafsanjan                 Sul!fou'sh-Shuhada'
> Kurdistan              Mustagha!.!:!          Ral)Jm                    Sunni
> Mu?affari'd-Din        Ra!) man                  Suratu'l-Haykal
> Lahijan                                       Ral)mat                   Surih
> Lar                                           Ra'is                     Suriy-i-Damm
> Nabfl
> Law!)                                         Ramac;Ian                 Suriy-i-Ghu~n
> Nabfl-i-A'?am
> Luristan                                      Ras ht                    Suriy-i-Ra'is
> Najaf
> Najaf-Abad             Rawl)ani                  Suriy-i-Sabr
> Madrisih                                      Ric;Ivan
> Naqic;Iin
> MaJ:ibubu'sh-Shuhada                          Ruhu'llah
> Na~ir                                            Tabarsi
> Mahd-i-'Ulya
> Na~iri'd-Dfn                                     Tabriz
> Mah-Ku                                        Sabzivar
> Navvab                                           Tahirih
> MaJ:imud               Naw-Ruz                Sadratu'l-Muntaha         Tajalliyat
> Malayir                                       SaJ:iibu'z-Zaman
> Nayriz                                           Takur
> Man- Yu?hiruhu'llah                           SaJ:iffatu'l-J:Iaramayn   Taqf
> Nishapur
> Maqam                                         Sa'id
> Nuq!ih                                           Tarazat
> Maraghih                                      Salsa bf!
> Nur                                              Tarbiyat
> MarJ:iaba                                     Samarqand                 Tashkand
> Marv                                          Sangsar
> Pahlavi                                          Tawl)fd
> Masa'il                                       Sari
> Pa ran                                           Thurayya
> Mashhad                                       Saysan                    Tihran
> Mashiyyat                                     Sha'ban                   Tuman
> Ma~riqu'l-A@kar        Qac;Ii                 Shah                      Turkistan
> Masjid                 Qadiyan                Shahid
> Maydan                 Qahqahih               Shahmfrzad
> 'U la ma
> Mazindaran             Qa'im                  Shahrud
> UrumJyyih
> Mihdi                  Qajar                  Sharaf
> 'U!.!:! ma n
> MiJ:irab               Qalyan                 Shari' ah
> Milan                  Qam~ar                 Shaylgl
> Mi' raj                Qa~r-i-Shfrin          Shaykh-Tabarsf            VaJ:iid
> Mirza                  Qawl                   Shaykhu'l-Islam           Vali
> Mishk.in-Qalam         Qayyum                 Shi'ah (Shi'ih)           Vali-'Ahd
> Mu'adhdhin             Qayyumu'l-Asma'        Shiraz                    Varqa
> Mufti                  Qazvfn                 Shuilitar                 Vazfr (also Vizfr)
> MuJ:iammad             Qiblih                 Sim nan
> MuJ:iammad-' Ali       Qu£han                 Sis tan                   Ya-Baha'u'l-Abha
> MuJ:iammarih           Quddus                 Siyah-Chal                YaJ:iya
> MuJ:iarram             Qudrat                 Siyyid                    Yazd
> Mujtahid               Qum                    Sllfi
> Mulk                   Qur'an                 Sulayman                  Zanjan
> Mull a                 Qurban                 Sul!an                    Zarand
> Munirih                Qurratu'l-' Ayn        Sul!an-Abad               Zaynu'l-Muqarrabin
> ORIENTAL TERMS                                                     597
> 
> 2. GUIDE TO TRANSLITERATION AND
> PRO NUN CIA TION OF THE
> PERSIAN ALPHABET
> 
> t       . . ... a
> L
> •
> .. .. kh     uD            ...... ~        ~           ..... k
> 
> '--'                                               J'                           :;.(        .... . g
> • . .. .. b              i>.       ..... d                     ..... <;I
> 
> -
> ' -• ' .. . .. p           ::;,      .... dh          ~ . . .... !                J        ...... 1
> 
> ~
> . .... m
> "-..::J ...... t           _).      ... . .. r
> E          •... . ?-
> •
> ~ ..... !.h
> ~
> -        .. . .. z
> .E        .. . ... '      _,,
> <..:)       ... . . n
> 
> -c        ...... j
> _.)        ····~
> ~
> .. . . gh
> ~
> . . ... v
> 
> .....h
> 
> ~          . ... ch
> ....r.-     ...... s
> ~ ...... f
> ~ .. .. . . ,
> . .... y
> 
> L..         ... .. I)
> ~ .... fill                  0           ..... q
> s
> 
> a ... as in              i ... as (e) in           u . . . as ( o) in            aw ... as m
> account                      best                        short                    mown
> a . . . as in           I ... as(ee)in             u . . . as (oo) in
> arm                       meet                       moon
> 
> The 'I' added to the name of a town signifies 'belonging to' . Thus Shfrazf means native of Shiraz.
> 
> 3. NOTES ON THE PRONUNCIATION
> OF PERSIAN WORDS
> The emphasis in Persian words is more or            and the second syllable to rhyme with on.
> less evenly distributed, each syllable being          Americans are apt to pronounce short 'a' plus
> equally stressed as in French . For example, do       'r' like the verb form a re; this is a mistake; 'ar'
> not say Tabriz or Tabarsf ; stay as long on one       should be pronounced as in the word
> syllable as on the next; Tabriz; Tabarsf. (While      hurry- cf. Tarblyat.
> there are many exceptions to this rule, it is the        The same differentia tion should be observed
> most generally correct method of treating the         in the case of long and short 'i' and long and
> question of stress.)                                  short 'u'. As the guide to the transliteration
> A frequent mistake is the failure to distin-       indicates, short ' i' is like 'e' in best, and long 'f'
> guish between broad and ft at 'a's.' This differen-   like 'ee' in meet; for example, Ibrahim is protiation makes the language especially musical         nounced Eb-raheem; Islam is Ess-lahm. Short
> and should be observed: in the word Afnan, for        'u' being like 'o' in short, and long 'u' like 'oo'
> example, pronounce the first 'a' as in account.       in moon, the following would be pronounced:
> 598                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Quddus- Qod-dooss;               Barfurufil}- Bar-      In the case of double letters pronounce each
> foroosh.                                             separately: 'Ab-bas.
> Pronounce 'aw' to rhyme with low , or mown;          The character transliterated (') represents a
> Naw-Ruz is No-Rooz.                                  pause; it is not unlike the initi al so und made in
> The following consonants may be pro-              pronouncing such a word as every. The word
> nounced like z: dh, z, '.?, <;!.                     Baha'i is phonetically as follows: 'a' as in
> T he following consonants may be pro-             account; 'a' as in hall; ('), pause; 'i'as ee in
> nounced like ss: !_h, s, ~-                          meet.
> Zh is pronounced like the 's' in pleasure. K!J       The character transliterated (') may also be
> is pronounced like 'ch' in Scottish lo ch or Ger-    treated as a pause .
> man nacht. Do not pronoun ce it as ' k'. Western-       N.B. As Persian often indicates no vowel
> ers often experience difficulty pronouncing          sounds and as its pronunciation differs in dif-
> 'gh' and 'q'; a guttural French ' r' will serve      ferent localities throughout Persia and the
> here; otherwise use hard 'g' as in good.             Near East as well as among individuals in any
> H and ~, approximately like the English           given locality, a uniform system of transliteraaspirate 'h' , should never be dropped. Tihran is    tion such as the above, which is in use by Baha'i
> Teh-ron; madrisih is mad-res-seh; Mi~rab is          communities all over the world, is indispe ns-
> Meh-rob .                                            able to the student.
> 
> Calligraphic arrangement ofpart ofthe opening sentence ofthe Will and Testament of'Abdu' l-
> Bahti: 'All Praise to Him Who, by the Shield of His Covenant, hath guarded the Temple of
> His Cause.'
> ORIENTAL TERMS                                            599
> 
> 4. DEFINITIONS OF SOME OF THE ORIENT AL
> TERMS USED IN BAHA'I LITERATURE
> Ab: Father.                                            Badf' calendar.
> Aba, Abu, Abi: Father of.                            Bab: 'Gate'. Title ass umed by Mirza 'Ali-
> 'Aba: Cloak or mantle .                                MuJ:iammad, after the declaration of His
> 'Abdu'l-Baha: Servant of Baha.                         Mission in Shiraz in May 1844 A .D .
> Abha: Most Glorious .                                Babi: Follower of the Bab.
> Adhan: Muslim call to prayer.                        Babu'l-Bab: 'The Gate of the Gate'. Title of
> Adib: literally 'the learned'.                         Mulla I:Iusayn, the first Letter of the Living.
> Afnan: literally 'twigs'. Denotes the relations of   Badi': literally 'the wonderful'.
> the Bab.                                           Baha: 'Glory', 'splendour', 'light'. Title by
> Agh~an: literally 'branches'. Denotes sons and         which Baha'u'llah (Mirza I:Iusayn-' Ali) is
> male descendants of Baha'u'llah.                    designated. First month of the Badi' calen-
> A.H.: 'Anno Hejirae'. Year of MuJ:iammad's             dar.
> migration from Mecca to Medina, and the           Baha'i: Follower of Baha'u'llah.
> beginning of the Muslim era.                       Baha'u'l-Abha: 'The Glory of the Most Glori-
> 'Ahd: Covenant.                                        ous'.
> AJ:isanu'l-Qi~a~: One of the commentaries on         Baha'u'llah: 'The Glory of God'. Title of Mirza
> the Qur'an revealed by the Bab, on the               I:Iusayn-'Ali; born Tihran, Persia, 12 Nov.
> Surih of Joseph, translated by Tahirih.              1817; ascended Bahjf, Palestine (now
> Akbar: 'Greater', 'greatest'. (See 'Kabir'.)           Israel), 29 May 1892 .
> A'la: 'The Most Exalted One', a title of the         Bahji: literally 'delight'. Denotes that part of
> Bab.                                                 the Plain of 'Akka (Israel) where the Shrine
> 'Ala': 'Loftiness'. Nineteenth month of the            and the Mansion of Baha'u'llah are situated.
> Badi' calendar.                                    Bani-Hashim: The family from which
> 'Ali: The first Imam, the rightful successor of        MuJ:iammad was descended.
> MuJ:iammad; also the fourth Caliph.               Baqiyyatu'llah: 'Remnant of God'; title
> Allah: 'God'.                                          applied both to the Bab and to Baha'u'llah.
> Allah-u-Abha: 'God is All-Glorious'. The             Bayan: 'Exposition', 'explanation'. Title given
> Greatest Name, adopted during the period             by the Bab to His Revelation, and to two of
> of Baha'u'llah's exile in Adrianople as a            His Writings, one in Persian the other in
> greeting among Baha'is. 1                            Arabic.
> Allah-u-Akbar: 'God is the Most Great'.              Baytu'l-'Adl-i-A'~am: The Universal House of
> Superseded by 'Allah-u-Abha' during the              Justice.
> Adrianople period .2                               Big: Honorary title; lower title than Khan.
> Al-Madinah: The city to which MuJ:iammad             Bisharat: literally 'Glad tidings'. Title of one of
> migrated. (See 'A.H.')                               the Tablets of Baha'u'llah.
> Amin: literally 'the trusted' . Trustee.             Caravansary (also 'caravanserai', 'caravan-
> Amir: 'Prince', 'ruler', 'commander', 'gover-          sera'): An inn for caravans.
> nor' .                                             Darughih: 'High constable' .
> Aqa: 'Master'. Title given by Baha'u'llah to         Dawlih: 'State', 'government'.
> 'Abdu'l-Baha . Also 'Mister' when preceding        Dhi'b: 'The Wolf, an appellation applied by
> a name .                                             Baha'u'llah to Shaykh MuJ:iammad-Baqir.
> Aqdas: 'The Most Holy'.                              Dhikr: 'Remembrance', 'commemoration',
> Asma: 'Names'. Ninth month of the Badi'                'mention'; praise or glorification of God;
> calendar.                                            recital of His Names; religious exercise or
> Ayyam: (See Ha).                                       ceremony; (plural adhkar) .
> A'~am: 'The greatest'.                               EI-Abha: Properly, al-Abha, 'The Most
> 'A~amat: 'Grandeur'. Fourth month of the               Glorious'.
> ' God Passes By, p. 176.                             Farman: 'Order', 'command', 'royal decree'.
> ibid ., p. 18.                                     Farrash: 'Footman', 'lictor', 'attendant'.
> 600                                    THE BAHA'l WORLD
> 
> Farrash-Bashi: The head-farrash.                    Imam-Zadih: Descendant of an Imam or his
> Farsakh: Unit of measurement. Approxi-                 shrine.
> mately three miles or five kilometres.          Insha'allah: 'If God wills it'.
> Fatva: Sentence or judgement by Muslim fqan: literally 'certitude'. The title of Baha'u'-
> mufti.                                             llah's Epistle to one of the uncles of the
> Ghu~an: 'Branch'. Son or male descendant of            Bab.
> Baha'u'llah.                                    Ishraqat: literally 'splendours'. Title of one of
> Ha, (Days of): Ayyam-i-Ha. The Intercalary             the Tablets of Baha'u'llah.
> Days, so named by Baha'u'llah in the Kitab- Israfil: The angel whose function is to sound
> i-Aqdas, where He also ordained that they           the trumpet on the Day of Judgement.
> should immediately precede the month of 'Izzat: 'Might'. Tenth month of the Badf'
> 'Ala', i.e. the month of fasting which closes      calendar.
> the Baha'i year. Every fourth year the Jahiliyyih: The dark age of ignorance among
> number of the Intercalary Days is raised           the Arabs before the appearance of
> from four to five.                                  MuQammad.
> l;ladi!h: Tradition. The whole body of the sa- Jalal: 'Glory' . Second month of the Badi'
> cred tradition of the Muslims is called the         calendar.
> Qadi!h. (Plural aQadi!h.)                       Jamal: ' Beauty'. Third month of the Badi'
> l;lac;lrat: literally 'threshold'. Courtesy title      calendar.
> sometimes translated as 'His Holiness'.         Jamal-i-Mubarak: literally 'the Blessed
> l;laji: A Muslim who has performed the pil-            Beauty', applied to Baha'u'llah.
> grimage to Mecca.                               Jamal-i-Qidam: literally 'the Ancient Beauty',
> l;laram-i-Aqdas: The Most Holy Sanctuary, a            applied to Baha'u'llah.
> designation given by the Guardian to the Jihad: Holy war, as specified in Qur'an .
> north-western quadrant of the garden sur- Jinab: Courtesy title sometimes translated 'His
> rounding the Shrine of Baha'u'llah.                Honour'.
> Hawdaj (Howdah): A litter carried by a camel, Jubbih: An outer coat.
> mule, horse or elephant for travelling pur- Ka'bih: Ancient shrine at Mecca. Now recogposes.                                             nized as the most holy shrine of Islam.
> l;la~iratu'l-Quds: 'The Sacred Fold', official      Kabir: literally 'great'. (See 'Akbar'.)
> title designating headquarters of Baha'i Kad-khuda: Chief of a ward or parish in a
> administrative activity.                           town; headman of a village.
> Hijrat (also 'Hijra', 'Hegira'.): literally 'Migra- Kalantar: 'Mayor'.
> tion'. The basis of Islamic chronology. The Kalim: 'One who discourses'.
> date of MuQammad's migration from Mecca Kalimu'llah: 'One Who converses with God'.
> to Medina.                                         Title given to Moses in the Islamic dispensal;luququ'llah: 'Right of God'; payment by              tion.
> believers instituted in the Kitab -i-Aqdas.     Kalimat: 'Words'. Seventh month of the Badi'
> l;lusayniyyih: Place where martyrdom of                calendar.
> J:Iusayn is mourned, or where Muslim pas- Kamal: 'Perfection'. Eight month of the Badi'
> sion plays may be presented. Designation           calendar.
> given by Shf'ahs to Baha'u'llah's Most Great Karbila'f: A Muslim who has performed the
> House in Baghdad, forcibly occupied by             pilgrimage to Karbila.
> them.                                           Kaw!har: A river in Paradise, whence all the
> Ibn: 'Son'.                                            other rivers derive their source.
> 11: 'Clan'.                                         Khadimu'llah: 'Servant of God'. Title of Mirza
> 'flm: 'Knowledge'. Twelfth month of the Badi'          Aqa Jan. 1
> calendar.                                       Khan: 'Prince', ' lord', 'nobleman', 'chieftain'.
> Imam: Title of the twelve Shf'ah successors of Khan: similar to a caravansary.
> MuQammad. Also applied to Muslim religi- Khic;lr: literally 'The Green One'. Said to have
> ous leaders.                                       lived at the time of Abraham, drank from the
> Imam-Jum'ih: Chief of the mullas, who recites
> the Friday prayers for the sovereign.          1
> God Passes By, p. 115.
> ORIENTAL TERMS                                              601
> fountain of life , and is called its custodian.     day of the martyrdom of I:Jusayn.
> He is also said to symbolize the true guide.      Mulk: 'Dominion'. Eighteenth month of the
> His name does not occur in the Qur'an, but          Badi' calendar.
> some commentators identify him with the           Mujtahid: Muslim doctor-of-law. Most of the
> mysterious personage referred to in Qur' an         mujtahids of Persia have received their dip-
> 18:59-81.                                           lomas from the most eminent jurists of Kar-
> Khutbih: Sermon delivered on Fridays at noon          bila and Najaf.
> in Islamic religion.                              Mulla: Muslim priest.
> Kitab: ' Book' .                                    Mustagha!h: 'He Who is invoked', the numeri-
> Kitab-i-Aqdas: literally 'The Most Holy               cal value of which has been assigned by the
> Book' . Title of Baha' u'llah's Book of Laws.       Bab as the limit of the time fixed for the
> Kulah: The Persian lambskin hat worn by               advent of the promised Manifestation.
> government employees and civilians.               Muti~arrif: ' Governor'.
> Madrisih: ' Seminary', 'school ', 'religious col-   Nabfl: ' Learned ', ' noble'.
> lege'.                                            Naw-Ruz: 'New Day' . Name applied to the
> Man- Yu~hiruhu'llah: 'He Whom God will                Baha'i New Year's Day; according to the
> make manifest'. The title given by the Bab to       Persian calendar the day on which the sun
> the Promised One.                                   enters Aries .
> Mar!)aba: 'Bravo! Well done!'                       N uqtih : 'Point'.
> Masa'il: 'Questions'. Fifteenth month of the        Nur: 'Light'. Fifth month of the Badi' calendar.
> Badi' calendar.                                   Pahlavan: 'Athlete', 'champion'; term applied
> Mashhadi: A Muslim who has performed the              to brave and muscular men.
> pilgrimage to Mashhad.                            Pasha: Honorary title formerly given to
> Mashiyyat: 'Will'. Eleventh month of the Badi'         officers of high rank in Turkey.
> calendar.                                         Pi§hki§h: 'Present', 'tip', 'douceur'.
> Mashriqu'l-Adhkar: literally 'the dawning           Qa<;li: 'Judge'; civil , criminal and ecclesiastical.
> place of the praise of God'. Title designating    Qa'im: 'He Who shall arise' . Title designating
> Baha'i Houses of Worship.                            the Promised One of Islam.
> Masjid: Mosque; Muslim place of worship.            Qalyan: A pipe for smoking through water.
> Maydan : A square or open place.                    Qawl: 'Speech'. Fourteenth month of the Badi'
> Mih<;li: Title of the Manifestation expected by       calendar.
> Muslims.                                          Qiblih: 'Point of Adoration'; prayer-direction
> Mi!)rab: The principal place in a mosque where        toward which the faithful turn in prayer. The
> the Imam prays with his face turned towards          Most Holy Tomb of Baha'u'llah at Bahji is
> Mecca .                                              'the Heart and Qiblih of the Baha'i world'.'
> Mi'raj: 'Ascent'. Used with reference               Qurban: 'Sacrifice'.
> Mu!)ammad's ascension to heaven.                  Qudrat: ' Power'. Thirteenth month of the
> Mirza: A contraction of 'Amir-Zadih', mean-           Badi' calendar.
> ing son of Amir. When affixed to a name it        Qur'an: 'The Reading'; 'that which ought to be
> signifies prince; when prefixed, simply mis-        read'. The Book revealed to MuQ.ammad.
> ter.                                              Rabbi-i-A'la: ' Exalted Lord'. One of the
> Mishkin-Qalam: literally 'the musk-scented            designations of the Bab.
> pen'. Title applied to a famed Baha'i callig-     RaJ:imat: 'Mercy' . Sixth month of the Badi'
> raphist.                                            calendar.
> Mu'adhdhin: The one who sounds the Adhan ,          Ra'is: 'President', 'head' . LawJ:i-i-Ra'is, a Tabthe Muslim call to prayer.                          let addressed to the Prime Minister of Tur-
> Mufti: Expounder of Muslim law; gives a fatva         key by Baha'u'llah.
> or sentence on a point of religious jurispru-     Ri<;lvan: 'Paradise'; also the name of the custodence .                                             dian of Paradise. The holiest and most
> Mu!)arram: First month of the Muslim year,            significant of all Baha'i festivals comthe first ten days o_f which are observed by        memorating Baha'u'llah's Declaration of
> Shi'ahs as part of their mourning period for
> the Imams. The tenth day, 'Ashura', is the        1
> God Passes By , pp. 110, 277.
> 602                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> His Mission to His companions in 1863, a            Siyyid: Descendant of the Prophet MuJ:iamtwelve-day period beginning on 21 April and           mad.
> celebrated annually.                                $Ufi: Mystics or mystical doctrine in Islam.
> Sadratu'l-Muntaha: The Divine Lote Tree; the          Sul!an: 'Sovereignty'. Seventeenth month of
> Tree beyond which there is no passing.                the Badf' calendar.
> $adr-i-A''.?am: 'Prime Minister'.                     Sunni, Sunnite: From 'Sunna' (the Way or
> $aJ:iibu'z-Zaman: 'Lord of the Age'; one of the         Practice of the Prophet, as reported in the
> titles of the promised Qa'im.                          J:iadf!h.) By far the largest sect of Islam, this
> Salam: 'Peace', 'salutation'. Muslim greeting.          includes the four so-called orthodox sects:
> Word used to end a thesis.                            Hanbalites, Hanafites, Malikites, Shafiites.
> Salsabil: A fountain of Paradise.                     Surih: Name of the chapters of the Qur'an.
> Samandar: literally 'the phoenix'.                    Suriy-i-Muluk: 'Surih of Kings'; Tablet
> Sarkar-Aqa: literally 'The Honourable Mas-              revealed by Baha'u'llah in Adrianople.
> ter', applied to 'Abdu'l-Baha.                      Ta: Letter 'T' standing for Tihran.
> Shah: 'King', especially of Persia.                   Taj: literally 'crown'; tall felt headdress
> Shah-Bahram: World Saviour and Promised                 adopted by Baha'u'llah in 1863, on the day
> One of the Zoroastrians. Fulfilled by Baha'u' -       of His departure from His Most Holy House .
> llah.                                               Tajalliyat: literally 'effulgences'. Title ofone of
> Shahid: 'Martyr'. Plural of martyr is 'Shuhada'.        the Tablets of Baha'u'llah.
> Sharaf: 'Honour' . Sixteenth month of the Ba di'      Takyih: Religious establishment; usual place
> calendar.                                              of observance of the martyrdom of Imam
> Shari'ah, Sharf'at: Muslim canonical law. The            I:Iusayn.
> law.                                                Tarazat: literally 'ornaments'. Title of one of
> Shaykh: Venerable old man; man of authority; ·           the Tablets of Baha'u'llah.
> elder, chief, professor, superior of a dervish     Tuman: Unit of Iranian currency.
> order, etc.                                        'Ulama: Plural of 'one who knows' ; 'learned' ,
> Shaykhf: School founded by Shaykh-AJ:imad-               'a scholar'.
> i-AJ:isa'f. Among his doctrines, in addition to    'Urvatu'l-Vuthqa: literally 'the strongest
> the imminent dual Advent, was that the                handle'; symbolic of the Faith of God.
> Prophet MuJ:iammad's material body did not         VaJ:iid: 1. A 'unity' or section of the Bayan. The
> ascend on the night of the Mi'raj.                    Persian Bayan consists of nine VaJ:iids of
> Shaykhu'l-Islam: Head of religious court,                nineteen chapters each , except the last,
> appointed to every large city by the Shah.            which has only ten chapters. 2. The eighteen
> Shi' ah, Shi'ih, Shi'ite: Party (of' Ali). Partisan      Letters of the Living (constituting the Bab's
> of 'Ali and of his descendants as the sole            first disciples) and the Bab Himself. 3. Each
> lawful 'Vicars of the Prophet', The Shi'ahs           cycle of nineteen years in the Badf' calendar.
> reject the first three Caliphs, believing that        The word, signifying unity, symbolizes the
> the successorship in Islam belonged right-            unity of God. The numerical values of the
> fully to 'Ali (first Imam and fourth Caliph)          letters of this word total nineteen.
> and to his descendants by divine right. Orig-       VaJ:iid: 'Unique'.
> inally, the successorship was the vital point      Vall: 'Governor'.
> of difference, and Islam was divided because       Vall: 'Guardian'.
> MuJ:iammad's (albeit verbal) appointment of         Vall-' Ahd: 'heir to the throne'.
> 'Ali was disregarded.                               Varaqiy-i-'Ulya: literally 'the Most Exalted
> $irat: literally 'bridge' or 'path'; denotes the          Lear , applied to Baha'fyyih (Bahiyyih)
> religion of God.                                      Khan um, sister of' Abdu'l-Baha. 1
> Sfyah-Chal: Black Pit in Tihran where, in              Varga: literally 'the dove'.
> August 1852, Baha'u'llah was chained in the         Vazfr (Vizir, Vizier): Minister of State. Grand
> darkness three flights of stairs underground,          Vazir; Prime Minister.
> with some 150 thieves and assassins. Here           Vilayat: 'Guardianship'.
> He received the first intimations of His
> world Mission. Ho liest place in Persia's           1
> The Bahti'( World, Vol. V, p. 205; 'Genealogy of Bah:\'-
> capital.                                                u'llah'.
> ORIENTAL TERMS                                        603
> Waqf: Muslim endowments; in Persia, the       Zaynu'l-Muqarrabfn: literally 'the Orna ment
> landed property of the expected Imam.         of the favoured'.
> Ya: 'O'-e.g., Ya Baha'u' l-Abha (0 Thou the   Zamzam : Sacred well within the precincts of
> Glory of the Most Glorious!)                  the Great Mosque at Mecca . Though salty,
> Zadih: 'Son'.                                   its water is much esteemed for pious uses,
> Zawra': A term sign ifying Baghdad.             such as ab lutions, and drinking after a fast.
> Calligraphic arrangement by Mishkfn-Qalam of the invocation : 'Praise be to God, the
> Exalted, the Beloved!'
> PART SEVEN
> LITERARY AND MUSICAL WORKS
> I
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS
> 
> 1. THE UNITY OF RELIGION AND SCIENCE
> 
> WILLIAMS . HATCHER
> 
> 0   F all the conflicts which exist in contem-                   edge gives greater mastery and, at the same
> porary society none is more destructive both                     time, greater humility before the everfor individual and social life than the conflict                 increasing vastness of the unknown which lies
> between religion and science. For the indi-                      before us.
> vidual, religion is the expression of a need for                    Basically, then, the religious urge and the
> self-transcendence, a need to feel a purpose                     scientific urge are complementary, as each
> which is God-given and not self-created. For                     reinforces the other.
> society, religion represents the need for unity,                    Of course , the thrill of first mastery which
> love, harmony, and co-operation. Science, by                     the adolescent experiences gives him a sense of
> contrast, represents the need to know, to                        omnipotence and an exaggerated pride in his
> understand, to gain mastery over ourselves and                   knowledge. Some people never outgrow this
> our environment. This is true both for the indi-                 immature response to knowledge and, therevidual who needs knowledge in order to func-                     fore , become blind or insensitive to the vasttion in his own life and for society which needs                 ness of their ignorance. This is the state of an
> organized knowledge in order to progress.                        individual or a society in which the scientific
> Returning for the moment to the individual's                  urge prevails while the religious urge is
> viewpoint, we might say that the religious urge                  excluded.
> is an urge to be encompassed. It is an urge to                      In such a case people have a sense of being in
> feel oneself a part of something greater. The .                  absolute control when, in reality, their control
> scientific urge is an urge to encompass. It is an                is very limited and relative. This is the situation
> urge to manipulate, control, direct, and domi-                   which largely characterizes modern Western
> nate. There is no contradiction in these two                     technological society. Western man has given
> urges since it is clearly possible for us to be in               in almost totally to the scientific urge, the urge
> control on one level of our functioning while, at                to dominate, manipulate, control, and direct.
> the same time, being controlled or encompas-                     Because he has lost his humility before his
> sed on another level. Indeed, since our knowl-                   ignorance, he has gradually overproduced,
> edge is always relative, we are in fact con-                     overdirected, and overcontrolled. The results
> stantly in the position of having a relative mas-                of this immoderation are to be seen everytery over part of our environment (including                     where. It has led to pollution and destruction of
> the selt) while being encompassed by that part                   the natural cycle, as we begin to discover,
> which we do not know. Moreover, the further                      perhaps too late, just how much damage we
> we make progress in knowledge, the more we                       may have unwittingly done. It has led to marealize just how great our ignorance is. There is                nipulation of the public through mass media. It
> an increasing realization of being encompassed                   has produced engines of war of unimaginable
> by the unknown which accompanies the exten-                      destructive power.
> sion of the boundaries of the known, for new                        On the personal level, the use of the social
> knowledge also reveals the existence of                          science of psychology, without the counterbalhitherto unsuspected unknowns. Greater know I-                   ance of religion, has resulted in a painful self-
> Author's note: This essay, revised for inclusion in the international record, originally appeared in World Order, Spring 1975,
> <!:! 1975 by the National Spiritual Assembly of the BaM'is of the United States. It was reprinted in slightly altered form in
> Bahd'f Studies, vol. 2, September 1977, a publication of the Canadian Association for Studies on the Baha'i Faith.
> 608                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> consciousness for the individual as he enters an       we call childhood.
> increasingly vicious circle of self-analysis and          Maturity or adulthood in the life of the indiintrospection in a futile attempt to encompass         vidual comes with the integration and balance
> himself with his own mind.                             of these two urges. It does not come by remain-
> We might say, then , that modern society is         ing continually adolescent. The adolescent,
> adolescent in that it is characterized by the false    because he is unsure of himself, needs, in his
> sense of omnipotence that comes from having            typical Western manifestation, continually to
> abandoned itself to the scientific urge to the         prove hi s independence by rebellious and
> exclusion of the religious urge. Let anyone who        exaggerated gestures. The adult, however,
> feels that science alone can provide the basis         knows how to accept a mature and conscious
> for human progress ask himself whether, at this        dependence. The adult knows, for example,
> moment, the future of society stands in greater        that he is dependent on society, and so he
> danger from science and its fruits or from relig-      obeys its laws. The extreme form of adolescent
> ion and its fruits.                                    independence is lawlessness.
> What happens when society abando ns itself             To be sure, the dependence of the adult is no
> to the religious urge to the exclusion of the          longer the absolute dependence of childhood.
> scientific urge? Since there will be a common          It is a dependence based on the relative masfeeling of humility before the unknown , there         tery of the adolescent. It is a dependence which
> will be a strong sense of unity within such a          is conscious because the adult is aware of his
> society. People will be drawn together by the          limitations as well as of his mastery. He thus
> shared awareness of being encompassed by               abandons his adolescent sense of omnipotence
> and submitted to unknown (generally non-               for a more realistic give and take. The giving
> human) forces. The feeling or sense of unity will      results from the degree of mastery, and the
> be strong, but if the scientific urge is neglected ,   taking from an intelligent realization of need.
> the concrete realization of that sense of unity        It is the foolish person who thinks that, because
> will be very limited.                                  he is ad ult, he has no genuine needs and, there-
> For example, without the means of organiza-         fore, does not have to take. It is the immature
> tion, education, communication, and transpor-          adult who remains in a childish state of exagtation, which come only from a certain mastery         gerated dependence and crippled mastery.
> of the environment, the gathering of large                The Baha'i principle of the unity of religion
> groups of people will be difficult as will be the      and science applies this same principle of comcommunication between the physically sepa-             plementarity, so clearly true for individuals , to
> rate groups. It will, therefore, be difficult for      human society as a whole. 'Abdu'l-Baha has
> people to share ideas, languages, history, and         said:
> the like. Society will remain organized in small
> Religion and science are the two wings upon
> villages, each with its particular expression of
> which man's intelligence can soar into the
> the intuitively-perceived unity and with its parheights, with which the human soul can proticular history. There will be many different
> gress. It is not possible to fly with one wing
> dialects and religious experiences. Because of
> alone! Should a man try to fly with the wing of
> the relative lack of mastery of the environreligion alone he would quickly fall into the
> ment, inhabitants of different villages will be
> quagmire of superstition, whilst on the other
> limited in the degree to which they can share
> hand, with the wing ofscience alone he would
> their experiences. This will make it difficult for
> also make no progress, but fall into the
> them to go beyond superficial differences and
> despairing slough of materialism. 1
> realize the basic similarity underlying various
> types of experience.                                     Concerning the state of religion without sci-
> The dominant feature of such a society will         ence, 'Abdu'l-Baha has further stated:
> be its dependence on the unknown forces. We
> Any religion that contradicts science or that is
> might say, then, that such a society is childlike
> opposed to it, is only ignorance-for ignorbecause the lack of mastery, the dependence,
> ance is the opposite of knowledge .
> and the passivity with respect to the environ-         1
> 'Abdu' I-Bah:I, Paris Talks: Addresses Given by 'A bdu'/-
> ment are all characteristics of the stage of               Bahtl in Paris in 1911-1912, 11th ed. (London: Baha'i
> development in the life of an individual which             Publishing Trust, 1969), p. 143.
> ESSAYS AND R EV IEW S                                                      609
> Religion which consists only of rites and                         set your faces towards the Most Sublime
> ceremonies of prejudice is not the truth. 1                       Word through which the Scriptures and the
> Books and this lucid Tablet have been dis-
> And again:
> tinctly set forth. 6
> All religions of th e present day have fallen
> Since it is the adolescen t excess of the sciinto superstitious practices out of harmony
> entific urge th at characterizes the modern
> alike with the true principles of the teaching
> world, the move to maturity can only come by
> they represent and with the scientific disthe rebirth of religion on a mature, ad ult level.
> coveries of the time. 2
> Man must acquire again a genuine humility a nd
> Concerning the positive effects of the unity                    deep respect for God, the creati ve force of the
> of religion and science, He says:                                 universe. He must realize that it is only by this
> force, and this force alone, that all of his dis-
> When religion, shorn of its superstitions, tracoveries and technological adva nces have bee n
> ditions, and unintelligent dogmas, shows its
> made. In this regard, Baha'u'llah says:
> conformity with science, then will there be a
> great unifying, cleansing force in the world                      Every word that proceedeth out of the mouth
> which will sw.eep before it all wars, disagree-                   of God is endowed with such potency as can
> ments, discords and struggles - and then will                     instil new life into every human frame, if ye
> mankind be united in the power of the Love                        be of them that comprehend this truth. A ll the
> ofGod. 3                                                          wondrous works ye behold in this world have
> been manifested through the operation of His
> Concerning the result of science without
> supreme and most exalted Will, His wonreligion, Baha'u'llah has written:
> drous and inflexible Purpose. 7
> The civilization, so often vaunted by the
> learned exponents of arts and sciences, will, if              Obstacles to the Unity of Science and Religion
> allowed to overleap the bounds of moder-                      A half century ago, the prime obstacle to the
> ation, bring great evil upon men. Thus warneth                unity of science and religion was probably
> you He Who is the A ll-Knowing. If carried to                 religion. In 1911, 'Abdu'l-B aha affirmed as
> excess, civilization will prove as prolific a                 much when He described the results of prevailsourceofevil as it had been ofgoodness when                   ing religious dissension and discord:
> kept within the restraints of moderation. 4
> The outcome of all this dissension is the belief
> Concerning the attempt of man to find ha p-                         of many cultured men that religion and scipiness through purely material pursuits, He has                        ence are contradictory terms, that religion
> also written:                                                          needs no powers of reflection, and should in
> no wise be regulated by science, but must of
> Say: 0 people! Let not this life and its deceits
> necessity be opposed, the one to the other.
> deceive you, for the world and all that is
> The unfortunate effect of this is that science
> therein is held firmly in the grasp of His Will
> has drifted apart from religion, and religion
> . . . Are ye rejoicing in the things which,
> has becom e a mere blind and more or less
> according to the estimate of God, are conapathetic following of the precepts of certain
> temptible and worthless, things wherewith He
> religious teachers, who insist on their own
> proveth the hearts of the doubtful? 5
> favourite dogmas being accepted even when
> In another passage He states flatly:                              they are contrary to science. 8
> Your sciences shall not profit you in this day,                  Thus it was the outmoded and narrow views
> nor your arts, nor your treasure, nor your                    of religionists which initially created the oppoglory. Cast them all behind your backs, and                   sition between religion and science.
> This opposition has, if anything, worsened in
> Iibid ., pp. 130-131.
> ibid. , p. 143.
> ibid., p. 146.                                                   6
> Baha'u'llah, Epistle to the Son of the Wolf, trans, Shoghi
> 'BaM' u'lla h, Gleanings from th e Writings of Baha'u'l/ah .         Effendi, rev . ed. (Wilmette, Ill.: Baha'i Publishing Trust,
> trans . Shoghi Effendi , rev. ed. (Wilmette, Ill.: Baha'i Pub-     1953), pp. 97- 98.
> lishing Trust, 1952), pp. 342-343.                               7
> Baha' u' llah , Gleanings, p. 141.
> ' ibid. , p. 209 .                                                 8 'Abdu' l-Baha, Pa ris Talks, pp. 143-144.
> 610                                     THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> the years since 'Abdu'l-Baha made the above               decide whether, in their eyes, I am within
> statement. Religious dogmatism and dissen-                their pale or am beyond it . But it lies with
> sion have continued, giving rise to open relig-           me, not with them , to feel the.feelings I, too,
> ious conflict in such places as the Middle East,          feel towards those sublime figures that are
> India, and Northern Ireland. Each of the tradi-           revered and adored by me as well as by their
> tional religious orthodoxies has continued to             orthodox followers or worshippers. No
> press, harder and harder, its claims to possess           human writ of excommunication can come
> an absolute or final truth, excluding the possi-          between those saviours and me. 1
> bility of reconciliation with other orthodoxies.         One senses a strong integrity in a position
> Even such a movement as Christian Ecumen-             such as that taken by Toynbee. Yet such a
> ism is severely limited in that its goal is only an   position , though helpful for the individual himinstitutional unity of certain Christian denomi-      self, does not solve the social problems resultnations rather than a genuine move towards            ing from the religion-science opposition. For
> universal religious reconciliation.                   there is no identifiable community of the vari-
> Moreover, to the voices of traditional             ous individuals who may have arrived at a view
> orthodoxy have been added a host of newer             like Toynbee's. Indeed , Toynbee himself
> movements, each with its own claim to possess         makes a similar remark in a footnote to the
> a unique or absolute path to the truth. Various       above-quoted passage:
> cults , various forms of meditation , of spiritual
> and physical discipline have been put forth as            In any case, whatever light my critics may or
> the answer to man's religious quest. At the               may not have thrown on my position, they
> same time, a rebirth of interest in astrology, in         have thrown much light, I should say, on a
> occultism, in satanism, in witchcraft, and in             far more interesting point. They have
> other forms of supernatural experience has                brought out the truth that, at the present
> taken place.                                              time, the Western World is a house divided
> Since it is clearly impossible to reconcile the        against itself on the fundamental issue of
> absolute and exclusive claim of each of the vari-         religious attitude and belief.2
> ous sects, movements, and orthodoxies in the             We may summarize, then, by saying that the
> world today, what is the rational seeker after        first major obstacle to the unity of science and
> religious truth to do? One common-sense an-           religion is the widespread feeling that there is
> swer, and one which many individuals have             no religious voice which recognizes the relativundoubtedly adopted as a solution, is to con-         ity of religious truth and which, at the same
> sider that there is some truth in each of these       time, speaks with deep wisdom and authority
> movements and that their basic fault lies pre-        on the spiritual questions of life which every
> cisely in the arrogant attempt of each one to         man sooner or later must face and ask himself.
> erect a partial and relative vision of truth into     There is widespread confusion in the realm of
> an absolute. The historian and religious              religion, and this confusion has been made
> thinker Arnold Toynbee has described                  worse, rather than being helped, by the multipoignantly his own reaction to this dilemma:          plication of claims to absolute authority and
> absolute truth which are now heard from all
> It is, of course, impossible that each of the       directions.
> higher religions can be right in believing that        Another major obstacle to the unity of religit has a monopoly of truth and salvation, but       ion and science derives from the fact that a
> it is not impossible that all of them should        complex of science and technology, divorced
> have found alternative roads to salvation           from all moral and ethical influence, has now
> and should have seen truth, 'through a glass,       become the dominant force in society. This
> darkly', in one or other of truth's different       all-pervasiveness of science and technology has
> facets ... A belief in the relative truth and       led many to a feeling of hopelessness. People
> relative saving-power of all the higher relig-      often feel that science has shown religion to be
> ions alike will seem tantamount to unbelief          a farce, and yet they recognize that science and
> in the eyes of an orthodox believer in any          1   Arnold Toynbee, A Study of History: Reconsiderations
> one of them.                                            (London: Oxford Univ. Press, 1961), XII, 99-100, 102 .
> . . . It lies with the orthodox, not with me, to    2
> ibid ., XII , lOln.
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                                         611
> technology have not made us deeply happy. In           meditates on problems . This is reflection (the
> fact, widespread unhappiness-unhappiness               conscious use of intuition). 1
> on a scale never before seen-is one of the                The practice of this method is not linked to
> most striking features of the contemporary             the study of any particular phenomenon. It can
> scene.                                                 be applied to the study of unseen forces and
> In spite of this dissatisfaction with the steril-   mysterious phenomen a as well as everyday,
> ity of modern technological existence, many            common occurrences. Failure to appreciate
> still feel that they cannot turn with integrity to     this universality of scientific method has led
> religion since, they believe, science has proved       many people to feel that science is really only
> that God does not exist and that religious             the study of matter and purely material
> experience is a sham . Because religious experi-       phenomena. This narrow philosophical outence is much more intensely subjective than            look, plus the historical fact that physics was
> technology, people are led to mistrust their           the first science to develop a high degree of
> own deepest emotions and their profoundest             mathematical objectivity, has led to a common
> religious and spiritual longings. In this way          misconception that scientific knowledge is
> does the misguided belief about technology             inherently limited only to physical reality and
> lead to a certain self-alienation-people are           material phenomena. 2 Such a misconception
> led to deny the validity of their own truest           naturally retards the unity of science and religneeds and deepest longings. These longings are         ion since religion definitely claims to have
> relegated to the domain of childish and imma-          knowledge of nonmaterial aspects of reality.
> ture emotions (perhaps to be 'cured' by                Once we see that the basis of science is its
> psychoanalysis).                                       method and not any particular object of study,
> This second major obstacle to the unity of          we can discard this misconception.
> religion and science is, then, the feeling that           Physics and chemistry result when we turn
> science has somehow proved the non-existence           scientific method to the study of the
> of God or at least invalidated spiritual and           phenomena of nonliving matter. But if, keepreligious experience and longings.                     ing the same method, we turn to the study of
> We now want to discuss certain aspects of           living matter, the result is biology. Ifwe turn to
> some of these obstacles.                               human beings as the objects of our study, we
> obtain psychology, sociology, and the other
> The Obstacle of Scientistic Materialism                'human sciences'. Baha'u'llah has referred to
> The characteristic feature of science, and the          religion as the 'science of the love of God.' 3
> basis of its unity, is scientific method. Scientific   Thus religion results when we turn scientific
> method consists in the systematic and organ-            method to the study of the unseen creative
> ized use of our various mental faculties in an         force of the universe which we call God.
> effort to arrive at a coherent understanding of            It might be objected by some that the unity
> whatever phenomenon is being investigated.              of science lies not in its method but in its goal,
> Of course, every human being on earth                which is to know. However, there are other
> knows things and uses his mental faculties in           disciplines such as magic and occultism, both
> order to attain this knowledge. What distin-            contemporary and historical, which claim
> guishes the method of science is the systematic,        knowledge as their objective. Yet these disciorganized, and conscious nature of the process.         plines are not compatible with science and are
> Science is self-conscious common sense.
> Instead of relying on chance experiences, one          ' For a more detailed and exhaustive discussion of the scientific method, see my essay 'Science and Religion' first
> systematically invokes certain types of experi-          printed in World Order , Spring 1969, and subsequently in
> ences. This is experimentation (the conscious            revised form in Baha'i Studies, vol. 2, September 1977.
> use of experience). Instead of relying on              ' This is why we have used the neologism 'scientistic' in the
> title of this section. The current materialism is scientistic in
> common-sense reasoning, one formalizes                   that it is generally attributed to science, but it is not scihypotheses explicitly and formalizes the                 entific since it is not really in harmony with the principles of
> reasoning leading from hypothesis to conclu-             science. We might say that this materialism is the result of
> an unscientific use of the results of science.
> sion. This is mathematics and logic (the con-          3
> Baha'u'llah, The Seven Valleys and the Four Valleys, trans.
> scious use of reason). Instead of relying on               'Alf-Kuli Khan and Marzieh Gail, rev. ed. (Wilmette, Ill.:
> occasional fl ashes of insight, one systematically         Baha'i Publishing Trust, 1952), p. 49 .
> 612                                     THE BAHA 'I WORLD
> 
> rejected by science because their method is           fa lse uses of religion , as for example when
> unscientific. Thus to be scientific it is not         religious institutions in the past have Jent supsufficient to desire knowledge or to proclaim         port to oppressive and immoral persecution of
> knowledge as one's goal.                              minorities .
> Another feature of scientific knowledge is its         It is heartening to note that , in recent years,
> relativity. Because science is the self-              increasing numbers of scientists have become
> conscious use of our faculties, we become             sensitive to such false uses of science and have
> aware that man has no absolute measure of             begun to raise their voices in public to point
> truth . The conclusions of scientific investiga-      them out. Over the years there has been a small
> tions are always more or less probable. They          but persistent intellect ual tradition of intelliare never absolute proofs. Of course, if a con-       gent criticism of the false uses of science. The
> clusion is highly probable and its negation           writings of Lewis Mumford are a strong conhighly improbable , we may feel very confident        temporary example of this tradition. The closin the results, especially if we have been very       ing paragraphs of his cogent The Pentagon of
> thorough in our investigation. But realization        Power are virtually poetic in their appeal:
> and acceptance of this essential uncertainty
> Reformers who would treat the campaign
> and relativity of our knowledge is important,
> against environmental and human degradafor the exigencies of human existence are often
> tion solely in terms of improved technologisuch that we are forced to act in some instances
> cal facilities, like the reduction of gasoline
> before we have had time to make such a
> exhaust in motor cars, see only a small part
> thorough investigation. It therefore behooves
> of the problem. Nothing less than a profound
> us to remain constantly alert to the possibility
> re-orientation of our vaunted technological
> that we may, in fact, be wrong.
> 'way of life' will save this planet from becom-
> Such a realization is also important for the
> ing a lifeless desert . .. For its effective salvaunity of science and religion, for there are
> tion mankind will need to undergo somemany who take the materialistic personal
> thing like a spontaneous religious converphilosophy of some scientists as indication that
> sion: one that will replace the mechanical
> science has proved that God does not exist.
> world picture with an organic world picture,
> There are even some scientists who claim that
> and give to the hum an personality , as the
> science has proved that God does not exist.
> highest known manifestation of life, the pre-
> Such claims are foolish and ridiculous in the
> cedence it now gives to its machines and
> light of the universally recognized relativity of
> computers ... Of only one thing we may be
> scientific conclusions, and especially as no sciconfident. If mankind is to escape its proentist or scientific discipline has ever claimed to
> grammed self-extinction the God who saves
> have undertaken a systematic, scientific study
> us will not descend from the machine: he will
> of the question of God's existence and come up
> rise up again in the human soul. 1
> with the carefully validated conclusion that
> there is no God.                                        Toynbee states a similar conclusion in more
> We should not be overly surprised at such          general terms:
> contradictions in behaviour, however, since
> Religion is Man's attempt to get into touch
> scientists are human and are subject to some of
> with an absolute spiritual Reality behind the
> the same disastrous prejudices which afflict the
> phenomena of the Universe, and, having
> generality of mankind.
> made contact with It, to Jive in harmony with
> There are, in fact, those who have con-
> It. This activity is all-pervading. It comsciously attempted to use science as a 'cover' or
> prehends all the others. Moreover, it is
> support to buttress some particular social or
> Man's lifeline. When once a creature has
> philosophical prejudice, or to justify some
> acquired, as Man has, a conscious intellect
> desired {but not necessarily justifiable) course
> and a free will, this creature must either seek
> of action. We must be constantly on our guard
> and find God or destroy itself. 2
> against such false uses of science; for they corrupt science, and they block effective attempts      1   Lewis Mumford, The Pentagon of Power: The Myth of the
> to establish the unity of science and religion.          Machine (New York: Harcourt, 1970), p. 413.
> Such false uses of science are comparable to         2
> Toynbee, Study of History , XII, 663.
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                          613
> Scientistic Atheism                                 see everything as a configuration of this one
> Even though science has not disproved the           force.
> existence of God, there still persists a feeling       The most striking fe ature of this energy, this
> that the success of science and technology,         ultimate mysterious force whose existence has
> independent of any religious orientation , has      been so strongly confirmed by science, is its
> undermined the credibility of such belief.          ability to organize itself in ever more subtle
> Be lief in God is often seen as a hangover from     forms and configurations. It is easy, for examprimitivism . Primitive man saw God, the            ple, to characterize the direction of biological
> unseen creative force, in everything. He was in     evolution. Biological evolution represents the
> awe of the forces of nature. This sense of awe of   organization of matter (thus energy) in ever
> primitive man is commonly attributed to his         more complex units, involving greater and greatignorance of the basis of natural phenomena.        er complexity and specialization , and greater
> To many, our modern scientific understanding        interdependence a mong the component parts.
> of these phenomena seems to have taken all           Man is 'higher' than other mammals precisely
> the 'mystery' out of reality. Modern man feels      because of his relatively greater complexity of
> guilty or childish about such feelings of           physiological organization.
> awe-about his need to be encompassed. Sci-              Let us compare man with, say, a colony of
> ence seems to have gradually reduced the pos-        one-celled organisms of comparable size. On
> sible domain of God's existence to a vanishing       the one hand, there is man with his cells specialpoint. Physics has removed God from nature,         ized to form tissues which combine to make
> and psychology has removed Him from the              organs which combine to form systems which
> human heart.                                        combine to form the human organism. This
> Again, further analysis reveals such an           hierarchical structure enables man to function
> attitude as a misconception. For science has         in an incredibly multifaceted way. Moreover,
> revealed to man not only 'facts' and 'things' but   the continued, moment-to-moment existence
> also a fascinating world of energy and unseen        of man is dependent on a host of favourable
> forces. Consider, for example, the view of mat-      conditions. On the other hand, we have the
> ter and the material world which physics so-         colony of, let us say, bacteria which are capable
> berly presents to us for our consideration as the    of functioning only individually on the crudest
> rational explanation for natural phenomena.          level, each individual being virtually immortal
> The astonishing diversity of matter which we         (some bacteria can remain dormant for cendaily encounter is really due , we are told , only   turies without dying).
> to different combinations of a small number of          In particular, the human brain is the most
> basic elements. Moreover, these elemental            complex physical structure known to us in the
> substances are themselves just different             universe. Even the galaxies of stars and the
> configurations of certain basic elementary par-      movements of the planets cannot begin to
> ticles which , in themselves, have no individual-    compare in complexity to the subtle and highly
> ity. Furthermore, these basic particles are          organized human brain. The most complex
> really just relatively stable forms of energy,       computers invented to date are roughly equivaand each of them is convertible, under suitable      lent to the brain of an ant when compared with
> conditions, into energy. Thus all the stuff of       the structure and complexity of the human
> everyday experience is ultimately just different     brain.
> configurations of energy.                               Now, one well-known feature of the human
> And what, we ask, is energy? We may be            organism is its self-awareness. Furthermore,
> successful in describing some of the ways            scientific investigation has confirmed what man
> energy works-some of the effects it produces.        has always suspected: he did not create him-
> But when we ask what energy is, we come up           self. It is not man who has organized himself in
> against a mystery. And if we are humble              this subtle and complex way. Rather man
> enough, we realize that this is the same mystery     awoke to his self-awareness and his subjectivprimitive man intuitively perceived. Our sci-        ity which he owes rather to the energy of which
> ence has served only to render our ultimate          he is but a configuration .
> ignorance more explicit by showing how truly            We can thus pose the following clear quesuniversal is this mysterious force, for now we       tion: Is it more reasonable to assume that a
> 614                                        THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> force capable of producing an effect (man)             all move perversely in a downward direction.
> which is endowed with subjectivity and intel-            We infer the existence of an unseen force,
> ligence has also such characteristics, or is it        called gravity, which produces this effect. The
> more reasonable to assume that this force is           effect is, in a word, a consistent deviation from
> deprived of such features? It is clearly more           presumed equiprobability. We do not call gravreasonable to suppose that such a force is at          ity God because the effect produced by this
> least as subtle as the effect it has produced. In      force (the downward falling of objects) is not
> fact, we know that energy is capable of subjec-         so marvelous as the effect we call man. Notice
> tivity and intelligence because we have self-           also that in space, when one is outside the
> awareness and intelligence and we are                   reaches of the earth's gravity, randomly dropconfigurations of this energy. Moreover, this           ped objects do move in a random direction.
> force has produced other effects which man                 In scientific investigations of phenomena it
> cannot produce (namely, it has produced man             therefore becomes important to decide what
> as well as the universe). Man has discovered            events are probable and what events are
> himself and the universe, but he has not pro-           improbable. In this way we can have some idea
> duced these phenomena. Thus we are inevit-              when a phenomenon is due to an unseen force
> ably led to hypothesize that this force is, in fact ,   and when it is due to chance. Science has discoveven more subtle than himself. Following a              ered such a principle. It is called the second
> long-established tradition, we call this force          law of thermodynamics or Carnot's principle.
> God.                                                    This principle says, simply stated, that order is
> Thus an unprejudiced application of sci-            improbable and disorder is probable. This is so
> entific method to the facts of human existence          because order represents a limited number of
> leads to the probable conclusion that God               stable configurations whereas any possible
> exists and that He has consciousness and intel-         configuration represents disorder.
> ligence. Notice, however, that although                    Let us compare, for example, a brick house
> reasoning and logic can lead us to the existence        and a pile of bricks. I can transform a brick
> of God, they cannot give to us the experience of        house into a pile of bricks by moving the bricks
> God . This is the role of religion, of which more       one by one in any possible sequence. I am free
> will be said later on.                                  to take a top brick or a bottom brick or a
> It is as if we had arrived at the conclusion, by    middle brick first. But to build the house, it is
> scientific investigation, that there must be            physically impossible to put in a top brick
> humanoid creatures on a planet which we                 before putting in any bottom brick. Only a
> lacked the technical means of visiting. The             certain limited number of possible sequences
> knowledge of the existence of these creatures           will produce the house. The house represents
> would not in itself give us the intersubjective         order, and the pile of bricks disorder (relative
> ' experience of their personalities.                      to each other) .
> There are several objections which are often            Thus Carnot's principle is nothing more than
> raised against the otherwise clear conclusions          a precise statement of what we all intuitively
> we have drawn in 1the preceding. It is often            feel about chance phenomena. The nonobjected that the process which has produced            scientist would be just as shocked as the scientist
> man is due to chance and not to any force. Let          to find that the wind or a thurlderstorm had
> us examine briefly this contention.                     transformed a pile of bricks into a well-built
> In scientific observation, a phenomenon is           house (even if we had left the pile of bricks to /
> said to be due to chance when all logical pos-          itself for many years). But we are not at all
> sibilites occur with equal relative frequency.          shocked if such a .storm transforms a house into
> When such is not the case, and more especially          a pile of bricks.
> when such deviations occur in some consistent              Now we have earlier on remarked that man,
> way, we infer the existence of a force which is         in particular man's brain, is the most highly
> said to 'cause' the deviation from random               ordered structure in the universe. Thus, by
> behaviour. For example, it is logically possible        Carnot's principle, it is also the least probable.
> for a dropped object to move in any direction           It is, therefore, the least likely to have been
> (or not to move at all). But we observe that            produced by a purely random process .
> dropped objects do not move at random . They               Biolog.ists point out that the fundamental
> ESSAYS ANO REVIEWS                                                   615
> mechanisms of evolution are mutation, by in Australia and the next one in Europe there
> which is meant spontaneous genetic change, cannot be any process of evolution). Nor did
> and natural selection , by which is meant the evolution take place in an 'unlimited' amount
> superior survival rate over successive genera- of time. Rather, the whole process occurred in
> tions, and within a given population , of those a period of no greater than three billion years,
> genotypes whose phenotypical (physically and the major part of it (from small, primitive
> observable or behavioural) characteristics animals to man) in about one-half billion years.
> better suit them to function within the natural Thus there was not time for an 'infinite' or
> milieu in question.' Natural selection elimi- unlimited 'experimentation' to take place.
> nates forms and organisms which are less well                      In other words, the phenomenon of biologiadapted , and thus tends to decrease variation cal evolution presents us precisely with a clear,
> (diversity) within a population. Mutation, consistent deviation from randomness of the
> however, has the opposite effect, that of sort discussed above . We must therefore conincreasing the genetic diversity. Evolution is a clude the existence of a force which is the cause
> process of moving from lower (less complex) to of biological evolution. Anyone for whom this
> higher (more complex) forms. Such a process conclusion is unacceptable must decide for
> necessarily involves periodic (though not himself why he feels such an inference to be
> necessarily regular) significant increases in var- unacceptable here while being generally and
> iation and thus cannot depend on natural selec- universally acceptable elsewhere in science.
> tion alone. In other words, the contribution of                    It is obviously impossible in a short article
> natural selection to the evolutionary process such as this to enter into extended detailed
> depends ultimately on the occurrence of muta- discussion of these points on which scores of
> tions since if there are no mutations there will books have been written. The reader who is
> ultimately be an insufficient diversity of forms interested in pursuing the technical side of the
> from which nature can select. But since, as we question can do so on his own.
> have already stressed, the direction of evolu-                      In closing this discussion, let us treat one last
> tion is precisely from lower (that is, less point, however. Recent advances in biology
> ordered and thus more probable) to higher have led to speculation that man may one day
> (that is, more ordered and thus less probable) be able to reproduce life in a test tube. Such
> forms, it is unreasonable to suppose that the knowledge or control over the vital process
> occurrence in the evolutionary process of would, it is sometimes said, show that ·God
> mutations favourable to an increase in com- does not exist after all because man would have
> plexity was wholly or primarily due to chance. discovered the secret of life. But no such con-
> We cannot reason from the fact of mutation to clusion is logically forthcoming. After all , man
> the conclusion that the cause of mutations in already knows how to reproduce life. Babies
> evolution is chance alone. We must be careful are born every day. What man clearly did not
> to distinguish between the known facts of the create is the process by which life is reproduced.
> evolutionary process and the possible theoreti- Thus, even if the human brain finally succeeds
> cal models used to explain and interpret the in discovering the secret of life, this will
> facts.                                                           not change the fact that man did not create
> Moreover, what is needed to explain biolog- the vital process which he would then underical evolution is not just an occasional favour- stand. Moreover, man's brain which does the
> able mutation (almost all observed mutations understanding would itself owe its existence to
> are unfavourable) but a consistent sequence of this vital process which it did not create. Disfavourable mutations in the right place and at covery is not creation.
> the right time intervals (if the first one happens                  Indeed, no discoveries that man can ever
> The somewhat technical, though nonetheless important,          make in the fut ure can change the eternal fact
> point is that the genetic configuration of an organism is      that man is not responsible for bringing into
> determined at conception and does not interact directly
> with the environment. It is rather the physical and
> being the process which has produced his brain
> behavioural characteristics of the organism which interact     and its understanding. Man is not responsible
> directly wit h the environment. Thus, natural selection can    for his own existence; and he depends, thereonly operate on the phenotypic level , but this affects genetic diversity indirectly to the degree that such physical and   fore, on something other than himself to which
> behavioural characteristics are genetically based.             he owes his existence.
> 616                                           THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> A Solution to Religious Dissension                           reveal His most personal and subjective attri-
> False concepts and false uses of science are                 butes to man through an instrument such as a
> only one-half of the problem. For even if one is             rock or a tree which does not itself possess
> quite willing and desires to turn to religion , the          consciousness. Baha'is believe that this act of
> question remains: where to turn? For the                     Self-Revelation through a chosen human
> author of this article, and for many others on               instrument has occurred periodically in history
> this planet, the answer to this question has                 (our collective experience). This is clearly
> turned out to be: the Baha'i Faith. Rather than              necessary if the intersubjective knowledge of
> engaging in any abstract dissertation on the                 God is to remain constantly accessible to us, for
> details of Baha'i doctrine-which are already                 with the passage of time the immediacy and
> adequately available in other sources-we                     force of such a revelation tends to be lost and
> have thought better to describe in a straight-               dissipated.
> forward manner those features of the Baha'i                     Baha'is call these chosen human instruments
> experience which have led so many to feel that               Manifestations of God. The Manifestations are
> it furnishes a deeply satisfying answer to their             none other than the great religious founders of
> religious quest.                                             history, some of whose names we know:
> First, and most important, the Baha'i Faith               Abraham, Moses, Jesus, Mu~ammad, Buddha,
> renders accessible to the individual that                    Zoroaster, and most recently Baha' u'llah, the
> experience of self-transcendence and mystic                  Founder of the Baha'i Faith. Concerning the
> communion with the Spirit of God which is the                revelation of God through these Manifestaheart of religion. We have previously                        tions, Baha'u'llah has said:
> remarked that logic and reason can prove to us
> .. . all things, in their inmost reality, testify to
> the existence of God but cannot give us the
> the revelation of the names and attributes of
> experience of communion with God. Concern-
> God within them ... Man, the noblest and
> ing proofs of the existence of God , 'Abdu'lmost perfect of all created things, excelleth
> Baha has said:
> them all in the intensity of this revelation, and
> ... apply thyself to rational and authoritative              is a fuller expression of its glory. And of all
> arguments. For arguments are a guide to the                  men, the most accomplished, the most distinpath and by this the heart will be turned unto               guished, and the most excellent are the Man -
> the Sun of Truth. And when the heart is                      ifestations of the Sun of Truth. Nay, all else
> turned unto the Sun, then the eye will be                    besides these Manifestations, live by the operopened and will recognize the Sun through                    ation of their Will, and move and have their
> the Sun itself Then (man) will be in no need                 being through the outpourings oftheir grace. 2
> of arguments (or proofs), for the Sun is
> altogether independent, ... 1                               It is, therefore, as a result of the comings of
> these Manifestations that man has the possibil-
> In other words, the reality of the experience of             ity of communion with God. 'Abdu'l-Baha
> communion with God carries with it a deeper                  puts it simply:
> conviction and sense of the reality of God than
> the purely intellectual acknowledgement of                        The knowledge of the Reality of the Divinity
> God's existence which comes from logic and                        is impossible and unattainable, but the knowlreasoning.                                                        edge of the Manifestations of God is the
> How, we might well ask, is this communion                      knowledge of God, for the bounties, splenobtained? How does God reveal to us some-                         dours, and divine attributes are apparent in
> thing of His personal and subjective nature in a                  them. Therefore if man attains to the knowlway that is accessible to us? Since, as we have                   edge of the Manifestations of God, he will
> already observed, man is the most highly                          attain to the knowledge of God; and if he be
> ordered and refined phenomenon accessible to                      neglectful of the knowledge ofthe Holy Man -
> us, it would be only logical that God might                       ifestation, he will be bereft of the knowledge
> choose precisely this instrument for his Self-                    of God. 3
> Revelation. It is clearly impossible for God to              2
> Baha'u'llah, Gleanings , pp. 178-179.
> 1                                                            3
> 'Abdu' l-BaM, Tablets of 'Abdu'l-Baha 'Abbas , 3 vols.       'Abdu'l-BaM, Some Answered Questions, comp. and
> (New York : Baha'i Publishing Society, 1909-1916), I,        trans. Laura Clifford Barney, rev. ed. {Wilmette, Ill.:
> 168.                                                         Baha'i Publishing Trust, 1964), pp. 257-258.
> ESSAYS AND REVIEW S                                            617
> The primary key to maintaining this com-                needs sooner or later exercise its influence
> munion of consciousness with God is the daily             upon his soul. 2
> discipline of prayer and meditation on the
> Second, the experience is general or uniwords of the Manifestation. Baha'u'llah states :
> versal. It is not reserved for some elite and
> Say: The first and fo remost testimony estab-      withheld from others. It is not vague or
> lishing His truth is His own Self Next to this     uncommunicab le. A ll Baha'ls experience it
> testimony is His Revelation. For whoso             and find that they can discuss it and share it
> faileth to recognize either the one or the other   with others with the same feeling of clarity and
> He hath established the words He hath              coherence that one naturally has about any
> revealed as proof of His reality and truth.        other multi-subjective experience such as
> This is, verily, an evidence of His tender         seeing a red object or eating a delicious meal.
> m ercy unto men. He hath endowed every soul          Another important feature of Baha'i experiwith the capacity to recognize the signs of        ence is the ex plicit acce ptance by the Baha'i
> God. How could He, otherwise, have fulfilled       Faith of the principle of the relativity of relig-
> His testimony unto men ... 1                       ious truth. Shoghi Effe ndi has said:
> These words are the instrument which creates              The Revelation proclaimed by Baha' u'll ah,
> the consciousness of the presence of God; for             His followers believe, is divine in origin , allmeditation , to be successful, must have s~ me            embracing in scope, broad in its outlook,
> object or focus.                                          scientific in its method, huma nitarian in its
> Although the experience of communion                   principles a nd dynamic in the influence it
> with God is an individual , subjective one, there         exerts on the hearts and minds of men. T he
> are two things in the Baha'i ex~erience which             mission of the Founder of their Faith, they
> tend to give it a sense of universality and objec-        conceive it to be to procl aim that religious
> tivity. First, it is repeatab le for the individual.      truth is not abso lute but relative, that Divine
> If one had only an occasionill 'fl-a-sh' oLajstic         Revelation is continuous and progressive
> feeling, one could well doubt whether such
> experience was valid a nd was not, rather, so me
> Such tota l and explicit recognition of the prinform of autosuggestion. But Baha'ls find that
> ciple of the relativity of religious truth is a
> when they practice the daily discipline of
> hallmark of the Baha 'i Faith and an important
> prayer and meditation on the words of Baha'u'-
> element in permitting its followers to reconcile
> llah, the experience of communion is conscientific method with religious and spiritual
> stantly renewed, accessible, and repeatable.
> needs.
> In a striking statement, Baha'u'llah boldly
> The Baha'i Faith is not excl usive a nd creates
> promises that the experience of communion
> unity rather than dissension. This aspect of
> with God will always be accessible through this
> Baha'i experience naturally derives from the
> discipline:
> fundamenta l principle of the relativity and
> Intone, 0 My servant, the verses of God that       progressive nature of truth mentioned above.
> have been received by thee, as intoned by          Baha'u'llah has said that the fundamental purthem who have drawn nigh unto Him, that the        pose of religion is to create love a nd unity and
> sweetness of thy melody may kindle thine            that whenever it happens that a religion ceases
> own soul, and attract the hearts of all men.       to perform this function and creates division
> Whoso recite th, in the privacy ofhis chamber,     and opposition, then it is better for such a
> the verses revealed by God, the scattering          religion not to exist.
> angels of the A lmighty shall scatter abroad          Some people who are otherwise attracted to
> the fragrance of the words uttered by his           Baha'i teachings and principles sometimes
> mouth, and shall cause th e heart of every          hesitate to ide ntify themselves with the moverighteous man to throb. Though he may, at           ment for fear that such identification will
> first, remain unaware of its effect, yet the vir-   somehow cut them off from other people.
> tue of the grace vouchsafed unto him must
> 'ibid ., p. 295.
> Shoghi Effe ndi, The World Order of Bahti'u'/ltih (New
> Baha'u'llah, Gleanings , pp. 105-106.                 York: Baha'i Publishing Committee, 1938), p. xi.
> 618                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Because the Baha'i Faith is numerically smal-         as a clarifying and ordering force which enables
> ler than some other religious groups, or              them to 'see' the truth in other movements,
> because the Baha'i Faith is new and therefore         perhaps even truths which orthodox followers
> sometimes unknown to or misinterpreted by             of these movements may have missed. In ta lkthe public, individuals perhaps fear that             ing about their Faith, Baha'is often find themidentification with it will subject them to simi-     selves in the position of defending or explainlar attitudes of mistrust on the part of others.      ing the validity of certain teachings of past
> However apparently reasonable such fears           Prophets which the followers themselves have
> may seem, this is not the experience which            abandoned or rejected. The dedication which
> Baha'is have. Genuine human relations are             Baha'is feel to such founders of religions as
> based on truth, honesty, love, and the ability to     Christ, Mul).ammad, Moses, and Buddha, is
> communicate deeply with others. Baha'is find          very real. It often surprises and amazes the
> that their Faith gives them new inner resources       followers of these religions , for it has even
> and tools which permit them to approach               happened that Baha'is have vigorously
> human relationships in the light of these prin-       defended the rights and doctrines of religious
> ciples. Rather than feeling 'cut off', Baha'is        communities who have actively persecuted the
> experience a feeling of vastly increased ability      Baha'is themselves.
> to communicate and indeed commune with                    Another important aspect of Baha'i experiothers, be they Baha'i or non-Baha'i. These           ence is that it does not tend to extremes in any
> new personal resources compensate a hun-              form. At the basis of the Baha'i Faith is a
> dredfold for any superficial and ignorant criti-      principle of moderation . This principle means
> cism which may, from time to time, be forthcom-       that the individual feels continually pulled
> ing. Moreover, both psychologists and                 towards greater balance, calm, and integration
> philosophers have pointed out that the crowd          in his life. He does not feel torn between
> togetherness and superficial conformities of          extreme desires or called upon to become
> modern life are only a poor substitute for            fanatical or unbalanced in his dealings with
> genuine human relationships. Such genuine             others or with himself. This sense of moderarelationships are seen to be largely absent from       tion does not imply a static or passive state or
> modern life due to the 'self-alienation' created      an indifference. It means rather the integration
> in part by the illusion of easy togetherness          and balance among the deep emotions one
> which leads the individual to suppose that satis-     feels.
> fying human relationships can be attained                 A final and extremely important aspect of
> without a strong and conscious effort of will on       the Baha'i experience is its focus on society
> his part. Once the individual pierces the veil of      and its goal of establishing world unity. We
> this illusion and accepts the fact that effort and     have seen religion as an answer to man's need
> suffering are necessary to attain deep friend-'        to be encompassed by something greater than
> ship and lasting love, he will naturally seek that     himself. Quite clearly the individual is already
> which will give him the resources necessary for        encompassed by society as a whole. Therefore,
> the task. It is the experience of Baha'is that         there can be no ultimate answer to man's
> their Faith gives them these resources.                religious quest and his religious needs unless
> Moreover, because the Baha'i Faith is a liv-        and until society itself is spiritualized. The
> ing community, and not just an abstract idea,          individual cells of a body cannot long remain
> the striving for love and unity can take place in      healthy if the body itself is sick. Society's
> a new context not otherwise available. It is the       influence on the individual is too great and too
> context of a community in which each indi-             pervasive to be neglected. Indeed, the focus on
> vidual member has a similar commitment to              the social aspects of religion and the goal of
> this new quality of human relationship based           establishing world unity constitute the most
> on communion with God, Who is the ultimate             fundamental contribution of the Baha'i Faith
> source of man's ability to Jove in the first place.    to man's collective religious consciousness.
> The Baha'i Faith illuminates our history and        Shoghi Effendi states:
> our personal experience. The inclusiveness of
> the Baha'i Faith is not just a passive principle         Unification of the whole of mankind is the
> of tolerance. It is experienced by Baha'is rather        hallmark of the stage which human society is
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                               619
> now approaching. Unity of family , of tribe,                      the life of each individual in the Baha'i comof city-state, and nation have been succes-                       munity, while the experience within the comsively attempted and fully established.                           munity itself furnishes practical opportunities
> World unity is the goal towards which a                           for growth and for the practice of this oneness.
> harassed humanity is striving ....                                  To anyone seriously seeking a solution to the
> The unity of the human race, as envisaged by                      current disunity and opposition between relig-
> Baha'u'llah, implies the establishment of a                       ion and science, the answer given by the Baha'i
> world commonwealth in which all nations,                          Faith merits deep investigation.
> races, creeds and classes are closely and                             Who, contemplating the helplessness, the
> permanently united, and in which the auton-                           fears and miseries of humanity in this day,
> omy of its state membe rs and the personal                            can any longer question the necessity for a
> freedom and initiative of the individuals that                        fresh revelation of the quickening power of
> compose them are definitely and completely                            God's redemptive love and guidance? Who,
> safeguarded. 1                                                        witnessing on one hand the stupendous
> Moreover, this consummation of human so-                               advance achieved in the realm of human
> ciety can only be accomplished on the basis of                            knowledge, of power, of skill and inventivereligion:                                                                 ness, and viewing on the other the unprecedented character of the sufferings that
> The principle of the Oneness of Mankind, as                           afflict, and the dangers that beset, presentproclaimed by Baha'u'llah, carries with it no                         day society, can be so blind as to doubt that
> more and no less than a solemn assertion                              the hour has at last struck for the advent of a
> that attainment to this final stage in this                           new Revelation, for a re-statement of the
> stupendous evolution is not only necessary                            Divine Purpose, a nd for the consequent
> but inevitable, that its realization is fast                          revival of those spiritual forces that have, at
> approaching, and that nothing short of a                              fixed intervals, rehabilitated the fortunes of
> power that is born of God can succeed in
> human society? Does not the very operation
> establishing it. 2
> of the world-unifying forces that are at work
> The Writings of Baha'u'llah contain a veri-                             in this age necessitate that He Who is the
> table blueprint for the establishment of this new                         Bearer of the Message of God in this day
> planetary society, involving, among others,                               should not only reaffirm that self-same
> such principles as the establishment of a uni-                            exalted standard of individual conduct inculversal auxiliary language, a world court, a world                         cated by the Prophets gone before Him, but
> legislature, a world police force, and universal                          embody in His appeal, to all governments
> education . The Baha'i community is viewed as,                            and peoples, the essentials of that social
> in some sense, the spiritual embryo of this                               code, that Divine Economy, which must
> future society. Thus the common goal of work-                             guide humanity's concerted efforts in estabing to achieve unity gives a sense of purpose to                          lishing that all-embracing federation which is
> Shoghi Effendi, The World Order of Bahti'u'l/tih: Selected
> to signalize the advent of the Kingdom of
> Letters, 2d rev. ed. (Wilmette , Ill .: Baha'i Publishing Trust ,       God on this earth? 3
> 1974),pp. 202-203 .
> 2                                                                     3
> ibid., p. 43.                                                           ibid., pp. 60- 61.
> 620                                              THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> 2. CAN THERE BE A BAHA'I POETRY? 1
> GEOFFREY P. NASH
> 
> THE high station ascribed in Baha'i scripture                      the Baha'i community, natural and inevitable.
> to art has led a number of Baha'i artists to                       We are as yet in the early Springtime of the new
> predicate and even to seek Baha'i forms and                        World Order when the golden harvest of Baha'i
> artistic conventions. Shoghi Effendi, Guardian                     civilization is but a vision, though an assured
> of the Baha'i Faith, made the following com-                       one, of the future. Baha'is anticipate-it is a
> ments on this:                                                     hallmark of their faith-a great world civilization in the fullness of time. At present, conso-
> Music, as one of the arts, is a natural culnant with the metaphor of natural cycles so ubitural development, and the Guardian does
> quitously used in the Baha'i Holy Writings,
> not feel that there should be any cultivation
> Baha'is recognize the barrenness of the times
> of 'Baha'i Music' any more than we are trywe live in as symptomatic of the season for
> ing to develop a Baha'i school of painting or
> planting the seeds. Hastening the advent of the
> writing. The believers are free to paint, write
> oneness of mankind is the surest way to expeand compose as their talents may guide
> dite the appearance of a world civilization
> them ... As long as they have music for its
> unparalleled in recorded annals.
> own sake it is all right, but they should not
> Must we then neglect the arts now, as of
> consider it Bahd'f music. 2
> secondary importance at this stage of our his-
> This is augmented by the following statement:                      tory? I incline to believe such a course would
> prove unsupportable for Baha'is. I believe
> As regards producing a book of Baha'i
> great enterprises have never proceeded withsongs, your understanding that there is no
> out a sense of poetry on the part of their
> cultural expression which could be called
> executors. If empires are built upon valour,
> Baha'i at this time (distinctive music, literaupon physical prowess, do they not require
> ture, art, architecture, etc ., being the flower
> exertion of an energetic, even an imaginative
> of the civilization and not coming at the
> will? Much more must this be so for the promobeginning of a new Revelation) , is correct.
> tion and establishment of the great religions.
> However, that does not mean that we
> Indeed the present activities of the Baha'is are
> haven't Baha'i songs, in other words, songs
> saturated with poetry; their past equally, if not
> written by Baha'is on Baha'i subjects. 3
> more so. Does not Baha'i Holy Writing-the
> In considering poetry, the divinest of the                      Word of God we believe- exude poetry? The
> arts, it is essential to differentiate between the                 writings of Shoghi Effendi abound in evocative
> true poet and the mere versifier. A true poet                      turns of phrase. Presumably Baha'is respond to
> must have poetic vision, be attuned to great                       this beauty. Can it be that they will continue to
> themes and ultimate mysteries, be impelled by                      do so but half consciously? If they do, it will be
> his Muse to express his perceptions in poetic                      against the experience of the early years of the
> form. Such a soul can be born into any age. But                    Baha'i movement.
> the above intimations from the Guardian are                           We recall how so many of the Babi martyrs
> unmistakable in their import. Great art is the                     died with poetry on their lips, be it a couplet or
> flower of civilization, and its development in                     more from J:Iafi~ or verses of their own composition, for many were themselves poets. One
> of the greatest jewels of the Babi dispensation
> ' This essay appears here in its original form. At the request
> of the Canadian Association for Studies on the Baha'i Faith     was that eloquent, ethereal poetess Tahirih- a
> it was subsequently revised for inclusion in vol. 7 of BahG'f   woman renowned in the East for her poetry as
> Studies. See also 'The Heroic Soul and the Ordinary Self- a     for her unique stature among women.
> Study in the Religious Poetry of Roger White,' by Geoffrey
> Nash .                                                           Baha'u'llah, the Author of Arabic and Persian
> The Universal House of Justice, compilation 'Baha'i Writ-       odes which are held to be so exquisitely
> ings on Music', Baha'i Publishing Trust, Oakham, Engbeautiful as to be untranslatable, liked to have
> land, p. II.
> J ibid.                                                             about Him believers who, at His bidding,
> ESSAYS AN D REVIEWS                                           621
> would recite to Him their poetry. Nabfl-i-           ation from society, could not live without
> A''.?am, companion of Baha'u'llah and res-           believing in supern atural agencies.
> pected historian of the early years of the Babl         We have to remember this situation because
> and Bah a'i Faiths, was an inspired poet.            no poetry of lasting significance is written
> 'Abd u'l-Baha would have Baha'i poets recite         independently of civilization and tradition.
> their works in the Holy Shrines.                     The poet is individual and subj ective, but he is
> If we consider the lovers of 'Abdu' l-Baha        mankind's conscience. Mystically initi ated to
> who came from the Occident, we find that Lua         the divine order of things, he registers man's
> Getsinger wrote verses imploring His favour.         departure from his nobler nature and his
> And thanks to a living Baha'i poet, Roger            higher idea ls. As Schiller said , the poet keeps
> White, the prose poetry of Juliet Thompson's         alive in man aims that are higher than the
> diaries has emerged in blank verse that tunes        material. No wonder he has no place in a world
> once again the strings of the proverbial             given over to the most vulgar technological
> Aeolian harp. George Townshend wrote devo-           hunger, the crudest behaviouristic philotion al poetry and meditations of high quality.      sophies, and the most soulless social engin-
> Shall not the Baha'ls go on? Assuredly, they         eering.
> will continue to be inspired by Baha'i ideals to        The depe nde nce of the poet, in spite of his
> write poetry of Baha'i character.                    subjective nature , is very real. He requires not
> But it is true as well that what Yeats once       only an audience but a ground-work of shared
> called 'The Muses' sterner laws' require of the      values with those among whom he dwells. Cut
> poet a single-minded devotion which is               off from this audie nce, above a ll cut off from a
> perhaps at present incompatible with the time        sustaining adherence to a genera ll y-held social
> required to be spent on the active establish-        vision, the poet has no mooring and floats
> ment of the Baha'i Faith in the world.               adrift in an amorphous, frightening ocean.
> Moreover, a great poet works within a tradi-         Matthew Arnold expressed the dilemma of the
> tion , and the tradition of great poetry has         detached nineteen th century poet:
> declined if not virtually died out.
> In the modern world the poet is perforce a n        Still bent to make some port he knows not
> embittered outsider. By 1850, it was beginning            where ,
> to become apparent that the poet, the sensitive        Still sta nding for some false, impossible shore.
> man , fe lt himself adrift in an alien world . The
> nineteenth century helped to fix the alienation         The Anglo-Saxon poet who composed
> of the poet in modern times, and also fixed iri      Beowulf never knew such alienation when he
> the minds of men in general an erroneous con-        sang before the assemb led warriors the limited
> ception of poets as bizarre, extravagant indi-       philosophy of valour and heroic death. The
> viduals, invariably at war with received values.     poet was in his place. So, one must suppose,
> The century which had begun with Shelley's           was Petrarch in his medieval world and Tasso
> claim that poets were the ' unacknowledged           in his renaissance o ne . Neither did Shakelegislators of the world' and Carlyle's predic-      speare lack a patron or Milton a livelihood.
> tion that Literature would become the new ,          Goethe too was estee med at Weimar, and if
> green branch of religion , ended with Nietzsche      Byron was a self-exile he still felt a link with the
> declaring that the man of genius was outside of,     tradition of Pope, and Keats with that of
> a nd must necessarily contemn, estab lished          Spenser. Arnold's desolation in isolation pressocial values. The claim of the poets, if it had     aged the tragic ends of the poets of the fin de
> grown more shrill a nd unbalanced , had done so      siecle, of whom Yeats wrote:
> because society had turned away from noble
> values. The best poets have always dealt with          What portion in the world can the poet
> intangibles, with spiritual values. The modern           have
> age is grossly materialistic and utilitarian , and     Who has awakened from the common dream
> above all atheistic; poets, if the evidence of the     But dissipation and despair.
> last century's poetry is to be trusted, cannot do
> without God . Baudelaire, the arch-defiant             There is thus a Church for the poet, as for the
> among nineteenth century poets in their a lie n-     composer of music, and an apostolic succession
> 622                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> of great ones to whom he feels indebted. And         tions, though its pure poetic value fail to match
> great epochs might consist of a handful of           that of the great practitioners. For the poetic
> major talents: Marlowe, Jonson, Shakespeare,         impulse, coming from the soul of men , is of
> Webster, Fletcher and Middleton; Goethe,             universal interest to all men for all time. It is
> Schiller, Holderlin, Novalis, Heine; Haydn,          thus that we may still read today fragments
> Mozart, Beethoven, Schubert, Schumann,               from ancient poets and know that the pulse of
> Mendelssohn and Brahms. But in a barren age          poetry was yet alive in those times.
> we can scarce name one master, let alone a              We can therefore best advise the Baha'i poet
> succession of heirs.                                 of today to hold to the great themes. The eter-
> Must the Baha'i poet be disconsolate then,        nal themes in poetry pertain to the perpetual
> alo ng with other contemporary poets? Cer-           themes of life. Above all, the greatest is Love:
> tainly he will make no idle claims, knowing the      Love for God, as it is to be found in, for examlow cultural standards of his time. But Baha'ls      ple, Indian literature , and in $6ff poetry ; Love
> perhaps may partially escape the sense of vac-       for na ture , and Love between human
> uum most artists now feel. Baha'ls live with         beings-how ubiquitous are these themes in
> that, but also maintain a transcendental vision .    the world's poetry .
> They are truly the heirs of the Romantic artists        By keeping poetry alive, we bear witness to
> who sensed the dawning of the new age around         the divine impulse within and also enrich soci-
> 1800. They know what Richter was speaking of         ety by increasing other men's perception.
> when he proclaimed:                                  Poetry is akin to the revealed Word, albeit
> infinitely lower in rank, being as all else de-
> Infinite Providence, Thou wilt cause the day
> pendent upon that; yet the poet also testifies
> to dawn.
> that in the beginning was the Word, that man's
> We are aware that the sun has risen, yet still    speech is also a mark of his divine descent, and
> know ourselves to be ' children of the half-         poetry the utterance of his deepest nature. Little
> light'. Such a vision, though circumscribed, still   wonder that poetry is so closely associated with
> looks to a future (a glorious one!) and, being       religion, and that the Word of God is often
> transcendental, bears witness to an eternity.        sublime poetry.
> Baha'ls once more have found man's place in             Surely, therefore, in the Baha'i community,
> endless time, regaining the organic awareness        poetry shall be accorded a very high place of
> of the succession of epochs which Herder knew        distinction, far above any mean assessment of
> of. Moreover, whereas Herder and Fichte had          utility. Even in this era of committees, the procaught a glimpse of God in the ever-unfolding        vince of the poet remains individual and inviorevelation of history, Baha'ls believe they are      late. There shall be no danger of official
> party to a knowledge of the Greater Revela-          demands for realism, or even quasi-romantion, the key to the whole progression. Baha'-       ticism. Plato's antagonism and the Prophet
> u'llah, the Greater Revelation, the Manifes-         MuQ.ammad's qualified consent that there
> tation of God for this age, confirmed this know-     was some truth in poetry are to be forgotledge of man's destiny when He said: All men         ten in the age of man's maturity. The Baha'i
> have been created to carry forward an ever-          poet is freed from restraint by virtue of the
> advancing civilization.                              ideals to which his Faith calls him to aspire.
> The transcendentalist sees across time and        Borne up by the moral vision of the Baha'i
> into eternity; for him the present is part of the    Faith, we will not need to look for an evident
> whole. A Baha'i poet may write poetry today          didacticism , conscious moralizing or theologizknowing that it will be far surpassed by great       ing. There need be no pressure for adherence
> Baha'i poets to come, poets supported by a           to the puritanical strain. For it remains true, in
> fully-developed philosophy and a world civiliz-      Yeats's words' ... that life is greater than the
> ation rooted in a religious culture. But he          cause ... and we artists ... are the servants not
> who writes today, writing in humility, may still     of any cause but of mere naked life, and above
> know he contributed his part to keeping the          all of that life in its nobler forms, where joy and
> vision of poetry alive. If what he writes comes       sorrow are one .. .' 1 We do not associate the
> from an inspired heart it may still be of human      ' W. B. Yeats, Essays and lmroductions, New York, 1961 p.
> value, and highly regarded by later genera-            260.
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                          623
> 'cause' referred to with God's Cause, the Baha'i      found in the tradition of his Faith. He has both
> Cause, but perhaps only that cause with a             a tradition which is yet a new one, and a vision
> small 'c' that men may make out of the Baha'i         which is faced to the future. He may recall the
> Faith. Causes, movements of ideas, have in the       potent influence of religion on previous literapast not infrequently become sterile in their         tures. In Hebrew literature poetry and religadherence to abstractions; that is, ideas not         ious inspiration are synonymous; the Indian
> lived and experienced. Ideas and beliefs are          languages have contributed a vital and varied
> not worthy until they become part of life itself.     literature to Hindu culture; and perhaps the
> Life in its mere naked form is what human             most powerful example of religion wedded to
> beings actually experience, and poetry addres-        literature is Islam and Arabic, which in turn
> ses itself essentially to personal experience. If     fertilized the fields of Persian, Turkish and
> the poet is to sing of life in its nobler forms he    Urdu literature.
> must have experienced or compassed imagina-              These thoughts only underline the inevitabiltively such realities. He must know the joy and       ity of an unimaginably resplendent range of
> suffering that are one, through his own sor-          literature in the mature Baha'i civilization.
> rows. It is as though he is articulating the          What an inheritance does the Baha'i poet
> spiritual battles of Everyman. In these matters       share! We may be present at the beginning, but
> there can be no abstraction, no dogma. It was         the prospect is vast. Here is not the place to
> Milton who insisted that poets who wished to          prophesy as to the possible images future poets
> write heroic poems should first make of their         will invoke, poets who have immersed themlives heroic poems. Baha'ls, following the            selves in the ocean of the Baha'i Writings. But
> advice of 'Abdu'l-Baha, do not merely recite          lest it seem that I am content only with generalverses but strive to make their lives beautiful       ization, I would like to quote briefly from a
> prayers . Poets must express what they believe        living Baha'i poet whose work possesses, in my
> not in theory but in the way they themselves,         estimation, a distinctive character.
> and others, have actually lived such belief.             Roger White's poetry contains, as far as I can
> Belief is in continual need of revitalization      tell, many echoes from the tradition of English
> through the influx of spiritual sensibility and       literature. He moves from the meditative,
> the infusion of real experience touched by            sometimes self-dissecting introspection of the
> imagination. The poet is one who can advance          seventeenth century Metaphysicals, through
> this aim, alongside the efforts of others, and         the light-hearted jeux d'esprits of the eighthus we reiterate his importance to the Baha'i         teenth, to the apparent disenchantment of the
> community. For fully accepted and approved,            modern mind.
> in this role he does become servant of the                We have a modern echo of John Donne:
> cause, which is life itself, the higher life that is
> Come, let me fete you, beloved foe,
> to be, which man must have more abundantly.
> for I tire of this old-born war.
> Profane imagery has been handled by the
> greatest poets, including J:Iafi'.? and Goethe; it       In stark contrast, we find the completely sechas influenced the sacred, as in the case of the       ular voice of the japing eighteenth century poet
> medieval lyric. The two English Puritan poets,         ostensibly berating a gourmand mistress:
> Spenser and Milton, the most serious of poets
> My deeper need you blithely slight,
> both, were alive to the sensuous. Hatred of the
> Love-not food-my appetite.
> world is not the poet's way; he must have water
> and clay as well as nightingales and roses. The           And yet another volte-face reveals the scep-
> Qur'anic paradise and the beloved's hair are           tical conscience of the modern:
> natural images that the most Sacred of Voices
> When you heard that God had died, you
> have not disdained to use.
> wondered
> At present then, the Baha'i who writes
> whether it was from sheer boredompoetry may find solace in the golden mines
> all that joyless music and our impudent
> which have been worked by the great poets of
> prayers.
> the past. Like most literate poets he will read
> widely. His particular advantage is the inspira-        I find in Roger White's variety of styles,
> tion of the themes, symbols and images to be           moods and themes the unity of a distinctive
> 624                                    THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> poetic mind. His use of secular image and idiom          sainthood by an exonerating intolerance
> is unabashed and unrepentant:                            and his need for us,
> but still a holy man.
> Named by her past suitors' Akka, Ptolemais,
> St. Jean d' Acre,                                   That these lines suggest so much about
> she is no beauty, this aged courtesan , meanly     ourselves as well as Fujita , as well as the poet's
> rouged by sun.                                   seeing, sensitive eye, is perhaps a mark of
> Roger White's range . On the surface eschew-
> Why did you do it, Keith?                  ing didacticism like a pl ague, th is poetry has
> And you a looker.                          'much to say' because it requires the reader to
> look into himself. Do we confine to cruel isola-
> Freddie, you walked in                             tion those we ostensibly canonize as living
> with eyes as open as your heart,                   saints? Roger White sees the predicament of
> knew it to be the deal beyond compromise;          the real man but his poet's lens also captures in
> survived the imagery                               a flash something of his subject's character:
> accommodated to nightingales and roses.
> mikado of mirth ,
> Here is the use of colloquial phrase and the                   the Servant's servant.
> profane conceit , but not merely for effect. We         This is real poetry then. It is not accomsense there is an ulterior purpose behind the        modating; it is often sardonic, questioning, not
> use of bawdy image, accusatory line a nd             easily satisfied. But it carries a note of wisdom
> worldly wit. This sense of controlling wisdom        and acceptance too. We see a practising poet
> behind the open technical faci lity is in fact the   writing, not as a single-minded poet-laureate
> secret to the appreciation of Roger White's          for the Baha'i Cause, but a sensitized human
> intention as poet. His is a deeply human eye;        being.
> hiding beneath the layers of burlesque and              But at a more obvious ' Baha'i' level , Roger
> modernist world-weariness is a sorrowful and         White's poetry suggests further points of
> joyous delicacy of feeling. The heart of the         departure . The heroes, heroines and history of
> quintessential pioneer-the grey-haired Baha'i        the Baha'i Faith are not invoked si mplistica lly
> lady inveigling an innocent 'contact' into her       or meretriciously, nor do quotations from
> Faith through her kindness and conviction-is         Scripture do the poet's work for him . When
> penetrated. She would:                               there is a quotation (he loves to borrow Shoghi
> Effendi's or the Universal House of Justice's
> . .. have shielded the hapless
> epithets to crown remembered Baha'i figures)
> of Nagasaki , Warsaw, Buchenwald,
> it is to build a n aura of pageant:
> with he r own body, if she could .
> Long ago she wept and worked for causes              Brilliant Keith! immortal Lua! steadfast
> not then named .                                       Thornton!
> courageous Marion! incomparable Martha!
> But if he can celebrate the unknown Baha 'i,           constant Juliet!
> he can also give a jolting insight into the predicament of known sa ints . The much-loved             What is the purpose in this?
> Fujita, renowned Japanese Baha'i, loving and           I fashion a paean; to vanquish dread, invoke
> devoted servant of 'Abdu' l-Baha, emerges as              the victors.
> a vulnerable, isolated man as opposed to the
> walking institution or sentimental relic:              It is an answer, then , to personal need, as
> well as to celebrate past souls and the spirit that
> Acquitted of triviality by a pain and loneli-      moved them. Roger White's poetry, while
> ness that might instruct us ,                    retaining the poet's individuality , yet leads us
> rescued a halo's-breadth from isolating            to hope for a Baha'i tradition of poetry.
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                           625
> 3. HIGHLIGHTS IN THE LIFE OF
> MIRZA ABU'L-FAQL
> (BASED ON AN ARTICLE BY R. MEHRABKHANI)
> 
> ... lea m ed apologist . .. (one of the) successive messengers despatched by 'Abdu'l-Bahti
> (who) succeeded in rapidly dispelling th e doubts, and in deepening the understanding of
> th e believers, in holding the community together, and in forming th e nucleus of those
> administrative insitutions which, two decades later, were to be formally inaugurated
> through the explicit provisions of'Abdu'l-Bahti's Will and Testament.
> Shoghi Effendi'
> 
> Mirza Abu'l-Fac;ll was born in Gulpaygan ,                   tember 1876. His first letter to Baha' u'llah was
> Iran in 1844 into a family distinguished for its                only a few lines from the Qur'an: ' O our Lord!
> scholarship. His father, Mirza Ric;la , was a                   we have indeed heard the voice of one that
> noted Shi'ih cleric. Even as a youth , Mirza                    called. He called us to the faith-"Believe ye
> Abu'l-Fac;ll displayed remarkable intelligence                  on your Lord"-and we have believed. 0 our
> and had a phenomenal memory. He received                        Lord! forgive us then our sin, and hide away
> his ·education in various centres in Iran includ-               from us our evil deeds , and cause us to die with
> ing I~fahan and also studied in 'Iraq, mastering                the righteous.' 5
> all branches of Islamic theology , Persian and                     He immediately began , in his straightfor-
> Arabic literature, and philosophy. Upon com-                    ward way , to propound the teachings ofBaha'-
> pletion of his studies in October 1873 he                       u'llah in his classroom. This provided an
> accepted appointment as a lecturer at I:Iakim                   opportunity to his jealous enemies who
> Hashim , an important and long-established                      denounced him to the clergy and prominent
> theological college in Tihran. Far from being a                 public figures in Tihran . In December 1876 he
> narrow-m inded priest, he had a broad outlook                   was dismissed from his teaching post and
> and an inquisitive mind and established contact                 imprisoned by order of the Prince Regent ,
> with Zoroastrians, Jews, Christians and even                    Kamran-Mfrza, the Governor of Tihran, a son
> the few Buddhists who could then be found in                    of Na~iri'd-Din Shah. This imprisonment
> fran. In 1875 he became acquainted with a                       lasted about five months during which time
> merchant of good character, Aqa 'Abdu'l-                        Mirza Abu'l-Fac;ll 's brothers seized the pro-
> Karfm , who had embraced the Baha'i Faith.                      perty which he had inherited from his father ,
> Although Aqa 'Abdu'l-Karfm had no school-                       valued at more than one million tumans; one of
> ing, he possessed a shrewd, acute mind. He                      them even robbed him of the few furnishings
> introduced Mirza Abu'l-Fac;ll to the Baha'i                     he had in his room. It was as though through
> teachings and arranged interviews for him with                  these hardships God was preparing Mirza
> learned Baha'is including Aqa Mul).ammad-                       Abu'l-Fac;ll for the life of dedicated service he
> i-Qa' ini (Nabfl-i-Akbar) 2 who was known as                    was to lead and remou lding his heart, mind and
> 'the Learned        One of Qa'in', I:Iaji                       spirit. 'Abdu'l-Baha was to refer to him later as
> Mul).ammad-lsma'fl of Kashan (surnamed                          'an angel of heave n' and encouraged the
> Dhabih 'sacrificed') ,3 I:Iaji Mirza I:Iaydar-'Alf              friends to 'follow his example'. Mirza Abu'lof Ardistan, 4 and others. For many months                      Fac;ll gave himself wholeheartedly to the Faith.
> Mirza Abu'l-Fac;ll debated with the Baha'is                     Years later when the friends would ask him to
> contemptuously and eventually finding him-                      tell something about his life he was wont to
> self, to his astonishment, unable to refute the                 answer: 'What can I say? Before becoming a
> proofs they adduced , became a convert in Sep-                  believer I was a dead man and the dead have no
> story to tell. And after becoming a believer,
> God Passes By, p. 195, 260.                                   one is like a shadow which has no existence in
> Memorials ofthe Fai1hful , p. 1; A. Taherzadeh, The Revela-   the light of the Faith.'
> tion of Baha'u'llah, vol. II, p. 42 , 341.
> J ibid., p. 137, 411 - 413.
> 
> ' ibid. , pp. 68- 73 , passim.                                  ' Qur'an 3: 190-192.
> 626                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> After his release from prison the clergy of
> T ihran attempted to persuade him to continue
> to verbally acknowledge allegiance to Islam
> and not to openly uphold the truth of the
> Baha'i Cause but he would not accede to their
> request. He then devoted himself to writing as
> a means of earning a livelihood and laboured
> diligently in spreading the Baha'i teachings .
> By 1882 the Faith had won a considerable
> number of converts throughout f ra n and the
> Caucasus, among whom were many prominent
> citizens. In Tihran , Rasht and Mazindaran the
> clergy and civil authorities were again inflamed
> with envy and hatred. In the wave of persecution that broke out Mirza Abu'l-Fa<;ll and a
> number of other believers were accused of sedition and plotting against the government and
> were imprisoned for twenty-two months. They
> suffered rigorous distress and hardship and
> during most of this time no one was allowed to
> visit them. Twenty-four of the prisoners,
> including Mirza Abu'l-Fa<;ll , were for fourteen
> days chained together with long, heavy chains
> a nd confined in a dark underground dungeon.
> He related that for about six months they
> received daily news of the plots and intrigues of                      Mirza Abu'l-Fa<j.l
> their enemies and expected death at any                                   1844-1914
> moment. The falseness of the accusations was
> eventually proven to the Shah who com-              prayer Baha'u' llah revealed for him in a Tabmanded that the prisoners should be set free.       let1-he also broadened his own knowledge in
> Mirza Abu'l-Fa<;ll then took up residence in     a way that would not have been possible withthe village of Qulhak, a delightful summer          out undertaking those extensive and freresort of Tihran, where he remained about           quently arduous journeys. He was an exemseven months, engaged in lecturing and writ-        plary travelling teacher. On his trips in Iran he
> ing. He was imprisoned again-this time for          lived modestly and subsisted on a simple diet.
> about six months-and released on 5 February         His clothing, too, was very simple. In order not
> 1886. In that year he received a Tablet addres-     to inconvenience the Baha'i friends he would
> sed to him by Baha'u'llah in which he was           stay at inexpensive caravansaries rather than
> instructed to travel for the purpose of spread-     accept hospitality from the believers. He
> ing the Baha'i message. Thus began his jour-        earned enough to cover his few expenses by
> neys which over the course of thirty years took     copying books for the friends. He continued
> him northward through Persia, Turkey, the           travelling and teaching the Faith in fran for
> Caucasus and as far as Moscow; eastward as far      some years, and despite the uncertain health
> as China and Kashgaria (Chinese Turkistan);         from which he suffered all his life, he knew
> to Syria and Egypt; and to Western Europe           neither rest nor leisure.
> and America. In his travels he held discussions        In 1887, encouraged by the renowned Baha'i
> with learned men of various religions,              teacher and poet (later martyred) Mirza
> nationalities and schools of thought. In addi-      'Ali-Mu~ammad , surnamed Varga ('Dove') by
> tion to inspiring them with his own particular      Baha'u'llah, Mirza Abu'l-Fa<;ll began to write
> gift for explaining subtle philosophical            for the Cause . He had felt it was an impertipoints-a skill which in the view of many of his      nence in the Day of God for the believers to
> contemporaries amounted to genius and one           1
> Tablet to J:laji Mul)ammad K~im of I~faban; see The
> which he felt he had received as a result of a          Baha'( Proofs, introductory matter to 2nd ed ., p. 12.
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                              627
> take up their pens when the Supreme Pen                        boundless. Such was his humility that he never
> was in motion. However, Mirza 'Ali-                            felt worthy of addressing Baha'u' llah directly
> Mul)ammad who had attained the presence of                     but wrote many letters and asked many ques-
> Baha' u'llah in ' Akka, relayed the command of                 tions through His amanuensis or sons. At the
> the Blessed Beauty that the believers should                   beginning of these letters he wrote long fervent
> write books demonstrating the truth of the                     prayers and supplications expressing his love.
> Cause. 'When I heard this statement from                       The receipt by Mirza Abu' l-Fa<;ll of a Tablet
> Varqa,' Mirza Abu'l-Fa<;ll records, 'I ventured                from 'Abdu'l-Baha asking him to arise and
> to undertake writing.Other believers from all                  serve the Covenant vivified his grieving heart
> parts were urging me both verbally and by                      and in 1894, at the invitation of the Master, he
> letters to write books of explanation and                      visited the Holy Land where he remained for
> proofs.' 1 There streamed from his pen, from                   several months, basking in the presence of
> 1888 until the time of his death, a flood of                   'Abdu'l-B aha and deepening in knowledge of
> treatises and books. Two of his works have                     the Faith. His humility before the Master and
> been translated into English, The Baha'i                       his obedience to Him were of a degree
> Proofs 2 and The Brilliant Proof 3 • The former                unknown. Some of his distinguished contemwas written in America, originally in Arabic,                  poraries have stated that they had never seen
> with the purpose of its being translated into                  any Baha'i more conscious of the greatness of
> English for the use of the friends and was not                 the Covenant and more humble before the
> completed when he left America . A first edi-                  Centre of the Covenant. The loving manner in
> tion was published in 1902; a second was pub-                  which 'Abdu'l-Baha treated him only
> lished shortly after his death in 1914 and con-                increased his humility and his desire to obey .
> tained an account of his life and tributes and                 His services springing from his understanding
> eulogies by ' Abdu'l-Baha. The Brilliant Proof                 of the Covenant constitute a brilliant chapter in
> is a small book written during Mirza Abu'l-                    the early history of the Faith.
> Fa<;Il's stay in Beirut in December 1911 at the                   At the request of 'Abdu'l-Baha he visited
> request of' Abdu'l-B aha in refutation of a criti-             Egypt, an important centre of Islamic studies
> cal article of Peter Z. Easton, a Protestant mis-              where he was soon acclaimed by a number of
> sionary, in which he misrepresented the aims                   theologians for his depth of knowledge .
> and purposes of the Faith. 'Abdu'l-Baha Him-                   Indeed, some thirty advanced students of
> self, while in America in 1912, directed that                  Al-Azhar, the greatest university of the Islamic
> The Brilliant Proof be published and in one of                 world, expressed their belief in Baha'u'llah.
> His discourses in Washington said of it: 'Each                 Some of the divines and professors of Alone of you should have a copy. Read , memo-                    Azhar then turned against Mirza Abu'l-Fa<;ll
> rize and reflect upon it. Then when accusations                and forbade their students to visit him or read
> and criticisms are advanced by those unfavour-                 his books. He was then confined to his house,
> able to the Cause, you will be well armed.' 4                  writing books and answering questions
> Mirza Abu'l-Fa<;il's Farti'id, a work of more                brought to him from Baha'is and inquirers.
> than 700 pages written in refutation of a                          Much could be said of the effect of his teachmulla's attack on Baha'u'llah's Kitab -i-lqan, is              ing among the friends of the West, who were deperhaps his best-known book in the East and                     prived of Baha'i literature, and some of whom
> an outstanding example of the logic and power                  had but a slight knowledge of the significance
> of his argument.                                               of the Cause which had attracted their hearts.
> The passing of Bahii'u'llah in 1892 had an                   Of his visit to Paris in 1901 it was written: 'What
> almost paralyzing effect upon Mirza Abu'l-                      a bounty to receive in 1901 the extended visit of
> Fa<;ll whose devotion to the Blessed Beauty was                Mirza Abu'l-Fa<;Il, sent by the Master to strengthen His Western children. For perhaps a
> The Baha'f Proofs, introductory matter to 2nd ed. , p. 14.    month he taught them almost daily, through the
> Trans. by Mimi ' Ali-Kuli Khan; New York : J. W. Pratt
> Co., 1902. Chicago: Baha'i Publishing Society, 1914. New
> translations of Anton I:Iaddad and 'Alf-Kuli
> York , Baha'i Publishing Committee, 1929.                    Khan. Of those memorable hours Agnes Alex-
> Chicago: Baha'i News Service, 1912. Wilmette, Baha'i         ander has written: "An atmosphere of pure
> Publishing Committee, 1949.
> 'Abdu' l-Bah:i, The Promulgation of Universal Peace, p.
> light pervaded the Paris meetings, so much so
> 425.                                                         that one was transported, as it were, from the
> 628                                        THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> world of man to that of God;" to which Juliet             they gave public lectures in halls rented by the
> Thompson 's testimony is added: "That Paris               believers for Sunday meetings only, as all other
> group was so deeply united in love and faith;             activities were held at the headquarters.
> May, Lua , Laura 1 and Khan, these four espe-                 ' Mfrza Abu'l-Fac_il spent much time in New
> cially so inspired, so carried away, so intoxi-           York, Green Acre , and Washington , returning
> cated with love for the beloved Master; our               there after his visit in Chicago. His explanagreat teacher, Mirza Abu'l-Fac_il , so heavenly           tions of the Bible were wonderful, giving from
> wise-that those days were the days of miracle,            Genesis to Revelation the most voluminous
> of all but incredible confirmations.'" 2 To this          and the most explicit interpretations we have
> may be added the tribute of May Maxwell: 'We              ever received.'
> must first touch the heart to awaken it; if it                The transcription of the stenographic record
> opens and responds we must sow the priceless              made of his talks and lectures, the account
> seed ... Prepare the soil with the warmth of              concludes, has been 'carefully preserved' and
> your love just as the sun prepares the soil in the        this, together with a large number of his letters
> spring or the seed will not grow. Remove the              to believers and inquirers served 'as a basis for
> stones and weeds .. that is to say, in a kind way         giving the Message, especially to Christians.'
> try to remove prejudices . . Uproot narrow                    On 29 November 1904 Mirza Abu' l-Fac_il
> superstitions by suggesting broader, deeper               took leave of the American friends. He was
> ideas. Never oppose people's ideas and state-             now old and his health, never robust, was
> ments, but give them a little nobler way of               deteriorating . The climate, the food, the
> seeing life. Such words and thoughts will take            demands on his time, had not benefitted him.
> effect because they come from a Baha'i whose              After returning to the East he spent his time in
> life flows from the source of all life on earth           Haifa, Beirut, Alexandria and Cairo. The Mastoday ... My great and wise teacher, Mfrza                ter took special care of him and he lived some
> Abu'l-Fac_il, laid down these divine principles           years more, devoting much time to his writing.
> of teaching in my soul . . and they have                  On 21January1914, in Cairo , his earthly life
> changed all my attitude . He showed me that it            ended. His attending nurse said that as he
> is the Spirit of God that is doing the work ; we          expired she heard him exclaim : 'God! God!' 5
> must wait upon the Spirit and do Its bidding                  An eyewitness has left this account of the
> only.' 3                                                  effect upon 'Abdu'l-Baha of the news of the
> The American Baha'i community's appreci-               passing of Mfrza Abu'l-Fac_il:
> ation of the visit of Mirza Abu'l-Fac_il is                   'The telegram arrived last night (21 January
> recorded       in   The    Bahri'(    Centenary:          1914); it was delivered this morning, and the
> 1844-1944 4 in an article entitled 'Teachers              heart-breaking news conveyed to ' Abdu' l-
> Sent to America by 'Abdu'l-Baha': 'Also                   Baha just as He sat down to partake of His
> 'Abdu'l-Baha sent to America in 1902 the                  lunch. The news saddened and grieved Him.
> revered Mirza Abu'l-Fac_il ... He was accom-              He did not say a word, but arose from His seat
> panied by Mfrza 'Ali-Kuli Khan, later an                  without eating. He remained alone in His room
> attache of the Persian Embassy in Washington,             till late in the afternoon. Then He went with
> D.C., who acted as his interpreter and trans-             Mirza Hadl to the telegraph office to send a
> lator. The Baha'ls had already rented a                   message of consolation to the friends in Cairo.
> house . . . for a headquarters where the                  The Pilgrims' House was a house of mourning;
> activities of the Cause were carried on. Here             many eyes were weeping and many hearts bur-
> I:Iajl Mfrza I:Iasan and party, Mfrza Abu'l-Fac_il        dened with sorrow.
> and all the translators lived at the same time.               'In the evening all the believers gathered in
> This was a glorious experience for the friends            'Abdu'l-Baha's house. Under breath everyone
> who gathered there to receive the teachings               was discussing the death of our venerable
> from these marvelous teachers. Every Sunday               teacher, when Mfrza Hadl brought us the word
> that 'Abdu'l-Baha would receive us . We all
> May (Bolles) Maxwell, Lua Getsinger, Laura (Clifford)
> Dreyfus-Barney.                                         ascended to the upper floor , and after a few
> 2 May Maxwell, 'In Memoriam'. The Balza'{ World, vol.
> minutes He came in. At first He was silent, then
> VIII, p. 634.
> ibid., p. 636.
> while His eyes were shut He started to speak.
> Baha'i Publishing Committee, Wilmette, Ill., 1944.      'Star oftlze West, No. 19, vol. IV.
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                               629
> He would speak a few phrases, then a Hood of                        pedantic expressions or circumlocution-in
> emotions sweeping over Him, He would stop a                         order to bear upon the mind of the reader the
> few seconds and continue.' 1                                        whole weight of his learning and scholarship
> In a series of moving eulogies the Master
> paid tribute to one who He said was, from                              ' How learned was he! How wise was he!
> every standpoint, 'peerless':                                       How well informed was he! His understanding
> ' . . . he was in a state of the utmost sever-                   was marvellous and his wisdom beyond comance, and adorned with the highest virtues of                       parison ... All the learned men and scholars of
> firmness and steadfastness. He was absolute,ly                      the Islamic world, especiall y those who reside
> detached from everything. From the day that                         in Egypt, and had conversed with Mirza
> he became a believer up to the last moment of                       Abu'l -Fac;Il , have testified that he was a genius,
> his life , ·he was occupied in the service of the                   a truly wise man . Notwithstanding this, his
> Cause of God; either he conveyed the Message                        character was never tinged with any vanity or
> or wrote books proving the validity of the                          self-conceit.' 2
> Cause. He had not the slightest attachment to                          In words such as these ' Abdu'l-Baha honth is mortal world .                                                oured a servant whose passing He said was 'an
> 'How erudite and learned he was! ... He ...                      irretrievable loss for the people of Baha" .3
> was a standard-bearer of the oneness of the                            Perhaps we glimpse in some small measure
> world of humanity. In the servitude of the Holy                     the personal loss experienced by the Master
> Threshold of Baha'u'llah he was my partner                          when we read: 'While I was living in Ramleh,
> a nd associate. During the hours of grief he was                    whenever I felt depressed or sad, I ca lled on
> the source of my consolation. From every                            him , and soon afterwa rds I was in a happier
> standpoint I trusted him , and had in him the                       frame of mind.' 4
> greatest amount of confidence. Whenever                                Now , on the Mediterranean coast of Spain ,
> anyone wrote books and articles against this                        my memory goes back to a period twenty-eight
> Cause, I referred them to him for irrefutable                       years ago when I was putting the last touches
> a nswer.                                                            on my work on the life of Mirza Abu ' l-Fac;Il5
> 'How humb le and meek he was! We tried                           written during years of eager investigation ,
> our best to persuade him to keep a servant, but                     having travel led to Gulpaygan, his birthplace,
> he wo ul d always gently decline. He desired to                     to get my last inspiration for it. I wa lked for
> serve the believers personally . . .                                hours and hours along the streets gazing at the
> 'During all the days of his life I never heard                   one-storey sun-dried brick buildings, the
> from him the use of the word "I" - " I said so ,"                   orchards of fruit trees, the fields of wheat and
> or "I wrote so and so." .. . He never made a                        barley with clumps of ta ll willow and poplar
> display of his knowledge , nor wished to                            here and there. In this unprepossessing setting
> impress upon the mind of any person that he                         was born a man of a kind of whom an Arab
> knew such and such a subject. He was evanes-                        proverb says 'he could count for a thousand
> cent and lived in the station of nothingness .. .                   men'. And, I thought , in the case of Mirza
> No one inhaled from him the odor of superior-                       Abu'l-Fac;Il , whose name means literall y 'the
> ity . ..                                                            father of learn ing', for many more!
> 'Were one to read all his writings and works,
> he does not find "I-ness" and "egoism" stalk-                       2
> ibid., pp. 19-27.
> ing between the lines, nor does he observe any                        ibid ., p. 23.
> 'ibid ., p. 21.
> ' Th e Bah ti ' ( Proofs, introductory matter to 2nd ed. , p. 19.   ' Published in Persian ; 1975.
> 630                                         THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 4. A PORTION OF RADIANCE: A REMINISCENCE 1
> BERTHALIN ALLIEN
> 
> I first heard of the Baha'i Cause a little before           New York. In her apartment, where Anton
> 1900, while I was in school in Paris. There I               Haddad gave the lessons of the Cause, the
> met a small group of people, a few American                 wonder of it, the hol y words, entranced me.
> st udents, like myself, who seemed to be                    The holy words, life-giving fountains, revealinvolved in a new religion stemming from Per-               ing, ever new, to this very day since 1900. I
> sia. I can' t say that I was especially impressed           believe I am thus the oldest living Baha'i, who
> by what they said. Rather I was attracted by                was living in New York City at that time.
> these people as unusual people-one in par-                     Soon after that I returned to school in Paris
> ticular, a very beautiful girl who seemed to                and joined that first Baha'i group of E urope. 5
> radiate a specia l magnetic charm. I was com-               The Guardian many years later wrote telling me
> pletely captivated by her and not understand-               how blessed I was to have been a member of
> ing what she was saying, I just silentl y sat in            that group. A small group but there was
> wonder, somehow feeling her special station .               radiance, the spirit of Baha'u'llah so strong, a
> Her name was May Bolles,2 who later became                  tightly united group; it made me speechless; all
> the mother of RuJ:iiyyfh Khanum.                            I wanted was to be with them; my whole life
> I was leavin g for home, New York City, and             was changed. There were no books ... the
> before leaving May gave me a letter to a friend             teachings of the Manifestation of God were
> who she said would explain things to me .... I              spread by word of mouth and from heart to
> found her to be a beautiful woman, beautiful                heart! How powerful the Spirit that radiated
> and on fire with the religion she had embraced .            from this group, out into the far-reach ing cor-
> Her name was Elfrida Martin. With her was a                 ners of this earth, until from that small begin-
> Persian, Anton Haddad ,3 who I found out                    ning the radiance of the Cause of God is now
> later was the translator of the famous                      felt by people, remote and far away.
> Suratu'l-Haykal. 4 'Abdu'l-Baha had sent him                   There were no books, just a few words brought
> to America to teach and it was listening to him             back to us from pilgrims who had gone to
> that I caught the first impact of something far             'Akka to see the prisoner, ' Abdu'l-Baha. They
> greater than I could grasp at the moment. It all            had seen Him, they had felt the magnetic
> seemed too big, too incomprehensible for my                 power of the 'Servant of God,' the only title He
> understanding, too fantastic for my mind to                 wanted; they told us about Him and brought
> grasp, but my heart seemed to know what my                  back the first teachings, His love, His hopes for
> mind was un ab le to take in .                              those who believed in Him .
> Anton's theme was that the Spirit of Christ                In those days we in Paris wrote to 'Abdu'lwas on earth again to bring the people back to              Baha to confirm our love and devotion to Him
> God. This thrilled me as ever since childhood I             and those letters were always answered by
> had in my heart a love for Jesus. I longed for              Him. After my schooling I returned to New
> Him always. Now was that divine Spirit here                 York City having lived in Paris four years. The
> again? It must be so, I wanted it to be so. It             Tablets I received, thirteen of them, made a
> flooded my heart with hope until I came to                  strange impact upon me. I was unable to
> believe even before I knew anything about                   'digest' them-that's not the best word-it was
> what I was to learn later, the greatness, the               simply I could not believe that they were
> majesty of Baha'u'llah . So it was that Mrs. Mar-           addressed to me. It was as if I should look over
> tin and I were the first Baha'is at that time in            my shoulder to see the person for whom they
> were meant. To this day this one sentence still
> Published under the title 'The Luminous Hour' in Baha'i    makes me stop short: ' Praise be to God, thou
> News, February 1965; © the National Spiritual Assembly
> of the Baha'is of the United States.                       hast been accepted at the threshold of the
> Later Mrs. William Sutherland Maxwell.
> ' Antun Haddad.
> 'Surih of the Temple , an important Tablet revealed by      ' A photograph of the first Baha'i gro up of E urope appea rs
> Baha'u'llah in •Akka.                                       on p. 132.
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                                  631
> Almighty and are mentioned in the Supreme            1817-November 12, when at the hour of
> Concourse! ' These Tablets are now safe in the       dawn a child was born in the city ofTihran. To
> Arch ives. I no longer remember dates, years,        me that hour must have stirred the very atoms
> what happened in such and such a year. My life       of the earth, making the earth tremble with joy,
> was a simple one, sometimes hard , many              for on it would walk the spirit of God and in
> heartbreaks, but over the long span of life since    another city a little known disciple' of
> 1900, now 1964 and close to ninety, I at last        Al)mad-i-Ahsa'f2 (the forerunner of the Bab)
> have made the words in the Tablets my                bowed to the ground in an act of wonderment,
> own-everything 'Abdu'l-Baha had predicted            testifying that 'At this hour the light of the
> for me has come true.                                Promised One has broken and is shedding
> illumination upon the whole world.' How shin-
> Year 1905: ' O thou who art advanced to
> ing was that hour! And as the believers multi-
> God!
> ply, their army marching into the far-off coun-
> Be assured and content with the great bounty
> tries of the earth, exiles from home and kin,
> and generosity of God, and be cheerful
> they carry the torch held high to tell the people
> because all that which is absolutely good will
> of that luminous hour-November 12, 1817.
> become possible for thee. In this day all that
> As to the moment of my actual meeting
> which is conducive to the eternal happiness is
> 'Abdu'l-Baha this was at the house of Ed Kinattainable by thee. Be not grieved at allney.3 As He entered the room there was a
> neither sit down dispirited. Every difficulty
> strange stillness; we were awed by His preswill be changed to enlargement, and every
> ence; majestic yet very human, He looked at us
> affliction will be transformed to the mercy
> with compassion. He strode about the room,
> of omnipotence.'
> some of us were sitting on the floor and every
> 'Upon thee be greeting and praise.'
> time He passed me I touched His garment. He
> (signed) 'Abdu'l-Baha 'Abbas
> spoke at length and each sentence was trans-
> Years passed with just living until , unexpect-   lated but what these words were I have no idea,
> edly, I had a chance to go to Haifa. Years           for I like others was completely engulfed in an
> before' Abdu'l-Baha had given me permission          exalted consciousness in which the mind had
> in one of His Tablets, but I had to wait all those   no place. I don't believe those words were
> years and by then 'Abdu'l-Baha had passed, in        taken down at that time, tape recording was
> 1921. Four unforgettable weeks were spent in         still half a century away. Many of those present
> the Holy Places, surrounded by so much love,         have described this scene and it can be found in
> the hours spent in the shrines, in prayer and        several books. For me the words were lost-we
> meditation , the precious time spent with the        were all caught up in an intensely vibrant
> Greatest Holy Leaf-a pure spirit-as well as          atmosphere. As we gazed at the beautiful face
> several visits with the Guardian . .. by his bed-    of 'Abdu'l-Baha, we were not in this world. A
> side, as he was ailing and depressed. The bur-       few who were there then are still alive, carrying
> den of responsibility thrust upon him so sud-        the spirit of that moment out into the fardenly almost crushed him. Looking back now,          reaching corners of the earth and all who hear
> since he has passed away, I have felt that he too    them too are given a portion of radiance
> was a martyr, for the responsibilities became        emanating from 'Abdu' l-Baha.
> ever more heavy. However, under it all he
> gained in strength and spirituality which helped     1
> Mirza Mal)mud-i-Qam~ari ; see Nabil-i-A'~am. (Mulla
> him to become a brilliant leader. ...                   Mul)ammad-i-Zaranc!i) , The Dawn Breakers pp. 8-9.
> Much time has passed since 1900 when I first       ' fillaytI.i Al)mad-i-Al)sa'i, (1743-1826) founder of the
> .fil)aykl!f school.
> caught a glimpse of what was to come, but to         3
> Edward B. Kinney ($afa), see 'In Memoriam', The Baha' f
> me the year to be remembered is                         World, vol. XII. p. 677.
> 632                                         THE BAH A' i WORLD
> 
> 5. FRAGMENTS FROM A DIARY
> JONATHA N RI S HW ORTH
> 
> (Impressions of a Baha'i yo uth of his vis it to Kenya as a trave llin g teacher)
> 10 D ece mber 1978- 25 January 1979
> 
> H aifa
> 10 February 1979
> So    ME days have passed since my return from              Kilifi, a nd ove r the eight days the experiences
> the beautiful country of Kenya. During a brief              share d by the twenty-five or more Baha'fs presix-wee k sojourn I was privilege d to trave l wi th        sent will a lways remain deeply deposited
> friend s into the Central Province as well as to            within each pe rso n, as gems ready to be
> the Coast Province . In both places, precious               brought forth and given to others when the
> hea rts ab ide , waiting for people to bring the            oppo rtunity presents itse lf to speak forth
> Message of Baha' u' ll ah into their lives.                 Baha'u' ll ah's Teachings.
> To have time to give our Lord , howeve r                    T he days were spent in a n atmosp here of
> short the days must be , however inadequate we              love a nd learning, prayer fillin g o ur soul s, Holy
> each must feel , is such a wondrous gift, th at as I        Words stirring hearts and laughte r re leas ing a
> look back over the days spe nt teaching in                  sp irit of joy that touched all in the warm glow
> Kenya the gratitude in my heart knows no way                of His Presence. Any previous doubts fled from
> of true expression; save to bend a little more              my mind , now instilled with greater insight into
> each day to try, to strive, to ta ke up the respon-         the myriad possibilities open to each of us when
> sibility given each of us to serve the world of             praye r is offered up and the teaching of His
> humanity forthe sake of the Blessed Perfection.             Message is carried out in accordance with the
> A pleasant flight from Israel , a brief delay in        directions given us in the Writings .
> customs, then , immediate contrast when I                       Afte r: the return to Nairobi , waiting fo r
> stepped through the outer door and was                      frie nds as they prepared for the days ahead,
> greeted by a welcoming group of Baha'fs from                 then the exciting mom ent of departure.
> Nairobi. A drive to the Nation al Centre which              Mehraz, Samuel, Ernie and myself drove into
> was to be my base. Staying there also were                  the Cent ra l Province, and he ld a rendezvous
> so me travelling teachers awaiting furth er                 with James, Moriuki and Mwangi. The joy of
> instructions from the National Spiritual                     those moments is beyond my power of descrip-
> Assembly before journeying to various parts of               tion. Prayers were offered by us all th at our
> the country to teach the village people, so                  hearts be e mptied, our spirits become magnets
> many of whose hearts a re yearning to hear the              of the love of God, and our feet be directed
> Message of God. Among those at the Centre                    un fa ilingly to souls who might be receptive to
> was Jenabe Caldwell , a n A las kan, who was                 the Message of Baha'u'llah that would e nrich
> organizing teaching institutes throughout the                their lives both in this world and in the spiritual
> Ke nyan Provinces . After talking with him and              worlds beyond.
> some National Spiritual Assembly members I                      T he seq ue nce of days, the innum erable indidecided to travel to one of the institutes prior             vidual eve nts that occurred are not relevant to
> to any teaching activity.                                    this sketch, but the freedom of those moments
> Before attending the institute I felt slightly           might be thus described:
> perturbed as to how I cou ld ensure that my time                Dawn ho urs found us praying together;
> in Kenya would not be frittered away on spas-                late r, as individ ual e ntities, o ur hearts, minds
> modic, ineffectual teaching caused by my pos-               and sou ls turn to the Creator supplicating
> sib le in ability to seize a nd promote to the full est,    stren gth , guidance, love, wisdom; praising
> any God-given opportunity. I wanted desperately              Him, magnifying His Na me , invok ing His ai d
> to be as a fine instrument, freed fr o m the impedi-         in recognizing the divine reality in the hearts
> ments of self, so His Spirit would fl ow swift ly           and minds of all we might meet.
> and deeply into the he arts of the people. ·                    Suns ri se, suns set, and a gree n-robed river
> The institute took place on the Coast, in                 valley witnesses a small band of the followers
> ESSAYS AN D REVIEWS                                              633
> of the Blessed Beauty being welcomed by chil-          short respite with friends in town- time to
> dren runnin g onto a wide, open grass field ,          reflect on the days that have passed. One realbright shining faces , each chil d calling A llah -    ization is overpowe rin g: that it is Baha'u'll ah
> u-Abhd! T hose days wi ll be remembered: the           Who knows what is to take place, what do es
> many waiting hearts, the precious individuals ,        take place, and the reality of what took place.
> one of the teachers smilin g rad iantl y with              On the road o nce more. Goda, Mwombegu
> God's love shining in him , the quiet David who        and myse lf were left in Malindi where a
> spoke such sweet words. Miracles see med to            warm-hearted Baha'i fa mily welcomed us into
> happe n dai ly, and all are reme mbered: those         their home inviting us to make it our home
> who liste ned , those who accepted, the sm il es ,     during our visit. T he days merged together.
> the prayers, the e lection as we wit nessed the        Goda, Samuel , Godo na, Mwombegu, Patrick
> birth of an Assembly.                                  and I travelled to Pendukiani , Mijomboni ,
> Leaving that va lley paradise , with two of o ur    walking over shadowed sa nd paths which wound
> new-found fami ly remaining behind , we jour-          past the homes of ma ny people who , ye t so phyneyed to a flat green countryside where tea            sica ll y close to western influe nce, see m re mote
> plantations lined the dust roads. There in one         from th at world . The la nd is still an integral part
> small village we sat for two evenings: women,          of th eir lives. As we travelled from one village
> me n and children relaxed on the grass listening       to anothe r, the pote nti alities of the area became
> as God's Message was offered. (Please, touch           increasingly appare nt; o ur minds stagge red
> their hearts, dear Lord!) Another Asse mbl y           un der the weight and beauty of the concept.
> was formed and thus was spun the unseen mys-               We envisio ned many Assemblies being
> tical web that binds and draws together, in            for med , the Message being quickly spread
> ways too subtl e to ever comprehend , those who        amon g a nd acce pted by great numbers of peorespond to His call. Circumsta nces call ed us         ple . A ll too qui ck ly my brief sojourn the re
> away. T hose who are able to return promise to         ended. Leaving the others behind teaching the
> do so; we ho ld them in our hearts and prayers ,       receptive villagers I returned to Mombasa, lost
> supplicati ng that those who have been deeply          in reminiscences of those pure-hearted villagtouched by the Ca use of God will talk often           e rs who declared their be lief, praying that
> with their Lo rd and lead all they meet to new         o th er teachers would soon arise and visit these
> spiritual insights.                                    people , teaching them , explainin g in detail the
> Again we reached the river valley, returning        significance of the Revelation of Baha' u' -
> wit h a ' fami ly' diminished in number because        ll ah- for the possibilities are limitless.
> some were required to attend to other matters,         (Please, Cod, we will achieve it!)
> each of us regretting the separation . There we            Nairobi o nce again , and a last glance at those
> see o ur brothers and sisters, so new to the Fa ith    hearts I had co me to know so well. Wonderful
> of Baha'u'llah, forgi ng spiritual awareness into      news! Many people a re accepting His Message
> daily rea lity as they teach those they encou nte r;   in the area surrounding that first magical valley
> in a brief time another Asse mbly is for med,          where He directed that pitifully sma ll band of
> cemented with love . T hat valley of red dust          followers.
> roads and verdant, fe rtile banks where He has             At home, e nriched by memories of my vi sit
> raised up lov ing souls eager to participate in the    to Kenya, I expe rience a wave of gratitude and
> greatest challenge ever given by God to man, the       tender love toward all those I met in Nairobi ,
> unificat io n of mankind-that valley is blessed.       Ta mbaya , Mo mbasa , Kilifi, Malindi, Pen-
> With the arriva l of a friend who suggested         dukiani , Mijomboni- and for all the people of
> that we must trave l onwards, events cha nged           Kenya. Innumerab le o pportunities lie ahead
> swiftly a nd my course was alte red. A fami liar       for those who take up the ir lives and cast the m
> destination awaited me: perhaps I owed it              at the feet of the Beloved: 'To assist Me , is to
> something. A telephone conversation with a              teach My Cause.' (Baha 'u'l!ah)
> member of the National Spiritual Asse mbl y, a             How ma ny prayers will be spoken from the
> trip to Nairobi by motorbike, preparation for a         heart? What lessons will be given? How often
> flight to th e coast and, God willing, a n oppor-      will we liste n?
> tunity to offer assistance to the Province in              'O God, my God, my Beloved, my heart's
> which th e teaching institute had bee n he ld. A       Desire .' (Th e Bab)
> 634                                    THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> 6. REGINALD TURVEY: AN APPRECIATION OF THE
> MAN AND HIS ART 1
> LOW ELL JOH NSON
> 
> REGINALD Ernest George Turvey was born               He painted a number of portraits, including
> in 1882 in Ladybrand , South Africa on the           one of Sir Thomas Fuller, but he excelled in
> border of the little country known today as          landscapes. The secret of his skill was his inti-
> Lesotho. His family descended from pioneer           macy with the landscape; he was the landscape.
> Englishmen who came to South Africa in the           He virtually walked into the painting which
> first wave of settlers in 1820. His great-           came to represent his feelings as he stood on
> grandfather, Edward Ford Turvey , also an            Yorkshire downs or the banks of the canals of
> artist, had headed one of the parties in the         Amsterdam , Ghent or Bruges, or the shores
> settlement. Life was difficult for these             and mountains of the Italian Riviera and
> pioneers, but by the time of Reg's birth, the        southern Africa. Much of his early work was
> Turvey brothers owned many of the farms              inspired by Constable and Cezanne whose
> encircling Ladybrand and t)le central square         paintings he greatly admired.
> block of the town itself where his father ran a          We have very few clues to Turvey's thinking
> trading store and collected rents.                   in this period except those to be found in a few
> Reg's first contact with art was the aboriginal   letters written to Bernard Leach between 1909
> Bushman paintings discovered while playing           and 1920 when Reg was in England and Africa
> in caves in the foothills around Ladybrand           and Leach was in Japan. The letters reveal a
> and the Drakensberg mountains of Lesotho.            lonely man. He loved England but close com-
> He never completed his schooling because             panionship meant more to him, so with a gift
> his teacher discovered his talent for drawing        from his father, he joined Leach in Japan in
> and convinced his father to send him abroad          1910. He had hoped to give art lessons there
> to art school. Reg entered the Slade School          but the Eastern way of life and the Japanese
> of Art in London in 1903 with the grudg-             weather did not agree with him and reluctantly
> ing support of his family who felt that he would     he agreed to return to his family in South
> do better to pursue a more lucrative profes-         Africa to assist on the farm. A letter written to
> sion.                                                his family at this time survives: ' ... but I shall,
> On the first day of school he met fellow          of course, in such spare time as I may have , try
> student Bernard Leach , in from another colony       to keep up my art-of course, not interfering
> (Hong Kong) , and they became lifelong               with the farm work. But, still you must never be
> friends. Leach says that he does not think he        sorry that your son is somewhat of an artist and
> had any influence upon Turvey as an artist. 'I        has the true feeling for art, for it is not a thing to
> was interested in line,' he said, 'and Reggie in     be ashamed of. People may scorn it as they will.
> colour texture. He loved painting in itself and       I shall always be proud of having done what I
> was a born colourist. What we used to call            have done, though it is little. My work has
> "tone" in our student days was almost always          given pleasure to some few ... it would be
> clearly to be found in his strong brushwork .         rather hard for me to lose touch with every-
> Touch sang to touch, tone to tone, tension to         thing that has concerned my life in the pursuit
> tension.' In the sphere of their personal lives,      of art, so while I am farming I would like just
> however, they influenced each other greatly.          now and then to smell a paint brush.'
> One year after entering Slade where he               The letter contains all the seeds of Turvey's
> studied under Henry Tonks and won the W.              future frustrations: his family of farmers and
> Steer prize for portrait painting, Reg moved to       businessmen did not understand him, and art
> the London School of Art where he spent four         made little impression in the South Africa of
> years becoming essentially a landscape painter.      that day. Also, his father who moved to Kenya
> and established a farm there with Reg as his
> ' Excerpted from a forthcoming biography by Lowell
> trainee, died within a year of the move leaving
> Johnson.                                            his bereft son in sole charge of the farm.
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                          635
> The outbreak of war in 1914 deeply affected        paintings and his at-one-ment with nature from
> Reg's sensitive nature. In a letter written on 8     which they sprang. A few months later he
> November 1915 from Nakuru , Kenya he reveals         wrote to Leach saying that he had been reading
> his abhorrence of war, intuitively reflecting the    Theosophical books, deriving satisfaction from
> teachings of the Baha 'i Faith which he had not       the writings of those 'able to see the inner truth
> yet encountered: ' Oh, when will this wretched        of things.'
> war be over? It is truly a barbarous thing: the          In 1924 Reg married Frances Waddell G unn
> worst thing that could have happened in this          in Ladybrand and not long after returned to
> supposed-to-be civilized era. Real civilization       England with his wife. Rejoining his friend,
> has not touched the souls of many; yet this war      Leach, he set up a studio in St. Ives, Cornwall
> is the indication of an evil thing which must be      and later built a house and studio opposite
> rooted out forever if possible. The cry of civi-      Leach's home. The next sixteen years were
> lization is Peace, or ought to be. But when will      fulfilling for Reg. He had compan ionship,
> real civilization be so universal and ingrained       painted full-time , and had a relatively happy
> as to make such a thing as war impossible? If         family life although his first son died of diphwars are to continue on into the ages and sci-        theria. When Leach moved to Dartington as
> ence continues to make the vast progress that it      resident potter the Turveys followed.
> has within the last sixty years or so, then, ulti-   A lthough Reg was not on the staff he lived
> mately the destruction of life will be so great      close to Dartington Hall and here entered into
> that there will be plenty of room on the earth        a new phase of art education. The bulk of his
> for the devil to walk to and fro in ... Tell me,      work in this period which had been stored in a
> what is the finest aim in life, and why?'             shed was destroyed by mischance after he
> Twice Reg tried to enlist in the army, once in     returned to South Africa in 1940.
> Kenya and a second time after selling the farm           In 1932 Turvey met the American Baha'i
> and returning to South Africa , but on both           painter Mark Tobey who taught the artist to
> occasions was told he had a weak heart, a fact        work less from the mind than the heart and
> proven not long after when he suddenly col-           broadened Turvey's outlook on contemporary
> lapsed in pain while climbing a hill on the Natal     art. Tobey's approach to painting was not
> coast to do some painting. He spent a year            immediately reflected in Turvey's work , but
> recovering during which he lived at sea level;        the ideas that Mark expressed about a gradual
> slowly he began to paint again.                       withdrawal from direct observational painting
> His letters to Bernard Leach during this           of nature and a movement toward abstraction
> period reveal his questing nature. After his          influenced the paintings Turvey produced
> heart attack, he wrote: 'I did fight for life any-    toward the end of his life . Bernard Leach, too,
> way, and the mind is a tremendous force when          was attracted to Tobey's teaching. He guided
> no adverse suggestion comes to bother it. I           both men into the many developments of modtried to impress this from the very first upon the    ern painting and introduced them to the Baha'i
> few people around me. What a mystery life is!         Faith. Within three years Reg became a Baha'i;
> And yet sometimes, like you, I feel I under-          Leach followed five years later.
> stand things . Anyway, as far as they matter to          The effect of the Baha'i Faith on Reg's life
> us. The rest we leave to God ... I think if one's     was not immediately manifested. He was to
> mind goes off searching in the right direction it     return to South Africa to his roots, experiencdoes eventually take one into a calm placid           ing occasional poverty and the pain and loneliregion. I am vague, but as I say, I do sometimes      ness of divorce before the universal teachings
> feel things rightly without having much actual        of the Faith of Baha'u'llah brought him the
> knowledge. Metaphysics, and all the rest of it; I     peace he had always sought.
> haven't the mind to go floundering about                 Soon after his return to South Africa a critic
> amongst all the thoughts of all the                   lauded Turvey's paintings for their echo of 'the
> philosophies. But to reach this calm region           suggestion of movement and the perfection of
> from which to regard life, to be "at-one-with"        line seen in many of the magnificent rock paintnature in its calm evolutionary progress seems        ings at Modderpoort and in the exposed caves
> to me the greatest attainment.' Here are clues        of the mountains of Ladybrand and Basutoto the calm placidity of Turvey's landscape           land ... He has developed a personal tech-
> 636                                       THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> nique whi ch in the result is very ori gin al. ' As
> early as 1937 whe n he exh ibited at the
> Bloomsbury Ga ll eries, London, his work was
> pra ised for ' its qua lities rooted in ancient art.'
> In 1961, when Reg was seventy-n ine, a perceptive reviewer wrote: 'Regin ald Turvey is a
> painter who has evo lved a sty le, through his
> long years of devotion to hi s art, which refuses
> to be classified under any arty " ism" . His malleable talent has co ntinued to expand and
> renew itse lf at a stage when most painters have
> become set in their hab its.'
> Reg never entered the realm of pure abstraction. His work ge nerally evolved toward a simplification in which im ages from nature, birds
> and anima ls, were recognizable but imaginatively transformed. He drew close r to the world
> of pure imagination, and spoke from within of
> the life he had experienced through hi s senses,
> now reflected from a mature perspective.
> A restrospective exhibition in 1966 drew
> this com ment: 'You need not to have known
> Reg T urvey to realize that this is an exh ibition
> in a class by itself ... Turvey himself, courte-
> Reginald Turvey
> ous, gentle and serene, has always firml y fol-
> 1882-1968
> lowed his own path (illumin ated for him by
> certain masters) and this path can be traced
> again by the beholder at this retrospective             almost indifferent attitude to success. Perhaps
> exhibitio n. T here are some touchingly lovely          it was th at self-denial was a feature of the myslandscapes from this (earlier) phase of the             tic Oriental religion he embraced.' A no th er
> artist's career. His "Drakensberg", painted             commented: 'This lack of recognition would
> with reverence and awe, makes o ne forget a ll          not have worried this most modest a nd lovable
> the purple-and-green tra vesties of the same            of painters, but ... it is o nl y right th at those
> su bject. Here ... can be found the tran sition         who neglected him should be ab le to go and
> from mere know-how to the spiritual percep-             worsh ip at his shrine before it is too late.'
> tion . . . Throug hout his a lmost unacclaimed             Those who knew Reg wel l in his later years
> career, Turvey's painting was slowly approach-          found him to be totally devoted to his painting
> ing a new mysticism as well as a mastery of a           and his fa ith. He often combined the two intertechniq ue he had made his own, resulting               ests by transporting African Baha'is to a n area
> finally in those elusive and imaginative canvas-        where they could teach. Having performed this
> ses in which silvery tones meet and dissolve in         simple service Reg would then take out his
> closely-woven brushstrokes . . . At eighty-             brushes and paint until they returned from
> three , with his brushes stacked away, Reg Tur-         their mission. He spoke about the Baha'i Faith
> vey has at las t become a "coll ector's painter".'      only when someone showed a kee n interest. A
> T his last sentence was wishful thinking on          frie nd a nd benefactor relates: 'He explained
> the reviewer's part. To the e nd , Reg was              what his religion stands for, how he be lieves,
> admired by fe ll ow artists and informed critics,       what he believes, what it meant to him. It was
> but he was not recognized by the general                personal. He was so excited abo ut his pilgrimpublic. Many critics have tried to analyze the          age. He was in his seventies. He was happy . It
> reasons: 'Somehow, during his lifetime, Reg             gave him a new lease on life. In our fam il y he
> Turvey failed to receive the recognition which          was always classified as a saint who didn't
> his wo rk deserved. Perhaps it was because of           expect anything from the world ; we a lways
> an extraordinarily retiring nature and an               compared him with the tsadik of the Jewish
> ESSAYS AND REVIEWS                                           637
> 
> Untitled painting by Reginald Turvey
> 
> religion, one of the thirty-six righteous men in             exhibited them. For example , the painting in
> each generation whose holiness and humble                    oi ls inspired by the story ofTahirih was entitled
> blameless lives merit for the world the divine               by the exhibitor 'Rima' and thereafter Reg
> grace that prevents its destruction. ' And again:            always referred to the picture by that name.
> 'Reg is the nearest to a saintl y man I have ever            Only in rare cases did he date his paintings and
> known. The only two saintly men I remember                   then usually at the request of the owner or
> in my life are Reg and my father. When you                   buyer. It is from his few paintings that bear
> told me that he is called the Father of the                  dates that we are able to estimate the dates of
> Baha'is of South Africa, 1 I wouldn't have                   other works. Many of his paintings are
> thought of such a thing, but it sums it up abso-             unsigned. An even greater number would bear
> lutely, a sp iritual father.'                                no signature had I not, towards the end of his
> On several occasions I asked Reg what                     life, urged him to sign them . Reg was without
> influence the Baha'i Faith had on his life. He               ego. He was like the unknown craftsman writsaid it gave him contentment. His paintings                  ten of by Soetsu Yanagi, the philosopherreflect it.                                                  leader of the Japanese craft movement:
> Turvey's works are not sentimental and he                  ' Where does beauty lie if not in these qualalmost never painted Baha'i themes. He was                   ities?-the plain and unagitated , the uncalcunot strongly attached to his p aintings and                  lated , the harmless, the straightforward , the
> rarely gave them titles, leaving it to those who             natural, the innocent, the humble, the modest,
> the meek, the austere, the unornate; they are
> An appellation given to him by Shoghi Effendi during     the natural characteristics that gain man's
> Reginald Turvey's pilgrimage to the Holy Land in 1956;
> see 'In Memoriam', The Baha'i World , vol. XIV, pp.      affection and respect.' Turvey had these vir-
> 385-387.                                                 tues.
> 638                                      THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Even in physical pain Reg never com-                themes. The closest he came to social commenplained. When his painting hand was afflicted          tary was in a painting depicting a black a nd a
> with arthritis he did not mention it. When his         wh ite horse and an African family looking into
> firs t finger wo uld no longer function he held the    a typical South African veld landscape an ticibrush between his thumb and second finger;             pating a better tomorrow. 1
> later, his second fi nger and thumb also gave             Turvey' s versatility and technical fac ility are
> o ut . His last works, semi-abst ract with the ir      much acclaimed. Increasingly it is recognized
> thin silvery mosaic lines, were done with this         that in his work extend ing over a period of
> disability. But he did not finally give up until his   approximate ly six decades he forged a
> eyesight fa iled. When he could no longer paint        significant link between South African a nd
> or drive his car to provide transportation for         international art. In 1977 a professor of art at
> Baha'i teaching work he lost interest in life and      Witwatersrand University , Johannesburg
> entered a nursing home. His former wife,               analyzed Turvey's retrospective exhibitio n at
> members of the Baha'i community and other              the Gertrude Pose! Ga llery and hinted at the
> friends visited him as he faded grad uall y into       permanent importance of his work.
> the next world . He died on 2 March 1968 in               But the words of his oldest friend, Bernard
> Durban.                                                Leach , who knew him best, should close this
> His sa les to art gall eries during his lifetime    tribute to Reginald T urvey:
> were few: o ne to the Durban gallery in 1928              'All his life Reg went on trusting people. He
> a nd two to the National Gallery in Cape Town          never lost integrity, and bitterness never
> in 1964. Since his death all the majo r gall eries     showed in his face . Sadness, yes. T hat a man, so
> in South Africa have acquired his paintings. A         persistent an artist and so honest a painter,
> recent definitive history of art in So uth Africa      should be neglected until the last chapter of his
> devotes two full pages and two plates to him.          life when his painting years were over, has been
> The National Council for Human Sciences                a sorrow to me . It is hard to wait sixty years for
> Research , which publishes the Dictionary of           the assurance from the informed and percep-
> South African Biography, the South African             tive that all those years of search were not
> Who's Who, has since 1978 included a two-               meaningless . It implies great modesty and
> page su mm ary of his life.                            steadfast loyalty to an inner vocation.' 2
> Turvey's pai ntin gs do not reflect the time in
> ' Owned by Phillip Hinton, Sydney, Australi a.
> which he lived. A lthough he was fully aware of        2
> Beyond East and West, Bernard Leach, Fabe r a nd Faber,
> the problems of society he did not use them as           Londo n and Boston, p. 291.
> VERSE                                                 639
> 
> II
> 
> VERSE
> LINES FROM PERSIAN POETS
> 
> BY MARZIEH GAIL
> 
> From Nli#r-i-Khusraw                                        I here appea l
> Against both heart and eyes,
> The mischief's thine , if I may have my say,                For what the eye doth see
> And o nl y terror hushes my lament.                         The heart doth prize.
> Thou criest to the hunted deer, 'Away! '                    Thus it seems good to me
> T hen loosest the swift hound upo n his sce nt.             To make a dagger with a tip of steel-
> And why hast Thou-I ask it by T hy leave-                   And with it blind my eyes,
> A woman's lips and teeth such bea uty lent?                 And set my sad hea rt free.
> If Thou, 0 Lord, hadst no thing up Thy sleeve,
> By fas hioning the Devil what was meant?
> 
> From Sana'{
> Na~ ir was show ing
> Of reaso n no sign;                                    If to the foo l my lore you' d bring,
> Straying and drunken                                   Or think my secrets ca n be told
> (Not like drinkers of wine)-                           To him who is not wise-
> And he came to a graveya rd                            Then to th e deaf go harp and sing,
> Beside a latrine,                                      Or stand before th e blind and hold
> And he shouted: 'Ye people                             A mirror to his eyes.
> Who gaze on th is sce ne,
> See the feasts of thi s wo rld ,
> And the people th at dine!
> Here: the feasts of this world,
> Here: the gues ts come to dine!'
> How can feeble reason encompass th e Qur'an,
> Or the spi der snare a phoenix in his web?
> Wouldst thou th at the mind should not entrap thee?
> Teach it the science of the love of God!
> From Shay!!J 'Abdu'lltih An$1iri
> 
> Ca nst thou on water walk, aga inst the law?
> So can a straw.
> Canst rise up in the air so high?
> So ca n a fly .                                      From Sa'di
> If thou wouldst play a re al man's part ,
> Subdue thy heart.                                    It is all one, if it be a throne
> Or the ba re gro und under the open sky,
> Where the pure so ul lays him
> Down to die.
> 
> From Babli 'rlihir                                            The Gulistan, 'O n th e Conduct of Kings'
> 
> Let me quit this abode.
> Let me rise, let me go
> Past th e Antipode,
> Past Indo-Chin a, where the ways extend ;
> I do as bidden, and I bring the message,
> And let me ask the pilgrims on the road:
> Whether it give thee counsel or offense.
> Is my way farther, or is this the end?
> 640                                              THE BAHA'I WOR LD
> 
> Tell us not th e ta le of Layli or of Majniin's 1 woe-                Since God Himself is never to be see n,
> Thy love hath made the world forget th e loves of lo ng               These Messengers a re but His go-between.
> ago .                                                               Nay-I misspoke,
> When once T hy name was o n th e to ngue, the lovers                  For He Who's deputi zed
> ca ught it                                                          Is one with Him th a t se nt Him ,
> A nd it se t th e speakers and the hea rers danci ng to               If we be we ll apprised.
> and fro .
> 
> Our desert has no end, o ur heart no bed .
> The sto ry of T hy bea uty reached the hermit' s de ll ;           World with in wo rl d is with Form's image sea led;
> Crazed , he so ught the Tavern whe re the win e they               W hich of the im ages to us is wed?
> buy and se ll .                                                  If on the road ye see a seve red head,
> The love of T hee hath leve led dow n the fort o f                 Rolling alo ng its way to o ur wide fi e ld,
> patience,                                                        Ask it, 0 ask it wh at we neve r sa id,
> The pain of T hee hath firmly barred the ga te o f hope            And hea r from it the secret we concealed .
> as well.
> 
> T he fl ower-faced may sulk or pl ay th e flirt ,
> From Jalti/u ' d-Di11 -i-R1imi                                       The cruel fa ir may bridle and coquet;
> But coyness in the ugly is ill- met ,
> At one time , Baha' u' llah had written down an ode               And pain in a blind eye's a double hurt.
> of Riimf' s for him (Ustad Isma'fl) and had told him to                                    T he Maf.hnavf, ! , 1906-7.
> turn his face toward the Bab and sin g the wo rd s, set
> to a melody: (See Memorials of the Faithful , by
> 'Abdu ' l-B ah:l , p. 29)
> 
> I a m lost, 0 Love, possessed and dazed ,
> Thou, broth e r, art th y thought alone,
> Love's foo l am I, in all the earth.
> T he rest is only thew and bone.
> T hey call me fi rst among the crazed,
> A garde n close, if th at thought be a rose
> Though I once came first fo r wit and worth .
> But if it be a thorn , th e n o nl y fit to burn .
> 0 Love, who sellest me this win e,'                                                     The Maf.hnav{, If, 2:277
> 0 Love, for whom I burn and bleed,
> Love, for whom I cry and pine-
> Thou the Piper, I the reed.
> 
> If Thou wishest me to live ,
> T hrough me blow Thy ho ly breath.                              The Sage of G hazna 3 to ld the mystic story
> The touch of Jesus Thou wilt give                               To his vei led hearers, in an all egory :
> To me , who 've lain an age in dea th.                          If those who err see naught in the Qur'an
> But onl y words , it's not to wonder on;
> Thou, both E nd and Origin ,                                    Of all the sun's fire , lighting up the sky
> T hou without and Thou within-                                  Only the wa rmth ca n reach a blind man' s eye.
> Fro m eve ry eye Thou hidest well ,                                                   The Ma!.!:J.navf, lll, 4229-3 1.
> A nd ye t in every eye dost dwe ll.
> 
> ' Literally, Majnun me ans ' insane'. T his is the title of the
> In thy so ul of love build thou a fire
> celebrated lover of ancient Persian and Arabian lore,                  A nd burn all thoughts a nd words entire .
> whose beloved was Laylf, daughter of an Arabian prince.
> Symbolizing true hum an love bordering on the divine, the
> story has been made the theme of many Persian romantic
> poems.
> This wine, Rumi says elsewhere, comes from the ja r of               If I speak fo rth , many a mind will shatter,
> 'Yea verily.' That is, it symbolizes the Primal Cove nant
> established between God and man on the day of' Am I not
> A nd if I wri te, many a pen will break
> your Lord?' On that day, the Creator summoned posterity
> out of the loins of Adam and said to the generati ons
> unbo rn,' Am I not yo ur Lord?' Whereupon the y answe red,
> 'Yea, verily, Thou art .' Cf. Qur'an 7: 171.                    ' The poet Sana'i.
> VERSE                                              641
> From lftifii                                              From Ttihirih
> 
> There'll be no end to lon ging till I find my hea rt' s       If mine eyes co uld ever see T hee,
> desire                                                     Light o n brow and lips a nd cheek,
> E ither I'll win my ow n Heart's Life or lose my life         I would te ll Thee of my yearn ingentire.                                                    Of Jove's lon ging I would speak .
> But thi s I know , th ough I be dead, my body will burn
> on:
> Open my grave wh en I am gone                                 From house to house, a nd door to door
> And see my shroud on fire .                                   Lonely as the wind I go,
> Past every lane and every turning,
> Ever do Thy prese nce seek .
> 
> To our King though we bow the knee ,
> We are lo rds of the morning star.                     Neve r think it's tears I'm shedd in g
> No changeable colors have we-                          Since our separation-no,
> Red lions, black dragons we are!                       Like a raging river burnin g,
> Lifeblood 's slippin g down my cheek.
> 
> Of Thy love my sad hea rt weaves
> Come Jet us scatter these roses,                   My soul' s fabric , to a nd fr o.
> Let us pour out this wine ,                        Through the warp and we ft re turning ,
> Let us split the roof of Heaven                    Shuttled strands thi s Jove bespeak.
> And draw a new design.
> 
> Within her soul gazed Tahirih ,
> The chambers of her hea rt to know;
> How shall a curtain pa rt the lover and th e loved one?       Through eve ry mem brane Thee discerning,
> No t AJ"exander's wall ca n separate the m!                   No ne other in the wo rld co uld seek.
> 
> Notes on the poets
> 
> Nti$ir-i-Khusraw                                          Babti Tahir
> Na~ir-i-Khusraw was a celebrated poet ,                   Baba Tahir, called ' Uryan (The Naked),
> traveller and Isma'fli missionary. A native of            saintly dialect poet of Hamadan , was a famed
> Khurasan, he was born in 1003-04 and died in              writer of quatrains . Little is known of his life
> 1088. He was called by his fellow-religionists            but the name 'Uryan suggests that he was a
> I:Jujjat (The Proof) .                                    wandering dervish ; he apparently still
> flourished in 1055-58. He is most famous for
> Shayf0 'Abdu'lltih An$tiri                                his double distichs, exhibiting in melodious and
> flowing language a sincerity and spirituality
> Shaykh 'Abdu'llah An~arf of Harat was born
> with profound philosophical overtones.
> at Kuhandiz on 4 May 1005 and died on 8
> March 1089. His biographers are una nimous in
> Santi'i
> praising his piety and the breadth of his knowledge in all branches of the religious sciences.            Sana'f was the pen name of Abu'l-Majd
> He expressed his devotion in the Munajat                  Majdud who was born circa 1050 in Ghaznf,
> (prayers or supplications, highly stylize d a nd          now a province of Afghanistan; he died in
> epigrammatic) and other writings in saj'                  1131. He is considered by some to be the
> (rhymed prose) as well as in verse which are              author of the first great mystical poem in the
> considered to be among the masterpieces of                Persian language and his verse has greatly
> Persian literature .                                      influenced Persian literature. As a young man
> 642                                        THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> he was poet at the court of the G haznavid               and famo us of Persian lyric poets. His principal
> sultans but at some point he underwent a                 verse form, one that he brought to a perfection
> spiritual conversion a nd , abandoning the               neve r achieved before, was the ghaza l, a lyric
> court, re tired to pursue a contemplative life.          poem of six to fifteen couplets linked by unit y
> The Enclosed Garden of Truth, o ne of his best           of subj ect and symbolism rather than by a logical
> known works, is composed of 10,000 couplets              sequence of ideas. His achievement was to give
> in ten separa te section s.                              existing poetic convention s and motifs a fre shness and subtlety free fr o m ar tificial virtuosity.
> Sa'di                                                    His poetry is above all characterized by love of
> humanity, contempt for hypocrisy a nd med ioc-
> Sa'df, a lso known as Mu~ li9u 'd -Dfn Sa'df,
> rity, and an ability to unive rsalise eve ryday
> was born in Shiraz circa 1213 and died in th at
> experie nce and to relate it to the mystic's
> city o n 9 December 1292. Foll owing the Monunending sea rch for union with God.
> gol invasion of Persia he wandered abroad
> through A nato lia, Syria , Egypt and ' Iraq . One
> of the greatest figures in cl ass ical Persian litera-
> Ttihirih
> ture, the peculiar blend of human kindness a nd
> cynicism, humour and resignation displayed in               Tahirih, impass ioned follower of the Bab
> his work make him, to many , the most typical            and Baha'u' ll ah, was the daughter of a lea ding
> and lovable writer in the world of Iranian cul-          mujtahid of Qazvfn, and was ca lled by her
> ture.                                                    mentor, Siyyid Ka'.?im , 'Solace of the Eyes'
> (Qurratu' l-'Ayn). She was the o nl y woman
> Rumi                                                     a mong the Bab's first d isciples, the Eighteen
> Letters of the Living. Famed for her beauty ,
> Jalalu'd-Dfn-i-Rumf lived much of his life in
> poetic gifts and scho larship, she attracted many
> Rum (Asia Mino r). Persia's greatest ~uff mysso uls to Persia's new Faith . A fearless advotic poet, his Ma!h_navf (rhymed couplets o n
> cate of sex equality, she was put to deat h in
> spiritual themes) has been called ' the Persian
> Tihran at the age of thirty-six, a nd became the
> Qur'an.' His spiritual director was the poet
> first woman suffrage martyr (August 1852).
> Shams-i-Tabrfzf ( d. 1246) in whose memory he
> wrote so me 30,000 verses ex pressing deep love
> for his master. Born at Balkh , in the autumn of
> 1207, Rumf died in 1273 and was buried at
> Qonya.
> Roger White
> 
> lfafii                                                   Sources: E.G. Browne, A Literary History of Persia, II , s.v.;
> Encyclopaedia Britannica; £11cyc/opaedia of Islam; Nabfl-i-
> Mu9ammad-S hams u' d-Dfn f:lafi'.? (born               A'~am, The Daw11-Breakers; Shoghi Effendi , God Passes
> 1325-26, died 1389-90) , is the most eminent             By .
> VERSE                             643
> Farewell
> (To 'Abdu ' l-Baha)
> by Lua Getsinger'
> 
> Accompany me in this journey, 0 my Lord ,
> that my impatie nt hea rt may not be shatt ered by sorrow.
> 
> I have le ft the wo rld fo r th e sake of Thy good-pleasure;
> if Thou acce pteth my li fe as a sacrifice ,
> it wi ll be my honour.
> 
> I tread this path by myself,
> yet I yearn to be hold T hee a t my sid e .
> 
> In thi s world, th e rea lm of sin and the feast of so rrow,
> I have no refuge save Thee.
> 
> 0 faithful Friend, do not forsake me :
> behold how my days pass in solitude!
> 
> In leaving Thee, I leave my hea rt and soul ;
> Thou art my purpose a nd Thy re membrance is my so lace .
> 
> Thy Word has ever been the living water and the so urce of all mercy
> fo r this bewildered hea rt of min e .
> 
> Do not stay afar fro m this se rvant of Thy Threshold.
> This is my ple a ; fu lfi l it, 0 my Lord!
> 
> I am not deserving of Thy bestowals;
> neve rtheless, I am T hy serva nt and Thou art my Lord.
> 
> Look Thou upon me with th e eyes of Thy mercy
> and witness with compassion my waywardness a nd he lplessness.
> 
> Hear Thou with the ea rs of Thy favour, 0 my Lord,
> this supplication, this imp lo ring of my morns a nd eves.
> 
> Thou art my refuge and my succo urer wherever I may go
> In my solitude,
> in my lo ne lin ess,
> in my distress.
> (Translation by Mahntiz Afititunt)
> 
> ' Re-translated from the Persian of Dr. Yunis Khan. The
> origin al English text is not available. See 'Abdu'l-Baht! by
> H. M. Balyuzi, pp. 96-97 (passim); and Th e Flam e-The
> Story of Lua by Willi am Sears and Robert Quigley; publications of George Ronald (Oxford).
> 644                                          THE BAHA'I WORLD
> 
> Le Signe de Dieu                             Toi qui attend s qu ' II te fasse sign e,
> R ega rde ou le Soleil se leve
> II etait un je une hom me                            II te fera le rencontrer
> Qui parlait d'amour , de justice.                    Ce lui qui dit la Verite.
> II etait beau, e t so n regard
> Avait le feu qui brGle l'ame.                        Aux po rtes de la liberte
> C'es t Lui qui brisera les chaines
> Le signe de Dieu, disaient les uns,                  Qui te retiennent pri so nnier
> II fa ut qu'il me ure, disaient les autres.          De ton enfa nce , de ton passe.
> 
> C'etai t un beau jeune homme.                        Tourne les ye ux vers le Soleil
> C'est a l'est qu' II se leve,
> II ai mai t tant ses freres                          En E la m, com me ii es t dit
> Qu'il partit leur donner                             Dans les Livres du Paradis.
> La parole de Dieu
> M. Lafaille (Belgium)
> Quiles re ndra it he ureux.
> 
> Le Signe de Dieu, disaient les un s,
> II fa ut qu' il meure , disaient les autres.
> 
> C'etait un beau jeune homme .
> 
> Partout sur so n passage                              De ge ns de toutes hum e urs
> Jaillissaient !'amour et la hain e                    Se retrouve nt dans la no irceur
> Mais Bab e tait un sage                               du contact et de la connaissance.
> II co nnaissait deja sa peine                         Chacun venant du droit chemin,
> le ur but devient la bienfaisance .
> Le signe de Dieu, disaient les uns.
> II faut qu ' il meure, disaient les autres.                              2
> Chercha nt a trouver la Verite
> II accomplissa it son destin                          il s font reco urs a leur parole
> D'eveiller le coeur des hommes                        puis, harmo nisan t leurs destins
> A ux rayons de l'astre divin :                        ils developpent e nfin l'am itie.
> C'e tait un beau je une ho mm e.
> II allait dans la lumi ere                            La nuit devient jour,
> Annoncer le jour no uvea u,                           la joie circule a uto ur.
> II portait ha ut la banniere                          Chacun tend la main
> Qui le conduisait au tom beau.                        remplie de Bonheur
> puis le porte a un autre coeur.
> Le signe de Dieu, disaient les uns ,
> II faut qu'il meure, di sa ie nt les autres                               4
> Le so leil se !eve
> Et les autres furent les plus forts,                  en ces nouvea ux visages
> Mais les uns surent qu'a jamais                       puis, en ce nouvel in stant
> II vivait pour l'ete rnite                            l' hive r cede pl ace a u printemps.
> Dans le coeur de tous les hommes.
> Pa1rick Gorman (Canada)
> C'etait un beau jeune hom me .
> M. Lafai//e (Belgium)
> 
> Tourne Jes yeux vers le Soleil
> Devant moi
> 0 toi qui cherches et qui appelles                   repose ce visage
> Toi qui as so if de Verite ,                         jo uissa nt de toutes joies
> Tourn e les yeux vers le Sole il                     formant ce fa me ux paysage.
> Et va sans te retourner.
> Laisse la po ussiere de ton vetement                 L' harm o nie de sa voix
> Loin derriere toi , aux ignora nts,                  balladant au gre du vent
> Tourne les ye ux vers le Soleil                      eclaire mon chez-moi
> Sans te lasser va de !'avant.                        en cette approche du printemps.
> VERSE                                                       645
> 
> 3                                                             4
> L'amitie par sa prese nce                                      Le chagrin e n mes soupirs
> le so urire de so n appa rence                                 !ors de ses adie ux
> stimul e mes pensees                                           l'ecl at de ses ye ux
> en ces moments si gais.                                        e n form era mon so uve nir.
> Patrick Gorman (Canada)
> 
> -La perso nn e hum a ine ve ut s'e panouir et e pano uir !es autres, ii
> fa ut e n prendre soin et bien la traite r.
> 
> -L'a miti e des humains e n forme leurs epan o ui sse me nts.
> A idons ceux dan s la misere et dan s la pa uvrete. Biitissons
> un no uvea u mo nd e.
> 
> - Une pe rso nn e humain e est cent mill e fo is pl us bell e
> qu ' un e rose. Si nous adorons Jes roses, pourqu oi
> detruison s-nous la perso nne.
> Pa1rick Gorman (Canada)
> 
> Bjc:elker I Br0dres 0jne 1                          D e er det pureste so m find es,
> fordi-
> Der find es venskaber i verden ,
> og hvilke venskabe r!                                   De bygge r pi hj e rterne s frell es rytm e !
> De bygge r pi hjerte rnes fre ll es rytme.
> Kommer der kl udd er i rytmen,                          D e har sa mkl ang i e t alto mfatte nd e mi\!!
> si h -- !
> De bygger pi kre rli ghede n!
> Der find es venskaber i partier,
> og hvil ke venska ber!                                  Men st0rst af alt-
> De har sa mkl ang i et mi\!.                            sa mmen ren ses og vederkvreges vi
> V i ska! vinde vor kamp!                                i Baha' u' ll ah s Ords Ocean .
> 
> Men ni\r kampen er vunde t                              Men, besm ittes dette va nd
> eller mi\ske-tabt,                                      af stoltheden s, se lvretfrerdighedens og egoe ts
> sa h - - !                                              gift ,
> si h- - s i  smertes Den Ve lsignede Sk0nne
> Der findes venskaber i familier ,                       og Hans Sag forb l0der
> og hvilke venskaber'                                    mens vi med balsam i hand uvirksomme se r pi .
> De bygge r pi krerlighed,
> men dens vresen er fl yg tigt                           D er find es et ve nskab i ve rdne rn e,
> og beh0ver en omsorgsfuld plej e.                       og hvilket venskab!
> Hvis plej en ogsi e r flygti g,
> si h- - !                                              'A bdu ' l- Bahas!
> 
> Der finde s ve nskaber i verden ,                       E r du svigtet, forri\dt og si re t?
> og hvilke venska ber!                                   H ans e kse mpe l e r G uds he lbredende kraft.
> 'Reprinted from Baha'i Nyhedsbrev, No. 12, Nov. 1978.                                 Steffen Rasmussen, Denma rk
> 646                                      T H E B AHA'I W ORLD
> 
> E in er ka n                                           e ii mare da nza
> de n e ure Blicke                                      di ora in o ra .
> ni cht sa he n                                         E l' uomo?
> in de r Dii rnrne rung                                 L' uomo ti ignora!
> des erste n T ages
> Maria Cervoni (Ita ly)
> E R kam
> vo n nirge ndwo
> un d imm e r
> un d ga b e uch
> se in e Wo rte                                           Le hera ut
> in die H and
> G loire et maj este ,
> Spate r gin ger                           Gra nde ur et Saintete,
> wisse nd                                  Te l es t le Hera ut de !'E re No uve ll e,
> um Ye rstand ni s                         Te l es t not re Heraut so lennel.
> manche r
> Gra nde ur in comparable,
> I h r muBt je tzt                         Co ura ge inl assa ble,
> T el es t le He raut de !'E re No uve ll e ,
> e rh ebe n e ure                          Te l est notre Hera ut so le nn el.
> Stimm e n
> und ii ffn e n                            Ou est sa grande ur?
> di e Fa uste                              Ou est sa gloire?
> e ure r He rze n                          Pa rmi no us po ur vo ir
> E t dans un coin d u coe ur.
> Gerald Jatzek, Ger111 a11y
> Precurse ur de la Fo i Baha' fe,
> Ma rtyre des ire po ur le Pro rnis,
> Porte de la Bon ne No uve ll e,
> Votre Gra nde ur est imm orte ll e .
> So rinnt d ie Ze it
> den Stro m hinab.                              Chiraz, vill e Be nie pa r Sa naissa nce,
> De r Que ll ist we it                          Tab riz, vill e Be ni e pa r So n ma rtyre ,
> und na h das G ra b,                           T o ut !' Ira n e n souffrance
> doch nahe r E r, de r all es len kt                Fut sa uve q uand ii vin t dire:
> und in un s lebt und liebt un d de nkt.
> Je suis le Precurseur, ecoutez-moi,
> Das ist de r Sinn                                Priez Dieu et ayez Jo i.
> de r E rde nze it:                            Q ue de so uffra nce ap res Sa declara tio n,
> vo n T ra umbeginn                            E t to ut !'Ira n fut e n revo lution.
> zu E wigke it.
> Ei n A te mzug vo ll Leid un d G liick             Ses pas on t ben i !' Iran,
> - und so d urch Ihn zu Ihm zuriick.                Que de baise rs do nn ere nt,
> Q ue de ple urs verse re nt
> Ein A temzug                                 Les Lettres d u Yiva nt.
> allhie r zu zwe in
> zugleich de r Flug                           Que l martyre ! Q ue l malhe ur !
> zu ne ue m Sein .                            Que ll e actio n sa ns honn eur !
> Was hier sich e int in Geist und Ta t,              A rretez m a/h eureux, arretez,
> bl eibt ewig eins, mein Ka mera d .                 Ne tirez pas sans penser.
> Adelbert Muh/sch legel, Greece
> Le pe upl e parl ait avec e mphase.
> Q ui osa it pro nonce r cette ph rase?
> Qui po uvait murmure r cette pe nsee?
> Aucun n'avait de liberte,
> II canto degli inconsape voli                     Personn e ne po uva it a rre ter
> Les ball es de Tabriz
> La te rra dice de ll a                    Sans e tre prise.
> tu a es iste nza                          Pe rsonne ne po uva it ge mir
> ii sol e spl e nde                        Deva nt un di sciple martyrise.
> la tu a luce d'o ro
> T o us all aie nt mo urir.
> le stelle cantan
> tutte in a rmonia                            Mahboubeh Hielscher- Ma her (Switzerland)
> VERSE                                                        647
> Epopee tragique du XIXe siecl e                            This stately temple, rightl y held
> In hi gh esteem
> ( extrait)                                      By all of those who come to view
> The tranquil scene-
> II quitta Baghdad, la vi lle merve ill e
> U nto uch ecl by cares with which the ea rth abo unds--
> qui vit l'aurored u num e n ce lestial
> s'o uvrir sur le Temps des te mps,
> Is cleclicatecl to a Ca use,
> de no uvea u l'ex il du Ross ignol e n fl a mm es
> A heave nl y sc he me
> a pein e a vait-il com me nce a e nto nn e r                         To bring mankind into one Faith,
> o h! l' extraorcl in aire Me lodie Divin e,
> Wh e re reigns supreme
> (parclonne Parole e nchanteresse que Son no m
> T he Lord of a ll , and King of wo rld s re nowned.
> mu sica l tu ne peux transcrire ,
> a uc un e cith are ni de Rumi) ni de l:lafiz                                            Adrienne Morgan (Chad)
> jamais ne reussiront la note in concevab le!)) ))
> et le Cent re du moncle se mit en marche
> de par le de sert, la caravane , sur le C heva l blanc,
> de par les montagnes turquoises .                                                     The Sfyah-Chal
> que de pleurs derriere quelle clouleur le moncle
> le Tigre e nfa nt a ce clesastre et le cri                           0 dreaded place! Shame a nd ignominy be th y lot!
> les roses fani: re nt parfum clechu pour toujours                      The cries of anguished me n have filled thine ears;
> (Hommes hommes vo us comprenclrez plu s ta rcl ,                       Their curses burned th y na me in dying te a rs
> retenez: la Sa inte Beaule Be ni e Universelle                       On Hi story's shi eld-a blood-sca rred spot!
> passa si pres, sur ces rives , si pres e t par la !)
> Pa rmi les dunes clorees se parse mere nt les pas                    Th y filth y walls a nd fet id brea th ,
> de Gloire cl'ou revo lutionnaient les siecles des siecles              Kn ew not th e G lo ry in their mid st ;
> terre consacree espace eternise temps imm o rta li se !                Thou didst no t see th e heave nly gleam
> Jean -Christophe Casu (Zai're)               Shine through thy stygia n mi st;
> Nor did th e chai n and co ll ar rud e
> Restrain Hi s glory midst thy brood.
> 
> Vision'                     Those chain s stayed not the mighty flood
> Of truth which filled that dungeon hold ,
> Are yo u then one to whom I dare relate                   As men hea rd no t from Ca lvary's Cross
> The grea t white dreams that beat upon my sig ht ? The sacred love fo retold!
> Have yo u been lifted high above the night          But by Hi s Self a nd by His Pen
> With its dim sta rs, to the fair shinin g gate            Has He regained the hea rts of me n.
> Of dawn; beheld the sombre face of Fate
> In its ete rnal beauty ; and been free             0 ha teful pl ace ! Shame a nd de feat shall be thy lot!
> From the world's long hea rtache a nd its misery    Whi le joyous sounds shall Ca rm el raise!
> Of fear , despair, of weari ness, a nd hate?              Kings bow clown a nd cha nt He r Pra ise,
> You a nswer not, a nd all unheed ing go             And Victory wipe away th y blo t.
> Along the highway. I may neve r know
> Eric S. C Bowes (Australia)
> If yo u have rid den o n the wings of light-
> But as yo u pass, yo ur face is very bright,
> As if, in th e clear mirrors of yo ur eyes
> Were caug ht so me straying gleams of paradise.
> I saw ideal beauty o nce.
> Garrern H. Busey (U.S.A.)            You didn't have to paste it toge the r
> From gnarled trees a nd nimbu s ski es
> Forged out of im age and mood .
> African Temple                         Nature is wi ld a nd untuto red
> And deli vers secrets of the d ivin e
> Set hi gh upo n Kikaaya Hill                     In variant degrees of perfection
> You'll find a queen;
> H er sk irts adorned with diverse flowers,                  On ly this was perfect.
> H e r crow n of green                                       As blue as you could have wished,
> Is visible for many miles around.                           As many co lo ured and irriclescent
> As yo u had a right to ex pect.
> The beauty of her grace a nd fo rm ,                        Id ea l because the Spirit of God
> The luminous sheen                                          Breathed into th e mind
> Of moo nligh t shining on her head                          Of one who knew th e bea uty of the Ages,
> Is lik e a clream-                                          And he bodied beauty forth ,
> A sacred vision hallowing the gro und .                     Pure and restrained,
> Ca lm a nd a t peace, balm to the eye
> Reprinted from Star of the West , vol. 13, No. 7, Oct. 1922 .     And bo unteous help to th e half-beli eving heart,
> 648                                                THE BAHA'i WORLD
> 
> Say ing: ' You asked for a proo f:                            T ha t groa nin g. Man with hi s bell y slashed,
> Here is Bea ut y, aro un d it                                 two-timin g love r. Dying?
> T he still g rea t ocean Truth -                              The nightnurse ru st les by.
> Blessed are th ose who never co me                            St rugg les in th e pit. I have come back
> But st ill be li eve .'                                       to te ll th ee of strugg les in the pit.
> Pe rhaps is dy in g.
> C eofji"ey P. Nash (Unit ed Kingdom)
> Free o f pain , my ow n dea th st ill
> a theo re m to be proved.
> A ll {t h' u' Ab ha. 0 Hea ling Spirit,
> Thy nea rn ess o ur fo rgivi ng cure.
> Too lo ng have I as ked
> Th e me rcha nt of ru bies                                                                     Robert Ha y den (U.S.A.)
> About the price of stra w,
> With my eyes a bout my feet so lo ng
> And the stubbl e brea kin g my sa ndal.
> There is no law
> Aga in st wa iting a t th e blu e a rchway                                   The Year of the Child 1
> A nd ask in g all I wish.                                                          (for my g ran dso n)
> I will pri ce the pale ruby
> A nd th e red , a nd more-fo r He who kn ows                                   And you have come,
> This subtl e sto ne will know                                               Michael A hman , to share
> T he leap of ligh t in o th e rs,                                              yo ur life with us.
> T heir sizes, se ttings, circlets,                                          We have give n you
> New-fashi oned a nd o ld;                                                      a n a rcha ngel' s name-
> T heir st udded Ma li faces ,                                               a nd a great poet ' s;
> Yemen ite-gold ;                                                               we ho nor too
> Co ld -ivo ri ed inl ay; tu ske d ebo ny,                                   Abyss ini a n A hm a n,
> Sandal-sweet linin gs for t he se nses;                                        hero of peace .
> Di a mo nd-brow for testi ng true detac hm e nt;
> Vei n- pear led purity. He knows it.                                           May these na mes
> Such a me rcha nt knows we ll                                               be tali sma ns;
> The price of straw, feath e rs,                                                May th ey invoke divine
> T hin gs that fa ll easil y to ea rth ,                                     magic to protect
> A ll birth s, th e costs of livin g,                                           yo u, as we cannot,
> T he tas te of the sweet cup take n from our lips ,                         in a world that is
> T he cost of givi ng of a ruby,                                                no place for a child-
> And the cost of givin g
> a Book of Law.                                                                 tha t had no shelter
> for th e childre n in Guyana
> Audrie R eynolds (U11alak/ee1, Alaska)                            slain by hands
> th ey trusted ; no succo r
> fo r th e Biafran
> child with swollen bell y
> The Broken D ark 1                                               a nd empty beggi ng-bow l;
> no refuge for the child
> Sleep less, I sta re                                                        of th e Warsaw ghe tto.
> from th e dark hosp ital roo m
> at shadow s of a flo we r a nd its leaves                                  Wh a t we yea rn ed
> t he ni ghtlight fixe s like a blotto                                    but were powerless to do
> o n th e corr idor wall. Shadow-plays                                      for t hem, o h we
> of Bali -demo ns move to th e left ,                                     will dare, Mich ael, for yo u,
> gods , in their fr ang ipan i crow ns                                      knowing o ur need
> and go ld, to t he ri ght.                                               of unea rn ed increments
> Ah and my life                                                             of grace.
> in th e shadow of God 's laser lightshadow of deformed ho mun culus?                                           I look into yo ur
> A foo l's e rrand give n by foo ls.                                      brilliant eyes, whose gaze
> So n, go fe tch a pint of pi geo n's milk                                  re news, transforms
> fro m t he drugstore a nd be qui ck.                                     each common thing, a nd hope
> De mon s o n the left. Death o n e ithe r side,                            that inner vision
> the Rabbi sa id , the way of li fe be twee n.                            will inte ns,ify
> their see ing. I a m
> ' The Broke n Dark' is reprinted from Angle of Ascent, New
> and Selected Poe ms, by Ro be rt Hayde n, with th e pe rmis-       Reprinted from World Order , Vol. 13, No. 4, Spring 1979.
> sion of Live ri ght Publishing Corpo rati o n. Copyri ght ©        Copyright © 1980 by the National Spiritual Asse mb ly of
> 1975 , 1972 , 1970, 1966, by Robert Hayde n.                      th e Baha'fs of the Un ited Sta tes.
> VERSE                                                       649
> co nte nt mea nwhil e to have                           Now he, ret urnin g after many yea rs
> yo u gla nce at me                                   sta nds o n t he massive sto nes
> so metimes , as t ho ugh , if yo u                      with pale mist sw irling
> co uld ta lk, yo u'd le t                            a nd so unds o f the no rth ern ri ver
> us in o n a subtle joke.                                co ntinu o usly fa lling
> in the pu re a ir,
> May Huck a nd J im                                  cries o ut t he Na me he'd new ly learned,
> a tte nd yo u. May yo u wa lk                           Baha'u'//ah' Baha'u'llah!
> with bea uty befo re yo u,                          hea ri ng his echoi ng voice
> bea uty be hind yo u, all                               repeated in the deep rav in e,
> aro un d yo u a nd                                   Baha'u'llah-
> Th e Most G reat Bea uty kee p                                           Baha 'u'llah .
> you Hi s co nce rn.
> Larry Rawdon (Canada)
> Robert Hayden ( U.S.A.)                               No . 5 in th e seri es, 'Ot he r Fa ces.'
> 
> The Coven ant- Keepers
> (A Vespe r Song)                                           SONG CYCLE
> W he n all is go ne but a n awesome light
> Th a t shows th e sun was he re,
> Wh o li ghts th e la nte rn s in th e night
> By o ur very li ving , we praise
> To wa rd away th e fea r?
> Yo ur ha ndiwo rk , a nd circl e
> Who chase d th e fire whil e the timi d hid
> In Yo ur da nce,
> A nd wished th e wa rmth was go ne?
> To eyes acc ursed with heavy lids
> For at Yo ur be hest bu ds pa rt
> The e mbers te ll of daw n.
> T heir in fa nt fi sts, trees surge th ro ugh
> R. Gregory Shaw (Puerto Rico )        The fou ntaini ng earth a nd res t;
> 
> D oves nest cl ose
> A nd fl ed glin gs gape with confi de nce;
> Ninth Morning                             Ski n sli des, fur hack ling
> 
> It was th e ni nt h mo rnin g                         Ove r sho ulde r- blade ,
> sin ce he'd le ft th e city,                          Mu scl es co ntract a nd stre tch,
> each day rea li zing                                  U nthinking skill places each step;
> th e re was so me thin g
> mo re th a n ge ntle                                  As blood o r d ust we cha nt a desca nt
> in th e sple nd o rous bea uty                        To Yo ur so ng, and wit h eve ry ca ress of created
> of a dyin g a utu mn ,                                   things
> dying so pea cefull y,                                P raye r to uches praye r, by blessin g, blessed.
> so gracefull y
> in a natural way,                                                                   ii
> decayi ng a nd resto ri ng
> wh at was tak en fr o m th e ea rth -                 In spite o f ev id e nce
> for a utumn seldo m ca me to city slum s.             Jn crea ti on ma ni fes t
> Wo ke the n to th e cold cl ean mo rning              I have fo rgo tte n Yo ur re me mb ra nce
> with fros t a mong the seed ing grasses ,
> lit no fire, having fas ted                           A nd have no remedy.
> a ll the previo us day ,                              Becalm ed , how can I move,
> le ft his pack against th e logs                      A nd seek a wind to save me?
> wa lkin g uphill all th e way
> alon g th e ri sing go rge                            Th e n J must
> to greet th e loo ming sun .                          Risk a te mpest
> W hich wo uld whip the sea
> The re was a tim e when he was yo un g
> his fa th e r's fa the r stoo d u po n the rocks      U ntil , e nrage d, rending my sa il s, it swa llows
> a bove th e plunging fa ll s,                         Me , a nd spues me fro m it s mo uth . More to ngue less
> called to the Spirit God fo r help.                   T han sto nes , my th roat so thirsty
> His peo pl e, t rave lling far
> had always k nown this pl ace                         I ca nn o t ask for d rin k, I am a wil de rn ess
> as o ne of peace and na med it                        A nd need Yo ur cry in me, lest I perish
> in the ir C ree, 'The point of dawn'.                 In th e midst of prayer, un bles t!
> 650                                        THE BAHA'f WORLD
> 
> iii                                  Thoughts on seeing a vision of
> 'Abdu'l-Baha'
> So, beat agai nst faithlessness,
> Die in a tantrum                                      Beyond the consciousness of dreams, I slept,
> As a fly against a windowpane                         A human body, coffined by fatigue,
> Away from heartbeat, and the circling blood,
> Beats without perceiving.                             Deeply alone with myself, and yet I went beyond
> A foetus, fo lded                                     The touch of friendly hands,
> Pink and privat.e in the womb                         And saw no mortal face.
> But as I stretched to wake
> Dares more upheaval,                                  it was as though
> Breaks forth like Jonah                               My who le self breathed ce lestia l verities.
> To embrace the sea-                                   I found no depth that was not deeper sti ll,
> No height that could be ca ll ed the peak of time,
> I'll sunder fears                                     No width that was not wider than the wide.
> Spread sails, quickening,                             Where had I drifted in the where of space?
> To grasp the hem of Your robe-                        Whose love had brought me certainty again?
> Through the tight wrapp ings of the days' swift pass-
> Your power's manifest, so's my deserving.             Then crystal clear-I kn ew!
> I'll trust Your mercy, then,                          My Lord had seen my need-no ch iding word!
> And, as I trust, be blessed.                          The total love of Baha' u' llah for all the world!
> Shirin Podger (Ausrralia)   He took-and shared with me.
> For one bright flash , unknowingly , yet known
> I had ascended with Him into Light.
> Florence Altass (United Kingdom)
> Best Provision
> I will take the Master with me where I go,
> Robed a nd sweet and shining.
> I will go where He bids me go
> And wear a silver lining.                                           Divine Alchemy
> 
> I will ta ke the Master with me where I go              May we be willing to receive
> And love where hatred's burning.                        His Spirit's chastening fire ,
> I will let His loving flow                              Exalting, quickening all within
> And kindle holy yearn in g.                             To spiritua l desire.
> 
> I will take the Master with me where I go               The mind's great wealth of attributes
> And go where He bids me go.                             In His alembic cast
> That they , refined and pure, may know
> I will take the Master with me where I go               True lowlin ess at last.
> And go with armies marching
> To where the blood runs thick and slow,                 The heart's emotions must pass through
> And kindle holy sea rching.                             God 's crucible within
> Ti ll they emerge as burnished go ld
> I will take the Master with me where I go,              Through love' s own discipline.
> Stern and sweet and daring,
> And learn what He bids me know                          Yet such distilled quintessence needs
> Of my brothers' saddened faring.                        Re-transmutation still
> That we, thus willing and empowered
> I will take the Master with me where I go               May do His holy will .
> And go where He bids me go.                                            Florence Altass (United Kingdom)
> 
> I will take the Master with me where I go
> For I have no way of seeing
> And I have no way to know
> Without my Master's Being.
> ' Miss A ltass met' Abdu' l-B aha in Edinburgh in 1913. Writ-
> I will take the Master with me where I go           ing of this in 1978 she said, 'I felt so unworthy and could
> And go where He bids me go.                         never reach the heights expected of me as a Baha'i. The
> gentle voice of ' Abdu'l-Baha still rings in my ears and His
> To His love I am fleeing.                           lovely blues eyes have followed me all my long life- now in
> my 95th year. Pardon this reference to myself-it is not to
> Bret Breneman (Japan)     my credit!'
> VERSE                                                          651
> 
> La Huerta, Cochimi Indian Village 1                                               An Irish Air2
> with the gent le                                     'Twas not some woman's yellow hair
> face of love                                               Did carefree hea rts of lads impair
> yo ur land receives us,                                 As she might ease were they to kiss.
> lays a path                                          A Beauty passed exceed ing this.
> beneath its tender ski n
> to ca tch our steps in,                                    'Twas not the envy of a lass
> draws our breath                                     Which drew each woman from her glass
> into its coo l swee t air                                  To test her worth by suitor's whim .
> and washes o ut                                         A Lover passed. They fo llowed Him.
> the sy ll ables of self
> then gives it back                                      'Twas not a young girl's la ughing ai r
> into o ur mouths                                     Which stopped the husb and on the stair
> to utter marvels:                                       To curse time's theft a nd death's rank haste.
> you are the orchard                                  A Cup was passed . He pa used to taste.
> of the joy of God,
> your blossoms                                           'Twas not swords glinting in the sun
> are the fragrant signs                                     Which mad dened every mother's son
> and your fruit is fi ll ed                              To prove the valorous blood e ngaged.
> with the treasured wi ne,                            They looked within where Battle raged.
> th e praise of ancient psalms
> sp rings from you r crystal tongue                      'Twas not a minstrel's tinkling air
> fresh and bold                                       Which called the childre n from the fa ir
> as the kiss of dawn .                          To caper gleefull y in the street
> That Life and Song should be so sweet.
> Ken Haley (Mexico)
> 'Twas not spring's leaf-sce nt on the breeze
> Which drew the o ld priest from his knees
> To wonder Whose light footfa ll brings
> Prayer is a globe of light                              Such glad renewal to all things.
> in the night.
> Praise be to God! He is                                 Through the half-light, tow ards the Dawn,
> my moment, and my love.                               Whose gleam ing sandal leads us on?
> 'Twas not some woman's ye llow hair
> Daniel Augur Reed (aged 5)
> Did lilting Irish hearts ensnare!
> St. John's, Antigua
> Roger White
> 
> Pilgrim Song
> Swift would I be, Lord, swift; on dancing feet
> Hastening would come, if ca lled , nor brook delay ,
> Gleefully come-tho ugh lone the perilous way
> And stern and starless- still would my step be fl eet;
> And singi ng would come a nd , with song, entreat
> Angels to cha rt my path. Though Thou might slay
> Me, still would I come a nd rejoicing stay
> Quick or faint or slain at T hy welcoming feet.
> Gifts would I bring-choice, my gifts, and ma ny-
> Laden with gifts, and laughing, would I come;
> Or pauperized come-ha nds cupped, bereft of any
> But hoarded hot tears- to stand befo re Thee, dum b.
> Swift would I be, Lord, if Thou wouldst but call-
> My aim, my hope, my home, my love, my all.
> Roger White
> 
> The poem pays tribute to the Hand of the Cause George
> ' One of the indigenous Local Spiritual Asse mblies in Mex-       Townshend who at the invitation of Shoghi Effendi gave
> ico, located forty-five miles northeast of E nsenada. The       God Passes By its title. Some will recognize the salute to
> name means 'orchard'.                                            two lines from 'September 1913' by W. B. Yeats.
> 652                     THE BAHA ' i WORLD
> 
> No
> The incidem described occurred in 1979 when a hostile
> mob entered the hom e of an old shepherd and his wife,
> Bahti'{s of a small village in iron , demanding under
> threat of dea th by fire that they reca111 their fa i1h.
> Th e poem is based on lhe husband's reply which
> turned th e mob away. On 19 May 1980 the old
> sheph erd was found dead, having been s/Oned lo
> dea th while len ding his flock . To reveal th e names
> al this lime m ight further endanger lives.
> 
> Yo u may have o ur li ves. It is no grea t feat
> To slay us, we are simpl y fl es h and bone .
> He re is my wife, my ch ild re n, our home ;
> He re too the kind lin g, there the ready fl a me.
> With yo ur contempt to fee d and fan the heat
> We wi ll qu ickly fall to ash a nd o ur name
> Soon va nish from the vi ll age . But to buy brea th
> With de ni a l wou ld be shabbie r death.
> Strike th e match, then , if th at is your desire.
> What sha ll we fear who know Undy in g Fi re?
> 
> II
> Make room in so me slim volume
> for his rustic wo rd s which
> unlik e the po litici an' s pious ex ho rtations
> did not grace
> the hea dlines of o ur tabloid day.
> No: it is litt le e no ugh to say
> but literature a nd legends will grow
> from thi s and our true , o ur o th e r history
> give it pl ace.
> Salute th e mystery:
> his No-e mpowe red to d is maydi sso lves o ur rese rvations
> to rese rve us heave n,
> survives to e rase
> the impude nt smirk fr o m Dea th 's
> irre leva nt face.
> Roger Whit e
> TABLET OF
> 'ABDU'L - BAHA
> Selections from the writings of 'Abdu 'I - Baha, no. 52
> NORWAY                                                                                             Lasse T horesen
> J = MM. ~ 50
> '            ,
> j ,. J J J J 3
> -
> j ,.     J tp
> 0 ser-vant of the One True God!         The Lord be praised,              the loved ones of
> 
> God are fo u nd in e            -      ve-ry land,          and are, o ne and all, neath the sha-dow
> 
> of the Tree      of Life   and un - der         the pro- tec-tion         of His good     pro-vidence.
> 
> His care      and lov -ing kind-ness           surge        e       - ven     as the e- t er-nal
> 
> bi! - lows of the sea,       and His ble - ssings          are con - tin - u - al - ly show -ered
> 
> ,---3----,
> 
> ḥJ a~Jl!btlJJ
> from His e - ter - nal      King - dom.            Ours        shdu ld be the pray-er          that His
> 
> i. ,,                        .-3--,         r-31                                   , 3-,                   ,3--,
> 
> ~~ ' &l J v11 J :J &J )&J1wFJJ J]&IO)J' 1 ḥJJ1JW
> '                                                         ~                 .
> bles-sings     may be vouch - safed in still       grea - ter a -          bund-ance          and ours
> and a great-er              mea - sure       of His di-vine as - s~tance.
> 
> One of        the great-est               of these means is the spi- rit of true fel-low-ship and loving com-
> 
> i-_ l1                ,-3-, r-3-,                                     r-3-. r-3-,                                         ..         C-~ r--;3----;
> ~ ~ ,, J J J J@J E F }                                                       J. ~ #J #1,fl· F ḥ } r r i JJ1H~1
> mun-ion a-mong the friends.                        Re-mem-ber the say-ing:                         'of all pi!- grim -ag- es             the
> 
> ,-3--,
> 
> great - est                   is
> 'in              w
> to re-lieve               the sor -                row- la
> &J."---'J\l....__,
> den heart. '
> 
> . . - -                                                            .                                r-3 I
> --
> I'        I
> ,
> I
> ,   .                  I
> 
> - -                                   - --                                                       -
> :;
> u
> -                                  -                   -
> .-. . _.o........__,,'-'
> Of         all pi! - grim- ag - es                           the great - est                     IS
> -ll         I
> 
> -                                        .           .-        I   I
> ~
> 
> v
> 
> -     -                ,
> -   -           -          =- -              ---- - -· --
> '-/r
> ~                                                          r                                                                   ~
> "                    A
> 
> u
> -
> e
> -   e
> O f all pl! - grim-ag- es
> r------3-----,
> ~
> e
> 
> -u"
> I
> 
> - .                  .-    I
> .           .                                 ~
> 
> ""
> :;
> "
> -              "    r
> -          - -- -              -
> r
> 
> - - -- - •...._____.,
> Of all        p1l - gnm-ag- es                                 the great-est                 IS
> 
> e
> heart.
> 
> e
> heart.
> 
> u
> to re - lieve                      the               sor - row - la - den                heart.
> (The choir section is optional)
> IF IT BE THY PLEASURE                   Prayers and Meditations of Bahii'u'll!ih
> 
> UNITED STATES                                                                                                              Abe Tobis
> 
> r              ~       p I bf ['
> ~
> If    it       be Thy plea - sure,                              make     me to grow                 as a ten -
> 
> j J J j IJ J J
> ~                                                                                                              b r r;;
> j                   ,,
> ~                            I                                                                     "I
> der     herb                            in     the mea- dows                of Thy grace,                that the gen - tie
> 
> f r ::= r
> winds
> ~ ~
> of Thy will
> 'I
> F        r f; I Ji F v
> may stir me up               and bend       me
> 'I    LJ I~
> in - to
> 
> ~s 0 r                       D
> ,J
> er I~ j A                                          r F r fl
> con - form             i    - ty                   with      Thy               plea - sure,             in such wise that
> 
> ~ p r                             r                      FJ I r                             v                  J           J
> my      move - ment                               and        my        still         ness               may          be
> 
> ~ r who!
> r
> ly
> f
> dir
> f
> ect
> r
> ed
> Ip
> by      Thee.
> v                  M
> I
> II
> SOME DAY
> Music by Yrjo Mikkonen
> to words of
> FINLAND                                                                 Teilhard de Chardin
> © Editions du Seuil
> 
> af - ter   mas - ter - ing _ __ __ _ __
> 
> af -       ter        mas - ter - ing _ _ __ _ __
> 
> wind         the waves
> 
> the                                                        ness for God _ _ the
> mp                                                                we shall har-ness_ the
> 
> I1               J    f
> 11'
> the        gra         vi   ty                              the
> 
> the   e - ner-gy of love, Some
> 
> mf
> 
> e - ner-gy
> day _ _                                       mas-ter-ing                    the                                              the
> 
> mas- ter - ing                             the                                                     the
> 
> f                                                                         Jj
> day _ _                                     mas- ter-ing                                                               the
> 
> tide and gra- vi - ty             and        then                        for the         se - cond time                 in the
> 
> and
> jn
> 
> gra       vi           ty         and          then _ _ _                                se - cond time
> 
> his                to - ry              of    the      world                       man         shall             have
> 
> '-----'
> man1 shall        have
> 
> J J J
> his -   to              ry              of             world           man                  shall            have
> 
> dis            COY              ered             fi               re.
> ll                                     '                                    '
> I   ~
> ·~.
> ~
> -
> ~
> 
> -  ~               ~
> 
> -
> ~·
> 
> -                     .                  :
> r- r                                                                             r·
> ~~
> 
> e.J
> I
> dk           -           COY                 ered
> '1ffi              -
> I
> re.
> j
> J.                        ~J
> -J             J                             J                J
> - ..
> .                                                                --                -           ,                                        ..
> I                I           I                 I
> dis          COY                  ered             fi              re. _ _ _ _ _ _ __
> FLOWERS OF THE GARDEN
> Submitted to UNICEF by the Baha'i International Community, this song
> was included in the UNICEF Universal Children's Day kit for 1977
> UNITED ST ATES                                                                 Mrs. Jerald Day
> 
> We      are the flow - ers               one        gar - den ,       Bright      as the mom - ing,
> 
> dawn.          Love - ly in diff - ' ren - ces,         ar - ied        in Jove - li - ness.
> 
> --" -
> r--1      I                   I
> 
> - -- - -                      -- - -.
> I                    I
> 
> f.)
> ~
> 
> v
> ~
> 
> We        are the flow - ers             of       hu     - ma          -
> - ..
> ~
> 
> ni - ty.
> (
> 
> -..             -
> ._
> -         -
> .-                  ...
> - ...
> .
> I      ~
> 
> v   -
> ~
> 
> -                   -    ~          ~
> 
> -                          -         -
> I    I          I    I I           I     rI              I   I
> i I              I
> 
> 2. I am a black rose, dark, exotic,                          5. I am a white rose, gleaming, shilling,
> Poignant in beauty, fragrant as                              Sparkling like snow on the
> the night.                                          mountainside,
> God has entrusted me with joy and                            Restless as whitecaps flun g by
> mystery.                                     the ocean's breeze.
> We are the flowers of humanity .                             We are the flo wers of humanity.
> (All together)
> 6. Brown is my color, rich and glowing,
> 3. I am a red rose, sweet and lovely ,                          FuII of the warmth of God's sweet Jove,
> Gay as a bird on a bright summer day,                        Heir to all nations, grandeur my
> Singing the song of God, where'er I                                                 destiny.
> wander.                             We are the flowers of humanity.
> We are the flowers of humanity.
> 7. We are the flowers of God's gard en
> 4. My color's golden, bright as sunshine                        Bright as the morning, fresh as
> Gilding the ocean and the morning sky,                                         the daw n,
> Soft as a summer mist, sweet in                              Lovely in differences, varied in
> the valley.                                                  loveliness.
> We are the flowers of humanity.                              We are the flowers of humanity.
> BAHA 'U 'LLAH
> UNITED STATES                                                                                                                                                                          Russell Garcia
> 
> Ba - M                                       'u - 'llah
> I
> -.
> I
> ,~
> -                      -                                                                                                        :.
> :;         '       r            :                                                           r
> 
> - ~r              ,.
> u
> 
> p
> f         r
> Ya
> i
> Ba
> &
> 
> 11a
> ah
> 1' ..                                t              ......                         ~                                                                                             ~kJ.
> - - .......-·------
> ~
> '
> -                                                                                                             -·                -I'
> ~
> 
>  ,_,_·· :;                 ~        -
> I
> :          ~
> ~
> ~
> 
> I
> ~
> 
> I'
> -
> ~
> 
> I
> ~~
> 
> I
> Ya           Ba - ha - 'u -'llah                                                          Ba -
> 
> Ba - ha                                           'u           - 'llah
> ,.,                                                                                                 I                                                I                     I
> - :;
> I
> 
> -                           -,                     ,
> 
> u
> ~
> 
> ~
> -
> -                               - c-r- .                             :.
> I                                                                                      Ia                 ha -          h~
> ~
> 
> ah
> I
> .            --              I          1
> -
> r----0                                                        ~.
> -.                 f
> -
> n&
> ~
> 
> I
> :;
> ""   ~
> 
> -                      ~
> ;:
> -·             ~       -
> ~-
> 
> l
> ha _ _ _ __ _ _                                                      Y3.       Ba -          ha - 'u - '113.h _ _ _ _                                                 Ba -
> 
> Ba - ha                                      'u - ' 113.h                                       Ba -
> ,.,                                                                                                     I                                   I                I                                 I
> -                                                                                                                                -
> I
> 
> -                              :.        ;;
> r
> - -
> ~
> ~.
> 
> ::                                - ..             r       •
> 
> I u                                                                                t                  ~a - ha
> '-....__                           .!!.--
> 
> '
> -                                                                ..
> ah                                   ah                                                                    Ba - ha - 'u - 'll3.h
> l-             -~                               •
> J.
> -..- .                              -=-. Ji 1~
> J- J.
> -I
> .0.
> I. -       -
> -                                                                                                                          ~
> 
> h{i _         _ __                _       _                      Ya        Ba - ha - 'u - 'llah _ __                                                                           Ba -
> ha                 'u    - ' llah             Ba     - ha - 'u- 'llfill, Ba          -     ha - 'u - 'llah, Ba -
> 
> llah       -     u - ab -
> 
> ha - 'u - '113.h                               Ba    -   ha                     'u
> cresc. _ _ _
> 
> ha      - 'u - 'llfo _ _ __                   A - llah - u-ab          -       ha _ _ __
> 
> r
> A -                  -           ha _ _--+-_
> 
> ua.11                   u-ab - ha             A    - ua11 - u-ab           -   ha
> -    -    -   -
> 
> .....___....
> r
> A - llah - u-ab -
> r
> 11a
> i i
> Ba - ha - 'u -
> r r       'llah
> >
> 
> J l              J                              J J                                             ,...---.....
> 
> >                                                              >
> ha                                 f
> 
> Ba - ha - 'u                    'na.11.
> 
> >
>
> — *The Baha'i World: Volume 17 (1976-1979) (Used by permission of the curator)*

